Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 2072

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System

V100R003C03

Configuration Guide (U2000)


Issue

01

Date

2011-10-30

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.

Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2011. All rights reserved.


No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written
consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Trademarks and Permissions


and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders.

Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the
customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the
purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information,
and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations
of any kind, either express or implied.
The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the
preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and
recommendations in this document do not constitute the warranty of any kind, express or implied.

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.


Address:

Huawei Industrial Base


Bantian, Longgang
Shenzhen 518129
People's Republic of China

Website:

http://www.huawei.com

Email:

support@huawei.com

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

About This Document

About This Document


Related Versions
The following table lists the product versions related to this document.
Product Name

Version

OptiX RTN 980

V100R003C03

iManager U2000

V100R006C00

Intended Audience
This document describes how to configure various services on the equipment. This document
describes the basic information and configuration process, and uses configuration examples to
show how to set specific parameters.
The intended audience of this document are:
l

Installation and commissioning engineer

Data configuration engineer

System maintenance engineer

Symbol Conventions
The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows.
Symbol

Description
Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk,
which if not avoided, will result in death or
serious injury.
Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level
of risk, which if not avoided, could result in
minor or moderate injury.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

ii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

About This Document

Symbol

Description
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation,
which if not avoided, could result in
equipment damage, data loss, performance
degradation, or unexpected results.
Indicates a tip that may help you solve a
problem or save time.
Provides additional information to emphasize
or supplement important points of the main
text.

GUI Conventions
The GUI conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.
Convention

Description

Boldface

Buttons, menus, parameters, tabs, window, and dialog titles


are in boldface. For example, click OK.

>

Multi-level menus are in boldface and separated by the ">"


signs. For example, choose File > Create > Folder.

Change History
Updates between document issues are cumulative. Therefore, the latest document issue contains
all updates made in previous issues.

Updates in Issue 01 (2011-10-30) Based on Product Version V100R003C03


This is the first document issue for the V100R003C03 product version.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

Contents
About This Document.....................................................................................................................ii
1 Configuration Preparations.........................................................................................................1
1.1 Preparing Documents and Tools.........................................................................................................................2
1.2 Checking Configuration Conditions...................................................................................................................2

2 U2000 Quick Start..........................................................................................................................3


3 Specifying the Configuration Procedure..................................................................................4
4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples....................................................8
4.1 Common Network Scenario of the TDM Radio Network..................................................................................9
4.2 Common Network Scenario of the IP Radio Network.....................................................................................12

5 Configuring the Network Topology........................................................................................18


5.1 Basic Concepts.................................................................................................................................................19
5.1.1 DCN.........................................................................................................................................................19
5.1.2 GNE and Non-GNE.................................................................................................................................20
5.1.3 NE ID and NE IP Address.......................................................................................................................20
5.1.4 Physical Boards and Logical Boards.......................................................................................................21
5.1.5 Fiber/Cable Types....................................................................................................................................22
5.1.6 Subnet......................................................................................................................................................22
5.2 Configuration Procedure...................................................................................................................................22
5.3 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Chain Network Topology)...................................................................29
5.3.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................29
5.3.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................30
5.3.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................31
5.4 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Ring Network Topology).....................................................................33
5.4.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................33
5.4.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................34
5.4.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................35
5.5 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Chain Network).................................................................................37
5.5.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................37
5.5.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................38
5.5.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................39
5.6 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Ring Network)...................................................................................41
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

5.6.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................41


5.6.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................42
5.6.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................42
5.7 Configuration Example (Packet Network).......................................................................................................44
5.7.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................44
5.7.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................46
5.7.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................48

6 Configuring Radio Links...........................................................................................................51


6.1 Basic Concepts.................................................................................................................................................52
6.1.1 Adaptive Modulation...............................................................................................................................52
6.1.2 CCDP and XPIC......................................................................................................................................53
6.1.3 RF Configuration Modes.........................................................................................................................54
6.1.4 PLA..........................................................................................................................................................55
6.2 Configuration Procedure...................................................................................................................................56
6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Chain Network)....................................................68
6.3.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................68
6.3.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................70
6.3.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................73
6.4 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Ring Network)......................................................79
6.4.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................79
6.4.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................81
6.4.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................84
6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network)..................................................88
6.5.1 Networking Diagram...............................................................................................................................88
6.5.2 Service Planning......................................................................................................................................91
6.5.3 Configuration Process..............................................................................................................................95
6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Ring Network)..................................................102
6.6.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................103
6.6.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................106
6.6.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................109
6.7 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Packet Network)......................................................................114
6.7.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................114
6.7.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................117
6.7.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................120

7 Configuring TDM Services.....................................................................................................123


7.1 Basic Concepts...............................................................................................................................................124
7.1.1 Protection Modes for TDM Services.....................................................................................................124
7.1.2 Timeslots for TDM Services on IF Boards...........................................................................................127
7.1.3 Numbering Schemes for SDH Timeslots .............................................................................................128
7.1.4 TDM Timeslot Planning Schemes.........................................................................................................129
7.2 Configuration Procedure on a Per-NE Basis..................................................................................................132
7.3 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio Chain Network)..................................................136
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

7.3.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................136


7.3.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................138
7.3.3 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)..........................................................................................140
7.4 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio Ring Network)....................................................143
7.4.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................143
7.4.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................145
7.4.3 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)..........................................................................................146
7.5 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid Radio Chain Network)...............................................150
7.5.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................150
7.5.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................153
7.5.3 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)..........................................................................................154
7.6 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid Radio Ring Network).................................................157
7.6.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................157
7.6.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................159
7.6.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................160

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane..............................................163


8.1 Basic Concepts...............................................................................................................................................165
8.1.1 What's the Packet Plane.........................................................................................................................165
8.1.2 Ethernet Port Numbers..........................................................................................................................166
8.1.3 Auto-Negotiation...................................................................................................................................166
8.1.4 Flow Control Function...........................................................................................................................168
8.1.5 Native Ethernet Service Types Based on the Packet Plane...................................................................169
8.1.5.1 Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Service...........................................................169
8.1.5.2 VLAN-based E-Line Services......................................................................................................171
8.1.5.3 QinQ-Based E-Line Services........................................................................................................172
8.1.5.4 8021D Bridge-based E-LAN Services.........................................................................................175
8.1.5.5 802.1Q Bridge-based E-LAN Services........................................................................................176
8.1.5.6 802.1ad Bridge-based E-LAN Services........................................................................................177
8.1.6 Typical Mobile Carrier Network Topologies for Ethernet Services.....................................................179
8.1.6.1 Networking of VLAN-Based E-Line Services.............................................................................179
8.1.6.2 Networking of IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services.......................................................180
8.1.6.3 Networking of IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services.......................................................181
8.1.6.4 Comparison Between the Three Networking Modes...................................................................182
8.1.7 MAC Address Table Management........................................................................................................185
8.1.8 VLAN Forwarding Table for E-Line Services......................................................................................186
8.1.9 Split Horizon Group..............................................................................................................................187
8.1.10 Protection for Native Ethernet Services..............................................................................................188
8.2 Configuration Procedure.................................................................................................................................191
8.2.1 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Services)
........................................................................................................................................................................191
8.2.2 Configuration Procedure (Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Services).......................198
8.2.3 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (VLAN-Based E-Line Services)...............................................205
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

vi

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

8.2.4 Configuration Procedure (VLAN-Based E-Line Services)...................................................................213


8.2.5 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (QinQ-Based E-Line Services)..................................................221
8.2.6 Configuration Procedure (QinQ-Based E-Line Services).....................................................................228
8.2.7 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services).............................................235
8.2.8 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services).............................................242
8.2.9 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN Services)...........................................251
8.3 Configuration Example (Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Services)..................................259
8.3.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................259
8.3.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................260
8.3.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................260
8.3.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................261
8.3.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................261
8.3.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................262
8.3.3 End-to-End Configuration Process........................................................................................................264
8.3.4 Per-NE Configuration Process...............................................................................................................264
8.3.4.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................264
8.3.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................264
8.3.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................265
8.3.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................265
8.3.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................267
8.4 Configuration Example (VLAN-Based E-Line Service)................................................................................269
8.4.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................269
8.4.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................272
8.4.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................272
8.4.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................275
8.4.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................275
8.4.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................278
8.4.3 End-to-End Configuration Process........................................................................................................279
8.4.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................280
8.4.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................283
8.4.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................283
8.4.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................285
8.4.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................288
8.4.4 Per-NE Configuration Process...............................................................................................................292
8.4.4.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................292
8.4.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................296
8.4.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................296
8.4.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................298
8.4.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................302
8.5 Configuration Example (QinQ-Based E-Line Service)..................................................................................306
8.5.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................306
8.5.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................309
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

vii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

8.5.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................309


8.5.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................312
8.5.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................313
8.5.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................316
8.5.3 End-to-End Configuration Process........................................................................................................318
8.5.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................318
8.5.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................322
8.5.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................322
8.5.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................324
8.5.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................328
8.5.4 Per-NE Configuration Process...............................................................................................................332
8.5.4.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................332
8.5.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................335
8.5.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................336
8.5.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................339
8.5.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................343
8.6 Configuration Example (802.1d-Bridge-Based E-LAN Service)...................................................................348
8.6.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................348
8.6.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................350
8.6.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................350
8.6.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................354
8.6.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................355
8.6.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................355
8.6.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................357
8.6.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................357
8.6.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................360
8.6.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................361
8.6.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................363
8.6.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................366
8.7 Configuration Example (802.1q-Bridge-Based E-LAN Service)...................................................................369
8.7.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................369
8.7.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................372
8.7.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................372
8.7.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................376
8.7.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................376
8.7.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................377
8.7.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................379
8.7.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................379
8.7.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................385
8.7.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................385
8.7.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................387
8.7.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................391
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

viii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

8.8 Configuration Example (802.1ad-Bridge-Based E-LAN Service).................................................................395


8.8.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................395
8.8.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................398
8.8.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................398
8.8.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................402
8.8.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................402
8.8.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................403
8.8.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................405
8.8.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................405
8.8.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................410
8.8.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................410
8.8.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................413
8.8.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................416
8.9 Configuration Example (Hybrid Configuration of E-Line Services and E-LAN Services)...........................420
8.9.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................420
8.9.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................422
8.9.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................423
8.9.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................426
8.9.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................426
8.9.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................428
8.9.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................430
8.9.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................430
8.9.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................434
8.9.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...............................................................................434
8.9.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................437
8.9.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................440

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services.............................................................445


9.1 Basic Concepts...............................................................................................................................................446
9.1.1 What's the EoS Plane.............................................................................................................................446
9.1.2 What's the EoPDH Plane.......................................................................................................................447
9.1.3 VCTRUNK............................................................................................................................................447
9.1.4 Hub/Spoke.............................................................................................................................................448
9.1.5 EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services...................................................................................................448
9.1.5.1 Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted EPL Services.............................................................448
9.1.5.2 EVPL Services Based on the VLAN............................................................................................449
9.1.5.3 QinQ-based EVPL Services.........................................................................................................451
9.1.5.4 EPLAN Services Based on the 802.1D Bridge............................................................................454
9.1.5.5 EVPLAN Services Based on the 802.1Q Bridge.........................................................................455
9.1.5.6 EVPLAN Services Based on 802.1ad Bridge..............................................................................457
9.2 Configuration Procedure.................................................................................................................................458
9.2.1 Configuration Procedure (Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted EPL Services)...........................458
9.2.2 Configuration Procedure (VLAN-Based EVPL Services)....................................................................464
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

ix

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

9.2.3 Configuration Procedure (QinQ-Based EVPL Services)......................................................................470


9.2.4 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based EPLAN Services)............................................476
9.2.5 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services).........................................482
9.2.6 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services).......................................489
9.3 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Based on TDM Radio)...............................................................496
9.3.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................496
9.3.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................499
9.3.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports).................................................................................................499
9.3.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)........................................................................................502
9.3.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)...........................................................................................503
9.3.2.4 Service Planning (Ethernet Service Cross-Connections).............................................................504
9.3.2.5 Service Planning (QoS)................................................................................................................507
9.3.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................507
9.3.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)........................................................................................507
9.3.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)................................................................................510
9.3.3.3 Configuration Process (Ethernet Services)...................................................................................511
9.3.3.4 Configuration Process (Cross-Connections) ...............................................................................512
9.3.3.5 Configuration Process (QoS)........................................................................................................515
9.3.3.6 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................515
9.4 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Traversing a TDM Network).....................................................517
9.4.1 Networking Diagram.............................................................................................................................517
9.4.2 Service Planning....................................................................................................................................520
9.4.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports on the Packet Plane)................................................................520
9.4.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane)...........................................................521
9.4.2.3 Service Planning (QoS on the Packet Plane)................................................................................521
9.4.2.4 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports on the EFP8 Board).................................................................523
9.4.2.5 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection for the EFP8 Board)........................................................525
9.4.2.6 Service Planning (Ethernet Services on the EFP8 Board)............................................................526
9.4.2.7 Service Planning (Cross-Connections).........................................................................................527
9.4.2.8 Service Planning (QoS of the EFP8 Board).................................................................................528
9.4.3 Configuration Process............................................................................................................................530
9.4.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports on the Packet Plane) .......................................................530
9.4.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane) .................................................531
9.4.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS on the Packet Plane).......................................................................532
9.4.3.4 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports on the EFP8 Board).........................................................534
9.4.3.5 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection on the EFP8 Board)................................................536
9.4.3.6 Configuration Process (Ethernet Services on the EFP8 Board)...................................................538
9.4.3.7 Configuration Process (Cross-Connections) ...............................................................................539
9.4.3.8 Configuration Process (QoS on the EFP8 Board)........................................................................540
9.4.3.9 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)...........................................542

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels..................................................................................................545


10.1 Basic Concept...............................................................................................................................................546
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

10.1.1 MPLS Network Architecture...............................................................................................................546


10.1.2 LSP......................................................................................................................................................546
10.1.3 Protection for MPLS Tunnels..............................................................................................................548
10.2 Configuration Procedure...............................................................................................................................549
10.2.1 End-to-End Configuration Procedure..................................................................................................550
10.2.2 Configuration Procedure (on a Per-NE Basis)....................................................................................560
10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).......................................................570
10.3.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................570
10.3.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................571
10.3.2.1 Service Planning (MPLS Interfaces)..........................................................................................571
10.3.2.2 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel)...............................................................................................574
10.3.2.3 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel APS)......................................................................................575
10.3.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................579
10.3.3 End-to-End Configuration Procedure..................................................................................................581
10.3.3.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Ports).........................................................................................581
10.3.3.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnels).....................................................................................583
10.3.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................586
10.3.3.4 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels).................................................588
10.3.4 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)........................................................................................589
10.3.4.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Interfaces)..................................................................................589
10.3.4.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnel)......................................................................................592
10.3.4.3 Configuration Process (MPLS APS)..........................................................................................599
10.3.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................603
10.3.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels).................................................605
10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No Protection).....................................................................605
10.4.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................605
10.4.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................607
10.4.2.1 Service Planning (MPLS Interfaces)..........................................................................................607
10.4.2.2 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel)...............................................................................................608
10.4.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................610
10.4.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................611
10.4.3.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Interfaces)..................................................................................612
10.4.3.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnels).....................................................................................613
10.4.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................615
10.4.3.4 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels).................................................617
10.4.4 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)........................................................................................618
10.4.4.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Interfaces)..................................................................................618
10.4.4.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnel)......................................................................................620
10.4.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................623
10.4.4.4 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels).................................................624
10.5 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels Traversing L2 Networks)............................................................625
10.5.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................626
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xi

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

10.5.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................627


10.5.2.1 Service Planning (MPLS Ports)..................................................................................................627
10.5.2.2 Service Planning (VLAN Sub-Interfaces)..................................................................................629
10.5.2.3 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel)...............................................................................................631
10.5.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................632
10.5.3 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................634
10.5.3.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Port Information).......................................................................634
10.5.3.2 Configuration Process (VLAN Sub-Interface Information).......................................................637
10.5.3.3 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnel Information)..................................................................638
10.5.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS Information)..................................................................................643
10.5.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels).................................................645

11 Configuring PWE3 Services..................................................................................................648


11.1 Basic Concept...............................................................................................................................................650
11.1.1 Types of PWE3 Services.....................................................................................................................650
11.1.1.1 CES Services..............................................................................................................................650
11.1.1.2 ATM/IMA Services....................................................................................................................652
11.1.1.3 PW-Carried E-Line Services......................................................................................................653
11.1.1.4 PW-Carried E-AGGR Services..................................................................................................656
11.1.2 MS-PW................................................................................................................................................659
11.2 Configuration Procedure...............................................................................................................................661
11.2.1 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (CES Services)........................................................................661
11.2.2 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (CES Services)...............................................................................664
11.2.3 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (ATM Services).......................................................................667
11.2.4 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (ATM Services)..............................................................................672
11.2.5 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (E-Line Services Carried by PWs)..........................................679
11.2.6 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (E-Line Services Carried by PWs).................................................685
11.2.7 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (PW-Carried E-Aggr Services)......................................................693
11.3 Configuration Example (Common CES Services).......................................................................................700
11.3.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................700
11.3.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................701
11.3.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................701
11.3.2.2 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................702
11.3.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................704
11.3.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................704
11.3.3.2 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................705
11.3.3.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)...............................................706
11.3.4 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................706
11.3.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................706
11.3.4.2 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................707
11.3.4.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)...............................................710
11.4 Configuration Example (Fractional CES Services)......................................................................................710
11.4.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................710
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

11.4.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................711


11.4.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................711
11.4.2.2 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................712
11.4.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................714
11.4.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................714
11.4.3.2 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................715
11.4.3.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)...............................................716
11.4.4 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................716
11.4.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................716
11.4.4.2 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................717
11.4.4.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)...............................................720
11.5 Configuration Example (MS-PW-based CES Services)..............................................................................720
11.5.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................720
11.5.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................721
11.5.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................722
11.5.2.2 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................722
11.5.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................724
11.5.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................724
11.5.3.2 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................725
11.5.3.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)...............................................726
11.5.4 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................726
11.5.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................726
11.5.4.2 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................727
11.5.4.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)...............................................731
11.6 Configuration Example (Common ATM Services)......................................................................................731
11.6.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................731
11.6.2 ServicePlanning...................................................................................................................................733
11.6.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................733
11.6.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)...............................................................................734
11.6.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................736
11.6.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................738
11.6.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................740
11.6.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................741
11.6.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................742
11.6.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS Information)..................................................................................744
11.6.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................745
11.6.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................747
11.6.4 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................747
11.6.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................747
11.6.4.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................748
11.6.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................750
11.6.4.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................752
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xiii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

11.6.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................757


11.7 Configuration Example (Fractional ATM Services)....................................................................................757
11.7.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................757
11.7.2 ServicePlanning...................................................................................................................................759
11.7.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................759
11.7.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)...............................................................................760
11.7.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................761
11.7.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................763
11.7.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................765
11.7.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................765
11.7.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................767
11.7.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS Information)..................................................................................769
11.7.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................770
11.7.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................772
11.7.4 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................772
11.7.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................772
11.7.4.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................774
11.7.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................776
11.7.4.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................777
11.7.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................782
11.8 Configuration Example (ATM Services on MS-PWs).................................................................................783
11.8.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................783
11.8.2 ServicePlanning...................................................................................................................................784
11.8.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................784
11.8.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)...............................................................................784
11.8.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................786
11.8.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................787
11.8.3 End-to-End Configuration Process......................................................................................................793
11.8.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................793
11.8.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................794
11.8.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS Information)..................................................................................796
11.8.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................797
11.8.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................799
11.8.4 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................799
11.8.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................799
11.8.4.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................800
11.8.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................802
11.8.4.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................803
11.8.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................813
11.9 Configuration Example (Transparently Transmitted ATM Services)..........................................................813
11.9.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................813
11.9.2 ServicePlanning...................................................................................................................................814
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xiv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

11.9.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports).....................................................................................................814


11.9.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)...............................................................................815
11.9.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)..............................................................................................................817
11.9.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information).....................................................................................817
11.9.3 Per-NE Configuration Process.............................................................................................................819
11.9.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports).............................................................................................819
11.9.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information).................................................................................820
11.9.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS)......................................................................................................823
11.9.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information).............................................................................823
11.9.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations).............................................827
11.10 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on PWs, a Simple Example).......................................828
11.10.1 Networking Diagram.........................................................................................................................828
11.10.2 Service Planning................................................................................................................................829
11.10.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)...................................................................................................829
11.10.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)....................................................................................831
11.10.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)...................................................................................831
11.10.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)............................................................................................................832
11.10.3 End-to-End Configuration Process....................................................................................................834
11.10.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................834
11.10.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................835
11.10.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................836
11.10.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)....................................................................................................837
11.10.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................839
11.10.4 Per-NE Configuration Process...........................................................................................................841
11.10.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................841
11.10.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................842
11.10.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................843
11.10.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)....................................................................................................845
11.10.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................847
11.11 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on PWs and Transmitting the Ethernet Services Aggregated
from the Hybrid Microwave Network).................................................................................................................849
11.11.1 Networking Diagram.........................................................................................................................849
11.11.2 Service Planning................................................................................................................................851
11.11.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)...................................................................................................851
11.11.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)....................................................................................852
11.11.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)...................................................................................853
11.11.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)............................................................................................................854
11.11.3 End-to-End Configuration Process....................................................................................................856
11.11.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................856
11.11.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................857
11.11.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................858
11.11.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)....................................................................................................860
11.11.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................861
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

11.11.4 Per-NE Configuration Process...........................................................................................................864


11.11.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................864
11.11.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................865
11.11.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................866
11.11.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)....................................................................................................870
11.11.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................872
11.12 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on MS-PWs)................................................................874
11.12.1 Networking Diagram.........................................................................................................................874
11.12.2 Service Planning................................................................................................................................875
11.12.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)...................................................................................................875
11.12.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)....................................................................................877
11.12.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)...................................................................................877
11.12.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)............................................................................................................879
11.12.3 End-to-End Configuration Process....................................................................................................880
11.12.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................881
11.12.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................882
11.12.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................882
11.12.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)....................................................................................................884
11.12.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................885
11.12.4 Per-NE Configuration Process...........................................................................................................888
11.12.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................888
11.12.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................889
11.12.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................890
11.12.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)....................................................................................................893
11.12.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................894
11.13 Configuration Example (PW-Carried E-AGGR Services).........................................................................896
11.13.1 Networking Diagram.........................................................................................................................896
11.13.2 Service Planning................................................................................................................................898
11.13.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)...................................................................................................898
11.13.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)....................................................................................900
11.13.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)...................................................................................900
11.13.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)............................................................................................................903
11.13.3 Per-NE Configuration Process...........................................................................................................904
11.13.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)...........................................................................................904
11.13.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)............................................................................906
11.13.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)...........................................................................907
11.13.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS Information)................................................................................911
11.13.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations).......................................912

12 Configuring the Clock............................................................................................................915


12.1 Basic Concepts.............................................................................................................................................916
12.1.1 Clock Source........................................................................................................................................916
12.1.2 Clock Protection Modes......................................................................................................................916
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xvi

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy.............................................................................................................920


12.2 Configuration Procedure...............................................................................................................................926
12.3 Configuration Example (Clock for a TDM Radio Chain Network).............................................................929
12.3.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................929
12.3.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................931
12.3.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................932
12.4 Configuration Example (Clock for a TDM Radio Ring Network)...............................................................933
12.4.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................933
12.4.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................935
12.4.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................936
12.5 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Chain Network)...........................................................937
12.5.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................937
12.5.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................939
12.5.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................939
12.6 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Ring Network)............................................................940
12.6.1 Network Diagram ...............................................................................................................................940
12.6.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................942
12.6.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................943
12.7 Configuration Example (Clocks for a PSN).................................................................................................944
12.7.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................944
12.7.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................946
12.7.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................948
12.8 Configuration Example (Clocks Across a Third-party TDM Network).......................................................949
12.8.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................949
12.8.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................950
12.8.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................950

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions.......................................................................952


13.1 Auxiliary Ports and Functions......................................................................................................................954
13.2 Environment Monitoring Functions.............................................................................................................956
13.3 Configuration Example (Orderwire)............................................................................................................957
13.3.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................957
13.3.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................958
13.3.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................960
13.4 Configuration Example (Synchronous Data Services).................................................................................961
13.4.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................961
13.4.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................963
13.4.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................963
13.5 Configuration Example (Asynchronous Data Services)...............................................................................964
13.5.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................964
13.5.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................966
13.5.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................966
13.6 Configuration Example (Wayside E1 Services)...........................................................................................967
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xvii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

13.6.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................967


13.6.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................967
13.6.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................968
13.7 Configuration Example (External Alarms)...................................................................................................968
13.7.1 Networking Diagram...........................................................................................................................968
13.7.2 Service Planning..................................................................................................................................969
13.7.3 Configuration Process..........................................................................................................................970

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data......................................................................971


14.1 Common Task Collection (Network Topology)...........................................................................................972
14.2 Common Task Collection (Radio Links)......................................................................................................973
14.3 Common Task Collection (TDM Services)..................................................................................................977
14.4 Common Task Collection (Packet-Plane Ethernet Services).......................................................................978
14.5 Task Collection (EoS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet Services)..............................................................................980

A Task Collection.........................................................................................................................983
A.1 U2000 Quick Start.........................................................................................................................................985
A.1.1 Logging in to a U2000 Client...............................................................................................................985
A.1.2 Shutting Down a U2000 Client.............................................................................................................985
A.1.3 Using Online Help................................................................................................................................986
A.1.4 Navigating to Common Views.............................................................................................................986
A.1.4.1 Navigating to the Main Topology................................................................................................986
A.1.4.2 Navigating to the NE Explorer....................................................................................................987
A.1.4.3 Navigating to the NE Panel.........................................................................................................988
A.2 Network Management...................................................................................................................................988
A.2.1 Managing NEs......................................................................................................................................988
A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method.................................................................................988
A.2.1.2 Creating NEs by Using the Manual Method................................................................................990
A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board....................................................................................................992
A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID....................................................................................................................993
A.2.1.5 Changing the NE Name...............................................................................................................994
A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time........................................................................................................995
A.2.1.7 Localizing the NE Time...............................................................................................................998
A.2.1.8 Configuring Standard NTP Keys.................................................................................................998
A.2.2 Configuring the NE Data......................................................................................................................999
A.2.2.1 Uploading the NE Data..............................................................................................................1000
A.2.2.2 Synchronizing NE Data.............................................................................................................1000
A.2.3 Configuring the Performance Monitoring Status of NEs...................................................................1001
A.2.4 Suppressing Alarms for Monitored Objects.......................................................................................1002
A.2.5 Connecting Fibers or Cables...............................................................................................................1003
A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method...............................................................1003
A.2.5.2 Creating Fibers Manually..........................................................................................................1004
A.2.5.3 Creating an Extended ECC........................................................................................................1005
A.2.5.4 Creating a Back-to-Back Radio Connection..............................................................................1005
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xviii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.2.6 Managing Subnets..............................................................................................................................1006


A.2.6.1 Creating a Subnet.......................................................................................................................1006
A.2.6.2 Copying Topology Objects........................................................................................................1008
A.2.6.3 Moving Topology Objects.........................................................................................................1008
A.2.7 Managing Communication.................................................................................................................1008
A.2.7.1 Setting NE Communication Parameters....................................................................................1009
A.2.7.2 Configuring DCCs.....................................................................................................................1010
A.2.7.3 Configuring DCC Transparent Transmission............................................................................1011
A.2.7.4 Configuring the VLAN ID and Bandwidth Used by an Inband DCN.......................................1012
A.2.7.5 Configuring the Priority of Inband DCN Packets......................................................................1013
A.2.7.6 Setting Parameters of Inband DCN...........................................................................................1013
A.2.7.7 Configuring Access Control......................................................................................................1014
A.2.7.8 Configuring Extended ECC Communication............................................................................1015
A.2.7.9 Creating Static IP Routes...........................................................................................................1017
A.2.7.10 Setting OSPF Protocol Parameters..........................................................................................1018
A.2.7.11 Creating an OSPF Area...........................................................................................................1019
A.2.7.12 Configuring the Network Information of an ABR..................................................................1020
A.2.7.13 Creating a Manual Route Aggregation Group.........................................................................1020
A.2.7.14 Configuring Interface IP Addresses of an ABR......................................................................1021
A.2.7.15 Configuring the OSPF Authentication Type...........................................................................1022
A.2.7.16 Enabling the Proxy ARP..........................................................................................................1023
A.2.7.17 Configuring the CLNS Role....................................................................................................1024
A.2.7.18 Configuring the OSI Tunnel....................................................................................................1025
A.2.7.19 Configuring OSI Port Parameters............................................................................................1026
A.2.7.20 Enabling/Disabling the RSTP Protocol When the L2 DCN Solution Is Used........................1026
A.2.7.21 Querying ECC Routes.............................................................................................................1027
A.2.7.22 Querying IP Routes..................................................................................................................1027
A.2.7.23 Querying OSI Routes...............................................................................................................1028
A.2.7.24 Verifying Connectivity of an ECC Network...........................................................................1029
A.2.7.25 Verifying Connectivity of an IP DCN Network......................................................................1029
A.2.7.26 Configuring the Active and Standby Gateway NEs................................................................1030
A.2.8 Configuring the Network Management Port and LCT Access to an NE............................................1031
A.2.8.1 Configuring the Ethernet Network Management Port on an NE...............................................1031
A.2.8.2 Configuring the Network Management Serial Port on an NE...................................................1032
A.2.8.3 Configuring LCT Access to NEs...............................................................................................1032
A.2.9 Configuring an NE User.....................................................................................................................1033
A.2.9.1 Creating an NE User..................................................................................................................1033
A.2.9.2 Changing the Password of an NE User......................................................................................1034
A.2.9.3 Setting Warning Screen Parameters..........................................................................................1035
A.2.9.4 Switching NE Users...................................................................................................................1036
A.2.10 Configuring SSL Protocol Communication......................................................................................1037
A.2.10.1 Configuring SSL Protocol Communication Between a U2000 Server and its Clients............1037
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xix

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.2.10.2 Configuring the Connection Mode Between a U2000 Client and Its Gateway NE................1038
A.2.11 Configuring RADIUS Authentication..............................................................................................1040
A.2.11.1 Enabling/Disabling the RADIUS Function.............................................................................1040
A.2.11.2 Creating a RADIUS Server or a RADIUS Proxy Server........................................................1041
A.2.11.3 Configuring RADIUS Server Parameters................................................................................1042
A.3 Managing Radio Links................................................................................................................................1044
A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group.................................................................................................1044
A.3.2 Creating an XPIC Workgroup............................................................................................................1046
A.3.3 Setting the AM Attributes of the XPIC Workgroup...........................................................................1047
A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link......................................................................1049
A.3.5 Creating an N+1 Protection Group.....................................................................................................1051
A.3.6 Querying the IF 1+1 Protection Status...............................................................................................1052
A.3.7 Querying the IF N+1 Protection Status..............................................................................................1053
A.3.8 IF 1+1 Protection Switching...............................................................................................................1054
A.3.9 IF N+1 Protection Switching..............................................................................................................1054
A.3.10 Starting/Stopping the N+1 Protection Protocol................................................................................1055
A.3.11 Creating a PLA Group......................................................................................................................1055
A.3.12 Querying the Status of a PLA Group................................................................................................1057
A.4 Managing the MSP......................................................................................................................................1058
A.4.1 Configuring Linear MSP....................................................................................................................1058
A.4.2 Querying the Status of the Linear MSP..............................................................................................1059
A.4.3 Performing Linear MSP Switching....................................................................................................1060
A.4.4 Starting/Stopping the Linear MSP Protocol.......................................................................................1061
A.4.5 Configuring Ring MSP.......................................................................................................................1062
A.4.6 Querying Ring MSP Status.................................................................................................................1063
A.4.7 Triggering Ring MSP Switching........................................................................................................1064
A.4.8 Starting/Stopping the Ring MSP Protocol..........................................................................................1065
A.5 Managing TDM Services.............................................................................................................................1065
A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services...............................................................1066
A.5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP Services.................................................................................1067
A.5.3 Modifying the Priorities of E1 Services.............................................................................................1067
A.5.4 Inserting E1_AIS upon a TU_AIS Condition.....................................................................................1069
A.5.5 Configuring the Automatic Switching of SNCP Services..................................................................1069
A.5.6 Deleting Cross-Connections...............................................................................................................1070
A.5.7 Converting a Normal Service into an SNCP Service.........................................................................1071
A.5.8 Converting an SNCP Service to a Normal Service............................................................................1072
A.5.9 Querying TDM Services.....................................................................................................................1073
A.5.10 Switching SNCP Services.................................................................................................................1074
A.5.11 Querying the Protection Status of SNCP Services...........................................................................1074
A.6 Managing Ports............................................................................................................................................1075
A.6.1 Setting the Parameters of SDH Ports..................................................................................................1075
A.6.2 Setting the Parameters of PDH Ports..................................................................................................1076
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xx

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.6.3 Configuring Overhead Bytes..............................................................................................................1077


A.6.3.1 Configuring RSOHs...................................................................................................................1077
A.6.3.2 Configuring VC-4 POHs...........................................................................................................1078
A.6.3.3 Configuring VC-12 POHs.........................................................................................................1079
A.6.4 Setting Smart E1 Port Parameters.......................................................................................................1081
A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports................................................................................1081
A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports........................................................................1082
A.6.5 Setting Serial Port Parameters............................................................................................................1082
A.6.5.1 Creating Serial Ports..................................................................................................................1082
A.6.5.2 Setting Basic Attributes of Serial Ports.....................................................................................1083
A.6.6 Setting Ethernet Port Parameters........................................................................................................1084
A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports.......................................................................1084
A.6.6.2 Configuring the Traffic Control of Ethernet Ports....................................................................1085
A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports........................................................................1086
A.6.6.4 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of Ethernet Ports..............................................................................1087
A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports....................................................................1088
A.6.7 Setting IF_ETH Port Parameters........................................................................................................1089
A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports........................................................................1089
A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports........................................................................1090
A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports..............................................................................1091
A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports....................................................................1092
A.6.8 Setting IF Port Parameters..................................................................................................................1092
A.6.8.1 Setting IF Attributes..................................................................................................................1092
A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes....................................................................................................1094
A.6.8.3 Setting Advanced AM Attributes..............................................................................................1095
A.6.8.4 Querying the AM Status............................................................................................................1096
A.6.8.5 Querying ATPC Adjustment Records.......................................................................................1097
A.6.8.6 Modifying the Hybrid/AM Attributes.......................................................................................1097
A.6.9 Setting ODU Port Parameters.............................................................................................................1100
A.6.9.1 Setting ODU Transmit Frequency Attributes............................................................................1100
A.6.9.2 Querying ODU Information......................................................................................................1100
A.6.9.3 Setting ODU Power Attributes..................................................................................................1101
A.6.9.4 Setting ODU Advanced Attributes............................................................................................1102
A.6.9.5 Setting the ODU Transmitter State............................................................................................1103
A.6.9.6 Querying the Historical Transmit Power and Receive Power...................................................1104
A.6.9.7 Querying the SNR Values of a Radio Link...............................................................................1104
A.6.10 Creating VLAN Sub-Interfaces........................................................................................................1105
A.7 Configuring Ethernet Services and Features on the Packet Plane...............................................................1106
A.7.1 Managing ERPS..................................................................................................................................1106
A.7.1.1 Creating Ethernet Ring Protection Instances.............................................................................1106
A.7.1.2 Setting the Parameters of Ethernet Ring Protocol.....................................................................1107
A.7.1.3 Querying the Status of the Ethernet Ring Protocol...................................................................1108
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxi

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.7.2 Managing the LAG.............................................................................................................................1109


A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG..........................................................................................................................1109
A.7.2.2 Setting LAG Parameters............................................................................................................1111
A.7.2.3 Querying the Protocol Information of the LAG........................................................................1112
A.7.3 Configuring Ethernet Services............................................................................................................1113
A.7.3.1 Configuring the QinQ Link.......................................................................................................1113
A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services.....................................................................................1113
A.7.3.3 Configuring NNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links)............................................1114
A.7.3.4 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links)............................................1115
A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs).......................................................1116
A.7.3.6 Creating E-AGGR Services.......................................................................................................1118
A.7.3.7 Creating a VLAN Forwarding Table for an E-Line Service.....................................................1121
A.7.3.8 Configuring TPID for a Request VLAN...................................................................................1122
A.7.3.9 Configuring IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services........................................................1122
A.7.3.10 Configuring IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services......................................................1124
A.7.3.11 Configuring IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN Services....................................................1125
A.7.3.12 Changing Logical Ports Connected to a VB............................................................................1127
A.7.3.13 Deleting an E-Line Service......................................................................................................1128
A.7.3.14 Deleting E-LAN Services........................................................................................................1128
A.7.4 Managing the MAC Address Table....................................................................................................1129
A.7.4.1 Creating a Static MAC Address Entry.......................................................................................1129
A.7.4.2 Creating a Blacklist Entry of MAC Addresses..........................................................................1130
A.7.4.3 Configuring the Aging Parameters of a MAC Address Table...................................................1130
A.7.4.4 Querying or Deleting a Dynamic MAC Address......................................................................1131
A.7.5 Setting the Mode for Processing an Unknown Frame of the E-LAN Service....................................1132
A.7.6 Managing the MSTP...........................................................................................................................1132
A.7.6.1 Creating the MSTP Port Group.................................................................................................1132
A.7.6.2 Setting the Bridge Parameters of the MSTP..............................................................................1134
A.7.6.3 Setting the Parameters of the CIST...........................................................................................1134
A.7.6.4 Querying the CIST Running Information..................................................................................1135
A.7.6.5 Changing the Spanning Tree Protocol Used by the Port Group................................................1136
A.7.6.6 Enabling/Disabling the MSTP Protocol....................................................................................1136
A.7.6.7 Modifying the Configuration Data of the MSTP Port Group....................................................1137
A.7.7 Managing the QoS..............................................................................................................................1138
A.7.7.1 Creating a DS Domain...............................................................................................................1139
A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain.......................................................1140
A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their Trusted Packet Types........................1142
A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy................................................................................................................1144
A.7.7.5 Modifying the Port Policy.........................................................................................................1146
A.7.7.6 Creating Traffic.........................................................................................................................1146
A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy.................................................................................1148
A.7.7.8 Configuring Port Shaping..........................................................................................................1149
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.7.7.9 Querying the Port Policy...........................................................................................................1150


A.7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port..........................................................................................1151
A.7.8 Using the IEEE 802.1ag OAM...........................................................................................................1152
A.7.8.1 Creating an MD.........................................................................................................................1152
A.7.8.2 Creating an MA.........................................................................................................................1153
A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs...........................................................................................................................1154
A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA.............................................................................................1155
A.7.8.5 Creating MIPs............................................................................................................................1156
A.7.8.6 Performing a CC Test................................................................................................................1157
A.7.8.7 Performing an LB Test..............................................................................................................1158
A.7.8.8 Performing an LT Test...............................................................................................................1159
A.7.8.9 Activating the AIS.....................................................................................................................1160
A.7.8.10 Monitoring Packet Loss Ratio, Delay, or Delay Variation of Ethernet Services....................1161
A.7.8.11 E-LAN Service Loopback Detection.......................................................................................1162
A.7.8.12 Reactivating E-LAN Services..................................................................................................1163
A.7.9 Using the IEEE 802.3ah OAM ..........................................................................................................1163
A.7.9.1 Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function...........................................................................1163
A.7.9.2 Enabling the Link Event Notification .......................................................................................1164
A.7.9.3 Modifying the OAM Error Frame Monitoring Threshold ........................................................1165
A.7.9.4 Performing Remote Loopbacks.................................................................................................1166
A.7.9.5 Enabling Self-Loop Detection...................................................................................................1167
A.7.10 LPT Configuration............................................................................................................................1168
A.7.10.1 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing an L2 Network..................................................1168
A.7.10.2 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing a PSN or QinQ Network...................................1169
A.7.10.3 Configuring Point-to-Multipoint LPT.....................................................................................1170
A.7.10.4 Configuring Simple LPT.........................................................................................................1171
A.8 Configuring Ethernet Services and Features on the EoS/EoPDH Plane.....................................................1172
A.8.1 Managing ERPS..................................................................................................................................1172
A.8.1.1 Creating ERPS Instances...........................................................................................................1172
A.8.1.2 Setting the Parameters of the ERPS Protocol............................................................................1173
A.8.1.3 Querying the Status of the ERPS Protocol................................................................................1174
A.8.2 Managing LAGs ................................................................................................................................1174
A.8.2.1 Creating a LAG..........................................................................................................................1174
A.8.2.2 Setting Parameters for LAGs.....................................................................................................1176
A.8.2.3 Querying the Protocol Information of LAGs.............................................................................1177
A.8.3 Configuring Ethernet Services............................................................................................................1177
A.8.3.1 Creating Ethernet Private Line Services....................................................................................1178
A.8.3.2 Creating Ethernet LAN Services...............................................................................................1180
A.8.3.3 Changing the Ports Connected to a VB.....................................................................................1184
A.8.3.4 Creating the VLAN Filtering Table...........................................................................................1185
A.8.3.5 Creating QinQ-Based EVPL Services.......................................................................................1186
A.8.3.6 Creating IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services........................................................1188
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxiii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.8.3.7 Deleting an Ethernet Private Line Service.................................................................................1191


A.8.3.8 Deleting an Ethernet LAN Service............................................................................................1191
A.8.4 Managing the MAC Address Table....................................................................................................1192
A.8.4.1 Creating a Static MAC Address Entry.......................................................................................1192
A.8.4.2 Creating a Blacklist Entry of a MAC Address..........................................................................1193
A.8.4.3 Setting the Aging Time of a MAC Address Table Entry .........................................................1194
A.8.4.4 Querying or Deleting a Dynamic MAC Address......................................................................1195
A.8.4.5 Querying the Actual Capacity of a MAC Address Table..........................................................1195
A.8.5 Configuring Ethernet Ports.................................................................................................................1196
A.8.5.1 Configuring External Ethernet Ports.........................................................................................1196
A.8.5.2 Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board.......................................................................1198
A.8.5.3 Modifying the Type Field of QinQ Frames...............................................................................1200
A.8.5.4 Dynamically Increasing/Decreasing the VCTRUNK Bandwidth.............................................1200
A.8.6 Managing the Spanning Tree Protocol...............................................................................................1202
A.8.6.1 Configuring the Type and Enabled Status of the Spanning Tree Protocol................................1202
A.8.6.2 Setting the Parameters of Spanning Tree Protocol....................................................................1202
A.8.6.3 Querying the Running Information About the Spanning Tree Protocol....................................1204
A.8.7 Managing the IGMP Snooping Protocol............................................................................................1204
A.8.7.1 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Protocol................................................................................1204
A.8.7.2 Configuring Static Multicast Entries.........................................................................................1205
A.8.7.3 Modifying the Aging Time of a Multicast Table Entry.............................................................1206
A.8.7.4 Querying the Running Information of the IGMP Snooping Protocol.......................................1207
A.8.8 Managing the QoS..............................................................................................................................1208
A.8.8.1 Creating a Flow..........................................................................................................................1208
A.8.8.2 Creating the CAR......................................................................................................................1209
A.8.8.3 Creating the CoS........................................................................................................................1209
A.8.8.4 Binding the CAR/CoS...............................................................................................................1211
A.8.8.5 Configuring Traffic Shaping for Egress Queues.......................................................................1212
A.8.8.6 Configuring Port Shaping..........................................................................................................1213
A.8.8.7 Setting Egress Queue Scheduling Policies................................................................................1213
A.8.9 Using the Ethernet service OAM........................................................................................................1214
A.8.9.1 Creating MDs.............................................................................................................................1214
A.8.9.2 Creating MAs.............................................................................................................................1215
A.8.9.3 Creating MPs.............................................................................................................................1216
A.8.9.4 Performing a CC Test................................................................................................................1217
A.8.9.5 Performing an LB Test..............................................................................................................1218
A.8.9.6 Performing an LT Test...............................................................................................................1219
A.8.9.7 Activating the AIS.....................................................................................................................1220
A.8.9.8 Performing a Ping Test .............................................................................................................1221
A.8.9.9 Performing Performance Check................................................................................................1222
A.8.10 Using the Ethernet port OAM...........................................................................................................1223
A.8.10.1 Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function.........................................................................1223
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxiv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.8.10.2 Enabling the Link Event Notification......................................................................................1224


A.8.10.3 Modifying the OAM Error Frame Monitoring Threshold.......................................................1225
A.8.10.4 Performing the Remote Loopback...........................................................................................1226
A.8.11 Configuring LPT...............................................................................................................................1227
A.8.11.1 Configuring LPT for Point-to-Point Services..........................................................................1227
A.8.11.2 Configuring LPT for Point-to-Multipoint Services.................................................................1228
A.9 Managing MPLS/PWE3 Services and Features..........................................................................................1230
A.9.1 Managing Address Resolution............................................................................................................1230
A.9.1.1 Creating ARP Static Entries......................................................................................................1230
A.9.1.2 Querying ARP Entries...............................................................................................................1231
A.9.1.3 Converting Dynamic ARP Entries to Static ARP Entries.........................................................1231
A.9.1.4 Deleting Static ARP Entries......................................................................................................1231
A.9.1.5 Setting ARP Aging Time...........................................................................................................1232
A.9.2 Managing MPLS Tunnels...................................................................................................................1232
A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes..................................................................................................1233
A.9.2.2 Creating a Unidirectional MPLS Tunnel...................................................................................1233
A.9.2.3 Creating a Bidirectional MPLS Tunnel.....................................................................................1235
A.9.2.4 Querying MPLS Tunnel Information........................................................................................1236
A.9.2.5 Changing MPLS Tunnel Information........................................................................................1237
A.9.2.6 Deleting MPLS Tunnels............................................................................................................1237
A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM Parameters...............................................................................................1238
A.9.2.8 Enabling/Disabling FDI.............................................................................................................1239
A.9.2.9 Starting/Stopping CV/FFD Detection for MPLS Tunnels.........................................................1239
A.9.2.10 Querying LSP Running Status.................................................................................................1240
A.9.2.11 Clearing OAM Configuration Data for MPLS Tunnels..........................................................1241
A.9.2.12 Performing an LSP Ping Test..................................................................................................1241
A.9.2.13 Performing an LSP Traceroute Test........................................................................................1242
A.9.3 Managing MPLS APS Protection Groups..........................................................................................1243
A.9.3.1 Creating an MPLS APS Protection Group................................................................................1243
A.9.3.2 Querying MPLS APS Status......................................................................................................1245
A.9.3.3 Triggering MPLS APS Switching.............................................................................................1246
A.9.3.4 Enabling/Disabling MPLS APS Protection...............................................................................1247
A.9.4 Managing PWs....................................................................................................................................1248
A.9.4.1 Querying Information and Running Status of PWs...................................................................1248
A.9.4.2 Creating an MS-PW...................................................................................................................1248
A.9.4.3 Setting PW OAM Parameters....................................................................................................1250
A.9.4.4 Performing a PW Ping Test.......................................................................................................1251
A.9.4.5 Performing a PW Traceroute Test.............................................................................................1252
A.9.5 Managing a PW APS Protection Group.............................................................................................1253
A.9.5.1 Creating a PW APS Protection Group.......................................................................................1253
A.9.5.2 Configuring Slave Protection Pairs of PW APS........................................................................1255
A.9.5.3 Querying PW APS Status..........................................................................................................1256
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.9.5.4 Triggering PW APS Switching..................................................................................................1257


A.9.5.5 Enabling/Disabling PW APS Protection...................................................................................1258
A.9.6 Managing CES Services.....................................................................................................................1259
A.9.6.1 Creating CES Services...............................................................................................................1259
A.9.6.2 Modifying CES Service Parameters..........................................................................................1261
A.9.6.3 Querying CES Service Information...........................................................................................1262
A.9.6.4 Deleting a CES Service.............................................................................................................1262
A.9.7 Managing ATM/IMA Ports................................................................................................................1263
A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs............................................................................................................1263
A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group .......................................................................................................1264
A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters....................................................................................................1265
A.9.7.4 Querying Running Status of an IMA Group..............................................................................1266
A.9.7.5 Querying Link Running Status of an IMA Group.....................................................................1266
A.9.8 Managing ATM Services....................................................................................................................1267
A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services.............................................................................................................1267
A.9.8.2 Modifying ATM Service Parameters.........................................................................................1270
A.9.8.3 Querying ATM Services............................................................................................................1270
A.9.8.4 Deleting an ATM Service..........................................................................................................1271
A.9.9 ATM Traffic Management.................................................................................................................1271
A.9.9.1 Creating an ATM-DiffServ Domain..........................................................................................1271
A.9.9.2 Modifying an ATM-Diffserv Domain.......................................................................................1272
A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy............................................................................................................1274
A.9.9.4 Modifying an ATM Policy........................................................................................................1275
A.9.10 Using ATM OAM.............................................................................................................................1275
A.9.10.1 Setting Segment and End Attributes of AIS/RDI....................................................................1275
A.9.10.2 Performing a Continuity Check Test.......................................................................................1276
A.9.10.3 Querying or Setting LLIDs......................................................................................................1277
A.9.10.4 Performing an LB Test............................................................................................................1277
A.10 Managing the Clock...................................................................................................................................1278
A.10.1 Managing Clocks at the Physical Layer...........................................................................................1278
A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources................................................................................................1278
A.10.1.2 Configuring Clock Subnets......................................................................................................1279
A.10.1.3 User-Defined Clock Quality....................................................................................................1280
A.10.1.4 Configuring the SSM Output Status........................................................................................1281
A.10.1.5 Configuring the Clock ID Output Status.................................................................................1282
A.10.1.6 Modifying the Parameters of the Clock Output.......................................................................1282
A.10.1.7 Configuring Clock Sources for External Clock Output...........................................................1283
A.10.1.8 Changing the Conditions for Clock Source Switching............................................................1284
A.10.1.9 Modifying the Recovery Parameter of the Clock Source........................................................1285
A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status..........................................................................1285
A.10.2 Managing CES ACR Clocks............................................................................................................1286
A.10.2.1 Configuring the Primary Clock for an ACR Clock Domain...................................................1286
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxvi

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.10.2.2 Configuring Ports Using the Clock Domain............................................................................1287


A.11 Using the RMON.......................................................................................................................................1288
A.11.1 Browsing the Performance Data in the Statistics Group of a Port....................................................1288
A.11.2 Configuring an Alarm Group for a Port...........................................................................................1290
A.11.3 Configuring a Historical Control Group...........................................................................................1292
A.11.4 Browsing the Performance Data in the Historical Group of a Port..................................................1293
A.12 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions...............................................................................................1295
A.12.1 Configuring Orderwire.....................................................................................................................1295
A.12.2 Configuring the Synchronous Data Service.....................................................................................1296
A.12.3 Configuring the Asynchronous Data Service...................................................................................1297
A.12.4 Configuring the Wayside E1 Service...............................................................................................1298
A.12.5 Configure External Alarms...............................................................................................................1298
A.13 End-to-End Configuration Task Collection...............................................................................................1299
A.13.1 Configuring E-Line Services (Native Ethernet) in an End-to-End Mode........................................1300
A.13.1.1 Searching for E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode....................................1300
A.13.1.2 Creating E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode............................................1301
A.13.1.3 Managing E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode..........................................1304
A.13.1.4 Managing Discrete Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode.......................................1304
A.13.2 Searching for MPLS Tunnels and PWE3 Services...........................................................................1305
A.13.3 Configuring MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode.......................................................................1307
A.13.3.1 Configuring Port IP Address Resources..................................................................................1307
A.13.3.2 Creating L2 Links....................................................................................................................1308
A.13.3.3 Creating Non-Protection MPLS Tunnels (in an End-to-End Mode).......................................1309
A.13.3.4 Creating MPLS Tunnels Configured with MPLS APS Protection in an End-to-End Mode
................................................................................................................................................................1312
A.13.3.5 Verifying MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode..................................................................1319
A.13.3.6 Managing MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode.................................................................1320
A.13.3.7 Managing Discrete MPLS Tunnels.........................................................................................1320
A.13.3.8 Searching for MPLS APS Protection Groups..........................................................................1321
A.13.3.9 Managing MPLS APS Protection Groups in an End-to-End Mode........................................1321
A.13.4 Configuring PWE3 Services in an End-to-End Mode......................................................................1322
A.13.4.1 Creating PWE3 Service Templates.........................................................................................1322
A.13.4.2 Configuring CES Services in an End-to-End Mode................................................................1323
A.13.4.3 Configuring an ATM Policy Profile........................................................................................1325
A.13.4.4 Configuring an ATM CoS Mapping Profile............................................................................1327
A.13.4.5 Configuring ATM Services in an End-to-End Mode..............................................................1328
A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based E-Line Services (in an End-to-End Mode)........................................1331
A.13.4.7 Verifying PW Configurations in an End-to-End Mode...........................................................1334
A.13.4.8 Verifying PW-Based E-Line Service Configurations (in an End-to-End Mode)....................1336
A.13.4.9 Managing and Maintaining PWE3 Services............................................................................1339
A.13.4.10 Managing Discrete PWE3 Services.......................................................................................1339
A.14 Verifying Services and Features................................................................................................................1340
A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using PRBS.....................................................................................................1340
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxvii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester....................................................................................1342


A.14.3 Testing Ethernet Services.................................................................................................................1343
A.14.4 Testing ATM Services......................................................................................................................1347
A.14.5 Testing AM Switching......................................................................................................................1350
A.14.5.1 Testing AM Switching by Using a BER Tester.......................................................................1350
A.14.5.2 Testing AM Switching Without a BER Tester........................................................................1352
A.14.6 Testing Protection Switching............................................................................................................1354
A.14.6.1 Testing IF 1+1 Switching........................................................................................................1354
A.14.6.2 Testing N+1 Protection Switching...........................................................................................1357
A.14.6.3 Testing SNCP Switching.........................................................................................................1360
A.14.6.4 Testing ERPS Switching..........................................................................................................1363
A.14.6.5 Testing MPLS APS Protection Switching...............................................................................1365
A.14.6.6 Testing Two-Fiber Bidirectional MSP Switching...................................................................1368
A.14.6.7 Testing Linear MSP Switching................................................................................................1373
A.14.6.8 Switching the System Control Unit and the Cross-Connect Unit............................................1376

B Parameters Description..........................................................................................................1378
B.1 Parameters for Network Management.........................................................................................................1379
B.1.1 Parameters for NE Management.........................................................................................................1379
B.1.1.1 Parameter Description: NE Searching.......................................................................................1379
B.1.1.2 Parameter Description: NE Creation.........................................................................................1384
B.1.1.3 Parameter Description: Attribute_Changing NE IDs................................................................1386
B.1.1.4 Parameter Description: NE Time Synchronization....................................................................1387
B.1.1.5 Parameter Description: Localization Management of the NE Time..........................................1390
B.1.1.6 Parameter Description: Standard NTP Key Management.........................................................1391
B.1.1.7 Parameter Description: License Management...........................................................................1392
B.1.1.8 Parameter Description: Automatic Disabling of the Functions of NEs.....................................1393
B.1.2 Parameters for Communications Management...................................................................................1394
B.1.2.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting................................................1394
B.1.2.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Rate Configuration......................................1395
B.1.2.3 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Transparent Transmission Management
................................................................................................................................................................1397
B.1.2.4 Parameter Description: ECC Management_Ethernet Port Extended ECC................................1399
B.1.2.5 Parameter Description: NE ECC Link Management.................................................................1401
B.1.2.6 Parameter Description: ECC Link Management_Availability Test..........................................1402
B.1.2.7 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management......................1403
B.1.2.8 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management Creation
................................................................................................................................................................1405
B.1.2.9 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_Availability Test...............................1405
B.1.2.10 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_OSPF Parameter Settings...............1406
B.1.2.11 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack_Proxy ARP...........................................................1412
B.1.2.12 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas...............................................1413
B.1.2.13 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas_Adding OSPF Areas............1414
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxviii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

B.1.2.14 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas_Adding Routes to Be Manually


Aggregated..............................................................................................................................................1416
B.1.2.15 Parameter Description: Port OSPF Setting..............................................................................1416
B.1.2.16 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Network Layer Parameter....................................1417
B.1.2.17 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Routing Table......................................................1418
B.1.2.18 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Tunnel...........................................................1419
B.1.2.19 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Port Parameters............................................1423
B.1.2.20 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Bandwidth Management....................................1424
B.1.2.21 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Port Setting........................................................1425
B.1.2.22 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Access Control...................................................1426
B.1.2.23 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Packet Control...................................................1427
B.1.2.24 Parameter Description: L2 DCN Management........................................................................1427
B.1.2.25 Parameter Description: Access Control...................................................................................1428
B.1.3 Parameters for Network Security Management..................................................................................1429
B.1.3.1 Parameter Description: NE User Management..........................................................................1430
B.1.3.2 Parameter Description: NE User Management_Creation..........................................................1430
B.1.3.3 Parameter Description: LCT Access Control............................................................................1432
B.1.3.4 Parameter Description: RADIUS Configuration_Creation.......................................................1433
B.1.3.5 Parameter Description: RADIUS Configuration_RADIUS Server...........................................1434
B.1.3.6 Parameter Description: Enabling/Disabling the RADIUS Function.........................................1436
B.2 Radio Link Parameters.................................................................................................................................1436
B.2.1 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC Workgroup_Creation.........................................1436
B.2.2 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC............................................................................1441
B.2.3 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection_Create..................................................................................1448
B.2.4 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection..............................................................................................1449
B.2.5 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection_Create..............................................................................1451
B.2.6 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection..........................................................................................1454
B.2.7 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_Creating a PLA Group.................................................1458
B.2.8 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_PLA..............................................................................1458
B.2.9 Parameter: Link Configuration_IF/ODU Configuration....................................................................1460
B.3 Multiplex Section Protection Parameters.....................................................................................................1469
B.3.1 Parameter Description: Linear MSP_Creation...................................................................................1469
B.3.2 Parameter Description: Linear MSP...................................................................................................1473
B.3.3 Parameter Description: Ring MSP_Creation......................................................................................1477
B.3.4 Parameter Description: Ring MSP......................................................................................................1479
B.4 SDH/PDH Service Parameters.....................................................................................................................1480
B.4.1 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Creation..........................................................1480
B.4.2 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_SNCP Service Creation..................................1483
B.4.3 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Converting Normal Services Into SNCP Services
......................................................................................................................................................................1487
B.4.4 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration..........................................................................1491
B.4.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control..................................................................................1493
B.4.6 Parameter Description: TU_AIS Insertion..........................................................................................1496
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxix

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

B.5 Parameters for Board Interfaces...................................................................................................................1497


B.5.1 PDH Port Parameters..........................................................................................................................1497
B.5.1.1 Parameter Description: PDH Ports_Basic Attributes................................................................1497
B.5.1.2 Parameter Description: PDH Ports_Advanced Attributes.........................................................1498
B.5.2 Parameters for the Ports on Ethernet Boards......................................................................................1502
B.5.2.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes.....................................................1502
B.5.2.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control.........................................................1507
B.5.2.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Layer 2 Attributes..................................................1509
B.5.2.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_Layer 3 Attributes.........................................................1512
B.5.2.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Advanced Attributes..............................................1514
B.5.3 Serial Port Parameters.........................................................................................................................1516
B.5.3.1 Parameter Description: Serial Port_Basic Attributes.................................................................1516
B.5.3.2 Parameter Description: Serial Port_Creation of Serial Ports.....................................................1517
B.5.4 Microwave Interface Parameters........................................................................................................1518
B.5.4.1 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Basic Attributes................................................1519
B.5.4.2 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2 Attributes.............................................1520
B.5.4.3 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 3 Attributes.............................................1522
B.5.4.4 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Advanced Attributes.........................................1523
B.5.5 IF Board Parameters...........................................................................................................................1527
B.5.5.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute......................................................................1527
B.5.5.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute...............................................................1535
B.5.5.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid_AM Configuration_Advanced Attributes...............................1537
B.5.5.4 Parameter Description: ATPC Adjustment Records..................................................................1538
B.5.5.5 Parameter Description: PRBS Test............................................................................................1539
B.5.6 ODU Parameters.................................................................................................................................1540
B.5.6.1 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Radio Frequency Attribute.........................................1540
B.5.6.2 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Power Attributes.........................................................1542
B.5.6.3 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Equipment Information..............................................1545
B.5.6.4 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Advanced Attributes...................................................1547
B.5.7 Parameters for SDH Interface Boards.................................................................................................1548
B.5.7.1 Parameter Description: SDH Interfaces.....................................................................................1548
B.5.7.2 Parameter Description: Automatic Laser Shutdown..................................................................1550
B.5.8 Parameters for PDH Interface Boards.................................................................................................1550
B.5.8.1 Parameter Description: PDH Ports............................................................................................1550
B.5.8.2 Parameter Description: PRBS Test............................................................................................1553
B.5.9 Parameters for Overhead.....................................................................................................................1554
B.5.9.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead.............................................................1554
B.5.9.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs..........................................................................................1555
B.5.9.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs........................................................................................1557
B.5.10 Parameter Description: Ethernet Virtual Interfaces..........................................................................1559
B.6 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet Features on the Packet Plane.............................................1561
B.6.1 Parameters for Ethernet Services........................................................................................................1561
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxx

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

B.6.1.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation......................................................................1562


B.6.1.2 Parameter Description: E-Line Service......................................................................................1582
B.6.1.3 Parameter Description: VLAN Forwarding Table Items for E-Line Services_Creation...........1593
B.6.1.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation.....................................................................1594
B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service.....................................................................................1600
B.6.1.6 Parameter Description: QinQ Link_Creation............................................................................1611
B.6.1.7 Parameter Description: E-AGGR Services_Creation................................................................1612
B.6.1.8 Parameter Description: E-AGGR Services................................................................................1619
B.6.2 Parameters for Ethernet Protocols......................................................................................................1624
B.6.2.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation..............................................................1624
B.6.2.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management..............................................................................1627
B.6.2.3 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Creation.........................................1633
B.6.2.4 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Configuration................................1635
B.6.2.5 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_ Bridge Parameters...........................................1635
B.6.2.6 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_CIST Parameters..............................................1641
B.6.2.7 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Running Information About the CIST.............1643
B.6.2.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation Management_LAG Creation....................1651
B.6.2.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Link Aggregation....................................1659
B.6.2.10 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Point LPT..............................................1660
B.6.2.11 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creating Point-to-Point LPT...............................1662
B.6.2.12 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Multipoint LPT.....................................1663
B.6.2.13 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creating Point-to-Multipoint LPT......................1665
B.6.3 Parameters for the Ethernet OAM......................................................................................................1669
B.6.3.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Domain Creation
................................................................................................................................................................1669
B.6.3.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Association Creation
................................................................................................................................................................1670
B.6.3.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MEP Creation..........................1671
B.6.3.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Remote MEP Creation............1673
B.6.3.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MIP Creation...........................1673
B.6.3.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LB Enabling............................1674
B.6.3.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LT Enabling.............................1676
B.6.3.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling Service Loopback Detection..........1678
B.6.3.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Parameter............................1679
B.6.3.10 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Error Frame Monitoring
................................................................................................................................................................1680
B.6.4 QoS Parameters...................................................................................................................................1682
B.6.4.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management.............................................................1682
B.6.4.2 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Management_Create...............................................1687
B.6.4.3 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Applied Port_Modification.....................................1694
B.6.4.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management.............................................................................1696
B.6.4.5 Parameter Description: Port Policy............................................................................................1702
B.6.4.6 Parameter Description: Port Policy_Traffic Classification Configuration................................1709
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxxi

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

B.6.4.7 Parameter Description: Port Shaping Management_Creation...................................................1720


B.7 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet Features on the EoS/EoPDH Plane...................................1722
B.7.1 Parameters for Ethernet Services........................................................................................................1722
B.7.1.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service_Creation...........................................................1722
B.7.1.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service_Creating QinQ-Based Ethernet Line Services
................................................................................................................................................................1726
B.7.1.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service...........................................................................1730
B.7.1.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service_Creation of Ethernet LAN Services Based on IEEE
802.1d/802.1q Bridge.............................................................................................................................1732
B.7.1.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service_Creating IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based Ethernet LAN
Service....................................................................................................................................................1736
B.7.1.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service..........................................................................1741
B.7.1.7 Parameter Description: VLAN Filtering Table_Creation..........................................................1747
B.7.1.8 Parameter Description: Aging Time of MAC Address Table Entries.......................................1749
B.7.2 Parameters for Ethernet Protocols......................................................................................................1749
B.7.2.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation..............................................................1750
B.7.2.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management..............................................................................1752
B.7.2.3 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Protocol Enabling.......................................................1758
B.7.2.4 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Bridge Parameters.......................................................1759
B.7.2.5 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Port Parameters...........................................................1761
B.7.2.6 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Bridge Running Information......................................1762
B.7.2.7 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Port Running Information...........................................1763
B.7.2.8 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Point-to-Point Attribute..............................................1764
B.7.2.9 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Enabling....................................................1765
B.7.2.10 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Creation of Static Multicast Table Entries
................................................................................................................................................................1766
B.7.2.11 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Aging Time of Multicast Table Entries
................................................................................................................................................................1767
B.7.2.12 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Creation of LAGs..................................1768
B.7.2.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Link Aggregation..................................1770
B.7.2.14 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation of Point-to-Point Service LPT..............1771
B.7.2.15 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation of Point-to-Multipoint Service LPT
................................................................................................................................................................1772
B.7.2.16 Parameter Description: Port Mirroring_Creation....................................................................1773
B.7.3 Parameters for the Ethernet OAM......................................................................................................1774
B.7.3.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MDs............................................1775
B.7.3.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MAs............................................1775
B.7.3.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MPs............................................1776
B.7.3.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling LB..................................................1778
B.7.3.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling LT..................................................1779
B.7.3.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_OAM Parameter..................................................1780
B.7.3.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_OAM Error Frame Monitoring...........................1782
B.7.3.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_Remote OAM Parameter....................................1783
B.7.4 QoS Parameters...................................................................................................................................1784
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxxii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

B.7.4.1 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of Flows..................................................1784


B.7.4.2 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CAR...................................................1786
B.7.4.3 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CoS.....................................................1788
B.7.4.4 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CAR/CoS...........................................1790
B.7.4.5 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Shaping Management of Egress Queues...............1791
B.7.4.6 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Port Shaping..........................................................1792
B.7.5 Parameters for the Ports on Ethernet Boards......................................................................................1793
B.7.5.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_External Port.................................................................1793
B.7.5.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_Internal Port..................................................................1800
B.7.5.3 Parameter Description: Type Field of QinQ Frames.................................................................1806
B.8 RMON Parameters.......................................................................................................................................1807
B.8.1 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_Statistics Group..........................................................1807
B.8.2 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Group............................................................1808
B.8.3 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Control Group...............................................1809
B.8.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting...........................................................1810
B.9 Parameters for MPLS/PWE3 Services.........................................................................................................1812
B.9.1 MPLS Tunnel Parameters...................................................................................................................1812
B.9.1.1 Parameter Description: Basic Configurations of MPLS Tunnels..............................................1812
B.9.1.2 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Static Tunnel........................................1813
B.9.1.3 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Creation of Unidirectional Tunnels
................................................................................................................................................................1818
B.9.1.4 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Creation of Bidirectional Tunnels
................................................................................................................................................................1822
B.9.1.5 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_OAM Parameters.................................1827
B.9.1.6 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_FDI.......................................................1832
B.9.1.7 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_LSP Ping..............................................1833
B.9.1.8 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_LSP Traceroute....................................1836
B.9.1.9 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Management....................................................1839
B.9.1.10 Parameter Description: PW Management_MS-PW Creation..................................................1845
B.9.1.11 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW OAM.............................................................1855
B.9.1.12 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Ping...............................................................1859
B.9.1.13 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Traceroute.....................................................1862
B.9.1.14 Parameter Description: MPLS APS Protection Management.................................................1865
B.9.1.15 Parameter Description: Tunnel Protection Group_Creation....................................................1868
B.9.1.16 Parameter Description: PW APS Protection Group_Creation.................................................1873
B.9.1.17 Parameter Description: Slave Protection Pair of a PW APS Protection Group_Creation
................................................................................................................................................................1884
B.9.2 CES Parameters..................................................................................................................................1890
B.9.2.1 Parameter Description: CES Service Management...................................................................1890
B.9.2.2 Parameter Description: CES Service Management_Creation....................................................1900
B.9.3 ATM Parameters.................................................................................................................................1914
B.9.3.1 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Group Management...........................1914
B.9.3.2 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_Bound Path Configuration..........................1919
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxxiii

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

B.9.3.3 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Group Status......................................1921


B.9.3.4 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Link Status.........................................1922
B.9.3.5 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_ATM Interface Management......................1923
B.9.3.6 Parameter Description: Configuration of ATM Service Class Mapping Table.........................1924
B.9.3.7 Parameter Description: Configuration of ATM Service Class Mapping Table_Creation.........1926
B.9.3.8 Parameter Description: ATM Policy Management....................................................................1928
B.9.3.9 Parameter Description: ATM Policy Management_Creation....................................................1933
B.9.3.10 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management................................................................1938
B.9.3.11 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management_Creation................................................1947
B.9.3.12 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_Segment and End Attributes...................1959
B.9.3.13 Parameter Description: ATM OMA Management_CC Activation Status..............................1963
B.9.3.14 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_Remote End Loopback Status.................1967
B.9.3.15 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_LLID.......................................................1970
B.10 Clock Parameters.......................................................................................................................................1971
B.10.1 Physical Clock Parameters................................................................................................................1971
B.10.1.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table...............................................................1971
B.10.1.2 Parameter Description: Priority Table for the PLL Clock Source of the External Clock Port
................................................................................................................................................................1973
B.10.1.3 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Subnet..................................................1975
B.10.1.4 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Quality.................................................1978
B.10.1.5 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_SSM Output Control.......................................1981
B.10.1.6 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_Clock ID Enabling Status...............................1982
B.10.1.7 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Restoration Parameters
................................................................................................................................................................1984
B.10.1.8 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching............................1986
B.10.1.9 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching Conditions.........1987
B.10.1.10 Parameter Description: Output Phase-Locked Source of the External Clock Source...........1989
B.10.1.11 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status..........................................................1991
B.10.2 CES ACR Clock Parameters.............................................................................................................1993
B.10.2.1 Parameter Description: ACR Clock Source.............................................................................1993
B.10.2.2 Parameter Description: Clock Domain....................................................................................1993
B.10.2.3 Parameter Description: Clock Domain_Creation....................................................................1994
B.10.3 Parameter Description: Auxiliary Ports............................................................................................1995
B.11 Parameters for the Orderwire and Auxiliary Interfaces.............................................................................1995
B.11.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General......................................................................................1995
B.11.2 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Advanced..................................................................................1997
B.11.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port..............................................................................1998
B.11.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port..................................................................1999
B.11.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface.............................................................2000

C Glossary....................................................................................................................................2004
C.1 0-9................................................................................................................................................................2005
C.2 A-E...............................................................................................................................................................2005
C.3 F-J................................................................................................................................................................2014
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxxiv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Contents

C.4 K-O..............................................................................................................................................................2019
C.5 P-T................................................................................................................................................................2025
C.6 U-Z...............................................................................................................................................................2034

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxxv

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

1 Configuration Preparations

Configuration Preparations

About This Chapter


Before configuring the NE data, you must make the required preparations.
1.1 Preparing Documents and Tools
The relevant documents and tools must be available to ensure the proper configuration of data.
1.2 Checking Configuration Conditions
Before the configuration, check whether the configuration conditions meet the requirements.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

1 Configuration Preparations

1.1 Preparing Documents and Tools


The relevant documents and tools must be available to ensure the proper configuration of data.

Documents
l

Network planning documents, such as the XXX Network Planning

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System Configuration Guide

A computer where the U2000 server software is installed

A computer where the U2000 client software is installed

Tools

NOTE

For information about the software and hardware required for the U2000 and the installation method, see the
documents that accompany the U2000.

1.2 Checking Configuration Conditions


Before the configuration, check whether the configuration conditions meet the requirements.

Context
Ensure that the following requirements are met:
l

All the NEs on the network must be powered on properly.

The DCN communication between the gateway NE and the non-gateway NEs must be
normal.

The network communication between the U2000 server and the gateway NE must be
normal.

The U2000 client can log in to the U2000 server and has the "network operator" authority
or higher.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2 U2000 Quick Start

U2000 Quick Start

The U2000 quick start guide helps to learn about basic operations on the U2000 client.
For details, see A.1 U2000 Quick Start.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3 Specifying the Configuration Procedure

Specifying the Configuration Procedure


You can select the proper configuration procedure according to the actual configuration
scenarios.

Initial Configuration
Initial configuration of a radio network refers to configuring the network-wide service data by
using the NMS for the first time after the NE commissioning is complete. Figure 3-1 describes
the configuration procedure.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3 Specifying the Configuration Procedure

Figure 3-1 Configuration flow chart (initial configuration)


Start

Configuring the network topology

Configuring radio links

Configuring TDM services

Configuring Packet-Based Ethernet


services
Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based
Ethernet services

Configuring MPLS packet services

Configuring the clock

Configuring auxiliary ports and


functions
End
Required
Optional

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described in Table 3-1.
Table 3-1 Initial configuration

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Required.

6 Configuring Radio Links

Required.

7 Configuring TDM Services

Required when the TDM services need to be


transmitted.

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services


on the Packet Plane

Required when Native Ethernet services based


on the packet plane need to be transmitted.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3 Specifying the Configuration Procedure

Operation

Description

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based
Ethernet Services

Required when Ethernet services based on the


EoS/EoPDH plane need to be transmitted.

Configuring MPLS
packet services

Required when MPLS packet services need to


be transmitted.

10 Configuring
MPLS Tunnels
11 Configuring
PWE3 Services

12 Configuring the Clock

Required.

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and


Functions

Required when orderwire information, wayside


E1 services, or synchronous/asynchronous data
services need to be transmitted or when the
external alarm input/output function needs to be
enabled.

NOTE

The configuration sequence provided in Table 3-1 is for reference only and needs to be adjusted as required in
actual application scenarios.

Network Adjustment
Network adjustment involves adding and adjusting configuration data in the equipment
commissioning and operation phases. You can find the corresponding configuration operations
according to the actual network adjustment requirements in Table 3-2.
Table 3-2 Network adjustment

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

14.1 Common Task Collection (Network


Topology)

This common task collection lists configuration


operations associated with NE attributes,
including changing the ID and IP address of an
NE.

14.2 Common Task Collection (Radio


Links)

This common task collection lists configuration


operations associated with radio links, including
changing the working mode of a TDM radio link
and changing the number of E1s on a Hybrid
radio link.

14.3 Common Task Collection (TDM


Services)

This common task collection lists configuration


operations associated with TDM services,
including deleting TDM services and upgrading
a normal service to an SNCP service.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

3 Specifying the Configuration Procedure

Operation

Description

14.4 Common Task Collection (PacketPlane Ethernet Services)

This common task collection lists configuration


operations associated with Native Ethernet
services based on the packet plane, including
setting or modifying Ethernet port parameters
and deleting Ethernet services.

14.5 Task Collection (EoS/EoPDHPlane Ethernet Services)

This common task collection lists configuration


operations associated with Ethernet services
based on the EoS/EoPDH plane, including
setting or modifying Ethernet port parameters
and deleting Ethernet services.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Common Network Scenarios of


Configuration Examples

About This Chapter


Initial configuration examples of each section are provided in the same TDM radio network
scenario or IP radio network scenario.
4.1 Common Network Scenario of the TDM Radio Network
Initial configuration examples are provided in a common network scenario of the TDM radio
network where a TDM radio chain network and a TDM radio ring network are interconnected
through a third-party SDH network.
4.2 Common Network Scenario of the IP Radio Network
Initial configuration examples are provided in a common network scenario of the IP radio
network where a Hybrid radio chain network, a Hybrid radio ring network, and a packet network
are interconnected. The packet network is a GE packet ring that includes packet radio links.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

4.1 Common Network Scenario of the TDM Radio Network


Initial configuration examples are provided in a common network scenario of the TDM radio
network where a TDM radio chain network and a TDM radio ring network are interconnected
through a third-party SDH network.

Overall Topology
Figure 4-1 shows the overall topology of the TDM radio network. The base station backhaul
services converged from a TDM radio chain network and a TDM radio ring network are
transmitted over a third-party SDH network to the BSC.
Figure 4-1 Overall topology of the TDM radio network

STM-1
TDM radio chain
network

Third party SDH network


BSC
E1
TDM radio ring
network

TDM Radio Chain Network


Figure 4-2 shows the topology of a TDM radio chain network. In this topology, all base stations
are 2G base stations connected to NEs at E1 ports. The base station backhaul services converged
from the TDM radio chain network are transmitted over the third-party SDH network to the
BSC. The TDM radio chain network and TDM radio ring network are interconnected through
STM-1 fiber links configured with linear MSP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Figure 4-2 Topology of a TDM radio chain network


NMS

BTS12

E1

DCN
STM-1

E1

Third party
SDH network

NE14

BTS13
NE13

NE12

E1

BTS11

E1

E1

STM-1

NE11

NE15

NE16

BTS14

BTS15

Figure 4-3 shows the board configuration of each NE on the radio network.
Figure 4-3 Board configuration of NEs on a TDM radio chain network
NE13
NE14
IF1

IF1
CSTA

CST
IF1
NE6
IF1
SL1D

E1

BTS12

E1

NE12

IF1
IF1

CST
IF1
NE6
IF1
SL1D

NE11
PIU

SP3S

STM-1

BTS13

E1

BTS11

CST
IF1

NE6
IF1

CSTA

NE16
E1

BTS15

NE15

CSHN
IF1
IF1

Third party
SDH netw ork

IF1
IF1
SP3S

PIU

STM-1

E1

BTS14

NOTE

NE11 is an OptiX RTN 980 NE; NE12, NE13, and NE15 are OptiX RTN 950 NEs; NE14 and NE16 are OptiX
RTN 910 NEs. This document describes configuration of all NEs to provide an overview of the radio network.

TDM Radio Ring Network


Figure 4-4 shows the topology of a TDM radio ring network. In this topology, all base stations
are 2G base stations connected to NEs at E1 ports. The TDM radio ring network is interconnected
with a third-party SDH network by using E1 cables. Therefore, the base station backhaul services
converged from the TDM radio ring network are transmitted over the third-party SDH network
to the BSC.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

10

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Figure 4-4 Topology of a TDM radio ring network

NMS
DCN
Third party
SDH network

E1
NE21

BTS21
NE22

NE24

BTS24

BTS22

NE23
BTS23

Figure 4-5 shows the board configuration of each NE on the radio network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

11

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Figure 4-5 Board configuration of NEs on a TDM radio ring network


NE21
PIU

Third party
SDH network

E1

CSHN

E1

IF1
SP3S

NE22

NE24

CST

BTS21

BTS22

IF1
IF1

PIU

NE6
IF1

CST

IF1
SP3S

NE6
IF1

E1

IF1
IF1
SP3S

E1
BTS24

NE23
IF1
IF1
CSTA

E1
BTS23

NOTE

NE21 is an OptiX RTN 980 NE; NE22 and NE24 are OptiX RTN 950 NEs; NE23 is an OptiX RTN 910 NE.
This document describes configuration of all NEs to provide an overview of the radio network.

4.2 Common Network Scenario of the IP Radio Network


Initial configuration examples are provided in a common network scenario of the IP radio
network where a Hybrid radio chain network, a Hybrid radio ring network, and a packet network
are interconnected. The packet network is a GE packet ring that includes packet radio links.

Overall Topology
Figure 4-6 shows the overall topology of the IP radio network. The base station backhaul
services converged from a Hybrid radio chain network, a Hybrid radio ring network, and a packet
radio chain network are transmitted to the BSC/RNC over a GE packet ring.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

12

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Figure 4-6 Overall topology of the IP radio network

Packet radio chain


network

GE packet ring

NMS

Hybrid radio chain


network
BSC
Hybrid radio ring
network
RNC

Packet Network
Figure 4-7 shows the topology of a packet network. The packet network receives various base
station services and the base station backhaul services converged from a Hybrid radio chain
network and a Hybrid radio ring network. The base station services transmitted on the network
are:
l
l
l

2G base station services (CES services transmitted to the BSC from E1 ports)
R99 base station services (ATM PWE3 services transmitted to the RNC from E1 ports)
R4 base station services (ETH PWE3 services transmitted to the RNC from GE ports)

Figure 4-7 Topology of a packet network


NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4
BTS32
E1

BTS34

R4

E1

R99

FE
GE

GE

NE32
Hybrid radio chain
network

NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE
+G
E1

E1

NMS
E1

E1

BTS36

BTS35

Hybrid radio ring


network

R99
BTS37

BSC

R99
BTS38
RNC

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

13

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

NOTE

l NE31 is an OptiX PTN NE in an actual network because it does not support any radio links. In this example,
NE31 is an IDU.
l NE11 receives base station services from BTS35 and BTS36 by using the Fractional E1 function.
l NE21 receives base station services from BTS37 and BTS38 by using the Fractional E1 function.

Figure 4-8 provides the board configuration of each NE on the packet network.
Figure 4-8 Board configuration of NEs on a packet network
BTS33

NE33

NE34

FE FE

CSH

ISU2
CSHD

ISX2
ISX2
ML1

NE6
ISU2

R4
E1

BTS34

E1

R99

NE32

BTS32

PIU

PIU

BTS31
FE

Hybrid radio chain


network

NE11
PIU

CSHN
ISX2
ISX2

PIU

R4

EM6T

NE31
CSH
NE6

ISU2
ISU2
SP3S

NE21

CSHN
PIU

ML1

GE

EM6T
ML1

PIU

GE
E1

E1

E1

BTS36

EM6F

BTS35

CSHN
ISU2
ISU2
EM6F

ML1
ISU2
SP3S

BSC

RNC

E1

R99
BTS38

R99
BTS37

Hybrid radio ring


network

NOTE

l NE11, NE21, and NE32 are OptiX RTN 980 NEs; NE31 and NE33 are OptiX RTN 950 NEs; NE34 is an
OptiX RTN 910 NE. This document describes configuration of all NEs to provide an overview of the radio
network.
l The Native E1 services received by the Hybrid radio network are converted to CES services by crossconnecting some E1 ports on the SP3S and ML1 boards of NE11 and NE21.
l The Native E-LAN services received by the Hybrid radio network are converted to E-Line services, which
can be carried by PWs, by cross-connecting some FE ports on the EM6F board of NE21. NE11 receives
Native E-Line services and does not require port cross-connections.
l The GE port connected to the RNC is configured into a LAG.

Hybrid Radio Chain Network


Figure 4-9 shows the topology of a Hybrid radio chain network. The Hybrid radio chain network
receives various base station services and transmits them to the packet network through NE11.
The base station services transmitted on the network are:
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

R99 base station services (Native E1 services)


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

14

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

R4 base station services (Native ETH services)

Figure 4-9 Topology of a Hybrid radio chain network

R4
BTS12

FE
E1+GE+
NE cascade

E1

R99
BTS13

NE14

Packet network
NE13

NE16

FE

NE12

NE11
R4
BTS11

E1

FE

NE15
R99
BTS14

R4
BTS15

NOTE

The cascading ports of NE12 and NE13 are connected by using network cables to achieve DCN communication
between NE12 and NE13.

Figure 4-10 shows the board configuration of each NE on the radio network.
Figure 4-10 Board configuration of NEs on a Hybrid radio chain network

FE
NE14
ISU2

R4
BTS12

ISU2
CSHA
E1

NE12
CSH
ISU2
NE6
ISU2
EM6T

ISU2
ISU2
SP3S

Pacekt network
NE11

SP3S

GE

R99
BTS13

E1
FE

R4
BTS11

NE15
CSH

NE16
ISU2

NE cascade

NE13
CSH
ISU2
NE6
ISU2
EM6T

NE6
ISU2

CSHA
FE

ISU2
ISU2
SP3S

E1

R99
BTS14

R4
BTS15

NOTE

NE11 is an OptiX RTN 980 NE; NE12, NE13, and NE15 are OptiX RTN 950 NEs; NE14 and NE16 are OptiX
RTN 910 NEs. This document describes configuration of all NEs to provide an overview of the radio network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

15

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Hybrid Radio Ring Network


Figure 4-11 shows the topology of a Hybrid radio ring network. The Hybrid radio ring network
receives various base station services and transmits them to the packet network through NE21.
The base station services transmitted on the network are:
l

2G base station services (Native E1 services)

R4 base station services (Native ETH services)

Figure 4-11 Topology of a Hybrid radio ring network

Packet network

NE21

R4
BTS21

FE
FE
E1 NE22

NE24

R4
BTS24

BTS22
FE
NE23
R4
BTS23

Figure 4-12 shows the board configuration of each NE on the radio network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

16

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4 Common Network Scenarios of Configuration Examples

Figure 4-12 Board configuration of NEs on a Hybrid radio ring network

Packet network

NE21

FE

NE22
CSH

R4
BTS21

NE6
ISU2

EM6T

NE24
CSH

ISU2
SP3S

NE6
ISU2

EM6T

E1

ISU2
ISU2

FE

BTS22

R4
BTS24

NE23
ISU2
ISU2
CSHA

FE

R4

BTS23

NOTE

NE21 is an OptiX RTN 980 NE; NE22 and NE24 are OptiX RTN 950 NEs; NE23 is an OptiX RTN 910 NE.
This document describes configuration of all NEs to provide an overview of the radio network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

17

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Configuring the Network Topology

About This Chapter


You can manage a transport network by using the U2000 only after configuring the network
topology on the network.
5.1 Basic Concepts
Before configuring the network topology, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
5.2 Configuration Procedure
This section describes the procedures for configuring the four topological objects, namely, NEs,
boards, fibers/cables, and subnets.
5.3 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Chain Network Topology)
This section considers a TDM radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
the network topology according to the network planning information.
5.4 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Ring Network Topology)
This section considers a TDM radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
the network topology according to the network planning information.
5.5 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Chain Network)
This topic considers a Hybrid radio chain network as an example and describes how to configure
NEs according to the planning information.
5.6 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Ring Network)
This topic considers a Hybrid radio ring network as an example and describes how to configure
NEs according to the planning information.
5.7 Configuration Example (Packet Network)
This section considers the NEs on a packet network as examples to describe how to configure
NEs according to the network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

18

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

5.1 Basic Concepts


Before configuring the network topology, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

5.1.1 DCN
To manage and maintain an NE, the U2000 needs to communicate with the NE through the data
communication network (DCN).
On a DCN, the U2000 and all the NEs are considered as nodes on the DCN. The DCN between
the U2000 and all the NEs is considered as the external DCN, and the DCN between the NEs is
considered as the internal DCN. The OptiX RTN 980 supports several DCN solutions, including
HWECC and IP DCN. HWECC is the commonest DCN solution.
HWECC is a DCN solution provided by Huawei. In this solution, the NMS manages NEs using
network management messages that are encapsulated in the HWECC protocol stack.
Figure 5-1 shows how network management messages are transmitted in the HWECC solution.
Network management messages encapsulated in compliance with the HWECC protocol stack
can be transmitted through the following DCN channels:
l

DCCs carried by SDH or microwave links

Integrated IP radio links or Ethernet paths over FE/GE ports

Ethernet network management ports or NE cascading ports

Figure 5-1 HWECC solution

Message
HWECC
DCC

Message
HWECC
DCC

Message
HWECC
ETH

Message
HWECC
DCC

NMS
Message
HWECC
DCC

Message
HWECC
DCC

OptiX radio
transmission equipment

OptiX optical
transmission equipment
Radio link

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Fiber

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Ethernet link

19

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

5.1.2 GNE and Non-GNE


A gateway NE (GNE) refers to an NE whose application layer communicates directly with the
NMS application layer. A non-GNE refers to an NE whose application layer communicates with
the NMS application layer by forwarding data through the GNE application layer.

GNE
Generally, a GNE is connected to the NMS through a local area network (LAN) or wide area
network (WAN). Its application layer can directly communicate with the NMS application layer.
One set of NMS needs to be connected to one or more GNEs.
ECC communication between the GNEs may create an oversized DCN. To prevent this, disable
extended ECC for the GNEs.

Non-GNE
A non-GNE communicates with the GNE through the DCN channels between NEs.

5.1.3 NE ID and NE IP Address


The ID and IP address are the unique NE on the DCN.

NE ID
At the application layer of each DCN solution, an OptiX NE uses its NE ID as the NE address.
Therefore, each NE must have a unique NE ID on the DCN and all these NE IDs must be planned
in a unified manner.
The NE ID has 24 bits. The most significant eight bits represent the subnet ID (or the extended
ID) and the least significant 16 bits represent the basic ID. For example, if an NE ID is 0x090001,
the subnet ID is 9 and the basic ID is 1.

NE IP Address
An NE uses an IP address as its unique identifier during TCP/IP communication.
In the HWECC solution, the IP addresses of the NEs on the DCN are used in the following
scenarios:
l

A gateway NE (GNE) communicates with the U2000 over TCP/IP. The IP address of the
GNE must be planned as required by the external DCN.

Different NEs communicate with each other over extended ECC channels. In this scenario,
NE IP addresses must be on the same network segment. By default, NE IP addresses are
on the 129.9.0.0 network segment.

In the DCN solution (for example, IP DCN) where network management messages are
transmitted over TCP/IP, an NE IP address is used as the NE address at the network layer.
Therefore, each NE IP address on the DCN must be unique and all these NE IP addresses must
be planned in a unified manner.
By default (which indicates that an NE IP address is never manually changed), this NE IP address
is automatically changed to 0x81000000 + ID if the NE ID is changed. For example, if an NE
IP address is never manually changed, this NE IP address is automatically changed to 129.9.0.1
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

20

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

when the NE ID is changed to 0x090001. Once an NE IP address is manually changed, the


interlocking relationship between the NE ID and NE IP address no longer takes effect.
It is recommended to configure the IP address of a GNE on a different network segment from
the IP addresses of its non-GNEs.

5.1.4 Physical Boards and Logical Boards


The NE software and NMS consider a physical board as one or more logical boards when
managing the physical board.
Table 5-1 provides the mappings between the physical boards and logical boards.
Table 5-1 Mappings between the physical boards and logical boards
Physical Board

Logical Board

CSHN

l CSHN in slot 15 + SL4D in slot 16 +


EG2D in slot 17
l CSHN in slot 20 + SL4D in slot 21 +
EG2D in slot 22

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

AUX

AUX in the same slot

IF1

IF1 in the same slot

IFU2

IFU2 in the same slot

IFX2

IFX2 in the same slot

ISU2

ISU2 in the same slot

ISX2

ISX2 in the same slot

SL1D

SL1D in the same slot

SL1DA

SL1DA in the same slot

EM6T

EM6T in the same slot

EM6F

EM6F in the same slot

EMS6

EMS6 in the same slot

SP3S

SP3S in the same slot

SP3D

SP3D in the same slot

ML1

ML1 in the same slot

MD1

MD1 in the same slot

PIU

PIU in the same slot

FAN

FAN in the same slot

ODU

ODU in the slot whose number is 50 plus the


slot number for the IF board that is connected
to the ODU
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

21

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

5.1.5 Fiber/Cable Types


You can obtain the clear fiber/cable connection relations between NEs by using the fiber
management function of the U2000. You can manage the fibers and cables by using the
U2000, including SDH fibers, radio links, extended ECC cables, and back-to-back radio
connections.
l

SDH fibers
SDH fibers refer to the fiber connections between different sets of equipment. That is, SDH
fibers indicate the connection relations between different SDH optical ports.

Radio links
Radio links refer to the radio connections between different sets of radio equipment. That
is, the radio links indicate the connection relations between different IF ports.

Extended ECC cables


Extended ECC cables refer to the extended ECC channels between the NEs. That is, the
extended ECC cables indicate the connection relations between the NEs.

Back-to-back radio connections


Back-to-back radio connections refer to the NE cascading relations. That is, the back-toback radio connections indicate the connection relations between the NEs.
NOTE

Fibers and cables are topological objects on the U2000. Hence, operations on the fibers or cables do not affect
the normal running of the NEs.

5.1.6 Subnet
NEs in a same domain or with similar attributes can be allocated to a same subnet. In this way,
they can be displayed as a whole on the U2000, thus facilitating the NE management.
The subnets are topological objects on the U2000. Hence, operations on the subnets do not affect
the normal running of the NEs. In the case of a large number of topological objects, subnets that
contain multiple NEs simplify the topology view on the U2000.

5.2 Configuration Procedure


This section describes the procedures for configuring the four topological objects, namely, NEs,
boards, fibers/cables, and subnets.
Figure 5-2 provides the procedures for configuring the network topology.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

22

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Figure 5-2 Configuration flow chart (network topology)


Start

Creating NEs

Configuring NE attributes

Configuring DCCs

Synchronizing NE time

Setting the performance


monitoring status
Creating fibers/cables and
subnets

End
Required
Optional

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.


NOTE

l If the NE ID and NE name are changed in the NE commissioning process and if the NE communication
parameters, logical boards, VLAN ID and bandwidth of the inband DCN are set during the NE
commissioning, the configuration data is automatically synchronized onto the U2000 in the NE data
uploading process. Hence, you do not need to perform the corresponding operations in the initial
configuration process.
l The DCN configuration procedure provided in Figure 5-2 is only a typical HWECC solution configuration.
For the configuration procedure for an HWECC solution containing special requirements or another DCN
solution, see related descriptions in the Feature Description.

Table 5-2 Procedures for creating NEs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Step

Operation

Creating NEs
on the U2000

Description
A.2.1.2 Creating
NEs by Using
the Manual
Method

It is recommended that you perform this


operation to add one or more NEs to a large
existing network on the U2000.
To achieve SSL communication between the
NMS and the gateway NE, Connection
Mode needs to be set to Security SSL.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

23

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Step

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Operation

Description
A.2.1.1 Creating
NEs by Using
the Search
Method

It is recommended that you perform this


operation to create NEs on the U2000 in other
cases. The following parameters need to be
set:
l Set Search Mode to Search for NE.
l Search Domain: When the IP address of
the GNE is known, it is recommended that
you set the IP address range of the GNE
as the search domain. In the case of initial
configuration, it is recommended that you
set the 129.9.255.255 network segment as
the search domain.
l Search for NE: It is recommended that
you select Create NE after search, and
Upload after create. By default, NE
User is root and Password is password.
l Connection Mode: This parameter
specifies the connection mode between
the NMS and the gateway NE. For SSL
connection, set this parameter to Security
SSL.

A.2.2.1 Uploading the NE Data

If you select Upload after create during A.


2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search
Method, skip this operation.

Table 5-3 Procedures for configuring NE attributes


Step

Operation

Description

A.2.1.4
Changing
the NE ID

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Change New ID to be the NE ID specified during the
planning of the DCN.
l If the extended NE ID is required, change New Extended
ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.2.1.5
Changing
the NE
Name

Optional.

A.2.1.3
Configuring
the Logical
Board

Required.
For the OptiX RTN 980, manually set the SFP module type
for the SL4D board (a logical board) according to the actual
board.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

24

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Table 5-4 Procedures for configuring DCCs


Step

Operation

Description

A.2.7.1
Setting NE
Communica
tion
Parameters

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of the GNE, set IP Address and Subnet
Mask according to the planning of the external DCN.
l In the case of the GNE, set if the external DCN requires.
l Generally, it is recommended that you set Connection
Mode to Common + Security SSL. If you need to set the
gateway NE to allow for NMS access only in SSL
connection mode, set Connection Mode to Security
SSL.
l In the case of non-GNEs, it is recommended that you set
IP Address to 0x81000000 + NE ID. That is, if the NE ID
is 0x090001, set IP Address to 129.9.0.1. Set Subnet
Mask to 255.255.0.0.
NOTE
If the IP address of an NE is not changed manually, the IP address
changes according to the NE ID and is always 0x81000000 + NE ID.
In this case, the IP address of a non-GNE does not need to be changed
manually.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.2.7.2
Configuring
DCCs

If the OptiX RTN 980 needs to interconnect with third-party


equipment or use inband DCN channels provided by the
Integrated IP radio.

A.2.7.8
Configuring
Extended
ECC
Communica
tion

For a gateway NE, disable the automatic extended ECC


function.

A.2.7.4
Configuring
the VLAN
ID and
Bandwidth
Used by an
Inband
DCN

Perform this operation if the OptiX RTN equipment uses the


inband DCN solution and if the VLAN ID and bandwidth
planned for this inband DCN do not assume their default
values (the default VLAN ID is 4094 and the default
bandwidth is 512 kbit/s).

Configuring
the Protocol
Type of the
Inband DCN

Required. If inband DCN channels use the HWECC protocol,


set Protocol Type to HWECC. If inband DCN channels use
the IP protocol, set Protocol Type to IP.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

25

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Step

Operation

Description

A.2.7.6
Setting
Parameters
of Inband
DCN

Required in the case of the Integrated IP radio network. Set


the parameters as follows:
l In the case of the Ethernet ports and microwave ports that
interconnect with the packet switching equipment, set
Enabled Status to Enabled.
l In the case of the other ports, set Enabled Status to
Disabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

26

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Table 5-5 Procedures for synchronizing NE time


Step

Operation

Synchroni
zing the
NE time

Description
A.2.1.6
Synchron
izing the
NE Time

Required.
l To synchronize the NEs with the NM server, set
the relevant parameters as follows:
Set Synchronous Mode to NM.
Right-click and choose the operation from the
shortcut menu to ensure that the NE are
synchronized with the NM time immediately.
Set the synchronization parameters according
to the requirements. It is recommended that
the parameters adopt the default values.
l To synchronize the NEs with the NTP server, set
the relevant parameters as follows:
Set Synchronous Mode to Standard NTP.
Set Standard NTP Authentication
according to the requirements for the NTP
server.
It is recommended that you set the upper level
NTP server that the NEs trace as follows:
In the case of the GNE, set the external
NTP server to the upper level NTP server.
Set Standard NTP Server Identifier to
IP and set Standard NTP Server to the
IP address of the external NTP server.
In the case of a non-GNE, set the GNE to
the upper level NTP server. If the nonGNE needs to communicate with the GNE
through the HWECC protocol, set
Standard NTP Server Identifier to NE
ID and set Standard NTP Server to the
NE ID of the GNE. If the non-GNE needs
to communicate with the GNE through the
IP protocol, set Standard NTP Server
Identifier to IP and set Standard NTP
Server to the IP address of the GNE.
Set Standard NTP Server Key according
to the requirements for the NTP server.

A.2.1.7
Localizin
g the NE
Time

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required if the DST scheme is used at the local area.


Set the parameters according to the planning of the
DST at the local area.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

27

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Step

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Operation

Description
A.2.1.8
Configuri
ng
Standard
NTP Keys

Required if the standard NTP authentication is used


to synchronize the NEs with the NTP server.
Set the parameters according to the identification
authentication of the NTP.

Table 5-6 Procedures for setting the performance monitoring status


Step

Operation

Description

A.2.3
Configuring
the
Performanc
e
Monitoring
Status of
NEs

If the 15-minute and 24-hour performance monitoring


functions are set to Disabled, enable these performance
monitoring functions.

Table 5-7 Procedures for creating fibers/cables and subnets

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Step

Operation

Creating
fibers/
cables

Description
A.2.5.1
Creating
Optical
Fibers by
Using the
Search
Method

It is recommended that you perform this operation


to create radio links or SDH fibers on the U2000
when the physical radio links or SDH fibers exist.

A.2.5.2
Creating
Fibers
Manually

You need to perform this operation to create the


fibers and cables (such as Ethernet links and E1
cables) that cannot be searched for.

A.2.5.3 Creating an
Extended ECC

Optional when NEs are connected through extended


ECC channels.

A.2.5.4 Creating a
Back-to-Back Radio
Connection

Optional when there are cascading NEs on the


network.

Configuri
ng the
subnet

Optional.

A.2.6.1
Creating
a Subnet

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

28

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Step

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Operation

Description
A.2.6.2
Copying
Topology
Objects

Optional.

A.2.6.3
Moving
Topology
Objects

Optional.

5.3 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Chain Network


Topology)
This section considers a TDM radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
the network topology according to the network planning information.

5.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Figure 5-3 shows a TDM radio chain network configured according to the following
requirements.
l

The TDM radio chain network is comprised of the OptiX RTN equipment managed by the
standalone U2000.

The U2000 is connected to NE11 with a network cable. Therefore, NE11 serves as a GNE
and the other NEs are non-GNEs with an access to the U2000 through NE11.

NE12 and NE13 are interconnected by using fibers.

The TDM radio chain network is interconnected with a third-party SDH network by using
fibers. Therefore, the base station backhaul services converged from the TDM radio chain
network are transmitted over the third-party SDH network.

Figure 5-3 Networking diagram (TDM radio chain network)


NMS

BTS12

E1

DCN
STM-1

E1
BTS13

NE13

NE12

E1

E1

E1

NE11

STM-1

BTS11

NE15

NE16
BTS15

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Third party
SDH network

NE14

BTS14

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

29

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

The connections of DCN links shown in Figure 5-3 are described as follows.
Table 5-8 Connections of DCN links (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Link between NE11 and the


third-party SDH network

16-SL4D-1 (working unit)

l Configure the ports as a 1


+1 linear MSP group.
l The base station backhaul
services converged from
the TDM radio chain
network are transmitted
over the third-party SDH
network to the BSC.

16-SL4D-2 (protection unit)

5.3.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
l

In this example, the network is comprised of OptiX RTN equipment only, and therefore
HWECC is preferred as the DCN solution. In the HWECC solution, NE12 and NE13
communicate with each other through DCC channels in the SDH optical fibers and the
other NEs communicate with each other through the DCC channels over microwave. If no
fiber connections are set up between NE12 and NE13, NE12 and NE13 communicate with
each other through the extended ECC that is enabled by default.

NE11 is the GNE. Hence, the extended ECC function of NE11 needs to be disabled.

The TDM radio chain network is connected to the third-party network through STM-1
optical fibers. The TDM radio chain and the third-party network are managed by the
U2000. Therefore, the DCC channel needs to be disabled over the port on the N11 for
connecting to the third-party network.

Figure 5-4 shows the ID and IP address that are allocated to each NE according to the
uniform DCN planning information.

Figure 5-4 Allocated IDs and IP addresses (TDM radio chain network)
NMS

10.0.0.100/16

9-14
129.9.0.14
0.0.0.0

NE14

9-16
129.9.0.16
0.0.0.0

NE16

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

9-15
129.9.0.15
0.0.0.0

NE15

9-13
129.9.0.13
0.0.0.0

NE13

9-12
129.9.0.12
0.0.0.0

9-11
10.0.0.11
0.0.0.0

NE12

NE11

Third party
SDH network

Extended ID-Basic ID
IP address
Gateway

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

30

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

NOTE

l The subnet mask for the IP address of each NE is 255.255.0.0.


l The IP addresses of all the NEs, except NE11, are in the interlocking relations with the NE IDs. Hence,
if the IP address of an NE (not NE11) is not changed manually, the NE automatically changes the IP
address to be the planned value after the NE ID is changed.

In this example, the policy of synchronizing the NE with the NM server is used. The
automatic synchronization period is one day. The daylight saving time (DST) scheme is
not used at the local area.

The 15-minute and 24-hour performance monitoring functions are enabled.

In this configuration example, no subnets need to be configured.

5.3.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Precautions
If the NE ID and the values of NE communication parameters are changed and the logical boards
are configured in the NE commissioning process, skip the operations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method and create the NEs.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Search Domain

Search for NE

IP Address

129.9.255.255

Search User

root

Create NE after search

Selected

Upload after create

Selected

NE User

root

Password

password

NOTE

In this configuration example, it is assumed that the IP address of the GNE is not changed manually and is not
known. Hence, you need to search for and create the NEs by using the 129.9.255.255 network segment as the
search domain. If the IP address of the GNE is known, it is recommended that you use the IP address of the
GNE as the search domain.

The icons of NE11 to NE16 should be displayed on the Main Topology and all the NE data
should be uploaded successfully.
Step 2 See A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID and change the NE ID.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

31

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Paramete
r

Value
NE11

NE12

NE13

NE14

NE15

NE16

New ID

11

12

13

14

15

16

New
Extended
ID

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

Step 3 See A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board and configure the logical boards.
Configure the logical boards according to the mapping relations between the physical boards
and logical boards.
Step 4 See A.2.7.1 Setting NE Communication Parameters and set the NE communication
parameters.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

IP Address

10.0.0.11

Gateway IP Address

0.0.0.0 (default value)

Subnet Mask

255.255.0.0 (default value)

Extended ID

Connection Mode

Common + Security SSL

NOTE

The IP addresses of all the NEs, except NE11, are in the interlocking relations with the NE IDs. Hence, you
need not change the values of the NE communication parameters manually.

Step 5 See A.2.7.2 Configuring DCCs and configure the DCCs.


The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Enabled/Disabled

16-SL4D-1

16-SL4D-2

Disabled

Disabled

Step 6 See A.2.7.8 Configuring Extended ECC Communication and disable the automatic extended
ECC function for the gateway NE (NE11).
Step 7 See A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time and synchronize the NE time.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

32

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Value
All the Ports on All the NEs

Synchronous Mode

NM

Synchronization Period(days)

Step 8 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links or
SDH fiber connections.
Normally, all the radio links or SDH fiber connections should be created successfully on the
Main Topology.
Step 9 See A.2.5.4 Creating a Back-to-Back Radio Connection and create back-to-back radio
connections.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Source NE

NE12

Sink NE

NE13

----End

5.4 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Ring Network


Topology)
This section considers a TDM radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
the network topology according to the network planning information.

5.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Figure 5-5 shows a TDM radio ring topology configured according to the following
requirements.
l

The TDM radio ring network is comprised of the OptiX RTN equipment managed by the
standalone U2000.

The U2000 is connected to NE21 with a network cable. Therefore, NE21 serves as a GNE
and the other NEs are non-GNEs with an access to the U2000 through NE21.

The TDM radio ring network is interconnected with a third-party SDH network by using
E1 cables. Therefore, the base station backhaul services converged from the TDM radio
ring network are transmitted over the third-party SDH network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

33

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Figure 5-5 Networking diagram (TDM radio ring network)

NMS
DCN
Third party
SDH network

E1
NE21

BTS21
NE22

NE24

BTS24

BTS22

NE23
BTS23

The connections of DCN links shown in Figure 5-5 are described as follows.
Table 5-9 Connections of DCN links (NE21)
Link

Port

Description

Link between NE21 and the


third-party SDH network

2-SP3S

The base station backhaul


services converged from the
TDM radio ring network are
transmitted over the thirdparty SDH network to the
BSC.

5.4.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
l

In this example, the network is comprised of OptiX RTN equipment only, and therefore
HWECC is preferred as the DCN solution. In the HWECC solution, the NEs communicate
with each other through the DCC channels over microwave.

NE21 is the GNE. Hence, the extended ECC function of NE21 should be disabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

34

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

The TDM radio ring network is connected to the third-party network through E1 cables
and cannot communicate with the third-party network. Therefore, the DCC channels need
to be disabled on NE21.

Figure 5-6 shows the ID and IP address that are allocated to each NE according to the
uniform DCN planning information.
Figure 5-6 Allocated IDs and IP addresses (TDM radio ring network)

Third part
SDH network

E1

10.0.0.101/16

9-21
10.0.0.21
0.0.0.0

NE21

9-22
129.9.0.22
0.0.0.0

NE22

9-23
129.9.0.23
0.0.0.0

NE23

9-24
129.9.0.24
0.0.0.0

NE24
Extended ID-Basic ID
IP address
Gateway

NOTE

l The subnet mask for the IP address of each NE is 255.255.0.0.


l The IP addresses of all the NEs, except NE21, are in the interlocking relations with the NE IDs. Hence,
if the IP address of an NE (not NE21) is not changed manually, the NE automatically changes the IP
address to be the planned value after the NE ID is changed.

In this example, the policy of synchronizing the NE with the NM server is used. The
automatic synchronization period is one day. The daylight saving time (DST) scheme is
not used at the local area.

The 15-minute and 24-hour performance monitoring functions are enabled.

In this configuration example, no subnets need to be configured.

5.4.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Precautions
If the NE ID and the values of NE communication parameters are changed and the logical boards
are configured in the NE commissioning process, skip the operations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method and create the NEs.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

35

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Parameter

Value

Search Domain

Search for NE

IP Address

129.9.255.255

Search User

root

Create NE after search

Selected

Upload after create

Selected

NE User

root

Password

password

NOTE

In this configuration example, it is assumed that the IP address of the GNE is not changed manually and the IP
addresses of the non-GNEs are not known. Hence, you need to search for and create the NEs by using the
129.9.255.255 network segment as the search domain. If the IP address of the GNE is known, it is recommended
that you use the IP address of the GNE as the search domain.

The icons of NE21 to NE24 should be displayed on the Main Topology and all the NE data
should be uploaded successfully.
Step 2 See A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID and change the NE ID.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

New ID

21

22

23

24

New Extended
ID

9 (default value)

9 (default value)

9 (default value)

9 (default value)

Step 3 See A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board and configure logical boards.
Configure the logical boards according to the mapping relations between the physical boards
and logical boards.
Step 4 See A.2.7.1 Setting NE Communication Parameters and set the NE communication
parameters.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

IP Address

10.0.0.21

Gateway IP Address

0.0.0.0 (default value)

Subnet Mask

255.255.0.0 (default value)


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

36

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Value
NE21

Extended ID

Connection Mode

Common + Security SSL

NOTE

The IP addresses of all the NEs, except NE21, are in the interlocking relations with the NE IDs. Hence, you
need not change the values of the NE communication parameters manually.

Step 5 See A.2.7.8 Configuring Extended ECC Communication and disable the automatic extended
ECC function for the gateway NE (NE21).
Step 6 See A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time and synchronize the NE time.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
All the Ports on All the NEs

Synchronous Mode

NM

Synchronization Period(days)

Step 7 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links or
SDH fiber connections.
Normally, all the radio links or SDH fiber connections should be created successfully on the
Main Topology.
----End

5.5 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Chain Network)


This topic considers a Hybrid radio chain network as an example and describes how to configure
NEs according to the planning information.

5.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Figure 5-7 shows a Hybrid radio chain network configured according to the following
requirements.
l

The Hybrid radio chain network is comprised of the OptiX RTN equipment managed by
the U2000 connected to the packet network.

All NEs on the Hybrid radio chain network are non-GNEs with an access to the U2000
through the packet network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

37

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

The Hybrid radio chain network receives various base station services and transmits them
to the packet network through NE11.

NE12 and NE13 are interconnected through cascading ports.


NOTE

For details on configuration of NE11, see 5.7 Configuration Example (Packet Network).

Figure 5-7 Networking diagram (Hybrid radio chain network)

R4
BTS12

R99
BTS13

FE
E1+GE+
NE cascade

E1

NE14

Packet network
NE13

NE16

NE12

NE11
R4
BTS11

E1

FE

FE

NE15
R99
BTS14

R4
BTS15

5.5.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.
l

All NEs except NE11 adopt HWECC for DCN communication. To be specific, NE12 and
NE13 are interconnected through cascading ports and adopt automatic extended ECC
(enabled by default) for DCN communication; the other NEs use DCC channels in radio
signals for DCN communication.

NEs numbered 12 to 16 are not connected to the packet network. Therefore, to improve
bandwidth utilization, the inband DCN function is disabled at all ports of these NEs.

Figure 5-8 shows the ID and IP address that are allocated to each NE according to the
uniform DCN planning information.

Figure 5-8 Allocated IDs and IP addresses (Hybrid radio chain network)
9-14
129.9.0.14
0.0.0.0

NE14

9-16
129.9.0.16
0.0.0.0

NE16

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

9-15
129.9.0.15
0.0.0.0

NE15

9-13
129.9.0.13
0.0.0.0

NE13

9-12
129.9.0.12
0.0.0.0

NE12

Packet
network
NE11

Extended ID-Basic ID
IP address
Gateway

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

38

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

NOTE

l The subnet mask for the IP address of each NE is 255.255.0.0.


l The IP addresses of all the NEs are in the interlocking relations with the NE IDs. Hence, if the IP
address of an NE is not changed manually, the NE automatically changes the IP address to be the
planned value after the NE ID is changed.

In this example, the policy of synchronizing the NE with the NM server is used. The
automatic synchronization period is one day. The daylight saving time (DST) scheme is
not used in the local area.

The 15-minute and 24-hour performance monitoring functions are enabled.

In this configuration example, no subnets need to be configured.

5.5.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for the data configuration.

Precautions
If the NE ID and the values of NE communication parameters are changed and the logical boards
are configured in the NE commissioning process, skip the operations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method and create the NEs.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Search Domain

Search for NE

IP Address

129.9.255.255

Search User

root

Create NE after search

Selected

Upload after create

Selected

NE User

root

Password

password

NOTE

In this configuration example, it is assumed that the IP address of the GNE has not been changed manually and
that the IP addresses of the non-GNEs are not known. Hence, you need to search for and create the NEs by using
the 129.9.255.255 network segment as the search domain. If the IP address of the GNE is known, it is
recommended that you use the IP address of the GNE as the search domain.

The icons of NE12 to NE16 should be displayed on the Main Topology and all the NE data
should be uploaded successfully.
Step 2 See A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID and change the NE ID.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

39

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Value
NE12

NE13

NE14

NE15

NE16

New ID

12

13

14

15

16

New
Extended
ID

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

Step 3 See A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board and configure logical boards.
Configure the logical boards according to the mapping relationships between the physical boards
and logical boards.
Step 4 See A.2.7.6 Setting Parameters of Inband DCN and enable/disable the inband DCN at the
ports.
The values for the related parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
All Ports

Enabled Status

Disabled

Step 5 See A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time and synchronize the NE time.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
All the Ports on All the NEs

Synchronous Mode

NM

Synchronization Period(days)

Step 6 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links or
SDH fiber connections.
Normally, all the radio links or SDH fiber connections should be created successfully on the
Main Topology.
Step 7 See A.2.5.4 Creating a Back-to-Back Radio Connection and create back-to-back connections.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Source NE

NE12

Sink NE

NE13
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

40

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

----End

5.6 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Ring Network)


This topic considers a Hybrid radio ring network as an example and describes how to configure
NEs according to the planning information.

5.6.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Figure 5-9 shows a Hybrid radio ring network configured according to the following
requirements.
l

The Hybrid radio ring network is comprised of the OptiX RTN equipment managed by the
U2000 connected to the packet network.

All NEs on the Hybrid radio ring network are non-GNEs with an access to the U2000
through the packet network.

The Hybrid radio ring network receives various base station services and transmits them
to the packet network through NE21.
NOTE

For details on configuration of NE21, see 5.7 Configuration Example (Packet Network).

Figure 5-9 Networking diagram (Hybrid radio ring network)

Packet network

NE21

R4
BTS21

FE
FE
E1 NE22

NE24

R4
BTS24

BTS22
FE
NE23
R4
BTS23

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

41

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

5.6.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.
l

All NEs except NE21 adopt HWECC for DCN communication. In HWECC mode, NEs
use DCC channels in radio signals for DCN communication.

NEs numbered 22 to 24 are not connected to the packet network. Therefore, to improve
bandwidth utilization, the inband DCN function is disabled at all ports of these NEs.

Figure 5-10 shows the ID and IP address that are allocated to each NE according to the
uniform DCN planning information.
Figure 5-10 Allocated IDs and IP addresses (Hybrid radio ring network)
Packet network

9-22
129.9.0.22
0.0.0.0

NE22

NE21

9-23
129.9.0.23
0.0.0.0

NE23

9-24
129.9.0.24
0.0.0.0

NE24
Extended ID-Basic ID
IP address
Gateway

NOTE

l The subnet mask for the IP address of each NE is 255.255.0.0.


l The IP addresses of all the NEs are in the interlocking relations with the NE IDs. Hence, if the IP
address of an NE is not changed manually, the NE automatically changes the IP address to be the
planned value after the NE ID is changed.

In this example, the policy of synchronizing the NE with the NM server is used. The
automatic synchronization period is one day. The daylight saving time (DST) scheme is
not used in the local area.

The 15-minute and 24-hour performance monitoring functions are enabled.

In this configuration example, no subnets need to be configured.

5.6.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for the data configuration.

Precautions
If the NE ID and the values of NE communication parameters are changed and the logical boards
are configured in the NE commissioning process, skip the operations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

42

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method and create the NEs.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Search Domain

Search for NE

IP Address

129.9.255.255

Search User

root

Create NE after search

Selected

Upload after create

Selected

NE User

root

Password

password

NOTE

In this configuration example, it is assumed that the IP address of the GNE has not been changed manually and
that the IP addresses of the non-GNEs are not known. Hence, you need to search for and create the NEs by using
the 129.9.255.255 network segment as the search domain. If the IP address of the GNE is known, it is
recommended that you use the IP address of the GNE as the search domain.

The icons of NE22 to NE24 should be displayed on the Main Topology and all the NE data
should be uploaded successfully.
Step 2 See A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID and change the NE ID.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE22

NE23

NE24

New ID

22

23

24

New Extended ID

9 (default value)

9 (default value)

9 (default value)

Step 3 See A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board and configure logical boards.
Configure the logical boards according to the mapping relationships between the physical boards
and logical boards.
Step 4 See A.2.7.6 Setting Parameters of Inband DCN.
The values for the related parameters of NE22 to NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
All Ports

Enabled Status
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

43

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Step 5 See A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time and synchronize the NE time.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
All the Ports on All the NEs

Synchronous Mode

NM

Synchronization Period(days)

Step 6 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links or
SDH fiber connections.
Normally, all the radio links or SDH fiber connections should be created successfully on the
Main Topology.
----End

5.7 Configuration Example (Packet Network)


This section considers the NEs on a packet network as examples to describe how to configure
NEs according to the network planning information.

5.7.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Figure 5-11 shows a packet network configured according to the following requirements.
l

The packet network receives various base station services and the base station backhaul
services converged from a Hybrid radio chain network and a Hybrid radio ring network.

The packet network is comprised of the OptiX RTN equipment managed by the U2000.
NOTE

NE31 is an OptiX PTN NE in an actual network because it does not support any radio links. In this
example, NE31 is an IDU.

The U2000 is connected to NE31 by using a network cable. Therefore, NE31 serves as a
GNE and the other NEs are non-GNEs with an access to the U2000 through NE31.

The NEs on the packet ring are interconnected through GE fiber links. The NEs on the
packet chain are interconnected through Packet radio links.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

44

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Figure 5-11 Networking diagram (packet network)


NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4
BTS32
E1

BTS34

R4

E1

R99

FE
GE

GE

NE32
Hybrid radio chain
network

NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE
+G
E1

E1

NMS
E1

E1

BTS36

Hybrid radio ring


network

BTS35

R99
BTS37

BSC

R99
BTS38
RNC

The connections of DCN links shown in Figure 5-11 are described as follows.
Table 5-10 Connections of DCN links (NE31)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE31 and NE21

1-EM6F-2

Between NE31 and NE32

1-EM6F-1

Transmits services on the


packet ring.

Table 5-11 Connections of DCN links (NE32)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE32 and NE31

17-EG2D-2

Between NE32 and NE11

17-EG2D-1

Transmits services on the


packet ring.

Between NE32 and NE33

3-ISU2-1 (main IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

Transmits services on the


packet chain.

5-ISU2-1 (standby IF board


of a 1+1 HSB protection
group)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

45

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Table 5-12 Connections of DCN links (NE33)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE33 and NE32

4-ISU2-1 (main IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

Transmits services on the


packet chain.

6-ISU2-1 (standby IF board


of a 1+1 HSB protection
group)
Between NE33 and NE34

3-ISU2-1

Table 5-13 Connections of DCN links (NE34)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE34 and NE33

3-ISU2-1

Transmits services on the


packet chain.

Table 5-14 Connections of DCN links (NE11)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and NE32

17-EG2D-2

Between NE11 and NE21

17-EG2D-1

Transmits services on the


packet ring.

Table 5-15 Connections of DCN links (NE21)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and NE11

17-EG2D-2

Between NE21 and NE31

17-EG2D-1

Transmits services on the


packet ring.

5.7.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
l

Service channels are used for communication because NEs on the packet ring are
interconnected through GE fiber links. For the convenience of maintenance, inband DCN
is adopted on the packet ring and the packet chain.

Plan the channel for inband DCN.


On the packet ring, the inband DCN function needs to be enabled at Ethernet ports of
all NEs and be disabled at other ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

46

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

On the packet chain, the inband DCN function needs to be enabled at microwave ports
of all NEs and be disabled at other ports.
l

Plan the management VLAN ID and bandwidth of inband DCN for each NE.
The management VLAN ID takes the default value 4094.
If the number of NEs is not greater than 50, set the bandwidth of the inband DCN to
512 kbit/s (default value).

To facilitate interconnection with equipment that does not support HWECC, plane inband
DCN channels to use the default IP protocol.

The extended ECC function needs to be disabled on the GNE, namely, NE31.

Figure 5-12 shows the ID and IP address that are allocated to each NE according to the
uniform DCN planning information.
Figure 5-12 Allocated IDs and IP addresses (packet network)
9-34
129.9.0.34
0.0.0.0

9-33
129.9.0.33
0.0.0.0

NE34

NE33
GE

Hybrid Radio
Network

Packet
radio link
9-32
129.9.0.32
0.0.0.0

GE

NE32

NMS

9-31
10.0.0.31
0.0.0.0

9-11
129.9.0.11
0.0.0.0 NE11

NE31

NE11
GE

9-21
129.9.0.21
0.0.0.0

GE

10.0.0.103/16

NE21

Hybrid Radio
Network

Extended ID-Basic ID
IP address
Gateway

NOTE

l The subnet mask for the IP address of each NE is 255.255.0.0.


l The IP addresses of all the NEs, except NE31, are in the interlocking relationships with the NE IDs.
Hence, if the IP address of an NE (not NE31) is not changed manually, the NE automatically changes
the IP address to be the planned value after the NE ID is changed.

In this example, the policy of synchronizing the NE with the NM server is used. The
automatic synchronization period is one day. The daylight saving time (DST) scheme is
not used at the local area.

The 15-minute and 24-hour performance monitoring functions are enabled.

In this configuration example, no subnets need to be configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

47

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

5.7.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for the data configuration.

Precautions
If the NE ID and the values of NE communication parameters are changed and the logical boards
are configured in the NE commissioning process, skip the operations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method and create the NEs.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Search Domain

Search for NE

IP Address

129.9.255.255

Search User

root

Create NE after search

Selected

Upload after create

Selected

NE User

root

Password

password

NOTE

In this configuration example, it is assumed that the IP address of the GNE has not been changed manually and
that the IP addresses of the non-GNEs are not known. Hence, you need to search for and create the NEs by using
the 129.9.255.255 network segment as the search domain. If the IP address of the GNE is known, it is
recommended that you use the IP address of the GNE as the search domain.

The icons of NE31 to NE34, NE11, and NE21 should be displayed on the Main Topology and
all the NE data should be uploaded successfully.
Step 2 See A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID and change the NE ID.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Paramete
r

Value
NE31

NE32

NE33

NE34

NE11

NE21

New ID

31

32

33

34

11

21

New
Extended
ID

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

9 (default
value)

Step 3 See A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board and configure logical boards.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

48

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

Configure the logical boards according to the mapping relationships between the physical boards
and logical boards.
Step 4 See A.2.7.1 Setting NE Communication Parameters and set the NE communication
parameters.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

IP Address

10.0.0.31

Gateway IP Address

0.0.0.0 (default value)

Subnet Mask

255.255.0.0 (default value)

Extended ID

Connection Mode

Common + Security SSL

NOTE

The IP addresses of all the NEs, except NE31, are in the interlocking relationships with the NE IDs. Hence, you
need not change the values of the NE communication parameters manually.

Step 5 See A.2.7.8 Configuring Extended ECC Communication and disable the automatic extended
ECC function for the gateway NE (NE31).
Step 6 See A.2.7.6 Setting Parameters of Inband DCN and configure the extended ECC.
The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Enabled Status

1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

Other Ports

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enabled
Status

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Other Ports

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Enabled Status
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Other Ports

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

49

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5 Configuring the Network Topology

The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Enabled Status

3-ISU2-1

Other Ports

Enabled

Disabled

The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Enabled Status

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Other Ports

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Enabled Status

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Other Ports

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

Step 7 See A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time and synchronize the NE time.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
All Ports on All NEs

Synchronous Mode

NM

Synchronization Period(days)

Step 8 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links or
SDH fiber connections.
Normally, all the radio links or SDH fiber connections should be created successfully on the
Main Topology.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

50

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Configuring Radio Links

About This Chapter


Before configuring services on a radio link, you need to configure the radio link.
6.1 Basic Concepts
Before configuring the radio link, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
6.2 Configuration Procedure
The configuration procedures of different radio link configuration methods are different.
6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Chain Network)
This section considers radio links on a TDM radio chain network as examples to describe how
to configure radio links according to the planning information.
6.4 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Ring Network)
This section considers TDM radio links on a TDM radio ring network as examples to describe
how to configure radio links according to the network planning information.
6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network)
This section considers radio links on a Hybrid radio chain network as examples to describe how
to configure radio links according to the network planning information.
6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Ring Network)
This section considers radio links on a Hybrid radio ring network as examples to describe how
to configure radio links according to the network planning information.
6.7 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Packet Network)
This section considers radio links on a packet network as examples to describe how to configure
radio links according to the network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

51

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

6.1 Basic Concepts


Before configuring the radio link, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

6.1.1 Adaptive Modulation


The adaptive modulation (AM) technology adjusts the modulation scheme automatically based
on channel quality.
When the AM technology is adopted, in the case of the same channel spacing, the microwave
service bandwidth varies according to the modulation scheme; the higher the modulation
efficiency, the higher the bandwidth of the transmitted services.
l

When the channel quality is good (such as on days when weather conditions are favorable),
the equipment adopts a high-efficiency modulation scheme to transmit more user services.
This improves transmission efficiency and spectrum utilization of the system.

When the channel quality deteriorates (such as on days with adverse weather), the
equipment adopts a low-efficiency modulation scheme to transmit only higher-priority
services within the available bandwidth while discarding lower-priority services. This
method improves anti-interference capabilities of the radio link, which helps ensure the
link availability for higher-priority services.

In Integrated IP radio mode, the equipment supports the AM technology. With configurable
priorities for E1 services and packet services, the transmission is controlled based on the service
bandwidth and QoS policies corresponding to the current modulation scheme. The highestpriority services are transmitted with precedence.
NOTE

In Integrated IP radio mode, when the equipment transmits STM-1 services and packet services at the same
time, STM-1 services have highest priority and their transmission is ensured.

Priorities of E1 services
The priorities of E1 services are assigned based on the number of E1 services that each
modulation scheme can transmit. When modulation scheme switching occurs, only the E1
services whose number is specified in the new modulation scheme can be transmitted and
the excess E1 services are discarded.

Priorities of packet services


With the QoS technology, packet services are scheduled to queues with different priorities.
The services in different queues are transmitted to the microwave port after running the
queue scheduling algorithm. When modulation scheme switching occurs, certain queues
may be congested due to insufficient capacity at the air interface. As a result, certain services
or all the services in these queues are discarded.

Figure 6-1 shows the change in services brought by the AM technology. The orange part
indicates E1 services. The blue part indicates packet services. The closer the service is to the
outside of the cylinder in the figure, the lower the service priority. Under all channel conditions,
the service capacity varies according to the modulation scheme. When the channel conditions
are unfavorable (during adverse weather conditions), lower-priority services are discarded.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

52

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Figure 6-1 Adaptive modulation

256QAM
128QAM
64QAM
32QAM
16QAM

QPSK
16QAM

Channel
Capability

32QAM
64QAM
128QAM

E1 Services
256QAM

Ethernet
Services

The AM technology used by the OptiX RTN 980 has the following characteristics:
l

The AM technology uses the QPSK, 16QAM, 32QAM, 64QAM, 128QAM, and 256QAM
modulation schemes.

The lowest-efficiency modulation scheme (also called reference scheme or modulation


scheme of guaranteed capacity) and the highest-efficiency modulation scheme (also called
nominal scheme or modulation scheme of full capacity) used by the AM can be configured.

In AM, when modulation schemes are switched, the transmit frequency, receive frequency,
and channel spacing remain unchanged.

In AM, modulation schemes are switched step-by-step.

In AM, modulation scheme switching is hitless. When the modulation scheme is


downshifted, high-priority services will not be affected when low-priority services are
discarded. The switching is successful even when 100 dB/s channel fast fading occurs.

6.1.2 CCDP and XPIC


The co-channel dual-polarization (CCDP) and cross-polarization interference cancellation
(XPIC) technologies are developed based on microwave polarization characteristics. The CCDP,
wherein two signals are transmitted over two orthogonal polarization waves, doubles the
transmission capacity; the XPIC cancels the cross-polarization interference between the two
polarization waves.
Microwave transmission can be classified into single-polarized transmission and CCDP
transmission by polarization transmission mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

53

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

In single-polarized transmission, a signal is transmitted over the horizontally polarized


wave or the vertically polarized wave on the same channel, as shown in Figure 6-2.

In CCDP transmission, two signals are transmitted over the horizontally polarized wave
and the vertically polarized wave on the same channel, as shown in Figure 6-3.

The capacity in CCDP transmission mode is double the capacity in single-polarized transmission
mode.
Figure 6-2 Single-polarized transmission

Figure 6-3 CCDP transmission

The ideal situation of CCDP transmission is that no interference exists between the two
orthogonal signals that operate at the same frequency, and then the receiver can easily recover
the two signals. In actual engineering conditions, however, regardless of the orthogonality of
the two signals, certain interference between the signals exists, due to cross-polarization
discrimination (XPD) of the antenna and channel deterioration. To cancel the interference, the
XPIC technology is adopted to receive and process the signals in the horizontal and vertical
directions, so that the original signals are recovered.

6.1.3 RF Configuration Modes


The OptiX RTN 980 supports five RF configuration modes, namely, 1+0 non-protection
configuration, N+0 non-protection configuration, 1+1 protection configuration, N+1 protection
configuration, and cross-polarization interference cancellation (XPIC) configuration.

1+0 Non-Protection Configuration


The 1+0 non-protection configuration indicates that the radio link has one working channel and
no protection channel.

N+0 Non-Protection Configuration


The N+0 non-protection configuration indicates that the radio link has N working channels and
no protection channel.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

54

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

The OptiX RTN 980 supports N+0 protection (1 N 14).

1+1 Protection Configuration


The 1+1 protection configuration indicates that the radio link has one working channel and one
protection channel.
The 1+1 protection configuration is classified into 1+1 HSB, 1+1 FD, and 1+1 SD.
l

In 1+1 HSB protection mode, the equipment provides a 1+1 hot standby configuration for
the IF boards and ODUs at both ends of each hop of radio link, implementing the protection.

In 1+1 FD protection mode, the system uses two channels with a specific frequency interval
to transmit and receive the same service signal. The opposite end selects one from the two
received signals. With the 1+1 FD protection, the impact of the fading on signal
transmission is reduced.
The 1+1 FD protection also supports the 1+1 HSB protection.

In the 1+1 SD protection mode, the system uses two antennas with a space distance to
receive the same RF signal. The equipment selects from the two received signals. With the
1+1 SD protection, the impact of the fading on signal transmission is reduced.
The 1+1 SD protection also supports the 1+1 HSB protection.

N+1 Protection Configuration


The N+1 protection configuration indicates that the radio link has N working channels and one
protection channel.
The OptiX RTN 980 supports N+1 protection only in STM-1 radio and Integrated IP radio. The
N+1 protection is implemented through the N+1 MSP similar to l:N linear MSP.
The OptiX RTN 980 supports N+1 protection (1 N 7).

XPIC Configuration
The XPIC adopts both the horizontally polarized wave and the vertically polarized wave over
one channel to transmit two channels of signals. The radio link capacity in XPIC configuration
is double the radio link capacity in 1+0 configuration.
The OptiX RTN 980 only supports the XPIC configuration for Integrated IP radio.

6.1.4 PLA
Physical link aggregation (PLA) aggregates all Ethernet bandwidths in several Integrated IP
radio links between two NEs into a logical Ethernet path for higher Ethernet bandwidth. Using
PLA can effectively improve the bandwidth and reliability for transmitting Ethernet services
over Integrated IP radio links.
As shown in Figure 6-4, PLA allows all Ethernet transmission paths in several Integrated IP
radio links connected to the same equipment to be aggregated as a PLA group. For MAC users,
a PLA group works as a single link.
NOTE

Native TDM services on the Integrated IP radio links are irrelevant to the PLA.

Different from air-interface LAG, PLA dynamically allocates Ethernet traffic based on the actual
Ethernet bandwidth over each member radio link to achieve load sharing between member radio
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

55

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

links. PLA can use the load sharing mode regardless of whether member radio links use the same
Ethernet frame type and frame length and provide the same Ethernet bandwidth. PLA ensures
equivalent Ethernet bandwidth utilization between member radio links even when the Ethernet
bandwidth on each member link changes.
Figure 6-4 PLA
Radio link 1
Native TDM Channel
Ethernet
Channel

Physical
Link
Aggregation

Ethernet
Channel
Native TDM Channel
Radio link 2

PLA is applicable to improve Ethernet service bandwidth and reliability for integrated IP
microwave when air-interface LAG is inapplicable (for example, when member radio links
provide different Ethernet bandwidths or the load-sharing algorithm used by air-interface LAG
cannot implement load equalization between member radio links).
NOTE

l The member links in a PLA group must be carried by the same type of IF board (ISU2 or ISX2).
l In the current version, PLA aggregates only two links, which means that a PLA group can contain only one
main port and one slave port. The IF boards where the main and slave ports are located must be installed in
two paired slots.

6.2 Configuration Procedure


The configuration procedures of different radio link configuration methods are different.
Figure 6-5 provides the procedures for configuring radio links.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

56

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Figure 6-5 Configuration flow chart (radio links)


Configure TDM radio links (with
XPIC function)
Start

Configure TDM radio links


(without XPIC function)
Start

Configure IP radio links (with XPIC


function)

Configure IP radio links (without


XPIC function)
Start

Start

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Create XPIC working


groups

Configure IF
IF 1+1
1+1
Configure
protection
protection

Create XPIC working


groups

Configure IF 1+1
protection

Configure IF
IF 1+1
1+1
Configure
protection
protection

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure ODU power


attributes

Configure N+1 protection

Create radio links by


using the search
method

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure ATPC function

Configure ODU power


attributes

Configure N+1 protection

Create radio links by


using the search
method

End

End

Compulsory

Optional

Configure AM attributes
for XPIC function

Configure IF
IF 1+1
1+1
Configure
protection
protection

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure ATPC function

Configure IF/ODU
information for radio links

Configure AM advanced
attributes

Configure ODU power


attributes

Configuring physical link


aggregation (PLA)

Configure N+1 protection

Create radio links by


using the search
method

Configure AM advanced
attributes

Configure ODU power


attributes

Configuring physical link


aggregation (PLA)

Configure N+1 protection

Create radio links by


using the search
method

End

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

57

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Procedures for Configuring TDM Radio Links (with the XPIC function enabled)
Table 6-1 Procedures for Configuring TDM Radio Links (with the XPIC function enabled)
Operation

Description

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/


ODU Information of a
Radio Link

For the ISX2, set IF Service Type for the IF boards in both
the vertically and horizontally polarized directions of an XPIC
workgroup according to planning information.
NOTE
The default value of IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).

A.3.2 Creating an XPIC


Workgroup

Required.

A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1


Protection Group

Required when two XPIC workgroups need to form two IF 1


+1 protection groups.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.
NOTE
One XPIC workgroup cannot form an IF 1+1 protection group. The
radio link in the horizontal/vertical polarization direction of the XPIC
workgroup can form an IF 1+1 protection group with the radio link in
the horizontal/vertical polarization direction of the other XPIC
workgroup.

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/


ODU Information of a
Radio Link

Required.

A.6.9.3 Setting ODU


Power Attributes

Optional.

A.3.5 Creating an N+1


Protection Group

Required when members of an XPIC workgroup need to be


configured in an N+1 protection group.

Set Power to Be Received(dBm) to the received signal level


specified in the network planning information. The antenna
non-alignment indication function is enabled only after this
parameter is set. When the antenna misalignment indicating
function is enabled, if the actual receive power of the ODU is
3 dB lower than the power expected to be received, the ODU
indicator on the IF board connected to the ODU blinks yellow
(300 ms on, 300 ms off), indicating that the antenna is not
aligned. After the antennas are aligned for consecutive 30
minutes, the NE automatically disables the antenna nonalignment indication function.

TX High Threshold(dBm), TX Low Threshold(dBm), RX


High Threshold(dBm), and RX Low Threshold(dBm)
affect only the performance events associated with ATPC.
Therefore, determine whether to set these parameters
according to the actual requirements.

Set attributes of the N+1 protection group to the same values


at both ends.
Set the related parameters according to network planning
information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

58

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Operation

Description

A.2.5.1 Creating Optical


Fibers by Using the Search
Method

In normal cases, the main topology displays the previously


created radio links.

NOTE

l During the site commissioning, you can configure the two XPIC links as two separate non-XPIC links.
l The preceding parameters need to set to the same values, separately for the radio links in the vertical and
horizontal polarization directions.
l In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 HSB/SD, you need to configure the IF and ODU information
on the main radio link only. In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 FD, you need to configure the IF
and ODU information on the main radio link and the ODU information on the standby radio link.

Procedures for Configuring TDM Radio Links (with the XPIC function disabled)
Table 6-2 Procedures for configuring TDM radio links (with the XPIC function disabled)
Operation

Description

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/


ODU Information of a
Radio Link

For the ISU2 and ISX2, set IF Service Type to SDH.

A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1


Protection Groupa

Required when the radio links are configured with 1+1


protection.

NOTE
The default value of IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.
A.3.4 Configuring the IF/
ODU Information of a
Radio Linka

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Work Mode and Link ID according to the network
planning information.
l Set TX Frequency(MHz), T/R Spacing(MHz), and TX
Power(dBm) according to the network planning
information.
l Set TX Status to unmute.
l Set Power to Be Received(dBm) to the received signal
level specified in the network planning information. The
antenna non-alignment indication function is enabled only
after this parameter is set. When the antenna misalignment
indicating function is enabled, if the actual receive power
of the ODU is 3 dB lower than the power expected to be
received, the ODU indicator on the IF board connected to
the ODU blinks yellow (300 ms on, 300 ms off), indicating
that the antenna is not aligned. After the antennas are
aligned for consecutive 30 minutes, the NE automatically
disables the antenna non-alignment indication function.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

59

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Operation

Description

A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC


Attributesa

Required when the ATPC function needs to be used.


l If the ATPC function needs to be used, set ATPC Enable
Status to Enabled.
l During site commissioning, set ATPC Enable Status to
Disabled.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC Upper Threshold
(dBm) to the central value plus 10 dB.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC Lower Threshold
(dBm) to the central value minus 10 dB.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status to Disabled.

A.6.9.3 Setting ODU


Power Attributesa

Optional.
l To set the maximum transmit power that is supported by
the ATPC adjustment function, you need to set Maximum
Transmit Power(dBm) according to the actual
requirements.
l TX High Threshold(dBm), TX Low Threshold(dBm),
RX High Threshold(dBm), and RX Low Threshold
(dBm) affect only the performance events associated with
ATPC. Therefore, determine whether to set these
parameters according to the actual requirements.

A.3.5 Creating an N+1


Protection Group

Required when the radio links are configured with N+1


protection.
Set the attributes of the N+1 protection group to the same
values for the equipment at both ends.
Set the parameters according to the network planning
information.

A.2.5.1 Creating Optical


Fibers by Using the Search
Method

In normal cases, the main topology displays the previously


created radio links.

NOTE

l a: Generally, during the site commissioning, the previous steps are completed. After the site commissioning,
however, you need to reset ATPC Enable Status.
l In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 HSB/SD, you need to configure the IF and ODU information
on the main radio link only. In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 FD, you need to configure the IF
and ODU information on the main radio link and the ODU information on the standby radio link.
l In the case of TDM radio links configured with N+1 protection, you need to configure the IF and ODU
information on each link. Work Mode must be configured as 7, STM-1, 28MHz, 128QAM.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

60

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Configuration Procedure of an Integrated IP radio Link (with the XPIC function


enabled)
Table 6-3 Procedure for configuring an Integrated IP radio link (with the XPIC function enabled)
Operation

Description

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU


Information of a Radio Link

For the ISX2, set IF Service Type for the IF boards in


both the vertically and horizontally polarized
directions of an XPIC workgroup according to
planning information.
NOTE
The default value of IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native E1
+ETH).

A.3.2 Creating an XPIC


Workgroup

Required.

A.3.3 Setting the AM Attributes


of the XPIC Workgroup

Required.

A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1


Protection Group

Required when two XPIC workgroups need to form


two IF 1+1 protection groups.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information. The parameters in both polarization
directions need to take the same values.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.
NOTE
One XPIC workgroup cannot form an IF 1+1 protection
group. The radio link in the horizontal/vertical polarization
direction of the XPIC workgroup can form an IF 1+1
protection group with the radio link in the horizontal/vertical
polarization direction of the other XPIC workgroup.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

61

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Operation

Description

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU


Information of a Radio Link

Required.
l Set Power to Be Received(dBm) to the received
signal level specified in the network planning
information. The antenna non-alignment indication
function is enabled only after this parameter is set.
When the antenna misalignment indicating
function is enabled, if the actual receive power of
the ODU is 3 dB lower than the power expected to
be received, the ODU indicator on the IF board
connected to the ODU blinks yellow (300 ms on,
300 ms off), indicating that the antenna is not
aligned. After the antennas are aligned for
consecutive 30 minutes, the NE automatically
disables the antenna non-alignment indication
function.
l To enable the E1 priority function, set Enable E1
Priority to Enabled. In addition, set Guarantee
E1 Capacity and Full E1 Capacity according to
the network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.8.3 Setting Advanced AM


Attributes

Optional.

A.6.9.3 Setting ODU Power


Attributes

Optional.

To ensure that a specific number of E1s can be


transmitted in intermediate modulation schemes,
adjust the E1 capacity in each modulation scheme
according to the network planning information.
Generally, it is recommended that you use the default
values.

TX High Threshold(dBm), TX Low Threshold


(dBm), RX High Threshold(dBm), and RX Low
Threshold(dBm) affect only the performance events
associated with ATPC. Therefore, determine whether
to set these parameters according to the actual
requirements.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

62

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation
Configuring
physical link
aggregation
(PLA)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Description
A.3.11 Creating
a PLA Group

Required when an XPIC workgroup consisting of the


ISX2 needs to use the PLA feature.
Set PLA-associated parameters according to the
network planning information.
NOTE
l In this version, PLA aggregates only two links, which
means that a PLA group can contain only one main port
and one slave port. The ISX2 boards where the main and
slave ports are located must be installed in two paired
slots.
l The slave port to be configured in a PLA group must carry
no Ethernet service.
l Member links in a PLA group must use the same channel
spacing.
l The IF services transmitted by the members in a PLA
group must be of the same type.
l The two members of an XPIC workgroup can form a PLA
group, providing Ethernet service protection between the
vertical and horizontal polarization directions. One
member in an XPIC workgroup and one member in
another XPIC workgroup cannot form a PLA group.
l Member links in a PLA group cannot be configured in
any 1+1 HSB/FD/SD or N+1 protection groups.
l Member links in a PLA group cannot be member links in
a LAG group.
l Member links in a PLA group support Layer 2 header
compression but do not support Layer 3 header
compression. The main and slave ports in a PLA group
must use the same Ethernet header compression mode.

A.3.12 Querying
the Status of a
PLA Group

Set Minimum Active Links according to the network


planning information.

A.3.5 Creating an N+1 Protection


Group

Required when members of an XPIC workgroup need


to be configured in an N+1 protection group.

When PLA and Ethernet ring protection switching


(ERPS) coexist and Minimum Active Links is not 1,
ERPS switching can be triggered even if not all
members in the PLA group fail.

Set attributes of the N+1 protection group to the same


values at both ends.
Set the related parameters according to network
planning information.
A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers
by Using the Search Method

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

In normal cases, the main topology displays the


previously created radio links.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

63

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

NOTE

l During the site commissioning, you can configure the two XPIC links as two separate non-XPIC links
according to Table 6-4.
l The preceding parameters need to set to the same values, separately for the radio links in the vertical and
horizontal polarization directions.
l In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 HSB/SD, you need to configure the IF and ODU information
on the main radio link only. In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 FD, you need to configure the IF
and ODU information on the main radio link and the ODU information on the standby radio link.
l The MW_CFG_MISMATCH alarm is reported, if the E1 count, AM enabled status, 1588 timeslot enabled
status, modulation mode, or STM-1 count is set inconsistently for both ends of an Integrated IP radio link.
This alarm should be cleared immediately. Otherwise, services may be configured unsuccessfully or
interrupted.

Procedure for configuring an Integrated IP radio link (with the XPIC function
disabled)
Table 6-4 Procedure for configuring an Integrated IP radio link (with the XPIC function
disabled)
Operation

Description

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU


Information of a Radio Link

For the ISU2 and ISX2, set IF Service Type


according to planning information.
NOTE
The default value of IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native
E1+ETH).

A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection


Groupa

Required when the radio links are configured with


IF 1+1 protection.
Set the parameters according to the network
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

64

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Operation

Description

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU


Information of a Radio Linka

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set AM Enable Status and IF Channel
Bandwidth according to the network
planning information.
l When the AM function is enabled on the radio
links, set Modulation Mode of the
Guarantee AM Capacity and Modulation
Mode of the Full AM Capacity according to
the network planning information.
l When the AM function is disabled on the radio
links, set Manually Specified Modulation
Mode according to the network planning
information.
l During site commissioning, set AM Enable
Status to Disabled. In addition, set Manually
Specified Modulation Mode to Modulation
Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity that is
planned.
l Set Full E1 Capacity and Link ID according
to the network planning information.
l Set TX Frequency(MHz), T/R Spacing
(MHz), and TX Power(dBm) according to
the network planning information.
l Set TX Status to unmute.
l Set Power to Be Received(dBm) to the
received signal level specified in the network
planning information. The antenna nonalignment indication function is enabled only
after this parameter is set. When the antenna
misalignment indicating function is enabled,
if the actual receive power of the ODU is 3 dB
lower than the power expected to be received,
the ODU indicator on the IF board connected
to the ODU blinks yellow (300 ms on, 300 ms
off), indicating that the antenna is not aligned.
After the antennas are aligned for consecutive
30 minutes, the NE automatically disables the
antenna non-alignment indication function.
l To enable the E1 priority function, set Enable
E1 Priority to Enabled. In addition, set
Guarantee E1 Capacity and Full E1
Capacity according to the network planning
information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

65

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Operation

Description

A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributesa

Required when the ATPC function needs to be


used.
l If the ATPC function needs to be used, set
ATPC Enable Status to Enabled.
l During site commissioning, set ATPC Enable
Status to Disabled.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC Upper
Threshold(dBm) to the central value plus 10
dB.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC Lower
Threshold(dBm) to the central value minus
10 dB.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC
Automatic Threshold Enable Status to
Disabled.

A.6.8.3 Setting Advanced AM


Attributesa

Optional.

A.6.9.3 Setting ODU Power


Attributesa

Optional.

To ensure that a specific number of E1s can be


transmitted in intermediate modulation schemes,
adjust the E1 capacity in each modulation scheme
according to the network planning information.
Generally, it is recommended that you use the
default values.

l To set the maximum transmit power that is


supported by the ATPC adjustment function,
you need to set Maximum Transmit Power
(dBm) according to the actual requirements.
l TX High Threshold(dBm), TX Low
Threshold(dBm), RX High Threshold
(dBm), and RX Low Threshold(dBm) affect
only the performance events associated with
ATPC. Therefore, determine whether to set
these parameters according to the actual
requirements.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

66

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation
Configuring
PLA

6 Configuring Radio Links

Description
A.3.11 Creating a
PLA Group

Required when the ISU2/ISX2 needs to use the


PLA feature.
Set PLA-associated parameters according to the
network planning information.
NOTE
l The member boards in a PLA group must be IF
boards of the same type.
l In this version, PLA aggregates only two links,
which means that a PLA group can contain only one
main port and one slave port. The IF boards where
the main and slave ports are located must be
installed in two paired slots.
l A port to be configured in a PLA group must carry
no Ethernet services.
l Member links in a PLA group must use the same
channel spacing.
l The IF services transmitted by the members in a
PLA group must be of the same type.
l Member links in a PLA group cannot be configured
in any 1+1 HSB/FD/SD or N+1 protection groups.
l Member links in a PLA group cannot be member
links in a LAG group.
l Member links in a PLA group support Layer 2
header compression but do not support Layer 3
header compression. The main and slave ports in a
PLA group must use the same Ethernet header
compression mode.

A.3.12 Querying the


Status of a PLA
Group

Set Minimum Active Links according to the


network planning information. Generally, it is
recommended that this parameter takes the
default value.
NOTE
When PLA and ERPS coexist and Minimum Active
Links is not 1, ERPS switching can be triggered even
if not all members in the PLA group fail.

A.3.5 Creating an N+1 Protection


Group

Required when the radio links are configured with


N+1 protection.
Set the attributes of the N+1 protection group to
the same values for the equipment at both ends.
Set the parameters according to the network
planning information.

A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by


Using the Search Method

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

In normal cases, the main topology displays the


previously created radio links.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

67

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

NOTE

l a: Generally, during the site commissioning, the previous steps are completed. After the site commissioning,
however, you need to reset AM Enable Status and ATPC Enable Status.
l In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 HSB/SD, you need to configure the IF and ODU information
on the main radio link only. In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 FD, you need to configure the IF
and ODU information on the main radio link and the ODU information on the standby radio link.
l To configure Integrated IP radio links with N+1 protection, you need to configure the IF and ODU
information on each link.
l The MW_CFG_MISMATCH alarm is reported, if the E1 count, AM enabled status, 1588 timeslot enabled
status, modulation mode, or STM-1 count is set inconsistently for both ends of an Integrated IP radio link.
This alarm should be cleared immediately. Otherwise, services may be configured unsuccessfully or
interrupted.

6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio


Chain Network)
This section considers radio links on a TDM radio chain network as examples to describe how
to configure radio links according to the planning information.

6.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 5.3 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Chain Network Topology), configure the
TDM radio links according to the following network planning information (as shown in Figure
6-6):
l

The service capacity accessed by each BTS is provided in Table 6-5.


Table 6-5 Service capacity accessed by each BTS
BTS

BTS11

BTS12

BTS13

BTS14

BTS15

Number of
E1 services

16

14

To improve transmission reliability of important services, the radio links between NE11
and NE12, between NE13 and NE14, and between NE13 and NE15 are configured with 1
+1 HSB protection.

The ATPC function is enabled to reduce inter-site interference.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

68

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Figure 6-6 Networking diagram (TDM radio chain network)


102
14952M
14532M
16E1,14M,16QAM
1+1 HSB
H-polarization

BTS12

BTS13

Tx high

104
14930M
14510M
8E1,7M,16QAM
1+0
H-polarzation

NE12

NE11

Tx low

NE14
Tx high

Tx high

NE15

Tx low

NE16

NE13

101
14930M
14510M
STM-1,28M,128QAM
1+1 HSB
V-polarzation

Tx low

Tx low
103
14967M
14547M
22E1,14M,32QAM
1+1 HSB
V-polarization

Tx high

Third party
SDH network

BTS11

BTS14
BTS15

Link ID
Tx high station Tx Freq.
Tx low station Tx Freq.
Radio work mode
RF configuarion
Polarization

The connections of radio links shown in Figure 6-6 are described as follows.
Table 6-6 Connections of radio links (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and NE12

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-IF1 (standby IF board)

Table 6-7 Connections of radio links (NE12)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE12 and NE11

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-IF1 (standby IF board)

Table 6-8 Connections of radio links (NE13)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE13 and NE14

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-IF1 (standby IF board)


Between NE13 and NE15

4-IF1 (main IF board)


6-IF1 (standby IF board)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

69

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Table 6-9 Connections of radio links (NE14)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE14 and NE13

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

4-IF1 (standby IF board)

Table 6-10 Connections of radio links (NE15)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and NE13

4-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

6-IF1 (standby IF board)


Between NE15 and NE16

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 6-11 Connections of radio links (NE16)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE16 and NE15

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

6.3.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Basic Information About Radio Links


According to the spectrum allocation on the radio network and the required radio transmission
capacity, you can obtain the basic information about the radio links, as provided in Table
6-12.
Table 6-12 Basic information about radio links

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Link ID

101

102

103

104

Tx high site

NE11

NE14

NE15

NE15

Tx low site

NE12

NE13

NE13

NE16

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

70

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Tx frequency at
the Tx high site
(MHz)

14930

14952

14967

14930

Tx frequency at
the Tx low site
(MHz)

14510

14532

14547

14510

T/R spacing
(MHz)

420

420

420

420

Radio working
mode

STM-1,
28MHz,
128QAM

16E1, 14MHz,
16QAM

22E1, 14MHz,
32QAM

8E1, 7MHz,
16QAM

RF
configuration
mode

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+0

Polarization
direction

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

NOTE

l To prevent interference on a microwave site, it is recommended that you plan the microwave site as
only a TX high site or a TX low site at a time.
l To prevent interference between two radio links on a microwave site that use transmit frequencies with
a small spacing between, it is recommended that you set the two radio links to operate in different
polarization directions.
l The planning information that is not related to the configuration of the IDU (except for the polarization
direction) is not provided in this example.

Power and ATPC Information


By using the radio network planning software such as the Pathloss, you can analyze and compute
the availability of services and parameters of radio links. Then, you can obtain the power and
ATPC information of the radio links as provided in Table 6-13.
Table 6-13 Power and ATPC information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Transmit power
(dBm)

5 (NE11)

10 (NE13)

10 (NE13)

15 (NE15)

5 (NE12)

10 (NE14)

10 (NE15)

15 (NE16)

Receive power
(dBm)

-42 (NE11)

-44 (NE13)

-43 (NE13)

-48 (NE15)

-42 (NE12)

-44 (NE14)

-43 (NE15)

-48 (NE16)

ATPC enabling

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

71

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

ATPC
automatic
threshold
enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Upper threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

-32 (NE11)

-34 (NE13)

-33 (NE13)

-38 (NE15)

-32 (NE12)

-34 (NE14)

-33 (NE15)

-38 (NE16)

Lower threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

-52 (NE11)

-54 (NE13)

-53 (NE13)

-58 (NE15)

-52 (NE12)

-54 (NE14)

-53 (NE15)

-58 (NE16)

Maximum
transmit power
(dBm)

NOTE

l In this example, the ATPC is enabled to reduce the inter-site interference. The ATPC may be disabled if
there is no such a requirement.
l The ATPC controls the receive power within a range, namely, (2 dB more or less than the central value
between the upper threshold and lower threshold of ATPC adjustment). Hence, this example sets the upper
threshold to 10 dB higher than the receive power, and the lower threshold is 10 dB lower than the receive
power.
l The maximum transmit power is the actual maximum transmit power of the ODU after the ATPC is enabled.
When this parameter is not specified, the value of the parameter is the rated maximum transmit power of
the ODU. If the ODU works at the rated maximum transmit power, the electromagnetic wave agrees with
the spectrum configuration profile. Hence, this parameter is not set generally.

Information of IF Boards
According to the radio type, slot priorities of IF boards, and configuration rules of the 1+1
protection, you can obtain the information of IF boards as provided in Table 6-14.
Table 6-14 Information of IF boards

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Main IF board

3-IF1 (NE11)

3-IF1 (NE13)

4-IF1 (NE13)

3-IF1 (NE15)

3-IF1 (NE12)

3-IF1 (NE14)

4-IF1 (NE15)

3-IF1 (NE16)

Standby IF
board

5-IF1 (NE11)

6-IF1 (NE13)

5-IF1 (NE12)

5-IF1 (NE13)
4-IF1(NE14)

RF
configuration
mode

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

6-IF1 (NE15)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1+0

72

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Revertive mode

Revertive
(default value)

Revertive
(default value)

Revertive
(default value)

WTR time(s)

600 (default
value)

600 (default
value)

600 (default
value)

Reverse
switching
enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

NOTE

l It is recommended that you install the IF boards in a 1+1 HSB protection group in any of the following slot
pairs (with the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and
6, slots 7 and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l You need to install the IF boards in a 1+1 FD/SD protection group in any of the following slot pairs (with
the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and 6, slots 7
and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l In 1+1 HSB configuration, it is recommended that you disable the reverse switching function. In 1+1 SD
configuration, it is recommended that you enable the reverse switching function.
l Unless otherwise specified the other parameters of the 1+1 HSB/FD/SD all take default values.

6.3.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group and create the IF 1+1 protection groups for
NE11 to NE15.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

3-IF1

Protection Board

5-IF1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

73

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Value
NE12

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

3-IF1

Protection Board

5-IF1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE13

Working Mode

HSB

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Disabled

Working Board

3-IF1

4-IF1

Protection Board

5-IF1

6-IF1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE14

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

3-IF1

Protection Board

4-IF1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

74

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
NE15

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

4-IF1

Protection Board

6-IF1

Step 2 See A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link and configure the IF/ODU
information of the radio link.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

Work Mode

7,STM-1,28MHz,128QAM

Link ID

101

TX Frequency(MHz)

14930

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-42

TX Status

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Work Mode

7,STM-1,28MHz,128QAM

Link ID

101

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-42

TX Status

unmute
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

75

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Work Mode

6,16E1,14MHz,16QAM

8,22E1,14MHz,32QAM

Link ID

102

103

TX Frequency(MHz)

14532

14547

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

10

10

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-44

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

Work Mode

6,16E1,14MHz,16QAM

Link ID

102

TX Frequency(MHz)

14952

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

10

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-44

TX Status

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Work Mode

4,8E1,7MHz,16QAM

8,22E1,14MHz,32QAM

Link ID

104

103

TX Frequency(MHz)

14930

14967

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

15

10

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

76

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-48

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

Work Mode

4,8E1,7MHz,16QAM

Link ID

104

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

15

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-48

TX Status

unmute

Step 3 See A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes and configure the ATPC function.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold(dBm)

-32

ATPC Lower Threshold(dBm)

-52

ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable


Status

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold(dBm)

-32

ATPC Lower Threshold(dBm)

-52

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

77

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable


Status

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold


(dBm)

-34

-33

ATPC Lower Threshold


(dBm)

-54

-53

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold(dBm)

-34

ATPC Lower Threshold(dBm)

-54

ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable


Status

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold


(dBm)

-38

-33

ATPC Lower Threshold


(dBm)

-58

-53

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

78

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold(dBm)

-38

ATPC Lower Threshold(dBm)

-58

ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable


Status

Disabled

Step 4 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links
connections.
The main topology should display all the created radio links.
----End

6.4 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio


Ring Network)
This section considers TDM radio links on a TDM radio ring network as examples to describe
how to configure radio links according to the network planning information.

6.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 5.4 Configuration Example (TDM Radio Ring Network Topology), configure the
TDM radio links according to the network planning information (as shown in Figure 6-7):
l

The service capacity accessed by each BTS is provided in Table 6-15.


Table 6-15 Service capacity accessed by each BTS
BTS

BTS21

BTS22

BTS23

BTS24

Number of E1
services

To improve transmission reliability of important services, the radio links between NE21
and NE24 are configured with 1+1 SD protection.

The ATPC function is enabled to reduce inter-site interference.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

79

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Figure 6-7 Networking diagram (TDM radio ring network)


Third party
SDH network
201
14930M
14510M
16E1,14M,16QAM
1+0
V-polarzation

NE21

Tx high

BTS21
NE22

Tx high

Tx low

Tx low

Tx low

Tx low
Tx high

BTS22

204
14958M
14538M
16E1,14M,16QAM
1+1
V-polarization

202
14958M
14538M
16E1,14M,16QAM
1+0
H-polarization

NE24

BTS24

Tx high
203
14930M
14510M
16E1,14M,16QAM
1+0
H-polarzation

4E1
NE23
BTS23
Link ID
Tx high station Tx Freq.
Tx low station Tx Freq.
Radio work mode
RF configuarion
Polarization

The connections of radio links shown in Figure 6-7 are described as follows.
Table 6-16 Connections of radio links (NE21)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and NE22

4-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE21 and NE24

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


SD protection group.

5-IF1 (standby IF board)

Table 6-17 Connections of radio links (NE22)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and NE21

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

80

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and NE23

4-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 6-18 Connections of radio links (NE23)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE23 and NE22

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE23 and NE24

4-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 6-19 Connections of radio links (NE24)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE24 and NE21

4-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

6-IF1 (standby IF board)


Between NE24 and NE23

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

6.4.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Basic Information About Radio Links


According to the spectrum allocation on the radio network and the required radio transmission
capacity, you can obtain the basic information about the radio links as provided in Table 6-20.
Table 6-20 Basic information about radio links

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Link ID

201

202

203

204

Tx high site

NE21

NE23

NE23

NE21

Tx low site

NE22

NE22

NE24

NE24

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

81

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Tx frequency at
the Tx high site
(MHz)

14930

14958

14930

14958

Tx frequency at
the Tx low site
(MHz)

14510

14538

14510

14538

T/R spacing
(MHz)

420

420

420

420

Radio working
mode

16E1, 14MHz,
16QAM

16E1, 14MHz,
16QAM

16E1, 14MHz,
16QAM

16E1, 14MHz,
16QAM

RF
configuration
mode

1+0

1+0

1+0

1+1 SD

Polarization
direction

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

V (vertical
polarization)

NOTE

The planning information that is not related to the configuration of the IDU (except for the polarization
direction) is not provided in this example.

Power and ATPC Information


By using the radio network planning software such as the Pathloss, you can analyze and compute
the availability of services and parameters of radio links. Then, you can obtain the power and
ATPC information about the radio links, as provided in Table 6-21.
Table 6-21 Power and ATPC information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Transmit power
(dBm)

9 (NE21)

10 (NE23)

10 (NE23)

8 (NE21)

9 (NE22)

10 (NE22)

10 (NE24)

8 (NE24)

Receive power
(dBm)

-46 (NE21)

-44 (NE23)

-43 (NE23)

-47 (NE21)

-46 (NE22)

-44 (NE22)

-43 (NE24)

-47 (NE24)

ATPC enabling

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC
automatic
threshold
enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

82

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Upper threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

-36 (NE21)

-34 (NE23)

-33 (NE23)

-37 (NE21)

-36 (NE22)

-34 (NE22)

-33 (NE24)

-37 (NE24)

Lower threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

-56 (NE21)

-54 (NE23)

-53 (NE23)

-57 (NE21)

-56 (NE22)

-54 (NE22)

-53 (NE24)

-57 (NE24)

Maximum
transmit power
(dBm)

NOTE

l In this example, the ATPC is enabled to reduce the inter-site interference. The ATPC may be disabled if
there is no such a requirement.
l The ATPC controls the receive power within a range, namely, (2 dB more or less than the central value of
the upper threshold and lower threshold of ATPC adjustment). Hence, this example sets the upper threshold
to 10 dB higher than the receive power, and the lower threshold is 10 dB lower than the receive power.
l The maximum transmit power is the actual maximum transmit power of the ODU after the ATPC is enabled.
When this parameter is not specified, the value of the parameter is the rated maximum transmit power of
the ODU. If the ODU works at the rated maximum transmit power, the electromagnetic wave agrees with
the spectrum configuration profile. Hence, this parameter is not set generally.

Information About IF Boards


According to the radio type, slot priorities of IF boards, and configuration rules of the 1+1
protection, you can obtain the information about IF boards as provided in Table 6-22.
Table 6-22 Information of IF boards

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Main IF board

4-IF1 (NE21)

4-IF1 (NE22)

4-IF1 (NE23)

4-IF1 (NE24)

3-IF1 (NE22)

3-IF1 (NE23)

3-IF1 (NE24)

3-IF1 (NE21)

Standby IF
board

6-IF1 (NE24)

RF
configuration
mode

1+0

1+0

1+0

1+1 SD

Revertive mode

Revertive
(default value)

WTR time(s)

600 (default
value)

5-IF1 (NE21)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

83

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Reverse
switching
enabling

Enabled

NOTE

l It is recommended that you install the IF boards in a 1+1 HSB protection group in any of the following slot
pairs (with the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and
6, slots 7 and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l You need to install the IF boards in a 1+1 FD/SD protection group in any of the following slot pairs (with
the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and 6, slots 7
and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l In 1+1 HSB configuration, it is recommended that you disable the reverse switching function. In 1+1 SD
configuration, it is recommended that you enable the reverse switching function.
l Unless otherwise specified, the other parameters of the 1+1 HSB/FD/SD all take default values.

6.4.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group and configure the 1+1 protection groups for
NE21 and NE24.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

Working Mode

SD

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Enabled

Working Board

3-IF1

Protection Board

5-IF1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE24

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Working Mode

SD

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

84

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Value
NE24

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Enabled

Working Board

4-IF1

Protection Board

6-IF1

Step 2 See A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link and configure the IF/ODU
information of the radio link.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Work Mode

6,16E1,14MHz,16QAM

6,16E1,14MHz,16QAM

Link ID

204

201

TX Frequency(MHz)

14958

14930

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-47

-46

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Work Mode

6, 16E1,14MHz, 16QAM

6, 16E1, 14MHz, 16QAM

Link ID

201

202

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

14538

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

10

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-46

-44

TX Status

unmute

unmute

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

85

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Work Mode

6, 16E1, 14MHz, 16QAM

6, 16E1, 14MHz, 16QAM

Link ID

202

203

TX Frequency(MHz)

14958

14930

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

10

10

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-44

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Work Mode

6, 16E1, 14MHz, 16QAM

6, 16E1, 14MHz, 16QAM

Link ID

203

204

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

14538

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

10

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-43

-47

TX Status

unmute

unmute

Step 3 See A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes and configure the ATPC function.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold


(dBm)

-37

-36

ATPC Lower Threshold


(dBm)

-57

-56

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

86

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold


(dBm)

-36

-34

ATPC Lower Threshold


(dBm)

-56

-54

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold


(dBm)

-34

-33

ATPC Lower Threshold


(dBm)

-54

-53

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

ATPC Upper Threshold


(dBm)

-33

-37

ATPC Lower Threshold


(dBm)

-53

-57

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

87

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status

3-IF1 and 23-ODU

4-IF1 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

Step 4 A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links
connections.
The main topology should display all the created radio links.
----End

6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid


Radio Chain Network)
This section considers radio links on a Hybrid radio chain network as examples to describe how
to configure radio links according to the network planning information.

6.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 5.5 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Chain Network), configure the Hybrid
radio links according to the following network planning information (as shown in Figure 6-8):
l

Each Hybrid radio link transmits E1 services and Ethernet services. The AM function is
enabled on each link.

To improve transmission reliability of important services, the radio links between NE11
and NE12, between NE13 and NE14, and between NE13 and NE15 are configured with 1
+1 HSB protection.

The service capacity accessed by each BTS is provided in Table 6-23.


Table 6-23 Service capacity accessed by each BTS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

BTS

BTS11

BTS12

BTS13

BTS14

BTS15

Number of
highpriority E1s

Number of
low-priority
E1s

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

88

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

BTS

BTS11

BTS12

BTS13

BTS14

BTS15

Capacity of
highpriority
Ethernet
services
(Mbit/s)

10

Capacity of
low-priority
Ethernet
services
(Mbit/s)

35

15

24

20

19

NOTE

High-priority services are guaranteed with sufficient transmission resources and are not discarded even in
the case of an AM switch. Low-priority services are not guaranteed with sufficient transmission resources
and may be discarded in the case of an AM switch. The common service priorities are provided in Table
6-24.

Table 6-24 Common service priorities

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service Type

Service Class

TDM E1s that transmit 2G base station


services

High-priority services

ATM E1s (IMA E1s are not used) that


transmit 3G base station services

High-priority services

E1s (of a bandwidth not lower than the


high-priority service bandwidth) in the
IMA E1 group that transmits 3G base
station services

High-priority service

Other E1s in the IMA E1 group that


transmits 3G base station services

Low-priority services

Voice, signaling, and OM Ethernet


services

High-priority services

Streaming media, background, and


interactive Ethernet services, for example,
Internet services

Low-priority services

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

89

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Figure 6-8 Networking diagram (Hybrid radio chain network)


102
14952M
14532M
14M
1+1 HSB
H-polarization

BTS12

BTS13

Tx high

104
14930M
14510M
7M
1+0
H-polarzation

NE12

NE11

Tx low

NE14

Tx low

Tx low

Tx low

Tx high

Tx high

NE16

NE13

101
14930M
14510M
28M
1+1 HSB
V-polarzation

NE15

103
14967M
14547M
14M
1+1 HSB
V-polarization

Tx high

Packet
network

BTS11

BTS14
BTS15

Link ID
Tx high station Tx Freq.
Tx low station Tx Freq.
Channel spacing
RF configuarion
Polarization

The connections of radio links shown in Figure 6-8 are described as follows.
Table 6-25 Connections of radio links (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and NE12

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Table 6-26 Connections of radio links (NE12)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE12 and NE11

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Table 6-27 Connections of radio links (NE13)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE13 and NE14

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)


Between NE13 and NE15

4-ISU2 (main IF board)


6-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

90

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Table 6-28 Connections of radio links (NE14)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE14 and NE13

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

4-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Table 6-29 Connections of radio links (NE15)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and NE13

4-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board)


Between NE15 and NE16

3-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 6-30 Connections of radio links (NE16)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE16 and NE15

3-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

6.5.2 Service Planning


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Basic Information About Radio Links


According to the spectrum allocation on the radio network and the required radio transmission
capacity, you can obtain the basic information of the radio links, as provided in Table 6-31.
Table 6-31 Basic information about radio links

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Link ID

101

102

103

104

Tx high site

NE11

NE14

NE15

NE15

Tx low site

NE12

NE13

NE13

NE16

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

91

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Tx frequency at
the Tx high site
(MHz)

14930

14952

14967

14930

Tx frequency at
the Tx low site
(MHz)

14510

14532

14547

14510

T/R spacing
(MHz)

420

420

420

420

Channel
spacing (MHz)

28

14

14

RF
configuration
mode

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+0

Polarization
direction

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

NOTE

The planning information that is not related to the configuration of the IDU (except for the polarization
direction) is not provided in this example.

Hybrid/AM Attribute Information


According to the capacity of E1 and Ethernet services and the availability requirement, you can
calculate the Hybrid/AM attribute information, as provided in Table 6-32.
Table 6-32 Hybrid/AM attribute information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Number of E1s
in AM
guaranteed
capacity mode

Number of E1s
in AM full
capacity mode

Capacity of
high-priority
Ethernet
services (Mbit/
s)

24

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

92

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Capacity of lowpriority
Ethernet
services (Mbit/
s)

113

39

39

19

AM enabling

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

AM guaranteed
capacity mode

QPSK

QPSK

QPSK

QPSK

AM full
capacity mode

128QAM

32QAM

64QAM

32QAM

E1 priority
enabling

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled

NOTE

The Hybrid radio capacity and the AM function require the proper license file.

Power and ATPC Information


By using the radio network planning software such as the Pathloss, you can analyze and compute
the parameters of radio links and obtain the power and ATPC information of the radio links, as
provided in Table 6-33.
Table 6-33 Power and ATPC information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Transmit power
(dBm)

16.5 (NE11)

16.5 (NE13)

16 (NE13)

20 (NE15)

16.5 (NE12)

16.5 (NE14)

16 (NE15)

20 (NE16)

Receive power
(dBm)

-46 (NE11)

-44 (NE13)

-43 (NE13)

-48 (NE15)

-46 (NE12)

-44 (NE14)

-43 (NE15)

-48 (NE16)

ATPC enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

ATPC
automatic
threshold
enabling

Upper threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

93

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Lower threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

Maximum
transmit power
(dBm)

NOTE

l The transmit power is calculated in AM guaranteed capacity mode.


l The receive power is calculated in AM guaranteed capacity mode.
l In this example, the ATPC function is disabled.

Information About IF Boards


According to the radio type, slot priorities of IF boards, and configuration rules of the 1+1
protection, you can obtain the information about IF boards, as provided in Table 6-34.
Table 6-34 Information about IF boards

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Main IF board

3-ISU2 (NE11)

3-ISU2 (NE13)

4-ISU2 (NE13)

3-ISU2 (NE15)

3-ISU2 (NE12)

3-ISU2 (NE14)

4-ISU2 (NE15)

3-ISU2 (NE16)

Standby IF
board

5-ISU2 (NE11)

5-ISU2 (NE13)

6-ISU2 (NE13)

5-ISU2 (NE12)

4-ISU2(NE14)

6-ISU2 (NE15)

RF
configuration
mode

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+1 HSB

1+0

Revertive mode

Revertive
(default value)

Revertive
(default value)

Revertive
(default value)

WTR time(s)

600 (default
value)

600 (default
value)

600 (default
value)

Reverse
switching
enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

94

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

NOTE

l It is recommended that you install the IF boards in a 1+1 HSB protection group in any of the following slot
pairs (with the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and
6, slots 7 and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l You need to install the IF boards in a 1+1 FD/SD protection group in any of the following slot pairs (with
the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and 6, slots 7
and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l In 1+1 HSB configuration, it is recommended that you disable the reverse switching function. In 1+1 SD
configuration, it is recommended that you enable the reverse switching function.
l Unless otherwise specified the other parameters of the 1+1 HSB/FD/SD all take default values.

6.5.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group and create the IF 1+1 protection groups for
NE11 to NE15.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

3-ISU2

Protection Board

5-ISU2

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE12

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

3-ISU2

Protection Board

5-ISU2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

95

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE13

Working Mode

HSB

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Disabled

Working Board

3-ISU2

4-ISU2

Protection Board

5-ISU2

6-ISU2

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE14

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

3-ISU2

Protection Board

4-ISU2

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE15

Working Mode

HSB

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Disabled

Working Board

4-ISU2

Protection Board

6-ISU2

Step 2 See A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link and configure the IF/ODU
information of the radio link.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

96

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Link ID

101

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

28M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM


Capacity

QPSK

Modulation Mode of the Full AM


Capacity

128QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Enabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

Full E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14930

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

16.5

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-46

TX Status

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link ID

101

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

28M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM


Capacity

QPSK

Modulation Mode of the Full AM


Capacity

128QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Enabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

Full E1 Capacity

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

97

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

16.5

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-46

TX Status

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Link ID

102

103

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

14M

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the


Guarantee AM Capacity

QPSK

QPSK

Modulation Mode of the


Full AM Capacity

32QAM

64QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Enabled

Enabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

Full E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14532

14547

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

16.5

16

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-44

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Link ID
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

102
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

98

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM


Capacity

QPSK

Modulation Mode of the Full AM


Capacity

32QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

Full E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14952

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

16.5

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-44

TX Status

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Link ID

104

103

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

7M

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the


Guarantee AM Capacity

QPSK

QPSK

Modulation Mode of the


Full AM Capacity

32QAM

64QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Enabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

Full E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14930

14967

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

99

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

20

16

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-48

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Link ID

104

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

7M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM


Capacity

QPSK

Modulation Mode of the Full AM


Capacity

32QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

Full E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

TX Power(dBm)

20

Power to Be Received(dBm)

-48

TX Status

unmute

Step 3 See A.6.8.1 Setting IF Attributes and set the IF attributes.


l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

100

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot

Disabled

Step 4 See A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes and configure the ATPC function.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

101

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

ATPC Enable Status

Disabled

Step 5 A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links
connections.
The main topology should display all the created radio links.
----End

6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid


Radio Ring Network)
This section considers radio links on a Hybrid radio ring network as examples to describe how
to configure radio links according to the network planning information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

102

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

6.6.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 5.6 Configuration Example (Hybrid Radio Ring Network), configure the Hybrid
radio links according to the network planning information (as shown in Figure 6-9):
l

Each Hybrid radio link transmits E1 services and Ethernet services. The AM function is
enabled on each link.

To improve transmission reliability of important services, the radio links between NE21
and NE24 are configured with 1+1 SD protection.

The service capacity accessed by each BTS is provided in Table 6-35.


Table 6-35 Service capacity accessed by each BTS
BTS

BTS21

BTS22

BTS23

BTS24

Number of
high-priority
E1s

Number of
low-priority
E1s

Capacity of
high-priority
Ethernet
services (Mbit/
s)

Capacity of
low-priority
Ethernet
services (Mbit/
s)

10

10

10

10

NOTE

High-priority services are guaranteed with sufficient transmission resources and are not discarded even in
the case of an AM switch. Low-priority services are not guaranteed with sufficient transmission resources
and may be discarded in the case of an AM switch. The common service priorities are provided in Table
6-36.

Table 6-36 Common service priorities

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service Type

Service Class

TDM E1s that transmit 2G base station


services

High-priority services

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

103

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Service Type

Service Class

ATM E1s (IMA E1s are not used) that


transmit 3G base station services

High-priority services

E1s (of a bandwidth not lower than the


high-priority service bandwidth) in the
IMA E1 group that transmits 3G base
station services

High-priority service

Other E1s in the IMA E1 group that


transmits 3G base station services

Low-priority services

Voice, signaling, and OM Ethernet


services

High-priority services

Streaming media, background, and


interactive Ethernet services, for example,
Internet services

Low-priority services

Figure 6-9 Networking diagram (Hybrid radio ring network)


Packet
network
201
14930M
14510M
14M
1+0
V-polarzation

NE21

Tx high

BTS21
NE22

Tx high

Tx low

Tx low

Tx low

Tx low
Tx high

BTS22

204
14958M
14538M
14M
1+1
V-polarization

202
14958M
14538M
14M
1+0
H-polarization

NE24

BTS24

Tx high
203
14930M
14510M
14M
1+0
H-polarzation

4E1
NE23
BTS23
Link ID
Tx high station Tx Freq.
Tx low station Tx Freq.
Channel spacing
RF configuarion
Polarization

The connections of radio links shown in Figure 6-9 are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

104

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Table 6-37 Connections of radio links (NE21)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and NE22

4-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE21 and NE24

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


SD protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Table 6-38 Connections of radio links (NE22)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and NE21

3-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE22 and NE23

4-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 6-39 Connections of radio links (NE23)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE23 and NE22

3-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE23 and NE24

4-ISU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 6-40 Connections of radio links (NE24)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE24 and NE21

4-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


SD protection group.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board)


Between NE24 and NE23

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

3-ISU2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

105

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

6.6.2 Service Planning


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Basic Information About Radio Links


According to the spectrum allocation on the radio network and the required radio transmission
capacity, you can obtain the basic information about the radio links, as provided in Table
6-41.
Table 6-41 Basic information about radio links
Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Link ID

201

202

203

204

Tx high site

NE21

NE23

NE23

NE21

Tx low site

NE22

NE22

NE24

NE24

Tx frequency at
the Tx high site
(MHz)

14930

14958

14930

14958

Tx frequency at
the Tx low site
(MHz)

14510

14538

14510

14538

T/R spacing
(MHz)

420

420

420

420

Channel
spacing (MHz)

14

14

14

14

RF
configuration
mode

1+0

1+0

1+0

1+1 SD

Polarization
direction

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

V (vertical
polarization)

NOTE

The planning information that is not related to the configuration of the IDU (except for the polarization
direction) is not provided in this example.

Hybrid/AM Attribute Information


According to the capacity of E1 and Ethernet services and the availability requirement, you can
calculate the Hybrid/AM attribute information as provided in Table 6-42.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

106

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Table 6-42 Hybrid/AM attribute information


Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Number of E1s
in guaranteed
capacity mode

Number of E1s
in AM full
capacity mode

Capacity of
high-priority
Ethernet
services (Mbit/
s)

28

28

28

28

Capacity of lowpriority
Ethernet
services (Mbit/
s)

40

40

40

40

AM enabling

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

AM guarantee
capacity mode

16QAM

16QAM

16QAM

16QAM

AM full
capacity mode

128QAM

128QAM

128QAM

128QAM

E1 priority
enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

NOTE

l In this example, E1 services are high-priority services and therefore the E1 service priority function
does not need to be enabled.
l According to the Hybrid ring protection scheme, each Hybrid radio link must carry all the services on
the ring.
l The Hybrid radio capacity and the AM function require the appropriate license file.

Power and ATPC Information


By using the radio network planning software such as the Pathloss, you can analyze and compute
the parameters of radio links and obtain the power and ATPC information of the radio links, as
provided in Table 6-43.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

107

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Table 6-43 Power and ATPC information


Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Transmit power
(dBm)

16.5 (NE21)

16.5 (NE23)

16 (NE23)

15 (NE21)

16.5 (NE22)

16.5 (NE22)

16 (NE24)

15 (NE24)

Receive power
(dBm)

-42 (NE21)

-44 (NE23)

-43 (NE23)

-45 (NE21)

-42 (NE22)

-44 (NE22)

-43 (NE24)

-45 (NE24)

ATPC enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

ATPC
automatic
threshold
enabling

Upper threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

Lower threshold
of ATPC
adjustment
(dBm)

Maximum
transmit power
(dBm)

NOTE

l The transmit power is calculated in AM guaranteed capacity mode.


l The receive power is calculated in AM guaranteed capacity mode.
l In this example, the ATPC function is disabled.

Information About IF Boards


According to the radio type, slot priorities of IF boards, and configuration rules of the 1+1
protection, you can obtain the information about IF boards, as provided in Table 6-44.
Table 6-44 Information about IF boards
Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

Main IF board

4-ISU2 (NE21)

4-ISU2 (NE22)

4-ISU2 (NE23)

4-ISU2 (NE24)

3-ISU2 (NE22)

3-ISU2 (NE23)

3-ISU2 (NE24)

3-ISU2 (NE21)

6-ISU2 (NE24)

Standby IF
board

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

5-ISU2 (NE21)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

108

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Link 4

RF
configuration
mode

1+0

1+0

1+0

1+1 SD

Revertive mode

Revertive
(default value)

WTR time(s)

600 (default
value)

Reverse
switching
enabling

Enabled

NOTE

l It is recommended that you install the IF boards in a 1+1 HSB protection group in any of the following slot
pairs (with the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and
6, slots 7 and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l You need to install the IF boards in a 1+1 FD/SD protection group in any of the following slot pairs (with
the main IF board in the slot with a smaller slot number): slots 1 and 2, slots 3 and 5, slots 4 and 6, slots 7
and 9, slots 8 and 10, slots 11 and 13, and slots 12 and 14.
l In 1+1 HSB configuration, it is recommended that you disable the reverse switching function. In 1+1 SD
configuration, it is recommended that you enable the reverse switching function.
l Unless otherwise specified, the other parameters of the 1+1 HSB/FD/SD all take default values.

6.6.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group and create the IF 1+1 protection groups for
NE21and NE24.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Working Mode

SD

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Enabled

Working Board

3-ISU2

Protection Board

5-ISU2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

109

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE24

Working Mode

SD

Revertive Mode

Revertive mode

WTR Time(s)

600

Enable Reverse Switching

Enabled

Working Board

4-ISU2

Protection Board

6-ISU2

Step 2 See A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link and configure the IF/ODU
information of the radio link.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Link ID

204

201

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

14M

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the


Guarantee AM Capacity

16QAM

16QAM

Modulation Mode of the


Full AM Capacity

128QAM

128QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Disabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14958

14930

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

15

16.5

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-45

-42

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

110

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Link ID

201

202

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

14M

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the


Guarantee AM Capacity

16QAM

16QAM

Modulation Mode of the


Full AM Capacity

128QAM

128QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Disabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14510

14538

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

16.5

16.5

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-42

-44

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Link ID

202

203

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

14M

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the


Guarantee AM Capacity

16QAM

16QAM

Modulation Mode of the


Full AM Capacity

128QAM

128QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Disabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14958

14930

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

111

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

16.5

16

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-44

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

Link ID

204

203

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

IF Channel Bandwidth

14M

14M

AM Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation Mode of the


Guarantee AM Capacity

16QAM

16QAM

Modulation Mode of the


Full AM Capacity

128QAM

128QAM

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Disabled

Guarantee E1 Capacity

TX Frequency(MHz)

14538

14510

T/R Spacing(MHz)

420

420

TX Power(dBm)

15

16

Power to Be Received
(dBm)

-45

-43

TX Status

unmute

unmute

Step 3 See A.6.8.1 Setting IF Attributes and set the IF attributes


l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

112

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

Step 4 See A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes and configure the ATPC function.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

113

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

ATPC Enable Status

3-ISU2 and 23-ODU

4-ISU2 and 24-ODU

Disabled

Disabled

Step 5 See A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and create radio links
connections.
The main topology should display all the created radio links.
----End

6.7 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Packet


Network)
This section considers radio links on a packet network as examples to describe how to configure
radio links according to the network planning information.

6.7.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 5.7 Configuration Example (Packet Network), configure radio links according to
the network planning information (as shown in Figure 6-10).
l

The AM function is enabled for each radio link.

To ensure transmission reliability of important services and to increase transmission


bandwidth, the radio links between NE32 and NE33 are enabled with XPIC and configured
with PLA protection.

The service capacity accessed by each BTS is provided in Table 6-45.


Table 6-45 Service capacity accessed by each BTS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

BTS

BTS32

BTS33

BTS34

Capacity of highpriority services


(Mbit/s)

Capacity of lowpriority services


(Mbit/s)

24

15

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

114

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

NOTE

High-priority services are services that require transmission guarantees. High-priority services cannot be
discarded in modulation scheme shifts. Low-priority services are services that do not require transmission
guarantees. Low-priority services can be discarded in modulation scheme shifts. Table 6-46 lists common
high-priority services.

Table 6-46 Common service priorities

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service Type

Service Class

TDM E1s that transmit 2G base station


services

High-priority services

ATM E1s (IMA E1s are not used) that


transmit 3G base station services

High-priority services

E1s (of a bandwidth not lower than the


high-priority service bandwidth) in the
IMA E1 group that transmits 3G base
station services

High-priority service

Other E1s in the IMA E1 group that


transmits 3G base station services

Low-priority services

Voice, signaling, and OM Ethernet


services

High-priority services

Streaming media, background, and


interactive Ethernet services, for example,
Internet services

Low-priority services

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

115

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Figure 6-10 Networking diagram (Packet radio chain network)


301
14967M
14547M
14M
XPIC
Dual - polarization

302
14930M
14510M
7M
1+0
H- polarzation
Tx low

Tx high

Tx high

Tx low

BTS33
PLA
NE34

NE32

NE33

BTS34
BTS32

Link ID
Tx high station Tx Freq.
Tx low station Tx Freq.
Channel spacing
RF configuarion
Polarization

The connections of radio links shown in Figure 6-10 are described as follows.
Table 6-47 Connections of radio links (NE32)
Link

Port

Remarks

Between NE32 and NE33

3-ISX2 (main port in the PLA


group)

Enables XPIC and configures


a PLA group.

5-ISX2 (slave port in the


PLA group)

NOTE
The boards where the main and
slave ports in the PLA group are
located must be installed in two
paired slots.

Table 6-48 Connections of radio links (NE33)


Link

Port

Remarks

Between NE33 and NE2

4-ISX2 (main port in the PLA


group)

Enables XPIC and configures


a PLA group.

6-ISX2 (slave port in the


PLA group)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

NOTE
The boards where the main and
slave ports in the PLA group are
located must be installed in two
paired slots.

116

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Link

Port

Remarks

Between NE33 and NE34

3-ISU2

Receives and transmits


Packet radio services.

Table 6-49 Connections of radio links (NE34)


Link

Port

Remarks

Between NE34 and NE33

3-ISU2

Receives and transmits


Packet radio services.

6.7.2 Service Planning


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring NE data.

Basic Information About Radio Links


Based on the spectrum allocation on radio networks and the required radio transmission capacity,
you can obtain the basic information about radio links as shown in Table 6-50.
Table 6-50 Basic information about radio links

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 2

Link ID

301

302

302

Tx high site

NE33

NE33

NE33

Tx low site

NE32

NE32

NE34

Tx frequency at the
Tx high site (MHz)

32660

32660

14930

Tx frequency at the
Tx low site (MHz)

31848

31848

14510

T/R spacing (MHz)

812

812

420

Channel spacing
(MHz)

56

56

RF configuration
mode

1+0

1+0

1+0

Polarization
direction

V (vertical
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

H (horizontal
polarization)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

117

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

NOTE

The link planning information (except the polarization direction) that is irrelevant to IDU configuration is
not provided in this example.

Hybrid/AM Attribute Information


According to the capacity of E1 services and Ethernet services and the availability requirement,
you can calculate the Hybrid/AM attribute information, as provided in Table 6-51.
Table 6-51 Hybrid/AM attribute information
Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Capacity of highpriority services


(Mbit/s)

Capacity of lowpriority services


(Mbit/s)

21.5

21.5

39

AM enabling

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Modulation scheme
of the assured AM
capacity

QPSK

QPSK

QPSK

Modulation scheme
of the full AM
capacity

64QAM

32QAM

32QAM

NOTE

The Hybrid radio capacity and the AM function are available only if the corresponding license files are
configured.

Power and ATPC information


By using radio network planning software such as Pathloss, you can analyze and compute various
parameters of the radio links. The power and automatic transmit power control (ATPC)
information about the radio links is provided in Table 6-52.
Table 6-52 Power and ATPC information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Transmit power
(dBm)

6.0 (NE1)

6.0 (NE1)

20 (NE33)

6.0 (NE2)

6.0 (NE2)

20 (NE34)

Receive power
(dBm)

-45.0 (NE1)

-45.0 (NE1)

-48 (NE33)

-45.0 (NE2)

-45.0 (NE2)

-48 (NE34)

ATPC enabling

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

118

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Parameter

Link 1

Link 2

Link 3

Automatic ATPC
threshold setting

Upper threshold of
ATPC adjustment
(dBm)

Lower threshold of
ATPC adjustment
(dBm)

Maximum transmit
power (dBm)

NOTE

l The transmit power is calculated in AM guaranteed capacity scheme.


l The receive power is calculated in AM guaranteed capacity scheme.
l In this example, the ATPC function is disabled.

Configuration Information About XPIC Workgroups


Table 6-53 provides XPIC configurations of NE32 and NE33.
Table 6-53 Configuration information about XPIC workgroups
Parameter
XPIC workgroup

NE32

NE33

V (vertical polarization)

4-ISX2

3-ISX2

H (horizontal
polarization)

6-ISX2

5-ISX2

Configuration information about PLA groups


Table 6-54 provides PLA configurations of NE32 and NE33.
Table 6-54 Configuration information about XPIC workgroups
Parameter

NE32

NE33

LAG ID

Main port

4-ISX2-1

3-ISX2-1

Slave port

6-ISX2-1

5-ISX2-1

Minimum number of active links

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

119

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

6.7.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link and
configure IF/ODU information for radio links.
The values for the IF/ODU parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

IF Service Type

3-ISX2-1

5-ISX2-1

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

The values for the IF/ODU parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

IF Service Type

4-ISX2-1

6-ISX2-1

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Hybrid(Native E1+ETH)

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.3.2 Creating an XPIC Workgroup and create XPIC workgroups for
NE32 and NE33.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value (NE33)

Value (NE32)

IF Channel Bandwidth

56M

56M

Polarization Direction-V

3-ISX2-1

4-ISX2-1

Link ID-V

301

301

Polarization Direction-H

5-ISX2-1

6-ISX2-1

Link ID-H

302

302

Transmit Power(dBm)

6.0

6.0

Transmission Frequency
(MHz)

32660

31848

T/R Spacing(MHz)

812

812

Transmission Status

Unmute

Unmute

ATPC Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

120

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6 Configuring Radio Links

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.3.11 Creating a PLA Group and create a PLA group.
The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

PLA ID

Main Board

3-ISX2

Main Port

1-(PORT-1)

Board

5-ISX2

Port

1-(PORT-1)

The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

PLA ID

Main Board

4-ISX2

Main Port

1-(PORT-1)

Board

6-ISX2

Port

1-(PORT-1)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.3.12 Querying the Status of a PLA Group and query the status of the
PLA group.
The values for the related parameters of NE32 and NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Minimum Active Links

Step 5 Follow instructions in A.6.8.1 Setting IF Attributes and configure IF attributes.


l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

Value
3-ISX2

5-ISX2

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

121

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslot

6 Configuring Radio Links

Value
4-ISX2

6-ISX2

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2

Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot

Enabled

Step 6 Follow instructions in A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes and set the ATPC function.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status

Value
3-ISX2

5-ISX2

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

ATPC Enable Status

Value
4-ISX2

6-ISX2

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2

ATPC Enable Status

Disabled

Step 7 Follow instructions in A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method and
create radio links.
The main topology should display all the created radio links.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

122

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Configuring TDM Services

About This Chapter


The key to configuring TDM services is configuring the corresponding service crossconnections.
7.1 Basic Concepts
Before configuring the TDM service, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
7.2 Configuration Procedure on a Per-NE Basis
This section describes the procedures for configuring the cross-connections and protection of a
TDM service and the procedures for setting the SDH/PDH port parameters.
7.3 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio Chain Network)
This section considers a TDM radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.
7.4 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio Ring Network)
This section considers a TDM radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.
7.5 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid Radio Chain Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.
7.6 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid Radio Ring Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

123

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

7.1 Basic Concepts


Before configuring the TDM service, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

7.1.1 Protection Modes for TDM Services


The OptiX RTN 980 supports linear MSP, two-fiber bidirectional ring MSP, and SNCP for TDM
services.

Linear MSP
Linear MSP applies to point-to-point physical networks. Linear MSP provides protection for the
services between two multiplex section termination (MST) modules. That is, when a linear MSP
switching occurs, the services are switched from the working section to the protection section.
In the case of the OptiX RTN 980, linear MSP provides protection for TDM services that are
transmitted over SDH fibers.
Linear MSP is classified into 1+1 linear MSP and 1:N linear MSP.
l

1+1 linear MSP


To realize the 1+1 linear MSP, one working channel and one protection channel are
required. The protection channel does not transmit extra services. When the working
channel becomes unavailable, services are switched to the protection channel for
transmission. Figure 7-1 shows the application of 1+1 linear MSP. According to the
revertive mode, 1+1 linear MSP is classified into dual-ended revertive, dual-ended nonrevertive, single-ended revertive, and single-ended non-revertive modes. The single-ended
non-revertive mode is the most common linear MSP mode.
Figure 7-1 1+1 linear MSP
NE A

Working
channel

NE B

Protection
channel

Protection switching
NE A

Working
channel

NE B

Protection
channel

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

124

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

1:N linear MSP


To realize the 1:N linear MSP, N working channels and one protection channel are required.
The working channels transmit normal services and the protection channel transmits extra
services. When a working channel becomes unavailable, the services on this channel are
switched to the protection channel for transmission. As a result, the extra services
previously transmitted on this protection channel are interrupted. Figure 7-2 shows the
application of the 1:N linear MSP. The 1:N linear MSP is available only in dual-ended
revertive mode.
Figure 7-2 1:N linear MSP
NE A
Normal
service 1

...

Working
channel 1

NE B
Normal
service1

...

Working
channel N

Normal
service N

Normal
service N

Protection
channel

Extra
service

Extra
service

Protection switching
NE A
Normal
service 1

...
Normal
service N
Extra
service

Working
channel 1

NE B

Working
channel N
Protection
channel

Normal
service1

...
Normal
service N
Extra
service

SNCP
In the case of subnetwork connection protection (SNCP), the protection subnetwork connection
takes over when the working subnetwork connection fails or deteriorates. In the case of the
OptiX RTN 980, SNCP provides protection for TDM services that are transmitted on STM-1
fiber ring networks, TDM radio ring networks, Hybrid radio ring networks, or hybrid ring
networks that comprise optical network equipment and Hybrid radio equipment.
The SNCP protection scheme, which requires one working subnetwork and one protection
subnetwork, selects one service from the dually transmitted services. In the case of SNCP, the
services are switched to the protection subnetwork for transmission when the working
subnetwork connection fails or deteriorates. Figure 7-3 shows the application of SNCP.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

125

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Figure 7-3 SNCP


Working SNC
Trail source

Trail sink

NE A

NE B
Protection SNC

Protection switching

Working SNC
Trail source

Trail sink

NE A

NE B
Protection SNC

The OptiX RTN 980 supports the coexistence of SNCP and the 1+1 protection or N+1 protection.
In the case of coexistence of the SNCP and the 1+1 protection or N+1 protection, you can set
the hold-off time for SNCP so that the protection switching for the radio link can be performed
first, thus preventing circular switchings.

Two-Fiber Bidirectional Ring MSP


Two-fiber bidirectional ring MSP applies to two-fiber bidirectional rings. Two-fiber
bidirectional ring MSP provides protection for the services between two multiplex section
termination (MST) modules. That is, when a two-fiber bidirectional ring MSP switching occurs,
the services are switched from the working section to the protection section.
On a two-fiber bidirectional MSP ring, the first half of VC-4s on each STM-N line is the working
channel, and the other half of VC-4s is the protection channel. Normally, services are transmitted
on the working channel. The services transmitted on the two fibers flow in reverse directions.
When a fiber cut occurs and the working channel becomes unavailable, the services on both ends
of the faulty point are switched from the working channel of the faulty fiber to the protection
channel of the reverse directional fiber for transmission. For application information of twofiber bidirectional ring MSP, see Figure 7-4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

126

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Figure 7-4 Two-fiber bidirectional ring MSP


NE A
East

West
NE B

West

East
STM-4 two-fiber
bidirectional MSP ring

East

NE D
West

East

West
NE C

Protection swicthing

NE A
East

West

East

West
NE B

STM-4 two-fiber
bidirectional MSP ring

East

NE D
West

West
NE C

East

Service between NE A and NE C

7.1.2 Timeslots for TDM Services on IF Boards


When TDM services need to be transmitted on a radio link, you need to configure the
corresponding cross-connections between the service timeslots on the service board and the
service timeslots on the IF board. The timeslots for the TDM services on the IF board are closely
related to the type of the radio services transmitted by the IF board and the radio capacity.

TDM Radio
When the IF board works in PDH radio mode and when the radio capacity is nxE1, the first to
nth VC-12 timeslots on the IF board are available and correspond to first to nth E1s that are
transmitted over microwave. For example, if the radio capacity is 4xE1, only the first to fourth
VC-12 timeslots in VC4-1 on the IF board are available. If a cross-connection is configured
between the E1 port of a service board and the second VC-12 in VC4-1 on the IF board, the E1
services that are accessed from the E1 port are sent to the second E1 timeslot that is transmitted
over radio.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

127

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

When the IF board works in STM-1 radio mode, all the timeslots in VC4-1 on the IF board are
available and correspond to the timeslots in the VC-4 that is transmitted on microwave.

Hybrid Radio
When the IF board works in Hybrid radio mode and when the Guarantee E1 Capacity is set to
n in Hybrid/AM Configuration, the first to nth VC-12 timeslots on the IF board are available
and correspond to the first to nth E1 timeslots that are transmitted over microwave. For example,
if the E1 capacity is 75xE1, only the first to sixty-third VC-12 timeslots in VC4-1 and the first
to twelfth VC-12 timeslots in VC4-2 on the IF board are available. If a cross-connection is
configured between the E1 port of a service board and the second VC-12 in VC4-2 on the IF
board, the E1 services that are accessed from the E1 port are sent to the sixty-fifth E1 timeslot
that is transmitted over microwave.

7.1.3 Numbering Schemes for SDH Timeslots


Two numbering schemes for VC-12 timeslots are applicable to SDH optical/electrical lines or
SDH radio links.

VC-12 Timeslot Numbering


Two numbering schemes are applicable to SDH optical/electrical lines or SDH radio links when
you create cross-connections.
l

By order
This timeslot numbering scheme is also considered as timeslot scheme. The numbering
formula is as follows: VC-12 number = TUG-3 number + (TUG-2 number - 1) x 3 + (TU-12
number -1) x 21.
This scheme is the numbering scheme recommended by ITU-T G.707 and is the default
scheme adopted by the OptiX equipment.

Interleaved scheme
This timeslot numbering scheme is also considered as line scheme. The numbering formula
is as follows: VC-12 number = (TUG-3 number - 1) x 21 + (TUG-2 number -1) x 3 + TU-12
number.
The OptiX equipment can adopt this scheme when it interconnects with the equipment that
adopts the interleaved scheme or when a specific timeslot numbering scheme is required.

Figure 7-5 Numbering VC-12 timeslots by order


TUG-2

TUG-3

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

{
{
{

10

13

16

19

22

25

28

31

34

37

40

43

46

49

52

55

58

61

11

14

17

20

23

26

29

32

35

38

41

44

47

50

53

56

59

62

12

15

18

21

24

27

30

33

36

39

42

45

48

51

54

57

60

63

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

TU-12

128

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Figure 7-6 Numbering VC-12 timeslots in the interleaved scheme

TUG-3

{
{
{

TUG-2
4

10

13

16

19

11

14

17

20

12

15

18

21

22

25

28

31

34

37

40

23

26

29

32

35

38

41

24

27

30

33

36

39

42

43

46

49

52

55

58

61

44

47

50

53

56

59

62

45

48

51

54

57

60

63

TU-12

VC-3 Timeslot Numbering


A VC-3 timeslot number corresponds to a TUG-3 number. If you need to configure crossconnections of VC-3s and VC-12s in the same VC-4, note that the timeslots in the TUG-3 that
are occupied by the VC-3 cross-connections cannot be configured for VC-12 cross-connections.

7.1.4 TDM Timeslot Planning Schemes


The timeslot allocation diagram illustrates the TDM timeslot planning scheme.

Timeslot Allocation Diagram


The timeslot allocation diagram provides significant references for configuring TDM services.
Before planning TDM timeslots, you need to be familiar with the meanings shown in the timeslot
allocation diagram.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

129

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Figure 7-7 Timeslot allocation diagram


Site
Timeslot

NE1
Interface
board 1

NE2
Interface Interface
board 2
board 3

NE3
Interface
board 5

NE4
Interface
board 6

Interface
board 4

Timeslot 1

VC4-1

Tributary board:
port No.
Tributary board:
port No.

Timeslot 2

Timeslot 4

Timeslot 3

Tributary board:
port No.

Tributary board: Tributary board: Tributary board:


port No.
port No.
port No.

VC4-2

......

Tributary board:
port No.
Timeslot 5
Tributary board:
port No.

......

Site area
Timeslot area
Timeslot allocation
area

Add/Drop
Foward
Pass-through
Add/Drop (SNCP path)

As shown in Figure 7-7, the timeslot allocation diagram contains three areas, namely, site area,
timeslot area, and timeslot allocation area.
The site area contains the NE icons and interface boards that carry radio links.
l

The start and end NEs each have only one interface board, which is located under the NE
icon. The intermediate NEs each have two interface boards, which are located at the two
sides of the vertical line under the NE icon. The interface boards may be IF boards or line
boards.

The interface board on the left side of the vertical line under an NE icon is connected to
the interface board on the right side of the vertical line under its upstream NE icon. The
interface board on the right side of the vertical line under an NE icon is connected to the
interface board on the left side of the vertical line under its downstream NE icon.

In the case of a ring radio link, before planning the site area, you need to divide the ring
radio link into a chain radio link and ensure that the start and end NEs are the same one.

The timeslot area represents the VC-4 timeslot resources. For example, in the case of radio links,
timeslots occupied by an STM-1 service are all in the first VC-4.
In the timeslot allocation area, each straight line represents a service and the numeric above the
straight line represents the timeslot occupied by this service.
l

A black dot indicates that services are added to or dropped from the NE. The board under
a black dot indicates the board and corresponding ports on the board that are used for adding
or dropping services.

An arrow indicates that services are transferred on the NE.

If a straight line passes a vertical line without any arrow or black dot, it indicates that
services pass through the NE.

In the case of protection configuration (for example, 1+1 HSB protection) wherein the
working service and protection service have the uniform route, you only need to draw a
continuous line to represent the working service. In the case of protection configuration

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

130

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

(for example, SNCP) wherein the working service and protection service have different
routes, you need to draw a continuous line to represent the working service and a dotted
line to represent the protection service.

TDM Timeslot Planning Scheme for Chain Networks


On the backhaul network for a mobile BTS, the services are accessed from different nodes and
then aggregated to the same node for transmission. In this case, allocate the timeslots on the
chain radio network as follows:
1.

Select the chain that contains the maximum of hops as the main chain. Then, divide the
chain network into several sub-chains by considering the main chain as the reference.
Consider the E1 channels or fiber connections that are used for transferring services
between NEs as links.

2.

Allocate the timeslots for the add/drop or pass-through services on the NEs of the main
chain one after another, in the descending order of the NE distance.

3.

Repeat the previous step to configure the timeslots for the services on all the sub-chains.

This timeslot allocation method ensures that only the numbers of the timeslots that the services
on the nodes of the aggregation sub-chain occupy may change.
The principles for obtaining the timeslot cross-connection configurations from the non-SNCP
service timeslot allocation diagram are as follows:
l

The vertical line under the NE name is considered as the reference.

If a straight line representing a pass-through service crosses the vertical line, it indicates
that cross-connections are configured between the boards on both sides of the vertical line.
The corresponding cross-connected timeslots are marked over the straight line.

If there is a straight line with one dot on one side of the vertical line, it indicates that crossconnections are configured between the board on this side of the vertical line and the board
under the straight line with one dot. The corresponding cross-connected timeslots are
marked over the straight line with one dot.

If there is a straight line with an arrow on both sides of the vertical line, it indicates that
cross-connections are configured between the two boards on both sides of the vertical line.
The corresponding cross-connected timeslots on each board are marked over the straight
line with an arrow on the side of this board.

For details, see 7.3 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio Chain
Network) and 7.5 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid Radio Chain
Network).

TDM Timeslot Planning Scheme for Ring Networks


On a backhaul network for a mobile BTS, the services are accessed from different nodes and
then aggregated to the same node for transmission. Hence, you can perform the following
operations to allocate the timeslots on the SNCP radio ring network:
1.

Allocate the timeslots to add/drop services on the NEs in anti-clockwise order. Allocate
the minimum VC-12 timeslot number to the service on the nearest NE. The number of the
timeslot each service occupies does not change on the ring network.

2.

Repeat the previous step to configure the timeslots for the services on all the sub-chains.

This timeslot allocation method ensures that only the timeslots that the services on the nodes of
the aggregation sub-chain occupy change.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

131

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

The principles for obtaining the timeslot cross-connection configurations from the SNCP service
timeslot allocation diagram are as follows:
l

The vertical line under the NE name is considered as the reference.

If a straight line representing a pass-through service crosses the vertical line, it indicates
that cross-connections are configured between the boards on both sides of the vertical line.
The corresponding cross-connected timeslots are marked over the straight line.

If there is a straight line with one dot on one side of the vertical line, it indicates that SNCP
cross-connections are configured between the board on this side of the vertical line and the
board under the straight line with one dot. The corresponding cross-connected timeslots
are marked over the straight line with one dot.

For details, see 7.4 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio Ring
Network) and 7.6 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid Radio Ring
Network).

7.2 Configuration Procedure on a Per-NE Basis


This section describes the procedures for configuring the cross-connections and protection of a
TDM service and the procedures for setting the SDH/PDH port parameters.
Figure 7-8 provides the procedures for configuring TDM services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

132

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Figure 7-8 Configuration flow chart (TDM services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring MSP

Creating TDM service crossconnections

Configuring the automatic switching


conditions of SNCP services

Modifying the priorities of E1 services

Configuring the overhead bytes

Setting parameters
of SDH port

Setting parameters of PDH ports

Performing PRBS tests for E1


services

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

133

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Table 7-1 Procedures for configuring TDM services


Step

Operation

Configuri
ng MSP

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Configuri
ng the
crossconnectio
ns of the
TDM
servicea

Description
A.4.1
Configuri
ng Linear
MSP

Required when linear MSP is configured for the


optical transmission line.

A.4.5
Configuri
ng Ring
MSP

Required when the optical transmission line is


configured with ring MSP.

A.5.1
Creating
the CrossConnectio
ns of
Point-toPoint
Services

Required when the TDM service is a point-to-point


service.

A.5.2
Creating
CrossConnectio
ns of
SNCP
Services

Required when the TDM service is an SNCP service.

A.5.5 Configuring the


Automatic Switching
of SNCP Services

The parameters need to be set according to the


service planning.

The parameters need to be set according to the


service planning.

The parameters need to be set according to the


service planning.

The parameters need to be set according to the


service planning.

Optional when the TDM service is an SNCP service.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

134

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Step

Operation

Description

A.5.3 Modifying the


Priorities of E1
Services

Required when the working source, protection


source, or sink of an SNCP service is a link where
the AM function and the E1 priority function are
enabled or when the E1 priority of a crossconnection needs to be changed.
E1 Priority needs to be modified according to the
service planning information.
NOTE
When the radio link on which the AM function is enabled
is configured with the E1 priority, note the following:
l If the cross-connection is configured for a point-topoint service, the E1 priority is configured when the
cross-connection is created.
l If the cross-connection is configured for an SNCP
service, the E1 priority is modified after the crossconnection is created.
l If the service priority is not configured when the crossconnection is created (that is, E1 Priority is set to
None), E1 Priority of each service must be set to a
specific value after the cross-connection is configured.

Configuri
ng the
overhead
bytes

A.6.3.1
Configuri
ng
RSOHs

Required when the J0_MM alarm is generated on the


local or remote equipment.

A.6.3.2
Configuri
ng VC-4
POHs

Required when the TIM or SLM alarm is generated


on the local or remote equipment.

A.6.3.3
Configuri
ng VC-12
POHs

Required when the TIM or SLM alarm is generated


on the local or remote equipment.

A.6.1 Setting the


Parameters of SDH
Ports

Optional.

A.6.2 Setting the


Parameters of PDH
Ports

Optional.

A.14.1 Testing E1
Services Using PRBS

The test results should show that each E1 service


contains no bit errors.

NOTE

a: In the case of 1+1 protection configuration or 1+1 linear MSP, you need to configure the TDM service on the
working channel only. In the case of N+1 protection configuration, two-fiber bidirectional ring MSP
configuration, or 1:N linear MSP configuration, you need to configure TDM services on the working channels
and the extra service (if any) on the protection channel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

135

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

7.3 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio


Chain Network)
This section considers a TDM radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.

7.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Chain Network),
configure the TDM services according to the following network planning information (as shown
in Figure 7-9):
l

To ensure reliable transmission of the services between NE11 and the third-party network,
linear MSP is configured for the optical transmission line.

Services are transferred between NE12 and NE13 through STM-1 optical ports.

Figure 7-9 Networking diagram (TDM services on a TDM radio chain network)
8xE1
BTS12
STM-1

STM-1

8xE1

NE14

BTS13

Third party
network

16xE1
NE13

NE12

14xE1

8xE1

NE11
BTS11

NE15

NE16
BTS15

BTS14

The connections of TDM links shown in Figure 7-9 are described as follows.
Table 7-2 Connections of TDM links (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and the thirdparty network

16-SL4D-1 (working port)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


linear MSP group.

Between NE11 and NE12

3-IF1 (main IF board)

16-SL4D-2 (protection port)

5-IF1 (standby IF board)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

136

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Table 7-3 Connections of TDM links (NE12)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE12 and BTS11

2-SP3S (1-16)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS11.

Between NE12 and NE11

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-IF1 (standby IF board)


Between NE12 and NE13

1-SL1D-1

Configure this port to


transmit TDM services.

Table 7-4 Connections of TDM links (NE13)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE13 and NE12

1-SL1D-1

Configure this port to


transmit TDM services.

Between NE13 and NE14

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-IF1 (standby IF board)


Between NE13 and NE15

4-IF1 (main IF board)


6-IF1 (standby IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

Table 7-5 Connections of TDM links (NE14)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE14 and BTS12

9-SP3S (1-16)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS12 and
BTS13.

3-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

Between NE14 and BTS13


Between NE14 and NE13

4-IF1 (standby IF board)

Table 7-6 Connections of TDM links (NE15)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and BTS14

2-SP3S (1-14)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS14.

Between NE15 and NE13

4-IF1 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

6-IF1 (standby IF board)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

137

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and NE16

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 7-7 Connections of TDM links (NE16)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE16 and BTS15

9-SP3S (1-8)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS15.

Between NE16 and NE15

3-IF1

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

7.3.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Timeslot Allocation Diagram


Figure 7-10 shows the timeslots that are allocated for the TDM services according to the service
planning information.
Figure 7-10 Timeslot allocation diagram (TDM services on the TDM radio chain network)
Links-1: NE11 - NE12 - NE13 -NE15 -NE16
Station BSC
Timeslot

NE11

16-SL4D-1
VC12: 1-8

NE12

3-IF1

3-IF1

1-SL1D-1

NE13
1-SL1D-1 4-IF1

NE15
4-IF1 3-IF1

3-IF1
9-SP3S:1-8

VC12: 9-22
VC4-1

NE16

2-SP3S:1-14

VC12: 23-38
VC12: 39-54
2-SP3S:1-16

Links-2: NE13-NE14
Station
Timeslot
VC4-1

NE13

NE14

1-SL1D-1 3-IF1
VC12: 23-38

3-IF1
VC12: 1-16
9-SP3S:1-16

Pass through
Add/Drop
Foward

As shown in Figure 7-10, the information about the timeslots that the TDM services occupy on
each NE is as follows:
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

138

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

E1 services on NE16:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to eighth ports on the SP3S board
in slot 9 of NE16.
The E1 services occupy the first to eighth VC-12 timeslots on the link between the first
optical port on the SL4D board in slot 16 of NE11 and the IF1 board in slot 3 of NE16.

E1 services on NE15:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to fourteenth ports on the SP3S
board in slot 2 of NE15.
The E1 services occupy the ninth to twenty-second VC-12 timeslots on the link between
the first optical port on the SL4D board in slot 16 of NE11 and the IF1 board in slot 3
of NE15.

E1 services on NE14:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to sixteenth ports on the SP3S
board in slot 9 of NE14.
The E1 services occupy the twenty-third to thirty-eighth VC-12 timeslots on the link
between the first optical port on the SL4D board in slot 16 of NE11 and the SL1D board
in slot 1 of NE13.
The E1 services occupy the first to sixteenth VC-12 timeslots on the link between the
IF1 board in slot 3 of NE13 and the IF1 board in slot 3 of NE14.

E1 services on NE12:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to sixteenth ports on the SP3S
board in slot 2 of NE12.
The E1 services occupy the thirty-ninth to fifty-fourth VC-12 timeslots on the link
between the first optical port on the SL4D board in slot 16 of NE11 and the IF1 board
in slot 3 of NE12.

Linear MSP
In this configuration example, no extra services need to be transmitted. Hence, the single-ended
non-revertive 1+1 linear MSP is configured to protect the optical transmission line between
NE11 and the third-party network. Table 7-8 provides the related planning information.
Table 7-8 Linear MSP

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE11

Protection Type

1+1 Linear MSP

Switching Mode

Single-Ended Switching

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

SD Enable

Enabled (default value)

Protocol Type

New Protocol (default value)

West Working Unit

16-SL4D-1

West Protection Unit

16-SL4D-2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

139

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

NOTE

Unless otherwise specified, SD Enable, Protocol Type take the default values.

7.3.3 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)


This section describes the process for the data configuration on a per-NE basis.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.4.1 Configuring Linear MSP and configure 1+1 linear MSP.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

Protection Type

1+1 Linear MSP

Switching Mode

Single-Ended Switching

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

SD Enable

Enabled

Protocol Type

New Protocol

Mapped Board

l West Working Unit:


16-SL4D-1
l West Protection Unit:
16-SL4D-2

Step 2 See A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services and create the pointto-point service cross-connections.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

16-SL4D-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-54

Sink Slot

3-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

140

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Parameter

Value
NE11

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-54

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE12

Level

VC-12

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

3-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-38

39-54

Sink Slot

1-SL1D-1

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-38

1-16

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE13

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Level

VC-12

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

1-SL1D-1

1-SL1D-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-22

23-38

Sink Slot

4-IF1-1

3-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-22

1-16

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

141

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE13

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE14

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-16

Sink Slot

9-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-16

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE15

Level

VC-12

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

4-IF1-1

4-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8

9-22

Sink Slot

3-IF1-1

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-8

1-14

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

142

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE16

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8

Sink Slot

9-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8

Activate Immediately

Yes

Step 3 See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using PRBS and test the E1 services.
Test two E1 services on each BTS. The test results should show that the E1 services contain no
bit errors.
----End

7.4 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a TDM Radio


Ring Network)
This section considers a TDM radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.

7.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.4 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Ring Network),
configure the TDM services according to the service requirements. To ensure reliable
transmission of the services between the BTSs and the third-party network, SNCP is configured
to provide protection for TDM services on the ring network. See Figure 7-11.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

143

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Figure 7-11 Networking diagram (TDM services on a TDM radio ring network)
Third party
SDH network

16E1

NE21

4E1
BTS21

4E1
4E1 NE22

NE24

BTS24

BTS22
4E1
NE23
BTS23

The connections of TDM links shown in Figure 7-11 are described as follows.
Table 7-9 Connections of TDM links (NE21)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and the thirdparty network

2-SP3S (1-16)

Configure the ports to


transmit TDM services.

Between NE21 and NE22

4-IF1

Configure the ports as east


ports.

Between NE21 and NE24

3-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


SD protection group)

Configure the ports as west


ports.

5-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 SD protection group)

Table 7-10 Connections of TDM links (NE22)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and BTS21

2-SP3S (1-8)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS21 and
BTS22.

Between NE22 and NE21

3-IF1

Configure the ports as west


ports.

Between NE22 and NE23

4-IF1

Configure this port as an east


port.

Between NE22 and BTS22

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

144

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Table 7-11 Connections of TDM links (NE23)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE23 and BTS23

9-SP3S (1-4)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS23.

Between NE23 and NE22

3-IF1

Configure this port as a west


port.

Between NE23 and NE24

4-IF1

Configure this port as an east


port.

Table 7-12 Connections of TDM links (NE24)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE24 and BTS24

2-SP3S (1-4)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS24.

Between NE24 and NE21

4-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


SD protection group)

Configure the ports as east


ports.

6-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 SD protection group)
Between NE24 and NE23

3-IF1

Configure this port as a west


port.

7.4.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Timeslot Allocation Diagram


Figure 7-12 shows the timeslots that are allocated for the TDM services according to the service
planning information.
Figure 7-12 Timeslot allocation diagram (TDM service on the TDM radio ring network)
Station
Timeslot

NE21

NE22

4-IF1

3-IF1 4-IF1
VC12: 1-8

2-SP3S:9-12

NE21

3-IF1 4-IF1

3-IF1

VC12: 1-8

2-SP3S:1-8
2-SP3S:1-8 2-SP3S:1-8
VC12: 9-12
VC4-1

NE24

NE23
3-IF1 4-IF1

2-SP3S:1-8
VC12: 9-12
2-SP3S:9-12
VC12: 13-16

9-SP3S:1-4 9-SP3S:1-4
VC12: 13-16

2-SP3S:13-16

2-SP3S:1-4

2-SP3S:1-4

2-SP3S:13-16

Pass through (SNCP working path)


Pass through (SNCP protection path)
Add/Drop (SNCP working path)
Add/Drop (SNCP protection path)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

145

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

As shown in Figure 7-12, the information about the timeslots that the TDM services occupy on
each NE is as follows:
l

E1 services on NE22:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to eighth ports on the SP3S board
in slot 2 of NE22.
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to eighth ports on the SP3S board
in slot 2 of NE21.
The E1 services occupy the first to eighth VC-12 timeslots on the ring.

E1 services on NE23:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to fourth ports on the SP3S board
in slot 9 of NE23.
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the ninth to twelfth ports on the SP3S
board in slot 2 of NE21.
The E1 services occupy the ninth to twelfth VC-12 timeslots on the ring.

E1 services on NE24:
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to fourth ports on the SP3S board
in slot 2 of NE24.
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the thirteenth to sixteenth ports on the
SP3S board in slot 2 of NE21.
The E1 services occupy the thirteenth to sixteenth VC-12 timeslots on the ring.

SNCP
Table 7-13 provides the information about SNCP.
Table 7-13 SNCP
Parameter

Value

Working Source

See the timeslot allocation diagram.

Protection Source

See the timeslot allocation diagram.

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time

600s (default value)

Hold-Off Time

0 (default value)

Switching Condition

Necessary conditions for an SNCP switching (default


values)

NOTE

Unless otherwise specified, WTR Time, Hold-Off Time, and Switching Condition take the default values.

7.4.3 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)


This section describes the process for the data configuration on a per-NE basis.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

146

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP Services and configure the SNCP service
cross-connections.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Level

VC-12

VC-12

Hold-off Time(100ms)

Revertive Mode

Revertive

Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

600

Source Slot

4-IF1-1 (working service)

3-IF1-1 (working service)

3-IF1-1 (protection service)

4-IF1-1 (protection service)

VC4-1 (working service)

VC4-1 (working service)

VC4-1 (protection service)

VC4-1 (protection service)

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-12

13-16

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-12

13-16

Source VC4

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE22

Direction

Bidirectional

Level

VC-12

Hold-off Time(100ms)

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

Source Slot

3-IF1-1 (working service)


4-IF1-1 (protection service)

Source VC4

VC4-1 (working service)


VC4-1 (protection service)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

147

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE22

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE23

Direction

Bidirectional

Level

VC-12

Hold-off Time(100ms)

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

Source Slot

3-IF1-1 (working service)


4-IF1-1 (protection service)

Source VC4

VC4-1 (working service)


VC4-1 (protection service)

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

9-12

Sink Slot

9-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-4

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE24

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Direction

Bidirectional

Level

VC-12

Hold-off Time(100ms)

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

148

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE24

Source Slot

4-IF1-1 (working service)


3-IF1-1 (protection service)

Source VC4

VC4-1 (working service)


VC4-1 (protection service)

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

13-16

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-4

Step 2 See A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services and configure the
service cross-connections on NE22, NE23, and NE24.
l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE22

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

9-16

Sink Slot

4-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

9-16

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE23

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

149

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE23

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8,13-16

Sink Slot

4-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-8,13-16

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE24

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-12

Sink Slot

4-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-12

Activate Immediately

Yes

Step 3 See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using PRBS and test the E1 services.
Test two E1 services on each BTS. The test results should show that the E1 services contain no
bit errors.
----End

7.5 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid


Radio Chain Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.

7.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

150

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Based on 6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network),
configure the TDM services according to the following network planning information (as shown
in Figure 7-13):
l

Services are transferred between NE12 and NE13 through E1 channels.

The service capacity accessed by each BTS is provided in Table 7-14.


Table 7-14 Service capacity accessed by each BTS
BTS

BTS13

BTS14

Number of high-priority E1
services

Number of low-priority E1
services

Figure 7-13 Networking diagram (TDM services on a Hybrid radio chain network)

1xE1

Packet
network

E1
NE14

BTS13
NE13

NE12

NE11

4xE1
NE16

NE15
BTS14

The connections of TDM links shown in Figure 7-13 are described as follows.
Table 7-15 Connections of TDM links (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and the PSN

1-SP3S-1 (1-5)

Configure the ports to


transmit TDM services.

Between NE11 and NE12

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

151

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Table 7-16 Connections of TDM links (NE12)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE12 and NE11

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)


Between NE12 and NE13

2-SP3S (1-5)

Configure the ports to


transmit TDM services.

Table 7-17 Connections of TDM links (NE13)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE13 and NE12

2-SP3S (1-5)

Configure the ports to


transmit TDM services.

Between NE13 and NE14

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board)


Between NE13 and NE15

4-ISU2 (main IF board)


6-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

Table 7-18 Connections of TDM links (NE14)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE14 and BTS13

9-SP3S (1)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS13.

Between NE14 and NE13

3-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

4-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Table 7-19 Connections of TDM links (NE15)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and BTS14

2-SP3S (1-4)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS14.

Between NE15 and NE13

4-ISU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports as a 1+1


HSB protection group.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

152

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

7.5.2 Service Planning


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Timeslot Allocation Diagram


Figure 7-14 shows the timeslots that are allocated for the TDM services according to the network
planning information.
Figure 7-14 Timeslot allocation diagram (TDM services on the Hybrid chain radio network)
Links-1: NE11 - NE12 - NE13 -NE5
Station

RNC

NE11

Timeslot

1-SP3S 3-ISU2

NE12
3-ISU2 2-SP3S

NE13
2-SP3S 4-ISU2

NE15
4-ISU2

VC12: 1-2
2-SP3S:1-2

VC12: 3-4
VC4-1

2-SP3S:3-4

VC12: 5

Links-2: NE13-NE14
Station
Timeslot
VC4-1

/
/
/

NE13

NE14

2-SP3S 3-ISU2
VC12: 5

3-ISU2

VC12: 1
9-SP3S:1

Pass through(low/high)
Add/Drop(low/high)
Foward(low/high)

As shown in Figure 7-14, the information about the timeslots that the TDM services occupy on
each NE is as follows:
l

E1 services on NE15
The E1 services are added to or dropped from ports 1-4 of the SP3S board in slot 2 on
NE15.Ports 1 and 2 add and drop high-priority services and ports 3 and 4 add and drop
low-priority services.
The E1 services occupy the first to fourth VC-12 timeslots on the link between the
SP3S board in slot 1 of NE11 and the ISU2 board in slot 4 of NE15. Ports 1 and 2
transmit high-priority services and ports 3 and 4 transmit low-priority services.

E1 services on NE14
The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first port on the SP3S board in slot
9 of NE14. The E1 services received by NE14 are high-priority services by default,

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

153

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

because the E1 service priority function is disabled on the radio link to which NE14
belongs.
The E1 services occupy the fifth VC-12 timeslot on the link between the SP3S board
in slot 1 of NE11 and the SP3S board in slot 2 of NE13.
The E1 services occupy the first VC-12 timeslot on the link between the ISU2 board in
slot 3 of NE13 and the ISU2 board in slot 3 of NE14.

7.5.3 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)


This section describes the process for the data configuration on a per-NE basis.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services and create point-topoint service cross-connections.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

Level

VC12

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

1-SP3S

1-SP3S

Source VC4

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2,5

3-4

Sink Slot

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-2,5

3-4

E1 Priority

High

Low

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE12

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Level

VC12

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

154

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Parameter

Value
NE12

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2,5

3-4

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-2,5

3-4

E1 Priority

High

Low

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE13

Level

VC12

VC12

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

2-SP3S

2-SP3S

2-SP3S

Source VC4

Source Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

3-4

Sink Slot

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

3-4

E1 Priority

High

Low

Activate
Immediately

Yes

Yes

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE14

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Level

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-ISU2-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

155

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Parameter

Value
NE14

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

Sink Slot

9-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

E1 Priority

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE15

Level

VC12

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

3-4

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-2

3-4

E1 Priority

High

Low

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

Step 2 See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using PRBS and test the E1 services.
Test one E1 service on BTS13 and BTS14. The test results should show that the E1 services
contain no bit errors.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

156

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

7.6 Configuration Example (TDM Services on a Hybrid


Radio Ring Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
TDM services according to the network planning information.

7.6.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Ring Network),
configure the TDM services according to the service requirements. To ensure reliable
transmission of the services between the BTSs and the PSN, SNCP is configured to provide
protection for TDM services on the ring network. See Figure 7-15.The service capacity accessed
by each BTS is provided in Table 7-20.
Table 7-20 Service capacity accessed by each BTS
BTS

BTS22

Number of E1s

Figure 7-15 Networking diagram (TDM services on a Hybrid radio ring network)
Packet
network

2E1

NE21

BSC

BTS21
2E1 NE22

NE24

BTS24

BTS22

NE23
BTS23

The connections of TDM links shown in Figure 7-15 are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

157

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Table 7-21 Connections of TDM links (NE21)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and the PSN

2-SP3S (1-2)

Configure the ports to


transmit TDM services.

Between NE21 and NE22

4-ISU2

Configure the ports as east


ports.

Between NE21 and NE24

3-ISU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 SD protection group)

Configure the ports as west


ports.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board of


a 1+1 SD protection group)

Table 7-22 Connections of TDM links (NE22)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and BTS22

2-SP3S (1-2)

Configure the ports to access


services from BTS22.

Between NE22 and NE21

3-ISU2

Configure the ports as west


ports.

Between NE22 and NE23

4-ISU2

Configure this port as an east


port.

Table 7-23 Connections of TDM links (NE23)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE23 and NE22

3-ISU2

Configure this port as a west


port.

Between NE23 and NE24

4-ISU2

Configure this port as an east


port.

Table 7-24 Connections of TDM links (NE24)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE24 and NE21

4-ISU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 SD protection group)

Configure the ports as east


ports.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board of


a 1+1 SD protection group)
Between NE24 and NE23

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

3-ISU2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure this port as a west


port.
158

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

7.6.2 Service Planning


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Timeslot Allocation Diagram


Figure 7-16 shows the timeslots that are allocated for the TDM services according to the network
planning information.
Figure 7-16 Timeslot allocation diagram (TDM services on the Hybrid radio ring network)
Station
Timeslot

NE22

NE21
4-ISU2

NE23

3-ISU2 4-ISU2

3-ISU2 4-ISU2

VC12: 1-2
2-SP3S:1-2

NE24

NE21

3-ISU2 4-ISU2

3-ISU2

VC12: 1-2

2-SP3S:1-2 2-SP3S:1-2

2-SP3S:1-2

Pass through (SNCP working path)


Pass through (SNCP protection path)
Add/Drop (SNCP working path)
Add/Drop (SNCP protection path)

As shown in Figure 7-16, the information about the timeslots that the TDM services occupy on
each NE is as follows:
l

The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to second ports on the SP3S board
in slot 2 of NE22.

The E1 services are added to or dropped from the first to second ports on the SP3S board
in slot 2 of NE21.

The E1 services occupy the first to second VC-12 timeslots on the ring.

SNCP
Table 7-25 provides the information about SNCP.
Table 7-25 SNCP
Parameter

Value

Working Source

See the timeslot allocation diagram.

Protection Source

See the timeslot allocation diagram.

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time

600s (default value)

Hold-Off Time

0 (default value)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

159

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7 Configuring TDM Services

Parameter

Value

Switching Condition

Necessary conditions for an SNCP switching (default


values)

NOTE

Unless otherwise specified, WTR Time, Hold-Off Time, and Switching Condition take the default values.

7.6.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for the data configuration on a per-NE basis.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP Services and configure the SNCP service
cross-connections.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

Direction

Bidirectional

Level

VC-12

Hold-off Time(100ms)

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

Source Slot

4-ISU2-1 (working service)


3-ISU2-1 (protection service)

Source VC4

VC4-1 (working service)


VC4-1 (protection service)

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

E1 Priority

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

160

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE22

Direction

Bidirectional

Level

VC-12

Hold-off Time(100ms)

Revertive Mode

Revertive

WTR Time(s)

600

Source Slot

3-ISU2-1 (working service)


4-ISU2-1 (protection service)

Source VC4

VC4-1 (working service)


VC4-1 (protection service)

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Sink Slot

2-SP3S

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

E1 Priority

Activate Immediately

Yes

Step 2 See A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services and configure the
service cross-connections on NE23 and NE24.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE23

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-ISU2-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Sink Slot

4-ISU2-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Priority

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

161

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

7 Configuring TDM Services

Value
NE23

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE24

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-ISU2-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Sink Slot

4-ISU2-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Priority

Activate Immediately

Yes

Step 3 See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using PRBS and test the E1 services.
Test one E1 service on BTS22. The test results should show that the E1 services contain no bit
error.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

162

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the


Packet Plane

About This Chapter


Native Ethernet services on the packet plane include Native E-Line services and Native E-LAN
services.
8.1 Basic Concepts
Before configuring the Ethernet services, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
8.2 Configuration Procedure
The service configuration procedure differs according to the specific service type.
8.3 Configuration Example (Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Services)
This section considers a point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line service as an example
to describe how to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.
8.4 Configuration Example (VLAN-Based E-Line Service)
This section considers a VLAN-based E-line service as an example to describe how to configure
the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.
8.5 Configuration Example (QinQ-Based E-Line Service)
This section considers a QinQ-based E-line service as an example to describe how to configure
the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.
8.6 Configuration Example (802.1d-Bridge-Based E-LAN Service)
This section considers an 802.1d-bridge-based E-LAN service as an example to describe how
to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.
8.7 Configuration Example (802.1q-Bridge-Based E-LAN Service)
This section considers an 802.1q-bridge-based E-LAN service as an example to describe how
to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.
8.8 Configuration Example (802.1ad-Bridge-Based E-LAN Service)
This section considers an 802.1ad-bridge-based E-LAN service as an example to describe how
to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.
8.9 Configuration Example (Hybrid Configuration of E-Line Services and E-LAN Services)
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

163

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

This section describes how to configure a radio network that transmits E-Line services and ELAN services at the same time according to the network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

164

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.1 Basic Concepts


Before configuring the Ethernet services, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

8.1.1 What's the Packet Plane


The packet plane refers to the switching plane provided by the packet switching unit on a system
control, switching, and timing board. The packet plane supports a wide range of services and
features based on Native Ethernet, as well as a wide range of services and features based on
MPLS/PWE3.
As shown in Figure 8-1, the ports connecting to the packet plane are classified into the following
types:
l

FE/GE ports on a system control, switching, and timing board


These ports are directly connected to the packet switching unit.

FE/GE ports on an Ethernet interface board


In the receive direction, the Ethernet switching unit on an Ethernet interface board adds
port tags to the packets received from its FE/GE ports. Then, the packets are converged to
the internal GE ports on the board, and then transmitted to the packet switching unit. The
packet switching unit processes the packets of each port based on the port tags. In the
transmit direction, the packet switching unit adds the port tags to the packets. Then, the
packets are transmitted to the Ethernet switching unit through the internal GE ports on the
board. The Ethernet switching unit transmits the packets to the ports based on the port tags.
Therefore, the FE/GE ports on the Ethernet interface board can be regarded as being directly
connected to the packet switching unit.

IF_ETH ports on a general IF board or general XPIC IF board


IF_ETH ports are internal GE ports on a general IF board or general XPIC IF board. Ethernet
packets are transmitted to the local IF board through its IF_ETH ports, and then mapped
into Integrated IP radio frames. Ethernet packets demapped from Integrated IP radio frames
are transmitted to the packet switching unit through IF_ETH ports.
The main differences between an IF_ETH port and an FE/GE port are as follows:
An IF_ETH port is an internal Ethernet port. It transmits and receives MAC frames and
does not have PHY-layer functions.
The bandwidth at an IF_ETH port is equal to the Ethernet service bandwidth that the
Integrated IP radio supports. Therefore, when the AM function is enabled in the case
of Integrated IP radio, the bandwidth at an IF_ETH port changes according to the
modulation scheme.
NOTE

Since an IF port corresponds to an IF_ETH port, the IF ports or the microwave ports corresponding to IF
ports can be regarded as being directly connected to the packet plane.

Bridging port (PORT 10) connecting to the packet plane on the EFP8 board
The EFP8 board has two bridging ports: PORT 9 and PORT 10.
PORT 9 and PORT 10 are two back-to-back internal GE ports, not having PHY-layer
functions.
PORT 10 is connected to the packet plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane
are transmitted to the EoPDH plane through PORT 10.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

165

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PORT 9 is connected to the EoPDH plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane
are transmitted to the FE port or VCTRUNK port on the EFP8 board through PORT 9.
l

Bridging port (PORT 8) connecting to the packet plane on the EMS6 board
The EMS6 board has two bridging ports: PORT 7 and PORT 8.
PORT 7 and PORT 8 are two back-to-back internal GE ports, having no PHY-layer
function.
PORT 8 is connected to the packet plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane are
transmitted to the EoS plane through PORT 8.
PORT 7 is connected to the EoS plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane are
transmitted to the FE port, GE port, or VCTRUNK port on the EMS6 board through
PORT 7.

Figure 8-1 Packet plane


System control, switching,
and timing board

Packet plane
Ethernet interface board
FE/GE

PORT1

IF_ETH

Ethernet
switching
unit

FE/GE

PORTn

FE/GE

Ethernet interface board


PORT1

GE

GE

PORTn

IF

IF unit

FE/GE

General IF board or
general XPIC IF board

General IF board or
general XPIC IF board

Packet
switching unit

Ethernet
switching
unit

IF_ETH

IF

IF unit
GE

GE

FE/GE

PORT10

FE/GE

GE

PORT9

GE
PORT8

GE

PORT7

GE

EFP8
Ethernet
switching unit

EoPDH plane

EMS6
Ethernet
switching unit

EoS plane

8.1.2 Ethernet Port Numbers


On the NMS, Ethernet ports are represented by PORTs.
l

For the , PORT1 and PORT2 represent GE1 and GE2 respectively; PORT3 to PORT6
represent FE1 to FE4 respectively.

For the , PORT1 and PORT2 represent GE1 and GE2 respectively; PORT3 to PORT6
represent FE1 to FE4 respectively.

For the EG2D (logical board), PORT1 and PORT2 represent GE1 and GE2 respectively.

8.1.3 Auto-Negotiation
The auto-negotiation function allows the network equipment to send information about its
supported working mode to the opposite end of the network and to receive corresponding
information that the opposite end may transfer.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

166

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Auto-Negotiation Function of FE Electrical Ports


FE electrical ports may work in four common working modes: 10M half-duplex, 10M fullduplex, 100M half-duplex, and 100M full-duplex. If the working modes of the local FE electrical
port and the opposite FE electrical port do not match, the two ports cannot communicate with
each other. Auto-negotiation effectively resolves this problem. Auto-negotiation uses fast link
pulses and normal link pulses to transfer negotiation information about the working mode; lastly,
the working modes of the FE electrical ports match at both ends.
Table 8-1 lists auto-negotiation rules for FE electrical ports.
Table 8-1 Auto-negotiation rules for FE electrical ports (when the local FE electrical port works
in auto-negotiation mode)
Working Mode of the Opposite FE
Electrical Port

Auto-Negotiation Result

Auto-negotiation

100M full-duplex

10M half-duplex

10M half-duplex

10M full-duplex

10M half-duplex

100M half-duplex

100M half-duplex

100M full-duplex

100M half-duplex

NOTE

As provided in Table 8-1, when the opposite FE electrical port works in 10M full-duplex or 100M full-duplex
mode, auto-negotiation does not necessarily achieve full matching between the working modes of the FE
electrical ports at both ends. As a result, some packets are lost. Therefore, when the opposite FE electrical port
works in 10M full-duplex or 100M full-duplex mode, set the working mode of the local FE electrical port to
10M full-duplex or 100M full-duplex.

When the FE electrical ports at both ends work in auto-negotiation mode, the equipment at both
ends can negotiate flow control.

Auto-Negotiation Function of GE Electrical Ports


GE electrical ports can work in five working modes: 10M half-duplex, 10M full-duplex, 100M
half-duplex, 100M full-duplex, and 1000M full-duplex. Auto-negotiation of GE electrical ports
is similar to FE electrical port auto-negotiation. Table 8-2 lists auto-negotiation rules for GE
electrical ports.
Table 8-2 Auto-negotiation rules for GE electrical ports (when the local GE electrical port works
in auto-negotiation mode)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Working Mode of the Opposite GE


Electrical Port

Auto-Negotiation Result

Auto-negotiation (GE electrical port)

1000M full-duplex

Auto-negotiation (FE electrical port)

100M full-duplex

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

167

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Working Mode of the Opposite GE


Electrical Port

Auto-Negotiation Result

10M half-duplex

10M half-duplex

10M full-duplex

10M half-duplex

100M half-duplex

100M half-duplex

100M full-duplex

100M half-duplex

1000M full-duplex

1000M full-duplex

NOTE

As provided in Table 8-2, when the opposite GE electrical port works in 10M full-duplex or 100M full-duplex
mode, auto-negotiation does not necessarily achieve full matching between the working modes of the GE
electrical ports at both ends. As a result, some packets are lost. Therefore, when the opposite GE electrical port
works in 10M full-duplex or 100M full-duplex mode, set the working mode of the local GE electrical port to
10M full-duplex or 100M full-duplex.

When the GE electrical ports at both ends work in auto-negotiation mode, the equipment at both
ends can negotiate flow control.

Auto-Negotiation Function of GE Optical Ports


GE optical ports support only 1000M full-duplex working mode. Auto-negotiation of GE optical
ports is used only for negotiating flow control.

8.1.4 Flow Control Function


When the equipment fails to handle the traffic received at the port due to poor data processing/
transferring capability, the line becomes congested. This also causes buffer overflow and
therefore some packets will be discarded. To reduce the number of packets to be discarded, take
appropriate flow control measures.
Half-duplex Ethernet uses a back-pressure mechanism to control flow. Full-duplex Ethernet uses
PAUSE frames to control flow. Currently, half-duplex Ethernet is not widely applied; therefore,
flow control implemented on the equipment is used for full-duplex Ethernet.
The flow control function on the equipment is classified into two types: auto-negotiation flow
control and non-auto-negotiation flow control.

Auto-Negotiation Flow Control


When an Ethernet port works in auto-negotiation mode, use auto-negotiation flow control. The
auto-negotiation flow control modes include the following:
l

Asymmetric PAUSE toward the link partner


The port can transmit PAUSE frames in case of congestion but cannot process received
PAUSE frames.

Symmetric PAUSE
The port can transmit PAUSE frames and process received PAUSE frames.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

168

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Both asymmetric and symmetric PAUSE


The port has the following capabilities:
Transmits and processes PAUSE frames.
Transmits PAUSE frames but cannot process received PAUSE frames.
Processes received PAUSE frames but cannot transmit PAUSE frames.

Disabled
The port does not transmit or process PAUSE frames.
NOTE

On the NMS, the OptiX RTN 980 supports only two auto-negotiation flow control modes: Disabled mode and
Enable Symmetric Flow Control (symmetric PAUSE) mode.

Non-Auto-Negotiation Flow Control


When an Ethernet port works in a fixed working mode, use non-auto-negotiation flow control.
The non-auto-negotiation flow control modes include the following:
l

Send only
The port can transmit PAUSE frames in case of congestion but cannot process received
PAUSE frames.

Receive only
The port can process received PAUSE frames but cannot transmit PAUSE frames in case
of congestion.

Symmetric
The port can transmit PAUSE frames and can also process received PAUSE frames.

Disabled
The port does not transmit or process PAUSE frames.
NOTE

On the NMS, the OptiX RTN 980 supports only two non-auto-negotiation flow control modes: Disabled mode
and Enable Symmetric Flow Control (symmetric) mode.

8.1.5 Native Ethernet Service Types Based on the Packet Plane


Based on the packet plane, Native Ethernet services are classified into six types.

8.1.5.1 Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Service


The point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line service are the basic E-Line model. Pointto-point transmission does not involve service bandwidth sharing, service isolation, or service
distinguishing; instead, Ethernet services are transparently transmitted between two service
access points.

Service Model
Table 8-3 describes the point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line service model.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

169

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-3 Point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line service model


Service Model

Traffic Flow

Service Direction

Encapsulation
Type

Description

Model 1

PORT (source)

UNI-UNI

Null (source)

The source port


transparently
transmits all the
received Ethernet
frames to the sink
port.

PORT (sink)

Model 2

PORT (source)

NOTE
In service model 2,
ports process the
received Ethernet
frames according to
their TAG attributes.
Therefore, service
model 2 is not a real
transparent
transmission model
and is not
recommended.

PORT (sink)

Null (sink)

UNI-UNI

802.1Q (source)
802.1Q (sink)

The source port


processes the
incoming Ethernet
frames based on its
TAG attribute, and
then sends the
processed Ethernet
frames to the sink
port. The sink port
processes the
Ethernet frames
based on its TAG
attribute, and then
exports the
processed Ethernet
frames.

Typical Application
Figure 8-2 shows the typical application of service model 1.
Figure 8-2 Typical application of service model 1
NE 1
Port 1
Service 1

E-Line

NE 2
Port 3

E-Line

Service 2
Port 2

Transmission
Network

Port 4

Port 3

E-Line

Port 1
Service 1

E-Line
Port 4

Service 2
Port 2

In service model 1, Ethernet service 1 and Ethernet service 2, which carry no VLAN IDs or carry
unknown VLAN IDs, are accessed to NE1 through port 1 and port 2 respectively. Port 1 and
port 2 transparently transmit Ethernet service 1 and Ethernet service 2 to port 3 and port 4,
respectively. Port 3 and port 4 then transmit Ethernet service 1 and Ethernet service 2 to NE2.
Service processing on NE2 is the same as on NE1.
In service model 2, Ethernet service 1 and Ethernet service 2, which carry no VLAN IDs or carry
unknown VLAN IDs, are accessed to NE1 through port 1 and port 2 respectively. Port 1 and
Port 2 process the incoming packets based on their own TAG attributes. Then, Port 1 and Port
2 send Ethernet service 1 and Ethernet service 2 to Port 3 and Port 4 respectively. Port 3 and
Port 4 process the incoming packets based on their own TAG attributes. Then, Port 3 and Port
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

170

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

4 send Ethernet service 1 and Ethernet service 2 to NE2. Service processing on NE2 is the same
as on NE1.

8.1.5.2 VLAN-based E-Line Services


VLANs can be used to separate several E-Line services so that these services share one physical
channel for transmission. These E-Line services are called VLAN-based E-Line services.

Service Model
Table 8-4 shows the VLAN-based E-Line service model.
Table 8-4 VLAN-based E-Line service model
Service Type

Service Flow

Service Direction

Port
Encapsulation
Mode

Service
Description

VLAN-based ELine service

PORT+VLAN
(source)

UNI-UNI

802.1Q (source)

The source port


processes the
incoming Ethernet
frames based on its
TAG attribute, and
then sends the
Ethernet frames
with a specific
VLAN ID to the sink
port. The sink port
processes the
Ethernet frames
based on its TAG
attribute, and then
exports the
processed Ethernet
frames.

802.1Q (sink)

PORT+VLAN
(sink)
NOTE
The VLAN ID of the
source must be the
same as that of the
sink.

Typical Application
Figure 8-3 shows the typical application of the VLAN-based E-Line service model. Service 1
and service 2 carry different VLAN IDs. After the two Ethernet services are received at NE1
through port 1 and port 2 respectively, they share the same transmission channel at port 3.
On NE1, port 1 and port 2 process the incoming packets based on their own TAG attributes;
then, port 1 and port 2 send service 1 and service 2 to port 3. Port 3 processes all the outgoing
packets based on its TAG attribute, and then sends service 1 and service 2 to NE2. Due to the
different VLAN IDs, service 1 and service 2 can be transmitted through port 3 at the same time.
NE2 processes service 1 and service 2 in the same manner as NE1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

171

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-3 VLAN-based E-Line service model


NE 1
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

Port 1

Port 2

NE 2

E-Line

Port 3

e
E-Lin

Transmission
Network

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

Port 3
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

E-Line

E-Lin
e

Port 1

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100

Service 2
Port 2 VLAN ID: 200

8.1.5.3 QinQ-Based E-Line Services


S-VLAN tags can be used to separate several E-Line services so that these services share one
physical channel for transmission. These services are called QinQ-based E-Line services.
NOTE

PW-Carried E-Line Services describes QinQ-based E-Line services carried by PWs.

Service Model
Table 8-5 shows the QinQ-based E-Line service models.
Table 8-5 QinQ-based E-Line service models
Service Model

Service Flow

Service Direction

Port
Encapsulation
Mode

Service
Description

Model 1

PORT (source)

UNI-NNI

Null (source)

The source port adds


the S-VLAN tag that
corresponds to the
QinQ link to all the
received Ethernet
frames, and then
transmits the
Ethernet frames to
the sink port to
which the QinQ link
is connected.

QinQ link (sink)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

QinQ (sink)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

172

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Service Model

Service Flow

Service Direction

Port
Encapsulation
Mode

Service
Description

Model 2

PORT (source)

UNI-NNI

802.1Q (source)a

After the source port


receives the
Ethernet frames that
carry C-VLAN tags,
it adds the S-VLAN
tag that corresponds
to the QinQ link to
all the Ethernet
frames and then
transmits the
Ethernet frames to
the sink port to
which the QinQ link
is connected.

QinQ link (sink)

PORT+C-VLAN
(source)

Model 3

QinQ (sink)

UNI-NNI

QinQ (sink)

QinQ link (sink)

QinQ link (source)

Model 4

QinQ link (sink)

802.1Q (source)a

NNI-NNI

QinQ (source)
QinQ (sink)

The source port adds


the S-VLAN tag that
corresponds to the
QinQ link to all the
Ethernet frames that
carry specific CVLAN tags and then
transmits the
Ethernet frames to
the sink port to
which the QinQ link
is connected.
The source port
transmits the
Ethernet frames that
carry a specific SVLAN tag
(corresponding to
the source QinQ
link) to the sink port
to which the sink
QinQ link is
connected. If the
source and sink
QinQ links have
different S-VLAN
tags, S-VLAN tag
swapping occurs.

NOTE

a: Set Tag to Tag Aware.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

173

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Typical Application
Figure 8-4 shows the typical application of service model 1.
Service 1 and service 2 contain tagged frames and untagged frames. Service 1 is transmitted to
NE1 through port 1, and service 2 is transmitted to NE1 through port 2. Port 1 adds an S-VLAN
tag to service 1, and port 2 adds another S-VLAN tag to service 2. Service 1 and service 2 are
then transmitted to Port 3. Port 3 transmits service 1 and service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes service 1 and service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 8-4 Typical application of service model 1
NE 1
Port 1
Service 1

E-Line

Service 2
Port 2
Strip S-VLAN Label

NE 2
Transmission
Network

Port 3

Port 1

E-Line

Port 3

Service 1
Service 2

E-Lin
e

e
E-Lin

Add S-VLAN Label

Add S-VLAN Label

Port 2

Strip S-VLAN Label

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

Data(1)

S-VLAN(300)

Data(1)

Data(1)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

Data(2)

Figure 8-5 shows the typical application of service model 2.


Service 1 and service 2 carry different unknown C-VLAN tags. Service 1 is transmitted to NE1
through port 1, and service 2 is transmitted to NE1 through port 2. Port 1 adds an S-VLAN tag
to service 1, and port 2 adds another S-VLAN tag to service 2. Service 1 and service 2 are then
transmitted to port 3. Port 3 transmits service 1 and service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes service 1 and service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 8-5 Typical application of service model 2
Strip S-VLAN Label

Add S-VLAN Label

C-VLAN

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN

Data(1)

C-VLAN

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN

Data(2)

NE 1
Service 1
Unknown CVLAN
Service 2
Unknown CVLAN

Port 1

Port 2

E-Line

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
Network

E-Line

Port 3

E-Lin
e

e
E-Lin
Add S-VLAN Label

Port 1

Port 2

Service 1
Unknown CVLAN
Service 2
Unknown CVLAN

Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN

Data(1)

C-VLAN

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN

Data(2)

C-VLAN

Data(2)

Figure 8-6 shows the typical application of service model 3.


Service 1 and service 2 carry different C-VLAN tags. Service 1 is transmitted to NE1 through
port 1, and service 2 is transmitted to NE1 through port 2. Port 1 adds an S-VLAN tag to service
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

174

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

1, and port 2 adds another S-VLAN tag to service 2. Service 1 and service 2 are then transmitted
to port 3. Port 3 transmits service 1 and service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes service 1 and service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 8-6 Typical application of service model 3
Strip S-VLAN Label

Add S-VLAN Label

C-VLAN(100)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(1)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

NE 1
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

Port 1

Port 2

E-Line

NE 2
Transmission
Network

Port 3

E-Line

Port 3

E-Lin
e

e
E-Lin
Add S-VLAN Label

Port 1

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100

Service 2
Port 2 VLAN ID: 200
Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(1)

C-VLAN(100)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

Figure 8-7 shows the typical application of service model 4.


Service 1 and service 2 carry the same S-VLAN tag. Service 1 is transmitted to NE1 through
port 1, and service 2 is transmitted to NE1 through port 2. Port 1 changes the S-VLAN tag carried
in service 1 and port 2 changes the S-VLAN tag carried in service 2 so that the service 1 and
service carry different S-VLAN tags. Port 3 transmits service 1 and service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes service 1 and service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 8-7 Typical application of service model 4
Switching S-VLAN Label
S-VLAN(100)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

Data(1)

S-VLAN(100)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

NE 1
Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
S-VLAN ID: 100

Port 1

Port 2

E-Line

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
Network

Port 3

E-Line

E-Lin
e

e
E-Lin

Port 1

Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100

Service 2
Port 2 S-VLAN ID: 100

Switching S-VLAN Label


S-VLAN(300)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(100)

Data(1)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(100)

Data(2)

8.1.5.4 8021D Bridge-based E-LAN Services


If packets of E-LAN services are forwarded only based on the MAC address table, these E-LAN
services are called 802.1D bridge-based E-LAN services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

175

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Service Model
Table 8-6 shows the 802.1D bridge-based E-LAN service model.
Table 8-6 802.1D bridge-based E-LAN service model
Service Type

Tag Attribute

Port
Encapsulation
Mode

Logical Port
Type

Learning
Mode

SubSwitching
Domain

802.1D bridgebased E-LAN


service

TagTransparent

Null

PORT

SVL

No division of
sub-switching
domains

Typical Application
Figure 8-8 shows the typical application of the 802.1D bridge-based E-LAN service model.
NE2 and NE3 receive A services, and the A services are transmitted over the transmission
network. The two A services are converged at the convergence node NE1. The services do not
need to be separated. Therefore, an 802.1D bridge is used at NE1 to groom services.
Figure 8-8 802.1D bridge-based E-LAN service model
NE 2

Port 1
User A2

Port 2
NE 1

Port 1
User A1

Transmission
Network
Port 2
Port 3

802.1d bridge

Transmission
Network

Port 2

NE 3

Port 1
User A3

8.1.5.5 802.1Q Bridge-based E-LAN Services


VLANs can be used to separate several E-LAN services, and then an 802.1Q bridge is divided
into multiple independent sub-switching domains. These E-LAN services are called 802.1Q
bridge-based E-LAN services.

Service Model
Table 8-7 shows the 802.1Q bridge-based E-LAN service model.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

176

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-7 802.1Q bridge-based E-LAN service model


Service Type

TAG
Attribute

Port
Encapsulation
Mode

Logical Port
Type

Learning
Mode

SubSwitching
Domain

802.1Q bridgebased E-LAN


service

C-Awared

802.1Q

PORT+VLAN

IVL

Sub-switching
domains are
divided based on
VLANs.

Typical Application
Figure 8-9 shows the typical application of the 802.1Q bridge-based E-LAN service model.
Services G and H are received at NE2 and NE3, and then are transmitted over the transmission
network. These services finally are converged and switched at NE1. As services G and H use
different VLAN planning, 802.1Q bridges are configured on NEs and sub-switching domains
are divided based on VLANs, differentiating and separating the two services.
Figure 8-9 802.1Q bridge-based E-LAN service model
NE 2
VLAN 100

Port 3

NE 1
Port 1
User G1

VLAN 100

VLAN 200

Port 2
User H1

Port 2
User H2

Transmission
Network
Port 3

VLAN 200

Port 1
User G2

802.1q bridge

Port 4

NE 3

Transmission
Network

VLAN 100

Port 1
User G3

802.1q bridge

Port 3

VLAN 200

Port 2
User H3

802.1q bridge

NOTE

You can configure VLAN-based E-Line Services on NE2 and NE3 for receiving services.

8.1.5.6 802.1ad Bridge-based E-LAN Services


S-VLAN tags can be used to separate several E-LAN services, and then a bridge is divided into
multiple independent sub-switching domains. These services are called 802.1ad bridge-based
E-LAN services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

177

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Service Model
Table 8-8 shows the 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN service models.
Table 8-8 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN service models
Service Type

Tag Attribute

Port
Encapsulation
Mode

Logical Port
Type

Learning
Mode

SubSwitching
Domain

E-LAN services
based on
802.1ad bridge

S-Awared

Null or 802.1Q
(UNI port)a

PORT (The
encapsulation
mode of the UNI
port is Null.)

IVL

Sub-switching
domains are
divided based on
S-VLAN tags.

QinQ (NNI port)

PORT or PORT
+C-VLAN (The
encapsulation
mode of the UNI
port is 802.1Q.)
a

PORT+SVLAN (NNI
port)

NOTE

a: When the encapsulation mode of port is 802.1Q, set Tag to Tag Aware.

Typical Application
Figure 8-10 shows the typical application of the 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN service model.
Services G and H are received at NE2 and NE3, and then are transmitted over the transmission
network. These services finally are converged and switched at NE1. As services G and H use
the same C-VLAN planning, extra S-VLAN tags are configured on NEs, differentiating and
separating the two services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

178

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-10 Typical application of the 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN service model
NE 2
Add S-VLAN Label

Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(G)

C-VLAN(100)

Data( G)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

NE 2
SVLAN 300

Port 1
User G2
CVLAN 100

Port 3
SVLAN 400

NE 1
Transmission
Network

SVLAN 300

Port 1
User G1

CVLAN 100

Port 3
802.1ad bridge

CVLAN 100
SVLAN 400

User H1

Port 2
User H2

NE 3

Port 2

CVLAN 100

Port 4
802.1ad bridge

SVLAN 300

Transmission
Network

Port 1
User G3
CVLAN 100
SVLAN 400

Port 3

NE 1
Strip S-VLAN Label

Port 2
User H3
CVLAN 100

Add S-VLAN Label

C-VLAN(100)

Data( G)

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(G)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

802.1ad bridge
NE 3

Add S-VLAN Label

Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(G)

C-VLAN(100)

Data( G)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

NOTE

You can configure QinQ-Based E-Line Services on NE2 and NE3 for service access.

8.1.6 Typical Mobile Carrier Network Topologies for Ethernet


Services
Generally, Ethernet services are transmitted in three network topologies on a mobile carrier
network.

8.1.6.1 Networking of VLAN-Based E-Line Services


VLANs can be used to separate E-Line services. With the VLAN technology, multiple E-Line
services can share one physical channel.
On the mobile carrier network shown in Figure 8-11, the VLAN IDs that received BTS services
carry are planned in a unified manner and are unique globally. The BTS services share the
Ethernet service bandwidth on the Hybrid radio network (NE1 to NE5) and are isolated from
each other by means of VLAN IDs. The BTS services are aggregated at NE1 and then transmitted
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

179

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

through the regional backhaul network to the BSC. Therefore, in this example, services on the
Hybrid radio network of the mobile carrier network are configured as VLAN-based E-Line
services.
Figure 8-11 Networking diagram of VLAN-based E-Line services
FE
BTS
VLAN 1

NE3
FE

BTS
VLAN 2

NE2
Hybrid microwave transmission network

Regional
Backhaul Network
NE1

GE
BSC

FE
BTS
VLAN 3

NE5

NE4

FE
BTS
VLAN 4

8.1.6.2 Networking of IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


In the case of IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN service networking, data is forwarded based
on MAC addresses instead of VLAN IDs.
As shown in Figure 8-12, the mobile carrier network need not sense whether the received BTS
services carry any VLAN IDs. Services from each BTS are aggregated at NE1 and then
transmitted through the regional backhaul network to the BSC. Therefore, in this example, the
services on the Hybrid radio network (NE1 to NE6) of the mobile carrier network are configured
as IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services. The Hybrid radio network checks the destination
ports in the MAC address table according to the destination MAC addresses carried by the BTS
services and then forwards BTS services to the ports.
NOTE

IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN service packets are forwarded based on MAC addresses and may be broadcast
among all ports connected to the IEEE 802.1d bridge. Therefore, isolate the ports that need not communicate
with each other by adding the ports into a split horizon group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

180

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-12 Networking diagram of IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services


FE
BTS

NE3
FE

NE2
Hybrid microwave transmission network

BTS

Regional backhaul
network
NE1

GE
BSC

FE
BTS

NE5

NE4

FE
BTS

NE6

Split horizon group

8.1.6.3 Networking of IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


In the case of IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN service networking, services are isolated by
means of VLAN IDs. That is, the IEEE 802.1q bridge is divided into multiple sub-switching
domains, which are isolated from each other.
On the mobile carrier network shown in Figure 8-13, the VLAN IDs that received BTS services
carry are planned in a unified manner and are unique within each domain. BTS services in
different domains are isolated from each other by means of VLAN IDs and BTSs in the same
domain can communicate with each other. The BTS services are aggregated at NE1 and then
transmitted through the regional backhaul network to the BSC. Therefore, in this example, the
services on the Hybrid radio network of the mobile carrier network are configured as IEEE
802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services. The Hybrid radio network checks the destination ports in
the MAC address table according to the destination MAC addresses and VLAN IDs carried by
the BTS services and then forwards BTS services to the ports.
NOTE

IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN service packets can be broadcast within each domain. Therefore, isolate the
ports that need not communicate with each other by adding the ports into a split horizon group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

181

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-13 Networking diagram of IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services

FE
BTS
VLAN 1

NE3
FE
Domain 1
VLAN 1

NE2

BTS
VLAN 1

Domain 2
VLAN 2

Hybrid radio
network

Regional backhaul
network
NE1

GE
BSC

FE
BTS
VLAN 2

NE5

NE4

FE
BTS
VLAN 2

NE6

Split horizon group

8.1.6.4 Comparison Between the Three Networking Modes


The three networking modes differ from each other.
Table 8-9 compares the three networking modes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

182

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-9 Comparison between the three networking modes


Networkin
g Mode

Application Scenario
Applicable
Network
Size

Applicable
VLAN ID
Allocation

Networking
of VLANbased E-Line
services

This
networking
mode is
applicable to
all network
sizes.

l The
VLAN
IDs that
received
BTS
services
carry are
planned in
a unified
manner
and are
unique
globally.

Service
Stability

Service
Security

Configurati
on
Complexity

Network
Scalability

High

l Very high

l The
configurat
ion
operations
are
complex.

l The
network is
difficult to
expand.

l Services
from
different
BTSs are
isolated
from each
other.

l BTS
services
share
Ethernet
service
bandwidt
hs and are
isolated
by means
of VLAN
IDs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

l Only
point-topoint
configurat
ion is
supported
.

l To add the
new
VLAN ID
after a
BTS is
added,
you need
to change
the E-Line
configurat
ions on all
the NEs
that the
new
service
path
traverses.

183

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Networkin
g Mode

Application Scenario
Applicable
Network
Size

Applicable
VLAN ID
Allocation

Networking
of IEEE
802.1d
bridge-based
E-LAN
services

It is
recommende
d that the
network
contains less
than 50 BTSs.

l The
network
need not
sense
whether
the
received
BTS
services
carry any
VLAN
IDs.

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Service
Stability

Service
Security

Configurati
on
Complexity

Network
Scalability

Medium

l Low

l The
configurat
ion
operations
are
simple.

l The
network is
easy to
expand.

l The
service
packets
can be
broadcast
on the
entire
network.

l Services
need not
be
isolated
between
different
ports
connected
to the
same
bridge.a

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

l Point-tomultipoint
configurat
ion is
supported
.

l After a
BTS is
added,
you need
not
change
the
configurat
ions of
other NEs
on the
network.
Instead,
you only
need to
change
the
mounted
ports on
the NE
connected
to the base
station.

184

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Networkin
g Mode

Application Scenario
Applicable
Network
Size

Applicable
VLAN ID
Allocation

Networking
of IEEE
802.1q
bridge-based
E-LAN
services

This
networking
mode is
applicable to
all network
sizes,
especially to a
network that
is divided into
several
domains.

l The
VLAN
IDs that
received
BTS
services
carry are
planned in
a unified
manner
and are
unique
within
each
domain.

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Service
Stability

Service
Security

Configurati
on
Complexity

Network
Scalability

Medium

l High

l The
configurat
ion
operations
are
simple.

l The
network is
easy to
expand.

l The
service
packets
are
broadcast
within
each
domain
and are
isolated
between
different
domains.

l The BTS
services
from
different
domains
are
isolated
from each
other by
means of
VLAN
IDs.
l BTS
services
within a
domain
need not
be
isolated
from each
other.a

l Point-tomultipoint
configurat
ion is
supported
.

l After a
BTS is
added in a
domain,
you need
not
change
the
configurat
ions of the
other NEs
in the
domain or
the
configurat
ions of
NEs in the
other
domains.
Instead,
you only
need to
change
the
mounted
ports and
VLAN
IDs on the
NE
connected
to the base
station.

NOTE

a: To block communication between certain ports connected to a bridge, you need to add the ports into a split
horizon group.

8.1.7 MAC Address Table Management


The entries in a MAC address table show the mappings between MAC addresses and ports. A
MAC address table contains dynamic entries, static entries, and blacklist entries.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

185

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Dynamic entry
A dynamic entry is obtained by learning of a bridge through the SVL/IVL mode. The
dynamic entry will be aged.

Static entry
A static entry is manually added to the MAC address table by a network administrator using
the NMS. The static entry will not be aged. Generally, the static entry is configured for a
port if a device with a known MAC address is mounted to the port and this device transmits
large traffic for a long time.

Blacklist entry
A blacklist entry is a MAC disabled entry and is used to discard a data frame that contains
a specified MAC address (source MAC address or destination MAC address). A blacklist
entry is also called a blackhole entry. The blacklist entry is configured by the network
administrator. The blacklist entry does not age, and is not lost after the Ethernet processing
board is reset.
NOTE

A forwarding entry is automatically deleted when that forwarding entry is not updated within a specified
period. This occurs when no new packet from this MAC address is received to enable the re-learning of
this MAC address. This mechanism is called aging, and this period is called aging time.

8.1.8 VLAN Forwarding Table for E-Line Services


Generally, the VLAN IDs of VLAN-based E-Line services are not changed. If changing VLAN
IDs is required, configure a VLAN forwarding table.
For VLAN-based E-Line services, the VLAN IDs on the source and sink nodes are usually set
to the same value. If packets carry different VLAN IDs on the source and sink nodes, these
VLAN IDs need to be set for the source and sink nodes of the E-Line services. In addition, you
need to configure a VLAN forwarding table to achieve the switch of VLAN IDs at the source
and sink nodes.
Figure 8-14 shows an application of the VLAN forwarding table. In this figure, service 1 carries
a VLAN ID of 100, and it is transmitted to NE1 through port 1. On a transmission network, the
VLAN ID of service 1 may be in conflict with the VLAN IDs of other services. To avoid this
situation, the VLAN ID of service 1 must be changed to another value before it is transmitted
on the transmission network and then be changed to the original value after it is transmitted out
of the transmission network. Therefore, a VLAN forwarding table is configured at NE1 and
NE2, so that the VLAN IDs of services between port 1 and port 3 can be changed as required.
For service 1, when it traverses NE1, the VLAN ID is changed from 100 to 200 and then changes
back to 100 again at NE2.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

186

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-14 Application of the VLAN forwarding table in E-Line services


NE 1
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100

NE 2

Port 1

Port 1

E-Lin
e

Port 3

Transmission
Network

Service 1
VLAN ID: 200

Port 3

e
E-Lin

Service 1
VLAN ID: 200

VLAN Forwarding Table


Source
Interface
Port 1

Source
VLAN ID
100

Port 3

200

VLAN Forwarding Table

Sink
Sink
Interface VLAN ID
200
Port 3
Port 1

100

Source
Interface
Port 1

Source
VLAN ID
100

Port 3

200

E-Line Service Information Table


Source
Interface

Source
VLAN ID

Port 1

100, 200

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100

Port 1

100

E-Line Service Information Table

Sink
Sink
Interface VLAN ID
Port 3

Sink
Sink
Interface VLAN ID
200
Port 3

100, 200

Source
Interface

Source
VLAN ID

Port 1

100, 200

Sink
Sink
Interface VLAN ID
100, 200

Port 3

8.1.9 Split Horizon Group


To separate services that are converged and to prevent a broadcast storm resulting from a service
loop, you can configure a split horizon group for the E-LAN services at the specified nodes.
After the configuration, the logical ports in one split horizon group cannot forward packets to
each other.
Figure 8-15 shows a typical application of the split horizon group. NEs on the network are
configured with E-LAN services, and the east and west ports and service access ports are
configured as mounted ports of a bridge. In this case, if a split horizon group is not configured
at NE1, broadcast storm occurs due to a network loop as the east and west ports can forward
packets to each other. If a split horizon group is created at NE1 and the east and west ports are
configured as members of the split horizon group, the east and west ports do not forward packets
to each other. Therefore, a service loop is prevented.
Figure 8-15 Split horizon group
NE1
BSC

Split horizon group

BTS
NE2

NE4

BTS

BTS

NE3
BTS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

187

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

l ERPS can prevent a service loop on a ring network. If ERPS is already enabled for a ring network, a split
horizon group is not needed as it may affect ERPS operation.
l On the OptiX RTN 980, only the split horizon group configuration based on physical ports is supported.
Therefore, if a physical port is mapped into several logical ports and one of these logical ports is a member
of a split horizon group, the other logical ports are added to the split horizon group automatically.

8.1.10 Protection for Native Ethernet Services


The OptiX RTN 980 supports three protection modes for Native Ethernet services, namely,
Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS), link aggregation group (LAG), and multiple
spanning tree protocol (MSTP).

ERPS
ERPS is applicable to ring physical networks and can provide protection for the E-LAN services
between all the nodes on the ring network. Generally, when a ring network is configured with
ERPS, the RPL node blocks the RPL port on one side so that all the services are transmitted
through the ports on the other side. In this manner, service loops are prevented. If a section of
link fails or an NE becomes faulty, the RPL node unblocks its RPL port so that the services are
switched from the faulty point to the RPL port for transmission. In this manner, protection for
the ring network is achieved.
The Ethernet ring network shown in Figure 8-16 is configured with ERPS. Generally, the RPL
node (NE D) blocks its RPL port that is connected to NE A, and all the services are transmitted
over the link NE A <-> NE B <-> NE C <-> NE D. When the link between NE A <-> NE B
becomes faulty, NE D unblocks the blocked port so that the services can be transmitted over the
link NE A <-> NE D <-> NE C <-> NE B.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

188

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-16 Implementation of ERPS

NE A

NE D

NE B

NE C

Protection switching

Failure

NE A

NE D

NE B

NE C
Link
Ethernet service direction
Blocked port

LAG
Link aggregation allows multiple links that are attached to the same equipment to be aggregated
to form a link aggregation group (LAG) so that the bandwidths and availability of the links
increase. The aggregated links can be considered as a single logical link.
As shown in Figure 8-17, the LAG provides the following functions:
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Increased the link capacity


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

189

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The LAG provides users with a cost-effective method for increasing link bandwidth. The
users obtain data links with higher bandwidths by combining multiple physical links into
one logical link without upgrading the existing equipment. The bandwidth of the logical
link is equal to the sum of the bandwidths of the physical links. The aggregation module
distributes the traffic to different members by using the load balancing algorithm, achieving
the load balancing at the link level.
l

Improved the link availability


The links in a LAG provide backup for each other dynamically. When a link fails, another
link in the LAG quickly takes over. This process in which link aggregation starts the backup
link only applies to the links in the same LAG and it cannot be performed on links that are
not in the LAG.

Figure 8-17 LAG


Link 1
Link 2
Ethernet
packet

Link 3

Ethernet
packet

Link aggregation
group

MSTP
The OptiX RTN 980 supports only the MSTP protocol that uses the common and internal
spanning tree (CIST). The MSTP that uses the CIST can be used as a rapid spanning tree protocol
(RSTP). The RSTP is applicable in case of a network loop. This protocol adopts certain
algorithms to reconstruct a loop network into a loop-free tree network and therefore prevents
Ethernet frames from increasing and cycling in an endless manner on the loop network.
On the OptiX RTN 980, the MSTP is used to prevent a network loop on the access side.
See Figure 8-18. When the user equipment is connected to the OptiX RTN 980 through two
different trails, you can configure the ports on the OptiX RTN 980 that are connected to the user
network into a port group. This port group, together with the switch on the user network, can
run the MSTP. If a service access link becomes faulty, the MSTP enables a re-configuration to
generate the spanning tree topology, providing protection for the user network that is configured
with multiple access points.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

190

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-18 Prevention of network loops on the access side


Root

Root

Port group
CIST
Blocked Port

8.2 Configuration Procedure


The service configuration procedure differs according to the specific service type.

8.2.1 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (Point-to-Point


Transparently Transmitted E-Line Services)
Configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services in an end-to-end mode
includes configuring the service information, port information, protection information, and QoS
information, and verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-19 shows the procedures for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted ELine services in an end-to-end mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

191

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-19 Configuration flowchart (point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet
ports

Configuring IF_ETH
ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring E-Line
services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet
service configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

192

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-10 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. In
the case of unused ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type
to Null.
l In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the
external equipment (the working mode of the external
equipment is generally auto-negotiation). In the case of an
Ethernet port within the network, set Working Mode to
Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet
Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the


external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected.
Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation
flow control function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow
Control Mode to Enable Symmetric Flow Control.

Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.
Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to
Null.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

193

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that
permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

194

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-11 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

195

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line


Services
Table 8-12 Procedures for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.2.5.1
Creating
Optical Fibers
by Using the
Search Method

Perform this task to create radio links if they have not been created on
Main Topology of the U2000.

A.2.5.2
Creating
Fibers
Manually

Required when Ethernet services are transmitted over FE/GE links.


Set the parameters as follows:
l If FE/GE ports are connected through optical fibers, set Fiber/Cable
to Fiber. If FE/GE ports are connected through electrical cables, set
Fiber/Cable to Cable.
l Set Automatically Allocate Address to No.

A.13.1.2
Creating ELine Services
Transmitted in
Native
Ethernet Mode

Required.
Set related parameters according to the service planning information and
parameter planning information.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-13 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

196

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-14 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

197

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.2 Configuration Procedure (Point-to-Point Transparently


Transmitted E-Line Services)
This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedures for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line
services.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 8-20 provides the procedures for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted ELine services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

198

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-20 Configuration flow chart (point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet
ports

Configuring IF_ETH
ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring E-Line
services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet
service configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

199

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-15 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. In
the case of unused ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type
to Null.
l In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the
external equipment (the working mode of the external
equipment is generally auto-negotiation). In the case of an
Ethernet port within the network, set Working Mode to
Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet
Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the


external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected.
Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation
flow control function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow
Control Mode to Enable Symmetric Flow Control.

Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.
Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to
Null.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

200

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that
permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

201

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-16 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

202

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line


Services
Table 8-17 Procedures for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.2
Configuring
UNI-UNI ELine Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Direction to UNI-UNI.
l Set Source Port and Sink Port according to the planning information.
l Source VLANs and Sink VLANs remain null.

A.7.3.7
Creating a
VLAN
Forwarding
Table for an ELine Service

Required when the VLAN tags of the Ethernet service need to be swapped
at the source and sink.
Set the parameters according to the network planning information.
NOTE
The corresponding VLAN forwarding table entries need to be configured for the
source port and sink port.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-18 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

203

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-19 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

204

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.3 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (VLAN-Based E-Line


Services)
Configuring VLAN-based E-Line services in an end-to-end mode includes configuring the
service information, port information, protection information, and QoS information, and
verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-21 provides the procedures for configuring VLAN-based E-Line services in an endto-end mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

205

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-21 Configuration flowchart (VLAN-based E-Line services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet ports

Configuring IF_ETH ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring E-Line services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet service


configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

206

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-20 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. In
the case of unused ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type
to 802.1Q in the case of ports that transmit only Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags.
l In the case of ports that transmit both Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried
by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set
Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of the Ethernet port that is connected to the
external equipment, set Working Mode to be the same
value as the external equipment (generally, the working
mode of the external equipment is auto-negotiation). In the
case of the Ethernet ports within the network, set Working
Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet
Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the


external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected.
Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation
flow control function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow
Control Mode to Enable Symmetric Flow Control.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

207

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.6.3
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l If all the accessed services carry VLAN tags (tagged
frames), set TAG to Tag Aware.
l If none of the accessed services carries VLAN tags
(untagged frames), set TAG to Access, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
NOTE
If Port Mode is set to Hybrid, Default VLAN ID of the port
must be different from the VLAN ID used by the VLAN subinterface.

l When the accessed services contain tagged frames and


untagged frames, set TAG to Hybrid, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.

Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.

A.6.7.2
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

Set Port Mode to Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type to


802.1Q in the case of ports that transmit only Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags.
In the case of ports that transmit both Native Ethernet services
carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried by MPLS
tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set Encapsulation
Type to 802.1Q.

l If all the accessed services carry VLAN tags (tagged


frames), set Tag to Tag Aware.
l If none of the accessed services carries VLAN tags
(untagged frames), set Tag to Access, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
l When the accessed services contain tagged frames and
untagged frames, set Tag to Hybrid, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

208

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that
permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

209

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-21 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

210

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring VLAN-Based E-Line Services


Table 8-22 Procedures for configuring VLAN-based E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.2.5.1
Creating
Optical Fibers
by Using the
Search Method

Perform this task to create radio links if they have not been created on
Main Topology of the U2000.

A.2.5.2
Creating
Fibers
Manually

Required when Ethernet services are transmitted over FE/GE links.


Set the parameters as follows:
l If FE/GE ports are connected through optical fibers, set Fiber/Cable
to Fiber. If FE/GE ports are connected through electrical cables, set
Fiber/Cable to Cable.
l Set Automatically Allocate Address to No.

A.13.1.2
Creating ELine Services
Transmitted in
Native
Ethernet Mode

Required.

A.7.3.7
Creating a
VLAN
Forwarding
Table for an ELine Service

Required if VLAN ID swapping is required at the source and sink of the


E-Line service.

Set related parameters according to the service planning information and


parameter planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.


NOTE
Configure the VLAN forwarding table items separately for the source port and the
sink port.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-23 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.


Set the related parameters according to the network plan.
You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

211

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-24 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

212

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance


Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.4 Configuration Procedure (VLAN-Based E-Line Services)


This section describes the procedures for configuring the service information, port information,
protection information, and QoS information of an VLAN-based E-Line service and the
procedure for verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-22 provides the procedures for configuring VLAN-based E-Line services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

213

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-22 Configuration flowchart (VLAN-based E-Line services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet ports

Configuring IF_ETH ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring E-Line services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet service


configurations

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

214

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-25 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. In
the case of unused ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type
to 802.1Q in the case of ports that transmit only Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags.
l In the case of ports that transmit both Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried
by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set
Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of the Ethernet port that is connected to the
external equipment, set Working Mode to be the same
value as the external equipment (generally, the working
mode of the external equipment is auto-negotiation). In the
case of the Ethernet ports within the network, set Working
Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet
Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the


external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected.
Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation
flow control function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow
Control Mode to Enable Symmetric Flow Control.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

215

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.6.3
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l If all the accessed services carry VLAN tags (tagged
frames), set TAG to Tag Aware.
l If none of the accessed services carries VLAN tags
(untagged frames), set TAG to Access, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
NOTE
If Port Mode is set to Hybrid, Default VLAN ID of the port
must be different from the VLAN ID used by the VLAN subinterface.

l When the accessed services contain tagged frames and


untagged frames, set TAG to Hybrid, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.

Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.

A.6.7.2
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

Set Port Mode to Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type to


802.1Q in the case of ports that transmit only Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags.
In the case of ports that transmit both Native Ethernet services
carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried by MPLS
tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set Encapsulation
Type to 802.1Q.

l If all the accessed services carry VLAN tags (tagged


frames), set Tag to Tag Aware.
l If none of the accessed services carries VLAN tags
(untagged frames), set Tag to Access, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
l When the accessed services contain tagged frames and
untagged frames, set Tag to Hybrid, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

216

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that
permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

217

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-26 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

218

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring VLAN-Based E-Line Services


Table 8-27 Procedures for configuring VLAN-based E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.2
Configuring
UNI-UNI ELine Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Direction to UNI-UNI.
l Set Source Port and Sink Port according to the network planning
information.
l Set Source VLANs and Sink VLANs according to the network
planning information. The two parameters should be set to the same
value.

A.7.3.7
Creating a
VLAN
Forwarding
Table for an ELine Service

Required when the VLAN tags of the Ethernet service need to be switched
at the source and sink.
The parameters need to be set according to the network planning
information.
NOTE
The corresponding VLAN forwarding table items need to be configured for the
source port and sink port.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-28 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

219

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-29 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

220

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.5 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (QinQ-Based E-Line


Services)
Configuring QinQ-based E-Line services in an end-to-end mode includes configuring the service
information, port information, protection information, and QoS information, and verifying the
service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-23 shows the procedures for configuring QinQ-based E-Line services in an end-to-end
mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

221

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-23 Configuration flowchart (QinQ-based E-Line services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet
ports

Configuring IF_ETH
ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring E-Line
services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet
service configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

222

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-30 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

Setting the
parameters of
Ethernet ports

A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to
Enabled. In the case of unused ports, set Enable
Port to Disabled.
l If a UNI can access untagged frames, set Port
Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to
Null. If a UNI can access tagged frames only, set Port
Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to
802.1Q.
l In the case of UNI ports that transmit both Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3
services carried by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to
Layer Mix, and set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of UNI ports that transmit both Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3
services carried by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to
Hybrid, and set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of an NNI, set Port Mode to Layer 2 and
set Encapsulation Type to QinQ.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the
jumbo frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you
set Max Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on


the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is
connected. Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the autonegotiation flow control function, set AutoNegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.

A.6.6.3 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required.
In the case of an NNI that is connected to the external
equipment, set QinQ Type Domain according to the TPID of the S-VLAN that is supported by the external
equipment. In the case of NNIs within the network, QinQ
Type Domain takes the default value.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

223

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

Setting the
parameters of
IF_ETH ports

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required.

A.6.7.2 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation


Type to QinQ.

In the case of an NNI that is connected to the external


equipment, set QinQ Type Domain according to the TPID of the S-VLAN that is supported by the external
equipment. In the case of NNIs within the network, QinQ
Type Domain takes the default value.
Optional.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot
be set to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission
at L3 consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

224

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-31 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

225

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring QinQ-Based E-Line Services


Table 8-32 Procedures for configuring QinQ-based E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.2.5.1
Creating
Optical Fibers
by Using the
Search Method

Perform this task to create radio links if they have not been created on
Main Topology of the U2000.

A.2.5.2
Creating
Fibers
Manually

Required when Ethernet services are transmitted over FE/GE links.


Set the parameters as follows:
l If FE/GE ports are connected through optical fibers, set Fiber/Cable
to Fiber. If FE/GE ports are connected through electrical cables, set
Fiber/Cable to Cable.
l Set Automatically Allocate IP Address to No.

A.13.1.2
Creating ELine Services
Transmitted in
Native
Ethernet Mode

Required.
Set related parameters according to the service planning information and
parameter planning information.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-33 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

226

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-34 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

227

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.6 Configuration Procedure (QinQ-Based E-Line Services)


This section describes the procedures for configuring the service information, port information,
protection information, and QoS information of a QinQ-based E-Line service and the procedure
for verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-24 provides the procedures for configuring QinQ-based E-Line services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

228

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-24 Configuration flowchart (QinQ-based E-Line services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet
ports

Configuring IF_ETH
ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring E-Line
services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet
service configurations

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

229

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-35 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

Setting the
parameters of
Ethernet ports

A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to
Enabled. In the case of unused ports, set Enable
Port to Disabled.
l If a UNI can access untagged frames, set Port
Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to
Null. If a UNI can access tagged frames only, set Port
Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to
802.1Q.
l In the case of UNI ports that transmit both Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3
services carried by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to
Layer Mix, and set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of UNI ports that transmit both Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3
services carried by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to
Hybrid, and set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of an NNI, set Port Mode to Layer 2 and
set Encapsulation Type to QinQ.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the
jumbo frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you
set Max Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on


the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is
connected. Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the autonegotiation flow control function, set AutoNegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.

A.6.6.3 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required.
In the case of an NNI that is connected to the external
equipment, set QinQ Type Domain according to the TPID of the S-VLAN that is supported by the external
equipment. In the case of NNIs within the network, QinQ
Type Domain takes the default value.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

230

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

Setting the
parameters of
IF_ETH ports

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required.

A.6.7.2 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation


Type to QinQ.

In the case of an NNI that is connected to the external


equipment, set QinQ Type Domain according to the TPID of the S-VLAN that is supported by the external
equipment. In the case of NNIs within the network, QinQ
Type Domain takes the default value.
Optional.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot
be set to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission
at L3 consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

231

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-36 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

232

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring QinQ-Based E-Line Services


Table 8-37 Procedures for configuring QinQ-based E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.1
Configuring
the QinQ Link

Required.

A.7.3.4
Configuring
UNI-NNI ELine Services
(Carried by
QinQ Links)

Required.

Set the parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning information.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-38 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

233

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-39 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

234

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.7 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN


Services)
This section describes the procedures for configuring the service information, port information,
protection information, and QoS information of an IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN service
and the procedure for verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 8-25 provides the procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1d-bridge-based E-LAN
services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

235

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-25 Configuration flow chart (IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet ports

Configuring IF_ETH ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring ERPS protection

Configuring E-LAN services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet service


configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

236

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-40 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l For used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. For unused
ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type
to Null.
l In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the
external equipment (generally, the working mode of the
external equipment is auto-negotiation). In the case of an
Ethernet port within the network, set Working Mode to
Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports
Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

Required when you need to enable the port self-loop test and
automatic loopback shutdown functions or to enable the
broadcast packet suppression function.
Set Loopback Check, Loopback Port Block, Broadcast
Packet Suppression, and Broadcast Packet Suppression
Threshold according to the actual requirements.

A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.

A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.

Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to


Null.

When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that


permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

237

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-41 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

238

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring ERPS Protection


Table 8-42 Procedures for configuring ERPS protection
Operation

Description

A.7.1.1
Creating
Ethernet Ring
Protection
Instances

Required when an Ethernet ring needs to be protected and service loops


need to be avoided on the Ethernet ring.

A.7.1.2 Setting
the Parameters
of Ethernet
Ring Protocol

Required if the values of the default parameters of the ERPS timers need
to be changed.
Set Hold-Off Time(ms), Guard Time(ms), WTR Time(mm:ss), and
Packet Transmit Interval(s) according to the actual requirements. Set
these parameters to the same values for all the NEs on the network.

Procedures for Configuring IEEE 802.1d-Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


Table 8-43 Procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1d-bridge-based E-LAN services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.9 Configuring IEEE


802.1d Bridge-Based ELAN Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Tag Type to Tag-Transparent.
l Set Self-Learning MAC Address to Enabled according
to the planning information.
l In the UNI tab page, set Port according to the planning
information and set VLANs/CVLAN to Null.
l To disable the packet forwarding between certain E-LAN
service ports, add the ports to Split Horizon Group
Member.

Managing
the MAC
address table

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.7.4.2
Creating a
Blacklist
Entry of
MAC
Addresses

Required when usage of E-LAN services needs to be disabled


on certain MAC address host.

A.7.4.1
Creating a
Static MAC
Address
Entry

Required if you need to set certain MAC address entries not


to age.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

239

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.7.4.3
Configuring
the Aging
Parameters
of a MAC
Address
Table

A.7.5 Setting the Mode for


Processing an Unknown
Frame of the E-LAN
Service

Required if the aging function needs to be disabled or if the


default aging time (five minutes) needs to be changed.
Set the parameters according to the network planning
information.

Optional.

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-44 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

240

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.
Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-45 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

241

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.8 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN


Services)
This section describes the procedures for configuring the service information, port information,
protection information, and QoS information of an IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN service
and the procedure for verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-26 provides the procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

242

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-26 Configuration flowchart (IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configure Ethernet ports.

Configure IF_ETH ports.

Configure LAGs.

Configure ERPS protection.

Configure E-LAN services

Configure QoS

Verify Ethernet service


configurations.

End

The detailed information about the procedures in the flow chart is provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

243

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-46 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. In
the case of unused ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type
to 802.1Q in the case of ports that transmit only Native
Ethernet services carrying VLAN tags.
l In the case of ports that transmit both Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried
by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set
Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of the Ethernet port that is connected to the
external equipment, set Working Mode to be the same
value as the external equipment (generally, the working
mode of the external equipment is auto-negotiation). In the
case of the Ethernet ports within the network, set Working
Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.3
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l If all the accessed services carry VLAN tags (tagged
frames), set TAG to Tag Aware.
l If none of the accessed services carries VLAN tags
(untagged frames), set TAG to Access, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
NOTE
If Port Mode is set to Hybrid, Default VLAN ID of the port
must be different from the VLAN ID used by the VLAN subinterface.

l When the accessed services contain tagged frames and


untagged frames, set TAG to Hybrid, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required when you need to enable the port self-loop test and
automatic loopback shutdown functions or to enable the
broadcast packet suppression function.
Set Loopback Check, Loopback Port Block, Broadcast
Packet Suppression, and Broadcast Packet Suppression
Threshold according to the requirements.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

244

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation
Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description
A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.

A.6.7.2
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

Set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set Encapsulation Type to


802.1Q.
In the case of ports that transmit both Native Ethernet services
carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried by MPLS
tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set Encapsulation
Type to 802.1Q.

l If all the accessed services carry VLAN tags (tagged


frames), set Tag to Tag Aware.
l If none of the accessed services carries VLAN tags
(untagged frames), set Tag to Access, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
NOTE
If Port Mode is set to Hybrid, Default VLAN ID of the port
must be different from the VLAN ID used by the VLAN subinterface.

l When the accessed services contain tagged frames and


untagged frames, set Tag to Hybrid, and set Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the network
planning information.
A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that
permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

245

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring ERPS Protection


Table 8-47 Procedures for configuring ERPS protection

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.1.1
Creating
Ethernet Ring
Protection
Instances

Required when an Ethernet ring needs to be protected and service loops


need to be avoided on the Ethernet ring.

A.7.1.2 Setting
the Parameters
of Ethernet
Ring Protocol

Required if the values of the default parameters of the ERPS timers need
to be changed.
Set Hold-Off Time(ms), Guard Time(ms), WTR Time(mm:ss), and
Packet Transmit Interval(s) according to the actual requirements. Set
these parameters to the same values for all the NEs on the network.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

246

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-48 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

247

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


Table 8-49 Procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.10 Configuring IEEE


802.1q Bridge-Based ELAN Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Tag Type to C-Awared.
l Set Self-Learning MAC Address to Enabled according
to the planning information.
l In the UNI tab page, set the parameters according to the
planning information.
l To disable the packet forwarding between certain E-LAN
service ports, add the ports to Split Horizon Group
Member.

Managing
the MAC
address table

A.7.4.2
Creating a
Blacklist
Entry of
MAC
Addresses

Required when usage of E-LAN services needs to be disabled


on certain MAC address host.

A.7.4.1
Creating a
Static MAC
Address
Entry

Required if you need to set certain MAC address entries not


to age.

A.7.4.3
Configuring
the Aging
Parameters
of a MAC
Address
Table

Required if the aging function needs to be disabled or if the


default aging time (five minutes) needs to be changed.

A.7.5 Setting the Mode for


Processing an Unknown
Frame of the E-LAN
Service

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

248

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-50 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

249

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-51 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance


Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance


Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

250

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.2.9 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN


Services)
This section describes the procedures for configuring the service information, port information,
protection information, and QoS information of an IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN service
and the procedure for verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 8-27 provides the procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN
services.
Figure 8-27 Configuration flowchart (IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet ports

Configuring IF_ETH ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring ERPS protection

Configuring E-LAN services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet service


configurations

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

251

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The detailed information about the procedures in the flow chart is provided as follows.

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 8-52 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation
Setting the
parameters
of Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l In the case of used ports, set Enable Port to Enabled. In
the case of unused ports, set Enable Port to Disabled.
l If a UNI can access untagged frames, set Port Mode to
Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type to Null. If a UNI
can access tagged frames only, set Encapsulation Type
to 802.1Q.
l In the case of UNI ports that transmit both Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried
by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix, and set
Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of an NNI, set Port Mode to Layer 2, and set
Encapsulation Type to QinQ.
l In the case of the Ethernet port that is connected to the
external equipment, set Working Mode to be the same
value as the external equipment (generally, the working
mode of the external equipment is auto-negotiation). In the
case of the Ethernet ports within the network, set Working
Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame
Length(byte) according to the actual length of the jumbo
frames. Otherwise, it is recommended that you set Max
Frame Length(byte) to 1536.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.6.3
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

A.6.6.5
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of Ethernet
Ports

Required when you need to enable the port self-loop test and
automatic loopback shutdown functions or to enable the
broadcast packet suppression function.

l In the case of a UNI, if Encapsulation Type is set to


802.1Q, set TAG to Tag Aware (default value).
l In the case of an NNI that is connected to the external
equipment, set QinQ Type Domain according to the TPID of the SVLAN that is supported by the external
equipment. In the case of an NNI within the network,
QinQ Type Domain takes the default value.

Set Loopback Check, Loopback Port Block, Broadcast


Packet Suppression, and Broadcast Packet Suppression
Threshold according to the requirements.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

252

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Description

Setting the
parameters
of IF_ETH
ports

A.6.7.1
Setting the
General
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required.
l If a UNI can access untagged frames, set Port Mode to
Layer 2, and set Encapsulation Type to Null. If a UNI
can access tagged frames only, set Port Mode to Layer
2 and set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of UNI ports that transmit both Native Ethernet
services carrying VLAN tags and PWE3 services carried
by MPLS tunnels, set Port Mode to Layer Mix and set
Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l In the case of an NNI, set Port Mode to Layer 2 and set
Encapsulation Type to QinQ.

A.6.7.2
Setting the
Layer 2
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

A.6.7.4
Setting the
Advanced
Attributes
of IF_ETH
Ports

Optional.

l In the case of a UNI, if Encapsulation Type is set to


802.1Q, set Tag to Tag Aware (default value).
l In the case of an NNI that is connected to the external
equipment, set QinQ Type Domain according to the TPID of the SVLAN that is supported by the external
equipment. In the case of an NNI within the network,
QinQ Type Domain takes the default value.

When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that


permits bit errors, such as a voice service or a video service,
you can set Error Frame Discard Enabled to Disabled.
NOTE
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set Speed
Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled, if the corresponding permission to enable the two
functions is already obtained.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to Enabled,
Encapsulation Type of the ISU2 and ISX2 boards cannot be set
to Null.
l Set Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed Transmission at L3
consistently for both ends of a radio link.

Procedures for Configuring ERPS Protection


Table 8-53 Procedures for configuring ERPS protection

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.1.1
Creating
Ethernet Ring
Protection
Instances

Required when an Ethernet ring needs to be protected and service loops


need to be avoided on the Ethernet ring.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

253

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Operation

Description

A.7.1.2 Setting
the Parameters
of Ethernet
Ring Protocol

Required if the values of the default parameters of the ERPS timers need
to be changed.
Set Hold-Off Time(ms), Guard Time(ms), WTR Time(mm:ss), and
Packet Transmit Interval(s) according to the actual requirements. Set
these parameters to the same values for all the NEs on the network.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

254

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 8-54 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

255

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


Table 8-55 Procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.11 Configuring IEEE


802.1ad Bridge-Based ELAN Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Tag Type to S-Awared.
l Set Self-Learning MAC Address to Enabled according
to the planning information.
l In the UNI and NNI tab pages, set the parameters
according to the planning information.
l To disable the packet forwarding between certain E-LAN
service ports, add the ports to Split Horizon Group
Member.

Managing
the MAC
address table

A.7.4.2
Creating a
Blacklist
Entry of
MAC
Addresses

Required when usage of E-LAN services needs to be disabled


on certain MAC address host.

A.7.4.1
Creating a
Static MAC
Address
Entry

Required if you need to set certain MAC address entries not


to age.

A.7.4.3
Configuring
the Aging
Parameters
of a MAC
Address
Table

Required if the aging function needs to be disabled or if the


default aging time (five minutes) needs to be changed.

A.7.5 Setting the Mode for


Processing an Unknown
Frame of the E-LAN
Service

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

256

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Configuring QoS


Table 8-56 Procedures for configuring QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required if the default mappings for the DS domain are inapplicable.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required if the trusted packet type of the port is different from the default
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) applied to the DS domain.

A.7.7.1
Creating a DS
Domain

Required if you need to create more than one DS domain.

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required if you need to apply QoS policies other than DS and port shaping
for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required if you need to perform the ACL, CoS, CAR or shaping operation
for a specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required if a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.


You can learn the default mappings for the DS domain by referring to A.
7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Set the related parameters according to the network plan.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

257

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 8-57 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance


Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance


Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

258

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

Description

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

8.3 Configuration Example (Point-to-Point Transparently


Transmitted E-Line Services)
This section considers a point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line service as an example
to describe how to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.

8.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
As shown in Figure 8-28, NE1 is a terminal station of a backhaul network. The service
requirements are as follows:
l

NE1 transparently transmits the Ethernet services from the BTS to NE2 in point-to-point
manner.

DSCP flags are used to identify the priorities of the Ethernet services from the BTS.

To meet the preceding requirements, point-to-point transparently transmitted E-line services are
configured; in addition, corresponding QoS processing is configured.
Figure 8-28 Networking diagram (point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services)
Tranparent transmitted
E-Line service

Backhaul network

NE1
BTS

NE2

BSC

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-28 are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

259

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-58 Connections of Ethernet links (NE1)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE1 and the BTS

1-EM6T-3

Configure this port to access


services from the BTS.

Between NE1 and NE2

3-IFU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul services
from a BTS.
The Hybrid radio link
between NE1 and NE2
adopts the 1+0 nonprotection configuration. In
addition, the AM function is
enabled for the Hybrid radio
link.

8.3.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before configuring an Ethernet
service.

8.3.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Ethernet Port
Table 8-59 provides the information about the Ethernet port involved in the service.
Table 8-59 Ethernet port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Maximum Frame Length (byte)

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

260

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

l In this example, the GE port on the BTS works in the auto-negotiation mode. Hence, the GE port that accesses
the BTS must work in the auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet port works in another mode, the local
Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of the Ethernet ports inside the network are
planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
Normally, if the equipment is interconnected with BTSs, the maximum frame length can also assume its
default value of 1522.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only when the NE or the peer equipment is inadequate for
QoS processing. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-60 provides the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry services.
Table 8-60 Ethernet port
Parameter

3-IFU2-1

Encapsulation Type

Null

Error Frame Discard Enabled

Enabled

NOTE

The majority of the backhaul services on the BTS are Internet services. Hence, the error frame discarding function
needs to be enabled.

8.3.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet protection.
In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.3.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.
Table 8-61 provides the detailed service planning information.
Table 8-61 Point-to-point transparently transmitted E-line service

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE1

Service ID

Service Name

BTStoNE2_Tline

Direction

UNI-UNI
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

261

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

NE1

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

1-EM6T-3

Source C-VLANs

Blank

Sink Port

3-IFU2-1

Sink C-VLANs

Blank

8.3.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring QoS.

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated according to the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding DSCP values according to
the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the DSCP value, as
shown in Table 8-62. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS configuration.
Table 8-62 Service class and PHB service class

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service Class

DSCP

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

56

CS6

48

EF

40

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

32

AF3

24

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

16

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

262

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PHB Service Class

DSCP

Corresponding Service
Type

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The required trusted packet type is not the C-VLAN priority but DSCP value. Therefore, the trusted packet
type needs to be modified for service-associated Ethernet ports applied in the default DS domain.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 8-63 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 8-63 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

263

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.3.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


Only per-NE configuration is applicable to this configuration example. That is, end-to-end
configuration is inapplicable to this configuration example.

8.3.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for setting parameters of MPLS tunnels on a per NE basis.

8.3.4.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the Ethernet port.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the general attributes of
the IF_ETH port.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-IFU2-1

Encapsulation Type

Null

----End

8.3.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

264

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.3.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services and configure the E-Line services.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

BTStoNE2_Tline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

1-EM6T-3

Source VLANs

Blank

Sink Port

3-IFU2-1

Sink VLANs

Blank

----End

8.3.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

265

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE
AF11
AF21
AF31
AF41
EF
CS6
CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11
AF21
AF31
AF41
EF
CS6
CS7

NOTE

l The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is
valid. In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

ip-dscp

3-IFU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

266

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

The required trusted packet type is not the C-VLAN priority but DSCP value. Therefore, the trusted packet type
needs to be modified for service-associated Ethernet ports applied in the default DS domain.

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm

Port

3-IFU2-1

----End

8.3.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

267

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create an MD.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

Maintenance Domain Name

InterNE

Maintenance Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create an MA.


The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

Maintenance Domain Name

InterNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS_Tline

Relevant Service

1-BTStoNE2_Tline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create MEP points.


The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Maintenance Domain
Name

InterNE

InterNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS_Tline

BTS_Tline

Board

1-EM6T

3-IFU2

Port

1-EM6T-3

3-IFU2-1

VLAN

MP ID

101

102

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Active

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

268

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Step 4 A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA.


Parameter

Value
NE1

Maintenance Domain Name

InterNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS_Tline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

102

Step 5 See perform an LB test to test the Ethernet service configurations and test the E-Line service.
Use MEP ID 101 as the source maintenance point and MEP ID 102 as the sink maintenance
point to perform the LB test.
No packet loss occurs.
----End

8.4 Configuration Example (VLAN-Based E-Line Service)


This section considers a VLAN-based E-line service as an example to describe how to configure
the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.

8.4.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network),
configure Ethernet services according to the following requirements:
l

BTS11, BTS12, and BTS15 provide FE ports whose port rate is 100 Mbit/s.

Services transmitted by each BTS carry VLAN IDs, and VLAN IDs on the entire network
are planned in a unified manner.

VLAN priorities are configured on each BTS according to service types.

To meet the preceding requirements, VLAN-based E-Line services are configured for service
transmission on each NE; in addition, corresponding QoS processing is configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

269

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-29 Networking diagram (VLAN-based E-Line services)


BTS12
VLAN 110
FE
R4
GE
NE14

Packet network
FE
NE13

NE12

NE11
R4

FE

NE15

NE16

BTS11
VLAN 100

R4
BTS15
VLAN 120

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-29 are described as follows.
Table 8-64 Connections of Ethernet links (NE12)
Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE12 and


NE13

1-EM6T-1

Configure these ports


to transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE12 and


NE11

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

1-EM6T-3

Between NE12 and


BTS11

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS11.

Table 8-65 Connections of Ethernet links (NE13)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE13 and


NE14

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

270

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Link

Between NE13 and


NE15

Between NE13 and


NE12

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Port

Port Description

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

1-EM6T-1

Description

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Table 8-66 Connections of Ethernet links (NE14)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE14 and


NE13

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

4-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

7-EM4T-1

Between NE14 and


BTS12

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS12.

Table 8-67 Connections of Ethernet links (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE15 and


NE16

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Between NE15 and


NE13

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

271

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-68 Connections of Ethernet links (NE16)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE16 and


NE15

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE16 and


BTS15

7-EM4T-1

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS15.

8.4.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before configuring an Ethernet
service.

8.4.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 8-69 to Table 8-72 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-69 Information about Ethernet ports (NE12)
Parameter

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Table 8-70 Information about Ethernet ports (NE13)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

272

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

1-EM6T-1

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Table 8-71 Information about Ethernet ports (NE14)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Table 8-72 Information about Ethernet ports (NE16)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

NOTE

l In this example, the FE ports on all the BTSs work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE/GE port of
each NE that accesses services must work in auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet port works in
another mode, the local Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of the Ethernet ports
inside the network are planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
Normally, if the equipment is interconnected with BTSs, the maximum frame length can also assume its
default value of 1522.
l Normally, the flow control function is enabled only when the NE or the peer equipment is inadequate for
QoS processing. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l In this example, all the services carry VLAN IDs. Therefore, the tag attributes of all the ports are tag aware.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

273

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-73 to Table 8-77 provide the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the Ethernet
services.
Table 8-73 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE12)
Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-74 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE13)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation
type

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame
discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-75 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE14)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-76 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

274

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-77 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE16)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

NOTE

The majority of the BTS backhaul services are the Internet services. Hence, the error frame discarding function
needs to be enabled.

8.4.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet protection.
In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.4.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.
Figure 8-30 shows the planning information of the VLAN-based E-Line services.
Figure 8-30 Information about VLAN-based E-Line services (in an end-to-end mode)
Links-1: NE11 - NE12 - NE13 -NE15-NE16
NE11
3-ISU2-1
RNC-BTS11
RNC-BTS15
RNC-BTS12

NE12

NE13

3-ISU2-1 1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1 4-ISU2-1

NE15

NE16

4-ISU2-1 3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

C:100
1-EM6T-1(C:100)

1-EM6T-3(C:100)
C:120

C:120
1-EM6T-1(C:120)
C:110

C:120

C:120
1-EM6T-3(C:120)

C:110

1-EM6T-1(C:110)
Links-2: NE13-NE14
NE13

NE14

1-EM6T-1 3-ISU2-1
RNC-BTS12

C:110

3-ISU2-1
C:110
1-EM6T-3(C:110)

S: S-VLAN
C: C-VLAN
Pass through
Add/Drop
Foward

Table 8-78 to Table 8-82 provide the planning information of the VLAN-based E-Line services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

275

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-78 Information about VLAN-based E-Line services (NE12)


Parameter

NE12
NE13 to NE11

BTS11 to NE11

Service ID

Service name

NE13toNE11_Vline

BTS11toNE11_Vline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

1-EM6F-1

1-EM6T-3

Source C-VLANs

110,120

100

Sink port

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

Sink C-VLANs

110, 120

100

Table 8-79 Information about VLAN-based E-Line services (NE13)


Parameter

NE13
NE14 to NE12

NE15 to NE12

Service ID

Service name

NE14toNE12_Vline

NE15toNE12_Vline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Source C-VLANs

110

120

Sink port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

Sink C-VLANs

110

120

Table 8-80 Information about VLAN-based E-Line services (NE14)


Parameter

NE4
BTS12 to NE13

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service ID

Service name

BTS12toNE13_Vline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

276

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NE4
BTS12 to NE13

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

7-EM4T-1

Source C-VLANs

110

Sink port

3-ISU2-1

Sink C-VLANs

110

Table 8-81 Information about VLAN-based E-Line services (NE15)


Parameter

NE15
NE16 to NE13

Service ID

Service name

NE16toNE13_Vline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

3-ISU2-1

Source C-VLANs

120

Sink port

4-ISU2-1

Sink C-VLANs

120

Table 8-82 Information about VLAN-based E-Line services (NE16)


Parameter

NE16
BTS15 to NE15

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service ID

Service name

BTS15toNE15_Vline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

7-EM4T-1

Source C-VLANs

120

Sink port

3-ISU2-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

277

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

NE16
BTS15 to NE15

Sink C-VLANs

120

8.4.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring QoS.

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding VLAN priorities according
to the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the VLAN priority,
as provided in Table 8-83. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.
Table 8-83 Service class and PHB service class

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

CS6

EF

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

AF3

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

278

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The default trusted packet type for each port that is applied for the default DS domain is C-VLAN priority
and therefore does not need to be modified.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 8-84 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 8-84 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.4.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration in an end-to-end mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

279

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.4.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

280

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

TAG

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

281

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Step 4 See A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

282

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Tag

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Tag

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Tag

Tag Aware

----End

8.4.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.4.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.5.2 Creating Fibers Manually and create optical fibers manually.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

283

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.


Parameter

Value
GE Optical Fiber between NE13 and
NE12

Fiber/Cable Type

Fiber

Source NE

NE13

Source NE Subrack-Slot-Board Type-Port

1-EM6F-1

Sink NE

NE12

Sink NE Subrack-Slot-Board Type-Port

1-EM6F-1

Automatically Allocate IP Address

No

Step 2 See A.13.1.2 Creating E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode and create ELine services transmitted in Native Ethernet mode.
1.

Choose Service > Native Ethernet Service > Create E-Line Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes of the E-Line service.

3.

Configure the source and sink of the E-Line service.

4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE11) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 1-EM6T-17-EM4T-3 and set C-VLAN to 100.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE12) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 1-EM6T-37-EM4T-3 and set C-VLAN to 100.

f.

Click OK.

g.

Select Deploy.

Click Calculate Route.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

284

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

5.

Click OK.

6.

Repeat Step 2.1 to Step 2.5 and configure the Ethernet services from the RNC to BTS12
and BTS15 according to the planned values in 8.4.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet
Services).

----End

8.4.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
NOTE

The actual mapping relationships for the default DS domain comply with the network planning information.
Therefore, you can skip this step.

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

285

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

NOTE

The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is valid.
In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
NOTE

The actual ports that are applied to the default DS domain and their trusted packet types comply with the network
planning information. Therefore, you can skip this step.

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-1

CVLAN

1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

7-EM4T-1
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

286

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

287

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-1
1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End

8.4.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

288

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and configure the MD for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE12

NE14

NE16

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create the maintenance association (MA) for NE12, NE14,
and NE16.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
l

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

Relevant
Service

1BTS11toNE11
_Vline

1NE13toNE11_
Vline

1NE13toNE11_
Vline

1NE13toNE11_
Vline

CC Test
Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

1s

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Vline

Relevant Service

1-BTS12toNE13_Vline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

289

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Vline

Relevant Service

1-BTS15toNE15_Vline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create the MEP for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

Board

1-EM6T

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

Port

1-EM6T-3

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

VLAN

100

100

110

120

MP ID

201

200

202

205

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active
Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Vline

Board

7-EM4T-1

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

110

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

290

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Vline

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

120

MP ID

601

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEP points for NE12,
NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

401

601

The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Vline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

202

The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

291

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Vline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

205

Step 5 See perform an LB test to test the Ethernet service configurations and test the E-Line services
on NE12.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 200 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 202 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 205 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packets lost during the LB tests.
----End

8.4.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for setting parameters of VLAN-based E-Line services on a
per NE basis.

8.4.4.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

292

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

TAG

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

293

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

294

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Step 4 See A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Tag

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

295

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Tag

Tag Aware

----End

8.4.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.4.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services and configure the E-Line services.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE13 to NE11

BTS11 to NE11

Service ID

Service Name

NE13toNE11_Vline

BTS11toNE11_Vline

Direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently
transmitted

Not transparently
transmitted

Source Port

1-EM6F-1

1-EM6T-3

Source VLANs

110, 120

100

Sink Port

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

110, 120

100

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

296

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE14 to NE12

NE15 to NE12

Service ID

Service Name

NE14toNE12_Vline

NE15toNE12_Vline

Direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently
transmitted

Not transparently
transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Source VLANs

110

120

Sink Port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

Sink VLANs

110

120

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS12 to NE13

Service ID

Service Name

BTS12toNE13_Vline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source Port

7-EM4T-1

Source VLANs

110

Sink Port

3-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

110

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE16 to NE13

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service ID

Service Name

NE16toNE13_Vline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

297

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
NE16 to NE13

Source VLANs

120

Sink Port

4-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

120

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS15 to NE15

Service ID

Service Name

BTS15toNE15_Vline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source Port

7-EM4T-1

Source VLANs

120

Sink Port

3-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

120

----End

8.4.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
NOTE

The actual mapping relationships for the default DS domain comply with the network planning information.
Therefore, you can skip this step.

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

298

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

NOTE

The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is valid.
In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
NOTE

The actual ports that are applied to the default DS domain and their trusted packet types comply with the network
planning information. Therefore, you can skip this step.

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

299

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-1

CVLAN

1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

7-EM4T-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

300

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-1
1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

301

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End

8.4.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and configure the MD for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE12

NE14

NE16

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create the maintenance association (MA) for NE12, NE14,
and NE16.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

302

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

Relevant
Service

1BTS11toNE11
_Vline

1NE13toNE11_
Vline

1NE13toNE11_
Vline

1NE13toNE11_
Vline

CC Test
Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

1s

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Vline

Relevant Service

1-BTS12toNE13_Vline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Vline

Relevant Service

1-BTS15toNE15_Vline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create the MEP for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

Board

1-EM6T

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

303

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Port

1-EM6T-3

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

VLAN

100

100

110

120

MP ID

201

200

202

205

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active
Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Vline

Board

7-EM4T-1

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

110

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Vline

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

120

MP ID

601

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

304

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEP points for NE12,
NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

401

601

The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Vline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

202

The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Vline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

205

Step 5 See perform an LB test to test the Ethernet service configurations and test the E-Line services
on NE12.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 200 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 202 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 205 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packets lost during the LB tests.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

305

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.5 Configuration Example (QinQ-Based E-Line Service)


This section considers a QinQ-based E-line service as an example to describe how to configure
the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.

8.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network),
configure Ethernet services according to the following requirements:
l

BTS11 to BTS15 provide FE ports whose port rate is 100 Mbit/s.

GE links to the RNC are configured with LAG protection.

The VLAN ID used by the services on a BTS is allocated by the RNC that controls the
BTS. Therefore, the VLAN IDs of services on BTSs that are controlled by different RNCs
may be the same. To solve this problem, an RNC allocates an S-VLAN ID for each BTS,
and the S-VLAN IDs on the entire network are planned in a unified manner.

VLAN priorities are configured on each BTS according to service types.

To meet the preceding requirements, QinQ-based E-Line services are configured for service
transmission on each NE; in addition, corresponding QoS processing is configured.
Figure 8-31 Networking diagram (QinQ-based E-Line services)
BTS12
SVLAN 201

FE
R4
RNC

GE

GE

NE14
FE
NE13

FE

NE12

NE15

NE16

NE11
R4
BTS11
SVLAN 200

R4
BTS15
SVLAN 202

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-31 are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

306

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-85 Connections of Ethernet links (NE11)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE11 and


the RNC

1-EM6T-1

Main port of a LAG

1-EM6T-2

Slave port of a LAG

Configure these ports


to transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE11 and


NE12

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure these ports


to transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Table 8-86 Connections of Ethernet links (NE12)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE12 and


NE13

1-EM6T-1

Configure these ports


to transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE12 and


NE11

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

1-EM6T-3

Between NE12 and


BTS11

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS11.

Table 8-87 Connections of Ethernet links (NE13)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE13 and


NE14

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

Between NE13 and


NE15

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.
307

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Link

Between NE13 and


NE12

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Port

Port Description

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

1-EM6T-1

Description

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Table 8-88 Connections of Ethernet links (NE14)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE14 and


NE13

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

4-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

7-EM4T-1

Between NE14 and


BTS12

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS12.

Table 8-89 Connections of Ethernet links (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE15 and


NE16

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Between NE15 and


NE13

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

308

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-90 Connections of Ethernet links (NE16)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE16 and


NE15

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE16 and


BTS15

7-EM4T-1

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS15.

8.5.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before configuring an Ethernet
service.

8.5.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 8-91 to Table 8-95 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-91 Information about Ethernet ports (NE11)
Parameter

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Table 8-92 Information about Ethernet ports (NE12)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

QinQ

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

309

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

Table 8-93 Information about Ethernet ports (NE13)


Parameter

1-EM6T-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

Table 8-94 Information about Ethernet ports (NE14)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Table 8-95 Information about Ethernet ports (NE16)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

310

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

l In this example, the FE ports on all the BTSs work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE/GE port of
each NE that accesses services must work in auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet port works in
another mode, the local Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of the Ethernet ports
inside the network are planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
l Normally, the flow control function is enabled only when the NE or the peer equipment is inadequate for
QoS processing. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l In this example, all the NNI ports are connected to Huawei equipment. Therefore, the QinQ type domain of
the NNI ports assumes the default value of 0x88a8.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-96 to Table 8-101 provide the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-96 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE11)
Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-97 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE12)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-98 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE13)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation
type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type
domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame
discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

311

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-99 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE14)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-100 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE15)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Table 8-101 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE16)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

Error frame discard

Enabled

NOTE

l All the IF_ETH ports are connected to Huawei equipment. Therefore, it is recommended that you set the
QinQ type domain to 0x88a8 for the IF_ETH ports.
l The majority of the BTS backhaul services are Internet services. Therefore, the error frame discarding
function needs to be enabled.

8.5.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet protection.
To improve the reliability of service transmission, NE11 and the RNC are interconnected through
the LAG formed by two GE links. Table 8-102 provides the planning information.
Table 8-102 LAG information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE11

LAG type

Static (default value)


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

312

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

NE11

Revertive mode

Non-revertive

Load sharing mode

Non-sharing (default value)

System priority

32768 (default value)

Main port

1-EM6T-1

Slave port

1-EM6T-2

NOTE

In this example, the bandwidth of the Ethernet services is much lower than the bandwidth of a GE port. Therefore,
you need not configure the LAG to the load-sharing mode for increasing the bandwidth.

8.5.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.
Figure 8-32 shows the planning information of the QinQ-based E-Line services.
Figure 8-32 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service
Links-1: NE11 - NE12 - NE13 -NE15-NE16
NE11
3-ISU2-1
RNC-BTS11
RNC-BTS15
RNC-BTS12

NE12

NE13

3-ISU2-1 1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1 4-ISU2-1

NE15

NE16

4-ISU2-1 3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

S:200
1-EM6T-1(S:200)

1-EM6T-3(null)

S:202

S:202

1-EM6T-1(S:202)
S:201

S:202

S:202
7-EM4T-1(null)

S:201

1-EM6T-1(S:201)
Links-2: NE13-NE14
NE13

NE14

1-EM6T-1 3-ISU2-1
RNC-BTS12

S:201

3-ISU2-1
S:201
7-EM4T-1(null)

S: S-VLAN
C: C-VLAN
Pass through
Add/Drop
Foward

Table 8-103 to Table 8-108 provide the planning information of the QinQ-based E-Line
services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

313

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-103 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service (NE11)


Parameter

NE11
BTS12 to the RNC

BTS11 to the RNC

BTS15 to the RNC

Service ID

Service name

BTS12toRNC_Qline

BTS11toRNC_Qline

BTS15toRNC2_Qli
ne

Service direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently
transmitted

Not transparently
transmitted

Not transparently
transmitted

Source port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

Source C-VLANs

QinQ link (source)

QinQ link (sink)

ID: 1

ID: 2

ID: 3

Port: 3-ISU2-1

Port: 3-ISU2-1

Port: 3-ISU2-1

S-VLAN: 201

S-VLAN: 200

S-VLAN: 202

Table 8-104 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service (NE12)


Parameter

NE12
BTS11 to NE11

BTS12 to NE11

BTS15 to NE11

Service ID

Service name

BTS11toNE11_Qlin
e

BTS12toNE11_Qlin
e

BTS15toNE11_Qlin
e

Service direction

UNI-NNI

NNI-NNI

NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently
transmitted

Not transparently
transmitted

Not transparently
transmitted

Source port

1-EM6T-3

Source C-VLANs

QinQ link (source)

ID: 2

ID: 4

Port: 1-EM6T-1

Port: 1-EM6T-1

S-VLAN: 201

S-VLAN: 202

ID: 1

ID: 3

ID: 5

Port: 3-ISU2-1

Port: 3-ISU2-1

Port: 3-ISU2-1

S-VLAN: 200

S-VLAN: 201

S-VLAN: 202

QinQ link (sink)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

314

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-105 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service (NE13)


Parameter

NE13
BTS12 to NE12

BTS15 to NE12

Service ID

Service name

BTS12toNE12_Qline

BTS15toNE12_Qline

Service direction

NNI-NNI

NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

Source C-VLANs

QinQ link (source)

ID: 1

ID: 3

Port: 1-EM6T-1

Port: 1-EM6T-1

S-VLAN: 201

S-VLAN: 202

ID: 2

ID: 4

Port: 3-ISU2-1

Port: 4-ISU2-1

S-VLAN: 201

S-VLAN: 202

QinQ link (sink)

Table 8-106 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service (NE14)


Parameter

NE14
BTS12 to NE13

Service ID

Service name

BTS12toNE13_Qline

Service direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

7-EM4T-1

Source C-VLANs

QinQ link (source)

QinQ link (sink)

ID: 1
Port: 3-ISU2-1
S-VLAN: 201

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

315

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-107 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service (NE15)


Parameter

NE15
BTS15 to NE13

Service ID

Service name

BTS15toNE13_Qline

Service direction

NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

Source C-VLANs

QinQ link (source)

ID: 1
Port: 3-ISU2-1
SVLAN: 202

QinQ link (sink)

ID: 2
Port: 4-ISU2-1
S-VLAN: 202

Table 8-108 Information about the QinQ-based E-Line service (NE16)


Parameter

NE16
BTS15 to NE15

Service ID

Service name

BTS15toNE15_Qline

Service direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

7-EM4T-1

Source C-VLANs

QinQ link (source)

QinQ link (sink)

ID: 1
Port: 3-ISU2-1
S-VLAN: 202

8.5.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring QoS.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

316

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding VLAN priorities according
to the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the VLAN priority,
as provided in Table 8-109. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.
Table 8-109 Service class and PHB service class
PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

CS6

EF

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

AF3

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The default trusted packet type for each port that is applied for the default DS domain is C-VLAN priority
and therefore needs to be modified as required.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

317

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-110 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 8-110 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.5.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration in an end-to-end mode.

8.5.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

318

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

QinQ

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

QinQ

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

319

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set Layer 2 attributes of
Ethernet ports
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

TAG

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

TAG

Value
1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tag Aware
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

320

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Encapsulation
Type

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Encapsulation
Type

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation Type
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

QinQ

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

321

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

----End

8.5.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes the procedures for configuring LAG.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create the LAG for NE11.
The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Automatically Assign

LAG Name

ToBSC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in Port Setting are as follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

1-EM6T

Main Port

1 (PORT-1)

Selected Standby Ports

1-EM6T-2

----End

8.5.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.2.5.2 Creating Fibers Manually and create fibers/cables manually.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

322

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
GE Optical Fiber between NE13 and
NE12

Fiber/Cable Type

Fiber

Source NE

NE13

Source NE Subrack-Slot-Board Type-Port

1-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

Sink NE

NE12

Sink NE Subrack-Slot-Board Type-Port

1-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

Automatically Allocate IP Address

No

Step 2 See A.13.1.2 Creating E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode and create ELine services transmitted in Native Ethernet mode.
NOTE

Step 2.1 to Step 2.5 describes how to configure the E-Line service from the RNC to BTS12.

1.

Choose Service > Native Ethernet Service > Create E-Line Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes of the E-Line service.

3.

Configure the source and sink of the E-Line service.


a.

Double-click the source NE (NE11) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 1-EM6T-1.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE14) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 7-EM4T-1.

f.

Click OK.

4.

Click Calculate Route.

5.

In Node List, configure Out S-VLAN for the source NE and In S-VLAN for the sink NE,
based on the service type listed in Table A-5.

6.

Repeat Step 2.1 to Step 2.5 to create the E-Line services from the RNC to BTS11 and to
BTS15 according to service planning information.

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

323

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.5.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

324

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

EF

CS6

CS7

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

NOTE

l The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is
valid. In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

1-EM6F-1

CVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

CVLAN

1-EM6T-1

SVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

1-EM6T-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

325

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE11 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE11 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHB service classes)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

326

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

327

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.5.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and configure the MD for NE11, NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE12

NE14

NE16

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and configure the MA for NE11, NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qline

BTS12_Qline

BTS15_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS11_Qline

2-BTS12_Qline

5-BTS15_Qline

CC Test Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS11_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS11_Qline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

328

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS12_Qline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS15_Qline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create the MEPs.


l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter
Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qline

BTS12_Qline

BTS15_Qline

Board

1-EM6T

1-EM6T

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

VLAN

100

110

140

MP ID

101

102

105

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS11_Qline

Board

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-3
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

329

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

VLAN

MP ID

201

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qline

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qline

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

MP ID

601

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs of the MA for
NE11, NE12, NE14, and NE16.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

330

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qline

BTS12_Qline

BTS15_Qline

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

401

601

The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS11_Qline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

101

The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

102

The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

105

Step 5 On NE1, perform LB tests to test the Ethernet service configurations.


l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

331

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 102 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 105 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packet lost during the LB tests.
----End

8.5.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for setting parameters of QinQ-based E-Line services on a
per NE basis.

8.5.4.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

QinQ

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

332

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

QinQ

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set Layer 2 attributes of
Ethernet ports
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

TAG

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

333

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

TAG

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Encapsulation Type

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Encapsulation Type

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

334

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Encapsulation
Type

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Encapsulation
Type

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation Type

QinQ

----End

8.5.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes the procedures for configuring LAG.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create the LAG for NE11.
The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Automatically Assign

LAG Name

ToBSC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

335

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in Port Setting are as follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

1-EM6T

Main Port

1 (PORT-1)

Selected Standby Ports

1-EM6T-2

----End

8.5.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.1 Configuring the QinQ Link and configure a QinQ link.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
QinQ Link ID

Board

Port

S-Vlan ID

3-ISU2

201

3-ISU2

200

3-ISU2

202

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
QinQ Link ID

Board

Port

S-Vlan ID

3-ISU2

200

1-EM6T

201

3-ISU2

201

1-EM6T

202

3-ISU2

202

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

336

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

QinQ Link ID

Board

Port

S-Vlan ID

1-EM6T

201

3-ISU2

201

1-EM6T

202

3-ISU2

202

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
QinQ Link ID

Board

Port

S-Vlan ID

3-ISU2

201

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
QinQ Link ID

Board

Port

S-Vlan ID

3-ISU2

202

4-ISU2

202

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
QinQ Link ID

Board

Port

S-Vlan ID

3-ISU2

202

Step 2 See A.7.3.4 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links) and configure
the E-Line services.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
BTS12 to the RNC

BTS11 to the RNC

BTS15 to the RNC

Service ID

Service Name

BTS12toRNC_Qlin
e

BTS11toRNC_Qlin
e

BTS15toRNC_Qlin
e

Direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Source Port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

1-EM6T-2

Source VLANs

QinQ Link ID

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

337

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS11 to NE11

BTS12 to NE11

BTS15 to NE11

Service ID

Service Name

BTS11toNE11_Qli
ne

BTS12toNE11_Qli
ne

BTS15toNE11_Qli
ne

Direction

UNI-NNI

NNI-NNI

NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Source Port

1-EM6T-3

Source VLANs

QinQ Link ID

QinQ Link ID 1

QinQ Link ID 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS12 to NE12

BTS15 to NE12

Service ID

Service Name

BTS12toNE12_Qline

BTS15toNE12_Qline

Direction

NNI-NNI

NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

QinQ Link ID 1

QinQ Link ID 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS12 to NE13

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service ID

Service Name

BTS12toNE13_Qline

Direction

UNI-NNI

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

338

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
BTS12 to NE13

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

7-EM4T-1

Source VLANs

QinQ Link ID

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS15 to NE13

Service ID

Service Name

BTS15toNE13_Qline

Direction

NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

QinQ Link ID 1

QinQ Link ID 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS15 to NE15

Service ID

Service Name

BTS15toNE15_Qline

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

7-EM4T-1

Source VLANs

QinQ Link ID

----End

8.5.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

339

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

340

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

l The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is
valid. In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

1-EM6F-1

CVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

CVLAN

1-EM6T-1

SVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

1-EM6T-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

341

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE11 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE11 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHB service classes)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

342

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End

8.5.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and configure the MD for NE11, NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

343

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE11

NE12

NE14

NE16

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and configure the MA for NE11, NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qline

BTS12_Qline

BTS15_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS11_Qline

2-BTS12_Qline

5-BTS15_Qline

CC Test Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS11_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS11_Qline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS12_Qline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

344

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qline

Relevant Service

1-BTS15_Qline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create the MEPs.


l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter
Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qline

BTS12_Qline

BTS15_Qline

Board

1-EM6T

1-EM6T

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

VLAN

100

110

140

MP ID

101

102

105

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS11_Qline

Board

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-3

VLAN

MP ID

201

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

345

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qline

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qline

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

MP ID

601

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs of the MA for
NE11, NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qline

BTS12_Qline

BTS15_Qline

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

346

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

401

601

The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS11_Qline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

101

The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

102

The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qline

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

105

Step 5 On NE1, perform LB tests to test the Ethernet service configurations.


l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 102 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 105 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packet lost during the LB tests.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

347

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.6 Configuration Example (802.1d-Bridge-Based E-LAN


Service)
This section considers an 802.1d-bridge-based E-LAN service as an example to describe how
to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.

8.6.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Ring Network),
configure Ethernet services according to the following requirements:
l

BTS21 to BTS23 provide FE ports whose port rate is 100 Mbit/s.

The Ethernet services on the ring network are protected.

The BTS services are transparently transmitted.

VLAN priorities are configured on each BTS according to service types.

The functions of detecting looped services and suppressing broadcast packets need to be
provided on the network.

To meet the preceding requirements, IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services are configured
to implement transmission of the BTS services; in addition, the functions of detecting looped
services and suppressing broadcast packets, ERPS protection, and QoS processing are
configured. See Figure 8-33.
Figure 8-33 Networking diagram (IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services)

Packet network
NE21

FE

FE

ERPS

R4

R4
BTS21

NE22
802.1d bridge

NE24

BTS24

802.1d bridge

FE
NE23
802.1d bridge

R4
BTS23

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-33 are described as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

348

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-111 Connections of Ethernet links (NE21)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE21 and


the PSN

1-EM6F-3

Configure this port to


drop the Native ELAN services from
the Hybrid radio ring
network.

Between NE21 and


NE22

4-ISU2-1

East port of an ERPS


ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE21 and


NE24

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Main IF board of a 1
+1 SD protection
group
5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 SD protection
group

Table 8-112 Connections of Ethernet links (NE22)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE22 and


NE23

4-ISU2-1

East port of an ERPS


ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE22 and


BTS21

1-EM6T-3

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS21.

Between NE22 and


NE21

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Table 8-113 Connections of Ethernet links (NE23)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE23 and


NE24

4-ISU2-1

l East port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

l RPL port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

349

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE23 and


BTS23

7-EM4T-1

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS23.

Between NE23 and


NE22

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Table 8-114 Connections of Ethernet links (NE24)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE24 and


NE21

4-ISU2-1

East port of an ERPS


ring node

Configure these ports


to transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Main IF board of a 1
+1 SD protection
group
6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 SD protection
group

Between NE24 and


BTS24

1-EM6T-3

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS24.

Between NE24 and


NE23

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

8.6.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before configuring an Ethernet
service.

8.6.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 8-118 and Table 8-115 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

350

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-115 Information about Ethernet ports (NE21)


Parameter

1-EM6F-3

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-116 Information about Ethernet ports (NE22)


Parameter

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-117 Information about Ethernet ports (NE23)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

351

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-118 Information about Ethernet ports (NE24)


Parameter

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

NOTE

l In this example, the FE ports on all the BTSs work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE/GE port of
each NE that accesses services must work in auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet port works in
another mode, the local Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of the Ethernet ports
inside the network are planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
Normally, if the equipment is interconnected with BTSs, the maximum frame length can also assume its
default value of 1522.
l In this example, no loopback port shutdown function is enabled.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-119 to Table 8-122 provide the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-119 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Null

Error frame discard


enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

352

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Enabling broadcast
packet suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

Table 8-120 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE22)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-121 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE23)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-122 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE24)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Null

Error frame discard


enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast
packet suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

353

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

NOTE

The majority of the BTS backhaul services are Internet services. Therefore, the errored frame discarding function
needs to be enabled.

8.6.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet protection.

Information About ERPS Instances


Table 8-123 provides the planning information about ERPS instances.
Table 8-123 Information about ERPS instances

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

ERPS ID

East port

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

West port

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

RPL owner ring


node flag

No

No

Yes

No

RPL port

4-ISU2-1

Control VLAN

4093

4093

4093

4093

Packet transmit
interval

5s (default
value)

5s (default
value)

5s (default
value)

5s (default
value)

Entity level

4 (default value)

4 (default value)

4 (default value)

4 (default value)

WTR time

5 minutes
(default value)

Guard time

500 ms (default
value)

500 ms (default
value)

500 ms (default
value)

500 ms (default
value)

Hold-off time

0s (default
value)

0s (default
value)

0s (default
value)

0s (default
value)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

354

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NOTE

l In this example, all the services are aggregated on NE21. Therefore, the NE that is farthest from NE21 needs
to function as the RPL owner. In this way, when the ring network is normal, the traffic carried on each link
is relatively even.
l The control VLAN needs to use a VLAN that is not used by any service. It is recommended that the control
VLAN use VLAN 4093.
l The packet transmit interval, entity level, WTR time, guard time, and hold-off time generally assume their
default values.

8.6.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.
Table 8-124 provides the planning information of IEEE 802.1a bridge-based E-LAN services.
Table 8-124 Information about IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services
Parameter

NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Service ID

Service name

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

TAG type

TagTransparent

TagTransparent

TagTransparent

TagTransparent

Self-learning
MAC address

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

MAC address
learning mode

SVL

SVL

SVL

SVL

Mounted UNI
port

1-EM6F-3
3-ISU2-1

1-EM6T-3

7-EM4T-1

1-EM6T-3

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

8.6.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring QoS.

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding VLAN priorities according
to the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the VLAN priority,
as provided in Table 8-125. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

355

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-125 Service class and PHB service class


PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

CS6

EF

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

AF3

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The default trusted packet type for each port that is applied for the default DS domain is C-VLAN priority
and therefore does not need to be modified.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 8-126 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 8-126 Queue scheduling mode

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

356

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.6.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

8.6.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6F-3

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

357

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
1-EM6F-3

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 and NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6F-3

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 and NE24 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

358

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
the IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

Null

Null

Null

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Null

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port Mode
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

359

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value

Encapsulation
Type

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Null

Null

Null

Step 4 See A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the advanced attributes
of the IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE22 and NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression
Threshold

30

30

30

----End

8.6.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet protection.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.1.1 Creating Ethernet Ring Protection Instances and create the ERPS instance.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

ERPS ID
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

360

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

East Port

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

West Port

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

RPL Owner
Ring Node Flag

No

No

Yes

No

RPL Port

4-ISU2-1

Control VLAN

4093

4093

4093

4093

----End

8.6.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.9 Configuring IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services and configure the ELAN services.
l Parameters of NE21
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Dlan

Tag Type

Tag-Transparent

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6F-3

Blank

3-ISU2-1

Blank

4-ISU2-1

Blank

l Parameters of NE22 and NE24


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

361

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Dlan

Tag Type

Tag-Transparent

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-3

Blank

3-ISU2-1

Blank

4-ISU2-1

Blank

l Parameters of NE23
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Dlan

Tag Type

Tag-Transparent

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

7-EM4T-1

Blank

3-ISU2-1

Blank

4-ISU2-1

Blank

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

362

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.6.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
NOTE

The actual mapping relationships for the default DS domain comply with the network planning information.
Therefore, you can skip this step.

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

2
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

363

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

PHB

CVLAN

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

NOTE

AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is valid at
a time. In this example, AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
NOTE

The actual ports that are applied to the default DS domain and their trusted packet types comply with the network
planning information. Therefore, you can skip this step.

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6F-3
3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

364

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHB service classes)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6F-3
3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

365

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 and NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

7-EM4T-1
3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

----End

8.6.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create the MA.


The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

366

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Relevant
Service

1-Dlan

1-Dlan

1-Dlan

1-Dlan

CC Test
Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create the MEPs.


The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Board

1-EM6F

1-EM6T

7-EM4T

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6F-3

1-EM6T-3

7-EM4T-1

1-EM6T-3

VLAN

MP ID

101

201

301

401

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active
Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEP points.
The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

367

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Dlan

Remote
Maintenance
Point ID(e.g:
1,3-6)

201

202

302

401

The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

Dlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

101

The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

Dlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

101

The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

Dlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

101

Step 5 Perform an LB test to verify Ethernet service configurations.


l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

368

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 202 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 301 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packet lost during the LB tests.
----End

8.7 Configuration Example (802.1q-Bridge-Based E-LAN


Service)
This section considers an 802.1q-bridge-based E-LAN service as an example to describe how
to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.

8.7.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network),
configure Ethernet services according to the following requirements:
l

BTS11, BTS12, and BTS15 provide FE ports whose port rate is 100 Mbit/s.

BTS11 and BTS12 belong to domain 1; BTS15 belongs to domain 2. The BTSs in a domain
have the same VLAN ID and the data from different domains is isolated from each other
by using the VLAN IDs.

VLAN priorities are configured on each BTS according to service types.

The functions of detecting looped services and suppressing broadcast packets need to be
provided on the network.

To meet the preceding requirements, IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services are configured
for service transmission on each NE; in addition, the functions of detecting looped services and
suppressing broadcast packets, and QoS processing are configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

369

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-34 Networking diagram (IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services)


BTS12
VLAN 100

BTS11
VLAN 100
Domain 1
VLAN 100

FE
R4

FE

NE14

R4

GE
Packet network
NE13

NE12

NE11

Domain 2
VLAN 110
FE

NE15

NE16
R4
BTS15
VLAN 110

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-34 are described as follows.
Table 8-127 Connections of Ethernet links (NE12)
Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE12 and


NE13

1-EM6T-1

Configure these ports


to transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE12 and


NE11

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

1-EM6T-3

Between NE12 and


BTS11

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS11.

370

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-128 Connections of Ethernet links (NE13)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE13 and


NE14

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

1-EM6T-1

Between NE13 and


NE15

Between NE13 and


NE12

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Table 8-129 Connections of Ethernet links (NE14)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE14 and


NE13

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

4-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

7-EM4T-1

Between NE14 and


BTS12

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS12.

Table 8-130 Connections of Ethernet links (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE15 and


NE16

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Between NE15 and


NE13

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

371

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Link

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Port

Port Description

Description

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Table 8-131 Connections of Ethernet links (NE16)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE16 and


NE15

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE16 and


BTS15

7-EM4T-1

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS15.

8.7.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

8.7.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 8-132 to Table 8-135 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-132 Information about Ethernet ports (NE12)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

372

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-133 Information about Ethernet ports (NE13)


Parameter

1-EM6T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-134 Information about Ethernet ports (NE14)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

373

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-135 Information about Ethernet ports (NE16)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

NOTE

l In this example, the FE ports on all the BTSs work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE/GE port of
each NE that accesses services must work in auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet port works in
another mode, the local Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of the Ethernet ports
inside the network are planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
Normally, if the equipment is interconnected with BTSs, the maximum frame length can also assume its
default value of 1522.
l In this example, all the services carry VLAN IDs. Therefore, the tag attributes of all the ports are tag aware.
l In this example, no loopback port shutdown function is enabled.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-136 to Table 8-140 provide the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-136 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE12)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

374

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-137 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE13)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation
type

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame
discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling
broadcast
packet
suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast
packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

30

Table 8-138 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE14)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-139 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast
packet suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

375

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-140 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE16)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

NOTE

The majority of the BTS backhaul services are Internet services. Therefore, the errored frame discarding function
needs to be enabled.

8.7.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet protection.
In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.7.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.
Table 8-141 provides the planning information of IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services.
Table 8-141 Information about IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE12

NE13

NE14

NE15

NE16

Service ID

Service
name

Qlan

Qlan

Qlan

Qlan

Qlan

Tag type

C-Awared

C-Awared

C-Awared

C-Awared

C-Awared

Self-learning
MAC
address

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

MAC
address
learning
mode

IVL

IVL

IVL

IVL

IVL

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

376

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

NE12

NE13

NE14

NE15

NE16

Mounted
UNI port

1-EM6T-1
(VLAN ID:
100, 110)

3-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
100)

3-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
100)

3-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
110)

3-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
110)

1-EM6T-3
(VLAN ID:
100)

4-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
110)

7-EM4T-1
(VLAN ID:
100)

4-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
110)

7-EM4T-1
(VLAN ID:
110)

3-ISU2-1
(VLAN ID:
100, 110)

1-EM6T-1
(VLAN ID:
100, 110)

NOTE

In this example, the split horizon group is not used.

8.7.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring QoS.

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding VLAN priorities according
to the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the VLAN priority,
as provided in Table 8-142. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.
Table 8-142 Service class and PHB service class

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

CS6

EF

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

AF3

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

377

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

AF2

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The default trusted packet type for each port that is applied for the default DS domain is C-VLAN priority
and therefore does not need to be modified.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 8-143 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 8-143 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

378

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.7.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

8.7.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

379

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

TAG

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tag Aware
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

380

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

TAG

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-3

Loopback Check

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

381

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

Step 4 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

802.1Q

802.1Q

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

802.1Q

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

382

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Step 5 See A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Tag

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Tag

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Tag

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tag Aware

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

383

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Step 6 See A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the advanced attributes
of the IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast
Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast
Packet
Suppression
Threshold

30

30

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression
Threshold

30

30

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

384

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

----End

8.7.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.7.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.10 Configuring IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services and configure the ELAN services.
l Parameters of NE12
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Qlan

Tag Type

C-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-1

100, 110

1-EM6T-3

100

3-ISU2-1

100, 110

l Parameters of NE13
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

385

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Qlan

Tag Type

C-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-1

100, 110

3-ISU2-1

100

4-ISU2-1

110

l Parameters of NE14
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Qlan

Tag Type

C-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

7-EM4T-1

100

3-ISU2-1

100

l Parameters of NE15
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

386

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Qlan

Tag Type

C-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

110

4-ISU2-1

110

l Parameters of NE16
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Qlan

Tag Type

C-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

7-EM4T-1

110

3-ISU2-1

110

----End

8.7.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

387

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
NOTE

The actual mapping relationships for the default DS domain comply with the network planning information.
Therefore, you can skip this step.

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

4
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

388

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

PHB

CVLAN

EF

CS6

CS7

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

NOTE

The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is valid.
In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
NOTE

The actual ports that are applied to the default DS domain and their trusted packet types comply with the network
planning information. Therefore, you can skip this step.

l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-1

CVLAN

1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

7-EM4T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

389

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-1
1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

390

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End

8.7.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

391

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE12

NE14

NE16

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create the MAs for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qlan

BTS12_Qlan

BTS15_Qlan

Relevant Service

1-Qlan

1-Qlan

1-Qlan

CC Test Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qlan

Relevant Service

1-Qlan

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qlan

Relevant Service

1-Qlan

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create the MEPs for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

392

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Qlan

BTS11_Qlan

BTS12_Qlan

BTS15_Qlan

Board

1-EM6T

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

Port

1-EM6T-3

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

VLAN

100

100

100

110

MP ID

201

200

202

205

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active
Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qlan

Board

7-EM4T-1

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

110

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qlan

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

393

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

VLAN

120

MP ID

601

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs for NE12, NE14,
and NE16.
The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11_Qlan

BTS12_Qlan

BTS15_Qlan

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

401

601

The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS12_Qlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

202

The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS15_Qlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

205

Step 5 On NE12, perform LB tests to test the Ethernet service configurations.


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

394

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 200 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 202 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 205 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packet lost during the LB tests.
----End

8.8 Configuration Example (802.1ad-Bridge-Based E-LAN


Service)
This section considers an 802.1ad-bridge-based E-LAN service as an example to describe how
to configure the Ethernet service according to the network planning information.

8.8.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Ring Network),
configure Ethernet services according to the following requirements:
l

BTS11 to BTS14 provide FE ports whose port rate is 100 Mbit/s.

The RNC provides GE ports whose port rate is 1000 Mbit/s.

The VLAN ID used by the services on a BTS is allocated by the RNC that controls the
BTS.

The VLAN IDs of services on BTSs that are controlled by different RNCs may be the same.
Therefore, the transport network allocates an S-VLAN ID for services from the BTSs
controlled by the same RNC, and the S-VLAN IDs on the entire network are planned in a
unified manner.

The Ethernet services on the ring network are protected.

VLAN priorities are configured on each BTS according to service types.

The functions of detecting looped services and suppressing broadcast packets need to be
provided on the network.

To meet the preceding requirements, IEEE 802.1ad bridge based E-LAN services are configured
to implement transmission of the BTS services; in addition, the functions of detecting looped
services and suppressing broadcast packets, ERPS protection, and QoS processing are
configured. See Figure 8-35.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

395

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Figure 8-35 Networking diagram (IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN services)


RNC1

NE21
802.1ad bridge

RNC2

GE

GE
BTS11
CVLAN 100
SVLAN 200

BTS14
CVLAN 100
SVLAN 201

FE

FE

ERPS

R4

R4

NE22
802.1ad bridge

NE24
802.1ad bridge

FE
NE23
802.1ad bridge

R4
BTS13
CVLAN 110
SVLAN 200

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-35 are described as follows.
Table 8-144 Connections of Ethernet links (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE21 and


RNC1

1-EM6T-1

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE21 and


RNC2

1-EM6T-2

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE21 and


NE22

4-ISU2-1

East port of an ERPS


ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Between NE21 and


NE24

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 SD protection
group
West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure these ports


to transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 SD protection
group

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

396

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-145 Connections of Ethernet links (NE22)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE22 and


NE23

4-ISU2-1

East port of an ERPS


ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE22 and


BTS21

1-EM6T-3

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS21.

Between NE22 and


NE21

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Table 8-146 Connections of Ethernet links (NE23)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE23 and


NE24

4-ISU2-1

l East port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

l RPL port
Between NE23 and
BTS23

7-EM4T-1

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS23.

Between NE23 and


NE22

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Table 8-147 Connections of Ethernet links (NE24)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE24 and


NE21

4-ISU2-1

East port of an ERPS


ring node

Configure these ports


to transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Main IF board of a 1
+1 SD protection
group
6-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Standby IF board of a
1+1 SD protection
group

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

397

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE24 and


BTS24

1-EM6T-3

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS24.

Between NE24 and


NE23

3-ISU2-1

West port of an
ERPS ring node

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

8.8.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

8.8.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 8-148 to Table 8-151 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-148 Information about Ethernet ports (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

398

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-149 Information about Ethernet ports (NE22)


Parameter

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-150 Information about Ethernet ports (NE23)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-151 Information about Ethernet ports (NE24)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-3

Encapsulation type

802.1q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

399

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

1-EM6T-3

Tag attribute

Tag aware

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

NOTE

l In this example, the FE/GE ports on all the BTSs/RNC work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE/
GE port of each NE that accesses services must work in auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet port
works in another mode, the local Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of the
Ethernet ports inside the network are planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
l In this example, no loopback port shutdown function is enabled.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-152 to Table 8-155 provide the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-152 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE21)
Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard


enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast
packet suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

Table 8-153 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE22)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

400

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-154 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE23)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-155 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE24)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

802.1q

802.1q

802.1q

QinQ type domain

0x88a8

0x88a8

0x88a8

Error frame discard


enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast
packet suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

NOTE

l All the IF_ETH ports are connected to Huawei equipment. Therefore, it is recommended that you set the
QinQ type domain to 0x88a8 for the IF_ETH ports.
l The majority of the BTS backhaul services are Internet services. Therefore, the errored frame discarding
function needs to be enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

401

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.8.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet protection.

Information about ERPS Instances


Table 8-156 provides the planning information about ERPS instances.
Table 8-156 Information about ERPS instances
Parameter

NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

ERPS ID

East port

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

West port

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

RPL owner ring


node flag

No

No

Yes

No

RPL port

4-ISU2-1

Control VLAN

4093

4093

4093

4093

Packet transmit
interval

5s (default
value)

5s (default
value)

5s (default
value)

5s (default
value)

Entity level

4 (default value)

4 (default value)

4 (default value)

4 (default value)

WTR time

5 minutes
(default value)

Guard time

500 ms (default
value)

500 ms (default
value)

500 ms (default
value)

500 ms (default
value)

Hold-off time

0s (default
value)

0s (default
value)

0s (default
value)

0s (default
value)

NOTE

l In this example, all the services are aggregated on NE21. Therefore, the NE that is farthest from NE21 needs
to function as the RPL owner. In this way, when the ring network is normal, the traffic carried on each link
is relatively even.
l The control VLAN needs to use a VLAN that is not used by any service. It is recommended that the control
VLAN use VLAN 4093.
l The packet transmit interval, entity level, WTR time, guard time, and hold-off time generally assume their
default values.

8.8.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.
Table 8-157 provides the planning information of IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

402

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-157 Information about IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN services


Parameter

NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Service ID

Service name

ADlan

ADlan

ADlan

ADlan

Tag type

S-Awared

S-Awared

S-Awared

S-Awared

Self-learning
MAC address

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

MAC address
learning mode

IVL

IVL

IVL

IVL

Mounted UNI
port

1-EM6T-3 (CVLAN ID: 100,


110) (S-VLAN
ID: 200)

1-EM6T-3 (CVLAN ID: 100)


(S-VLAN ID:
200)

1-EM6T-3 (CVLAN ID: 110)


(S-VLAN ID:
200)

1-EM6T-3 (CVLAN ID: 100)


(S-VLAN ID:
201)

3-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

3-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

3-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

3-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

4-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

4-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

4-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

4-ISU2-1 (SVLAN ID: 200,


201)

1-EM6T-4 (CVLAN ID: 100)


(S-VLAN ID:
201)
Mounted NNI
port

8.8.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring QoS.

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding VLAN priorities according
to the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the VLAN priority,
as provided in Table 8-158. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

403

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-158 Service class and PHB service class


PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

CS6

EF

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

AF3

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The default trusted packet type for each port that is applied for the default DS domain is C-VLAN priority
and therefore needs to be modified as required.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 8-159 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 8-159 Queue scheduling mode

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

404

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.8.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

8.8.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

405

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Max Frame Length(byte)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
Ethernet ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

406

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

TAG

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

TAG

Tag Aware

The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-3

TAG

Tag Aware

The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

TAG

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

Loopback Check

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

407

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 and NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

Step 4 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the attributes of the
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

408

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

QinQ

QinQ

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

QinQ

QinQ

QinQ

Step 5 See A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the advanced attributes
of the IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression
Threshold

30

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 and NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

409

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression
Threshold

30

30

30

----End

8.8.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet protection.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.1.1 Creating Ethernet Ring Protection Instances and create the ERPS instance.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

ERPS ID

East Port

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

West Port

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

RPL Owner
Ring Node Flag

No

No

Yes

No

RPL Port

4-ISU2-1

Control VLAN

4093

4093

4093

4093

----End

8.8.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.11 Configuring IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN Services and configure the
E-LAN services.
l Parameters of NE21
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

410

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

ADlan

Tag Type

S-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-1

200

100, 110

1-EM6T-2

201

100

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the NNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLANs

3-ISU2-1

200, 201

4-ISU2-1

200, 201

l Parameters of NE22
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

ADlan

Tag Type

S-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-3

200

100

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

411

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the NNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLANs

3-ISU2-1

200, 201

4-ISU2-1

200, 201

l Parameters of NE23
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

ADlan

Tag Type

S-Awared

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

7-EM4T-1

200

110

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the NNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLANs

3-ISU2-1

200, 201

4-ISU2-1

200, 201

l Parameters of NE24
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

ADlan

Tag Type

S-Awared
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

412

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-3

201

100

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the NNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLANs

3-ISU2-1

200, 201

4-ISU2-1

200, 201

----End

8.8.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

BE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

413

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

NOTE

l The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is
valid. In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

414

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-1

CVLAN

1-EM6T-2
l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

CVLAN

3-ISU2-1

SVLAN

4-ISU2-1

SVLAN

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE21 to NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE21 to NE23 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

415

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters of NE21 to NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

----End

8.8.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create an MA.


The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

416

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

ADlan

ADlan

ADlan

ADlan

Relevant
Service

1-ADlan

1-ADlan

1-ADlan

1-ADlan

CC Test
Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create MEPs.


l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

ADlan

ADlan

ADlan

Board

1-EM6T

1-EM6T

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-1

1-EM6T-2

VLAN

100

110

100

MP ID

101

103

104

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

ADlan

Board

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-3

VLAN

100
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

417

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

MP ID

201

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

ADlan

Board

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-3

VLAN

110

MP ID

301

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

ADlan

Board

1-EM6T

Port

1-EM6T-3

VLAN

100

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs.
The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

418

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

ADlan

ADlan

ADlan

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

301

401

The values for the related parameters of NE22 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

ADlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

101

The values for the related parameters of NE23 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

ADlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

103

The values for the related parameters of NE24 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

ADlan

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

104

Step 5 Perform LB tests to verify Ethernet service configurations.


l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 101 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 103 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 301 as the sink MEP.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

419

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 104 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packet lost during the LB tests.
----End

8.9 Configuration Example (Hybrid Configuration of E-Line


Services and E-LAN Services)
This section describes how to configure a radio network that transmits E-Line services and ELAN services at the same time according to the network planning information.

8.9.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network),
configure Ethernet services according to the following requirements:
l

BTS11, BTS12, and BTS15 provide FE ports whose port rate is 100 Mbit/s.

It is unknown whether the Ethernet services on each BTS carry a VLAN ID or whether the
carried VLAN IDs conflict. Therefore, in this example, the point-to-point transparently
transmitted E-Line services are configured to implement point-to-point transparent service
transmission, and the IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services are configured to
implement service convergence.

DSCP values are configured on each BTS according to service types.

The BTSs need not communicate with each other.

Figure 8-36 Networking diagram


BTS12
FE
R4
GE
NE14

PSN
NE13

NE12

FE
NE11
R4

NE16

BTS11

FE
NE15
R4
BTS15
Point-to-point transparently
transmitted E-Line service
IEEE 802.1d bridge
Split horizon group

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

420

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The connections of Ethernet links shown in Figure 8-36 are described as follows.
Table 8-160 Connections of Ethernet links (NE12)
Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE12 and


NE13

1-EM6T-1

Configure these ports


to transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

Between NE12 and


NE11

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

1-EM6T-3

Between NE12 and


BTS11

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS11.

Table 8-161 Connections of Ethernet links (NE13)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE13 and


NE14

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

5-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

1-EM6T-1

Between NE13 and


NE15

Between NE13 and


NE12

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Configure this port to


transmit backhaul
services from BTSs.

421

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-162 Connections of Ethernet links (NE14)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE14 and


NE13

3-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

4-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

7-EM4T-1

Between NE14 and


BTS12

Configure this port to


access services from
BTS12.

Table 8-163 Connections of Ethernet links (NE15)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE15 and


NE16

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Between NE15 and


NE13

4-ISU2-1

Main IF board of a 1
+1 HSB protection
group

6-ISU2-1

Standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection
group

Configure this port to


transmit Native
Ethernet services on
Hybrid radio.

Table 8-164 Connections of Ethernet links (NE16)


Link

Port

Port Description

Description

Between NE16 and


NE15

3-ISU2-1

Configure this port to


transmit Ethernet
services on Hybrid
radio.

Between NE16 and


BTS15

7-EM4T-1

Configure these ports


to access services
from BTS15.

8.9.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

422

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

8.9.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 8-165 to Table 8-168 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-165 Information about Ethernet ports (NE12)
Parameter

1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Loopback check

Enabled

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-166 Information about Ethernet ports (NE13)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6T-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Loopback check

Enabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

423

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-167 Information about Ethernet ports (NE14)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Table 8-168 Information about Ethernet ports (NE16)


Parameter

7-EM4T-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

NOTE

l In this example, the planned encapsulation type is null because whether the Ethernet services on each BTS
carry a VLAN ID or whether the carried VLAN IDs conflict is unknown.
l In this example, the FE/GE ports on all the BTSs/BSC work in the auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the
FE/GE port of each NE that accesses services must work in the auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet
port works in another mode, the local Ethernet port must work in the same mode. The working modes of
the Ethernet ports inside the network are planned as auto-negotiation.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
Normally, if the equipment is interconnected with BTSs, the maximum frame length can also assume its
default value of 1522.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only if the local NE or opposite equipment has insufficient
QoS capabilities. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l In this example, no loopback port shutdown function is enabled.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 8-169 to Table 8-173 provide the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the
Ethernet services.
Table 8-169 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE12)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

424

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast packet
suppression threshold

30

30

Table 8-170 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE13)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation
type

Null

Null

Null

Null

Error frame
discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling
broadcast
packet
suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast
packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

30

Table 8-171 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE14)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

Table 8-172 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Null

Null

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabling broadcast
packet suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

425

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast packet
suppression
threshold

30

30

30

Table 8-173 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE16)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Encapsulation type

Null

Error frame discard

Enabled

Enabling broadcast packet suppression

Enabled

Broadcast packet suppression threshold

30

NOTE

The majority of the BTS backhaul services are Internet services. Therefore, the errored frame discarding function
needs to be enabled.

8.9.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.9.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring Ethernet services.

Information About Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted E-Line Services


Point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services need to be configured on NE14, NE15,
and NE16. Table 8-174 to Table 8-176 provide the planning information of the E-Line services.
Table 8-174 Information about point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services (NE14)
Parameter

NE14
BTS12 to NE13

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service ID

Service name

BTS12toNE13_Tline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

426

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

NE14
BTS12 to NE13

Source port

3-ISU2-1

Source C-VLANs

Sink port

7-EM4T-1

Sink C-VLANs

Table 8-175 Information about point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services (NE15)
Parameter

NE15
NE16 to NE13

Service ID

Service name

NE16toNE13_Tline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

3-ISU2-1

Source C-VLANs

Sink port

4-ISU2-1

Sink C-VLANs

Table 8-176 Information about point-to-point transparently transmitted E-Line services (NE16)
Parameter

NE16
BTS15 to NE15

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service ID

Service name

BTS15toNE15_Tline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

7-EM4T-1

Source C-VLANs

Sink port

3-ISU2-1

Sink C-VLANs

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

427

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Information About IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services need to be configured on NE12 and NE13, where
VLAN IDs may conflict. In addition, the split horizon group needs to be configured for
preventing the BTSs from communicating with each other. Table 8-177 and Table 8-178
provide the planning information of the IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services.
Table 8-177 Information about IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services (NE12)
Parameter

NE12

Service ID

Service name

Dlan

Tag type

Tag-Transparent

Self-learning MAC address

Enabled

Mounted UNI port

1-EM6T-1
1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

Split horizon group

1-EM6T-1
1-EM6T-3

Table 8-178 Information about IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services (NE13)
Parameter

NE3

Service ID

Service name

Dlan

Tag type

Tag-Transparent

Self-learning MAC address

Enabled

Mounted UNI port

1-EM6T-1
3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

Split horizon group

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

8.9.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS.

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated according to the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

428

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding DSCP values according to
the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the DSCP value, as
shown in Table 8-179. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.
Table 8-179 Service class and PHB service class
PHB Service Class

DSCP

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

56

CS6

48

EF

40

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

32

AF3

24

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

16

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The required trusted packet type is not the C-VLAN priority but DSCP value. Therefore, the trusted packet
type needs to be modified for service-associated Ethernet ports applied in the default DS domain.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 8-180 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

429

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Table 8-180 Queue scheduling mode


PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

8.9.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

8.9.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

430

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

431

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
7-EM4T-1

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Ethernet ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6T-1

Loopback Check

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression

Enabled

Broadcast Packet Suppression


Threshold

30

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Null

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

432

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

Null

Null

Null

Null

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation
Type

Null

Null

Null

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

Null

Step 4 See A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the advanced attributes
of the IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

30

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

433

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Broadcast
Packet
Suppression

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Broadcast
Packet
Suppression
Threshold

30

30

30

30

----End

8.9.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


In this example, Ethernet protection is not used.

8.9.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services and configure the E-Line services on NE14
to NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS12 to NE13

Service ID

Service Name

BTS12toNE13_Tline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

Source VLANs

Sink Port

7-EM4T-1

Sink VLANs

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

434

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value
NE16 to NE13

Service ID

Service Name

NE16toNE13_Tline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

Source VLANs

Sink Port

4-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
BTS15 to NE15

Service ID

Service Name

BTS15toNE15_Tline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

7-EM4T-1

Source VLANs

Sink Port

3-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

Step 2 See A.7.3.9 Configuring IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services and configure the ELAN services on NE12 and NE13.
The values for the related parameters of NE12 that need to be set in the main interface are
provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Dlan

Tag Type

Tag-Transparent

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

435

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-3

1-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Split Horizon Group tab page
are provided as follows.
Split Horizon Group ID

Split Horizon Group Member

1-EM6T-1, 1-EM6T-3

The values for the related parameters of NE13 that need to be set in the main interface are
provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

Dlan

Tag Type

Tag-Transparent

Self-Learning MAC Address

Enabled

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.
Port

SVLAN

VLANs/CVLAN

1-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Split Horizon Group tab page
are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Split Horizon Group ID

Split Horizon Group Member

3-ISU2-1, 4-ISU2-1
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

436

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

----End

8.9.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
change the mapping relationships for the DS domain.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

16

AF21

24

AF31

32

AF41

40

EF

48

CS6

56

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

8
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

437

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

PHB

CVLAN

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

SVLAN

IP DSCP

AF21

16

AF31

24

AF41

32

EF

40

CS6

48

CS7

56

MPLS EXP

NOTE

l The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is
valid. In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

1-EM6T-3

ip-dscp

1-EM6T-1
3-IFU2-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-IFU2-1

ip-dscp

4-IFU2-1
1-EM6T-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-IFU2-1

ip-dscp

7-EM4T-1
l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-IFU2-1

ip-dscp

4-IFU2-1
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

438

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

7-EM4T-1

ip-dscp

3-IFU2-1

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE12 to NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6T-1
1-EM6T-3
3-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

439

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l The values for the related parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1
1-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End

8.9.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and configure the MD for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

440

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Value
NE12

NE14

NE16

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create the MAs for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Relevant Service

1-Dlan

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Relevant Service

1-BTS12toNE13_Tline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Relevant Service

1-BTS15toNE15_Tline

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and configure the MEPs for NE12, NE14, and NE16.
l The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

441

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

DlantoBTS

DlantoBTS

Board

7-EM4T-1

3-ISU2

Port

7-EM4T-1

3-ISU2-1

VLAN

MP ID

201

200

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Board

7-EM4T-1

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

MP ID

401

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

l The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Board

7-EM4T

Port

7-EM4T-1

VLAN

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

442

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

Parameter

Value

MP ID

601

Direction

Ingress

CC Status

Active

AIS Active Status

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEP points for NE12,
NE14, and NE16.
The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

DlantoBTS

DlantoBTS

DlantoBTS

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

201

401

601

The values for the related parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

200

The values for the related parameters of NE16 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

DlantoBTS

Remote Maintenance Point ID(e.g:1,3-6)

200

Step 5 On NE12, perform LB tests to test the Ethernet service configurations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

443

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

8 Configuring Native Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane

l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 200 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 201 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 200 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MEP ID is 200 as the source MEP and
the MEP whose MEP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
There should be no packet lost during the LB tests.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

444

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet


Services

About This Chapter


EoS/EoPDH-based Ethernet services are classified into EPL services, EVPL services, EPLAN
services, and EVPLAN services.
9.1 Basic Concepts
This section describes the basic concepts that are related to EoPDH services.
9.2 Configuration Procedure
The service configuration procedure differs according to the specific service type.
9.3 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Based on TDM Radio)
This section considers an Ethernet service based on TDM radio as an example to describe how
to configure Ethernet services according to the service planning information.
9.4 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Traversing a TDM Network)
This section considers an Ethernet service traversing a TDM network as an example to describe
how to configure Ethernet services according to the service planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

445

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

9.1 Basic Concepts


This section describes the basic concepts that are related to EoPDH services.

9.1.1 What's the EoS Plane


The EoS plane refers to the switching plane provided by the Ethernet switching unit on the EMS6
board. The EoS plane provides a wide range of services and features based on Native Ethernet.
As shown in Figure 9-1, the ports connecting to the EoS plane are classified into the following
types:
l

PORT on the EMS6 board, which is the external FE/GE port on the EMS6 board

VCTRUNK port on the EMS6 board, which is the internal port on the EMS6 board
The Ethernet packets on the EoS plane can be transmitted to the EoS encapsulating/mapping
module. Then, the packets are encapsulated into VC-12s/VC-3s/VC-4s for transmission.

Bridging port (PORT7) connecting to the EoS plane on the EMS6 board
The EMS6 board has two bridging ports: PORT7 and PORT8.
PORT7 and PORT8 are two back-to-back internal GE ports, not having PHY-layer
functions.
PORT7 is connected to the EoS plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane are
transmitted to the FE/GE port or VCTRUNK port on the EMS6 board through PORT7.
PORT8 is connected to the packet plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane are
transmitted to the EoS plane through PORT8.

Figure 9-1 EoS plane


GE

PORT1

GE

PORT2

FE

PORT3

EMS6

GE

System control, switching,


and timing board

Packet
switching unit

PORT6

VCTRUNK1

Packet
plane

PORT7 PORT8

Ethernet
switching
unit

FE

EoS plane

GE

VCTRUNK8

Encapsulating
/Mapping unit

VC-4

Crossconnect unit
TDM plane

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

446

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

9.1.2 What's the EoPDH Plane


The EoPDH plane refers to the switching plane provided by the Ethernet switching unit on the
EFP8 board. The EoPDH plane provides a wide range of services and features based on Native
Ethernet.
As shown in Figure 9-2, the ports connecting to the EoPDH plane are classified into the
following types:
l

PORT on the EFP8 board, which is the external FE port on the EFP8 board

VCTRUNK port on the EFP8 board, which is the internal port on the EFP8 board
The Ethernet packets on the EoPDH plane can be transmitted to the EoPDH encapsulating/
mapping module. Then, the packets are encapsulated into E1 services for transmission.

Bridging port (PORT9) connecting to the EoPDH plane on the EFP8 board
The EFP8 board has two bridging ports: PORT9 and PORT10.
PORT9 and PORT10 are two back-to-back internal GE ports, not having PHY-layer
functions.
PORT9 is connected to the EoPDH plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane
are transmitted to the FE port or VCTRUNK port on the EFP8 board through PORT9.
PORT10 is connected to the packet plane. The Ethernet services on the packet plane
are transmitted to the EoPDH plane through PORT10.

Figure 9-2 EoPDH plane


FE

PORT1

PORT8

GE

VCTRUNK1

Packet
plane

PORT9 PORT10

Ethernet
switching
unit

FE

EoPDH plane

EFP8

System control, switching,


and timing board

Packet
switching
unit

GE

VCTRUNK16

Encapsulating
/Mapping unit

VC-4

Crossconnect unit
TDM
plane

9.1.3 VCTRUNK
When Ethernet services need to be transmitted in EoS or EoPDH mode, you need to configure
the Ethernet services between corresponding FE/GE ports and VCTRUNKs on Ethernet boards.
In the application of EoS, the rate of a standard VC container does not adapt to that of Ethernet
services. If you directly map Ethernet services into a standard VC container, transmission
bandwidth is lavishly used. To solve this problem, the virtual concatenation technology is used
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

447

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

to concatenate standard VC to a VCG that adapts to the rate of Ethernet services. Similarly, in
the application of EoPDH, the virtual concatenation technology is used to concatenate PDHs to
a VCG that adapts to the rate of Ethernet services.
The EMS6 is an EoS board and support VC-3 or VC-12 VCTRUNKsa.
The EFP8 is an EoPDH Ethernet board and provides VCTRUNKs binding E1 channelsb.
NOTE

a: For the EMS6, VC-12s only in VC4-4 can be bound with VCTRUNKs.
b: On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

9.1.4 Hub/Spoke
In the case of convergence services, mutual access between non-central stations and central
stations is needed but mutual access between non-central stations is not needed. Therefore, you
need to specify a mounted port as a Hub port or a Spoke port.
l

Hub port
Hub ports can mutually access each other.
Hub ports and Spoke ports can mutually access each other.

Spoke port
Spoke ports cannot mutually access each other.
Spoke ports and Hub ports can mutually access each other.
NOTE

A mounted port is a Hub port by default. During configuration, you can configure the mounted port of a
central station to a Hub port, and configure the mounted port of a non-central station to a Spoke port. This
can ensure that a central station can communicate with any non-central station, but non-central stations
cannot communicate with each other.

9.1.5 EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services


Based on the EoS/EoPDH mode, Ethernet services can be classified into six types.

9.1.5.1 Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted EPL Services


In the case of EPL services, the source port transparently transmits all the received Ethernet
packets to the sink port, and the services occupy the bandwidth exclusively. These services are
point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL services.

Service Model
Table 9-1 describes the point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL service model.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

448

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-1 Point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL service model


Traffic Flow

Network Attribute

Entry Detection

Description

PORT (source)

UNI (source)

Disabled (source)

PORT (sink)

UNI (sink)

Disabled (sink)

The source port


transparently transmits all
the received Ethernet
frames to the sink port, and
the sink port processes the
Ethernet frames and sends
out the Ethernet frames.

Typical Application
Figure 9-3 shows the typical application scenarios of the point-to-point transparently transmitted
EPL service model.
Ethernet service 1 gains access to NE1 through port 1, regardless of whether the Ethernet service
carries an unknown VLAN ID or does not carry a VLAN ID. Port 1 processes the received
packets and transparently transmits Ethernet service 1 to port 3. Port 3 then processes the received
packets and transmits Ethernet service 1 to NE2.
Service processing on NE2 is the same as on NE1.
Figure 9-3 Typical application of the service model
NE 1
Port 1
Service 1

EPL

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
network

Port 3

EPL

Port 1
Service 1

9.1.5.2 EVPL Services Based on the VLAN


VLANs can be used to separate EVPL services. With the VLAN technology, multiple EVPL
services can share one physical channel. This type of EVPL services is called the EVPL service
based on the VLAN.

Service Model
Table 9-2 shows the models of the EVPL service based on the VLAN.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

449

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-2 Models of the EVPL service based on the VLAN


Service Model

Service Flow

Network
Attribute

Ingress Check

Service
Description

Model 1

PORT (source)

UNI (source)

Enabled (source)

PORT (sink)

UNI (sink)

Enabled (sink)

The source port


processes the
incoming Ethernet
frames based on its
TAG attribute, and
then sends the
processed Ethernet
frames to the sink
port. The sink port
processes the
Ethernet frames
based on its TAG
attribute, and then
sends the processed
Ethernet frames.

PORT+VLAN
(source)

UNI (source)

Enabled (source)

UNI (sink)

Enabled (sink)

Model 2

PORT+VLAN
(sink)

The source port


processes the
incoming Ethernet
frames based on its
TAG attribute, and
then sends the
Ethernet frames
with a specific
VLAN ID to the sink
port. The sink port
processes the
Ethernet frames
based on its TAG
attribute, and then
sends the processed
Ethernet frames.

Typical Applications
Figure 9-4 shows the typical application of service model 1.
Ethernet Service 1 and Service 2 carry unknown VLAN IDs. Service 1 is accessed to NE1
through Port 1, and Service 2 is accessed to NE2 through Port 2. Port 1 and Port 2, based on
their own TAG attributes, process the incoming packets. Then, Port 1 sends Service 1 to Port 3,
and Port 2 sends Service 2 to Port 4. Port 3 and Port 4, based on their own TAG attributes, process
the incoming packets. Then, Port 3 sends Service 1 to NE2, and Port 4 sends Service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes Service 1 and Service 2 in the same manner as NE1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

450

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-4 Typical application of service model 1


NE 1
Port 1
Service 1

NE 2
Port 3

EVPL
EVPL

Service 2
Port 2

Port 3

Transmission
Network

EVPL

Port 1
Service 1

EVPL

Port 4

Port 4

Service 2
Port 2

NOTE

The application of service model 1 is similar to point-to-point transparent transmission of Ethernet services.
The difference lies in that ports need to process packets based on their TAG attributes in the application
of service model 1.

Figure 9-5 shows the typical application of service model 2. Service 1 and Service 2 carry
different VLAN IDs. Service 1 is accessed to NE1 through Port 1, and Service 2 is accessed to
NE1 through Port 2. They share the transmission channel at Port 3 and are isolated by using
VLANs.
On NE1, Port 1 and Port 2, based on their own TAG attributes, process the incoming packets.
Then, Port 1 sends Service 1 to Port 3, and Port 2 sends Service 2 to Port 3. Port 3, based on
their own TAG attributes, processes the incoming packets, and then sends Service 1 and Service
2 to NE2. Service 1 and Service 2 carry different VLAN IDs, so they can be transmitted through
Port 3 with separated from each other.
NE2 processes Service 1 and Service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 9-5 Typical application of service model 2
NE 1
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

Port 1

EVPL
L

Port 2

EVP

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
Network

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

Port 3
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

EVPL

EVP
L

Port 1

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100

Service 2
Port 2 VLAN ID: 200

9.1.5.3 QinQ-based EVPL Services


S-VLAN tags can be used to separate EVPL services. Thus, multiple EVPL services can share
one physical channel. Such services are called QinQ-based EVPL services.

Service Model
Table 9-3 shows a main service model of QinQ-based EVPL services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

451

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-3 Main service model of QinQ-based EVPL services


Service Model

Service Flow
(Bidirectional)

Network
Attribute

Operation of Tag

Description of
Service

Model 1

PORT (source)

C-Aware (Source)

PORT+S-VLAN
(sink)

S-Aware (Sink)

Adding S-VLAN
tags (C-Aware port)

The source port adds


S-VLAN tags to all
the received
Ethernet packets,
and then transmits
the packets to the
sink port.

PORT+C-VLAN
(source)

C-Aware (Source)

Adding S-VLAN
tags (C-Aware port)

The source port adds


S-VLAN tags to all
the received
Ethernet packets
that carry the
specified C-VLAN
tags, and then
transmits the
packets to the sink
port.

Transparently
transmitting SVLAN tags (SAware port)

The source port


transparently
transmits the
Ethernet packets
that carry the
specified S-VLAN
tags to the sink port.

Switching S-VLAN
tags (S-Aware port)

The source port


transmits the
Ethernet packets
that carry the
specified S-VLAN
tags to the sink port.
If the source and
sink QinQ links
correspond to
different S-VLAN
tags, the S-VLAN
tags carried in the
Ethernet frames are
switched.

Model 2

S-Aware (Sink)

PORT+C-VLAN
+S-VLAN (sink)

PORT+S-VLAN
(source)

Model 3

S-Aware (source)
S-Aware (sink)

PORT+S-VLAN
(sink)

PORT+S-VLAN
(source)

Model 4

S-Aware (source)
S-Aware (sink)

PORT+S-VLAN
(sink)

Typical Applications
Figure 9-6 shows the typical application of service model 1.
Ethernet Service 1 and Service 2 include tagged frames and untagged frames. Service 1 is
accessed to NE1 through Port 1, and Service 2 is accessed to NE1 through Port 2. Port 1 adds
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

452

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

the corresponding S-VLAN tag to Service 1, and Port 2 adds the corresponding S-VLAN tag to
Service 2. Then, Service 1 and Service 2 are transmitted to Port 3. Port 3 transmits Service 1
and Service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes Service 1 and Service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 9-6 Typical application of service model 1
NE 1
Port 1
Service 1
Service 2

NE 2

EVPL

Transmission
Network

Port 3

EVPL

Port 3

EVP
L

Port 2
Strip S-VLAN Label

EVP

Add S-VLAN Label

Add S-VLAN Label

Port 1
Service 1
Service 2
Port 2

Strip S-VLAN Label

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

Data(1)

S-VLAN(300)

Data(1)

Data(1)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

Data(2)

Figure 9-7 shows the typical application of service model 2.


Service 1 and Service 2 carry different VLAN IDs. Service 1 is accessed to NE1 through Port
1, and Service 2 is accessed to NE 1 through Port 2. Port 1 adds the corresponding S-VLAN tag
to Service 1, and Port 2 adds the corresponding S-VLAN tag to Service 2. Then, Service 1 and
Service 2 are transmitted to Port 3. Port 3 transmits Service 1 and Service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes Service 1 and Service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 9-7 Typical application of service model 2
Strip S-VLAN Label

Add S-VLAN Label

C-VLAN(100)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(1)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

NE 1
Service 1
VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
VLAN ID: 200

Port 1

EVPL

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
Network

EVP

Port 2

EVPL

Port 3

EVP

Add S-VLAN Label

Port 1

Service 1
VLAN ID: 100

Service 2
Port 2 VLAN ID: 200
Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(1)

C-VLAN(100)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

C-VLAN(200)

Data(2)

Figure 9-8 shows the typical application of service model 3.


Service 1 and Service 2 carry different VLAN IDs. After Service 1 is accessed to NE1 through
Port 1 and Service 2 is accessed to NE1 through Port 2, they share the same transmission channel
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

453

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

at Port 3 and are separated from each other through S-VLAN tags. On NE1, Port 1 and Port 2
transparently transmit Service 1 and Service 2 respectively to Port 3. Port 3 transmits Service 1
and Service 2 to NE2. With the different S-VLAN tags, Service 1 and Service 2 can be
transmitted through Port 3 at the same time.
NE2 processes Service 1 and Service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 9-8 Typical application of service model 3
NE 1
Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
S-VLAN ID: 200

Port 1

Port 2

EVPL
EVP

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
Network

Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
S-VLAN ID: 200

Port 1

EVPL

Port 3

Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100

EVP

Port 2

Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
S-VLAN ID: 200

Service 2
S-VLAN ID: 200

Figure 9-9 shows the typical application of service model 4.


Service 1 and Service 2 carry a same S-VLAN tag. Service 1 is accessed to NE1 through Port
1, and Service 2 is accessed to NE1 through Port 2. Port 1 changes the S-VLAN tag carried in
Service 1 and Port 2 changes the S-VLAN tag carried in Service 2 so that the S-VLAN tags
carried in Service 1 and Service 2 are different. Then, Port 1 and Port 2 transmit Service 1 and
Service 2 to Port 3 respectively. Port 3 transmits Service 1 and Service 2 to NE2.
NE2 processes Service 1 and Service 2 in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 9-9 Typical application of service model 4
Switching S-VLAN Label
S-VLAN(100)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(300)

Data(1)

S-VLAN(100)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

NE 1
Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100
Service 2
S-VLAN ID: 100

Port 1

Port 2

E-Line

NE 2
Port 3

Transmission
Network

Port 3

E-Line

E-Lin
e

e
E-Lin

Port 1

Service 1
S-VLAN ID: 100

Service 2
Port 2 S-VLAN ID: 100

Switching S-VLAN Label


S-VLAN(300)

Data( 1)

S-VLAN(100)

Data(1)

S-VLAN(400)

Data(2)

S-VLAN(100)

Data(2)

9.1.5.4 EPLAN Services Based on the 802.1D Bridge


In the case of EPLAN services, packets can be forwarded only based on the MAC address table.
This type of EPLAN services is called the EPLAN service based on the 802.1D bridge.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

454

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Service Model
Table 9-4 shows the model of EPLAN services based on the 802.1D bridge.
Table 9-4 Model of EPLAN services based on the 802.1D bridge
Type of Service

Service Flow

Learning/
Switching Mode
of a Bridge

Attribute of a
Mounted Port

Sub-Switching
Domain

EPLAN services
based on the 802.1D
bridge

PORT

SVL/Ingress filter
disable

UNI

No classification of
sub-switching
domains

Typical Applications
Figure 9-10 shows a typical application based on the model of service. The transmission network
needs to carry the A services accessed from NE2 and NE3. The two A services are aggregated
at the convergence node NE1. The services need not be isolated. Therefore, an 802.1D bridge
is used at NE1 to groom services.
Figure 9-10 Model of EPLAN services based on the 802.1D bridge
NE 2

Port 1
User A2

Port 2
NE 1

Port 1
User A1

Transmission
Network
Port 2
Port 3

802.1d bridge

Transmission
Network

NE 3

Port 2

Port 1
User A3

9.1.5.5 EVPLAN Services Based on the 802.1Q Bridge


EVPLAN services can be separated by setting VLANs, and then a bridge is divided into multiple
sub-switching domains. This type of EVPLAN services is called the EVPLAN service based on
802.1Q bridge.

Service Model
Table 9-5 shows the models of EVPLAN services based on the 802.1Q bridge.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

455

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-5 Models of EVPLAN services based on the 802.1Q bridge


Type of Service

Service Flow

Attribute of a
Mounted Port

Learning/
Switching Mode
of a Bridge

Sub-Switching
Domain

EVPLAN service
based on the 802.1Q
bridge

PORT+VLAN

UNI

IVL/Ingress filter
enablea

Division of subswitching domains


based on VLANs

NOTE

a: A VLAN filter table must be configured to check the VLAN tag. If a packet carries a VLAN ID different
from the VLAN ID of the port specified in the VLAN filter table, the packet is discarded.

Typical Applications
Figure 9-11 shows the typical application of the model of the EVPLAN service based on the
802.1Q bridge. The transmission network needs to carry G and H services accessed from NE2
and NE3. Both types of services are aggregated and switched on NE1. G and H services adopt
different VLAN planning. Therefore, a 802.1Q bridge is used on NEs and sub-switching domains
are divided based on VLANs, differentiating and separating the two types of services.
Figure 9-11 Model of EVPLAN services based on the 802.1Q bridge
NE 2
VLAN 100

Port 3

NE 1
Port 1
User G1

VLAN 100

VLAN 200

Port 2
User H1

Port 2
User H2

Transmission
Network
Port 3

VLAN 200

Port 1
User G2

802.1q bridge

Port 4

NE 3

Transmission
Network

VLAN 100

Port 1
User G3

802.1q bridge

Port 3

VLAN 200

Port 2
User H3

802.1q bridge

NOTE

You can also configure EVPL Services Based on the VLAN on NE2 and NE3 for service access.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

456

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

9.1.5.6 EVPLAN Services Based on 802.1ad Bridge


S-VLAN tags can be used to separate EVPLAN services. Therefore, a bridge is divided into
multiple independent sub-switching domains. Such services are called EVPLAN services based
on 802.1ad bridge.

Model of Service
Table 9-6 lists the models of EVPLAN services based on 802.1ad bridge.
Table 9-6 Models of EVPLAN services based on 802.1ad bridge
Type of
Service

Model of
Service

Learning/
Switching
Mode of a
Bridge

Mount Port
Attribute

Operation of
Tag

SubSwitching
Domain

EVPLAN
services based
on 802.1ad
bridge

Model 1

IVL/Ingress
filter enable

C-Aware port

Adding SVLAN tags


based on PORT

Division of subswitching
domains based
on S-VLAN tags

Adding SVLAN tags


based on PORT
and C-VLAN

Model 2

SVL/Ingress
filter disable

S-Aware port

Mount Port and


base for PORT
and S-VLAN

C-Aware port

Adding SVLAN tags


based on PORT

S-Aware port

Mount port

No division of
sub-switching
domains

NOTE

a: When Bridge Learning Mode is set to IVL, the VLAN filtering table must be configured so that the
bridge can check the contents of the VLAN tags. If the VLAN ID is not defined in the VLAN filtering
table, the packet is discarded.

Typical Applications
The 802.1ad bridge normally adopts Model 1. Figure 9-12 shows the typical application of the
model of service. The transport network needs to carry G and H services accessed from NE2
and NE3. The two types of services are aggregated and switched on NE1. Since G and H services
have a same C-VLAN tag, you need to add different S-VLAN tags to G and H services for
service isolation.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

457

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-12 Model of EVPLAN services based on 802.1ad bridge


NE 2
Add S-VLAN Label

Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(G)

C-VLAN(100)

Data( G)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

NE 2
SVLAN 300

Port 1
User G2
CVLAN 100

Port 3
SVLAN 400

NE 1
Transmission
Network

SVLAN 300

Port 1
User G1

CVLAN 100

Port 3
802.1ad bridge

CVLAN 100
SVLAN 400

User H1

Port 2
User H2

NE 3

Port 2

CVLAN 100

Port 4
802.1ad bridge

SVLAN 300

Transmission
Network

Port 1
User G3
CVLAN 100
SVLAN 400

Port 3

NE 1
Strip S-VLAN Label

Port 2
User H3
CVLAN 100

Add S-VLAN Label

C-VLAN(100)

Data( G)

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(G)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

802.1ad bridge
NE 3

Add S-VLAN Label

Strip S-VLAN Label

S-VLAN(300)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(G)

C-VLAN(100)

Data( G)

S-VLAN(400)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

C-VLAN(100)

Data(H)

NOTE

You can configure QinQ-based EVPL Services on NE2 and NE3 for service access.

9.2 Configuration Procedure


The service configuration procedure differs according to the specific service type.

9.2.1 Configuration Procedure (Point-to-Point Transparently


Transmitted EPL Services)
This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedure for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL services.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 9-13 provides the procedures for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted
EPL services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

458

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-13 Configuration flow chart (point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet Ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring Ethernet Line


Services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet Service


Configurations

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

459

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedures for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 9-7 Procedures for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.8.5.1
Configuring
External
Ethernet Ports

l You need to set Basic Attributes. Set the parameters as follows:


In the case of used ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Enabled. In the
case of unused ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Disabled.
In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment
is auto-negotiation). In the case of Ethernet ports for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
When JUMBO frames are transmitted, set Maximum Frame
Length according to the actual length of a JUMBO frame.
Otherwise, it is recommended that Maximum Frame Length takes
the default value.
l Click the Flow Control tab if the flow control function is enabled on
the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the
parameters as follows:
When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enable Symmetric Flow Control.
When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow Control.
l You need to set TAG Attributes. In the case of a point-to-point
transparently transmitted EPL service, set Entry Detection to
Disabled.
l In the case of a point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL service,
set Port Attributes in the Network Attributes tag page to UNI.
l Determine whether to set Advanced Attributes according to actual
requirements.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

460

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.5.2
Configuring
VCTRUNKs
on an Ethernet
Board

Required when internal ports need to be used.


l You need to set TAG Attributes. In the case of a point-to-point
transparently transmitted EPL service, set Entry Detection to
Disabled.
l Determine whether to set Encapsulation/Mapping according to actual
requirements. It is recommended that the parameters take the default
values and are the same for both ends of a link.
l In the case of a point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL service,
set Port Attributes in the Network Attributes tag page to UNI.
l Determine whether to configure the LCAS function according to actual
requirements. If the LCAS function is required, set Enabling LCAS
to Enabled and set LCAS Mode according to the type of third-party
equipment. In addition, it is recommended that the other parameters
take the default values. Ensure that the parameter settings are consistent
at both ends of a link.
l You need to set Bound Path. Configure bound channels according to
the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1
channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

461

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring a LAG


Table 9-8 Procedure for configuring a LAG
Operation

Description

A.8.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required when a LAG needs to be configured. Set the major parameters


as follows:
l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. LAG
Type is generally set to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite equipment. If the
LAG is configured only to implement protection, it is recommended
that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the equipment at both
ends. If the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment
at both ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set
to Non-Sharing.
l Set Sharing Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment. Unless
otherwise specified, this parameter takes the default value. This
parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to
Sharing.
l Set Main Port and Selected Standby Ports according to the network
planning information. It is recommended that the main and slave ports
at both ends adopt the same settings.

A.8.2.2 Setting
Parameters for
LAGs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

462

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring Point-to-Point Transparently Transmitted EPL Services


Table 9-9 Procedure for configuring point-to-point transparently transmitted EPL services
Operation

Description

A.8.3.1
Creating
Ethernet
Private Line
Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Service Type to EPL.
l Set Service Direction to Bidirectional.
l Set Source Port and Sink Port according to the network planning
information.
l Set Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6) and Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6) to null.
l If any VCTRUNK to which no paths are bound is used as Source
Port or Sink Port, configure corresponding bound channels according
to the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports VCTRUNKs that bind
E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as
VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 9-10 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.8.8.1
Creating a
Flow

Required when you need to perform CAR or CoS operations. Before


performing any CAR or CoS operations, you need to create flows.

A.8.8.2
Creating the
CAR

Required if you need to perform CAR or CoS operations for a specific flow
over a port.
Set CAR or CoS parameters and bind the configured CARs or CoSs to the
corresponding flows according to the network planning information.

Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

A.8.8.3
Creating the
CoS
A.8.8.4
Binding the
CAR/CoS
A.8.8.5
Configuring
Traffic
Shaping for
Egress Queues

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required if you need to perform queue scheduling over an egress port or


limit the bandwidth of queues over an egress port.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

463

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Testing Ethernet Services


NOTE

It is recommended that you use standard MPs for testing Ethernet services. The following table only provides
the description about standard MPs.

Table 9-11 Procedure for testing Ethernet services


Operation

Description

A.8.9.1 Creating
MDs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to the same
values for the two NEs.
l In the test of an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport network,
it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes the default value 4. In the
test of an Ethernet service between two internal NEs on the transport network, set
Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than 4. In the test of an Ethernet
service between two Ethernet ports on the same NE, set Maintenance Domain
Level to a value smaller than the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service
between two internal NEs on the transport network.
Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.8.9.2 Creating
MAs

l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance Domain Name that
is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the two NEs.
A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the major parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance Association
Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Node to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the Ethernet switching
unit on the EMS6 or EFP8 board, set Direction of the MEP to SDH. Otherwise, set
Direction to IP.
l If the MP ID is used to identify an MEP, set CC Status to Active.
l It is recommended that you set CCM Sending Period(ms) to 1000 ms.

perform an LB test to
test the Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that the test is successful.

9.2.2 Configuration Procedure (VLAN-Based EVPL Services)


This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedure for configuring VLAN-based EVPL services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

464

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 9-14 provides the procedures for configuring VLAN-based EVPL services.
Figure 9-14 Configuration flow chart (VLAN-based EVPL services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet Ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring Ethernet Line


Services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet Service


Configurations

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

465

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 9-12 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.8.5.1
Configuring
External
Ethernet Ports

l You need to set Basic Attributes. Set the parameters as follows:


In the case of used ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Enabled. In the
case of unused ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Disabled.
In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment
is auto-negotiation). In the case of Ethernet ports for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
When JUMBO frames are transmitted, set Maximum Frame
Length according to the actual length of a JUMBO frame.
Otherwise, it is recommended that Maximum Frame Length takes
the default value.
l Click the Flow Control tab if the flow control function is enabled on
the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the
parameters as follows:
When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enable Symmetric Flow Control.
When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow Control.
l You need to set TAG Attributes.
In the case of a VLAN-based EVPL service, set Entry Detection
to Enabled.
Set TAG, Default VLAN ID, and VLAN Priority as planned.
Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority are valid only when
TAG is Access or Hybrid.
l In the case of a VLAN-based EVPL service, set Port Attributes in the
Network Attributes tab page to UNI.
l Determine whether to set Advanced Attributes according to actual
requirements.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

466

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.5.2
Configuring
VCTRUNKs
on an Ethernet
Board

Required when internal ports need to be used.


l You need to set TAG Attributes.
In the case of a VLAN-based EVPL service, set Entry Detection
to Enabled.
Set TAG, Default VLAN ID, and VLAN Priority as planned.
Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority are valid only when
TAG is Access or Hybrid.
l Determine whether to set Encapsulation/Mapping according to actual
requirements. It is recommended that the parameters take the default
values and are the same for both ends of a link.
l In the case of a VLAN-based EVPL service, it is recommended that
you set Port Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to UNI.
l Determine whether to configure the LCAS function according to actual
requirements. If the LCAS function is required, set Enabling LCAS
to Enabled and set LCAS Mode according to the type of third-party
equipment. In addition, it is recommended that the other parameters
take the default values. Ensure that the parameter settings are consistent
at both ends of a link.
l You need to set Bound Path. Configure bound channels according to
the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1
channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

467

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring a LAG


Table 9-13 Procedure for configuring a LAG
Operation

Description

A.8.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required when a LAG needs to be configured. Set the major parameters


as follows:
l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. LAG
Type is generally set to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite equipment. If the
LAG is configured only to implement protection, it is recommended
that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the equipment at both
ends. If the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment
at both ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set
to Non-Sharing.
l Set Sharing Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment. Unless
otherwise specified, this parameter takes the default value. This
parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to
Sharing.
l Set Main Port and Selected Standby Ports according to the network
planning information. It is recommended that the main and slave ports
at both ends adopt the same settings.

A.8.2.2 Setting
Parameters for
LAGs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

468

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring VLAN-Based EVPL Services


Table 9-14 Procedure for configuring VLAN-based EVPL services
Operation

Description

A.8.3.1
Creating
Ethernet
Private Line
Services

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set Service Type to EPL.
l Set Service Direction to Bidirectional.
l Set Source Port and Sink Port according to the network planning
information.
l Set Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6) and Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6) according
to the network planning information.
l If any VCTRUNK to which no paths are bound is used as Source
Port or Sink Port, configure corresponding bound channels according
to the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports VCTRUNKs that bind
E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as
VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 9-15 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.8.8.1
Creating a
Flow

Required when you need to perform CAR or CoS operations. Before


performing any CAR or CoS operations, you need to create flows.

A.8.8.2
Creating the
CAR

Required if you need to perform CAR or CoS operations for a specific flow
over a port.
Set CAR or CoS parameters and bind the configured CARs or CoSs to the
corresponding flows according to the network planning information.

Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

A.8.8.3
Creating the
CoS
A.8.8.4
Binding the
CAR/CoS
A.8.8.5
Configuring
Traffic
Shaping for
Egress Queues

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required if you need to perform queue scheduling over an egress port or


limit the bandwidth of queues over an egress port.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

469

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Testing Ethernet Services


NOTE

It is recommended that you use standard MPs for testing Ethernet services. The following table only provides
the description about standard MPs.

Table 9-16 Procedure for testing Ethernet services


Operation

Description

A.8.9.1 Creating
MDs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to the same
values for the two NEs.
l In the test of an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport network,
it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes the default value 4. In the
test of an Ethernet service between two internal NEs on the transport network, set
Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than 4. In the test of an Ethernet
service between two Ethernet ports on the same NE, set Maintenance Domain
Level to a value smaller than the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service
between two internal NEs on the transport network.
Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.8.9.2 Creating
MAs

l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance Domain Name that
is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the two NEs.
A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the major parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance Association
Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Node to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the Ethernet switching
unit on the EMS6 or EFP8 board, set Direction of the MEP to SDH. Otherwise, set
Direction to IP.
l If the MP ID is used to identify an MEP, set CC Status to Active.
l It is recommended that you set CCM Sending Period(ms) to 1000 ms.

perform an LB test to
test the Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that the test is successful.

9.2.3 Configuration Procedure (QinQ-Based EVPL Services)


This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedure for configuring QinQ-based EVPL services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

470

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 9-15 provides the procedures for configuring QinQ-based EVPL services.
Figure 9-15 Configuration flow chart (QinQ-based EVPL services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet Ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring Ethernet Line


Services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet Service


Configurations

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

471

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 9-17 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.8.5.1
Configuring
External
Ethernet Ports

l You need to set Basic Attributes. Set the parameters as follows:


In the case of used ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Enabled. In the
case of unused ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Disabled.
In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment
is auto-negotiation). In the case of Ethernet ports for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
When JUMBO frames are transmitted, set Maximum Frame
Length according to the actual length of a JUMBO frame.
Otherwise, it is recommended that Maximum Frame Length takes
the default value.
l Click the Flow Control tab if the flow control function is enabled on
the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the
parameters as follows:
When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enable Symmetric Flow Control.
When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow Control.
l In the case of a QinQ-based EVPL service, set Port Attributes in the
Network Attributes tab page to C-Aware or S-Aware.
l Determine whether to set Advanced Attributes according to actual
requirements.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

472

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.5.2
Configuring
VCTRUNKs
on an Ethernet
Board

Required when internal ports need to be used.


l Determine whether to set Encapsulation/Mapping according to actual
requirements. It is recommended that the parameters take the default
values and are the same for both ends of a link.
l In the case of a QinQ-based EVPL service, set Port Attributes in the
Network Attributes tab page to C-Aware or S-Aware.
l Determine whether to configure the LCAS function according to actual
requirements. If the LCAS function is required, set Enabling LCAS
to Enabled and set LCAS Mode according to the type of third-party
equipment. In addition, it is recommended that the other parameters
take the default values. Ensure that the parameter settings are consistent
at both ends of a link.
l You need to set Bound Path. Configure bound channels according to
the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1
channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Procedure for Configuring a LAG


Table 9-18 Procedure for configuring a LAG
Operation

Description

A.8.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required when a LAG needs to be configured. Set the major parameters


as follows:
l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. LAG
Type is generally set to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite equipment. If the
LAG is configured only to implement protection, it is recommended
that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the equipment at both
ends. If the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment
at both ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set
to Non-Sharing.
l Set Sharing Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment. Unless
otherwise specified, this parameter takes the default value. This
parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to
Sharing.
l Set Main Port and Selected Standby Ports according to the network
planning information. It is recommended that the main and slave ports
at both ends adopt the same settings.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

473

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.2.2 Setting
Parameters for
LAGs

Optional.

Procedure for Configuring QinQ-Based EVPL Services


Table 9-19 Procedure for configuring QinQ-based EVPL services
Operation

Description

A.8.3.5
Creating
QinQ-Based
EVPL Services

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


NOTE
Before setting the parameters, select Display QinQ Shared Service.

l Set Service Type to EVPL (QinQ).


l Set Service Direction to Bidirectional.
l Set Operation Type, Source Port, Source C-VLAN (e.g. 1, 3-6),
Source S-VLAN, Sink Port, Sink C-VLAN(e.g. 1, 3-6), Sink SVLAN, C-VLAN Priority, and S-VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.
l If any VCTRUNK to which no paths are bound is used as Source
Port or Sink Port, configure corresponding bound channels according
to the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports VCTRUNKs that bind
E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as
VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 9-20 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.8.8.1
Creating a
Flow

Required when you need to perform CAR or CoS operations. Before


performing any CAR or CoS operations, you need to create flows.

A.8.8.2
Creating the
CAR

Required if you need to perform CAR or CoS operations for a specific flow
over a port.
Set CAR or CoS parameters and bind the configured CARs or CoSs to the
corresponding flows according to the network planning information.

A.8.8.3
Creating the
CoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

474

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Description

A.8.8.4
Binding the
CAR/CoS
A.8.8.5
Configuring
Traffic
Shaping for
Egress Queues

Required if you need to perform queue scheduling over an egress port or


limit the bandwidth of queues over an egress port.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Procedure for Testing Ethernet Services


NOTE

It is recommended that you use standard MPs for testing Ethernet services. The following table only provides
the description about standard MPs.

Table 9-21 Procedure for testing Ethernet services


Operation

Description

A.8.9.1 Creating
MDs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to the same
values for the two NEs.
l In the test of an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport network,
it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes the default value 4. In the
test of an Ethernet service between two internal NEs on the transport network, set
Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than 4. In the test of an Ethernet
service between two Ethernet ports on the same NE, set Maintenance Domain
Level to a value smaller than the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service
between two internal NEs on the transport network.

A.8.9.2 Creating
MAs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance Domain Name that
is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the two NEs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

475

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the major parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance Association
Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Node to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the Ethernet switching
unit on the EMS6 or EFP8 board, set Direction of the MEP to SDH. Otherwise, set
Direction to IP.
l If the MP ID is used to identify an MEP, set CC Status to Active.
l It is recommended that you set CCM Sending Period(ms) to 1000 ms.

perform an LB test to
test the Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that the test is successful.

9.2.4 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based EPLAN


Services)
This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedure for configuring IEEE 802.1d bridge-based EPLAN services.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 9-16 provides the procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1d bridge-based EPLAN
services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

476

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-16 Configuration flow chart (802.1d bridge-based EPLAN services)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet Ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring Ethernet LAN


Services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet Service


Configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

477

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 9-22 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.8.5.1
Configuring
External
Ethernet Ports

l You need to set Basic Attributes. Set the parameters as follows:


In the case of used ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Enabled. In the
case of unused ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Disabled.
In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment
is auto-negotiation). In the case of Ethernet ports for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
When JUMBO frames are transmitted, set Maximum Frame
Length according to the actual length of a JUMBO frame.
Otherwise, it is recommended that Maximum Frame Length takes
the default value.
l Click the Flow Control tab if the flow control function is enabled on
the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the
parameters as follows:
When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enable Symmetric Flow Control.
When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow Control.
l In the case of an IEEE 802.1d bridge-based EPLAN service, set Port
Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to UNI.
l To enable the broadcast packet suppression function, you need to set
Advanced Attributes.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning
information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

478

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.5.2
Configuring
VCTRUNKs
on an Ethernet
Board

Required when internal ports need to be used.


l Determine whether to set Encapsulation/Mapping according to actual
requirements. It is recommended that the parameters take the default
values and are the same for both ends of a link.
l In the case of an IEEE 802.1d bridge-based EPLAN service, set Port
Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to UNI.
l Determine whether to configure the LCAS function according to actual
requirements. If the LCAS function is required, set Enabling LCAS
to Enabled and set LCAS Mode according to the type of third-party
equipment. In addition, it is recommended that the other parameters
take the default values. Ensure that the parameter settings are consistent
at both ends of a link.
l You need to set Bound Path. Configure bound channels according to
the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1
channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Procedure for Configuring a LAG


Table 9-23 Procedure for configuring a LAG
Operation

Description

A.8.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required when a LAG needs to be configured. Set the major parameters


as follows:
l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. LAG
Type is generally set to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite equipment. If the
LAG is configured only to implement protection, it is recommended
that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the equipment at both
ends. If the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment
at both ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set
to Non-Sharing.
l Set Sharing Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment. Unless
otherwise specified, this parameter takes the default value. This
parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to
Sharing.
l Set Main Port and Selected Standby Ports according to the network
planning information. It is recommended that the main and slave ports
at both ends adopt the same settings.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

479

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.2.2 Setting
Parameters for
LAGs

Optional.

Procedure for Configuring IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based EPLAN Services


Table 9-24 Procedure for configuring IEEE 802.1d bridge-based EPLAN services
Operation

Description

A.8.3.2 Creating Ethernet


LAN Services

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set VB name according to the network planning
information.
l Set Bridge Type to 802.1d.
l Set Mount Port according to the network planning
information.
l If any VCTRUNK to which no channels are bound is used
as Mount Port, configure corresponding bound channels
according to the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board,
which supports VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS,
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs
that bind VC-12 channels.

Managing
the MAC
address table

A.8.4.2
Creating a
Blacklist
Entry of a
MAC
Address

Required when usage of EPLAN services needs to be disabled


on certain MAC address hosts.

A.8.4.1
Creating a
Static MAC
Address
Entry

Required if you need to set certain MAC address entries not


to age.

A.8.4.3
Setting the
Aging Time
of a MAC
Address
Table Entry

Required if you need to disable the aging function or change


the aging time (five minutes by default).

A.8.3.3 Changing the Ports


Connected to a VB

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The parameters need to be set according to network planning.

The parameters need to be set according to network planning.

The parameters need to be set according to network planning.

Required if you need to change a port connected to a VB,


enabled status of a port connected to a VB, or Hub/Spoke
attribute of a port connected to a VB.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

480

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 9-25 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.8.8.1
Creating a
Flow

Required when you need to perform CAR or CoS operations. Before


performing any CAR or CoS operations, you need to create flows.

A.8.8.2
Creating the
CAR

Required if you need to perform CAR or CoS operations for a specific flow
over a port.
Set CAR or CoS parameters and bind the configured CARs or CoSs to the
corresponding flows according to the network planning information.

Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

A.8.8.3
Creating the
CoS
A.8.8.4
Binding the
CAR/CoS
A.8.8.5
Configuring
Traffic
Shaping for
Egress Queues

Required if you need to perform queue scheduling over an egress port or


limit the bandwidth of queues over an egress port.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Procedure for Testing Ethernet Services


NOTE

It is recommended that you use standard MPs for testing Ethernet services. The following table only provides
the description about standard MPs.

Table 9-26 Procedure for testing Ethernet services


Operation

Description

A.8.9.1 Creating
MDs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to the same
values for the two NEs.
l In the test of an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport network,
it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes the default value 4. In the
test of an Ethernet service between two internal NEs on the transport network, set
Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than 4. In the test of an Ethernet
service between two Ethernet ports on the same NE, set Maintenance Domain
Level to a value smaller than the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service
between two internal NEs on the transport network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

481

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.9.2 Creating
MAs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance Domain Name that
is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the two NEs.

A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the major parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance Association
Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Node to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the Ethernet switching
unit on the EMS6 or EFP8 board, set Direction of the MEP to SDH. Otherwise, set
Direction to IP.
l If the MP ID is used to identify an MEP, set CC Status to Active.
l It is recommended that you set CCM Sending Period(ms) to 1000 ms.

perform an LB test to
test the Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that the test is successful.

9.2.5 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based EVPLAN


Services)
This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedure for configuring IEEE 802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN services.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 9-17 provides the procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN
services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

482

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-17 Configuration flow chart (IEEE 802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet Ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring Ethernet LAN


Services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet Service


Configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

483

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 9-27 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.8.5.1
Configuring
External
Ethernet Ports

l You need to set Basic Attributes. Set the parameters as follows:


In the case of used ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Enabled. In the
case of unused ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Disabled.
In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment
is auto-negotiation). In the case of Ethernet ports for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
When JUMBO frames are transmitted, set Maximum Frame
Length according to the actual length of a JUMBO frame.
Otherwise, it is recommended that Maximum Frame Length takes
the default value.
l Click the Flow Control tab if the flow control function is enabled on
the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the
parameters as follows:
When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enable Symmetric Flow Control.
When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow Control.
l TAG Attributes is mandatory.
Set TAG, Default VLAN ID, and VLAN Priority as required. Default
VLAN ID and VLAN Priority are valid only when TAG is Access or
Hybrid.
l In the case of an IEEE 802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN service, set Port
Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to UNI.
l To enable the broadcast packet suppression function, you need to set
Advanced Attributes.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning
information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

484

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.5.2
Configuring
VCTRUNKs
on an Ethernet
Board

Required when internal ports need to be used.


l TAG is mandatory.
Set TAG, Default VLAN ID, and VLAN Priority. Default VLAN
ID and VLAN Priority are valid only when TAG is Access or
Hybrid.
l Determine whether to set Encapsulation/Mapping according to actual
requirements. It is recommended that the parameters take the default
values and are the same for both ends of a link.
l In the case of an IEEE 802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN service, set Port
Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to UNI.
l Determine whether to configure the LCAS function according to actual
requirements. If the LCAS function is required, set Enabling LCAS
to Enabled and set LCAS Mode according to the type of third-party
equipment. In addition, it is recommended that the other parameters
take the default values. Ensure that the parameter settings are consistent
at both ends of a link.
l You need to set Bound Path. Configure bound channels according to
the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1
channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

485

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring a LAG


Table 9-28 Procedure for configuring a LAG
Operation

Description

A.8.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required when a LAG needs to be configured. Set the major parameters


as follows:
l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. LAG
Type is generally set to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite equipment. If the
LAG is configured only to implement protection, it is recommended
that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the equipment at both
ends. If the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment
at both ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set
to Non-Sharing.
l Set Sharing Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment. Unless
otherwise specified, this parameter takes the default value. This
parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to
Sharing.
l Set Main Port and Selected Standby Ports according to the network
planning information. It is recommended that the main and slave ports
at both ends adopt the same settings.

A.8.2.2 Setting
Parameters for
LAGs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

486

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services


Table 9-29 Procedure for configuring IEEE 802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN services
Operation

Description

A.8.3.2 Creating Ethernet


LAN Services

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set VB name according to the network planning
information.
l Set Bridge Type to 802.1q.
l Set Mount Port according to the network planning
information.
l If any VCTRUNK to which no channels are bound is used
as Mount Port, configure corresponding bound channels
according to the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board,
which supports VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS,
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs
that bind VC-12 channels.

A.8.3.4 Creating the VLAN


Filtering Table

Required.

Managing
the MAC
address table

A.8.4.2
Creating a
Blacklist
Entry of a
MAC
Address

Required when usage of EVPLAN services needs to be


disabled on certain MAC address hosts.

A.8.4.1
Creating a
Static MAC
Address
Entry

Required if you need to set certain MAC address entries not


to age.

A.8.4.3
Setting the
Aging Time
of a MAC
Address
Table Entry

Required if you need to disable the aging function or change


the aging time (five minutes by default).

A.8.3.3 Changing the Ports


Connected to a VB

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set VLAN ID(e.g.1,3-6) and Selected forwarding ports


according to the network planning information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Required if you need to change a port connected to a VB,


enabled status of a port connected to a VB, or Hub/Spoke
attribute of a port connected to a VB.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

487

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 9-30 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.8.8.1
Creating a
Flow

Required when you need to perform CAR or CoS operations. Before


performing any CAR or CoS operations, you need to create flows.

A.8.8.2
Creating the
CAR

Required if you need to perform CAR or CoS operations for a specific flow
over a port.
Set CAR or CoS parameters and bind the configured CARs or CoSs to the
corresponding flows according to the network planning information.

Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

A.8.8.3
Creating the
CoS
A.8.8.4
Binding the
CAR/CoS
A.8.8.5
Configuring
Traffic
Shaping for
Egress Queues

Required if you need to perform queue scheduling over an egress port or


limit the bandwidth of queues over an egress port.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Procedure for Testing Ethernet Services


NOTE

It is recommended that you use standard MPs for testing Ethernet services. The following table only provides
the description about standard MPs.

Table 9-31 Procedure for testing Ethernet services


Operation

Description

A.8.9.1 Creating
MDs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to the same
values for the two NEs.
l In the test of an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport network,
it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes the default value 4. In the
test of an Ethernet service between two internal NEs on the transport network, set
Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than 4. In the test of an Ethernet
service between two Ethernet ports on the same NE, set Maintenance Domain
Level to a value smaller than the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service
between two internal NEs on the transport network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

488

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.9.2 Creating
MAs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance Domain Name that
is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the two NEs.

A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the major parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance Association
Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Node to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the Ethernet switching
unit on the EMS6 or EFP8 board, set Direction of the MEP to SDH. Otherwise, set
Direction to IP.
l If the MP ID is used to identify an MEP, set CC Status to Active.
l It is recommended that you set CCM Sending Period(ms) to 1000 ms.

perform an LB test to
test the Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that the test is successful.

9.2.6 Configuration Procedure (IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based


EVPLAN Services)
This section describes how to perform parameter settings and other relevant operations as
required in the procedure for configuring IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based EVPLAN services.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 9-18 provides the procedures for configuring IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based EVPLAN
services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

489

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-18 Configuration flow chart (IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based EVPLAN services)
Required

Start

Optional
Configuring Ethernet Ports

Configuring LAGs

Configuring Ethernet LAN


Services

Configuring QoS

Verifying Ethernet Service


Configurations

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

490

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 9-32 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.8.5.1
Configuring
External
Ethernet Ports

l You need to set Basic Attributes. Set the parameters as follows:


In the case of used ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Enabled. In the
case of unused ports, set Enabled/Disabled to Disabled.
In the case of an Ethernet port that is connected to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value as the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment
is auto-negotiation). In the case of Ethernet ports for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
When JUMBO frames are transmitted, set Maximum Frame
Length according to the actual length of a JUMBO frame.
Otherwise, it is recommended that Maximum Frame Length takes
the default value.
l Click the Flow Control tab if the flow control function is enabled on
the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the
parameters as follows:
When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enable Symmetric Flow Control.
When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow Control.
l In the case of an IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based EVPLAN service, set
Port Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to C-Aware or
S-Aware.
l To enable the broadcast packet suppression function, you need to set
Advanced Attributes.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning
information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

491

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.5.2
Configuring
VCTRUNKs
on an Ethernet
Board

Required when internal ports need to be used.


l Determine whether to set Encapsulation/Mapping according to actual
requirements. It is recommended that the parameters take the default
values and are the same for both ends of a link.
l In the case of an IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based EVPLAN service, set
Port Attributes in the Network Attributes tab page to C-Aware or
S-Aware.
l Determine whether to configure the LCAS function according to actual
requirements. If the LCAS function is required, set Enabling LCAS
to Enabled and set LCAS Mode according to the type of third-party
equipment. In addition, it is recommended that the other parameters
take the default values. Ensure that the parameter settings are consistent
at both ends of a link.
l You need to set Bound Path. Configure bound channels according to
the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board, which supports
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS, VCTRUNKs that bind E1
channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs that bind VC-12 channels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

492

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring a LAG


Table 9-33 Procedure for configuring a LAG
Operation

Description

A.8.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required when a LAG needs to be configured. Set the major parameters


as follows:
l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. LAG
Type is generally set to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite equipment. If the
LAG is configured only to implement protection, it is recommended
that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the equipment at both
ends. If the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment
at both ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set
to Non-Sharing.
l Set Sharing Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment. Unless
otherwise specified, this parameter takes the default value. This
parameter is valid to only LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to
Sharing.
l Set Main Port and Selected Standby Ports according to the network
planning information. It is recommended that the main and slave ports
at both ends adopt the same settings.

A.8.2.2 Setting
Parameters for
LAGs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

493

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services


Table 9-34 Procedure for configuring IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based EVPLAN services
Operation

Description

A.8.3.6 Creating IEEE


802.1ad Bridge-Based
EVPLAN Services

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set VB name according to the network planning
information.
l Set Bridge Type to 802.1ad.
l Set Mount Port according to the network planning
information.
l If any VCTRUNK to which no channels are bound is used
as Mount Port, configure corresponding bound channels
according to the network planning information.
NOTE
The EFP8 of the OptiX RTN 980 is an EoPDH Ethernet board,
which supports VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels. On the NMS,
VCTRUNKs that bind E1 channels are displayed as VCTRUNKs
that bind VC-12 channels.

A.8.3.4 Creating the VLAN


Filtering Table

Required if you set Bridge Switch Mode to IVL/Ingress


Filter Enable.
Set VLAN ID(e.g.1,3-6) and Selected forwarding ports
according to the network planning information.

Managing
the MAC
address table

A.8.4.2
Creating a
Blacklist
Entry of a
MAC
Address

Required when usage of EVPLAN services needs to be


disabled on certain MAC address hosts.

A.8.4.1
Creating a
Static MAC
Address
Entry

Required if you need to set certain MAC address entries not


to age.

A.8.4.3
Setting the
Aging Time
of a MAC
Address
Table Entry

Required if you need to disable the aging function or change


the aging time (five minutes by default).

A.8.3.3 Changing the Ports


Connected to a VB

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The parameters need to be set according to network planning.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.

Required if you need to change a port connected to a VB,


enabled status of a port connected to a VB, or Hub/Spoke
attribute of a port connected to a VB.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

494

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 9-35 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.8.8.1
Creating a
Flow

Required when you need to perform CAR or CoS operations. Before


performing any CAR or CoS operations, you need to create flows.

A.8.8.2
Creating the
CAR

Required if you need to perform CAR or CoS operations for a specific flow
over a port.
Set CAR or CoS parameters and bind the configured CARs or CoSs to the
corresponding flows according to the network planning information.

Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

A.8.8.3
Creating the
CoS
A.8.8.4
Binding the
CAR/CoS
A.8.8.5
Configuring
Traffic
Shaping for
Egress Queues

Required if you need to perform queue scheduling over an egress port or


limit the bandwidth of queues over an egress port.
Set the relevant parameters according to the network planning information.

Procedure for Testing Ethernet Services


NOTE

It is recommended that you use standard MPs for testing Ethernet services. The following table only provides
the description about standard MPs.

Table 9-36 Procedure for testing Ethernet services


Operation

Description

A.8.9.1 Creating
MDs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to the same
values for the two NEs.
l In the test of an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport network,
it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes the default value 4. In the
test of an Ethernet service between two internal NEs on the transport network, set
Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than 4. In the test of an Ethernet
service between two Ethernet ports on the same NE, set Maintenance Domain
Level to a value smaller than the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service
between two internal NEs on the transport network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

495

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Operation

Description

A.8.9.2 Creating
MAs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance Domain Name that
is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the two NEs.

A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

Required in the case of the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service test
are located. Set the major parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance Association
Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Node to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the Ethernet switching
unit on the EMS6 or EFP8 board, set Direction of the MEP to SDH. Otherwise, set
Direction to IP.
l If the MP ID is used to identify an MEP, set CC Status to Active.
l It is recommended that you set CCM Sending Period(ms) to 1000 ms.

perform an LB test to
test the Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that the test is successful.

9.3 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Based on


TDM Radio)
This section considers an Ethernet service based on TDM radio as an example to describe how
to configure Ethernet services according to the service planning information.

9.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Chain Network),
configure the Ethernet services on the TDM radio chain network shown in Figure 9-19,
according to the following requirements:
l

In this example, few Ethernet services are transmitted only on BTS13 and BTS14. To meet
the service requirements, the radio network need not be upgraded and the EoS mode is
adopted to transmit Ethernet services.

The Ethernet services on BTS13 occupy a 4 Mbit/s bandwidth and the Ethernet services
on BTS14 occupy a 10 Mbit/s bandwidth.

Ethernet services transmitted by BTS13 and BTS14 carry VLAN tags, and VLAN IDs on
the entire network are planned in a unified manner.

FE links to the BSC are configured with LAG protection.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

496

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

QoS processing is not required.

Figure 9-20 shows the board configuration of each NE on the radio network.

Figure 9-19 Networking diagram (Ethernet services based on TDM radio)


E1
BTS12

BTS13
4 Mbit/s
VLAN 120

STM-1

FE+E1

FE+STM-1

NE14
E1
NE13

NE12

NE11
BSC

FE+E1
E1

BTS11

NE15

NE16

BTS14
10 Mbit/s
VLAN 130

BTS15

Figure 9-20 Board configuration (Ethernet services based on TDM radio)


NE13

NE14
IF1

CST
IF1
NE6
IF1
SL1D

E1
BTS12

EMS6
CSTA

FE

IF1
IF1

NE11

NE12
CST
IF1
NE6
IF1
SL1D

BTS13

PIU

IF1
IF1

EMS6

SP3S

STM-1

E1

PIU

E1
BTS11

CSHN

CST
IF1

CSTA

NE16
E1

NE6
IF1
EMS6

IF1
IF1
SP3S

NE15

FE

STM-1

FE
BSC

E1
BTS14

BTS15

NOTE

NE11 is an OptiX RTN 980 NE; NE12, NE13, and NE15 are OptiX RTN 950 NEs; NE14 and NE16 are OptiX
RTN 910 NEs.
If Ethernet services need to be encapsulated to E1s for transmission (in this example, the Ethernet services need
to traverse the E1 service cable between NE12 and NE13), the EFP8 is required. Configure the EFP8 in the
similar way for configuring the EMS6.

The connections of Ethernet links are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

497

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-37 Connections of Ethernet links (NE11)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and the BSC

4-EMS6-PORT1 (main port


of a LAG)

l Configure these ports to


aggregate the Ethernet
services backhauled from
BTS13 and BTS14 to the
BSC.
l Configure these ports into
a load non-sharing LAG,
therefore improving link
reliability.

4-EMS6-PORT2 (slave port


of a LAG)

Between NE11 and NE12

3-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)
5-IF1 (standby IF board of a
1+1 HSB protection group)

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

Table 9-38 Connections of Ethernet links (NE12)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE12 and NE11

3-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

5-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)
Between NE12 and NE13

1-SL1D-1

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

Table 9-39 Connections of Ethernet links (NE13)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE13 and NE12

1-SL1D-1

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

Between NE13 and NE14

3-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

5-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)
Between NE13 and NE15

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

4-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

498

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Link

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Port

Description

6-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 9-40 Connections of Ethernet links (NE14)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE14 and BTS13

4-EMS6-PORT1

Configure this port to support


access of services from
BTS13 and transmit the
services in EoS mode.

Between NE14 and NE13

3-IF1

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

Table 9-41 Connections of Ethernet links (NE15)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and BTS14

1-EMS6-PORT1

Configure this port to support


access of services from
BTS14 and transmit the
services in EoS mode.

Between NE15 and NE13

4-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these ports to


transmit Ethernet services
encapsulated in STM-1.

6-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

9.3.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before configuring an Ethernet
service based on TDM radio.

9.3.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
ports.

Information About Ethernet External Ports


Table 9-42 to Table 9-44 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

499

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-42 Information about Ethernet external ports (NE11)


Parameter

4-EMS6-PORT1

4-EMS6-PORT2

Port enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length

1522

1522

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

UNI

Table 9-43 Information about Ethernet external ports (NE14)


Parameter

4-EMS6-PORT1

Port enabled

Enabled

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length

1522

Flow control

Disabled

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

Table 9-44 Information about Ethernet external ports (NE15)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EMS6-PORT1

Port enabled

Enabled

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length

1522

Flow control

Disabled

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

500

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

NOTE

l In this example, the FE ports on all the BTSes/BSC work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE
ports on the NEs that receive services from and transmit services to the BTSes/BSC must also work in
auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet ports work in a mode other than the auto-negotiation mode,
plan the local Ethernet ports to work in the same mode as the peer Ethernet ports. In the case of Ethernet
ports within a network, plan the Ethernet ports to work in auto-negotiation mode.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only when the NE or the peer equipment is inadequate
for QoS processing. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at
both ends.
l In this example, all the Ethernet services carry VLAN tags. Therefore, the TAG attributes of all the
ports are Tag Aware.
l In this example, the maximum frame length is planned to be the default value, 1522. If required, change
the maximum frame length according to the requirements of the specific BTS.

Information About VCTRUNKs


Table 9-45 to Table 9-47 provide the information about the VCTRUNKs that are configured
to transmit the Ethernet services.
Table 9-45 Information about VCTRUNKs (NE11)
Parameter

4-EMS6-VCTRUNK1 (Receiving
and Transmitting Ethernet
Services Between BTS14 and the
BSC)

4-EMS6-VCTRUNK2 (Receiving
and Transmitting Ethernet
Services Between BTS13 and the
BSC)

TAG
attribute

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry
detection

Enabled

Enabled

Network
attribute

UNI

UNI

Mapping
protocol

GFP

GFP

LCAS

Enabled

Enabled

Bound paths

VC4-4-VC12(1-5)

VC4-4-VC12(6-7)

Table 9-46 Information about VCTRUNKs (NE14)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-EMS6-VCTRUNK1 (Receiving and


Transmitting Ethernet Services
Between BTS13 and the BSC)

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

501

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

4-EMS6-VCTRUNK1 (Receiving and


Transmitting Ethernet Services
Between BTS13 and the BSC)

Mapping protocol

GFP

LCAS

Enabled

Bound paths

VC4-4-VC12(1-2)

Table 9-47 Information about VCTRUNKs (NE15)


Parameter

1-EMS6-VCTRUNK1 (Receiving and


Transmitting Ethernet Services
Between BTS14 and the BSC)

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

Mapping protocol

GFP

LCAS

Enabled

Bound paths

VC4-4-VC12(1-5)

9.3.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
protection.
To improve reliability of service transmission, NE11 and the BSC are interconnected through
the LAG formed by two FE links. Table 9-48 provides the planning information.
Table 9-48 Information about the LAG

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE11

LAG type

Static

Revertive mode

Non-Revertive

Load sharing

Non-Sharing

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EMS6-PORT1

Slave port

4-EMS6-PORT2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

502

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

NOTE

In this example, the bandwidth of the Ethernet services to be transmitted is 14 Mbit/s, which is much lower
than the bandwidth of an FE port. Therefore, you need not configure the LAG to the load-sharing mode to
increase the bandwidth.

9.3.2.3 Service Planning (Ethernet Services)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
services.
Ethernet services received by each BTS carry the specific VLAN ID. Therefore, you need to
configure VLAN-based EVPL services in this example. Table 9-49 to Table 9-51 provide the
service planning information.
Table 9-49 Information about VLAN-based EVPL services (NE11)
Parameter

Between BTS14 and the


BSC

Between BTS13 and the


BSC

Board

4-EMS6

4-EMS6

Service type

EPL

EPL

Service direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source port

VCTRUNK1

VCTRUNK2

Source VLAN

130

120

Sink port

PORT1

PORT1

Sink VLAN

130

120

Table 9-50 VLAN-based EVPL services (NE14)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Between BTS13 and the BSC

Board

4-EMS6

Service type

EPL

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source port

PORT1

Source VLAN

120

Sink port

VCTRUNK1

Sink VLAN

120

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

503

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-51 VLAN-based EVPL services (NE15)


Parameter

Between BTS14 and the BSC

Board

1-EMS6

Service type

EPL

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source port

PORT1

Source VLAN

130

Sink port

VCTRUNK1

Sink VLAN

130

9.3.2.4 Service Planning (Ethernet Service Cross-Connections)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
service cross-connections.

Timeslot Allocation
Figure 9-21 shows the timeslots that are allocated to the TDM radio-based Ethernet services
according to the service planning information. 7.1.4 TDM Timeslot Planning Schemes
describes the meanings of the timeslot allocation diagram and how to plan the timeslot allocation
diagram.
Figure 9-21 Timeslot allocation diagram (Ethernet services based on TDM radio)
Links-1: NE11 - NE12 - NE13 -NE15-NE16
Station
Timeslot

NE13

NE12

NE11
3-IF1

3-IF1

1-SL1D-1

1-SL1D-1 4-IF1

NE15
4-IF1

3-IF1

NE16
3-IF1

VC12:1-5
1-EMS6-1 (VCTRUNK1)
VC4-4:VC12:1-5

4-EMS6-1 (VCTRUNK1)
VC4-4:VC12:1-5
VC4-4

VC12:6-7
4-EMS6-1(VCTRUNK2)
VC4-4:VC12:6-7

Links-2: NE13-NE14
Station

NE13

Timeslot
VC4-4

NE14

1-SL1D-1 3-IF1
VC12:6-7

3-IF1
VC12:1-2

4-EMS6 -1(VCTRUNK1)
VC4-4:VC12:1-2

Pass through
Add/Drop
Foward

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

504

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

As shown in Figure 9-21, the information about the timeslots that the TDM radio-based Ethernet
services occupy on each NE is as follows:
l

Ethernet services on NE15:


The Ethernet services are added to or dropped from the first to fifth VC-12 timeslots in
the second VC-4 of VCTRUNK1 on the EMS6 board in slot 1 of NE15.
The Ethernet services are added to or dropped from the first to fifth VC-12 timeslots in
the second VC-4 of VCTRUNK1 on the EMS6 board in slot 4 of NE11.
The Ethernet services occupy the first to fifth VC-12 timeslots on the link between the
IF1 board in slot 3 of NE11 and the IF1 board in slot 4 of NE15.

Ethernet services on NE14:


The Ethernet services are added to or dropped from the first and second VC-12 timeslots
in the second VC-4 of VCTRUNK1 on the EMS6 board in slot 4 of NE14.
The Ethernet services are added to or dropped from the sixth and seventh VC-12
timeslots in the second VC-4 of VCTRUNK2 on the EMS6 board in slot 4 of NE11.
The Ethernet services occupy the sixth and seventh VC-12 timeslots on the link between
the IF1 board in slot 3 of NE11 and the first optical port on the SL1D board in slot 1 of
NE13.
The Ethernet services occupy the first and second VC-12 timeslots on the link from the
IF1 board in slot 3 of NE13 to the IF1 board in slot 3 of NE14.

Information About Cross-Connections of Ethernet Services


Based on the timeslot allocation information shown in Figure 9-21, you can plan the Ethernet
service cross-connections. Table 9-52 to Table 9-56 provide the information about crossconnections of the Ethernet services.
Table 9-52 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Service level

VC12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source slot

4-EMS6

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-4

Source timeslot range

1-7

Sink slot

3-IF1

Sink port

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink timeslot range

1-7

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

505

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-53 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE12)


Parameter

Value

Service level

VC12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source slot

3-IF1

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source timeslot range

1-7

Sink slot

1-SL1D

Sink port

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink timeslot range

1-7

Table 9-54 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE13)


Parameter

Value

Service level

VC-12

VC-12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source slot

1-SL1D

1-SL1D

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Source timeslot range

1-5

6-7

Sink slot

4-IF1

3-IF1

Sink port

Sink VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Sink timeslot range

1-5

1-2

Table 9-55 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE14)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Service level

VC12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

506

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Source slot

4-EMS6

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-4

Source timeslot range

1-2

Sink slot

3-IF1

Sink port

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink timeslot range

1-2

Table 9-56 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE15)


Parameter

Value

Service level

VC12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source slot

1-EMS6

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-4

Source timeslot range

1-5

Sink slot

4-IF1

Sink port

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink timeslot range

1-5

9.3.2.5 Service Planning (QoS)


In this example, the QoS function is not used.

9.3.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

9.3.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

507

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.5.1 Configuring External Ethernet Ports and configure the Ethernet external ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EMS6-PORT1

4-EMS6-PORT2

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Enabled

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Maximum Frame Length

1522

1522

Non-Autonegotiation
Flow Control Mode

Disabled

Disabled

Autonegotiation Flow
Control Mode

Disabled

Disabled

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Port Attributes

UNI

UNI

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EMS6-PORT1

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Maximum Frame Length

1522

Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control


Mode

Disabled

Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode

Disabled

TAG

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Port Attributes

UNI

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EMS6-PORT1

Enabled/Disabled
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

508

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value
1-EMS6-PORT1

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Maximum Frame Length

1522

Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control


Mode

Disabled

Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode

Disabled

TAG

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Port Attributes

UNI

Step 2 See A.8.5.2 Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board and configure the VCTRUNKs.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EMS6-VCTRUNK1

4-EMS6-VCTRUNK2

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Mapping Protocol

GFP

GFP

Port Attributes

UNI

UNI

Enabling LCAS

Enabled

Enabled

Level

VC-12-Xv

VC-12-Xv

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Bound Path

VC4-4-VC12(1-5)

VC4-4-VC12(6-7)

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EMS6-VCTRUNK1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

TAG

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Mapping Protocol

GFP

Port Attributes

UNI

Enabling LCAS

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

509

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value
4-EMS6-VCTRUNK1

Level

VC-12-Xv

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bound Path

VC4-4-VC12(1-2)

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EMS6-VCTRUNK1

TAG

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Mapping Protocol

GFP

Port Attributes

UNI

Enabling LCAS

Enabled

Level

VC-12-Xv

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bound Path

VC4-4-VC12(1-5)

----End

9.3.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet protection.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.2.1 Creating a LAG and create the LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EMS6

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

LAG No

LAG Name

ToBSC

LAG Type

Static

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

510

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value
4-EMS6

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Main Port

PORT1

Selected Standby Ports

PORT2

Step 2 See A.8.2.2 Setting Parameters for LAGs and set the parameters for LAGs.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EMS6

LAG No

LAG Name

ToBSC

System Priority

32768

----End

9.3.3.3 Configuration Process (Ethernet Services)


This section describes the process for configuring the Ethernet service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.3.1 Creating Ethernet Private Line Services and create the Ethernet private line
service.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between BTS14 and the
BSC

Between BTS13 and the


BSC

Board

4-EMS6

4-EMS6

Service Type

EPL

EPL

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Port

VCTRUNK1

VCTRUNK2

Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

130

120

Sink Port

PORT1

PORT1

Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

130

120

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

511

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between BTS13 and the BSC

Board

4-EMS6

Service Type

EPL

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Source Port

PORT1

Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

120

Sink Port

VCTRUNK1

Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

120

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between BTS14 and the BSC

Board

1-EMS6

Service Type

EPL

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Source Port

PORT1

Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

130

Sink Port

VCTRUNK1

Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

130

----End

9.3.3.4 Configuration Process (Cross-Connections)


This section describes the process for configuring the cross-connections.

Procedure
Step 1 On NE11, NE14, and NE15, see A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point
Services and create the service cross-connections.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

512

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Level

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

4-EMS6-1

Source VC4

VC4-4

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-7

Sink Slot

3-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-7

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Level

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

3-IF1-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-7

Sink Slot

1-SL1D-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-7

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE13 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Level

VC12

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Slot

1-SL1D-1

1-SL1D-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-5

6-7

Sink Slot

4-IF1-1

3-IF1-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

513

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Sink VC4

VC4-1

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-5

1-2

Activate Immediately

Yes

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Level

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

4-EMS6-1

Source VC4

VC4-4

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Sink Slot

3-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-2

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Level

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

1-EMS6-1

Source VC4

VC4-4

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-5

Sink Slot

4-IF1-1

Sink VC4

VC4-1

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-5

Activate Immediately

Yes

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

514

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

9.3.3.5 Configuration Process (QoS)


In this example, the QoS function is not used.

9.3.3.6 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 On NE11, NE14, and NE15, see A.8.9.1 Creating MDs and create the maintenance domain.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE14

NE15

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 On NE11, NE14, and NE15, see A.8.9.2 Creating MAs and create the maintenance association.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS13_Vline

BTS14_Vline

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS13_Vline

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS14_Vline

Step 3 On NE11, NE14, and NE15, see A.8.9.3 Creating MPs and create the maintenance points.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

515

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS13_Vline

BTS14_Vline

Node

4-EMS6-PORT1

4-EMS6-PORT1

VLAN ID

120

130

MP ID

103

104

Type

MEP

MEP

Direction

SDH

SDH

CC Status

Activate

Activate

CCM Sending Period(ms)

1000

1000

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE14 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS13_Vline

Node

4-EMS6-PORT1

VLAN ID

120

MP ID

401

Type

MEP

Direction

SDH

CC Status

Activate

CCM Sending Period(ms)

1000

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE15 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS14_Vline

Node

1-EMS6-PORT1

VLAN ID

130

MP ID

501
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

516

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Type

MEP

Direction

SDH

CC Status

Activate

CCM Sending Period(ms)

1000

Step 4 On NE11, perform LB tests to test the Ethernet service configurations.


l Perform the LB test by considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 103 as the source
maintenance point and considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 401 as the sink
maintenance point.
l Perform the LB test by considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 104 as the source
maintenance point and considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 501 as the sink
maintenance point.
All LB tests should show that the tests are successful.
----End

9.4 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Traversing a


TDM Network)
This section considers an Ethernet service traversing a TDM network as an example to describe
how to configure Ethernet services according to the service planning information.

9.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
On the network shown in Figure 9-22, all the Ethernet services from BTS11-BTS15 are
aggregated through Hybrid radio links to NE11, traverse the leased TDM network, and then are
transmitted to the BSC. Based on 6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM
Radio Chain Network), configure the Ethernet services according to the following
requirements:
l

NE11 uses the EFP8 board to receive Ethernet services from and transmit Ethernet services
to BTS16.

NE11 and NE17 use the EoPDH technology, wherein Ethernet services are encapsulated
into E1 services so that Ethernet services traverse the TDM network successfully.
NOTE

To facilitate description of service configurations in this example, NE17 is an IDU that supports the EoPDH
function. In actual networking scenarios, NE17 can also be OptiX MSTP equipment that supports the
EoPDH function.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Each BTS is allocated with a specific Ethernet bandwidth and a total of 40 Mbit/s bandwidth
is required. Therefore, 20 E1 lines need to be leased.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

517

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

The services transmitted by each BTS carry VLAN tags, and VLAN IDs on the entire
network are planned in a unified manner. Therefore, the VLAN-based E-Line services are
configured for service transmission in this example.

VLAN priorities are configured on each BTS according to service types and QoS processing
is required.

Figure 9-23 shows the board configuration of each NE on the radio network.
NOTE

This section describes only how to configure Ethernet services on NE11 and NE17. For details on how to
configure Ethernet services on NE12 to NE16, see 8.4 Configuration Example (VLAN-Based E-Line
Service).

Figure 9-22 Networking diagram (Ethernet services traversing a TDM network)


BTS12
10 Mbit/s
VLAN 110

BTS16
10 Mbit/s
VLAN 150

FE

FE

GE
NE14
FE
NE13

FE

NE15

NE16

NE12

E1
NE11

BTS11
10 Mbti/s
VLAN 100

TDM
network
E1
FE
NE17

BSC

BTS15
10 Mbit/s
VLAN 120

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

518

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Figure 9-23 Board configuration (Ethernet services traversing a TDM network)


NE11
NE cascade

NE13
E1+FE
NE14

BTS12

ISU2
CSHA

CSH
ISU2
NE6
ISU2
EM6T

GE

NE12
CSH
ISU2
NE6
ISU2
EM6T

ISU2
ISU2
SP3S

PIU

PIU

SP3D
CSHN

E1

ISU2
ISU2

E1
FE
BTS11

EFP8
SP3D

E1

NE6
ISU2
EM6T

NE16
E1+FE

ISU2
ISU2
SP3S

PIU

BTS16

TDM
network

CSH
ISU2
CSHA

FE

PIU

E1

NE15
CSHN

BTS15

EFP8
SP3D

NE17

FE

BSC

The connections of Ethernet links are described as follows.


Table 9-57 Connections of Ethernet links (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and the


leased TDM network

2-SP3D(1-20)

Configure these ports to be


connected to the leased E1
lines.

Between NE11 and BTS16

4-EFP8-PORT1

Configure this port to receive


Ethernet services from and
transmit Ethernet service to
BTS16.

Between NE11 and NE12

4-EFP8-PORT9

PORT9 and PORT10 bridge


between the EoPDH plane
and the packet plane. PORT9
bridges the EoPDH plane and
PORT10 bridges the packet
plane.

4-EFP8-PORT10

3-ISU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 HSB protection group)
5-ISU2 (standby IF board of
a 1+1 HSB protection group)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Configure this port to receive


Ethernet services from and
transmit Ethernet services to
NE12.

519

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-58 Connections of Ethernet links (NE17)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE17 and the


leased TDM network

2-SP3D(1-20)

Configure these ports to be


connected to the leased E1
lines.

Between NE17 and the BSC

4-EFP8-PORT1

Configure this port to


aggregate the Ethernet
services backhauled from the
BTSs to the BSC.

NOTE

In this example, 20 E1 lines are used to transmit Ethernet services only. In actual networking scenarios,
extra E1 lines need to be leased for transmitting E1 services.

9.4.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before configuring an Ethernet
service traversing a TDM network.

9.4.2.1 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports on the Packet Plane)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
ports on the packet plane.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 9-59 provides the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the Ethernet service.
Table 9-59 Information about Ethernet ports (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-EFP8-PORT10

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Maximum frame length

1522

Flow control

Disabled

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

520

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

NOTE

l In this example, all the services carry VLAN tags. Therefore, the TAG attributes of all the ports are Tag
Aware.
l In the case of the EFP8 board, the flow control function is enabled only when the NE or the peer equipment
is inadequate for QoS processing. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the
equipment at both ends.
l In this example, the maximum frame length is planned to be the default value, 1522. If required, change the
maximum frame length according to the requirements of the specific BTS.

Information About the IF_ETH Ports


Table 9-60 provides the information about the IF_ETH ports that carry the Ethernet service.
Table 9-60 Information about the IF_ETH port (NE11)
Parameter

3-ISU2

5-ISU2

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

802.1Q

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

9.4.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
services on the packet plane.
Table 9-61 provides the planning information about the Ethernet service.
Table 9-61 Information about Ethernet services (NE11)
Parameter

Between NE12 and the TDM Network

Service ID

Service name

NE12toTDM_Vline

Service direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

No transparent transmission

Source port

4-EFP8-PORT10

Source C-VLAN

100, 110, 120

Sink port

3-ISU2

Sink C-VLAN

100, 110, 120

9.4.2.3 Service Planning (QoS on the Packet Plane)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS on
the packet plane.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

521

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

QoS (Diffserv)
DS is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the BTS
services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding DS domain according to the allocated VLAN priority or DSCP value. Each
Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same DS configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated with corresponding VLAN priorities according
to the service type, and the NEs allocate the PHB service classes according to the VLAN priority,
as provided in Table 9-62. Each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same DS
configuration.
Table 9-62 Service class and PHB service class
PHB Service Class

VLAN Priority

Corresponding Service
Type

CS7

CS6

EF

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

AF4

AF3

Real-time OM and HSDPA


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

AF2

Non-real-time R99 service


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data service (HSPA


interactive and background
services)

NOTE

l During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 or CS6 is not recommended, because CS7 or CS6 may
be used to transmit Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
l The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified.
l The default trusted packet type for each port that is applied for the default DS domain is C-VLAN priority
and therefore does not need to be modified.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

522

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-63 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 9-63 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

9.4.2.4 Service Planning (Ethernet Ports on the EFP8 Board)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
ports on the EFP8 board.

Information About Ethernet External Ports


Table 9-64 and Table 9-65 provide the information about the Ethernet ports that transmit the
Ethernet services.
Table 9-64 Information about Ethernet external ports (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT9

Port enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

523

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT9

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length

1522

1522

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

UNI

Table 9-65 Information about Ethernet external ports (NE17)


Parameter

4-EFP8-PORT1

Port enabled

Enabled

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length

1522

Flow control

Disabled

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

NOTE

l In this example, the FE ports on all the BTSes/BSC work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, the FE
ports on the NEs that receive services from and transmit services to the BTSes/BSC must also work in
auto-negotiation mode. If the peer Ethernet ports work in a mode other than the auto-negotiation mode,
plan the local Ethernet ports to work in the same mode as the peer Ethernet ports. In the case of Ethernet
ports within a network, plan the Ethernet ports to work in auto-negotiation mode.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only when the NE or the peer equipment is inadequate
for QoS processing. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at
both ends.
l In this example, all the Ethernet services carry VLAN tags. Therefore, the TAG attributes of all the
ports are Tag Aware.
l In this example, the maximum frame length is planned to be the default value, 1522. If required, change
the maximum frame length according to the requirements of the specific BTS.

Information About VCTRUNKs


In EoPDH mode, a VCTRUNK can bind a maximum of 16 VC-12 channels. In this example, a
total of 40 Mbit/s Ethernet bandwidth is required, that is, 20 VC-12 channels are occupied.
Therefore, you need to configure two VCTRUNKs. In this example, configure the two
VCTRUNKs with the same number of VC-12 channels and then create the two VCTRUNKs
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

524

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

into a load-sharing LAG. Table 9-66 and Table 9-67 provide the information about the
VCTRUNKs that are configured to transmit the Ethernet services.
Table 9-66 Information about VCTRUNKs (NE11)
Parameter

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK1

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK2

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

UNI

Mapping protocol

GFP

GFP

LCAS

Enabled

Enabled

Bound paths

VC4-1-VC12(1-10)

VC4-1-VC12(11-20)

Table 9-67 Information about VCTRUNKs (NE17)


Parameter

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK1

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK2

TAG attribute

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry detection

Enabled

Enabled

Network attribute

UNI

UNI

Mapping protocol

GFP

GFP

LCAS

Enabled

Enabled

Bound paths

VC4-1-VC12(1-10)

VC4-1-VC12(11-20)

9.4.2.5 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection for the EFP8 Board)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
protection for the EFP8 board.
According to the information about the VCTRUNKs in this example, you need to configure the
two VCTRUNKs into a load-sharing LAG to increase the bandwidth. Table 9-68 and Table
9-69 provide the planning information of LAGs.
Table 9-68 Information about the LAG (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE11

LAG type

Static aggregation

Revertive mode

Load sharing type

Load sharing

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

525

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

NE11

Load sharing mode

Load sharing based on IP

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK1

Slave port

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK2

Table 9-69 Information about the LAG (NE17)


Parameter

NE17

LAG type

Static aggregation

Revertive mode

Load sharing type

Load sharing

Load sharing mode

Load sharing based on IP

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK1

Slave port

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK2

9.4.2.6 Service Planning (Ethernet Services on the EFP8 Board)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
services on the EFP8 board.
LAGs are created on NE1 and NE7 in this example. Therefore, you need to configure services
only on the main ports. Table 9-70 and Table 9-71 provide the service planning information.
Table 9-70 Information about Ethernet services (NE11)
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE11
Between BTS16 and the
TDM Network

Between NE12 and the


TDM Network

Board

4-EFP8

4-EFP8

Service type

EPL

EPL

Service direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source port

VCTRUNK1

VCTRUNK1

Source VLAN

150

100, 110, 120

Sink port

PORT1

PORT9

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

526

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

NE11

Sink VLAN

Between BTS16 and the


TDM Network

Between NE12 and the


TDM Network

150

100, 110, 120

Table 9-71 Information about Ethernet services (NE17)


Parameter

NE17
Between the TDM Network and the
BSC

Board

4-EFP8

Service type

EPL

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source port

VCTRUNK1

Source VLAN

100, 110, 120, 150

Sink port

PORT1

Sink VLAN

100, 110, 120, 150

9.4.2.7 Service Planning (Cross-Connections)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring Ethernet
services.
In this example, VC-12 timeslot cross-connections are set up between the first to twentieth
VC-12 timeslots (bound with VCTRUNKs) in VC4-1 on the 4-EFP8 board and the first to
twentieth ports on the 2-SP3D board. Table 9-72 and Table 9-73 provide the information about
cross-connections of the Ethernet services.
Table 9-72 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Service level

VC12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source slot

4-EFP8

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source timeslot range

1-20

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

527

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Sink slot

2-SP3D

Sink port

Sink VC4

Sink timeslot range

1-20

Table 9-73 Cross-connections of Ethernet services (NE17)


Parameter

Value

Service level

VC-12

Service direction

Bidirectional

Source slot

4-EFP8

Source port

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source timeslot range

1-20

Sink slot

2-SP3D

Sink port

Sink VC4

Sink timeslot range

1-20

9.4.2.8 Service Planning (QoS of the EFP8 Board)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS of
the EFP8 board.

QoS (Flow)
Traffic classification is the prerequisite for configuring QoS of the EFP8 board. In this example,
VLAN-based EVPL services are created. Therefore, you need to create PORT+VLAN-based
flows. Table 9-74 and Table 9-75 provide the planning information of flows.
Table 9-74 Flow parameters (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Flow type

PORT+VLANbased flow

PORT+VLANbased flow

PORT+VLANbased flow

PORT+VLANbased flow

Port

4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT9

4-EFP8-PORT9

4-EFP8-PORT9

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

528

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

VLAN ID

150

100

110

120

Bound CAR ID

Bound CoS ID

Table 9-75 Flow parameters (NE17)


Parameter

Value

Flow type

PORT+VLANbased flow

PORT+VLANbased flow

PORT+VLANbased flow

PORT+VLANbased flow

Port

4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT1

VLAN ID

100

110

120

150

Bound CAR ID

Bound CoS ID

NOTE

According to the service classes of the BTS services, CoS with the ID of 1 schedules BTS services with different
VLAN priorities into egress queues with different forwarding priorities.

QoS (CAR)
In this example, CAR need not be configured.

QoS (CoS)
In this example, the BTS services are configured with corresponding VLAN priorities or DSCPs
based on the service types. The EFP8 board performs CoS processing for a BTS service
according to its VLAN priority or DSCP.
In this example, BTSs allocate VLAN priorities to services according to the service types.
Therefore, you need to configure CoS on Ethernet ports that receive services from and transmit
services to the BTSs, according to the service types. Table 9-76 and Table 9-77 provide the
CoS planning information.
Table 9-76 CoS attributes of the EFP8 board (NE11 and NE17)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

CoS ID

CoS type

VLAN priority

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

529

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Table 9-77 CoS parameters and corresponding BTS service types of the EFP8 board (NE11 and
NE17)
CoS Parameter

CoS Priority

Corresponding BTS
Service Type

User priority 0 in the VLAN


tag

HSDPA data services (HSPA


interactive and HSPA
background services)

User priority 1 in the VLAN


tag

User priority 2 in the VLAN


tag

R99 non-real-time services


(R99 interactive and R99
background services)

User priority 3 in the VLAN


tag

OM and HSDPA real-time


services (OM streaming and
HSPA streaming services)

User priority 4 in the VLAN


tag

User priority 5 in the VLAN


tag

Real-time voice service and


signaling service (R99
conversational and R99
streaming services)

User priority 6 in the VLAN


tag

User priority 7 in the VLAN


tag

NOTE

Queue 8 (namely, CoS priority 7) is the SP queue and queues 1 to 7 (namely, CoS priorities 0 to 6) are WRR
queues. Therefore, you need to map all high-priority services into queue 8 so that high-priority services can be
scheduled in time.

QoS (Shaping Based on the Egress Queues)


In this example, you need not configure traffic shaping based on the egress queues.

9.4.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

9.4.3.1 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports on the Packet Plane)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports on the packet plane.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

530

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic attributes of
the Ethernet ports.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8-PORT10

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Max Frame Length(byte)

1522

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the Ethernet ports.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8-PORT10

TAG

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
the IF_ETH ports.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Encapsulation Type

3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

802.1Q

802.1Q

Step 4 See A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the IF_ETH ports.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Tag

Value
3-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

----End

9.4.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Services on the Packet Plane)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet services on the packet plane.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

531

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services and create the E-Line services.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE12 and the TDM Network

Service ID

Service Name

NE12toTDM_Vline

Direction

UNI-UNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

4-EFP8-PORT10

Source VLANs

100, 110, 120

Sink Port

3-ISU2-1

Sink VLANs

100, 110, 120

----End

9.4.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS on the Packet Plane)


This section describes the procedure for configuring QoS on the packet plane.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and modify the
mapping relationships for the DS domain.
NOTE

The mapping relationship defined in the default DS domain is the same as the mapping relationship defined in
the DS domain that is created in this step. Therefore, you can skip this step.

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Ingress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

532

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

PHB

Default value

Default value

Default value

BE

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Egress Mapping Relation tab
page are provided as follows.
PHB

CVLAN

SVLAN

IP DSCP

MPLS EXP

BE

Default value

Default value

Default value

AF11

AF21

AF31

AF41

EF

CS6

CS7

NOTE

The AF1 is classified into three sub service classes, namely, AF11, AF12, and AF13, only one of which is valid.
In this example, the AF11 is used. It is the same case with the AF2, AF3, and AF4.

Step 2 A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their Trusted Packet Types and
change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted packet types.
NOTE

The actual ports that are applied to the default DS domain and their trusted packet types comply with the network
planning information. Therefore, you can skip this step.

The values for the related parameters of NE12 are provided as follows.
Port

Packet Type

3-ISU2-1

CVLAN

4-EFP8-PORT10
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

533

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Step 3 See A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 4 See A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that use the port policy.
The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1
4-EFP8-PORT10

----End

9.4.3.4 Configuration Process (Ethernet Ports on the EFP8 Board)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet ports on the EFP8 board.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

534

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.5.1 Configuring External Ethernet Ports and configure the Ethernet external ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8-PORT1

4-EFP8-PORT9

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Enabled

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Maximum Frame Length

1522

1522

Non-Autonegotiation
Flow Control Mode

Disabled

Disabled

Autonegotiation Flow
Control Mode

Disabled

Disabled

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Port Attributes

UNI

UNI

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8-PORT1

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Maximum Frame Length

1522

Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control


Mode

Disabled

Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode

Disabled

TAG

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Port Attributes

UNI

Step 2 See A.8.5.2 Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board and configure the VCTRUNKs.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

535

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Value
4-EFP8-VCTRUNK1

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK2

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Mapping Protocol

UNI

UNI

Port Attributes

GFP

GFP

Enabling LCAS

Enabled

Enabled

Level

VC-12-Xv

VC-12-Xv

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Bound Path

VC4-1-VC12(1-10)

VC4-1-VC12(11-20)

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8-VCTRUNK1

4-EFP8-VCTRUNK2

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Mapping Protocol

UNI

UNI

Port Attributes

GFP

GFP

Enabling LCAS

Enabled

Enabled

Level

VC-12-Xv

VC-12-Xv

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Bound Path

VC4-1-VC12(1-10)

VC4-1-VC12(11-20)

----End

9.4.3.5 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection on the EFP8 Board)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet protection on the EFP8 board.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.2.1 Creating a LAG and create the LAGs.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

536

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Value
4-EFP8

LAG No

LAG Name

ToTDM

LAG Type

Static

Load Sharing

Sharing

Sharing Mode

IP Sharing Mode

Main Port

VCTRUNK1

Selected Standby Ports

VCTRUNK2

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

LAG No

LAG Name

ToBSC

LAG Type

Static

Load Sharing

Sharing

Sharing Mode

IP Sharing Mode

Main Port

VCTRUNK1

Selected Standby Ports

VCTRUNK2

Step 2 See A.8.2.2 Setting Parameters for LAGs and set the parameters for LAGs.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

LAG No

LAG Name

ToTDM

System Priority

32768

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

537

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

LAG No

LAG Name

ToBSC

System Priority

32768

----End

9.4.3.6 Configuration Process (Ethernet Services on the EFP8 Board)


This section describes the process for configuring Ethernet services on the EFP8 board.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.3.1 Creating Ethernet Private Line Services and create the Ethernet private line
services.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between BTS16 and the
TDM Network

Between NE12 and the


TDM Network

Board

4-EFP8

4-EFP8

Service Type

EPL

EPL

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Source Port

VCTRUNK1

VCTRUNK1

Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

150

100, 110, 120

Sink Port

PORT1

PORT9

Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

150

100, 110, 120

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between the TDM Network and the
BSC

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Board

4-EFP8

Service Type

EPL

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Source Port

VCTRUNK1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

538

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value
Between the TDM Network and the
BSC

Source VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

100, 110, 120, 150

Sink Port

PORT1

Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6)

100, 110, 120, 150

----End

9.4.3.7 Configuration Process (Cross-Connections)


This section describes the process for configuring the cross-connections.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services and create the service
cross-connections.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Level

VC12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

4-EFP8-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-20

Sink Slot

2-SP3D

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-20

Activate Immediately

Yes

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Level

VC-12

Direction

Bidirectional

Source Slot

4-EFP8-1

Source VC4

VC4-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

539

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Source Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-20

Sink Slot

2-SP3D

Sink VC4

Sink Timeslot Range(e.g.1,3-6)

1-20

Activate Immediately

Yes

----End

9.4.3.8 Configuration Process (QoS on the EFP8 Board)


This section describes the procedures for configuring QoS on the EFP8 board.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.8.1 Creating a Flow and create the flows.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

Flow Type

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port

PORT1

PORT9

PORT9

PORT9

VLAN ID

150

100

110

120

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

Flow Type

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port

PORT1

PORT1

PORT1

PORT1

VLAN ID

100

110

120

150

Step 2 See A.8.8.3 Creating the CoS and create the CoS.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

540

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Value
4-EFP8

CoS ID

CoS Type

VLAN priority

CoS Parameter

CoS Priority

User Priority 0 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 1 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 2 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 3 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 4 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 5 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 6 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 7 in the VLAN Tag

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CoS ID

CoS Type

VLAN priority

CoS Parameter

CoS Priority

User Priority 0 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 1 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 2 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 3 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 4 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 5 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 6 in the VLAN Tag

User Priority 7 in the VLAN Tag

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

541

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Step 3 See A.8.8.4 Binding the CAR/CoS and bind the CAR/CoS.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

Flow Type

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port

PORT1

PORT9

PORT9

PORT9

C-VLAN

150

100

110

120

Bound CAR

Bound CoS

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
4-EFP8

Flow Type

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port+VLAN
Flow

Port

PORT1

PORT1

PORT1

PORT1

C-VLAN

150

100

110

120

Bound CAR

Bound CoS

----End

9.4.3.9 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.8.9.1 Creating MDs and create the maintenance domain on NE11 and NE17.
The values for the required parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain
Name
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE11

NE17

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

542

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain
Level

NE11

NE17

Step 2 See A.8.9.2 Creating MAs and create the maintenance domain on NE11 and NE17.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS16_Vline

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

BTS16_Vline

Step 3 See A.8.9.3 Creating MPs and create the maintenance domain on NE11 and NE17.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance Domain Name

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association Name

BTS16_Vline

Node

4-EFP8-PORT1

VLAN ID

150

MP ID

101

Type

MEP

Direction

SDH

CC Status

Activate

CCM Sending Period(ms)

1000

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE17 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

543

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDH-Based Ethernet Services

Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11_Vline

BTS12_Vline

BTS15_Vline

BTS16_Vline

Node

4-EFP8PORT1

4-EFP8PORT1

4-EFP8PORT1

4-EFP8PORT1

VLAN ID

100

110

120

150

MP ID

701

702

705

706

Type

MEP

MEP

MEP

MEP

Direction

SDH

SDH

SDH

SDH

CC Status

Activate

Activate

Activate

Activate

CCM Sending
Period(ms)

1000

1000

1000

1000

Step 4 On NE17, perform an LB test to test the Ethernet service configurations.


l Perform the LB test by considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 706 as the source
maintenance point and the maintenance point whose MP ID is 101 as the sink maintenance
point.
l Perform the LB test by considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 701 as the source
maintenance point and the maintenance point whose MP ID is 201 as the sink maintenance
point.
l Perform the LB test by considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 702 as the source
MEP and the maintenance point whose MP ID is 401 as the sink MEP.
l Perform the LB test by considering the maintenance point whose MP ID is 705 as the source
MEP and the maintenance point whose MP ID is 601 as the sink MEP.
NOTE

The sink maintenance points whose MP IDs are 201, 401, and 601 need to be created on NE12 to NE16
respectively. The process for creating these sink maintenance points is not described in this section.

All LB tests should show that the tests are successful.


----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

544

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring MPLS Tunnels

About This Chapter


Configuring MPLS tunnels is the prerequisite for configuring PWE3 services.
10.1 Basic Concept
Before configuring MPLS tunnels, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
10.2 Configuration Procedure
MPLS tunnels can be configured on a per-NE basis.
10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection)
This section uses an example to describe how to configure MPLS tunnels with MPLS APS
protection on a PSN.
10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No Protection)
This section uses an example to describe how to configure MPLS tunnels with no protection on
a PSN.
10.5 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels Traversing L2 Networks)
In this example, the MPLS tunnels traverse an L2 network through VLAN sub-interfaces.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

545

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.1 Basic Concept


Before configuring MPLS tunnels, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

10.1.1 MPLS Network Architecture


An MPLS network, also called an MPLS domain, is a network area that consists of
interconnected label switching routers (LSRs). An LSR, also called an MPLS node, is a network
device that performs MPLS label switching and packet forwarding.
Figure 10-1 shows the MPLS network architecture. On an MPLS network, LSRs on the network
edge are called label edge routers (LERs), and LSRs within the network range are called core
LSRs. An LER may have one or more adjacent non-LSR nodes, but all the adjacent nodes of a
core LSR are LSRs.
Figure 10-1 MPLS network architecture

LER
Other
MPLS
network

LER

LSR

MPLS
network

Core LSR

LSR

Other
MPLS
network
LER

LER

Other
MPLS
network

Packet transmission equipment

On an MPLS network, each LSR has a unique identifier; that is, a 16-byte LSR ID. An LSR ID
can be based on the IPv4 address or IPv6 address.
NOTE

Currently, the OptiX RTN 980 supports only LSR IDs based on the IPv4 address.

10.1.2 LSP
Label switched paths (LSPs), also called MPLS tunnels, are classified into various types
depending on different classification criteria.

Basic Concepts of LSPs


On an MPLS network, an LSR adopts the same label switching mechanism to forward packets
with the same characteristics. The packets with the same characteristics are called a forwarding
equivalence class (FEC). The path along which an FEC travels through the MPLS network is
called an LSP, or an MPLS tunnel.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

546

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

To provide a unified interface for upper-level applications of an LSP, the system needs to assign
an ID to the LSP. This ID is called an LSP ID or tunnel ID. An LSP ID is 4-byte long, and is
only valid for the local LSR.
An LSP is unidirectional. As shown in Figure 10-2, LSRs on an LSP can be classified into the
following types:
l

Ingress
An LSP ingress node pushes a label onto the packet for MPLS packet encapsulation and
forwarding. One LSP has only one ingress node.

Transit
An LSP transit node swaps labels and forwards MPLS packets according to the label
forwarding table. One LSP may have one or more transits nodes.

Egress
An LSP egress node pops the label and recovers the packet for forwarding. One LSP has
only one egress node.

Figure 10-2 Classification of LSRs on an LSP

MPLS
network
Other
MPLS
network

Ingress

Transit

Transit

Egress

Other
MPLS
network

LSP

Packet transmission equipment

LSP Types
LSPs are classified into various types depending on different classification criteria. For details,
see Table 10-1.
Table 10-1 LSP types

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Aspect

LSP Type

Definition

Support
Capability

Setup mode

Static tunnel

A static tunnel is set


up according to the
data configurations.

The OptiX RTN 980


supports static
tunnels.

Dynamic tunnel

A dynamic tunnel is
set up by running the
Label Distribution
Protocol (LDP).

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

547

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Aspect

LSP Type

Definition

Support
Capability

Direction

Unidirectional
tunnel

A unidirectional
tunnel is an LSP with
one specific
direction.

The OptiX RTN 980


supports both types.

Bidirectional tunnel

A bidirectional
tunnel is actually a
pair of LSPs that
have the same path
but different
directions.

E-LSP

An E-LSP uses the


EXP field for
prioritizing packet
scheduling. One ELSP supports PWs
belonging to up to
eight scheduling
types.

DiffServ
identification mode

LSP mode

L-LSP

An L-LSP uses the


MPLS label value for
prioritizing packet
scheduling priority.
One L-LSP supports
PWs belonging to
one scheduling type.

Uniform

When an egress node


pops the MPLS
tunnel label, it
renews the packet
scheduling priority
according to the EXP
field in the label.

Pipe

When an egress pops


the MPLS tunnel
label, it does not
renew the packet
scheduling priority.

The OptiX RTN 980


supports both types.
However, the OptiX
RTN 980 does not
support prioritizing
packet discarding.

The OptiX RTN 980


supports the Pipe
mode only.

10.1.3 Protection for MPLS Tunnels


The OptiX RTN 980 supports 1:1 MPLS APS.
MPLS APS is a function that protects MPLS tunnels based on the APS protocol. MPLS APS
improves reliability for service transmission in tunnels. With this function, when the working
tunnel is faulty, the service can be switched to the preconfigured protection tunnel.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

548

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

The MPLS APS function supported by the OptiX RTN 980 has the following characteristics:
l

MPLS APS provides end-to-end protection for tunnels.

The working tunnel and protection tunnel have the same ingress and egress nodes.

The protection tunnel in an MPLS APS protection group does not carry extra traffic.

In MPLS APS, the MPLS OAM mechanism is used to detect faults in tunnels, and the ingress
and egress nodes exchange APS protocol packets to achieve protection switching. As shown in
Figure 10-3, when the MPLS OAM mechanism detects a fault in the working tunnel, the service
is switched to the protection tunnel for transmission.
Figure 10-3 MPLS APS
Transit

Working Tunnel
Ingress

Egress
Protection Tunnel

Transit
Protect switching
Transit

Working Tunnel
Ingress

Egress
Protection Tunnel

Transit
Service
Packet transmission equipment

10.2 Configuration Procedure


MPLS tunnels can be configured on a per-NE basis.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

549

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.2.1 End-to-End Configuration Procedure


This section describes the procedures for configuring MPLS tunnels in an end-to-end mode,
MPLS ports, and QoS policies on MPLS ports, and the procedure for verifying the
configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 10-4 provides the procedures for configuring MPLS tunnels in an end-to-end mode.
Figure 10-4 Configuration flowchart
Required

Start

Start

Optional

Set MPLS port


attributes (not using
VLAN sub-interfaces)

Set MPLS port


attributes (using VLAN
sub-interfaces)

Create LAG for MPLS


Ports

Create LAG for MPLS


Ports

Create MPLS tunnels

Create MPLS tunnels

Create MPLS
protection groups

Create MPLS
protection groups

Set the QoS policy for


MPLS ports

Set the QoS policy for


MPLS ports

Verify configured
MPLS tunnels

Verify configured
MPLS tunnels

End

End

NOTE

If MPLS tunnels have been configured on a per-NE basis before end-to-end configuration, follow the instructions
in A.13.2 Searching for MPLS Tunnels and PWE3 Services to synchronize the tunnels to the network layer
of the U2000. This enables end-to-end management of the MPLS tunnels. If MPLS APS protection groups have
been configured on a per-NE basis before en-to-end configuration, follow the instructions in A.13.3.8 Searching
for MPLS APS Protection Groups to synchronize the protection groups to the network layer of the U2000.

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

550

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Procedure for Configuring MPLS Ports (not Using VLAN Sub-Interfaces)


Table 10-2 Procedure for configuring MPLS ports (Using VLAN Sub-Interfaces)
Operation

Description

A.13.3.1 Configuring Port IP


Address Resources

Required when IP addresses of MPLS ports are


automatically allocated when operations in A.2.5.2
Creating Fibers Manually are performed.

Configuring
Ethernet
ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

l For ports to be used, set Enable Port to Enabled.


For ports not to be used, set Enable Port to
Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 3.
l For Ethernet ports that are connect to external
equipment, set Working Mode to the same value as
that of the external equipment (the working mode of
the external equipment is generally autonegotiation). For Ethernet ports used for connection
within the network, set Working Mode to AutoNegotiation.
l It is recommended that you set Max Frame Length
(byte) to 1620.
NOTE
If operations in A.2.5.2 Creating Fibers Manually are
performed, you do not need to set Port Mode.

A.6.6.2
Configuring the
Traffic Control
of Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on


the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is
connected. Set the parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the autonegotiation flow control function, set AutoNegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

551

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.6.4 Setting
Layer 3
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required if the NE at either end of an MPLS link cannot


be managed on the U2000.
l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to
Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Enable Tunnel on the main port to Enabled, and set
Enable Tunnel on the slave port to Disabled (the default
value).

l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP


Address of each port according to planning
information. The IP addresses of different MPLS
ports on the NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the ports at both
ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same network
segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Optional.

A.2.5.2 Creating
Fibers Manually

Required if NEs at two ends of an MPLS link can be


managed on the U2000. Set the parameters as follows:
l If MPLS ports are connected through optical fibers,
set Fiber/Cable Type to Fiber; if MPLS ports are
connected through electrical cables, set Fiber/Cable
Type to Cable.
l Set Automatically Allocate IP Address to Yes.

Configuring
IF_ETH
ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required.
Set Port Mode to Layer 3.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

552

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.7.3 Setting
Layer 3
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to
Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Enable Tunnel on the main port to Enabled, and set
Enable Tunnel on the slave port to Disabled (the default
value).

l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP


Address of each port according to planning
information. The IP addresses of different MPLS
ports on the NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the ports at both
ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same network
segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Optional. In the following scenarios, parameters need to


be modified.
l If services transmitted through MPLS ports tolerate
some bit errors, set Error Frame Discard
Enabled to Disabled.
l For the ISU2/ISX2, it is recommended that you set
Speed Transmission at L2 and Speed
Transmission at L3 to Enabled, if the related
permission to the two functions has already been
obtained. Set the same parameter values at both ends
of a microwave link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

553

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring MPLS Ports (Using VLAN Sub-Interfaces)


Table 10-3 Procedure for configuring MPLS ports (using VLAN sub-interfaces)
Operation
Setting
attributes of
Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l For ports to be used, set Enable Port to Enabled.
For ports not to be used, set Enable Port to
Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Hybrid.
l For Ethernet ports that are connect to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value
as the external equipment (the working mode of the
external equipment is generally auto-negotiation).
For Ethernet ports used for connection within the
network, set Working Mode to Auto-negotiation.
l Set Max Frame Length(byte) according to the
service packet length. It is recommended that you set
Max Frame Length(byte) to 1620.

A.6.6.2
Configuring the
Traffic Control
of Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on


the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is
connected. Set the major parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the autonegotiation flow control function, set AutoNegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

554

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.10 Creating
VLAN SubInterfaces

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set Port Type to VLAN Sub Interface.
l Set Board, Port, and VLAN according to network
planning information.
l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP
Address for each port according to the planning
information. The IP addresses of different MPLS
ports on the NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the ports at both
ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same network
segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to


Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

Setting
attributes of
IF_ETH
ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


Set Port Mode to Hybrid.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

555

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.10 Creating
VLAN SubInterfaces

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set Port Type to VLAN Sub Interface.
l Set Board, Port, and VLAN according to network
planning information.
l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP
Address for each port according to the planning
information. The IP addresses of different MPLS
ports on the NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the ports at both
ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same network
segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to


Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Optional. In the following scenarios, parameter values


need to be modified.
l If services transmitted through MPLS ports tolerate
some bit errors, set Error Frame Discard
Enabled to Disabled.
l For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if Speed Transmission at
L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 are allowed, set
them to Enabled. Set the same parameter values at
both ends of a microwave link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

556

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring LAG on MPLS Ports


Table 10-4 Procedure for configuring LAG on MPLS ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the major
parameters as follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite
equipment. If the LAG is configured to provide protection, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the
equipment at both ends. If the LAG is configured to provide protection
and to increase bandwidths, it is recommended that you set Load
Sharing to Sharing for the equipment at both ends.
l When the Integrated IP radio works in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG
protection, set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment at both
ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid only to the non-sharing LAG.
l Load Sharing Hash Algorithm takes the default value of
Automatic. This parameter is valid only to the load-sharing LAG.
l It is recommended that you set these parameters to the same value for
the main and slave ports of the LAGs at both ends. In this case, you can
set System Priority as desired. It is recommended that this parameter
takes its default value. This parameter is valid only to the static LAG.
l During the configuration of LAG at air interfaces, if LAG switching
needs to be triggered when signals on the microwave link deteriorate,
set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the planning information. It is recommended that you set this
parameter to the same value for the main and slave ports of the LAGs
at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

557

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Creating MPLS Tunnels


Table 10-5 Creating MPLS tunnels
Operation

Description

A.9.2.1 Setting Basic


MPLS Attributes

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set LSR ID according to planning information and ensure that
the value is unique on the entire network.
l Set Start of Global Label Space according to the network
planning information. The label space configured must be wider
than or equal to the planned label range.

A.9.1.1 Creating
ARP Static Entries

Required when the dynamic ARP protocol cannot obtain the nexthop MAC address (for example, when traversing an L2 network).
Set the parameters as follows:
l ARP List IP Address: Set this parameter to the IP address of
the next-hop port.
l ARP List MAC: Set this parameter to the MAC address of the
next-hop port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.13.3.2 Creating L2
Links

If the NEs at two ends of an MPLS link can be managed on the


U2000, the link needs to be created with L2 links. In this case, the
automatic link computation function can be used to create MPLS
tunnels.

A.13.3.3 Creating
Non-Protection
MPLS Tunnels (in an
End-to-End Mode)
orA.13.3.4 Creating
MPLS Tunnels
Configured with
MPLS APS
Protection in an Endto-End Mode

Required.

A.9.2.5 Changing
MPLS Tunnel
Information

Perform this operation to set a VLAN ID for related MPLS nodes if


packets in a link of an MPLS tunnel need to traverse an L2 network.

Set related parameters according to the tunnel planning information


and parameter planning information.
NOTE
For end-to-end configuration of MPLS tunnels, the OptiX RTN 980 supports
MPLS tunnels whose scheduling type is E-LSP.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

558

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring QoS on an MPLS Port


Table 10-6 Procedure for configuring QoS on an MPLS port
Operation
Configuring
the Diffserv

Configuring
the port
policy

Description
A.7.7.2
Modifying
the
Mapping
Relationshi
ps for the
DS Domain

When the default mapping between the DS domain and the


PHBs does not meet network requirements, perform this
operation to change the mapping.

A.7.7.3
Changing
the Ports
Applied to a
DS Domain
and Their
Trusted
Packet
Types

Required.

A.7.7.4
Creating a
Port Policy

Required when the queue scheduling algorithm needs to be


changed or the shaping function needs to be enabled for the
egress queues at an MPLS port.

Set Packet Type for each MPLS port to MPLS-EXP.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.
A.7.7.7
Setting the
Port That
Uses the
Port Policy
A.7.7.8 Configuring Port
Shaping

Required if a port policy is created.


Set the parameters according to the network planning
information.

Required when the shaping function needs to be configured.


Set the parameters according to the network planning
information.

Verifying MPLS Tunnels


Table 10-7 Verifying MPLS tunnels

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Operation

Description

A.13.3.5 Verifying
MPLS Tunnels in an
End-to-End Mode

Required. It is recommended that you perform an LSP ping test to


verify that the MPLS tunnel is available.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

559

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.2.2 Configuration Procedure (on a Per-NE Basis)


This section describes the procedures for configuring MPLS tunnels, MPLS OAM, MPLS APS,
and QoS, and the procedure for verifying the configurations.
Figure 10-5 provides the procedures for configuring MPLS tunnels.
Figure 10-5 Configuration flowchart (MPLS tunnels)
Required

Start

Start

Optional

Set MPLS port


attributes (not using
VLAN sub-interfaces)

Set MPLS port


attributes (using VLAN
sub-interfaces)

Create LAG for MPLS


Ports

Create LAG for MPLS


Ports

Create MPLS tunnels

Create MPLS tunnels

Create MPLS
protection groups

Create MPLS
protection groups

Set the QoS policy for


MPLS ports

Set the QoS policy for


MPLS ports

Verify configured
MPLS tunnels

Verify configured
MPLS tunnels

End

End

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

560

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Table 10-8 Procedure for setting MPLS port attributes (not using VLAN sub-interfaces)
Operation
Setting
attributes of
Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l For ports to be used, set Enable Port to Enabled.
For ports not to be used, set Enable Port to
Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 3.
l For Ethernet ports that are connect to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value
as the external equipment (the working mode of the
external equipment is generally auto-negotiation).
For Ethernet ports used for connection within the
network, set Working Mode to Auto-negotiation.
l Set Max Frame Length(byte) according to the
service packet length. It is recommended that you set
Max Frame Length(byte) to 1620.

A.6.6.2
Configuring the
Traffic Control
of Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on


the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is
connected. Set the major parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the autonegotiation flow control function, set AutoNegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.

A.6.6.4 Setting
Layer 3
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to
Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Enable Tunnel on the main port to Enabled, and set
Enable Tunnel on the slave port to Disabled (the default
value).

l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP


Address of each port according to the planning
information. The IP addresses of different ports on
the NE must be in different network segments, but
the IP addresses of the ports at both ends of the MPLS
tunnel must be in the same network segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

561

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

Setting
attributes of
IF_ETH
ports

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:

A.6.7.3 Setting
Layer 3
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:

Set Port Mode to Layer 3.

l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to


Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Enable Tunnel on the main port to Enabled, and set
Enable Tunnel on the slave port to Disabled (the default
value).

l Set Specify IP Address and IP Address according


to the planning information. The IP addresses of
different ports on the NE must be in different
network segments, but the IP addresses of the ports
at both ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same
network segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Optional. In the following scenarios, parameter values


need to be modified.
l If services transmitted through MPLS ports tolerate
some bit errors, set Error Frame Discard
Enabled to Disabled.
l For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if Speed Transmission at
L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 are allowed, set
them to Enabled. Set the same parameter values at
both ends of a microwave link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

562

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring MPLS Ports (Using VLAN Sub-Interfaces)


Table 10-9 Procedure for configuring MPLS ports (using VLAN sub-interfaces)
Operation
Setting
attributes of
Ethernet
ports

Description
A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l For ports to be used, set Enable Port to Enabled.
For ports not to be used, set Enable Port to
Disabled.
l Set Port Mode to Hybrid.
l For Ethernet ports that are connect to external
equipment, set Working Mode to be the same value
as the external equipment (the working mode of the
external equipment is generally auto-negotiation).
For Ethernet ports used for connection within the
network, set Working Mode to Auto-negotiation.
l Set Max Frame Length(byte) according to the
service packet length. It is recommended that you set
Max Frame Length(byte) to 1620.

A.6.6.2
Configuring the
Traffic Control
of Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on


the external equipment to which the Ethernet port is
connected. Set the major parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-autonegotiation flow control function, set NonAutonegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.
l When the external equipment uses the autonegotiation flow control function, set AutoNegotiation Flow Control Mode to Enable
Symmetric Flow Control.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

563

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.10 Creating
VLAN SubInterfaces

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set Port Type to VLAN Sub Interface.
l Set Board, Port, and VLAN according to network
planning information.
l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP
Address for each port according to the planning
information. The IP addresses of different MPLS
ports on the NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the ports at both
ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same network
segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to


Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

Setting
attributes of
IF_ETH
ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Optional.

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


Set Port Mode to Hybrid.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

564

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Description
A.6.10 Creating
VLAN SubInterfaces

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set Port Type to VLAN Sub Interface.
l Set Board, Port, and VLAN according to network
planning information.
l Set Specify IP Address to Manually. Set IP
Address for each port according to the planning
information. The IP addresses of different MPLS
ports on the NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the ports at both
ends of the MPLS tunnel must be in the same network
segment.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

l For ports to be used, set Enable Tunnel to


Enabled.
NOTE
If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set
Specify IP Address on the main port to Manually, and set
Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Optional. In the following scenarios, parameter values


need to be modified.
l If services transmitted through MPLS ports tolerate
some bit errors, set Error Frame Discard
Enabled to Disabled.
l For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if Speed Transmission at
L2 and Speed Transmission at L3 are allowed, set
them to Enabled. Set the same parameter values at
both ends of a microwave link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

565

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring LAG on MPLS Ports


Table 10-10 Procedure for configuring LAG on MPLS ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the major
parameters as follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as the opposite equipment. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static for the equipment at both ends.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as the opposite
equipment. If the LAG is configured to provide protection, it is
recommended that you set Load Sharing to Non-Sharing for the
equipment at both ends. If the LAG is configured to provide protection
and to increase bandwidths, it is recommended that you set Load
Sharing to Sharing for the equipment at both ends.
l When the Integrated IP radio works in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG
protection, set Load Sharing to Sharing for the equipment at both
ends.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as the opposite equipment.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive for the equipment at both
ends. This parameter is valid only to the non-sharing LAG.
l Load Sharing Hash Algorithm takes the default value of
Automatic. This parameter is valid only to the load-sharing LAG.
l It is recommended that you set these parameters to the same value for
the main and slave ports of the LAGs at both ends. In this case, you can
set System Priority as desired. It is recommended that this parameter
takes its default value. This parameter is valid only to the static LAG.
l During the configuration of LAG at air interfaces, if LAG switching
needs to be triggered when signals on the microwave link deteriorate,
set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the planning information. It is recommended that you set this
parameter to the same value for the main and slave ports of the LAGs
at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

566

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring an MPLS Tunnel


Table 10-11 Procedure for configuring an MPLS tunnel
Operation

Description

A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS


Attributes

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l Set LSR ID according to the planning information
and ensure that the value is unique on the entire
network.
l Set Start of Global Label Space according to the
planning information. On an MPLS network, global
label spaces of NEs are recommended to overlap
each other if possible.

Configuring
an MPLS
tunnel

A.9.2.2 Creating
a Unidirectional
MPLS Tunnel

Required if you need to configure a unidirectional


MPLS tunnel.

A.9.2.3 Creating
a Bidirectional
MPLS Tunnel

Required if you need to configure a bidirectional MPLS


tunnel.

A.9.1.1 Creating ARP Static


Entries

Set the parameters according to the planning


information.

Set the parameters according to the planning


information.
Required when the dynamic ARP protocol cannot obtain
the next-hop MAC address (for example, when
traversing an L2 network). Set the major parameters as
follows:
l ARP List IP Address: Set this parameter to the IP
address of the next-hop port.
l ARP List MAC: Set this parameter to the MAC
address of the next-hop port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

567

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Configuring MPLS Protection


Table 10-12 Procedure for configuring MPLS protection
Operation

Description

A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM


Parameters

Required when you need to configure an MPLS APS


protection group.
l For a bidirectional MPLS tunnel, set the major
parameters as follows:
Set OAM Status to Enabled for a tunnel where
an OAM test needs to be performed.
It is recommended that you set Detection Mode
to Auto-Sensing.
When you need to create an MPLS APS
protection group, set Detection Packet Type to
FFD and set Detection Packet Period(ms) to
3.3. This ensures that the switching time is less
than 100 ms.
Set SD Threshold and SF Threshold as
required.
l For the ingress node of a unidirectional MPLS
tunnel, set the major parameters as follows:
Set OAM Status to Enabled for a tunnel where
an OAM test needs to be performed.
When you need to create an MPLS APS
protection group, set Detection Packet Type to
FFD and set Detection Packet Period(ms) to
3.3. This ensures that the switching time is less
than 100 ms.
Select the corresponding reverse tunnel.
l For the egress node of a unidirectional MPLS tunnel,
set the major parameters as follows:
Set OAM Status to Enabled for a tunnel where
an OAM test needs to be performed.
It is recommended that you set Detection Mode
to Auto-Sensing.
Select the corresponding reverse tunnel.
Set SD Threshold and SF Threshold as
required.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

568

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Operation

Description

A.9.3.1 Creating an MPLS APS


Protection Group

Required when you need to configure protection for


services carried on an MPLS tunnel.
l The protection tunnel must be created.
l When creating an APS protection group, set
Protocol Status to Disabled. Start the protocol only
when the APS protection group is successfully
created on nodes at both ends.
l Set the parameters of the protection group according
to the planning information.

Configuring QoS on an MPLS Port


Table 10-13 Procedure for configuring QoS on an MPLS port
Operation
Configuring
the Diffserv

Configuring
the port
policy

Description
A.7.7.2
Modifying
the
Mapping
Relationshi
ps for the
DS Domain

When the default mapping between the DS domain and the


PHBs does not meet network requirements, perform this
operation to change the mapping.

A.7.7.3
Changing
the Ports
Applied to a
DS Domain
and Their
Trusted
Packet
Types

Required.

A.7.7.4
Creating a
Port Policy

Required when the queue scheduling algorithm needs to be


changed or the shaping function needs to be enabled for the
egress queues at an MPLS port.

Set Packet Type for each MPLS port to MPLS-EXP.

Set the parameters according to the network planning


information.
A.7.7.7
Setting the
Port That
Uses the
Port Policy

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required if a port policy is created.


Set the parameters according to the network planning
information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

569

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Operation

Description

A.7.7.8 Configuring Port


Shaping

Required when the shaping function needs to be configured.


Set the parameters according to the network planning
information.

Verifying an MPLS tunnel


Table 10-14 Procedure for verifying an MPLS tunnel
Operation

Description

A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM


Parameters

Required. Before you create an MPLS APS protection


group, you need to enable the MPLS OAM function to
detect the tunnel status.
When you need to check availability of an MPLS tunnel,
it is recommended that you set Detection Packet
Type to CV.

A.9.2.10 Querying LSP Running


Status

Required.

10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS


APS Protection)
This section uses an example to describe how to configure MPLS tunnels with MPLS APS
protection on a PSN.

10.3.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
All base station services need to be transmitted through a PSN to the BSC and RNC. Based on
6.7 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Packet Network), configure MPLS tunnels
on the packet ring according to the following actual requirements:
l

Bidirectional MPLS tunnels are configured between NE31 and NE11, between NE31 and
NE21, and between NE31 and NE32.

MPLS APS protection is configured for each tunnel on the packet ring to ensure service
availability upon a tunnel fault.

MPLS interfaces used on the packet ring are shown in Figure 10-6.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

570

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Figure 10-6 Networking diagram (packet ring network)


NE34
NE33

17-EG2D-1(to NE11)
17-EG2D-2(to NE31)
GE

GE
NE32

NE11
17-EG2D-1(to NE21)

1-EM6F-1(to NE32)
NE31

GE

NE21

1-EM6F-2(to NE21)

GE

17-EG2D-2(to NE32)
17-EG2D-1(to NE31)
17-EG2D-2(to NE11)

10.3.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

10.3.2.1 Service Planning (MPLS Interfaces)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring MPLS
interfaces.
Table 10-15 to Table 10-18 provide the information about each NNI port involved in the service.
Table 10-15 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE31)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

Port name

conn_NE32

conn_NE21

Port enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Port mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1620

1620

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Manually

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

571

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

Port IP address

46.1.64.1

46.1.64.14

IP mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Loopback check

Disabled

Disabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Disabled

Disabled

Table 10-16 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE32)


Parameter

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Port name

conn_NE11

conn_NE31

Port enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Port mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1620

1620

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.5

46.1.64.2

IP mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Loopback check

Disabled

Disabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Disabled

Disabled

Table 10-17 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Port name

conn_NE21

conn_NE32

Port enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Port mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

572

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1620

1620

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.9

46.1.64.6

IP mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Loopback check

Disabled

Disabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Disabled

Disabled

Table 10-18 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Port name

conn_NE31

conn_NE11

Port enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Port mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1620

1620

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.13

46.1.64.10

IP mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Loopback check

Disabled

Disabled

Loopback port shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

Enabling broadcast packet


suppression

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

573

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

NOTE

l Appropriate port names facilitate future maintenance. It is recommended that you name ports on the entire
network in a unified manner.
l In this example, all GE ports on the packet network are set to the auto-negotiation mode.
l The maximum frame length for each MPLS interface is set to 1620, because an Ethernet frame carrying
MPLS packet is longer than a Native Ethernet frame.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only when the local NE or opposite equipment has insufficient
QoS capabilities. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l An MPLS interface does not carry E-LAN services, so the loopback check, loopback port shutdown, and
broadcast packet suppression functions do not need to be enabled for Ethernet ports.
l During end-to-end configuration, port IP addresses are automatically allocated when the MPLS interfaces
are Ethernet ports. So, the port IP address is planned only when the configuration is on the per-NE basis.
The port IP addresses available for end-to-end configuration are 46.1.64.0 to 46.1.64.15.

10.3.2.2 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring MPLS tunnels.

Basic NE Configuration
Before creating an MPLS tunnel, you need to assign an LSR ID for each NE as its unique ID on
the network. See Table 10-19.
Table 10-19 Basic NE configuration
Parameter

NE31

NE32

NE11

NE21

LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

Start of global
label space

NOTE

The LSR ID of NE32 planned in this example is the same as that planned in 10.4 Configuration Example
(MPLS Tunnels with No Protection).

Information About MPLS Tunnels


Table 10-20 provides basic information about the working and protection tunnels between NE31
and NE32, between NE31 and NE11, and between NE31 and NE21.
Table 10-20 Basic information about MPLS tunnels
Parameter
Working
tunnel

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

Tunnel name

NE31-NE32-W

NE31-NE11-W

NE31-NE21-W

Tunnel ID

1501

1503

1505

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

574

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter
Protection
tunnel

Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

Tunnel name

NE31-NE32-P

NE31-NE11-P

NE31-NE21-P

Tunnel ID

1507

1509

1511

NE31

NE31

NE31

Ingress node of the forward


working tunnel

NOTE

l Tunnel name planning is performed only for per-NE configuration. For end-to-end configuration, tunnel
names are automatically generated by the U2000 according to the naming rules.
l In this example, tunnel IDs and MPLS labels are planned in a unified manner. For end-to-end configuration,
these parameters can be automatically assigned by the U2000.

Figure 10-7 shows the specific tunnel information.


Figure 10-7 MPLS tunnel planning
Links-1: NE31 - NE32 - NE11 -NE21 -NE31
NE31
(130.0.0.1)

NE32
(130.0.0..2)

1-EM6F-1
(46.1.64.1)

17-EG2D-2 17-EG2D-1
(46.1.64.2) (46.1.64.5)

L:1505

ID:1503

L:1506
L:1503

NE31
(130.0.0.1)

NE21
(130.0.0.4)

1-EM6F-2
(46.1.64.14)

17-EG2D-2 17-EG2D-1
(46.1.64.6) (46.1.64.9)

17-EG2D-2 17-EG2D-1
(46.1.64.10) (46.1.64.13)

L:1501 L:1507

L:1507 L:1501
L:1508 L:1502

L:1501 L:1507
L:1502 L:1508

ID:1507

L:1502

ID:1509

L:1509
L:1510

ID:1505

L:1511

ID:1501

L:1501
L:1502

NE11
(130.0.0.3)

L:1508

L:1509

L:1503

L:1505 L:1509
L:1506 L:1510

L:1510 L:1504

L:1503 L:1509
L:1504 L:1510

L:1503 L:1511
L:1504 L:1512

L:1511 L:1505
L:1512 L:1506

L:1505 L:1511
L:1506 L:1512

ID:1511

L:1504

L:1507
L:1508

L:1512

Ingress/Egress
L:

Label
Working tunnel
Protection tunnel

NOTE

l Next Hop Address represents the port IP address of the next-hop node. In Figure 10-7, the IP addresses
under board names are port IP addresses.
l For end-to-end configuration, the IP addresses of ports are automatically assigned.
l Generally, it is recommended that you set CIR(kbit/s) to No Limit. If you need to enable the CES
CAC function or limit the PW bandwidth, set this parameter to be the same as the planned tunnel
bandwidth.

10.3.2.3 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel APS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring MPLS tunnel APS.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

575

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Information About MPLS OAM


MPLS APS is configured on the packet ring network to improve service reliability. Before
creating an MPLS APS protection group, you need to enable the MPLS OAM function. Table
10-21 to Table 10-24 provide the planning information about MPLS OAM.
Table 10-21 Information about MPLS OAM (NE31)
Paramete
r

Between NE31 and


NE32

Between NE31 and


NE11

Between NE31 and


NE21

Tunnel ID

1501

1507

1503

1509

1505

1511

OAM
status

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Detection
mode

Autosensing

Autosensing

Autosensing

Autosensing

Autosensing

Autosensing

Detection
packet
type

FFD

FFD

FFD

FFD

FFD

FFD

Detection
packet
period
(ms)

3.3

3.3

3.3

3.3

3.3

3.3

Table 10-22 Information about MPLS OAM (NE32)


Parameter

Between NE31 and NE32

Tunnel ID

1501

1507

OAM status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection mode

Auto-sensing

Auto-sensing

Detection packet type

FFD

FFD

Detection packet period (ms)

3.3

3.3

Table 10-23 Information about MPLS OAM (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Between NE31 and NE11

Tunnel ID

1503

1509

Node type

Egress

Egress

OAM status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection mode

Auto-sensing

Auto-sensing

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

576

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Between NE31 and NE11

Detection packet type

FFD

FFD

Detection packet period (ms)

3.3

3.3

Table 10-24 Information about MPLS OAM (NE21)


Parameter

Between NE31 and NE21

Tunnel ID

1505

1511

OAM status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection mode

Auto-sensing

Auto-sensing

Detection packet type

FFD

FFD

Detection packet period (ms)

3.3

3.3

Information About MPLS APS Protection Groups


Based on the planning MPLS tunnel information, MPLS APS protection groups are planned as
shown Table 10-25 to Table 10-28.
Table 10-25 Information about MPLS APS protection groups (NE31)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Between NE31 and


NE32

Between NE31 and


NE11

Between NE31 and


NE21

Tunnel type

MPLS tunnel

MPLS tunnel

MPLS tunnel

Working ingress
tunnel ID

1501

1503

1505

Working egress
tunnel ID

1501

1503

1505

Protection ingress
tunnel ID

1507

1509

1511

Protection egress
tunnel ID

1507

1509

1511

Protection type

1:1 dual-ended
revertive mode

1:1 dual-ended
revertive mode

1:1 dual-ended
revertive mode

WTR time (m)

Hold-off time

Protocol status

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

577

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Table 10-26 Information about MPLS APS protection groups (NE32)


Parameter

Between NE31 and NE32

Tunnel type

MPLS tunnel

Working ingress tunnel ID

1501

Working egress tunnel ID

1501

Protection ingress tunnel ID

1507

Protection egress tunnel ID

1507

Protection type

1:1 dual-ended revertive mode

WTR time (m)

Hold-off time

Protocol status

Disabled

Table 10-27 Information about MPLS APS protection groups (NE11)


Parameter

Between NE31 and NE11

Tunnel type

MPLS tunnel

Working ingress tunnel ID

1503

Working egress tunnel ID

1503

Protection ingress tunnel ID

1509

Protection egress tunnel ID

1509

Protection type

1:1 dual-ended revertive mode

WTR time (m)

Hold-off time

Protocol status

Disabled

Table 10-28 Information about MPLS APS protection groups (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Between NE31 and NE21

Tunnel type

MPLS tunnel

Working ingress tunnel ID

1505

Working egress tunnel ID

1505

Protection ingress tunnel ID

1511

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

578

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Between NE31 and NE21

Protection egress tunnel ID

1511

Protection type

1:1 dual-ended revertive mode

WTR time (m)

Hold-off time

Protocol status

Disabled

NOTE

In this example, MPLS APS is configured as the only protection scheme on the packet ring network.
Therefore, set Hold-Time(100ms) to 0.

10.3.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS for
MPLS interface.
NOTE

The NEs in this example and in 10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No Protection) are on the
same MPLS network, so the QoS planning for the NEs is the same.

QoS (DiffServ)
Differentiated service (DiffServ) configuration is essential to QoS configuration. For the OptiX
RTN 980, all the ports that transmit a service must be in the same DS domain. Therefore, DiffServ
information is planned in a unified manner. Table 10-29 lists the mapping between the DS
domain and PHB service classes.
Table 10-29 Classes of Service and PHB Service Classes

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service
Class

VLAN
Priority

DSCP

MPLS EXP
Priority

Correspondin
g Service
Category

CS7

56

CS6

48

EF

40

Real-time voice
service and
signaling
service (R99
conversational
and R99
streaming
services)

AF4

32

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

579

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

PHB Service
Class

VLAN
Priority

DSCP

MPLS EXP
Priority

Correspondin
g Service
Category

AF3

24

OM, real-time
HSDPA
services (OM,
HSPA
streaming)

AF2

16

R99 non-realtime services


(R99 interactive
and R99
background
services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data
services (HSPA
interactive and
HSPA
background
services)

NOTE

During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 is not recommended, because CS7 may be used to transmit
Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified. Set the type of trusted packet at an MPLS interface to MPLS EXP.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 10-30 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 10-30 Queue scheduling mode

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

580

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

10.3.3 End-to-End Configuration Procedure


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS tunnel parameters in an end-to-end
mode.

10.3.3.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Ports)


This section describes how to configure MPLS ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.3.1 Configuring Port IP Address Resources and configure MPLS ports.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Name

Start IP Address

End IP Address

ETH_PORT_IP

46.1.64.0

46.1.64.15

Step 2 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic port attributes.
l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

Name

conn_NE32

conn_NE21

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Name
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

conn_NE11

conn_NE31

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

581

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Name

conn_NE21

conn_NE32

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Name

conn_NE31

conn_NE11

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

Step 3 See A.2.5.2 Creating Fibers Manually and perform accordingly.


The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

582

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
GE optical
fibers
between NE31
and NE32

GE optical
fibers
between NE32
and NE11

GE optical
fibers
between NE11
and NE21

GE optical
fibers
between NE21
and NE31

Fiber/Cable
Type

Optical fibers

Optical fibers

Optical fibers

Optical fibers

Source NE

NE31

NE32

NE11

NE21

Source NE
Subrack-SlotBoard TypePort

1-EM6F-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

Sink NE

NE32

NE11

NE21

NE31

Sink NESubrack-SlotBoard TypePort

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

1-EM6F-2

Automatically
Allocate IP
Address

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

----End

10.3.3.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes how to configure MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes and set the LSR ID for each NE.
The values for the related parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE32

NE11

NE21

LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

Start of Global
Label Space

Step 2 See A.13.3.2 Creating L2 Links and configure MPLS tunnels.


The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

583

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Link Type

Source NE

Source Port

Sink NE

Sink Port

L2 Link

NE31

1-EM6F-1

NE32

17-EG2D-2

L2 Link

NE32

17-EG2D-1

NE11

17-EG2D-2

L2 Link

NE11

17-EG2D-1

NE21

17-EG2D-2

L2 Link

NE21

17-EG2D-1

NE31

1-EM6F-2

Step 3 See A.13.3.4 Creating MPLS Tunnels Configured with MPLS APS Protection in an Endto-End Mode and perform accordingly.
1.

Choose Service > Tunnel > Create Tunnel from the Main Menu.

2.

Set attributes for MPLS tunnels.

3.

Configure on the nodes at both ends of an MPLS tunnel.


a.

Click Add > NE.

b.

In the Select NE dialog box that is displayed, select NE11, NE21, NE31, and NE32,
and click

4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click NE Role. Set NE31 as Ingress, set NE11 as Egress, and set NE32 and
NE21 as Transit.

Configure a route for the tunnel using the automatic route computation function.
a.

Select Auto-Calculate route.

b.

Set Restriction Bandwidth(kbit/s) to No Limit.

c.

Double-click the ingress NE (NE31), and then the egress NE (NE11) in the Physical
Topology tab page on the right.

d.

If NE32 is not on the working tunnel, right-click NE32. Choose Set Working Explicit
Route > NE from the shortcut menu to set NE32 as the explicit node of the working
tunnel.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

584

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5.

6.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Set information about the tunnels and the MPLS OAM used for MPLS APS protection.
a.

Click Details.

b.

Set information about the working tunnel in the Working Tunnel tab page on the
right.

c.

Click Configure OAM. In the dialog box displayed, set OAM parameters and click
OK.

d.

Repeat steps 3.5.b and 3.5.c to set information about protection tunnels and OAM i
the Protection Tunnel tab page according to planning information.

Click Configure Protection Group. In the dialog box displayed, set attributes about MPLS
APS protection groups and click OK.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

585

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

7.

Choose Deploy and then Enable.

8.

Click OK.

9.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select View Tunnel.
The created tunnels are listed in the tunnel list.

10. Repeat steps from Step 3.1 to Step 3.9 to create bidirectional tunnels from NE31 to NE32
and from NE31 to NE21 configured with MPLS APS protection, according to the tunnel
planning information.
----End

10.3.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for MPLS interfaces.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port

Packet Type

Value
NE31

NE32

NE11

NE21

1-EM6F-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

1-EM6F-2

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

2
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

586

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6F-1
1-EM6F-2

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

17-EG2D-1
17-EG2D-2

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

587

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

17-EG2D-1
17-EG2D-2

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

17-EG2D-1
17-EG2D-2

----End

10.3.3.4 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes the process for verifying configured MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Manage Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
Step 3 Select all eight MPLS tunnels and right-click them. Choose Test and Check from the shortcut
menu.
Step 4 Select LSP Ping from Diagnosis Option.

Step 5 Click
displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

on the right and set parameters about the LSP ping test in the dialog box that is

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

588

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

In this example, set Packet Size to 64 bytes, and set Response Mode to Application Control
Channel.

NOTE

To verify the service availability at different packet lengths, you can set Packet Size to 128/256/512/1024/1280
bytes as desired.

Step 6 Click Run.


Step 7 After the verification, query the verification result of each MPLS tunnel.
In the test result of each tunnel, the value of Packet Loss Ratio(%) must be 0.
----End

10.3.4 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)


This section describes how to set parameters of MPLS tunnel on a per NE basis.

10.3.4.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Interfaces)


This section describes the process for configuring NNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the basic port attributes.
l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

Name

conn_NE32

conn_NE21

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

589

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Max Frame Length(byte)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

1620

1620

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Name

conn_NE11

conn_NE31

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Name

conn_NE21

conn_NE32

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Name

conn_NE31

conn_NE11

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Working Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Max Frame Length(byte)

1620

1620

Step 2 See A.6.6.4 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 3 attributes of the
ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

590

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
1-EM6F-1

1-EM6F-2

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.1

46.1.64.14

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.5

46.1.64.2

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.9

46.1.64.6

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.13

46.1.64.10

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

591

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.3.4.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnel)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes and set the LSR ID for each NE.
The values for the related parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE32

NE11

NE21

LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

Start of Global
Label Space

Step 2 See A.9.2.3 Creating a Bidirectional MPLS Tunnel and create unidirectional MPLS tunnels.
1.

Create the working MPLS tunnels.


l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

Tunnel ID

1501

1503

1505

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE32-W

NE31-NE11-W

NE31-NE21-W

Node Type

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

In Port

Forward In Label

Reverse Out
Label

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

1-EM6F

1-EM6F

1-EM6F

Out Port

Forward Out
Label

1501

1503

1505

Reverse In Label

1502

1504

1506

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

592

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

Forward Next
Hop Address

46.1.64.2

46.1.64.2

46.1.64.13

Reverse Next Hop


Address

Source Node

Sink Node

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

None

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE31 and
NE32

Between NE31 and


NE11

Tunnel ID

1501

1503

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE32-W

NE31-NE11-W

Node Type

Egress

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

17-EG2D

In Port

Forward In Label

1501

1503

Reverse Out Label

1502

1504

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

Out Port

Forward Out Label

1509

Reverse In Label

1510

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.6

Reverse Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.1

46.1.64.1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

593

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE31 and
NE32

Between NE31 and


NE11

Source Node

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

130.0.0.3

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE11

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tunnel ID

1503

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE11-W

Node Type

Egress

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

In Board/Logic Interface Type

17-EG2D

In Port

Forward In Label

1503

Reverse Out Label

1504

Out Board/Logic Interface Type

Out Port

Forward Out Label

Reverse In Label

Forward Next Hop Address

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.5

Source Node

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

594

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE21

2.

Tunnel ID

1505

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE21-W

Node Type

Egress

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

In Board/Logic Interface Type

17-EG2D

In Port

Forward In Label

1505

Reverse Out Label

1506

Out Board/Logic Interface Type

Out Port

Forward Out Label

Reverse In Label

Forward Next Hop Address

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.14

Source Node

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

Create the protection MPLS tunnels.


l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

Tunnel ID

1507

1509

1511

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE32-P

NE31-NE11-P

NE31-NE21-P

Node Type

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

No Limit

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

595

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

In Port

Forward In Label

Reverse Out
Label

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

1-EM6F

1-EM6F

1-EM6F

Out Port

Forward Out
Label

1507

1509

1511

Reverse In Label

1508

1510

1512

Forward Next
Hop Address

46.1.64.13

46.1.64.13

46.1.64.2

Reverse Next Hop


Address

Source Node

Sink Node

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

None

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE31 and
NE32

Between NE31 and


NE21

Tunnel ID

1507

1511

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE32-P

NE31-NE21-P

Node Type

Egress

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

17-EG2D

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

596

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and
NE32

Between NE31 and


NE21

In Port

Forward In Label

1507

1511

Reverse Out Label

1508

1512

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

Out Port

Forward Out Label

1511

Reverse In Label

1512

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.6

Reverse Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.6

46.1.64.1

Source Node

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

130.0.0.4

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE21

Tunnel ID

1509

1507

1511

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE11-P

NE31-NE32-P

NE31-NE21-P

Node Type

Egress

Transit

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

17-EG2D

17-EG2D

In Port

Forward In Label

1509

1507

1511

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

597

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE21

Reverse Out
Label

1510

1508

1512

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

17-EG2D

Out Port

Forward Out
Label

1507

1511

Reverse In Label

1508

1512

Forward Next
Hop Address

46.1.64.5

46.1.64.10

Reverse Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.10

46.1.64.10

46.1.64.5

Source Node

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.4

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE31 and
NE21

Between NE31 and


NE32

Tunnel ID

1511

1507

Tunnel Name

NE31-NE21-P

NE31-NE32-P

Node Type

Egress

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

17-EG2D

In Port

Forward In Label

1511

1507

Reverse Out Label

1512

1508

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

598

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and
NE21

Between NE31 and


NE32

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

17-EG2D

Out Port

Forward Out Label

1507

Reverse In Label

1508

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.9

Reverse Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.9

46.1.64.14

Source Node

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

130.0.0.2

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

----End

10.3.4.3 Configuration Process (MPLS APS)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS APS protection groups.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM Parameters and set MPLS OAM parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Paramet
er

Value
Between NE31 and
NE32

Between NE31 and


NE11

Between NE31 and


NE21

Tunnel
ID

1501

1507

1503

1509

1505

1511

OAM
Status

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Detection
Mode

AutoSensing

AutoSensing

AutoSensing

AutoSensing

AutoSensing

AutoSensing

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

599

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Paramet
er

Value
Between NE31 and
NE32

Between NE31 and


NE11

Between NE31 and


NE21

Detection
Packet
Type

FFD

FFD

FFD

FFD

FFD

FFD

Detection
Packet
Period
(ms)

3.3

3.3

3.3

3.3

3.3

3.3

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE32

Tunnel ID

1501

1507

OAM Status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

FFD

FFD

Detection Packet Period


(ms)

3.3

3.3

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE11

Tunnel ID

1503

1509

OAM Status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

FFD

FFD

Detection Packet Period


(ms)

3.3

3.3

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Between NE31 and NE21

Tunnel ID

1505

1511

OAM Status

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

600

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Between NE31 and NE21

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

FFD

FFD

Detection Packet Period


(ms)

3.3

3.3

Step 2 See A.9.3.1 Creating an MPLS APS Protection Group and create the MPLS APS protection
group.
l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31
and NE32

Between NE31
and NE11

Between NE31
and NE21

Protection Type

1:1

1:1

1:1

Switching Mode

Dual-Ended

Dual-Ended

Dual-Ended

Working Tunnel
Type

MPLS Tunnel

MPLS Tunnel

MPLS Tunnel

Working Ingress
Tunnel ID

1501

1503

1505

Working Egress
Tunnel ID

1501

1503

1505

Protection Tunnel
Type

MPLS Tunnel

MPLS Tunnel

MPLS Tunnel

Protection Ingress
Tunnel ID

1507

1509

1511

Protection Egress
Tunnel ID

1507

1509

1511

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Non-Revertive

Non-Revertive

WTR Time(min)

Hold-Time(100ms)

Protocol Status

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE32

Protection Type

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

1:1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

601

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE31 and NE32

Switching Mode

Dual-Ended

Working Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

Working Ingress Tunnel ID

1501

Working Egress Tunnel ID

1501

Protection Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

Protection Ingress Tunnel ID

1507

Protection Egress Tunnel ID

1507

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

WTR Time(min)

Hold-Time(100ms)

Protocol Status

Disabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE11

Protection Type

1:1

Switching Mode

Dual-Ended

Working Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

Working Ingress Tunnel ID

1503

Working Egress Tunnel ID

1503

Protection Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

Protection Ingress Tunnel ID

1509

Protection Egress Tunnel ID

1509

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

WTR Time(min)

Hold-Time(100ms)

Protocol Status

Disabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

602

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
Between NE31 and NE21

Protection Type

1:1

Switching Mode

Dual-Ended

Working Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

Working Ingress Tunnel ID

1505

Working Egress Tunnel ID

1505

Protection Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

Protection Ingress Tunnel ID

1511

Protection Egress Tunnel ID

1511

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

WTR Time(min)

Hold-Time(100ms)

Protocol Status

Disabled

Step 3 See A.9.3.4 Enabling/Disabling MPLS APS Protection and start/stop the MPLS APS protocol.
If Protocol Status is Enabled, the MPLS APS protocol is enabled for the NE where the MPLS
APS protection group is configured.
----End

10.3.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for MPLS interfaces.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port

Packet Type

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
NE31

NE32

NE11

NE21

1-EM6F-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

1-EM6F-2

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

603

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

1-EM6F-1
1-EM6F-2

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

17-EG2D-1
17-EG2D-2

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

604

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

17-EG2D-1
17-EG2D-2

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

17-EG2D-1
17-EG2D-2

----End

10.3.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes the process for verifying configured MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 For MPLS tunnels configured in an MPLS APS protection group, see A.9.2.10 Querying LSP
Running Status and query the LSP running status.
Normally, each MPLS tunnel is available.
----End

10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No


Protection)
This section uses an example to describe how to configure MPLS tunnels with no protection on
a PSN.

10.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
All base station services need to be transmitted through a PSN to the BSC and RNC. Based on
6.7 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Packet Network), configure MPLS tunnels
on Packet radio links according to the following actual requirements:
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Bidirectional MPLS tunnels need to be configured between NE32 and NE33 and between
NE32 and NE34.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

605

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

MPLS APS is not configured for any tunnel on Packet radio links.

MPLS interfaces used on the Packet radio links are shown in Figure 10-8. The radio link
between NE32 and NE33 is configured with 1+1 HSB protection. In the 1+1 HSB protection
group, the IF board in the slot with the smaller slot ID functions as the main IF board.

Figure 10-8 Networking diagram (Packet radio links)


3-ISU2-1(to NE34)
4-ISX2-1(to NE32)
6-ISX2-1(to NE32)
NE34
NE33
3-ISU2-1(to NE33)

PLA

3-ISX2-1(to NE33)
5-ISX2-1(to NE33)

GE

GE
NE32
NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE

NOTE

To save tunnel resources, MPLS tunnels are created only between NE33 and NE32 and between NE34 and NE32
in this example. NE32 is the S-PE. The MPLS tunnels on the chain and the MPLS tunnels on the packet ring
are created segment by segment through this example and 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with
MPLS APS Protection). See Figure 10-9. In actual application scenarios, you can also create MPLS tunnels
between NE34 and NE31 and between NE33 and NE31 to transmit corresponding base station services to NE31;
in addition, you can configure MPLS APS for the MPLS tunnels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

606

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Figure 10-9 Networking diagram (Packet radio links)


NE34
NE33

GE

GE
NE32
NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE

Working Tunnel
Protection Tunnel

10.4.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

10.4.2.1 Service Planning (MPLS Interfaces)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring MPLS
interfaces.
Table 10-31 to Table 10-33 provide the information about each NNI port on the Packet radio
links that are used for configuring the MPLS tunnel.
NOTE

In this example, PLA protection is configured for the radio links between NE32 and NE33. Therefore, you
need to configure IF_ETH port information only for the main radio link.

Table 10-31 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE32)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-ISX2-1

Port name

conn_NE33

Port mode

Layer 3

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

607

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

3-ISX2-1

Port IP address

46.1.64.17

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

Table 10-32 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE33)


Parameter

3-ISU2

4-ISX2-1

Port name

conn_NE34

conn_NE32

Port mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.21

46.1.64.18

IP mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

Enabled

Table 10-33 Information about MPLS interfaces (NE34)


Parameter

3-ISU2

Port name

conn_NE33

Port mode

Layer 3

Enable tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP address

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.22

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Error frame discard enabled

Enabled

10.4.2.2 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring MPLS tunnels.

Basic NE configuration
Before creating an MPLS tunnel, you need to assign an LSR ID for each NE as its unique ID on
the network. See Table 10-34.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

608

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Table 10-34 Basic NE configuration


Parameter

NE32

NE33

NE34

LSR ID

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.5

130.0.0.6

Start of global label


space

NOTE

The LSR ID of NE32 planned in this example is the same as that planned in 10.3 Configuration Example
(MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).

Information About MPLS Tunnels


Table 10-35 provides basic information about the bidirectional MPLS tunnels between NE32
and NE33 and between NE32 and NE34.
Table 10-35 Basic information about MPLS tunnels
Parameter

Between NE32 and NE33

Between NE32 and NE34

Tunnel name

NE32-NE33-W

NE32-NE34-W

Tunnel ID

1513

1515

Ingress node of the forward


working tunnel

NE32

NE32

NOTE

l Tunnel name planning is performed only for per-NE configuration. For end-to-end configuration, tunnel
names are automatically generated by the U2000 according to the naming rules.
l In this example, tunnel IDs and MPLS labels are planned in a unified manner. For end-to-end configuration,
these parameters can be automatically assigned by the U2000.

Figure 10-10 shows the specific tunnel information.


Figure 10-10 MPLS tunnel planning
Links: NE32-NE33-NE34

NE32
(130.0.0.2)

NE33
(130.0.0.5)

3-ISX2-1
(46.1.64.17)
L:1513

4-ISX2-1
(46.1.64.18)
ID:1513

L:1514

3-ISU2-1
(46.1.64.21)

NE34
(130.0.0.6)
3-ISU2-1
(46.1.64.22)

L:1513
L:1514

L:1515
L:1516

ID:1515

L:

Label

L:1515 L:1501
L:1516 L:1502

L:1501
L:1502

Ingress/Egress
Working tunnel

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

609

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.4.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS for
MPLS interfaces.
NOTE

The NEs in this example and the NEs in 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS
Protection) belong to the same MPLS network. Therefore, the QoS planning in this example is the same as that
in 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).

QoS (DiffServ)
Differentiated service (DiffServ) configuration is essential to QoS configuration. For the OptiX
RTN 980, all the ports that transmit a service must be in the same DS domain. Therefore, DiffServ
information is planned in a unified manner. Table 10-36 lists the mapping between the DS
domain and PHB service classes.
Table 10-36 Classes of Service and PHB Service Classes

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PHB Service
Class

VLAN
Priority

DSCP

MPLS EXP
Priority

Correspondin
g Service
Category

CS7

56

CS6

48

EF

40

Real-time voice
service and
signaling
service (R99
conversational
and R99
streaming
services)

AF4

32

AF3

24

OM, real-time
HSDPA
services (OM,
HSPA
streaming)

AF2

16

R99 non-realtime services


(R99 interactive
and R99
background
services)

AF1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

610

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

PHB Service
Class

VLAN
Priority

DSCP

MPLS EXP
Priority

Correspondin
g Service
Category

BE

HSDPA data
services (HSPA
interactive and
HSPA
background
services)

NOTE

During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 is not recommended, because CS7 may be used to transmit
Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified. Set the type of trusted packet at an MPLS interface to MPLS EXP.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 10-37 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 10-37 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

10.4.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS tunnel parameters in an end-to-end
mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

611

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.4.3.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Interfaces)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS interfaces.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISX2-1

Name

conn_NE33

Port Mode

Layer 3

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISX2-1

Name

conn_NE34

conn_NE32

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Name

conn_NE33

Port Mode

Layer 3

Step 2 See A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 3 attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.17

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

612

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.21

46.1.64.18

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.22

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

----End

10.4.3.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes how to configure MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes and set the LSR ID for each NE.
The values for the related parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE32

NE33

NE34

LSR ID

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.5

130.0.0.6

Start of Global
Label Space

Step 2 See A.13.3.2 Creating L2 Links and perform accordingly.


The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

613

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Link Type

Source NE

Source Port

Sink NE

Sink Port

L2 Link

NE32

3-ISX2-1

NE33

4-ISX2-1

L2 Link

NE33

3-ISU2-1

NE34

3-ISU2-1

Step 3 See A.13.3.3 Creating Non-Protection MPLS Tunnels (in an End-to-End Mode) and
perform accordingly.
1.

Choose Service > Tunnel > Create Tunnel from the Main Menu.

2.

Set attributes for MPLS tunnels.

3.

Configure on the nodes at both ends of an MPLS tunnel.


a.

Click Add > NE.

b.

In the Select NE dialog box that is displayed, select NE32, NE33, and NE34, and click
.

4.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click NE Role. Set NE32 as Ingress, set NE34 as Egress, and set NE33 as
Transit.

Configure a route for the tunnel using the automatic route computation function.
a.

Select Auto-Calculate route.

b.

Set Restriction Bandwidth(kbit/s) to No Limit.

c.

Double-click the ingress NE (NE32), and then the egress NE (NE34) in the Physical
Topology tab page on the right.

The U2000 will automatically compute a tunnel between NE32 and NE34 and display the
tunnel in the Physical Topology tab page.

5.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click Details, and configure related parameters on the tabs on the right.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

614

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

6.

Choose Deploy and then Enable.

7.

Click OK.

8.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select View Tunnel.
The created tunnels are listed in the tunnel list.

9.

Repeat steps from Step 3.1 to Step 3.8 to create a bidirectional tunnel from NE32 to NE33
according to the tunnel planning information.

----End

10.4.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for MPLS ports.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE32

NE33

NE34

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

4-ISU2
Packet Type

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

615

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2
4-ISU2

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

3-ISU2
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

616

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

----End

10.4.3.4 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes the process for verifying configured MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Manage Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
Step 3 Select the MPLS tunnels from NE32 to NE33 and from NE32 to NE34, and right-click them.
Choose Test and Check from the shortcut menu.
Step 4 Select LSP Ping from Diagnosis Option.

Step 5 Click
displayed.

on the right and set parameters about the LSP ping test in the dialog box that is

In this example, set Packet Size to 64 bytes, and set Response Mode to Application Control
Channel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

617

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

NOTE

To verify the service availability at different packet lengths, you can set Packet Size to 128/256/512/1024/1280
bytes as desired.

Step 6 Click Run.


Step 7 After the verification, query the verification result of each MPLS tunnel.
In the test result of each tunnel, the value of Packet Loss Ratio(%) must be 0.
----End

10.4.4 Configuration Process (on a Per-NE Basis)


This section describes how to set parameters of MPLS tunnel on a per NE basis.

10.4.4.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Interfaces)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS interfaces.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the basic attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISX2-1

Name

conn_NE33

Port Mode

Layer 3

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

618

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISX2-1

Name

conn_NE34

conn_NE32

Port Mode

Layer 3

Layer 3

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Name

conn_NE33

Port Mode

Layer 3

Step 2 See A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 3 attributes of
IF_ETH ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.17

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.21

46.1.64.18

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

619

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.22

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

----End

10.4.4.2 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnel)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes and set the LSR ID for each NE.
The values for the related parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE32

NE33

NE34

LSR ID

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.5

130.0.0.6

Start of Global
Label Space

Step 2 See A.9.2.3 Creating a Bidirectional MPLS Tunnel and create unidirectional MPLS tunnels.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE32 and NE33

Between NE32 and NE34

Tunnel ID

1513

1515

Tunnel Name

NE32-NE33-W

NE32-NE34-W

Node Type

Ingress

Ingress

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

In Port

Forward In Label

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

620

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE32 and NE33

Between NE32 and NE34

Reverse Out Label

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

3-ISX2-1

3-ISX2-1

Out Port

Forward Out Label

1513

1515

Reverse In Label

1514

1516

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.18

46.1.64.18

Reverse Next Hop


Address

Source Node

Sink Node

130.0.0.5

130.0.0.6

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE32 and NE33

Between NE32 and NE34

Tunnel ID

1513

1515

Tunnel Name

NE32-NE33-W

NE32-NE34-W

Node Type

Egress

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

4-ISX2-1

4-ISX2-1

In Port

Forward In Label

1513

1515

Reverse Out Label

1514

1516

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

3-ISU2

Out Port

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

621

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE32 and NE33

Between NE32 and NE34

Forward Out Label

1515

Reverse In Label

1516

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.22

Reverse Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.17

46.1.64.17

Source Node

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.2

Sink Node

130.0.0.6

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE34 and NE32

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tunnel ID

1515

Tunnel Name

NE34-NE32-W-F

Node Type

Egress

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

In Board/Logic Interface Type

3-ISU2

In Port

Forward In Label

1515

Reverse Out Label

1516

Out Board/Logic Interface Type

Out Port

Forward Out Label

Reverse In Label

Forward Next Hop Address

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.21

Source Node

130.0.0.2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

622

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
Between NE34 and NE32

Sink Node

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

Pipe

----End

10.4.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for MPLS ports.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the ports that are applied to the DS domain and their trusted
packet types.
The values for the related parameters that need to be set are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Port

NE32

NE33

NE34

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

3-ISU2

4-ISU2
Packet Type

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

623

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2
4-ISU2

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2

----End

10.4.4.4 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes the process for verifying configured MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 If MPLS APS protection is not configured for MPLS tunnels on the Packet radio links, the MPLS
OAM function needs to be enabled to detect the tunnel status. See A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM
Parameters.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

624

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

l The values for the related parameters of NE32 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE32 and NE33

Between NE32 and NE34

Tunnel ID

1513

1515

OAM Status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE32 and NE33

Tunnel ID

1513

OAM Status

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE32 and NE34

Tunnel ID

1515

OAM Status

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

Step 2 See A.9.2.10 Querying LSP Running Status and query the LSP running status.
Normally, each MPLS tunnel is available.
----End

10.5 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels Traversing L2


Networks)
In this example, the MPLS tunnels traverse an L2 network through VLAN sub-interfaces.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

625

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
In this example (as shown in Figure 10-11), two MPLS tunnels need to traverse the L2 network
and therefore transmit services from BTS1 and BTS2 to the BSC. The VLAN sub-interfaces of
ports for carrying the MPLS tunnels on NE1, NE2, and NE4 need to be enabled and be assigned
with VLAN IDs. When planning the VLAN IDs for the VLAN sub-interfaces, ensure that they
are different from the VLAN IDs carried by services in the L2 network so that the services carried
on the MPLS tunnels do not conflict with services in the L2 network.
The services from BTS1 and BTS2 are aggregated on the MPLS port on NE1 and then transmitted
to the BSC, so the VLAN sub-interfaces transmitting the services must have different VLAN
IDs to isolate the services.
Figure 10-11 Networking diagram (MPLS tunnels traversing an L2 network)

L2 network

BTS1

VLAN=4060
BSC

NE1

VL
A

NE2
N=
40

NE3

90

NE4

MPLS Tunnel 1

NE5

BTS2

MPLS Tunnel 2

Figure 10-12 shows information about the MPLS ports on the network. The VLAN subinterfaces of ports for carrying the MPLS tunnels on NE1, NE2, and NE4 are enabled so that
the MPLS tunnels can traverse the L2 network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

626

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Figure 10-12 Networking diagram (MPLS port information)


3-ISU2-1(to NE3)
4-EM6T-1(to NE1)
3-EM6T-1
(to NE2 and NE4)

3-ISU2-1(to NE2)

L2 network
VLAN=4060
NE1

VL
AN
=4

NE2

NE3

09
0

3-ISU2-1(to NE4)

NE4
3-ISU2-1(to NE5)

NE5

4-EM6T-1(to NE1)

MPLS Tunnel 1
MPLS Tunnel 2
Using VLAN sub-Interfaces
Not using VLAN sub-Interfaces

10.5.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the related parameter information before service configuration.

10.5.2.1 Service Planning (MPLS Ports)


This section provides information about all the parameters required for configuring MPLS ports.
Table 10-38 shows the information about all MPLS ports carrying the MPLS tunnels which
traverse the L2 network.
Table 10-38 Information about MPLS ports (NE1)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-EM6T-1

Port name

conn_NE1NE2

Port mode

Layer Mix

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

627

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Table 10-39 Information about MPLS ports (NE2)


Parameter

3-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

Port name

conn_NE1

conn_NE3

Port mode

Layer Mix

Layer 2

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Specification mode of IP
addresses

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.5

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Enabling errored frame


discarding function

Enabled

Table 10-40 Information about MPLS ports (NE3)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Port name

conn_NE2

Port mode

Layer 2

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Specification mode of IP addresses

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.6

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Enabling errored frame discarding function

Enabled

Table 10-41 Information about MPLS ports (NE4)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

3-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

Port name

conn_NE1

conn_NE5

Port mode

Layer Mix

Layer 2

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Specification mode of IP
addresses

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.15

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

628

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

3-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

Enabling errored frame


discarding function

Enabled

Table 10-42 Information about MPLS ports (NE5)


Parameter

3-ISU2-1

Port name

conn_NE4

Port mode

Layer 2

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Specification mode of IP addresses

Manually

Port IP address

46.1.64.16

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Enabling errored frame discarding function

Enabled

10.5.2.2 Service Planning (VLAN Sub-Interfaces)


The section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring VLAN
sub-interfaces.
Table 10-43 to Table 10-45 show the information about all VLAN sub-interfaces carrying the
MPLS tunnels which traverse the L2 network.
Table 10-43 Information about VLAN sub-interfaces (NE1)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Port

Name

conn_NE2_subvlan

conn_NE4_subvlan

Port type

VLAN sub-interface

VLAN sub-interface

Located board

3-EM6T

3-EM6T

Located port

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

Occupied VLAN

4060

4090

Specification mode of IP
addresses

Manually

Manually

IP address

46.1.64.1

46.1.64.11

IP mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

629

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Enabled

Table 10-44 Information about VLAN sub-interfaces (NE2)


Parameter

Value

Port

Name

conn_NE1_subvlan

Port type

VLAN sub-interface

Located board

3-EM6T

Located port

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

Occupied VLAN

4060

Specification mode of IP addresses

Manually

IP address

46.1.64.2

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Table 10-45 Information about VLAN sub-interfaces (NE4)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Port

Name

conn_NE1_subvlan

Port type

VLAN sub-interface

Located board

3-EM6T

Located port

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

Occupied VLAN

4090

Specification mode of IP addresses

Manually

IP address

46.1.64.12

IP mask

255.255.255.252

Enabling tunnels

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

630

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

10.5.2.3 Service Planning (MPLS Tunnel)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring MPLS tunnels.

Basic NE Configuration
Before creating an MPLS tunnel, you need to assign an LSR ID for each NE as its unique ID on
the network. See Table 10-46.
Table 10-46 Basic NE configuration
Parameter

NE1

NE2

NE3

NE4

NE5

LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

130.0.0.5

Start of
global label
space

Information About MPLS Tunnels


Table 10-47 provides basic information about the bidirectional working MPLS tunnels between
NE1 and NE3 and between NE1 and NE5.
Table 10-47 Basic information about MPLS tunnels
Parameter

NE1 to NE3

NE1 to NE5

Tunnel name

NE1-NE3-W

NE1-NE5-W

Tunnel ID

1001

1002

Ingress node of the forward


working tunnel

NE1

NE1

Based on Table 10-47, Figure 10-13 shows the specific tunnel information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

631

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Figure 10-13 MPLS tunnel planning


Links: NE1-NE2-NE3
NE1
(130.0.0.1)
3-EM6T1(Subvlan-1)
(46.1.64.1)

L:1515
L:1516

NE2
(130.0.0.2)
4-EM6T1(Subvlan-1) 3-ISU2-1
(46.1.64.2) (46.1.64.5)

ID:1001

L:1515 L:1515
L:1516 L:1516

NE3
(130.0.0.3)
3-ISU2-1
(46.1.64.6)

L:1515
L:1516

Links: NE1-NE4-NE5
NE1
(130.0.0.1)
3-EM6T1(Subvlan-2)
(46.1.64.11)

L:1535
L:1536

NE4
(130.0.0.4)
4-EM6T1(Subvlan-1) 3-ISU2-1
(46.1.64.12) (46.1.64.15)

ID:1002

L:1535 L:1535
L:1536 L:1536

NE5
(130.0.0.5)
3-ISU2-1
(46.1.64.16)

L:1535
L:1536

Ingress/Egress
L:

Label
Working tunnel

10.5.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS for
MPLS ports.

QoS (DiffServ)
Differentiated service (DiffServ) configuration is essential to QoS configuration. For the OptiX
RTN 980, all the ports that transmit a service must be in the same DS domain. Therefore, DiffServ
information is planned in a unified manner. Table 10-48 lists the mapping between the DS
domain and PHB service classes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

632

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Table 10-48 Classes of Service and PHB Service Classes


PHB Service
Class

VLAN
Priority

DSCP

MPLS EXP
Priority

Correspondin
g Service
Category

CS7

56

CS6

48

EF

40

Real-time voice
service and
signaling
service (R99
conversational
and R99
streaming
services)

AF4

32

AF3

24

OM, real-time
HSDPA
services (OM,
HSPA
streaming)

AF2

16

R99 non-realtime services


(R99 interactive
and R99
background
services)

AF1

BE

HSDPA data
services (HSPA
interactive and
HSPA
background
services)

NOTE

During the mapping of the PHB service class, CS7 is not recommended, because CS7 may be used to transmit
Ethernet protocol packets or inband DCN packets on the NE.
The default mapping relationships for the DS domain comply with the network planning requirements and
therefore do not need to be modified. Set the type of trusted packet at an MPLS interface to MPLS EXP.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

633

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Table 10-49 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 10-49 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

10.5.3 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes how to set parameters for MPLS tunnels that traverse a Layer 2
network on a per-NE basis.

10.5.3.1 Configuration Process (MPLS Port Information)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS port information.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the
basic Ethernet port attributes.
l The values for the related parameters of NE1 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-EM6T-1

Name

conn_NE1NE2

Port Mode

Layer Mix

l The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-EM6T-1

Name
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

conn_NE1
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

634

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
3-EM6T-1

Port Mode

Layer Mix

l The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-EM6T-1

Name

conn_NE1

Port Mode

Layer Mix

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the
basic IF_ETH port attributes.
l The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Name

conn_NE3

Port Mode

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE3 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Name

conn_NE2

Port Mode

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Name

conn_NE5

Port Mode

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE5 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

635

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
3-ISU2-1

Name

conn_NE4

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the L3
IF_ETH port attributes.
l The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISX2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.5

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE3 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.6

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.15

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

l The values for the related parameters of NE5 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

636

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
3-ISU2-1

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.16

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

----End

10.5.3.2 Configuration Process (VLAN Sub-Interface Information)


This section describes the process for configuring VLAN sub-interface information.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.6.10 Creating VLAN Sub-Interfaces and create VLAN subinterfaces.
The values for the related parameters of NE1 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Port

Name

conn_NE2_subvlan

conn_NE4_subvlan

Port Type

VLAN Sub Interface

VLAN Sub Interface

Board

3-EM6T

3-EM6T

Port

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

VLAN

4060

4090

Specify IP Address

Manually

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.1

46.1.64.11

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

255.255.255.252

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Enabled

The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Port

Name

conn_NE1_subvlan
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

637

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value

Port Type

VLAN Sub Interface

Board

3-EM6T

Port

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

VLAN

4060

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.2

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Port

Name

conn_NE1_subvlan

Port Type

VLAN Sub Interface

Board

3-EM6T

Port

3-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

VLAN

4090

Specify IP Address

Manually

IP Address

46.1.64.12

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

----End

10.5.3.3 Configuration Process (MPLS Tunnel Information)


This section describes the process for configuring MPLS tunnel information.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes and set the basic MPLS
attributes.
The values for the related parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

638

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE4

NE5

LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

130.0.0.5

Start of
Global
Label Space

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.9.2.3 Creating a Bidirectional MPLS Tunnel and create bidirectional
MPLS tunnels.
l The values for the related parameters of NE1 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Between NE1 and NE5

Tunnel ID

1001

1002

Tunnel Name

NE1-NE3-W

NE1-NE5-W

Node Type

Ingress

Ingress

CIR(kbit/s)

No limit

No limit

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

In Port

Forward In Label

Reverse Out Label

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

Virtual Ethernet

3-EM6T-1

Out Port

1(VEtherconn_NE2_subvlan)

1(conn_NE4_subvlan)

Forward Out Label

1515

1535

Reverse In Label

1516

1536

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.2

46.1.64.12

Reverse Next Hop


Address

Source Node

Sink Node

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.4

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

EXP

None

None

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

639

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

LSP Mode

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Between NE1 and NE5

l The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Tunnel ID

1001

Tunnel Name

NE1-NE3-W

Node Type

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No limit

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

Virtual Ethernet

In Port

1(VEther-conn_NE1_subvlan)

Forward In Label

1515

Reverse Out Label

1516

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

3-ISU2

Out Port

1(conn_NE3-1)

Forward Out Label

1515

Reverse In Label

1516

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.6

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.1

Source Node

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

130.0.0.3

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

l The values for the related parameters of NE3 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

640

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Tunnel ID

1001

Tunnel Name

NE1-NE3-W

Node Type

Egress

CIR(kbit/s)

No limit

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

3-ISU2

In Port

1(conn_NE2-1)

Forward In Label

1515

Reverse Out Label

1516

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

Out Port

Forward Out Label

Reverse In Label

Forward Next Hop


Address

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.5

Source Node

130.0.0.2

Sink Node

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

l The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE5

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tunnel ID

1002

Tunnel Name

NE1-NE5-W

Node Type

Transit

CIR(kbit/s)

No limit

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

641

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE1 and NE5

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

Virtual Ethernet

In Port

1(VEther-conn_NE1_subvlan)

Forward In Label

1535

Reverse Out Label

1536

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

3-ISU2

Out Port

1(conn_NE3-1)

Forward Out Label

1535

Reverse In Label

1536

Forward Next Hop


Address

46.1.64.16

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.11

Source Node

130.0.0.1

Sink Node

130.0.0.5

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

l The values for the related parameters of NE5 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE5

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Tunnel ID

1002

Tunnel Name

NE1-NE5-W

Node Type

Egress

CIR(kbit/s)

No limit

In Board/Logic Interface
Type

3-ISU2

In Port

1(conn_NE2-1)

Forward In Label

1535

Reverse Out Label

1536

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

642

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE1 and NE5

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

Out Port

Forward Out Label

Reverse In Label

Forward Next Hop


Address

Reverse Next Hop Address

46.1.64.15

Source Node

130.0.0.4

Sink Node

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

EXP

None

LSP Mode

----End

10.5.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS Information)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for MPLS ports.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their
Trusted Packet Types and change the DS-enabled ports and their trusted packet types.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE4

NE5

3-EM6T-1

3-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

3-EM6T-1

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1
Packet Type

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

3-ISU2-1
mpls-exp

mpls-exp

mpls-exp

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and change the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

643

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of each NE are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
will use the specified port policy.
l The values for the related parameters of NE1 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-EM6T-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-EM6T-1
3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE3 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

644

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-EM6T-1
3-ISU2-1

l The values for the related parameters of NE5 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port

3-ISU2-1

----End

10.5.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Configured MPLS Tunnels)


This section describes the process for verifying configured MPLS tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 If MPLS APS protection is not configured for MPLS tunnels on the Packet radio links, the MPLS
OAM function needs to be enabled to detect the tunnel status. See A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM
Parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE1 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Between NE1 and NE5

Tunnel ID

1001

1002

OAM Status

Enabled

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l The values for the related parameters of NE2 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

645

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Tunnel ID

1001

OAM Status

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

l The values for the related parameters of NE3 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Tunnel ID

1001

OAM Status

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

l The values for the related parameters of NE4 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Tunnel ID

1002

OAM Status

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

l The values for the related parameters of NE5 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Between NE1 and NE3

Tunnel ID

1002

OAM Status

Enabled

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Detection Packet Type

CV

Step 2 See A.9.2.10 Querying LSP Running Status and query the LSP running status.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

646

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

10 Configuring MPLS Tunnels

Normally, each MPLS tunnel is available.


----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

647

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configuring PWE3 Services

About This Chapter


The procedure and method of configuring PWE3 services vary with types of PWE3 services.
11.1 Basic Concept
Before configuring PWE3, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
11.2 Configuration Procedure
The service configuration procedure differs according to the specific service type.
11.3 Configuration Example (Common CES Services)
This section considers a common CES service on a packet network as an example to describe
how to configure CES services according to network planning information. Each CES service
is encapsulated in SAToP mode.
11.4 Configuration Example (Fractional CES Services)
This section considers a Fractional CES service on a packet network as an example to describe
how to configure CES services according to the network planning information. Each service is
encapsulated in CESoPSN mode.
11.5 Configuration Example (MS-PW-based CES Services)
This section considers an MS-PW-based CES service on a packet network as an example to
describe how to configure CES services according to the network planning information. This
sample service is encapsulated in CESoPSN mode.
11.6 Configuration Example (Common ATM Services)
This section uses a common ATM service on a PSN as an example to describe how to configure
ATM services according to service planning information. In this example, services are
encapsulated in n-to-1 VCC mode.
11.7 Configuration Example (Fractional ATM Services)
This section uses a Fractional ATM service on a PSN as an example to describe how to configure
ATM services according to service planning information. In this example, services are
encapsulated in n-to-1 VCC mode.
11.8 Configuration Example (ATM Services on MS-PWs)
This section uses an ATM service carried on MS-PWs of a PSN as an example to describe how
to configure ATM services according to service planning information. In this example, services
are encapsulated in 1-to-1 VCC mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

648

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.9 Configuration Example (Transparently Transmitted ATM Services)


This section uses a transparently transmitted ATM service on a PSN as an example to describe
how to configure ATM services according to service planning information.
11.10 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on PWs, a Simple Example)
This section considers E-Line services carried on PWs as an example to describe how to
configure E-Line services.
11.11 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on PWs and Transmitting the Ethernet
Services Aggregated from the Hybrid Microwave Network)
This section considers E-Line services carried on PWs and transmitting the Ethernet services
aggregated from the Hybrid microwave network as an example to describe how to configure ELine services carried on PWs.
11.12 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on MS-PWs)
This section considers E-Line services carried on MS-PWs as an example to describe how to
configure E-Line services carried on PWs.
11.13 Configuration Example (PW-Carried E-AGGR Services)
This section uses a PW-carried E-AGGR service as an example to describe how to configure EAGGR services according to service planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

649

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.1 Basic Concept


Before configuring PWE3, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

11.1.1 Types of PWE3 Services


The OptiX RTN 980 supports the following types of PWE3 services: CES services, ATM
services, and E-Line services carried by PWs.

11.1.1.1 CES Services


On the OptiX RTN 980, CES services are constructed using the TDM PWE3 technology. That
is, TDM E1 services are encapsulated into PW packets, and the PW packets are transmitted
through a PW on the PSN.

Application Example
Circuit emulation service (CES) is mainly used to transmit mobile backhauled services and
enterprise private line services. As shown in Figure 11-1, a 2G base station or an enterprise
private line connects to the OptiX RTN 980 through a TDM line. The OptiX RTN 980
encapsulates the TDM signals into packets, and then transmits the packets to the opposite end
through a PW on the PSN.
Figure 11-1 Example of CES services
Backebone
layer

IP/MPLS Backebone
Network

Convergence
BSC
layer

BSC

Access
layer

BTS

BTS

CES services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Corporation

BTS

OptiX RTN 900

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

BTS

Corporation

OptiX packet
transmission product

650

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Emulation Modes
The OptiX RTN 980 supports CES services in structured emulation mode and non-structured
emulation mode.
l

The structured emulation mode is the CESoPSN mode. The equipment is aware of the frame
structure, framing mode, and timeslot information in the TDM circuit.

The non-structured emulation mode is the SAToP mode. The equipment is not aware of
the frame structure. Instead, the equipment considers the TDM signals as consecutive bit
streams, and then emulates and transparently transmits the TDM signals.

As shown in Figure 11-2, the OptiX RTN 980 in CESoPSN mode supports the compression of
idle 64 kbit/s timeslots in TDM E1 signals to save transmission bandwidth.
Figure 11-2 Compression of idle 64 kbit/s timeslots in TDM E1 signals

BTS

BTS

0 1
2 3
... 2
9 30
31

30
... 29
2 3
1
0

PW
1 2 29

0 1 2 3 ... 29 30 31
0 1 2 3 ... 29 30 31

31

0 1 2 3 ... 29 30 31

PW
1 3 30 31

BSC

0 1 2 3 ... 29 30 31

PW
1 2 3

BTS
0 1 2 3 ... 29 30 31

Timeslots in the E1 frame

Service Clocks
Clock information is an important feature of TDM services. The OptiX RTN 980 supports the
retiming clocks and CES ACR clocks of CES services.
In retiming synchronization mode, the system clocks of all PEs on the network are synchronized.
The system clock of a PE is considered as the service transmit clock (retiming). As shown in
Figure 11-3, the system clock of BTS synchronizes itself with the service clock of PE. In this
manner, all PEs and CEs are synchronous, and the transmit clocks of TDM services on all CEs
and PEs are synchronous.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

651

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-3 Retiming synchronization mode of CES service clocks


Synchronizes with
the radio link clock.

Transmits E1
signals according to
the system clock.

Synchronizes with
the E1 signal clock.

E1

E1
BTS

PE

PE

BSC

CES
Clock synchronization

In ACR mode, the clock is extracted from the TDM interface on the PE on the ingress side. On
the PE on the egress side, the clock of the emulated TDM service is recovered based on the clock
information in the CES service. Figure 11-4 shows the retiming synchronization mode of CES
service clocks.
Figure 11-4 Adaptive synchronization mode of CES service clocks
Extracts the clock from the
E1 signal and add the
clock information to the
CES service.

Recovers the E1 signal


clock from the CES
service.

E1

E1
PE

BTS

PE

BSC

CES

Clock synchronization

11.1.1.2 ATM/IMA Services


The OptiX RTN 980 supports ATM PWE3 services. The ATM/IMA E1 technology is used to
transmit ATM services to the OptiX RTN equipment, and then the ATM cells are encapsulated
into PW packets. The packets are then transmitted in the MPLS tunnel on the PSN.

Application Example
ATM/IMA services are mainly backhauled services of base stations. With the ATM/IMA E1
technology, the ATM services from NodeB are transmitted to the OptiX RTN 980. On the OptiX
RTN 980, PWE3 emulation is performed for the ATM services. Then, the services are
transmitted over PWs in MPLS tunnels across the PSN towards the RNC. Before being sent to
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

652

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

the RNC, the services are decapsulated on the OptiX PTN/RTN equipment. Figure 11-5 shows
the application example.
Figure 11-5 Example of ATM/IMA services
IMA E1/
c-STM-1

IMA E1

NodeB

RTN

MPLS tunnel

PTN

PSN

RNC

PW (ATM PWE3)

ATM/IMA Services on the UNI Side


On the UNI side, the OptiX RTN 980 supports the following ATM/IMA functions:
l

Supports the IMA E1 technology in which an IMA group is comprised of E1 links.

Supports the Fractional IMA technology in which an IMA group is comprised of Fractional
E1 links.

ATM PWE3 Services on the NNI Side


On the NNI side, the OptiX RTN 980 supports the following ATM PWE3 functions:
l

One-to-one VCC mapping scheme: One VCC is mapped into one PW.

N-to-one VCC mapping scheme: N (N32) VCCs are mapped into one PW.

One-to-one VPC mapping scheme: One VPC is mapped into one PW.

N-to-one VPC mapping scheme: N (N32) VPCs are mapped into one PW.

On one PW, a maximum of 31 ATM cells can be concatenated.

ATM transparent service.

11.1.1.3 PW-Carried E-Line Services


A PW-carried E-Line service is an E-Line service category where the E-Line service packets
from one Ethernet port are transmitted on one PW.

Service Models
Table 11-1 defines the PW-carried E-Line service models.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

653

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-1 PW-carried E-Line service models


Service Model

Service Flow

Service
Direction

Port Mode

Port
Encapsulation
Type

Description

Model 1

PORT+CVLAN (source)

UNI-NNI

Layer 2 (source)

IEEE 802.1q
(source)

A UNI port
processes the
packets carrying
a specific CVLAN ID based
on its tag
attribute and
then sends the
packets to the
NNI side for
transmission on
PWs.

Layer 3 (sink)

PW (sink)

Model 2

- (sink)

PORT+SVLAN (source)

UNI-NNI

Layer 2 (source)

QinQ (sink)

Layer 3 (sink)

- (sink)

Layer 2 (source)

IEEE 802.1q or
QinQ (source)

PW (sink)

Model 3

PORT (source)

UNI-NNI

PW (sink)

Layer 3 (sink)

- (sink)

A UNI port
processes the
packets carrying
a specific SVLAN ID based
on its QinQ type
field, and then
sends the
packets to the
NNI side for
transmission on
PWs.
A UNI port
processes the
received packets
based on its tag
attribute or
QinQ type field,
and then sends
the packets to
the NNI side for
transmission on
PWs.

Typical Application of Service Model 1


Figure 11-6 shows the typical application of service model 1. Service 1 is present between
NodeB 1 and the RNC, and service 2 is present between NodeB 2 and the RNC. The two services
carry different VLAN IDs and need to be transmitted over a PSN.
On the UNI side of NE1, service 1 is received by port 1 and service 2 is received by port 2. On
the NNI side of NE1, service 1 and service 2 are transmitted separately on two PWs.
NE2 processes the two services in the same manner as NE1.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

654

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-6 Typical application of service model 1


Service 1

Service 1

Port: 1(802.1Q)
VLAN ID: 100

Port: 1(802.1Q)
VLAN ID: 100

PSN
NodeB 1

AC

PW2
LSP

AC
NE1
UNI

NodeB 2

AC

PW1

NNI

AC
NE2
NNI

Service 2
Port: 2(802.1Q)
VLAN ID: 200

RNC

UNI
Service 2
Port: 2(802.1Q)
VLAN ID: 200

Packet transmission
equipment

Typical Application of Service Model 2


Figure 11-7 shows the typical application of service model 2. Service 1 is present between
NodeB 1 and the RNC, and service 2 is present between NodeB 2 and the RNC. The two QinQ
services carry different S-VLAN IDs and need to be transmitted over a PSN.
On the UNI side of NE1, service 1 is received by port 1 and service 2 is received by port 2. On
the NNI side of NE1, service 1 and service 2 are transmitted separately on two PWs.
NE2 processes the two services in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 11-7 Typical application of service model 2
Service 1

Service 1

Port: 1(QinQ)
S-VLAN ID: 100

Port: 1(QinQ)
S-VLAN ID: 100

PSN
NodeB 1

AC

PW2
LSP

AC
NE1
NodeB 2

AC

PW1

UNI

NNI

Service 2
Port: 2(QinQ)
S-VLAN ID: 200

AC
NE2
NNI

RNC

UNI
Service 2
Port: 2(QinQ)
S-VLAN ID: 200

Packet transmission
equipment

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

655

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Typical Application of Service Model 3


Figure 11-8 shows the typical application of service model 3. Service 1 is present between
NodeB 1 and the RNC, and service 2 is present between NodeB 2 and the RNC. Service 1 carries
various C-VLAN IDs, and service 2 carries various S-VLAN IDs. The two services need to be
transmitted over a PSN.
On the UNI side of NE1, service 1 is received by port 1 and service 2 is received by port 2. On
the NNI side of NE1, service 1 and service 2 are transmitted separately on two PWs.
NE2 processes the two services in the same manner as NE1.
Figure 11-8 Typical application of service model 3
Service 1

Service 1

Port: 1 (802.1Q)

Port: 1 (802.1Q)

PSN
NodeB 1

AC

PW2
LSP

AC
NE1
NodeB 2

AC

PW1

UNI

NNI

AC
NE2
NNI

RNC

UNI

Service 2

Service 2

Port: 2(QinQ)

Port: 2(QinQ)

Packet transmission equipment

11.1.1.4 PW-Carried E-AGGR Services


A PW-carried E-AGGR service is an E-AGGR service category where Ethernet services from
multiple Ethernet ports are transmitted over one PW or Ethernet services from multiple PWs are
aggregated to one Ethernet port.

Service Model
Table 11-2 defines the PW-carried E-AGGR service models.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

656

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-2 PW-carried E-AGGR service models


Service Model

Aggregation
Mode

Service Flow

Port Mode

Port
Encapsulation
Type

Description

Model 1

Aggregating
services from
multiple UNI
ports to one PW

PORT+VLAN
(source)

Layer 2 (source)

IEEE 802.1q or
QinQ (source)

The packets
carrying specific
VLAN IDs are
aggregated from
multiple UNI
ports to the NNI
side for
transmission on
a PW. In this
manner,
multipoint-topoint service
aggregation is
implemented.

Aggregating
services from
multiple PWs to
one UNI port

PW (source)

Layer 3 (source)

- (source)

PORT+VLAN
(sink)

Layer 2 (sink)

IEEE 802.1q or
QinQ (sink)

Aggregating
services from
one UNI port to
one PW

PORT+VLAN
(source)

Layer 2 (source)

IEEE 802.1q or
QinQ (source)

Model 2

Model 3

Layer 3 (sink)

PW (sink)

- (sink)

Layer 3 (sink)

PW (sink)

- (sink)

Packets are
aggregated from
multiple PWs on
the NNI side to
one UNI port. In
this manner,
multipoint-topoint service
aggregation is
implemented.
The packets
carrying a
specific VLAN
IDs are
aggregated from
one UNI port to
one PW for
transmission
and VLAN ID
swapping. In
this manner,
VLAN ID
swapping is
implemented for
an Ethernet
PWE3 service.

Typical Applications of Service Models 1 and 2


NE1 and NE2 in Figure 11-9 show the typical application of service model 1, and NE3 in Figure
11-9 shows the typical application of service model 2.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

657

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

As shown in Figure 11-9, service 1 is present between NodeB 1 and the RNC, service 2 is present
between NodeB 2 and the RNC, service 3 is present between NodeB 3 and the RNC, and service
4 is present between NodeB 4 and the RNC. The four services need to be transmitted over a
PSN. Service 1 and service 2 are aggregated at NE1. Service 3 and service 4 are aggregated at
NE2. PW1 carrying service 1 and service 2 and PW2 carrying service 3 and service 4 are
aggregated at NE3.
Figure 11-9 Typical applications of service models 1 and 2
Service 1

NodeB 1

Port: 1
VLAN ID: 100

Service 2

PSN

Port: 2
VLAN ID: 200 AC
NE1
NodeB 2

Service 3
Port: 1
VLAN ID: 300

Service 2

PW1

Port: 1
VLAN ID: 200

PW2

AC
NE3 Service 3
Port: 1
VLAN ID: 300

LSP1

LSP2

AC

RNC

Service 4

NodeB 3
AC
Service 4
NodeB 4

Service 1
Port: 1
VLAN ID: 100

AC

Port: 2
VLAN ID: 400

NE2

UNI NNI

Port: 1
VLAN ID: 400
NNI UNI

Packet transmission equipment

On the UNI side of NE1, service 1 is received by port 1 and service 2 is received by port 2. On
the NNI side of NE1, service 1 and service 2 are aggregated to the same PW for transmission.
In this manner, multipoint-to-point service aggregation is implemented.
NE2 processes service 3 and service 4 in the same manner as NE1 processes service 1 and service
2.
On the NNI side of NE3, PW1 carrying service 1 and service 2 and PW2 carrying service 3 and
service 4 are aggregated. On the UNI side of NE3, the four services are sent out through port 1.
In this manner, multipoint-to-point service aggregation is implemented.

Typical Application of Service Model 3


NE1 in Figure 11-10 shows the typical application of service model 3.
As shown in Figure 11-10, service 1 and service 2 carry the same VLAN ID. PW1 carrying
service 1 and PW2 carrying service 2 are aggregated at NE3. For isolated service transmission,
the VLAN ID of service 1 is changed from 100 to 200 on NE1.
On the UNI side of NE1, service 1 is received by port 1. On the NNI side of NE1, service 1 is
aggregated to PW1 for transmission and VLAN ID swapping. After the VLAN ID swapping,
service 1 carries a VLAN ID different from that of service 2 and is therefore isolated from service
2 during transmission.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

658

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-10 Typical application of service model 3


VLAN Forwarding
Service 1

Service 1

Port: 1
VLAN ID: 100

PW: 1
VLAN ID: 200
Service 1

PSN
NodeB 1

AC

Port: 1
VLAN ID: 200

PW1
NE1

LSP1

AC
PW2

AC

NE3 Service 2
Port: 1
VLAN ID: 100

LSP2
NodeB 2

Service 2
NE2

Port: 1
VLAN ID: 100

UNI NNI

RNC

Service 2
PW: 2
VLAN ID: 100

NNI UNI

Packet transmission equipment

11.1.2 MS-PW
A PW that is carried in a PSN tunnel is called a single-segment PW (SS-PW). If a PW is carried
in multiple PSN tunnels, the PW is called a multi-segment PW (MS-PW).
NOTE

For the SS-PW network reference model, see PWE3 Network Reference Model.

MS-PW Network Reference Model


Figure 11-11 shows the MS-PW network reference model.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

659

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-11 MS-PW network reference model


Emulated service
MS-PW
PSN
tunnel
1

Native
service
T-PE1

PW1

PSN
tunnel
2
S-PE1

PW3

Native
service
T-PE2

CE1

CE2
PW2

PW4

AC

AC
PW switching point

T-PE: terminating provider edge

S-PE: switching provider edge

NOTE

PSN tunnels are available in several types, but the OptiX RTN 980 supports only MPLS tunnels. In this
document, PWE3 is based on MPLS tunnels (LSPs), unless otherwise specified.

In the preceding network reference model, T-PE1 and T-PE2 provide PWE3 services to CE1
and CE2. The PWs are carried in two PSN tunnels, and constitute the MS-PW.
The two tunnels (PSN tunnel 1 and PSN tunnel 2) that are used to carry PWs reside in different
PSN domains. PSN tunnel 1 extends from T-PE1 to S-PE1, and PSN tunnel 2 extends from SPE1 to T-PE2. Labels of PW1 carried in PSN tunnel 1 and PW3 carried in PSN tunnel 2 are
swapped at S-PE1. Similarly, labels of PW2 carried in PSN tunnel 1 and PW4 carried in PSN
tunnel 2 are swapped at S-PE1.

MS-PW Application
Compared with the SS-PW, the MS-PW has the following characteristics:
l

Reduces required tunnel resources.

Traverses different PSNs.

Provides segment-based protection for tunnels.

The following paragraphs and figures compare the application scenarios of the SS-PW and MSPW to show that it is easier for the MS-PW to implement segment-based protection for tunnels.
Figure 11-12 shows the SS-PW networking mode. The services between PE1 and PE2 are
transmitted on PW1 carried in MPLS tunnel 1. Both MPLS tunnel 1 and MPLS tunnel 2 are
configured with 1:1 protection. Protection, however, fails to be provided if disconnection faults
occur on different sides of the operator device (called the P device).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

660

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-12 SS-PW application


SS-PW

MPLS tunnel 1
PW1

PE1

PW1

PW1

PE2

PW1

MPLS tunnel 2
Packet transmission equipment

NOTE

The PWs are invisible to the P device on a PSN; the P device provides transparent transport in tunnels.

Figure 11-13 shows the MS-PW networking mode. The services between T-PE1 and T-PE2 are
transmitted on PW1 carried in MPLS tunnel 1 and PW2 carried on MPLS tunnel 2. The paired
tunnels (MPLS tunnel 1 and MPLS tunnel 3; MPLS tunnel 2 and MPLS tunnel 4) are configured
with 1:1 protection. In this configuration, protection can still be provided even when
disconnection faults occur on different sides of the S-PE1 device.
Figure 11-13 MS-PW application
MS-PW
MPLS tunnel 1

T-PE1

MPLS tunnel 2

PW1

PW2

PW1

PW2

MPLS tunnel 3

S-PE1

MPLS tunnel 4

T-PE2

Packet transmission equipment

11.2 Configuration Procedure


The service configuration procedure differs according to the specific service type.

11.2.1 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (CES Services)


This section describes the procedures for configuring the CES service information and UNI port
information, and the procedure for verifying the service configurations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

661

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 11-14 shows the procedures for configuring CES services in an end-to-end mode.
Figure 11-14 Configuration Flowchart
Required

Start

Optional
Configure UNI ports

Configure CES
services

Configure PW APS

Verify CES services

End

NOTE

For PWE3 services that have been configured in an end-to-end mode, follow the instructions in A.13.2 Searching
for MPLS Tunnels and PWE3 Services to synchronize the services to the network layer of the U2000. This
enables end-to-end management of the PWE3 services.

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Setting the Attributes of UNI Ports


Setting the attributes of UNI ports carrying CES services mainly involves setting the attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
Table 11-3 Setting the attributes of UNI ports
Operation

Remarks

Setting the
attributes of
Smart E1 ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.4.1 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Smart E1
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


Set Port Mode to Layer 1.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

662

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Remarks
A.6.4.2 Setting
Advanced
Attributes of
Smart E1 Ports

Optional. Set the parameters as follows:


l When PW Type is CESoPSN, set Frame
Format to CRC-4 Multiframe or Double
Frame as planned. The value CRC-4
Multiframe is recommended for securing
transmission quality.
When PW Type is SAToP, set Frame Format to
Unframe.
l Set Frame Mode to 31. If Frame Mode of the
opposite end is 30, the source 64 kbit/s timeslots
at the local end must include the 16th timeslot.

Procedure for Configuring CES Services


Table 11-4 Procedure for configuring CES services
Operation

Description

A.13.4.1 Creating PWE3 Service


Templates

Optional.

A.13.4.2 Configuring CES


Services in an End-to-End Mode

Required.

A.9.6.2 Modifying CES Service


Parameters

Perform this task to change the PHB service class if a


value other than the default value EF is required.

Perform this operation task when you need to


customize the default PWE3 service parameter values.

Set related parameters according to the service


planning information and parameter planning
information.

For example, if CES services are transmitted on the


ISU2/ISX2, set the PHB service class to CS7 to
decrease the CES service transmission delay and jitters.

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


Normally, PW APS is configured so that the OptiX RTN equipment works with other equipment
configured with MC-PW APS to achieve dual-homing protection. For details on how to
configure services with dual-homing protection on the U2000, see the Configuration Guide of
the equipment where MC-PW APS is configured or U2000 Online Help.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

663

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Verifying CES Services


Table 11-5 Verifying CES services
Operation

Remarks

A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by


Using a BER Tester

Test CES services at each E1 port by using BER testers.


The BER testers that support Nx64 kbit/s are required
to test CES services in CESoPSN mode.

11.2.2 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (CES Services)


This section describes how to configure CES services, configure UNI ports, and verify CES
services.

Configuration Flow Chart


Figure 11-15 provides the procedures for configuring CES services on a single NE.
Figure 11-15 Configuration flow chart
Required

Start

Optional
Configure UNI ports

Configure CES
services

Configure PW APS

Verify CES services

End

NOTE

By default, CES services use the retiming mode to transmit clock. Therefore, it is unnecessary to describe
the retiming mode in this topic. If CES services need to use the CES ACR mode to transmit clock, configure
the mode according to Configuration Procedure in the OptiX RTN 980 V100R003C00 Radio Transmission
System Feature Description.

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

664

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Setting the Attributes of UNI Ports


Setting the attributes of UNI ports carrying CES services mainly involves setting the attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
Table 11-6 Setting the attributes of UNI ports
Operation

Remarks

Setting the
attributes of
Smart E1 ports

A.6.4.1 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Smart E1
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

A.6.4.2 Setting
Advanced
Attributes of
Smart E1 Ports

Optional. Set the parameters as follows:

Set Port Mode to Layer 1.

l When PW Type is CESoPSN, set Frame


Format to CRC-4 Multiframe or Double
Frame as planned. The value CRC-4
Multiframe is recommended for securing
transmission quality.
When PW Type is SAToP, set Frame Format to
Unframe.
l Set Frame Mode to 31. If Frame Mode of the
opposite end is 30, the source 64 kbit/s timeslots
at the local end must include the 16th timeslot.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

665

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configuring CES Services


Table 11-7 Configuring CES services
Operation

Remarks

A.9.6.1 Creating CES


Services

Setting the general


attributes of services

Required. Set the parameters as


follows:
l Set Service ID(e.g.1,3-6), Service
name, Source Board, Source
Low Channel(e.g.1,3-6), and
Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.1,3-6)
according to service planning
information.
Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.1,3-6) is
valid only for the CESoPSN mode.
If the Frame Mode at the opposite
end is set to 30, the source 64 kbit/
s timeslots at the local end must
include the 16th timeslot.
l Set Priority List. Priority List
indicates the PHB service class for
CES services.
The default PHB service class
for CES services is EF.
If CES services are transmitted
on the ISU2/ISX2, set the PHB
service class to CS7 to decrease
the CES service transmission
delay and jitters.
l Set Mode to UNI-NNI.
l Set PW Type according to
planning information.
If PCM timeslots are used for
service access, select CESoPSN;
otherwise, select SAToP. For
Fractional E1, select CESoPSN.
l Set Protection Type for a PW
according to network planning
information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

666

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Remarks
Configuring PWs

l Required. Set the basic attributes of


PWs.
Set PW ID according to
planning information.
Set PW Ingress Label/Source
Port and PW Egress Label/
Sink Port according to
planning information.
Select the Tunnel according to
planning information. For a
unidirectional tunnel, select or
create an egress tunnel.
l Optional. Set advanced attributes
of PWs.
Advanced attributes of PWs take
their default values.

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


For details about how to configure PW protection, see Configuration Procedure in PW APS of
the Feature Description.

Verifying CES Services


Table 11-8 Verifying CES services
Operation

Remarks

A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by


Using a BER Tester

Test CES services at each E1 port by using BER testers.


The BER testers that support Nx64 kbit/s are required
to test CES services in CESoPSN mode.

11.2.3 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (ATM Services)


This section describes the procedures for configuring the ATM service information, UNI port
information, ATM/IMA information, global ATM QoS profile, and the procedure for verifying
the service configurations in an end-to-end mode.

Configuration Flowchart
The procedure for configuring ATM/IMA E1 services is different from the procedure for
configuring fractional ATM/IMA services. For details, see Figure 11-16.
NOTE

Transparently transmitted (PORT-TRANS) ATM services cannot be configured in an end-to-end mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

667

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-16 End-to-end configuration flowchart (ATM services)


Flow chart for configuring
ATM/IMA E1 services

Flow chart for configuring Fractional


ATM/IMA services

Required

Start

Start

Optional

Set UNI port attributes of


ATM/IMA E1 services

Set UNI port attributes of


Fractional E1 services

Configure IMA group


information

Configure IMA group


information

Configure Global ATM


QoS Profile

Configure Global ATM


QoS Profile

Configure ATM services

Configure ATM services

Configure PW APS

Configure PW APS

Verify ATM service


configurations

Verify ATM service


configurations

End

End

NOTE

For PWE3 services that have been configured on a per-NE basis before end-to-end configuration, follow
instructions in A.13.2 Searching for MPLS Tunnels and PWE3 Services to synchronize the services to the
network layer of the U2000. This enables end-to-end management of the PWE3 services.

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Setting UNI Port Attributes for ATM/IMA E1 Services


Table 11-9 Setting attributes of Smart E1 ports
Operation

Description

Setting attributes
of Smart E1 ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.4.1 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Smart E1
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Name according to service planning
information.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

668

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Description
A.6.4.2 Setting
Advanced
Attributes of
Smart E1 Ports

Optional. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Frame Format and Frame Mode according
to service planning information. Ensure that the
same frame mode is used at both ends.
Normally, the port that transmits ATM/IMA
services uses the CRC-4 multi-frame format and
the PCM30 frame mode.

Setting UNI Port Attributes for Fractional E1 Services


Setting the UNI port attributes for Fractional E1 services involves setting Smart E1 port
attributes, creating serial ports, and configuring serial ports.
Table 11-10 Setting attributes of Smart E1 ports
Operation

Description

Setting attributes
of Smart E1 ports

A.6.4.1 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Smart E1
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

A.6.4.2 Setting
Advanced
Attributes of
Smart E1 Ports

Optional. Set the parameters as follows:

l Set Name according to service planning


information.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 1.

Set Frame Format and Frame Mode according to


service planning information. Ensure that the same
frame mode is used at both ends.
Normally, the port that transmits Fractional ATM
services uses the CRC-4 multi-frame format and the
PCM31 frame mode.

Creating and
configuring
serial ports

A.6.5.1
Creating Serial
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set the parameters according to service planning
information.
Port Number(e.g:1,3-6) and Name specifies
the ID and name of a serial port.
Used Board and Used Port specifies the board
and port where the serial port exists.
64K Timeslot(e.g:1,3-6) specifies the IDs of
the 64 kbit/s timeslots that are used as a serial
port.
l The default value of Level is 64K Timeslot.
NOTE
When the E1 frame mode is PCM30, timeslot 0 and timeslot
16 cannot be used to carry services. When the E1 frame
mode is PCM31, timeslot 0 cannot be used to carry services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

669

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Description
A.6.5.2 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Serial Ports

Required.
Set Port Mode to Layer 2.

Setting IMA Group Information


Configuring IMA group information involves binding ATM trunks, configuring an IMA group,
and configuring ATM ports.
Table 11-11 Configuring an IMA group
Operation

Description

A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs

Required.
l For ATM/IMA services, set Level to E1.
For Fractional E1 services, set Level to
Fractional E1.
l Set the other parameters according to
service planning information.
NOTE
When the E1 frame mode is PCM30, timeslot 16
cannot be bound to an ATM trunk.

A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set IMA Protocol Enable Status.
For ATM E1 and Fractional ATM, set
IMA Protocol Enable Status to
Disabled in most cases. For IMA E1 and
Fractional IMA, set IMA Protocol
Enable Status to Enabled.
l Set Clock Mode of the local NE and the
NE at the opposite end of the IMA trunk
to be the same as Clock Mode of the
interconnected BTS.
l The other parameters are valid only for
IMA E1 and Fractional IMA. Parameters
must be set to the same values for
equipment at both ends of an IMA link. It
is recommended that the parameters take
their default values.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

670

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Description

A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters

Optional.
l Set Port Type and ATM Cell Payload
Scrambling according to the type of
access equipment. It is recommended that
the parameters take their default values.
The parameter values must be the same for
both ends of a link.
l The other parameters take their default
values.

Procedure for Configuring the Global ATM QoS Profile


Configuring the global ATM QoS profile includes configuring the global ATM policy profile
and configuring the global CoS mapping table.
Table 11-12 Configuring the global ATM QoS profile
Operation

Description

A.13.4.3 Configuring an ATM Policy


Profile

Required. Set parameters according to the


type of the ATM service access equipment.

A.13.4.4 Configuring an ATM CoS


Mapping Profile

Required if the default CoS mapping


"DefaultAtmCosMap" does not meet
requirements. Set parameters according to the
network planning information.

Procedure for Configuring ATM Services


Operation

Description

A.13.4.1 Creating PWE3 Service


Templates

Optional.

A.13.4.5 Configuring ATM Services in an


End-to-End Mode

Required.

Perform this operation task when you need to


customize the default PWE3 service
parameter values.

Set related parameters according to the


service planning information and parameter
planning information.

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


Normally, PW APS is configured so that the OptiX RTN equipment works with other equipment
configured with MC-PW APS to achieve dual-homing protection. For details on how to
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

671

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

configure services with dual-homing protection on the U2000, see the Configuration Guide of
the equipment where MC-PW APS is configured or U2000 Online Help.

Verifying ATM Service Configurations


Operation

Description

A.14.4 Testing ATM Services

Use the ATM OAM function to test ATM


service connectivity.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 does not support ATM OAM
tests on transparently transmitted services (PORTTRANS) over an ATM port. Therefore, it is
recommended that you initiate an ATM OAM test
on a CE (for example, a BTS or RNC) of a PSN so
that ATM OAM packets can be transparently
transmitted through the OptiX RTN 980 to the
opposite CE on the PSN. In this manner, an ATM
service connectivity test is implemented.

11.2.4 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (ATM Services)


This section describes the procedures for configuring the service information, UNI port
information, IMA information, and QoS information of an ATM service and the procedure for
verifying the service configurations.

Configuration Flow Chart


The procedure for configuring ATM/IMA E1 services is different from the procedure for
configuring Fractional ATM/IMA services. See Figure 11-17.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

672

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-17 Configuration flow chart (ATM services on a per-NE basis)


Flow chart for configuring
ATM/IMA E1 services
Required
Optional

Flow chart for configuring Fractional


ATM/IMA services

Start

Start

Set UNI port attributes of


ATM/IMA E1 services

Set UNI port attributes of


Fractional E1 services

Configure IMA group


information

Configure IMA group


information

Configure ATM QoS

Configure ATM QoS

Configure ATM services

Configure ATM services

Configure PW APS

Configure PW APS

Verify ATM service


configurations

Verify ATM service


configurations

End

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.

Setting UNI Port Attributes for ATM/IMA E1 Services


Table 11-13 Setting attributes of Smart E1 ports
Operation

Description

Setting attributes
of Smart E1 ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.6.4.1 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Smart E1
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Name according to service planning
information.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

673

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Description
A.6.4.2 Setting
Advanced
Attributes of
Smart E1 Ports

Optional. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set Frame Format and Frame Mode according
to service planning information. Ensure that the
same frame mode is used at both ends.
Normally, the port that transmits ATM/IMA
services uses the CRC-4 multi-frame format and
the PCM30 frame mode.

Setting UNI Port Attributes for Fractional E1 Services


Setting the UNI port attributes for Fractional E1 services involves setting Smart E1 port
attributes, creating serial ports, and configuring serial ports.
Table 11-14 Setting attributes of Smart E1 ports
Operation

Description

Setting attributes
of Smart E1 ports

A.6.4.1 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Smart E1
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:

A.6.4.2 Setting
Advanced
Attributes of
Smart E1 Ports

Optional. Set the parameters as follows:

l Set Name according to service planning


information.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 1.

Set Frame Format and Frame Mode according to


service planning information. Ensure that the same
frame mode is used at both ends.
Normally, the port that transmits Fractional ATM
services uses the CRC-4 multi-frame format and the
PCM31 frame mode.

Creating and
configuring
serial ports

A.6.5.1
Creating Serial
Ports

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set the parameters according to service planning
information.
Port Number(e.g:1,3-6) and Name specifies
the ID and name of a serial port.
Used Board and Used Port specifies the board
and port where the serial port exists.
64K Timeslot(e.g:1,3-6) specifies the IDs of
the 64 kbit/s timeslots that are used as a serial
port.
l The default value of Level is 64K Timeslot.
NOTE
When the E1 frame mode is PCM30, timeslot 0 and timeslot
16 cannot be used to carry services. When the E1 frame
mode is PCM31, timeslot 0 cannot be used to carry services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

674

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Operation

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Description
A.6.5.2 Setting
Basic Attributes
of Serial Ports

Required.
Set Port Mode to Layer 2.

Setting IMA Group Information


Configuring IMA group information involves binding ATM trunks, configuring an IMA group,
and configuring ATM ports.
Table 11-15 Configuring an IMA group
Operation

Description

A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs

Required.
l For ATM/IMA services, set Level to E1.
For Fractional E1 services, set Level to
Fractional E1.
l Set the other parameters according to
service planning information.
NOTE
When the E1 frame mode is PCM30, timeslot 16
cannot be bound to an ATM trunk.

A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group

Required. Set the parameters as follows:


l Set IMA Protocol Enable Status.
For ATM E1 and Fractional ATM, set
IMA Protocol Enable Status to
Disabled in most cases. For IMA E1 and
Fractional IMA, set IMA Protocol
Enable Status to Enabled.
l Set Clock Mode of the local NE and the
NE at the opposite end of the IMA trunk
to be the same as Clock Mode of the
interconnected BTS.
l The other parameters are valid only for
IMA E1 and Fractional IMA. Parameters
must be set to the same values for
equipment at both ends of an IMA link. It
is recommended that the parameters take
their default values.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

675

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Description

A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters

Optional.
l Set Port Type and ATM Cell Payload
Scrambling according to the type of
access equipment. It is recommended that
the parameters take their default values.
The parameter values must be the same for
both ends of a link.
l The other parameters take their default
values.

Configuring ATM QoS


Configuring ATM QoS involves configuring the ATM policy and configuring the CoS mapping
table. For transparently transmitted ATM services, you do not need to configure the ATM traffic
management policy. For ATM connection-based services, the ATM traffic management policy
must be configured.
Table 11-16 Configuring ATM QoS
Operation

Description

A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy

Required for services that are not


transparently transmitted ATM services. Set
parameters according to the type of the ATM
service access equipment.
l Set Policy ID. Alternatively, you can
select Automatically Assign so that the
policy ID is automatically assigned.
l Select or assign a value for Policy
Name.
l Set Service Type according to service
planning information.
l Set Traffic Type and corresponding
traffic parameters based on Service
Type.
l Set the enabled status of Discard Traffic
Frame and UPC/NPC according to
planning information.

A.9.9.1 Creating an ATM-DiffServ


Domain

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required if "DefaultAtmCosMap" does not


meet requirements. Set parameters according
to service planning information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

676

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configuring an ATM Service


Operation

Description

A.9.8.1 Creating ATM


Services

Setting service
attributes

Set the basic attributes for ATM


services. Required. Set the
parameters as follows:
l Set Service ID and Service
Name.
l Set Service Type to UNIs-NNI.
l Set Connection Type.
If services are transmitted based
on VP connections, set
Connection Type to PVP. If
services are transmitted based on
VC connections, set Connection
Type to PVC. If services are
transparently transmitted over
ports, set Connection Type to
Port Transparent.

Configuring ATM
connections

Creating ATM connections Required.


Set connection parameters according
to service planning information.
l For ATM connection-based
services, the connection
parameters need to be configured.
Uplink Policy and Down link
Policy are specified for ATM
connections during configuration
of ATM policies.
l For services transparently
transmitted through ATM ports,
only Source Board, Source
Port, and PW ID need to be
configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

677

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Description
Configuring PWs

l Setting basic attributes of PWs


Required.
Set PW ID, PW Ingress
Label / Source Port, and PW
Egress Label / Sink Port
according to service planning
information.
Set PW Type according to
planning information.
Select a value for Tunnel
according to service planning
information. For
unidirectional tunnels, you
also need to set Egress
Tunnel.
l Setting advanced attributes of
PWs Optional.
If Control Word is No Use, set
Control Channel Type to Alert
Label. Other advanced attributes
generally take their default values.
Advanced attributes of PWs take
their default values.
l Optional. Configure the QoS.
The QoS parameters take their
default values.

Configuring CoS
mapping

Required if "DefaultAtmCosMap"
does not meet requirements.
Set CoS Mapping according to
planning information.
Set the mapping between PW ID and
CoS Mapping.
Select the policy for mapping
different ATM service levels to CoS
priorities. In this way, different
quality levels are provided for
different ATM services.

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


For details about how to configure PW protection, see Configuration Procedure in PW APS of
the Feature Description.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

678

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Verifying ATM Service Configurations


Operation

Description

A.14.4 Testing ATM Services

Use the ATM OAM function to test ATM


service connectivity.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 does not support ATM OAM
tests on transparently transmitted services (PORTTRANS) over an ATM port. Therefore, it is
recommended that you initiate an ATM OAM test
on a CE (for example, a BTS or RNC) of a PSN so
that ATM OAM packets can be transparently
transmitted through the OptiX RTN 980 to the
opposite CE on the PSN. In this manner, an ATM
service connectivity test is implemented.

11.2.5 End-to-End Configuration Procedure (E-Line Services


Carried by PWs)
This section describes how to configure the following information in an end-to-end mode:
parameters about E-Line services carried by PWs, ports that receive and transmit Ethernet
services, link aggregation groups (LAGs), QoS policies, PW protection, and service verification.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 11-18 provides the procedures for configuring E-Line services carried by PWs in an endto-end mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

679

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-18 Configuration flowchart


Required

Start

Optional
Configure Ethernet ports.

Configure IF_ETH ports.

Configure LAGs.

Configure E-Line services


carried by PWs.

Configure a PW APS
protection group.

Configure QoS.

Verify E-Line service


configurations.

End

NOTE

If PWE3 services have been configured on a per-NE basis before end-to-end service configuration, follow the
instructions in A.13.2 Searching for MPLS Tunnels and PWE3 Services to synchronize the services to the
network layer of the U2000. This enables end-to-end management of the PWE3 services.

The procedures in the configuration flowchart are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

680

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 11-17 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required when Ethernet ports are used to receive and transmit Ethernet
services. Set parameters for the Ethernet ports that receive and transmit
Ethernet services as follows:
l Set Enable Port to Enabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.
l Set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l For an Ethernet port that is connected to external equipment (BTS or
RNC), set Working Mode to the same value as that of the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment is
auto-negotiation). For an Ethernet port within the network, set
Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame Length(byte)
according to the actual length of the jumbo frames. If no jumbo frame
is transmitted, it is recommended that you set Max Frame Length
(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the external


equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the major
parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enabled.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow Control Mode to Enabled.

A.6.6.3 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l If only frames carrying VLAN tags (tagged frames) are received, set
TAG to Tag Aware.
l If only frames carrying no VLAN tag (untagged frames), set TAG to
Access, and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to
the network planning information.
l If both tagged and untagged frames are received, set TAG to Hybrid,
and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.

A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

681

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring IF_ETH Ports


Table 11-18 Procedure for configuring IF_ETH ports
Operation

Description

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required when IF_ETH ports are used to receive and transmit Ethernet
services. Set parameters for the IF_ETH ports that receive and transmit
Ethernet services as follows:
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.
l Set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.

A.6.7.2 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l If only frames carrying VLAN tags (tagged frames) are received, set
Tag to Tag Aware.
l If only frames carrying no VLAN tag (untagged frames), set Tag to
Access, and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to
the network planning information.
l If both tagged and untagged frames are received, set Tag to Hybrid,
and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that permits bit errors,
such as a voice service or a video service, you can set Error Frame
Discard Enabled to Disabled.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

682

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 11-19 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

683

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring E-Line Services Carried by PWs


Table 11-20 Procedure for configuring UNI-NNI E-Line services carried by PWs
Operation

Description

A.13.4.1 Creating PWE3 Service


Templates

Optional.

A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based


E-Line Services (in an End-toEnd Mode)

Required.

Perform this operation task when you need to


customize the default PWE3 service parameter values.

Set related parameters according to the service


planning information and parameter planning
information.

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


Normally, PW APS is configured so that the OptiX RTN equipment works with other equipment
configured with MC-PW APS to achieve dual-homing protection. For details on how to
configure services with dual-homing protection on the U2000, see the Configuration Guide of
the equipment where MC-PW APS is configured or U2000 Online Help.

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 11-21 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required.

If the mappings that are planned between the packet priority and PHB
service classes for base stations or interconnected equipment are different
from the mappings that are configured for the default DS domain of the
OptiX RTN equipment, change the mappings of the OptiX RTN equipment
to be the same as the mappings planned for the base stations or
interconnected equipment.

l If the packet priority type (namely, the trusted packet type) supported
by base stations or interconnected equipment is different from the
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority, by default) for the default DS
domain of the OptiX RTN equipment, change the trusted packet type
of the UNI port in the DS domain that receives the Ethernet service
packets to be the same as the trusted packet type of the base stations or
interconnected equipment.
l When transmitting the PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line service packets,
an NNI port supports only packets with the MPLS EXP priority.
Therefore, you need to change the trusted packet type of the NNI port
in the default DS domain to MPLS EXP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

684

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Description

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required when you need to apply QoS policies other than Diffserv and
port shaping for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required when you need to perform the CAR or shaping operation for a
specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required when a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Procedure for Verifying E-Line Services


Table 11-22 Procedure for verifying E-Line services
Operation

Description

A.13.4.8 Verifying PW-Based ELine Service Configurations (in


an End-to-End Mode)

Required.
It is recommended that you perform an LB test (ETH
OAM function) verify connectivity of an E-Line
service.

11.2.6 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (E-Line Services Carried by


PWs)
This section describes how to configure the following information on a per-NE basis: parameters
about E-Line services carried by PWs, ports that receive and transmit Ethernet services, link
aggregation groups (LAGs), QoS policies, PW protection, and service verification.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 11-19 provides the procedures for configuring E-Line services carried by PWs on a perNE basis.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

685

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-19 Configuration flowchart (E-Line services carried by PWs)


Required

Start

Optional
Configure Ethernet ports.

Configure IF_ETH ports.

Configure LAGs.

Configure E-Line services


carried by PWs.

Configure a PW APS
protection group.

Configure QoS.

Verify E-Line service


configurations.

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

686

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 11-23 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required when Ethernet ports are used to receive and transmit Ethernet
services. Set parameters for the Ethernet ports that receive and transmit
Ethernet services as follows:
l Set Enable Port to Enabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.
l Set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l For an Ethernet port that is connected to external equipment (BTS or
RNC), set Working Mode to the same value as that of the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment is
auto-negotiation). For an Ethernet port within the network, set
Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame Length(byte)
according to the actual length of the jumbo frames. If no jumbo frame
is transmitted, it is recommended that you set Max Frame Length
(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the external


equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the major
parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enabled.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow Control Mode to Enabled.

A.6.6.3 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l If only frames carrying VLAN tags (tagged frames) are received, set
TAG to Tag Aware.
l If only frames carrying no VLAN tag (untagged frames), set TAG to
Access, and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to
the network planning information.
l If both tagged and untagged frames are received, set TAG to Hybrid,
and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.

A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

687

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring IF_ETH Ports


Table 11-24 Procedure for configuring IF_ETH ports
Operation

Description

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required when IF_ETH ports are used to receive and transmit Ethernet
services. Set parameters for the IF_ETH ports that receive and transmit
Ethernet services as follows:
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.
l Set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.

A.6.7.2 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l If only frames carrying VLAN tags (tagged frames) are received, set
Tag to Tag Aware.
l If only frames carrying no VLAN tag (untagged frames), set Tag to
Access, and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to
the network planning information.
l If both tagged and untagged frames are received, set Tag to Hybrid,
and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that permits bit errors,
such as a voice service or a video service, you can set Error Frame
Discard Enabled to Disabled.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

688

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 11-25 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

689

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services Carried by PWs


Table 11-26 Procedure for configuring UNI-NNI E-Line services carried by PWs
Operation

Description

A.7.3.5
Configuring
UNI-NNI ELine Services
(Carried by
PWs)

Required.
Set the major parameters of E-Line services as follows:
l Set Direction to UNI-NNI.
l Set BPDU to Not Transparently transmitted.
l Set Source Port and Source VLANs according to the network
planning information.
l Set Bearer Type to PW.
l It is recommended that you set Protection Type to No Protection.
Although a PW protection scheme needs to be created, it is
recommended that you create it after creating E-Line services carried
by PWs.
Set the major parameters for a PW in the General Attributes tab as
follows:
l Set PW ID according to the service planning information.
l Set PW Signaling Type to Static.
l PW Type indicates whether to add P-TAG when Ethernet frames are
encapsulated on a PW. When no request is proposed to add VLAN IDs,
set this parameter to Ethernet. When a request is proposed to add
VLAN IDs, set this parameter to Ethernet Tagged Mode. In the
Advanced Attributes tab page, set Request VLAN to be added.
l Set PW Ingress Label/Source Port and PW Egress Label/Sink
Port according to the service planning information.
l Set Tunnel Type to MPLS.
l Select the Tunnel that carries PWs according to the service planning
information.
Set the major parameters for a PW in the Advanced Attributes tab as
follows:
l The control word is not supported during ETH PWE3 packet
encapsulation on the OptiX RTN 980. Therefore, set Control Word to
No Use.
l Set Control Channel Type to Alert Label.
l Set VCCV Verification Mode to Ping.
Set the major parameters for a PW in the QoS tab as follows:
l Set Bandwidth Limit for a PW according to the service planning
information. Its default value is Disabled.
l To enable Bandwidth Limit to take effect for a PW, first configure a
maximum bandwidth for the tunnel that carries the PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

690

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


For details about how to configure PW protection, see Configuration Procedure in PW APS of
the Feature Description.

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 11-27 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required.

If the mappings that are planned between the packet priority and PHB
service classes for base stations or interconnected equipment are different
from the mappings that are configured for the default DS domain of the
OptiX RTN equipment, change the mappings of the OptiX RTN equipment
to be the same as the mappings planned for the base stations or
interconnected equipment.

l If the packet priority type (namely, the trusted packet type) supported
by base stations or interconnected equipment is different from the
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority, by default) for the default DS
domain of the OptiX RTN equipment, change the trusted packet type
of the UNI port in the DS domain that receives the Ethernet service
packets to be the same as the trusted packet type of the base stations or
interconnected equipment.
l When transmitting the PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line service packets,
an NNI port supports only packets with the MPLS EXP priority.
Therefore, you need to change the trusted packet type of the NNI port
in the default DS domain to MPLS EXP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required when you need to apply QoS policies other than Diffserv and
port shaping for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required when you need to perform the CAR or shaping operation for a
specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required when a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

691

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 11-28 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance


Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance


Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

692

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Description

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

11.2.7 Per-NE Configuration Procedure (PW-Carried E-Aggr


Services)
Configuring PW-carried E-Aggr services on a per-NE basis includes configuring the service
information, UNI port information, protection information, and QoS information, and verifying
the service configurations.

Configuration Flowchart
Figure 11-20 shows the procedure for configuring PW-carried E-Aggr services.
Figure 11-20 Configuration flowchart on a per-NE basis (PW-carried E-Aggr services)
Required
Optional

Start

Configure Ethernet ports.

Configure IF_ETH ports.

Configure LAGs.

Configure PW-carried E-Aggr


Services.

Configure a PW APS
protection group.

Configure QoS.

Verify Ethernet service


configurations.

End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

693

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring Ethernet Ports


Table 11-29 Procedure for configuring Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.6.6.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required when Ethernet ports are used to receive and transmit Ethernet
services. Set parameters for the Ethernet ports that receive and transmit
Ethernet services as follows:
l Set Enable Port to Enabled.
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.
l Set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.
l For an Ethernet port that is connected to external equipment (BTS or
RNC), set Working Mode to the same value as that of the external
equipment (generally, the working mode of the external equipment is
auto-negotiation). For an Ethernet port within the network, set
Working Mode to Auto-Negotiation.
l When jumbo frames are transmitted, set Max Frame Length(byte)
according to the actual length of the jumbo frames. If no jumbo frame
is transmitted, it is recommended that you set Max Frame Length
(byte) to 1536.

A.6.6.2
Configuring
the Traffic
Control of
Ethernet Ports

Required when the flow control function is enabled on the external


equipment to which the Ethernet port is connected. Set the major
parameters as follows:
l When the external equipment uses the non-auto-negotiation flow
control function, set Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode to
Enabled.
l When the external equipment uses the auto-negotiation flow control
function, set Auto-Negotiation Flow Control Mode to Enabled.

A.6.6.3 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l If only frames carrying VLAN tags (tagged frames) are received, set
TAG to Tag Aware.
l If only frames carrying no VLAN tag (untagged frames), set TAG to
Access, and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to
the network planning information.
l If both tagged and untagged frames are received, set TAG to Hybrid,
and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.

A.6.6.5 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
Ethernet Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

694

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring IF_ETH Ports


Table 11-30 Procedure for configuring IF_ETH ports
Operation

Description

A.6.7.1 Setting
the General
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required when IF_ETH ports are used to receive and transmit Ethernet
services. Set parameters for the IF_ETH ports that receive and transmit
Ethernet services as follows:
l Set Port Mode to Layer 2.
l Set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q.

A.6.7.2 Setting
the Layer 2
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Required. Set the major parameters as follows:


l If only frames carrying VLAN tags (tagged frames) are received, set
Tag to Tag Aware.
l If only frames carrying no VLAN tag (untagged frames), set Tag to
Access, and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to
the network planning information.
l If both tagged and untagged frames are received, set Tag to Hybrid,
and set Default VLAN ID and VLAN Priority according to the
network planning information.

A.6.7.4 Setting
the Advanced
Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.
When the IF_ETH port transmits an Ethernet service that permits bit errors,
such as a voice service or a video service, you can set Error Frame
Discard Enabled to Disabled.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

695

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports


Table 11-31 Procedure for Configuring LAG on Ethernet ports
Operation

Description

A.7.2.1
Creating a
LAG

Required if LAG protection is configured for FE/GE ports or for the


Integrated IP radio that works in N+0/XPIC mode. Set the parameters as
follows:
NOTE
For ISU2/ISX2 boards, if they have been added to a PLA group during microwave
link configuration, the LAG does not need to be configured.

l Set LAG Type to the same value as that at the opposite end. Generally,
set LAG Type to Static at both ends.
l Set the Hybrid/AM attributes to the same values for the IF ports in a
LAG.
l For FE/GE ports, set Load Sharing to the same value as that at the
opposite end. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to NonSharing at both ends, if the LAG is configured only to provide
protection. It is recommended that you set Load Sharing to Sharing
at both ends, if the LAG is configured to increase the bandwidth.
l Set Load Sharing to Sharing at both ends, if Integrated IP radio works
in N+0/XPIC mode and uses LAG protection.
l Set Revertive Mode to the same value as that at the opposite end.
Generally, set Revertive Mode to Revertive at both ends. This
parameter is valid only to LAGs whose Load Sharing is set to NonSharing.
l Set this parameter to the same value as for the opposite equipment.
Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value
Automatic. This parameter is applicable only to load-sharing LAGs.
l It is recommended that the main and slave ports take the same settings
at both ends. In this case, you can set System Priority as required. It
is recommended that this parameter take its default value. This
parameter is valid only to static LAGs.
l For an air interface LAG, to enable microwave signal degrade to trigger
LAG switching, set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to
Enabled.
l Set Main Board, Main Port, and Selected Standby Ports according
to the network plan. It is recommended that the same main and slave
ports are used for the LAGs at both ends.
NOTE
Set the AM attributes to the same value for the microwave ports in a LAG.

A.7.2.2 Setting
LAG
Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

696

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring PW-carried E-Aggr Services


Table 11-32 Procedure for configuring PW-carried E-Aggr services
Operation

Description

A.7.3.6
Creating EAGGR
Services

Required.
l An E-Aggr service can have more than one Source but can have only
one Sink. Configure the sources and sink for an E-Aggr service in
different aggregation scenarios as follows:
For an E-Aggr service aggregating services from multiple UNI ports
to a PW, configure these UNI ports as Source and the PW as
Sink.
For an E-Aggr service aggregating services from multiple PWs to
one UNI port, configure these PWs as Source and the UNI port as
Sink.
Regardless of whether VLAN ID swapping is required by an EAggr service, a VLAN forwarding table needs to be configured.
Configure a VLAN forwarding table according to the network
planning information.
Set the other parameters according to the network planning
information.
l If VLAN ID swapping is required for PW-carried E-Line services,
change the E-Line services to an E-Aggr service. Configure the E-Aggr
service as follows:
It is recommended that you configure the UNI port as Source and
the PW as Sink.
Configure a VLAN forwarding table according to the network
planning information.
Set the other parameters according to the network planning
information.
NOTE
On a packet switched network (PSN), if Ethernet services carried on PEs are pointto-point services from one UNI port to a PW and require no VLAN ID swapping,
configure the Ethernet services as E-Line services carried on PWs on a per-NE basis.

Procedure for Configuring PW Protection


For details about configuring PW protection, see Configuration Procedure in PW APS of the
Feature Description.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

697

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure for Configuring the QoS


Table 11-33 Procedure for configuring the QoS
Operation

Description

A.7.7.2
Modifying the
Mapping
Relationships
for the DS
Domain

Required.

A.7.7.3
Changing the
Ports Applied
to a DS Domain
and Their
Trusted Packet
Types

Required.

If the mappings that are planned between the packet priority and PHB
service classes for base stations or interconnected equipment are different
from the mappings that are configured for the default DS domain of the
OptiX RTN equipment, change the mappings of the OptiX RTN equipment
to be the same as the mappings planned for the base stations or
interconnected equipment.

l If the packet priority type (namely, the trusted packet type) supported
by base stations or interconnected equipment is different from the
trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority, by default) for the default DS
domain of the OptiX RTN equipment, change the trusted packet type
of the UNI port in the DS domain that receives the Ethernet service
packets to be the same as the trusted packet type of the base stations or
interconnected equipment.
l When transmitting the PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line service packets,
an NNI port supports only packets with the MPLS EXP priority.
Therefore, you need to change the trusted packet type of the NNI port
in the default DS domain to MPLS EXP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

A.7.7.4
Creating a Port
Policy

Required when you need to apply QoS policies other than Diffserv and
port shaping for a specific port.

A.7.7.6
Creating
Traffic

Required when you need to perform the CAR or shaping operation for a
specific flow over the port.

A.7.7.7 Setting
the Port That
Uses the Port
Policy

Required when a port policy is created.

A.7.7.8
Configuring
Port Shaping

Required if you need to limit the egress bandwidth that an Ethernet service
occupies.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Set the related parameters according to the network planning information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

698

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedures for Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations


Table 11-34 Procedures for verifying Ethernet service configurations
Operation

Description

A.7.8.1
Creating an
MD

Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name and Maintenance Domain Level to
the same values for the NEs.
l For an Ethernet service between two edge nodes on the transport
network, it is recommended that Maintenance Domain Level takes its
default value of 4. For an Ethernet service between two internal NEs
on the transport network, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value
smaller than 4. For an Ethernet service between two Ethernet ports on
the same NE, set Maintenance Domain Level to a value smaller than
the value that is set in the test of an Ethernet service between two
internal NEs on the transport network.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.2
Creating an
MA

l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance


Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the same value for the NEs.
l Set Relevant Service to the same service for the NEs.
l It is recommended that you set CC Test Transmit Period to 1s.
Required for the NEs where the two Ethernet ports involved in the service
test are located. Set the parameters as follows:

A.7.8.3
Creating
MEPs

l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance


Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Board and Port to the Ethernet ports that are involved in the service
test.
l Set MP ID to different values for MEPs in the same MD.
l If the OAM information initiated by the MEP travels through the packet
switching unit on the local NE, set Direction of the MEP to Ingress.
Otherwise, set Direction to Egress.
l Set CC Status to Active, as the MEP ID is used to identify the MEP
during the LB test.

A.7.8.4
Creating
Remote MEPs
in an MA

Required for the NE where the Ethernet ports involved in the OAM
operation are located. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Maintenance Domain Name to the value of Maintenance
Domain Name that is set in the preceding step.
l Set Maintenance Association Name to the value of Maintenance
Association Name that is set in the preceding step.
l To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated
by the other MEPs in the same MA, you need to set the other MEPs as
the remote MEPs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

699

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Operation

Description

Perform an LB
test to test the
Ethernet
service
configurations

Required.
The LB test result should show that no packet loss occurs.

11.3 Configuration Example (Common CES Services)


This section considers a common CES service on a packet network as an example to describe
how to configure CES services according to network planning information. Each CES service
is encapsulated in SAToP mode.

11.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection),
configure CES services according to the following requirements for BTS22 shown in Figure
11-21.
l

Table 11-35 provides the port information of CES services.

There is a bidirectional working tunnel between NE21 and NE31. Protection schemes are
configured for this tunnel and its tunnel ID is 1505. 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS
Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection) describes the configuration of this tunnel.

There are no requirements for transmitting services with some of the timeslots.

Figure 11-21 Networking Diagram

GE

GE

NE32
NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE

E1

BSC
Working tunnel
(ID=1505)

E1 loop

Hybrid radio ring


network
E1

BTS22

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

700

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-35 Service port information


NE

Service Port

Description

NE21

2-SP3S(1-2)

Receives base station


services from BTS22 over
the Hybrid radio network.
For the configuration process
of these services, see 7.6
Configuration Example
(TDM Services on a Hybrid
Radio Ring Network).

6-ML1(1-2)

Switches the E1 services of


BTS22 from the TDM
domain to the packet domain
by forming cross-connect
loops with and 2-SP3S-(1-2)
ports.

2-ML1(1-2)

Transmits base station


services from BTS22 to the
BSC.

NE31

NOTE

If E1 services are locally accessed, they can be received by Smart E1 ports. Therefore, the cross-connect loop
between PDH ports and Smart E1 ports is not required.

11.3.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

11.3.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring UNI ports.
Table 11-36 to Table 11-37 provide UNI port information.
Table 11-36 UNI port information (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

6-ML1-1

6-ML1-2

Port name

conn_bts22_ces1

conn_bts22_ces2

E1 frame format

Unframe

Unframe

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

701

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-37 UNI port information (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-1

2-ML1-2

Port name

conn_bsc_ces1

conn_bsc_ces2

E1 frame format

Unframe

Unframe

NOTE

l Proper port names facilitate maintenance operations. A uniform style is recommended for defining port
names.
l If customers have no requirements for transmitting services with some of the timeslots, CES services adopt
the SAToP mode and the E1 frame format always adopts the unframe mode.

11.3.2.2 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring CES services.

Service Information Planning


Table 11-38 to Table 11-39 provide the service planning information.
Table 11-38 Service information (CES service 1 of BTS22)
Parameter

CES Service 1 of BTS22


Source NE (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

201

Service name

bts22_ces_service_01

Service port

6-ML1-1

Encapsulation mode

SAToP

64 kbit/s timeslot

Priority

EF

EF

Protection scheme

Non-protection

PW ID

201

PW In/Out label

201/201

ID of working tunnel

1505

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-ML1-1

702

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-39 Service information (CES service 2 of BTS22)


Parameter

CES Service 2 of BTS22


Source NE (NE21)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

202

Service name

bts22_ces_service_02

Service port

6-ML1-2

Emulation mode

SAToP

64 kbit/s timeslot

Priority

EF

EF

Protection scheme

Non-protection

PW ID

202

PW In/Out label

202/202

Working tunnel ID

1505

2-ML1-2

NOTE

l OptiX RTN 980 supports point-to-point CES services only. That is, one PW cannot carry services from
multiple E1 ports.
l CES services can adopt the CESoPSN or SAToP mode. The SAToP mode is adopted unless otherwise
required. If customers require the CESoPSN mode, they need to specify the required 64 kbit/s timeslots.
l Service name planning is only performed in per-NE configuration. In the case of end-to-end configuration,
the U2000 use the service names generated according to naming rules.
l In end-to-end configuration, service ID, PW ID, PW In/Out label can be automatically allocated.

Planning of Advanced Attributes of CES Services


NOTE

The advanced attributes of CES services take default values on both PEs if CES services are transmitted only
on Huawei equipment. If Huawei equipment communicates CES services with third-party equipment, the
advanced attributes of CES services need to be negotiated according to the default values listed in Table
11-40. Ensure that the parameters take the same values on both PEs.

Table 11-40 Default values of advanced attributes of CES services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value Range

RTP header encapsulation enabling

Disabled

Jitter buffer time

8000 us

Packet loading time

1000 us

VCCV verification mode

VCCV using CW

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

703

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value Range

Sequence number mode

Huawei mode

11.3.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring CES services in an end-to-end mode.

11.3.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-1

6-ML1-2

Name

conn_bts22_ces1

conn_bts22_ces2

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1

2-ML1-2

Name

conn_bsc_ces1

conn_bsc_ces2

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 1

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Frame Format

NE21
6-ML1-1

6-ML1-2

Unframe

Unframe

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Frame Format
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE31
2-ML1-1

2-ML1-2

Unframe

Unframe

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

704

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

----End

11.3.3.2 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring CES service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.2 Configuring CES Services in an End-to-End Mode and configure CES services
in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set basic attributes of the CES services.

3.

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PWE3 services.

4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE21) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 6-ML1-1 and deselect Channeled.

c.

Select 6-ML1-2 and deselect Channeled.

d.

Click OK.

e.

Double-click the sink NE (NE31) in the physical topology on the right.

f.

Select 2-ML1-1 and deselect Channeled.

g.

Select 2-ML1-2 and deselect Channeled.

h.

Click OK.

Set the basic attributes of the PW.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

705

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

5.

Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.

6.

Click OK.

7.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new CES services are displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End

11.3.3.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying CES service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester and test E1 services by using BER
testers.
It is recommended that you connect BER testers to NE31 and perform loopbacks on NE21.
The test results should be no bit errors.
----End

11.3.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring CES services on a single NE.

11.3.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-1

6-ML1-2

Name

conn_bts22_ces1

conn_bts22_ces2

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

706

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
2-ML1-1

2-ML1-2

Name

conn_bsc_ces1

conn_bsc_ces2

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 1

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Frame Format

NE21
6-ML1-1

6-ML1-2

Unframe

Unframe

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Frame Format

NE31
2-ML1-1

2-ML1-2

Unframe

Unframe

----End

11.3.4.2 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring CES services.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.6.1 Creating CES Services and create CES services.
l Parameters of NE21
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE21
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

201

202

Service name

bts22_ces_service_01

bts22_ces_service_02

Mode

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

Source Board

6-ML1

6-ML1

Source Low Channel(e.g.


1,3-6)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

707

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE21
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.


1,3-6)

Priority List

EF

EF

PW Type

SAToP

SAToP

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in General Attributes of the
Configure PW dialog box are as follows.
Parameter

NE21
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

PW ID

201

202

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

201

202

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

201

202

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1505

1505

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab are as follows.
Parameter

NE21
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Mode

l Parameters of NE31
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

708

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

201

202

Service name

bts22_ces_service_01

bts22_ces_service_02

Mode

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

Source Board

2-ML1

2-ML1

Source Low Channel(e.g.


1,3-6)

Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.


1,3-6)

Priority List

EF

EF

PW Type

SAToP

SAToP

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in General Attributes of the
Configure PW dialog box are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

PW ID

201

202

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

201

202

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

201

202

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1505

1505

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab are as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE31
CES Service 1 of BTS22

CES Service 2 of BTS22

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

709

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

----End

11.3.4.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying CES service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester and test E1 services by using BER
testers.
It is recommended that you connect BER testers to NE31 and perform loopbacks on NE21.
The test results should be no bit errors.
----End

11.4 Configuration Example (Fractional CES Services)


This section considers a Fractional CES service on a packet network as an example to describe
how to configure CES services according to the network planning information. Each service is
encapsulated in CESoPSN mode.

11.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection),
configure the CES services according to the following requirements for BTS35 and BTS36
shown in Figure 11-22.
l

Table 11-41 provides the CES service port information.

There is a bidirectional working tunnel between NE11 and NE31. Protection schemes are
configured for this tunnel and its tunnel ID is 1509. 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS
Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection) describes the configuration of this tunnel.

Figure 11-22 Networking Diagram


Working tunnel
(ID=1509)
GE

GE

NE32
NE31

NE11
GE
E1

BTS36

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

E1

NE21

GE

BSC

BTS35

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

710

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-41 Service port information


NE

Service Port

Description

NE11

4-ML1-1

Receives base station


services from BTS35 and
BTS36 in Fractional CES
mode. The services from
BTS35 occupy the first to
15th timeslots and those from
BTS36 occupy the 17th to
31st timeslots.

NE31

2-ML1-3

Transmits base station


services from BTS35 to the
BSC. These services occupy
the first to 15th timeslots.

2-ML1-4

Transmits base station


services from BTS36 to the
BSC. These services occupy
the first to 15th timeslots.

11.4.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

11.4.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring UNI ports.
Table 11-42 to Table 11-43 provide UNI port information.
Table 11-42 UNI Port Information (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-ML1-1

Port name

conn_bts35_bts36_ces1

E1 frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

E1 frame mode

PCM31

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

711

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-43 UNI Port Information (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-3

2-ML1-4

Port name

conn_bsc_ces3

conn_bsc_ces4

E1 frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

CRC-4 multiframe

E1 frame mode

PCM31

PCM31

NOTE

l Proper port names facilitate maintenance operations. A uniform style is recommended for defining port
names.
l In CESoPSN mode, the E1 frame format and E1 frame mode in UNI port information must be the same as
those on the access equipment. Generally, the E1 frame mode of base stations is PCM31. The E1 frame
format is double for base stations of earlier types and is CRC-4 multiframe for base stations of later types.
During deployment, the E1 frame format of base stations can be set to CRC-4 multiframe first. If the actual
E1 frame format is double, the E1 port will report the LMFA alarm.
l If CES services are converged through the Hybrid radio network, UNI port parameters need to be planned
according to the configuration of BTSs because E1 services are transmitted in Native mode on the Hybrid
radio network.

11.4.2.2 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring CES services.

Service Information Planning


Table 11-44 to Table 11-45 provide the service planning information.
Table 11-44 Service information (CES service 1 of BTS35)
Parameter

CES Service 1 of BTS35


Source NE (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

203

Service name

bts35_ces_service_01

Service port

4-ML1-1

Encapsulation mode

CESoPSN

64 kbit/s timeslot

1-15

1-15

Priority

EF

EF

Protection scheme

Non-protection

PW ID

203

PW In/Out label

203/203

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-ML1-3

712

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

CES Service 1 of BTS35


Source NE (NE11)

Working tunnel ID

Sink NE (NE31)

1509

Table 11-45 Service information (CES service 1 of BTS36)


Parameter

CES Service 1 of BTS36


Source NE (NE11)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

204

Service name

bts36_ces_service_01

Service port

4-ML1-1

Emulation type

CESoPSN

64 kbit/s timeslot

17-31

1-15

Priority

EF

EF

Protection scheme

Non-protection

PW ID

204

PW In/Out label

204/204

ID of working tunnel

1509

2-ML1-4

NOTE

l Fractional CES services must adopt the CESoPSN mode. Therefore, you need to know the allocation of E1
timeslots in advance.
l If the allocation of E1 timeslots is the same on the BSC side and the BTS side, as in this example, the E1
that transmits the services of BTS35 and BTS36 with the same timeslot allocation on the BSC side can be
considered a common CES service.
l In end-to-end configuration, service ID, PW ID, PW In/Out label can be automatically allocated.

Planning of Advanced Attributes of CES Services


NOTE

The advanced attributes of CES services take default values on both PEs if CES services are transmitted only
on Huawei equipment. If Huawei equipment communicates CES services with third-party equipment, the
advanced attributes of CES services need to be negotiated according to the default values listed in Table
11-46. Ensure that the parameters take the same values on both PEs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

713

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-46 Default values of advanced attributes of CES services


Parameter

Value Range

RTP header encapsulation enabling

Disabled

Jitter buffer time

8000 us

Packet loading time

1000 us

VCCV verification mode

VCCV using CW

Sequence number mode

Huawei mode

11.4.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring fractional CES services in an end-to-end mode.

11.4.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1

Name

conn_bts35_bts36_ces1

Port Mode

Layer 1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-3

2-ML1-4

Name

conn_bsc_ces3

conn_bsc_ces4

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 1

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

714

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-3

2-ML1-4

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

31

----End

11.4.3.2 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring fractional CES service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.2 Configuring CES Services in an End-to-End Mode and configure CES services
in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set basic attributes of the CES services.

3.

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PWE3 services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE11) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 4-ML1-1. Select Channeled and set 64K TimeSlot to 1-15.

c.

Click OK.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

715

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE31) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 2-ML1-3. Select Channeled and set 64K TimeSlot to 1-15.

f.

Click OK.

4.

Set the basic attributes of the PW.

5.

Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.

6.

Click OK.

7.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new CES service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

8.

Repeat Step 1.1 to Step 1.7 to configure the CES service on BTS36 according to planning
information.

----End

11.4.3.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying CES service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester and test E1 services by using BER
testers.
l Because the CES services under test adopt the CESoPSN mode, BER testers must be used
for testing nx64 kbit/s services according to timeslot allocation.
l It is recommended that you connect BER testers to NE31 and perform loopbacks on NE11.
The test results should be no bit errors.
----End

11.4.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring CES services on a single NE.

11.4.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

716

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1

Name

conn_bts35_bts36_ces1

Port Mode

Layer 1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-3

2-ML1-4

Name

conn_bsc_ces3

conn_bsc_ces4

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 1

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the relevant parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-3

2-ML1-4

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

31

----End

11.4.4.2 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring CES services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

717

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.6.1 Creating CES Services and create CES services.
l Parameters of NE11
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE11
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

203

204

Service name

bts35_ces_service_01

bts36_ces_service_01

Mode

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

Source Board

4-ML1

4-ML1

Source Low Channel(e.g.


1,3-6)

Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-15

17-31

Priority List

EF

EF

PW Type

CESoPSN

CESoPSN

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in General Attributes of the
Configure PW dialog box are as follows.
Parameter

NE11
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

PW ID

203

204

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

203

204

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

203

204

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1509

1509

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab are as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

718

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Mode

l Parameters of NE31
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

203

204

Service name

bts35_ces_service_01

bts36_ces_service_01

Mode

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

Source Board

2-ML1

2-ML1

Source Low Channel(e.g.


1,3-6)

Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-15

1-15

Priority List

EF

EF

PW Type

CESoPSN

CESoPSN

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in General Attributes of the
Configure PW dialog box are as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE31
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

PW ID

203

204

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

203

204

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

203

204

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

719

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1509

1509

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CES Service of BTS35

CES Service of BTS36

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Mode

----End

11.4.4.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying CES service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester and test E1 services by using BER
testers.
l Because the CES services under test adopt the CESoPSN mode, BER testers must be used
for testing nx64 kbit/s services according to timeslot allocation.
l It is recommended that you connect BER testers to NE31 and perform loopbacks on NE11.
The test results should be no bit errors.
----End

11.5 Configuration Example (MS-PW-based CES Services)


This section considers an MS-PW-based CES service on a packet network as an example to
describe how to configure CES services according to the network planning information. This
sample service is encapsulated in CESoPSN mode.

11.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

720

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Based on 10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No Protection), configure CES
services according to the following requirements for BTS32 shown in 10.3 Configuration
Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).
l

Table 11-47 provides the port information of CES services.

The information about the working tunnels between NE33 and NE31 is as follows:
There is a bidirectional working tunnel between NE33 and NE32. Protection schemes
are configured for this tunnel and its tunnel ID is 1513. 10.4 Configuration Example
(MPLS Tunnels with No Protection) describes the configuration of this tunnel.
There is a bidirectional working tunnel between NE32 and NE31. Protection schemes
are configured for this tunnel and its tunnel ID is 1501. 10.3 Configuration Example
(MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection) describes the configuration of this
tunnel.

Figure 11-23 Networking Diagram


Working tunnel
(ID=1513)

NE33
BTS32

Working tunnel
(ID=1501)

E1
GE

GE

NE32
NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE

E1

BSC

Table 11-47 Service port information


NE

Service Port

Description

NE33

2-ML1-1

Receives base station


services from BTS32. These
services occupy the first to
21st timeslots.

NE31

2-ML1-5

Transmits base station


services from BTS32 to the
BSC. These services occupy
the first to 21st timeslots.

11.5.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

721

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.5.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring UNI ports.
Table 11-48 to Table 11-49 provide UNI port information.
Table 11-48 UNI Port Information (NE33)
Parameter

2-ML1-1

Port name

conn_bts32_ces1

E1 frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

E1 frame mode

PCM31

Table 11-49 UNI port information (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-5

Port name

conn_bsc_ces5

E1 frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

E1 frame mode

PCM31

NOTE

l Proper port names facilitate maintenance operations. A uniform style is recommended for defining port
names.
l In CESoPSN mode, the E1 frame format and E1 frame mode in UNI port information must be the same as
those on the access equipment. Generally, the E1 frame mode of base stations is PCM31. The E1 frame
format is double for base stations of earlier types and is CRC-4 multiframe for base stations of later types.
During deployment, the E1 frame format of base stations can be set to CRC-4 multiframe first. If the actual
E1 frame format is double, the E1 port will report the LMFA alarm.
l If CES services are converged through the Hybrid radio network, UNI port parameters need to be planned
according to the configuration of BTSs because E1 services are transmitted in Native mode on the Hybrid
radio network.

11.5.2.2 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring CES services.

Service Information Planning


Table 11-50 provides the the service planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

722

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-50 Service information (CES service 1 of BTS32)


Parameter

CES Service 1 of BTS32


Source NE (NE33)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

205

206

Service name

bts32_ces_service_01_1stp
w

bts32_ces_service_01_2ndc
pw

Service port

2-ML1-1

2-ML1-5

Encapsulation mode

CESoPSN

64 kbit/s timeslot

1-21

1-21

Priority

CS7

CS7

Protection scheme

Non-protection

PW ID

205

206

PW In/Out label

205\205

206\206

ID of working tunnel

1513

1501

PW switch node

NE32

PW switch service ID

901

PW switch service name

bts32_ces_service_mspw

NOTE

l OptiX RTN 980 supports point-to-point CES services only. That is, one PW cannot carry services from
multiple E1 ports.
l CES services can adopt the CESoPSN or SAToP mode. The SAToP mode is adopted unless otherwise
required. If customers require the CESoPSN mode, they need to specify the required 64 kbit/s timeslots. In
this example, the CESoPSN mode is adopted because the allocation of 64 kbit/s timeslots is specified, PWs
are carried on radio links, and the radio bandwidth is better utilized.
l The default PHB service class for CES services is EF. If CES services are transmitted on the ISU2/ISX2,
set the PHB service class to CS7 to decrease the CES service transmission delay and jitters.
l If an MS-PW is used, the label values of the first segment and the last segment must be different.
l In end-to-end configuration, PW ID and PW In/Out label can be automatically allocated.
l In end-to-end configuration, MS-PW service ID and PW switch service ID are automatically allocated and
are invisible to users.

Planning of Advanced Attributes of CES Services


NOTE

The advanced attributes of CES services take default values on both PEs if CES services are transmitted only
on Huawei equipment. If Huawei equipment communicates CES services with third-party equipment, the
advanced attributes of CES services need to be negotiated according to the default values listed in Table
11-51. Ensure that the parameters take the same values on both PEs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

723

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-51 Default values of advanced attributes of CES services


Parameter

Value Range

RTP header encapsulation enabling

Disabled

Jitter buffer time

8000 us

Packet loading time

1000 us

VCCV verification mode

VCCV using CW

Sequence number mode

Huawei mode

11.5.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring MS-PW-based CES services in an end-to-end
mode.

11.5.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE33
2-ML1-1

Name

conn_bts32_ces1

Port Mode

Layer 1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-5

Name

conn_bsc_ces5

Port Mode

Layer 1

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

724

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE33
2-ML1-1

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-5

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

----End

11.5.3.2 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring MS-PW-based CES service information in an
end-to-end mode.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.2 Configuring CES Services in an End-to-End Mode and configure a CES service
in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set basic attributes of the CES services.

3.

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PWE3 services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE33) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 2-ML1-1. Select Channeled and set 64K TimeSlot to 1-21.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

725

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE31) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 2-ML1-5. Select Channeled and set 64K TimeSlot to 1-21.

f.

Click OK.

g.

In the Physical Topology tab page, right-click NE32 and choose Set As Switching
Node > Working from the shortcut menu.

4.

Set the basic attributes of the PW.

5.

Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.

6.

Click OK.

7.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new CES service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End

11.5.3.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying CES service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester and test E1 services by using BER
testers.
l Because the CES services under test adopt the CESoPSN mode, BER testers must be used
for testing nx64 kbit/s services according to timeslot allocation.
l It is recommended that you connect BER testers to NE31 and perform loopbacks on NE11.
The test results should be no bit errors.
----End

11.5.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring CES services on a single NE.

11.5.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

726

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE33
2-ML1-1

Name

conn_bts32_ces1

Port Mode

Layer 1

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-5

Name

conn_bsc_ces5

Port Mode

Layer 1

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE33 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE33
2-ML1-1

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

l The values for the relevant parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-5

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

----End

11.5.4.2 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring CES services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

727

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.6.1 Creating CES Services and create CES services.
l Parameters of NE33
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE33
CES Service of BTS32 (First Segment
of PW)

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

205

Service name

bts32_ces_service_01_1stpw

Mode

UNI-NNI

Source Board

2-ML1

Source Low Channel(e.g.1,3-6)

Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.1,3-6)

1-21

Priority List

CS7

PW Type

CESoPSN

Protection Type

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in General Attributes of the
Configure PW dialog box are as follows.
Parameter

NE33
CES Service of BTS32 (First Segment
of PW)

PW ID

205

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

205

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

205

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1513

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

728

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE33
CES Service of BTS32 (First Segment
of PW)

Control Channel Type

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

l Parameters of NE31
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CES Service of BTS32 (Last Segment
of PW)

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

206

Service name

bts32_ces_service_01_2ndpw

Mode

UNI-NNI

Source Board

2-ML1

Source Low Channel(e.g.1,3-6)

Source 64K Timeslot(e.g.1,3-6)

1-21

Priority List

CS7

PW Type

CESoPSN

Protection Type

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in General Attributes of the
Configure PW dialog box are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CES Service of BTS32 (Last Segment
of PW)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PW ID

206

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

206

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

206

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

729

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE31
CES Service of BTS32 (Last Segment
of PW)

Tunnel

1501

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CES Service of BTS32 (Last Segment
of PW)

Control Channel Type

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Step 2 See A.9.4.2 Creating an MS-PW and create an MS-PW on NE32.


The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE32

ID

901

Name

bts32_ces_service_mspw

Service Type

CES Service

Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE32
CES Service of BTS32
(First Segment of PW)

CES Service of BTS32


(Last Segment of PW)

PW ID

205

206

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

CESoPSN

CESoPSN

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

205

206

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

205

206

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

730

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE32

Tunnel

CES Service of BTS32


(First Segment of PW)

CES Service of BTS32


(Last Segment of PW)

1513

1501

The values for related parameters that need to be set in Advanced Attributes are as follows.
The other parameters take their default values.
Parameter

NE32
CES Service of BTS32
(First Segment of PW)

CES Service of BTS32


(Last Segment of PW)

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

64K Timeslot Number

21

21

----End

11.5.4.3 Configuration Process (Verifying CES Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying CES service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester and test E1 services by using BER
testers.
l Because the CES services under test adopt the CESoPSN mode, BER testers must be used
for testing nx64 kbit/s services according to timeslot allocation.
l It is recommended that you connect BER testers to NE31 and perform loopbacks on NE11.
The test results should be no bit errors.
----End

11.6 Configuration Example (Common ATM Services)


This section uses a common ATM service on a PSN as an example to describe how to configure
ATM services according to service planning information. In this example, services are
encapsulated in n-to-1 VCC mode.

11.6.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

731

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Based on 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection),
configure information about ATM services transmitted from BTS13 and BTS14 according to
the following network planning information (as shown in Figure 11-24):
l

Information about ATM service ports is provided in Table 11-52.

A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1503), which has a protection tunnel, is available between NE11
and NE31. This tunnel and its corresponding information have been configured in 10.3
Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).

None of the services accessed from BTSs occupies only part of an E1 timeslot.

Each BTS has real-time voice services, signaling services (CBR services), HSDPA data
services (UBR services), OM and HSDPA real-time services (rt-VBR services), and R99
non-real-time services (nrt-VBR services).

Figure 11-24 Networking diagram


Working tunnel
(ID=1503)
GE

GE

NE32

E1

R99
BTS13

E1

NE31

NE11

Hybrid radio chain


network

GE

NE21

E1
RNC

GE

E1 loo p

R99
BTS14

Table 11-52 Information about service ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE

Service Port

Description

NE11

1-SP3S-1

Configure this port to receive


BTS13 services through a
Hybrid radio chain network.
For the service configuration
process, see 7.5
Configuration Example
(TDM Services on a Hybrid
Radio Chain Network).

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

732

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

NE

NE31

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Service Port

Description

1-SP3S-2 to 1-SP3S-5

Configure these ports to


receive BTS14 services
through a Hybrid radio chain
network. For the service
configuration process, see
7.5 Configuration Example
(TDM Services on a Hybrid
Radio Chain Network).

4-ML1-2

Use an E1 cable to connect


this port to port 1-SP3S-1 so
that the E1 services from
BTS13 are switched from the
TDM plane to the packet
plane.

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Use E1 cables to connect


these ports to ports 1-SP3S-2
to 1-SP3S-5 so that the E1
services from BTS14 are
switched from the TDM
plane to the packet plane.

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Configure these ports to


transmit BTS13 and BTS14
services to the RNC.

NOTE

If E1 services are received directly from Smart E1 ports, you need not connect the Smart E1 ports with
corresponding PDH ports with E1 cables.

11.6.2 ServicePlanning
You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.6.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.
Table 11-53 and Table 11-54 provide planning information about UNI ports.
Table 11-53 Information about NNI ports (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Port name

conn_bts13_atm1

conn_bts14_ima1 to
conn_bts14_ima4

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

CRC-4 multiframe

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

733

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Frame mode

PCM30

PCM30

Table 11-54 Information about UNI ports (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Port name

conn_rnc_ima1 to conn_rnc_ima8

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM30

NOTE

l Appropriate port names facilitate future maintenance. It is recommended that you name ports on the
entire network in a unified manner.
l As specified in ITU-T G.804, ATM service ports use the CRC-4 multiframe format and PCM30 frame
mode by default. The E1 frame format and frame mode must be the same as those at the opposite end.
l ATM services are converged from a Hybrid radio chain network. On the Hybrid radio chain network,
E1 services are transmitted in Native E1 mode. Therefore, set the information about the UNI ports
based on BTS configurations.

11.6.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM/IMA services.
Table 11-55 and Table 11-56 provide ATM/IMA information.
Table 11-55 ATM/IMA information (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

4-ML1-2 (TRUNK2)

Bound port

4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

IMA protocol
enabled status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA protocol
version

1.1

IMA frame
length

128

IMA symmetric
mode

Symmetrical mode and


symmetrical operation

Minimum
number of
activated links

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

734

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

4-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

4-ML1-2 (TRUNK2)

Differential
delay tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_bts13_trunk1

conn_bts14_trunk2

Port type

UNI

UNI

ATM cell
payload
scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

Table 11-56 ATM/IMA information (NE31)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

2-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

Bound port

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

IMA protocol enabled status

Enabled

IMA protocol version

1.1

IMA frame length

128

IMA symmetric mode

Symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation

Differential delay tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port type

UNI

ATM cell payload


scrambling

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

735

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NOTE

l If carried over a single E1, ATM services from a BTS are generally transmitted and received through
a single UNI port. In this case, the IMA protocol needs to be disabled. If carried over multiple E1s,
ATM services from a BTS are transmitted and received through IMA trunks.
l Normally, set the IMA protocol version, IMA frame length, IMA symmetric mode, and differentiated
delay tolerance of an NE (with IMA protocol enabled) to the same values as those of its interconnected
equipment. Normally, the BTS/RNC configurations are as follows:
l IMA protocol version: 1.1
l IMA frame length: 128
l IMA symmetric mode: symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation
l The differentiated delay tolerance: 25
l The clock modes must be the same at both ends of an IMA trunk. The default clock mode for a BTS
is ITC. Therefore, the clock mode is set to ITC for the NE that is interconnected with the BTS and the
NE at the opposite end of the IMA link.

11.6.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM service classes and ATM policies.

Mapping Information Between ATM Service Types and ATM Service Classes
Table 11-57 provides the mapping information between ATM service types and the ATM
service classes.
Table 11-57 Mapping information between ATM service types and the ATM service classes
Parameter

PHB Service Class

CBR

EF

rt-VBR

AF3

nrt-VBR

AF2

UBR

BE

This mapping table is consistent with "DefaultAtmCosMap". Therefore, you can use the default
CoS mapping table during service configuration.

Information about ATM policies


The parameter values of the ATM policy differ with the E1 quantity and service type.
NE11 uses one E1 to receive and transmit BTS13 services and use four E1s to receive and
transmit BTS14 services. Both BTS13 services and BTS14 services contain CBR, UBR, rt-VBR,
and ntr-VBR services. An ATM policy needs to be configured for each type of service; therefore,
up to eight ATM policies need to be configured on NE11. Eight ATM policies also need to be
configured on NE31.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

736

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-58 Information about the 1xE1 ATM policy


Parameter

Service Type
CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Policy ID

Policy name

1e1_cbr

1e1_rtvbr

1e1_nrtvbr

1e1_ubr

Service type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr(cell/
s)

175

1859

1859

1859

Clp01Scr(cell/
s)

1685

1685

Clp0Pcr(cell/s)

Clp0Scr(cell/s)

Clp01Mcr(cell/
s)

MBS (cell)

1000

1000

CDVT (us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Table 11-59 Information about the 4xE1 ATM policy


Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service Type
CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Policy ID

Policy name

4e1_cbr

4e1_rtvbr

4e1_nrtvbr

4e1_ubr

Service type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr(cell/
s)

500

2252

9295

9295

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

737

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Service Type
CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Clp01Scr(cell/
s)

2048

8799

Clp0Pcr(cell/s)

Clp0Scr(cell/s)

Clp01Mcr(cell/
s)

MBS (cell)

1000

1000

CDVT (us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

11.6.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM services.
Table 11-60 provides the service planning information.
Table 11-60 Service information (ATM services from BTS13 and BTS14)
Parame
ter

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Service
name

bts13_bts14_atmservice

Service
ID

101

Service
type

UNIs-NNI

Connect
ion type

PVC

Protecti
on type

No protection

Source NE (NE11)

Sink NE (NE31)

ATM connection information (source NE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

738

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Connect
ion
name

bts13_cb
r_atm

Service
board

4-ML1

Service
port

TRUNK1

Source
VPI

13

13

13

13

Source
VCI

33

34

35

Sink
VPI

13

13

Sink
VCI

33

Upstrea
m QoS
Policy
Downst
ream
QoS
policy

Source NE (NE11)
bts13_r
tvbr_at
m

Sink NE (NE31)
bts13_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts13_
ubr_at
m

bts14_
cbr_at
m

bts14_r
tvbr_at
m

bts14_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts14_
ubr_at
m

14

14

14

14

36

33

34

35

36

13

13

14

14

14

14

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

1
(1e1_cbr
)

2
(1e1_rt
vbr)

3
(1e1_n
rtvbr)

4
(1e1_u
br)

5
(4e1_c
br)

6
(4e1_rt
vbr)

7
(4e1_n
rtvbr)

8
(4e1_u
br)

1
(1e1_cbr
)

2
(1e1_rt
vbr)

3
(1e1_n
rtvbr)

4
(1e1_u
br)

5
(4e1_c
br)

6
(4e1_rt
vbr)

7
(4e1_n
rtvbr)

8
(4e1_u
br)

TRUNK2

ATM connection information (sink NE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Connect
ion
name

bts13_cb
r_atm

bts13_r
tvbr_at
m

bts13_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts13_
ubr_at
m

bts14_
cbr_at
m

bts14_r
tvbr_at
m

bts14_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts14_
ubr_at
m

Service
board

2-ML1

Service
port

TRUNK1

Source
VPI

13

13

13

13

14

14

14

14

Source
VCI

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Sink
VPI

13

13

13

13

14

14

14

14

Sink
VCI

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

739

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Upstrea
m QoS
policy

1
(1e1_cbr
)

2
(1e1_rt
vbr)

3
(1e1_n
rtvbr)

4
(1e1_u
br)

5
(4e1_c
br)

6
(4e1_rt
vbr)

7
(4e1_n
rtvbr)

8
(4e1_u
br)

Downst
ream
QoS
policy

1
(1e1_cbr
)

2
(1e1_rt
vbr)

3
(1e1_n
rtvbr)

4
(1e1_u
br)

5
(4e1_c
br)

6
(4e1_rt
vbr)

7
(4e1_n
rtvbr)

8
(4e1_u
br)

Source NE (NE11)

Sink NE (NE31)

PW information
PW ID

101

PW
ingress/
egress
label

101/101

Encapsu
lation

ATM n-to-one VCC

Tunnel

1503

Control
Word

No Use

Control
Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verifica
tion
Mode

Ping

CoS mapping information


CoS
mappin
g

DefaultAtmCosMap

NOTE

In end-to-end configuration mode, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label can be automatically assigned
and therefore they do not need to be planned.

11.6.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring ATM services in an end-to-end mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

740

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.6.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Name

conn_bts13_atm_1

conn_bts14_ima_1 to
conn_bts14_ima_4

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
9-MP1-6 to 9-MP1-132-ML1-6 to 2ML1-13

Name

conn_rnc_ima_1 to conn_rnc_ima_8

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
9-MP1-6 to 9-MP1-132-ML1-6 to 2ML1-13

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

741

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.6.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the procedure for configuring IMA information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind the ATM trunk.
l The values for the related parameters for NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
Trunk1 (Connecting
BTS13 Services)

Trunk2 (Connecting
BTS14 Services)

Available Boards

4-ML1

4-ML1

Configurable Ports

4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)

Level

E1

E1

Available Resources

4-ML1-2
(conn_bts13_atm_1)

4-ML1-3
(conn_bts14_ima_1) to 4ML1-6
(conn_bts14_ima_4)

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Available Boards

2-ML1

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

Level

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_ima_1) to 2-ML1-13


(conn_rnc_ima_8)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and create an IMA group.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

742

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and


Symmetrical Operation

Maximum Delay Between


Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operation

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set ATM port parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

Name

conn_bts13_trunk1

conn_bts14_trunk2

Port Type

UNI

UNI

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

743

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

----End

11.6.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS Information)


This section describes the process for configuring global ATM QoS templates.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.3 Configuring an ATM Policy Profile and configure ATM policy templates.
1.

Choose Configuration > PTN QoS Profile > ATM Profile from the Main Menu.

2.

Right-click in ATM Profile and choose Add Global Profile from the shortcut menu.

The Create ATM Profile dialog box is displayed.


3.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the ATM policy profile according to network planning information so that it is available
for traffic management policy selection during ATM connection creation.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

744

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

4.

Click OK.

5.

Repeat Step 1.3 and Step 1.4 to create the other ATM policy templates for ATM services
between NE11 and NE31.

----End

11.6.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring ATM services in an end-to-end mode.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.5 Configuring ATM Services in an End-to-End Mode and configure ATM
services in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes for ATM services.


The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

745

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

4.

5.

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the ATM service.
a.

Double-click the source NE (NE11) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 4-ML1-1 and 4-ML1-2.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Repeat 1.3.a and 1.3.c to configure the service port on the sink NE (NE31).

Set the advanced attributes of the PW.


a.

Click Detail.

b.

In the Advanced PW Attribute tab page, set the advanced attributes of the PW.

Configure ATM connections.


a.

Click ATM Link.The Configure Link dialog box is displayed.

b.

Click Add Link.

c.

Set the ATM connection attributes according to network planning information.

d.

Click OK.

6.

Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.

7.

Click OK.

8.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new ATM service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

746

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.6.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.4 Testing ATM Services and verify the ATM service configurations.
The "success" verification result should be displayed.
----End

11.6.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring ATM services on a per-NE basis.

11.6.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Name

conn_bts13_atm_1

conn_bts14_ima_1 to
conn_bts14_ima_4

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
9-MP1-6 to 9-MP1-132-ML1-6 to 2ML1-13

Name

conn_rnc_ima_1 to conn_rnc_ima_8

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

747

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
9-MP1-6 to 9-MP1-132-ML1-6 to 2ML1-13

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

----End

11.6.4.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the procedure for configuring IMA information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind the ATM trunk.
l The values for the related parameters for NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
Trunk1 (Connecting
BTS13 Services)

Trunk2 (Connecting
BTS14 Services)

Available Boards

4-ML1

4-ML1

Configurable Ports

4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)

Level

E1

E1

Available Resources

4-ML1-2
(conn_bts13_atm_1)

4-ML1-3
(conn_bts14_ima_1) to 4ML1-6
(conn_bts14_ima_4)

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Available Boards
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

2-ML1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

748

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

Level

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_ima_1) to 2-ML1-13


(conn_rnc_ima_8)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and create an IMA group.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and


Symmetrical Operation

Maximum Delay Between


Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operation

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

749

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set ATM port parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

Name

conn_bts13_trunk1

conn_bts14_trunk2

Port Type

UNI

UNI

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

----End

11.6.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for ATM services.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy and create ATM policies.
Parameters for NE11 and NE31:
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE11 and NE31


CBR Service
(1xE1)

rt-VBR
Service (1xE1)

nrt-VBR
Service (1xE1)

UBR Service
(1xE1)

Policy ID

Policy Name

1e1_cbr

1e1_rtvbr

1e1_nrtvbr

1e1_ubr

Service Type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

750

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11 and NE31


CBR Service
(1xE1)

rt-VBR
Service (1xE1)

nrt-VBR
Service (1xE1)

UBR Service
(1xE1)

Traffic Type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr(cell/
s)

175

1859

1859

1859

Clp01Scr(cell/
s)

1685

1685

Max. Cell
Burst Size (cell)

1000

1000

Cell Delay
Variation
Tolerance
(0.1us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Parameter

NE11 and NE31 (Continued)


CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Policy ID

Policy Name

4e1_cbr

4e1_rtvbr

4e1_nrtvbr

4e1_ubr

Service Type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic Type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr(cell/
s)

500

2252

9295

9295

Clp01Scr(cell/
s)

2048

8799

Max. Cell
Burst Size (cell)

1000

1000

Cell Delay
Variation
Tolerance
(0.1us)

102400

10240

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

751

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11 and NE31 (Continued)


CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

----End

11.6.4.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services and create ATM services.
l Parameters of NE11:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Service Name

bts13_bts14_atmservice

Service ID

101

Service Type

UNIs-NNI

Connection
Type

PVC

Protection Type

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE11

Conne
ction
Name

bts13_
cbr_at
m

bts13_r
tvbr_at
m

bts13_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts13_
ubr_at
m

bts14_
cbr_at
m

bts14_r
tvbr_at
m

bts14_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts14_
ubr_at
m

Source
Board

4-ML1

4-ML1

4-ML1

4-ML1

4-ML1

4-ML1

4-ML1

4-ML1

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

752

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Param
eter

NE11

Source
Port

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

2
(TRU
NK2)

2
(TRU
NK2)

2
(TRU
NK2)

2
(TRU
NK2)

Source
Bind
Path

4ML1(2)

4ML1(2)

4ML1(2)

4ML1(2)

4ML1(3-6)

4ML1(3-6)

4ML1(3-6)

4ML1(3-6)

Source
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

13

13

13

13

14

14

14

14

Source
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

PW ID

101

101

101

101

101

101

101

101

Sink
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

13

13

13

13

14

14

14

14

Sink
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Uplink
Policy

Down
link
Policy

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

PW ID

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

101

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

753

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

PW Signaling
Type

Static

PW Type

ATM n-to-one VCC cell transport

PW Ingress
Label / Source
Port

101

PW Egress
Label / Sink Port

101

Tunnel

1503

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Control Word

NO use

Control Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

PW ID

101

CoS Mapping

DefaultAtmCosMap

l Parameters of NE31:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

754

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Service Name

bts13_bts14_atmservice

Service ID

101

Service Type

UNIs-NNI

Connection
Type

PVC

Protection Type

No protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE31

Conne
ction
Name

bts13_
cbr_at
m

bts13_r
tvbr_at
m

bts13_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts13_
ubr_at
m

bts14_
cbr_at
m

bts14_r
tvbr_at
m

bts14_
nrtvbr_
atm

bts14_
ubr_at
m

Source
Board

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

Source
Port

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

Source
Bind
Path

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

Source
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

13

13

13

13

14

14

14

14

Source
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

PW ID

101

101

101

101

101

101

101

101

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

755

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Param
eter

NE31

Sink
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

13

13

13

13

14

14

14

14

Sink
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Uplink
Policy

Down
link
Policy

ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

PW ID

101

PW Signaling
Type

Static

PW Type

ATM n-to-one VCC cell transport

PW Ingress
Label / Source
Port

101

PW Egress
Label / Sink
Port

101

Tunnel

1503

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

756

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

Control Word

NO use

Control Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13 and BTS14

PW ID

101

CoS Mapping

DefaultAtmCosMap

----End

11.6.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.4 Testing ATM Services and verify the ATM service configurations.
The "success" verification result should be displayed.
----End

11.7 Configuration Example (Fractional ATM Services)


This section uses a Fractional ATM service on a PSN as an example to describe how to configure
ATM services according to service planning information. In this example, services are
encapsulated in n-to-1 VCC mode.

11.7.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection),
configure information about ATM services transmitted from BTS37 and BTS38 according to
the following network planning information (as shown in Figure 11-25):
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

757

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Information about ATM service ports is provided in Table 11-61.

A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1505), which has a protection tunnel, is available between NE21
and NE31. This tunnel and its corresponding information have been configured in 10.3
Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).

NE21 uses a Fractional E1 to receive and transmit BTS37 and BTS38 services. The BTS37
services occupy the 1st to 15th timeslots of the E1 port and the BTS38 services occupy the
17th to 31st timeslots of the E1 port.

Each BTS has real-time voice services, signaling services (CBR services), HSDPA data
services (UBR services), OM and HSDPA real-time services (rt-VBR services), and R99
non-real-time services (nrt-VBR services).

Figure 11-25 Networking diagram

GE

GE

NE32
E1

NE31

NE11
GE

NE21

GE

E1

R99
BTS37

l
ne
n
tu
g 0 5)
n
5
ki
o r D=1
W (I

RNC

R99
BTS38

Table 11-61 Information about service ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE

Service Port

Description

NE21

6-ML1-3

BTS37 and BTS38 services


occupy different timeslots of
the same E1 port. The BTS37
services occupy the 1st to
15th timeslots of the E1 port
and the BTS38 services
occupy the 17th to 31st
timeslots of the E1 port.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

758

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE

Service Port

Description

NE31

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Configure these ports to


transmit BTS37 and BTS38
services to the RNC.

11.7.2 ServicePlanning
You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.7.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.
Table 11-62 to Table 11-64 provide the planning information.
Table 11-62 Information about UNI ports (NE21)
Parameter

6-ML1-3

Port name

conn_bts37_bts38_frac

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM31

A UNI port that transmits the fractional ATM service is described as a serial port.Table 11-63
provides the planning information about serial ports.
Table 11-63 Serial port information (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Paramete
r

Serial Port Where BTS37 Services


Are Located

Serial Port Where BTS38 Services


Are Located

Port name

conn_bts37_sp01

conn_bts38_sp02

Level

64K timeslot

64K timeslot

Port

6-ML1-3

6-ML1-3

64K
timeslot

Timeslots 1 to 15

Timeslots 17 to 31

Port mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

759

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-64 Information about UNI ports (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Port name

conn_rnc_ima1 to conn_rnc_ima8

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM30

NOTE

l Appropriate port names facilitate future maintenance. It is recommended that you name ports on the
entire network in a unified manner.
l The E1 frame format and frame mode must be the same as those of service access equipment.
l For an E1 port that transmits Fractional ATM services, set the E1 frame mode to PCM31.

11.7.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM/IMA information.
Table 11-65 and Table 11-66 provide ATM/IMA information.
Table 11-65 ATM/IMA information (NE21)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

6-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

6-ML1-2 (TRUNK2)

Bound port

6-ML1-3 (conn_bts37_sp01)

6-ML1-3 (conn_bts38_sp02)

IMA protocol
enabled status

Disabled

Disabled

IMA protocol
version

IMA frame
length

IMA symmetric
mode

Differentiated
delay tolerance

Clock mode

ATM port name

conn_bts37_trunk1

conn_bts38_trunk2

Port type

UNI

UNI

ATM cell
payload
scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

760

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-66 ATM/IMA information (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

Bound port

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

IMA protocol enabled status

Enabled

IMA protocol version

1.1

IMA frame length

128

IMA symmetric mode

Symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation

Differentiated delay
tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port type

UNI

ATM cell payload


scrambling

Enabled

NOTE

l If one E1 is divided into several timeslots to transmit ATM services from BTSs, the Fractional ATM
mode is used and the IMA protocol is disabled in most cases.
l Normally, set the IMA protocol version, IMA frame length, IMA symmetric mode, and differentiated
delay tolerance of an NE (with IMA protocol enabled) to the same values as those of its interconnected
equipment. Normally, the BTS/RNC configurations are as follows:
l IMA protocol version: 1.1
l IMA frame length: 128
l IMA symmetric mode: symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation
l The differentiated delay tolerance: 25
l The clock modes must be the same at both ends of an IMA trunk. The default clock mode for a BTS
is ITC. Therefore, the clock mode is set to ITC for the NE that is interconnected with the BTS and the
NE at the opposite end of the IMA link.

11.7.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM service classes and ATM policies.

Mapping Information Between ATM Service Types and ATM Service Classes
Table 11-67 provides the mapping information between ATM service types and the ATM
service classes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

761

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-67 Mapping information between ATM service types and the ATM service classes
Parameter

PHB Service Class

CBR

EF

rt-VBR

AF3

nrt-VBR

AF2

UBR

BE

This mapping table is consistent with "DefaultAtmCosMap". Therefore, you can use the default
CoS mapping table during service configuration.

Information about ATM policies


The parameter values of the ATM policy differ with the E1 quantity and service type. NE21
uses timeslots 1 to 15 of one E1 port to receive and transmit BTS37 services and timeslots 17
to 31 to receive and transmit BTS38 services. Both BTS37 services and BTS38 services contain
CBR, UBR, rt-VBR, and ntr-VBR services. An ATM policy needs to be configured for each
type of service; therefore, up to four ATM policies need to be configured.
Table 11-68 shows the planning information about the ATM policy.
Table 11-68 Information about the 15-timeslot E1 ATM policy
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service Type
CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Policy ID

10

11

12

Policy name

15ts_cbr

15ts_rtvbr

15ts_nrtvbr

15ts_ubr

Service type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr (cell/
s)

105

960

960

960

Clp01Scr (cell/
s)

858

858

Clp0Pcr (cell/s)

Clp0Scr (cell/s)

Clp01Mcr (cell/
s)

MBS (cell)

1000

1000

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

762

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Service Type
CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

CDVT (us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

11.7.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM services.
Table 11-69 provides the service planning information.
Table 11-69 Service information (ATM services from BTS37 and BTS38)
Parame
ter

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Service
name

bts37_bts38_fracatmservice

Service
ID

102

Service
type

UNIs-NNI

Connect
ion type

PVC

Protecti
on type

No protection

Source
NE

NE21

Source NE (NE21)

Sink NE (NE31)

ATM connection information (source NE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Connect
ion
name

bts37_cb
r_atm

Service
board

6-ML1

Service
port

TRUNK1

bts37_r
tvbr_at
m

bts37_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts37_
ubr_at
m

bts38_
cbr_at
m

bts38_r
tvbr_at
m

bts38_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts38_
ubr_at
m

TRUNK2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

763

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Source
VPI

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Source
VCI

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Sink
VPI

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Sink
VCI

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Upstrea
m QoS
policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

Downstr
eam
QoS
policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

bts37_
ubr_at
m

bts38_
cbr_at
m

bts38_r
tvbr_at
m

bts38_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts38_
ubr_at
m

Source NE (NE21)

Sink NE (NE31)

ATM connection information (sink NE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Connect
ion
name

bts37_cb
r_atm

bts37_r
tvbr_at
m

bts37_
nrtvbr_
atmM

Service
board

2-ML1

Service
port

TRUNK1

Source
VPI

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Source
VCI

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Sink
VPI

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Sink
VCI

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Upstrea
m QoS
policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

Downstr
eam
QoS
policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

TRUNK2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

764

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parame
ter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38


Source NE (NE21)

Sink NE (NE31)

PW information
PW ID

102

PW
ingress/
egress
label

102/102

Encapsu
lation
type

ATM n-to-one VCC

Tunnel

1505

Control
Word

No Use

Control
Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verifica
tion
Mode

Ping

CoS mapping information


CoS
mappin
g

DefaultAtmCosMap

NOTE

In end-to-end configuration mode, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label can be automatically assigned
and therefore they do not need to be planned.

11.7.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring ATM services in an end-to-end mode.

11.7.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

765

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-3

Name

conn_bts37_bts38_frac

Port Mode

Layer 1

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Name

conn_rnc_ima_1 to conn_rnc_ima_8

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
6-ML1-3

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

31

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

Step 3 See A.6.5.1 Creating Serial Ports and configure serial ports on NE21.
The values for the serial port parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE21
Serial Port Where BTS37
Services Are Located

Serial Port Where BTS38


Services Are Located

Port

Name

conn_bts37_sp01

conn_bts38_sp02

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

766

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE21
Serial Port Where BTS37
Services Are Located

Serial Port Where BTS38


Services Are Located

Level

64K Timeslot

64K Timeslot

Used Board

6-ML1

6-ML1

Used Port

6-ML1-3

6-ML1-3

64K Timeslot

1-15

17-31

Step 4 See A.6.5.2 Setting Basic Attributes of Serial Ports and set the basic attributes of serial ports
on NE21.
The values for basic attributes of serial ports that need to be set are as follows.
Parameter

NE21
conn_bts37_sp01

conn_bts38_sp02

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

ATM

ATM

----End

11.7.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the process for configuring IMA information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind the ATM trunk.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Trunk1 (Connecting
BTS37 Services)

Trunk2 (Connecting
BTS38 Services)

Available Boards

6-ML1

6-ML1

Configurable Ports

6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)

Level

Fractional E1

Fractional E1

Available Resources

6-ML1-1
(conn_bts37_sp01)

6-ML1-2
(conn_bts38_sp02)

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

767

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Available Boards

2-ML1

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

Level

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_ima_1) to 2-ML1-13


(conn_rnc_ima_8)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and create an IMA group.
l The values for the IMA group parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS37
Services)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS38
Services)

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Disabled

Disabled

IMA Protocol Version

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

IMA Symmetry Mode

Maximum Delay Between


Links (ms)

Clock Mode

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operational

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

768

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set the ATM port parameters.
l The values for the ATM port parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS37
Services)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS38
Services)

Name

conn_bts37_trunk1

conn_bts38_trunk2

Port Type

UNI

UNI

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

----End

11.7.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS Information)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for fractional ATM services.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.3 Configuring an ATM Policy Profile and configure ATM policy templates.
1.

Choose Configuration > PTN QoS Profile > ATM Profile from the Main Menu.

2.

Right-click in ATM Profile and choose Add Global Profile from the shortcut menu.

The Create ATM Profile dialog box is displayed.


3.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the ATM policy profile according to network planning information so that it is available
for traffic management policy selection during ATM connection creation.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

769

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

4.

Click OK.

5.

Repeat Step 1.3 and Step 1.4 to create the other ATM policy templates for ATM services
between NE21 and NE31.

----End

11.7.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring fractional ATM service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.5 Configuring ATM Services in an End-to-End Mode and configure fractional
ATM services in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes for ATM services.


The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

770

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

4.

5.

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the ATM service.
a.

Double-click the source NE (NE21) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 6-ML1-1 and 6-ML1-2.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Repeat 1.3.a and 1.3.c to configure the service port on the sink NE.

Set the advanced attributes of the PW.


a.

Click Detail.

b.

In the Advanced PW Attribute tab page, set the advanced attributes of the PW.

Configure ATM connections.


a.

Click ATM Link.The Configure Link dialog box is displayed.

b.

Click Add Link.

c.

Set the ATM connection attributes according to network planning information.

d.

Click OK.

6.

Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.

7.

Click OK.

8.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new ATM service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

771

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.7.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.4 Testing ATM Services and verify the ATM service configurations.
The verification result should be "success".
----End

11.7.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring fractional ATM services on a per-NE basis.

11.7.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the general attributes of Smart
E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-3

Name

conn_bts37_bts38_frac

Port Mode

Layer 1

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Name

conn_rnc_ima_1 to conn_rnc_ima_8

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set the advanced attributes
of Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
6-ML1-3

Frame Format
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CRC-4 Multiframe

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

772

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value
6-ML1-3

Frame Mode

31

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

Step 3 See A.6.5.1 Creating Serial Ports and configure serial ports on NE21.
The values for the serial port parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
Serial Port Where BTS37
Services Are Located

Serial Port Where BTS38


Services Are Located

Port

Name

conn_bts37_sp01

conn_bts38_sp02

Level

64K Timeslot

64K Timeslot

Used Board

6-ML1

6-ML1

Used Port

6-ML1-3

6-ML1-3

64K Timeslot

1-15

17-31

Step 4 See A.6.5.2 Setting Basic Attributes of Serial Ports and set the basic attributes of serial ports
on NE21.
The values for basic attributes of serial ports that need to be set are as follows.
Parameter

NE21
conn_bts37_sp01

conn_bts38_sp02

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

ATM

ATM

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

773

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.7.4.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the process for configuring IMA information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind the ATM trunk.
l The values for the related parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
Trunk1 (Connecting
BTS37 Services)

Trunk2 (Connecting
BTS38 Services)

Available Boards

6-ML1

6-ML1

Configurable Ports

6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)

Level

Fractional E1

Fractional E1

Available Resources

6-ML1-1
(conn_bts37_sp01)

6-ML1-2
(conn_bts38_sp02)

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Available Boards

2-ML1

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

Level

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_ima_1) to 2-ML1-13


(conn_rnc_ima_8)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and create an IMA group.
l The values for the IMA group parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE21
6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS37
Services)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS38
Services)

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Disabled

Disabled

IMA Protocol Version

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

774

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE21
6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS37
Services)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS38
Services)

IMA Symmetry Mode

Maximum Delay Between


Links (ms)

Clock Mode

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operational

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set the ATM port parameters.
l The values for the ATM port parameters of NE21 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
6-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS37
Services)

6-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS38
Services)

Name

conn_bts37_trunk1

conn_bts38_trunk2

Port Type

UNI

UNI

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

775

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

----End

11.7.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information of ATM services.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy and create the ATM policy.
The values for the related parameters of NE21 and NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE21 and NE31


CBR Service
(15 Timeslots
in an E1)

rt-VBR
Service (15
Timeslots in
an E1)

nrt-VBR
Service (15
Timeslots in
an E1)

UBR Service
(15 Timeslots
in an E1)

Policy ID

10

11

12

Policy Name

15ts_cbr

15ts_rtvbr

15ts_nrtvbr

15ts_ubr

Service Type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic Type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr(cell/
s)

105

960

960

960

Clp01Scr(cell/
s)

858

858

Max. Cell
Burst Size (cell)

1000

1000

Cell Delay
Variation
Tolerance
(0.1us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

776

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE21 and NE31

UPC/NPC

CBR Service
(15 Timeslots
in an E1)

rt-VBR
Service (15
Timeslots in
an E1)

nrt-VBR
Service (15
Timeslots in
an E1)

UBR Service
(15 Timeslots
in an E1)

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

----End

11.7.4.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services and create ATM services.
l Parameters of NE21:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE21
ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Service Name

bts37_bts38_fracatmservice

Service ID

102

Service Type

UNIs-NNI

Connection
Type

PVC

Protection Type

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE21

Conne
ction
Name

bts37_
cbr_at
m

bts37_r
tvbr_at
m

bts37_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts37_
ubr_at
m

bts38_
cbr_at
m

bts38_r
tvbr_at
m

bts38_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts38_
ubr_at
m

Source
Board

6-ML1

6-ML1

6-ML1

6-ML1

6-ML1

6-ML1

6-ML1

6-ML1

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

777

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Param
eter

NE21

Source
Port

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRUN
K1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

2
(TRU
NK2)

2
(TRUN
K2)

2
(TRU
NK2)

2
(TRU
NK2)

Source
Bind
Path

6ML1(1)

6ML1(1)

6ML1(1)

6ML1(1)

6ML1(2)

6ML1(2)

6ML1(2)

6ML1(2)

Source
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Source
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

PW ID 102

102

102

102

102

102

102

102

Sink
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Sink
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Uplin
k
Policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

Down
link
Policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE21

PW ID

102

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

778

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Param
eter

NE21

PW
Signali
ng
Type

Static

PW
Type

ATM n-to-one VCC cell transport

PW
Ingres
s
Label /
Source
Port

102

PW
Egress
Label /
Sink
Port

102

Tunne
l

1505

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21
ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Control Word

NO use

Control Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE21

PW ID

102

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

779

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Param
eter

NE21

CoS
Mappi
ng

DefaultAtmCosMap

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

l Parameters of NE31:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Service Name

bts37_bts38_fracatmservice

Service ID

102

Service Type

UNIs-NNI

Connection
Type

PVC

Protection Type

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE31

Conne
ction
Name

bts37_
cbr_at
m

bts37_r
tvbr_at
m

bts37_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts37_
ubr_at
m

bts38_
cbr_at
m

bts38_r
tvbr_at
m

bts38_
nrtvbr_
atmM

bts38_
ubr_at
m

Source
Board

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

Source
Port

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

1
(TRU
NK1)

Source
Bind
Path

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

2ML1(6-13)

Source
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

780

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Param
eter

NE31

Source
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

PW ID

102

102

102

102

102

102

102

102

Sink
VPI
(eg.
35,3639)

37

37

37

37

38

38

38

38

Sink
VCI
(eg.
35,3639)

33

34

35

36

33

34

35

36

Uplink
Policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

Down
link
Policy

10

11

12

10

11

12

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Param
eter

NE31

PW ID

102

PW
Signali
ng
Type

Static

PW
Type

ATM n-to-one VCC cell transport

PW
Ingres
s
Label /
Source
Port

102

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

781

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Param
eter

NE31

PW
Egress
Label /
Sink
Port

102

Tunne
l

1505

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

Control Word

NO use

Control Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Param
eter

NE31

PW ID

102

CoS
Mappi
ng

DefaultAtmCosMap

ATM Services from BTS37 and BTS38

----End

11.7.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

782

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.4 Testing ATM Services and verify the ATM service configurations.
The verification result should be "success".
----End

11.8 Configuration Example (ATM Services on MS-PWs)


This section uses an ATM service carried on MS-PWs of a PSN as an example to describe how
to configure ATM services according to service planning information. In this example, services
are encapsulated in 1-to-1 VCC mode.

11.8.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection) and
10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No Protection), configure information
about ATM services transmitted from BTS34 according to the following network planning
information (as shown in Figure 11-26):
l

Information about ATM service ports is provided in Table 11-70.

The information about the tunnel between NE34 and NE31 is as follows:
A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1515), which has no protection tunnel, is available between
NE34 and NE32. This tunnel and its corresponding information have been configured
in 10.3 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).
A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1501), which has a protection tunnel, is available between
NE32 and NE31. This tunnel and its corresponding information have been configured
in 10.4 Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with No Protection).

Each BTS has real-time voice services, signaling services (CBR services), HSDPA data
services (UBR services), OM and HSDPA real-time services (rt-VBR services), and R99
non-real-time services (nrt-VBR services).

Figure 11-26 Networking diagram

NE34

E1

R99
BTS34

Wo
rki n
(ID g tu n
=1 5
n
1 5) el

W
or
ki
ID ng t
=1 u n
50 ne
l
1

NE33
GE

GE

NE32
NE31

NE11
GE

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE21

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GE

E1

RNC

783

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-70 Information about service ports


NE

Service Port

Description

NE34

9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-5

Configure these ports to


receive and transmit BTS34
services.

NE31

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Configure these ports to


transmit BTS34 services to
the RNC.

11.8.2 ServicePlanning
You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.8.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.
Table 11-71 and Table 11-72 provide planning information about UNI ports.
Table 11-71 Information about UNI ports (NE34)
Parameter

9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Port name

conn_bts34_ima1 to conn_bts34_ima4

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM30

Table 11-72 Information about UNI ports (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Port name

conn_rnc_ima1 to conn_rnc_ima8

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM30

11.8.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM/IMA information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

784

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-73 and Table 11-74 provide ATM/IMA information.


Table 11-73 ATM/IMA information (NE34)
Parameter

9-MP1-1 (TRUNK1)

Bound port

9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

IMA protocol enabled status

Enabled

IMA protocol version

1.1

IMA frame length

128

IMA symmetric mode

Symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation

Differentiated delay
tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_bts34_trunk1

Port type

UNI

ATM cell payload


scrambling

Enabled

Table 11-74 ATM/IMA information (NE31)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

2-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

Bound port

9-MP1-6 to 9-MP1-13

IMA protocol enabled status

Enabled

IMA protocol version

1.1

IMA frame length

128

IMA symmetric mode

Symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation

Differentiated delay
tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port type

UNI

ATM cell payload


scrambling

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

785

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NOTE

l If carried over a single E1, ATM services from a NodeB are transmitted and received through UNI
ports. In this case, the IMA protocol needs to be disabled. If carried over multiple E1s, ATM services
from a NodeB are transmitted and received through IMA trunks.
l Normally, set the IMA protocol version, IMA frame length, IMA symmetric mode, and differentiated
delay tolerance of an NE (with IMA protocol enabled) to the same values as those of its interconnected
equipment. Normally, the BTS/RNC configurations are as follows:
l IMA protocol version: 1.1
l IMA frame length: 128
l IMA symmetric mode: symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation
l The differentiated delay tolerance: 25
l The clock modes must be the same at both ends of an IMA trunk. The default clock mode for a BTS
is ITC. Therefore, the clock mode is set to ITC for the NE that is interconnected with the BTS and the
NE at the opposite end of the IMA link.

11.8.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM service classes and ATM policies.

Mapping Information Between ATM Service Types and ATM Service Classes
Table 11-75 provides the mapping information between ATM service types and the ATM
service classes.
Table 11-75 Mapping information between ATM service types and the ATM service classes
Parameter

PHB Service Class

CBR

EF

rt-VBR

AF3

nrt-VBR

AF2

UBR

BE

This mapping table is consistent with "DefaultAtmCosMap". Therefore, you can use the default
CoS mapping table during service configuration.

Information about ATM policies


The parameter values of the ATM policy differ with the E1 quantity and service type. NE34
uses four E1 ports to receive and transmit BTS34 services, which contain CBR, UBR, rt-VBR,
and nrt-VBR services. Therefore, up to four ATM policies need to be configured. Table
11-76 shows the planning information about the ATM policy.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

786

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-76 Information about the 4xE1 ATM policy


Parameter

Service Type
CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Policy ID

Policy name

4e1_cbr

4e1_rtvbr

4e1_nrtvbr

4e1_ubr

Service type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr (cell/
s)

500

2252

9295

9295

Clp01Scr (cell/
s)

2048

8799

Clp0Pcr (cell/s)

Clp0Scr (cell/s)

Clp01Mcr (cell/
s)

MBS (cell)

1000

1000

CDVT (us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

11.8.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM services.
Table 11-77 to Table 11-80 provide the service planning information.
Table 11-77 Service information (CBR services from BTS34)
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service name

bts34_cbrservice_1stpw

bts34_cbrservice_2ndpw

Service ID

103

104

Service type

UNIs-NNI

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

787

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

CBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Connection type

PVC

Protection type

No protection

Sink NE (NE31)

ATM connection information (source NE)


Connection name

bts34_cbr_atm

Source board

9-MP1

Source port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

33

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

33

Upstream QoS policy

5 (4e1_cbr)

Downstream QoS policy

5 (4e1_cbr)

ATM connection information (sink NE)


Connection name

bts34_cbr_atm

Source board

2-ML1

Source port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

33

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

33

Upstream QoS policy

5 (4e1_cbr)

Downstream QoS policy

5 (4e1_cbr)

PW information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PW ID

103

104

PW ingress/egress label

103/103

104/104

Encapsulation type

ATM one-to-one VCC

Tunnel

1515

Control Word

Must Use

Control Channel Type

CW

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1501

788

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

CBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

VCCV Verification Mode

Sink NE (NE31)

Ping

CoS mapping information


CoS mapping

DefaultAtmCosMap

PW switching node

NE32

PW switching service ID

902

PW switching service name

bts34_cbrservice_mspw

Table 11-78 Service information (rt-VBR services from BTS34)


Parameter

rt-VBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service name

bts34_rtvbrservice_1stpw

bts34_rtvbrservice_2ndpw

Service ID

105

106

Service type

UNIs-NNI

Connection type

PVC

Protection type

No protection

ATM connection information (source NE)


Connection name

bts34_rtvbr_atm

Service board

9-MP1

Service port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

34

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

34

Upstream QoS policy

6 (4e1_rtvbr)

Downstream QoS policy

6 (4e1_rtvbr)

ATM connection information (sink NE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Connection name

bts34_rtvbr_atm

Service board

2-ML1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

789

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

rt-VBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Service port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

34

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

34

Upstream QoS policy

6 (4e1_rtvbr)

Downstream QoS policy

6 (4e1_rtvbr)

Sink NE (NE31)

PW information
PW ID

105

106

PW ingress/egress label

105/105

106/106

Encapsulation type

ATM one-to-one VCC

Tunnel

1515

Control Word

Must Use

Control Channel Type

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

1501

CoS mapping information


CoS mapping

DefaultAtmCosMap

PW switching node

NE32

PW switching ervice ID

903

PW switching service name

bts34_rtvbrservice_mspw

Table 11-79 Service information (nrt-VBR services from BTS34)


Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

nrt-VBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service name

bts34_nrtvbrservice_1stpw

bts34_nrtvbrservice_2ndpw

Service ID

107

108

Service type

UNIs-NNI

Connection type

PVC

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

790

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

nrt-VBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Protection type

Sink NE (NE31)

No protection

ATM connection information (source NE)


Connection name

bts34_nrtvbr_atm

Service board

9-MP1

Service port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

35

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

35

Upstream QoS policy

7 (4e1_nrtvbr)

Downstream QoS policy

7 (4e1_nrtvbr)

ATM connection information (sink NE)


Connection name

bts34_nrtvbr_atm

Service board

2-ML1

Service port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

35

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

35

Upstream QoS policy

7 (4e1_nrtvbr)

Downstream QoS policy

7 (4e1_nrtvbr)

PW information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

PW ID

107

108

PW ingress/egress label

107/107

108/108

Encapsulation type

ATM one-to-one VCC

Tunnel

1515

Control Word

Must Use

Control Channel Type

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1501

791

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

nrt-VBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

CoS mapping information


CoS mapping

DefaultAtmCosMap

PW switching node

NE32

PW switching service ID

904

PW switching service name

bts34_nrtvbrservice_mspw

Table 11-80 Service information (UBR services from BTS34)


Parameter

UBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service name

bts34_ubrservice_1stpw

bts34_ubrservice_2ndpw

Service ID

109

110

Service type

UNIs-NNI

Connection type

PVC

Protection type

No protection

ATM connection information (source NE)


Connection name

bts_ubr_atm

Service board

9-MP1

Service port

TRUNK1

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

36

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

36

Upstream QoS policy

8 (4e1_ubr)

Downstream QoS policy

8 (4e1_ubr)

ATM connection information (sink NE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Connection name

bts_ubr_atm

Service board

2-ML1

Service port

TRUNK1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

792

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

UBR Services from BTS34


Source NE (NE34)

Source VPI

34

Source VCI

36

Sink VPI

34

Sink VCI

36

Upstream QoS policy

8 (4e1_ubr)

Downstream QoS policy

8 (4e1_ubr)

Sink NE (NE31)

PW information
PW ID

109

110

PW ingress/egress label

109/109

110/110

Encapsulation type

ATM one-to-one VCC

Tunnel

1515

Control Word

Must Use

Control Channel Type

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

1501

CoS mapping information


CoS mapping

DefaultAtmCosMap

PW switching node

NE32

PW switching service ID

905

PW switching service name

bts34_ubrservice_mspw

NOTE

In end-to-end configuration mode, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label can be automatically assigned
and therefore they do not need to be planned.

11.8.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring MS-PW-based ATM services in an end-toend mode.

11.8.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

793

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set general attributes of Smart E1
ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Name

conn_bts34_ima1 to conn_bts34_ima4

Port Mode

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Name

conn_rnc_ima1 to conn_rnc_ima8

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set advanced attributes of
Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

----End

11.8.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the process for configuring IMA information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

794

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind ATM trunks.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
Trunk1 (Connecting BTS34 Services)

Available Boards

9-MP1

Configurable Ports

9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Level

E1

Available Resources

9-MP1-1 (conn_bts34_ima1) to 9-MP1-4


(conn_bts34_ima4)

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Available Boards

2-ML1

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

Level

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_ima_1) to 2-ML1-13


(conn_rnc_ima_8)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and configure an IMA group.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 (TRUNK1) (Connecting
BTS34 Services)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operational

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

795

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operational

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set ATM port parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 (TRUNK1) (Connecting
BTS34 Services)

Name

conn_bts34_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

----End

11.8.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS Information)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for MS-PW-based ATM
services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

796

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.3 Configuring an ATM Policy Profile and configure ATM policy templates.
1.

Choose Configuration > PTN QoS Profile > ATM Profile from the Main Menu.

2.

Right-click in ATM Profile and choose Add Global Profile from the shortcut menu.

The Create ATM Profile dialog box is displayed.


3.

Set the ATM policy profile according to network planning information so that it is available
for traffic management policy selection during ATM connection creation.

4.

Click OK.

5.

Repeat Step 1.3 and Step 1.4 to create the other ATM policy templates for ATM services.

Step 2 See A.13.4.4 Configuring an ATM CoS Mapping Profile and configure an ATM CoS mapping
template.
NOTE

In this example, the default Default ATMCosMap template is used. Therefore, skip this step.

----End

11.8.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring MS-PW-based ATM service information in
an end-to-end mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

797

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Context
NOTE

This section uses the process for configuring the bts34_cbrservice_1stpw ATM service in an end-to-end mode
as an example. The processes for configuring other services are similar to the configuration process described
in this section.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.5 Configuring ATM Services in an End-to-End Mode and configure MS-PWbased ATM services in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes for ATM services.

3.

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the ATM service.

4.

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE31) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 2-ML1-1.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Repeat 1.3.a and 1.3.c to configure the service port (9-MP1-1) on the sink NE (NE34).

e.

In the Physical Topology tab page, right-click NE32 and choose Set As Switching
Node > Working from the shortcut menu.

Set the basic attributes of the PW.


Set Forward Tunnel, Reverse Tunnel, PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label.

5.

6.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the advanced attributes of the PW.


a.

Click Detail.

b.

In the Advanced PW Attribute tab page, set the advanced attributes of the PW.

Configure ATM connections.


a.

Click ATM Link.The Configure Link dialog box is displayed.

b.

Click Add Link.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

798

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

c.

Set the ATM connection attributes according to network planning information.

d.

Click OK.

7.

Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.

8.

Click OK.

9.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new ATM service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End

11.8.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.4 Testing ATM Services and verify ATM service configurations.
The verification result should be "success".
----End

11.8.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring MS-PW-based ATM services on a per-NE
basis.

11.8.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set general attributes of Smart E1
ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Name

conn_bts34_ima1 to conn_bts34_ima4

Port Mode

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

799

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Name

conn_rnc_ima1 to conn_rnc_ima8

Port Mode

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set advanced attributes of
Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6 to 2-ML1-13

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

----End

11.8.4.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the process for configuring IMA information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind ATM trunks.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
Trunk1 (Connecting BTS34 Services)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Available Boards

9-MP1

Configurable Ports

9-MP1-1 to 9-MP1-4

Level

E1

Available Resources

9-MP1-1 (conn_bts34_ima1) to 9-MP1-4


(conn_bts34_ima4)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

800

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Connecting the RNC)

Available Boards

2-ML1

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

Level

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_ima_1) to 2-ML1-13


(conn_rnc_ima_8)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and configure an IMA group.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 (TRUNK1) (Connecting
BTS34 Services)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operational

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

IMA Protocol Enable Status

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and Symmetrical


Operational

Maximum Delay Between Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

801

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set ATM port parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE34 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
9-MP1-1 (TRUNK1) (Connecting
BTS34 Services)

Name

conn_bts34_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1) (Connecting the
RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

Port Type

UNI

ATM Cell Payload Scrambling

Enabled

----End

11.8.4.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy and create ATM policies.
The values for the related parameters of NE34 and NE31 are provided as follows,
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE34 and NE31


CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Policy ID

Policy Name

4e1_cbr

4e1_rtvbr

4e1_nrtvbr

4e1_ubr

Service Type

CBR

RT-VBR

NRT-VBR

UBR

Traffic Type

ClpTransparent
NoScr

ClpTransparentScr

NoClpScr

NoClpNoScr

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

802

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE34 and NE31


CBR Service

rt-VBR
Service

nrt-VBR
Service

UBR Service

Clp01Pcr(cell/
s)

500

2252

9295

9295

Clp01Scr(cell/
s)

2048

8799

Max. Cell
Burst Size (cell)

1000

1000

Cell Delay
Variation
Tolerance
(0.1us)

102400

10240

Discard Traffic
Frame

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

UPC/NPC

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

Disabled

----End

11.8.4.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services and create ATM services.
l Parameters of NE34:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Pa
ra
m
ete
r

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR Services
from BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Se
rvi
ce
Na
me

bts34_cbrservice_
1stpw

bts34_rtvbrservice
_1stpw

bts34_nrtvbrservi
ce_1stpw

bts34_ubrservice_
1stpw

Se
rvi
ce
ID

103

105

107

109

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

803

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Pa
ra
m
ete
r

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR Services
from BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Se
rvi
ce
Ty
pe

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

Co
nn
ect
ion
Ty
pe

PVC

PVC

PVC

PVC

Pr
ote
cti
on
Ty
pe

No Protection

No Protection

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Connection
Name

bts34_cbr_atm

bts34_rtvbr_at
m

bts34_nrtvbr_a
tm

bts34_ubr_atm

Source Board

9-MP1

9-MP1

9-MP1

9-MP1

Source Port

1(TRUNK1)

1(TRUNK1)

1(TRUNK1)

1(TRUNK1)

Source VPI
(eg.35,36-39)

34

34

34

34

Source VCI
(eg.35,36-39)

33

34

35

36

PW ID

103

105

107

109

Sink VPI(eg.
35,36-39)

34

34

34

34

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

804

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Sink VCI(eg.
35,36-39)

33

34

35

36

Uplink Policy

Down link
Policy

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

PW ID

103

105

107

109

PW Signaling
Type

Static

Static

Static

Static

PW Type

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

PW Ingress
Label / Source
Port

103

105

107

109

PW Egress
Label / Sink
Port

103

105

107

109

Tunnel

1515

1515

1515

1515

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

Control Word

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Must use

Must use

Must use

Must use

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

805

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Control
Channel Type

CW

CW

CW

CW

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

Ping

Ping

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

PW ID

103

105

107

109

CoS Mapping

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

l Parameters of NE31:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Service Name

bts34_cbrservi
ce_2ndpw

bts34_rtvbrser
vice_2ndpw

bts34_nrtvbrse
rvice_2ndpw

bts34_ubrservi
ce_2ndpw

Service ID

104

106

108

110

Service Type

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

Connection
Type

PVC

PVC

PVC

PVC

Protection
Type

No Protection

No Protection

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

806

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Connection
Name

bts34_cbr_atm

bts34_rtvbr_at
m

bts34_nrtvbr_a
tm

bts34_ubr_atm

Source Board

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

2-ML1

Source Port

1 (TRUNK1)

1 (TRUNK1)

1 (TRUNK1)

1 (TRUNK1)

Source VPI
(eg.35,36-39)

34

34

34

34

Source VCI
(eg.35,36-39)

33

34

35

36

PW ID

104

106

108

110

Sink VPI(eg.
35,36-39)

34

34

34

34

Sink VCI(eg.
35,36-39)

33

34

35

36

Uplink Policy

Down link
Policy

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE31
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

PW ID

104

106

108

110

PW Signaling
Type

Static

Static

Static

Static

PW Type

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

ATM one to
one VCC cell
transport

PW Ingress
Label / Source
Port

104

106

108

110

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

807

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

PW Egress
Label / Sink
Port

104

106

108

110

Tunnel

1501

1501

1501

1501

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

Control Word

Must use

Must use

Must use

Must use

Control
Channel Type

CW

CW

CW

CW

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

Ping

Ping

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
CBR Services
from BTS34

rt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

nrt-VBR
Services from
BTS34

UBR Services
from BTS34

PW ID

104

106

108

110

CoS Mapping

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

DefaultAtmCo
sMap

Step 2 See A.9.4.2 Creating an MS-PW and create an MS-PW on NE32.


l MS-PW parameters for CBR services:
The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

808

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE32
CBR Services from BTS34

ID

902

Name

bts34_cbrservice_mspw

Service Type

ATM Service

Connection Type

PVC

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the PW Basic Attributes tab page
are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE32
CBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

CBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

PW ID

103

104

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

103

104

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

103

104

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1515

1501

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE32
CBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

CBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

Control Word

Must use

Must use

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

809

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

l MS-PW parameters for rt-VBR services:


The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE32
rt-VBR Services from BTS34

ID

903

Name

bts34_rtvbrservice_mspw

Service Type

ATM Service

Connection Type

PVC

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the PW Basic Attributes tab page
are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE32
rt-VBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

rt-VBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

PW ID

105

106

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

105

106

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

105

106

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1515

1501

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE32
rt-VBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

rt-VBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

Control Word

Must use

Must use

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

810

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

VCCV Verification Mode

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE32
rt-VBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

rt-VBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

Ping

Ping

l MS-PW parameters for nrt-VBR services:


The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE32
nrt-VBR Services from BTS34

ID

904

Name

bts34_nrtvbrservice_mspw

Service Type

ATM Service

Connection Type

PVC

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the PW Basic Attributes tab page
are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE32
nrt-VBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

nrt-VBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

PW ID

107

108

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

107

108

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

107

108

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1515

1501

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

811

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE32
nrt-VBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

nrt-VBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

Control Word

Must use

Must use

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

l MS-PW parameters for UBR services:


The values for the required parameters that are set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE32
UBR Services from BTS34

ID

905

Name

bts34_ubrservice_mspw

Service Type

ATM Service

Connection Type

PVC

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the PW Basic Attributes tab page
are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE32
UBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

UBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

PW ID

109

110

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

ATM one to one VCC cell


transport

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

109

110

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

109

110

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1515

1501

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

812

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE32
UBR Services from
BTS34 (Forward PW)

UBR Services from


BTS34 (Backward PW)

Control Word

Must use

Must use

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

----End

11.8.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.14.4 Testing ATM Services and verify ATM service configurations.
The verification result should be "success".
----End

11.9 Configuration Example (Transparently Transmitted


ATM Services)
This section uses a transparently transmitted ATM service on a PSN as an example to describe
how to configure ATM services according to service planning information.

11.9.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Compared with service requirements in 11.6 Configuration Example (Common ATM
Services), this configuration example has the following different service requirements:
l

Services from BTS13 and BTS14 are directly transmitted to NE11. The RNC uses different
E1 ports to receive services from different BTSs. For specific ATM service port
information, see Table 11-81.

A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1503), which has a protection tunnel, is available between NE11
and NE31. This tunnel and its corresponding information have been configured in 10.3
Configuration Example (MPLS Tunnels with MPLS APS Protection).

The NEs need not perform traffic management for ATM services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

813

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-27 Networking diagram


Working tunnel
(ID=1503)
GE

GE

NE32
NE31

NE11
E1

R99
BTS13

GE

NE21

E1

E1
RNC

GE

R99
BTS14

Table 11-81 Information about service ports


NE

Service Port

Description

NE11

4-ML1-2

Configure this port to receive


BTS13 services.

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Configure these ports to


receive BTS14 services.

2-ML1-6

Configure this port to


transmit BTS13 services to
the RNC.

2-ML1-7 to 2-ML1-10

Configure these ports to


transmit BTS14 services to
the RNC.

NE31

11.9.2 ServicePlanning
You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.9.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.
Table 11-82 and Table 11-83 provide planning information about UNI ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

814

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-82 Information about UNI ports (NE11)


Parameter

4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Port name

conn_bts13_atm1

conn_bts14_ima1 to
conn_bts14_ima4

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM30

PCM30

Table 11-83 Information about UNI ports (NE31)


Parameter

2-ML1-6

2-ML1-7 to 2-ML1-10

Port name

conn_rnc_atm1

conn_rnc_ima1 to
conn_rnc_ima4

Frame format

CRC-4 multiframe

CRC-4 multiframe

Frame mode

PCM30

PCM30

NOTE

l Appropriate port names facilitate future maintenance. It is recommended that you name ports on the
entire network in a unified manner.
l The E1 frame format and frame mode must be the same as those of service access equipment. As
specified in ITU-T G.804, ATM service ports use the default CRC-4 multiframe format and the PCM30
frame mode.

11.9.2.2 Service Planning (ATM/IMA Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM/IMA information.
Table 11-84 and Table 11-85 provide ATM/IMA information.
Table 11-84 ATM/IMA information (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

4-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

4-ML1-2 (TRUNK2)

Bound port

4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

IMA protocol
enabled status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA protocol
version

1.1

IMA frame
length

128

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

815

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

4-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

4-ML1-2 (TRUNK2)

IMA symmetric
mode

Symmetric mode and symmetric


operation

Minimum
number of
activated links

Differentiated
delay tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_bts13_trunk1

conn_bts14_trunk2

Port type

UNI

UNI

ATM cell
payload
scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

Table 11-85 ATM/IMA information (NE31)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

2-ML1-1 (TRUNK1)

2-ML1-2 (TRUNK2)

Bound port

2-ML1-6

2-ML1-7 to 2-ML1-10

IMA protocol
enabled status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA protocol
version

1.1

IMA frame
length

128

IMA symmetric
mode

Symmetric mode and symmetric


operation

Differentiated
delay tolerance

25

Clock mode

ITC

ATM port name

conn_rnc_trunk1

conn_rnc_trunk2

Port type

UNI

UNI

ATM cell
payload
scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

816

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NOTE

l If carried over a single E1, ATM services from a BTS are transmitted and received through UNI ports.
In this case, the IMA protocol needs to be disabled. If carried over multiple E1s, ATM services from
a BTS are transmitted and received through IMA trunks.
l Normally, set the IMA protocol version, IMA frame length, IMA symmetric mode, and differentiated
delay tolerance of an NE (with IMA protocol enabled) to the same values as those of its interconnected
equipment. Normally, the BTS/RNC configurations are as follows:
l IMA protocol version: 1.1
l IMA frame length: 128
l IMA symmetric mode: symmetrical mode and symmetrical operation
l The differentiated delay tolerance: 25
l The clock modes must be the same at both ends of an IMA trunk. The default clock mode for a BTS
is ITC. Therefore, the clock mode is set to ITC for the NE that is interconnected with the BTS and the
NE at the opposite end of the IMA link.

11.9.2.3 Service Planning (QoS)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM service classes and ATM policies.
In this example, the PHB service class is set to EF for transparently transmitted ATM services
to ensure reliable transmission of medium- and high-priority services. The PHB service class
for transparently transmitted ATM services, however, is defined as BE in the default ATM CoS
mapping table. Therefore, a new ATM CoS mapping table needs to be created.
Table 11-86 Information about the ATM CoS mapping table
Parameter

Value
NE11

Mapping table ID

Mapping table name

Port-transparent

PHB service class for


transparently transmitted
ATM services

EF

NE31

11.9.2.4 Service Planning (Service Information)


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring ATM services.
Table 11-87 provides the service planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

817

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-87 Service information (ATM services from BTS13)


Parameter

ATM Services from BTS13


Source NE (NE11)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service name

bts13_atmservice

Service ID

101

Service type

UNIs-NNI

Connection type

Port Transparent

Protection type

No protection

Service board

4-ML1

2-ML1

Service port

TRUNK1

TRUNK1

PW information
PW ID

101

PW ingress/
egress label

101/101

PW type

ATM transparent cell transport

Tunnel

1503

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

CoS mapping information


CoS mapping

2 (Port Transparent)

Table 11-88 Service information (ATM services from BTS14)


Parameter

ATM Services from BTS14


Source NE (NE11)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Service name

bts14_imaservice

Service ID

112

Service type

UNIs-NNI

Connection type

Port Transparent

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Sink NE (NE31)

818

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

ATM Services from BTS14


Source NE (NE11)

Sink NE (NE31)

Protection type

No protection

Service board

4-ML1

2-ML1

Service port

TRUNK2

TRUNK2

PW information
PW ID

112

PW ingress/
egress label

112/112

PW type

ATM transparent cell transport

Tunnel

1503

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel
Type

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

CoS mapping information


CoS mapping

2 (Port Transparent)

NOTE

In end-to-end configuration mode, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label can be automatically
assigned and therefore they do not need to be planned.

11.9.3 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring transparently transmitted ATM services on a
per-NE basis.

11.9.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set general attributes of Smart E1
ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

819

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Name

conn_bts13_atm1

conn_bts14_ima1 to
conn_bts14_ima4

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6

2-ML1-7 to 2-ML1-10

Name

conn_rnc_atm1

conn_rnc_ima1 to
conn_rnc_ima4

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Step 2 See A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports and set advanced attributes of
Smart E1 ports.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-2

4-ML1-3 to 4-ML1-6

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

30

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-6

2-ML1-7 to 2-ML1-10

Frame Format

CRC-4 Multiframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

Frame Mode

30

30

----End

11.9.3.2 Configuration Process (IMA Information)


This section describes the process for configuring IMA information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs and bind the ATM trunk.
l The values for the related parameters for NE11 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

820

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
Trunk1 (Connecting
BTS13 Services)

Trunk2 (Connecting
BTS14 Services)

Available Boards

4-ML1

4-ML1

Configurable Ports

4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)

Level

E1

E1

Available Resources

4-ML1-2
(conn_bts13_atm_1)

4-ML1-3
(conn_bts14_ima1) to 4ML1-6 (conn_bts14_ima4)

l The values for the related parameters for NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
Trunk1 (Transmitting
BTS13 Services to the
RNC)

Trunk2 (Transmitting
BTS14 Services to the
RNC)

Available Boards

2-ML1

2-ML1

Configurable Ports

2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)

2-ML1-2 (Trunk2)

Level

E1

E1

Available Resources

2-ML1-6 (conn_rnc_atm1)

2-ML1-7 (conn_rnc_ima1)
to 2-ML1-10
(conn_rnc_ima4)

Step 2 See A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group and create an IMA group.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and


Symmetrical Operational

Maximum Delay Between


Links (ms)

25

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

821

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Clock Mode

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

ITC

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Transmitting BTS13
Services to the RNC)

2-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Transmitting BTS14
Services to the RNC)

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Disabled

Enabled

IMA Protocol Version

1.1

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

128

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and


Symmetrical Operational

Maximum Delay Between


Links (ms)

25

Clock Mode

ITC

Step 3 See A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters and set ATM port parameters.
l The values for the related parameters of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
4-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Connecting BTS13
Services)

4-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Connecting BTS14
Services)

Name

conn_bts13_trunk1

conn_bts14_trunk2

Port Type

UNI

UNI

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

l The values for the related parameters of NE31 are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

822

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
2-ML1-1 (Trunk1)
(Transmitting BTS13
Services to the RNC)

2-ML1-2 (Trunk2)
(Transmitting BTS14
Services to the RNC)

Name

conn_rnc_trunk1

conn_rnc_trunk2

Port Type

UNI

UNI

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Enabled

Enabled

----End

11.9.3.3 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for ATM services.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.9.1 Creating an ATM-DiffServ Domain and create the ATM DS domain.
Parameters for NE11 and NE31:
Parameter

Value
NE11 and NE31

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

Port-transparent

PORT-TRANS

EF

NOTE

PHB service classes for other service types are invalid for transparently transmitted ATM services. It is
recommended that a transparently transmitted ATM service takes its default PHB service class.

----End

11.9.3.4 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring service information.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services and create ATM services.
l Parameters of NE11:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

823

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

Service
Name

bts13_atmservice

bts14_imaservice

Service
ID

101

112

Service
Type

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

Connec
tion
Type

Port Transparent

Port Transparent

Protecti
on Type

No Protection

No Protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
ATM Services from
BTS13

ATM Services from


BTS14

Source Board

4-ML1

4-ML1

Source Port

1 (TRUNK1)

2 (TRUNK2)

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parame
ter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

PW ID

101

112

PW
Signalin
g Type

Static

Static

PW
Type

ATM transparent cell transport

ATM transparent cell transport

PW
Ingress
Label /
Source
Port

101

112

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

824

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

PW
Egress
Label /
Sink
Port

101

112

Tunnel

1503

1503

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parame
ter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

Control
Word

NO use

NO use

Control
Channe
l Type

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV
Verifica
tion
Mode

Ping

Ping

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Parame
ter

NE11
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

PW ID

101

112

CoS
Mappin
g

2 (Port-transparent)

2 (Port-transparent)

l Parameters of NE31:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

825

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

Service
Name

bts13_atmservice

bts14_imaservice

Service
ID

101

112

Service
Type

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

Connec
tion
Type

Port Transparent

Port Transparent

Protecti
on Type

No protection

No protection

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the Configure Connection tab
page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
ATM Services from
BTS13

ATM Services from


BTS14

Source Board

2-ML1

2-ML1

Source Port

1 (TRUNK1)

2 (TRUNK2)

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parame
ter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

PW ID

101

112

PW
Signali
ng Type

Static

Static

PW
Type

ATM transparent cell transport

ATM transparent cell transport

PW
Ingress
Label /
Source
Port

101

112

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

826

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parame
ter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

PW
Egress
Label /
Sink
Port

101

112

Tunnel

1503

1503

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parame
ter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

Control
Word

NO use

NO use

Control
Channe
l Type

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV
Verifica
tion
Mode

Ping

Ping

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the CoS Mapping tab page are
provided as follows.
Parame
ter

NE31
ATM Services from BTS13

ATM Services from BTS14

PW ID

101

112

CoS
Mappin
g

2 (Port-transparent)

2 (Port-transparent)

----End

11.9.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying ATM Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying ATM service configurations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

827

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 The OptiX RTN 980 does not support ATM OAM tests on transparently transmitted services
(PORT-TRANS) over an ATM port. Therefore, it is recommended that you initiate an ATM
OAM test on a CE (for example, a BTS or RNC) of a PSN so that ATM OAM packets can be
transparently transmitted through the OptiX RTN 980 to the opposite CE on the PSN. In this
manner, an ATM service connectivity test is implemented.
----End

11.10 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on


PWs, a Simple Example)
This section considers E-Line services carried on PWs as an example to describe how to
configure E-Line services.

11.10.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
After planning and configuring MPLS tunnels, aggregate Ethernet services from BTSs to the
RNC by means of PWs. The service requirements are as follows:
l

Ethernet services (VLAN ID: 310) at BTS31, which are received by NE32, need to be
transmitted to the RNC. A bidirectional working tunnel (ID: 1501), which has a protection
tunnel, is available between NE32 and NE31. Ethernet services carried on PWs connected
to BTS31 are transparently transmitted over the tunnel.

Ethernet services at all preceding BTSs have already been configured with corresponding
VLAN priorities based on service types (real-time voice services, HSDPA real-time
services, R99 non-real-time services, and HSDPA data services), and the transmission
network is required to provide end-to-end QoS control based on the VLAN priorities
specified at the BTSs.

GE ports on NE31, which are connected to the RNC, need to be protected in link aggregation
group (LAG) mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

828

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-28 Networking diagram (E-Line services carried on PWs, a simple example)
NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4
FE

R4
Working Tunnel
(ID=1501)

GE

Hybrid radio chain network

NE32

NE31

NE11
GE

GE

NE21

GE
GE

Hybrid radio ring network

RNC

Table 11-89 provides the information about UNI ports of E-Line services carried on PWs.
Table 11-89 Information about service ports
NE

Service Port

Description

NE32

2-EM6T-3

Receives the Ethernet


services from BTS31.

NE31

4-EM6T-1

Ports 4-EM6T-1 and 4EM6T-2 form a LAG.

4-EM6T-2

11.10.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.10.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.
Table 11-90 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE32.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

829

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-90 Information about Ethernet ports (NE32)


Parameter

NE32
2-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Table 11-91 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE31.
Table 11-91 Information about Ethernet ports (NE31)
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Disabled

NOTE

l In this example, all GE ports on the packet network work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, FE ports on
all NEs, which receive Ethernet services from BTSs, need to work in auto-negotiation mode. If Ethernet
ports at BTSs, which are connected to FE ports, work in other modes, FE ports at the local end need to work
in the corresponding modes.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only when the local NE or opposite equipment has insufficient
QoS capabilities. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l In this example, no loopback check, loopback port shutdown, or broadcast packet suppression function is
enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

830

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.10.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


This section provides the information about all the Ethernet protection parameters required for
GE ports of NE31 connected to the RNC.
To improve the reliability of service transmission, NE31 and the RNC are interconnected through
the LAG formed by two GE links.Table 11-92 provides the planning information.
Table 11-92 Information about LAGs
Parameter

NE31

LAG type

Static

Revertive mode

Non-Revertive

Load sharing

Non-Sharing

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EM6T-1

Slave port

4-EM6T-2

NOTE

In this example, the bandwidth of the Ethernet services is lower than the bandwidth of a GE port. Therefore,
you need not configure the LAG to the load-sharing mode for increase of the bandwidth utilization.

11.10.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for E-Line services
carried by PWs.
Table 11-93 provides the planning information about E-Line services carried by PWs.
Table 11-93 Planning information about E-Line services carried by PWs
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

E-Line Services Carried by PWs Connected to BTS31


Source NE (NE32)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

303

303

Service Name

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Source Port

2-EM6T-3

4-EM6T-1

Source VLANs

310

310

Bearer Type

PW

PW

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

831

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

E-Line Services Carried by PWs Connected to BTS31

Protection Type

Source NE (NE32)

Sink NE (NE31)

No Protection

No Protection

NOTE

For per-NE service configuration, the service name needs to be planned manually. For end-to-end service
configuration, the U2000 automatically generates the service name based on naming rules.

Table 11-94 provides the planning information about PWs.


Table 11-94 Planning information about PWs
Parameter

E-Line Services Carried by PWs Connected to BTS31


Source NE (NE32)

Sink NE (NE31)

PW ID

303

303

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Labs/Source Port

40

40

PW Egress Labs/Sink Port

40

40

Tunnel selection mode

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1501

1501

Opposite LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.2

Control Word

No Use

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

NOTE

In this example, the service ID, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label are manually planned. For endto-end service configuration, the U2000 automatically sets these parameters.
In this example, the tunnel has already been planned when you plan MPLS tunnels. Therefore, you need to
select only the tunnel that carries the PWs.

11.10.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

832

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

QoS (DiffServ)
Diffserv is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the
BTS services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding Diffserv domain according to the allocated VLAN priority, DSCP value, or MPLS
EXP value. Each Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same Diffserv configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated corresponding C-VLAN priorities by service
type, and PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line services are configured on the transmission network.
DiffServ planning has been completed for the transmission network during MPLS tunnel
planning. In this example, you only need to set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI
ports to C-VLAN priority and MPLS EXP respectively. This setting results in the mapping from
the C-VLAN priority of the UNI-side BTS services to the MPLS EXP value on the NNI side of
the transmission network, therefore achieving end-to-end QoS control on the transmission
network.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 11-95 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 11-95 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

833

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

QoS (PW Bandwidth Control)


In this example, PW bandwidth does not need to be controlled.

11.10.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes how to configure E-Line services carried by PWs in an end-to-end mode.

11.10.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port attributes.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE32 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE32
2-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

834

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE32 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE32
2-EM6T-3

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

TAG

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

----End

11.10.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

835

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

----End

11.10.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes how to configure information about E-Line services carried by PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based E-Line Services (in an End-to-End Mode) and
configure an E-Line service carried by PWs in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes of a PW-based E-Line service.

3.

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PW-carried E-Line
service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE32) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 2-EM6T-3 and set VLAN ID to 310.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE31) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 4-EM6T-1 and set VLAN ID to 310.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

836

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

f.
4.

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Click OK.

Set the basic attributes of PWs.


Based on 11.10.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information), set Forward Tunnel,
Reverse Tunnel, PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label.

5.

At the lower left corner, select Deploy and Enable.

6.

Click OK.

7.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new Ethernet PWE3 service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End

11.10.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS of E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI ports on NE32 and NE31 that transmit the UNINNI ETH PWE3 services to C-VLAN and MPLS EXP respectively.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

2.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE32 and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

837

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Value
NE32

NE31

Port

2-EM6T-3

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

NOTE

For an NNI port that transmits a PW-carried E-Line service, set Packet Type trusted by the NNI port to
MPLS EXP.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE32 are
provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE32 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters of UNI ports of NE32 and NE31 are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

838

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Port

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Value
NE32

NE31

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

2-EM6T-3

4-EM6T-1

----End

11.10.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes how to use Ethernet OAM to verify connectivity of an Ethernet service.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria window, select Source NE and Sink Node. Click Filter.

Step 3 Right-click the PWE3 service to verify, and choose Ethernet OAM > LB Test... from the
shortcut menu.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

839

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 4 In the Eth Oam LB Test dialog box that is displayed, select the source NE for initiating an LB
test.
NOTE

l An LB test detects whether a service is bidirectionally available. For a bidirectional service, it is


recommended that you select either end of a PW as the source NE for initiating the LB test.
l If a PW carries Ethernet services from different VLANs, the U2000 automatically select the service
of a VLAN for the LB test.

Step 5 Optional: Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Configure... from
the shortcut menu. In the Config Eth Oam LB Test Parameter dialog box that is displayed,
set Sent Packets, Sent Packets Length, and Sent Packets Priority. Then, click OK.

Step 6 Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Run from the shortcut menu.
Step 7 Click the LB Statistic Information tab and determines whether the service is available based
on the displayed information.
If Test Result displays Test Succeeded, the service is available.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

840

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

----End

11.10.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring E-Line services carried on PWs in Per-NE
configuration mode.

11.10.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port attributes.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE32 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE32
2-EM6T-3

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

841

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE32 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE32
2-EM6T-3

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

TAG

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

----End

11.10.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

842

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

----End

11.10.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs) and configure the ELine services.
l Parameters of NE32
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE32

Service ID

303

Service Name

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

2-EM6T-3

Source VLANs

310

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

843

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE32

PW ID

303

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

40

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

40

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1501

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.1

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE32

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

l Parameters of NE31
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE31

Service ID

303

Service Name

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

4-EM6T-1

Source VLANs

310

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

844

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31

PW ID

303

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

40

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

40

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1501

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.2

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

----End

11.10.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS of E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI ports on NE32 and NE31 that transmit the UNINNI ETH PWE3 services to C-VLAN and MPLS EXP respectively.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

845

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE32 and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Parameter

Value
NE32

NE31

Port

2-EM6T-3

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

NOTE

For an NNI port that transmits a PW-carried E-Line service, set Packet Type trusted by the NNI port to
MPLS EXP.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE32 are
provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE32 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

846

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters of UNI ports of NE32 and NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Port

NE32

NE31

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

2-EM6T-3

4-EM6T-1

----End

11.10.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs for NE31 and NE32.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE32

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Domain
Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create an MA for NE31 and NE32.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
NE31

NE32

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

847

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Value
NE31

NE32

Relevant Service

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create MEPs for NE31 and NE32.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE32

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

Board

4-EM6T

2-EM6T

Port

4-EM6T-1

2-EM6T-3

VLAN

310

310

MP ID

310

320

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs for NE31 and
NE32.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE32

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

BTS31-RNC_E-Line

Remote Maintenance Point


ID(e.g:1,3-6)

320

310

Step 5 On NE31, perform LB tests to verify the Ethernet service configurations.


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

848

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MP ID is 310 as the source MEP and the
MEP whose MP ID is 320 as the sink MEP to check the connectivity of the E-Line services
carried on the PWs between NE31 and NE32.
The LB test result shows that no packet loss occurs.
----End

11.11 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on


PWs and Transmitting the Ethernet Services Aggregated
from the Hybrid Microwave Network)
This section considers E-Line services carried on PWs and transmitting the Ethernet services
aggregated from the Hybrid microwave network as an example to describe how to configure ELine services carried on PWs.

11.11.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
After planning and configuring MPLS tunnels, aggregate Ethernet services from BTSs to the
RNC by means of PWs. The service requirements are as follows:
l

On the Hybrid microwave chain network connected to NE11, Ethernet services at BTS11,
BTS12, and BTS13 respectively carry VLAN ID 100, VLAN ID 110, and VLAN ID 120,
and they need to be transmitted to the RNC. A bidirectional working tunnel (ID: 1503),
which has a protection tunnel, is available between NE11 and NE31. Ethernet services
carried on PWs at BTS11, BTS12, and BTS13 are transparently transmitted over the tunnel.

On the Hybrid microwave ring network connected to NE21, Ethernet services at BTS21,
BTS22, and BTS23 respectively carry VLAN ID 200, VLAN ID 210, and VLAN ID 220,
and they need to be transmitted to the RNC. A bidirectional working tunnel (ID: 1505),
which has a protection tunnel, is available between NE21 and NE31. Ethernet services
carried on PWs at BTS21, BTS22, and BTS23 are transparently transmitted over the tunnel.

Ethernet services at all preceding BTSs have already been configured with corresponding
VLAN priorities based on service types (real-time voice services, HSDPA real-time
services, R99 non-real-time services, and HSDPA data services), and the transmission
network is required to provide end-to-end QoS control based on the VLAN priorities
specified at the BTSs.

GE ports on NE31, which are connected to the RNC, need to be protected in link aggregation
group (LAG) mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

849

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-29 Networking diagram (E-Line services carried on PWs and transmitting the
Ethernet services aggregated from the Hybrid microwave network)
NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4
FE

Working Tunnel
(ID=1503)

BTS11

R4
GE

GE

R4
BTS12

Hybrid radio chain network

NE32

GE

NE11
GE

R4

NE31

NE21

GE

RNC

BTS13
Working Tunnel
(ID=1505)

BTS21
R4

Hybrid radio ring network


R4
BTS22

BTS23

R4

R4

Table 11-96 provides the information about UNI service ports of E-Line services carried on
PWs.
Table 11-96 Information about service ports
NE

Service Port

Description

NE11

3-ISU2-1

Receive Ethernet services at


BTS11, BTS12, and BTS13
connected to the Hybrid
microwave chain network.

NE21

1-EM6F-4

NE21 cross-connects and


loops back the 1-EM6F-3
port to the 1-EM6F-4 port by
means of a network cable to
convert Native E-LAN
services (at BTS21, BTS22,
and BTS23) received by the
1-EM6F-3 port on the Hybrid
microwave ring network to
E-Line services carried on
PWs.

NE31

4-EM6T-1

Ports 4-EM6T-1 and 4EM6T-2 form a LAG.

4-EM6T-2

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

850

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.11.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.11.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 11-97 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE21.
Table 11-97 Information about Ethernet ports (NE21)
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Table 11-98 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE31.
Table 11-98 Information about Ethernet ports (NE31)
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

851

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NOTE

l NE21 cross-connects and loops back the 1-EM6F-3 port to the 1-EM6F-4 port by means of a network cable
to convert Native E-LAN services received by the 1-EM6F-3 port on the Hybrid microwave ring network
to E-Line services carried on PWs.
l In this example, all GE ports on the packet network work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, FE ports on
all NEs, which receive Ethernet services from BTSs, need to work in auto-negotiation mode. If Ethernet
ports at BTSs, which are connected to FE ports, work in other modes, FE ports at the local end need to work
in the corresponding modes.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only when the local NE or opposite equipment has insufficient
QoS capabilities. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l In this example, no loopback check, loopback port shutdown, or broadcast packet suppression function is
enabled for Ethernet ports.

Information About IF_ETH Ports


Table 11-99 provides the information about IF_ETH ports on NE11, which receive Ethernet
services from BTSs on the Hybrid microwave chain network.
Table 11-99 Information about IF_ETH ports
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

11.11.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


This section provides the information about all the Ethernet protection parameters required for
GE ports of NE31 connected to the RNC.
To improve the reliability of service transmission, NE31 and the RNC are interconnected through
the LAG formed by two GE links.Table 11-100 provides the planning information.
Table 11-100 Information about LAGs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE31

LAG type

Static

Revertive mode

Non-Revertive

Load sharing

Non-Sharing

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EM6T-1

Slave port

4-EM6T-2
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

852

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NOTE

In this example, the bandwidth of the Ethernet services is lower than the bandwidth of a GE port. Therefore,
you need not configure the LAG to the load-sharing mode for increase of the bandwidth utilization.

11.11.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for E-Line services
carried by PWs.
Table 11-101 provides the planning information about E-Line services carried by PWs.
Table 11-101 Planning information about E-Line services carried by PWs
Parameter

E-Line Services Carried on PWs


Connected to BTS11, BTS12, or
BTS13

E-Line Services Carried on PWs


Connected to BTS21, BTS22, or
BTS23

Source NE
(NE11)

Source NE
(NE21)

Sink NE
(NE31)

Sink NE
(NE31)

Service ID

301

301

302

302

Service Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not
Transparently
Transmitted

Not
Transparently
Transmitted

Not
Transparently
Transmitted

Not
Transparently
Transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

4-EM6T-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

Source VLANs

100,110,120

100,110,120

200,210,220

200,210,220

Bearer Type

PW

PW

PW

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

No Protection

No Protection

NOTE

For per-NE service configuration, the service name needs to be planned manually. For end-to-end service
configuration, the U2000 automatically generates the service name based on naming rules.

Table 11-102 provides the planning information about PWs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

853

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-102 Planning information about PWs


Parameter

E-Line Services Carried on PWs


Connected to BTS11, BTS12, or
BTS13

E-Line Services Carried on PWs


Connected to BTS21, BTS22, or
BTS23

Source NE
(NE11)

Source NE
(NE21)

Sink NE
(NE31)

Sink NE
(NE31)

PW ID

301

301

302

302

PW Signaling
Type

Static

Static

Static

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

Ethernet

Ethernet

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW
Encapsulation
Type

MPLS

MPLS

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress
Labs/Source
Port

60

60

50

50

PW Egress
Labs/Sink Port

60

60

50

50

Tunnel
selection mode

MPLS

MPLS

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

1503

1505

1505

Opposite LSR
ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.4

Control Word

No Use

No Use

No Use

No Use

Control
Channel Type

Alert Label

Alert Label

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV
Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

Ping

Ping

NOTE

In this example, the service ID, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label are manually planned. For endto-end service configuration, the U2000 automatically sets these parameters.
In this example, the tunnel has already been planned when you plan MPLS tunnels. Therefore, you need to
select only the tunnel that carries the PWs.

11.11.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

854

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

QoS (DiffServ)
Diffserv is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the
BTS services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding Diffserv domain according to the allocated VLAN priority, DSCP value, or MPLS
EXP value. Each Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same Diffserv configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated corresponding C-VLAN priorities by service
type, and PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line services are configured on the transmission network.
DiffServ planning has been completed for the transmission network during MPLS tunnel
planning. In this example, you only need to set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI
ports to C-VLAN priority and MPLS EXP respectively. This setting results in the mapping from
the C-VLAN priority of the UNI-side BTS services to the MPLS EXP value on the NNI side of
the transmission network, therefore achieving end-to-end QoS control on the transmission
network.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 11-103 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 11-103 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

855

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

QoS (PW Bandwidth Control)


In this example, PW bandwidth does not need to be controlled.

11.11.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes how to configure E-Line services carried by PWs in an end-to-end mode.

11.11.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE21 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

856

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE21 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

TAG

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Step 4 See A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Tag

Tag Aware

----End

11.11.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

857

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

----End

11.11.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes how to configure information about E-Line services carried by PWs.

Context
NOTE

This section describes the process of configuring the E-Line service between NE11 (source NE) and NE31
(sink NE). The process of configuring the E-Line service between NE21 (source NE) and NE31 (sink NE)
is similar to the configuration process described in this section, except for parameter values.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based E-Line Services (in an End-to-End Mode) and
configure the E-Line service carried by PWs between NE11 and NE31 in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes of a PW-based E-Line service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

858

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

4.

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PW-carried E-Line
service.
a.

Double-click the source NE (NE11) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 3-ISU2-1 and set VLAN ID to 100,110,120.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE31) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 4-EM6T-1 and set VLAN ID to 100,110,120.

f.

Click OK.

Set the basic attributes of PWs.


Based on 11.11.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information), set Forward Tunnel,
Reverse Tunnel, PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label.

5.

At the lower left corner, select Deploy and Enable.

6.

Click OK.

7.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

859

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

The new Ethernet PWE3 service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End

11.11.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS of E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 that transmit
the UNI-NNI ETH PWE3 services to C-VLAN and MPLS EXP respectively.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

2.

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Port

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

CVLAN

NOTE

For an NNI port that transmits a PW-carried E-Line service, set Packet Type trusted by the NNI port to
MPLS EXP.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE32
are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

860

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters of UNI ports of NE11, NE21, and NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

----End

11.11.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes how to use Ethernet OAM to verify connectivity of an Ethernet service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

861

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Context
NOTE

This section describes the process of verifying the E-Line service between NE11 (source NE) and NE31
(sink NE). The process of verifying the E-Line service between NE21 (source NE) and NE31 (sink NE) is
similar to the verifying process described in this section, except for parameter values.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria window, select Source NE and Sink Node. Click Filter.

Step 3 Right-click the PWE3 service to verify, and choose Ethernet OAM > LB Test... from the
shortcut menu.

Step 4 In the Eth Oam LB Test dialog box that is displayed, select the source NE for initiating an LB
test.
NOTE

l An LB test detects whether a service is bidirectionally available. For a bidirectional service, it is


recommended that you select either end of a PW as the source NE for initiating the LB test.
l If a PW carries Ethernet services from different VLANs, the U2000 automatically select the service
of a VLAN for the LB test.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

862

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 5 Optional: Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Configure... from
the shortcut menu. In the Config Eth Oam LB Test Parameter dialog box that is displayed,
set Sent Packets, Sent Packets Length, and Sent Packets Priority. Then, click OK.

Step 6 Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Run from the shortcut menu.
Step 7 Click the LB Statistic Information tab and determines whether the service is available based
on the displayed information.
If Test Result displays Test Succeeded, the service is available.

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

863

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.11.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring E-Line services carried on PWs in Per-NE
configuration mode.

11.11.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE21 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE21 are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

864

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

TAG

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Step 3 See A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Step 4 See A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Tag

Tag Aware

----End

11.11.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

865

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

----End

11.11.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs) and configure the ELine services.
l Parameters of NE11
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE11

Service ID

301

Service Name

BTS11/12/13-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

Source VLANs

100,110,120

Bearer Type

PW

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

866

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE11

Protection Type

No Protection

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11

PW ID

301

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

60

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

60

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.1

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

l Parameters of NE21
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE21

Service ID

302

Service Name

BTS21/22/23-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

867

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE21

Source Port

1-EM6F-4

Source VLANs

200,210,220

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21

PW ID

302

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

50

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

50

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1505

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.1

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

l Parameters of NE31
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

868

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE31
E-Line Services Carried
on PWs Connected to
BTS11, BTS12, or BTS13

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs Connected to
BTS21, BTS22, or BTS23

Service ID

301

302

Service Name

BTS11/12/13-RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Source Port

4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-1

Source VLANs

100,110,120

200,210,220

Bearer Type

PW

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE31
E-Line Services Carried
on PWs Connected to
BTS11, BTS12, or BTS13

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs Connected to
BTS21, BTS22, or BTS23

PW ID

301

302

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

60

50

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

60

50

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

1505

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.4

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

869

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31
E-Line Services Carried
on PWs Connected to
BTS11, BTS12, or BTS13

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs Connected to
BTS21, BTS22, or BTS23

Control Word

No Use

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

----End

11.11.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS of E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 that transmit
the UNI-NNI ETH PWE3 services to C-VLAN and MPLS EXP respectively.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

2.

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Port

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

CVLAN

NOTE

For an NNI port that transmits a PW-carried E-Line service, set Packet Type trusted by the NNI port to
MPLS EXP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

870

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE32
are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters of UNI ports of NE11, NE21, and NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

871

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.11.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create an MA for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

Relevant
Service

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

CC Test
Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create MEPs for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Maintenance
Domain Name

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE11

NE21

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

NE31
EdgeNE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

EdgeNE

872

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

Board

3-ISU2

1-EM6F

4-EM6T

4-EM6T

Port

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-1

VLAN

100

200

100

200

MP ID

110

210

311

312

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

Active

NOTE

l On NE11, when performing the connectivity check on the E-Line services carried on PWs, use the BTS
service (VLAN ID: 100) received by NE11 as an example.
l On NE21, when performing the connectivity check on the E-Line services carried on PWs, use the BTS
service (VLAN ID: 200) received by NE21 as an example.

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs for NE11, NE21,
and NE31.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association
Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

Remote
Maintenance
Point ID(e.g:
1,3-6)

311

312

110

210

Step 5 On NE31, perform LB tests to verify the Ethernet service configurations.


Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MP ID is 311 as the source MEP and the
MEP whose MP ID is 110 as the sink MEP to check the connectivity of the E-Line services
carried on the PWs between NE31 and NE11.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

873

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MP ID is 310 as the source MEP and the
MEP whose MP ID is 210 as the sink MEP to check the connectivity of the E-Line services
carried on the PWs between NE31 and NE21.
The LB test results show that no packet loss occurs.
----End

11.12 Configuration Example (E-Line Services Carried on


MS-PWs)
This section considers E-Line services carried on MS-PWs as an example to describe how to
configure E-Line services carried on PWs.

11.12.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
After planning and configuring MPLS tunnels, aggregate Ethernet services from BTSs to the
RNC by means of PWs. The service requirements are as follows:
l

Ethernet services (VLAN ID: 330) at BTS33, which are received by NE34, need to be
transmitted to the RNC.

The information about the tunnel between NE34 and NE31 is as follows:
A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1515), which does not have a protection tunnel, is available
between NE34 and NE32.
A bidirectional tunnel (ID: 1501), which has a protection tunnel, is available between
NE32 and NE31.
Ethernet services at BTSs are carried by PWs on the two tunnels, and exchange PW
labels and tunnel labels on NE32.

Ethernet services at all preceding BTSs have already been configured with corresponding
VLAN priorities based on service types (real-time voice services, HSDPA real-time
services, R99 non-real-time services, and HSDPA data services), and the transmission
network is required to provide end-to-end QoS control based on the VLAN priorities
specified at the BTSs.

GE ports on NE31, which are connected to the RNC, need to be protected in link aggregation
group (LAG) mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

874

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Figure 11-30 Networking diagram (E-Line services carried by PWs and transmitting the
Ethernet services aggregated from the Hybrid microwave network)
NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4
Tunnel
(ID=1515)

R4
FE

Working Tunnel
(ID=1501)

GE

NE32
Hybrid radio chain network

NE31

NE11
GE

GE

NE21

GE

GE

RNC

Hybrid radio ring network

Table 11-104 provides the information about UNI ports of E-Line services carried by PWs.
Table 11-104 Information about service ports
NE

Service Port

Description

NE34

7-EM6X-1

Receives the Ethernet


services from BTS33.

NE31

4-EM6T-1

Ports 4-EM6T-1 and 4EM6T-2 form a LAG.

4-EM6T-2

11.12.2 Service Planning


You need to plan the corresponding parameter information before service configuration.

11.12.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.
Table 11-105 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE34.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

875

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-105 Information about Ethernet ports (NE34)


Parameter

NE34
7-EM6X-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Table 11-105 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE31.
Table 11-106 Information about Ethernet ports (NE31)
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Flow Control

Disabled

Disabled

NOTE

l In this example, all GE ports on the packet network work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, FE ports on
all NEs, which receive Ethernet services from BTSs, need to work in auto-negotiation mode. If Ethernet
ports at BTSs, which are connected to FE ports, work in other modes, FE ports at the local end need to work
in the corresponding modes.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet frames that carry more than one tag such as QinQ can traverse
the equipment, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If the equipment needs to transmit jumbo
frames with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length of a jumbo frame.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only if the local NE or opposite equipment has insufficient
QoS capabilities. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the equipment at both ends.
l In this example, no loopback check, loopback port shutdown, or broadcast packet suppression function is
enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

876

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.12.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


This section provides the information about all the Ethernet protection parameters required for
GE ports of NE31 connected to the RNC.
To improve the reliability of service transmission, NE31 and the RNC are interconnected through
the LAG formed by two GE links.Table 11-107 provides the planning information.
Table 11-107 Information about LAGs
Parameter

NE31

LAG type

Static

Revertive mode

Non-Revertive

Load sharing

Non-Sharing

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EM6T-1

Slave port

4-EM6T-2

NOTE

In this example, the bandwidth of the Ethernet services is lower than the bandwidth of a GE port. Therefore,
you need not configure the LAG to the load-sharing mode for increase of the bandwidth utilization.

11.12.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for E-Line services
carried by PWs.
Table 11-108 provides the planning information about E-Line services carried by PWs.
Table 11-108 Planning information about E-Line services carried by PWs
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

E-Line Services Carried on PWs Connected to BTS33


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

Service ID

304

305

Service Name

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Source Port

7-EM6X-1

4-EM6T-1

Source VLANs

330

330

Bearer Type

PW

PW

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

877

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

E-Line Services Carried on PWs Connected to BTS33

Protection Type

Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

No Protection

No Protection

NOTE

For per-NE service configuration, the service name needs to be planned manually. For end-to-end service
configuration, the U2000 automatically generates the service name based on naming rules.

Table 11-109 provides the planning information about PWs.


Table 11-109 Planning information about PWs
Parameter

E-Line Services Carried on PWs Connected to BTS33


Source NE (NE34)

Sink NE (NE31)

PW ID

304

305

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Ingress Labs/Source Port

20

30

PW Egress Labs/Sink Port

20

30

Tunnel selection mode

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1515

1501

Opposite LSR ID

130.0.0.2

130.0.0.2

Control Word

No Use

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Ping

NOTE

In this example, the service ID, PW ID, PW ingress label, and PW egress label are manually planned. For endto-end service configuration, the U2000 automatically sets these parameters.
In this example, the tunnel has already been planned when you plan MPLS tunnels. Therefore, you need to
select only the tunnel that carries the PWs.

Table 11-110 provides the planning information about MS-PWs connected to NE32.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

878

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-110 Planning information about MS-PWs


Parameter

NE32

ID

903

Name

bts33_e-line_service_mspw

MTU (byte)

9000

Service Type

Ethernet Service

PW ID

Forward PW: 305

Backward PW: 304

PW Signaling Type

Forward PW: Static

Backward PW: Static

PW Type

Forward PW: Ethernet

Backward PW: Ethernet

Direction

Forward PW: Bidirectional

Backward PW: Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

Forward PW: MPLS

Backward PW: MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

Forward PW: 30

Backward PW: 20

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

Forward PW: 30

Backward PW: 20

Tunnel Type

Forward PW: MPLS

Backward PW: MPLS

Tunnel

Forward PW: 1501

Backward PW: 1515

Opposite LSR ID

Forward PW: 130.0.0.1

Backward PW: 130.0.0.6

NOTE

l When MS-PWs are used, the label values of Forward PW and Backward PW cannot be the same.
l In end-to-end configuration mode, PW ID, PW Ingress Label, and PW Egress Label can be automatically
allocated and therefore they do not need to be planned.
l In end-to-end configuration mode, MS-PW service ID and PW switching service ID are automatically
allocated and invisible.

11.12.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS.

QoS (DiffServ)
Diffserv is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the
BTS services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding Diffserv domain according to the allocated VLAN priority, DSCP value, or MPLS
EXP value. Each Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same Diffserv configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated corresponding C-VLAN priorities by service
type, and PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line services are configured on the transmission network.
DiffServ planning has been completed for the transmission network during MPLS tunnel
planning. In this example, you only need to set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI
ports to C-VLAN priority and MPLS EXP respectively. This setting results in the mapping from
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

879

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

the C-VLAN priority of the UNI-side BTS services to the MPLS EXP value on the NNI side of
the transmission network, therefore achieving end-to-end QoS control on the transmission
network.

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 11-111 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 11-111 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

QoS (PW Bandwidth Control)


In this example, PW bandwidth does not need to be controlled.

11.12.3 End-to-End Configuration Process


This section describes how to configure E-Line services carried by PWs in an end-to-end mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

880

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.12.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port attributes.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE34 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE34
7-EM6X-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE34 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE34
7-EM6X-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

881

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

TAG

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

----End

11.12.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

----End

11.12.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes how to configure information about E-Line services carried by PWs.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

882

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 See A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based E-Line Services (in an End-to-End Mode) and
configure the E-Line service carried by PWs in an end-to-end mode.
1.

Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.

2.

Set the basic attributes of a PW-based E-Line service.

3.

Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PW-carried E-Line
service.

4.

a.

Double-click the source NE (NE34) in the Physical Topology tab page.

b.

Select 7-EM6X-1 and set VLAN ID to 330.

c.

Click OK.

d.

Double-click the sink NE (NE31) in the Physical Topology tab page.

e.

Select 4-EM6T-1 and set VLAN ID to 330.

f.

Click OK.

g.

In the Physical Topology tab page, right-click NE32 and choose Set As Switching
Node > Working from the shortcut menu.

Set the basic attributes of PWs.


Based on 11.12.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information), set Forward Tunnel,
Reverse Tunnel, PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

883

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

5.

At the lower left corner, select Deploy and Enable.

6.

Click OK.

7.

In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new Ethernet PWE3 service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End

11.12.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS of E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI ports on NE34 and NE31 that transmit the UNINNI ETH PWE3 services to C-VLAN and MPLS EXP respectively.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

2.

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE34 and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Parameter

Value
NE34

NE31

Port

7-EM6X-1

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

NOTE

For an NNI port that transmits a PW-carried E-Line service, set Packet Type trusted by the NNI port to
MPLS EXP.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

884

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE34 are
provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE34 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the relevant parameters of UNI ports of NE34 and NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE34

NE31

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

7-EM6X-1

4-EM6T-1

----End

11.12.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes how to use Ethernet OAM to verify connectivity of an Ethernet service.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

885

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria window, select Source NE and Sink Node. Click Filter.

Step 3 Right-click the PWE3 service to verify, and choose Ethernet OAM > LB Test... from the
shortcut menu.

Step 4 In the Eth Oam LB Test dialog box that is displayed, select the source NE for initiating an LB
test.
NOTE

l An LB test detects whether a service is bidirectionally available. For a bidirectional service, it is


recommended that you select either end of a PW as the source NE for initiating the LB test.
l If a PW carries Ethernet services from different VLANs, the U2000 automatically select the service
of a VLAN for the LB test.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

886

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Step 5 Optional: Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Configure... from
the shortcut menu. In the Config Eth Oam LB Test Parameter dialog box that is displayed,
set Sent Packets, Sent Packets Length, and Sent Packets Priority. Then, click OK.

Step 6 Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Run from the shortcut menu.
Step 7 Click the LB Statistic Information tab and determines whether the service is available based
on the displayed information.
If Test Result displays Test Succeeded, the service is available.

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

887

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.12.4 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring E-Line services carried on PWs in Per-NE
configuration mode.

11.12.4.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI port attributes.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the general attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE34 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE34
7-EM6X-1

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 See A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the Layer 2 attributes of
the UNI ports.
l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE34 are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

888

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE34
7-EM6X-1

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

TAG

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

----End

11.12.4.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

889

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

----End

11.12.4.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs) and configure the ELine services.
l Parameters of NE34
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

NE34

Service ID

304

Service Name

BTS34-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

7-EM6X-1

Source VLANs

330

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE34

PW ID

304

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

20

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

20

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1515
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

890

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE34

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.2

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE34

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

l Parameters of NE31
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided
as follows.
Parameter

NE31

Service ID

305

Service Name

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

4-EM6T-1

Source VLANs

330

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE31

PW ID

305

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

30

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

891

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE31

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

30

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1501

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.2

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE31

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Step 2 See A.9.4.2 Creating an MS-PW and configure the E-Line services.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set for creating an MS-PW on NE32 are
provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE32

ID

903

Name

bts33_e-line_service_mspw

MTU(bytes)

9000

Service Type

Ethernet Service

PW ID

Forward PW: 305

Backward PW: 304

PW Signaling Type

Forward PW: Static

Backward PW: Static

PW Type

Forward PW: Ethernet

Backward PW: Ethernet

PW Direction

Forward PW: Bidirectional

Backward PW: Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

Forward PW: MPLS

Backward PW: MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source
Port

Forward PW: 30

Backward PW: 20

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

Forward PW: 30

Backward PW: 20

Tunnel Type

Forward PW: MPLS

Backward PW: MPLS

Tunnel

Forward PW: 1501

Backward PW: 1515

Peer LSR ID

Forward PW: 130.0.0.1

Backward PW: 130.0.0.6

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

892

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

----End

11.12.4.4 Configuration Process (QoS)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS of E-Line services carried on PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI ports on NE34 and NE31 that transmit the UNINNI ETH PWE3 services to C-VLAN and MPLS EXP respectively.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

2.

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE34 and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Parameter

Value
NE34

NE31

Port

7-EM6X-1

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

NOTE

For an NNI port that transmits a PW-carried E-Line service, set Packet Type trusted by the NNI port to
MPLS EXP.

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE34 are
provided as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

893

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE31 and NE34 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the relevant parameters of UNI ports of NE34 and NE31 are provided as follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE34

NE31

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm (Policy ID=1)

7-EM6X-1

4-EM6T-1

----End

11.12.4.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs For NE31 and NE34.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

894

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Value
NE31

NE34

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Domain
Level

Step 2 See A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create an MA for NE31 and NE34.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE34

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

Relevant Service

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

CC Test Transmit Period

1s

1s

Step 3 See A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create MEPs for NE31 and NE34.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE31

NE34

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

Board

4-EM6T

7-EM6X

Port

4-EM6T-1

7-EM6X-1

VLAN

330

330

MP ID

313

340

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Step 4 See A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs for NE31 and
NE34.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

895

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.


Parameter

Value
NE31

NE34

Maintenance Domain
Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance Association
Name

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

BTS33-RNC_E-Line

Remote Maintenance Point


ID(e.g:1,3-6)

340

313

Step 5 On NE31, perform LB tests to verify the Ethernet service configurations.


Perform the LB test by considering the MEP whose MP ID is 313 as the source MEP and the
MEP whose MP ID is 340 as the sink MEP to check the connectivity of the E-Line services
carried on the PWs between NE31 and NE34.
The LB test result shows that no packet loss occurs.
----End

11.13 Configuration Example (PW-Carried E-AGGR


Services)
This section uses a PW-carried E-AGGR service as an example to describe how to configure EAGGR services according to service planning information.

11.13.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about each NE.
After planning and configuring MPLS tunnels, aggregate Ethernet services from BTSs (with
conflicting VLAN IDs) to the RNC by means of PWs. The service requirements are as follows:
l

Ethernet services from BTS11, BTS12, and BTS13, which respectively carry VLAN ID
100, VLAN ID 110, and VLAN ID 120, need to be transmitted to NE11 through a Hybrid
radio chain network and then to the RNC. The PW-carried BTS Ethernet services are
transparently transmitted over the working tunnel between NE11 and NE31 whose tunnel
ID is 1503.

Ethernet services from BTS21, BTS22, and BTS23, which respectively carry VLAN ID
100, VLAN ID 110, and VLAN ID 120, need to be transmitted to NE21 through a Hybrid
radio ring network and then to the RNC by means of VLAN forwarding. The PW-carried
BTS Ethernet services are transparently transmitted over the working tunnel between NE21
and NE31 whose tunnel ID is 1505.

At the BTSs, Ethernet services have been configured with specific VLAN priorities based
on service types (real-time voice services, HSDPA real-time services, R99 non-real-time
services, or HSDPA data services). The transmission network provides end-to-end QoS
control based on the VLAN priorities specified at the BTSs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

896

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

The GE ports on NE31, which are connected to the RNC, need to be configured in a link
aggregation group (LAG).

Figure 11-31 Configuration flowchart (PW-carried E-AGGR services)


VLAN forwarding
Service

NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4

1 BTS21
2 BTS22
3 BTS23

Source
VLAN ID
(NNI)

Sink
VLAN ID
(UNI)

100

200

110

210

120

220
E-Aggr

BTS11
VLAN 100

FE

Working tunnel
(ID=1503)

R4
NNI UNI

GE
GE

R4
Hybrid radio chain network

NE32

NE31

GE

NE11
E-Line

E-Line

GE

GE

E-Aggr

R4
BTS12
VLAN 110

NE21

RNC

Working tunnel
(ID=1505)

Hybrid radio ring network

R4
BTS13
VLAN 120

R4

BTS21
VLAN 100
R4

2 BTS22

VLAN 110

1 2 3 VLAN IDs conflict.

R4

3 BTS23
VLAN 120

NOTE

Table 11-112 provides the port information about the PW-carried E-Line and E-AGGR services.
Table 11-112 Information about service ports

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE

Service Port

Description

NE11

3-ISU2-1

This port receives Ethernet


services from BTS11,
BTS12, and BTS13 through
the Hybrid radio chain
network.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

897

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE

Service Port

Description

NE21

1-EM6F-4

On NE21, the 1-EM6F-3 port


is connected to the 1-EM6F-4
port with a network cable.
After being transmitted to the
1-EM6F-4 port, Native ELAN services that are
received by the 1-EM6F-3
port from BTS21, BTS22,
and BTS23 through the
Hybrid radio ring network
are converted to PW-carried
E-Line services.

NE31

4-EM6T-1

Ports 4-EM6T-1 and 4EM6T-2 form a LAG.

4-EM6T-2

11.13.2 Service Planning


You need to plan related parameter information before service configuration.

11.13.2.1 Service Planning (UNI Ports)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring UNI
ports.

Information About Ethernet Ports


Table 11-113 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE21.
Table 11-113 Information about Ethernet ports (NE21)
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

Port enabling

Enabled

Port mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length (byte)

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Table 11-114 provides the information about the Ethernet ports on NE31.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

898

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-114 Information about Ethernet ports (NE31)


Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Port enabling

Enabled

Enabled

Port mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Port working mode

Auto-negotiation

Auto-negotiation

Maximum frame length


(byte)

1536

1536

Flow control

Disabled

Disabled

NOTE

l NE21 cross-connects and loops back the 1-EM6F-3 port to the 1-EM6F-4 port by means of a network cable
to convert Native E-LAN services received by the 1-EM6F-3 port on the Hybrid microwave ring network
to E-Line services carried on PWs.
l In this example, all GE ports on the packet network work in auto-negotiation mode. Therefore, FE ports on
all NEs, which receive Ethernet services from BTSs, need to work in auto-negotiation mode. If Ethernet
ports at BTSs, which are connected to FE ports, work in other modes, FE ports at the local end need to work
in the corresponding modes.
l In this example, to ensure that the Ethernet packets that carry more than one tag, such as QinQ packets,
traverse OptiX RTN NEs, the maximum frame length is set to 1536 (bytes). If OptiX RTN NEs need to
transmit jumbo packets with a greater length, set the maximum frame length according to the actual length
of a jumbo frame.
l Generally, the flow control function is enabled only if the local NE or opposite NE has insufficient QoS
capabilities. The planning information of flow control must be the same for the NEs at both ends.
l In this example, the loopback check, loopback port shutdown, or broadcast packet suppression function is
not enabled.

Information About IF_ETH Ports


Table 11-115 provides the information about IF_ETH ports on NE11, which receive Ethernet
services from BTSs on the Hybrid microwave chain network.
Table 11-115 Information about IF_ETH ports
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Port mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation type

802.1Q

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

899

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

11.13.2.2 Service Planning (Ethernet Protection)


This section provides the information about all the Ethernet protection parameters required for
GE ports of NE31 connected to the RNC.
To improve the reliability of service transmission, NE31 and the RNC are interconnected through
the LAG formed by two GE links.Table 11-116 provides the planning information.
Table 11-116 Information about LAGs
Parameter

NE31

LAG type

Static

Revertive mode

Non-Revertive

Load sharing

Non-Sharing

System priority

32768

Main port

4-EM6T-1

Slave port

4-EM6T-2

NOTE

In this example, the bandwidth of the Ethernet services is lower than the bandwidth of a GE port. Therefore,
you need not configure the LAG to the load-sharing mode for increase of the bandwidth utilization.

11.13.2.3 Service Planning (Service Information)


This section provides the information about all the parameters required for E-Line services and
E-Aggr services carried on PWs.

E-Line Services Carried on PWs


Table 11-117 provides the planning information about E-Line services carried on PWs.
Table 11-117 Information about E-Line services carried on PWs

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs (NE11)

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs (NE21)

Service ID

Service name

BTS11/12/13-RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23-RNC_E-Line

Service direction

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not transparently transmitted

Not transparently transmitted

Source port

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

Source VLANs

100, 110, 120

100, 110, 120

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

900

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs (NE11)

E-Line Services Carried


on PWs (NE21)

Carrier

PW

PW

Protection mode

No protection

No protection

Table 11-118 provides the planning information about PWs.


Table 11-118 Planning information about PWs
Parameter

PW (NE11)

PW (NE21)

PW ID

301

302

PW signaling type

Static

Static

PW type

Ethernet

Ethernet

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW encapsulation type

MPLS

MPLS

PW ingress label/Source port

60

50

PW egress label/Sink port

60

50

Tunnel type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

1505

Opposite LSR ID

130.0.0.1

130.0.0.1

Control word

No use

No use

Control channel type

Alert Label

Alert Label

VCCV verification mode

Ping

Ping

NOTE

In this example, the tunnel has already been planned when you plan MPLS tunnels. You need to select only
the tunnel that carries the PWs.

E-Aggr Services Carried on PWs


Table 11-119 to Table 11-123 provide the planning information about E-Aggr services carried
on PWs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

901

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-119 Basic Planning Information (NE31)


Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service name

RNC_E-Aggr

Table 11-120 Planning information about UNI ports (NE31)


Parameter

Value

Location

Sink

Port

4-EM6T-1

VLANs

100, 110, 120, 200, 210, 220

Table 11-121 Planning information about NNI ports


Parameter

Value
Receives services from
BTS11/12/13

Receives services from


BTS21/22/23

Location

Source

Source

PW ID

301

302

PW signaling type

Static

Static

PW type

Ethernet

Ethernet

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW encapsulation type

MPLS

MPLS

PW ingress label/Source port

60

50

PW egress label/Sink port

60

50

Tunnel type

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

1505

Opposite LSR ID

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.1

NOTE

In this example, the tunnel has already been planned when you plan MPLS tunnels. You need to select only
the tunnel that carries the PWs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

902

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Table 11-122 Planning information about the VLAN forwarding table (NE31)
Parameter

Value
From BTS11/12/13 to the RNC

Source port type

V-NNI

Source port

PW(Ethernet,301)

VLANs

100, 110, 120

Port type

V-UNI

Sink Port

4-EM6T-1

VLANs

100, 110, 120

Table 11-123 Planning information about the VLAN forwarding table (NE31)
Parameter

Value
From BTS21/22/23 to the RNC

Source port type

V-NNI

Source port

PW(Ethernet,302)

VLANs

100, 110, 120

Sink port type

V-UNI

Sink port

4-EM6T-1

VLANs

200, 210, 220

11.13.2.4 Service Planning (QoS)


The section provides the information about all the parameters required for configuring QoS.

QoS (DiffServ)
Diffserv is the basis for QoS. It is recommended that the VLAN priority or DSCP value of the
BTS services be allocated by the service type. Then, the transmission network creates the
corresponding Diffserv domain according to the allocated VLAN priority, DSCP value, or MPLS
EXP value. Each Ethernet port involved in the service must use the same Diffserv configuration.
In this example, the BTS services are allocated corresponding C-VLAN priorities by service
type, and PW-carried UNI-NNI E-Line services are configured on the transmission network.
DiffServ planning has been completed for the transmission network during MPLS tunnel
planning. In this example, you only need to set the trusted packet types of the UNI and NNI
ports to C-VLAN priority and MPLS EXP respectively. This setting results in the mapping from
the C-VLAN priority of the UNI-side BTS services to the MPLS EXP value on the NNI side of
the transmission network, therefore achieving end-to-end QoS control on the transmission
network.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

903

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

QoS (Queue Scheduling Mode)


Generally, each Ethernet port involved in the service uses the same queue scheduling mode.
Table 11-124 lists the queue scheduling mode used by each Ethernet port involved in the service
in this example.
Table 11-124 Queue scheduling mode
PHB Service Class

Queue Scheduling Mode

CS7

SP

CS6

SP

EF

SP

AF4

WRR (weight = 5)

AF3

WRR (weight = 60)

AF2

WRR (weight = 30)

AF1

WRR (weight = 5)

BE

SP

QoS (CAR or Shaping for a Specified Service Flow)


Normally, flow control is already performed on 2G/3G base stations and BSCs/RNCs and
therefore CAR or shaping processing does not need to be performed again on the microwave
backhaul network.

QoS (Port Shaping)


If the Ethernet bandwidth planned for the aggregation link is lower than the total bandwidth of
the aggregation services, you can perform port shaping at the edge node to limit the Ethernet
service traffic that travels to the aggregation node, thus preventing congestion at the aggregation
node.
In this example, you do not need to perform port shaping.

QoS (PW Bandwidth Control)


In this example, PW bandwidth does not need to be controlled.

11.13.3 Per-NE Configuration Process


This section describes the process for configuring PW-carried E-Line services and E-AGGR
services on a per-NE basis.

11.13.3.1 Configuration Process (UNI Ports)


This section describes the process for configuring UNI ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

904

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the
general attributes of the UNI ports.
l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE21 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

Enable Port

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

l The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

802.1Q

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Max Frame Length(byte)

1536

1536

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports and set the
Layer 2 attributes of the UNI ports.
l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE21 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

NE21
1-EM6F-4

TAG

Tag Aware

l The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE31 are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

905

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

TAG

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

NE31
4-EM6T-1

4-EM6T-2

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the
general attributes of the UNI ports.
The values for the general attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Port Mode

Layer 2

Encapsulation Type

802.1Q

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports and set the
Layer 2 attributes of the UNI ports.
The values for the Layer 2 attribute parameters of the UNI port of NE11 are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11
3-ISU2-1

Tag

Tag Aware

----End

11.13.3.2 Configuration Process (Ethernet Protection)


This section describes how to create a LAG of the GE port of NE31 connected to the RNC.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG and create a LAG.
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

LAG No.

Select Automatically Assign.

LAG Name

ToRNC

LAG Type

Static

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

906

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Load Sharing

Non-Sharing

System Priority

32768

The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the Port Setting tab page are as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Main Board

4-EM6T

Main Port

Selected Standby Ports

----End

11.13.3.3 Configuration Process (Service Information)


This section describes the process for configuring PW-carried E-Line services and E-AGGR
services.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs) and
configure the E-Line services.
l Parameters of NE11
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.
Parameter

NE11

Service ID

Service Name

BTS11/12/13-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

3-ISU2-1

Source VLANs

100,110,120

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the related parameters that need to be set in
the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

907

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

NE11

PW ID

301

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

60

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

60

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.1

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE11

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

l Parameters of NE21
The values for the relevant parameters that need to be set in the main interface are as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

NE21

Service ID

302

Service Name

BTS21/22/23-RNC_E-Line

Direction

UNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently Transmitted

Source Port

1-EM6F-4

Source VLANs

200,210,220

Bearer Type

PW

Protection Type

No Protection

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

908

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the General Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21

PW ID

302

PW Signaling Type

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

PW Ingress Label/Source Port

50

PW Egress Label/Sink Port

50

Tunnel Type

MPLS

Tunnel

1505

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.1

In the Configure PW dialog box, the values for the relevant parameters that need to be set
in the Advanced Attributes tab page are provided as follows.
Parameter

NE21

Control Word

No Use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.3.6 Creating E-AGGR Services and configure E-AGGR services.
Parameters of NE31:
The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the main interface are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Value

Service ID

Service Name

RNC_E-Aggr

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in the UNI tab page are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

909

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Location

Sink

Port

4-EM6T-1(ORT-1)

VLANs

100, 110, 120, 200, 210, 220

The values for the Basic Attributes that need to be set in the NNI tab are as follows.
Parameter

Value

Location

Source

Source

PW ID

301

302

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

PW Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

PW Incoming Label

60

50

PW Outgoing Label

60

50

Tunnel Selection Mode

MPLS

MPLS

Tunnel

1503

1505

Peer LSR ID

130.0.0.3

130.0.0.1

The values for the Advanced Attributes that need to be set in the NNI tab are as follows.
Parameter

Value

Control Word

Not in use

Control Channel Type

Alert Label

VCCV Verification Mode

Ping

The values for the related parameters that need to be set in VLAN Forwarding Table item are
as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Source Interface Type

V-NNI

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

V-NNI

910

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Source Interface

PW(Ethernet,301)

PW(Ethernet,302)

Source VLAN ID

100,110,120

100,110,120

Sink Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

Sink Interface

[Port]4-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

[Port]4-EM6T-1(PORT-1)

Sink VLAN ID

100,110,120

200,210,220

----End

11.13.3.4 Configuration Process (QoS Information)


This section describes the process for configuring QoS information for PW-carried E-Line
services and E-AGGR services.

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain and
set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 that carry UNI-NNI ETH
PWE3 services and E-AGGR services to C-VLAN.
1.

Select the default DS domain for the OptiX RTN equipment.


NOTE

In this example, the planned mapping between the trusted packet type (C-VLAN priority) and the PHB
service class queues for BTSs is the same as the mapping in the default DS domain of the OptiX RTN
equipment. Therefore, the default DS domain settings are used.

2.

Parameter

Value

Mapping Relation ID

Mapping Relation Name

DefaultMap

Set the trusted packet type of the UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 to C-VLAN.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Port

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

CVLAN

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy and create the port policy.
The values for the WRR scheduling policy parameters of UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31
are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

911

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_WRR

Scheduling Weight

5 (AF4)
60 (AF3)
30 (AF2)
5 (AF1)

The values for the port policy parameters of UNI ports on NE11, NE21, and NE31 are provided
as follows.
Parameter

Value

Policy ID

Policy Name

Port_Comm

WRR Scheduling Policy

2-Port_WRR

Grooming Police After Reloading

SP (CS7, CS6, EF)


WRR (AF4 to AF1)
SP (BE)

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled (for all PHBs)

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy and set the ports that
use the port policy.
The values for the related parameters of UNI ports of NE11, NE21, and NE31 are provided as
follows.
Parameter

Port

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

Port_Comm
(Policy ID=1)

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

----End

11.13.3.5 Configuration Process (Verifying Ethernet Service Configurations)


This section describes the process for verifying Ethernet service configurations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

912

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Procedure
Step 1 Follow instructions in A.7.8.1 Creating an MD and create the MDs for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Domain Level

Step 2 Follow instructions in A.7.8.2 Creating an MA and create an MA for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

RNC_E-Aggr

Relevant Service

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

RNC_E-Aggr

CC Test Transmit
Period

1s

1s

1s

Step 3 Follow instructions in A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs and create MEPs for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
NE11

NE21

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

RNC_E-Aggr

Board

3-ISU2

1-EM6F

4-EM6T

Port

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-4

4-EM6T-1

VLAN

100

100

100,200

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

NE31

913

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

11 Configuring PWE3 Services

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

MP ID

110

210

311

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Ingress

CC Status

Active

Active

Active

NOTE

l On NE11, when performing the continuity check on the E-Line services carried on PWs, use the BTS service
(VLAN ID: 100) received by NE11 as an example.
l On NE21, when performing the continuity check on the E-Line services carried on PWs, use the BTS service
(VLAN ID: 100) received by NE21 as an example.

Step 4 Follow instructions in A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA and create the remote MEPs
for NE11, NE21, and NE31.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

Maintenance
Domain Name

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

EdgeNE

Maintenance
Association Name

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

BTS21/22/23RNC_E-Line

BTS11/12/13RNC_E-Line

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

311

311

110,210

Step 5 On NE31, perform LB tests to verify the Ethernet service configurations.


Perform an LB test by considering the MEP whose MP ID is 311 as the source MEP and the
MEP whose MP ID is 110 as the sink MEP to check whether the Ethernet service between NE31
and NE11 is available.
Perform an LB test by considering the MEP whose MP ID is 311 as the source MEP and the
MEP whose MP ID is 210 as the sink MEP to check whether the Ethernet service between NE31
and NE21 is available.
The LB test results show that no packet loss occurs.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

914

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12

12 Configuring the Clock

Configuring the Clock

About This Chapter


To ensure that clocks of all the nodes on the transmission network are synchronized, configure
the clocks for these nodes according to a unified clock synchronization policy.
12.1 Basic Concepts
Before configuring the clock, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.
12.2 Configuration Procedure
This section describes the procedures for configuring the clock source, clock protection, and
output clock.
12.3 Configuration Example (Clock for a TDM Radio Chain Network)
This section considers a TDM radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
the clock according to the network planning information.
12.4 Configuration Example (Clock for a TDM Radio Ring Network)
This section considers a TDM radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
the clock according to the network planning information.
12.5 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Chain Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
clocks according to the network planning information.
12.6 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Ring Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
the clock according to the network planning information.
12.7 Configuration Example (Clocks for a PSN)
This section uses clocks for a packet convergence ring and a Packet radio chain as examples to
describe how to configure clocks according to the network planning information.
12.8 Configuration Example (Clocks Across a Third-party TDM Network)
This section considers Ethernet services transmitted across a third-party TDM network as an
example and describes how to configure clocks according to the planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

915

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

12.1 Basic Concepts


Before configuring the clock, you need to be familiar with the basic concepts.

12.1.1 Clock Source


A clock source is a signal source that carries timing reference information. An NE implements
clock synchronization, by using its phase locked loop (PLL) to lock the timing information of
the clock source.
The OptiX RTN 980 supports the following clock sources:
l

Line clock source: refers to a clock source that is extracted from the received SDH signal.

Radio clock source: refers to a clock source that is extracted from the received radio signal.

Tributary clock source: refers to a clock source that is extracted from the received E1 signal.

Ethernet clock source: refers to a clock source that is extracted from the Ethernet stream.

External clock source: refers to a clock source that is synchronized with the 2 Mbit/s or 2
MHz signal received at the external clock port.

Internal clock source: refers to a clock source that is generated through the free-run
oscillation of an NE built-in clock. The internal clock source has the lowest priority.

12.1.2 Clock Protection Modes


The OptiX RTN 980 supports clock source protection based on priorities, synchronization status
message (SSM) protection, and extended SSM protection.

Clock Source Protection Based on Priorities


Clock source protection is provided based on the priorities specified in the clock source priority
list. When a clock source with a higher priority fails, a clock source with a lower priority is used.
As shown in Figure 12-1, the radio links between NE1 and NE2 adopt 1+1 HSB protection.
NE2 needs to trace the clock on the radio links to keep synchronized with NE1. In this case, the
clock sources extracted by the main and standby IF boards can be configured in the clock source
priority list. The clock source extracted by the main IF board, however, has a higher priority.
Therefore, if the 1+1 HSB protection switching occurs on the radio links, the clock can be
switched at the same time.
Figure 12-1 Clock source protection based on priorities
1+1 HSB
configuration

BITS

NE1

NE2

Clock

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

916

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

SSM Protection
SSM protection uses the SSM protocol specified in ITU-T G.781 to provide clock protection.
According to the SSM protocol, SDH NEs transmit the SSM by using bits 5-8 of the S1 byte,
to implement automatic protection switching of clock sources and prevent timing loops. The
OptiX RTN 980 supports SSM protection on SDH optical transmission lines, FE/GE links, and
radio links. After SSM protection is enabled on an NE, automatic protection switching of clock
sources follows these rules:
l

According to the clock source priority list, the NE selects the clock source of the highest
quality as the synchronization source.

If multiple clock sources have the same highest quality, the NE selects the source with the
highest priority as the synchronization source.

The NE broadcasts quality information about the synchronization clock source to its
downstream NEs and also notifies its upstream NE that its own clock source cannot be used
for synchronization.

Figure 12-2 is a radio ring where SSM protection is enabled.


When the network operates normally, the NEs on the ring select the clock source as follows:
1.

NE1 selects the external clock source as the synchronization source and notifies NE2 and
NE4 of the external clock quality.

2.

NE2 and NE4 select the clock source from NE1 as the synchronization source and notify
NE1 that the clock sources from NE2 and NE4 are unavailable.

3.

After determining that the clock sources from NE2 and NE4 have the same quality, NE3
selects the clock source with a higher priority (the clock source from NE2) as the
synchronization source. In addition, NE3 transmits quality information about the
synchronization source to NE4 and notifies NE2 that the clock source from NE3 is
unavailable.

4.

After determining that the clock sources from NE1 and NE3 have the same quality, NE4
selects the clock source with a higher priority (the clock source from NE3) as the
synchronization source. In addition, NE4 transmits quality information about the
synchronization source to NE1 and notifies NE3 that the clock source from NE4 is
unavailable.

5.

According to the clock quality in the west and east directions and configured clock source
priorities, NE2, NE3, and NE4 determine that the synchronization source does not need to
be modified. The clock source selection is completed.

When the radio links between NE1 and NE2 become faulty, the NEs on the ring select the clock
source as follows:
1.

NE2 selects the internal source as the synchronization source and transmits quality
information about the synchronization source to NE1 and NE3.

2.

NE3 selects NE2 as the clock source and notifies NE4 of the clock quality.

3.

After determining that the quality of the clock from NE1 is higher than the quality of the
clock from NE3, NE4 selects the clock source from NE1 as the synchronization source. In
addition, NE4 transmits quality information about the synchronization source to NE3 and
notifies NE1 that the clock from NE4 is unavailable.

4.

After determining that the quality of the clock from NE4 is higher than the quality of the
clock from NE2, NE3 selects the clock source from NE4 as the synchronization source. In

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

917

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

addition, NE3 transmits quality information about the synchronization source to NE2 and
notifies NE4 that the clock source from NE3 is unavailable.
5.

After determining that the quality of the clock from NE3 is higher than the quality of the
internal clock source, NE2 selects the clock source from NE3 as the synchronization source.
In addition, NE2 transmits quality information about the synchronization source to NE1
and notifies NE3 that the clock source from NE2 is unavailable.

6.

According to the clock quality in the west and east directions and the configured clock
source priorities, NE2, NE3, and NE4 determine that the synchronization source does not
need to be modified. The clock source selection is completed.
NOTE

SSM protection cannot prevent timing loops. Therefore, when configuring clock sources, ensure that clock
sources do not form a timing loop. For example, configuration of clock sources on NE1 prevents a timing loop,
as shown in Figure 12-2.

Figure 12-2 SSM protection


BITS

West/East/
Internal
NE2

NE1

Extenal/
Internal

W
W

West/East/
Internal
NE4

Master clock
NE3

West/East/
Internal

Extended SSM Protection


Extended SSM protection uses the extended SSM protocol to provide clock protection. The
extended SSM protocol, developed by Huawei on the basis of the SSM protocol, introduces the
concept of clock ID, which indicates that a clock ID can be defined for any clock source. The
clock ID of the synchronization source can be transmitted together with the SSM and be used
for automatic clock switching. The OptiX RTN 980 supports extended SSM protection on SDH
optical transmission lines, FE/GE links and radio links.
After extended SSM protection is enabled on an NE, automatic clock switching follows these
rules:
l

According to the clock source priority list, the NE selects the clock source of the highest
quality as the synchronization source.

If the clock ID of a clock source indicates that the clock source is from the local NE, the
clock source is not processed.

If multiple clock sources have the same highest quality, the NE selects the source with the
highest priority as the synchronization source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

918

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

The NE broadcasts quality information and the clock ID of the synchronization clock source
to its downstream NEs, and also notifies its upstream NE that its own clock source cannot
be used for synchronization.

The clock ID takes a value in the range of 0 to 15. 0 is the default value, indicating that the clock
ID is invalid. After the extended SSM protocol is enabled on the NE, the NE does not select any
clock source with an ID of 0 as its current clock source.
Follow these guidelines when you allocate clock IDs:
l

When the extended SSM is used, the clock ID of an external clock source cannot be
automatically extracted. Therefore, allocate clock IDs to all external clock sources.

At all the NEs that are connected to external clock sources, allocate clock IDs to the internal
clock sources.

At all the intersecting nodes of a ring/chain and a ring, allocate clock IDs to the internal
clock sources.

At all the intersecting nodes of a ring/chain and a ring, allocate clock IDs to the clock
sources that are transmitted to the ring.

Do not allocate clock IDs to clock sources different from the preceding four types. Their
clock IDs are 0 by default.

Clock IDs do not determine clock source priorities.

Figure 12-3 is a radio ring where the extended SSM protection is enabled.
On the ring, the following clock sources require clock IDs:
l

External clock source 1 on NE1

External clock source 2 on NE3

Internal clock source on NE1

Internal clock source on NE3

Figure 12-3 Extended SSM protection


Master BITS

West / East /
Internal

NE1

Extenal 1 /
West /
East / Internal

E
West / East /
Internal

NE2

NE3

Master clock

NE4

West /
East /
Extenal 2 /
Internal

Slave BITS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

919

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

NOTE

l When extended SSM protection is enabled, clocks can constitute a ring during clock source configuration.
l Extended SSM protection is advantageous in complex clock protection network topologies, for example, in
a network with dual external clocks. Therefore, extended SSM protection is used in only a few scenarios.

12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy


Users plan an appropriate clock synchronization policy based on the network topology.

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Chain Network


For a chain network consisting of radio links, follow these guidelines to plan the clock
synchronization policy:
l

If one clock source is input into the master (source) node (the clock source can be an external
clock, a line clock, or an Ethernet clock), configure this clock source for this node.

For the other nodes, configure the clock sources from their upper level radio links.

If 1+1 protection is configured for the upper level radio links of a node, configure two radio
clock sources for this node. The clock source on the active radio link has a higher priority
than the clock source on the standby radio link.

If a node has multiple upper level radio links (for example, the upper level radio links use
the XPIC or N+1 protection configuration), configure one radio clock source for each radio
link. Allocate priorities to these radio clock sources depending on the radio link status.

Do not configure synchronization status message (SSM) or extended SSM protection.

Figure 12-4 shows the clock synchronization policy for a chain network.
l

On the master node (NE1), one external clock source is input. For NE1, clock source
priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: external clock source > internal clock
source.

The ISU2 boards in slots 3 and 5 on NE2 form a 1+1 IF protection group, where the ISU2
board in slot 3 functions as the main board; in addition, the radio links between NE1 and
NE2 comprise the two ISU2 boards. For NE2, clock source priorities are allocated in
descending order as follows: 3-ISU2-1 > 5-ISU2-1 > internal clock source.

The radio link between NE3 and NE2 comprises the ISU2 board in slot 3 on NE3. For NE3,
clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: 3-ISU2-1 > internal
clock source.

Do not configure SSM or extended SSM protection.

Figure 12-4 Clock synchronization policy for a chain network


NE1

BITS

NE2

Extenal/
Internal

3-IF1-1/
5-IF1-1/
Internal

NE3

3-IF1-1/
Internal

Clock

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

920

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Tree Network


A tree network derives from a chain network; therefore, a tree network can adopt the same clock
synchronization policy as a chain network.
Figure 12-5 shows the clock synchronization policy for a tree network.
l

On the master node (NE1), the Ethernet link connected to port 1 on the EM6T board in slot
2 provides a clock source. For NE1, clock source priorities are allocated in descending
order as follows: 2-EM6T-1 > internal clock source.

The ISX2 boards in slots 3 and 5 on NE2 form an XPIC workgroup, where the ISX2 board
in slot 3 uses the vertical polarization mode and the ISX2 board in slot 5 uses the horizontal
polarization mode; in addition, the radio links between NE1 and NE2 comprise the two
ISX2 boards. For NE2, clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows:
3-ISX2-1 > 5-ISX2-1 > internal clock source.

The radio link between NE3 and NE2 comprises the ISU2 board in slot 3 on NE3. For NE3,
clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: 3-ISU2-1 > internal
clock source.

The radio link between NE4 and NE2 comprises the ISU2 board in slot 3 on NE4. For NE4,
clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: 3-ISU2-1 > internal
clock source.

The radio link between NE5 and NE4 comprises the ISU2 board in slot 3 on NE5. For NE5,
clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: 3-ISU2-1 > internal
clock source.

Do not configure SSM or extended SSM protection.

Figure 12-5 Clock synchronization policy for a tree network


NE3

NE1

3-ISU2-1/
Internal

NE2

NE4
BSC

2-EM6T-1/
Internal

3-ISX2-1/
5-ISX2-1/
Internal

Clock

3-ISU2-1/
Internal

NE5

3-ISU2-1/
Internal

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Ring Network


If a ring network comprises only radio links or comprises radio links and optical transmission
lines, follow these guidelines to plan the clock synchronization policy:
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

921

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

If only SDH signals are transmitted on the ring network, configure SSM or extended SSM
protection according to the clock synchronization policy for an optical transmission
network.

If PDH radio or Integrated IP radio is used on some segments of the ring network, equally
divide the ring into two chains and then plan the clock synchronization policy according
to the policy for a chain network.

Figure 12-6 shows the clock synchronization policy for a ring network on which only SDH
signals are transmitted.
l

Configure SSM or extended SSM protection for all the nodes on the ring network.

On the master node (NE1), one external clock source is input. For NE1, clock source
priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: external clock source > internal clock
source.

For the other nodes, clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows:
west clock source > east clock source > internal clock source.

Figure 12-6 Clock synchronization policy for a ring network (on which only SDH signals are
transmitted)
BITS
NE1

NE2
West/East/
Internal

Extenal/ W
Internal

W
West/East/
Internal

NE3
NE4
Master clock

NE6
West/East/
Internal

E
W

E
West/East/
Internal
NE5

West/East/
Internal

Figure 12-7 shows the clock synchronization policy for a ring network on which not only SDH
signals are transmitted.
l

The ring network uses Integrated IP radio for transmission. Therefore, divide the ring into
two chains at the master node (NE1): NE1-NE2-NE3 and NE1-NE4.

On the master node (NE1), the Ethernet link connected to port 1 on the EM6T board in slot
3 provides a clock source. For NE1, clock source priorities are allocated in descending
order as follows: 3-EM6T-1 > internal clock source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

922

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

NE2 traces the clock of the master node. For NE2, clock source priorities are allocated in
descending order as follows: west clock source > internal clock source.

NE3 traces the clock of NE2. For NE3, clock source priorities are allocated in descending
order as follows: west clock source > internal clock source.

NE4 traces the clock of the master node (NE1). For NE4, clock source priorities are
allocated in descending order as follows: east clock source > internal clock source.

Do not configure SSM or extended SSM protection.

Figure 12-7 Clock synchronization policy for a ring network (on which not only SDH signals
are transmitted)
NE1

BSC

3-EM6T-1/
Internal

West/
Internal
NE2

Clock

W
W

East/
Internal
NE4

NE3

West/
Internal

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Port Aggregation Network


On a port aggregation network, services of several OptiX RTN NEs are aggregated to the upper
level RTN NE through the optical transmission line, tributary, or Ethernet. Follow these
guidelines to plan the clock synchronization policy for a port aggregation network:
l

On the upper level NE, a clock source (which can be an external clock source, a line clock
source, or an Ethernet clock source) is input.

A lower-level NE traces the line clock source or the Ethernet clock source of its upper-level
NE, if the service of the lower-level NE is aggregated to the upper-level NE through an
optical transmission line or Ethernet.

If the service of a lower-level NE is aggregated to the upper-level NE only through the E1


signal, the lower-level NE should trace the tributary clock source (E1 ports 1 and 5 on the
E1 tributary board support the tributary clock source).

If the service of a lower-level NE is aggregated to the upper-level NE only through the E1


signal and the lower-level NE is connected to many hops of downstream radio links, tracing
the tributary clock source causes pointer justifications or other exceptions. Therefore, the
lower-level NE should trace the external clock source output by its upper level NE.

Do not configure SSM or extended SSM protection.

Figure 12-8 shows the clock synchronization policy for a tributary port aggregation network.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

923

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

On the master node (NE1), one external clock source is input. For NE1, clock source
priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: external clock source > internal clock
source.

The IF1 boards in slots 3 and on NE2 form 1+1 IF protection, where the IF1 board in slot
3 functions as the main board; in addition, the radio links between NE1 and NE2 comprise
the two IF1 boards. For NE2, clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as
follows: 3-IF1-1 > -IF1-1 > internal clock source.

The services of NE3 are aggregate to NE2 through ports 1 to 4 on the SP3S board in slot .
For NE3, clock source priorities are allocated in descending order as follows: -SP3S-1 >
internal clock source.

NE4 is connected to many hops of downstream radio links. If it traces the tributary clock
source, pointer justifications occur on the downstream nodes. Therefore, NE4 traces the
external clock source output by NE2.

Do not configure SSM or extended SSM protection.

Figure 12-8 Clock synchronization policy for a port aggregation network (aggregation only
through the tributary port)
NE3
NE1

NE2
1-SP3S-1/
Internal

External/
Internal

Clock

3-IF1-1/
5-IF1-1/
Internal

NE4

External/
Internal

Precautions of Planning a Clock Synchronization Policy


When planning the clock synchronization policy, pay attention to the following points:
l

The number of NEs on a long clock chain cannot be more than 20. A number smaller than
10 is recommended. If a large number of NEs exist on a long clock chain, add one more
clock source for signal compensation in the middle of the chain.

It is recommended that the SDH optical port should be used at a convergence node to
converge TDM services. This ensures the quality of clock signals by transmitting them over
SDH signals rather than over PDH signals.

Clock Synchronization Policy for Base Stations


If synchronization signals are transmitted to a BTS through the radio transmission network,
follow these guidelines to plan the synchronization policy:
If the BTS can access the transmission network through an SDH optical port or Ethernet port,
use the SDH optical port or Ethernet port to provide the timing reference signal for the BTS.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

924

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

If the BTS can access the transmission network only through the E1 signal, the external clock
port is preferred to transmit the timing reference signal to the BTS.
If the BTS can access the transmission network only through the E1 signal and the external clock
port cannot be used, use the E1 port to transmit the timing reference signal to the BTS. If the
output clock does not meet the requirement of the BTS, the NE that is connected to the BTS can
use the tributary retiming function.
If the BTS can be accessed to the transmission network through Ethernet only and does not
support the synchronous Ethernet function, you can provide the timing reference signal to the
BTS through the external clock port.

Tributary Retiming
When being transmitted by the OptiX RTN 980, the PDH signal must undergo mapping and
demapping processes, during which the jitter occurs. In addition, pointer justifications during
the network transmission process cause the jitter of the PDH signal.
Tributary retiming helps to reduce the jitter of the PDH signal when it is transmitted on a
transmission network. Tributary retiming achieves transmission of the signal that combines the
timing reference signal and the PDH service signal. Hence, the transmitted PDH signal carries
the timing information that is synchronized with the timing reference signal.
Figure 12-9 shows how a BSC transmits the synchronization information to a BTS through the
radio transmission network after the tributary retiming function is enabled. The radio
transmission network extracts the tributary clock from the E1 signal that is transmitted from the
BSC. This tributary clock functions as the synchronization reference clock for the radio
transmission network to be synchronized with the clock of the BSC. The tributary retiming
function is enabled on NE3. In this manner, NE3 transmits the E1 signal that carries the retiming
clock information to the BTS (NE3 selects the system clock as the retiming clock). In addition,
NE3 is synchronized with the BSC. Hence, the BTS can extract the clock signal of the BSC from
the tributary signal.
The basic working principle of tributary retiming is as follows: The tributary signal is written
into a large-capacity first in first output (FIFO), and then the tributary signal is read from the
FIFO through the retiming clock. In this manner, the output signal contains the retiming clock
information, and FIFO eliminates the jitter and wander in the original tributary signal. The OptiX
RTN 980 can select the system clock or the line clock in the uplink E1 signal as the retiming
clock, depending on the specific networking. In general cases, the system clock is selected as
the retiming clock.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

925

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Figure 12-9 Tributary retiming


NE1

NE2

NE3

E1

E1

BSC
NE3
Write clk
(downlink E1 clk)

Clock
E1

FIFO

E1
Read clk
(retiming clk)

When using the tributary retiming function, pay attention to the following points:
l

The retiming clock should be synchronized with the clock of the BSC, and the retiming
clock should not undergo mapping and demapping processes.

The tributary retiming function uses the FIFO. This causes a delay of 125 us or more. Use
this function only when it is necessary.

The retiming function requires that the entire transmission network should be synchronized
with the service network that requires retiming. If certain NEs on the transmission network
are not synchronized, slips occur.

The transmission network can meet the retiming requirement of only one service network.

12.2 Configuration Procedure


This section describes the procedures for configuring the clock source, clock protection, and
output clock.
Figure 12-10 provides the procedures for configuring clocks.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

926

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Figure 12-10 Configuration flow chart (clocks)


Required

Start

Optional
Configuring clock sources

Configuring the SSM or


extended SSM protection

Modifying clock switching


conditions

Modifying clock restoration


parameters
Modifying parameters of
the output clock

Setting parameters of PDH


ports
Querying the clock
synchronization status

End

The procedures in the configuration flow chart are described as follows.


Table 12-1 Procedures for configuring clocks
Step

Operation

Description

A.10.1.1 Configuring
the Clock Sources

Required. The parameters are set as follows:


l According to the clock source that is planned, set
Clock Source.
l The External Clock Source Mode and
Synchronous Status Byte parameters are valid
only for the external clock source. Set the two
parameters according to the actual condition of
the external clock. In general cases, the two
parameters take the default values.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

927

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Step

Operation

Configuri
ng the
SSM or
extended
SSM
protection

12 Configuring the Clock

Description
A.10.1.2
Configuri
ng Clock
Subnets

Required when the SSM or extended SSM


protection is used. Set the parameters as follows:
l Set Protection Status according to the used
protocol type.
l If the clock uses the extended SSM protection,
set Clock Source ID for the following clock
sources:
External clock source
Internal clock source of the NE that accesses
the external clock source
Internal clock source of the NE that connects
the intersecting ring and chain or connects the
intersecting rings
Line clock source that is accessed to the ring
through the NE that connects the intersecting
ring and chain or connects the intersecting
rings and is configured with the line clock
source on the ring
The values of Clock Source ID for these clock
sources should be different.

A.10.1.4
Configuri
ng the
SSM
Output
Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Required when the SSM or extended SSM


protection.
When a line port is connected to the NE on the same
clock subnet, set Output S1 Byte Info to Enabled.
In other cases, set Output S1 Byte Info to
Disabled.

A.10.1.5
Configuri
ng the
Clock ID
Output
Status

Required when the extended SSM protection is used.

A.10.1.3
UserDefined
Clock
Quality

Optional.

When a line port is connected to the NE on the same


clock subnet, set Output Clock ID to Enabled.

A.10.1.8 Changing the


Conditions for Clock
Source Switching

Optional.

A.10.1.9 Modifying the


Recovery Parameter of
the Clock Source

Optional.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

928

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Step

Operation

Description

A.10.1.7 Configuring
Clock Sources for
External Clock Output

Optional.

A.10.1.6 Modifying the


Parameters of the
Clock Output

Optional when the external clock port is used to


transmit the clock reference signal for the customer
equipment.

By default, the OptiX RTN 980 allows output of the


system clock source through the external clock port.
If the external clock port transmits the system clock
source only, manual configuration is not required. If
the external clock port needs to transmit other clock
sources, such as a clock from a radio link or
synchronous Ethernet clock, you need to configure
the priority table for the phase-locked loop (PLL)
clock source of the external clock port.

Set the parameters according to the requirement of


the customer equipment. In general cases, these
parameters take the default values.
7

A.6.2 Setting the


Parameters of PDH
Ports

Optional when the output tributary clock requires


retiming.

A.10.1.10 Querying the


Clock Synchronization
Status

l When a clock subnet uses the internal clock


source of an NE as the reference clock, set NE
Clock Mode to Free-Run Mode for this NE; set
NE Clock Mode to Tracing Mode for the other
NEs.

Set Retiming Mode to Retiming Mode of CrossConnect Clock for the tributary port.

l When a clock subnet uses the clock out of the


subnet as the reference clock, set NE Clock
Mode to Tracing Mode for all the NEs.

12.3 Configuration Example (Clock for a TDM Radio Chain


Network)
This section considers a TDM radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
the clock according to the network planning information.

12.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.3 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Chain Network),
configure the clocks according to the following network planning information (as shown in
Figure 12-11):

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

929

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

The radio transmission network is directly synchronized with the clock of the upstream
third-party network.

Clock synchronization signals are transmitted to the BTSs over E1 signals.

Figure 12-11 Networking diagram (clock on a TDM radio chain network)

BTS2

E1
STM-1

STM-1

E1

NE4

BTS3

E1
NE3

BSC

BTS1

E1

E1

NE1

NE2

NE5

NE6

BTS4

BTS5

The clock connections shown in Figure 12-11 are described as follows.


Table 12-2 Clock connections (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and the thirdparty network

16-SL4D-1 (working port in


a linear MSP group)

Configure these ports to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

16-SL4D-2 (protection port


of a linear MSP group)

Table 12-3 Clock connections (NE12)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE12 and NE11

3-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these boards to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

5-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

930

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Table 12-4 Clock connections (NE13)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE13 and NE12

1-SL1D-1

Configure this port to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

Table 12-5 Clock connections (NE14)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE14 and NE13

3-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these boards to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

4-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 12-6 Clock connections (NE15)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE15 and NE13

4-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these boards to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

6-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 12-7 Clock connections (NE16)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE16 and NE15

3-IF1

Configure this board to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

12.3.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Clock Source Information


According to 12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy, Figure 12-12 shows the clock source
information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

931

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Figure 12-12 Clock source information (TDM radio chain network)


3-IF1-1/
4-IF1-1/
Internal

STM-1

STM-1
NE14

Third party
network
NE13

NE12

NE11

1-SL1D-1/
Internal

3-IF1-1/
5-IF1-1/
Internal

16-SL4D-1/
16-SL4D-2/
Internal

NE15
4-IF1-1/
6-IF1-1/
Internal

NE16

Clock

Clock Protection
In this example, a chain network is set up. Thus, only the clock source protection based on
priorities is needed, whereas the SSM or extended SSM protection need not be configured.

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Base Station


In this example, the radio network is synchronized with the third party network through the SDH
optical port and transmits the timing reference signal through the E1 port. Hence, the E1 retiming
function need not be enabled.

12.3.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources and configure the clock sources.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Paramete
r

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE4

NE5

NE6

Clock
Source

16SL4D-1

3-IF1-1

3-IF1-1

4-IF1-1

3-IF1-1

4-IF1-1

6-IF1-1

16SL4D-2

Internal
Clock
Source

1-SL1D-1
Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

5-IF1-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

932

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Step 2 See A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status and query the clock
synchronization status of the NEs.
NE Clock Mode of all the NEs should be Tracing Mode.
----End

12.4 Configuration Example (Clock for a TDM Radio Ring


Network)
This section considers a TDM radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
the clock according to the network planning information.

12.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.4 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the TDM Radio Ring Network),
configure the clocks according to the following network planning information (as shown in
Figure 12-13):
l

The radio transmission network is directly synchronized with the clock of the upstream
third-party network.

Clock synchronization signals are transmitted to the BTSs over E1 signals.

Figure 12-13 Networking diagram (clocks on a TDM radio ring network)


Third party
network

E1

NE21

E1
BTS21

E1
E1 NE22

NE24

BTS24

BTS22
E1
NE23
BTS23

The clock connections shown in Figure 12-13 are described as follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

933

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Table 12-8 Clock connections (NE21)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and the thirdparty network

2-SP3S

Configure this board to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

Table 12-9 Clock connections (NE22)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and NE21

3-IF1

Configure this board to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

Between NE22 and BTS21

2-SP3S

Between NE22 and BTS22

2-SP3S

Configure these ports for


enabling the re-timing
function so that the BTS can
be precisely synchronized
with the clock of the
upstream third-party
network.

Table 12-10 Clock connections (NE23)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE23 and NE22

3-IF1

Configure this board to


synchronize clock signals
with the upstream third-party
network.

Between NE23 and BTS23

2-SP3S

Configure this board for


enabling the re-timing
function so that the BTS can
be precisely synchronized
with the clock of the
upstream third-party
network.

Table 12-11 Clock connections (NE24)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE24 and NE21

4-IF1 (main IF board of a 1+1


HSB protection group)

Configure these boards to


synchronize clock signals

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

934

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Link

Between NE24 and BTS24

Port

Description

6-IF1 (standby IF board of a


1+1 HSB protection group)

with the upstream third-party


network.

2-SP3S

Configure this board for


enabling the re-timing
function so that the BTS can
be more precisely
synchronized with the clock
of the BSC.

12.4.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Clock Source Information


According to 12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy, Figure 12-14 shows the clock source
information.
Figure 12-14 Clock source information (TDM radio ring network)
2-SP3S-1/
Internal
E1

Third party
network

NE21

NE22
3-IF1-1
Internal

NE24
4-IF1-1/
6-IF1-1
Internal

Clock

NE23
3-IF1-1/
Internal

Clock Protection
In this example, a PDH radio ring network is set up. Thus, only the clock source protection based
on priorities is needed, whereas the SSM or extended SSM protection need not be configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

935

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Base Station


In this example, the radio network is synchronized with the BSC through the E1 port and
transmits the timing reference signal through the E1 port. Hence, the E1 retiming function needs
to be enabled. The retiming function needs to be enabled for the following ports:
l

NE22: 2-SP3S-1, 2-SP3S-5

NE23: 2-SP3S-1

NE24: 2-SP3S-1
NOTE

In application, the external clock port, rather than the E1 port, is preferred to transmit the timing reference signal
to a BTS.

12.4.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources and configure the clock sources.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Clock Source

NE21

NE22

NE23

NE24

2-SP3S-1

3-IF1-1

3-IF1-1

4-IF1-1

Internal Clock
Source

5-IF1-1

Internal Clock
Source

6-IF1-1

Internal Clock
Source

Internal Clock
Source

Step 2 See A.6.2 Setting the Parameters of PDH Ports and set the PDH port parameters.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Retiming Mode

NE22

NE23

NE24

Retiming Mode of
Tributary Clock (2SP3S-1)

Retiming Mode of
Tributary Clock (2SP3S-1)

Retiming Mode of
Tributary Clock (2SP3S-1)

Retiming Mode of
Tributary Clock (2SP3S-5)

Normal (other ports)

Normal (other ports)

Normal (other ports)

Step 3 See A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status and query the clock
synchronization status of the NEs.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

936

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

NE Clock Mode of all the NEs should be Tracing Mode.


----End

12.5 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio


Chain Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio chain network as an example to describe how to configure
clocks according to the network planning information.

12.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.5 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Chain Network),
configure the clocks according to the following network planning information (as shown in
Figure 12-15):
l

The radio transmission network is directly synchronized with the clock of the BSC through
a LAG consisting of two GE links.

Clock synchronization signals are transmitted to the BTSs over FE signals.

Figure 12-15 Networking diagram (clocks on a Hybrid radio chain network)


FE
BTS2
GE

FE

GE

NE4

BTS3

FE
NE3

NE2

BSC

BTS1

FE

FE

NE1

NE5

NE6

BTS4

BTS5

The clock connections shown in Figure 12-15 are described as follows.


Table 12-12 Clock connections (NE1)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE1 and the BSC

1-EM6F-1 (main port of a


LAG)

The ports are used to


synchronizing NE1 with the
clock of the BSC.

1-EM6F-2 (slave port of a


LAG)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

937

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Table 12-13 Clock connections (NE2)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE2 and NE1

3-ISU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 HSB protection group)

The ports are used to


synchronizing NE2 with the
clock of the BSC.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board of


a 1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 12-14 Clock connections (NE3)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE3 and NE2

1-EM6T-1

This port is used to


synchronizing NE3 with the
clock of the BSC.

Table 12-15 Clock connections (NE4)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE4 and NE3

3-ISU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 HSB protection group)

The ports are used to


synchronizing NE4 with the
clock of the BSC.

5-ISU2 (standby IF board of


a 1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 12-16 Clock connections (NE5)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE5 and NE3

4-ISU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 HSB protection group)

The ports are used to


synchronizing NE5 with the
clock of the BSC.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board of


a 1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 12-17 Clock connections (NE6)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE6 and NE5

3-ISU2

This port is used to


synchronizing NE6 with the
clock of the BSC.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

938

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

12.5.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Clock Source Information


According to 12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy, Figure 12-16 shows the clock source
information.
Figure 12-16 Networking diagram (clock for a Hybrid radio chain network)
3-ISU2-1/
5-ISU2-1
Internal
GE

GE

NE4
NE3

NE6
3-ISU2-1/
Internal

NE5
4-ISU2-1/
6-ISU2-1
Internal

NE2

1-EM6T-1/ 3-ISU2-1/
Internal 5-ISU2-1
Internal

NE1
1-EM6F-1/
1-EM6F-2/
Internal

BSC

Clock

NOTE

Separately configure the Ethernet clock source for each link in the LAG.

Clock Protection
In this example, a chain network is set up. Thus, only the clock source protection based on
priorities is needed, whereas the SSM or extended SSM protection need not be configured.

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Base Station


In this example, the radio transmission network is synchronized with the BSC through the GE
port, and transmits the timing reference signal to the BTS through the FE port.

12.5.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources and configure the clock sources.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

939

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Paramete
r

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE4

NE5

NE6

Clock
Source

1-EM6F-1

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-1

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

1-EM6F-2

5-ISU2-1

5-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Step 2 See A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status and query the clock
synchronization status of the NEs.
NE Clock Mode of all the NEs should be Tracing Mode.
----End

12.6 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Ring


Network)
This section considers a Hybrid radio ring network as an example to describe how to configure
the clock according to the network planning information.

12.6.1 Network Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 6.6 Configuration Example (Radio Links on the Hybrid Radio Ring Network),
configure the clocks according to the following network planning information (as shown in
Figure 12-17):
l

The Hybrid radio transmission network is synchronized with NE21 on the PSN.

OptiX RTN NEs transmit clock synchronization signals through their E1/FE ports to 2G/
3G base stations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

940

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Figure 12-17 Networking diagram (clock on a Hybrid radio ring network)

Packet network

R4

FE

NE21

BTS21

FE
R4
E1 NE22

NE24

BTS24

BTS22
FE
NE23

R4
BTS23

The clock connections shown in Figure 12-17 are described as follows.


Table 12-18 Clock connections (NE22)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE22 and NE21

3-ISU2 (high-priority clock


source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Between NE22 and NE23

4-ISU2 (low-priority clock


source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Configure these ports to


implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream PSN.

Table 12-19 Clock connections (NE23)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE23 and NE22

3-ISU2 (high-priority clock


source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Between NE23 and NE24

4-ISU2 (low-priority clock


source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Configure these ports to


implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream PSN.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

941

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Table 12-20 Clock connections (NE24)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE24 and NE21

4-ISU2 (main IF board in a 1


+1 HSB protection group;
high-priority clock source,
with the SSM protocol
enabled)

Configure these ports to


implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream PSN.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board in


a 1+1 HSB protection group;
high-priority clock source,
with the SSM protocol
enabled)
Between NE24 and NE23

3-ISU2 (low-priority clock


source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

12.6.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Clock Source Information


Based on 12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy, you can obtain the clock source information
as shown in Figure 12-18.
Figure 12-18 Information about clock sources (Hybrid radio ring network)

Packet network

NE21

NE22

NE24

3-ISU2-1/
4-ISU2-1/
Internal

4-ISU2-1/
6-ISU2-1/
3-ISU2-1/
Internal
NE23

Clock

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

3-ISU2-1/
4-ISU2-1/
Internal

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

942

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Clock Protection
The standard SSM protocol is enabled for all NEs on the ring network.

Clock Synchronization Policy for 2G Base Stations - CES Retiming Function


In this example, 2G base stations extract clock information through E1 ports on the PSN.
The PSN implements the following clock synchronization:
l

Network-wide clock synchronization

Synchronization between the network-wide clock and the service clock

Therefore, the PSN can use the CES retiming function for clock synchronization. That is, the
PSN extracts system clock information from the E1 signal converted from a CES service and
then provides the clock synchronization signal through E1 ports to base stations.
NOTE

CES retiming is the default clock recovery solution for PSNs and therefore does not need to be enabled manually.

Clock Synchronization Policy for 3G Base Stations - Synchronous Ethernet


Function
In this example, 3G base stations extract reference clock information from FE ports on the PSN.
Therefore, the PSN can use the synchronous Ethernet function for clock synchronization with
base stations. That is, the PSN provides clock synchronization signals to base stations through
FE ports.
NOTE

Synchronous Ethernet is the default clock recovery solution for PSNs and therefore does not need to be enabled
manually.

12.6.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources and configure the clock sources.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Clock Source

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
NE22

NE23

NE24

3-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

4-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

Internal Clock
Source

Internal Clock
Source

3-ISU2-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Internal Clock
Source
943

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Step 2 See A.10.1.2 Configuring Clock Subnets and configure protection for clock sources.
For NE22 to NE24, the values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value

Start Standard SSM Protocol

Selected

NOTE

The other parameters take their default values.

Step 3 See A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status and query the clock
synchronization status.
NE Clock Mode of all NEs should be Tracing Mode.
----End

12.7 Configuration Example (Clocks for a PSN)


This section uses clocks for a packet convergence ring and a Packet radio chain as examples to
describe how to configure clocks according to the network planning information.

12.7.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 4.2 Common Network Scenario of the IP Radio Network, configure the clocks
according to the following network planning information (as shown in Figure 12-19):
l

The BSC and RNC are synchronized with an external BITS clock.

The PSN is synchronized with the same BITS clock as the BSC and RNC. The NEs on the
PSN are synchronized with each other through physical clocks (clocks from microwave
ports or clocks from Ethernet ports using the synchronous Ethernet function).

The PSN transmits clock synchronization signals through its E1/FE ports to 2G/3G base
stations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

944

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Figure 12-19 Networking diagram (clocks for a PSN)


NE34

BTS33

NE33
FE

BTS31

R4
BTS32
E1

BTS34

R4

E1

R99

FE
GE

GE

NE32
Hybrid radio chain
network

NE31

NE11
GE

GE
E
+G
E1

E1

E1

NE21
E1

BTS36

BTS35

Hybrid radio ring


network

R99
BTS37

BSC

R99
BTS38
RNC

The clock connections shown in Figure 12-19 are described as follows.


Table 12-21 Clock connections (NE11)
Link

Port

Description

Between NE11 and NE21

17-EG2D-2 (high-priority
clock source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Configure Ethernet clocks


extracted from ports that use
the synchronous Ethernet
function to implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream clock.

17-EG2D-1 (low-priority
clock source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Table 12-22 Clock connections (NE21)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE21 and NE31

17-EG2D-1 (high-priority
clock source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Configure Ethernet clocks


extracted from ports that use
the synchronous Ethernet
function to implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream clock.

17-EG2D-2 (low-priority
clock source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

945

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Table 12-23 Clock connections (NE31)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE31 and a BITS

External clock port

Configure the external clock


port (CLK/TOD1) on the
CSHN board to implement
clock synchronization with
the external BITS clock.

Table 12-24 Clock connections (NE32)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE32 and NE31

17-EG2D-1 (high-priority
clock source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Configure Ethernet clocks


extracted from ports that use
the synchronous Ethernet
function to implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream clock.

17-EG2D-2 (low-priority
clock source, with the SSM
protocol enabled)

Table 12-25 Clock connections (NE33)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE33 and NE32

4-ISU2 (main IF board in a 1


+1 HSB protection group)

Configure microwave clocks


to implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream clock.

6-ISU2 (standby IF board of


a 1+1 HSB protection group)

Table 12-26 Clock connections (NE34)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE34 and NE33

3-ISU2

Configure a microwave clock


to implement clock
synchronization with the
upstream clock.

12.7.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

946

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Clock Source Information


12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy provides clock source tracing information of the PSN
and the clock source priority table of each NE.
Figure 12-20 Clock source information (PSN)
NE34

BTS33
R4

NE33
BTS31
FE
E1

E1
BTS34

R99

FE

R4

GE

BTS32

GE
NE32
E1
NE21

GE

GE

BTS35

E
+G

E1

E1

E1

BTS36

NE31

SSM

NE11

R99
BTS37

BSC

R99
BTS38

Clock

RNC

Table 12-27 Clock source priority table


NE11

NE21

NE31

NE32

NE33

NE34

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-1

4-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

17-EG2D-1

17-EG2D-2

17-EG2D-2

6-ISU2-1

Internal
clock source

Internal
clock source

External
clock source
1

Internal
clock source

Internal
clock source

Internal
clock source

Internal
clock source

Clock Protection
The standard SSM protocol is enabled for all NEs on the ring network.

Clock Synchronization Policy for 2G Base Stations - CES Retiming Function


In this example, 2G base stations extract clock information through E1 ports on the PSN.
The PSN implements the following clock synchronization:
l

Network-wide clock synchronization

Synchronization between the network-wide clock and the service clock

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

947

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Therefore, the PSN can use the CES retiming function for clock synchronization. That is, the
PSN extracts system clock information from the E1 signal converted from a CES service and
then provides the clock synchronization signal through E1 ports to base stations.
NOTE

CES retiming is the default clock recovery solution for PSNs and therefore does not need to be enabled manually.

Clock Synchronization Policy for 3G Base Stations - Synchronous Ethernet


Function
In this example, 3G base stations extract reference clock information from FE ports on the PSN.
Therefore, the PSN can use the synchronous Ethernet function for clock synchronization with
base stations. That is, the PSN provides clock synchronization signals to base stations through
FE ports.
NOTE

Synchronous Ethernet is the default clock recovery solution for PSNs and therefore does not need to be enabled
manually.

12.7.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources and configure clock sources.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Paramete
r

Value
NE11

NE21

NE31

NE32

NE33

NE34

Clock
Source

17EG2D-2

17EG2D-1

17EG2D-1

4-ISU2-1

3-ISU2-1

6-ISU2-1

17EG2D-1

17EG2D-2

External
Clock
Source 1

17EG2D-2

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Internal
Clock
Source

Step 2 See A.10.1.2 Configuring Clock Subnets and configure protection for clock sources.
For NE11, NE21, and NE31 to NE34, the values for the related parameters are provided as
follows.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Parameter

Value

Start Standard SSM Protocol

Selected

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

948

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

NOTE

The other parameters take their default values.

Step 3 See A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status and query the clock
synchronization status.
NE Clock Mode of all NEs should be Tracing Mode.
----End

12.8 Configuration Example (Clocks Across a Third-party


TDM Network)
This section considers Ethernet services transmitted across a third-party TDM network as an
example and describes how to configure clocks according to the planning information.

12.8.1 Networking Diagram


The section describes the networking information about the NEs.
Based on 9.4 Configuration Example (Ethernet Services Traversing a TDM Network),
configure the clocks according to the following network planning information (as shown in
Figure 12-21):
l

The transmission network is directly synchronized with the clock of the BSC through FE
ports.

Clock synchronization signals are transmitted to the BTS over FE ports.


NOTE

This example only describes the clock configuration on NE1 and NE7. For the clock configuration on NE2NE6, see 12.5 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Chain Network).

Figure 12-21 Networking diagram (clocks across a third-party TDM network)


BTS2
BTS6

FE

FE

FE

GE
NE4
FE
NE3

NE2

NE1

BTS5

E1

BTS1

NE5

NE6

TDM
network

FE

FE

FE

E1

NE7

BSC

BTS4

Figure 12-22 Board configuration (clocks across a third-party TDM network)


The following figure shows the clock link connections of NE1 and NE7.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

949

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Table 12-28 Clock link connections (NE7)


Link

Used Clock Port

Description

Connected to the BSC

4-EFP8-1

Used for synchronization


with the BSC.

12.8.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains all the parameters required for configuring the NE
data.

Clock Source Information


Based on 12.1.3 Clock Synchronization Policy, you can obtain the clock source information
as shown in Figure 12-23.
Figure 12-23 Information about clock sources (Hybrid radio chain network)
NOTE

This example only describes the clock configuration on NE1 and NE7. For the clock configuration on NE2NE6, see 12.5 Configuration Example (Clock for a Hybrid Radio Chain Network).

Clock Protection
In this example, a chain network is set up. Therefore, only the clock source protection based on
priorities is configured and the SSM or extended SSM protection is not configured.

Clock Synchronization Policy for a Base Station


In this example, the radio transmission network is synchronized with the BSC through the FE
port on the EFP8 board of NE7, and transmits the timing reference signal to the base station
through the FE ports that accesses services from the base station.

12.8.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the process for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources and configure the clock sources.
The values for the relevant parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Clock Source

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value Range
NE1

NE7

-SP3D-1

4-EFP8-1

Internal Clock Source

Internal Clock Source

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

950

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

12 Configuring the Clock

Step 2 See A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status and query the clock
synchronization status of the NEs.
For all NEs, set NE Clock Mode to Tracing Mode.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

951

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Configuring Auxiliary Ports and


Functions

About This Chapter


The OptiX RTN 980 provides multiple auxiliary ports and functions. These functions require
certain data configuration.
13.1 Auxiliary Ports and Functions
This section describes the auxiliary ports and functions supported by the OptiX RTN 980,
namely, the orderwire, synchronous data services, asynchronous data services, and wayside
services.
13.2 Environment Monitoring Functions
The OptiX RTN 980 supports the function of monitoring environment by means of external
alarms.
13.3 Configuration Example (Orderwire)
This section considers the orderwire on a radio network as an example to describe how to plan
the orderwire according to network planning information.
13.4 Configuration Example (Synchronous Data Services)
This section considers a synchronous data service that transmits the network management
information as an example to describe how to configure a synchronous data service according
to the network planning information.
13.5 Configuration Example (Asynchronous Data Services)
This section considers an asynchronous data service that transmits the NM messages as an
example to describe how to configure an asynchronous data service according to the network
planning information.
13.6 Configuration Example (Wayside E1 Services)
This section considers a wayside E1 service that transmits the NM messages as an example to
describe how to configure a wayside E1 service according to the network planning.
13.7 Configuration Example (External Alarms)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

952

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

This section considers the centralized control of environment monitoring and equipment alarms
through external alarms as an example to describe how to configure external alarms according
to the network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

953

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

13.1 Auxiliary Ports and Functions


This section describes the auxiliary ports and functions supported by the OptiX RTN 980,
namely, the orderwire, synchronous data services, asynchronous data services, and wayside
services.

Orderwire
The OptiX RTN 980 supports one orderwire phone so that the operation or maintenance
engineers at different workstations can perform voice communication through microwave or
SDH overhead bytes.
When using the orderwire phone, take the following precautions:
l

The orderwire phone numbers of all the NEs on the network must be of the same length.
It is recommended that the orderwire telephone number is a 3-digit number and all orderwire
telephone numbers on the entire network are unique.

The dialing method of the orderwire phone of each node is dual-tone multifrequency.

The call waiting time of each node should be set to the same value. If less than 30 nodes
exist in the orderwire subnet, it is recommended that you set the call waiting time to five
seconds. If more than 30 nodes exist in the orderwire subnet, it is recommended that you
set the call waiting time to nine seconds.

The equipment supports the orderwire group call function. When one set of the OptiX RTN
equipment dials the orderwire group call number "888", the orderwire phones of all the
OptiX equipment on the orderwire subnet ring. When an orderwire phone receives the call,
the orderwire phones on the other NEs stop ringing. In this case, the orderwire point-tomultipoint group call changes to a point-to-point ordinary orderwire call.

When the orderwire signals are transmitted over a radio link, they are always transmitted
through one customized overhead byte. When the orderwire signals are transmitted over
SDH fibers, they are transmitted through the E1 or E2 byte.

By default, all the line ports, IF ports, and unconfigured synchronous data ports on the
equipment function as the orderwire ports. Therefore, in normal cases, the orderwire ports
needs to be configured only at the edge of the orderwire subnet.

The OptiX RTN 980 supports a maximum of 16 orderwire ports.

The equipment supports the transmission of orderwire overhead bytes through the 64 kbit/
s synchronous data ports or external clock ports.

If multiple radio links or optical transmission lines exist between two NEs, the ports
corresponding to these links should be configured as the orderwire ports. In this case, except
for the hybrid radio links in N+1 protection, if one radio link is available between two NEs,
the orderwire transmission between two NEs is normal. When the orderwire signals are
transmitted over the hybrid radio links in N+1 protection, the protection link cannot transmit
the orderwire signals.

The equipment provides the orderwire ports on the AUX board. For definitions of the pins
on the ports, see the OptiX RTN 980 IDU Hardware Description.

Synchronous Data Services


The synchronous data service is also called the F1 data service. The OptiX RTN 980 supports
one synchronous data service. The microwave/SDH overhead bytes transmitted between two
NEs can be used for transmitting one 64 kbit/s synchronous data service.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

954

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

When using the synchronous data service, take the following precautions:
l

The synchronous data service is fully transparently transmitted, and the transmission rate
at the port is 64 kbit/s.

The synchronous data service is clock-sensitive. If the clock is not synchronized, bit errors
occur.

The ports on the equipment comply with ITU-T G.703.

When the orderwire signals are transmitted over a radio link, they are always transmitted
through one customized overhead byte. When the orderwire signals are transmitted over
SDH fibers, they are always transmitted through the F1 byte.

The equipment supports the transmission of the overhead bytes in the synchronous data
service through the external clock ports to realize the service spanning function.

When the synchronous data service is transmitted over the protected radio links or optical
transmission lines, the synchronous data service is also protected.

The equipment provides the synchronous data service ports on the AUX. For definitions
of the pins on the ports, see the OptiX RTN 980 IDU Hardware Description.

Asynchronous Data Services


The asynchronous data service is also called a transparent data service or a broadcast data port
service. The OptiX RTN 980 supports one asynchronous data service. The microwave/SDH
overhead bytes transmitted between two sites can be used for realizing full-duplex
communication between the universal asynchronous receiver/transmitter (UART).
When using the asynchronous data service, take the following precautions:
l

The asynchronous data service is fully transparently transmitted. The transmission rate and
transmission control protocol need not be configured. The transmission rate at the port is
19.2 kbit/s.

The asynchronous data service is clock-sensitive. If the clock is not synchronized, bit errors
occur.

The equipment provides the RS-232 electrical port that complies with ITU-T V.24/V.28.

The equipment supports only point-to-point communications.

When the orderwire signals are transmitted over radio links, they are always transmitted
through one customized overhead byte. When the orderwire signals are transmitted over
SDH fibers, they are transmitted through any of the SERIAL 1 to SERIAL 4 bytes.

The equipment supports the transmission of the overhead bytes in the asynchronous data
service through the external clock ports to realize the service spanning function.

When the asynchronous data service is transmitted over the protected radio links or optical
transmission lines, the asynchronous data service is also protected.

The equipment provides the asynchronous data ports on the AUX board. For definitions of
the pins on the ports, see the OptiX RTN 980 IDU Hardware Description.

Wayside E1 Services
The OptiX RTN 980 supports one wayside E1 service. The transmitted overhead bytes in the
STM-1 radio signals can be used for transmitting one wayside E1 service between two sites in
one hop of STM-1 radio link.
When using the wayside E1 service, take the following precautions:
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

955

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

The wayside E1 service is supported by only STM-1 radio links or E1 radio links.

The wayside E1 service is fully and transparently transmitted, and the transmission rate at
the port is 2048 kbit/s.

The wayside E1 service is clock-sensitive. If the clock is not synchronized, bit errors occur.

The equipment does not support the pass-through of the wayside E1 service. Therefore, the
wayside E1 service is transmitted only between two sites on one hop of radio link.

When the wayside E1 service is transmitted over the radio links in 1+1 or N+1 protection
mode, the wayside E1 service is also protected.

The equipment adds or drops the wayside E1 service through the external clock port on the
SCC, cross-connect and clock board. The external clock port complies with ITU-T G.703,
and the impedance on the path is 120 ohms. For definitions of the pins on the external clock
ports, see the OptiX RTN 980DU Hardware Description.

13.2 Environment Monitoring Functions


The OptiX RTN 980 supports the function of monitoring environment by means of external
alarms.

External Alarms
External alarms are also called housekeeping alarms or relay alarms. The OptiX RTN 980
provides 4-input and 2-output external alarms.
Figure 13-1 shows the interface circuit for external alarm input. When the external relay is
switched off, the interface circuit generates a high-level signal. When the external relay is
switched on, the interface circuit generates a low-level signal. The board generates
corresponding alarms based on the level signal. External alarm input mainly achieves access of
the relay alarms generated by the environmental alarm generator.
Figure 13-1 Interface circuit for external alarm input
Circuit for external
alarm input
Output level

+3.3 V/+5 V
Pull-up
resistance

External
system
Relay

The interface circuit for external alarm output works in a similar manner as the external system
shown in Figure 13-1. When the specified external alarm output conditions are met, the NE
switches on or switches off the relay depending on the conditions that result in the alarm. When
the specified external alarm output conditions are no longer met, the NE changes the relay to
the reverse of its current state. External alarm output helps to provide equipment alarms to the
centralized alarming device.
The equipment provides external alarm ports on the AUX board. For pin assignments for the
ports, see the OptiX RTN 980 IDU Hardware Description.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

956

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

13.3 Configuration Example (Orderwire)


This section considers the orderwire on a radio network as an example to describe how to plan
the orderwire according to network planning information.

13.3.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
In the networking diagram shown in Figure 13-2, each NE needs to be configured with the
orderwire. Except that the radio links between NE1 and NE2 are configured with 1+1 protection,
all the other radio links are configured with 1+0 non-protection.
Figure 13-2 Networking diagram (orderwire)
1+0
1+1
E1

NE4
1+0
NE3

1+0

NE6

NE2

NE1

NE5

Table 13-1 Orderwire phone connections (NE1)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE1 and NE2

3-IFU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports to


implement IF 1+1 protection.

5-IFU2 (standby IF board)

Table 13-2 Orderwire phone connections (NE2)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE2 and NE1

3-IFU2 (main IF board)

Configure the ports to


implement IF 1+1 protection.

5-IFU2 (standby IF board)


Between NE2 and NE3

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

F1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

The two NEs are


interconnected through
synchronous data ports.

957

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Table 13-3 Orderwire phone connections (NE3)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE3 and NE2

F1

The two NEs are


interconnected through
synchronous data ports.

Between NE3 and NE4

3-IFU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE3 and NE5

4-IFU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 13-4 Orderwire phone connections (NE4)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE4 and NE3

3-IFU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 13-5 Orderwire phone connections (NE5)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE5 and NE3

4-IFU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Between NE5 and NE6

3-IFU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

Table 13-6 Orderwire phone connections (NE6)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE6 and NE5

3-IFU2

Configure this port to receive


and transmit radio service
signals.

13.3.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

958

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Information About Orderwire Phone Numbers


In this example, the number of NEs is very small. Therefore, the orderwire phone numbers are
allocated in the format of 100+NE ID, as shown in Figure 13-3.
Figure 13-3 Networking diagram (for orderwire)
1+0
1+1

104
NE4
1+0

E1
NE2

NE3

1+0

NE1
101

103

NE5

NE6

102

105
106

Information About Orderwire Ports


l

In this example, the service between NE2 and NE3 is forwarded through the E1 line.
Therefore, service spanning is required. The 64 kbit/s synchronous data service port is used
for service spanning.

NE2 to NE6 are located on the orderwire subnet. Hence, they use the default orderwire
ports (all the IF ports, line ports, and unconfigured synchronous data ports) that are
automatically mapped by the equipment.

NE1 is not located at the edge of the orderwire subnet. Hence, it is configured according
to the situation of NE2 to NE6. If NE1 is located at the edge of the orderwire subnet and
if it is connected to an IF ports or line ports on the other orderwire subnets, the IF ports or
line ports are deleted from the orderwire ports through the NMS.

The information about orderwire ports of each NE is provided in Table 13-7.

Table 13-7 Information about orderwire ports


NE

Orderwire Port

NE1

3-IFU2-1
5-IFU2-1

NE2

3-IFU2-1
5-IFU2-1
F1

NE3

3-IFU2-1
4-IFU2-1
F1

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

959

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

NE

Orderwire Port

NE4

3-IFU2-1

NE5

3-IFU2-1
4-IFU2-1

NE6

3-IFU2-1

NOTE

l An external clock port can also be used to realize service spanning between NE2 and NE3. In this case, the
external clock port needs to be added to the orderwire port through the NMS.
l Certain orderwire ports are unnecessary. These ports do not, however, affect the orderwire phones if they
do not receive orderwire signaling.

Information About Orderwire Parameters


l

Fewer than 30 NEs exist on the orderwire subnet. Hence, the call waiting time needs to be
set to five seconds for these NEs.

In this example, the SDH optical transmission equipment is not involved on the orderwire
subnet. Therefore, the overhead byte is set to E1 by default.

13.3.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.12.1 Configuring Orderwire and configure the orderwire.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Paramete
r

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE4

NE5

NE6

Call
Waiting
Time(s)

Phone 1

101

102

103

104

105

106

Selected
Orderwir
e Port

3-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

5-IFU2-1

5-IFU2-1

4-IFU2-1

F1

F1

4-IFU2-1

----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

960

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

13.4 Configuration Example (Synchronous Data Services)


This section considers a synchronous data service that transmits the network management
information as an example to describe how to configure a synchronous data service according
to the network planning information.

13.4.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
In the networking diagram shown in Figure 13-4, the radio network transmits the network
management messages of the third-party equipment. The third-party equipment and the NMS
use the protocol converter to convert the network management messages carried by the Ethernet
network into the network management messages carried by the 64 kbit/s synchronous data
service. Hence, the radio network needs to transparently transmit the corresponding synchronous
data only.
l

NE1 and NE6 add or drop 64 kbit/s synchronous data services. NE2, NE3, and NE5 pass
through 64 kbit/s synchronous data services.

Except that the radio links between NE1 and NE2 are configured with 1+1 protection, all
the other radio links are configured with 1+0 non-protection.

Figure 13-4 Networking diagram (synchronous data services)


3rd party NM
1+0
1+1
3rd party
equipment

64kbps

E1

NE4

ETH

1+0
ETH

NE3

1+0

NE2

NE1

64kbps

64k/ETH
Converter

NE6

64k/ETH
Converter

NE5

Table 13-8 Connections of synchronous data services (NE1)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE1 and a protocol


converter

F1

Configure this port to access


synchronous data services.

Between NE1 and NE2

3-IFU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 protection group)

Configure the main IF board


to transmit synchronous data
services.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

961

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Table 13-9 Connections of synchronous data services (NE2)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE2 and NE1

3-IFU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 protection group)

Configure the main IF board


to transmit synchronous data
services.

Between NE2 and NE3

F1

The two NEs are


interconnected through
synchronous data ports.

Table 13-10 Connections of synchronous data services (NE3)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE3 and NE5

4-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit synchronous data
services.

Between NE3 and NE2

F1

The two NEs are


interconnected through
synchronous data ports.

Table 13-11 Connections of synchronous data services (NE5)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE5 and NE3

4-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit synchronous data
services.

Between NE5 and NE6

3-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit synchronous data
services.

Table 13-12 Connections of synchronous data services (NE6)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE6 and NE5

3-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit synchronous data
services.

Between NE6 and a protocol


converter

F1

Configure this port to access


synchronous data services.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

962

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

13.4.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
l

In this example, the TDM service between NE2 and NE3 is forwarded through the E1 line.
Therefore, service spanning is required. The two synchronous data ports between NE2 and
NE3 are interconnected with each other to realize the service spanning function.

According to the service path, you can obtain the synchronous data service information
provided in Table 13-13.
Table 13-13 Information about the synchronous data service
NE

Data Channel 1

Data Channel 2

NE1

F1

3-IFU2-1

NE2

3-IFU2-1

F1

NE3

F1

4-IFU2-1

NE5

4-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

NE6

3-IFU2-1

F1

NOTE

l The external clock port can also be used to realize service spanning between NE2 and NE3.
l In the case of radio links or SDH optical transmission lines configured with 1+1 protection, only the active
link is configured with the synchronous data service.

13.4.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.12.2 Configuring the Synchronous Data Service and configure the synchronous data
services.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE5

NE6

Data
Channel 1

F1

3-IFU2-1

F1

4-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

Data
Channel 2

3-IFU2-1

F1

4-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

F1

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

963

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

13.5 Configuration Example (Asynchronous Data Services)


This section considers an asynchronous data service that transmits the NM messages as an
example to describe how to configure an asynchronous data service according to the network
planning information.

13.5.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
In the networking diagram shown in Figure 13-5, the radio network transmits the network
management information of the third-party equipment. The third-party equipment and the NMS
use the protocol converter to convert the network management information carried by the
Ethernet network into the network management information carried by the RS-232 synchronous
data service. Hence, the radio network needs to transparently transmit the corresponding
synchronous data only.
l

NE1 and NE6 add or drop asynchronous data services. NE2, NE3, and NE5 pass through
asynchronous data services.

Except that the radio links between NE1 and NE2 are configured with 1+1 protection, all
the other radio links are configured with 1+0 non-protection.

Figure 13-5 Networking diagram (asynchronous data services)


3rd party NM
1+0
1+1
3rd party
equipment

RS-232

E1

NE4

ETH

1+0
ETH

NE3

1+0

NE2

NE1

RS-232/ETH
Converter

RS-232

RS-232/ETH
Converter

NE6

NE5

Table 13-14 Connections of asynchronous data services (NE1)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE1 and a protocol


converter

SERIAL1

Configure this port to access


asynchronous data services.

Between NE1 and NE2

3-IFU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 protection group)

Configure the main IF board


to transmit asynchronous
data services.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

964

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Table 13-15 Connections of asynchronous data services (NE2)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE2 and NE1

3-IFU2 (main IF board of a 1


+1 protection group)

Configure the main IF board


to transmit asynchronous
data services.

Between NE2 and NE3

SERIAL1

The two NEs are


interconnected through
asynchronous data ports.

Table 13-16 Connections of asynchronous data services (NE3)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE3 and NE5

4-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit asynchronous data
services.

Between NE3 and NE2

SERIAL1

The two NEs are


interconnected through
asynchronous data ports.

Table 13-17 Connections of asynchronous data services (NE5)


Link

Port

Description

Between NE5 and NE3

4-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit asynchronous data
services.

Between NE5 and NE6

3-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit asynchronous data
services.

Table 13-18 Connections of asynchronous data services (NE6)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Link

Port

Description

Between NE6 and NE5

3-IFU2

Configure this port to


transmit asynchronous data
services.

Between NE6 and a protocol


converter

SERIAL1

Configure this port to access


asynchronous data services.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

965

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

13.5.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
l

In this example, the TDM service between NE2 and NE3 is forwarded through the E1 line.
Therefore, service spanning is required. The two asynchronous data ports between NE2
and NE3 are interconnected with each other to realize the service spanning function.

In this example, the SDH equipment is not required to jointly transmit the asynchronous
data service. Hence, the overhead byte is set to SERIAL1.

According to the service path, you can obtain the asynchronous data service information
provided in Table 13-19.
Table 13-19 Information about the asynchronous data service
NE

Broadcast Data Source

Broadcast Data Sink

NE1

SERIAL1

3-IFU2-1

NE2

3-IFU2-1

SERIAL1

NE3

SERIAL1

4-IFU2-1

NE5

4-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

NE6

3-IFU2-1

SERIAL1

NOTE

l The external clock port can also be used to realize service spanning between NE2 and NE3.
l In the case of radio links or SDH optical transmission lines configured with 1+1 protection, only the active
link is configured with the asynchronous data service.

13.5.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.12.3 Configuring the Asynchronous Data Service and configure the asynchronous data
services.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE5

NE6

Overhead
Byte

SERIAL1

SERIAL1

SERIAL1

SERIAL1

SERIAL1

Broadcast
Data Source

SERIAL1

3-IFU2-1

SERIAL1

4-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

966

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Selected
Broadcast
Data Sink

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Value
NE1

NE2

NE3

NE5

NE6

3-IFU2-1

SERIAL1

4-IFU2-1

3-IFU2-1

SERIAL1

----End

13.6 Configuration Example (Wayside E1 Services)


This section considers a wayside E1 service that transmits the NM messages as an example to
describe how to configure a wayside E1 service according to the network planning.

13.6.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
In the networking shown in Figure 13-6, the STM-1 radio network transmits the network
management information of the third-party equipment. The third-party equipment and the NMS
use the protocol converter to convert the network management information carried by the
Ethernet network into the network management information carried by the wayside E1 service.
To maximize the bandwidth utilization, the NEs transmit the service over the wayside E1
channel.
Figure 13-6 Networking diagram (wayside E1 services)
3rd party
NM

3rd party
equipment
3-IF1 to NE1
ETH

E1

ETH

E1

STM-1
NE2

E1/ETH
Converter

3-IF1 to NE2

NE1

E1/ETH
Converter

13.6.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.
According to the service path, you can obtain the wayside E1 service information provided in
Table 13-20.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

967

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Table 13-20 Information about wayside E1 services


NE

IF Board

Whether to Enable
the Wayside E1
Service

Input Slot of the


Wayside E1
Service

NE1

3-IF1

Enabled

15

NE2

3-IF1

Enabled

15

NOTE

In the case of radio links configured with 1+1 or N+1 protection, only the active link is configured with the
wayside E1 service.

13.6.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.12.4 Configuring the Wayside E1 Service and configure the wayside E1 service.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

NE2

Port

NE1-3-IF1-1

NE2-3-IF1-1

2M Wayside Enable Status

Enabled

Enabled

2M Wayside Input Board

15

15

----End

13.7 Configuration Example (External Alarms)


This section considers the centralized control of environment monitoring and equipment alarms
through external alarms as an example to describe how to configure external alarms according
to the network planning information.

13.7.1 Networking Diagram


This section describes the networking information about the NEs.
In the networking diagram shown in Figure 13-7, the external alarms on NE1 are required as
follows:
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

External alarm input port 1 is used for connecting the alarm port on the smoke sensor. When
the alarm port on the smoke sensor is closed, NE1 should report a fire alarm.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

968

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

External alarm input port 2 is used for connecting the alarm port on the water sensor. When
the alarm port on the water sensor is closed, NE1 should report a water alarm.

External alarm input port 3 is used for connecting the alarm port on the magnetic door
switch sensor. When the alarm port on the magnetic door switch sensor is closed, NE1
should report an alarm, indicating that the cabinet door is open.

External alarm output port 1 is used for connecting the centralized alarming boxes. When
a major or critical alarm is generated on NE1, the alarm output port is closed.

Figure 13-7 Networking diagram (external alarms)


2-AUX

Input 1
Smoke sensor
Input 2

NE1
Water sensor Input 3

Magnetic door
switch sensor

Output 1

Centralized
alarming box

13.7.2 Service Planning


The service planning information contains the information about all the parameters required for
configuring the NE data.

Information About Input Alarms


According to the requirements, you can obtain the input alarm information provided in Table
13-21.
Table 13-21 Information about input alarms

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Input External
Alarm

Alarm Name

Usage Status

Alarm Mode

Severity

Interface 1

Fire alarm

Used

An alarm is
generated when
the port is
closed.

Major

Interface 2

Water alarm

Used

An alarm is
generated when
the port is
closed.

Major

Interface 3

Open cabinet
door

Used

An alarm is
generated when
the port is
closed.

Major

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

969

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

13 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions

Information About Output Alarms


According to the requirements, you can obtain the output alarm information provided in Table
13-22.
Table 13-22 Information about output alarms
Output External Alarm

Usage Status

Working Mode

Interface 1

Used

Automatic Mode

NOTE

The OptiX RTN 980 supports the automatic mode and the manual mode. The manual mode is used for
commissioning the output alarms.

13.7.3 Configuration Process


This section describes the procedures for the data configuration.

Procedure
Step 1 See A.12.5 Configure External Alarms and configure the external alarms.
l The values for the input alarm parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

Operation Object

NE1-2-AUXCSK-1

NE1-2-AUXCSK-2

NE1-2-AUXCSK-3

Path Name

Fire alarm

Water alarm

Open cabinet door

Using Status

Used

Used

Used

Alarm Mode

Relay Turns On/


Low Level

Relay Turns On/


Low Level

Relay Turns On/


Low Level

Alarm Severity

Major Alarm

Major Alarm

Major Alarm

l The values for the output alarm parameters are provided as follows.
Parameter

Value
NE1

Operation Object

NE1-2-AUX-CSK-1

Use or Not

Used

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

970

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Adding and Modifying Configuration


Data

About This Chapter


During the equipment commissioning and operating phases, you need to add or modify certain
configuration data according to the actual requirements.
14.1 Common Task Collection (Network Topology)
Common tasks associated with the network topology include common configuration tasks
associated with NE attributes.
14.2 Common Task Collection (Radio Links)
This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with radio links.
14.3 Common Task Collection (TDM Services)
This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with TDM services.
14.4 Common Task Collection (Packet-Plane Ethernet Services)
This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with packet-plane Ethernet
services.
14.5 Task Collection (EoS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet Services)
This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with EoS/EoPDH-plane
Ethernet services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

971

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

14.1 Common Task Collection (Network Topology)


Common tasks associated with the network topology include common configuration tasks
associated with NE attributes.
Table 14-1 Common task collection (NE attributes)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Creating NEs

When using the NMS


to perform centralized
management of NEs,
create the icons of the
NEs to be managed at
corresponding
positions on the Main
Topology.

A.2.1.1 Creating NEs


by Using the Search
Method or A.2.1.2
Creating NEs by Using
the Manual Method

l Generally, NEs
are created by
searching for the
NE on the NMS.

Changing an
NE ID

You need to change an


NE ID, if the NE ID
does not meet the
network planning
requirements (for
example, if the NE ID
is the same as another
NE ID).

A.2.1.4 Changing the


NE ID

Changing the
IP address of an
NE

You need to change the


IP address of the
gateway NE if changes
occur in the external
DCN between the
NMS server and the
gateway NE.

Changing the IP
address of an NE

Synchronizing
NE time

After you conduct the


settings on the NMS,
the NE time is
synchronized
automatically and
periodically. You can
also synchronize the
NE time manually if
the NE time is lost due
to NE faults.

A.2.1.6 Synchronizing
the NE Time

To ensure that the NE


time is synchronized
correctly, the time
and time domain of
the NMS server must
be set correctly.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

l The manual NE
creation method
is applicable only
when several NEs
need to be created
on a large radio
transmission
network.

972

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

14.2 Common Task Collection (Radio Links)


This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with radio links.

CAUTION
When you add or modify the configurations of a radio link, you need to modify the configurations
of the NE that is located far from the NMS server and then modify the configurations of the NE
that is located near to the NMS server.
NOTE

l For 1+1 HSB/SD protection, you need to configure only the IF/ODU information of the main radio
link.
l For 1+1 FD protection, you need to configure the IF/ODU information of the main radio link and the
ODU information of the standby radio link.
l Before configuring XPIC workgroups, you need to set IF Service Type separately for IF boards in the
vertical polarization and those in horizontal polarization.
l For N+1 protection, you need to configure the IF/ODU information of the N+1 radio links respectively.
l The MW_CFG_MISMATCH alarm is reported, if the E1 count, AM enabled status, STM-1 count, or
modulation mode is set inconsistently for both ends of an Integrated IP radio link. This alarm should
be cleared immediately. Otherwise, services may be configured unsuccessfully or interrupted.

Table 14-2 Common task collection (radio links)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Changing the
radio working
mode of a
TDM radio link

You need to change the


radio working mode of
a TDM radio link, if the
TDM radio link does
not meet the service
capacity requirements.

1. A.5.6 Deleting CrossConnections

If the capacity of the


existing TDM
services exceeds the
capacity of the TDM
radio link after the
change, you need to
delete the crossconnections of the
excessive TDM
services.

2. A.3.4 Configuring
the IF/ODU
Information of a Radio
Link

Before you change


the radio working
mode, it is
recommended that
you consult the
network planning
department to check
whether the radio link
supports the new
radio working mode.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

973

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Configuring
the ATPC
function

The ATPC function


needs to be enabled for
the radio link or the
values of ATPC
parameters need to be
changed.

A.6.8.2 Configuring
ATPC Attributes

To enable the ATPC


function, set ATPC
Enable Status to
Enabled and change
other ATPC
parameter values
according to the
planning
information.

Changing the
transmit power

You can change the


transmit power if the
fading margin is
insufficient but the
transmit power can still
be increased.

A.3.4 Configuring the


IF/ODU Information
of a Radio Link

In Power Attributes
of the ODU, change
TX Power(dBm) or
parameter values
associated with
power.

Upgrading a 1
+0 radio link to
a 1+1 HSB/SD/
FD radio link

To improve reliability
of a 1+0 radio link,
upgrade the 1+0 radio
link to a 1+1 HSB/SD/
FD radio link.

1.A.3.1 Creating an IF
1+1 Protection Group

For IF 1+1
protection, the
original IF board
functions as the main
IF board.

2.A.3.4 Configuring the


IF/ODU Information
of a Radio Link

Ensure that TX
Status of the standby
ODU is Unmute.

A.6.8.6 Modifying the


Hybrid/AM Attributes

l Before using the


new modulation
scheme, contact
the network
planning
department to
confirm that the
Hybrid radio link
supports the new
Modulation
Mode of the
Guarantee AM
Capacity and
Modulation
Mode of the Full
AM Capacity.

Changing the
modulation
scheme of a
Hybrid radio
link

When the original


modulation scheme
does not meet the
service requirements,
you need to use another
modulation scheme.

l Ensure that the


parameter values
are the same at
both ends of the
Hybrid radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

974

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Changing the
number of E1s
on a Hybrid
radio link

To adjust the number


of E1s and Ethernet
bandwidth, you need to
change the number of
E1s on the Hybrid
radio link.

A.6.8.6 Modifying the


Hybrid/AM Attributes

l To reduce E1s
with high
priorities, you
need to delete the
corresponding
cross-connections
before changing
Guarantee E1
Capacity. The
change does not
affect other E1
services or cause
Ethernet service
interruptions.
l To increase E1s
with high
priorities, you
need to add the
corresponding
cross-connections
after changing
Guarantee E1
Capacity. The
change does not
affect other E1
services or cause
Ethernet service
interruptions.
NOTE
The number of
added E1s should
be within the
specified range.

l To reduce E1s
with low
priorities, you
need to delete the
corresponding
cross-connections
before changing
Full E1
Capacity. The
change does not
affect other E1
services or cause
Ethernet service
interruptions.
l To increase E1s
with low

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

975

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Task

Application
Scenario

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Configuration
Operation

Description
priorities, you
need to add the
corresponding
cross-connections
after changing
Full E1
Capacity. The
change does not
affect other E1
services or cause
Ethernet service
interruptions.
NOTE
The number of
added E1s should
be within the
specified range.

l The
MW_CFG_MIS
MATCH alarm
occurs when the
number of E1
services is
different on both
ends of the radio
link. The alarm
clears when the
number of E1
services is the
same on both ends
of the radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

976

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Changing the
priority of E1
services on a
Hybrid radio
link

You can change the


priority of E1 services
on a Hybrid radio link.

A.5.3 Modifying the


Priorities of E1
Services

l When you change


the priority of an
E1, the E1 is
interrupted
transiently.
l If the number of
E1s with high
priorities exceeds
the value of
Modulation
Mode of the
Guarantee AM
Capacity, you
need to increase
the value of
Modulation
Mode of the
Guarantee AM
Capacity before
changing the
priorities.

14.3 Common Task Collection (TDM Services)


This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with TDM services.
Table 14-3 Common task collection (TDM services)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Adding TDM
services

More TDM services


need to be accessed on
the network.

A.5.1 Creating the


Cross-Connections of
Point-to-Point Services
or A.5.2 Creating
Cross-Connections of
SNCP Services

Deleting TDM
services

If the line resources are


insufficient, you need
to delete the TDM
services that are not
used to release the
corresponding
resources.

A.5.6 Deleting CrossConnections

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

977

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration
Operation

Description

Upgrading an
unprotected
link to a linear
MSP link

Upgrade an
unprotected link to a
linear MSP link to
improve service
reliability.

A.4.1 Configuring
Linear MSP

In the case of linear


MSP, the existing
line port functions as
the working port.
Upgrading an
unprotected link to a
linear MSP link does
not interrupt the
existing services.

Upgrading
normal
services to
SNCP services

Upgrade normal
services to SNCP
services to improve
service reliability.

A.5.7 Converting a
Normal Service into an
SNCP Service

Only the normal


services in the
receive direction are
converted to SNCP
services. Therefore,
you need to configure
the unidirectional
cross-connections
from the SNCP
services to the
working trail and
from the SNCP
services to the
protection trail so that
the normal services
both in the receive
direction and in the
transmit direction are
converted to SNCP
services.

14.4 Common Task Collection (Packet-Plane Ethernet


Services)
This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with packet-plane Ethernet
services.
Table 14-4 Common task collection (Packet-plane Ethernet services)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration Operation

Description

Creating
Ethernet
services

Create the Ethernet


services according to
the service planning
information.

8 Configuring Native
Ethernet Services on the
Packet Plane

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

978

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration Operation

Description

Setting or
modifying the
parameters of
Ethernet ports

The service
requirements or
configuration at the
opposite end change.
As a result, the
parameters of the
Ethernet port need to be
changed.

A.6.6 Setting Ethernet Port


Parameters

Deleting
Ethernet
services

Delete the Ethernet


services that are not
used to release the
corresponding
resources.

A.7.3.13 Deleting an E-Line


Service or A.7.3.14 Deleting
E-LAN Services

Creating a
LAG

l When the available


bandwidth is
insufficient, you can
create a LAG to
increase the
bandwidth.

A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG

l When using
the LAG,
set the port
that is
configured
with
services to
the main
port.

l To improve link
reliability, you can
bind the links into a
LAG.

Changing
logical ports
connected to
an E-LAN

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The E-LAN service


requirements change.
As a result, the logical
ports connected to the
E-LAN need to be
changed.

l This
operation
briefly
interrupts
the existing
services.
A.7.3.12 Changing Logical
Ports Connected to a VB

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

You need to
add or delete a
logical port
connected to an
E-LAN, or
modify
attributes
associated with
a logical port
connected to
the E-LAN
according to the
actual planning
information.

979

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration Operation

Description

Managing the
MAC address
table

l To disable certain
MAC address hosts
to use E-LAN
services, you need
to create MAC
address blacklist
entries.

A.7.4 Managing the MAC


Address Table

A.7.7 Managing the QoS

Change the
values of QoS
parameters to
ensure that the
QoS control
adapts to the
changes in the
service
requirements.

l To prevent certain
MAC address
entries from being
aged, you need to
create static MAC
address entries.
l To disable the aging
function or modify
the default aging
time (five minutes),
you need to set the
aging parameters of
corresponding
MAC addresses.
Adjusting
QoS

The service
requirements change.
As a result, QoS needs
to be adjusted.

14.5 Task Collection (EoS/EoPDH-Plane Ethernet Services)


This section describes the common configuration tasks associated with EoS/EoPDH-plane
Ethernet services.
Table 14-5 Task Collection (EoS/EoPDH-plane Ethernet services)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration Operation

Remarks

Creating
Ethernet
services

Create the Ethernet


services according to
the service planning
information.

9 Configuring EoS/EoPDHBased Ethernet Services

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

980

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration Operation

Remarks

Setting or
modifying the
parameters of
Ethernet ports

The service
requirements or
configuration at the
opposite end change.
As a result, the
parameters of the
Ethernet port need to be
changed.

A.8.5 Configuring Ethernet


Ports

Deleting
Ethernet
services

Delete the Ethernet


services that are not
used to release the
corresponding
resources.

A.8.3.7 Deleting an Ethernet


Private Line Service or A.
8.3.8 Deleting an Ethernet
LAN Service

Creating a
LAG

l When the available


bandwidth is
insufficient, you can
create a LAG to
increase the
bandwidth.

A.8.2 Managing LAGs

l When using
the LAG,
set the port
that is
configured
with
services to
the main
port.

l To improve link
reliability, you can
bind the links into a
LAG.

Changing
logical ports
connected to a
VB

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The Ethernet LAN


service requirements
change. As a result, the
logical ports connected
to the VB need to be
changed.

l This
operation
briefly
interrupts
the existing
services.
A.8.3.3 Changing the Ports
Connected to a VB

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

You need to
add or delete
the logical port
connected to a
VB, or modify
attributes
associated with
the logical port
connected to
the VB
according to the
actual planning
information.

981

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

14 Adding and Modifying Configuration Data

Task

Application
Scenario

Configuration Operation

Remarks

Managing the
MAC address
table

l To disable certain
MAC address hosts
to use Ethernet LAN
services, you need
to create MAC
address blacklist
entries.

A.8.4 Managing the MAC


Address Table

A.8.8 Managing the QoS

Change the
values of QoS
parameters to
ensure that the
QoS control
adapts to the
changes in the
service
requirements.

l To prevent certain
MAC address
entries from being
aged, you need to
create static MAC
address entries.
l To disable the aging
function or modify
the default aging
time (five minutes),
you need to set the
aging parameters of
corresponding
MAC addresses.
Adjusting
QoS

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The service
requirements change.
As a result, QoS needs
to be adjusted.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

982

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Task Collection

This document describes various tasks involved in this document.


A.1 U2000 Quick Start
The U2000 quick start guide helps to learn about basic operations on the U2000 client.
A.2 Network Management
Network management involves topology management, communication management, and
security management.
A.3 Managing Radio Links
Before you configure the radio link between two microwave sites, configure the information
about the radio link.
A.4 Managing the MSP
The OptiX RTN 980 supports the linear MSP and ring MSP.
A.5 Managing TDM Services
The TDM services involve the SDH service and the PDH service.
A.6 Managing Ports
Setting correct port parameter is the basis of configuring ports that transmit services.
A.7 Configuring Ethernet Services and Features on the Packet Plane
Configurations of Ethernet services and features on the packet plane include Ethernet port,
protection, service, protocol, and OAM configurations.
A.8 Configuring Ethernet Services and Features on the EoS/EoPDH Plane
Configurations of Ethernet services and features on the EoS/EoPDH plane include relevant
Ethernet port configuration, protection configuration, service configuration, protocol
configuration, and OAM configuration.
A.9 Managing MPLS/PWE3 Services and Features
The OptiX RTN 980 supports multiple MPLS/PWE3 services and features.
A.10 Managing the Clock
To ensure the clock synchronization between transmission nodes on a transport network, you
need to manage the NE clock.
A.11 Using the RMON
Remote monitoring (RMON) is mainly used to monitor the data traffic on a network segment
or on the entire network. Currently, it is one of the widely used network management standards.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

983

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.12 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions


The auxiliary ports and functions supported by the OptiX RTN 980 include the orderwire,
synchronous data service, asynchronous data service, wayside E1 service, external alarm.
A.13 End-to-End Configuration Task Collection
End-to-end configuration is simpler than per-NE configuration.
A.14 Verifying Services and Features
This topic describes how to verify service and feature configurations.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

984

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.1 U2000 Quick Start


The U2000 quick start guide helps to learn about basic operations on the U2000 client.

A.1.1 Logging in to a U2000 Client


The U2000 uses the client/server architecture and allows multiple clients; you can log in to the
U2000 server by means of a U2000 client to manage OptiX RTN NEs.

Prerequisite
l

The U2000 system has been started on the U2000 server.

The IP address of the U2000 client is in the access control list (ACL) configured in the
U2000 system.

The U2000 client has proper communication with the U2000 server.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Double-click the U2000 client icon on the desktop.
Step 2 In the Login dialog box, set User Name and Password.
Step 3 Select the desired U2000 server from the Server drop-down list.
Step 4 Click Login.
You are logging in to the U2000 system.
----End

A.1.2 Shutting Down a U2000 Client


Shut down the U2000 client when it is not used any longer.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Exit from the Main Menu.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Click OK to shut down the U2000 client.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

985

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

If the main topology has changed but the changes have not been stored, a dialog box will be displayed
asking whether to update the main topology. The U2000 client is shut down after you determine whether
to update the main topology.

----End

A.1.3 Using Online Help


Online Help provides help information about the U2000.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Help > Help Topics from the Main Menu.
The Online Help page is displayed.
TIP

When using the U2000 client, press the F1 key to quickly display the related Online Help page.

----End

A.1.4 Navigating to Common Views


This section describes the main views on the U2000 and their functions.

A.1.4.1 Navigating to the Main Topology


The U2000 provides the Main Topology view to support network topology management.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

986

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Choose View > Main Topology from the Main Menu, or double-click the Main Topology icon
in Workbench.
The Main Topology view is displayed.
Step 2 Optional: Choose View > Display Settings > Filter from the Main Menu.
The Filter tab page is displayed on the right of the main topology.
Figure A-1 Main topology
TIP

To quickly navigate to the Main Topology view, click

----End

A.1.4.2 Navigating to the NE Explorer


The U2000 provides the NE Explorer view to support users' management on equipment. The
NE Explorer view consists of the Function Tree pane, the Object Tree pane, and the
configuration interface.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Optional: In Main Topology, double-click the subnet to which the NE belongs.
Step 2 In Main Topology, right-click the icon of the desired NE and choose NE Explorer from the
shortcut menu.
The NE Explorer view is displayed.
Figure A-2 NE explorer
TIP

l To quickly navigate to NE Explorer, click

l To quickly navigate to the NE Panel view, click


l To quickly navigate to Online Help, click

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

987

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.1.4.3 Navigating to the NE Panel


NE Panel displays the boards configured on the NE. Different colors of the boards represent
different board states.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Optional: In Main Topology, double-click the subnet to which the NE belongs.
Step 2 Double-click the icon of the desired NE in Main Topology.
NE Panel is displayed.
TIP

l To quickly navigate to the NE Explorer view, click


l To quickly synchronize the NE time, click

----End

A.2 Network Management


Network management involves topology management, communication management, and
security management.

A.2.1 Managing NEs


Before you configure NEs, ensure that the NEs can be managed on the NMS.

A.2.1.1 Creating NEs by Using the Search Method


The U2000 can find all NEs that communicate with a specific gateway NE by using the IP address
of the gateway NE, the IP address range of the gateway NE, or the NSAP addresses. In addition,
the U2000 can create the NEs that are found in batches. Compared with the method of manually
creating NEs, this method is faster and more reliable.

Prerequisite
l

The NMS must have proper communication with NEs.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

988

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Discovery > NE from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Select Transport NE Search tab.
Step 3 Select Search Mode.
NOTE

l If the U2000 server and the gateway NE are in the same network segment, it is recommended that you set
Search Mode to IP auto discovery.
l In other scenarios, it is recommended that you set Search Mode to Search for NE.

If...

Then...

Search Mode is set to Search for NE

Perform Step 4 to Step 7.

Search Mode is set to IP auto discovery

Perform Step 8 to Step 10.

Step 4 If Search Mode is set to Search for NE, you need to add a search domain.
1.

Click Add, and then the Input Search Domain dialog box is displayed.

2.

Select an address type and enter the search address.

NOTE

l When Address Type is set to NSAP Address, ensure that the OSI protocol stack software is installed
on the U2000.
l When Address Type is set to IP Address of GNE or IP Address Range of GNE, and the U2000
server and gateway NE are not in the same network segment, ensure that the IP routes of the network
segments to which the U2000 server and gateway NE belong are configured on the U2000 and related
routers.

3.

Click OK.

Step 5 Repeat Step 4 to add several search domains.


Step 6 In the Search for NE dialog box, perform the operations described in the Note part.
NOTE

l If Create NE after search is selected, you need to specify NE User and Password.
l You can select either Create NE after search or Upload after Create or both Create NE after search and
Upload after Create. In this manner, after the NE searching is complete, the system automatically creates
an NE and uploads the NE.

Step 7 Click Next, and then the Transport NE Search dialog box is displayed.
After the search is complete, all the NEs that are found are displayed in the Result list.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

989

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 8 If Search Mode is set to IP auto discovery, enter NE User and Password.

Step 9 Click Next to navigate to the search interface.


Step 10 After the NE to be created is displayed in Result, click Stop. In the dialog box that is displayed,
click Yes.
Step 11 Create NEs.
1.

Select an NE that is not created from the Result list.

2.

Optional: Select the GNE ID of the NE.

3.

Click Create.
The Create dialog box is displayed.

4.

Specify User Name and Password.

5.

Click OK.
The icon of the created NE is displayed in the Main Topology.

Step 12 Optional: Repeat Step 11 to create other NEs that are not created.
----End

A.2.1.2 Creating NEs by Using the Manual Method


You can only create NEs one by one by using the manual method. The manual method, unlike
the search method, does not allow creating NEs in batches.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The NMS must have proper communication with the NE to be created.

If the NE to be created is a non-gateway NE, the gateway NE to which the NE to be created


belongs must be created.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

990

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Creat > NE from the Main Menu.
The Create NE dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Choose RTN Series > OptiX RTN 980 from the Object Tree.
Step 3 Enter the following information: ID, Extended ID, Name, and Remarks.
Step 4 Set Gateway Type for the NE.
If...

Then...

The Gateway Type parameter is set to


Gateway

Proceed to the next step.

The Gateway Type parameter is set to Non- Select the gateway to which the NE belongs,
Gateway
and go to Step 6.
Step 5 Specify the protocol and IP address that the NE uses.
If...

Then...

If the Protocol parameter is set to IP

Enter the IP Address of the NE.

If the Protocol parameter is set to OSI

Enter the NSAP Address of the NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

991

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Specify NE User and Password.


The default user name is root and the default password is password.
Step 7 Click OK.
Step 8 Click the Main Topology.
The icon of the NE is displayed at the cursor position.
----End

Related References
B.1.1.2 Parameter Description: NE Creation

A.2.1.3 Configuring the Logical Board


If the logical board corresponding to the physical board is not added in the slot layout, add the
logical board in the slot layout. If the physical board is inconsistent with the logical board in the
slot layout, delete the inconsistent logical board and add the correct logical board.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

All the boards must be installed correctly.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Double-click the NE icon to open the NE layout diagram.
Step 2 Optional: On the slot to which the board is to be added, right-click, and then choose Add
XXX.
NOTE

XXX is the name of the board to be added.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

992

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Optional: On the slot to which the board is to be deleted, right-click, and then choose Delete.
1.

In the displayed confirmation dialog box, click OK.

2.

In the dialog box that is displayed again for confirmation, click OK.

NOTE

Before deleting the board, delete the data, such as the service, clock, orderwire, and protection, on the
board.

Step 4 Optional: Configure the optical module type for the SL4D board.
1.

Click the optical module on the SL4D board.

2.

Right-click and choose Add Port from the shortcut menu.

3.

Set Level for Port according to the type of the optical module on the SL4D board.

4.

Click OK.

----End

A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID


Change the NE ID according to the engineering plan to guarantee that each NE ID is unique.
This operation task does not interrupt services.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, right-click the NE whose ID needs to be changed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

993

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Choose Object Attributes.


The Attribute dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click the NE Attribute[xxx] tab.
NOTE

xxx indicates the current name of the NE.

Step 4 Click Modify NE ID.


The Modify NE ID dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Specify New ID and New Extended ID.

Step 6 Click OK.


A dialog box is displayed for confirmation, click OK.
Step 7 Click OK.
----End

Related References
B.1.1.3 Parameter Description: Attribute_Changing NE IDs

A.2.1.5 Changing the NE Name


To better identify the NE in the Main Topology, name the NE according to the NE geographical
location or the device connected to the NE.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, select the NE whose name is to be changed.
Step 2 Right-click on this NE, and then choose Object Attributes from the shortcut menu. The
Attributes dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click the NE Attribute [xxx] tab.
NOTE

xxx is the current name of the NE.

Step 4 Enter the name of the NE in Name.


NOTE

The name of an NE cannot contain any space or characters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

994

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK. Close the dialog box indicating the operation result.
The new name of the NE is displayed below the NE icon in the Main Topology.
----End

A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time


By setting the NE time to be synchronous with the time on the NMS or standard NTP server,
you can record the exact time when alarms and abnormal events occur.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

When you need to synchronize the NE time with the time on the NMS server, the time zone
and time must be set correctly on the PC or server running the NMS software.

When you need to synchronize the NE time with the time on the NTP server, the time on
the NTP server must be set correctly and the NTP protocol must be normal.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Synchronization from the
Main Menu.
Step 2 Click the NE Time Synchronization tab.
Step 3 In the physical view, select the NE whose time needs to be synchronized, and then click
.
Step 4 After the operation is complete, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is
successful. Click Close.
Step 5 When you need to synchronize the NE time with the NMS time, set the time synchronization
mode and the related parameters.
1.

Optional: The NE time is synchronized with the NMS time immediately.


a.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Right-click the NE whose time needs to be synchronized, and then choose


Synchronize with NM Time from the shortcut menu.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

995

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

b.

In the displayed confirmation dialog box, click Yes.

c.

Close the displayed operation result dialog box.

2.

Set Synchronous Mode to NM.

3.

Click Apply.

4.

Optional: Set auto synchronization parameters.


a.

Set auto synchronization parameters.

b.

Click Apply.

c.

In the displayed confirmation dialog box, click Yes.

d.

Close the displayed operation result dialog box.

A Task Collection

NOTE

l When you need to synchronize the NE time with the NMS time, set Synchronous Mode to NM.
l When you need to synchronize the NE time with the time on the NTP server, set Synchronous Mode to
Standard NTP. Configure Standard NTP Authentication according to the requirements of the NTP server.

Step 6 When you need to synchronize the NE time with the time on the NTP server, set the time
synchronization mode and the related parameters.
1.

Set Synchronous Mode to Standard NTP.

2.

Configure Standard NTP Authentication according to the requirements of the NTP


server.

3.

Click Apply.

4.

Click Close. The dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result is closed.

5.

Configure the upper-layer NTP server.


a.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Select the NE, right-click in the configuration box where the standard NTP server is
configured, and then choose New.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

996

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6.

b.

Configure the parameters related to the NTP server.

c.

Click Apply.

d.

Close the displayed operation result dialog box.

A Task Collection

Optional: Copy the configuration of the upper-layer NTP server.


NOTE

Before the copy operation, set Synchronous Mode to Standard NTP for the source NE and the target
NE.

a.

Select the NE to be copied, right-click, and then choose Copy Standard NTP
Server.

b.

Select the NE to be pasted, right-click, and then choose Paste Standard NTP
Server.

c.

In the displayed confirmation dialog box, click Yes.

d.

Close the displayed operation result dialog box.

----End

Related References
B.1.1.4 Parameter Description: NE Time Synchronization
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

997

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.1.7 Localizing the NE Time


When the daylight saving time (DST) is used in the area where the NE is located, you need to
localize the NE time to synchronize the NE time with the local time.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Localization Management
from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Select the NE for time localization management from the Object Tree, and then click
.
Step 3 Click the Time Zone drop-down list, and then set the time zone of the NE.
Step 4 Optional: Click DST, and then configure the related parameters.
Step 5 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End

Related References
B.1.1.5 Parameter Description: Localization Management of the NE Time

A.2.1.8 Configuring Standard NTP Keys


When the NE time is synchronized with the time on the NTP server and the identity
authentication is required, configure NTP keys.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Synchronous Mode must be set to Standard NTP and Standard NTP Authentication
must be set to Enabled.

The NTP protocol must be running properly and the NTP identity authentication must be
enabled on the NTP server.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

998

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Synchronization from the
Main Menu.
Step 2 Click the Standard NTP Key Management tab.
Step 3 In the physical view, select the NE whose NTP keys need to be configured, and then click
.
Step 4 Click Add.
The Add Key and Password dialog box is displayed.

Step 5 After the related parameters are configured, click OK.


----End

Related References
B.1.1.6 Parameter Description: Standard NTP Key Management

A.2.2 Configuring the NE Data


If an NE is not configured after being created successfully, you need to configure the NE data
so that the NMS can manage this NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

999

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.2.1 Uploading the NE Data


Uploading the NE data is commonly used for configuring the NE data. By uploading the NE
data, the data such as the configuration, alarm, and performance data of the NE is uploaded to
the NMS.

Prerequisite
l

An NE must be logged in to successfully.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding operation steps according to the NE status.
If...

Then...

An NE is not configured and the NE data


needs to be uploaded.

In the Main Topology, double-click the NE


that is not configured, and then perform Step
2 through Step 4.

An NE is configured with data and NE data Perform Step 5 through Step 8.


needs to be uploaded.
Step 2 In the displayed NE Configuration Wizard dialog box, select Upload, and then click Next.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.
Step 3 Click OK.
Step 4 Click Close.
Step 5 Choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu.
Step 6 Select the NE whose data needs to be uploaded from the Object Tree, and then click

Step 7 Select the NE, click Upload. In the displayed confirmation dialog box, click OK.
The uploading is started. After the uploading is complete, the Operation Result dialog box is
displayed.
Step 8 Click Close.
----End

A.2.2.2 Synchronizing NE Data


Synchronizing NE data is uploading the NE-side data that is different from the NMS-side data
(including conflicting data and absent data) to the NMS.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1000

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

The NE is created.

The NE is in unsynchronized state.

A Task Collection

NOTE

When an NE is in unsynchronized state, it carries the

mark.

Procedure
Step 1 Method 1:
1.

Choose Configuration > Synchronize NE Data from the Main Menu.

2.

Select one or more NEs from the NE list, and click

3.

Select one or more unsynchronized NEs, and then click the Synchronize button or select
Synchronize from the shortcut menu.
The NMS starts synchronizing the configuration data.

Step 2 Method 2:
1.

In the Main Topology, select the NE with the mark, right-click it, and choose
Synchronize NE Data from the shortcut menu.
The system displays the Synchronize NE Data dialog box, indicating that the system starts
synchronizing the configuration data.

Step 3 Method 3:
1.

Choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu.

2.

Select one or more NEs from the NE list, and click

3.

Select one or more unsynchronized NEs, and then click the Synchronize button or select
Synchronize from the shortcut menu.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

4.

Click OK.
The NMS starts synchronizing the configuration data.

----End

A.2.3 Configuring the Performance Monitoring Status of NEs


By performing this operation task, you can manually enable or disable performance monitoring
for NEs, or set the performance monitoring period.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree, and then choose Performance > NE
Performance Monitoring Time from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1001

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Configure the performance monitoring parameters of the NEs.


1.

Select 15-Minute or 24-Hour.

2.

Select Enabled or Disabled in Set 15-Minute Monitoring or Set 24-Hour Monitoring.

3.

Set the start time and end time of the performance monitoring of NEs.
NOTE

l Generally, both Set 15-Minute Monitoring and Set 24-Hour Monitoring are enabled.
l You can specify the start time of the performance monitoring function, only after selecting Enabled
in the Set 15-Minute Monitoring or Set 24-Hour Monitoring area.
l You can specify the end time of the performance monitoring function, only after selecting Enabled
and then selecting To in the Set 15-Minute Monitoring or Set 24-Hour Monitoring area.

4.

Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End

A.2.4 Suppressing Alarms for Monitored Objects


This section describes how to suppress specific alarms for a specific monitored object.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired board.
Step 2 Choose Alarm > Alarm Suppression from the Function Tree.
Step 3 Set Monitored Object and click Query.
Step 4 Set Status in Alarm Suppression.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1002

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click Apply.


Step 6 Close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

A.2.5 Connecting Fibers or Cables


To implement the end-to-end management on the NMS, you need to connect fibers or cables.

A.2.5.1 Creating Optical Fibers by Using the Search Method


By searching for optical fibers, the NMS can detect the information about optical fibers that are
connected to specific IF ports or SDH ports and therefore quickly create optical fibers. The
search-and-create method is the most common method for creating radio links and optical
fibers.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The SDH/IF boards of various NEs must be created on the NMS.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Discovery > Fiber from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Select the board of the NE on which the fiber needs to be searched for or the IF board of the NE
on which radio links need to be searched for from the Subject Tree.
Step 3 Click Search.
NOTE

l If Do not search the ports with Fiber/Cable created on NMS is selected, the port whose optical
transmission line or radio link is created is not searched on the NMS.
l If you need to check whether the connection of an optical transmission line or a radio link is the same
as the actual connection of the optical transmission line or radio link, do not select Do not search the
ports with Fiber/Cable created on NMS.
l If Do not search the ports with Fiber/Cable created on NMS is selected and all the selected ports
are created with optical transmission lines or radio links, a dialog box is displayed after the search,
indicating that the search domain is null.

Step 4 After the operation is complete, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is
successful. Click Close.
Step 5 In Physical Fiber/Cable Link List, select one or multiple optical transmission lines or radio
links, and then click Create Fiber/Cable.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1003

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l When you select one or multiple optical transmission lines or radio links from Physical Fiber/Cable
Link List, the conflicting optical transmission lines or radio links are automatically displayed in
Logical Fiber/Cable Link List. In this manner, you need to delete these conflicting optical
transmission lines or radio links by referring to Step 6, and then create the links.
l When you create optical transmission lines or radio links, No fiber to create is displayed if the
selected optical transmission lines or radio links are in the Already created state.

Step 6 When you select one or multiple conflicting optical transmission lines or radio links from
Logical Fiber/Cable Link List, click Delete Fiber/Cable.
----End

Follow-up Procedure
If the information about the optical transmission lines or radio links that are created using the
search method is incomplete, you can supplement the information by changing the information
about the optical transmission lines or radio links.

A.2.5.2 Creating Fibers Manually


You can create a fiber by specifying the ports connected by the fiber. This method can be used
for creating SDH fibers, radio links , Ethernet links and E1 links. Ethernet links and E1 links
cannot be created by using the search and create method.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The relevant boards of various NEs must be created on the NMS.

The resources of port IP addresses must be created if the automatic allocation of port IP
addresses is enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, select the icon

. Then, the cursor is displayed as "+".

Step 2 Click the source NE of a fiber in the Main Topology.


Step 3 In the Select Fiber/Cable Source dialog box, select the source board and source port.
Step 4 Click OK. In the Main Topology, the cursor is displayed as "+".
Step 5 Click the sink NE of the fiber in the Main Topology.
Step 6 In the Select Fiber/Cable Sink dialog box, select the sink board and sink port.
Step 7 Click OK. Set the attributes of the fiber in the Create Fiber/Cable dialog box.
Step 8 Click OK. Then, the created fiber is displayed between the source NE and the sink NE in the
Main Topology.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1004

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.5.3 Creating an Extended ECC


Extended ECC connections indicate that the inter-NE DCN communication is implemented
through concatenated NM ports.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Create > Link from the Main Menu. The Create Link dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Choose Link > Extended ECC.
Step 3 Configure the attributes of the created extended ECC according to the data plan.

Step 4 Click OK.


In the Main Topology, the created extended ECC is displayed between the source NE and the
sink NE.
----End

A.2.5.4 Creating a Back-to-Back Radio Connection


Back-to-back radio connections indicate the stacking of multiple OptiX RTN NEs on one site.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, choose File > Create > Link.
The Create Link dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1005

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Select Fiber/Cable > Microwave Back To Back.


Step 3 Select the source NE from the drop-down list of Source NE.
Step 4 Select the sink NE from the drop-down list of Sink NE.
Step 5 Configure the attributes of the back-to-back radio connection.

Step 6 Click OK.


The created back-to-back radio connection is displayed in the Main Topology.
----End

A.2.6 Managing Subnets


To facilitate NE management, you can allocate the NEs that are in the same domain or have
similar attributes into the same subnet.

A.2.6.1 Creating a Subnet


In the Main Topology, you can create a subnet object and allocate an NE to this subnet.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, right-click, and then choose New > Subnet.
The Create Physical Subnet dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Click the Property tab.
Step 3 Enter the attributes of the subnet.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1006

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click the Select Object tab, select a created NE from Available Objects, and then click
to add the NE to Selected Objects.

NOTE

l Click

to add the selected object in the left pane to the right pane.

l Click

to add all the objects in the left pane to the right pane.

Step 5 Click OK.


Step 6 In the Main Topology, click in a blank area, and then the created subnet is displayed in the
position where you click.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1007

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.6.2 Copying Topology Objects


In the current topology, you can copy topology objects from one subnet to another subnet.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, right-click the NE or subnet that needs to be copied.
Step 2 Choose Edit > Copy to.
The Select a Parent Subnet dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Select the subnet that the NE or subnet needs to be pasted to.
Step 4 Click OK.
----End

A.2.6.3 Moving Topology Objects


In the current topology, you can move topology objects from one subnet to another subnet.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, right-click the NE or subnet that needs to be moved.
Step 2 Choose Edit > Move to.
The Select the path of Parent Subnet dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Select the subnet that the NE or subnet needs to be moved to.
Step 4 Click OK.
----End

A.2.7 Managing Communication


To manage the NE by the NMS, ensure that the DCN communication is working properly.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1008

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.7.1 Setting NE Communication Parameters


The communication parameters of an NE include the IP address of the NE, the gateway IP
address, and the subnet mask.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication >
Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Configure the communication parameters of the NE.
Step 3 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.
NOTE

If configuring multiple parameters, click Apply for each instance.

----End

Related References
B.1.2.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1009

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.7.2 Configuring DCCs


To meet the requirements for managing a complex network, you need to set the channel type,
protocol type, or enable status of the DCCs according to the network plan.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the DCC Rate Configuration tab.
Step 3 Optional: Change the enable status of the DCC.
1.

Double-click the cell in the Enabled/Disabled column to which the DCC corresponds.
Select the required state from the drop-down list.

2.

Click Apply.

Step 4 Optional: Change the protocol type of the DCC.


1.

Double-click the cell in the Protocol Type column to which the DCC corresponds. Select
the required protocol type from the drop-down list.

2.

Click Apply.

NOTE

l On the NMS interface, the first port on the system control, switching, and clock board (like 20CSHN-1) corresponds to its external clock port.
l If the port is connected to the other ECC subnet, Enabled/Disabled is set to Disabled.
l If the port is connected to a third-party network and does not exchange the network management
information with other ports, Enabled/Disabled is set to Disabled.
l Set Protocol Type based on the management protocol used by the DCN solution.
l If a DCC port is a non-backbone area port on the ABR, set IP Address and Subnet Mask of the DCC
port. In addition, it is recommended that you set the interface IP address to be in a network segment
from the NE IP address.

Step 5 Optional: Create DCCs.


1.

Click Create.
The Create dialog box is displayed.

2.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set the attributes of the DCC.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1010

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

Set Protocol Type based on the management protocol used by the DCN solution.

3.

Click OK.

----End

Related References
B.1.2.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Rate Configuration

A.2.7.3 Configuring DCC Transparent Transmission


The OptiX equipment supports the DCC transparent transmission function. With this function,
the equipment can transparently transmit NM messages when the OptiX equipment is used
together with other equipment to form a network and can also transparently transmit the NM
messages between ECC subnets.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
The DCC bytes required by the transparent transmission function must not be used.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the DCC Transparent Transmission Management tab.
Step 3 Click Create.
Then, the Create DCC Trarnsparent Transmission Byte dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the DCC transparent transmission byte.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1011

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.3 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Transparent Transmission
Management

A.2.7.4 Configuring the VLAN ID and Bandwidth Used by an Inband DCN


The VLAN ID used by an inband DCN must be different from the VLAN ID used by services
and the bandwidth by an inband DCN must meet the requirements of the transmission network
for managing messages.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCN
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Bandwidth Management tab.
Step 3 Set the VLAN ID and bandwidth used by an inband DCN.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1012

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l If the default VLAN ID of the inband DCN conflicts with the VLAN ID in the service, the Ethernet Board
VLAN ID of the inband DCN can be changed manually. The same VLAN ID must be, however, is used on
the network-wide inband DCN.
l Bandwidth(Kbit/s) specifies the bandwidth for inband DCN messaging on the Ethernet link.
l IF Port Bandwidth(Kbit/s) specifies the bandwidth for inband DCN messaging on the radio link.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.20 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Bandwidth Management

A.2.7.5 Configuring the Priority of Inband DCN Packets


This section describes how to set the VLAN priority and DSCP value carried by inband DCN
packets.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > DCN Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Packet Control tab.
Step 3 Specifies the priority of inband DCN packets.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.23 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Packet Control

A.2.7.6 Setting Parameters of Inband DCN


Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1013

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCN
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Settings tab.
Step 3 Optional: Select FE/GE, configure the port parameters for the inband DCN function.
NOTE

l Enabled Status specifies the enabling status of the port.


l The network management information can be transmitted over the inband DCN when the DCN function is
enabled for the ports at both ends of a link.

Step 4 Click Apply.


Step 5 Optional: Select IF, configure the port parameters for the inband DCN function.
NOTE

l Enabled Status specifies the enabling status of the port.


l The network management information can be transmitted over the inband DCN when the DCN function is
enabled for the ports at both ends of a link.

Step 6 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.21 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Port Setting

A.2.7.7 Configuring Access Control


When the equipment is connected to the NMS through an Ethernet service port, you need to
configure access control.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose Communication >
DCN Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Access Control tab.
Step 3 Set the parameters for configuring access control.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1014

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l If the Enabled Status is set to Enabled, this port can be used to support access of the management
information from the NMS.
l If the Enabled Status is set to Disabled, this port cannot be used to support access of the management
information from the NMS.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.22 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Access Control

A.2.7.8 Configuring Extended ECC Communication


If there is no DCC between two or more NEs, you can connect the Ethernet NM ports or NE
cascading ports on the system control boards of the NEs to achieve extended ECC
communication.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

Context
The default extended ECC mode is Auto mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Click an NE in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > ECC Management from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Optional: You can disable the Auto mode function of the extended ECC.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1015

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

1.

A Task Collection

Click Stop.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

2.

Click OK.

Step 3 Optional: Set parameters for the extended ECC function in Specified mode at the server end.
1.

Set ECC Extended Mode to Specified mode.

2.

Set related parameters for the server end.

3.

Click Apply.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

4.

Click OK.

Step 4 Set parameters for the extended ECC function in Specified mode at the client end.
1.

Set ECC Extended Mode to Specified mode.

2.

Set related parameters for the client end.

3.

Click Apply.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

4.

Click OK.

Step 5 Enable the automatic extended ECC function.


NOTE

Before enabling the automatic extended ECC function, you need to clear related parameters that are configured
in Specified mode for the server end and client end.

1.

Set ECC Extended Mode to Specified mode.

2.

To clear parameters configured for the server end, click Clear Server.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

3.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click OK.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1016

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

To clear parameters configured for the client end, click Clear Client.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

5.

Click OK.

6.

Set ECC Extended Mode to Auto mode.

7.

Click Apply.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click OK.

----End

Related References
B.1.2.4 Parameter Description: ECC Management_Ethernet Port Extended ECC

A.2.7.9 Creating Static IP Routes


When dynamic routes fail to meet the planning requirements, you need to create the
corresponding static IP routes manually.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP Protocol
Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IP Route Management tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create an IP Route dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the static IP route.

NOTE

The created static route has a lower priority than a dynamic route.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1017

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.1.2.8 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management Creation

A.2.7.10 Setting OSPF Protocol Parameters


When the OptiX RTN equipment is interconnected with third-party equipment, routing protocol
communication works properly after you set OSPF protocol parameters of the OptiX RTN
equipment based on related requirements of the third-party equipment.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP Protocol
Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OSPF Parameter Settings tab.
Step 3 Set the parameters of the OSPF protocol.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1018

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

Set the parameters according to the network plan.

Step 4 Click Apply.


Step 5 Optional: Set OSPF parameters for DCC channels.
1.

Click the Port OSPF Parameter Settings tab.

2.

Set the OSPF parameters for DCC channels.

3.

Click Apply.

----End

Related References
B.1.2.10 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_OSPF Parameter Settings

A.2.7.11 Creating an OSPF Area


When an NE functions as an ABR, you need to create the non-backbone area to which the ABR
belongs.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The New dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the new OSPF area.

NOTE

Set parameters according to network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1019

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.13 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas_Adding OSPF Areas

A.2.7.12 Configuring the Network Information of an ABR


This section describes how to add or modify the Network information of an ABR.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.
Step 3 Optional: Add a Network to an OSPF area.
1.

In Network Segment, click Add.


The Add dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set the IP address and subnet mask of the new Network.

NOTE

Set parameters according to network planning information.

3.

Click OK.

Step 4 Optional: Change a Network of an OSPF area.


1.

In Network Segment, change the IP address and subnet mask of the target Network.

2.

Click Apply.

----End

Related References
B.1.2.12 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas

A.2.7.13 Creating a Manual Route Aggregation Group


An NE supports a maximum of eight manual route aggregation groups.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1020

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.
Step 3 Disable the automatic route aggregation function in an area.
1.

In OSPF Area, select the area where routes need to be manually aggregated and set
Automatic Route Aggregation to Disabled.

2.

Click Apply.

Step 4 In Manual Route Aggregation, click Add.


The Add dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Set the IP address and subnet mask of the Network where routes are manually aggregated.

NOTE

Set parameters according to network planning information.

Step 6 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.14 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas_Adding Routes to Be
Manually Aggregated

A.2.7.14 Configuring Interface IP Addresses of an ABR


If a port on an ABR does not belong to the backbone area, you need to configure an interface
IP address for the port.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1021

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Optional: Set the interface IP address for the DCC port.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the DCC Rate Configuration tab.

3.

Set the IP address and subnet mask for each DCC port.

NOTE

This parameter is available only if Protocol Type of the DCC port is TCP/IP.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 2 Optional: Set the interface IP address for the inband DCN port.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCN
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Settings tab.

3.

Select FE/GE or IF and set the IP address and subnet mask for each inband DCN port.

NOTE

This parameter is available only if Protocol Type of the inband DCN port is IP.

4.

Click Apply.

----End

Related References
B.1.2.21 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Port Setting
B.1.2.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Rate Configuration

A.2.7.15 Configuring the OSPF Authentication Type


This section describes how to configure the authentication type and the authentication passwords
for different port types when different authentication types are used.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1022

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP Protocol
Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OSPF Parameter Settings tab.
Step 3 Set the OSPF authentication type.
1.

Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.

2.

In OSPF Area, change the value of Authentication Type of the desired OSPF area.

NOTE

none indicates no authentication.

3.

Click Apply.

Step 4 Set the passwords used for different types of DCN ports when different OSPF authentication
types are used.

NOTE

l If Authentication Type is set to none, all preset authentication passwords are cleared.
l MD5 Key is available only when Authentication Type is MD5.

Step 5 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.12 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas

A.2.7.16 Enabling the Proxy ARP


The proxy ARP enables the NEs in the same network segment but different domains to
communicate with each other.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP Protocol
Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Proxy ARP tab.
Step 3 Set the enable status of the proxy ARP.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1023

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l The proxy ARP enables the NEs in the same network segment but different domains to communicate with
each other.
l To realize communication between such NEs, the source NE sends the ARP broadcast packet to address the
route to the destination NE. The NE with the proxy ARP function enabled checks the routing table after
sensing the ARP broadcast packet. If the routing table contains the destination address that the ARP broadcast
packet looks for, the NE returns an ARP spoofing packet, which enables the NE that sends the ARP broadcast
packet to consider that the MAC address of the NE that returns the ARP spoofing packet is the MAC address
of the destination NE. In this manner, the packet that is to be sent to the destination NE is first sent to the
NE with the proxy ARP function enabled and then forwarded to the destination NE.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.11 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack_Proxy ARP

A.2.7.17 Configuring the CLNS Role


When the CLNS role of an NE is L1, the NE is involved in the routes in the area. When the
CLNS role of an NE is L2, the NE is involved in the routes between areas. By default, the CLNS
role of the OptiX RTN 980 is L1.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Network Layer Parameters tab.
Step 3 Set the CLNS role of the NE.

NOTE

When Configuration Role is set to L2, the NE has the functions of the L1 role and the L2 role.

Step 4 Click Apply.


The system displays the prompt.
Step 5 Click Yes.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1024

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.1.2.16 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Network Layer Parameter

A.2.7.18 Configuring the OSI Tunnel


The OSI tunnel function involves the creation of a virtual LAPD channel between the NEs on
the IP network. In this manner, the network management message encapsulated in compliance
with the OSI protocol can be transparently transmitted.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OSI Tunnel tab.
Step 3 Click New.
Then, the Create OSI Tunnel dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set Remote IP Address and LAPD Actor.

Step 5 Click OK.


Step 6 Configure the attributes of the OSI tunnel according to the network planning.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1025

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 7 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.18 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Tunnel

A.2.7.19 Configuring OSI Port Parameters


This section describes how to configure OSI port parameters.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Communication >
OSI Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Parameters tab.
Step 3 Set LAPD Role and LAPD MTU.
Step 4 Click Apply.
----End

Related References
B.1.2.19 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Port Parameters

A.2.7.20 Enabling/Disabling the RSTP Protocol When the L2 DCN Solution Is Used
The RSTP protocol improves stability of an L2 DCN.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > L2DCN Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1026

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Set Config Status.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.1.2.24 Parameter Description: L2 DCN Management

A.2.7.21 Querying ECC Routes


By querying ECC routes, you can check whether the correct HWECC solution is configured and
whether the communication between NEs works properly.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > NE ECC
Link Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Check whether the ECC route and related parameters are set correctly in NE ECC Link
Management List.
----End

Related References
B.1.2.5 Parameter Description: NE ECC Link Management

A.2.7.22 Querying IP Routes


By querying IP routes, you can check whether the IP DCN solution and inband DCN solution
are configured correctly and whether the communication between NEs works properly.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1027

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP Protocol
Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IP Route Management tab.
Step 3 Click Query.
Step 4 Check whether the IP routes and related parameters in the routing table are in accordance with
the plan.
----End

Related References
B.1.2.7 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management

A.2.7.23 Querying OSI Routes


By querying OSI routes, you can check whether the OSI over DCC solution is configured
correctly and whether the communication between NEs is normal.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Routing Table tab.
Step 3 Check whether the information in Link Adjacency Table meets the planning requirements.
Step 4 Click the L1 Routing tab to check whether the information about the L1 routes is correct.
Step 5 Click the L2 Routing tab to check whether the information about the L2 routes is correct.
----End

Related References
B.1.2.17 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Routing Table
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1028

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.7.24 Verifying Connectivity of an ECC Network


For a HWECC network, connectivity between two NEs can be verified by means of a ping or
traceroute test.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > NE ECC Link Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Reachability Test and choose Ping Test or Trace Route from the drop-down menu.
The Ping Test or Trace Route dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set test parameters.
Step 4 Click Start Test.
The test result is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.1.2.6 Parameter Description: ECC Link Management_Availability Test

A.2.7.25 Verifying Connectivity of an IP DCN Network


For an IP DCN network, connectivity between two NEs can be verified by means of a ping or
traceroute test.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > IP Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Reachability Test and choose Ping Test or Trace Route from the drop-down menu.
The Ping Test or Trace Route dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set test parameters.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1029

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Start Test.


The test result is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.1.2.9 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_Availability Test

A.2.7.26 Configuring the Active and Standby Gateway NEs


This section describes how to configure the active and standby gateway NEs in a DCN network,
therefore improving network reliability.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > DCN Management from the Main Menu.
The Filter dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Click OK.
Step 3 Click the NE tab.
Step 4 Select the NE for which the standby gateway NE needs to be configured, double-click GNE2,
and select the desired standby gateway NE from the drop-down list.

TIP

l Alternatively, you can select the NE for which a standby gateway NE needs to be configured, rightclick the NE, and select the desired gateway NE from the drop-down list.
l You can select several NEs for which a standby gateway NE needs to be configured, right-click the
NE, and select the desired gateway NE from the drop-down list.
NOTE

l If more than one standby gateway NE is required, set GNE3 and GNE4.
l If the main gateway NE fails, GNE2 takes over. If GNE2 fails, GNE3 takes over. If GNE3 fails,
GNE4 takes over.
l During a switch between gateway NEs, communication may be interrupted but services are not affected.

Step 5 Click Apply. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1030

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.8 Configuring the Network Management Port and LCT Access


to an NE
This section describes how to configure the NMS port and LCT access, ensuring normal
operation of the NMS port and network security.

A.2.8.1 Configuring the Ethernet Network Management Port on an NE


By default, an NE can access the NMS or another NE through its Ethernet network management
port or NE cascading port, with the port working mode being auto-negotiation.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

It is recommended that the LCT accesses an NE through Ethernet ports.

If you need to initialize an NE or perform software loading by using the LCT, the LCT
needs to access the NE through Ethernet ports.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose Communication >
Access Control from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select Enable Ethernet Access. Then, the NE allows NMS access through its Ethernet ports.

NOTE

To disable the Ethernet port-based access function, deselect Enable Ethernet Access.

Step 3 Click Apply.


A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Click OK. Close the displayed operation result dialog box.
Step 5 Set Work Mode and Enabled/Disabled of the Ethernet network management port and NE
cascading port on the system control, switching, and timing board.

Step 6 Click Apply.


----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1031

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.2.8.2 Configuring the Network Management Serial Port on an NE


By default, the NMS can access an NE through the serial port.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
If the LCT cannot access an NE through serial ports when the Enable Serial Port Access check
box is selected, the LCT access function may be disabled.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose Communication >
Access Control from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the Enable Serial Port Access check box and select Access NM.

Step 3 Click Apply. Close the displayed operation result dialog box.
Step 4 Optional: Select the baud rate of the serial port from the Baud Rate drop-down list. Click
Apply. Close the displayed operation result dialog box.
----End

A.2.8.3 Configuring LCT Access to NEs


When an NE is managed by the NMS, the LCT can access this NE by default.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1032

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Context
l

If the LCT requests to log in to an NE to which the NMS has logged in, the NE determines
whether to permit the login of the LCT according to the status of LCT Access Control
Switch.

If the LCT requests to log in to an NE to which the NMS has not logged in, the NE permits
the login of the LCT regardless of the status of LCT Access Control Switch. The NMS,
however, can log in to an NE to which the LCT has logged in. That is, the login of the LCT
does not affect the login of the NMS. After the NMS user logs in to the NE successfully,
the logged LCT user is not affected. If LCT Access Control Switch is set to Disable
Access, the logged LCT user is also not affected.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose Security > LCT Access
Control from the Function Tree.

Step 2 Select the required NE from the list, and click Access Allowed to enable the LCT access function.
NOTE

To disable the LCT access function, click Disable Access.

----End

A.2.9 Configuring an NE User


NE users refer to the users who log in to and operate NEs. Different types of NE users are
assigned different rights to log in and manage NEs.

A.2.9.1 Creating an NE User


Based on the operation rights, NE users are divided into five levels, which involve monitoring
level, operation level, maintenance level, system level, and debugging level in an ascending
order. Different levels of NE users can be created as required.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

An online user can create a user at a lower level.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

The default NE user is at the monitoring level.

For security of NE data, NE users are assigned operation rights based on their
responsibilities.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1033

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the required NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Security > NE User
Management from the Function Tree. A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation
is successful.
Step 2 Close the dialog box.
Step 3 Click Add.
The Add NE User Attribute/Value dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the NE user according to the network plan.

NOTE

l A Debug Level NE user has all security and configuration authorities, and has the right to run debugging
commands.
l A System Level NE user has all security and configuration authorities.
l A Maintenance Level NE user has some security authorities, some configuration authorities, the
communication setting authority, and the log management authority.
l An Operation Level NE user has all fault performance authorities, some security authorities, and some
configuration authorities.
l A Monitor Level NE user has the right to use all query commands, to log in, to log out, and to change
its own password.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.1.3.2 Parameter Description: NE User Management_Creation

A.2.9.2 Changing the Password of an NE User


Periodically changing the password of an NE user ensures the NE security.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1034

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The NE user is created.

An online user can change the password of a user at a lower level.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
NOTE

Periodically change the password of an NE user to avoid password leaks.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the required NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Security > NE User
Management from the Function Tree. A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation
is successful.
Step 2 Close the dialog box.
Step 3 Select the required NE user from the NE user management list, and click Set Password.
The Set Password of NE User dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Input New Password, and input it again in Confirm Password.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

A.2.9.3 Setting Warning Screen Parameters


This topic describes how to enable the warning screen function. When a user logs in to an NE,
the NMS can display some information to the user. The displayed information can be defined
by users.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1035

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree. Choose Security > NE Security
Parameters from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Set Warning Screen Switching and Warning Screen Information according to the network
plan.

Step 3 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.1.3.1 Parameter Description: NE User Management

A.2.9.4 Switching NE Users


This section describes how to switch an NE user to a higher-level NE user when the operations
on the NMS are beyond the operation rights of the NE user.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

An NE user is created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
An NE cannot be logged in to and managed by the same NE user from different servers at the
same time. If the same NE user from different servers logs in to an NE at different time, the first
online user will be forcibly logged out of the NE.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree. Choose Security > NE Login
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required NE, and click Switch NE User.
The Switch Current NE User dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1036

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Set User and Password of the user to be switched.

Step 4 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

A.2.10 Configuring SSL Protocol Communication


The security socket layer (SSL) protocol provides encrypted and reliable communication
between entities. Therefore, SSL protocol communication greatly improves the network
management security.

A.2.10.1 Configuring SSL Protocol Communication Between a U2000 Server and its
Clients
Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol communication between a U2000 server and its clients is
supported only after corresponding configurations are performed on the U2000 server and
clients.

Prerequisite
The connection mode of the U2000 server is set to SSL.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Two connection modes are supported, which are Common and Security(SSL) and which
can be queried on the U2000 server by running a query command.

The default connection mode is Common.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1037

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l When the U2000 server and its client are deployed on the same host and the U2000 server uses the
SSL connection mode, the client can log in to the server by using the common or SSL connection
mode. When the U2000 server and its client are deployed on the same host and the U2000 server uses
the common connection mode, the client can log in to the server only by using the common connection
mode.
l When the U2000 server and its client are deployed on different hosts, the client can log in to the U2000
server only by using the same connection mode as the U2000 server.

Procedure
Step 1 Start the U2000 client.
Step 2 In the Login interface, click

The Server List dialog box is displayed.


Step 3 Select the required U2000 server and click Modify.
The Modify Server Information dialog box is displayed.

Step 4 Set Mode to Security(SSL).


Step 5 Click OK.
Step 6 Click OK.
----End

A.2.10.2 Configuring the Connection Mode Between a U2000 Client and Its
Gateway NE
Two connection modes are supported between a U2000 client and its gateway NE, namely
common connection mode and Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) connection mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE maintainer authority or higher.

SSL licenses have been deployed on the gateway NE and the U2000 client according to
the SSL loading guide.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1038

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Configure the connection mode of the U2000 client.
1.

Choose Administration > DCN Management from Main Menu.


The Filter NE dialog box is displayed.

2.

Click Cancel and then click the GNE tab.


The Filter GNE dialog box is displayed.

3.

Click

4.

Click OK.

5.

Select the required NE, right-click the NE, and choose Modify GNE from the shortcut
menu.
The Modify GNE dialog box is displayed.

6.

Change the value of Connection Mode to Security SSL.

7.

Click OK.
A warning dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.

, choose the required gateway NE, and then click OK.

Step 2 Configure the connection mode of the gateway NE.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication >
Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.

2.

Set Connection Mode to Security SSL or Common + Security SSL.


NOTE

If Connection Mode of a gateway NE is Security SSL, tools (such as the Web LCT and DC) that use the
common connection mode cannot communicate with the gateway NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1039

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

Click Apply.

----End

A.2.11 Configuring RADIUS Authentication


The RADIUS authentication function allows a RADIUS server to implement centralized
management over all users that log in to an NE.

A.2.11.1 Enabling/Disabling the RADIUS Function


An NE can use the RADIUS function only after the NE is enabled to be a RADIUS client. An
NE can function as a proxy server only after the NE is enabled to be a proxy server.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Security > NE
RADIUS Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Enable an NE to be a RADIUS client.
1.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Double-click RADIUS Client and choose Open from the drop-down menu.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1040

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

A Task Collection

Click Apply. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.

Step 3 Optional: Enable an NE to be a proxy server.


1.

Double-click Proxy Server and choose Open from the drop-down menu.

NOTE

l Proxy Server can be set to Open only if RADIUS Client is set to Open.
l When an NE uses RADIUS authentication in the proxy NAS mode, set Proxy Server to Close.

2.

Click Apply. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.

----End

Related References
B.1.3.6 Parameter Description: Enabling/Disabling the RADIUS Function

A.2.11.2 Creating a RADIUS Server or a RADIUS Proxy Server


A RADIUS server needs to be configured if an NE uses RADIUS authentication in the NAS
mode or functions as a proxy server. A RADIUS proxy server needs to be configured if an NE
uses RADIUS authentication in the proxy NAS mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The RADIUS function has been enabled for the NE.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Security > NE
RADIUS Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the RADIUS Server Configuration tab.
The RADIUS Server Information dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click New.
The New RADIUS Server Information dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Configure information about the RADIUS server or RADIUS proxy server.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1041

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

l If an NE uses RADIUS authentication in the NAS mode or functions as a proxy server, set
the parameters as follows:

NOTE

l For both NE RADIUS authentication and NE usage accounting, set this parameter to Authentication
+ Accounting or Accounting (when the Authentication function has been enabled).
l Set Server Type to RADIUS Server.
l Set Server ID to IP Address and specify the IP address of the RADIUS server.

l If an NE uses RADIUS authentication in the proxy NAS mode, set the parameters as follows:

NOTE

l For both NE RADIUS authentication and NE usage accounting, set this parameter to Authentication
+ Accounting or Accounting (when the Authentication function has been enabled).
l Set Server Type to Proxy Server.
l It is recommended that you set Server ID to NE ID and set the gateway NE as a proxy server.

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.1.3.5 Parameter Description: RADIUS Configuration_RADIUS Server

A.2.11.3 Configuring RADIUS Server Parameters


This section describes how to configure RADIUS server parameters.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1042

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The RADIUS server or RADIUS proxy server have been configured for the NE.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Security > NE
RADIUS Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New RADIUS Server Information dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click

The Select Server dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Select a configured server and click OK. Then, the system automatically associates out the values
of Function, Server ID, and Server Type.
Step 5 Configure the RADIUS parameters.
l If an NE uses RADIUS authentication in the NAS mode or functions as a proxy server:

l If an NE uses RADIUS authentication in the proxy NAS mode:

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1043

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l If no standby server is required, set Server Status to Active.


l The OptiX RTN 980 supports one active server and one standby server. If both the active and standby servers
are configured, set Server Status of the active server to Active and Server Status of the standby server to
Standby.
l Set Shared Key to the same value on the NE and on the RADIUS server.
l If Server Type is Proxy Server, Shared Key is not available.
l It is recommended that Interval of Packet Transmission and Packet Retransmission Attempts take their
default values.

Step 6 Click OK. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.1.3.4 Parameter Description: RADIUS Configuration_Creation

A.3 Managing Radio Links


Before you configure the radio link between two microwave sites, configure the information
about the radio link.

A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group


If the radio link requires 1+1 HSB/FD/SD protection, create the IF 1+1 protection group.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

The IF boards of an IF 1+1 FD/SD protection group must be configured in two paired slots.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
When a 1+0 service is converted into a 1+1 HSB protection configuration by configuring the IF
1+1 protection group, the original service is not interrupted. The board that carries the original
service, however, needs to be set as the working board.

Procedure
Step 1 For an IF 1+1 protection group comprised of ISU2 or ISX2 boards, set IF Service Type to
appropriate values for the main and standby IF boards according to the network plan.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1044

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Ensure that the values of IF Service Type set for the main and standby IF boards are the same and meet the
network plan requirements.
l For ISU2 or ISX2 boards, the default value of IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).

1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE and then choose Configuration > Link
Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Changes the values of IF Service Type for the main and standby IF boards according to
the network plan.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 2 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 3 Click Create.
The Create IF 1+1 Protection dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Configure the parameters of the IF 1+1 protection group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1045

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l When Working Mode is set to HSB, the equipment provides a 1+1 hot standby configuration for the
IF board and ODU at both ends of each hop of a radio link to realize the protection.
l When Working Mode is set to FD, the system uses two channels that have a frequency spacing between
them, to transmit and receive the same signal. The remote end selects signals from the two received
signals. With FD protection, the impact of the fading on signal transmission is reduced.
l When Working Mode is set to SD, the system uses two antennas that have a space distance between
them, to receive the same signal. The equipment selects signals from the two received signals. With
SD protection, the impact of the fading on signal transmission is reduced.
l When Revertive Mode is set to Revertive Mode, the NE that is in the switching state releases the
switching and enables the former working channel to return to the normal state some time after the
former working channel is restored to normal. It is recommended that you set this parameter to
Revertive Mode.
l When Revertive Mode is set to Non-Revertive, the NE that is in the switching state keeps the current
state unchanged unless another switching occurs even though the former working channel is restored
to normal.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when Revertive Mode is set to Revertive Mode. It is recommended
that you use the default value.
l Enable Reverse Switching is valid only when Working Mode is set to HSB or SD.
l Generally, if Working Mode is set to HSB, it is recommended that you set Enable Reverse
Switching to Disabled; if Working Mode is set to SD, it is recommended that you set Enable Reverse
Switching to Enabled.
l Each of the parameters Working Mode, Revertive Mode, WTR Time(s),Anti-jitter Time(s) and
Enable Reverse Switching must be set to the same value at both ends of a radio hop.
l It is recommended that you set Alarm Report Mode to Only protection group alarms. In this case,
protection group alarms are reported to indicate radio link faults.
l It is recommended that Anti-jitter Time(s) take its default value.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed operation result dialog box.
----End

Related References
B.2.5 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection_Create

A.3.2 Creating an XPIC Workgroup


After you create an XPIC workgroup comprised of two XPIC radio links, the two radio links
take the same values for the parameters including the channel bandwidth, transmit frequency,
transmit power, and ATPC attributes.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding XPIC IF boards and the ODUs connected to the XPIC IF boards are
added to the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1046

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Link
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the XPIC tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create XPIC Working Group dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Configure the parameters for the XPIC workgroup.

NOTE

l Set Link ID-V, Link ID-H, Transmit Power(dBm), Maximum Transmit Power(dBm), and
Transmission Frequency(MHz) according the network plan. Set Link ID-V, Link ID-H, Transmit
Power(dBm), T/R Spacing(MHz), and ATPC Enabled to the same values for both ends of a link.
l In normal cases, Transmission Status is set to unmute.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.2.1 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC Workgroup_Creation

A.3.3 Setting the AM Attributes of the XPIC Workgroup


After the XPIC workgroup is created, configure the AM attributes of the XPIC Integrated IP
radio link according to the planned values.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1047

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The workgroup must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The XPIC IF boards (IFX2 and ISX2 boards) support Integrated IP radio, and the AM attributes
can be configured.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Link
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the XPIC tab.
Step 3 Click the Hybrid/AM Configuration tab.
Step 4 Configure the AM attributes of the XPIC Hybrid radio link.

NOTE

l When AM Enable Status is set to Disabled, the radio link uses only the specified modulation scheme.
In this case, you need to select Manually Specified Modulation Mode.
l When AM Enable Status is set to Enabled, the radio link uses the corresponding modulation scheme
according to the channel conditions.
l Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity specifies the lowest-order modulation scheme
that the AM function supports. This parameter is set according to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the service transmission bandwidth that the Hybrid radio must ensure
and the availability of the radio link that corresponds to this modulation scheme.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity specifies the highest-order modulation scheme that the
AM function supports. This parameter is set according to the network plan. Generally, the value of this
parameter is determined by the bandwidth of the services that need to be transmitted over the Hybrid
radio and the availability of the radio link that corresponds to this modulation scheme.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity must be higher than Modulation Mode of the Guarantee
AM Capacity.

Step 5 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.2.2 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1048

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link


By performing this operation, you can configure the IF/ODU information for a radio link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
l

For 1+1 HSB/SD protection, you need to configure only the IF/ODU information of the
main radio link.

For 1+1 FD protection, you need to configure the IF/ODU information of the main radio
link and the ODU information of the standby radio link.

Before configuring XPIC workgroups, you need to set IF Service Type separately for IF
boards in the vertical polarization and those in horizontal polarization.

For N+1 protection, you need to configure the IF/ODU information of the N+1 radio links
respectively.

The MW_CFG_MISMATCH alarm is reported, if the E1 count, AM enabled status, STM-1


count, or modulation mode is set inconsistently for both ends of an Integrated IP radio link.
This alarm should be cleared immediately. Otherwise, services may be configured
unsuccessfully or interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE and then choose Configuration > Link Configuration from
the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.
Step 3 Click an IF board icon or ODU icon.
The system displays the IF/ODU information of the radio link that the IF board or ODU
connected to the IF board belongs to.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1049

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Configure the corresponding IF information of the radio link.


1.

Optional: For ISU2/ISX2 boards, set IF Service Type according to the network plan. Click
Apply.
NOTE

l After this operation, the IF board will be reset. Set other IF information after the IF board starts up.
l For ISU2 and ISX2 boards, set IF Service Type appropriately for the ISU2 and ISX2 boards before
configuring IF 1+1 protection, N+1 protection, and XPIC.

2.

Set other IF information.


NOTE

l Link ID is set according to the network plan. Each radio link of an NE should have a unique link ID,
and the link IDs at both ends of a radio link should be the same.
l When AM Enable Status is set to Disabled, the radio link uses only the specified modulation scheme.
In this case, you need to select Manually Specified Modulation Mode.
l When AM Enable Status is set to Enabled, the radio link uses the corresponding modulation scheme
according to the channel conditions.
l Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity specifies the lowest-order modulation scheme
that the AM function supports. This parameter is set according to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the service transmission bandwidth that the Hybrid radio must ensure
and the availability of the radio link that corresponds to this modulation scheme.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity specifies the highest-order modulation scheme that the
AM function supports. This parameter is set according to the network plan. Generally, the value of this
parameter is determined by the bandwidth of the services that need to be transmitted over the Hybrid
radio and the availability of the radio link that corresponds to this modulation scheme.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity must be higher than Modulation Mode of the Guarantee
AM Capacity.

Step 5 Click Apply.


Step 6 Configure the corresponding ODU information of the radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1050

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Power to Be Received(dBm) is used to set the expected receive power of the ODU and is mainly used
in the antenna alignment stage. After this parameter is set, the NE automatically enables the antenna
misalignment indicating function.
l When Power to Be Received(dBm) takes the default value (-10.0), the antenna misalignment
indicating function is disabled.
l In normal cases, it is recommended that you set TX Status to unmute.

Step 7 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.2.9 Parameter: Link Configuration_IF/ODU Configuration

A.3.5 Creating an N+1 Protection Group


When multiple STM-1 or Integrated IP radio services are transmitted in the point-to-point mode,
you can adopt the N+1 protection configuration.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

The IF1 boards must work in the STM-1 mode.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

When an N+0 service is converted into an N+1 service through the configuration of the N
+1 protection group, the original service is not interrupted.

In the case of Integrated IP radio, the Hybrid/AM attributes must be the same for all the N
+1 radio links in the N+1 protection group.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Create.
The Create N+1 Protection dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1051

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure the Attribute of the N+1 protection group.


Step 4 Configure the mapping relation between the board and the slot.
1.

Select Work Unit from Select Mapping Direction.

2.

Select a port to which a working channel corresponds from Select Mapping Way, and then
click

3.

Repeat Step 4.2 to select the ports to which other working channels correspond. Click
.

4.

Select Protection Unit from Select Mapping Direction.

5.

Select a port to which a protection channel corresponds from Select Mapping Way, and
then click

Step 5 Click OK. Then, click OK to close the dialog box that is displayed, indicating that the operation
is successful.
----End

Related References
B.2.3 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection_Create

A.3.6 Querying the IF 1+1 Protection Status


You can learn about the current information about the IF 1+1 protection by querying the IF 1+1
protection status.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The IF 1+1 protection must be configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1052

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query. Close the displayed operation result dialog box. In Protection Group, check the
IF 1+1 protection groups.
Step 3 Select the IF 1+1 protection group whose protection status needs to be queried.
Step 4 Click Query Switch Status, and then close the displayed prompt dialog box. In Slot Mapping
Relation, check the protection status of the IF 1+1 protection group.
----End

Related References
B.2.6 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection

A.3.7 Querying the IF N+1 Protection Status


You can learn about the current information of the IF N+1 protection by querying the IF N+1
protection status.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The IF N+1 protection must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query, and then close the displayed prompt dialog box. In Protection Group, check the
IF N+1 protection groups.
Step 3 Select the protection group whose protection status needs to be queried.
Step 4 Click Query Switch Status, and then close the displayed dialog box. In Slot Mapping
Relation, check the IF N+1 protection status.
----End

Related References
B.2.4 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1053

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.3.8 IF 1+1 Protection Switching


You can perform external switching on the IF 1+1 protection by performing IF 1+1 protection
switching.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF 1+1 protection must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In Protection Group, select the protection group for protection switching.
Step 3 In Slot Mapping Settings, select a working unit or the protection unit of the protection group,
and then right-click the selected unit.
Step 4 Choose the required switching mode from the shortcut menu.
The system displays the dialog box that indicates the successful operation.
Step 5 Click Close.
Step 6 Click Query Switching Status and check whether the switching is successful, and then close
the displayed prompt dialog box.
----End

A.3.9 IF N+1 Protection Switching


You can perform external switching on the IF N+1 protection by performing IF N+1 protection
switching.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF N+1 protection must be configured.

The N+1 protection protocol is enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1054

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 In Protection Group, select the protection group for protection switching.
Step 3 In Slot Mapping Relation, select a working unit or the protection unit of the protection group,
and then right-click the selected unit.
Step 4 Choose the required switching mode from the shortcut menu.
Step 5 In the dialog box that is displayed, click OK.
The system displays the dialog box that indicates the successful operation.
Step 6 Click Close.
Step 7 Click Query Switch Status to check whether the switching operation is successful.
----End

A.3.10 Starting/Stopping the N+1 Protection Protocol


If you stop the N+1 protection protocol and then restart it, the N+1 protection protocol can be
restored to the initial state.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF N+1 protection must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
l

Stopping the N+1 protection protocol causes a failure of the N+1 protection.

When services are switched onto the protection channel, stopping the N+1 protection
protocol causes switchover of the services back to the working tunnel. At this time, if the
working channel is normal, the services are transiently interrupted. If the working channel
is faulty, the services are interrupted until the working channel is restored to normal or the
N+1 protection protocol is started.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1
Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In Protection Group, select the protection group whose N+1 protection protocol needs to be
started.
Step 3 Click Start Protocol or Stop Protocol. Then, close the displayed prompt dialog box.
Step 4 Click Query to check the protocol status.
----End

A.3.11 Creating a PLA Group


When PLA is used to increase Ethernet service bandwidth or improve reliability on radio links,
you need to create a PLA group.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1055

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected have been added on the
NE Panel.

The main and slave IF boards are installed in two paired slots.

The main and slave IF boards in the PLA group are of the same type.

No Ethernet service has been configured on the slave IF board.

The services configured on the member IF boards in the PLA group are of the same type.

The member IF boards in the PLA group have the same channel spacing.

Neither member IF board in the PLA group functions as a member in a 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
or N+1 protection group.

Neither member IF board in the PLA group functions as a member in LAG group.

The Layer 3 header compression function is disabled for the member IF boards in the PLA
group.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

In V100R003C03, PLA aggregates only two links, which means that a PLA group can
contain only one main port and one slave port. The IF boards where the main and slave
ports are located must be installed in two paired slots.

IF boards are reset (cold) during creation or deletion of a PLA group.

PLA can work together with adaptive modulation (AM). Member links in a PLA group can
use different Hybrid/AM attributes and modulation modes.

The two members of an XPIC workgroup can form a PLA group, providing Ethernet service
protection between the vertical and horizontal polarization directions. One member in an
XPIC workgroup and one member in another XPIC workgroup cannot form a PLA group.

Native TDM services in Integrated IP radio links are irrelevant to the PLA group consisting
of the Integrated IP radio links, and need to be configured separately on the Integrated IP
radio links.

If a PLA group is configured to provide protection for Ethernet bandwidth on Integrated


IP radio links, subnetwork connection protection (SNCP) can be configured to provide
protection for Native TDM services on the Integrated IP radio links.

PLA can work together with Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS). ERPS switching
can be triggered when all links in a PLA group fail or when the number of available links
in a PLA group is smaller than Minimum Number of Activated Member Links.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Physical Link Aggregation from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create Physical Link Aggregation dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1056

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Enter the PLA group ID in PLA ID.


Step 4 Configure the main and slave ports in the PLA group.
1.

Select the main IF board from Main Board and select the main port from Main Port.

2.

Select the slave IF board from Board and select the slave port from Port.

3.

Click .

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.2.7 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_Creating a PLA Group

A.3.12 Querying the Status of a PLA Group


This section describes how to query the current information about a PLA group.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

A PLA group has been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Physical Link Aggregation from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1057

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Click Query. View the information about the PLA group in Physical Link Aggregation List.
NOTE

This parameter specifies the minimum number of available links in a PLA group and helps to trigger ERPS
switching even if not all members in the PLA group fail

----End

Related References
B.2.8 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_PLA

A.4 Managing the MSP


The OptiX RTN 980 supports the linear MSP and ring MSP.

A.4.1 Configuring Linear MSP


You can configure linear MSP to protect services over the optical fibers between two nodes.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
When an unprotected service is converted into a linear MSP service by configuring the linear
MSP, the original services are not interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear MS
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Create.
The system displays the Create a Linear Multiplex Section dialog box.
Step 3 Set the parameters of the linear MSP group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1058

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Follow-up Procedure
l

In the case of the 1:N linear MSP, you need to configure bidirectional cross-connections
between the services and the working channels later. If extra services need to be transmitted,
it is necessary to configure bidirectional cross-connections between the extra services and
the protection channels.

In the case of the 1+1 linear MSP, you need to configure bidirectional cross-connections
between the services and the working channels later.

Related References
B.3.1 Parameter Description: Linear MSP_Creation

A.4.2 Querying the Status of the Linear MSP


By using this operation, you can know the current information about the linear MSP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1059

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The linear MSP must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear MS
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query > Query Protection Group to query the current linear MSP group. Then close the
dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 In Protection Group, click the linear MSP group to be queried.
Step 4 Click Query > Query Switching Status In Slot Mapping Relation, query the status of the
linear MSP.
----End

Related References
B.3.2 Parameter Description: Linear MSP

A.4.3 Performing Linear MSP Switching


By using this operation, you can perform the external switching on the linear MSP.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The linear MSP must be configured.

The protection protocol is enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear MS
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In Protection Group, select the MSP group to be switched. In Slot Mapping Relation, select
the working unit or protection unit, and then right-click.
Step 3 Right-click and select the required switching mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1060

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The confirmation dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Click OK, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
NOTE

If the switching of a higher priority occurs in a channel, the switching of a lower priority will not occur in
the channel.

----End

A.4.4 Starting/Stopping the Linear MSP Protocol


If you first stop the linear MSP protocol and then start it, the linear MSP status can be restored
to the initial state.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The linear MSP must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
l

Stopping the ring MSP protocol causes failure of ring MSP.

When services are switched onto the protection channel, stopping the ring MSP protocol
causes the services to switch back to the working channel. At this time, if the working
channel is normal, the services are transiently interrupted; if the working channel is faulty,
the services are interrupted until the working channel is restored to normal or the protocol
is started.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear MS
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In Protection Group, select the MSP group for which the linear MSP protocol is to be stopped.
Step 3 Click Start Protocol or Stop Protocol, and then close the prompt dialog box that is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1061

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Query > Query Protection Group, close the dialog box that is displayed, and check
Protocol Status.
----End

A.4.5 Configuring Ring MSP


If a ring network formed by STM-4 fibers is used and the services are discrete services, you can
configure ring MSP to provide protection for the ring network.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The number of nodes on an MSP ring should not exceed 16.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Ring MS from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Create.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click OK.
The Create a Multiplex Section Ring dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set parameters of the ring MSP protection group as planned.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1062

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.3.3 Parameter Description: Ring MSP_Creation

A.4.6 Querying Ring MSP Status


This topic describes how to check the current status of a ring MSP protection group.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

A ring MSP protection group has been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1063

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Ring MS from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Select Query Protection Group from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed. In Protection Group, check basic information about the protection group.
Step 4 Select the required protection group and click Query.
Step 5 Select Query Switching Status from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed. In Slot Mapping Relation, check the switching status of the protection group.
----End

Related References
B.3.4 Parameter Description: Ring MSP

A.4.7 Triggering Ring MSP Switching


This topic describes how to trigger external ring MSP switching.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Ring MSP has been configured for a service.

The ring MSP protocol has been enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information

CAUTION
All switching operations except exercise switching may interrupt services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Ring MS from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required service, right-click the service, and select a switching mode from the dropdown list.
Then, a confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click Yes Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1064

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Query.


Step 5 Select Query Switching Status from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed.
Step 6 Check whether the service is already switched to the protection channel.
----End

A.4.8 Starting/Stopping the Ring MSP Protocol


If you first stop the ring MSP protocol and then start it, the ring MSP protocol is restored to its
initial state.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Ring MSP has been configured for a service.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Ring MS from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Stop the ring MSP protocol.
1.

Select the required protection group and click Stop Protocol.

CAUTION
After the ring MSP protocol is stopped, the protection group fails. In addition, services are
unavailable until the working channel is restored or the ring MSP protocol is restarted, if
services have been switched to the protection channel.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
2.

Click Yes, Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 3 Start the ring MSP protocol.


1.

Select the required protection group. Click Start Protocol, Then, close the dialog box that
is displayed.

----End

A.5 Managing TDM Services


The TDM services involve the SDH service and the PDH service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1065

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services


In a cross-connection of point-to-point services, one service source corresponds to one service
sink.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding source and sink boards must be added on NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Options to change the VC-12 timeslot numbering policy used by the cross-connection.

Step 3 Click Create.


The Create SDH Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Configure the parameters of a new SDH service.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.4.1 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Creation
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1066

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP Services


The cross-connection of SNCP services is a cross-connection that a working source and a
protection source correspond to a service sink.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding source and sink boards must be added on NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Options to change the VC-12 timeslot numbering policy used by the cross-connection.

Step 3 Click Create SNCP Service.


The Create SNCP Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Configure the parameters of a new SNCP service.

Step 5 Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.4.2 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_SNCP Service Creation

A.5.3 Modifying the Priorities of E1 Services


This section describes how to adjust the priorities of E1 services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1067

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding source and sink boards must be added in the NE Panel.

The E1 cross-connections must be created. The IF boards in the cross-connections must


support the E1 priority function. The E1 priorities must be set already and need to be
modified.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Select an E1 service in Cross-Connection.
Step 4 Right-click the E1 service and choose Expand from the shortcut menu.
Step 5 If the number of E1 services configured on an IF board is smaller than Full E1 Capacity, select
the required E1 service, right-click the service, and choose Modify from the short-cut menu.
Then, change the E1 priority of each timeslot in the dialog box that is displayed..
NOTE

For an SNCP service, you need to modify E1 Priority of only the services that are transmitted to the
working source and the protection source of the SNCP service.

Step 6 If the number of E1 services configured on an IF board is the same as Full E1 Capacity, do as
follows to interchange the priority levels of two E1 services:
1.

Add one to Full E1 Capacity for both ends of the radio link.

2.

Change E1 Priority of the E1 service with a higher priority to Low.

3.

Change E1 Priority of the E1 service with a lower priority to High.

4.

Change Full E1 Capacity to the original values for both ends of the radio link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1068

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

If Full E1 Capacity uses its maximum value, do as follows to interchange the priority levels of two services.
1. Delete either E1 service.
2. Change the priority of the other E1 service.
3. Add the E1 service that was deleted, setting its E1 Priority to the required value.

Step 7 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

A.5.4 Inserting E1_AIS upon a TU_AIS Condition


Perform this operation to configure the function of inserting the TU_AIS upon E1_AIS detection.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IFU2, IFX2, ISU2, or ISX2 board is added to NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the IF board from the Object Tree and choose Alarm > Triggered
Alarm Insertion from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Set E1_AIS to TU_AIS.
NOTE

Generally, it is recommended that Auto take its default value.

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.4.6 Parameter Description: TU_AIS Insertion
B.4.6 Parameter Description: TU_AIS Insertion

A.5.5 Configuring the Automatic Switching of SNCP Services


You can manually add certain alarms for the automatic switching of SNCP services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The SNCP protection group must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1069

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SNCP Service
Control from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the SNCP protection group, and then right-click SD Initiation Condition to which the
working service corresponds.
Step 3 Set the initiation condition for the working service. Click OK.

NOTE

The conditions for automatic switching of higher order services are different from those of lower order
services.

Step 4 Right-click SD Initiation Condition to which the protection service corresponds.


Step 5 Set the initiation condition for the protection service. Click OK.
NOTE

It is recommended that you set SD Initiation Condition of the working service to be the same as SD
Initiation Condition of the protection service.

Step 6 Click Apply, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.4.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control

A.5.6 Deleting Cross-Connections


When a service is not used, you can delete the cross-connections of this service to release the
corresponding resources.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The cross-connections of the service must be configured and the service must not be used.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1070

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Query the related data.
1.

Click Query.
Then, a dialog box is displayed, indicating that this operation will update the service data
saved on the NMS.

2.

Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 3 Deactivate the service.


1.

Right-click the service and choose Deactivate from the shortcut menu.
Then, a dialog box is displayed, querying whether you need to deactivate the selected
service.

2.

Click OK.
Then, a dialog box is displayed, indicating that this operation will clear the corresponding
service data on the NE side.

3.

Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 4 Delete the service.


1.

Right-click the service and choose Delete from the shortcut menu.
Then, a dialog box is displayed, querying whether you need to delete the selected service.

2.

Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 5 Click Query. The queried information should show that the cross-connection is already deleted.
----End

A.5.7 Converting a Normal Service into an SNCP Service


By converting a normal service into an SNCP service, you can convert the unidirectional crossconnections of a normal service into the unidirectional cross-connection in the receive direction
of the SNCP service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The unidirectional cross-connection of the normal service must be configured and the
source of the cross-connection must be a line board.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
When this task is performed to convert a normal service into an SNCP service, the original
services are not interrupted.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1071

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Optional: If a bidirectional SDH service is created, select this service in Cross-Connection.
Right-click the selected service and choose Expand to Unidirectional from the shortcut menu.
Step 3 Select the unidirectional service. Right-click the selected service and choose Convert to SNCP
Service from the shortcut menu.
Then, a dialog box is displayed, querying whether you need to perform this operation.Then, the
Convert to SNCP Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Click OK.
Then, the Create SNCP Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Set the parameters of the SNCP service.

Step 6 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.4.3 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Converting Normal Services Into
SNCP Services

A.5.8 Converting an SNCP Service to a Normal Service


By converting an SNCP service to a normal service, you can convert the SNCP cross-connection
in the receive direction into the unidirectional cross-connection of the normal service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The SNCP cross-connection in the receive direction must be configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1072

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The current service must be transmitted on the working path.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
When this task is performed to convert an SNCP service into a normal service, the original
services are not interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In Auto-Created Cross-Connection, select the configured service. Right-click and choose
Convert to Non-Protection Service from the shortcut menu.
Then, a dialog box is displayed, querying whether you need to perform this operation.
Step 3 Click OK.
----End

Follow-up Procedure
You also need to delete the unidirectional cross-connection between the service source and the
working path or the unidirectional cross-connection between the service source and the
protection path. The SNCP service can be converted into the normal service both in the receive
direction and the transmit direction only after the deletion.

A.5.9 Querying TDM Services


You can learn about the TDM services that are configured for an NE by querying TDM services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

TDM services must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 In the displayed dialog box for confirmation, click OK.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1073

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Close the displayed prompt dialog box. In Cross-Connection, query the TDM services.
----End

Related References
B.4.4 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration

A.5.10 Switching SNCP Services


You can perform external switching on SNCP services by performing this operation.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The SNCP protection group must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SNCP Service
Control from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the SNCP protection group for SNCP service switching.
Step 3 Click Function. Select the required switching mode from the displayed menu.
Step 4 In the displayed dialog box for confirmation, click OK.
Step 5 The system displays a prompt dialog box, indicating that the operation is successful. Then, close
the displayed prompt dialog box.
Step 6 Choose Function > Query Switch Status to check whether the switching operation is
successful.
----End

A.5.11 Querying the Protection Status of SNCP Services


You can know the current information of an SNCP service by querying the protection status of
SNCP services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The SNCP protection group must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1074

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SNCP Service
Control from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the SNCP protection group whose service protection status needs to be queried.
Step 3 Click Function > Query Switch Status, and then close the displayed prompt dialog box.
----End

Related References
B.4.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control

A.6 Managing Ports


Setting correct port parameter is the basis of configuring ports that transmit services.

A.6.1 Setting the Parameters of SDH Ports


The parameters of SDH ports are used to configure the loopback on the SDH interface board
and the laser status.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select By Board/Port(Channel), and select Port or VC4 Channel from the list box.
Step 3 Set the parameters of SDH ports.

1.

Choose Port from the drop-down list, and then configure the parameters of SDH ports.
Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

2.

Click OK.
The dialog box is displayed again for confirmation.

3.

Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.

Step 4 Set the parameters of VC-4 paths.


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1075

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

1.

Choose VC4 Channel from the drop-down list, and then configure the parameters of VC-4
paths.

2.

Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

3.

Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.

----End

Related References
B.5.7.1 Parameter Description: SDH Interfaces

A.6.2 Setting the Parameters of PDH Ports


The parameters of PDH ports are used to configure the tributary loopback, service load
indication, and tributary retiming.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select By Board/Port(Channel).
Step 3 Select Port from the list box.
Step 4 Configure the parameters of PDH ports.

Step 5 Click Apply.


A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.
Step 6 Click OK.
The dialog box is displayed again for confirmation.
Step 7 Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1076

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.5.8.1 Parameter Description: PDH Ports

A.6.3 Configuring Overhead Bytes


Generally, the default overload bytes can meet the requirements of the device. In certain special
application scenarios, however, such as device interconnection, you need to change the overload
bytes according to the requirements of the interconnected device.

A.6.3.1 Configuring RSOHs


When the local or remote NE reports the J0_MM alarm, you need to configure the J0 byte in
regenerator section overheads (RSOHs).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Procedure
Step 1 Select an SDH interface board in the NE Explorer Choose Configuration > Overhead
Management > Regenerator Section Overhead from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.
Step 3 Configure the J0 byte.
1.

Double-click the parameter whose value needs to be changed.


The Please Input the Overhead Byte dialog box is displayed.

2.

Configure overhead bytes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1077

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

Click OK.

Step 4 Click Apply.


A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.
Step 5 Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.
----End

Related References
B.5.9.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead

A.6.3.2 Configuring VC-4 POHs


When the HP_TIM or HP_SLM alarm is reported by the line board of the local or peer NE, you
need to configure the J1 or C2 byte in VC-4 path overheads (POHs).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Procedure
Step 1 Select SDH interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Overhead Management > VC4 Path Overhead from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1078

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Optional: Configure the J1 byte.


1.

Click the Trace Byte J1 tab.

2.

Double-click the parameter whose value needs to be changed.


The Please Input Overhead Byte dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure overhead bytes.

4.

Click OK.

5.

Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

6.

Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.

Step 4 Optional: Configure the C2 byte.


1.

Click the Signal Flag C2 tab.

2.

Configure the required parameters.

3.

Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

4.

Click OK. Close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.

Step 5 Optional: Configure the termination mode of the VC-4 overhead.


1.

Click the Overhead Termination tab.

2.

Configure VC4 Overhead Termination.

3.

Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

4.

Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed indicating the operation result.

----End

Related References
B.5.9.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs

A.6.3.3 Configuring VC-12 POHs


When the E1 port board of the local or remote NE reports the LP_TIM or LP_TIM_VC12 alarm,
you need to configure the signal flag in the J2 byte in VC-12 path overheads (POHs).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Overhead Management > VC12 Path Overhead from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Configure the J2 byte.
1.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click the Trace Byte J2 tab.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1079

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.

3.

Double-click the parameter whose value needs to be changed.


The Please input the overhead byte dialog box is displayed.

4.

Configure overhead bytes.

5.

Click OK.

6.

Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

7.

Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure the signal flag.


1.

Click the Signal Flag V5 tab.

2.

Click Options.
The Options dialog box is displayed.

3.

Click Extended Mode.

4.

Click OK.

5.

Configure the signal flag in the V5 byte.

6.

Click Apply.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

7.

Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1080

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.5.9.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs

A.6.4 Setting Smart E1 Port Parameters


Smart E1 ports can be configured as CES E1 ports or ATM E1 ports.

A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports


The basic attributes of Smart E1 ports involve parameters such as the port name, port mode, and
encapsulation type.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the General Attributes tab.
Step 3 Select the required port and set the parameters.

Step 4 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1081

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.5.1.1 Parameter Description: PDH Ports_Basic Attributes

A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports


The alarm attributes of Smart E1 ports define the parameters such as E1 frame type and loopback
mode.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Select the required port and set the parameters for its advanced attributes.

Step 4 Click Apply.


A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.5.1.2 Parameter Description: PDH Ports_Advanced Attributes

A.6.5 Setting Serial Port Parameters


When some 64 kbit/s timeslots of an Smart E1 port are used for transmission of ATM services,
these timeslots can be considered as a serial port.

A.6.5.1 Creating Serial Ports


When creating a serial port, you can set the 64 kbit/s timeslots to be bound with the serial port.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The ports that travel services are set to Layer 1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1082

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > Serial Port from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the General Attributes tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The New Serial Interface dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters for the serial port according to the planning information.

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.5.3.2 Parameter Description: Serial Port_Creation of Serial Ports

A.6.5.2 Setting Basic Attributes of Serial Ports


The basic attributes of serial ports involve the parameters such as port mode and encapsulation
type.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Serial ports are added.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > Serial Port from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1083

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Click the General Attributes tab.


Step 3 Select the required port and set the parameters for the serial port according to the planning
information.

Step 4 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.5.3.1 Parameter Description: Serial Port_Basic Attributes

A.6.6 Setting Ethernet Port Parameters


Ethernet port parameters include basic attributes, traffic control, Layer-2 attributes, Layer-3
attributes, and advanced attributes.

A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports


General Ethernet port attributes define the physical-layer information, such as the interface
mode, encapsulation type, and maximum frame length.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the General Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set basic Ethernet port attributes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1084

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Port Mode specifies the mode of the Ethernet port.


l If Port Mode is Layer 2, Encapsulation Type can be set to Null, 802.1Q, or QinQ.
l If Port Mode is Layer 3, Encapsulation Type can be set to 802.1Q only and the port can carry MPLS
tunnels.
l Encapsulation Type specifies the method of the port to process the received packets.
l If you set Encapsulation Type to Null, the port transparently transmits the received packets.
l If you set Encapsulation Type to 802.1Q, the port identifies the packets that comply with the IEEE
802.1q standard.
l If you set Encapsulation Type to QinQ, the port identifies the packets that comply with the IEEE
802.1ad QinQ standard.
l The Ethernet ports of different types support different Working Mode.
l When the equipment on the opposite side works in auto-negotiation mode, set the Working Mode of
the equipment on the local side to Auto-Negotiation.
l When the equipment on the opposite side works in full-duplex mode, set the Working Mode of the
equipment on the local side to 10M Full-Duplex, 100M Full-Duplex, or 1000M Full-Duplex
depending on the port rate of the equipment on the opposite side.
l When the equipment on the opposite side works in half-duplex mode, set the Working Mode of the
equipment on the local side to 10M Half-Duplex, 100M Half-Duplex, or Auto-Negotiation depending
on the port rate of the equipment on the opposite side.
l GE electrical ports support 10M full-duplex, 10M half-duplex, 100M full-duplex, 100M half-duplex,
1000M full-duplex, and auto-negotiation.
l GE optical ports support 1000M full-duplex and auto-negotiation.
l The value of Max Frame Length(byte) should be greater than the length of any frame to be transported.
l Auto-Negotiation Ability specifies the auto-negotiation capability of the Ethernet port.
l For GE optical ports, Auto-Negotiation Ability can be set to 1000M Full-Duplex only.
l Auto-Negotiation Ability is valid only when Working Mode is set to Auto-Negotiation.
l The SFP on the EM6F,EM6FA, CSHN board supports the optical port and electrical port.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.5.2.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes

A.6.6.2 Configuring the Traffic Control of Ethernet Ports


After traffic control is enabled, the Ethernet port sends the pause frame to instruct the peer end
to stop sending Ethernet packets for a period if the link is congested, eliminating link congestion.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1085

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Flow Control tab.
Step 3 Configure the Ethernet port traffic control.

NOTE

l Auto-Negotiation Flow Control Mode is valid only when Working Mode is set to AutoNegotiation.
l Auto-Negotiation Flow Control Mode of the equipment on the local side must be consistent with the
auto-negotiation flow control mode of the equipment on the opposite side
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports only two auto-negotiation flow control modes, namely, Disabled mode
and Enable Symmetric Flow Control mode.
l Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode is valid only when Working Mode is not set to AutoNegotiation.
l Non-Autonegotiation Flow Control Mode of the equipment on the local side must be consistent with
the non-autonegotiation flow control mode of the equipment on the opposite side
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports only two non-auto-negotiation flow control modes, namely, Disabled
mode and Enable Symmetric Flow Control mode.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.5.2.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control

A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports


Ethernet port Layer 2 attributes define link-layer information.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

Port Mode of Ethernet ports are set to Layer 2.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1086

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Layer 2 Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set Ethernet port Layer 2 attributes.

NOTE

l When Encapsulation Type in the General Attributes tab page is set to QinQ, you need to set QinQ
Type Domain. The default value is 88A8.
l When Encapsulation Type in the General Attributes tab page is set to Null or 802.1Q, you cannot
set QinQ Type Domain. In this case, QinQ Type Domain is displayed as FFFF and cannot be
changed.
l QinQ Type Domain should be set to the same value for all the ports on the EM6T/EM6TA/EM6F/
EM6FA board or the EG2D logical board.
l If all the accessed services are frames with the VLAN tag (tagged frames), set TAG to Tag Aware.
l If all the accessed services are frames without the VLAN tag (untagged frames), set TAG to Access.
l If the accessed services contain tagged frames and untagged frames, set TAG to Hybrid.
l Default VLAN ID is valid only when TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l VLAN Priority is valid only when TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l When the VLAN priority is required to divide streams or to be used for other purposes, VLAN
Priority is set according to the planning information. In normal cases, it is recommended that you use
the default value.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.2.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Layer 2 Attributes

A.6.6.4 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of Ethernet Ports


The Layer 3 attributes of Ethernet ports define the relevant information used for carrying MPLS
tunnels, such as MPLS tunnel statuses and Ethernet port IP addresses.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Port Mode of Ethernet ports are set to Layer 3.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1087

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Layer 3 Attributes tab.

Step 3 Set the parameters for Ethernet ports according to the planning information.
Step 4 Click Apply.
The Warning dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Click Yes.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.
Step 6 Click Close.
----End

Related References
B.5.2.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_Layer 3 Attributes

A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports


You can configure MAC/PHY layer loopbacks, check the port rates, and configure loopback
detection and broadcast packet suppression functions by setting related Ethernet advanced
attributes.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1088

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set Ethernet port advanced attributes.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.5.2.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Advanced Attributes

A.6.7 Setting IF_ETH Port Parameters


This section describes how to set the IF_ETH port parameters. The IF_ETH port is the internal
Ethernet port on an IF board in IP radio mode and is used to receive and transmit Native ETH
services or packet services.

A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports


General IF_ETH port attributes specify the basic information, including the port mode and
encapsulation mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added to NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Basic Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set basic IF_ETH port attributes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1089

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l If Port Mode is Layer 2, Encapsulation Type can be set to Null, 802.1Q, or QinQ.
l If Port Mode is Layer 3, Encapsulation Type can be set to 802.1Q only and the port can carry tunnels.
l If Port Mode is Layer Mix, Encapsulation Type can be set to only 802.1Q or QinQ and the port can
carry both tunnels and Native Ethernet services.
l Encapsulation Type specifies the method of the port to process the received packets.
l If Encapsulation Type is set to Null, the port transparently transmits the received packets.
l If Encapsulation Type is set to 802.1Q, the port identifies the packets that comply with the IEEE
802.1Q standard.
l If Encapsulation Type is set to QinQ, the port identifies the packets that comply with the IEEE 802.1ad
QinQ standard.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.5.4.1 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Basic Attributes

A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports


IF_ETH port Layer 2 attributes specify the relevant information about the link layer, including
the tag attribute and QinQ type domain.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added to NE Panel.

The parameter Port Mode is set to Layer 2.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Layer 2 Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set IF_ETH port Layer 2 attributes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1090

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l When Encapsulation Type in the General Attributes tab page is set to QinQ, you need to set QinQ
Type Domain. The default value is 88A8.
l When Encapsulation Type in the General Attributes tab page is set to Null or 802.1Q, you cannot
set QinQ Type Domain. In this case, QinQ Type Domain is displayed as FFFF and cannot be
changed.
l If all the accessed services are frames that contain the VLAN tag (tagged frames), set Tag to "Tag
Aware".
l If all the accessed services are frames that do not contain the VLAN tag (untagged frames), set Tag to
"Access".
l If the accessed services contain tagged frames and untagged frames, set Tag to "Hybrid".
l Default VLAN ID is valid only when TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l VLAN Priority is valid only when TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l When the VLAN priority is required to divide streams or to be used for other purposes, VLAN
Priority needs to be set according to the planning information. In normal cases, it is recommended
that you use the default value.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.5.4.2 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2 Attributes

A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports


The Layer 3 attributes of IF_ETH ports define the relevant information used for carrying MPLS
tunnels, such as MPLS tunnel statuses and IF_ETH port IP addresses.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Port Mode of the ports on IF boards are set to Layer 3.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Layer 3 Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set parameters for Layer 3 attributes of the ports on IF boards according to the planning
information.

Step 4 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1091

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.5.4.3 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 3 Attributes

A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports


This section describes how to set the advanced attributes of IF_ETH ports.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added to NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set IF_ETH port advanced attributes.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.5.4.4 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Advanced Attributes

A.6.8 Setting IF Port Parameters


This section describes how to set IF port parameters, including IF attributes, ATPC attributes,
and AM attributes.

A.6.8.1 Setting IF Attributes


Set parameters specific to different IF boards.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1092

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Context
l

The IF1 board is used for TDM microwave.

The IFU2 and ISU2 boards are general-purpose IF boards.

The IFX2 and ISX2 boards are general-purpose XPIC IF boards.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IF Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set the parameters of general attributes.
l In the case of the IF1:

l In the case of the IFU2:

l In the case of the IFX2:

l For the ISU2 board:


1.

Optional:
set IF Service Type according to the network plan. Click Apply.
NOTE

After this operation, the IF board will be reset. Set other IF information after the IF board starts up.

2.

Set other general attributes.

l For the ISX2 board:


1.

Optional:
set IF Service Type according to the network plan. Click Apply.
NOTE

After this operation, the IF board will be reset. Set other IF information after the IF board starts up.

2.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Set other general attributes.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1093

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Link ID is set according to the network plan. Each radio link of an NE should have a unique link ID,
and the link IDs at both ends of a radio link should be the same.
l Generally, IF Port Loopback is used to locate the faults that occur at each IF interface. The IF loopback
is used for diagnosis. If this function is enabled, the services at the related ports are affected. In normal
cases, this parameter is set to Non-Loopback.
l 350 MHz Consecutive Wave Status can be set to Start in the commissioning process only. In normal
cases, this parameter is set to Stop. Otherwise, the services are interrupted.
l If the XPIC IF board does not perform the XPIC function, XPIC Enabled should be set to Disabled.
l Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot needs to be set consistently between two ends of a radio link.

Step 4 Configure the parameters of Hybrid/AM attributes for different IF services.


l For the IFU2 and IFX2 boards:

l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards:

NOTE

l When AM Enable Status is set to Disabled, the radio link uses only the specified modulation scheme.
In this case, you need to select Manually Specified Modulation Mode.
l When AM Enable Status is set to Enabled, the radio link uses the corresponding modulation scheme
according to the channel conditions.
l Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity specifies the lowest-order modulation scheme
that the AM function supports. This parameter is set according to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the service transmission bandwidth that the Hybrid radio must ensure
and the availability of the radio link that corresponds to this modulation scheme.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity specifies the highest-order modulation scheme that the
AM function supports. This parameter is set according to the network plan. Generally, the value of this
parameter is determined by the bandwidth of the services that need to be transmitted over the Hybrid
radio and the availability of the radio link that corresponds to this modulation scheme.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity must be higher than Modulation Mode of the Guarantee
AM Capacity.

Step 5 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.5.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes


To configure the ATPC function, set the ATPC attributes of the IF board.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added on the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1094

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Precautions
l

For the IF boards that are configured with 1+1 protection, configure only the ATPC
attributes of the main IF board.

The following procedure describes the ATPC parameter configurations in the IF port
configuration dialog box for the IF board. You can also configure ATPC parameters in the
Create XPIC Protection Group window.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the ATPC Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set the parameters of ATPC attributes.

NOTE

l The settings of the ATPC attributes must be consistent at both ends of a radio link.
l In the case of areas where fast fading severely affects the radio transmission, it is recommended that
you set ATPC Enable Status to Disabled.
l If ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable Status is set to Enabled, the equipment automatically uses
the preset ATPC upper and lower thresholds according to the work mode of the radio link.
l If ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable Status is set to Disabled, you need to manually set ATPC
Upper Automatic Threshold(dBm) and ATPC Lower Automatic Threshold(dBm).
l It is recommended that you set ATPC Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of the planned central value
between the ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC Lower
Threshold(dBm) to the difference between the planned central value between the ATPC upper
threshold and the ATPC lower threshold and 10 dB.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.5.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute

A.6.8.3 Setting Advanced AM Attributes


By performing this operation, you can query and adjust the E1 capacity in each modulation
scheme.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF boards must be added in the NE Panel.

The E1 priority function must be enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1095

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

The OptiX RTN 980 supports the configuration of E1 priorities. The IF boards that support
this function are IFU2, IFX2, ISU2, and ISX2.

For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, only the Integrated IP radio that transmits Native E1 services
supports the configuration of E1 priorities.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the IF board, and then choose Configuration > IF Interface from
the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the AM Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set each parameter for the advanced AM attributes.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.5.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid_AM Configuration_Advanced Attributes

A.6.8.4 Querying the AM Status


By querying the AM status, you can trace the change of the modulation mode when the AM
function is used.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF boards must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1096

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IF Attributes tab.
Step 3 Click Query.
Step 4 Query the AM information in Hybrid/AM Configuration.
----End

Related References
B.5.5.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

A.6.8.5 Querying ATPC Adjustment Records


By querying the ATPC adjustment records, you can view the ATPC running status.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF board must be added.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > ATPC Adjustment Records from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query to query the running information.
----End

Related References
B.5.5.4 Parameter Description: ATPC Adjustment Records

A.6.8.6 Modifying the Hybrid/AM Attributes


Any modifications to Hybrid/AM attributes must ensure that the Hybrid/AM attribute settings
are the same for both ends of the adjusted radio link. Otherwise, the modifications do not take
effect or services are interrupted.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF boards have been added in the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1097

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IF Attributes tab.
Step 3 Optional: Change the channel bandwidth.
1.

Set IF Channel Bandwidth to its planned value.

2.

Click Apply.

Step 4 Optional: When the AM function is disabled, adjust the modulation mode.
1.

Set Manually Specified Modulation Mode to its planned value.

2.

Click Apply.

Step 5 Disable the AM function.


1.

Optional: If the E1 priority function has been enabled, delete low-priority E1 services, set
Enable E1 Priority to Disabled, and click Apply.

2.

Set AM Enable Status to Disabled and set Manually Specified Modulation Mode to its
planned value.

3.

Click Apply.

Step 6 Optional: Enable the AM function.


1.

If the planned Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity is lower than Manually
Specified Modulation Mode, perform Step 4 and then change Manually Specified
Modulation Modeto the planned Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity.

2.

Set AM Enable Status to Enabled, and set Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM
Capacity and Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity to their planned values.

3.

Click Apply.

Step 7 Optional: When the AM function is enabled, adjust the modulation mode.
If...

Then...

You need to lower Modulation Mode of


the Guarantee AM Capacity

1. Perform Step 5 to disable the AM function,


and change Manually Specified
Modulation Mode to the lowered
Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM
Capacity.
2. Perform Step 6 to enable the AM function.

In other cases

1. Set Modulation Mode of the Guarantee


AM Capacity and Modulation Mode of the
Full AM Capacity to their planned values.
2. Click Apply.

Step 8 Optional: Change the number of high-priority E1 services (namely, Guarantee E1 Capacity)
in a radio link.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1098

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

If...

A Task Collection

Then...

You need to reduce the number of high- 1. Perform A.5.6 Deleting Cross-Connections
priority E1 services
to delete unnecessary E1 services.
2. Decrease Guarantee E1 Capacity.
3. Click Apply.
You need to increase the number of
high-priority E1 services

1. Increase Guarantee E1 Capacity.


2. If Enable E1 Priority is Enabled, increase
Full E1 Capacity accordingly.
3. Click Apply.
4. Perform A.5.1 Creating the CrossConnections of Point-to-Point Services or A.
5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP
Services to add required E1 services.
NOTE
l Full E1 Capacity is the total number of highpriority E1 services and low-priority E1 services.
l Adding high-priority E1 services does not affect
original E1 services.

Step 9 Optional: Change the number of low-priority E1 services (namely, Guarantee E1 Capacity)
in a radio link.
If...

Then...

You need to reduce the number of low- 1. Perform A.5.6 Deleting Cross-Connections
priority E1 services
to delete unnecessary E1 services.
2. Decrease Full E1 Capacity.
3. Click Apply.
You need to increase the number of low- 1. If Enable E1 Priority is Disabled, change
priority E1 services
Enable E1 Priority to Enabled.
2. Increase Full E1 Capacity.
3. Click Apply.
4. Perform A.5.1 Creating the CrossConnections of Point-to-Point Services or A.
5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP
Services to add required E1 services.
l Full E1 Capacity is the total number of highpriority E1 services and low-priority E1
services.
l Adding low-priority E1 services does not affect
original E1 services.
----End

Related References
B.5.5.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1099

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.6.9 Setting ODU Port Parameters


This section describes how to set ODU port parameters, including the transmit frequency
attributes, power attributes, ODU information, and advanced attributes.

A.6.9.1 Setting ODU Transmit Frequency Attributes


The ODU transmit frequency attributes define the DOU transmit frequency and T/R spacing.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Radio Frequency Attributes tab.
Step 3 Configure Transmit Frequency(MHz) and T/R Spacing(MHz) of the ODU.

NOTE

l The value of Transmit Frequency(MHz) must not be less than the sum of the minimum transmit
frequency supported by the ODU and a half of the channel spacing, and must not be more than the
difference between the maximum transmit frequency supported by the ODU and a half of the channel
spacing.
l The difference between the transmit frequencies at both ends of a radio link should be one T/R spacing.
l If the ODU is a Tx high station, the transmit frequency is one T/R spacing higher than the receive
frequency. If the ODU is a Tx low station, the transmit frequency is one T/R spacing lower than the
receive frequency.
l A valid T/R spacing value is determined by the ODU itself, and T/R Spacing(MHz) should be set
according to the technical specifications of the ODU.
l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be set to the same value at both ends of a radio link.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.6.1 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Radio Frequency Attribute

A.6.9.2 Querying ODU Information


ODU information provides details about the ODU.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1100

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > ODU Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Equipment Information tab.
Step 3 Click Query to obtain the information about the ODU.

----End

Related References
B.5.6.3 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Equipment Information

A.6.9.3 Setting ODU Power Attributes


The ODU power attributes define the transmit power and receive power of the ODU.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Power Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set the parameters of ODU power attributes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1101

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Maximum Transmit Power(dBm) is set according to the network plan. This parameter cannot be set
to a value that exceeds the nominal power rang of the ODU in the guaranteed capacity modulation
module.
l The maximum transmit power adjusted by using the ATPC function should not exceed Maximum
Transmit Power(dBm).
l Transmit Power(dBm) is set according to the network plan. This parameter specifies the transmit
power of the ODU. This parameter cannot be set to a value that exceeds the nominal power rang of the
ODU or a value that exceeds Maximum Transmit Power(dBm).
l Power to Be Received(dBm) is used to set the expected receive power of the ODU and is mainly used
in the antenna alignment stage. After this parameter is set, the NE automatically enables the antenna
misalignment indicating function.
l Power to Be Received(dBm) is set according to the network plan. When this parameter takes the
default value, the antenna misalignment indicating function is disabled.
l TX High Threshold(dBm) and TX Low Threshold(dBm) are valid only when the ATPC function is
enabled.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.6.2 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Power Attributes

A.6.9.4 Setting ODU Advanced Attributes


ODU advanced attributes define the ODU transmit status.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected must be added on the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Configure the ODU parameters, such as Configure Transmission Status.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1102

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l RF Loopback function is used for fault locating for the RF interfaces. The RF Loopback function is
used for diagnosis and may affect the services that are transmitted over the interfaces. Hence, exercise
caution before starting this function.
l In normal cases, RF Loopback is set to Non-Loopback.
l In normal cases, Configure Transmission Status is set to unmute.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.6.4 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Advanced Attributes

A.6.9.5 Setting the ODU Transmitter State


The state of an ODU transmitter can be mute or unmute. When the ODU transmitter is in the
unmute state, the ODU transmits and receives microwave signals normally. When the ODU
transmitter is in the mute state, the ODU transmitter does not work, but the ODU can receive
microwave signals.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF boards and the ODUs connected to the IF boards must be added to
the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set Configure Transmission Status for the ODU.

NOTE

l In normal cases, Configure Transmission Status is set to unmute.


l If Configure Transmission Status is set to mute, the transmitter of the ODU does not work but can
normally receive microwave signals.
l If Configure Transmission Status is set to unmute, the ODU can normally transmit and receive
microwave signals.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1103

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.6.9.6 Querying the Historical Transmit Power and Receive Power


If the radio link requires troubleshooting, query the change trend for the historical transmit power
and receive power for reference.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding IF boards and the ODUs connected to the IF boards must be added to
the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Performance Graph Analyse from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Specify the start time and end time of a specific time span.
Step 3 Set Monitoring Period and Power.
Step 4 Click Draw. The historical transmit and receive power curve of the ODU in the specified time
span is displayed.
----End

A.6.9.7 Querying the SNR Values of a Radio Link


This section describes how to query the signal-to-noise ratio (SNR) change curve of a radio link,
assisting in handling radio link faults.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF boards and the ODUs to which the IF boards are connected have been added in the
NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired IF board from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Set the desired query time span by specifying the start time and end time.
Step 3 Set Monitoring Period and SNR Type according to the planning information.
Step 4 Click Draw. Then, the system displays the SNR change curve during the specified time span.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1104

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.6.10 Creating VLAN Sub-Interfaces


When LSPs need to traverse a Layer 2 network or be transmitted together with Native Ethernet
services, you need to create VLAN sub-interfaces.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Ethernet boards have been added on the NE Panel.

Port Mode has been set to Layer Mix for Ethernet ports.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
VLAN sub-interfaces are similar to Layer 3 ports. By configuring Layer 3 port attributes for
VLAN sub-interfaces, you can create MPLS tunnel-based services. After being received by
access-layer RTN equipment and then mapped into an MPLS tunnel, services are allocated
different VLAN IDs at VLAN sub-interfaces in compliance with configuration requirements for
the third-party network that the services need to traverse. In this manner, services are
differentiated and therefore correctly forwarded on the third-party network.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > Ethernet Virtual Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Basic Attributes tab.
Step 3 Choose New > Create Ethernet Virtual Interface.
The Create Ethernet Virtual Interface dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set VLAN sub-interface parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1105

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.5.10 Parameter Description: Ethernet Virtual Interfaces

A.7 Configuring Ethernet Services and Features on the


Packet Plane
Configurations of Ethernet services and features on the packet plane include Ethernet port,
protection, service, protocol, and OAM configurations.

A.7.1 Managing ERPS


Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS) can be configured on the FE/GE ring or Integrated
IP radio ring to protect the Ethernet service.

A.7.1.1 Creating Ethernet Ring Protection Instances


Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS) is configured by creating Ethernet ring protection
instances.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet boards, general-purpose IF boards, or general-purpose XPIC IF boards must


be added to the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1106

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protection > ERPS Management.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create Ethernet Ring Protection Protocol Instance dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the parameters for the ERPS protection instance.

NOTE

l Only one node on the ring can be set as the RPL owner for each Ethernet ring.
l An RPL owner needs to balance the traffic on each link of an Ethernet ring. Therefore, it is not recommended
that you select a convergence node as an RPL owner. Instead, select the NE that is farthest away from the
convergence node as an RPL owner.
l It is recommended that you set the east port on an RPL owner as an RPL Port.
l The ID of a Control VLAN must not be the same as any VLAN ID used by Ethernet services. All ring nodes
should use the same Control VLAN ID.

Step 4 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.6.2.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation

A.7.1.2 Setting the Parameters of Ethernet Ring Protocol


The parameters to be set include the hold-off time, WTR time, and guard time.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The ERPS protection instance must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1107

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protection > ERPS Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Optional: Double-click Control VLAN, and then modify the VLAN ID.

Step 3 Optional: Set the parameters of Ethernet ring protocol.

NOTE

Set the parameters according to the network plan. Default values are recommended.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.6.2.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management

A.7.1.3 Querying the Status of the Ethernet Ring Protocol


By performing this operation, you can discover the current status of Ethernet ring protection
switching (ERPS).

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protection > ERPS Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Query the status of the Ethernet ring protocol.
----End

Related References
B.6.2.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1108

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.2 Managing the LAG


Link aggregation allows one or multiple links that are attached to the same equipment to be
aggregated together to form a LAG. The aggregated links can be considered as a single logical
link by the MAC address. In this manner, the bandwidth is increased and the availability of the
links is improved.

A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG


Between two NEs, if the bandwidth and availability of the Ethernet links need to be improved,
the new LAG must be created.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The board on which the LAG port to be created must be added to the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The system displays the Create Link Aggregation Group dialog box.
Step 4 Set the LAG attributes in Attribute Settings.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1109

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l When Automatically Assign is selected, LAG No. cannot be set.


l Revertive Mode can be set only when Load Sharing is set to Non-Sharing.
l When Revertive Mode is set to Revertive Mode, the services are switched back to the former working
channel after this channel is restored to normal.
l Set Load Sharing to the same value as the peer equipment. It is recommended that you set Load
Sharing to Non-Sharing at both ends if the LAGs are used for protection and set Load Sharing to
Sharing at both ends if the LAGs are used for increasing bandwidths.
l System Priority indicates the priority of a LAG. The smaller the value of System Priority, the higher the
priority.
l WTR Time(min) takes effect only when Revertive Mode is Revertive Mode.

Step 5 Set the LAG port in Port Settings.


1.

Set Main Board and Main Port.

2.

In Available Slave Ports, select Board for the slave port.

3.

In Port, select the slave port, and then click

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key or the Shift key on the keyboard to select multiple ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1110

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

For a LAG consisting of Native Ethernet ports:


l The Ethernet links in a LAG are considered as one link at the data link layer. Therefore, the Ethernet
port attributes or IF_ETH port attributes of a master port are set to the same as those of a slave port.
l If a port is already configured with Ethernet services, set the port to a master port when a LAG is
configured.
l When a LAG is configured, do not set a port that is already configured with services to a slave port.
For a LAG consisting of MPLS ports:
l If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set Enable Tunnel on the main port to
Enabled, and set Enable Tunnel on the slave port to Disabled (the default value).
l If LAG protection is configured for the MPLS ports, set Specify IP Address on the main port to
Manually, and set Specify IP Address on the slave port to Unspecified.

4.

Click OK. A dialog box is displayed for confirmation. Click OK. A dialog box is displayed,
indicating that the operation is successful. Close this dialog box.

Step 6 Optional: Set Switch LAG upon Air Interface SD to Enabled.


NOTE

This operation is necessary during LAG configuration at air interfaces if signals on the radio link deteriorate
and LAG switching occurs.

----End

Related References
B.6.2.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation Management_LAG Creation

A.7.2.2 Setting LAG Parameters


The LAG parameters for a LAG include port priorities. In a static LAG, traffic is always carried
by a port with a higher priority.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The board on which the LAG to be created must be added to NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Priority tab.
Step 3 Set the port priority.
Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1111

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.6.2.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Link Aggregation

A.7.2.3 Querying the Protocol Information of the LAG


By performing this operation, you can learn about the running information of the LACP used
for the LAG.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The LAG must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.
Step 3 Click Query. A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation is successful. Close this
dialog box.
Step 4 In the Main Interface, select the LAG to be queried.
Step 5 Query port status of the main and slave ports.
NOTE

The system displays the information about the slave port in the lower part of the Main Interface.

Step 6 Right-click on the selected LAG and choose the LAG-specific information from the shortcut
menu.

Step 7 Click Close.


Step 8 Click the Port Priority tab.
Step 9 Click Query. A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation is successful. Close this
dialog box.
Step 10 Query the port priority of the LAG.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1112

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.3 Configuring Ethernet Services


The Ethernet service is classified into two types, namely, E-Line service and E-LAN service.

A.7.3.1 Configuring the QinQ Link


Configuring the QinQ link is the prerequisite for configuring QinQ private line services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

On associated ports, the Encapsulation Type is set to QinQ.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > QinQ Link from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
Step 3 Configure the basic attributes of the QinQ link.

Step 4 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.6 Parameter Description: QinQ Link_Creation

A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services


This section describes how to create an E-Line service that is transparently transmitted end to
end or is transmitted based on VLANs.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1113

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The parameter Port Mode is set to Layer 2 for the UNI port that carries the E-Line service.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-Line Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set Direction to UNI-UNI.
Step 4 Configure the attributes of the E-Line service.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.1.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation

A.7.3.3 Configuring NNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links)


This topic describes how to configure QinQ-based E-Line services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Ethernet boards have been added on the NE Panel.

For ports that carry services, Port Mode has been set to Layer 2 and Encapsulation
Type has been set to QinQ.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1114

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-Line Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set Direction to NNI-NNI.
Step 4 Set relevant attributes of the E-Line service.

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation

A.7.3.4 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links)


This topic describes how to configure E-Line services carried by QinQ links.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Ethernet boards have been added on the NE Panel.

For UNI and NNI ports that carry services, Port Mode has been set to Layer 2. For NNI
ports, Encapsulation Type has been set to QinQ.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1115

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Click New.


The New E-Line ServiceCreate E-Line Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set Direction to UNI-NNI and set Bearer Type to QinQ Link.
Step 4 Set relevant attributes of the E-Line service.
NOTE

You can configure QinQ links during service creation or before service creation by choosing Configuration >
Ethernet Service Management > QinQ Link.

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation

A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs)


This section describes how to configure E-Line services carried by PWs.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board is added on the NE Panel.

Port Mode is set to Layer 2 for the UNI ports that carry services.

For the UNI port that carries the service, Port Mode has been set to Layer 2. For the NNI
port that carries the service, Port Mode has been set to Layer 3.

The tunnel that carries PWs is configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1116

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-Line Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set Direction to UNI-NNI, Bearer Type to PW, and Protection Type to No Protection for
E-Line services.
NOTE

When E-Line services are initially configured, it is recommended that you set Protection Type to No
Protection for the services. After successful service creation, add the APS protection when necessary. For details
on how to add APS protection, see A.9.5.1 Creating a PW APS Protection Group.

Step 4 Set the basic attributes of E-Line services.

Step 5 Click Advanced Attributes.


The Advanced Attributes dialog box is displayed.
Step 6 Click Configure PW.
The Configure PW dialog box is displayed.
Step 7 Click the General Attributes tab and set the basic parameters for PWs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1117

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 8 Click the QoS tab and set the QoS parameters for PWs.

Step 9 Click the Advanced Attributes tab and set the advanced parameters for PWs.

Step 10 Click OK, and close the Configure PW dialog box.


Step 11 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation

A.7.3.6 Creating E-AGGR Services


This section describes how to create E-AGGR services aggregating services from multiple UNI
ports to a PW or aggregating services from multiple PWs to a UNI port. If VLAN ID swapping
is required for PW-based E-Line services, change the E-Line services to an E-AGGR service.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1118

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Ethernet boards have been added on the NE Panel.

For the UNI ports that carry the service, Port Mode has been set to Layer 2 and
Encapsulation Type has been set to 802.1Q or QinQ. For the NNI port that carries the
service, Port Mode has been set to Layer 3.

The MPLS tunnels that carry PWs have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
l

Regardless of whether VLAN ID swapping is required by an E-AGGR service, a VLAN


forwarding table needs to be configured, specifying the source and sink VLAN IDs of each
VLAN service.

If VLAN ID swapping is required for PW-based E-Line services, change the E-Line
services to an E-AGGR service.

For an E-AGGR service aggregating services from multiple UNI ports to a PW, the NNI
port must be configured as the sink. For an E-AGGR service aggregating services from
multiple PWs to a UNI port, the UNI port must be configured as the sink.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Ethernet Service Management > E-AGGR Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-AGGR Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the basic attributes for the E-AGGR service.

Step 4 Configure the UNI ports required for the E-AGGR service.
1.

Click the UNI tab. Click Configuration.


The Configure Port dialog box is displayed.

2.

Select the desired port from the Available Port list and click
the Selected Port list.

3.

In the Selected Port area, set Location and VLANs according to planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

to add the port to

1119

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

You can set Location to Source or Sink. You can configure one or more source ports but only one
sink port for an E-AGGR service. Otherwise, configuration of the E-AGGR service will fail.

4.

Click OK.

Step 5 Configure the NNI port required for the E-AGGR service.
1.

Click the NNI tab. Click the PW tab. Click New.


The New dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set parameters in Basic Attributes according to planning information.

3.

Set parameters in Advanced Attributes according to planning information.

4.

Click OK.

Step 6 Set the attributes for the VLAN forwarding table.


1.

Click VLAN Forwarding Table Item and click New.


The New VLAN Forwarding Table Item dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set related parameters according to VLAN planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1120

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

Services are forwarded by VLAN ID. Therefore, you need to set the VLAN forwarding attributes
from each Source Interface to its Sink Interface. Both the source and the sink VLAN IDs must be
within the VLAN ID range configured for the service.

3.

Click OK.

Step 7 Optional: Click the Configure QoS tab and set QoS parameters.
1.

Click the PW tab and set EXP and LSP Mode.

2.

Click OK.

Step 8 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.6.1.7 Parameter Description: E-AGGR Services_Creation

A.7.3.7 Creating a VLAN Forwarding Table for an E-Line Service


A VLAN forwarding table enables VLAN ID swapping at the source or sink end of an E-Line
service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Ethernet boards have been added on the NE Panel.

A UNI-UNI E-Line service has been created.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1121

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the E-Line service for which a VLAN forwarding table needs to be configured.
Step 3 Click the VLAN Forwarding Table Item tab.
Step 4 Click New.
Step 5 Set the attributes for the VLAN forwarding table.
Step 6 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.3 Parameter Description: VLAN Forwarding Table Items for E-Line Services_Creation

A.7.3.8 Configuring TPID for a Request VLAN


When a request VLAN is used for E-Line services transmitted by PWs, the TPID in the request
VLAN is defaulted to be 0x88A8. The TPID can be set for an NE.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Instruments and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree, and then choose
Configuration > TPID Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Set TPID(Hexadecimal) according to planning information.

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

A.7.3.9 Configuring IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


The E-LAN service refers to Ethernet service dynamic transmission in the multipoint-tomultipoint mode by means of MAC addresses.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1122

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

For ports carrying IEEE 802.1d bridge-based E-LAN services, Port Mode has been set to
Layer 2 and Encapsulation Type has been set to Null.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-LAN Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the basic attributes of the E-LAN service according to the network plan.
NOTE

Set Tag Type to Tag-Transparent.

Step 4 Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the UNI side.
1.

Click UNI.

2.

Click Configuration.
The Configure Port dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the UNI side.


a.

Select the port to be mounted to the bridge.


NOTE

Preset Encapsulation Type of the port to Null.

b.
4.

Click

to mount the port to the bridge.

Click OK.

Step 5 Optional: Configure split horizon groups.


NOTE

The port members that are added to the same split horizon group cannot communicate with each other.

1.

Click the Split Horizon Group tab and click New.


The New Split Horizon Group dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1123

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

Set port parameters for the split horizon group as planned.

3.

Click

4.

Click OK.

A Task Collection

Step 6 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.1.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation

A.7.3.10 Configuring IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


An IEEE 802.1q bridge is a virtual bridge (VB), which can be divided by VLAN into several
switching domains.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

For the ports that carry the IEEE 802.1q bridge-based E-LAN services, Port Mode has
been set to Layer 2 and Encapsulation Type has been set to 802.1Q.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-LAN Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set basic attributes of the E-LAN service as planned.
NOTE

Set Tag Type to C-Awared.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1124

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the UNI side.
1.

Click UNI.

2.

Click Configuration.
The Configure Port dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the UNI side.


a.

Select the port to be mounted to the bridge.


NOTE

Preset Encapsulation Type of the port to 802.1Q.

4.

b.

Click

to mount the port to the bridge.

c.

Set the VLAN ID of the port mounted to the bridge according to the network plan.

Click OK.

Step 5 Optional: Configure split horizon groups.


NOTE

The port members that are added to the same split horizon group cannot communicate with each other.

1.

Click the Split Horizon Group tab and click New.


The New Split Horizon Group dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set port parameters for the split horizon group as planned.

3.

Click

4.

Click OK.

Step 6 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.1.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation

A.7.3.11 Configuring IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN Services


An IEEE 802.1ad bridge is a provider bridge (PB), which can be divided by SVLAN into several
switching domains.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

For the board that transmits the IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN service, Port Mode
has been set to Layer 2.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1125

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New E-LAN Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set parameters of the E-LAN service as planned.
NOTE

Set Tag Type to S-Awared.

Step 4 Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the UNI side.
1.

Click UNI.

2.

Click Configuration.
The Configure Port dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the UNI side.


a.

Select the port to be mounted to the bridge.


NOTE

Preset Encapsulation Type of the port to 802.1Q.

4.

b.

Click

c.

Set the VLAN ID of the port mounted to the bridge according to the network plan.

to mount the port to the bridge.

Click OK.

Step 5 Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the NNI side.
1.

Click NNI.

2.

Click Configuration.
The Configure Port dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure the ports mounted to the bridge on the NNI side.

4.

Click OK.

Step 6 Optional: Configure split horizon groups.


NOTE

The port members that are added to the same split horizon group cannot communicate with each other.

1.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click the Split Horizon Group tab and click New.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1126

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The New Split Horizon Group dialog box is displayed.


2.

Set port parameters for the split horizon group as planned.

3.

Click

4.

Click OK.

Step 7 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.1.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation

A.7.3.12 Changing Logical Ports Connected to a VB


This section describes how to change the logical ports connected to a VB and the port attributes.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The E-LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Add or delete logical ports connected to a VB.
NOTE

l To add or delete ports connected to the VB on the UNI side, click the UNI tab.
l To add or delete ports connected to the VB on the NNI side, click the NNI tab.

1.

Click Configuration. In the displayed Configure Port dialog box, select the port to be
added to or deleted from the list of ports connected to the VB.

2.

Optional: Click

3.

Optional: Click

to add ports to the list of ports connected to the VB.


to delete ports from the list of ports connected to the VB.

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key on the key board to select multiple ports.

4.

In Selected Port List, set the attributes of the ports connected to the VB.

5.

Click OK.
A dialog box is displayed for confirmation.

6.

Click Yes. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1127

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.3.13 Deleting an E-Line Service


When an E-Line service is not used, you need to delete the E-Line service to release the resources.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The E-Line service is configured and this service is not used.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 3 Select the E-Line service that needs to be deleted and then click Delete.
A dialog box is displayed, querying whether you need to perform this operation.
Step 4 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 5 Click Query.
The E-Line service is already deleted.
----End

A.7.3.14 Deleting E-LAN Services


When an E-LAN service is not required, you can delete this E-LAN service to release the
Ethernet resources.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

A configured E-LAN service is not required.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 3 Select the E-LAN service to be deleted and click Delete.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1128

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Yes. Close the displayed dialog box.


Step 5 Click Query.
The E-LAN service is already deleted.
----End

A.7.4 Managing the MAC Address Table


The MAC address table is the core of the E-LAN service. The OptiX RTN 980 provides various
functions for managing the MAC address table.

A.7.4.1 Creating a Static MAC Address Entry


Through the creation of a static MAC address entry, the host with a specified MAC address is
not affected by MAC address aging. In addition, the E-LAN service can be supported by the
host that receives packets only.

Prerequisite
l

The E-LAN service must be created.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 On the main interface, select the E-LAN service whose static MAC address entry needs to be
created.
Step 3 Click the Static MAC Address tab.
Step 4 Click New.
The New Static MAC Address dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Configure the parameters of the static MAC address entry.

Step 6 Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1129

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.4.2 Creating a Blacklist Entry of MAC Addresses


Through the creation of a blacklist entry of MAC addresses, the host with a specified MAC
address can be prohibited from using the E-LAN service.

Prerequisite
l

The E-LAN service must be created.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 On the main interface, select the E-LAN service whose blacklist entry of MAC addresses needs
to be created.
Step 3 Click the Disabled MAC Address tab.
Step 4 Click New.
The Create Disabled MAC Address dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Configure the blacklist entry of MAC addresses.

Step 6 Click OK, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service

A.7.4.3 Configuring the Aging Parameters of a MAC Address Table


By default, the aging function of a MAC address table is enabled and the aging time is five
minutes. By configuring the aging parameters of a MAC address table, you can modify such
parameters.

Prerequisite
l

The E-LAN service must be created.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1130

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 On the main interface, select the E-LAN service whose aging parameters of the MAC address
table need to be configured.
Step 3 Click the MAC Address Learning Parameters tab.
Step 4 Configure the status of the aging function and set the aging time.

Step 5 Click Apply, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service

A.7.4.4 Querying or Deleting a Dynamic MAC Address


By querying or deleting a dynamic MAC address, you can query or delete all the MAC address
entries that are learned by the E-LAN service.

Prerequisite
l

The E-LAN service must be created.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 On the main interface, select the E-LAN service whose dynamic MAC address needs to be
queried or cleared.
Step 3 Click the Self-Learning MAC Address tab.
Step 4 Optional: Select the board whose dynamic MAC address needs to be queried and then check
the dynamic MAC addresses in the MAC address table that is displayed.
Step 5 Optional: Click Clear MAC Address to clear the dynamic MAC addresses. Then, click OK
in the dialog box that is displayed for confirmation.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1131

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service

A.7.5 Setting the Mode for Processing an Unknown Frame of the ELAN Service
An unknown frame is a unicast frame whose destination MAC address is not listed in the MAC
address table or a multicast frame whose destination MAC address is not listed in the multicast
group. By default, the NE broadcasts the unknown frame. By setting the mode for processing
an unknown frame of the E-LAN service, you can change the processing mode so that unknown
frame can be discarded.

Prerequisite
l

The E-LAN service must be created.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 On the main interface, select the E-LAN service, the mode for processing whose unknown frame
needs to be set.
Step 3 Click the Unknown Frame Processing tab.
Step 4 Set the mode for processing an unknown frame of the E-LAN service.

Step 5 Click Apply, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service

A.7.6 Managing the MSTP


The OptiX RTN 980 supports only the MSTP that generates the CIST.

A.7.6.1 Creating the MSTP Port Group


When the NE needs to run the MSTP protocol together with the user network, the ports on the
NE that are connected to the user network need to be configured as a port group. All the members
in the port group are involved in the spanning tree algorithm of the user network.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1132

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The boards where the member ports are located must be added in NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Group Parameters tab.
Step 3 Click Create.
Then, the Create Port Group dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the attributes of the port group.
1.

Set Protocol Type and Enable Protocol.

2.

Select the board where the member port is located from the drop-down list of Board under
Apply Port.

3.

Select the member port from Available Port List. Then, click

TIP

To select more than one port at a time, press and hold the Ctrl key or the Shift key when selecting
the ports.

4.

Click OK.

----End

Related References
B.6.2.3 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Creation
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1133

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.6.2 Setting the Bridge Parameters of the MSTP


This topic describes how to set the bridge parameters and port parameters of the MSTP.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The port group must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Bridge Parameters tab.
Step 3 Select the port group ID.
Step 4 Click the Bridge Parameters tab.
Step 5 Set the attributes of the bridge.

Step 6 Click Apply.


Step 7 Click the Port Parameter tab.
Step 8 Set the parameters of each member of the port group.

Step 9 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.6.2.5 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_ Bridge Parameters

A.7.6.3 Setting the Parameters of the CIST


This topic describes how to set the CIST parameters, including the bridge priority, port priority,
and path overheads.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The port group must be created.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1134

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the CIST&MSTI Parameters tab.
Step 3 Select the port group from the drop-down list of Port Group.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the port group.

Step 5 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.6.2.6 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_CIST Parameters

A.7.6.4 Querying the CIST Running Information


By querying the CIST running information, you can be familiar with the current information of
the CIST.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MSTP port group must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1135

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the CIST Running Information tab.
Step 3 Click Query.
Step 4 Query the CIST running information.
----End

Related References
B.6.2.7 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Running Information About the CIST

A.7.6.5 Changing the Spanning Tree Protocol Used by the Port Group
When the spanning tree protocol is upgraded (for example, from the STP protocol to the MSTP
protocol) for the equipment that runs the spanning tree together with the local NE, you need to
change the spanning tree protocol used by the port group on the local NE to be the same.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Group Parameters tab.
Step 3 Select the target protocol type from the Protocol Type drop-down list of the port group whose
spanning tree protocol needs to be changed.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

A.7.6.6 Enabling/Disabling the MSTP Protocol


This topic describes how to enable or disable the MSTP protocol of a port group or members of
the port group.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1136

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Group Parameters tab.
Step 3 Select Enabled or Disabled from the Enable Protocol drop-down list of the port group for
which the MSTP protocol needs to be enabled or disabled.

Step 4 Click Apply.


Step 5 Select Enabled or Disabled from the Enable Protocol drop-down list in Port Group to enable
or disable the MSTP protocol of a port.

Step 6 Click Apply.


----End

A.7.6.7 Modifying the Configuration Data of the MSTP Port Group


This topic describes how to modify the configuration data of the MSTP port group.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Group Parameters tab.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1137

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Click Config.


Then, the Config Port Group dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Modify the configuration data of the MSTP port group.
Option

Description

If...

Then...

A member port needs to be added

1. Select the board where the member ports are located


from the drop-down list of Board.
2. Select the port to be added from Available Port
List.
3. Click

A member port needs to be deleted 1. Select the port to be deleted from Selected Port
List.
2. Click

TIP

To select more than one port at a time, press and hold the Ctrl key or Shift key when selecting the ports.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.6.2.4 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Configuration

A.7.7 Managing the QoS


By managing the QoS, you can provide the services of different levels for different service types.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1138

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.7.1 Creating a DS Domain


By creating a DS domain, you can create the mappings relationship of a new DS domain and
configure the ports that use this mapping relationship.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The board of the Ethernet ports must be added on NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The OptiX RTN 980 has a default DS domain, whose Mapping Relation ID is 1 and Mapping
Relation Name is default map.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create DS Domain dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 On the main interface, configure the DS domain attributes.
NOTE

The MPLS EXP value can be modified in the default Diffserv domain (Default Map) only.

Step 4 Click the Inbound Mapping Relation tab.


Step 5 Configure the mapping relationships between the priorities of ingress packets and PHB service
classes.
Step 6 Click the Outbound Mapping Relation tab.
Step 7 Configure the mapping relationships between the priorities of egress packets and PHB service
classes.
Step 8 Select Board where the application ports exist from Application Port.
Step 9 Select a port from Available Port, and then click

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key on the keyboard to select multiple ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1139

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l The PHB service class refers to the forwarding behavior of the DS node on the behavior aggregate (BA)
operation. The forwarding behavior can meet the specific requirements.
l The PHB service classes are BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The priorities (C_VLAN priority,
S_VLAN priority, DSCP value and MPLS EXP value) contained in the packets of the DS domain and the
eight PHB service classes meet the requirements of the specified or default mapping relationship.

Step 10 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.4.2 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Management_Create

A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain


This section describes how to modify the mapping relationships between packet priorities and
PHB service classes in the ingress or egress direction of a DS domain.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1140

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The OptiX RTN 980 has a default DS domain, whose Mapping Relation ID is 1 and Mapping
Relation Name is default map.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the created DS domain and change its attributes on the main interface.
NOTE

The MPLS EXP value can be modified in the default Diffserv domain (Default Map) only.

Step 3 Optional: Change the mapping relationship in the ingress direction.


1.

Click the Inbound Mapping Relation tab.

2.

Double-click the parameters whose values need to be changed and change the mapping
relationship between the packet priorities and PHB classes in the ingress direction.
NOTE

l The PHB service class refers to the forwarding behavior of the DS node on the behavior aggregate
(BA) operation. The forwarding behavior can meet the specific requirements.
l The PHB service classes are BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The priorities (C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN priority, DSCP value and MPLS EXP value) contained in the packets of the DS
domain and the eight PHB service classes meet the requirements of the specified or default mapping
relationship.

3.

Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.

Step 4 Optional: Change the mapping relationship in the egress direction.


1.

Click the Outbound Mapping Relation tab.

2.

Double-click the parameters whose values need to be changed and change the mapping
relationship between the packet priorities and PHB classes in the egress direction.
NOTE

l The PHB service class refers to the forwarding behavior of the DS node on the behavior aggregate
(BA) operation. The forwarding behavior can meet the specific requirements.
l The PHB service classes are BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The priorities (C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN priority, DSCP value and MPLS EXP value) contained in the packets of the DS
domain and the eight PHB service classes meet the requirements of the specified or default mapping
relationship.

3.

Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.6.4.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1141

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their Trusted Packet
Types
This section describes how to add or delete a port that uses the DS domain and set the packet
type over the port.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The OptiX RTN 980 has a default DS domain, whose Mapping Relation ID is 1 and Mapping
Relation Name is default map.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the DS domain for which you need to add or delete an application port on the main
interface.
Step 3 Click the Application Object tab.
Step 4 Click Modify.
Step 5 Add or delete a port that uses the DS domain.
Option

Description

If...

Then...

You need to add a port that uses the DS


domain

1. Select the board where the application port is


located from the drop-down list of Board.
2. Select the port to be added from the dropdown list of Available Port.
3. Click

You need to delete a port that uses the DS 1. Select the board where the application port is
domain
located from the drop-down list of Board.
2. Select the port to be deleted from the port list
of Selected Port.
3. Click
You need to change the packet type
identified by the port
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Select a new packet type from the drop-down list


of Packet Type.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1142

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key on the key board to select multiple ports.

NOTE

l C-VLAN indicates the client-side VLAN priority, and the value 7 indicates the highest priority.
l S-VLAN indicates the server-side VLAN priority, and the value 7 indicates the highest priority.
l The differentiated services code point (DSCP) refers to bits 0-5 of the differentiated services (DS) field in
the packet and indicates the service class and discarding priority of the packet.
l The packets trusted by the OptiX RTN 980 are the C_VLAN, S_VLAN, IP DSCP and MPLS packets that
contain the C_VLAN priority, S_VLAN priority, DSCP value or MPLS EXP value. By default, the untrusted
packets are mapped to the BE service class for best-effort forwarding.

Step 6 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1143

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.6.4.3 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Applied Port_Modification

A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy


By creating a port policy, you can create a scheduling, weight, and shaping of the egress queues.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The board of the Ethernet ports must be added on NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Optional: Configure the weighted round robin (WRR) scheduling policy.
NOTE

In the default WRR scheduling policy for OptiX RTN 980, AF4, AF3, AF2, and AF1 occupy the same
weight of 25% and other queues occupy the weight of 0%.

1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > WRR Scheduling Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New. The Create WRR Policy dialog box is displayed.

3.

Set the scheduling weight for each queue.

4.

Click OK.

Step 2 Configure the port policy.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New. The Create Port Policy dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1144

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

Set the ID and name of the port policy.

4.

Configure the scheduling and shaping of the egress queues.

A Task Collection

NOTE

l The strict priority (SP) scheduling algorithm is designed for the key services. One important
characteristic of the key services is that higher priorities are required to minimize the response delay
in the case of congestion events.
l The weighted round robin (WRR) scheduling algorithm divides each port into multiple output subqueues. The polling scheduling is performed among the output sub-queues to ensure that each subqueue has a certain period of service time.
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports the setting of the SP+WRR scheduling algorithm of the CoS queue
according to the requirement, and provides one or more queues that comply with the SP algorithm.
Except for the default value, however, the value of the WRR scheduling algorithm and the value of
the SP scheduling algorithm cannot be interleaved. That is, except for the default value, Grooming
Police After Reloading can be changed from SP to WRR according to the queue priorities in a
descending order (CS7-BE).
l Bandwidth Limit indicates or specifies whether traffic shaping is enabled for an egress queue
corresponding to a PHB service class.
l CIR (kbit/s), PIR (kbit/s), CBS (byte), and PBS (byte) can be set only when Bandwidth Limit is
set to Enabled.

5.

Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End

Related References
B.6.4.5 Parameter Description: Port Policy
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1145

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.7.7.5 Modifying the Port Policy


This section describes how to change the parameter values of a created port policy.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The port policy must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the port policy whose parameter values need to be changed.
Step 3 Double-click the parameters whose values need to be changed and change the queue scheduling,
and queue shaping of the port queues.
NOTE

l The strict priority (SP) scheduling algorithm is designed for the key services. One important characteristic
of the key services is that higher priorities are required to minimize the response delay in the case of
congestion events.
l The weighted round robin (WRR) scheduling algorithm divides each port into multiple output sub-queues.
The polling scheduling is performed among the output sub-queues to ensure that each sub-queue has a certain
period of service time.
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports the setting of the SP+WRR scheduling algorithm of the CoS queue according
to the requirement, and provides one or more queues that comply with the SP algorithm. Except for the
default value, however, the value of the WRR scheduling algorithm and the value of the SP scheduling
algorithm cannot be interleaved. That is, except for the default value, Grooming Police After Reloading
can be changed from SP to WRR according to the queue priorities in a descending order (CS7-BE).
l Bandwidth Limit indicates or specifies whether traffic shaping is enabled for an egress queue corresponding
to a PHB service class.
l CIR (kbit/s), PIR (kbit/s), CBS (byte), and PBS (byte) can be set only when Bandwidth Limit is set to
Enabled.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.4.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management

A.7.7.6 Creating Traffic


By creating traffic, you can configure ACL, CAR and shaping for a specified traffic stream on
a specified port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1146

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

The port policy must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Traffic Classification Configuration tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create Traffic Classification dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the attributes.

NOTE

Set the parameters according to the network plan.

Step 5 Click Apply.


----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1147

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.6.4.6 Parameter Description: Port Policy_Traffic Classification Configuration

A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy


This section describes how to set the port that uses the port policy.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be added on the NE Panel.

The port policy must be created.

Tools, Instruments, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Application Object tab.
Step 3 Click Modify.
Then, the Configure Port dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the port that uses the port policy.
1.

Select Board where the port that needs to use the port policy from Application Port.

2.

Select a port from Available Ports, and then click

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key on the keyboard to select multiple ports.

3.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1148

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Delete the port that uses the port policy.


1.

Select the port to be deleted from Selected Ports and click

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key on the keyboard to select multiple ports.

2.

Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.

----End

Related References
B.6.4.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management

A.7.7.8 Configuring Port Shaping


This section describes how to configure traffic shaping for an egress port.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet board must be created on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the parameters for port shaping.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1149

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

Traffic shaping for an egress queue uses the single token bucket two color marker algorithm. The value of the
CIR must be equal to the value of the PIR. In actual traffic shaping processing, only the PIR is valid.
If the traffic shaping function is enabled, OptiX RTN 980 processes the packets in the buffer queue through the
following methods when no packets are available in the queue.
l When the buffer queue is empty, the packets are processed as follows: If the rate of a packet is equal to or
lower than the PIR, it is directly forwarded; if the rate of a packet is higher than the PIR, it enters the buffer
queue and then is forwarded at a rate equal to the PIR.
l When the buffer queue is empty, certain burst packets can be forwarded if the rate of the packets is equal to
or lower than the PIR in a certain period. The maximum traffic of the burst packets is determined by the
PBS.
l When the buffer queue is not empty, the packets whose rate passes the restriction of the PIR directly enter
the buffer queue and then are forwarded at a rate equal to the PIR.

Step 4 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.6.4.7 Parameter Description: Port Shaping Management_Creation

A.7.7.9 Querying the Port Policy


This section describes how to query the port policy of a port.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the created port policy.
Step 3 Click the CoS Configuration tab.
Step 4 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1150

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Query the CoS configuration of the port policy.


Step 6 Click the Traffic Classification Configuration tab.
Step 7 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 8 Query the traffic classification of the port policy.
Step 9 Click the Applied Object tab.
Step 10 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 11 Query the ports that use the port policy.
----End

Related References
B.6.4.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management

A.7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port


This topic describes how to query the mapping relationship between a port and a DS domain.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The OptiX RTN 980 has a default DS domain, whose Mapping Relation ID is 1 and Mapping
Relation Name is default map. Before another DS domain is created, all the ports belong to this
default DS domain.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Inbound Mapping Relation tab.
Step 3 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 4 Query the attributes of the DS domain and the mapping relationship between the packet priority
level in the ingress direction and the PHB service class.
Step 5 Click the Outbound Mapping Relation tab.
Step 6 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 7 Query the attributes of the DS domain and the mapping relationship between the priority level
of the packets in the egress direction and the PHB service class.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1151

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 8 Click the Application Object tab.


Step 9 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 10 Query the ports that use the DS domain.
----End

Related References
B.6.4.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management

A.7.8 Using the IEEE 802.1ag OAM


By using the 802.1ag OAM, you can maintain Ethernet services in an end-to-end manner.

A.7.8.1 Creating an MD
A maintenance domain (MD) defines the Ethernet OAM range and level. MDs of different ranges
and levels can provide users with differentiated OAM services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added on the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Choose New > New Maintenance Domain.
The system displays the New Maintenance Domain dialog box.
Step 4 Set the MD parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1152

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Maintenance Domain Level specifies the level of the maintenance domain.


l The values 0 to 7 indicates maintenance domain levels in an ascending order.
l MEPs transparently transmit OAM protocol packets if the packets have a higher level than the
parameter value.
l MEPs discard OAM protocol packets if the packets have a lower level than the parameter value.
l MEPs respond to or terminate OAM protocol packets based on the packet type if the packets have the
same level as the parameter value.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Domain
Creation

A.7.8.2 Creating an MA
An MD can be divided into several independent maintenance associations (MAs). By creating
MAs, you can associate specific Ethernet services with MAs. This facilitates Ethernet OAM
operations.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MD must be created.

The Ethernet service must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Select the maintenance domain in which a maintenance association needs to be created. Choose
New > New Maintenance Association.
The system displays the New Maintenance Association dialog box.
Step 4 Set the MA parameters.
NOTE

Click
in Relevant Service. Select the corresponding services in the displayed Select
Service dialog box.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1153

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Association
Creation

A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs


MEPs initiate or terminate Ethernet OAM packets. After creating MEPs, you can check the
Ethernet link between MEPs in the same MA by performing OAM operations.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MA must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Select the maintenance association in which an MEP needs to be created. Choose New > New
MEP Point.
The system displays the New MEP Point dialog box.
Step 4 Set the MEP parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1154

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Each MEP needs to be configured with an MP ID, which is unique in the maintenance association.
The MP ID is required in the OAM operation.
l Direction specifies the direction of the MEP.
l Ingress indicates the direction in which the packets are transmitted to the port, and Egress indicates
the direction in which the packets are transmitted from the port.
l In the case of the tests based on the MP IDs, CC Status must be set to Active.

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MEP Creation

A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA


To ensure that an MEP can respond to the OAM operations initiated by the other MEPs in the
same MA, you need to set the other MEPs to become remote MEPs of this MEP.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MA must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Choose OAM > Manage Remote MEP Point. The Manage Remote MEP Point dialog box
is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1155

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click New.


The Add Maintenance Association Remote Maintenance Point dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Set the parameters of the new remote MEP.

NOTE

If other MEPs will initiate OAM operations to an MEP in the same MA, set these MEPs as remote MEPs.

Step 6 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Remote MEP Creation

A.7.8.5 Creating MIPs


The maintenance association intermediate points (MIPs) can respond to specific OAM packets.
By creating MIPs, you can divide the Ethernet link between the MEPs in the same MA into
several segments, therefore facilitating the detection of the Ethernet link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MA must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the MIP Point tab.
Step 3 Select the maintenance domain in which an MIP needs to be created, and then click New.
The New MIP Maintenance Point dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the new MIP.
NOTE

l Each MIP needs to be configured with an MP ID, which is unique in the maintenance domain. The
MP ID is required in the OAM operation.
l To create MEPs and MIPs in a service at a port, ensure that only one MIP can be created and the level
of the MIP must be higher than the level of the MEP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1156

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MIP Creation

A.7.8.6 Performing a CC Test


After the continuity check (CC) test, the unidirectional link status can be checked automatically
and periodically. If the link is fault after the CC test is started at the source end, the sink equipment
reports the corresponding alarm.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MEP must be created.

The remote MEPs must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Only the MEP can enable the CC test and function as the receiving and responding end in
the test.

During the CC check, the source MEP constructs and transmits continuity check message
(CCM) packets periodically. After receiving the CCM packets from the source MEP, the
sink MEP directly enables the CC function for this source MEP. If the sink MEP fails to
receive the CCM packets from the source MEP within the check period (that is, 3.5 times
of the transmit period), it reports the alarm automatically.

Performing a CC test does not affect the services.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Select the MEP where you need to perform the CC test and then choose OAM > Activate
CC.
A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation is successful.
NOTE

l Before the CC test, you can set CC Test Transmit Period according to the actual requirements.
l To disable a CC test, select the MEP where the CC test is performed and then choose OAM >
Deactivate.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1157

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

TIP

l Alternatively, you can enable a CC test by right-clicking an MEP and then choosing Activate CC from
the shortcut menu.
l Alternatively, you can disable a CC test by right-clicking an MEP and then choosing Deactivate CC
from the shortcut menu.

Step 4 Click Close.


----End

A.7.8.7 Performing an LB Test


During a loopback (LB) test, you can check the bidirectional connectivity between the source
MEP and any MEP in the same maintenance association (MA).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The source and sink MEPs in the same maintenance domain must be created.

The remote MEPs must be created.

The CC function must be enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Only MEPs can initiate the LB test and function as the receive end in the test.

During the LB test, the source MEP constructs and transmits the LBM frames and starts
the timer. If the sink MP receives the LBM frames, it sends the LBR frames back to the
source MEP. This indicates that the loopback is successful. If the source MEP timer times
out, it indicates that the loopback fails.

Performing an LB test does not affect the services.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Select the maintenance domain and maintenance association for the LB test.
Step 4 Choose OAM > Start LB.
The LB Test dialog box is displayed.
TIP

To enable an LB test, you can also right-click an MEP and then choose Start LB from the shortcut menu.

Step 5 Select the method for identifying the destination MP and set the parameters involved in the LB
test.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1158

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l To identify the destination MP according to the MP ID, select MP ID. Only the MEP ID can be set
to the Destination Maintenance Point ID.
l To identify the destination MP according to the MAC address, select Maintenance Point MAC
Address. Only the MAC address of the MEP can be set to the MAC address of the Destination
Maintenance Point MAC Address.

Step 6 Click Start Test. Then, the LB test result is displayed in the Detection Result window.
----End

Related References
B.6.3.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LB Enabling

A.7.8.8 Performing an LT Test


Based on the LB test, the link trace (LT) test further improves the capability to locate faults.
That is, the faulty network segment can be located according to the MIP through only one test.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

The remote MEPs must be created.

The CC function must be enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Only MEPs can initiate the LT test and work as the termination point in the test.

During the LT test, the source MEP constructs and transmits the LTM frames and starts
the timer. All the MPs that receive the LTM frames send the LTR frame response.
According to the LTR frame response, you can verify all the MIPs that pass from the source
MEP to the sink MEP.

Performing an LT test does not affect services.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1159

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.


Step 3 Select the maintenance domain and maintenance association for the LT test.
Step 4 Choose OAM > Start LT.
The LT Test dialog box is displayed.
TIP

To enable an LT test, you can also right-click an MEP and then choose Start LT from the shortcut menu.

Step 5 Select the method for identifying the destination MP and set the parameters involved in the LT
test.
NOTE

l To identify the destination MP according to the MP ID, select MP ID. Only the MEP ID can be set
to the Destination Maintenance Point ID.
l To identify the destination MP according to the MAC address, select Maintenance Point MAC
Address. Only the MAC address of the MEP can be set to the MAC address of the Destination
Maintenance Point MAC Address.

Step 6 Click Start Test. Then, the LT test result is displayed in the Detection Result window.
----End

Related References
B.6.3.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LT Enabling

A.7.8.9 Activating the AIS


After a fault is detected by an MP, if this MP activates the AIS, it sends the AIS packet to a
higher level MP so that the higher level MP is informed of the fault information.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1160

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Select the MD and MA where the MEP is located.


Step 4 Select the node to be monitored. Double-click or right-click AIS Active Status and then select
Active or Inactive.
Step 5 Click Apply.
----End

A.7.8.10 Monitoring Packet Loss Ratio, Delay, or Delay Variation of Ethernet


Services
The ETH OAM function allows you to monitor packet loss ratio, delay, or delay variation of
Ethernet services without any impact on the Ethernet services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Native E-Line services that are transmitted based on ports and VLAN IDs have been
created.

Source and sink maintenance end points (MEPs) in the same maintenance domain (MD)
have been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
The OptiX RTN 980 uses the RMON function to collect statistics about packet loss ratio, delay,
or delay variation of Ethernet services. This section describes navigation paths to monitoring
packet loss ratio, delay, or delay variation of Ethernet services. Follow instructions in A.11 Using
the RMON to use the RMON function.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Ethernet OAM
Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Maintenance Association tab.
Step 3 Select the desired maintenance association (MA).
Step 4 Right-click an MEP and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.
Step 5 Select the desired statistics item.
If...

Then...

You want to query the current packet loss


ratio, delay, or delay variation

Click the Statistics Group tab and set


required parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1161

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

If...

A Task Collection

Then...

You want to query the historical packet loss Click the History Group tab and set required
parameters.
ratio, delay, or delay variation
NOTE
Ensure that historical performance monitoring
for associated periods has been enabled before
querying the historical packet loss ratio, delay, or
delay variation.

You want to set alarming thresholds for the Click the RMON Setting tab. Then click the
packet loss ratio, delay, or delay variation
Event tab and set required parameters.
You want to set the historical performance
monitoring period for the packet loss ratio,
delay, or delay variation

Click the RMON Setting tab. Then click the


Object tab and set required parameters.

----End

A.7.8.11 E-LAN Service Loopback Detection


This section describes how to configure automatic detection of E-LAN service loopbacks and
automatic service deactivation in the case of an E-LAN service loopback.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

E-LAN services have been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
l

Creation of MEPs is not a prerequisite for service loopback detection.

Service loopback detection and STP/RSTP/MSTP are mutually exclusive.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Configuration > Ethernet Service
Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
Step 3 Select the port where service loopback detection will be performed and click Start.
The Start Loopback dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the desired parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1162

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l Vlans/CVLAN displays the VLAN ID of a loopback service. Loopback detection can be performed for only
one service one time.
l Loopback detection stops if no loopback detection packets are received until Packet Timeout Period(s)
expires.
l Disable Service When Loopback is Detected displays whether a loopback service will be deactivated.

Step 5 Click Start. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Detection Result displays the loopback detection result.
----End

A.7.8.12 Reactivating E-LAN Services


This section describes how to reactivate E-LAN services that are deactivated during a service
loopback detection process.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

An E-LAN service port has been shut down due to a service loopback.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Loopback tab.
Step 3 Click Service Status List.
The Service Status List dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Select the port where an E-LAN service needs to be reactivated and click Enable. Close the
dialog box that is displayed.
----End

A.7.9 Using the IEEE 802.3ah OAM


By using the IEEE 802.3ah OAM, you can maintain the point-to-point Ethernet links.

A.7.9.1 Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function


The IEEE 802.3ah OAM is realized based on the OAM auto-discovery. After the OAM autodiscovery succeeds, the equipment automatically monitors the fault and performance of the link.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1163

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The OAM auto-discovery is realized based on the auto-negotiation between the local equipment
and the opposite equipment. If the negotiation fails, the local equipment reports an alarm. After
OAM auto-discovery is successfully completed, the link performance is monitored according
to the error frame threshold. You can set the error frame threshold on the NMS.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the port, and set OAM Working Mode.
NOTE

l The OAM mode includes the active mode and the passive mode. For two interconnected systems, the
OAM mode of either or both systems must be the active mode. Otherwise, the OAM auto-discovery
fails.
l If both ends of a link are in passive OAM mode, a link fault occurs, or either end of a link does not
receive OAM protocol packets within 5 seconds, an alarm is reported, indicating that OAM autodiscovery fails.

Step 4 Set Enable OAM Protocol to Enabled.

Step 5 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


Step 6 Click the Remote OAM Parameter tab. Click Query to obtain the OAM capability of the
opposite end. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End

Related References
B.6.3.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Parameter

A.7.9.2 Enabling the Link Event Notification


After the link event notification is enabled on the local equipment, the opposite equipment is
informed if the OAM detects a link fault or an link performance event.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1164

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The OAM auto-discovery operation must successful on the equipment at both ends.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the corresponding port and set Link Event Notification to Enabled.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Parameter

A.7.9.3 Modifying the OAM Error Frame Monitoring Threshold


The threshold for the OAM error frame monitoring is a standard for the OAM to detect the link
performance. Generally, the default value is used. You can modify the value according to the
situation of the link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IEEE 802.3ah OAM function must be enabled on the remote equipment and the OAM
auto-discovery operation must be successful on the equipment at both ends.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
After the OAM auto-discovery operation is successful, the remote link event notification
function is enabled and the monitoring time and errored frame threshold are set at the local end.
If the local equipment detects a link event in the receive direction, it informs the opposite
equipment of the link event. If the remote alarm for the link event is also supported at the opposite
end, the opposite equipment can also inform the local equipment of the link event that is detected
at the opposite end. Then, the corresponding alarm is reported at the local end.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1165

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab.
Step 3 Select the port and set the parameters in the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab page.

NOTE

An alarm is reported if the number of errored frame events within Monitor Window or Period Window
exceeds the specified monitoring threshold.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.6.3.10 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Error Frame
Monitoring

A.7.9.4 Performing Remote Loopbacks


After the Ethernet port on the local equipment sends data to the port on the interconnected
equipment, the local end can request the opposite end to return the data.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The OAM auto-discovery operation must be successful at both ends of the link.

On the equipment that initiates the loopback, OAM Working Mode must be set to
Active.

The equipment that responds to the loopback must support the remote loopback.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

If a port is capable of responding to loopbacks, it enters the loopback responding state and
reports the loopback responding alarm after receiving the command of enabling the remote
loopback function sent from the opposite OAM port. In this case, the equipment that
initiates the loopback enters the loopback initiation state and reports the loopback initiation
alarm.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1166

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Generally, after the remote loopback function is enabled, service packets, except the
OAMPDU, are looped back at the remote end.

After using the remote loopback function to complete the fault locating and the link
performance detection, you need to disable the remote loopback function at the end where
the loopback is initiated and then restore the services. The alarm is automatically cleared.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the port and set Remote Side Loopback Response to Enabled.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


Step 5 Choose Enable Remote Loopback from the drop-down menu of OAM. Close the displayed
dialog box.

NOTE

To release remote loopbacks, select Disable Remote Loopback.

----End

A.7.9.5 Enabling Self-Loop Detection


After enabling the self-loop detection on an Ethernet port, you can check the loopback of the
port and the loopback between the port and other Ethernet ports on the board.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The required board is already added on the NE Panel.

All the external physical ports on the Ethernet service processing board must be enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1167

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Advanced Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set Loopback Check to Enabled.
Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End

A.7.10 LPT Configuration


When you use LPT function, you need to configure the relationship between LPT ports and the
related information of LPT ports.

A.7.10.1 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing an L2 Network


When you configure point-to-point LPT traversing an L2 network, it is unnecessary to bind LPT
with Ethernet services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

L2 services are configured.


NOTE

L2 services include UNI-UNI E-Line services and UNI-UNI E-LAN services transmitted in a point-to-point
manner.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Point-to-Point LPT tab.
Step 3 Click Bind in the lower right corner of the pane based on the type of service network.
Step 4 Choose L2 net from the shortcut menu.
The Bind L2 net dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Set the parameters of the primary and secondary points of LPT.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1168

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Click OK, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 7 Optional: Reset Recovery Time(s), Hold-Off Time(ms), and Fault Detection Period
(100ms).
Step 8 Set LPT Enabled to Enabled. Then, click Apply.
----End

Related References
B.6.2.11 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creating Point-to-Point LPT
B.6.2.10 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Point LPT

A.7.10.2 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing a PSN or QinQ Network


When you configure point-to-point LPT traversing a PSN or QinQ network, it is necessary to
bind LPT with services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

QinQ services exclusively occupying UNI ports have been configured.

E-Line services carried by PWs exclusively occupying UNI ports have been configured.
NOTE

l For the service models of QinQ services exclusively occupying UNI ports, see Model 1 and Model 2 in
QinQ-Based E-Line Services.
l For the service models of E-Line services carried by PWs exclusively occupying UNI ports, see Model 3 in
PW-Carried E-Line Services.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Point-to-Point LPT tab.
Step 3 Select PW or QinQ services that require the LPT function.
Step 4 Click Bind in the lower right corner of the pane. Then, choose PW+QinQ from the shortcut
menu.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1169

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Optional: Reset Recovery Time(s), Hold-Off Time(ms), and Fault Detection Period
(100ms).
Step 6 Set LPT Enabled to Enabled. Then, click Apply.
----End

Related References
B.6.2.10 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Point LPT

A.7.10.3 Configuring Point-to-Multipoint LPT


When you configure point-to-multipoint LPT, it is necessary to configure the primary and
secondary points.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

At least one of the following services has been configured.


L2 services
QinQ services sharing UNI ports
E-Line services carried by PWs sharing UNI ports
NOTE

l L2 services include UNI-UNI E-Line services and UNI-UNI E-LAN services transmitted in a point-tomultipoint manner.
l For the service models of QinQ services sharing UNI ports, see Model 3 in QinQ-Based E-Line Services.
l For the service models of E-Line services carried by PWs sharing UNI ports, see Model 1 and Model 2 in
PW-Carried E-Line Services.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Point-to-Multipoint LPT tab.
Step 3 Click New in the lower right corner of the pane based on the type of service network.
Step 4 Choose PW, QinQ, or L2 net from the shortcut menu based on the type of service network.
The Create LPT dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Set the parameters of the primary and secondary points of LPT.
Step 6 Click OK, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 7 Optional: Reset Recovery Time(s), Hold-Off Time(ms), and Fault Detection Period
(100ms).
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1170

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 8 Set LPT Enabled to Enabled. Then, click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.6.2.13 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creating Point-to-Multipoint LPT
B.6.2.12 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Multipoint LPT

A.7.10.4 Configuring Simple LPT


If a hybrid radio link is faulty, the Ethernet port related to the hybrid radio link is automatically
disabled through the LPT function.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added to the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > Simple LPT from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create LPT dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1171

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure the board and port of the Convergence Point.


Step 4 Set Access Point.
1.

In the Board list, select the board of the access point.

2.

In Port, select the required port, and then click

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

A.8 Configuring Ethernet Services and Features on the EoS/


EoPDH Plane
Configurations of Ethernet services and features on the EoS/EoPDH plane include relevant
Ethernet port configuration, protection configuration, service configuration, protocol
configuration, and OAM configuration.

A.8.1 Managing ERPS


Ethernet Ring Protection Switching (ERPS) can be configured on an Ethernet over SDH (EoS)
ring to protect Ethernet services.

A.8.1.1 Creating ERPS Instances


Ethernet Ring Protection Switching (ERPS) is configured by creating ERPS instances.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1172

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

An EMS6 board has been added to the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Protection >
ERPS Management.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create Ethernet Ring Protection Protocol Instance dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the parameters for the ERPS instance.

Step 4 Click OK.


----End

A.8.1.2 Setting the Parameters of the ERPS Protocol


The parameters of the Ethernet Ring Protection Switching (ERPS) protocol include the hold-off
time, WTR time, and guard time.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

An ERPS instance has been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1173

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Protection >
ERPS Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Optional: Double-click Control VLAN, and then modify the control VLAN ID.
Step 3 Optional: Set the parameters of the ERPS protocol.

NOTE

Set the parameters according to the network plan. Default values are recommended.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

A.8.1.3 Querying the Status of the ERPS Protocol


This section describes how to query the status of Ethernet Ring Protection Switching (ERPS).

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Protection >
ERPS Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Query the status of the ERPS protocol.
----End

A.8.2 Managing LAGs


Link aggregation enables one or multiple links that are connected to the same equipment to be
aggregated into a LAG. The aggregated links are considered as a single logical link at the MAC
layer. In this manner, bandwidth and availability of radio links are improved.

A.8.2.1 Creating a LAG


To improve bandwidth and availability of Ethernet links between two NEs, you need to create
the corresponding LAG.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1174

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board where the LAG ports are located must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Link Aggregation
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create Link Aggregation Group dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 In Attributes Settings, set the parameters of the LAG.

Step 5 In Port Settings, set the LAG ports.


1.

Set Main Port.

2.

Select a slave port from Available Standby Ports and then click

TIP

To select more than one port at a time, press and hold the Ctrl or Shift key when selecting the ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1175

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Click OK.


A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 7 Click OK.
----End

Related References
B.7.2.12 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Creation of LAGs

A.8.2.2 Setting Parameters for LAGs


The parameters for a LAG include port priorities and system priorities. In a static LAG that uses
the static aggregation mode, a port with a higher priority is always selected for transmitting
services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board where the LAG ports are located must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Link Aggregation
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Link Aggregation Parameters tab.
Step 3 Set the parameters associated with the system priority and port priority.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1176

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.2.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Link Aggregation

A.8.2.3 Querying the Protocol Information of LAGs


This section describes how to learn about the running information of the LACP protocol used
by LAGs.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board where the LAG ports are located must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Link Aggregation
Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.
Step 3 In the main interface, select the LAG to be queried.
Step 4 Click Query to check the working status of the main and slave ports in the LAG.
NOTE

The system automatically displays the working status of the slave port at the bottom of the main interface.

Step 5 Right-click the LAG and select an option from the drop-down list. A dialog box is displayed,
indicating the query result.

Step 6 Click Close.


Step 7 Click the Link Aggregation Parameters tab.
Step 8 Click Query to check the parameters associated with the port priority and system priority.
----End

A.8.3 Configuring Ethernet Services


The EFP8/EMS6 board supports EPL, EVPL, EPLAN, and EPVLAN services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1177

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.8.3.1 Creating Ethernet Private Line Services


This section describes how to create EPL services and VLAN-based EVPL services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
For the method of creating QinQ-based Ethernet private line services, see A.8.3.5 Creating
QinQ-Based EVPL Services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Deselect Display QinQ Shared Service.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create Ethernet Line Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the attributes of the Ethernet private line service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1178

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Set the port attributes.


NOTE

The result of setting the port attributes during the Ethernet private line service configuration process is the same
as the result of directly setting the Ethernet service port attributes.

Step 6 Optional: Set the bound path.


1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click Configuration.
The Bound Path Configuration dialog box is displayed. Set the attributes of the bound
path.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1179

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

2.

In Configurable Ports, select a VCTRUNK as the configurable port.

3.

In Available Bound Paths, set Direction of the bound path.

4.

Select required items in Available Resources and Available Timeslots and click
.

5.

Optional: Repeat Step 6.4 to bind other VC paths.

6.

Click OK.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click Yes.
NOTE

The result of configuring the attributes of bound paths during service configuration is consistent with the result
of directly setting the attributes of VCTRUNKs.

Step 7 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service_Creation

A.8.3.2 Creating Ethernet LAN Services


This section describes how to create IEEE 802.1d bridge-based EPLAN services and IEEE
802.1q bridge-based EVPLAN services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1180

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Precautions
For the method of creating the IEEE 802.1ad bridge, see A.8.3.6 Creating IEEE 802.1ad
Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create Ethernet LAN Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the attributes of the bridge according to the bridge type.
l Set the attributes of the IEEE 802.1q bridge.

l Set the attributes of the IEEE 802.1d bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1181

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Set the ports to be connected to the bridge.


1.

Click Configure Mount.


The Service Mount Configuration dialog box is displayed.

2.

Select a port from the ports listed in Available Mounted Ports, and then click
.

3.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional: Repeat Step 4.2 to mount other ports.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1182

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

Click OK.

Step 5 Optional: Set the bound path.


1.

Click Configuration.
The Bound Path Configuration dialog box is displayed. Set the attributes of the bound
path.

2.

In Configurable Ports, select a VCTRUNK as the configurable port.

3.

In Available Bound Paths, set Direction of the bound path.

4.

Select required items in Available Resources and Available Timeslots and click
.

5.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Optional: Repeat Step 5.4 to bind other VC paths.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1183

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6.

A Task Collection

Click OK.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click Yes.
NOTE

The result of configuring the attributes of bound paths during service configuration is consistent with the result
of directly setting the attributes of VCTRUNKs.

Step 6 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service_Creation of Ethernet LAN Services
Based on IEEE 802.1d/802.1q Bridge

A.8.3.3 Changing the Ports Connected to a VB


This section describes how to change the ports connected to a VB, the enabling status of the
ports, and Hub/Spoke attribute of the ports.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the VB that is already created, and click the Service Mount tab.

Step 3 Change the ports connected to the VB.


1.

To delete a mounted port, double-click the port under Mount Port and select
Unconnected from the drop-down list.

2.

To add a mounted port, double-click the cell without any port under Mount Port and select
the port to be connected to the VB.

Step 4 To change any parameter value of a mounted port, double-click the parameter value and specify
a new value.
Step 5 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1184

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.8.3.4 Creating the VLAN Filtering Table


To create an Ethernet LAN service in IVL learning mode, you need to create the VLAN filtering
table for the VB.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IEEE 802.1q/802.1ad bridge-based Ethernet LAN services must be created.

In the case of IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based Ethernet LAN services, the learning mode of the
VB must be IVL.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select an IEEE 802.1q or 802.1ad bridge and click the VLAN Filtering tab.
Step 3 Create the VLAN filtering table.
1.

Click New.
The Create VLAN dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set VLAN ID(e.g:1,3-6).

3.

Select a port from the ports listed in Available forwarding ports, and then click
.

4.

Optional: Repeat Step 3.3 to select other forwarding ports.

5.

Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

Related References
B.7.1.7 Parameter Description: VLAN Filtering Table_Creation
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1185

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.8.3.5 Creating QinQ-Based EVPL Services


When creating a QinQ-based EVPL service, you need to set service information such as the
service source, service sink, and QinQ type.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service > Ethernet Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select Display QinQ Shared Service.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create Ethernet Line Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the attributes of the QinQ-based EVPL service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1186

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Optional: Set the port attributes.


NOTE

The result of setting the port attributes during the Ethernet private line service configuration process is the same
as the result of directly setting the Ethernet service port attributes.

Step 6 Optional: Set the bound path.


1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click Configuration.
The Bound Path Configuration dialog box is displayed. Set the attributes of the bound
path.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1187

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

2.

In Configurable Ports, select a VCTRUNK as the configurable port.

3.

In Available Bound Paths, set Direction of the bound path.

4.

Select required items in Available Resources and Available Timeslots and click
.

5.

Optional: Repeat Step 6.4 to bind other VC paths.

6.

Click OK.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click Yes.
NOTE

The result of configuring the attributes of bound paths during service configuration is consistent with the result
of directly setting the attributes of VCTRUNKs.

Step 7 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service_Creating QinQ-Based Ethernet Line
Services

A.8.3.6 Creating IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services


To create EVPLAN services that are based on the IEEE 802.1ad bridge, you need to set relevant
service information, including the attributes of the bridge and the ports that are connected to the
bridge.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1188

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create Ethernet LAN Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the basic attributes of the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.

Step 4 Set service mounting relationships.


1.

Click Configure Mount.


The Service Mount Configuration dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set the parameters for configuring mounted services.

3.

Click Add Mount Port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1189

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

4.

Repeat Step 4.2 and Step 4.3 to add the other mounted ports.

5.

Click OK.

6.

Optional: You can change the Ethernet port attributes of the mounted ports in the Service
Mount window.

Step 5 Optional: Set the bound path.


1.

Click Configuration.
The Bound Path Configuration dialog box is displayed. Set the attributes of the bound
path.

2.

In Configurable Ports, select a VCTRUNK as the configurable port.

3.

In Available Bound Paths, set Direction of the bound path.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1190

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

Select required items in Available Resources and Available Timeslots and click
.

5.

Optional: Repeat Step 5.4 to bind other VC paths.

6.

Click OK.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click Yes.
NOTE

The result of configuring the attributes of bound paths during service configuration is consistent with the result
of directly setting the attributes of VCTRUNKs.

Step 6 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service_Creating IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based
Ethernet LAN Service

A.8.3.7 Deleting an Ethernet Private Line Service


When an Ethernet private line service is not used, you need to delete the Ethernet private line
service to release the corresponding resources.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet private line service must be configured and the service is not used.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Select the Ethernet private line service that needs to be deleted and then click Delete.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 5 Click Query. At this time, the Ethernet private line service is already deleted.
----End

A.8.3.8 Deleting an Ethernet LAN Service


When an Ethernet LAN service is not used, you need to delete the Ethernet LAN service to
release the corresponding resources.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1191

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The Ethernet LAN services must be configured and the service is not used.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
Deleting an Ethernet LAN service involves the following tasks:
1.

Deleting the VLAN filtering table

2.

Deleting the service mounting configuration

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Click the VLAN Filtering tab.
Step 4 Select the VLAN filtering entries that need to be deleted. Then, click Delete.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 6 Click the Service Mount tab.
Step 7 Select the Ethernet LAN service to be deleted and click Delete.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 8 Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 9 Click Query. At this time, the Ethernet LAN service is already deleted.
----End

A.8.4 Managing the MAC Address Table


The MAC address table is the core of the Ethernet LAN service. The EFP8/EMS6 board provides
various functions for managing the MAC address table.

A.8.4.1 Creating a Static MAC Address Entry


By performing this operation, you can ensure that the hosts with specific MAC addresses are
not affected after the MAC addresses are aged and that Ethernet LAN services are also applicable
to the hosts only receiving and not transmitting packets.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1192

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the bridge that is already created, and click the VLAN Unicast tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create VLAN Unicast dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the unicast entries.

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service

A.8.4.2 Creating a Blacklist Entry of a MAC Address


By performing this operation, you can ensure that the hosts with specific MAC addresses cannot
use Ethernet LAN services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1193

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the created bridge and click the Disable MAC Address tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Disable MAC Address Creation dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the disabled MAC address entries.

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service

A.8.4.3 Setting the Aging Time of a MAC Address Table Entry


The aging time of a MAC address table is five minutes by default.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Aging Time from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Modify the aging time of the MAC address table entry.
1.

Double-click MAC Address Aging Time corresponding to the EFP8 board.


The MAC Address Aging Time dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set the duration and unit of the aging time.

3.

Click OK.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1194

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.1.8 Parameter Description: Aging Time of MAC Address Table Entries

A.8.4.4 Querying or Deleting a Dynamic MAC Address


This section describes how to query and delete self-learnt MAC addresses of Ethernet LAN
services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the created bridge and click the Self-learning MAC Address tab.
Step 3 Click First Page, Previous Page, or Next Page to view the dynamic entries of a MAC address
table page by page.
Step 4 Optional: Select a MAC address to be deleted, and then click Clear MAC address. Then, close
the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.7.1.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service

A.8.4.5 Querying the Actual Capacity of a MAC Address Table


This section describes how to query the actual capacity of a MAC address table.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1195

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Precautions
l

In the case of EVPLAN services, you can query the capacity of a MAC address table where
MAC addresses are queried based on VLAN IDs and the capacity of a MAC address table
where MAC addresses are queried based on VB logical ports.

In the case of EPLAN services, you can query the capacity of a MAC address table where
MAC addresses are queried based on VB logical ports.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select a created bridge.
Step 3 Query the actual number of dynamically learnt MAC addresses based on the VLAN IDs.
1.

Click the VLAN MAC Address Table Capacity tab.

2.

Click Query. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed. Check the actual capacity of the
MAC address table.

Step 4 Query the actual number of dynamically learnt MAC addresses based on the VB ports.
1.

Click the VB Port MAC Address Table Capacity tab.

2.

Click Query. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed. Check the actual capacity of the
MAC address table.

----End

Related References
B.7.1.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service

A.8.5 Configuring Ethernet Ports


The EFP8/EMS6 board supports external ports and internal ports.

A.8.5.1 Configuring External Ethernet Ports


When an NE uses external ports on the EFP8/EMS6 board to support access of Ethernet services,
you need to set the attributes of the external ports so that external ports can work with the data
communication equipment on the client side and therefore support normal access of Ethernet
services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1196

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Precautions
Ethernet ports FE1 to FE8 on an EFP8 board correspond to PORT1 to PORT8 respectively.
PORT9 on an EFP8 board is used to connect the EoPDH plane to the packet plane. PORT9 is
provided by the Ethernet switching unit of an EFP8 board and is connected to the EoPDH plane.
PORT9 forwards Ethernet services from the packet plane to FE ports or VCTRUNKs on an
EFP8 board.
Ethernet ports GE1 and GE2 on the EMS6 board correspond to PORT1 and PORT2 respectively;
Ethernet ports FE1 to FE4 on an EMS6 board correspond to PORT3 to PORT6 respectively.
PORT7 on an EMS6 board is used to connect the EoS plane to the packet plane. PORT9 is
provided by the Ethernet switching unit of an EMS6 board and is connected to the EoS plane.
PORT9 forwards Ethernet services from the packet plane to FE/GE ports or VCTRUNKs on an
EMS6 board.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board and then choose Configuration > Ethernet
Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select External Port.
Step 3 Set the basic attributes of the port.
1.

Click the Basic Attributes tab.

2.

Set the basic attributes of the port.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 4 Set the flow control mode of the port.


1.

Click the Flow Control tab.

2.

Set the flow control mode of the port.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 5 Set the TAG attribute of the port.


1.

Click the TAG Attributes tab.

2.

Set the TAG attribute of the port.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 6 Set the network attributes of the port.


1.

Click the Network Attributes tab.

2.

Set the network attributes of the port.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1197

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 7 Set the advanced attributes of the port.


1.

Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

2.

Set the advanced attributes of the port.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

Related References
B.7.5.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_External Port

A.8.5.2 Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board


When an NE transmits Ethernet services to a line through an internal port (that is, VCTRUNK)
on an Ethernet board, you need to set the attributes of the VCTRUNK so that the Ethernet board
works with the Ethernet board at the opposite end to implement transmission of the Ethernet
services on the network.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
The EFP8 board supports VCTRUNKs 1-16. VCTRUNKs 1-16 determine the services to be
transmitted depending on information about the created Ethernet services.
The EMS6 board supports VCTRUNKs 1-8. VCTRUNKs 1-8 determine the services to be
transmitted depending on information about the created Ethernet services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board and then choose Configuration > Ethernet
Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select Internal Port.
Step 3 Optional: Set the TAG attribute of the VCTRUNK.
1.

Click the TAG Attributes tab.

2.

Set the TAG attribute of the VCTRUNK.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1198

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Set the encapsulation and mapping protocol used by the VCTRUNK.
1.

Click the Encapsulation/Mapping tab.

2.

Set Mapping Protocol and the protocol parameters.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 5 Optional: Set the network attributes of the VCTRUNK.


1.

Click the Network Attributes tab.

2.

Set the network attributes of the VCTRUNK.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 6 Configure the LCAS function for the port.


1.

Click the LCAS tab.

2.

Set the Enabling LCAS parameter and other LCAS parameters.

3.

Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 7 Click Bound Path.


Step 8 Optional: Set the bound path.
1.

Click Configuration.
The Bound Path Configuration dialog box is displayed. Set the attributes of the bound
path.

2.

In Configurable Ports, select a VCTRUNK as the configurable port.

3.

In Available Bound Paths, set Direction of the bound path.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1199

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

Select required items in Available Resources and Available Timeslots and click
.

5.

Optional: Repeat Step 8.4 to bind other VC paths.

6.

Click OK.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click Yes.
NOTE

The result of configuring the attributes of bound paths during service configuration is consistent with the result
of directly setting the attributes of VCTRUNKs.

----End

Related References
B.7.5.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_Internal Port

A.8.5.3 Modifying the Type Field of QinQ Frames


The default type field of QinQ frames is 0x8100.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Advance Attribute > QinQ Type Area Settings from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Modify the type field of QinQ frames.

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.5.3 Parameter Description: Type Field of QinQ Frames

A.8.5.4 Dynamically Increasing/Decreasing the VCTRUNK Bandwidth


When the LCAS function is enabled on an NE, you can dynamically increase or decrease the
paths bound with a VCTRUNK to increase or decrease the bandwidth. The operation does not
affect services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1200

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board and then choose Configuration > Ethernet
Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select Internal Port.
Step 3 Click the Bound Path tab.
Step 4 Click Configuration.
The Bound Path Configuration dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Optional: Dynamically increase the VCTRUNK bandwidth.
1.

In Configurable Ports, select a VCTRUNK as the configurable port.

2.

In Available Bound Paths, set Level and Service Direction of the bound paths.

3.

Select required items in Available Resources and Available Timeslots and click
.

4.

Optional: Repeat Step 5.3 to bind other VC paths.

Step 6 Optional: Dynamically decrease the VCTRUNK bandwidth.


1.

Deselect the Display in Combination check box.

2.

Select the VC paths to be deleted in Selected Bound Paths, and then click

3.

Optional: Repeat Step 6.2 to delete other VC paths.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1201

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 7 Click OK.


A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 8 Click Yes.
----End

A.8.6 Managing the Spanning Tree Protocol


The OptiX RTN OptiX RTN 980 supports Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) and Rapid Spanning
Tree Protocol (RSTP).

A.8.6.1 Configuring the Type and Enabled Status of the Spanning Tree Protocol
If a loop is formed in an Ethernet LAN service, you need to enable the STP or RSTP for the
bridge.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Protocol Enabled tab.
Step 3 Set Protocol Enabled and Protocol Type.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.2.3 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Protocol Enabling

A.8.6.2 Setting the Parameters of Spanning Tree Protocol


If the STP or RSTP is enabled on a bridge, you can set the bridge parameters and port parameters
of the STP or RSTP according to the requirements of the reachable data communications
equipment.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1202

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Set bridge parameters.
1.

Click the Bridge Parameters tab.

2.

Set bridge parameters.

3.

Click Apply.

Step 3 Set port parameters.


1.

Click the Port Parameters tab.

2.

Set port parameters.

3.

Click Apply.

Step 4 Optional: If Protocol Type is set to RSTP, specify the point-to-point attribute of the Ethernet
port.
1.

Click the Point to Point Attribute tab.

2.

Set the point-to-point attribute of the port.

3.

Click Apply.

----End

Related References
B.7.2.4 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Bridge Parameters
B.7.2.5 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Port Parameters
B.7.2.8 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Point-to-Point Attribute
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1203

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.8.6.3 Querying the Running Information About the Spanning Tree Protocol
This topic describes how to query the running information about the spanning tree protocol
(STP).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

The STP or RSTP must be enabled for the bridge.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Query the bridge running information.
1.

Click the Bridge Running Information tab.

2.

Click Query.

3.

Check the bridge running information.

Step 3 Query the port running information.


1.

Click the Port Running Information tab.

2.

Click Query.

3.

Check the port running information.

----End

Related References
B.7.2.6 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Bridge Running Information
B.7.2.7 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Port Running Information

A.8.7 Managing the IGMP Snooping Protocol


If a multicast router exists on a network, the bridge can enable the IGMP Snooping protocol to
implement the multicast function together with the router.

A.8.7.1 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Protocol


This section describes how to enable the IGMP Snooping protocol for a bridge and how to
configure the method for the bridge to process unknown multicast packets.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1204

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

The VLAN filtering table must be created.

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Enable IGMP Snooping Protocol tab.
Step 3 Set the information about the IGMP Snooping protocol.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.2.9 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Enabling

A.8.7.2 Configuring Static Multicast Entries


This section describes how to configure and query information about static multicast entries.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

The VLAN filtering table must be created.

The IGMP Snooping protocol must be enabled for the bridge.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Static Multicast Table tab.
Step 3 Click New.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1205

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The Create Static Multicast Item dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Set the attributes of static multicast entries.
1.

Set VB ID, VLAN ID, and MAC Address.

2.

In Multicast Port, select the member ports corresponding to the static multicast entries.
Click

TIP

To select more than one port at a time, press and hold the Ctrl or Shift key when selecting the ports.

3.

Click OK.

----End

Related References
B.7.2.10 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Creation of Static Multicast Table
Entries

A.8.7.3 Modifying the Aging Time of a Multicast Table Entry


The aging time of a MAC address table is eight minutes by default.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

The IGMP Snooping protocol must be enabled for the bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1206

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Multicast Aging Time tab.
Step 3 Modify the aging time of the multicast table entries.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.2.11 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Aging Time of Multicast Table
Entries

A.8.7.4 Querying the Running Information of the IGMP Snooping Protocol


By performing this operation, you can learn the information about the multicast table entries and
router port when the bridge runs the IGMP Snooping protocol.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet LAN services must be created.

The IGMP Snooping protocol must be enabled for the bridge.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.
Step 2 Query the information about the router port.
1.

Click the Multicast Router Port Management tab.

2.

Click Query. Check the information about the router port.

Step 3 Query the information about the multicast table entries.


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1207

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

1.

Click the Multicast Table Item tab.

2.

Click Query. Check the information about the multicast table entries.

A Task Collection

----End

A.8.8 Managing the QoS


By managing the QoS, you can provide differentiated services for different service types.

A.8.8.1 Creating a Flow


A flow refers to a collection of packets on which the same QoS operation is performed. Creating
a flow is the prerequisite for performing CAR and CoS operations.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The associated Ethernet services must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Flow Configuration tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The New Flow dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the flow parameters.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.4.1 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of Flows
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1208

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.8.8.2 Creating the CAR


CAR is a type of traffic policing technology. After the flow classification, the CAR assesses the
rate of the traffic in a certain period (including in the long term and in the short term). The CAR
allocates the packets whose rates do not exceed the specified rate with higher priorities and
discards the packet whose rate exceeds the specified rate or downgrades this kind of packet, thus
restricting the traffic into the transmission network.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and then choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the CAR Configuration.
Step 3 Click New.
The New CAR dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the CAR parameters.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.4.2 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CAR

A.8.8.3 Creating the CoS


By using the CoS, the packets in a flow can be scheduled to different queues of different priorities
and can be processed according to the priority of each queue. This ensures that the packets of
different priorities can be processed according to different QoS requirements.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1209

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the CoS Configuration tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The New CoS dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the CoS parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1210

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.4.3 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CoS

A.8.8.4 Binding the CAR/CoS


To enable the CAR or CoS function, you need to bind the corresponding flow to the created
CAR/CoS.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1211

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The flow must be created.

The CAR/CoS must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and then choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Flow Configuration tab.

Step 3 Double-click Bound CAR and select the CAR to be bound.


Step 4 Double-click Bound CoS and select the CoS to be bound.
Step 5 Click Apply.
----End

Related References
B.7.4.4 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CAR/CoS

A.8.8.5 Configuring Traffic Shaping for Egress Queues


This section describes how to enable traffic shaping for egress queues and how to set shapingassociated parameters.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required Ethernet switching board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In Port List, select a port. In Port Queue Shaping Information, set the traffic shaping
information about the egress queues.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1212

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.4.5 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Shaping Management of Egress Queues

A.8.8.6 Configuring Port Shaping


This section describes how to configure the traffic shaping for an egress port.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

An EMS6 board has been added to the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
QoS Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Shaping tab.
Step 3 Set the port shaping parameters for a port.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

A.8.8.7 Setting Egress Queue Scheduling Policies


This section describes how to set the queue scheduling mode and the Weighted Round Robin
(WRR) weight on an EMS6 boards.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

An EMS6 board has been added to the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1213

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required Ethernet switching board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Port Queue Information tab.
Step 3 Select a port from Port List.
Step 4 Set Scheduling Mode and Weight for the port queue.

Step 5 Click Apply.


----End

A.8.9 Using the Ethernet service OAM


By using the Ethernet service OAM, you can maintain the Ethernet service in an end-to-end
manner.

A.8.9.1 Creating MDs


A maintenance domain (MD) defines the scope and level of the Ethernet service OAM. The
MDs of different levels and scopes can provide differentiated OAM services to users.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In the right pane, click OAM Configuration.
The OAM Configuration dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1214

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

In this GUI, you can maintain or delete OAM MDs.

Step 3 Click New and choose Create MD from the drop-down list.
The Create MD dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set the parameters of the new MD.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.3.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MDs

A.8.9.2 Creating MAs


A maintenance domain (MD) can be divided into several independent maintenance associations
(MA). By creating MAs, operators can associate specific Ethernet services with the MAs for
easy Ethernet OAM operation.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The MD must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1215

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In the right pane, click OAM Configuration.
The OAM Configuration dialog box is displayed.
NOTE

In this GUI, you can maintain or delete OAM MAs.

Step 3 Click New and choose Create MA from the drop-down list.

The Create MA dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Set the parameters of the new MA.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.3.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MAs

A.8.9.3 Creating MPs


MPs refer to function entities of Ethernet service OAM, including MEPs and MIPs. The
functions of the Ethernet service OAM can be used only after MPs are created.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet services must be created and activated.

The MD and MA must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions
In an OAM test, all MPs that are involved in the operation of the same service flow must be in
the same MD. In an existing MD involved in the same service flow, creating an MP of the same
level or a higher level may damage the existing MD. As a result, the OAM test fails.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1216

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create MP dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the parameters of the new MP.

Step 4 Optional: Click Advanced. In the displayed dialog box, set the corresponding parameters and
click OK.
NOTE

If an MEP is created, you can choose whether to perform the following configurations:
l Activate the CC and set the sending period of the CC test.
l Set the timeout time for the LB or LT test.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.3.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MPs

A.8.9.4 Performing a CC Test


After the continuity check (CC) test, the unidirectional link status can be checked automatically
and periodically. If the link is fault after the CC test is started at the source, the source equipment
reports the corresponding alarm.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1217

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet services must be created and activated.

The MD and MA must be created.

The MEPs must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Only the MEP can enable the continuity test and function as the receive respond end for
the test.

The source MEP constructs CCM packets and transmits them periodically. After receiving
the CCM packet from the source MEP, the sink MEP directly enables the CC function for
this source MEP. If the sink MEP fails to receive the CCM packet from the source MEP
within the check period (that is, 3.5 times of the transmission interval), it reports the specific
alarm automatically.

Performing a CC test does not affect the services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the node to be monitored, click OAM Operation, and select Activate CC.
NOTE

l Before the CC test, you can set CCM Sending Period(ms) according to the actual requirements.
l To disable a CC test, right-click the MEP where the CC test is performed and then choose Activate
CC from the shortcut menu.
TIP

l Alternatively, you can enable a CC test by right-clicking an MEP and then choosing Activate CC from
the shortcut menu.
l Alternatively, you can disable a CC test by right-clicking an MEP and then choosing Inactivate CC
from the shortcut menu.

----End

A.8.9.5 Performing an LB Test


During a loopback (LB) test, you can check the bidirectional connectivity between the source
MEP and any MP in the same maintenance association (MA).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1218

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

In the case of a standard MP, you must activate CC before an LB test.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Only an MEP can initiate an LB test.

During the LB test, the source MEP constructs and transmits the LBM frames and starts
the timer. If the sink MP receives the LBM frames, it sends the LBR frames back to the
source MEP. This indicates that the loopback is successful. If the source MEP timer times
out, it indicates that the loopback fails.

Performing an LB test does not affect the services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the node that requires an LB test, click OAM Operation, and select Start LB.
The LB Test dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the parameters involved in the LB test.
NOTE

l In the case of standard MPs, when an MIP functions as the receive end in the LB test, you need to select
Test based on the MAC Address and set LB Sink MP MAC Address.
l Before the LB test, you can set LB Timeout(ms) according to the actual requirements.

Step 4 Click Start LB. Then, the test result is displayed.


TIP

To enable an LB test, you can also right-click an MEP and then choose Start LB from the shortcut menu.

----End

Related References
B.7.3.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling LB

A.8.9.6 Performing an LT Test


Based on the LB test, the linktrace (LT) test further improves the capability to locate faults. That
is, the faulty network segment can be located through only one test.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1219

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

In the case of a standard MP, you must activate CC before an LT test.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Only an MEP can initiate the LT test, and the MEP can work as the receive end in the test.

During the LT test, the source MEP constructs and transmits the LTM frames and starts
the timer. All the MPs that receive the LTM frames send the LTR frame response.
According to the LTR frame response, you can verify all the MIPs that pass from the source
MEP to the sink MEP.

Performing an LT test does not affect the services.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the node that requires an LT test, click OAM Operation, and select Start LT.
Step 3 Set the parameters involved in the LT test.
NOTE

Before the test, you can set LT Timeout(ms) according to the actual requirements.

Step 4 Click Start LT. Then, the test result is displayed.


TIP

To enable an LT test, you can also right-click an MEP and then choose Start LT from the shortcut menu.

----End

Related References
B.7.3.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling LT

A.8.9.7 Activating the AIS


After a fault is detected by an MP, if this MP activates the AIS, it sends the AIS packet to a
higher level MP so that the higher level MP is informed of the fault information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1220

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

Only a standard MP supports this function.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the node to be monitored. Double-click or right-click AIS Active Status and then select
Active or Inactive.

NOTE

l If several MDs exist on a link, to locate a fault accurately, set AIS Active Status to Active and Client Layer
Level that functions to suppress the AIS information.
l After a fault is detected by an MP, if this MP activates the AIS, it sends the AIS packet to a higher level MP,
informing the higher level MP of the fault information; if this MP does not activate the AIS, it does not
report the fault.
l Normally, if an MP is set to level n, Client Layer Level that functions to suppress the AIS information
should be set to n+1.
l Client Layer Level is valid only if AIS Active Status is Active.

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

A.8.9.8 Performing a Ping Test


In a ping test, the ARP and ICMP Layer 3 protocol packets are used to test the connectivity,
packet loss ratio, and delay of the service between the Ethernet service processing board and the
data communication equipment (such as a switch or a router).

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

You must be aware of the IP addresses of the source MP and the sink MP in the ping test.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1221

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Background Information
The source end of the ping test obtains the IP addresses of the source MP and sink MP, and
constructs and sends ARP packets and ICMP packets. The MP that receives the ARP packets or
ICMP packets parses the packets, and responds to the source end. After receiving the response
packet, the source end reports the ping test result to the NE software (including the ratio of packet
loss and time delay) based on the response packet.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the node to be monitored, click OAM Operation, and select Start Ping.
The Ping Test dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Select Send Mode. Then, set Frame Length, Timeout, and Ping Attempts for the ping packet.

Step 4 Set Destination IP Address and Local IP Address.


Step 5 Click Start Ping. Then, the test result is displayed.
----End

A.8.9.9 Performing Performance Check


A performance check achieves on-line detection of the packet loss ratio and delay of the service
based on the check of the connectivity between the MPs on the Ethernet service processing
board.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The source and sink MEPs in the same MD must be created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The performance check method provides an in-service test of packet loss ratio and delay based
on the check of the connectivity between the MPs on the Ethernet service processing unit.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1222

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A performance check is implemented as follows: The source MP initiates several LB tests and
counts different packet loss ratio and delay values.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the node to be monitored, click OAM Operation, and select Performance Detect.
The Performance Detect dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Select Send Mode. Then, set Frame Length, Timeout, and Detect Attempts for the test packet.
Step 4 Set Source MP ID and Destination MP ID.
Step 5 Click Start Detect. Then, the check result is displayed.
----End

A.8.10 Using the Ethernet port OAM


By using the Ethernet port OAM, you can maintain the point-to-point Ethernet links.

A.8.10.1 Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function


The Ethernet port OAM is achieved based on the OAM auto-discovery function. After the OAM
auto-discovery succeeds, the equipment automatically monitors the faults and performance of
the link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The OAM auto-discovery is achieved based on auto-negotiation between the local equipment
and the opposite equipment. If the negotiation fails, the local equipment reports an alarm. After
OAM auto-discovery is successful, the link performance is monitored according to the error
frame threshold. You can set the error frame threshold on the NMS.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the port and set OAM Working Mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1223

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l The OAM mode includes the active mode and the passive mode. For two interconnected systems, the
OAM mode of either or both systems must be the active mode. Otherwise, OAM auto-discovery fails.
l If the OAM modes of the two systems are passive modes, if a fault occurs on the link, or if one system
fails to receive the OAM protocol message within five consecutive seconds, an alarm is reported,
indicating that OAM auto-discovery fails.

Step 4 Select Enabled from the Enable OAM Protocol drop-down list.

Step 5 Click Apply.


Step 6 Click the Remote OAM Parameter tab. Click Query to check the OAM capability of the
opposite end.
----End

Related References
B.7.3.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_OAM Parameter

A.8.10.2 Enabling the Link Event Notification


After the link event notification is enabled on the local equipment, if the OAM detects a link
fault and link performance event, the opposite equipment is informed.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The OAM auto-discovery operation must be successful on the equipment at both ends.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
After the OAM auto-discovery operation is successful at both ends, the link fault detection and
performance detection are automatically started.
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The local end can notify the opposite end of link fault events only if Remote Alarm
Support for Link Event is set to Enabled at the local end.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1224

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The local end can notify the opposite end of link performance events only if Remote Alarm
Support for Link Event is set to Enabled and if the monitoring time and error frame
thresholds are configured at the local end.

After Remote Alarm Support for Link Event is set to Enabled at the opposite port, if
the opposite end detects link performance degradation, you can query the
ETHOAM_RMT_SD alarm, which is reported on the local end, by using the NMS.
According to the alarm, you can determine the type of the link performance event.

After Remote Alarm Support for Link Event is set to Enabled at the opposite port, if
the opposite equipment detects a link fault event or encounters a fault that makes the
equipment fail to be restored (such as a power failure), you can query the
ETHOAM_RMT_CRIT_FAULT alarm, which is reported at the local end, by using the
NMS. Based on the alarm, you can determine the fault type.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the corresponding port and set Remote Alarm Support for Link Event to Enabled.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.3.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_Remote OAM Parameter

A.8.10.3 Modifying the OAM Error Frame Monitoring Threshold


The threshold for the OAM error frame monitoring is a standard for the OAM to detect the link
performance. Generally, the default value is used. You can modify the value according to the
situation of the link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The Ethernet port OAM function must be enabled on the remote equipment and the OAM
auto-discovery operation must be successful on the equipment at both ends.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1225

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Background Information
The local end notifies the opposite end after detecting a link event in the receive direction under
the following conditions:
l

The OAM auto-discovery operation is successful.

Remote Alarm Support for Link Event is set to Enabled and the monitoring time and
error frame thresholds have been configured at the local end.

If Remote Alarm Support for Link Event is also set to Enabled at the opposite end, the
opposite end notifies the local end after detecting a link event, and then the local end generates
the corresponding alarm.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab.
Step 3 Select the port and set the parameters in the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab page.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.3.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_OAM Error Frame Monitoring

A.8.10.4 Performing the Remote Loopback


After the Ethernet port on the local equipment sends data to the port on the interconnected
equipment, the local end can request the opposite end to return the data.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The OAM auto-discovery operation must be successful on the equipment at both ends.

On the equipment where the loopback is initiated, OAM Working Mode must be set to
Active.

The equipment that responds to the loopback must support remote loopbacks.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

If a port is capable of responding to loopbacks, it enters the Respond Loopback of


Remote state and reports the loopback responding alarm when receiving the command of
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1226

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

enabling the remote loopback function sent from the opposite OAM port. In this case, the
equipment that initiates the loopback enters the loopback initiating state and reports the
loopback initiating alarm.
l

Generally, after the remote loopback function is enabled, service packets, except the
OAMPDU packets, are looped back at the remote end.

After using the remote loopback function to locate faults and test link performance, you
should disable the remote loopback function at the end where the loopback is initiated and
then restore the services. At this time, the alarm clears automatically.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Choose Enable Remote Loopback from the OAM drop-down menu. Then, close the dialog
box that is displayed.

----End

A.8.11 Configuring LPT


After enabling the LPT function for an Ethernet service, you need to configure the LPT port and
the relevant information.

A.8.11.1 Configuring LPT for Point-to-Point Services


When a point-to-point service uses the LPT function, you need to set LPT parameters both in
the positive and reverse directions.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The PORT-based Ethernet private line services must be created and activated.

The data services must be configured as EPL services that are transmitted from PORTs to
VCTRUNKs and do not carry any VLAN tags.

An Ethernet port on which the LPT function is enabled must be in auto-negotiation mode.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1227

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Precautions
NOTE

Point-to-point LPT and point-to-multipoint LPT are mutually exclusive. On the same board, you can select
only one configuration mode to implement the LPT function.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > LPT Management from the Function
Tree.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Select a PORT and a VCTRUNK, and then set the following parameters.
NOTE

If LPT is enabled, you can set PORT-Type Port Hold-Off Time(ms) and VCTRUNK Port Hold-Off
Time(ms) according to actual requirements.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.7.2.14 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation of Point-to-Point Service LPT

A.8.11.2 Configuring LPT for Point-to-Multipoint Services


To configure LPT for point-to-multipoint services, you need to specify the corresponding
relationships between aggregation ports and access ports and LPT parameters.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The EFP8/EMS6 board must be added in the NE Panel.

The VLAN-based EVPL services must be created and activated.

An Ethernet port on which the LPT function is enabled must be in auto-negotiation mode.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1228

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Precautions
NOTE

Point-to-point LPT and point-to-multipoint LPT are mutually exclusive. On the same board, you can select
only one configuration mode to implement the LPT function.

CAUTION
Before configuring the point-to-multipoint LPT function, make sure that the following two
conditions are met. Otherwise, the services may be interrupted.
l

The data services are displayed in the tree topology.

The data service topology is consistent with the topology of the LPT.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > LPT Management from the Function
Tree.
Step 2 Click PtoMP LPT. Then, the LPT Management dialog box appears.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create LPT dialog box is displayed.

Step 4 Set the parameters in Convergence Point.


Step 5 Set the parameters in Access Point.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1229

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

1.

Select the ports from Port and then click

2.

If you select a VCTRUNK, set Bearer Mode.

A Task Collection

Step 6 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.7.2.15 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation of Point-to-Multipoint Service
LPT

A.9 Managing MPLS/PWE3 Services and Features


The OptiX RTN 980 supports multiple MPLS/PWE3 services and features.

A.9.1 Managing Address Resolution


The OptiX RTN 980 runs the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) to set up mapping between
MAC addresses and IP addresses of ports.

A.9.1.1 Creating ARP Static Entries


This topic describes how to create ARP entries that are not aged.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Control Plane Configuration > Address Parse from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Create.
The Add Address Parse dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set the parameters for address resolution.
NOTE

Configure the MAC address in an ARP entry according to the MAC address of its next-hop equipment.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1230

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click OK. Then, the static ARP entry is successfully created.
----End

A.9.1.2 Querying ARP Entries


You can learn about ARP information.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Control Plane Configuration > Address Parse from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query and query ARP entries in the main interface.
----End

A.9.1.3 Converting Dynamic ARP Entries to Static ARP Entries


During the equipment operation phase, you can change dynamic entries in the ARP table to static
entries to improve stability of tunnels.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Control Plane Configuration > Address Parse from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required dynamic ARP entry and click Switch to Static Type.
Step 3 Click Query. Then, ARP List Type changes to Static for the selected dynamic ARP entry.
----End

A.9.1.4 Deleting Static ARP Entries


When MAC addresses of interconnected ports change, you can delete the existing static ARP
entries of the network element (NE) and create other ARP entries.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1231

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Control Plane Configuration > Address Parse from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required static ARP entry and click Delete.
NOTE

When deleting dynamic ARP entries, click Clear. Exercise caution when performing this operation to avoid
service interruption.

A confirmation dialog box is displayed.


Step 3 Click OK.
Step 4 Click Query. The selected static ARP entry is deleted.
----End

A.9.1.5 Setting ARP Aging Time


This topic describes how to set the ARP aging time. The default aging time is 720 minutes.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Control
Plane Configuration > Aging Time from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required port, double-click it, and modify the parameter Dynamic ARP Entry Aging
Time(min).
NOTE

It is recommended that Dynamic ARP Entry Aging Time(min) take its default value 720.

Step 3 Click Apply.


----End

A.9.2 Managing MPLS Tunnels


Managing MPLS tunnels include managing MPLS OAM functions.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1232

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes


This topic describes how to set basic MPLS attributes, including the LSR ID and the global label
space.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Basic Configuration from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Double-click LSR ID and set the LSR ID of the NE according to the planning information.

CAUTION
When PWE3 services are configured on the NE, the PWE3 services may be interrupted if LSR
ID of the NE is changed.

Step 3 Click Apply.


A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.1 Parameter Description: Basic Configurations of MPLS Tunnels

A.9.2.2 Creating a Unidirectional MPLS Tunnel


When creating a unidirectional MPLS tunnel, you need to manually create a MPLS tunnel in
the reverse direction.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The port attributes are set correctly.

The LSR ID of each NE is set correctly.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1233

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Static Tunnel tab.
Step 3 Click New and choose Unidirectional Tunnel from the drop-down list.
Step 4 Select New Reverse Tunnel.
Step 5 Set parameters for the new MPLS tunnel.

Step 6 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1234

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.9.1.3 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Creation of Unidirectional
Tunnels

A.9.2.3 Creating a Bidirectional MPLS Tunnel


During creation of a bidirectional MPLS tunnel, both the forward and reverse tunnels are created.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The port attributes have been correctly configured.

The LSR ID of each NE has been correctly configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Static Tunnel tab.
Step 3 Click New and choose Bidirectional Tunnel from the drop-down list.
The New Unicast Bidirectional Tunnel dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set parameters for the bidirectional MPLS tunnel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1235

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.4 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Creation of Bidirectional Tunnels

A.9.2.4 Querying MPLS Tunnel Information


You can learn about information about all MPLS tunnels configured for an NE.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

MPLS tunnels are configured correctly.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1236

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Static Tunnel tab.
Step 3 Click Query.Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 4 View the information about all MPLS tunnels configured for the NE in the main interface.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.2 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Static Tunnel

A.9.2.5 Changing MPLS Tunnel Information


This section describes how to change parameter values of an MPLS tunnel, for example, the
egress/ingress ports.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS tunnel has been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Static Tunnel tab.
Step 3 Click Query.Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 4 Choose the MPLS tunnel whose parameter values need to be changed and click Modify at the
lower right corner.
Step 5 In the dialog box that is displayed, modify the MPLS tunnel information.
Step 6 Click Apply.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 7 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 8 Click OK.
----End

A.9.2.6 Deleting MPLS Tunnels


If a tunnel is no longer used, you can delete it to free the corresponding transmission resources.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1237

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

An MPLS tunnel is configured correctly and is no longer used to transmit services.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Static Tunnel tab.
Step 3 Click Query.Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 4 Select the required MPLS tunnel and click Delete.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 6 Click Query and find that the selected MPLS tunnel does not exist.
----End

A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM Parameters


This section describes how to set OAM parameters for MPLS tunnel availability test.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

MPLS tunnels are created and enabled.

Node Type is set to Ingress or Egress for tunnels.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required MPLS tunnel and set MPLS OAM parameters.

Step 4 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1238

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.9.1.5 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_OAM Parameters

A.9.2.8 Enabling/Disabling FDI


When the FDI function of an NE is enabled, fault locating and protection switching can be
performed more quickly.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

MPLS tunnels are created and enabled.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the FDI tab.
Step 3 Set Enable FDI based on the applications.

Step 4 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.6 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_FDI

A.9.2.9 Starting/Stopping CV/FFD Detection for MPLS Tunnels


Before enabling CV/FD detection, you need to set MPLS OAM parameters.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS OAM function has been enabled and related parameters have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required tunnel and click OAM Operation.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1239

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Select the required operation from the drop-down list.


1.

To enable CV/FFD detection, click Start CV/FFD. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed.

2.

To disable CV/FFD detection, click Stop CV/FFD. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed.
NOTE

l For unidirectional tunnels, this operation task can be performed only for a tunnel whose Node Type
is Ingress.
l For bidirectional tunnels, this operation task cannot be performed if Node Type is Transit.
l After the MPLS OAM function is enabled, CV/FFD detection is enabled by default.
TIP

l You can select more than one tunnel at a time by pressing and holding down the Ctrl key.
l Alternatively, you can select the required tunnel, right-click the tunnel, and then select Start CV/
FFD or Stop CV/FFD from the drop-down list.

----End

A.9.2.10 Querying LSP Running Status


This topic describes how to query the MPLS tunnel status detected by MPLS OAM.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS OAM detection function has been enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required tunnel and click OAM Operation at lower right of the main interface.
Step 4 Select Query LSP Status from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 5 Check the tunnel status according to the LSP Status parameter value in the main interface.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1240

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

TIP

l You can select more than one tunnel at a time by pressing and holding down the Ctrl key.
l Alternatively, you can select a tunnel, right-click the tunnel, and select LSP Status from the drop-down
list.

----End

A.9.2.11 Clearing OAM Configuration Data for MPLS Tunnels


This topic describes how to restart MPLS OAM detection by clearing MPLS OAM configuration
data.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS OAM detection function has been enabled.

The tunnel is not configured in any protection group.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required tunnel and click OAM Operation at lower right of the main interface.
Step 4 Select Clear OAM from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
NOTE

After this step is performed, OAM parameters for the tunnel are restored to default values. If OAM
operations need to be performed, you need to re-enable and configure the OAM functions.
TIP

l You can select more than one tunnel at a time by pressing and holding down the Ctrl key.
l Alternatively, you can select a tunnel, right-click the tunnel, and select Clear OAM from the dropdown list.

----End

A.9.2.12 Performing an LSP Ping Test


This topic describes how to detect whether an MPLS tunnel is available.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1241

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameters tab.
Step 3 Select the required tunnel, click OAM Operation in the lower right corner, and choose Ping
Test from the drop-down list.
NOTE

The test can be initiated only by an ingress node.


TIP

Alternatively, you can select a tunnel, right-click the tunnel, and select Ping Test from the drop-down list.

The Ping Test dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Set parameters for a ping test.

Step 5 Click Start Test to check the test result.


NOTE

l If LSP ping uses the IPv4 UDP response mode, all the nodes on the tunnel must support DCN
communication over IP protocols.
l To stop a test, click Stop Test.

----End

Related References
B.9.1.7 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_LSP Ping

A.9.2.13 Performing an LSP Traceroute Test


You can detect fault points on an MPLS tunnel by performing LSP traceroute tests.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1242

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the OAM Parameters tab.
Step 3 Select the required tunnel, click OAM Operation in the lower right corner, and choose
Traceroute Test from the drop-down list.
NOTE

The test can be initiated only by an ingress node.


TIP

Alternatively, you can select a tunnel, right-click the tunnel, and select Traceroute Test from the dropdown list.

The Traceroute Test dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Set parameters for the traceroute test.

Step 5 Click Start Test to check the test result.


NOTE

l If LSP traceroute uses the IPv4 UDP response mode, all the nodes on the tunnel must support DCN
communication over IP protocols.
l To stop a test, click Stop Test.

----End

Related References
B.9.1.8 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_LSP Traceroute

A.9.3 Managing MPLS APS Protection Groups


MPLS APS is the commonest protection mode for MPLS tunnels.

A.9.3.1 Creating an MPLS APS Protection Group


An MPLS APS protection group needs to be configured if a service carried by an MPLS tunnel
needs to be protected.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The working and protection MPLS tunnels have been created.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1243

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

MPLS OAM as been enabled for both working and protection MPLS tunnel in the
protection group.

The protection tunnel cannot carry extra services.

PW APS protection is not configured for the service.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
MPLS OAM needs to be enabled for working and protection tunnels. The detection packets used
by MPLS OAM are FFD packets. FFD packets are usually sent at an interval of 3.3 ms. If the
packet transmission delay time of an MPLS tunnel exceeds 3.3 ms, the transmission interval of
FFD packets needs to be a value greater than the delay time.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > APS
Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Tunnel APS Management tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The New Tunnel Protection Group dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Set parameters for the MPLS APS protection group.
NOTE

When creating an MPLS APS protection group, set Protocol Status to Disabled. Start the protocol only when
the MPLS APS protection group is successfully created on nodes at both ends.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1244

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.15 Parameter Description: Tunnel Protection Group_Creation

A.9.3.2 Querying MPLS APS Status


You can know current information about MPLS APS by querying MPLS APS status on the
NMS.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS APS protection group has been created.

The MPLS APS protocol has been enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
APS Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1245

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Click the Tunnel APS Management tab.


Step 3 Click Query, and then close the dialog box that is displayed. Check basic information about the
protection group.
Step 4 Select the required protection group and click Function.
Step 5 Select Query Switching Status from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed. Check the status of the protection group.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.14 Parameter Description: MPLS APS Protection Management

A.9.3.3 Triggering MPLS APS Switching


This topic describes how to trigger an external PW APS switching.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS APS protection group has been created.

The MPLS APS protocol has been enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
APS Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Tunnel APS Management tab.
Step 3 Select the required protection group, click Function, and then select the required switching mode
from the drop-down list.
TIP

Alternatively, you can select the required protection group, right-click the protection group, and then select
the required switching mode from the drop-down list.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1246

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Then, a confirmation dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 5 Click Function.
Step 6 Select Query Switching Status from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is
displayed. Check whether switching is performed successfully.
----End

A.9.3.4 Enabling/Disabling MPLS APS Protection


If you first stop the MPLS APS protection protocol and then start it, the MPLS APS protection
protocol is restored to its initial state.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The MPLS APS protection group has been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
APS Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Tunnel APS Management tab.
Step 3 Stop the MPLS APS protocol.
1.

Select the required protection group and click Function.

2.

Select Stop Protocol from the drop-down list.

CAUTION
After the MPLS APS protocol is stopped, the protection group fails. In addition, services
are unavailable until the working channel is restored or the MPLS APS protocol is restarted,
if services have been switched to the protection channel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1247

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A confirmation dialog box is displayed.


3.

Click Yes. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 4 Start the MPLS APS protocol.


1.
2.

Select the required protection group and click Function.


Select Start Protocol from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
TIP

Alternatively, you can select the required protection group, right-click the protection group, and choose
Start Protocol or Stop Protocol from the shortcut menu.

----End

A.9.4 Managing PWs


All types of PWE3 services are carried by PWs.

A.9.4.1 Querying Information and Running Status of PWs


This topic describes how to query information and running status of PWs.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

PW-carried services have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW Management tab.
Step 3 Click Query Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 4 In the main interface, check the basic information and running status of each PW.
Step 5 After selecting a PW, to query other PW information, do as follows:
1.

Click the QoS Information tab and check QoS information of the PW.

2.

Click the Advanced Attributes tab and check the advanced attributes of the PW.

----End

Related References
B.9.1.9 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Management

A.9.4.2 Creating an MS-PW


This topic describes how to configure cross-connections for front-end and rear-end PWs at an
S-PE node and create an MS-PW.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1248

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The steps for creating MS-PWs vary according to service types. This topic uses an Ethernet
service as an example to describe how to create MS-PWs.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the MS PW tab.
Step 3 Click New.
The Create MS PW dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 In the main interface, configure basic service information.

Step 5 Click the PW Basic Attributes tab and set PW parameters.

Step 6 Click the QoS tab and set QoS parameters.


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1249

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 7 Click the Advanced Attributes tab and set advanced attributes.

Step 8 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.10 Parameter Description: PW Management_MS-PW Creation

A.9.4.3 Setting PW OAM Parameters


This topic describes how to set OAM parameters for PW availability test.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

PW-carried services have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required PW and set PW OAM parameters.

Step 4 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1250

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.9.1.11 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW OAM

A.9.4.4 Performing a PW Ping Test


This topic describes how to detect whether a PW is available.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

A PW has been created and enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required PW and click OAM Operation > Ping Test.
TIP

Alternatively, you can select a PW, right-click the PW, and select Ping Test from the drop-down list.

The Ping Test dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Set parameters for a ping test.

Step 5 Click Start Test to check the test result.


NOTE

l If PW ping/traceroute uses the IPv4 UDP response mode, all the nodes on the PW must support DCN
communication over IP protocols.
l To stop a test, click Stop Test.

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1251

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.9.1.12 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Ping

A.9.4.5 Performing a PW Traceroute Test


You can detect fault points on an MS-PW by performing PW traceroute tests.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

A PW has been created and enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW OAM Parameter tab.
Step 3 Select the required PW, click OAM Operation in the lower right corner, and choose Traceroute
Test from the drop-down list.
TIP

Alternatively, you can select a PW, right-click the PW, and select Traceroute Test from the drop-down
list.

The Traceroute Test dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Set parameters for the traceroute test.

Step 5 Click Start Test to check the test result.


NOTE

l If PW ping/traceroute uses the IPv4 UDP response mode, all the nodes on the PW must support DCN
communication over IP protocols.
l To stop a test, click Stop Test.

----End

Related References
B.9.1.13 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Traceroute
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1252

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.9.5 Managing a PW APS Protection Group


PW APS provides protection for PWs.

A.9.5.1 Creating a PW APS Protection Group


If MPLS APS cannot be configured to protect a PW-carried service, you can configure PW APS
to protect the service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

MPLS APS protection is not configured for the service.

The tunnel carrying the working and protection PWs has been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
PW OAM needs to be enabled for the working and protection PWs of a PW APS protection
group. The detection packets used by PW OAM are FFD packets. FFD packets are usually sent
at an interval of 3.3 ms. If the packet transmission delay time of a PW exceeds 3.3 ms, the
transmission interval of FFD packets needs to be a value greater than the delay time.
CES services, ATM services, and E-Line services carried by PWs support PW APS. You can
create a PW APS protection group during initial service configuration or after service
configuration.
l

During initial service configuration, set Protection Type to PW APS, create the working
and protection PWs, use the PWs to configure a PW APS protection group.

If services are already configured, create the PW APS protection group in the Protection
Group tab page.

For SS-PWs and MS-PWs, configuration of the PW APS protection group needs to be done
on both source NE and sink NE.
NOTE

l This topic describes how to configure PW APS after services are configured.
l This topic uses a PW-carried E-Line service as an example to describe how to configure PW APS protection.
The methods of configuring PW APS protection for other types of service are similar.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required services and click the Protection Group tab.
Step 3 Click PW APS.
Step 4 Click New.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1253

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The Configure PW dialog box is displayed.


Step 5 Click the General Attributes tab and set the basic attributes of the protection PW.

Step 6 Click the Protection Group tab and set information about the PW APS protection group.
NOTE

When creating a PW APS protection group, set Enabling Status to Disabled. Start the protocol only when the
PW APS protection group is successfully created on nodes at both ends.

Step 7 Click PW OAM and configure OAM information.


NOTE

l When the PW APS protection group is created, the PW OAM function is automatically enabled to
detect the PW status.
l You can also configure OAM information by choosing Configuration > MPLS Management > PW
Management > PW OAM Parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1254

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 8 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.16 Parameter Description: PW APS Protection Group_Creation

A.9.5.2 Configuring Slave Protection Pairs of PW APS


During PW APS switching, the PWs in the slave protection pair are also switched.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The mapping between a slave protection pair and a PW APS protection group has been
specified.

MPLS APS protection is not configured for the service.

The tunnel carrying the working and protection PWs has been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
CES services, ATM services, and E-Line services carried by PWs support PW APS slave
protection pairs. The slave protection pairs are bound with a PW APS protection group. You
can create a slave protection pair during initial service configuration or after service
configuration.
l

During initial service configuration, set Protection Type to Slave Protection Pair, create
the working and protection PWs, use the PWs to configure a slave protection pair.

If services are already configured, create the slave protection pair in the Protection
Group tab page.

For SS-PWs and MS-PWs, binding of a slave protection pair to a PW APS protection group
requires that the slave protection pair is added on both the source NE and sink NE.
NOTE

l This topic describes how to configure a slave protection pair after services are configured.
l This topic uses a PW-carried E-Line service as an example to describe how to configure a slave protection
pair. The methods of configuring slave protection pairs for other types of service are similar.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1255

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required services and click the Protection Group tab.
Step 3 Click Slave Protection Pair.
Step 4 Click New.
The Configure PW dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Click the General Attributes tab and set the basic attributes of the protection PW.

Step 6 Click the Protect Group tab and set the ID of the PW APS protection group to which the slave
protection pair is bound.
NOTE

You can manually enter an ID, or double-click the ID parameter and select from the drop-down list.

Step 7 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.1.17 Parameter Description: Slave Protection Pair of a PW APS Protection Group_Creation

A.9.5.3 Querying PW APS Status


You can know current information about a PW APS protection group by querying PW APS
status on the NMS.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1256

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The PW APS protection group has been created.

The PW APS protocol has been enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > APS
Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW APS Management tab.
Step 3 Click Query, and then close the dialog box that is displayed. Check basic information about the
protection group.
NOTE

If a slave protection pair is configured, information about the slave protection pair is displayed at the lower
part of the main interface after you select the protection group.

Step 4 Select the required protection group. Click Function > Query Switching Status, and then close
the dialog box that is displayed. Check the status of the protection group.
----End

A.9.5.4 Triggering PW APS Switching


This topic describes how to trigger an external PW APS switching.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The PW APS protection group has been created.

The PW APS protocol has been enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > APS
Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW APS Management tab.
Step 3 Select the required protection group, click Function, and then select the required switching mode
from the drop-down list.
TIP

Alternatively, you can select the required protection group, right-click the protection group, and then select
the required switching mode from the drop-down list.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1257

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Then, a confirmation dialog box is displayed.


Step 4 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 5 Click Function and choose Query Switching Status from the drop-down list. Then, close the
dialog box that is displayed. Check whether switching is performed successfully.
----End

A.9.5.5 Enabling/Disabling PW APS Protection


If you first stop the PW APS protection protocol and then start it, the PW APS protection protocol
is restored to its initial state.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The PW APS protection group has been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > APS
Protection Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the PW APS Management tab.
Step 3 Stop the PW APS protocol.
1.

Select the required protection group and click Function.

2.

Select Stop Protocol from the drop-down list.

CAUTION
After the PW APS protocol is stopped, the protection group fails. In addition, services are
unavailable until the working channel is restored or the PW APS protocol is restarted, if
services have been switched to the protection channel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1258

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A confirmation dialog box is displayed.


3.

Click Yes Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 4 Start the PW APS protocol.


1.

Select the required protection group and click Function.

2.

Select Start Protocol from the drop-down list. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
TIP

You can enable or disable the PW APS protocol by using either of the following methods:
l Select the required protection group, right-click the protection group, and choose Start Protocol or
Stop Protocol from the short-cut menu.
l Set Enabling Status to Enabled or Disabled.

----End

A.9.6 Managing CES Services


The OptiX RTN 980 supports PWE3-based CES services.

A.9.6.1 Creating CES Services


This topic describes how to create a CES service. During creation of a CES service, the PW for
carrying the CES service is also created.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The attributes of the UNI port that carries the CES service have been configured. That is,
Port Mode has been set to Layer 1, and Frame Format and Frame Mode have also been
configured.

The MPLS tunnel that carries the PW has been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Generally, UNI-NNI CES services are configured on the OptiX RTN 980. Therefore, this
topic uses a UNI-NNI CES service as an example to describe how to configure CES
services.

It is recommended that you create protection information before creating a CES service.
In this configuration example, Protection Type is set to No Protection. For details on how
to configure protection information, see A.9.5.1 Creating a PW APS Protection Group
and A.9.5.2 Configuring Slave Protection Pairs of PW APS.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1259

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The Create CES Service dialog box is displayed.


Step 3 Set Mode to UNI-NNI. Configure basic information about the CES service carried by a PW.
NOTE

l If Mode is UNI-NNI, you can configure advanced attributes of the PW.


l Set Protection Type to No Protection.

Step 4 Click Configure PW, and and set the basic attributes of the PW.

Step 5 Click Advanced and set parameters for the advanced attributes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1260

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Click OK.


Step 7 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.2.2 Parameter Description: CES Service Management_Creation

A.9.6.2 Modifying CES Service Parameters


This topic describes how to modify parameters related to CES services, such as CES alarm
transparent transmission parameters.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

CES services have been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required CES service and click Query. Then, click the dialog box that is displayed.
In the main interface, check basic service information.
Step 3 Click PW General Attributes to query information about the PW that carry the service.
Step 4 Modify advanced parameters.
1.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click the Advanced Attributes tab.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1261

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

2.

Select the required PW, double-click a required advance attribute, and change the attribute
value.

3.

Click Apply.

Step 5 Change protection group information.


1.

Click the Protection Group tab.

2.

Click PW APS.

3.

Change values of protection group parameters, such as Restoration Mode.

4.

Click Apply.

----End

Related References
B.9.2.1 Parameter Description: CES Service Management

A.9.6.3 Querying CES Service Information


This topic describes how to query information about a CES service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

CES services have been created.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required CES service and click Query. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
In the main interface, check basic service information.
Step 3 Click PW General Attributes to query information about the PW that carry the service.
Step 4 Click QoS to check the QoS information of the CES service.
Step 5 Click Advanced Attributes to check advanced attributes of the CES service.
Step 6 Click Protection Group to check whether a protection group is configured and to check
information about the protection group if configured.
----End

Related References
B.9.2.1 Parameter Description: CES Service Management

A.9.6.4 Deleting a CES Service.


If a CES service is no longer used, you can delete it to free up the corresponding transmission
resources. To delete a CES service, you need to delete the corresponding ACR clock
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1262

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

configuration at both the source and sink nodes of the CES service. After the CES service is
deleted, the corresponding PW is automatically deleted.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The CES service has been created and will no longer be used.

No ACR clock has been configured for the CES service.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Select the required CES service and click Delete.
A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Click OK. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 4 Click Query, and then close the dialog box that is displayed to check whether the CES service
is successfully deleted.
----End

A.9.7 Managing ATM/IMA Ports


On the OptiX RTN 980, ATM/IMA ports are mapped into one ATM TRUNK.

A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs


An ATM TRUNK can bind one or more E1 ports that transmit ATM/IMA services, or serial
ports (SPs) that transmit ATM/IMA services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

For ATM/IMA E1 services, set Port Mode in PDH Interface to Layer 2.

For Fractional ATM/IMA services, set Port Mode in PDH Interface to Layer 1 and
configure A.6.5 Setting Serial Port Parameters.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Binding tab.
Step 3 Click Configuration.
The Bound Path dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1263

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Step 4 Configure the related parameters according to the network plan. Click
required E1 ports or SPs to the ATM TRUNK.

A Task Collection

to bind the

NOTE

l If ATM/IMA services need to be mapped into the ATM TRUNK that binds one or more E1 ports, select
E1 in Level.
l If ATM/IMA services need to be mapped into the ATM TRUNK that binds one or more serial ports,
select Fractional E1 in Level.

Step 5 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Follow-up Procedure
If the IMA group is required, you need to bind the member links of the IMA group with the
ATM TRUNK, enable the IMA protocol for the ATM TRUNK, and then configure the
parameters of the IMA group.

Related References
B.9.3.2 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_Bound Path Configuration

A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group


If the ATM TRUNK binds IAM E1 links or Fractional IMA links, you need to configure the
parameters of the IMA group.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1264

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IMA Group Management tab.
Step 3 Configure the parameters of the IMA group according to the network plan.

NOTE

l Set IMA Protocol Enable Status to Enabled if the links bound in the ATM TRUNK require the IMA
protocol; otherwise, set this parameter to Disabled.
l After IMA Protocol Enable Status is set to Enabled, the E1 links or Fractional E1 timeslots bound
in the ATM TRUNK start running the IMA protocol.
l The values of Minimum Number of Active Transmitting Links and Minimum Number of Active
Receiving Links must be the same because the OptiX RTN 980 supports Symmetrical Mode and
Symmetrical Operation only. The parameters Minimum Number of Active Transmitting Links
and Minimum Number of Active Receiving Links must assume the same value on the two ends of
an IMA link.
l On the two ends of the IMA link, you need to set IMA Protocol Version, IMA Transmit Frame
Length, and Maximum Delay Between Links (ms) to the same values.
l Clock Mode is set to the same value for the interconnected ends of IMA links.

Step 4 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.


----End

Related References
B.9.3.1 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Group Management

A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters


This topic describes how to configure ATM port parameters.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the ATM Interface Management tab.
Step 3 Configure and adjust the ATM port attributes.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1265

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l UNI: the port connecting user-side devices. For example, the UNI port applies to the user-side interface on
the common ATM network or to the user-side interface of the PE on the PSN network that transmits ATM
PWE3 services.
l NNI: the port connecting network-side devices. For example, the NNI port applies to the network-side
interface on the common ATM network.
l The ITU-T G.804 stipulates that the payload (48 bytes) of ATM cells must be scrambled before it is mapped
into E1 signals. Therefore, it is recommended that you set ATM Cell Payload Scrambling to Enabled.
l ATM Cell Payload Scrambling must assume the same value on the two ends of an ATM link. Otherwise,
packet loss will occur.

Step 4 Click Apply, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.5 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_ATM Interface Management

A.9.7.4 Querying Running Status of an IMA Group


This topic describes how to query the running status of an IMA group.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IMA Group States tab. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 3 Click Query. Close the displayed dialog box.
Step 4 Query the running status of an IMA group.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.3 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Group Status

A.9.7.5 Querying Link Running Status of an IMA Group


This topic describes how to query the running status of the member links of an IMA group.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1266

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Interface
Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IMA Link States tab.Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 Click Query, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 4 Query the running status of the member links of an IMA group.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.4 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Link Status

A.9.8 Managing ATM Services


The OptiX RTN 980 supports common ATM services (UNI-UNI) and PW-carried ATM services
(UNI-NNI).

A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services


To create common ATM services, you only need to configure ATM connections and CoS
mapping. To create ATM PWE3 services, you also need to configure the PW that carries ATM
services.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Generally, UNIs-NNI ATM services are configured on the OptiX RTN 980. Therefore,
this topic uses a UNIs-NNI ATM service as an example to describe how to configure ATM
PWE3 services.

Before creating ATM PWE3 services, you need to bind member links to the ATM TRUNK,
set the parameters of the IMA group, and create the MPLS tunnels that carries PWs.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

To create ATM PWE3 services (UNIs-NNI), it is recommended that you create services
before configuring PW protection. Configuration will be simplified in this manner.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1267

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

In this configuration example, Protection Type is set to No Protection. For details on how
to configure PW protection, see A.9.5.1 Creating a PW APS Protection Group and A.
9.5.2 Configuring Slave Protection Pairs of PW APS.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The New ATM Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Configure the basic information about the ATM PWE3 service according to the network plan.

Step 4 Click the Connection tab and configure the attributes of the ATM connection.

Step 5 Click PW, and click Add to configure the attributes of PWs.
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click the General Attributes tab and set the basic attributes of PWs.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1268

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

2.

Click the QoS tab and enable the PW bandwidth restriction.

3.

Click the Advanced Attributes tab to configure the advanced attributes of PWs.

4.

Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.

Step 6 Click the CoS Mapping tab and click Add to configure the CoS mapping of PWs.

Step 7 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.


Step 8 Click OK. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.11 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management_Creation
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1269

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.9.8.2 Modifying ATM Service Parameters


This topic describes how to modify ATM service parameters.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

ATM PWE3 services are already created and their parameters need to be modified
according to the planning information.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 Select the required ATM service and modify the parameters of the ATM service.
Step 4 Click Apply, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.10 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management

A.9.8.3 Querying ATM Services


This topic describes how to query ATM services.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 Select the required ATM service and query the parameters of the ATM service.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1270

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.9.3.10 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management

A.9.8.4 Deleting an ATM Service


This topic describes how to delete an ATM service. If an ATM service is no longer used, you
can delete it to release its resources.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 Select the required ATM service and click Delete.
Step 4 In the confirmation dialog box, click OK.
Step 5 After the service is deleted, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

A.9.9 ATM Traffic Management


ATM traffic management includes ATM-Diffserv management and ATM policy management.

A.9.9.1 Creating an ATM-DiffServ Domain


This topic describes how to create an ATM-DiffServ domain. If the default ATM-Diffserv
domain does not serve the purpose, a new ATM-Diffserv needs to be created.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv domain Management > ATM COS Mapping Configuration from
the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1271

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Click New.


The New ATM CoS Mapping dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Configure the ATM-Diffserv domain according to the planning information.

NOTE

l Eight PHB service classes are available: BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The OptiX RTN
980 provides different QoS policies for the queues of different service classes.
l CS6 to CS7: highest service classes, mainly applicable to signaling transmission.
l EF: fast forwarding, applicable to services of low transmission delays and low packet loss rates.
l AF1 to AF4: assured forwarding, applicable to services that require an assured transmission rate rather than
delay or jitter limits.
NOTE

The AF1 class includes three subclasses: AF11, AF12, and AF13. Only one of these subclasses can take
effect for one queue. It is the same case with AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l BE: best effort, applicable to services that do not require special processing.

Step 4 Click OK, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.7 Parameter Description: Configuration of ATM Service Class Mapping Table_Creation

A.9.9.2 Modifying an ATM-Diffserv Domain


This topic describes how to modify an ATM-Diffserv domain. By performing this operation,
you can modify the mapping relationship between ATM service types and PHB service classes.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1272

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv domain Management > ATM COS Mapping Configuration from
the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 Select the required ATM-Diffserv domain and modify its parameters according to the planning
information.

NOTE

l Eight PHB service classes are available: BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The OptiX RTN
980 provides different QoS policies for the queues of different service classes.
l CS6 to CS7: highest service classes, mainly applicable to signaling transmission.
l EF: fast forwarding, applicable to services of low transmission delays and low packet loss rates.
l AF1 to AF4: assured forwarding, applicable to services that require an assured transmission rate rather than
delay or jitter limits.
NOTE

The AF1 class includes three subclasses: AF11, AF12, and AF13. Only one of these subclasses can take
effect for one queue. It is the same case with AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l BE: best effort, applicable to services that do not require special processing.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1273

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click OK, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.6 Parameter Description: Configuration of ATM Service Class Mapping Table

A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy


This topic describes how to create an ATM policy for an ATM connection.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > ATM Policy from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create ATM Policy dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Configure the parameters of the ATM policy according to the planning information.

Step 4 Click OK, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1274

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.9.3.9 Parameter Description: ATM Policy Management_Creation

A.9.9.4 Modifying an ATM Policy


This topic describes how to modify the QoS parameters of an ATM policy.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > ATM Policy from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click Query, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 3 Select the required ATM policy and modify its parameters according to the planning information.
Step 4 Click Apply, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.8 Parameter Description: ATM Policy Management

A.9.10 Using ATM OAM


ATM OAM is an OAM mechanism that is used for detecting and locating ATM faults, and
monitoring ATM performance.

A.9.10.1 Setting Segment and End Attributes of AIS/RDI


This topic describes how to set the segment and end attributes of AIS/RDI.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

ATM services have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1275

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Segment End Attributes tab.
Step 3 Set the segment and end attributes of AIS/RDI according to the planning information.

Step 4 Click Apply, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.12 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_Segment and End Attributes

A.9.10.2 Performing a Continuity Check Test


This topic describes how to perform a continuity check (CC) test. A CC test can be performed
to continuously check the unidirectional connectivity of an ATM link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

ATM services have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the CC Activation Status tab.
Step 3 Configure the parameters of the CC test according to the planning information.

Step 4 Click Apply, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.13 Parameter Description: ATM OMA Management_CC Activation Status
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1276

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.9.10.3 Querying or Setting LLIDs


This topic describes how to query or set locate loopback IDs (LLIDs). LLIDs need to be
configured before an LB test.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the LLID tab.
Step 3 Set the LLIDs according to the planning information.

Step 4 Click Apply, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End

Related References
B.9.3.15 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_LLID

A.9.10.4 Performing an LB Test


This topic describes how to perform a loopback (LB) test. An LB test can be performed to
continuously check the bidirectional connectivity of an ATM link.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

ATM services have been configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Remote Loopback Test tab.
Step 3 Configure the attributes of the LB test according to the planning information.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1277

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Select an ATM connection for which an LB test needs to be performed.


TIP

By pressing the Ctrl key on the keyboard, you can select multiple ATM connections at one time.

Step 5 Click Test, and close the dialog box that is displayed.
Step 6 Check Test Result.

----End

Related References
B.9.3.14 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_Remote End Loopback Status

A.10 Managing the Clock


To ensure the clock synchronization between transmission nodes on a transport network, you
need to manage the NE clock.

A.10.1 Managing Clocks at the Physical Layer


This section describes how to synchronize clock signals by transmission of reference clock
signals at the physical layer.

A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources


This topic describes how to configure the clock source according to the planned clock
synchronization scheme to ensure that all the NEs on the network trace the same clock.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Source Priority.
Step 2 Click the System Clock Source Priority List tab.
Step 3 Click Create.
The Add Clock Source dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Select the clock sources.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1278

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

TIP

Hold the Ctrl key on the keyboard to select multiple clock sources.

Step 5 Click OK.


Step 6 Optional: Repeat Step 3 to Step 5 to add other clock sources.
Step 7 Optional: Select a clock source and click
clock source.

or

to adjust the priority of this

NOTE

The clock priorities levels are arranged in a descending order from the first row to the last row. The internal
clock source is always of the lowest priority.

Step 8 Optional: Set External Clock Source Mode and Synchronous Status Byte for the external
clock sources.

Step 9 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table

A.10.1.2 Configuring Clock Subnets


For simple networks, such as chain networks, configure the clock source protection or only
configure the clock priority to implement the clock source protection. For complex networks,
such as ring networks or intersecting and tangent rings that are derived from ring networks,
configure clock subnets and enable the standard SSM protocol or extended SSM protocol to
implement the clock source protection.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The priority list of the clock source must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.
Step 2 Click the Clock Subnet tab.
Step 3 Start the clock protection protocol and configure its parameters.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1279

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.3 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Subnet

A.10.1.3 User-Defined Clock Quality


By default, the NE considers the clock quality extracted from the clock source as the clock
quality. If the clock quality is zero (the synchronization quality is unknown), the clock is
considered as unavailable clock. In the case of any special requirements, the user can define the
clock quality for which the source clock quality and clock quality are zero.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The priority level of a clock source must be set.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.
Step 2 Click the Received Quality tab.
Step 3 Click the Clock Source Quality tab.
Step 4 Set the user-defined clock quality.

NOTE

Generally, it is recommended that you use the default value.

Step 5 Click Apply.


Step 6 Click the Manual Setting of 0 Quality Level tab.
Step 7 Set the clock quality for which the quality level is zero.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1280

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

Generally, it is recommended that you use the default value.

Step 8 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.4 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Quality

A.10.1.4 Configuring the SSM Output Status


After the standard SSM protocol or extended synchronization status message (SSM) protocol is
enabled, the NE transmits the SSM to other NEs through the SDH radio link or optical line by
default. To prevent two clock subnets from affecting each other, the NE needs to forbid the SSM
bytes from being transmitted on the link that is connected to other clock subnets.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The priority level of a clock source must be set.

The standard SSM or extended SSM protocol is enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.
Step 2 Click the SSM Output tab.
Step 3 Set the SSM control status.

NOTE

l Output S1 Byte Info is valid only when the SSM protocol or the extended SSM protocol is started.
l Output S1 Byte Info indicates whether the SSM is output at the line port.
l When the line port is connected to an NE in the same clock subnet, set Output S1 Byte Info to Enabled.
Otherwise, set this parameter to Disabled.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.5 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_SSM Output Control
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1281

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.10.1.5 Configuring the Clock ID Output Status


After the extended synchronization status message (SSM) protocol is enabled, the NE transmits
the clock ID to other NEs through the radio link or optical line by default. To prevent two clock
subnets from affecting each other, the NE needs to forbid the clock ID from being transmitted
on the link that is connected to other clock subnets.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The priority level of a clock source must be set.

The extended SSM protocol must be enabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.
Step 2 Click the Clock ID Output tab.
Step 3 Set the clock ID control status.

NOTE

l Output Clock ID is valid only when the extended SSM protocol is started.
l Output Clock ID indicates whether the clock source ID is output at the line port.
l If the line ports are connected to the NEs in the same clock subnet and if the extended SSM protocol is
started on the opposite NE, Output Clock ID is set to Enabled. Otherwise, this parameter is set to
Disabled.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.6 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_Clock ID Enabling Status

A.10.1.6 Modifying the Parameters of the Clock Output


The NE outputs the 2-Mbit/s external clock regardless of the clock quality.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1282

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Phase-Locked Source Output by External Clock.
Step 2 Modify the parameters of the clock output.
Step 3 Click Apply.
----End

Related References
B.10.1.10 Parameter Description: Output Phase-Locked Source of the External Clock Source

A.10.1.7 Configuring Clock Sources for External Clock Output


By default, the OptiX RTN 980 allows output of the system clock source through the external
clock port. If the external clock port needs to transmit other clock sources, such as a clock from
a radio link or a synchronous Ethernet clock, you need to configure the priority table for the PLL
clock source of the external port.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose Configuration >
Clock > Physical Clock > Clock Source Priority from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Priority for PLL Clock Sources of 1st External Output tab.
Step 3 Click Create.
The Add Clock Source dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Configure the clock sources for external clock output based on network planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1283

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

TIP

To select more than one clock source at a time, press and hold the Ctrl key when selecting the clock sources.
NOTE

l When the PLL clock source of the external clock port extracts the system clock (namely, the local clock of
the NE), Clock Source takes its default value Internal Clock Source. In this case, no manual configuration
is required.
l When the PLL clock source of the external clock port needs to extract the clock from an SDH line board,
clock from a radio link, clock from a PDH tributary board, or synchronous Ethernet clock, set Clock
Source to the corresponding clock source according to the network planning information.

Step 5 Click OK.


Step 6 Select Internal Clock Source and click Delete.

----End

Related References
B.10.1.2 Parameter Description: Priority Table for the PLL Clock Source of the External Clock
Port

A.10.1.8 Changing the Conditions for Clock Source Switching


You can change the default conditions for clock source switching of the NE for special purposes.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Source Switching.
Step 2 Click the Clock Source Switching Condition tab.
Step 3 Change the conditions for clock source switching.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.9 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching Conditions
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1284

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.10.1.9 Modifying the Recovery Parameter of the Clock Source


In the case of the special requirements, you can modify the recovery parameter of the clock
source.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Source Switching.
Step 2 Click the Clock Source Reversion tab.
Step 3 Set the recovery parameter of the clock source.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.10.1.7 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Restoration Parameters

A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status


You can know the current clock synchronization status of an NE by querying the clock
synchronization status.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Synchronization Status.
Step 2 Click Query.
Step 3 Query the clock synchronization status.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1285

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.10.1.11 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status

A.10.2 Managing CES ACR Clocks


CES ACR refers to a function that uses the adaptive clock recovery (ACR) technology to recover
clock synchronization information carried by CES packets.

A.10.2.1 Configuring the Primary Clock for an ACR Clock Domain


An ACR clock domain can use the clock extracted from a CES service as its primary clock.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

CES services are configured.

Precautions

CAUTION
l An ACR clock domain can bind only the CES services from the E1 ports on a local board.
l On the MD1 board, the four ACR clock domains can bind the CES services either from the
former 16 E1 ports or from the latter 16 E1 ports on a local board. That is, the four ACR
clock domains cannot simultaneously bind the CES services from the former 16 E1 ports and
from the latter 16 E1 ports on a local board.
l A maximum of four ACR clock domains can bind CES services.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Clock > ACR Clock from the Function Tree.
Step 2 In CES Service, select an CES service for primary clock extraction.

Step 3 Click Apply. Then, close the dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1286

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.10.2.1 Parameter Description: ACR Clock Source

A.10.2.2 Configuring Ports Using the Clock Domain


An CES E1 port can transmit the clock information in the system clock domain or CES ACR
clock domain.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

CES services are configured.

Precautions

CAUTION
l E1 ports output clocks from the system clock domain by default. Therefore, it is unnecessary
to set application ports to the system clock domain if system clocks are to be used.
l An ACR clock domain can only be applied to the E1 ports on a local board.
l The E1 ports corresponding to the primary clock for an ACR clock domain must be added
to the ACR clock domain.
l On the MD1 board, the four ACR clock domains can bind the CES services either from the
former 16 E1 ports or from the latter 16 E1 ports on a local board. That is, the four ACR
clock domains cannot simultaneously bind the CES services from the former 16 E1 ports and
from the latter 16 E1 ports on a local board.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Clock > Clock Domain from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click New.
The Create Clock Domain Port dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1287

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Select Clock Domain.


Step 4 In Clock Domain Board, select the board where the ACR clock domain resides.
Step 5 Set the application ports to the ACR clock domain.
1.

In Board, select a board that uses the ACR clock domain.

2.

In Available Port, select a port that transmits CES services.

3.

Click

Step 6 Click OK.


----End

Related References
B.10.2.3 Parameter Description: Clock Domain_Creation

A.11 Using the RMON


Remote monitoring (RMON) is mainly used to monitor the data traffic on a network segment
or on the entire network. Currently, it is one of the widely used network management standards.

A.11.1 Browsing the Performance Data in the Statistics Group of a


Port
After you configure an RMON statistics group for an port, you can browse the real-time statistical
performance data of the port.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding board must be added in the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1288

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, navigate to the performance query interfaces for different objects according
to the following tables.
Table A-1 Packet plane
Performa
nce
Object

Obrowse
Object

Navigation Path

Basic
performan
ce

Ethernet
porta

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE


Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
Function Tree.

MPLS
Tunnel

1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object


Tree and choose Configuration > MPLS Management >
Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.

Extended
performan
ce
MPLS
tunnel
performan
ce

2. Click the Static Tunnel tab.


3. Select one or more tunnels, right-click the tunnel(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPNPW
performan
ce

ETH
PWE3
service

L2 VPN
performan
ce

UNI-UNI
E-Line
service

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose


Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more ETH PWE3 services, right-click the service
(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.
1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more UNI-UNI E-Line services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

CES-PW
performan
ce
CES
performan
ce

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CES
service

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and


choose Configuration > CES Service Management from the
Function Tree.
2. Select one or more CES services, right-click the service(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1289

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Performa
nce
Object

Obrowse
Object

Navigation Path

ATM/IMA
(access
side)
performan
ce

Smart E1
port

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE


Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
Function Tree.

ATM-PW
performan
ce

ATM
PWE3
service

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and


choose Configuration > ATM Service Management from
the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more ATM PWE3 services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

ATM
PWE3
performan
ce

Step 2 Click the Statistics Group tab.


Step 3 Set the required parameters for the statistics group.
1.

Select the desired object or port from the drop-down list.

2.

Select the performance items for which statistics need to be collected.

3.

Set Sampling Interval.


Sampling Interval represents the time unit of the performance statistics.

Step 4 Click Resetting begins.


NOTE

If you click Start, the register of the statistics group is not reset to clear the existing data.

----End

Related References
B.8.1 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_Statistics Group

A.11.2 Configuring an Alarm Group for a Port


After you configure an RMON alarm group for a port, you can monitor whether the performance
value of the port crosses the configured thresholds in the long term.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding boards must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1290

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, navigate to the performance query interfaces for different objects according
to the following tables.
Table A-2 Packet plane
Performa
nce
Object

Obrowse
Object

Navigation Path

Basic
performan
ce

Ethernet
porta

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE


Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
Function Tree.

MPLS
Tunnel

1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object


Tree and choose Configuration > MPLS Management >
Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.

Extended
performan
ce
MPLS
tunnel
performan
ce

2. Click the Static Tunnel tab.


3. Select one or more tunnels, right-click the tunnel(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPNPW
performan
ce

ETH
PWE3
service

L2 VPN
performan
ce

UNI-UNI
E-Line
service

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose


Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more ETH PWE3 services, right-click the service
(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.
1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more UNI-UNI E-Line services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

CES-PW
performan
ce

CES
service

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and


choose Configuration > CES Service Management from the
Function Tree.
2. Select one or more CES services, right-click the service(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

Smart E1
port

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE


Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
Function Tree.

CES
performan
ce
ATM/IMA
(access
side)
performan
ce

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1291

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Performa
nce
Object

Obrowse
Object

Navigation Path

ATM-PW
performan
ce

ATM
PWE3
service

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and


choose Configuration > ATM Service Management from
the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more ATM PWE3 services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

ATM
PWE3
performan
ce

Step 2 Click the RMON Setting tab.


Step 3 Click the Object tab and set the corresponding parameters.
Step 4 Click the Event tab and set the corresponding parameters.
Step 5 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End

Related References
B.8.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting

A.11.3 Configuring a Historical Control Group


When configuring a historical control group for an Ethernet port, you can configure how the
historical performance data of the port is monitored. The Ethernet board monitors the historical
performance data of each port at the default sampling interval of 30 minutes. A maximum of 50
historical performance entries can be saved.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding boards must be added in the NE Panel.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON History
Control Group.
Step 2 Set the parameters of the historical control group.
Step 3 Click Apply. Close the displayed dialog box.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1292

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.8.3 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Control Group

A.11.4 Browsing the Performance Data in the Historical Group of a


Port
After you configure an RMON historical group for a port, you can browse the historical
performance data of the port.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The corresponding boards must be added in the NE Panel.

The objects and performance events to be monitored must be set.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, navigate to the performance query interfaces for different objects according
to the following tables.
Table A-3 Packet plane
Performa
nce
Object

Obrowse
Object

Navigation Path

Basic
performan
ce

Ethernet
porta

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE


Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
Function Tree.

MPLS
Tunnel

1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object


Tree and choose Configuration > MPLS Management >
Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function Tree.

Extended
performan
ce
MPLS
tunnel
performan
ce

2. Click the Static Tunnel tab.


3. Select one or more tunnels, right-click the tunnel(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

L2 VPNPW
performan
ce

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

ETH
PWE3
service

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose


Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more ETH PWE3 services, right-click the service
(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1293

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Performa
nce
Object

Obrowse
Object

Navigation Path

L2 VPN
performan
ce

UNI-UNI
E-Line
service

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose


Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-Line
Service from the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more UNI-UNI E-Line services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

CES
service

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and


choose Configuration > CES Service Management from the
Function Tree.
2. Select one or more CES services, right-click the service(s), and
choose Browse Performance from the shortcut menu.

ATM/IMA
(access
side)
performan
ce

Smart E1
port

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE


Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON Performance from the
Function Tree.

ATM-PW
performan
ce

ATM
PWE3
service

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and


choose Configuration > ATM Service Management from
the Function Tree.
2. Select one or more ATM PWE3 services, right-click the
service(s), and choose Browse Performance from the shortcut
menu.

CES-PW
performan
ce
CES
performan
ce

ATM
PWE3
performan
ce

Step 2 Click the History Group tab.


Step 3 Set the parameters of the historical group.
1.

Select the desired object or port from the drop-down list.

2.

Click and specify the required time span.

3.

Select the performance items to browse.

4.

Under History Table Type, set the time span for the performance items to be browsed.

Step 4 Click Query.


----End

Related References
B.8.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1294

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.12 Configuring Auxiliary Ports and Functions


The auxiliary ports and functions supported by the OptiX RTN 980 include the orderwire,
synchronous data service, asynchronous data service, wayside E1 service, external alarm.

A.12.1 Configuring Orderwire


The orderwire for an NE provides a dedicated communication channel that the network
maintenance personnel can use.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Orderwire
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the General tab.
Step 3 Configure the orderwire information.

Step 4 Click Apply.


Step 5 Optional: Change the overhead bytes occupied by the orderwire.
1.

Click the Advanced tab.

2.

Configure Orderwire Occupied Bytes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1295

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

Click Apply.

----End

Related References
B.11.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General
B.11.2 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Advanced

A.12.2 Configuring the Synchronous Data Service


The OptiX RTN 980 supports the transmission of a channel of 64-kbit/s synchronous data service
through a user-defined byte in the microwave frame or the F1 overhead byte in the STM-N
frame. Such a service is also called F1 data port service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The board involved in the synchronous data service must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Orderwire
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the F1 Data Port tab.
Step 3 Hold on the Ctrl key, select two data channels from Available Data Path, and then click
.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1296

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.11.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port

A.12.3 Configuring the Asynchronous Data Service


The OptiX RTN 980 supports the transmission of a channel of asynchronous data service with
a maximum rate of 64 kbit/s through a user-defined byte in the microwave frame or any byte
within the range of SERIAL1-SERIAL4 in the STM-N frame. Such a service is also called
broadcast data port service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The board involved in the asynchronous data service must be configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Orderwire
from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the Broadcast Data Port tab.
Step 3 Configure the parameters of the broadcast data port.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1297

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Related References
B.11.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port

A.12.4 Configuring the Wayside E1 Service


The OptiX RTN 980 supports the transmission of a channel of 2.048-Mbit/s wayside E1 service
through 32 user-defined bytes in the SDH microwave frame.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The IF1 board must be added on the NE Panel.

The DCC channels corresponding to external clocks must be disabled.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
The wayside E1 service can be supported by the IF1 board in the 7,STM-1,28MHz,128QAM
mode.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.
Step 2 Click the IF Attributes tab.
Step 3 Configure the enable status of the wayside E1 service and set the slot that houses the board.

Step 4 Click Apply.


----End

Related References
B.5.5.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

A.12.5 Configure External Alarms


After the outputting of external alarms is configured, the alarm information of the OptiX RTN
980 can be output to other equipment. After the inputting of external alarms is configured, the
alarm information of other equipment can be input to the OptiX RTN 980.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

The AUX board must be added on the NE Panel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1298

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Context
The external alarms of the OptiX RTN 980 are also considered as housekeeping alarms. The
external alarm port of the OptiX RTN 980 is a relay port. This port can be either in the "on" state
or in the "off" state.
The OptiX RTN 980 provides two alarm output ports and four alarm input ports. The alarm input
ports report the RELAY_ALARM alarm (the alarm parameter indicates the port number of the
input alarm) after the external alarm is triggered. To ensure that the external alarm port works
normally, the external alarm cables must be correctly connected.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the AUX board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Environment Monitor Configuration > Environment Monitor Interface from the Function
Tree.
Step 2 Configure the input alarm.
1.

Select Input Relay from the drop-down list.

2.

Configure the parameters of the input alarm.

3.

Click Apply, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.

Step 3 Configure the output alarm.


1.

Select Output Relay from the drop-down list.

2.

Configure the parameters of the output alarm.

3.

Click Apply, and then close the dialog box that is displayed.

----End

Related References
B.11.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface

A.13 End-to-End Configuration Task Collection


End-to-end configuration is simpler than per-NE configuration.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1299

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Note
This topic describes only common end-to-end configuration operations on the OptiX RTN
980. For more details, see the U2000 Online Help.

A.13.1 Configuring E-Line Services (Native Ethernet) in an End-toEnd Mode


The U2000 allows E-Line services transmitted in Native Ethernet mode to be configured in an
end-to-end mode.

A.13.1.1 Searching for E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode


By searching for E-Line services transmitted in Native Ethernet mode, you can synchronize the
E-Line service configuration data from the NE layer of the U2000 to the network layer of the
U2000.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

E-Line services have been correctly configured.

The configuration data on the U2000 side is the same as the configuration data on the NE
side.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Native Ethernet Service > Search for E-Line Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Perform settings to search for E-Line services by customer name.
1.

.
Click
The Search dialog box is displayed.

2.

Click Search. Select Customer Name and OK.


The selected customer name is displayed in Customer.

Step 3 Click Start.


The E-Line services that have been found by Customer Name are displayed in Search
Result.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1300

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Optional: Select an E-Line service and click Jump Service to navigate to windows for
configuring related service query and maintenance operations.
----End

A.13.1.2 Creating E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode


This section describes how to create E-Line services (Native Ethernet) in an end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Port attributes have been correctly configured for each board on an NE.

Fibers/Cables for Ethernet links between NEs have been created on the main topology.

The configuration data on the U2000 side is the same as the configuration data on the NE
side.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Native Ethernet Service > Create E-Line Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Set the basic attributes of the E-Line service.
Set related parameters as follows:
l Service Name: Set this parameter according to the service planning information or customer
conventions. Unless otherwise specified, this parameter can take the value that the system
automatically assigns.
l BPDU Private Service: No
l Customer: Click
. In the Search dialog box that is displayed, create a customer name
or select the desired customer name from existing ones.
l Remarks: Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1301

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure the source and sink of the E-Line service.


1.

Double-click the source NE in the Physical Topology tab page.


The Select Source dialog box is displayed.

2.

Select the source board and source port.

3.

Set C-VLAN and S-VLAN for the service source according to the planning rules listed in
Table A-4.
Table A-4 E-Line service types
Service Type

C-VLAN

S-VLAN

Point-to-point transparently transmitted ELine service

Blank

Blank

VLAN-based E-Line service

Set C-VLAN
according to service
planning
information.

Blank

QinQ-based E-Line
service

The source port is a


UNI port and the
service is a PORTbased flow.

Blank

Blank

The source port is a


UNI port and the
service is a PORT
+C-VLAN-based
flow.

Set C-VLAN
according to
planning
information.

Blank

The source port is


an NNI port.

Blank

Set S-VLAN
according to
planning
information.

4.

Click OK.

5.

Refer to Step 3 and configure the service sink of the E-Line service.

Step 4 Optional: Select Deploy.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1302

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click Calculate Route.


The created routes are displayed in Physical Topology

NOTE

If correct routes have not been configured on the U2000, perform Step 6 and then click Calculate Route.

Step 6 Optional: Configure the explicit nodes for the E-Line service.
1.

Click Add.
The Select NE dialog box is displayed.

2.

Select the desired NE from the NE list on the left pane and click

3.

Click OK.

4.

In Explicit Node, set Interface.

Step 7 Optional: In Node List, set Out C-VLAN and Out S-VLAN for the source NE and set In CVLAN and In S-VLAN for the sink NE, based on the service type listed in Table A-5.
Table A-5 E-Line service types
Service Type

Out C-VLAN

Out S-VLAN

Point-to-point transparently transmitted ELine service

Blank

Blank

VLAN-based E-Line
service

VLAN ID swapping
is not performed over
Out Interface.

Blank

Blank

VLAN ID swapping
is performed over
Out Interface.

Set C-VLAN
according to service
planning
information.

Blank

Out Interface is a
UNI port and the
service is a PORTbased flow.

Blank

Blank

QinQ-based E-Line
service

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1303

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Service Type

Out C-VLAN

Out S-VLAN

Out Interface is a
UNI port and the
service is a PORT
+C-VLAN-based
flow.

Set C-VLAN
according to service
planning
information.

Blank

Out Interface is an
NNI port.

Blank

Set S-VLAN
according to service
planning
information.

Step 8 Click OK.


----End

A.13.1.3 Managing E-Line Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode


This section describes how to perform management and maintenance operations, such as
querying information about E-Line services transmitted in Native Ethernet mode and deploying/
deleting E-Line services.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Native Ethernet Service > Manage E-Line Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The E-Line services that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Optional: Select the desired E-Line service from the query result, and view information in the
Topology and Interface Information tab pages.
Step 4 Optional: Select the desired E-Line service from the query result, click functional buttons under
the query result or right-click the service and choose options from the shortcut menu to perform
related maintenance operations.
----End

A.13.1.4 Managing Discrete Services Transmitted in Native Ethernet Mode


Discrete services transmitted in Native Ethernet mode are services that are transmitted in Native
Ethernet mode, but cannot become network-layer services and exist only on isolated NEs.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1304

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Native Ethernet Service > Manage E-Line Discrete Service from the Main
Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The E-Line services that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
----End

A.13.2 Searching for MPLS Tunnels and PWE3 Services


This section describes how to synchronize the configuration data of MPLS tunnels and PWE3
services from the NE layer of the U2000 to the network layer of the U2000.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

MPLS tunnels and PWE3 services have been correctly configured for NEs.

The configuration data on the U2000 side is the same as the configuration data on the NE
side.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Search for IP Service from the Main Menu.
The Search for IP Service dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Set the search domain.
1.

Select Select NE and click Add.


The Select NE dialog box is displayed.

2.

Select the desired NE and click OK.


The NEs are displayed in the NE list.

Step 3 Configure the service type to search for.


1.

In the service list on the left, select one or more service types.
The OptiX RTN 980 only supports Tunnel and PWE3.

2.

Optional: In the Tunnel and PWE3 tab pages, set the search criteria.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1305

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click Start.


The U2000 searches its NE-layer configuration data based on the search range and service type.

Step 5 Click the Add Service, Modify Service, and Discrete Service tabs to view the found services.
l Add Service refers to a service that is not in the configuration data at the network layer of
the U2000.
l Modify Service refers to a service that is in the configuration data at the network layer of
the U2000 but some service parameters differ between the network layer and the NE layer
of the U2000. For MPLS tunnels, the U2000 does not support the search of modified services.
l Discrete Service refers to a service that is only in the configuration data at the NE layer of
the U2000.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1306

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Optional: Select a service and click Jump Service to start related service query and maintenance
operations.
----End

Follow-up Procedure
l

Follow the instructions in A.13.3.6 Managing MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode


to query and maintain the found MPLS tunnels.

Follow the instructions in A.13.4.9 Managing and Maintaining PWE3 Services to query
and maintain the found PWE3 services.

Follow the instructions in A.13.3.7 Managing Discrete MPLS Tunnels to query and
maintain the found discrete MPLS tunnels.

Follow the instructions in A.13.4.10 Managing Discrete PWE3 Services to query and
maintain the found discrete PWE3 services.

A.13.3 Configuring MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode


Configuring MPLS tunnels in an end-to-end mode is the prerequisite for configuring PWE3
services.

A.13.3.1 Configuring Port IP Address Resources


Configuring port IP address resources is the prerequisite for IP addresses to be automatically
allocated for MPLS ports.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Context
l

IP addresses cannot be automatically allocated to some MPLS ports, such as ports on


Integrated IP radio links, on non-point-to-point FE/GE links, or on MPLS links where the
NEs at both ends are unreachable on the NMS. Therefore, do not configure IP addresses
for these ports as the IP address resources for automatic allocation.

If the IP addresses to be configured are discontinuous, many IP address resources can be


configured.

The IP address resources should not contain IP addresses in the 192.168.0.0/16 network
segment, 192.169.0.0/16 network segment, or the network segments to which LSR IDs and
NE IP addresses belong.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > Port IP Address Management from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Click Add Row.
Step 3 Configure port IP address resources.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1307

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Click OK.


A confirmation dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Click OK. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.
----End

A.13.3.2 Creating L2 Links


Creating L2 links between MPLS ports is the prerequisite for using the automatic route
computation function to create MPLS tunnels.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Inventory > Link Management from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Click New.
The system displays the Create Link dialog box.
Step 3 Click New.
Step 4 Set Source NE, Source Port, Sink NE, and Sink Port for the L2 link.

Step 5 Click Apply. Then, close the operation result dialog box that is displayed.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1308

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Follow-up Procedure
If alarms are reported on the created L2 link, verify the following items.
l

Fibers/cables are correctly connected.

The port IP addresses at both ends of the L2 link are in the same network segment.

A.13.3.3 Creating Non-Protection MPLS Tunnels (in an End-to-End Mode)


This section describes how to create non-protection MPLS tunnels in end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The basic attributes of the MPLS nodes have been correctly configured.

Parameters related to MPLS ports have been correctly configured.

Links between MPLS nodes are proper.

Ingress nodes and egress nodes can be managed on the U2000.

If any ingress node or egress node cannot be managed on the U2000, create MPLS tunnels
when creating PWE3 services.

It is recommended that you use the automatic route computation function to create MPLS
tunnels. Before you use the automatic route computation function, ensure that L2 links have
been created between MPLS nodes.

Context

Precautions
In each step, two snapshots are provided. The first one shows how to create bidirectional tunnels,
whereas the second one shows how to create unidirectional tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Create Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Set attributes for MPLS tunnels.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
l Tunnel Name: Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value, which is
automatically generated by the U2000 according to the naming rules.
l Protocol Type: MPLS
l Signaling Type: Static CR
l Service Direction: Set this parameter to Bidirectional with priority. On MPLS nodes that
only support unidirectional tunnels, you need to set this parameter to Unidirectional.
l Create Reverse Tunnel: During the creation of unidirectional tunnels, if routes for forward
tunnels and backward tunnels are the same, you can configure forward and backward tunnels
synchronously.
l Protection Type: Protection-Free
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1309

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure on the nodes at both ends of an MPLS tunnel.


1.

Click Add > NE.

2.

In the Select NE dialog box that is displayed, select one or more NEs, and click

3.

Click OK.

4.

Double-click NE Role to set an NE node type.

Step 4 Optional: Configure a route for the tunnel using the automatic route computation function.
1.

Select Auto-Calculate route.

2.

Optional: Set Restriction Bandwidth(kbit/s) to No Limit.


To use the CES CAC verification function or to restrict the PW bandwidth, you need to set
this parameter according to the planned tunnel bandwidth.

3.

Double-click the ingress NE, and then the egress NE in the Physical Topology tab page
on the right.
The U2000 will compute a tunnel between the ingress NE and the egress NE, and display
the tunnel in the Physical Topology tab page.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1310

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

If the computed route is not the desired one, right-click the explicit or excluded NE in the
Physical Topology tab page, and set restrictions from the shortcut menu.

Step 5 Optional: Manually specify a route for a tunnel.


1.

Do not select Auto-Calculate route.

2.

Optional: Set Restriction Bandwidth(kbit/s).


It is recommended that this parameter takes its default value, No Limit. To use the CES
CAC verification function or to restrict the PW bandwidth, you need to set this parameter
according to the planned tunnel bandwidth.

3.

In the Physical Topology tab page on the right, double-click the ingress NE, egress NE,
and the transit NEs between them one by one.
A tunnel route will be generated on the U2000 and displayed in the Physical Topology tab
page.

NOTE

The NEs marked by

4.

are ingress NEs, and the NEs marked by

are egress NEs.

If the generated route is not the desired one, you can modify it in the NE lists on the left.

Step 6 Click Details, and configure related parameters on the tabs on the right.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
l Tunnel ID: Set the parameter according to the network planning information. If the
parameter value is not specified in the planning information and the entire network is
managed by the U2000, the U2000 automatically allocates tunnel IDs.
l LSP Type and EXP: Unless otherwise specified, the two parameters take their default values.
l In Interface, Out Interface, Next Hop, and Reverse Next Hop: When the automatic route
computation function is used, these parameters are automatically configured by the U2000.
When the route is computed manually, set these parameters according to the route planning
information.
l Incoming Label, Reverse Incoming Label, Outgoing Label, and Reverse Outgoing
Label: Set these parameters according to the network planning information. If the parameter
values are not specified in the planning information and the entire network is managed by
the U2000, the U2000 automatically allocates these labels.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1311

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 7 Choose Deploy and then Enable.


l After Deploy is selected, the tunnel configuration data is saved on the U2000 side and
deployed to the NE side. Otherwise, the service configuration data is saved on the U2000
side but is not deployed to the NE side.
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports only enabling tunnels.
Step 8 Click OK.
Step 9 In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select View Tunnel.
The created tunnels are listed in the tunnel list.
----End

Follow-up Procedure
Follow the instructions in A.13.3.6 Managing MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode to
query and maintain the created MPLS tunnels.

A.13.3.4 Creating MPLS Tunnels Configured with MPLS APS Protection in an Endto-End Mode
This section describes how to create MPLS tunnels configured with MPLS APS protection in
an end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1312

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The basic attributes of the MPLS nodes have been correctly configured.

Parameters related to MPLS ports have been correctly configured.

Links between MPLS nodes are proper.

Ingress nodes and egress nodes can be managed on the U2000.

If any ingress node or egress node cannot be managed on the U2000, create MPLS tunnels
when creating PWE3 services.

It is recommended that you use the automatic route computation function to create MPLS
tunnels. Before you use the automatic route computation function, ensure that L2 links have
been created between MPLS nodes.

Context

Precautions
In each step, two snapshots are provided. The first one shows how to create bidirectional tunnels,
whereas the second one shows how to create unidirectional tunnels.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Create Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Set attributes for MPLS tunnels.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
l Tunnel Name: Unless otherwise specified, this parameter takes its default value, which is
automatically generated by the U2000 according to the naming rules.
l Protocol Type: MPLS
l Signaling Type: Static CR
l Service Direction: Set this parameter to Bidirectional with priority. On MPLS nodes that
only support unidirectional tunnels, you need to set this parameter to Unidirectional.
l Create Reverse Tunnel: During the creation of unidirectional tunnels, if routes for forward
tunnels and backward tunnels are the same, you can configure forward and backward tunnels
synchronously.
l Protection Type: 1:1
l Switching Mode: Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that you set this parameter
to Double-Ended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1313

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure on the nodes at both ends of an MPLS tunnel.


1.

Click Add > NE.

2.

In the Select NE dialog box that is displayed, select one or more NEs, and click

3.

Click OK.

4.

Double-click NE Role to set an NE node type.

Step 4 Optional: Configure a route for the tunnel using the automatic route computation function.
1.

Select Auto-Calculate route.

2.

Optional: Set Restriction Bandwidth(kbit/s) to No Limit.


To use the CES CAC verification function or to restrict the PW bandwidth, you need to set
this parameter according to the planned tunnel bandwidth.

3.

Double-click the ingress NE, and then the egress NE in the Physical Topology tab page
on the right.
The U2000 will automatically computes a working tunnel and a protection tunnel between
the ingress NE and the egress NE, and display the tunnels in the Physical Topology tab
page.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1314

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

If the computed working or protection route is not the desired one, you can right-click the
explicit or excluded NE in the Physical Topology tab page, and set restrictions in the dialog
box displayed.

Step 5 Optional: Manually specify a route for a tunnel.


1.

Do not select Auto-Calculate route.

2.

Optional: Set Restriction Bandwidth(kbit/s).


It is recommended that this parameter takes its default value, No Limit. To use the CES
CAC verification function or to restrict the PW bandwidth, you need to set this parameter
according to the planned tunnel bandwidth.

3.

In the Physical Topology tab page on the right, double-click the ingress NE, egress NE,
and the transit NEs between them one by one.
A tunnel route will be generated on the U2000 and displayed in the Physical Topology tab
page.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1315

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

The NEs marked by

4.

are ingress NEs, and the NEs marked by

are egress NEs.

If the generated route is not the desired one, you can modify it in the NE lists on the left.

Step 6 Set information about the tunnels and the MPLS OAM used for MPLS APS protection.
1.

Click Details.

2.

Set information about the working tunnel in the Working Tunnel or the Forward
Working Tunnel tab on the right.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
l Tunnel ID: Set the parameter according to the network planning information. If the
parameter values are not specified in the planning information and the entire network
is managed by the U2000, the U2000 automatically allocates tunnel IDs.
l LSP Type and EXP: Unless otherwise specified, the two parameters take their default
values.
l In Interface, Out Interface, Next Hop, and Reverse Next Hop: When the automatic
route computation function is used, these parameters are automatically configured by
the U2000. When the route is computed manually, set these parameters according to
the planned route information.
l Incoming Label, Reverse Incoming Label, Outgoing Label, and Reverse Outgoing
Label: Set these parameters according to the network planning information. If the
parameter values are not specified in the planning information and the entire network
is managed by the U2000, the U2000 automatically allocates these labels.

3.

Click Configure OAM. In the dialog box displayed, set OAM parameters and click OK.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
l Detection Packet Type: Set this parameter to FFD.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1316

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

l Detection Packet Period(ms): Set this parameter to 3.3 (in most cases). If the packet
transmitting delay jitter in an MPLS tunnel exceeds 3.3 ms, set the packet transmission
interval to a value greater than the delay.
l Other parameters: Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that the parameters
take their default value.

4.

Repeat steps Step 6.2 and Step 6.3, to set information about tunnels and OAM on the
Protection Tunnel tab, or the Reverse Working Tunnel, Forward Protection Tunnel,
and Reverse Protection Tunnel tabs.

Step 7 Click Configure Protection Group. In the dialog box displayed, set attributes about MPLS
APS protection groups and click OK.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1317

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

l Revertive Mode: Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that you set this parameter
to Revertive.
l Other parameters: Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that the parameters take
their default value.

Step 8 Choose Deploy and then Enable.


l After Deploy is selected, the tunnel configuration data is saved on the U2000 side and
deployed to the NE side. Otherwise, the service configuration data is saved on the U2000
side but is not deployed to the NE side.
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports only enabling tunnels.
Step 9 Click OK.
Step 10 In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select View Tunnel.
The created tunnels are listed in the tunnel list.
----End

Follow-up Procedure
l

Follow the instructions in A.13.3.6 Managing MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode


to query and maintain the created MPLS tunnels.

Follow the instructions in A.13.3.9 Managing MPLS APS Protection Groups in an Endto-End Mode to query and maintain the created MPLS APS protection groups.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1318

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.13.3.5 Verifying MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to verify that an MPLS tunnel is available using the LSP ping test
or LSP traceroute function.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

MPLS tunnels have already been deployed.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Manage Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The MPLS tunnels that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Right-click the tunnel to verify. Choose Test and Check from the shortcut menu.
TIP

You can select and verify several MPLS tunnels concurrently.

Step 4 Select LSP Ping or LSP Traceroute from Diagnosis Option.

Step 5 Optional: Click the


on the right and set parameters about the LSP ping/LSP traceroute
test in the dialog box that is displayed.
The values for the related parameters are provided as follows.
l Packet Size: Set this parameter according to requirements.
l Response Mode: Set this parameter to Application Control Channel if the tunnel is
bidirectional and its egress node supports reverse channel response. Set this parameter to
IPv4 UDP Response if the egress node does not support reverse channel response, but
support DCN channel response based on IP protocols. In other scenarios, set this parameter
to No Response.
l Other parameters: Other parameters take their default values.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1319

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Click Run.


Step 7 After the verification, query the verification result of each MPLS tunnel.
----End

A.13.3.6 Managing MPLS Tunnels in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to perform management and maintenance operations on MPLS
tunnels, such as querying tunnel information, running/deploying/deleting an MPLS tunnel, and
troubleshooting MPLS tunnels.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Manage Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The MPLS tunnels that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Optional: Select a desired tunnel, and browse the tunnel information in the Topology, Hop
Information, QoS Information, and Relevant Service tab pages at the bottom.
Step 4 Optional: Select the desired tunnels from the query result, click functional buttons under the
query result or right-click the service and choose options from the shortcut menu to perform
related maintenance operations.
----End

A.13.3.7 Managing Discrete MPLS Tunnels


This section describes how to query or delete discrete MPLS tunnels.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1320

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Manage Discrete Tunnel from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The discrete tunnels that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Optional: Select a discrete tunnel, and browse the tunnel information on the Hop
Information and QoS Information tabs at the bottom.
Step 4 Optional: Select the desired discrete tunnel from the query result, click the Delete button or
right-click the tunnel and choose Delete to delete the tunnel.
----End

A.13.3.8 Searching for MPLS APS Protection Groups


This section describes how to synchronize the MPLS APS protection group configuration data
from the NE layer of the U2000 to the network layer of the U2000.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

MPLS APS protection groups have been correctly configured.

The configuration data on the U2000 side is the same as the configuration data on the NE
side.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Search for Protection Group from the Main Menu.
The Searching for Protection Groups dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Set the search domain.
1.

Click Add.
The Equipment Selection dialog box is displayed.

2.

Set the NEs to search for and click OK.


The NEs are displayed in the NE list.

Step 3 Click OK.


----End

A.13.3.9 Managing MPLS APS Protection Groups in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to perform maintenance operations, such as how to query the
information about an MPLS APS protection group and how to run a command to trigger MPLS
APS switching.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1321

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Tunnel > Manage Protection Group from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The MPLS APS protection groups that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Optional: Select the desired MPLS APS protection group from the query result, right-click the
MPLS APS protection group and choose options from the shortcut menu or directly click
functional buttons under the query result to perform related maintenance operations.
----End

A.13.4 Configuring PWE3 Services in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to configure a PWE3 service based on a default or customized service
template, in an end-to-end mode.

A.13.4.1 Creating PWE3 Service Templates


This section describes how to customize service templates when the service templates provided
by the U2000 do not meet customer requirements.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Context
l

When a PWE3 service template is used for configuring a PWE3 service, the U2000 displays
the default service parameter values. If the OptiX RTN 980 does not support default
parameter values in the service template, the U2000 displays parameter values defaulted
to the OptiX RTN 980.

To configure a PWE3 service, you can use a default service template that is exported from
the U2000 or customize a service template by making related modifications to the exported
service template. This section describes how to customize a service template by making
related modifications to a default service template.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Service Template from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The templates that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Select the desired template and click Clone.
Step 4 In the Clone dialog box that is displayed, modify the template name and parameter values, and
select/deselect Set as Default Template.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1322

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

Parameters whose default values have been changed must be selected.

Step 5 Click OK.


----End

A.13.4.2 Configuring CES Services in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to configure CES services in an end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Parameters related to UNI ports have been configured correctly.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Set basic attributes of the CES services.
Set the parameters as follows:
l Service template: If no service template has been specified, set this parameter to
DEFAULT_PWE3_CES_PTN/ATN.
l Service Type: CES
l Protection Type: Protection-Free
l Service ID and Service Name: Unless otherwise specified, these two parameters take their
default values. The U2000 automatically generates the parameter values according to the
service naming rules.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1323

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PWE3 services.
1.

Double-click the source NE in the Physical Topology tab page.

2.

Select the service port on the source NE, configure its SAI information, and click OK.
l If mapping between source ports and sink ports is specified and the PWs connected by
the mapping source and sink ports are transmitted over the same tunnel, you can select
some or all the source ports and configure parameters for the source service ports at the
same time.
l For SAToP CES services, deselect Channeled.
l For CESoPSN CES services, select Channeled and set 64K TimeSlot.
NOTE

For PCM30 services, the 64K TimeSlot parameter values must contain 16.

3.

Repeat Step 3.1 and Step 3.2 to configure the service ports on the sink NE.

4.

Optional: In the Physical Topology tab page, right-click the S-PE and choose Set As
Switching Node > Working from the shortcut menu.
NOTE

To create an unterminated PWE3 service, of which the PE at one end is unreachable on the U2000, right-click
the service in the physical topology and choose corresponding options from the shortcut menu to create the
service source or sink (a virtual node).

Step 4 Set the basic attributes of the PW.


Set the parameters as follows:
l Forward Tunnel and Reverse Tunnel: If there are end-to-end working MPLS tunnels
between PEs, the U2000 automatically generates the parameter values. If the tunnels
generated by the U2000 are different from the planned tunnels, select correct tunnels if the
tunnels have already been created or create the desired tunnels.
l PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label: Set these parameters according to the service
planning information. If the parameter values are not specified in the service planning
information and the entire network is managed by the U2000, the U2000 automatically
allocates values for these parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1324

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

If these parameters need to be set according to planning information when multiple pairs of source and sink
ports have configured, you need to set the parameters separately for each pair of source and sink ports.

l Protection Type: Protection-Free


l Service ID and Service Name: Unless otherwise specified, these two parameters take their
default values. The U2000 automatically generates the parameter values according to the
service naming rules.

Step 5 Optional: Set the advanced attributes of the PW.


1.

Click Detail.

2.

In the Advanced PW Attribute tab page, set the advanced attributes of the PW.
Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that all parameters in the tab take their
default values.

Step 6 Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.


l After Deploy is selected, the tunnel configuration data is saved on the U2000 side and
deployed to the NE side. If you do not select Deploy, the service configuration data is saved
on the U2000 side but is not deployed to the NE side.
l The OptiX RTN 980 only supports enabling PWE3 services.

Step 7 Click OK.


Step 8 In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new CES service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

NOTE

If multiple pairs of source and sink service ports have been configured, you need to create a CES service for
each pair of the source and sink ports.

----End

Follow-up Procedure
Follow the instructions in A.13.4.9 Managing and Maintaining PWE3 Servicesto query and
maintain the created PWE3 services.

A.13.4.3 Configuring an ATM Policy Profile


This section describes how to configure a traffic management policy, which can be selected as
the traffic management profile for ATM services configured in an end-to-end mode.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1325

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > PTN QoS Profile > ATM Profile from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Right-click in ATM Profile and choose Add Global Profile from the shortcut menu.

The Create ATM Profile dialog box is displayed.


Step 3 Set the ATM policy profile according to network planning information so that it is available for
traffic management policy selection during ATM connection creation.

Step 4 Click OK.


Step 5 Optional: Check and manage the global ATM policy profile in the Details, NE Reference, and
NE Unreference tabs.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1326

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.13.4.4 Configuring an ATM CoS Mapping Profile


This section describes how to configure an ATM CoS mapping profile, which can be selected
as the ATM CoS mapping for ATM services configured in an end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > PTN QoS Profile > ATM CoS Mapping Profile from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Select appropriate steps based on the requirement.
If...

Then...

You need to change the default global ATM CoS mapping


profile

Perform Step 3 and Step 5.

You need to create a global ATM CoS mapping profile

Perform Step 6 and Step 8.

Step 3 Double-click the Default ATMCosMap profile.


The Modify ATM CoS Mapping Profile dialog box is displayed.
Step 4 Modify the global ATM CoS mapping profile according to network planning information.

NOTE

l Eight PHB service classes are available: BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The OptiX RTN
980 provides different QoS policies for the queues of different service classes.
l CS6 to CS7: highest service classes, mainly applicable to signaling transmission.
l EF: fast forwarding, applicable to services of low transmission delays and low packet loss rates.
l AF1 to AF4: assured forwarding, applicable to services that require an assured transmission rate rather than
delay or jitter limits.
NOTE

The AF1 class includes three subclasses: AF11, AF12, and AF13. Only one of these subclasses can take
effect for one queue. It is the same case with AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l BE: best effort, applicable to services that do not require special processing.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1327

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 Click OK.


Step 6 Right-click in ATM CoS Mapping Profile and choose Add Global Profile from the shortcut
menu.

The Create ATM CoS Mapping Profile dialog box is displayed.


Step 7 Create a global ATM CoS mapping profile according to network planning information.

NOTE

l Eight PHB service classes are available: BE, AF1, AF2, AF3, AF4, EF, CS6, and CS7. The OptiX RTN
980 provides different QoS policies for the queues of different service classes.
l CS6 to CS7: highest service classes, mainly applicable to signaling transmission.
l EF: fast forwarding, applicable to services of low transmission delays and low packet loss rates.
l AF1 to AF4: assured forwarding, applicable to services that require an assured transmission rate rather than
delay or jitter limits.
NOTE

The AF1 class includes three subclasses: AF11, AF12, and AF13. Only one of these subclasses can take
effect for one queue. It is the same case with AF2, AF3, and AF4.
l BE: best effort, applicable to services that do not require special processing.

Step 8 Click OK.


----End

A.13.4.5 Configuring ATM Services in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to configure ATM services in an end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1328

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Set the basic attributes for ATM services.
Set the parameters as follows:
l Service template: If no service template has been specified, it is recommended that you set
this parameter to DEFAULT_PWE3_ATM_PTN/ATN.
l Service Type: ATM
l Service ID and Service Name: Unless otherwise specified, these two parameters take their
default values. The U2000 automatically generates the parameter values according to the
service naming rules. An appropriate Service Name improves service maintainability in the
case of centralized management.
l Protection Type: Protection-Free

Step 3 Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the ATM service.
1.

Double-click the source NE in the Physical Topology tab page.

2.

Select the service port on the NE.

3.

Click OK.

4.

Repeat Step 3.1 and Step 3.3 to configure the service port on the sink NE.

5.

Optional: In the Physical Topology tab page, right-click the S-PE and choose Set As
Switching Node > Working from the shortcut menu.
NOTE

To create an unterminated PWE3 service, of which the PE at one end is unreachable on the U2000, right-click
the service in the physical topology and choose related options from the shortcut menu to create the service
source or sink (a virtual node).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1329

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 4 Optional: Set the basic attributes of the PW.


Set Forward Tunnel, Reverse Tunnel, PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label.
Step 5 Optional: Configure the QoS information of the PW.
1.

Click Detail.

2.

In the PW QoS tab page, configure the QoS information of the PW.
Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that all parameters in the tab take their
default values.

Step 6 Optional: Set the advanced attributes of the PW.


1.

Click Detail.

2.

In the Advanced PW Attribute tab page, set the advanced attributes of the PW.
Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that all parameters in the tab take their
default values.

Step 7 Configure ATM connections.


1.

Click ATM Link.


The Configure Link dialog box is displayed.

2.

Click Add Link.

3.

Set the ATM connection attributes according to network planning information.


NOTE

If multiple ATM connections have been planned, configure all the planned ATM connections.

4.

Click OK.

Step 8 Select Deploy and Enable at the lower left corner.


l After Deploy is selected, the tunnel configuration data is saved on the U2000 side and
deployed to the NE side. If you do not select Deploy, the service configuration data is saved
on the U2000 side but is not deployed to the NE side.
l For the OptiX RTN 980, generally only ATM PWE3 services are used. Therefore, always
select Enabled.

Step 9 Click OK.


Step 10 In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new ATM service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.
----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1330

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based E-Line Services (in an End-to-End Mode)


This section describes how to configure PW-based E-Line services in an end-to-end mode.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Parameters related to UNI ports have been configured correctly.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Create PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 Set the basic attributes of a PW-based E-Line service.
l Service template: If no service template has been specified, set this parameter to
DEFAULT_PWE3_ETH_PTN/ATN.
l Service Type: ETH
l Protection Type: Protection-Free
l Service ID and Service Name: Unless otherwise specified, these two parameters take their
default values. The U2000 automatically generates the parameter values according to the
service naming rules.

Step 3 Configure the NEs and service ports on the NEs that are involved in the PW-carried E-Line
service.
1.

Double-click the source NE in the Physical Topology tab page.

2.

Select the service port on the source NE, configure its VLAN ID, and click OK.
l Set VLAN ID to the VLAN ID planned for the Ethernet services over the UNI port.
l If you do not configure VLAN ID, Ethernet services exclusively occupy the UNI port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1331

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

Repeat Step 3.1 and Step 3.2 to configure the service port on the sink NE.
The information about the source and sink NEs is displayed in Node List.

4.

Optional: In the Physical Topology tab page, right-click the S-PE and choose Set As
Switching Node > Working from the shortcut menu.
NOTE

To create an unterminated PWE3 service, of which the PE at one end is unreachable on the U2000, right-click
the service in the physical topology and choose corresponding options from the shortcut menu to create the
service source or sink (a virtual node).

Step 4 Set the basic attributes of PWs.


Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1332

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

l Forward Tunnel and Reverse Tunnel: If there are end-to-end working MPLS tunnels
between PEs, the U2000 automatically generates the parameter values. If the tunnels
generated by the U2000 are different from the planned tunnels, select correct tunnels if the
tunnels have already been created or create the desired tunnels.
l PW ID, Forward Label, and Reverse Label: Set these parameters according to the service
planning information. If the parameter values are not specified in the service planning
information and the entire network is managed by the U2000, the U2000 automatically
allocates values for these parameters.

Step 5 Optional: Set the advanced attributes of PWs.


1.

Click Detail.

2.

In the PW QoS tab, configure QoS of the PWs.


Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that all parameters in the tab take their
default values.

3.

In the Advanced PW Attribute tab, set advanced attributes of the PWs.


l PW Type: This parameter specifies whether a P-TAG is added to the Ethernet frames
that are encapsulated to a PW. If a P-TAG does not need to be added to Ethernet frames
that are encapsulated to a PW, set this parameter to Ethernet. If a P-TAG needs to be
added to Ethernet frames that are encapsulated to a PW, set this parameter to Ethernet
Tagged Mode and set the desired Request VLAN.
l Control Word: Not in use
l Control Channel Type: This parameter specifies the PW connectivity detection mode.
Alert Label indicates that VCCV packets in Alert Label encapsulation mode are used
for PW connectivity detection. None indicates that VCCV is not used.

Step 6 At the lower left corner, select Deploy and Enable.


If you select Deploy, the service configuration data is saved on the U2000 side and deployed to
the NE side. If you do not select Deploy, the service configuration data is saved on the U2000
side but is not deployed to the NE side.
Step 7 Click OK.
Step 8 In the Operation Result dialog box that is displayed, select Browse Trail.
The new Ethernet PWE3 service is displayed in the PWE3 service list.

----End
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1333

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Follow-up Procedure
Query and verify the created Ethernet PWE3 service by referring to A.13.4.8 Verifying PWBased E-Line Service Configurations (in an End-to-End Mode).

A.13.4.7 Verifying PW Configurations in an End-to-End Mode


This section describes how to verify connectivity of a PW using the PW ping test or PW
traceroute function.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
The Set Filter Criteria dialog box is displayed.
Step 2 Click Filter.
NOTE

After you click Filter, all configured PWE3 services will be displayed.

Step 3 Right-click the PWE3 service to verify and choose Test And Check from the shortcut menu.

The Diagnosis Option tab page is displayed.


Step 4 Perform a PW service connectivity test.
If...

Then...

You perform a PW ping test

Perform Step 5 and Step 9.

You perform a PW traceroute test Perform Step 10 and Step 14.


Step 5 Select VCCV Ping from the Diagnosis Option list.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1334

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Step 6 Click

A Task Collection

on the right of VCCV Ping.

The VCCV ping dialog box is displayed.


Step 7 Set the connectivity test parameters.

Set the parameters as follows:


l Response Mode: Application Control Channel
l Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that other parameters take their default values.
Step 8 Click OK.
Step 9 Click Run.
Step 10 Select VCCV Traceroute from the Diagnosis Option list.

Step 11 Click
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

on the right of VCCV Traceroute.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1335

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The VCCV Traceroute dialog box is displayed.


Step 12 Set the connectivity test parameters.

Set the parameters as follows:


l Response Mode: Application Control Channel
l Unless otherwise specified, it is recommended that other parameters take their default values.
Step 13 Click OK.
Step 14 Click Run.
----End

A.13.4.8 Verifying PW-Based E-Line Service Configurations (in an End-to-End


Mode)
This section describes how to use Ethernet OAM to verify connectivity of a PW-based E-Line
service.

Prerequisite
l

You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

The A.13.4.6 Configuring PW-Based E-Line Services (in an End-to-End Mode) task
has been completed.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria window, select Source NE and Sink Node. Click Filter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1336

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 3 Right-click the PWE3 service to verify, and choose Ethernet OAM > LB Test... from the
shortcut menu.

Step 4 In the Eth Oam LB Test dialog box that is displayed, select the source NE for initiating an LB
test.
NOTE

l An LB test detects whether a service is bidirectionally available. For a bidirectional service, it is


recommended that you select either end of a PW as the source NE for initiating the LB test.
l If a PW carries Ethernet services from different VLANs, the U2000 automatically select the service
of a VLAN for the LB test.

Step 5 Optional: Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Configure... from
the shortcut menu. In the Config Eth Oam LB Test Parameter dialog box that is displayed,
set Sent Packets, Sent Packets Length, and Sent Packets Priority. Then, click OK.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1337

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 6 Right-click the service that is selected for an LB test, and choose Run from the shortcut menu.
Step 7 Click the LB Statistic Information tab and determines whether the service is available based
on the displayed information.
If Test Result displays Test Succeeded, the service is available.

If Packet Loss Ratio(%) displays 100 and Test Result displays Test Failed, the service is
unavailable. If the service is unavailable, check whether the service configurations are incorrect.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1338

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

----End

A.13.4.9 Managing and Maintaining PWE3 Services


This section describes how to perform management and maintenance operations, including
querying PWE3 service information, deploying or deleting a PWE3 service, and detecting PW
faults.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The PWE3 services that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Optional: Select a desired PWE3 service and browse the service information in the Topology,
SAI, Service Parameter, and PW tab pages at the bottom.
Step 4 Optional: Select the desired PWE3 service from the query result, click functional buttons under
the query result or right-click the service and choose options from the shortcut menu to perform
related maintenance operations.
----End

A.13.4.10 Managing Discrete PWE3 Services


This section describes how to query and delete discrete PWE3 services and how to convert
discrete PWE3 services to unterminated services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1339

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE administrator authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > PWE3 Service > Manage PWE3 Discrete Service from the Main Menu.
Step 2 In the Set Filter Criteria dialog box that is displayed, set filter conditions and click Filter.
The discrete PWE3 services that meet the criteria are listed in the query result.
Step 3 Optional: Select a desired discrete PWE3 service and browse the service information in the
SAI, Service Parameter, and PW tab pages at the bottom.
Step 4 Optional: Select the desired discrete PWE3 service from the query result, click Delete Discrete
Service, or right-click the service and choose Delete Discrete Service from the shortcut menu.
Step 5 Optional: Select the desired discrete PWE3 service from the query result, click Convert to
Unterminated, or right-click the service and choose Convert to Unterminated from the
shortcut menu.
----End

A.14 Verifying Services and Features


This topic describes how to verify service and feature configurations.

A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using PRBS


If no BER tester is available, you can test E1 services by using the PRBS test system embedded
in the equipment.

Prerequisite
l

The NE must be configured with E1 services, and the E1 services must be transmitted
through the DDF.

The communication between the NMS and the NE must be normal.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Precautions

CAUTION
l When a PRBS test is performed, the services carried on the tested path are interrupted.
l The PRBS test can be performed only in a unidirectional manner and on one path at a time.
l CES services do not support a PRBS test.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1340

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 On the NMS, perform an inloop for the corresponding E1 port at the remote site.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 2 At the central site, on the NMS, select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.
Step 3 In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PRBS Test.
Step 4 Select the first E1 port, and then set the following PRBS-related parameters:
l Direction: Cross
l Duration: a value from 120 to 180
l Measured in Time: seconds

Step 5 Click Start to Test.


The system displays a dialog box indicating The operation may interrupt the service, are you
sure to continue?
Step 6 Click OK.
Step 7 When the Progress column is 100%, click Query to check the test result.
The curve diagram should be green.
Step 8 Release the inloop set in Step 1.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1341

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The Confirm dialog box is displayed.


6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 9 Repeat Step 1 through Step 8 to test all other E1 ports.


----End

A.14.2 Testing E1 Services by Using a BER Tester


If a BER tester is available, the BER tester can be used to test E1 services.

Prerequisite
The NE must be configured with E1 services, and the E1 services must be transmitted through
the DDF.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

U2000

BER tester
NOTE

For a test of CES services in CESoPSN mode, a BER tester supporting Nx64 Kbit/s timeslot setting is
necessary.

Procedure
Step 1 On the DDF at the central site, connect the BER tester to the first E1 port of the IDU.
The BER tester indicates the AIS alarm.
Figure A-3 Connecting the BER tester
DDF
RX TX

RX

TX

.
..
.

1
2
3
4

BER tester

Step 2 On the NMS, perform an inloop for the corresponding E1 port at the remote site.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1342

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 3 Test the bit errors for two minutes.


There should be no bit errors.
NOTE

For a test of CES services, it is necessary to configure 64 Kbit/s timeslots on a BER tester to align with the
timeslots carrying CES services.

Step 4 Release the inloop set in Step 2.


1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 5 Repeat Step 1 through Step 4 to test all other E1 ports.


----End

A.14.3 Testing Ethernet Services


By testing Ethernet services, you can check whether the Ethernet services are available over
radio links. The Ethernet services can be tested using the ETH-OAM function. Therefore, no
tester is required.

Prerequisite
Ethernet services must be configured.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1343

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NOTE

l It is recommended that you test low-priority Ethernet services in good weather conditions when the AM
function works in the highest-efficiency modulation mode.
l The tested Ethernet services can be Native Ethernet services, EoS/EoPDH services, or Ethernet services
carried by PWs.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Test Connection Diagram


The following test procedure considers the Ethernet service from PORT2 on NE2 and PORT3
on NE3 to PORT1 on NE1 as an example, as shown in Figure A-4.The three Ethernet ports are
not on the EMS6/EFP8 boards.
Figure A-4 Networking diagram for testing Ethernet services
NE 2

PORT 2

VLAN ID=100
PORT 1

NE 1

NE 3

PORT 3

Microwave network
VLAN ID=200

The VLAN ID of the Ethernet service from NE2 to NE1 is 100, and the VLAN ID of the Ethernet
service from NE3 to NE1 is 200.
NOTE

If the Ethernet ports are on the EMS6/EFP8 boards, you can still perform the following steps to test the
Ethernet services by eliminating the need to set up the remote maintenance end point. In addition, the
operations on the NMS are different. For details, see A.8.9.1 Creating MDs, A.8.9.2 Creating MAs, A.
8.9.3 Creating MPs, and A.8.9.5 Performing an LB Test.

Procedure
Step 1 Configure the maintenance domains of NE1, NE2, and NE3.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Choose New > New Maintenance Domain.


The New Maintenance Domain dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure the parameters of the new maintenance domains.


l Maintenance Domain Name: MD1 for NE1, NE2, and NE3

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1344

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

l Maintenance Domain Level: 4 for NE1, NE2, and NE3


NOTE

The maintenance domain names and the maintenance domain levels of the NEs must be the same.

4.

Click OK to close the displayed dialog box.

Step 2 Configure the maintenance associations of NE1, NE2, and NE3.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the maintenance domain in which a maintenance association needs to be created.


Choose New > New Maintenance Association.
The New Maintenance Association dialog box is displayed.

3.

Configure the parameters of the new maintenance associations.


l Maintenance Association Name: MA1 for NE1, NE2, and NE3
l Relevant Service: services from NE1 to NE2 and NE3
NOTE

Click
in Relevant Service, and select associated services in the New Maintenance
Association dialog box.

4.

Click OK to close the displayed dialog box.

Step 3 Configure the MEPs of NE1, NE2, and NE3.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Select the maintenance association in which an MEP needs to be created. Choose New >
New MEP Point.
The system displays the New MEP Point dialog box.

4.

Configure the parameters of the new MEPs.


l MP ID: 101 for NE1, 102 for NE2, and 103 for NE3
l Direction: Ingress for NE1, NE2, and NE3
l CC Status: activation for NE1, NE2, and NE3

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1345

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

5.

A Task Collection

Click OK to close the displayed dialog box.

Step 4 Configure the remote MEPs for the maintenance associations of NE1, NE2, and NE3.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Choose OAM > Manage Remote MEP Point. The Manage Remote MEP Point dialog
box is displayed.

4.

Click New.
Then, the Add Maintenance Association Remote Maintenance Point dialog box is
displayed.

5.

Set the parameters of the new remote MEPs.


l Remote Maintenance Point ID: 102 and 103 for NE1, and 101 for NE2 and NE3
NOTE

Set the Remote Maintenance Point ID of NE1 to the MP ID of NE2 and NE3, and set the
Remote Maintenance Point ID of NE2 and NE3 to the MP ID of NE1.

6.

Click OK to close the displayed dialog box.

Step 5 Test the availability of the Ethernet services from NE1 to NE2 and NE3.
1.

Select an NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of the NE1, and then choose
Configuration > Ethernet OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM.

2.

Select the MD, MA, and MEP that correspond to Port 1, click OAM.

3.

Select Start LB.


The LB Test window is displayed.

4.

Select Destination Maintenance Point ID, and set the parameters in Test Node.
l Source Maintenance Point ID: 101 (maintenance point ID of NE1)
l Destination Maintenance Point ID: 102 (maintenance point ID of NE2)
l Transmitted Packet Count: 20 (recommended)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1346

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

l Transmitted Packet Length: 64 (64 is a recommended value, and the parameter can
also be set to 128, 256, 512, 1024, and 1280 for testing the Ethernet services of different
packet lengths.)
NOTE

The maximum Packet Length is 1400.

l Transmitted Packet Priority: 7 (recommended)

5.

Click Start Test.

6.

Check Detection Result.


The LossRate in the Detection Result should be 0.

7.

Repeat Step 5.4 to Step 5.6 to test the Ethernet services from NE1 to NE3.
l Source Maintenance Point ID: 101 (maintenance point ID of NE1)
l Destination Maintenance Point ID: 103 (maintenance point ID of NE3)
l Transmitted Packet Count: 20 (recommended)
l Transmitted Packet Length: 64 (recommended)
l Transmitted Packet Priority: 7 (recommended)
The LossRate in the Detection Result should be 0.

----End

A.14.4 Testing ATM Services


By testing ATM services, you can check whether ATM services are available over radio links.
The ATM services can be tested using the ATM OAM function. Therefore, no tester is required.

Prerequisite
l
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

End-to-end ATM services must be configured.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1347

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Background Information
When an LB test is performed on the ATM service, the segment and end attribute is set to specify
the types of transmitted ATM OAM cells.
l

When Segment End Attribute is set to Segment point, segment LB cells are transmitted.

When Segment End Attribute is set to Endpoint, end-to-end LB cells are transmitted.

Test Connection Diagram


This example shows how to test the ATM service over a radio link hop. The method for testing
the ATM services over multiple radio link hops is the same. Figure A-5 shows the test connection
diagram. NE A and NE B are the OptiX RTN 980.
The services of the boards on the NE1 and NE2 are configured as follows:
Attribute
UNI

NNI

NE A

NE B

Service source

3-MD1-1 (Trunk-1)

3-MD1-1 (Trunk-1)

Bound port

3-MD1-1 (Port-1)

3-MD1-1 (Port-1)

3-MD1-2 (Port-2)

3-MD1-2 (Port-2)

VPI

101

VCI

51

501

PW ID

Service source

Bound port

VPI

101

101

VCI

501

501

Figure A-5 Connection diagram for testing the connectivity of the ATM service
UNI
VPI
1

NodeB

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

VCI
51

NNI
VPI
101

NE A

NNI
VCI
501

VPI
101

VCI
501

UNI
VPI
101

NE B

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

VCI
501

RNC

1348

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Procedure
Step 1 Set the segment and end attributes of the ATM services on the NE A and NE B.
1.

In the NE Explorer, select an NE and then choose Configuration > ATM OAM
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Segment and End Attribute tab, and choose the ATM service to be tested.

3.

As for NE A and NE B, set Segment and End Attribute to Segment point.

4.

As for NE A and NE B, set Connection Direction to Sink.

5.

Click Apply.

Step 2 Set the identifier at the loopback point from NE A to NE B.


1.

In the NE Explorer, select an NE and then choose Configuration > ATM OAM
Management from the Function Tree. Click the LLID tab.

2.

Set Country Code, Network Code, and NE Code.


Set the parameters of NE A as follows:
l Set Country Code to 00 86.
l Set Network Code to 00 16.
l Set NE Code to 00 09 78 01 00 00 00 00 00 00 00.
Set the parameters of NE B as follows:
l Set Country Code to 00 86.
l Set Network Code to 00 16.
l Set NE Code to 00 09 78 02 00 00 00 00 00 00 00.
NOTE

If the default LLID is unique on a network, the default LLID can also be used.

3.

Click Apply.

4.

Click Close.

Step 3 Test the ATM service from NE A to NE B.


1.

In the NE Explorer, select NE A and then choose Configuration > ATM OAM
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Remote Loopback Test tab, and choose the ATM service to be tested.

3.

Set Loopback Point NE of the ATM service to be tested to NE B.

4.

Click Test to start an LB test.

5.

In normal situations, Test Result should be Test succeeded.


If the test is not successful, see Maintenance Guide and rectify the fault based on the test
result.

Step 4 Test the ATM service from NE B to NE A.


1.

With reference of Step 1, set Connection Direction of NE A to Sink; set Connection


Direction of NE B to Source.

2.

Select NE B from the NE Explorer. Then, choose Configuration > ATM OAM
Management from the Function Tree.

3.

Click the Remote Loopback Test tab, and choose the ATM service to be tested.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1349

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

Set Loopback Point NE of the ATM service to be tested to NE B.

5.

Click Test to start an LB test.

6.

In normal situations, Test Result should be Test succeeded.

A Task Collection

If the test is not successful, see Maintenance Guide and rectify the fault based on the test
result.
----End

A.14.5 Testing AM Switching


By testing AM switching, you can determine whether the AM switching is normal over radio
links.

A.14.5.1 Testing AM Switching by Using a BER Tester


If a BER tester is available, the BER tester can be used to test AM switching.

Prerequisite
l

The antennas have been aligned.

The radio links must be the Integrated IP radio links for which the AM function is enabled.

The E1 service must be configured.

The weather is favorable.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

U2000

BER tester

Precautions
The following test procedure uses the E1 services between NEs as an example.

Procedure
Step 1 Connect the BER tester to an E1 port on the local NE.
NOTE

Test the E1 services with the highest priority, which are not discarded in the lowest-order modulation mode.

Step 2 On the remote NE, perform an inloop at the E1 port by using the NMS.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1350

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7.

A Task Collection

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 3 Configure the Hybrid/AM attribute on the local NE.


1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

On the local NE, set the AM attribute to Disable, and set Manually Modulation Mode to
the same value as Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 4 Query the AM working status on the local NE.


1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

Click Query.
Transmit-End Modulation Mode should be Manually Modulation Mode of a pre-set
value.

Step 5 Use the BER tester to test the bit errors.


The test result should show that no bit error occurs.
Step 6 Configure the Hybrid/AM attribute to the planned values on the local NE.
1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

On the local NE, set the AM attribute to Enable, and set Modulation Mode of the
Guarantee AM Capacity and Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity to the planned
values.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 7 Query the AM working status on the local NE.


1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

Click Query.
Transmit-End Modulation mode should be Modulation Mode of the Full AM
Capacity of a preset value.

NOTE

When adverse weather prevails, the current modulation mode may be lower than the value of
Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1351

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 8 Check the BER test result.


There should be no bit errors.
Step 9 Release the inloop set in Step 2.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

----End

A.14.5.2 Testing AM Switching Without a BER Tester


If no BER tester is available, you can test AM switching by querying the bit errors over radio
links.

Prerequisite
l

The antennas have been aligned.

The radio links must be the Integrated IP radio links for which the AM function is enabled.

The weather is favorable.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Configure the Hybrid/AM attribute on the local NE.
1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

On the local NE, set the AM attribute to Disable, and set Manually Modulation Mode to
the same value as Modulation Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 2 Query the 15-minute performance value of the IF board on the local NE.
1.

Select the desired IF board from the Object Tree in NE Explorer.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Performance > Current Performance.

3.

In Monitored Object Filter Criteria, select All.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1352

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

4.

Set Monitor Period to 15-Minute.

5.

In Count, select FEC Performance. In Display Options, select Display Zero Data and
Display Continuous Severely Errored Seconds.

6.

Click Query, and then close the Operation Result dialog box is displayed.
In performance events, the value of FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT should be 0. If the
value is not 0, choose Reset on the performance register to clear the existing performance
values.

Step 3 Query the AM working status on the local NE.


1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

Click Query.
Transmit-End Modulation Mode should be Manually Modulation Mode of a pre-set
value.

Step 4 Reset the performance event register.


1.

Select the desired IF board from the Object Tree in NE Explorer.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Performance > Current Performance.

3.

Click Reset.
The confirmation dialog box is displayed.

4.

Click Yes.

5.

Click Close.

Step 5 Configure the Hybrid/AM attribute to the planned values on the local NE.
1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

3.

On the local NE, set the AM attribute to Enable, and set Modulation Mode of the
Guarantee AM Capacity and Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity to the planned
values.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 6 Repeat Step 2. Wait for a period, and query the 15-minute performance value of the IF board
on the local NE.
In performance events, the value of FEC_UNCOR_BLOCK_CNT should be 0.
Step 7 Query the AM working status on the local NE.
1.

Select the IF board from the NE Explorer, and then choose Configuration > IF
Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1353

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

Click Query.
Transmit-End Modulation mode should be Modulation Mode of the Full AM
Capacity of a preset value.

NOTE

When adverse weather prevails, the current modulation mode may be lower than the value of
Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity.

----End

A.14.6 Testing Protection Switching


By testing protection switching, you can determine whether the protection switching is normal
over radio links.

A.14.6.1 Testing IF 1+1 Switching


You can verify whether the IF 1+1 protection function is in the normal state by checking the
working board of the IF 1+1 protection group before and after the switching.

Prerequisite
l

The antennas have been aligned.

The equipment is configured with IF 1+1 protection.

E1 services are configured.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

U2000

BER tester

Test Connection Diagram


Figure A-6 Configuration for testing IF 1+1 switching
NE A and NE B are configured as follows:
l

Main IF board: ISU2 in slot 3

Standby IF board: ISU2 in slot 5

Main ODU: ODU in slot 53

Standby ODU: ODU in slot 55

NE A

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

NE B

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1354

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

As shown in Figure A-6, the following procedures use the E1 services between NE A and NE
B that are configured with 1+1 HSB protection as an example.
NOTE

l If Working Mode of the IF 1+1 protection is set to HSB, TX Status should be set to Mute for the ODU
on the main channel of NE A, and Enable Reverse Switching should be set to Enable. The switching occurs
at NE A.
l If Working Mode of the IF 1+1 protection is set to SD, TX Status should be set to Mute for the ODU on
the main channel of NE A, and Enable Reverse Switching should be set to Enable. The switching occurs
at NE A.
l If Working Mode of the IF 1+1 protection is set to FD, TX Status should be set to Mute for the ODU on
the main channel of NE B. The switching occurs at NE A.

Precautions
NOTE

If no BER tester is available on site, you can compare the values of Active Board of Device or Active Board
of Channel in Protection Group before and after the protection switching.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether a BER tester is available at the central site.
If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 2 through Step 11.

No BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 6 through Step 10.

Step 2 On NE A at the central site, connect one E1 port to the BER tester.
Step 3 On NE B at the remote site, perform a software inloop at the E1 port by using the NMS.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 4 Test the BER by using the BER tester.


The BER tester should show that no bit errors occur.
Step 5 Set Enable Reverse Switching in the 1+1 HSB protection group for NE A.
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Select the desired NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > IF 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1355

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

2.

Select the corresponding protection group in Protection Group, and set Enable Reverse
Switching to Enable.

3.

Click Apply.

4.

Click Close.

Step 6 Before the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE A.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > IF 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the corresponding protection group in Protection Group, and click Query.

3.

In Protection Group, the value of Active Board of Device should be the main IF board
3-ISU2.

Step 7 Set TX Status to Mute for the main ODU 53-ODU of NE A.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Mute.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 8 Check service availability after the switching.


If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Check the test result on the BER tester. It


should show that the services are restored after
transient interruption.

No BER tester is available on site, and the


E1 services are transmitted on the radio
link

Refer to A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using


PRBS to test availability of the E1 services.

No BER tester is available on site, and the


Ethernet services are transmitted on the
radio link

Refer to A.14.3 Testing Ethernet Services to


test availability of the Ethernet services.

Step 9 After the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE A.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > IF 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the corresponding protection group in Protection Group, and click Query.

3.

In Protection Group, the value of Active Board of Device should be the standby IF board
5-ISU2.

Step 10 Set TX Status to Unmute for the main ODU 53-ODU of NE A.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1356

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Unmute.

4.

Click Apply.

A Task Collection

Step 11 Release the software inloop set in Step 3.


1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 12 Restore the setting of Enable Reverse Switching in Step 5.


1.

Select the desired NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > IF 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the corresponding protection group in Protection Group, and set Enable Reverse
Switching to Disable.

3.

Click Apply.

4.

Click Close.

----End

A.14.6.2 Testing N+1 Protection Switching


You can verify whether the IF N+1 protection function works normally by checking the working
board of the IF N+1 protection group before and after the switching.

Prerequisite
l

The antennas have been aligned.

The equipment must be configured with the N+1 protection.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

U2000

BER tester

Test Connection Diagram


Figure A-7 Configuration for testing N+1 protection switching
NE A and NE B are configured as follows:
l

Main IF boards: ISU2 in slot 3 and ISU2 in slot 5

Standby IF board: ISU2 in slot 4

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1357

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Main ODUs: ODU in slot 53 and ODU in slot 55

Standby ODU: ODU in slot 54

NE A

NE B

As shown in Figure A-7, the following procedures consider the E1 services between NE A and
NE B that are configured with the N+1 (N=2) configuration as an example.

Precautions
NOTE

If no BER tester is available on site, you can compare the values of Switching Status in Slot Mapping
Relation before and after the protection switching.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether a BER tester is available at the central site.
If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 2 to Step 10.

No BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 5 to Step 9.

Step 2 At the central site NE A, connect one E1 port to the BER tester.
Step 3 At the remote site NE B, perform a software inloop at the E1 port by using the NMS.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 4 Test the BER by using the BER tester.


The BER tester should show that no bit error occurs.
Step 5 Before the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE B.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1358

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE B, and then choose
Configuration > N+1 protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the ID of the protection group to be queried, and then click Query.

3.

In Slot Mapping Relation, Switching Status of the working units 3-ISU2-1 and 5ISU2-1 and the protection unit 4-ISU2-1 should be Normal.

NOTE

If a fault arises, you must rectify the fault and then proceed with the N+1 protection testing.

Step 6 Set TX Status to Mute for the main ODU 53-ODU of NE A.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Mute.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 7 Check service availability after the switching.


If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Check the test result on the BER tester. It


should show that the services are restored after
a transient interruption.

No BER tester is available on site, and the


E1 services are transmitted on the radio
link.

See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using


PRBS to test availability of the E1 services.

No BER tester is available on site, and the


Ethernet services are transmitted on the
radio link.

See A.14.3 Testing Ethernet Services to test


availability of the Ethernet service.

Step 8 After the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE B.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE B, and then choose
Configuration > N+1 protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the ID of the protection group to be queried, and then click Query.

3.

In Slot Mapping Relation, the Switching Status of the working unit 3-ISU2-1 for the
service that is configured with the N+1 protection should be SF.

Step 9 Set TX Status to Unmute for the main ODU 53-ODU of NE A.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Unmute.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1359

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

4.

A Task Collection

Click Apply.

Step 10 Release the loopback set in Step 3.


1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

----End

A.14.6.3 Testing SNCP Switching


You can verify whether SNCP works normally by checking the working port of the SNCP
protection group before and after the switching.

Prerequisite
l

The antennas have been aligned.

The equipment is configured with the SNCP.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

U2000

BER tester

Test Connection Diagram


As shown in Figure A-8, the following procedures consider the E1 services between NE A and
NE C that are configured with SNCP as an example. Figure A-8 shows a network composed of
radio links, and the test procedures are similar in the case of a network composed of optical fiber
links.
Figure A-8 Configuration for testing SNCP switching
NE A and NE C are configured as follows:
l

West IF board: ISU2 in slot 3

East IF board: ISU2 in slot 4

West ODU: ODU in slot 53

East ODU: ODU in slot 54

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1360

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

NE A

Working
SNC

Protecting SNC

NE D
NE B

NE C

Precautions
NOTE

If no BER tester is available on site, you can compare the values of Active Channel in Working Service before
an d after the protection switching.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether a BER tester is available at the central site.
If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 2 through Step 10.

No BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 5 through Step 9.

Step 2 At the central site NE A, connect one E1 port to the BER tester.
Step 3 At the remote site NE C, perform a software inloop at the E1 port by using the NMS.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1361

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

7.

A Task Collection

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 4 Test the BER by using the BER tester.


The BER tester should show that no bit errors occur.
Step 5 Before the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE C.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE C, and choose
Configuration > SNCP Service Control from the Function Tree.

2.

In Working Service, select an SNCP service that is already created, then click Function,
and finally select Query Switching Status.

3.

The current SNCP status of the equipment is displayed in Working Service and Protection
Service.
In Current Status, Normal should be displayed. In Active Channel, Working
Channel should be displayed.

Step 6 Set TX Status to Mute for the west ODU 53-ODU of NE A.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Mute.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 7 Check service availability after the switching.


If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Check the test result on the BER tester. It


should show that the services are restored after
a transient interruption.

No BER tester is available on site, and the


E1 services are transmitted on the radio
link.

See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using


PRBS to test availability of the E1 services.

Step 8 After the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE C.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE C, and choose
Configuration > SNCP Service Control from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Function, and then select Query Switching Status.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1362

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

The current SNCP status of the equipment is displayed in Working Service and Protection
Service.
In Current Status, the service switching mode is displayed. In Active Channel,
Protection Channel should be displayed.

Step 9 Set TX Status to Unmute for the west ODU 53-ODU of NE A.


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Unmute.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 10 Release the loopback set in Step 3.


1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

----End

A.14.6.4 Testing ERPS Switching


You can verify whether the ERPS function is in the normal state by checking the port status of
the ERPS protection group before and after the switching.

Prerequisite
l

The equipment is configured with ERPS.

The network cable for carrying the working and protection Ethernet services of ERPS is
properly connected.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1363

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Test Connection Diagram


As shown in Figure A-9, the following procedures use the Ethernet services that are configured
with ERPS between NE A and NE D as an example. The RPL owner node is NE D.
Figure A-9 Configuration for testing ERPS
NE A, NE B, NE C, and NE D are configured as follows:
l

West IF board: ISU2 in slot 3

East IF board: ISU2 in slot 5

West ODU: ODU in slot 53

East ODU: ODU in slot 55

West

East

NE B
Protection channel
West

East

NE A

NE D

East
West

Working channel
West

NE C
East

Procedure
Step 1 Before the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE D.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE D, and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Protection > ERPS Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the ERPS protection group to be queried, and click Query.

3.

The value of State Machine Status should be Idle.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1364

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 2 Refer to A.14.3 Testing Ethernet Services to test availability of the Ethernet services.
The LossRate in the Detection Result should be 0.
Step 3 Set TX Status to Mute for the west ODU 53-ODU of NE A.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Mute.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 4 After the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE D.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE D, and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Protection > ERPS Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Select the ERPS protection group to be queried, and click Query.

3.

The value of State Machine Status should be Protection.

Step 5 Refer to A.14.3 Testing Ethernet Services to test availability of the Ethernet services.
The LossRate in the Detection Result should be 0.
Step 6 Set TX Status to Unmute for the west ODU 53-ODU of NE A.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and choose
Configuration > Link Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

3.

Select the desired ODU, and set TX Status to Unmute.

4.

Click Apply.

----End

A.14.6.5 Testing MPLS APS Protection Switching


By checking the change in the status of MPLS tunnels before and after the MPLS APS switching,
you can verify whether the MPLS APS protection function is normal.

Prerequisite
l

The MPLS tunnel protection group must be created properly.

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1365

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Background Information
1:1 protection
In normal situations, services are transmitted in the working tunnel. That is, services are
transmitted and received in a different tunnel respectively. When the working tunnel is faulty,
the equipment at the transmit end transmits services through the protection tunnel, and the
equipment at the receive end receive services through the protection tunnel after a negotiation
through the APS protocol. Therefore, service switching is realized.

Test Connection Diagram


Figure A-10 shows the connection diagram for testing MPLS APS protection switching. NE A
and NE B are the OptiX RTN 980 NEs.
Figure A-10 Connection diagram for testing the MPLS APS protection
Working Tunnel
NE A

NE B

Protection Tunnel

Procedure
Step 1 Query the switching status of the current MPLS tunnel 1:1 protection group on NE A and NE
B.
1.

In the NE Explorer, select NE A and then choose Configuration > APS Protection
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Tunnel APS Management tab, right-click the tested protection group, and then
choose Query Switching Status from the shortcut menu, to check the MPLS protection
group configured on the NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1366

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

A Task Collection

Choose the protection group for switching, and check its switching status. In normal
situations, the switching status should be Normal.

Step 2 Switch the services to the protection tunnel manually and forcedly.
1.

In the NE Explorer, select NE A and then choose Configuration > APS Protection
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Tunnel APS Management tab and choose the protection group for switching.

3.

Right-click the tested protection group, and then choose Forced Switching from the
shortcut menu.
NOTE

l Forced switching: With the highest priority, the operation is performed no matter whether the
current status of the protection tunnel is normal.
l Manual switching: The operation is performed only when the status of the protection tunnel is
normal.

The Confirm dialog box is displayed.


4.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

5.

Click Close.

Step 3 Query the switching status of the MPLS 1:1 protection groups on NE A and NE B after the
switching.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1367

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

1.

In the NE Explorer, select NE A and then choose Configuration > APS Protection
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Tunnel APS Management tab and choose the protection group for switching.

3.

Right-click the tested protection group and then choose Query Switching Status from the
shortcut menu, to check Switching Status of the tunnel protection group.
In normal situations, the switching status should be Forced Switching.

4.

Query Active Tunnel of the tunnel protection group.


In normal situation, Working should be Standby, and Protection should be Active.

NOTE

l If Forced Switching is performed at the previous step, the state of the protection group should be
Forced Switching.
l If Manual Switching to Protection is performed at the previous step, the state of the protection group
should be Manual (Working to Protection) Switching.

Step 4 Restore the services on NE A and NE B to the working tunnel.


1.

In the NE Explorer, select NE A and then choose Configuration > APS Protection
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Tunnel APS Management tab and choose the protection group for switching.

3.

Right-click the tested protection group and then choose Clear from the shortcut menu.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

4.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

5.

Click Close.

6.

Click Query.
Services is restored to the working tunnel.

----End

A.14.6.6 Testing Two-Fiber Bidirectional MSP Switching


By checking the change in the current working port in a ring MSP switching before and after
the switching, to verify whether the two-fiber bidirectional MSP function is normal.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1368

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Prerequisite
l

The equipment must be configured with two-fiber bidirectional MSP and corresponding
services.

The optical fibers on the equipment must be connected properly.

l
l

You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

BER tester

U2000

Test Connection Diagram


Figure A-11 shows a two-fiber bidirectional MSP ring that comprises the OptiX RTN 980. The
following steps consider the E1 services from NE A to NE C as an example.
NOTE

Only the logical board SL4D of the CSHN board supports the two-fiber bidirectional MSP.

Figure A-11 Two-fiber bidirectional MSP switching


NE A
West

East

West
NE B

STM-4 two-fiber
bidirectional MSP ring

East

East
NE D
West

West

East
NE C

Service between NE A and NE C

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether a BER tester is available at the central site.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1369

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

If...

Then...

If a BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 2 to Step 13.

If no BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 6 to Step 12.

Step 2 On the NE A side at the central site, connect the E1 port to be tested with the BER tester.
Step 3 Cancel the loopback automatic disabling function for NE A and NE C.
1.

Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > Automatic Disabling of NE


Function from the Main Menu to display the Automatic Disabling of NE Function
window.

2.

Select the NE A and NE C in the left-hand object tree and click


are displayed in Automatic Disabling of NE Function on the right.

3.

Set Auto Disabling of SDH Optical/Electrical Interface Loopback on the NE to


Disabled.

. The selected NEs

NOTE

When the automatic disabling function of SDH Optical/Electrical Interface Loopback on the NE is set
to Disabled, the loopback automatic disabling function for all of the SDH optical interfaces, PDH electrical
interfaces and ATM IMA groups on the NE is disabled.

4.

Click Apply.

Step 4 On the NE C side at the remote site, use the U2000 to perform the inloop on the software of the
corresponding E1 port.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 5 Use the BER tester to perform the bit error test.
The BER tester should indicate that no bit error occurs. If a bit error occurs, see Maintenance
Guide to rectify the fault.
Step 6 Query the working status of the protection group on NE A before switching.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and then choose
Configuration > Ring MS from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Query, and then select Query Switching Status.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1370

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

In Slot Mapping Relation, the Switching Status of east line and west line should be
Idle.

NOTE

If exceptions occur, you must rectify the fault first, and then continue to test the linear MSP switching.

Step 7 Shut down the laser on the optical interface board (east) on NE A to trigger the two-fiber
bidirectional MSP switching.
1.

Select the required optical interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE
A.

2.

Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

3.

Select By Function and then select Laser Switch from the drop-down list.

4.

Select the laser port that corresponds to the working unit, and then set Laser Switch to
Close.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.
TIP

You can also disconnect the optical fiber to trigger the two-fiber bidirectional MSP switching.

Step 8 Verify service availability after the switching.


If...

Then...

If a BER tester is available on site

Check the result on the BER tester. The result


should indicate that the services are restored
after a transient interruption.

If no BER tester is available on site and the See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using
E1 services are transmitted on the fiber
PRBS to test availability of the E1 services.
links
Step 9 Query the working status of the protection group on NE A after the switching.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and then choose
Configuration > Ring MS from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Query, and then select Query Switching Status.


In Slot Mapping Relation, the value of Switching Status should be Signal Fail-Ring.

Step 10 Re-enable the laser on the optical interface board (east) on NE A.


1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Select the required optical interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE
A.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1371

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

2.

Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

3.

Select By Function and then select Laser Switch from the drop-down list.

4.

Select the laser port that corresponds to the working unit, and then set Laser Switch to
Open.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 11 Query the working status of the protection group on NE A after the switching restoration.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and then choose
Configuration > Ring MS from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Query, and then select Query Switching Status.


In Slot Mapping Relation, the Switching Status of east line and west line should be
Idle.
NOTE

After the service is restored, you can query Switching Status after the WTR time expires. The default
value of WTR Time is 600s.

Step 12 Verify service availability after the switching restoration.


If...

Then...

If a BER tester is available on site.

Check the result on the BER tester. When


WTR time expires, the result should indicate
that the services are restored after a transient
interruption. WTR Time is 600s by default.

If no BER tester on site and E1 services are See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using
transmitted on the fiber links
PRBS to test availability of the E1 services.

NOTE

Revertive Mode of the two-fiber bidirectional MSP is always set to Revertive.

Step 13 Release the loopback that is set in Step 4.


1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click OK.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1372

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.


8.

Click Close.

----End

A.14.6.7 Testing Linear MSP Switching


You can verify whether the linear MSP group works normally by checking the working port of
the linear MSP group before and after the switching.

Prerequisite
l

The equipment must be configured with linear MSP.

The working and protection optical fibers of the linear MSP are connected properly.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


l

U2000

BER tester

Test Connection Diagram


Figure A-12 shows linear MSP composed of the OptiX RTN equipment through the connection
of optical fibers. The following procedures consider the E1 services from NE A to NE B as an
example.
Figure A-12 Configuration for testing linear MSP switching
NE A

Working channel

NE B

Protection channel

Precautions
NOTE

If no BER tester is available on site, you can compare the values of West Switching Status in Slot Mapping
Relation before and after the protection switching.

Procedure
Step 1 Check whether a BER tester is available at the central site.
If...

Then...

A BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 2 to Step 10.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1373

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

If...

Then...

No BER tester is available on site

Perform Step 5 to Step 9.

Step 2 At the central site NE A, connect one E1 port to the BER tester.
Step 3 At the remote site NE B, perform a software inloop at the corresponding E1 port by using the
NMS.
1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Inloop.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 4 Test the BER by using the BER tester. The BER tester should show that no bit errors occur.
If bit errors occur, see the Maintenance Guide for handling the bit errors.
Step 5 Before the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE A.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and then choose
Configuration > Linear MS from the Function Tree.

2.

In Slot Mapping Relation, select Working Unit.

3.

Click Query, and then select Query Switching Status.


In Slot Mapping Relation, the value of West Switching Status should be Idle.

NOTE

In the case of the working and protection units of the services that are configured with the linear MSP, the
values of West Switching Status should be Idle. If a fault arises, you must rectify the fault and proceed
with the linear MSP switching testing.

Step 6 Shut down the laser for the working unit on NE A.


1.

Select the required optical interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE
A.

2.

Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

3.

Select By Function and then select Laser Switch from the drop-down list.

4.

Select the laser port that corresponds to the working unit, and then set Laser Switch to
Close.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1374

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

6.

A Task Collection

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 7 Check service availability after the switching.


If...

Then...

The BER tester is available on site

Check the test result on the BER tester. It


should show that the services are restored after
a transient interruption.

No BER tester is available on site, and the


E1 services are transmitted on the optical
fiber link.

See A.14.1 Testing E1 Services Using


PRBS to test availability of the E1 services.

Step 8 After the switching, query the status of the protection group that is configured on NE A.
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE A, and then choose
Configuration > Linear MS from the Function Tree.

2.

In Slot Mapping Relation, select Working Unit.

3.

Click Query, and then select Query Switching Status.


In Slot Mapping Relation, the value of West Switching Status should be Switch upon
signal failure.

NOTE

In the case of the 1+1 linear MSP, Revertive Mode can be set to Revertive or Non-Revertive. In the case
of the 1:N linear MSP, Revertive Mode is always set to Revertive.
l After the automatic switching occurs on the equipment, the services are restored. If Revertive
Mode is set to Revertive for the linear MSP, the change in values of West Switching Status and
Protected Unit can be queried after the WTR time expires.
l After the automatic switching occurs on the equipment, the services are restored. If Revertive
Mode is set to Non-Revertive for the linear MSP, stop and then start the MSP protocol to restore the
value of West Switching Status to Idle.

Step 9 Turn on the laser for the working unit on NE A.


1.

Select the required optical interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer of NE
A.

2.

Choose Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

3.

Select By Function and then select Laser Switch from the drop-down list.

4.

Select the laser port that corresponds to the working unit, and then set Laser Switch to
Open.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Click OK.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1375

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

The Confirm dialog box is displayed.


7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

Step 10 Release the loopback set in Step 3.


1.

Select the PDH interface board in the Object Tree.

2.

In the Function Tree, choose Configuration > PDH Interface.

3.

Select By Function and select Tributary Loopback from the drop-down menu.

4.

In Tributary Loopback, select Non-Loopback.

5.

Click Apply.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

6.

Click OK.
The Confirm dialog box is displayed.

7.

Click OK.
The Operation Result dialog box is displayed.

8.

Click Close.

----End

A.14.6.8 Switching the System Control Unit and the Cross-Connect Unit
When the OptiX RTN 980 is configured with two system control, cross-connect, and timing
boards, you can manually switch the system control unit and the cross-connect unit as required.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with NE operator authority or higher.

Tools, Equipment, and Materials


U2000

Procedure
Step 1 Select the desired NE from the Object Tree.
Step 2 Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
Step 3 In 1+1 Protection List, select Cross-Connect Protection Pair.
Step 4 Perform the 1+1 protection switching on the board.
If...

Then...

Active Board is set to Working Board

Click Working/Protection Switching.

Active Board is set to Protection Board

Click Restore Working/Protection.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1376

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

A Task Collection

Step 5 In the prompt that is displayed, click OK.


----End

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1377

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters Description

This chapter describes the parameters used in this document.


B.1 Parameters for Network Management
This topic describes the parameters that are related to network management.
B.2 Radio Link Parameters
This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio links.
B.3 Multiplex Section Protection Parameters
This topic describes the parameters that are related to multiplex section protection (MSP).
B.4 SDH/PDH Service Parameters
This topic describes the parameters that are related to SDH/PDH services.
B.5 Parameters for Board Interfaces
This topic describes the parameters that are related to board interfaces.
B.6 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet Features on the Packet Plane
This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet services and Ethernet features on the
packet plane, including service parameters, protocol parameters, OAM parameters, Ethernet port
parameters, and QoS parameters.
B.7 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet Features on the EoS/EoPDH Plane
This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet services and Ethernet features on the EoS/
EoPDH plane, including service parameters, protocol parameters, OAM parameters, Ethernet
port parameters, and QoS parameters.
B.8 RMON Parameters
This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON performances.
B.9 Parameters for MPLS/PWE3 Services
This topic describes parameters that are related to MPLS/PWE3 services.
B.10 Clock Parameters
This topic describes the parameters that are related to clocks.
B.11 Parameters for the Orderwire and Auxiliary Interfaces
This topic describes the parameters that are related to the orderwire and auxiliary interfaces.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1378

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.1 Parameters for Network Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to network management.

B.1.1 Parameters for NE Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing network elements (NEs).

B.1.1.1 Parameter Description: NE Searching


This topic describes the parameters that are used for searching for NEs.

Navigation Path
Choose File > Discovery > NE from the Main Menu.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1379

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for the Search Field


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Address Type

IP Address of GNE

IP Address Range of GNE

l If the OSI protocol is


used on the DCN, you
can search for an NE
based on NSAP
Address only.

NSAP Address
IP Address Range of GNE

l If the IP protocol is
used on the DCN, you
can search for an NE
based on IP Address
of GNE or IP Address
Range of GNE.
l To search for all the
NEs that communicate
with the gateway NE,
select IP Address
Range of GNE.
l To select the gateway
NE only, select IP
Address of GNE.
NOTE
If Address Type is set to IP
Address of GNE or IP
Address Range of GNE,
and if the U2000 (server)
and the gateway NE are
located in different network
segments, ensure that the
U2000 and relevant routers
are configured with the IP
routes for the network
segment in which the
U2000 and gateway NE are
located.
If Address Type is set to
NSAP Address, ensure that
the OSI protocol stack is
installed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1380

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Search Address

l If Address Type is set


to IP Address of
GNE, enter the IP
address of the gateway
NE, such as 129.9.x.x.
l If Address Type is set
to IP Address Range
of GNE, enter the
number of the IP
network segment in
which the gateway NE
is located, such as
129.9.255.255.
l If Address Type is set
to NSAP Address,
enter the NSAP
address of the gateway
NE.

User Name

This parameter specifies


the user name of the
gateway NE.

Password

This parameter specifies


the password of the
gateway NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1381

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter for Searching for NEs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Create NE after search

Selected

Deselected

l To create NEs in
batches, it is
recommended that you
select Create NE
after search. The NEs
are automatically
created after they are
found.

Deselected

l After Create NE after


search is selected,
enter NE User and
Password that are
used for creating an
NE.
NOTE
If only Create NE after
search is selected, Search
for NE is selected
automatically.

NE User

l This parameter
specifies the user name
to be entered when an
NE is created.
l This parameter is valid
only when Create NE
after search is
selected.

Password

l This parameter
specifies the password
to be entered when an
NE is created.
l This parameter is valid
only when Create NE
after search is
selected.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1382

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Upload after create

Selected

Deselected

l This parameter
specifies whether to
automatically upload
the NE data after the
NE is found and
created.

Deselected

l If only Upload after


create is selected,
Search for NE and
Create NE after
search are selected
automatically.

Parameter for the Found NEs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE ID

This parameter indicates


the ID of the found NE,
which consists of
extended ID and NE ID.

GNE Address

This parameter indicates


the address of the gateway
NE that is connected to the
found NE.

GNE ID

This parameter indicates


the ID of the gateway NE
that is connected to the
found NE.

Created As GNE

Yes

Yes

l This parameter
specifies the password
to be entered when an
NE is created.

No

l This parameter is valid


only when Create NE
after search is
selected.
Connection Mode

Common

Common

The communication
between the client and the
server is encrypted if this
parameter is set to
Security SSL.

1400

This parameter specifies


the communication port.

Security SSL

Port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1383

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Status

Created

This parameter indicates


whether the found NE is
created.

Uncreated

B.1.1.2 Parameter Description: NE Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to NE creation.

Navigation Path
1.

Choose File > Creat > NE from the Main Menu.

2.

Choose RTN Series > OptiX RTN 980 from the Object Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Type

This parameter indicates


the type of the NE to be
created.

ID

1 to 49135

l The ID refers to the


basic ID. If the
extended ID is not
used, the basic ID of an
NE must be unique on
the networks that are
managed by the same
NMS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.
l The NE ID consisting
of the basic ID and
extended ID identifies
an NE on the NMS.

Extended ID

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

1 to 254

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

If the number of existing


NEs does not exceed the
range represented by the
basic ID, do not change
Extended ID.

1384

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Name

l This parameter
specifies the name of
the NE.
l After you have
specified the name of
the NE, the name is
displayed under the
icon of the NE.

Remarks

This parameter specifies


the remarks of the NE.

Gateway Type

Non-Gateway

Non-Gateway

l This parameter is set to


Gateway if the new
NE is a gateway NE.

Gateway

l This parameter is set to


Non-Gateway if the
new NE is a nongateway NE.
l This parameter is set
according to the DCN
planning if the new NE
can function as a
gateway NE or a nongateway NE.
Gateway

This parameter indicates


the gateway NE of the new
NE when Gateway Type
is set to Non-Gateway.

Protocol

IP

IP

l This parameter needs


to be set when
Gateway Type is set
to Gateway.

OSI

l When the OSI over


DCC solution is used,
this parameter is set to
OSI.
l In other cases, this
parameter is set to IP.
IP Address

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the IP address of the new
NE. This parameter needs
to be set when Affiliated
Gateway Protocol is set
to IP.

1385

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Connection Mode

Common

Common

The communication
between the client and the
server is encrypted if this
parameter is set to
Security SSL.

Security SSL

Port

1400

This parameter specifies


the communication port.

NE User

This parameter specifies


the user name to be
entered when an NE is
created.

Password

This parameter specifies


the password to be entered
when an NE is created.

NSAP Address

This parameter indicates


the NSAP address of the
new NE. This parameter
needs to be set when
Affiliated Gateway
Protocol is set to OSI.
You need to set the area ID
only, and the other parts
are automatically
generated by the NE.

Related Tasks
A.2.1.2 Creating NEs by Using the Manual Method

B.1.1.3 Parameter Description: Attribute_Changing NE IDs


This topic describes the parameters that are used for changing NE IDs.

Navigation Path
1.

In the Main Topology, right-click the NE whose ID needs to be changed.

2.

Choose Object Attributes.

3.

Click Modify NE ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1386

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Changing NE IDs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

New ID

l The new ID refers to


the basic ID. If the
extended ID is not
used, the basic ID of an
NE must be unique on
the networks that are
managed by the same
NMS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
network plan.
NOTE
The NE ID consisting of the
basic ID and extended ID
identifies an NE on the
NMS.

1 to 254

New Extended ID

If the number of existing


NEs does not exceed the
range represented by the
basic ID, do not change
the extended ID.

Related Tasks
A.2.1.4 Changing the NE ID

B.1.1.4 Parameter Description: NE Time Synchronization


This topic describes the parameters that are used for synchronizing the time of NEs.

Navigation Path
1.

Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Synchronization from


the Main Menu.

2.

Click the NE Time Synchronization tab.

Parameters for NE Time Synchronization


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Name

This parameter indicates


the name of the NE.

NE ID

This parameter indicates


the ID of the NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1387

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Synchronous Mode

Standard NTP

Null

l If this parameter is set


to NM, the NE
synchronizes the time
of the NMS server.

NM
Null

l If this parameter is set


to Standard NTP, the
NE synchronizes the
Network Time
Protocol (NTP) server
through the standard
NTP.
Standard NTP
Authentication

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter is valid


only when Synchronous
Mode is set to Standard
NTP.

Disabled

Parameters for the Standard NTP Server


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Standard NTP Server


Identifier

NE ID

NE ID

l If the NE functions as
the gateway NE, this
parameter is set to IP.

IP

l If the NE functions as
a non-gateway NE and
communicates with
the gateway NE
through the HWECC
protocol, this
parameter is set to NE
ID.
l If the NE functions as
a non-gateway NE and
communicates with
the gateway NE
through the IP
protocol, this
parameter is set to IP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1388

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Standard NTP Server

l If the NE functions as
the gateway NE, this
parameter is set to the
IP address of the
external NTP server.
l If the NE functions as
a non-gateway NE,
this parameter is set to
the ID or IP address of
the gateway NE.

Standard NTP Server


Key

0 to 1024

l If the NTP server does


not need to
authenticated, this
parameter is set to the
value "0".
l If the NTP server
needs to be
authenticated, the
authentication is
performed according
to the allocated key of
the NTP server. In this
case, the NE
authenticates the NTP
server based on the key
and the corresponding
password (specified in
the management of the
standard NTP key).

Parameters for Setting Automatic Synchronization


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Synchronization
Starting Time

l This parameter
specifies the start time
of the synchronization
period. After this
parameter is specified,
the NMS and the NE
synchronize the time
once at the intervals of
Synchronization
Period(days).
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1389

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

DST

Selected

Deselected

l This parameter
indicates whether
Synchronization
Starting Time is the
daylight saving time.

Deselected

l This parameter is set


according to the actual
situation.
Synchronization Period
(days)

1 to 300

l This parameter
indicates the period of
synchronizing the time
of the NE with the time
of the NMS.

l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.

Related Tasks
A.2.1.6 Synchronizing the NE Time

B.1.1.5 Parameter Description: Localization Management of the NE Time


This parameter describes the parameters that are used for localization management of the NE
time.

Navigation Path
1.

Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Localization


Management from the Main Menu.

2.

Select the NE for time localization management from the Object Tree, and then click
.

Parameters for Localization Management of the NE Time


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE

This parameter indicates the name of the


NE.

TimeZone

This parameter indicates the time zone.

DST

This parameter indicates whether DST is


enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1390

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Time Zone


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Time Zone

l After the time zone is changed, the


current time of the NE is changed
accordingly.
l This parameter is set according to the
place where the NE is located.

DST

Selected

Deselected

Deselected

l The parameters related to daylight


saving time can be valid only when this
parameter is selected.
l This parameter is set according to the
situation whether daylight saving time is
used in the place where the NE is located.

1 to 120

Offset

This parameter specifies the offset value of


the daylight saving time.

WEEK

This parameter specifies the method of


adjusting the daylight saving time.

Unit: minute(s)
Start Rule

WEEK
DATE

Start Time

This parameter specifies the start daylight


saving time.

End Rule

WEEK

WEEK

This parameter specifies the method of


adjusting the daylight saving time.

This parameter specifies the end daylight


saving time.

DATE
End Time

Related Tasks
A.2.1.7 Localizing the NE Time

B.1.1.6 Parameter Description: Standard NTP Key Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing the standard NTP key.

Navigation Path
1.

Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Synchronization from


the Main Menu.

2.

Click the Standard NTP Key Management tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1391

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Key

1 to 1024

l This parameter
indicates the key for
NTP authentication.
l This parameter is set
according to the
requirements of the
external NTP server.

Password

l This parameter
indicates the password
that corresponds to
Key.
l This parameter is set
according to the
requirements of the
external NTP server.

Yes

Trusted

Yes

No

l When this parameter is


set to No, the key
verification is not
trusted. After
receiving the key, the
NE rejects the clock
synchronization
service.
l When this parameter is
set to Yes, the key
verification is trusted.
After receiving the
key, the NE provides
the clock
synchronization
service.
l After receiving an
unknown or incorrect
key, the NE rejects the
clock synchronization
service. Hence, it is
recommended that you
set a trusted key only.

Related Tasks
A.2.1.8 Configuring Standard NTP Keys

B.1.1.7 Parameter Description: License Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing the license.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1392

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE and then choose Configuration > License
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the License Management tab.

Parameters for Managing Licenses


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter displays the boards that need


to be supported by licenses.

License File Type

This parameter displays the license type


corresponding to each board.

Capacity

This parameter displays the capacity of each


board.

Loaded

This parameter displays whether the


corresponding license file is loaded to each
board.

B.1.1.8 Parameter Description: Automatic Disabling of the Functions of NEs


This parameter describes the parameters that are used for automatically disabling the functions
of an NE.

Navigation Path
1.

On the Main Topology, choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > Automatic
Disabling of NE Function.

2.

Select the NE whose functions need to be automatically disabled from the Object Tree, and
.

then click

Parameters for Automatically Disabling the Functions of NEs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Name

This parameter indicates the name of the


NE.

NE Type

OptiX RTN 980

This parameter indicates the type of the NE.

Operation Type

This parameter indicates the type of the


operation, such as loopback, and shutdown
of the laser.

Auto Disabling

Disabled

Enabled

This parameter specifies whether to


automatically disable the operations such as
loopback, and shutdown of the laser.

Enabled

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1393

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Auto Disabling
Time(min)

1 to 2880

This parameter specifies the time of


automatically disabling the operations such
as loopback, and shutdown of the laser.

B.1.2 Parameters for Communications Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for communications management.

B.1.2.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting


This topic describes the parameters that are used for NE communication setting.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication >
Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.

Parameters for NE Communication Setting


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP Address

Before delivery, the


IP address of the NE
is set to 129.9.0.x.
The letter x indicates
the basic ID.

Gateway IP
Address

0.0.0.0

Subnet Mask

255.255.0.0

In the HWECC solution, an IP address is set


according to the following rules:
l The IP address, subnet mask, and default
gateway of the gateway NE should meet
the planning requirements of the
external DCN.
l If an NE uses the extended ECC, the IP
address must be in the same network
segment.
l The IP address of other NEs should be
set according to the NE ID. In this case,
the IP address of an NE should be set in
the format of 0x81000000+ID. That is,
if the ID is 0x090001, the IP address
should be set to 129.9.0.1.

Extended ID

1 to 254

l Do not change the extended ID when the


number of actual NEs does not exceed
the range permitted by the basic NE ID.
l It is recommended that this parameter
takes the default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1394

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NSAP Address

This parameter is valid only when the OSI


over DCC solution is applied. This
parameter is used to set only the area ID of
an NSAP address. The other parts of the
NSAP address are automatically generated
by the NE.

Connection Mode

Common + Security
SSL

Common + Security
SSL

l Specifies the connection mode that the


gateway NE allows the NMS to use for
connecting to the gateway NE.

Common
Security SSL

l If the gateway NE has no special


security requirement for connection to
the NMS, Connection Mode can be set
to Common.
l If the gateway NE requests secure
connection to the NMS for preventing
information interception and cracking,
Connection Mode needs to be set to
Security SSL.
l If NE communication security level
needs to be the same as NMS
communication security level,
Connection Mode needs to be set to
Common + Security SSL.
l The default parameter value is
recommended unless the gateway NE
requires that the NMS use the SSL
connection mode.
l The parameter value takes effect only
when it is set for a gateway NE and the
gateway NE is connected to the NMS by
means of the IP protocol.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.1 Setting NE Communication Parameters

B.1.2.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Rate Configuration


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the DCC rate.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the DCC Rate Configuration tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1395

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for DCC Rate Configuration


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the port that is


connected to the DCC channel.

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Enabled

It is recommended that you use the default


value, except for the following cases:

Disabled

l If the port is connected to the other ECC


subnet, Enabled/Disabled is set to
Disabled.
l If the port is connected to a third-party
network and does not exchange the
network management information with
other ports, Enabled/Disabled is set to
Disabled.
Channel

D1-D3
D4-D12
D1-D12
D1-D1

D1-D1 (for the PDH


radio whose
transmission
capacity is less than
16xE1)
D1-D3 (for other
cases)

It is recommended that you use the default


value, except for the following cases:
l If the IP DCN or OSI over DCC solution
is adopted, Channel for the SDH line
ports is set to a value that is the same as
the value for third-party network.
l If the DCC transparent transmission
solution is adopted, the value of
Channel for the SDH line ports should
not conflict with the value that is set for
the third-party network.

DCC Resources

This parameter indicates the DCC


resources.

Communication
Status

This parameter indicates the


communication status.

Protocol Type

HWECC

HWECC

It is recommended that you use the default


value, except for the following cases:

TCP/IP

l If the IP DCN solution is adopted,


Protocol Type is set to TCP/IP.

OSI
L2DCN

l If the OSI over DCC solution is adopted,


Protocol Type is set to OSI.
l When the L2 DCN solution is used, set
Protocol Type to L2DCN.

IP Address

l IP Address is available only if Protocol


Type is set to TCP/IP.
l When the IP DCN solution is used and
the NE functions as an ABR, this
parameter specifies the interface IP
address of the non-backbone area port on
the ABR.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1396

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Subnet Mask

l Subnet Mask is available only if


Protocol Type is set to TCP/IP.
l When the IP DCN solution is used and
the NE functions as an ABR, this
parameter specifies the subnet mask of
the non-backbone area port on the ABR.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.2 Configuring DCCs
A.2.7.14 Configuring Interface IP Addresses of an ABR

B.1.2.3 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Transparent Transmission


Management
This topic describes the parameters that are used for DCC transparent transmission management.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the DCC Transparent Transmission Management tab.

3.

Click Create.

Parameters for DCC Transparent Transmission Management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Timeslot/
Porta

This parameter specifies the source timeslot


or port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1397

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transparent
Transmission of
Overhead Bytes at
Source Port

D1

l Only one overhead byte can be selected


each time.

D2

l X1, X2, X3, and X4 indicate the


customized overhead bytes that are used
for transmitting asynchronous data
services.

D3
D4
D5
D6

l An overhead byte cannot be a byte that


is used. For example, an overhead byte
cannot be a byte in the used DCC
channel.

D7
D8
D9

NOTE
Only the ISU2/ISX2/SL1DA board supports
transparent transmission of the K1/K2 byte.

D10
D11
D12
E1
E2
F1
K1
K2
X1
X2
X3
X4
Sink Timeslot/
Porta

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

This parameter specifies the sink timeslot or


port.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1398

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transparent
Transmission of
Overhead Bytes at
Sink Port

D1

l Only one overhead byte can be selected


each time.

D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12

l An overhead byte cannot be a byte that


is used. For example, an overhead byte
cannot be a byte in the used DCC
channel.
l Generally, Transparent Transmission
of Overhead Bytes at Sink Port can be
set to a value that is the same as or
different from the value in the case of
Transparent Transmission of
Overhead Bytes at Source Port.
NOTE
Only the ISU2/ISX2/SL1DA board supports
transparent transmission of the K1/K2 byte.

E1
E2
F1
K1
K2
X1
X2
X3
X4

NOTE

a. A bidirectional cross-connection is set up between the source port and the sink port. Hence, a port functions
the same regardless of the source port or sink port.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.3 Configuring DCC Transparent Transmission

B.1.2.4 Parameter Description: ECC Management_Ethernet Port Extended ECC


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the extended ECCs of Ethernet ports.

Navigation Path
Click an NE in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > ECC Management from the
Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1399

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for the ECC Extended Mode


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ECC Extended
Mode

Auto mode

Auto mode

It is recommended that you use the default


value.

Specified mode

Parameters for Setting the Server


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP

This parameter indicates the IP address of


the server.

Port

1601 to 1699

l This parameter is valid only when ECC


Extended Mode is set to Specified
mode.
l This parameter can be set only when the
NE functions as the server of the
extended ECC. In normal cases, the NE
that is close to the NMS functions as the
server.
l This parameter can be set to any value
from 1601 to 1699.

Parameters for Setting the Client


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Opposite IP

0.0.0.0

Port

1601 to 1699

l This parameter is valid only when ECC


Extended Mode is set to Specified
mode.
l This parameter can be set only when the
NE functions as the client of the
extended ECC. Except for the NE that
functions as the server, all other NEs that
use the extended ECC can function as the
client.
l Opposite IP and Port are respectively
set to the IP address of the server NE and
the specified port number.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.8 Configuring Extended ECC Communication

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1400

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.1.2.5 Parameter Description: NE ECC Link Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for NE ECC link management.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > NE ECC
Link Management from the Function Tree.

Parameter for NE ECC Link Management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination NE

This parameter specifies the sink NE of the


ECC connection.

Transfer NE

This parameter specifies the next transfer


NE and the direction of the ECC route.

Distance

l This parameter specifies the number of


NEs (excluding the source NE and sink
NE) through which the ECC route
passes, namely, the number of ECC
packet forwarding attempts. The value
can be set to a value that is greater than
the number of actual ECC packet
forwarding attempts. If the value is set to
a value that is less than the number of
actual ECC packet forwarding attempts,
however, the destination NE fails to be
accessed.
l If the value is set to 0, it indicates that the
source NE is adjacent to the destination
NE.

Level

l This parameter indicates that multiple


ECC routes from the source NE to the
destination NE may be available. An
ECC route of a higher priority is selected
to transmit the packets to the destination
NE.
l If the ECC route is generated
automatically, the priority is 4.
l If the ECC route is added manually, the
priority is 5.

Mode

This parameter indicates the ECC routing


mode.

SCC No.

This parameter specifies the physical port


through which the ECC route passes. The
value of this parameter is automatically
assigned the NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1401

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.2.7.21 Querying ECC Routes

B.1.2.6 Parameter Description: ECC Link Management_Availability Test


This topic describes the parameters that are used to test ECC availability.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > NE ECC Link Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Reachability Test and choose Ping Test or Trace Route from the drop-down menu.

Ping Test Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Target NE

Specifies the NE for which a ping test will


be performed.

Packet Length
(Byte)

0-800

64

l Specifies the test packet length.

Packet Quantity

1-65535

l It is recommended that this parameter


take its default value.
3

l Specifies the number of test packets.


l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

Sending Interval
(ms)

0-65535

l Specifies the test packet transmission


interval.
l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

To Be Translated
(ms)

1-65535

1000

l Specifies the maximum time for test


packet to wait until being responded to.
l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

Traceroute Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Target NE

Specifies the NE for which a traceroute test


will be performed.

To Be Translated
(ms)

0-65535

1000

l Specifies the maximum time for test


packet to wait until being responded to.
l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1402

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Forwarding NEs

0-255

64

Specifies the number of NEs that test


packets will traverse during the forwarding
process.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.24 Verifying Connectivity of an ECC Network

B.1.2.7 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route


Management
This topic describes the parameters that are used for IP route management.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP
Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IP Route Management tab.

Parameters for IP Route Management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination
Address

This parameter indicates the destination


address of the packets. This parameter can
be set to a valid IP address of class A, B, or
C only, but cannot be set to the IP address
of the local host or the loopback address
with the 127 field.

Subnet Mask

This parameter indicates the subnet mask of


the destination address of the packets.

Gateway

This parameter indicates the IP address of


the gateway on the subnetwork where the
NE is located, namely, the IP address of the
next hop of the packets.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1403

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protocol

l DIRECT: indicates the route between


the local NE and an adjacent NE.
l STATIC: indicates the route that is
created manually.
l OSPF: indicates the route between the
local NE and a non-adjacent NE.
l RIP: indicates the route that is
discovered by the routing information
protocol.
l OSPF_ASE: indicates the route whose
Destination Address is beyond the
OSPF domain.
l OSPF_NSSA: indicates the route whose
Destination Address is in a not so
stubby area (NSSA).
l A route can be deleted in the case of
STATIC only, but cannot be edited in
the other cases.
l Compared with a dynamic route, a static
route has a higher priority. If any conflict
occurs, the static route is preferred.

Interface

This parameter indicates the interface that is


used on the route. Interface is a concept
specified in the TCP/IP protocol stack. In
the TCP/IP protocol stack, you can create
multiple types of interface, such as a
loopback interface (namely, the interface
whose IP address is 127.0.0.1), an Ethernet
interface, and PPP interface. Each interface
must have a unique interface name.

Metric

This parameter indicates the maximum


number of routers through which the
packets are transmitted. Metric is used to
indicate the overhead bytes that are
transmitted to the destination address. The
smaller the value, the less the overhead
bytes. If multiple routes can reach the same
destination address, a route whose overhead
is less is preferred to transmit the packets.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.22 Querying IP Routes

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1404

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.1.2.8 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route


Management Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for new static IP routes.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP
Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IP Route Management tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters for Creating IP Routes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination
Address

This parameter specifies the destination


address of the packets. This parameter can
be set to a valid IP address of class A, B, or
C only, but cannot be set to the IP address
of the local host or the loopback address
with the 127 field.

Subnet Mask

This parameter indicates the subnet mask of


the destination address of the packets.

Gateway

This parameter specifies the IP address of


the gateway on the subnetwork where the
NE is located, namely, the IP address of the
next hop of the packets.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.9 Creating Static IP Routes

B.1.2.9 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_Availability Test


This topic describes the parameters that are used to test IP DCN availability.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > IP Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Reachability Test and choose Ping Test or Trace Route from the drop-down menu.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1405

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Ping Test Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Target NE IP

Specifies the NE for which a ping test will


be performed.

Packet Length
(Byte)

0-800

64

l Specifies the test packet length.

Packet Quantity

1-65535

l It is recommended that this parameter


take its default value.
3

l Specifies the number of test packets.


l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

Sending Interval
(ms)

0-65535

l Specifies the test packet transmission


interval.
l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

To Be Translated
(ms)

1-65535

5000

l Specifies the maximum time for test


packet to wait until being responded to.
l It is recommended that this parameter
take its default value.

Traceroute Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Target NE IP

Specifies the NE for which a traceroute test


will be performed.

Max Hops

1-30

10

Specifies the number of hops which test


packets traverse during the packet
transmission process.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.25 Verifying Connectivity of an IP DCN Network

B.1.2.10 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_OSPF Parameter


Settings
This topic describes the parameters that are used for OSPF settings.

Navigation Path
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP
Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1406

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

B Parameters Description

Click the OSPF Parameter Settings tab.

OSPF Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Area

0.0.0.0

l If only an OSPF area is configured on an


NE, set this parameter according to the
planning information.
l If multiple OSPF areas are configured on
an NE, this parameter takes its default
value 0.0.0.0.

DCC Hello Timer


(s)

1 to 255

10

l DCC Hello Timer(s) specifies the Hello


packet timer for the DCC channel or
inband DCN.
l The Hello packets are used for detecting
the neighbor router on the network that
is connected to the router. By
periodically transmitting the hello
packets, you can determine whether the
interface on the neighbor router is still in
the active status.
l DCC Hello Timer(s) determines the
interval for the hello packet timer to
transmit the hello packets.
l In the case of two interconnected NEs,
DCC Hello Timer(s) must be set to the
same value.
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1407

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

DCC Neighbor
Dead Time(s)

1 to 65535

40

l DCC Neighbor Dead Time(s) specifies


the dead time of a neighbor router for the
DCC channel or inband DCN.
l If the local router fails to receive the
hello packets from the connected
neighbor router within the time specified
in DCC Neighbor Dead Time(s), it
considers that the neighbor router is
unavailable.
l DCC Neighbor Dead Time(s) should
be set to a value that is a minimum of
twice the value of DCC Hello Timer
(s).
l In the case of adjacent NEs, DCC
Neighbor Dead Time(s) must be set to
the same value. Otherwise, the OSPF
protocol fails to operate normally.
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

DCC
Retransmission
Timer(s)

1 to 65535

l DCC Retransmission Timer(s)


specifies the interval for transmitting a
request through the DCC channel or
inband DCN to retransmit the link state
advertisement (LSA) packets.
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

DCC Delay(s)

1 to 3600

l DCC Delay(s) specifies the delay time


to transmit the LSA packets through the
DCC channel or inband DCN.
l The LSA packets in the LSA database of
the local router are aged as the time
elapses, but are not aged when they are
being transmitted on the network.
Hence, before the LSA packets are
transmitted, you need to increase the age
of the LSA packets based on the value of
DCC Delay(s).
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1408

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAN Hello Timer


(s)

1 to 255

10

l DCC Hello Timer(s) specifies the hello


packet timer at the Ethernet network
management port or NE cascading port.
l The hello packets are used for detecting
the neighbor router on the network that
is connected to the router. By
periodically transmitting the hello
packets, you can determine whether the
interface on the neighbor router is still in
the active status.
l LAN Hello Timer(s) determines the
interval for the hello packet timer of the
NE to transmit the hello packets.
l In the case of two interconnected NEs,
LAN Hello Timer(s) must be set to the
same value.
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

LAN Neighbor
Dead Time(s)

1 to 65535

40

l LAN Neighbor Dead Time(s) specifies


the dead time of a neighbor router at the
LAN interface.
l If the local router fails to receive the
hello packets from the connected
neighbor router within the time specified
in LAN Neighbor Dead Time(s), it
considers that the neighbor router is
unavailable.
l LAN Neighbor Dead Time(s) should be
set to a value that is a minimum of two
times the value of LAN Neighbor Dead
Time(s).
l In the case of adjacent NEs, DCC
Neighbor Dead Time(s) must be set to
the same value. Otherwise, the OSPF
protocol fails to operate normally.
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1409

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAN
Retransmission
Timer(s)

1 to 65535

l LAN Retransmission Timer(s)


specifies the time for transmitting a
request for retransmission of the LSA
packets through the Ethernet network
management port or NE cascading port.
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

LAN Delay(s)

1 to 3600

l LAN Delay(s) specifies the delay time


to transmit the LSA packets through the
Ethernet network management port or
NE cascading port.
l The LSA packets in the LSA database of
the local router are aged as the time
elapses, but are not aged when they are
being transmitted on the network.
Hence, before the LSA packets are
transmitted, you need to increase the age
of the LSA packets based on the value of
LAN Delay(s).
l Unless otherwise specified, it is
recommended that this parameter take its
default value.

OSPF Status

Enabled

Enabled

Specifies whether the OSPF protocol is


enabled. If an NE uses only static routes
with OSPF disabled, set this parameter to
Disabled.

Disabled

l Specifies whether to enable the STUB


Area.

Disabled

STUB Area

Enabled
Disabled

l Set this parameter as required.


l A backbone area cannot be a STUB area.
NSSA Area

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether to enable the NSSA


Area.
l Set this parameter as required.
l A backbone area cannot be an NSSA
area.

Direct route

Enabled
Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether the direct route


automatic flooding function is enabled.
l Direct route: the route detected by the
link layer protocol.
l Set this parameter as required.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1410

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Static route

Enabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether the static route


automatic flooding function is enabled.

Disabled

l Static route: the route manually


configured by the network
administrator.
l Set this parameter as required.
RIP route

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether the RIP route


automatic flooding function is enabled.
l RIP route: the route detected by the RIP
protocol.
l Set this parameter as required.

Default route

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether the default route


automatic flooding function is enabled
for ASBRs.
l Default OSPF routes are routes whose
destination addresses and subnet masks
are 0s.
l Set this parameter according to the
planning information.

Router ID

The Router IP address is always the NE IP


address.

Opaque LSA of
External Network
Port

Enabled

Enabled

l Specifies whether the Ethernet network


management port or NE cascading port
transmits Type-10 LSAs.

Disabled

l If this parameter is set to Disabled, the


Ethernet network management port or
NE cascading port transmits network
management information.
l Set this parameter as required.
LAN Interface

Enabled
Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether the OSPF protocol is


enabled for the Ethernet network
management port or NE cascading port.
l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the
OSPF protocol is communicated with
other equipment through the Ethernet
network management port or NE
cascading port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1411

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

OSPF authentication parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Interface Type

l Displays the DCN port types that allow


the OSPF authentication key to be
specified.
l LAN indicates the Ethernet network
management port or NE cascading port.
l DCC indicates the DCC channels or
inband DCN port.

none

Authentication
Type

none

MD5

l Specifies the OSPF authentication mode


for which a key needs to be set.
l If Authentication Type is MD5, a key
needs to be set for the MD5
authentication mode.

simple

l If Authentication Type is simple, a key


needs to be set for the simple
authentication mode.
l If Authentication Type is none, all
preset keys for the related port type are
cleared.
Authentication
Password

Specifies the OSPF authentication password


for each port type.

MD5 Key

1-255

MD5 Key is available only when


Authentication Type is MD5.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.10 Setting OSPF Protocol Parameters

B.1.2.11 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack_Proxy ARP


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the proxy ARP.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP
Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Proxy ARP tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1412

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for configuring the proxy ARP


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Proxy ARP

Disabled

Disabled

l The proxy ARP enables the NEs in the


same network segment but different
domains to communicate with each
other.

Enabled

l To realize communication between such


NEs, the source NE sends the ARP
broadcast packet to address the route to
the destination NE. The NE with the
proxy ARP function enabled checks the
routing table after sensing the ARP
broadcast packet. If the routing table
contains the destination address that the
ARP broadcast packet looks for, the NE
returns an ARP spoofing packet, which
enables the NE that sends the ARP
broadcast packet to consider that the
MAC address of the NE that returns the
ARP spoofing packet is the MAC
address of the destination NE. In this
manner, the packet that is to be sent to
the destination NE is first sent to the NE
with the proxy ARP function enabled
and then forwarded to the destination
NE.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.16 Enabling the Proxy ARP

B.1.2.12 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas


This topic describes the parameters that are related to management of multiple OSPF areas.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.

Parameters Required for Configuring Multiple OSPF Areas


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID

Displays the area ID.

Default Area

Displays whether an area is the default area.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1413

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Authentication
Type

none

none

MD5

l Specifies the OSPF authentication type


used by an area.

simple

l none indicates no authentication.

Automatic Route
Aggregation

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether automatic route


aggregation is enabled for an area.
l The number of routes after automatic
route aggregation is the same as the
number of Networks.

Stub Type

Displays the STUB type of an area.

Network Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP Address

Displays the IP addresses of the Networks


in an area.

Subnet Mask

Displays the subnet masks of the Networks


in an area.

Parameters for Configuring Manual Route Aggregation


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP Address

Displays the IP address of the Network


where route aggregation is manually
enabled.

Subnet Mask

Displays the subnet mask of the Network


where route aggregation is manually
enabled.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.12 Configuring the Network Information of an ABR
A.2.7.15 Configuring the OSPF Authentication Type

B.1.2.13 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas_Adding


OSPF Areas
This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding OSFP areas.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1414

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters Required for Creating OSPF Areas


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID

l Set the area ID of a new OSPF area


according to the planning information.
l An NE can be configured with a
maximum of four OSPF areas.

IP Address

l Set the IP addresses of the Networks in


an area according to planning
information.
l An area supports a maximum of four
Networks.

Subnet Mask

Set the subnet masks of the Networks in an


area according to planning information. A
subnet mask can contain a maximum of 30
bits.

Authentication
Type

none

none

Specifies the OSPF authentication type used


by an area according to planning
information.

MD5
simple

l none indicates no authentication.


l MD5 indicates that authentication is
performed based on the preset password,
with the password encrypted in MD5
mode.
l simple: indicates that authentication is
performed based on the preset password,
with the password not encrypted.

Automatic Route
Aggregation

Enabled
Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether automatic route


aggregation is enabled for an area.
l The number of routes after automatic
route aggregation is the same as the
number of Networks.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1415

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

STUB Type

NON-STUB

NON-STUB

Set the STUB type of an area according to


planning information.

STUB

l For the backbone area, this parameter


must be set to NON-STUB.

NSSA

l For other areas, it is recommended that


you set this parameter to NON-STUB. If
required, this parameter can also be set
to STUB or NSSA.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.11 Creating an OSPF Area

B.1.2.14 Parameter Description: Management of Multiple OSPF Areas_Adding


Routes to Be Manually Aggregated
This topic describes the parameters for adding routes to be manually aggregated.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Multi-OSPF Management tab.

3.

In Manual Route Aggregation, click Add.

Parameters for Configuring Manual Route Aggregation


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID Address

Specifies the IP address of the Network


where routes need to be aggregated
manually.

Subnet Mask

Specifies the subnet mask of the Network


where routes need to be aggregated
manually.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.13 Creating a Manual Route Aggregation Group

B.1.2.15 Parameter Description: Port OSPF Setting


This section describes the parameters that are used for setting port OSPF parameters.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1416

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE and choose Communication > IP Protocol
Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port OSPF Parameter Settings tab.

Port OSPF Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the ports that allow OSPF


parameters to be set.

Path Type

Displays the current DCC channel type.

OSPF Status

Enabled

Enabled

l Specifies whether to enable the OSPF.


l Set this parameter as required.

Disabled
Opaque LSA of
External Network
Port

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether DCC channels support


Opaque LSAs.
l Set this parameter as required.

B.1.2.16 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Network Layer Parameter


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the network layer of the OSI protocol
model.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Network Layer Parameters tab.

Network Layer Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE

This parameter indicates the name of the


NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1417

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Configuration Role

ES

L1

l An NE whose Configuration Role is set


to L1 cannot function as a neighbor of an
NE in the other area. It uses a route in the
local area only and accesses the other
area by distributing the default route of
the nearest L2 NE.

L1
L2

l An NE whose Configuration Role is set


to L2 can function as a neighbor of an
NE in the other area and can use a route
in the backbone area. The backbone area
is a collection that is formed by
consecutive L2 NEs. That is, the L2 NE
of all the roles must be consecutive
(connected to each other).
NOTE
Configuration Role cannot be set to ES.

Current Role

This parameter indicates the current role.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.17 Configuring the CLNS Role

B.1.2.17 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Routing Table


This topic describes the parameters that are related to OSI routing tables.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Routing Table tab.

Parameters for Link Adjacency Table


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the port used for


OSI communication.

Data Link Layer

This parameter indicates the protocol that is


used at the data link layer.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1418

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Adjacency No.

l This parameter specifies the identifier of


the adjacency that is set up by two NEs
through the OSI protocol. One adjacency
number corresponds to an OSI
adjacency.
l The value is dynamically allocated by
the NE.

Adjacency Type

This parameter indicates the type of the


adjacency.

Adjacency State

This parameter indicates the state of the


adjacency.

Peer End Area ID

This parameter indicates the area ID that is


contained in the NSAP address of the
opposite NE.

Peer End System


ID

This parameter indicates the system ID of


the opposite NE. Generally, the system ID
is the MAC address.

Parameters for L1 and L2 Routing Tables


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination SYSID

This parameter indicates the system ID of


the destination NE. Generally, the system
ID is the MAC address.

Metric

This parameter indicates the number of hops


that reach the destination NE or destination
area.

Adjacency No.1

This parameter indicates the number of the


adjacent link that is connected to the
destination NE.

Adjacency No.2

This parameter indicates the number of the


adjacent link that is connected to the
destination NE.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.23 Querying OSI Routes

B.1.2.18 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Tunnel


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the OSI tunnels.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1419

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the OSI Tunnel tab.

Parameters for OSI Tunnel Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Remote IP Address

This parameter indicates the IP address of


the opposite end of the OSI tunnel.

LAPD Actor

User

User

l This parameter specifies the LAPD


actor.

Network

l If the adjacent NEs run the OSI protocol,


they can perform the LAPD negotiation
only when the LAPD actor is set to
User at one end and is set to Network at
the other end.
Efficient LAPD
Enable

This parameter indicates whether the


current LAPD is enabled.

Configurable
LAPD Enable

Enabled

Enabled

This parameter specifies whether the LAPD


is enabled.

Disabled

LAPD Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Remote IP Address

This parameter indicates the IP address of


the opposite end of the OSI tunnel.

L2 Wait Time to
Retry(s)

1 to 20

l This parameter specifies L2 Wait Time


to Retry(s).
l L2 Wait Time to Retry(s) indicates the
interval for retransmitting packets at the
LAPD link layer.
l L2 Wait Time to Retry(s) needs to be
set according to the network situation. If
the network is in good situation, L2 Wait
Time to Retry(s) can be set to a smaller
value. Otherwise, it is recommended that
you set L2 Wait Time to Retry(s) to a
greater value.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information. In normal
cases, it is recommended that you use the
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1420

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

L2 Retry Times

2 to 6

l This parameter specifies L2 Retry


Times.
l L2 Retry Times indicates the maximum
number of packet retransmission
attempts at the LAPD link layer.
l L2 Retry Times needs to be set
according to the network situation. If the
network is in good situation, L2 Retry
Times can be set to a smaller value.
Otherwise, it is recommended that you
set L2 Retry Times to a greater value.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information. In normal
cases, it is recommended that you use the
default value.

L3 Hello Timer(s)

1 to 100

l This parameter specifies L3 Hello


Timer(s).
l L3 Hello Timer(s) indicates the Hello
packet timer at the LAPD link network
layer. It is used for periodical
transmission of the Hello packets.
l The Hello timer determines the interval
for transmitting the Hello packets once.
L3 Hello Timer(s) needs to be set
according to the network situation. If the
network is in good situation, L3 Hello
Timer(s) can be set to a greater value.
Otherwise, it is recommended that you
set L3 Hello Timer(s) to a smaller value.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information. In normal
cases, it is recommended that you use the
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1421

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

L3 ES Timer(s)

1 to 200

50

l This parameter specifies L3 ES Timer


(s).
l L3 ES Timer(s) indicates the ES
configuration timer at the LAPD link
network layer. It is used for setting the
time to transmit the configuration
information on the ES route.
l L3 ES Timer(s) needs to be set
according to the network situation. If the
network is in good situation, L3 ES
Timer(s) can be set to a greater value.
Otherwise, it is recommended that you
set L3 Hello Timer(s) to a smaller value.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information. In normal
cases, it is recommended that you use the
default value.

L3 IS Timer(s)

1 to 200

10

l This parameter specifies L3 IS Timer


(s).
l L3 IS Timer(s) indicates the IS
configuration timer at the LAPD link
network layer. It is used for setting the
time to transmit the configuration
information through the L1/L2 router.
l L3 IS Timer(s) needs to be set according
to the network situation. If the network
is in good situation, L3 IS Timer(s) can
be set to a greater value. Otherwise, it is
recommended that you set L3 IS Timer
(s) to a smaller value.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information. In normal
cases, it is recommended that you use the
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1422

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

L3 Hold Timer(s)

2 to 63

l This parameter specifies L3 Hold Timer


(s).
l L3 Hold Timer(s) indicates the hold
timer at the LAPD link network layer.
l L3 Hold Timer(s) needs to be set
according to the network situation. If the
network is in good situation, L3 Hold
Timer(s) can be set to a smaller value.
Otherwise, it is recommended that you
set L3 IS Timer(s) to a greater value.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information. In normal
cases, it is recommended that you use the
default value.

1 to 63

COST

20

l This parameter specifies COST.


l COST indicates the overhead value of
the virtual LAPD that corresponds to the
OSI tunnel.
l The overhead value determines whether
this link is perverted. If the overhead
value is smaller, this link has a higher
priority to be selected.
l This parameter needs to set according to
the planning information.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.18 Configuring the OSI Tunnel

B.1.2.19 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Port Parameters


This topic describes the OSI port parameters.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose
Communication > OSI Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Parameters tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1423

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

OSI port parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAPD Role

User

User

l This parameter is available only when


Protocol Type is OSI.

Network

l Set LAPD Role to User at one end of a


DCC and to Network at the other end of
the DCC.
LAPD MTU

This parameter displays the maximum


LAPD packet length.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.19 Configuring OSI Port Parameters

B.1.2.20 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Bandwidth Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for bandwidth management of the inband DCN.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCN
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Bandwidth Management tab.

Parameters for Bandwidth Management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Ethernet Board
VLAN ID

2 to 4094

4094

l The equipment on the traditional DCN


can be connected to the NMS through the
SCC board, but the OptiX RTN 980 can
also be connected to the NMS through an
Ethernet interface. If an Ethernet port is
used to carry the network management
information, the NE differentiates the
network management information and
Ethernet service information according
to the VLAN ID.
l If the default VLAN ID of the inband
DCN conflicts with the VLAN ID in the
service, the Ethernet Board VLAN ID
of the inband DCN can be changed
manually. The same VLAN ID must be,
however, is used on the network-wide
inband DCN.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1424

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth(Kbit/s)

64 to 1000

512

Bandwidth(Kbit/s) specifies the bandwidth


for inband DCN messaging on the Ethernet
link.

E1 Port
Bandwidth(Kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Tunnel Bandwidth
(Kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

IF Port Bandwidth
(Kbit/s)

64 to 1000

512

IF Port Bandwidth(Kbit/s) specifies the


bandwidth for inband DCN messaging on
the radio link.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.4 Configuring the VLAN ID and Bandwidth Used by an Inband DCN

B.1.2.21 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Port Setting


This topic describes the parameters that are used for setting ports of the inband DCN.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCN
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Settings tab.

Parameters for Setting Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Name

This parameter indicates the port name.

Enabled Status

Enabled

Enabled

l Enabled Status specifies the enabling


status of the port.

Disabled

l The network management information


can be transmitted over the inband DCN
when the DCN function is enabled for
the ports at both ends of a link.
Protocol Type

IP
HWECC
L2DCN

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

IP

l Specifies the DCN protocol used by the


inband DCN.
l If Protocol Type is set to different
values for two interconnected sets of
equipment, equipment interconnection
fails. Therefore, set Protocol Type to the
same value for both ends of a link.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1425

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP Address

l This parameter is available only when


Protocol Type is set to IP.
l When the IP DCN solution is used and
the NE functions as an ABR, this
parameter specifies the interface IP
address of the non-backbone area port on
the ABR.

Subnet Mask

l This parameter is available only when


Protocol Type is set to IP.
l When the IP DCN solution is used and
the NE functions as an ABR, this
parameter specifies the subnet mask of
the non-backbone area port on the ABR.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.6 Setting Parameters of Inband DCN
A.2.7.14 Configuring Interface IP Addresses of an ABR

B.1.2.22 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Access Control


This section describes the parameters for configuring access control.

Navigation Path
l

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > DCN Management from the Function Tree.

Click the Access Control tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Name

Displays the Ethernet ports that support this


function.

Enabled Status

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies the enabling status of the port.

Enabled

l If the Enabled Status is set to


Enabled, this port can be used to support
access of the management information
from the NMS.
l If the Enabled Status is set to
Disabled, this port cannot be used to
support access of the management
information from the NMS.

IP Address
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

0.0.0.0

Specifies the IP address of the port.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1426

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Subnet Mask

0.0.0.0

Specifies the submask of the port.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.7 Configuring Access Control

B.1.2.23 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Packet Control


This topic describes the parameters for controlling the priority of inband DCN packets.

Navigation Path
l

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > DCN Management from the Function Tree.

Click the Packet Control tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Type

Displays the packet type for which the


packet priority can be manually specified.

Supported
Application

This parameter cannot be specified


manually.

Packet Priority

CS6

CS6 (Packet Type


is VLAN)

Specifies the PHB service class of inband


DCN packets.

EF
AF4
AF3

BE (Packet Type is
DSCP)

AF2
AF1
BE

Related Tasks
A.2.7.5 Configuring the Priority of Inband DCN Packets

B.1.2.24 Parameter Description: L2 DCN Management


This section describes the parameters that are related to L2 DCN management.

Navigation Path
l

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Communication > L2DCN Management from the Function Tree.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1427

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Click Query.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Config Status

Auto

Auto

When the OptiX RTN 980 uses the L2 DCN


solution, the RSTP protocol can be used to
prevent L2 forwarding loops. It is
recommended that the RSTP protocol uses
its default enable/disable mode Auto for the
OptiX RTN 980 NE level. That is, the RSTP
protocol is automatically enabled/disabled
depending on the enable/disable status of
the L2 DCN function over IF ports.

l Real Status is queried to be Disabled in


the following scenarios:

Disabled

Disabled

Real Status

Enabled

Config Status is set to Disabled.


When Config Status is set to Auto,
the L2 DCN function is disabled for
all IF ports on the NE.
l When Config Status is set to Auto, the
L2 DCN function is enabled for at least
one IF port on the NE. In this case, the
RSTP protocol will automatically work.
At this time, the queried Real Status is
Enabled.

Related Tasks
A.2.7.20 Enabling/Disabling the RSTP Protocol When the L2 DCN Solution Is Used

B.1.2.25 Parameter Description: Access Control


This topic describes the parameters that are used for access control of the NMS.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > Access
Control from the Function Tree.

Parameters for Ethernet Access Control


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Ethernet
Access

Selected

After The First Network Port is set to


Enabled for Ethernet access, the NE can
access the NMS through the Ethernet port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Deselected

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1428

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PORT

This parameter displays the NMS port and


the NE cascading port on the system control,
switching, and timing board.

Work Mode

adapt

This parameter specifies the working modes


of the NMS port and the NE cascading port
on the system control, switching, and timing
board.

This parameter displays the working modes


of the NMS port and the NE cascading port
on the system control, switching, and timing
board.

10M Half_Duplex
10M Full_Duplex
100M Half_Duplex
100M Full_Duplex
Actual Work Mode

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Specifies whether the Ethernet network


management port or NE cascading port is
enabled.

Disabled

Parameters for Access Control over Serial Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Serial Port


Access

Selected

Selected

After Enable Serial Port Access is


selected, the NE can access the NMS or
command lines through the serial port.

Access Command
Line

Selected

Deselected

If Access Command Line is selected, the


serial interface can be used to access the
command line terminal.

Access NM

Selected

Deselected

If Access NM is selected, the serial interface


can be used to access the NMS.

9600

l This parameter specifies the data


transmission rate in the communications
through serial ports.

Deselected

Deselected

Deselected
Baud Rate

1200
2400
4800
9600
19200
38400

l This parameter is set according to the


rate of the serial port at the opposite end,
and the rates at both ends must be the
same.

57600
115200

B.1.3 Parameters for Network Security Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to network security management.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1429

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.1.3.1 Parameter Description: NE User Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to NE user management.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the required NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Security > NE
User Management from the Function Tree.
A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation is successful.

2.

Close the dialog box.

Parameters for NE user management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE

Displays the current NE


name.

NE User

Displays the registered NE


user name.

User Level

Displays the registered NE


user level.

NE User Flag

Displays whether a
registered NE user is
logged in.

Related Tasks
A.2.9.3 Setting Warning Screen Parameters

B.1.3.2 Parameter Description: NE User Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an NE user.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the required NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Security > NE
User Management from the Function Tree. A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the
operation is successful.

2.

Close the dialog box.

3.

Click Add.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1430

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE User

Specifies the name of a


registered NE user.
NOTE
The name of an NE cannot
contain any space or
Chinese characters.

User Level

Monitor Level

Monitor Level

Operation Level
Maintenance Level
System Level
Debug Level

l A Debug Level NE
user has all security
and configuration
authorities, and has the
right to run debugging
commands.
l A System Level NE
user has all security
and configuration
authorities.
l A Maintenance
Level NE user has
some security
authorities, some
configuration
authorities, the
communication setting
authority, and the log
management
authority.
l An Operation Level
NE user has all fault
performance
authorities, some
security authorities,
and some
configuration
authorities.
l A Monitor Level NE
user has the right to use
all query commands, to
log in, to log out, and to
change its own
password.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1431

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE User Flag

LCT NE User

LCT NE User

l Specifies the NE user


flag.

EMS NE User

l LCT NE User
indicates NE users for
NE management on
the U2000 Local Craft
Terminal (U2000
LCT).

CMD NE User
General NE User

l EMS NE User
indicates NE users for
NE management on
the U2000.
l CMD NE User
indicates NE users for
NE management on
the CMD.
l General NE User
indicates NE users for
all NMS types.
Detailed Description

Describes a configured
NE user.

New Password

l Specifies the password


for a new NE user.

Confirm Password

Enter the same value as


New Password.

Immediate Password
Change

Yes

Yes

Specifies whether the


password of a registered
NE user can be changed.

No

Related Tasks
A.2.9.1 Creating an NE User

B.1.3.3 Parameter Description: LCT Access Control


This topic describes the parameters that are used for LCT access control.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Security > LCT Access
Control from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1432

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for LCT Access Control


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE

This parameter indicates the name of the


NE.

LCT Access
Control Switch

Access Allowed

Access Allowed

l No NMS user logs in to the NE. In this


case, when the LCT requests an LCT
user to log in to the NE, the NE does not
check the status of LCT Access Control
Switch, and directly allows the LCT user
to log in to the NE.

Disable Access

l An NMS user first logs in to the NE. In


this case, when the LCT requests an LCT
user to log in to the NE, the NE
determines whether to allow the LCT
user to log in to the NE through the LCT
according to the status of LCT Access
Control Switch.
l An LCT user first logs in to the NE. In
this case, when the NMS requests an
NMS user to log in to the NE, the NMS
user can directly log in to the NE. After
the NMS user successfully logs in to the
NE, the online LCT user is not affected.
l When both the LCT user and NMS user
log in to the NE, the online LCT user is
not affected after LCT Access Control
Switch is set to Disable Access.

B.1.3.4 Parameter Description: RADIUS Configuration_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to RADIUS configuration.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Security > NE
RADIUS Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Function

Server ID

Specifies the desired RADIUS function, the


authentication server ID, and the server type.
l Function, Server ID, and Server Type are
associated with the servers that are

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1433

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Server Type

configured in A.2.11.2 Creating a


RADIUS Server or a RADIUS Proxy
Server.
l Select the desired RADIUS server or proxy
server according to planning information.

Server Status

Active

Active

Specifies the active/standby status of the


RADIUS server or proxy server.

Standby

l If no standby server is required, set Server


Status to Active.
l The OptiX RTN 980 supports one active
server and one standby server. If both the
active and standby servers are configured,
set Server Status of the active server to
Active and Server Status of the standby
server to Standby.
-

Shared Key

Specifies the key for communication between


an NE and the RADIUS server.
l Set Shared Key to the same value on the
NE and on the RADIUS server.
l If Server Type is Proxy Server, Shared
Key is not available.

Interval of Packet
Transmission

3-10

Packet
Retransmission
Attempts

1-5

Specifies the number of packet retransmission


attempts and the interval between the attempts.
l If an NE does not receive the response from
the RADIUS server within a specific
period, the NE re-transmits the
authentication request for the configured
attempt times and at the configured
interval.
l It is recommended that Interval of Packet
Transmission and Packet
Retransmission Attempts take their
default values.

Related Tasks
A.2.11.3 Configuring RADIUS Server Parameters

B.1.3.5 Parameter Description: RADIUS Configuration_RADIUS Server


This topic describes the parameters that are related to RADIUS server configuration.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1434

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Security > NE
RADIUS Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the RADIUS Server Configuration tab.


The RADIUS Server Information dialog box is displayed.

3.

Click New.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Function

Authentication

Authentication

Accounting

Specifies the RADIUS function that an NE


needs to use.

Authentication +
Accounting

l For NE RADIUS authentication, select


Authentication.
l For both NE RADIUS authentication and
NE usage accounting, set this parameter to
Authentication + Accounting or
Accounting (when the Authentication
function has been enabled).

Server Type

RADIUS Server

RADIUS Server

Proxy Server

Specifies the server type used for NE RADIUS


authentication.
l When an NE uses RADIUS authentication
in the NAS mode or functions as a proxy
server, set Server Type to RADIUS
Server.
l When an NE uses RADIUS authentication
in the proxy NAS mode, set Server Type
to Proxy Server.

Server ID

IP Address
NE ID

IP Address

Specifies the address of the server that is used


for NE RADIUS authentication.
l If Server Type is RADIUS Server, set
Server ID to IP Address and specify the
IP address of the RADIUS server.
l If Server Type is Proxy Server, it is
recommended that you set Server ID to
NE ID and set the gateway NE as the proxy
server.
l If Server Type is Proxy Server and there
is no IP route between the NE and the proxy
server, Server ID can be set to only NE
ID. If Server Type is Proxy Server and
there is an IP route between the NE and the
proxy server, Server ID can be set to NE
ID or IP Address.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1435

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.2.11.2 Creating a RADIUS Server or a RADIUS Proxy Server

B.1.3.6 Parameter Description: Enabling/Disabling the RADIUS Function


This topic describes the parameters that are required for enabling/disabling the RADIUS
function.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose Security > NE
RADIUS Configuration from the Function Tree.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE

Displays the NE name.

RADIUS Client

Open

Close

Specifies whether an NE has the ability to be


a RADIUS client. The RADIUS function can
be enabled on an NE only if RADIUS Client
is set to Open for the NE.

Close

Specifies whether an NE has the ability to be


a proxy server.

Close

Proxy Server

Open
Close

l If an NE needs to function as a proxy


server, set Proxy Server to Open for the
NE.
l Proxy Server can be set to Open only if
RADIUS Client is set to Open.
l When an NE uses RADIUS authentication
in the proxy NAS mode, set Proxy
Server to Close.

Related Tasks
A.2.11.1 Enabling/Disabling the RADIUS Function

B.2 Radio Link Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio links.

B.2.1 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC


Workgroup_Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are related to the XPIC function.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1436

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Link
Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the XPIC tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IF Channel
Bandwidth

ISX2:

l This parameter specifies the channel


spacing when the XPIC function is
enabled.

7M
14M

l When this parameter is set to 56M or


40M, the high-power ODU must be
used.

28M
40M
56M
IFX2:
7M
14M
28M
56M
Polarization
Direction-V

l This parameter indicates the polarization


direction of a radio link.
l It is recommended that you set the IF port
on the XPIC IF board that has a smaller
slot number to Link ID-V and the IF port
on the other XPIC IF board to Link IDH.

1 to 4094

l Set Link ID-V and Link ID-H.


l A link ID is an identifier of a radio link
and is used to prevent the radio links
between sites from being wrongly
connected.
l When the link ID received by an NE is
different from the link ID set for the NE,
the NE reports an MW_LIM alarm and
inserts the AIS.
l These two parameters are set according
to the planning information. These two
parameters must be set to different
values, but Link ID-V must be set to the
same value at both ends of a link and
Link ID-H must also be set to the same
value at both ends of a link.

Polarization
Direction-H

Link ID-V
Link ID-H

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1437

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transmit Power
(dBm)

l This parameter specifies the transmit


power of an ODU. The value of this
parameter must not exceed the rated
power range supported by the ODU.
l It is recommended that you set the
transmit power of the ODU to the same
value at both ends of a radio link.
l Consider the receive power of the ODU
at the opposite end when you set this
parameter. Ensure that the receive power
of the ODU at the opposite end can
ensure stable radio services.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Maximum
Transmit Power
(dBm)

l This parameter specifies the maximum


transmit power of the ODU. This
parameter cannot be set to a value that
exceeds the nominal power rang of the
ODU in the guaranteed capacity
modulation module.
l This parameter is set to limit the
maximum transmit power of the ODU
within this preset range.
l The maximum transmit power adjusted
by using the ATPC function should not
exceed this value.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Transmission
Frequency(MHz)

l This parameter indicates the channel


central frequency.
l The value of this parameter must not be
less than the sum of the lower transmit
frequency limit supported by the ODU
and a half of the channel spacing, and
must not be more than the difference
between the upper transmit frequency
limit supported by the ODU and a half of
the channel spacing.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1438

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

T/R Spacing(MHz)

l This parameter specifies the spacing


between the transmit frequency and the
receive frequency of an ODU to prevent
mutual interference between the
transmitter and the receiver.
l If Station Type of the ODU is TX
high, the transmit frequency is one T/R
spacing higher than the receive
frequency. If Station Type of the ODU
is TX low, the transmit frequency is one
T/R spacing lower than the receive
frequency.
l If the ODU supports only one T/R
spacing, this parameter is set to 0,
indicating that the T/R spacing
supported by the ODU is used.
l A valid T/R spacing value is determined
by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing
should be set according to the technical
specifications of the ODU.
l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be
set to the same value at both ends of a
radio link.

Transmission
Status

unmute
mute

unmute

l When this parameter is set to mute, the


ODU does not transmit microwave
signals but can normally receive
microwave signals.
l When this parameter is set to unmute,
the ODU normally transmits and
receives microwave signals.
l In normal cases, Transmission Status is
set to unmute.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1439

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ATPC Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


ATPC function is enabled.

Enabled

l If this parameter is set to Enabled and if


the RSL at the receive end is 2 dB higher
or lower than the central value between
the ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC
lower threshold at the receive end, the
receiver notifies the transmitter to
decrease or increase the transmit power
until the RSL is within the range that is
2 dB higher or lower than the central
value between the ATPC upper
threshold and the ATPC lower threshold.
l The settings of the ATPC attributes must
be consistent at both ends of a radio link.
l In the case of areas where fast fading
severely affects the radio transmission, it
is recommended that you set this
parameter to Disabled.
l During the commissioning process, set
this parameter to Disabled to ensure that
the transmit power is not changed. After
the commissioning, re-set the ATPC
attributes.
ATPC Upper
Threshold(dBm)

-45.0

ATPC Lower
Threshold(dBm)

-70.0

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

l The central value between the ATPC


upper threshold and the ATPC lower
threshold is set as the expected receive
power.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC
Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of
the planned central value between the
ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC
lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC
Lower Threshold(dBm) to the
difference between the planned central
value between the ATPC upper
threshold and the ATPC lower threshold
and 10 dB.
l You can set the ATPC upper threshold
only when ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable Status is set to
Disabled.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1440

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable
Status

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


ATPC automatic threshold function is
enabled.

Enabled

l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the


equipment automatically uses the preset
ATPC upper and lower thresholds
according to the work mode of the radio
link.

Related Tasks
A.3.2 Creating an XPIC Workgroup

B.2.2 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the XPIC function.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Link
Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the XPIC tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Group ID

This parameter indicates the ID of the work


group.

Polarization
Direction-V

This parameter indicates the IF port to which


the polarization direction V corresponds.

Link ID-V

This parameter indicates the link ID to


which the polarization direction V
corresponds.

Polarization
Direction-H

This parameter indicates the IF port to which


the polarization direction H corresponds.

Link ID-H

This parameter indicates the link ID to


which the polarization direction H
corresponds.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1441

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IF Channel
Bandwidth

ISX2:

l IF Channel Bandwidth refers to the


channel spacing of the corresponding
radio links.

7M
14M

l When this parameter is set to 56M or


40M, the high-power ODU must be
used.

28M
40M
56M

l This parameter is set according to the


planning information.

IFX2:
7M
14M
28M
56M
Power to Be
Received -V(dBm)

-90.0 to -20.0

-10.0

l This parameter is used to set the


expected receive power of the ODU and
is mainly used in the antenna alignment
stage. After this parameter is set, the NE
automatically enables the antenna
misalignment indicating function.
l When the antenna misalignment
indicating function is enabled, if the
actual receive power of the ODU is 3 dB
lower than the power expected to be
received, the ODU indicator on the IF
board connected to the ODU blinks
yellow (300 ms on, 300 ms off),
indicating that the antenna is not aligned.
l After the antenna alignment, after the
state that the antenna is aligned lasts for
30 minutes, the NE automatically
disables the antenna misalignment
indicating function.
l When this parameter takes the default
value, the antenna misalignment
indicating function is disabled.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1442

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Power to Be
Received -H(dBm)

-90.0 to -20.0

-10.0

l This parameter is used to set the


expected receive power of the ODU and
is mainly used in the antenna alignment
stage. After this parameter is set, the NE
automatically enables the antenna
misalignment indicating function.
l When the antenna misalignment
indicating function is enabled, if the
actual receive power of the ODU is 3 dB
lower than the power expected to be
received, the ODU indicator on the IF
board connected to the ODU blinks
yellow (300 ms on, 300 ms off),
indicating that the antenna is not aligned.
l After the antenna alignment, after the
state that the antenna is aligned lasts for
30 minutes, the NE automatically
disables the antenna misalignment
indicating function.
l When this parameter takes the default
value, the antenna misalignment
indicating function is disabled.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Maximum
Transmit Power
(dBm)

l This parameter specifies the maximum


transmit power of the ODU. This
parameter cannot be set to a value that
exceeds the nominal power rang of the
ODU in the guaranteed capacity
modulation module.
l This parameter is set to limit the
maximum transmit power of the ODU
within this preset range.
l The maximum transmit power adjusted
by using the ATPC function should not
exceed this value.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1443

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transmit Power
(dBm)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit power of the ODU. This
parameter cannot be set to a value that
exceeds the nominal power range of the
ODU.
l It is recommended that you set the
transmit power of the ODU to the same
value at both ends of a radio link.
l Consider the receive power of the ODU
at the opposite end when you set this
parameter. Ensure that the receive power
of the ODU at the opposite end can
ensure stable radio services.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Transmission
Frequency(MHz)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit frequency of the ODU, namely,
the channel central frequency.
l The value of this parameter must not be
less than the sum of the lower TX
frequency limit supported by the ODU
and a half of the channel spacing, and
must not be more than the difference
between the upper TX frequency limit
supported by the ODU and a half of the
channel spacing.
l The difference between the transmit
frequencies of both the ends of a radio
link should be one T/R spacing.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1444

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

T/R Spacing(MHz)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


spacing between the transmit frequency
and receive frequency of the ODU to
prevent mutual interference between the
transmitter and receiver.
l If the ODU is a Tx high station, the
transmit frequency is one T/R spacing
higher than the receive frequency. If the
ODU is a Tx low station, the transmit
frequency is one T/R spacing lower than
the receive frequency.
l If the ODU supports only one T/R
spacing, this parameter is set to 0,
indicating that the T/R spacing
supported by the ODU is used.
l A valid T/R spacing value is determined
by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing
should be set according to the technical
specifications of the ODU.
l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be
set to the same value at both ends of a
radio link.

Transmission
Status

unmute

unmute

mute

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit status of the ODU.
l If this parameter is set to mute, the
transmitter of the ODU does not work
but can normally receive microwave
signals.
l If this parameter is set to unmute, the
ODU can normally transmit and receive
microwave signals.
l In normal cases, this parameter is set to
unmute.

Parameters for Hybrid/AM Configuration


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Group ID

This parameter indicates the ID of the work


group.

Polarization
direction

This parameter indicates the IF port to which


the polarization direction H or the
polarization direction V corresponds.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1445

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

AM Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

l When AM Enable Status is set to


Disabled, the radio link uses only the
specified modulation scheme. In this
case, you need to select Manually
Specified Modulation Mode.

Enabled

l When AM Enable Status is set to


Enabled, the radio link uses the
corresponding modulation scheme
according to the channel conditions.
Hence, the Hybrid radio can ensure the
reliable transmission of the E1 services and
provide bandwidth adaptively for the
Ethernet services when the AM function is
enabled.
Modulation Mode
of the Guarantee
AM Capacity

QPSK

16QAM
32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

This parameter specifies the highest-gain


modulation scheme that the AM function
supports. This parameter is set according to
the planning information. Generally, the
value of this parameter is determined by the
bandwidth of the services that need to be
transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the
availability of the radio link that
corresponds to this modulation scheme.
NOTE
Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity
must be higher than Modulation Mode of the
Guarantee AM Capacity.

This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.
Modulation Mode
of the Full AM
Capacity

QPSK
16QAM
32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

This parameter specifies the highest-gain


modulation scheme that the AM function
supports. This parameter is set according to
the planning information. Generally, the
value of this parameter is determined by the
bandwidth of the services that need to be
transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the
availability of the radio link that
corresponds to this modulation scheme.
NOTE
Modulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity
must be higher than Modulation Mode of the
Guarantee AM Capacity.

This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1446

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Manually Specified
Modulation Mode

QPSK

QPSK

This parameter specifies the modulation


scheme that the radio link uses for signal
transmission.

16QAM
32QAM

This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Disabled.

64QAM
128QAM
256QAM
Transmit-End
Modulation Mode

Displays the modulation mode at the


transmit end.

Receive-End
Modulation Mode

Displays the modulation mode at the receive


end.

Parameters for ATPC Management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Group ID

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

ATPC Enable
Status

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


ATPC function is enabled.

Enabled

l If this parameter is set to Enabled and if


the RSL at the receive end is 2 dB higher
or lower than the central value between
the ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC
lower threshold at the receive end, the
receiver notifies the transmitter to
decrease or increase the transmit power
until the RSL is within the range that is
2 dB higher or lower than the central
value between the ATPC upper threshold
and the ATPC lower threshold.
l The settings of the ATPC attributes must
be consistent at both ends of a radio link.
l In the case of areas where fast fading
severely affects the radio transmission, it
is recommended that you set this
parameter to Disabled.
l During the commissioning process, set
this parameter to Disabled to ensure that
the transmit power is not changed. After
the commissioning, re-set the ATPC
attributes.
ATPC Upper
Threshold(dBm)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

l Set the central value between the ATPC


upper threshold and the ATPC lower

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1447

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ATPC Lower
Threshold(dBm)

threshold to a value for the expected


receive power.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC
Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of
the planned central value between the
ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC
lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC
Lower Threshold(dBm) o the
difference between the planned central
value between the ATPC upper threshold
and the ATPC lower threshold and 10
dB.
l You can set this parameter only when
ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable
Status is set to Disabled.

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable
Status

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


ATPC automatic threshold function is
enabled.

Enabled

l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the


equipment automatically uses the preset
ATPC upper and lower thresholds
according to the work mode of the radio
link.
l If this parameter is set to Disabled, you
need to manually set ATPC Upper
Threshold(dBm) and ATPC Lower
Threshold(dBm).

Related Tasks
A.3.3 Setting the AM Attributes of the XPIC Workgroup

B.2.3 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection_Create


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an IF N+1 protection group.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1
Protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Create.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1448

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR time(s)

300 to 720

600

l This parameter specifies the wait-torestore (WTR) time.


l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
set WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

Enabled

SD enable

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


signal degradation switching function of
N+1 protection is enabled.
l When this parameter is set to Enabled,
the signal degradation condition is
considered as a trigger condition of
protection switching.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Enabled.

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Select Mapping
Direction

Work Unit

Work Unit

l This parameter specifies the mapping


direction of N+1 protection.

Protection Unit

l This parameter is set according to the


planning information.
Select Mapping
Way

l In the case of N+1 protection, map N IF


ports as Work Unit and map the
remaining IF port as Protection Unit.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Mapped Board

This parameter indicates the working unit


and protection unit that have been set.

Related Tasks
A.3.5 Creating an N+1 Protection Group

B.2.4 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF N+1 protection.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1449

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1
Protection from the Function Tree.

Protection Group Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group
ID

This parameter indicates the ID of the


protection group.

WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


WTR time.
l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
set WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

SD Enable

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the SD switching function of N
+1 protection is enabled.
l When this parameter is set to Enabled,
the SD condition is considered as a
trigger condition of protection
switching.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Enabled.

Protocol Status

This parameter indicates the status of the


switching control protocol.

Protection Unit Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Unit

This parameter indicates the protection unit.

Line

This parameter indicates the information


about the working board or protection
board.

Switching Status

This parameter indicates the switching state.

Protected Unit

This parameter indicates the protected unit.

Remote/Local End
Indication

This parameter indicates the local end or


remote end.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1450

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.3.7 Querying the IF N+1 Protection Status

B.2.5 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection_Create


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an IF 1+1 protection group.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1
Protection from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Create.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Working Mode

HSB

HSB

l This parameter specifies the working


mode of the IF 1+1 protection.

FD
SD

l When Working Mode is set to HSB, the


equipment provides a 1+1 hot standby
configuration for the IF board and ODU
at both ends of each hop of a radio link
to realize the protection.
l When Working Mode is set to FD, the
system uses two channels that have a
frequency spacing between them, to
transmit and receive the same signal. The
remote end selects signals from the two
received signals. With FD protection, the
impact of the fading on signal
transmission is reduced.
l When Working Mode is set to SD, the
system uses two antennas that have a
space distance between them, to receive
the same signal. The equipment selects
signals from the two received signals.
With SD protection, the impact of the
fading on signal transmission is reduced.
l The FD mode and SD mode are
compatible with the HSB switching
function.
l This parameter is set according to the
network plan.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1451

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Revertive Mode

Revertive Mode

Revertive Mode

l This parameter specifies the revertive


mode of the IF 1+1 protection.

Non-Revertive

l When Revertive Mode is set to


Revertive Mode, the NE that is in the
switching state releases the switching
and enables the former working channel
to return to the normal state some time
after the former working channel is
restored to normal. It is recommended
that you set this parameter to Revertive
Mode.
l When Revertive Mode is set to NonRevertive, the NE that is in the
switching state keeps the current state
unchanged unless another switching
occurs even though the former working
channel is restored to normal.
WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

600

l This parameter specifies the wait-torestore (WTR) time.


l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
set WTR Time(s), a revertive switching
occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when
Revertive Mode is set to Revertive
Mode. It is recommended that you use
the default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1452

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Reverse
Switching

Enabled

Enabled

l This parameter indicates whether the


reverse switching function is enabled.

Disabled

l When both the main IF board and the


standby IF board at the sink end report
service alarms, they send the alarms to
the source end by using the MWRDI
overhead in the microwave frame. When
Enable Reverse Switching at the source
end is set to Enabled and the reverse
switching conditions are met, the IF 1+1
protection switching occurs at the source
end.
l Enable Reverse Switching is valid only
when Working Mode is set to HSB or
SD.
l Generally, if Working Mode is set to
HSB, it is recommended that you set
Enable Reverse Switching to
Disabled; if Working Mode is set to
SD, it is recommended that you set
Enable Reverse Switching to
Enabled.
Working Board

This parameter specifies the working board


of the protection group.

Protection Board

This parameter specifies the protection


board of the protection group.

Alarm Report
Mode

Only board alarms

Only board alarms

l When Alarm Report Mode is set to


Only board alarms, only IF board
alarms are reported.

Only protection
group alarms
Protection group
and board alarms

l When Alarm Report Mode is set to


Only protection group alarms, alarms
are reported if a protection group fails or
degrades and suppress IF board alarms
and radio link alarms.
l When Alarm Report Mode is set to
Protection group and board alarms,
IF board alarms and protection group
alarms are reported.
l It is recommended that you set Alarm
Report Mode to Only protection
group alarms. In this case, protection
group alarms are reported to indicate
radio link faults.
NOTE
The faulty board reports related fault alarms
regardless of parameter settings.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1453

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Anti-jitter Time(s)

0 to 600

300

l When Anti-jitter Time(s) is not set to 0,


a protection group does not report an
alarm immediately after it is degraded,
but reports the alarm after the specified
anti-jitter time expires.
l It is recommended that Anti-jitter Time
(s) take its default value.

NOTE

Each of the parameters Working Mode, Revertive Mode, WTR Time(s),Anti-jitter Time(s) and Enable
Reverse Switching must be set to the same value at both ends of a radio hop.

Related Tasks
A.3.1 Creating an IF 1+1 Protection Group

B.2.6 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF 1+1 protection.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1
Protection from the Function Tree.

Protection Group Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group
ID

This parameter indicates the ID of the


protection group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1454

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Working Mode

HSB

l This parameter indicates the working


mode of the created IF 1+1 protection
group.

FD
SD

l In HSB mode, the equipment provides a


1+1 hot standby configuration for the IF
board and ODU at both ends of each hop
of a radio link to realize the protection.
l In FD mode, the system uses two
channels that have a frequency spacing
between them, to transmit and receive
the same signal. The remote end selects
signals from the two received signals.
With FD protection, the impact of the
fading on signal transmission is reduced.
l In SD mode, the system uses two
antennas that have a space distance
between them, to receive the same signal.
The equipment selects signals from the
two received signals. With SD
protection, the impact of the fading on
signal transmission is reduced.
l The FD mode and SD mode are
compatible with the HSB switching
function.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Revertive Mode

Revertive Mode
Non-Revertive
Mode

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


revertive mode of the protection group.
l When this parameter is set to Revertive
Mode, the NE that is in the switching
state releases the switching and enables
the former working channel to return to
the normal state some time after the
former working channel is restored to
normal.
l When this parameter is set to NonRevertive Mode, the NE that is in the
switching state keeps the current state
unchanged unless another switching
occurs even though the former working
channel is restored to normal.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Revertive Mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1455

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


WTR time.
l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
set WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when
Revertive Mode is set to Revertive
Mode.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

Enable Reverse
Switching

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the reverse switching function is
enabled.
l When both the main IF board and the
standby IF board at the sink end report
service alarms, they send the alarms to
the source end by using the MWRDI
overhead in the microwave frame. When
this parameter at the source end is set to
Enabled and the reverse switching
conditions are met, the IF 1+1 protection
switching occurs at the source end.
l This parameter is valid only when
Working Mode is set to HSB or SD.

NE Switching
Status

l This parameter indicates the switching


state on the equipment side.
l Unknown is displayed when the
switching state on the channel side is not
queried or not obtained after a query.

Channel Switching
Status

l This parameter indicates the switching


state on the channel side.
l Unknown is displayed when the
switching state on the channel side is not
queried or not obtained after a query.

Active Port of
Device

This parameter indicates the current


working board on the equipment side.

Active Port of
Channel

This parameter indicates the current


working board on the channel side.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1456

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Alarm Report
Mode

Only board alarms

l When Alarm Report Mode is set to


Only board alarms, only IF board
alarms are reported.

Only Protection
group alarms

l When Alarm Report Mode is set to


Only protection group alarms, alarms
are reported if a protection group fails or
degrades and suppress IF board alarms
and radio link alarms.

Protection group
and board alarms

l When Alarm Report Mode is set to


Protection group and board alarms, IF
board alarms and protection group
alarms are reported.
l It is recommended that you set Alarm
Report Mode to Only protection group
alarms. In this case, protection group
alarms are reported to indicate radio link
faults.
NOTE
The faulty board reports related fault alarms
regardless of parameter settings.

Anti-jitter Time

0 to 600

l When Anti-jitter Time(s) is not set to 0,


a protection group does not report an
alarm immediately after it is degraded,
but reports the alarm after the specified
anti-jitter time expires.
l It is recommended that Anti-jitter Time
(s) take its default value.

NOTE

Each of the parameters Working Mode, Revertive Mode, and WTR Time(s) must be set to the same
value at both ends of a radio hop.

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Unit

This parameter indicates the working board


and protection board.

Slot Mapping
Relation

This parameter indicates the names and


ports of the working board and protection
board.

Working Status of
Device

This parameter indicates the working state


on the equipment side.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1457

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Signal Status of
Channel

This parameter indicates the status of the


link signal.

Related Tasks
A.3.6 Querying the IF 1+1 Protection Status

B.2.7 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_Creating a PLA


Group
This topic describes the parameters for creating a PLA group.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Physical Link Aggregation from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters for Creating a PLA group


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PLA ID

1 to 7

This parameter specifies the ID of a PLA


group.

Main Board

This parameter specifies the main IF board


in a PLA group.

Main Port

This parameter specifies the main port in a


PLA group.

Board

This parameter specifies the slave IF board


in a PLA group.

Port

This parameter specifies the slave port in a


PLA group.

Selected Slave
Ports

This parameter displays the slave IF board


and slave port that have been selected.

Related Tasks
A.3.11 Creating a PLA Group

B.2.8 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_PLA


This topic describes PLA parameters.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1458

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and then choose
Configuration > Physical Link Aggregation from the Function Tree.

PLA Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PLA ID

This parameter displays the ID of a PLA


group.

Main Board

This parameter displays the main IF board


in a PLA group.

Main Port

This parameter displays the main port in a


PLA group.

Hardware Status
of Main Port

This parameter displays whether the main IF


board in a PLA group is functional.

Link Status of
Main Port

This parameter displays whether the main


link in a PLA group is functional.

Work Status of
Main Port

This parameter displays the working status


of the main port in a PLA group.

Minimum Active
Links

This parameter specifies the minimum


number of available links in a PLA group
and helps to trigger ERPS switching even if
not all members in the PLA group fail
For example, if you set Minimum Active
Links to 2, ERPS switching is triggered
when either PLA member link fails.

Slave Board

This parameter displays the slave IF board


in a PLA group.

Slave Port

This parameter displays the slave port in a


PLA group.

Hardware Status
of Slave Port

This parameter displays whether the slave IF


board in a PLA group is functional.

Link Status of
Slave Port

This parameter displays whether the slave


link in a PLA group is functional.

Work Status of
Slave Port

This parameter displays the working status


of the slave port in a PLA group.

Related Tasks
A.3.12 Querying the Status of a PLA Group

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1459

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.2.9 Parameter: Link Configuration_IF/ODU Configuration


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the IF/ODU.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE and then choose Configuration > Link
Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

Parameters for Configuring the IF


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Work Mode

1,4E1,7MHz,QPSK

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


work mode of the radio link in "work
mode number, service capacity, channel
spacing, modulation mode" format.

2,4E1,3.5MHz,
16QAM
3,8E1,14MHz,QPS
K
4,8E1,7MHz,
16QAM
5,16E1,28MHz,QP
SK

l This parameter is set according to the


network plan. The work modes of the IF
boards at the two ends of a radio link
must be the same.
NOTE
The IF1 board supports this parameter.

6,16E1,14MHz,
16QAM
7,STM-1,28MHz,
128QAM
10,22E1,14MHz,
32QAM
11,26E1,14MHz,
64QAM
12,32E1,14MHz,
128QAM
13,35E1,28MHz,
16QAM
14,44E1,28MHz,
32QAM
15,53E1,28MHz,
64QAM

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1460

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Link ID

1 to 4094

l Link ID indicates or specifies the ID of


a radio link. As the identifier of a radio
link, this parameter is used to prevent
incorrect connections of radio links
between sites.
l If the value of Received Radio Link
ID does not match the preset value of
Link ID at the local end, the local end
inserts the AIS signal to the downstream
direction of the service. At the same time,
the local end reports MW_LIM alarm to
the NMS, indicating that the link IDs do
not match.
l Link ID is set according to the network
plan. Each radio link of an NE should
have a unique link ID, and the link IDs at
both ends of a radio link should be the
same.

Received Link ID

l This parameter indicates the received ID


of the radio link.
l If the value of Received Radio Link
ID does not match the preset value of
Radio Link ID at the local end, the local
end inserts the AIS signal to the
downstream direction of the service. At
the same time, the local end reports an
alarm to the NMS, indicating that the link
IDs do not match.
l When the radio link becomes faulty, this
parameter is displayed as an invalid
value.

IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1
+ETH)
Hybrid(Native
STM-1+ETH)
SDH

Hybrid(Native E1
+ETH)

l Displays or specifies the type of services


carried by the IF board.
l If the Integrated IP radio transmits
Native E1 services, set this parameter to
Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).
l If the Integrated IP radio transmits
Native STM-1 services, set this
parameter to Hybrid(Native STM-1
+ETH).
l If the SDH radio transmits SDH services,
set this parameter to SDH.
NOTE
The ISU2 and ISX2 boards support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1461

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IF Channel
Bandwidth

3.5M

IF Channel Bandwidth indicates the


channel spacing of the corresponding radio
link. This parameter is set according to the
network plan.

7M
14M
28M

NOTE

40M

l This parameter is not applicable to the IF1


board.

56M

l The IFU2 board does not support the value


40M.
l The IFX2 board does not support the values
40M.
l IF Channel Bandwidth can be set to 3.5M
only for the ISU2 board.

AM Mode

This parameter is not applicable to the OptiX


RTN 980.

AM Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

l When AM Enable Status is set to


Disabled, the radio link uses only the
specified modulation scheme. In this
case, you need to select Manually
Specified Modulation Mode.

Enabled

l When AM Enable Status is set to


Enabled, the radio link uses the
corresponding modulation scheme
according to the channel conditions.
l Hence, the Integrated IP radio can ensure
the reliable transmission of the E1
services and provide bandwidth
adaptively for the Ethernet services
when the AM function is enabled.
l The ISX2/ISU2 does not support the AM
function when IF Service Type is
SDH.
l When IF Channel Bandwidth is 3.5M
for the ISU2 board, the AM function is
unavailable and AM Enable Status
must be set to Disabled.
NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Manually Specified
Modulation Mode

QPSK
16QAM
32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

QPSK

l This parameter specifies the modulation


scheme that the radio link uses for signal
transmission.
l This parameter is valid only when AM
Enable Status is set to Disabled.
NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1462

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Modulation Mode
of the Guarantee
AM Capacity

QPSK

QPSK

l This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.

16QAM

l Modulation Mode of the Guarantee


AM Capacity specifies the lowest-order
modulation scheme that the AM function
supports. This parameter is set according
to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the
service transmission bandwidth that the
Hybrid radio must ensure and the
availability of the radio link that
corresponds to this modulation scheme.

32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Modulation Mode
of the Full AM
Capacity

QPSK

QPSK

16QAM

l This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.
l Modulation Mode of the Full AM
Capacity specifies the highest-order
modulation scheme that the AM function
supports. This parameter is set according
to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the
bandwidth of the services that need to be
transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the
availability of the radio link that
corresponds to this modulation scheme.

32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

NOTE
Modulation Mode of the Full AM
Capacity must be higher than Modulation
Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity.
NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

STM-1 Capacity

l Specifies the STM-1 capacity of the IF


board.
l This parameter is available only when IF
Service Type is set to Hybrid(Native
STM-1+ETH) and SDH.
l If IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native
STM-1+ETH), this parameter can be set
to 0 or 1.
l If IF Service Type is SDH, this
parameter can be set to 1 or 2.
NOTE
The IF1, IFU2, and IFX2 boards do not support
this parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1463

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Guarantee E1
Capacity

l If AM Enable Status is set to Enabled,


this parameter needs to be set according
to IF Channel Bandwidth, Modulation
Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity,
and the actually transmitted services.
l If AM Enable Status is set to
Disabled, this parameter needs to be set
according to IF Channel Bandwidth,
Manually Specified Modulation
Mode, and the actually transmitted
services.
l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, this
parameter is available when IF Service
Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).
NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Guarantee E1
Capacity Range

Displays the E1 capacity range of the IF


board in guarantee capacity modulation
mode.

Data Service
Bandwidth(Mbit/
s)

Displays the data service bandwidth of the


IF board.

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether to


enable the E1 priority function.

Enabled

l This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.
l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, this
parameter is available when IF Service
Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).
NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1464

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Full E1 Capacity

l This parameter specifies the number of


transmitted E1 services in Modulation
Mode of the Full AM Capacity.
l This parameter is valid if Enable E1
Priority is set to Enabled.
l E1 service bandwidth in full capacity
mode Service bandwidth in full
capacity mode - Service bandwidth in
guarantee capacity mode + E1 service
bandwidth in guarantee capacity mode.
In addition, the number of E1 services in
full capacity modulation mode should be
smaller than or equal to the maximum
number of E1 services in full capacity
modulation mode.
l The Full E1 Capacity must be set to the
same value at both ends of a radio link.
l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, this
parameter is available when IF Service
Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).
NOTE
This parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Full E1 Capacity
Range

Displays the E1 capacity range of the IF


board in full capacity modulation mode.

Parameters for Configuring the RF


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TX Frequency
(MHz)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit frequency of the ODU, namely,
the channel central frequency.
l The value of this parameter must not be
less than the sum of the lower TX
frequency limit supported by the ODU
and a half of the channel spacing, and
must not be more than the difference
between the upper TX frequency limit
supported by the ODU and a half of the
channel spacing.
l The difference between the transmit
frequencies of both the ends of a radio
link should be one T/R spacing.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the network plan.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1465

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Range of TX
Frequency(MHz)

l This parameter indicates the range of the


transmit frequency of the ODU.
l The Range of Frequency(MHz)
depends on the specifications of the
ODU.

Actual TX
Frequency(MHz)

This parameter indicates the actual transmit


frequency of the ODU.

Actual RX
Frequency(MHz)

This parameter indicates the actual receive


frequency of the ODU.

T/R Spacing(MHz)

l This parameter specifies the spacing


between the transmit frequency and the
receive frequency of an ODU to prevent
interference between them.
l If Station Type of the ODU is TX
high, the TX frequency is one T/R
spacing higher than the receive
frequency. If Station Type of the ODU
is TX low, the TX frequency is one T/R
spacing lower than the receive
frequency.
l If the ODU supports only one T/R
spacing, set this parameter to 0,
indicating that the T/R spacing supported
by the ODU is used.
l A valid T/R spacing value is determined
by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing
should be set according to the technical
specifications of the ODU.
l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be
set to the same value at both the ends of
a radio link.

Actual T/R
Spacing(MHz)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

This parameter indicates the actual T/R


spacing of the ODU.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1466

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Configuring the Power


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TX Power(dBm)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit power of the ODU. This
parameter cannot be set to a value that
exceeds the nominal power range of the
ODU.
l This parameter cannot take a value
greater than the preset value of
Maximum Transmit Power(dBm).
l It is recommended that you set the
transmit power of the ODU to the same
value at both ends of a radio link.
l Consider the receive power of the ODU
at the opposite end when you set this
parameter. Ensure that the receive power
of the ODU at the opposite end can
ensure stable radio services.
l This parameter needs to be set according
to the network plan.

Range of TX
Power(dBm)

This parameter indicates the range of the


transmit power of the ODU.

Actual TX Power
(dBm)

l This parameter indicates the actual


transmit power of the ODU.
l If the ATPC function is enabled, the
queried actual transmit power may be
different from the preset value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1467

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Power to Be
Received(dBm)

-90.0 to -20.0

-10.0

l Power to Be Received(dBm) is used to


set the expected receive power of the
ODU and is mainly used in the antenna
alignment stage. After this parameter is
set, the NE automatically enables the
antenna misalignment indicating
function.
l When the antenna misalignment
indicating function is enabled, When the
antenna non-alignment indication
function is enabled, if the actual receive
power of the ODU is 3 dB lower than the
power expected to be received, the ODU
indicator on the IF board connected to
the ODU blinks yellow (300 ms on, 300
ms off), indicating that the antenna is not
aligned.
l After the antenna alignment, after the
state that the antenna is aligned lasts for
30 minutes, the NE automatically
disables the antenna misalignment
indicating function.
l When Power to Be Received(dBm)
takes the default value (-10.0), the
antenna misalignment indicating
function is disabled.
l This parameter is set according to the
network plan.

Actual RX Power
(dBm)

This parameter indicates the actual receive


power of the ODU.

TX Status

Unmute

Unmute

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit status of the ODU.

Mute

l When this parameter is set to Mute, the


transmitter of the ODU does not work
but can normally receive microwave
signals.
l When this parameter is set to Unmute,
the ODU can normally transmit and
receive microwave signals.
l In normal cases, it is recommended that
you set TX Status to unmute.
Actual TX Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

This parameter indicates the actual transmit


status of the ODU.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1468

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Equipment Information
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Frequency(GHz)

This parameter indicates the frequency band


where the ODU operates.

Equip Type

l This parameter indicates the equipment


type of the ODU.
l PDH and SDH indicate the transmission
capacity only and are irrelevant to the
type of transmitted service.

Station Type

l This parameter indicates whether the


ODU is a Tx high station or a Tx low
station.
l The transmit frequency of a Tx high
station is one T/R spacing higher than the
transmit frequency of a Tx low station.

Produce SN

This parameter indicates the manufacturing


serial number and the manufacturer code of
the ODU.

Transmission
Power Level

This parameter indicates the level of the


output power of the ODU.

Related Tasks
A.3.4 Configuring the IF/ODU Information of a Radio Link

B.3 Multiplex Section Protection Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to multiplex section protection (MSP).

B.3.1 Parameter Description: Linear MSP_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating linear MSP groups.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear
MS from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Create.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1469

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default
Value

Description

Protection Type

1+1 Protection

1+1 Protection

l This parameter specifies the


protection type of the linear
MSP group.

1:N Protection

l In the case of 1+1 linear MSP,


one working channel and one
protection channel are
required. When the working
channel fails, the service is
switched from the working
channel to the protection
channel.
l In the case of 1:N linear MSP,
N working channels and one
protection channel are
required. Normal services are
transmitted on the working
channels and extra services
are transmitted on the
protection channel. When one
working channel fails, the
services are switched from
this working channel to the
protection channel, and the
extra services are interrupted.
l If extra services need to be
transmitted or several
working channels are
required, select 1:N
Protection.
l This parameter is set
according to the planning
information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1470

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default
Value

Description

Switching Mode

Single-Ended
Switching

Single-Ended
Switching (1
+1 Protection)

l This parameter specifies the


switching mode of the linear
MSP.

Dual-Ended
Switching (1:N
Protection)

l In single-ended mode, the


switching occurs only at one
end and the state of the other
end remains unchanged.

Dual-Ended
Switching

l In dual-ended mode, the


switching occurs at both ends
at the same time.
l If the linear MSP type is set to
1:N Protection, Switching
Mode can be set to DualEnded Switching only.
Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive
Revertive

Non-Revertive
(1+1
Protection)

l This parameter specifies the


revertive mode of the linear
MSP.

Revertive (1:N
Protection)

l When this parameter is set to


Revertive, the NE that is in
the switching state releases
the switching and enables the
former working channel to
return to the normal state
some time after the former
working channel is restored to
normal.
l When this parameter is set to
Non-Revertive, the NE that
is in the switching state keeps
the current state unchanged
unless another switching
occurs even though the
former working channel is
restored to normal.
l It is recommended that you
set this parameter to
Revertive.
l If the linear MSP type is set to
1:N Protection, Revertive
Mode can be set to
Revertive only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1471

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default
Value

Description

WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

600

l This parameter specifies the


WTR time.
l When the time after the
former working channel is
restored to normal reaches the
preset WTR time, a revertive
switching occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s)
only when Revertive Mode
is set to Revertive.
l It is recommended that you
use the default value.

SD Enable

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or


specifies whether the
switching at the SD alarm of
the linear MSP is enabled.
l When this parameter is set to
Enabled, the B2_SD alarm is
considered as a switching
condition.
l It is recommended that you
set this parameter to
Enabled.

Protocol Type

New Protocol

New Protocol

Restructure
Protocol

l The new protocol is


supported at the early stage,
and the mainstream protocol
version is used currently.
l The restructure protocol
optimizes the new protocol
and provides better measures
to protect the new protocol,
thus ensuring that the new
protocol runs in a better
manner.
l The new protocol is more
mature, and the restructure
protocol complies with the
standard. It is recommended
that you use the new protocol.
l You must ensure that the
interconnected NEs run the
protocols of the same type.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1472

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Select Mapping
Direction

West Working Unit

West Working Unit

This parameter specifies the mapping


direction of the linear MSP.

Select Mapping
Mode

l This parameter specifies the mapping


board and port in the mapping direction.

West Protection
Unit

l If the protection type is set to 1+1


Protection, only one line port can be
mapped as West Working Unit.
l Only one line port can be mapped as
West Protection Unit.
l The line port mapped as West
Protection Unit and the line port
mapped as West Working Unit should
be configured for different boards if
possible.
-

Mapped Board

This parameter indicates the preset slot


mapping relations, including the mapping
direction and the corresponding mapping
mode.

Related Tasks
A.4.1 Configuring Linear MSP

B.3.2 Parameter Description: Linear MSP


This topic describes the parameters that are related to linear MSP groups.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear MS
from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group
ID

This parameter indicates the ID of the


protection group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1473

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

l This parameter indicates the protection


type of the linear MSP group.
l In the case of 1+1 linear MSP, one
working channel and one protection
channel are required. When the working
channel fails, the service is switched
from the working channel to the
protection channel.
l In the case of 1:N linear MSP, N working
channels and one protection channel are
required. Normal services are
transmitted on the working channels and
extra services are transmitted on the
protection channel. When one working
channel fails, the services are switched
from this working channel to the
protection channel, and the extra
services are interrupted.
l If extra services need to be transmitted
or several working channels are
required, select 1:N Protection.

Switching Mode

Single-Ended
Switching
Dual-Ended
Switching

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


switching mode of the linear MSP.
l In single-ended mode, the switching
occurs only at one end and the state of
the other end remains unchanged.
l In dual-ended mode, the switching
occurs at both ends at the same time.
l If the linear MSP type is set to 1:N
Protection, Switching Mode can be set
to Dual-Ended Switching only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1474

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


revertive mode of the linear MSP.

Revertive

l When this parameter is set to


Revertive, the NE that is in the
switching state releases the switching
and enables the former working channel
to return to the normal state some time
after the former working channel is
restored to normal.
l When this parameter is set to NonRevertive, the NE that is in the
switching state keeps the current state
unchanged unless another switching
occurs even though the former working
channel is restored to normal.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Revertive.
l If the linear MSP type is set to 1:N
Protection, Revertive Mode can be set
to Revertive only.
WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


WTR time.
l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
preset WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when
Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

SD Enable

Enabled
Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the reverse switching function
is enabled.
l When this parameter is set to Enabled,
the B2_SD alarm is considered as a
switching condition.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1475

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protocol Type

New Protocol

l The new protocol is supported at the


early stage, and the mainstream protocol
version is used currently.

Restructure Protocol

l The restructure protocol optimizes the


new protocol and provides better
measures to protect the new protocol,
thus ensuring that the new protocol runs
in a better manner.
l You must ensure that the interconnected
NEs run the protocols of the same type.
l The new protocol is more mature, and
the restructure protocol complies with
the standard. It is recommended that you
use the new protocol.
Protocol Status

This parameter indicates the protocol status


of the linear MSP.

Protection Subnet

This parameter displays the protection


subnet where the MS protection is
configured.

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Unit

This parameter indicates that which of the


units, namely, the west protection unit or the
west working unit, is currently in the
protection status.

West Line

This parameter indicates the west protection


unit and the west working unit of the linear
MSP.

West Switching
Status

This parameter indicates the switching


status of the line.

Protected Unit

This parameter indicates the working


channel protected by the current protection
channel.

Remote/Local End
Indication

When Switching Mode is set to DualEnded Switching, the central office end
that issues the switching command is
displayed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1476

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.4.2 Querying the Status of the Linear MSP

B.3.3 Parameter Description: Ring MSP_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating ring MSP groups.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ring MS from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Create.
A dialog box is displayed, prompting for confirmation.

3.

Click OK.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

STM-4

STM-4

Specifies the transmission level of ring MSP


services. The parameter value is always
STM-4.

Protection Type

2-fiber Bidirectional
Multiplex Section

2-fiber Bidirectional
Multiplex Section

Specifies the ring MSP protection type. The


parameter value is always 2-fiber
Bidirectional Multiplex Section.

Local Node

0-15

Specifies the node ID that the local NE uses


on the MSP ring. Node IDs of NEs on the
ring must be different from each other.

West Node

0-15

Specifies the node ID of the NE that is


connected to the west line board on the local
NE. The parameter value must be different
from Local Node.

East Node

0-15

Specifies the node ID of the NE that is


connected to the east line board on the local
NE. The parameter value must be different
from Local Node.

WTR Time(s)

300-720

600

l Specifies the WTR time for the local NE.


After the working channel recovers,
services are switched back from the
protection channel to the working
channel when the WTR time expires.
l Prevents frequent service switches. The
default value is recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1477

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SD Enable

Enabled

Enabled

l Specifies whether the B2_SD alarm on


the local NE functions as a switching
trigger condition. When the parameter
value is Enabled, the B2_SD alarm on
the local NE functions as a switching
trigger condition.

Disabled

l It is recommended that you set this


parameter to Enabled.
Protocol Type

New Protocol

New Protocol

Restructure Protocol

l The new MSP protocol is supported


from an early stage, and is still widely
used.
l Compared with the new MSP protocol,
the restructure MSP protocol is
optimized and more stable,
incorporating better protection
measures.
l The new MSP protocol has higher
technology maturity than the restructure
MSP protocol, and therefore is generally
recommended. The restructure MSP
protocol, however, features higher
standard compliance than the new MSP
protocol. Therefore, the restructure MSP
protocol is used when the new MSP
protocol fails to support interconnection
between Huawei RTN equipment and
third-party equipment.
l Two interconnected NEs must use the
same MSP protocol type.

Parameters for Slot Mapping Relationships


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Select Mapping
Direction

West Line 1

West Line 1

Specifies the mapping direction of a


member in a ring MSP protection group.

Select Mapping
Mode

l Specifies the mapped board and port in


the mapping direction.

East Line 1

l It is recommended that you map the


SL4D-1 port to West Line 1 and map the
SL4D-2 port to East Line 1.
Mapped Board

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Displays the configured slot mapping


relationship, including the mapping
direction and the mapping mode.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1478

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.4.5 Configuring Ring MSP

B.3.4 Parameter Description: Ring MSP


This topic describes the parameters that are related to ring MSP.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Ring MS from the Function Tree.

Protection Group Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group
ID

Displays the ID of a ring MSP protection


group.

Level

Displays the transmission level of ring MSP


services. The parameter value is always
STM-4.

Protection Type

Displays the ring MSP protection type. The


parameter value is always 2-fiber
Bidirectional Multiplex Section.

Local Node

Displays the node ID that the local NE uses


on the MSP ring.

West Node

Displays the node ID of the NE that is


connected to the west line board on the local
NE.

East Node

Displays the node ID of the NE that is


connected to the east line board on the local
NE.

WTR Time(s)

Displays the wait-to-restore (WTR) time of


the local NE. After the working channel is
restored, revertive switching occurs when
the WTR time expires.

SD Enable

Displays whether SD Enable is Enabled for


the local NE. If SD Enable is Enabled, the
B2_SD alarm is regarded as a switching
trigger condition.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1479

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protocol Type

l Displays the protocol type used by the


local NE.
l The new MSP protocol is supported
from an early stage, and is still widely
used.
l Compared with the new MSP protocol,
the restructure MSP protocol is
optimized and more stable,
incorporating better protection
measures.

Protocol Status

Displays the current protocol status of the


local NE.

Protection Subnet

Displays the current protection subnet.

Parameters for Slot Mapping Relationships


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mapping Direction

Displays the direction of an MSP ring.

Slot Mapping

Displays the slot mapping relationship in a


ring MSP protection group.

Switching Status

Displays the current switching status of the


local NE.

Related Tasks
A.4.6 Querying Ring MSP Status

B.4 SDH/PDH Service Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to SDH/PDH services.

B.4.1 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Creation


This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating point-to-point crossconnections.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH
Service Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Options to change the VC-12 timeslot numbering policy used by the crossconnection.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1480

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

B Parameters Description

Click Create.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

VC12

VC12

l This parameter specifies the level of the


service to be created.

VC3

l If the service is an E1 service or a data


service that is bound with VC-12
channels, set this parameter to VC12.

VC4

l If the service is a data service that is


bound with VC-3 channels, set this
parameter to VC3.
l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass
through the NE, set this parameter to
VC4.
Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Unidirectional

l When this parameter is set to


Unidirectional, create only the crossconnections from the service source to
the service sink.
l When this parameter is set to
Bidirectional, create the crossconnections from the service source to
the service sink and the crossconnections from the service sink to the
service source.
l In normal cases, it is recommended that
you set this parameter to Bidirectional.

Source Slot

This parameter specifies the slot of the


service source.

Source VC4

l This parameter specifies the number of


the VC-4 channel where the service
source is located.
l This parameter cannot be set when
Source Slot is set to the slot of the
tributary board.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1481

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

l This parameter indicates the timeslot


range of the service source.
l This parameter can be set to a number or
several numbers. When setting this
parameter to several numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate the discrete
numbers, or use the endash (-) to
represent a consecutive number. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l This parameter is set according to the
network plan.

Sink Slot

This parameter specifies the slot of the


service sink.

Sink VC4

l This parameter specifies the number of


the VC-4 channel where the service sink
is located.
l This parameter cannot be set when Sink
Slot is set to the slot of the tributary
board.

Sink Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

l This parameter specifies the timeslot


range of the service sink.
l This parameter can be set to a number or
several numbers. When setting this
parameter to several numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate the discrete
numbers, or use the endash (-) to
represent a consecutive number. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l This parameter is set according to the
network plan.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1482

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

E1 Priority

High

l This parameter specifies the priority of


an E1 service. This parameter is
available only if the E1 priority function
is enabled for the ports configured in the
cross-connections.

Low
None

l If E1 Priority is set to High,


transmission of the E1 service is ensured
in any modulation scheme.
l If E1 Priority is set to Low, transmission
of the E1 service is ensured only in fullcapacity modulation scheme
l If the service priority is not specified
during service creation, E1 Priority is
None. In this case, the E1 priority of a
service needs to be changed after the
service is created.
Yes

Activate
Immediately

Yes

No

l This parameter specifies whether to


immediately activate the configured
service.
l To immediately deliver the configured
SDH service to the NE, set this parameter
to Yes.

Related Tasks
A.5.1 Creating the Cross-Connections of Point-to-Point Services

B.4.2 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_SNCP


Service Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating SNCP services.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH
Service Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click Options to change the VC-12 timeslot numbering policy used by the crossconnection.

3.

Click Create SNCP Service.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Type

SNCP

SNCP

This parameter indicates that the type of the


service to be created is SNCP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1483

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

l When this parameter is set to


Unidirectional, create only the crossconnections from the SNCP service
source to the SNCP service sink.

Unidirectional

l When this parameter is set to


Bidirectional, create the crossconnections from the SNCP service
source to the service sink and the crossconnections from the SNCP service sink
to the service source.
l In normal cases, it is recommended that
you set this parameter to Bidirectional.
Level

VC12
VC3
VC4

VC12

l This parameter specifies the level of the


SCNP service to be created.
l If the service is an E1 service or a data
service that is bound with VC-12
channels, set this parameter to VC12.
l If the service is a data service that is
bound with VC-3 channels, set this
parameter to VC3.
l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass
through the NE, set this parameter to
VC4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1484

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Hold-off Time
(100ms)

0 to 100

l This parameter specifies the duration of


the hold-off time.
l When a line is faulty, SNCP switching
can be performed on the NE after a delay
of time to prevent the situation where the
NE performs SNCP switching and other
protection switching at the same time.
l Hold-off Time(100ms) is generally set
to prevent SNCP protection switching,
when SNCP works with N+1 protection.
Hold-off Time(100ms) must be longer
than the switching time of any protection
mode that works with SNCP. Generally,
Hold-off Time(100ms) is set to 200 ms.
l When SNCP works with 1+1 FD/SD,
trigger conditions for HSM switching or
SNCP switching trigger HSM switching
but do not trigger SNCP switching.
Therefore, Hold-off Time(100ms) does
not need to be set in this case.
l The switching time of 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
protection is much longer than that of
SNCP. Therefore, to shorten service
interruptions, it is recommended that you
do not set Hold-off Time(100ms) when
SNCP works with 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
protection.
l If only the SNCP scheme is available, it
is recommended that you set the hold-off
time to 0.

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive
Revertive

Non-Revertive

l This parameter specifies whether to


switch the service to the original working
channel after the fault is rectified.
l If this parameter is set to Revertive, the
service is switched from the protection
channel to the original working channel.
If this parameter is set to NonRevertive, the service is not switched
from the protection channel to the
original working channel.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Revertive.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1485

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

600

l This parameter specifies the WTR time.


l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
preset WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when
Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

Source Slot

This parameter specifies the slot of the


service source.

Source VC4

l This parameter specifies the number of


the VC-4 channel where the service
source is located.
l This parameter cannot be set when
Source Slot is set to the slot of the
tributary board.

Source Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

l This parameter indicates the timeslot


range of the service source.
l This parameter can be set to a number or
several numbers. When setting this
parameter to several numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate the discrete
numbers, or use the endash (-) to
represent a consecutive number. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Sink Slot

This parameter specifies the slot of the


service sink.

Sink VC4

l This parameter specifies the number of


the VC-4 channel where the service sink
is located.
l This parameter cannot be set when Sink
Slot is set to the slot of the tributary
board.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1486

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

l This parameter specifies the timeslot


range of the service sink.
l This parameter can be set to a number or
several numbers. When setting this
parameter to several numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate the discrete
numbers, or use the endash (-) to
represent a consecutive number. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Selected

Configure SNCP
Tangent Ring

Deselected

Deselected

l After the Configure SNCP Tangent


Ring checkbox is selected, you can
quickly configure the SNCP service for
the SNCP ring tangent point.
l In normal cases, it is recommended that
you do not select this checkbox.

Selected

Activate
Immediately

Deselected

Selected

l This parameter specifies whether to


immediately activate the configured
SNCP service.
l After the Activate Immediately
checkbox is selected, you can
immediately activate the created SNCP
service.

Related Tasks
A.5.2 Creating Cross-Connections of SNCP Services

B.4.3 Parameter Description: SDH Service


Configuration_Converting Normal Services Into SNCP Services
This topic describes the parameters that are used for converting normal services into SNCP
services.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH
Service Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Optional: If a bidirectional SDH service is created, select this service in CrossConnection. Right-click the selected service and choose Expand to Unidirectional from
the shortcut menu.

3.

Select the unidirectional service. Right-click the selected service and choose Convert to
SNCP Service from the shortcut menu.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1487

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Type

SNCP

SNCP

This parameter indicates that the type of the


service to be created is SNCP.

Direction

Unidirectional

This parameter indicates the direction of the


SNCP service.

Level

l This parameter indicates the level of the


SNCP service.
l If the service is an E1 service or a data
service that is bound with VC-12
channels, the parameter value is VC12.
l If the service is a data service that is
bound with VC-3 channels, the
parameter value is VC3.
l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass
through the NE, the parameter value is
VC4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1488

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Hold-off Time
(100ms)

0 to 100

l This parameter specifies the duration of


the hold-off time.
l When a line is faulty, SNCP switching
can be performed on the NE after a delay
of time to prevent the situation where the
NE performs SNCP switching and other
protection switching at the same time.
l Hold-off Time(100ms) is generally set
to prevent SNCP protection switching,
when SNCP works with N+1 protection.
Hold-off Time(100ms) must be longer
than the switching time of any protection
mode that works with SNCP. Generally,
Hold-off Time(100ms) is set to 200 ms.
l When SNCP works with 1+1 FD/SD,
trigger conditions for HSM switching or
SNCP switching trigger HSM switching
but do not trigger SNCP switching.
Therefore, Hold-off Time(100ms) does
not need to be set in this case.
l The switching time of 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
protection is much longer than that of
SNCP. Therefore, to shorten service
interruptions, it is recommended that you
do not set Hold-off Time(100ms) when
SNCP works with 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
protection.
l If only the SNCP scheme is available, it
is recommended that you set the hold-off
time to 0.

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive
Revertive

Non-Revertive

l This parameter specifies whether to


switch the service to the original working
channel after the fault is rectified. If this
parameter is set to "Revertive", the
service is switched from the protection
channel to the original working channel.
l If this parameter is set to Revertive, the
service is switched from the protection
channel to the original working channel.
If this parameter is set to NonRevertive, the service is not switched
from the protection channel to the
original working channel.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Revertive.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1489

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

600

l This parameter specifies the WTR time.


l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
preset WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when
Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

Source Slot

This parameter specifies the slot of the


service source.

Source VC4

l This parameter specifies the number of


the VC-4 channel where the service
source is located.
l This parameter cannot be set when
Source Slot is set to the slot of the
tributary board.

Source Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

l This parameter indicates the timeslot


range of the service source.
l This parameter can be set to a number or
several numbers. When setting this
parameter to several numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate the discrete
numbers, or use the endash (-) to
represent a consecutive number. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Sink Slot

This parameter specifies the slot of the


service sink.

Sink VC4

l This parameter specifies the number of


the VC-4 channel where the service sink
is located.
l This parameter cannot be set when Sink
Slot is set to the slot of the tributary
board.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1490

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink Timeslot
Range(e.g.1,3-6)

l This parameter specifies the timeslot


range of the service sink.
l This parameter can be set to a number or
several numbers. When setting this
parameter to several numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate the discrete
numbers, or use the endash (-) to
represent a consecutive number. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Configure SNCP
Tangent Ring

After the Configure SNCP Tangent Ring


checkbox is selected, you can quickly
configure the SNCP service for the SNCP
ring tangent point.

Activate
Immediately

l This parameter indicates whether to


immediately activate the configured
SNCP service.
l After the Activate Immediately
checkbox is selected, you can
immediately activate the created SNCP
service.

Related Tasks
A.5.7 Converting a Normal Service into an SNCP Service

B.4.4 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring SDH services (namely,
configuring cross-connections).

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service
Configuration from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1491

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Cross-Connection Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

VC12

l This parameter indicates the level of the


service.

VC3

l If the service is an E1 service or a data


service that is bound with VC-12
channels, VC12 is displayed.

VC4

l If the service is a data service that is


bound with VC-3 channels, VC3 is
displayed.
l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass
through the NE, VC4 is displayed.
Source Slot

This parameter indicates the slot of the


service source.

Source Timeslot/
Path

This parameter indicates the timeslot or


timeslot range of the service source.

Sink Slot

This parameter indicates the slot of the


source sink.

Sink Timeslot/
Path

This parameter indicates the timeslot or


timeslot range of the service sink.

E1 Priority

High

l This parameter specifies the priority of


an E1 service. This parameter is
available only if the E1 priority function
is enabled for the ports configured in the
cross-connections.

Low
None

l If E1 Priority is set to High,


transmission of the E1 service is ensured
in any modulation scheme.
l If E1 Priority is set to Low, transmission
of the E1 service is ensured only in fullcapacity modulation scheme
l If the service priority is not specified
during service creation, E1 Priority is
None. In this case, the E1 priority of a
service needs to be changed after the
service is created.
Activation Status

Yes

This parameter indicates whether to activate


the service.

No
Bound Group
Number

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Lockout Status

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1492

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Trail Name

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Schedule No.

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Parameters for Automatically Created Cross-Connections


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

VC12

l This parameter indicates the level of the


service.

VC3

l If the service is an E1 service or a data


service that is bound with VC-12
channels, VC12 is displayed.

VC4

l If the service is a data service that is


bound with VC-3 channels, VC3 is
displayed.
l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass
through the NE, VC4 is displayed.
Source Slot

This parameter indicates the slot of the


service source.

Source Timeslot/
Path

This parameter indicates the timeslot or


timeslot range of the service source.

Sink Slot

This parameter indicates the slot of the


source sink.

Sink Timeslot/
Path

This parameter indicates the timeslot or


timeslot range of the service sink.

Lockout Status

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Trail Name

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Schedule No.

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Related Tasks
A.5.9 Querying TDM Services

B.4.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control


This topic describes the parameters that are used for controlling SNCP services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1493

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SNCP Service
Control from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Type

This parameter indicates the service


protection type of the protection group.

Source

This parameter indicates the timeslots where


the working service source and protection
service source of the protection group are
located.

Sink

This parameter indicates the timeslots where


the working service sink and protection
service sink of the protection group are
located.

Level

VC12

l This parameter indicates the level of the


service.

VC3

l If the service is an E1 service or a data


service that is bound with VC-12
channels, VC12 is displayed.

VC4

l If the service is a data service that is


bound with VC-3 channels, VC3 is
displayed.
l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass
through the NE, VC4 is displayed.
Current Status

This parameter indicates the current


switching mode and switching status of the
services of the protection group.

Revertive Mode

Revertive

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


revertive mode of the service.

Non-Revertive

l This parameter determines whether to


switch the service from the protection
channel to the original working channel
after the fault is rectified.
l If this parameter is set to Revertive, the
service is switched from the protection
channel to the original working channel.
If this parameter is set to NonRevertive, the service is not switched
from the protection channel to the
original working channel.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Revertive.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1494

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(s)

300 to 720

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


WTR time.
l When the time after the former working
channel is restored to normal reaches the
preset WTR time, a revertive switching
occurs.
l You can set WTR Time(s) only when
Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

Hold-off Time
(100ms)

0 to 100

l This parameter specifies the duration of


the hold-off time.
l When a line is faulty, SNCP switching
can be performed on the NE after a delay
of time to prevent the situation where the
NE performs SNCP switching and other
protection switching at the same time.
l Hold-off Time(100ms) is generally set
to prevent SNCP protection switching,
when SNCP works with N+1 protection.
Hold-off Time(100ms) must be longer
than the switching time of any protection
mode that works with SNCP. Generally,
Hold-off Time(100ms) is set to 200 ms.
l When SNCP works with 1+1 FD/SD,
trigger conditions for HSM switching or
SNCP switching trigger HSM switching
but do not trigger SNCP switching.
Therefore, Hold-off Time(100ms) does
not need to be set in this case.
l The switching time of 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
protection is much longer than that of
SNCP. Therefore, to shorten service
interruptions, it is recommended that you
do not set Hold-off Time(100ms) when
SNCP works with 1+1 HSB/FD/SD
protection.
l If only the SNCP scheme is available, it
is recommended that you set the hold-off
time to 0.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1495

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SD Initiation
Condition

Null

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


conditions that trigger the protection
switching of the service.
l After being selected as SD Initiation
Condition, an alarm becomes a
condition for triggering switching of an
SNCP service.
l It is recommended that you set SD
Initiation Condition to the same
condition for Working Service and
Protection Service.
l The protection switching conditions in
SD Initiation Condition are optional
values not included in the default values,
and they are set according to the planning
information.

Trail Status

This parameter indicates the status of the


working service and protection service of
the protection group.

Service Grouping

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Group Type

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Active Channel

This parameter indicates whether the


working service or protection service is
currently received by the protection group.

Trail Name

Displays the trail name.

Related Tasks
A.5.5 Configuring the Automatic Switching of SNCP Services
A.5.11 Querying the Protection Status of SNCP Services

B.4.6 Parameter Description: TU_AIS Insertion


This section describes the parameters for TU_AIS insertion.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the IF board from the Object Tree and choose Alarm > Triggered
Alarm Insertion from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1496

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-1 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the slot ID of the IF board and the


ID of the IF port.

High Channel

Displays the higher order path number of the


IF board.

Low Channel

Displays the lower order path number of the


IF board.

Insert TU_AIS to
E1_AIS

Enable

Auto

l When Insert TU_AIS to E1_AIS is


Auto, the TU_AIS is automatically
inserted after the E1_AIS is detected in
the E1 channel.

Disable
Auto

l Generally, it is recommended that Auto


take its default value.

Related Tasks
A.5.4 Inserting E1_AIS upon a TU_AIS Condition
A.5.4 Inserting E1_AIS upon a TU_AIS Condition

B.5 Parameters for Board Interfaces


This topic describes the parameters that are related to board interfaces.

B.5.1 PDH Port Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to PDH ports supported by Smart E1 interface
boards.

B.5.1.1 Parameter Description: PDH Ports_Basic Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of PDH ports.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the General Attributes tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1497

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the ID of a
service port.

Name

Specifies or displays the


customized port name.

Port Mode

Layer 1

Layer 2

l Specifies the working


mode of a PDH port.

Layer 2

l When this parameter is


set to Layer 1, the port
can transmit TDM
signals. A port can
transmit CES and
serial services only if
this parameter is set to
Layer 1.
l When this parameter is
set to Layer 2, the port
can transmit ATM
signals.
Encapsulation Type

l Displays
Encapsulation Type
of a PDH port.
l When Port Mode is
Layer 1,
Encapsulation Type
takes its default value
Null.
l When Port Mode is
Layer 2,
Encapsulation Type
takes its default value
ATM.

Related Tasks
A.6.4.1 Setting Basic Attributes of Smart E1 Ports

B.5.1.2 Parameter Description: PDH Ports_Advanced Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the advanced attributes of PDH ports.

Navigation Path
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1498

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

B Parameters Description

Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of a


service port.

Frame Format

Unframe

CRC-4 Multiframe

l Specifies the frame


format.

Double Frame

l If a CES service uses


the emulation mode of
CESoPSN, this
parameter can assume
the value CRC-4
Multiframe or
Double Frame. The
value CRC-4
Multiframe is
recommended.

CRC-4 Multiframe

l If a CES service uses


the emulation mode of
SAToP, this parameter
needs to assume the
value Unframe.
l The value of Frame
Format must be the
same at the local and
opposite ends.
Line Encoding Format

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Displays the line encoding


format. The parameter
value is always HDB3.

1499

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Loopback Mode

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l Specifies the loopback


status for a port.

Inloop

l Non-Loopback
indicates that
loopbacks are
cancelled or not
performed.

Outloop

l Inloop indicates that


the signals that need to
be transmitted to the
opposite end are
looped back.
l Outloop indicates that
the received signals are
looped back.
l This function is used
for fault locating for
the PDH ports. This
function affects
services over related
ports. Therefore,
exercise precaution
before starting this
function.
l Generally, this
parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.
Impedance

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Displays the port


impedance.

1500

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Frame Mode

30(ATM)

l 30 timeslots: In an E1
frame format,
timeslots 1 to 15 and 17
to 31 are used to
transmit service data,
and timeslot 16 is used
to transmit signaling.

31(ATM,CES)

l 31 timeslots: In an E1
frame format,
timeslots 1 to 31 are
used to transmit
service data.
l This parameter is
unavailable if Frame
Format is Unframe.
l The port frame modes
need to be the same at
the local and opposite
ends.
Clock Mode

Master Mode

Master Mode

Slave Mode
System Clock Mode

l Master Mode: The


system clock is used as
the output clock of
services.
l Slave Mode: The CES
ACR clock is used as
the output clock of
services. The port
inputting E1 clocks on
Slave is set to Slave
Mode.
l System Clock Mode:
The upstream E1 line
clock of the opposite
equipment is used as
the output clock of
services. The port
inputting E1 clocks on
Master is set to System
Clock Mode

Composite Port
Loopback

For the OptiX RTN 980,


this parameter cannot be
configured.

Service Load Indication

For the OptiX RTN 980,


this parameter cannot be
configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1501

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Equalize Input Signal

For the OptiX RTN 980,


this parameter cannot be
configured.

Equalize Outpput Signal

For the OptiX RTN 980,


this parameter cannot be
configured.

Related Tasks
A.6.4.2 Setting Advanced Attributes of Smart E1 Ports

B.5.2 Parameters for the Ports on Ethernet Boards


This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet ports on the packet plane.

B.5.2.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of an Ethernet interface.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the General Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

Name

Specifies the port name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1502

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Port

Enabled

Enabled

l Specifies whether an
Ethernet port is
enabled. An Ethernet
port can receive,
process, and forward
Ethernet services only
if this parameter is set
to Enabled.

Disabled

l Set this parameter


according to the
planning information.
NOTE
Port 10 of the EFP8 board
does not support this
parameter.
Port 8 of the EMS6 board
does not support this
parameter.

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

Layer 3
Layer Mix

l Port Mode specifies


the mode of the
Ethernet port.
l If Port Mode is Layer
2, Encapsulation
Type can be set to
Null, 802.1Q, or
QinQ.
l If Port Mode is Layer
3, Encapsulation
Type can be set to
802.1Q only and the
port can carry MPLS
tunnels.
NOTE
Port 10 of the EFP8 board
does not support the value
Layer 3 and Layer Mix.
Port 8 of the EMS6 board
does not support the value
Layer 3 and Layer Mix.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1503

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Encapsulation Type

Null

l Encapsulation Type
specifies the method of
the port to process the
received packets.

802.1Q
QinQ

l If you set
Encapsulation Type
to Null, the port
transparently
transmits the received
packets.
l If you set
Encapsulation Type
to 802.1Q, the port
identifies the packets
that comply with the
IEEE 802.1q standard.
l If you set
Encapsulation Type
to QinQ, the port
identifies the packets
that comply with the
IEEE 802.1ad QinQ
standard.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1504

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

l The Ethernet ports of


different types support
different Working
Mode.

10M Half-Duplex
10M Full-Duplex
100M Half-Duplex
100M Full-Duplex
1000M Full-Duplex

l When the equipment


on the opposite side
works in autonegotiation mode, set
the Working Mode of
the equipment on the
local side to AutoNegotiation.
l When the equipment
on the opposite side
works in full-duplex
mode, set the
Working Mode of the
equipment on the local
side to 10M FullDuplex, 100M FullDuplex, or 1000M
Full-Duplex
depending on the port
rate of the equipment
on the opposite side.
l When the equipment
on the opposite side
works in half-duplex
mode, set the
Working Mode of the
equipment on the local
side to 10M HalfDuplex, 100M HalfDuplex, or AutoNegotiation
depending on the port
rate of the equipment
on the opposite side.
l GE electrical ports
support 10M fullduplex, 10M halfduplex, 100M fullduplex, 100M halfduplex, 1000M fullduplex, and autonegotiation.
l GE optical ports
support 1000M full-

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1505

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
duplex and autonegotiation.
NOTE
Port 10 of the EFP8 board
does not support this
parameter.
Port 8 of the EMS6 board
does not support this
parameter.
The logical EG2D board
does not support halfduplex.

Max Frame Length


(byte)

1518 to 9600

1522

The value of Max Frame


Length(byte) should be
greater than the length of
any frame to be
transported.

Auto-Negotiation
Ability

10M Half-Duplex

FE: 100M Full-Duplex

10M Full-Duplex

GE: 1000M Full-Duplex

l Auto-Negotiation
Ability specifies the
auto-negotiation
capability of the
Ethernet port.

100M Half-Duplex
100M Full-Duplex
1000M Full-Duplex

l For GE optical ports,


Auto-Negotiation
Ability can be set to
1000M Full-Duplex
only.
l Auto-Negotiation
Ability is valid only
when Working Mode
is set to AutoNegotiation.

Logical Port Attribute

Optical Port

Electrical Port

l This parameter
specifies the attribute
of the logical port.
l The SFP on the
EM6F,EM6FA,
CSHN board supports
the optical port and
electrical port.

Physical Port Attribute

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the attribute of the
physical port.

1506

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Traffic Monitoring
Status

Enabled

Disabled

This parameters indicates


the enabled status of the
traffic monitoring
function over an Ethernet
port.

Traffic Monitoring
Period (min)

1 to 30

15

This parameter indicates


the traffic monitoring
period.

Disabled

Related Tasks
A.6.6.1 Setting the General Attributes of Ethernet Ports

B.5.2.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control


This topic describes the parameters that are related to flow control.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Flow Control tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1507

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Non-Autonegotiation
Flow Control Mode

Disabled

Disabled

l Non-Autonegotiation
Flow Control Mode is
valid only when
Working Mode is not
set to AutoNegotiation.

Enable Symmetric Flow


Control

l Non-Autonegotiation
Flow Control Mode
of the equipment on
the local side must be
consistent with the
non-autonegotiation
flow control mode of
the equipment on the
opposite side
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports only two nonauto-negotiation flow
control modes,
namely, Disabled
mode and Enable
Symmetric Flow
Control mode.
NOTE
Port 10 of the EFP8 board
does not support this
parameter.
Port 8 of the EMS6 board
does not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1508

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Auto-Negotiation Flow
Control Mode

Disabled

Disabled

l Auto-Negotiation
Flow Control Mode is
valid only when
Working Mode is set
to Auto-Negotiation.

Enable Symmetric Flow


Control

l Auto-Negotiation
Flow Control Mode
of the equipment on
the local side must be
consistent with the
auto-negotiation flow
control mode of the
equipment on the
opposite side
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports only two
auto-negotiation flow
control modes,
namely, Disabled
mode and Enable
Symmetric Flow
Control mode.
NOTE
Port 10 of the EFP8 board
does not support this
parameter.
Port 8 of the EMS6 board
does not support this
parameter.

Related Tasks
A.6.6.2 Configuring the Traffic Control of Ethernet Ports

B.5.2.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Layer 2 Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 2 attributes.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Layer 2 Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


NOTE

The parameter Layer 2 Attributes is meaningful only when Port Mode is set to Layer 2.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1509

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port name.

QinQ Type Domain

l When Encapsulation
Type in the General
Attributes tab page is
set to QinQ, you need
to set QinQ Type
Domain. The default
value is 88A8.
l When Encapsulation
Type in the General
Attributes tab page is
set to Null or 802.1Q,
you cannot set QinQ
Type Domain. In this
case, QinQ Type
Domain is displayed
as FFFF and cannot be
changed.
l QinQ Type Domain
should be set to the
same value for all the
ports on the EM6T/
EM6TA/EM6F/
EM6FA board or the
EG2D logical board.

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Access
Hybrid

l If all the accessed


services are frames
with the VLAN tag
(tagged frames), set
TAG to Tag Aware.
l If all the accessed
services are frames
without the VLAN tag
(untagged frames), set
TAG to Access.
l If the accessed
services contain
tagged frames and
untagged frames, set
TAG to Hybrid.
NOTE
TAG specifies the TAG
flag of a port. For details
about the TAG flags and
associated frameprocessing methods, see
Table B-2.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1510

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Default VLAN ID

1 to 4094

l Default VLAN ID is
valid only when TAG
is set to Access or
Hybrid.
l Default VLAN ID is
set according to the
actual situations.
NOTE
For details about the
functions of Default VLAN
ID, see Table B-2.

VLAN Priority

0 to 7

l VLAN Priority is
valid only when TAG
is set to Access or
Hybrid.

l When the VLAN


priority is required to
divide streams or to be
used for other
purposes, VLAN
Priority is set
according to the
planning information.
In normal cases, it is
recommended that you
use the default value.
NOTE
For details about the
functions of VLAN
Priority, see Table B-2.

Table B-2 Methods used by Ethernet interfaces to process data frames


Port

Ingress UNI

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag Aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

The port receives the


frame.

The port discards


the frame.

The port receives


the frame.

Untagged frame

The port discards the


frame.

The ports add the


VLAN tag, to which
Default VLAN ID
and VLAN
Priority
correspond, to the
frame and receive
the frame.

The ports add the


VLAN tag, to which
Default VLAN ID
and VLAN
Priority
correspond, to the
frame and receive
the frame.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1511

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Port

Egress UNI

B Parameters Description

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag Aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

The port transmits


the frame.

The port strips the


VLAN tag from the
frame and then
transmits the frame.

l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
Default VLAN
ID, the port
strips the VLAN
tag from the
frame and then
transmits the
frame.
l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
not Default
VLAN ID, the
port directly
transmits the
frame.

Related Tasks
A.6.6.3 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of Ethernet Ports

B.5.2.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_Layer 3 Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 3 attributes of Ethernet ports.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Layer 3 Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


NOTE

Layer 3 Attributes is valid only if Port Mode is set to Layer 3.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1512

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Tunnel

Disabled

Enabled

l If Enable Tunnel is set


Enabled, a port
identifies and
processes MPLS
labels.

Enabled

l Enable Tunnel is
available if you set
Port Mode to Layer 3
in the General
Attributes tab.
Specify IP Address

Manually

Unspecified

Unspecified

l Specifies the method of


setting the IP address
of a port.
l The value
Unspecified indicates
that the IP addresses do
not need to be
configured.
l The value Manually
indicates that the IP
address of the port can
be manually
configured.

IP Address

0.0.0.0

l Specifies the IP
address of a port.
l This parameter is
available when Specify
IP Address is
Manually.
l The IP addresses of
different ports on the
NE cannot be in the
same network
segment, but the IP
addresses of the ports
at both ends of the
MPLS tunnel must be
in the same network
segment.

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

l Specifies the subnet


mask of a port.
l This parameter is
available when Specify
IP Address is
Manually.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1513

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.6.6.4 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of Ethernet Ports

B.5.2.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Advanced Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port name.

Port Physical
Parameters

This parameter indicates


the physical parameters of
the port.

MAC Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l This parameter
specifies the loopback
state at the MAC layer.
When this parameter is
set to Inloop, the
Ethernet signals
transmitted to the
opposite end are
looped back.

Inloop

l In normal cases, it is
recommended that you
use the default value.
PHY Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

Inloop

l This parameter
specifies the loopback
state at the PHY layer.
When this parameter is
set to Inloop, the
Ethernet signals
transmitted to the
opposite end are
looped back.
l In normal cases, it is
recommended that you
use the default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1514

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

MAC Address

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
port.

Transmitting Rate(kbit/
s)

This parameter indicates


the rate at which the data
packets are transmitted.

Receiving Rate(kbit/s)

This parameter indicates


the rate at which the data
packets are received.

Loopback Check

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter specifies


whether to enable loop
detection, which is used to
check whether a loop
exists on the port.

Disabled

This parameter indicates


whether to enable the loop
port shutdown function.

Disabled

Loopback Port Block

Enabled
Disabled

Egress PIR Bandwidth


(Kbit/s)

This parameter indicates


the egress PIR bandwidth.

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter
specifies whether to
limit the traffic rate of
the broadcast packets
according to the
proportion of the
broadcast packets in
the total packets.
When the equipment at
the opposite end may
encounter a broadcast
storm, this parameter
is set to Enabled.

Enabled

l If Ethernet services are


E-LAN services, the
recommended value is
Enabled.
l This parameter takes
effect only for E-LAN
services in the ingress
direction.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1515

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Broadcast Packet
Suppression Threshold

0 to 100

30

When the proportion of


the broadcast packets in
the total packets exceeds
the value of this
parameter, the received
broadcast packets are
discarded. The value of
this parameter should be
more than the proportion
of the broadcast packets in
the total packets before
the broadcast storm
occurs. In normal cases,
this parameter is set to
default value.

Network Cable Mode

This parameter displays


the working mode of the
network cable connected
to an Ethernet port.

Related Tasks
A.6.6.5 Setting the Advanced Attributes of Ethernet Ports

B.5.3 Serial Port Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to serial ports.

B.5.3.1 Parameter Description: Serial Port_Basic Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of series ports.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Serial Port from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the General Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the


port where a serial service
is configured.

Name

Specifies or displays the


customized port name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1516

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

l Specifies or displays
the serial port level.
l 64K Timeslot: 64 kbit/
s timeslots of E1
signals can be bound.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports 64K Timeslot
only.

Used Port

Displays the physical port


that carries a serial
service.

64K Timeslot

Displays the timeslots that


a serial service occupies.
The timeslots can be
consecutive or not.

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 3

l Displays or specifies
the port mode.

Layer 3

l A port supports ATM


encapsulation if its
Port Mode is Layer
2. A port does not
support encapsulation
if its Port Mode is
Layer 3.
Encapsulation Type

l Displays and specifies


the encapsulation type
of a PW.
l When Port Mode is
Layer 2, this
parameter displays
ATM; when Port
Mode is Layer 3, this
parameter displays
Null.

Related Tasks
A.6.5.2 Setting Basic Attributes of Serial Ports

B.5.3.2 Parameter Description: Serial Port_Creation of Serial Ports


This topic describes parameters that are used for creating serial ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1517

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the New tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Number(e.g:1,3-6)

Specifies the port where


the serial service is
configured.

Name

Specifies the customized


port name.

Level

64K Timeslot

64K Timeslot

l Specifies the serial


port level.
l When this parameter is
set to 64K Timeslot ,
E1 timeslots can be
bound.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only the parameter
value 64K Timeslot .

Used Board

Specifies the board where


a serial port is located.

Used Port

Displays the board where


a serial port is located.

High Channel

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Low Channel(e.g:1,3-6)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

64K Timeslot(e.g:1,3-6)

Specifies the 64 kbit/s


timeslots to be bound with
the serial port. The
timeslots can be
consecutive or not.

Related Tasks
A.6.5.1 Creating Serial Ports

B.5.4 Microwave Interface Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF_ETH interfaces.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1518

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.5.4.1 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Basic Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of microwave
interfaces.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Basic Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF port.

Name

This parameter indicates or specifies the


customized port name.

Port Mode

Layer 2

Layer 2

l If Port Mode is Layer 2, Encapsulation


Type can be set to Null, 802.1Q, or
QinQ.

Layer 3
Layer Mix

l If Port Mode is Layer 3, Encapsulation


Type can be set to 802.1Q only and the
port can carry tunnels.
l If Port Mode is Layer Mix,
Encapsulation Type can be set to only
802.1Q or QinQ and the port can carry
both tunnels and Native Ethernet
services.

Null

Encapsulation
Type

802.1Q
QinQ

802.1Q

l Encapsulation Type specifies the


method of the port to process the
received packets.
l If Encapsulation Type is set to Null, the
port transparently transmits the received
packets.
l If Encapsulation Type is set to
802.1Q, the port identifies the packets
that comply with the IEEE 802.1Q
standard.
l If Encapsulation Type is set to QinQ,
the port identifies the packets that
comply with the IEEE 802.1ad QinQ
standard.

Related Tasks
A.6.7.1 Setting the General Attributes of IF_ETH Ports
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1519

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.5.4.2 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2 Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 2 attributes of microwave
interfaces.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Layer 2 Attributes tab.

Parameters for Layer 2 Attributes


NOTE

The parameter Layer 2 Attributes is meaningful only when Port Mode is set to Layer 2.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF port.

QinQ Type
Domain

l When Encapsulation Type in the


General Attributes tab page is set to
QinQ, you need to set QinQ Type
Domain. The default value is 88A8.
l When Encapsulation Type in the
General Attributes tab page is set to
Null or 802.1Q, you cannot set QinQ
Type Domain. In this case, QinQ Type
Domain is displayed as FFFF and
cannot be changed.

Tag

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

Access
Hybrid

l If all the accessed services are frames


that contain the VLAN tag (tagged
frames), set Tag to "Tag Aware".
l If all the accessed services are frames
that do not contain the VLAN tag
(untagged frames), set Tag to "Access".
l If the accessed services contain tagged
frames and untagged frames, set Tag to
"Hybrid".
NOTE
Tag specifies the TAG flag of a port. For details
about the TAG flags and associated frameprocessing methods, see Table B-3.

Default VLAN ID

1 to 4094

l Default VLAN ID is valid only when


TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l Default VLAN ID needs to be set
according to the actual situations.
NOTE
For details about the functions of Default VLAN
ID, see Table B-3.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1520

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN Priority

l VLAN Priority is valid only when


TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.

l When the VLAN priority is required to


divide streams or to be used for other
purposes, VLAN Priority needs to be set
according to the planning information. In
normal cases, it is recommended that you
use the default value.

2
3
4
5
6

NOTE
For details about the functions of VLAN
Priority, see Table B-3.

Table B-3 Data frame processing


Status

Ingress Port

Egress Port

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag Aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

The port receives the


frame.

The port discards


the frame.

The port receives


the frame.

Untagged frame

The port discards the


frame.

The port receives


the frame after the
VLAN tag that
corresponds to
"Default VLAN ID"
and "VLAN
Priority" is added to
the frame.

The port receives


the frame after the
VLAN tag that
corresponds to
"Default VLAN ID"
and "VLAN
Priority" is added to
the frame.

Tagged frame

The port transmits


the frame.

The port strips the


VLAN tag from the
frame and then
transmits the frame.

l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
"Default VLAN
ID", the port
strips the VLAN
tag from the
frame and then
transmits the
frame.
l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
not "Default
VLAN ID", the
port directly
transmits the
frame.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1521

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.6.7.2 Setting the Layer 2 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports

B.5.4.3 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 3 Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 3 attributes of an IF_ETH port.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Layer 3 Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the
corresponding IF port.

Enable Tunnel

Disabled

Disabled

l A port identifies and


processes MPLS
labels, if its Enable
Tunnel is set
Enabled.

Enabled

l Enable Tunnel is
available if you set
Port Mode to Layer
3 in the General
Attributes tab.
Specify IP Address

Manually

Unspecified

Unspecified

l Specifies the method


of setting the IP
address of a port.
l The value
Unspecified indicates
that the IP addresses do
not need to be
configured for a port.
l The value Manually
indicates that the IP
address of a port can be
manually configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1522

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP Address

0.0.0.0

l Specifies the IP
address for a port.
l This parameter is
available when
Specify IP Address is
Manually.
l The IP addresses of
different ports on the
NE cannot be in the
same network
segment, but the IP
addresses of the ports
at both ends of the
MPLS tunnel must be
in the same network
segment.

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

l Specifies the subnet


mask of a port.
l This parameter is
available when
Specify IP Address is
Manually.

Related Tasks
A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of IF_ETH Ports

B.5.4.4 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Advanced Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the advanced attributes of microwave
interfaces.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters for Advanced Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1523

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Radio Link ID

1 to 4094

l This parameter specifies the ID of the


radio link. As the identifier of a radio
link, this parameter is used to prevent
incorrect connections of radio links
between sites.
l The ID of each radio link of an NE must
be unique, and the link IDs at both ends
of a radio link must be the same.

Received Radio
Link ID

l This parameter indicates the received ID


of the radio link.
l If the value of Received Radio Link
ID does not match with the preset value
of Radio Link ID at the local end, the
local end inserts the AIS signal to the
downstream direction of the service. At
the same time, the local end reports an
alarm to the NMS, indicating that the link
IDs do not match.

IF Port Loopback

l This parameter indicates the loopback


status of the IF interface.
l Non-Loopback indicates that the
loopback is cancelled or not performed.
l Inloop indicates that the IF signals
transmitted to the opposite end are
looped back.
l Outloop indicates that the received IF
signals are looped back.
l Generally, this parameter is used to
locate the faults that occur at each IF
interface. The IF loopback is used for
diagnosis. If this function is enabled, the
services at the related ports are affected.
In normal cases, this parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.

Composite Port
Loopback

l This parameter indicates the loopback


status on the composite interface.
l Non-Loopback indicates that the
loopback is cancelled or not performed.
l Inloop indicates that the composite
signals transmitted to the opposite end
are looped back.
l Outloop indicates that the received
composite signals are looped back.
l In normal cases, this parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1524

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Error Frame
Discard Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to discard the Ethernet frame
when a CRC error occurs in an Ethernet
frame.

Disabled

l If the Ethernet service transmitted on the


IF_ETH port is a voice service or a video
service, you can set this parameter to
Disabled.
MAC Address

This parameter indicates the MAC address


of the port.

Transmitting Rate
(Kbit/s)

This parameter indicates the transmit rate of


the local port.

Receiving Rate
(Kbit/s)

This parameter indicates the receive rate of


the local port.

MAC Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l This parameter specifies the loopback


state at the MAC layer. When this
parameter is set to Inloop, the Ethernet
signals transmitted to the opposite end
are looped back.

Inloop

l In normal cases, it is recommended that


you use the default value.
NOTE
The ISU2 and ISX2 boards can not be set to
Inloop.

Speed
Transmission at
L2

Disabled
Enabled

Disabled

l If Speed Transmission at L2 is set to


Enabled, the Layer-2 Ethernet packets
transmitted at microwave ports will be
compressed to improve transmission
efficiency.
l If the Layer 2 header compression
function can be enabled for the ISU2 or
ISX2 board, it is recommended that you
set Speed Transmission at L2 to
Enabled.
l The settings of Speed Transmission at
L2 must be the same at both ends of a
radio link.
NOTE
The ISU2 and ISX2 boards support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1525

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Speed
Transmission at
L3

Disabled

Disabled

l If Speed Transmission at L3 is set to


Enabled, the IP packets transmitted at
microwave ports will be compressed to
improve transmission efficiency.

Enabled

l If the Layer 3 header compression


function can be enabled for the ISU2 or
ISX2 board, it is recommended that you
set Speed Transmission at L3 to
Enabled.
l The settings of Speed Transmission at
L3 must be the same at both ends of a
radio link.
NOTE
l The ISU2 and ISX2 boards support this
parameter.
l When Speed Transmission at L3 is set to
Enabled, Encapsulation Type of the ISU2
and ISX2 boards cannot be set to Null.

Loopback Check

Disabled

Disabled

This parameter specifies whether to enable


loop detection, which is used to check
whether a loop exists on the port.

Disabled

This parameter indicates whether to enable


the automatic shut-down of looped ports.

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether to limit


the traffic rate of the broadcast packets
according to the proportion of the
broadcast packets in the total packets.
When the equipment at the opposite end
may encounter a broadcast storm, this
parameter is set to Enabled.

Enabled
Loopback Port
Shutdown

Disabled

Enabling
Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Disabled

Enabled

Enabled

l If Ethernet services are E-LAN services,


the recommended value is Enabled.
l This parameter takes effect only for ELAN services in the ingress direction.
Enabling
Broadcast Packet
Suppression
Threshold

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

0 to 100

30

When the proportion of the broadcast


packets in the total packets exceeds the value
of this parameter, the received broadcast
packets are discarded. The value of this
parameter should be more than the
proportion of the broadcast packets in the
total packets before the broadcast storm
occurs. In normal cases, this parameter is set
to default value.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1526

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.6.7.4 Setting the Advanced Attributes of IF_ETH Ports

B.5.5 IF Board Parameters


This topic describes parameters that are related to IF boards.

B.5.5.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF attributes.

Navigation Path
l

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.

Click the IF Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF interface.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1527

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Radio Link ID

1,4E1,7MHz,QPSK

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


work mode of the radio link in "work
mode number, service capacity, channel
spacing, modulation mode" format.

2,4E1,3.5MHz,
16QAM
3,8E1,14MHz,QPS
K

l This parameter is set according to the


network plan. The work modes of the IF
boards at the two ends of a radio link
must be the same.

4,8E1,7MHz,
16QAM
5,16E1,28MHz,QP
SK

NOTE
The IF1 board supports this parameter.

6,16E1,14MHz,
16QAM
7,STM-1,28MHz,
128QAM
10,22E1,14MHz,
32QAM
11,26E1,14MHz,
64QAM
12,32E1,14MHz,
128QAM
13,35E1,28MHz,
16QAM
14,44E1,28MHz,
32QAM
15,53E1,28MHz,
64QAM
IF Service Type

Hybrid(Native E1
+ETH)
Hybrid(Native
STM-1+ETH)
SDH

Hybrid(Native E1
+ETH)

l Displays or specifies the type of services


carried by the IF board.
l If the Integrated IP radio transmits
Native E1 services, set this parameter to
Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).
l If the Integrated IP radio transmits
Native STM-1 services, set this
parameter to Hybrid(Native STM-1
+ETH).
l If the SDH radio transmits SDH services,
set this parameter to SDH.
NOTE
The ISU2 and ISX2 boards support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1528

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Radio Link ID

1 to 4094

l Link ID indicates or specifies the ID of


a radio link. As the identifier of a radio
link, this parameter is used to prevent
incorrect connections of radio links
between sites.
l If the value of Received Radio Link
ID does not match the preset value of
Link ID at the local end, the local end
inserts the AIS signal to the downstream
direction of the service. At the same
time, the local end reports MW_LIM
alarm to the NMS, indicating that the link
IDs do not match.
l Link ID is set according to the network
plan. Each radio link of an NE should
have a unique link ID, and the link IDs
at both ends of a radio link should be the
same.

Received Radio
Link ID

l This parameter indicates the received ID


of the radio link.
l If the value of Received Radio Link
ID does not match the preset value of
Radio Link ID at the local end, the local
end inserts the AIS signal to the
downstream direction of the service. At
the same time, the local end reports an
alarm to the NMS, indicating that the link
IDs do not match.
l When the radio link becomes faulty, this
parameter is displayed as an invalid
value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1529

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IF Port Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


loopback status of the IF interface.

Inloop

l Non-Loopback indicates that the


loopback is cancelled or not performed.

Outloop

l Inloop indicates that the IF signals


transmitted to the opposite end are
looped back.
l Outloop indicates that the received IF
signals are looped back.
l Generally, IF Port Loopback is used to
locate the faults that occur at each IF
interface. The IF loopback is used for
diagnosis. If this function is enabled, the
services at the related ports are affected.
In normal cases, this parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.
2M Wayside
Enable Statusa

Disabled

Disabled

Enabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the radio link transmits the
wayside E1 service.
l The wayside E1 service can be supported
by the IF1 board in the
7,STM-1,28MHz,128QAM,
8,E3,28MHz,QPSK, or 9,E3,14MHz,
16QAM mode.

2M Wayside Input
Boarda

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


slot in which the 2M wayside service is
accessed.
l This parameter can be set only when 2M
Wayside Enable Status is set to
Enabled.
l The wayside E1 service can be supported
by the IF1 board in the
7,STM-1,28MHz,128QAM,
8,E3,28MHz,QPSK, or 9,E3,14MHz,
16QAM mode.

350 MHz
Consecutive Wave
Status

Stop
Start

Stop

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


status of transmitting the 350 MHz
carrier signals at the IF interface.
l 350 MHz Consecutive Wave Status
can be set to Start in the commissioning
process only. In normal cases, this
parameter is set to Stop. Otherwise, the
services are interrupted.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1530

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

XPIC Enabledb

Enabled

Enabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the XPIC function of the XPIC
IF board is enabled.

Disabled

l If the XPIC IF board does not perform


the XPIC function, XPIC Enabled
should be set to Disabled.
Enable IEEE-1588
Timeslotc

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

Enable IEEE-1588 Timeslot needs to be


set consistently between two ends of a radio
link.

NOTE

l a. The IFU2 and IFX2 boards do not support way-side services.


l b. The IFU2, ISU2, and IF1 boards do not support the XPIC function.
l c. The IF1 board does not support the IEEE-1588 timeslot function.

Parameters for Hybrid/AM Configuration


NOTE

The IF1 board does not support Hybrid/AM configuration.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF port.

IF Channel
Bandwidth

3.5M

IF Channel Bandwidth indicates the


channel spacing of the corresponding radio
link. This parameter is set according to the
network plan.

7M
14M
28M
40M
56M

NOTE
l This parameter is not applicable to the IF1
board.
l The IFU2 board does not support the value
40M.
l The IFX2 board does not support the values
40M.
l IF Channel Bandwidth can be set to 3.5M
only for the ISU2 board.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1531

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

AM Enable Status

Disabled

Disabled

l When AM Enable Status is set to


Disabled, the radio link uses only the
specified modulation scheme. In this
case, you need to select Manually
Specified Modulation Mode.

Enabled

l When AM Enable Status is set to


Enabled, the radio link uses the
corresponding modulation scheme
according to the channel conditions.
l Hence, the Integrated IP radio can ensure
the reliable transmission of the E1
services and provide bandwidth
adaptively for the Ethernet services
when the AM function is enabled.
l The ISX2/ISU2 does not support the AM
function when IF Service Type is
SDH.
l When IF Channel Bandwidth is 3.5M
for the ISU2 board, the AM function is
unavailable and AM Enable Status
must be set to Disabled.
Modulation Mode
of the Guarantee
AM Capacity

QPSK
16QAM
32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

QPSK

l This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.
l Modulation Mode of the Guarantee
AM Capacity specifies the lowest-order
modulation scheme that the AM function
supports. This parameter is set according
to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the
service transmission bandwidth that the
Hybrid radio must ensure and the
availability of the radio link that
corresponds to this modulation scheme.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1532

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Modulation Mode
of the Full AM
Capacity

QPSK

QPSK

l This parameter is valid only when AM


Enable Status is set to Enabled.

16QAM

l Modulation Mode of the Full AM


Capacity specifies the highest-order
modulation scheme that the AM function
supports. This parameter is set according
to the network plan. Generally, the value
of this parameter is determined by the
bandwidth of the services that need to be
transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the
availability of the radio link that
corresponds to this modulation scheme.

32QAM
64QAM
128QAM
256QAM

NOTE
Modulation Mode of the Full AM
Capacity must be higher than Modulation
Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity.

Manually
Specified
Modulation Mode

QPSK

QPSK

16QAM
32QAM

l This parameter specifies the modulation


scheme that the radio link uses for signal
transmission.
l This parameter is valid only when AM
Enable Status is set to Disabled.

64QAM
128QAM
256QAM
STM-1 Capacity

l Specifies the STM-1 capacity of the IF


board.
l This parameter is available only when IF
Service Type is set to Hybrid(Native
STM-1+ETH) and SDH.
l If IF Service Type is Hybrid(Native
STM-1+ETH), this parameter can be set
to 0 or 1.
l If IF Service Type is SDH, this
parameter can be set to 1 or 2.
NOTE
The IFU2 and IFX2 boards do not support this
parameter.

Enable E1 Priority

Disabled
Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether to


enable the E1 priority function.
l This parameter is valid only when AM
Enable Status is set to Enabled.
l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, this
parameter is available when IF Service
Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1533

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Guarantee E1
Capacity

l If AM Enable Status is set to Enabled,


this parameter needs to be set according
to IF Channel Bandwidth, Modulation
Mode of the Guarantee AM Capacity,
and the actually transmitted services.
l If AM Enable Status is set to
Disabled, this parameter needs to be set
according to IF Channel Bandwidth,
Manually Specified Modulation
Mode, and the actually transmitted
services.
l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, this
parameter is available when IF Service
Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).

Guarantee E1
Capacity Range

Displays the E1 capacity range of the IF


board in guarantee capacity modulation
mode.

Data Service
Bandwidth(Mbit/
s)

Displays the data service bandwidth of the


IF board.

Full E1 Capacity

l This parameter specifies the number of


transmitted E1 services in Modulation
Mode of the Full AM Capacity.
l This parameter is valid if Enable E1
Priority is set to Enabled.
l E1 service bandwidth in full capacity
mode Service bandwidth in full
capacity mode - Service bandwidth in
guarantee capacity mode + E1 service
bandwidth in guarantee capacity mode.
In addition, the number of E1 services in
full capacity modulation mode should be
smaller than or equal to the maximum
number of E1 services in full capacity
modulation mode.
l The Full E1 Capacity must be set to the
same value at both ends of a radio link.
l For the ISU2 and ISX2 boards, this
parameter is available when IF Service
Type is Hybrid(Native E1+ETH).

Full E1 Capacity

Displays the E1 capacity range of the IF


board in full capacity modulation mode.

Transmit-End
Modulation Mode

Displays the modulation mode at the


transmit mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1534

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Receive-End
Modulation Mode

Displays the modulation mode at the receive


mode.

Guarantee AM
Service Capacity
(Mbit/s)

Displays the guarantee AM service capacity.

Full AM Service
Capacity(Mbit/s)

Displays the full AM service capacity.

Transmitted AM
Service Capacity
(Mbit/s)

Displays the transmitted AM service


capacity.

Received AM
Service Capacity
(Mbit/s)

Displays the received AM service capacity.

E1 Capacity For
High Priority

Displays the number of configured highpriority E1s.

Related Tasks
A.6.8.1 Setting IF Attributes
A.6.8.4 Querying the AM Status
A.6.8.6 Modifying the Hybrid/AM Attributes
A.12.4 Configuring the Wayside E1 Service

B.5.5.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the ATPC attributes.

Navigation Path
l

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.

Click the ATPC Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF interface.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1535

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ATPC Enable
Status

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


ATPC function is enabled.

Enabled

l When this parameter is set to Enabled


and if the RSL at the receive end is 2 dB
higher or lower than the central value
between the ATPC upper threshold and
the ATPC lower threshold at the receive
end, the receiver notifies the transmitter
to decrease or increase the transmit
power until the RSL is within the range
that is 2 dB higher or lower than the
central value between the ATPC upper
threshold and the ATPC lower threshold.
l The settings of the ATPC attributes must
be consistent at both ends of a radio link.
l In the case of areas where fast fading
severely affects the radio transmission, it
is recommended that you set ATPC
Enable Status to Disabled.
l During the commissioning process, set
this parameter to Disabled to ensure that
the transmit power is not changed. After
the commissioning, re-set the ATPC
attributes.
ATPC Upper
Threshold(dBm)

-45.0

ATPC Lower
Threshold(dBm)

-70.0

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

l Set the central value between the ATPC


upper threshold and the ATPC lower
threshold to a value for the expected
receive power.
l It is recommended that you set ATPC
Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of
the planned central value between the
ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC
lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC
Lower Threshold(dBm) to the
difference between the planned central
value between the ATPC upper threshold
and the ATPC lower threshold and 10
dB.
l You can set the ATPC upper threshold
only when ATPC Automatic
Threshold(dBm) is set to Disabled.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1536

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ATPC Automatic
Threshold Enable
Status

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies whether the


ATPC automatic threshold function is
enabled.

Disabled

l If ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable


Status is set to Enabled, the equipment
automatically uses the preset ATPC
upper and lower thresholds according to
the work mode of the radio link.
l If ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable
Status is set to Disabled, you need to
manually set ATPC Upper Automatic
Threshold(dBm) and ATPC Lower
Automatic Threshold(dBm).
ATPC Upper
Automatic
Threshold(dBm)

ATPC Lower
Automatic
Threshold(dBm)

l This parameter indicates that the


equipment automatically uses the preset
ATPC upper and lower thresholds.
l This parameter is valid only when ATPC
Automatic Threshold Enable Status is
set to Enabled.

Related Tasks
A.6.8.2 Configuring ATPC Attributes

B.5.5.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid_AM Configuration_Advanced Attributes


This section describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes.

Navigation Path
l

In the NE Explorer, select the IF board, and then choose Configuration > IF Interface
from the Function Tree.

Click the AM Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


IF interface.

Modulation Mode

Displays the modulation schemes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1537

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

E1 Capacity

l You can specify the number of E1s that


can be transmitted in intermediate
modulation scheme, by setting the
advanced attributes correspondingly.
l Generally, it is recommended that this
parameter takes the default value. To
ensure that a specific number of E1s can
be transmitted in intermediate
modulation scheme, adjust the E1
capacity in each modulation scheme
according to the network planning
information.
l If the E1 priority function is enabled, the
maximum number of allowed E1
services in the current mode = Min
{[Bandwidth of the air interface in the
current mode - (Bandwidth for the
assured capacity - Assured E1 number x
2Mbps)]/2Mbps, E1 number in the
highest-gain modulation mode}.

Data Service
Bandwidth(Mbit/
s)

Displays the data service bandwidth.

Related Tasks
A.6.8.3 Setting Advanced AM Attributes

B.5.5.4 Parameter Description: ATPC Adjustment Records


This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATPC adjustment records.

Navigation Path
Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > ATPC Adjustment Records from the Function Tree.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the port for the


ATPC adjustment.

Event NO.

This parameter indicates the number of the


ATPC adjustment event.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1538

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Adjustment Time

This parameter indicates the time of the


ATPC adjustment.

Adjustment
Direction

This parameter indicates the direction of the


adjustment at the port.

Switchover

This parameter indicates the switching


operation at the port.

Transmitted
Power(dBm)

This parameter indicates the transmitted


power of the port to be switched.

Received Power
(dBm)

This parameter indicates the received power


of the port to be switched.

Related Tasks
A.6.8.5 Querying ATPC Adjustment Records

B.5.5.5 Parameter Description: PRBS Test


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the pseudorandom binary sequence (PRBS)
test.

Navigation Path
Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > PRBS Test from the Function Tree.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the port for the


PRBS test.

Direction

Cross

Cross

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


direction of the PRBS test.

Tributary

l In the tributary direction, the PRBS test


is performed to check the connectivity of
the cable from the tributary board to the
DDF.
l In the cross-connect direction, the PRBS
test is performed to check the processing
of the service from the tributary board to
the NE at the remote end.
Duration

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

1 to 255

This parameter indicates or specifies the


duration of the PRBS test.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1539

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Measured Time

This parameter indicates or specifies the


time unit used for the PRBS test.

10min
h
Start Time

This parameter indicates the start time of the


PRBS test.

Progress

This parameter indicates the progress


percentage of the PRBS test.

Total PRBS

This parameter indicates the number of bit


errors that occur in the PRBS test.

Accumulating
Mode

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies whether to display


the values in accumulative mode. If
Accumulating Mode is selected, it
indicates that the values are displayed in
accumulative mode.

Deselected

B.5.6 ODU Parameters


This topic describes parameters that are related to ODUs.

B.5.6.1 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Radio Frequency Attribute


This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio frequency attributes of an ODU.

Navigation Path
l

Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.

Click the Radio Frequency Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter indicates the corresponding


ODU.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1540

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transmit
Frequency(MHz)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit frequency of the ODU, namely,
the central frequency of the channel.
l The value of Transmit Frequency
(MHz) must not be less than the sum of
the minimum transmit frequency
supported by the ODU and a half of the
channel spacing, and must not be more
than the difference between the
maximum transmit frequency supported
by the ODU and a half of the channel
spacing.
l The difference between the transmit
frequencies at both ends of a radio link
should be one T/R spacing.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

T/R Spacing(MHz)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


spacing between the transmit frequency
and receive frequency of the ODU to
prevent mutual interference of the
transmitter and receiver.
l If the ODU is a Tx high station, the
transmit frequency is one T/R spacing
higher than the receive frequency. If the
ODU is a Tx low station, the transmit
frequency is one T/R spacing lower than
the receive frequency.
l If the ODU supports only one T/R
spacing, T/R Spacing(MHz) is set to 0,
indicating that the T/R spacing supported
by the ODU is used.
l A valid T/R spacing value is determined
by the ODU itself, and T/R Spacing
(MHz) should be set according to the
technical specifications of the ODU.
l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be
set to the same value at both ends of a
radio link.

Actual Transmit
Frequency(MHz)

This parameter indicates the actual transmit


frequency of the ODU.

Actual Receive
Frequency(MHz)

This parameter indicates the actual receive


frequency of the ODU.

Actual T/R
Spacing(MHz)

This parameter indicates the actual T/R


spacing of the ODU.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1541

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

The range of
frequency point
(MHz)

This parameter indicates the working range


of the frequency of the ODU.

Related Tasks
A.6.9.1 Setting ODU Transmit Frequency Attributes

B.5.6.2 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Power Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the power attributes of the
ODU.

Navigation Path
l

Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.

Click the Power Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter indicates the corresponding


ODU.

Maximum
Transmit Power
(dBm)

l Maximum Transmit Power(dBm) is


set according to the network plan. This
parameter cannot be set to a value that
exceeds the nominal power rang of the
ODU in the guaranteed capacity
modulation module.
l This parameter is set to limit the
maximum transmit power of the ODU
within this preset range.
l The maximum transmit power adjusted
by using the ATPC function should not
exceed Maximum Transmit Power
(dBm).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1542

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transmit Power
(dBm)

l Transmit Power(dBm) is set according


to the network plan. This parameter
specifies the transmit power of the ODU.
This parameter cannot be set to a value
that exceeds the nominal power rang of
the ODU or a value that exceeds
Maximum Transmit Power(dBm).
l It is recommended that you set the
transmit power of the ODU to the same
value at both ends of a radio link.
l Consider the receive power of the ODU
at the opposite end when you set this
parameter. Ensure that the receive power
of the ODU at the opposite end can
ensure stable radio services.

Power to Be
Received(dBm)

-90.0 to -20.0

-10.0

l Power to Be Received(dBm) is used to


set the expected receive power of the
ODU and is mainly used in the antenna
alignment stage. After this parameter is
set, the NE automatically enables the
antenna misalignment indicating
function.
l When the antenna misalignment
indicating function is enabled, if the
actual receive power of the ODU is 3 dB
lower than the power expected to be
received, the ODU indicator on the IF
board connected to the ODU blinks
yellow (300 ms on, 300 ms off),
indicating that the antenna is not aligned.
l After the antenna alignment, after the
state that the antenna is aligned lasts for
30 minutes, the NE automatically
disables the antenna misalignment
indicating function.
l Power to Be Received(dBm) is set
according to the network plan. When this
parameter takes the default value, the
antenna misalignment indicating
function is disabled.

TX High
Threshold(dBm)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

l If the value of the actual transmit power


of the ODU is greater than the preset
value of TX High Threshold(dBm), the
system separately records the duration
when the value of the actual transmit
power of the ODU is greater than the
preset value of TX High Threshold

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1543

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TX Low Threshold
(dBm)

(dBm) and the duration when the value


of the actual transmit power of the ODU
is greater than the preset value of TX
Low Threshold(dBm) in the
performance events.
l If the value of the actual transmit power
of the ODU is greater than the preset
value of TX Low Threshold(dBm) and
is lower than the preset value of TX High
Threshold(dBm), the system records
the duration when the value of the actual
transmit power of the ODU is greater
than the preset value of TX Low
Threshold(dBm) in the performance
events.
l If the value of the actual transmit power
of the ODU is lower than the preset value
of TX Low Threshold(dBm), the
system does not record it.
l TX High Threshold(dBm) and TX
Low Threshold(dBm) are valid only
when the ATPC function is enabled.

RX High
Threshold(dBm)

l If the value of the actual receive power


of the ODU is lower than the preset value
of RX Low Threshold(dBm), the
system records the duration when the
value of the actual receive power of the
ODU is lower than the preset value of
RX Low Threshold(dBm) and duration
when the value of the actual transmit
power of the ODU is lower than the
preset value of RX High Threshold
(dBm)in the performance events.
l If the value of the actual receive power
of the ODU is greater than the preset
value of RX Low Threshold(dBm) and
is lower than the preset value of RX High
Threshold(dBm), the system records
the duration when the value of the actual
receive power of the ODU is Lower than
the preset value of RX High Threshold
(dBm) in the performance events.
l If the value of the actual receive power
of the ODU is greater than the preset

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1544

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

RX Low Threshold
(dBm)

Actual Transmit
Power(dBm)

Description
value of RX High Threshold(dBm), the
system does not record it.

l This parameter indicates the actual


transmit power of the ODU.
l If the ATPC function is enabled, the
queried actual transmit power may be
different from the preset value.

Actual Receive
Power(dBm)

This parameter indicates the actual receive


power of the ODU.

Actual range of
Power(dBm)

This parameter indicates the range of the


actual transmit power of the ODU.

Transmission
Power Type

This parameter indicates the level of the


output power of the ODU.

Related Tasks
A.6.9.3 Setting ODU Power Attributes

B.5.6.3 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Equipment Information


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the equipment information of
the ODU.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1545

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
l

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > ODU Interface from the Function Tree.

Click the Equipment Information tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter indicates the corresponding


ODU.

Frequency(GHz)

This parameter indicates the frequency band


where the ODU operates.

Equipment Type

l This parameter indicates the equipment


type of the ODU.
l PDH and SDH indicate the transmission
capacity only and are irrelevant to the
type of transmitted service.

T/R Spacing(MHz)

This parameter indicates the T/R spacing of


the ODU.

Intermediate
Frequency
Bandwidth (MHz)

This parameter indicates the IF frequency


bandwidth of the ODU.

IF Bandwidth
Type

Displays the IF bandwidth type.

Station Type

l This parameter indicates whether the


ODU is a Tx high station or a Tx low
station.
l The transmit frequency of a Tx high
station is one T/R spacing higher than the
transmit frequency of a Tx low station.

Transmission
Power Type

This parameter indicates the level of the


output power of the ODU.

Produce Time

This parameter indicates the manufacturing


time of the ODU.

Produce SN

This parameter indicates the manufacturing


serial number and the manufacturer code of
the ODU.

Related Tasks
A.6.9.2 Querying ODU Information

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1546

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.5.6.4 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Advanced Attributes


This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes of the
ODU.

Navigation Path
l

Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU
Interface from the Function Tree.

Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter indicates the corresponding


ODU.

RF Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


loopback status of the RF interface of the
ODU.

Inloop

l Non-Loopback indicates that the


loopback is canceled or not performed.
l Inloop indicates that the RF signals
transmitted to the opposite end are
looped back.
l RF Loopback function is used for fault
locating for the RF interfaces. The RF
Loopback function is used for diagnosis
and may affect the services that are
transmitted over the interfaces. Hence,
exercise caution before starting this
function.
l In normal cases, RF Loopback is set to
Non-Loopback.
Configure
Transmission
Status

unmute

unmute

mute

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


transmit status of the ODU.
l If Configure Transmission Status is set
to mute, the transmitter of the ODU does
not work but can normally receive
microwave signals.
l If Configure Transmission Status is set
to unmute, the ODU can normally
transmit and receive microwave signals.
l In normal cases, Configure
Transmission Status is set to unmute.

Actual
Transmission
Status
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Displays the ODU manufacturer


information.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1547

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Factory
Information

This parameter indicates the manufacturer


information about the ODU.

Remarks

Specifies the remarks of the ODU.

Related Tasks
A.6.9.4 Setting ODU Advanced Attributes

B.5.7 Parameters for SDH Interface Boards


This topic describes parameters that are related to SDH interface boards.

B.5.7.1 Parameter Description: SDH Interfaces


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the SDH interfaces.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Select By Board/Port(Channel), and select Port or VC4 Channel from the list box.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


SDH interface.

Optical Interface
Namea

This parameter indicates or specifies the


name of the optical interface.

Laser Switcha

On

On

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


on/off state of the laser.

Off

l This parameter is set for SDH optical


interfaces only.
l In normal cases, this parameter is set to
On.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1548

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Optical(Electrical)
Interface
Loopbacka

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


loopback status on the SDH interface.

Inloop

l Non-Loopback indicates that the


loopback is canceled or not performed.

Outloop

l Inloop indicates that the SDH signals


transmitted to the opposite end are
looped back.
l Outloop indicates that the received SDH
signals are looped back.
l This function is used for fault locating
for the SDH interfaces. The Optical
(Electrical) Interface Loopback
function is used for diagnosis and may
affect the services that are transmitted
over the interfaces. Hence, exercise
precaution before starting this function.
l In normal cases, this parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.
Non-Loopback

VC4 Loopbackb

Non-Loopback

Inloop

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


loopback status in the VC-4 path.
l Non-Loopback indicates that the
loopback is canceled or not performed.

Outloop

l Inloop indicates that the VC-4 signals


transmitted to the opposite end are
looped back.
l Outloop indicates that the received
VC-4 signals are looped back.
l This function is used for fault locating
for the VC-4 paths. The VC4
Loopback function is used for diagnosis
and may affect the services that are
transmitted over the interfaces. Hence,
exercise precaution before starting this
function.
l In normal cases, this parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.

NOTE

l a: Indicates the parameters that are supported when Port is selected from the list box.
l b: Indicates the parameters that are supported when VC4 Channel is selected from the list box.

Related Tasks
A.6.1 Setting the Parameters of SDH Ports
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1549

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.5.7.2 Parameter Description: Automatic Laser Shutdown


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the automatic laser shutdown (ALS)
function.

Navigation Path
Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Automatic Laser Shutdown from the Function Tree.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Optical Interface

This parameter indicates the corresponding


optical interface.

Auto Shutdown

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the Auto Laser Shutdown
function is enabled or disabled for the
laser.

Enabled

l The ALS function allows the laser to shut


down automatically when an optical port
does not carry services, an optical fiber
is broken, or no optical signal is received.
l You can set On Period(ms), Off Period
(ms), and Continuously On-test Period
(ms) only when this parameter is set to
Enabled.
On Period(ms)

1000 to 3000

2000

This parameter indicates or specifies the


period when a shutdown laser automatically
starts up and tests whether the optical fiber
is normal.

Off Period(ms)

2000 to 300000

60000

This parameter indicates or specifies the


period when the laser does not work (with
the ALS function being enabled).

Continuously Ontest Period(ms)

2000 to 300000

90000

This parameter indicates or specifies the


period when a shutdown laser is manually
started up and tests whether the optical fiber
is normal.

B.5.8 Parameters for PDH Interface Boards


This topic describes parameters that are related to PDH interface boards.

B.5.8.1 Parameter Description: PDH Ports


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the PDH ports.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1550

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Select By Board/Port(Channel).

3.

Select Port from the list box.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


port.

Port Name

This parameter indicates or specifies the


name of the port.

Tributary
Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


loopback status in the associated path of
the tributary unit.

Inloop
Outloop

l Non-Loopback indicates that the


loopback is canceled or not performed.
l Inloop indicates that the PDH signals
transmitted to the opposite end are
looped back.
l Outloop indicates that the received PDH
signals are looped back.
l This function is used for fault locating
for the paths of the tributary unit. The
Tributary Loopback function is used
for diagnosis and may affect the services
that are transmitted over the interfaces.
Hence, exercise precaution before
starting this function.
l In normal cases, this parameter is set to
Non-Loopback.

Port Impedance

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

This parameter indicates the impedance of a


path, which depends on the tributary unit.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1551

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Load
Indication

Load

Load

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


service loading status in a specific path.

Non-Loaded

l When this parameter is set to Load, the


board detects whether alarms exist in the
path.
l When this parameter is set to NonLoaded, the board does not detect
whether there are alarms in the path.
l If a path does not carry any services, you
can set this parameter to Non-Loaded
for the path to mask all the alarms. If a
path carries services, you need to set this
parameter to Load for the path.
Input Signal
Equalization

Unequalized

Unequalized

Equalized

l This parameter indicates whether the


input signals are equalized.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to default value.

Retiming Mode

Normal

Normal

Retiming Mode of
Tributary Clock
Retiming Mode of
Cross-Connect
Clock

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


retiming mode of a specific path.
l By using the retiming function, the
retiming reference signal from the SDH
network and the service data signal are
combined and then sent to the client
equipment, therefore decreasing the
output jitter in the signal. In this way, the
retiming function ensures that the service
code flow can normally transfer the
retiming reference signal.
l When this parameter is set to Normal,
the retiming function is not used.
l When this parameter is set to Retiming
Mode of Tributary Clock, the retiming
function is used with the clock of the
upstream tributary unit traced.
l When this parameter is set to Retiming
Mode of Cross-Connect Clock, the
retiming function is used with the clock
of the cross-connect unit traced.
l It is recommended that the external
clock, instead of the retiming function,
should be used to provide reference
clock signals for the equipment.
l If the retiming function is required, it is
recommended that you set this parameter
to Retiming Mode of Cross-connect
Clock.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1552

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Service Type

This parameter indicates the type of services


that are processed in a path. It depends on
the services that are transmitted in a path.

Output Signal
Equalization

Unequalized

Unequalized

l This parameter indicates whether the


output signals are equalized.

Equalized

l It is recommended that you use the


default value.
E1 Frame Format

Unframe

Unframe

Double Frame
CRC-4 Multiframe

Specifies the E1 frame format for E1 ports.


l To detect E1 BER performance on the
OptiX RTN 980, set E1 Frame
Format of the local E1 port to the same
value as that of the opposite E1 port. It is
recommended that E1 Frame Format of
both the local and opposite E1 ports be
CRC-4 Multiframe.
l In other scenarios wherein the OptiX
RTN 980 is used, it is recommended that
E1 Frame Format take its default value
Unframe. If E1 Frame Format is
Unframe, the OptiX RTN 980
transparently transmits E1 frames and
the local E1 port allows for
interconnection with another E1 port
whose E1 Frame Format is Double
Frame or CRC-4 Multiframe.
NOTE
E1 Frame Format needs to be set to the same
value at both ends of an E1 link.

Related Tasks
A.6.2 Setting the Parameters of PDH Ports

B.5.8.2 Parameter Description: PRBS Test


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the pseudorandom binary sequence (PRBS)
test.

Navigation Path
Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > PRBS Test from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1553

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the port for the


PRBS test.

Direction

Cross

Cross

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


direction of the PRBS test.

Tributary

l In the tributary direction, the PRBS test


is performed to check the connectivity of
the cable from the tributary board to the
DDF.
l In the cross-connect direction, the PRBS
test is performed to check the processing
of the service from the tributary board to
the NE at the remote end.
Duration

1 to 255

This parameter indicates or specifies the


duration of the PRBS test.

Measured Time

This parameter indicates or specifies the


time unit used for the PRBS test.

10min
h
Start Time

This parameter indicates the start time of the


PRBS test.

Progress

This parameter indicates the progress


percentage of the PRBS test.

Total PRBS

This parameter indicates the number of bit


errors that occur in the PRBS test.

Accumulating
Mode

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies whether to display


the values in accumulative mode. If
Accumulating Mode is selected, it
indicates that the values are displayed in
accumulative mode.

Deselected

B.5.9 Parameters for Overhead


This topic describes the parameters that are related to overhead.

B.5.9.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the regenerator section overheads
(RSOHs).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1554

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select an SDH interface board in the NE Explorer Choose Configuration > Overhead
Management > Regenerator Section Overhead from the Function Tree.

2.

Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.

Parameters for Setting the Display Format


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Display in Text
Format

Selected

Selected

This parameter specifies the display in the


text format.

Display in
Hexadecimal

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies the display in the


hexadecimal format.

Deselected

Deselected

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

J0 to be Sent
([Mode]Content)

[16 Bytes]HuaWei
SBS

If the NE at the opposite end reports the


J0_MM alarm, this parameter is set
according to the J0 byte to be received at the
opposite end.

J0 to be Received
([Mode]Content)

[Disabled]

l This parameter specifies the J0 byte to be


received.
l If this parameter is set to [Disabled], the
board does not monitor the received J0
byte.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

J0 Received
([Mode]Content)

This parameter indicates the J0 byte that is


actually received.

Related Tasks
A.6.3.1 Configuring RSOHs

B.5.9.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the VC-4 path overheads (POHs).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1555

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select SDH interface board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Overhead Management > VC4 Path Overhead from the Function Tree.

2.

Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.

Parameters for Setting the Display Format


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Display in Text
Format

Selected

Selected

This parameter specifies the display in the


text format.

Display in
Hexadecimal

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies the display in the


hexadecimal format.

Deselected

Deselected

Parameters for the Trace Byte J1


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

J1 to be Sent
([Mode]Content)

[16 Bytes]HuaWei
SBS

If the NE at the opposite end reports the


HP_TIM alarm, this parameter is set
according to the J1 byte to be received at the
opposite end.

J1 to be Received
([Mode]Content)

[Disabled]

l If this parameter is set to [Disabled], the


board does not monitor the received J1
byte.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

J1 Received
([Mode]Content)

This parameter displays the J1 byte that is


actually received.

Parameters for the Signal Flag C2


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

C2 to be Sent

If the NE at the opposite end reports the


HP_SLM alarm, this parameter is set
according to the C2 byte to be received at the
opposite end.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1556

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

C2 to be Received

If the NE at the local end reports the


HP_SLM alarm, this parameter is set
according to the C2 byte to be sent at the
opposite end.

C2 Received

This parameter displays the C2 byte that is


actually received.

Parameters for Overhead Termination


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

VC4 Overhead
Termination

Termination

Auto

l If this parameter is set to PassThrough, the NE forwards the original


overhead after monitoring the VC-4 path
overhead regardless of the C2 byte.

Pass-Through
Auto

l If this parameter is set to Termination,


the NE generates the new VC-4 path
overhead according to the board setting
after monitoring the VC-4 path overhead
regardless of the C2 byte.
l If this parameter is set to Auto, the VC-4
path overhead in the VC-4 pass-through
service is passed through, and the VC-4
path overhead in the VC-12 service is
terminated.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.

Related Tasks
A.6.3.2 Configuring VC-4 POHs

B.5.9.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the VC-12 path overheads (POHs).

Navigation Path
1.

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Configuration > Overhead Management > VC12 Path Overhead from the Function
Tree.

2.

Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1557

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Setting the Display Format


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Display in Text
Format

Selected

Selected

This parameter specifies the display in the


text format.

Display in
Hexadecimal

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies the display in the


hexadecimal format.

Deselected

Deselected

Parameters for the Trace Byte


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

J2 to be Sent

[16 Bytes]HuaWei
SBS

If the NE at the opposite end reports the


LP_TIM or LP_TIM_VC12 alarm, this
parameter is set according to the J2 byte to
be received by the NE at the opposite end.

J2 to be Received

[Disabled]

l If this parameter is set to [Disabled], the


board does not monitor the received J2
byte.
l It is recommended that you use the
default value.
NOTE
IF boards do not support this parameter.

J2 Received

This parameter displays the J2 byte that is


actually received.

Parameters for the Signal Flag


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be set.

Signal Label
(L1,L2,L3 of V5) to
be Sent

If the NE at the opposite end reports the


LP_SLM or LP_SLM_VC12 alarm, this
parameter is set according to the V5 byte to
be received at the opposite end.

Signal Label
(L1,L2,L3 of V5) to
be Received

If the NE at the local end reports the


LP_SLM or LP_SLM_VC12 alarm, this
parameter is set according to the V5 byte to
be sent at the opposite end.
NOTE
IF boards do not support this parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1558

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Signal Label
(L1,L2,L3 of V5)
Received

This parameter displays the V5 byte that is


actually received.

Related Tasks
A.6.3.3 Configuring VC-12 POHs

B.5.10 Parameter Description: Ethernet Virtual Interfaces


This topic describes the parameters of Ethernet virtual interfaces.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Interface Management > Ethernet Virtual Interface from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the Basic Attributes tab.

3.

Choose New > Create Ethernet Virtual Interface.

Basic Attributes of Ethernet Virtual Interfaces


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

1 to 8191

This parameter displays or specifies the port


number of an Ethernet virtual interface.

Name

This parameter displays or specifies the port


name of an Ethernet virtual interface.

Port Type

EoA Virtual
Interface

EoA Virtual
Interface

This parameter displays or specifies the port


type of an Ethernet virtual interface.

VLAN Sub Interface

The OptiX RTN 980 allows Port Type to be


set to VLAN Sub Interface only.

Board

This parameter displays or specifies the


board where an Ethernet virtual interface is
located.

Port

This parameter displays or specifies the port


where an Ethernet virtual interface is
located.

VPI

Setting this parameter is not available.

VCI

Setting this parameter is not available.

AAL5
Encapsulation
Type

Setting this parameter is not available.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1559

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN

This parameter specifies the VLAN ID that


an Ethernet virtual interface uses.
This parameter can be set when Port Type
is VLAN Sub Interface.

Specify IP Address

Manually

Unspecified

Unspecified

This parameter specifies whether to set the


IP address for a port.
l Unspecified: indicates that the IP
address will not be specified for a port.
l Manually: indicates that the IP address
will be specified for a port. If the
specified IP address is a valid value, it
will become the IP address of this port.

IP Address

0.0.0.0

This parameter specifies the IP address of a


port.
l This parameter can be set only when
Specify IP Address is Manually.
l The IP addresses of different ports on an
NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the
ports at both ends of an MPLS tunnel
must be in the same network segment.

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

This parameter specifies the subnet mask for


a port.
This parameter can be set only when Specify
IP Address is Manually.

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

This parameter specifies whether to enable


an MPLS tunnel.
This parameter specifies the MPLS enabled
status for a port. If you set Enable Tunnel
to Enabled for a port, the port identifies and
processes MPLS labels.

MAC Address

This parameter displays the port MAC


address of an Ethernet virtual interface.

Layer 3 Attributes
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter displays an IF port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1560

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Tunnel

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter displays or specifies whether


to enable an MPLS tunnel.

Disabled

Set the MPLS enabled status for a port. If


you set Enable Tunnel to Enabled, the port
identifies and processes MPLS labels.
Specify IP
Address

Manually

Unspecified

Unspecified

This parameter displays or specifies whether


to set the IP address for a port.
l Unspecified: indicates that the IP
address will not be specified for a port.
l Manually: indicates that the IP address
will be specified for a port. If the
specified IP address is a valid value, it
will become the IP address of this port.

IP Address

0.0.0.0

This parameter displays or specifies the IP


address of a port.
l This parameter can be set only when
Specify IP Address is Manually.
l The IP addresses of different ports on an
NE must be in different network
segments, but the IP addresses of the
ports at both ends of an MPLS tunnel
must be in the same network segment.

IP Mask

255.255.255.252

This parameter displays or specifies the


subnet mask of a port.
This parameter can be set only when Specify
IP Address is Manually.

Related Tasks
A.6.10 Creating VLAN Sub-Interfaces

B.6 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet Features


on the Packet Plane
This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet services and Ethernet features on the
packet plane, including service parameters, protocol parameters, OAM parameters, Ethernet port
parameters, and QoS parameters.

B.6.1 Parameters for Ethernet Services


This topic describes the parameters that are related to Ethernet services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1561

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.6.1.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation


This topic describes the interface parameters that are used for creating an Ethernet line (E-Line)
service.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-4 Service direction of UNI-UNI
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter specifies


the ID of the E-Line
service.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the E-Line
service.

Direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

l This parameter
specifies the direction
of the E-Line service.

UNI-NNI
NNI-NNI

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

l Set this parameter to


UNI-UNI.

1562

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

l This parameter
specifies the
transparent
transmission ID of the
bridge protocol data
unit (BPDU) packets.
It is used to indicate
whether the E-Line
service transparently
transmits the BPDU
packets.

Transparently
Transmitted

l If the BPDU packets


are used as the service
packets and
transparently
transmitted to the
opposite end, set this
parameter to
Transparently
Transmitted. That is,
the parameter value
Transparently
Transmitted takes
effect only if
Encapsulation Type
of the source and sink
ports of the E-Line
service are Null.
l In other cases, set this
parameter to Not
Transparently
Transmitted.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.
MTU(bytes)

This parameter cannot be


set here.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1563

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Port

l Before setting this


parameter, check and
ensure that the
attributes in Ethernet
Interface of the port
are set correctly and
are the same as the
planning information.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
the same as the value
of sink port.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
used for the E-LAN
port.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1564

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source VLANs

1 to 4094

l This parameter can be


set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l The number and value
of VLANs must be the
same value of Sink
VLANs.
l If this parameter is set
to null, all the services
at the source port are
used as the service
source.
l If this parameter is not
set to null, only the
service that contains
the VLAN ID at the
source port can be used
as the service source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1565

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink Port

l Before setting this


parameter, check and
ensure that the
attributes in Ethernet
Interface of the port
are set correctly and
are the same as the
planning information.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
the same as the value
of Source Port.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
used for the E-LAN
port.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1566

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink VLANs

1 to 4094

l This parameter can be


set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l The number and value
of VLANs must be the
same value of Source
VLANs.
l If this parameter is set
to null, all the services
at the sink port are
used as the service
sink.
l If this parameter is not
set to null, only the
service that contains
the VLAN ID at the
sink port can be used
as the service sink.

Table B-5 Service direction of UNI-NNI (carried by PWs)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter specifies


the ID of the E-Line
service.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the E-Line
service.

Direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

l This parameter
specifies the direction
of the E-Line service.

UNI-NNI
NNI-NNI

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

l Set this parameter to


UNI-NNI.

1567

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

Not Transparently
Transmitted

For UNI-NNI ETH


PWE3 services, the
parameter value is always
Not Transparently
Transmitted.

Transparently
Transmitted
MTU(bytes)

This parameter cannot be


set here.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Source Port

l Before setting this


parameter, check and
ensure that the
attributes in Ethernet
Interface of the port
are set correctly and
are the same as the
planning information.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
the same as the value
of sink port.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
used for the E-LAN
port.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1568

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source VLANs

1 to 4094

l This parameter can be


set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l If this parameter is set
to null, all the services
at the source port are
used as the service
source.
l If this parameter is not
set to null, only the
service that contains
the VLAN ID at the
source port can be
used as the service
source.

PRI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Bearer Type

QinQ Link

PW

For UNI-NNI ETH


PWE3 services, the
parameter value is always
PW.

PW

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1569

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

l If this parameter is set


to PW APS, working
and protection PWs
need to be configured.

PW APS
Slave Protection Pair

l If this parameter is set


to Slave Protection
Pair, you need to bind
the slave PW APS
protection group with
the master PW APS
protection group. The
switching of the
master PW APS
protection group
triggers the switching
of the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Table B-6 Service direction of UNI-NNI (carried by QinQ links)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter specifies


the ID of the E-Line
service.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the E-Line
service.

Direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

l This parameter
specifies the direction
of the E-Line service.

UNI-NNI
NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

l Set this parameter to


UNI-NNI.
Not Transparently
Transmitted

For UNI-NNI QinQ


services, the parameter
value is always Not
Transparently
Transmitted.

Transparently
Transmitted
MTU(bytes)

This parameter cannot be


set here.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1570

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Port

l Before setting this


parameter, check and
ensure that the
attributes in Ethernet
Interface of the port
are set correctly and
are the same as the
planning information.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
the same as the value
of sink port.
l The value of this
parameter cannot be
used for the E-LAN
port.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Source VLANs

1 to 4094

l This parameter can be


set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l If this parameter is set
to null, all the services
at the source port are
used as the service
source.
l If this parameter is not
set to null, only the
service that contains
the VLAN ID at the
source port can be used
as the service source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1571

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PRI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Bearer Type

QinQ Link

PW

For NNI-NNI QinQ


services, the parameter
value is always QinQ
Link.

Selects or specifies the ID


of a QinQ link. You can
create a QinQ link or
select an existing QinQ
link.

PW

QinQ Link ID

Table B-7 Service direction of NNI-NNI


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter specifies


the ID of the E-Line
service.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the E-Line
service.

Direction

UNI-UNI

UNI-UNI

l This parameter
specifies the direction
of the E-Line service.

UNI-NNI
NNI-NNI

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

l Set this parameter to


NNI-NNI.
Not Transparently
Transmitted

For NNI-NNI QinQ


services, the parameter
value is always
Not Transparently
Transmitted
.

Transparently
Transmitted

MTU(bytes)

This parameter cannot be


set here.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

PRI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1572

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bearer Type 1

QinQ Link

QinQ Link

Uses the QinQ link to


carry the E-Line service.

QinQ Link ID 1

l Selects the QinQ link


ID of the first QinQ
link.
l The QinQ link ID is
preset in QinQ Link.

Bearer Type 2

QinQ Link

QinQ Link

Uses the QinQ link to


carry the E-Line service.

QinQ Link ID 2

l Selects the QinQ link


ID of the second QinQ
link.
l The QinQ link ID is
preset in QinQ Link.

QinQ Link ID

Selects or specifies the ID


of a QinQ link. You can
create a QinQ link or
select an existing QinQ
link.

Parameters of PWs
NOTE

l Parameters of PWs need to be configured only when Direction is UNI-NNI and Bearer Type is PW.
l If the parameter Protection Type of PWs is set to PW APS or Slave Protection Pair, all the parameters
of working and protection PWs need to be configured. This section considers the parameters of the working
PW as an example.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

Labels for static PWs need


to be manually assigned.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1573

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

l Specifies the type of


the PW.

Ethernet Tagged Mode

l PW Type indicates
whether P-TAG is
added to Ethernet
frames that are
encapsulated for
transmission on PWs.
If it is not required to
add VLAN IDs, set this
parameter to
Ethernet. If it is
required to add VLAN
IDs, set this parameter
to Ethernet Tagged
Mode and then set
Request VLAN in the
Advanced Attributes
tab.
PW Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Displays the direction of


the PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the
encapsulation type of the
packets on the PW.

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Ingress


label.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Egress


label.

Tunnel selection mode

Displays the method to


select tunnels.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.

Tunnel

A tunnel needs to be
selected. If no tunnel is
available, creation of a
PW will fail.

Egress Tunnel

For a bidirectional tunnel,


the system will configure
the egress tunnel
automatically.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1574

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Peer LSR ID

Specifies the LSR ID of


the PW at the remote end.
If an existing tunnel is
selected, the LSR ID will
be automatically assigned.

QoS Parameters (PW)


NOTE

QoS parameters need to be configured only when Direction is UNI-NNI and Bearer Type is PW.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit function
is enabled.
l This function limits the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ETH PWE3 service
corresponds to a PW.
Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ETH
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CIR(Kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS(byte)

Specifies the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(Kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1575

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PBS(byte)

Specifies the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe: When stripping


MPLS tunnel labels from
packets, an egress node
does not update the
scheduling priority for the
packets.

Parameters of Advanced Attributes (PW)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

No Use

No Use

For ETH PWE3 services,


the parameter value is
always No Use.

Control Channel Type

None

Alert Label

l Specifies the mode of


PW connectivity
check.

Alert Label

l None indicates that


VCCV is not used.
l Alert Label indicates
VCCV packets in
Alert Label
encapsulation mode.
VCCV Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

None

l Specifies the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is
used for PW
connectivity check.
l If the VCCV-Ping test
is required, do not set
this parameter to
None.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1576

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Request VLAN

l Set this parameter


when PW Type is
Ethernet Tagged
Mode.
l If the received packets
do not carry any
VLAN IDs, the PW
will add VLAN IDs to
the packets as required
by the setting of this
parameter.

TPID

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support request VLAN
TPID of the PW level.

Protection Group Parameters (PW APS)


NOTE

The parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of PWs is set to
PW APS.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

Specifies the protection


type.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the protection


group ID.

Enabling Status

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies the enabling


status of the PW
protection group.

Enabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports 1:1 protection
mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1577

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Switching Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports dual-ended
switching.

Revertive Mode

Non-revertive

Revertive

Revertive

l This parameter
specifies whether to
switch services back to
the original working
PW after it recovers.
l The value Revertive
indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.

Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Specifies the WTR


time of the protection
group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1578

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Specifies the hold-off


time of the protection
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.
l The default value is
recommended.

Detection mode

Displays the detection


mode of the PW APS
protection group.

OAM Parameters
NOTE

l The OAM parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of
PWs is set to PW APS.
l To configure PW OAM parameters, choose Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management >
PW OAM Parameter from the Function Tree.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

OAM Status

Displays the enabling


status of PW OAM.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1579

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

l Specifies the detection


mode of OAM packets.

Manual

l Manual: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval specified
by the user.
l Auto-Sensing: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval of
receiving PW OAM
packets.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, you
need to set the PW
OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value AutoSensing is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1580

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l CV: The detection


packets are sent at a
fixed interval.

FFD

l FFD: The detection


packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Auto-Sensing,
this parameter
specifies the PW OAM
detection packets to be
transmitted.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, this
parameter specifies the
PW OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value FFD is
assumed for PW APS
and the value CV is
assumed for
continuous
connectivity check on
PWs.
Detection Packet Period
(ms)

3.3

50

10

l Specifies the period of


detection packets.
l This parameter is
configurable when
Detection Packet
Type is FFD and
assumes the fixed
value of 1000 when
Detection Packet
Type is CV.

20
50
100
200
500

l Set this parameter to


3.3 for PW APS.
LSR ID to be Received

Specifies the LSR ID to be


received.

PW ID to be Received

Specifies the PW ID to be
received.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1581

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters (Slave Protection Pair)


NOTE

The parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of PWs is set to
Slave Protection Pair.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the ID of the


slave protection pair. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection group
triggers the switching of
the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW in the slave
protection pair.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW in the slave
protection pair.

Related Tasks
A.7.3.2 Configuring UNI-UNI E-Line Services
A.7.3.3 Configuring NNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links)
A.7.3.4 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by QinQ Links)
A.7.3.5 Configuring UNI-NNI E-Line Services (Carried by PWs)

B.6.1.2 Parameter Description: E-Line Service


This topic describes the parameters that are related to E-Line services.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter indicates


the ID of the E-Line
service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1582

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Name

This parameter indicates


or specifies the name of
the E-Line service.

Source Node

This parameter indicates


the source node.

Sink Node

This parameter indicates


the sink node.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

MTU(byte)

This parameter cannot be


queried here.

BPDU

Not Transparently
Transmitted

This parameter indicates


the transparent
transmission tag of the
bridge protocol data unit
(BPDU) packets. This
parameter is used to
indicate whether the
Ethernet line
transparently transmits
the BPDU packets.

This parameter indicates


whether E-Line service is
deployed.

Transparently
Transmitted

Deployment Status

Parameters Associated with UNI Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the UNI port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1583

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLANs

1 to 4094

This parameter indicates


or specifies the VLAN ID
of the UNI port.
l This parameter can be
set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l This parameter is valid
only when Direction
is set to UNI-UNI or
UNI-NNI in the
process of creating an
E-Line service.
l If this parameter is set
to null, all the services
of the UNI work as the
service source or
service sink.
l If this parameter is not
set to null, only the
services of the UNI
port whose VLAN IDs
are included in the set
value of this parameter
work as the service
source or service sink.

NNI Parameters (PW)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

This parameter displays


the PW ID.

Working Status

This parameter displays


the working status of a
PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1584

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Status

This parameter displays


whether a PW is enabled.

PW Signaling Type

This parameter displays


the PW signaling type.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 uses
static PWs only.

PW Type

This parameter displays


the configured PW type.

PW Direction

This parameter displays


the direction of the PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

This parameter displays


the PW encapsulation
type.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 uses
MPLS only.

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

This parameter displays


the configured PW ingress
label.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

This parameter displays


the configured PW egress
label.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

This parameter displays


the type of the tunnel that
carries a PW.

Peer LSR ID

This parameter displays


the opposite LSR ID.

Tunnel

This parameter displays


the tunnel.

Control Word

For ETH PWE3 services,


the parameter value is
always No Use.

Control Channel Type

This parameter displays


the control channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

This parameter displays


the VCCV mode.

Local Working Status

Displays the working


status of the PW at the
local end.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1585

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Remote Working Status

This parameter displays


the working status of the
PW at the remote end.

Compositive Working
Status

This parameter displays


the comprehensive
working status of the PW.

Request VLAN

This parameter displays


the request VLAN.

Deployment Status

This parameter displays


the deployment status.

Tunnel Automatic
Selection Policy

This parameter displays


the automatic tunnel
selection policy.

TPID

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support request
VLAN TPID of the PW
level.

Parameters Associated with NNI Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

QinQ Link ID

1 to 4294967295

l This parameter
indicates the QinQ link
ID of the QinQ link
connected to the NNI
port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Direction
is set to UNI-UNI or
UNI-NNI in the
process of creating an
E-Line service.

Port

l This parameter
indicates the NNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Direction
is set to UNI-UNI or
UNI-NNI in the
process of creating an
E-Line service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1586

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

S-VLAN ID

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the VLAN ID of the
NNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Direction
is set to UNI-NNI or
NNI-NNI in the
process of creating an
E-Line service.
l This parameter is
preset in QinQ Link.

QoS Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

This parameter displays


the PW ID.

Direction

l This parameter
displays the direction
of the PW.
l Egress indicates the
egress direction of the
PW.
l Ingress indicates the
ingress direction of the
PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1587

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

This parameter displays or


specifies whether the
bandwidth limit function
is enabled for a PW to
prevent network
congestion.
l Regarding
transmission channels,
this function can be
used to limit the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ETH PWE3
service corresponds to
a PW. Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ETH
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

CIR (Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the committed
information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS (kbyte)

This parameter displays or


specifies the committed
burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR (kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the peak
information rate (PIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS (kbyte)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter displays or


specifies the peak burst
size (PBS) of a PW.

1588

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe: When stripping


MPLS tunnel labels from
packets, an egress node
does not update the
scheduling priority for the
packets.

Parameters for the Port Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port


information.

Enable Port

l This parameter
indicates whether to
enable the port.
l This parameter is
preset in General
Attributes of
Ethernet Interface.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1589

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Encapsulation Type

Null

l This parameter
indicates the
encapsulation type of
the port.

802.1Q
QinQ

l This parameter is valid


only when Direction
is set to UNI-UNI or
UNI-NNI in the
process of creating an
E-Line service.
l If this parameter is set
to Null, the port
transparently
transmits the received
packets.
l If this parameter is set
to 802.1Q, the port
identifies the packets
that comply with the
IEEE 802.1Q
standard.
l If this parameter is set
to QinQ, the port
identifies the packets
that comply with the
IEEE 802.1 QinQ
standard.
l This parameter is
preset in General
Attributes of
Ethernet Interface.
TAG

Tag Aware

Access
Hybrid

l This parameter
displays the tag of the
port.
l This parameter is
preset in Layer 2
Attributes of
Ethernet Interface .

Protection Group Parameters (PW APS)


NOTE

The following parameters are available only after the PW APS protection group is configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1590

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group ID

Displays the ID of the


protection group to be
created.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Enabling Status

Enabled

l Displays or specifies
the enabling status of
the PW protection
group.

Disabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Switchover Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supporting dual-ended
switching.

Restoration Mode

Non-revertive

Revertive

l Specifies whether to
switch services to the
original working PW
after the fault is
rectified.
l The value Revertive
indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1591

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Displays or specifies
the WTR time of the
protection group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Displays or specifies
the hold-off time of the
protection group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.

Deployment Status

Display the deployment


status of the protection
group.

Switchover Status

Displays the switchover


status of the protection
group.

Protocol Status

Displays the enabling


status of the protocol.

Working Path Status

Displays the status of the


current working path.

Protection Path Status

Display the status of the


current protection path.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1592

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters (Slave Protection Pair)


NOTE

The following parameters are available only after the slave protection pair is configured.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group ID

Specifies the ID of the


slave protection pair. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection group
triggers the switching of
the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW in the slave
protection pair.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW in the slave
protection pair.

DNI PW ID

Displays the DNI PW ID.

PW Type

Displays the PW type.

Deployment Status

Displays the deployment


status of the slave
protection pair.

B.6.1.3 Parameter Description: VLAN Forwarding Table Items for E-Line


Services_Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating VLAN forwarding table items.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the VLAN Forwarding Table Item tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters for VLAN Forwarding Table Item


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

This parameter specifies


the network attribute of
the source interface.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1593

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Interface

This parameter specifies


the source interface.

Source VLAN ID

1 to 4094

This parameter specifies


the VLAN ID of the
source service.

Sink Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

This parameter specifies


the network attribute of
the sink interface.

Sink Interface

This parameter specifies


the sink interface.

Sink VLAN ID

1 to 4094

This parameter specifies


the VLAN ID of the sink
service.

NOTE

l The VLAN ID of the UNI-UNI E-Line service can be converted after a VLAN forwarding table item is
created. In this case, a service from Source Interface to Sink Interface carries the VLAN ID specified in
Sink VLAN ID when the service is transmitted from Sink Interface.
l The VLAN ID in a VLAN forwarding table item is converted unidirectionally and can be converted from
Source VLAN ID to Sink VLAN ID only. The VLAN ID can be converted bidirectionally only when the
other VLAN forwarding table item is configured reversely.
l In normal cases, Ethernet services are bidirectional. Hence, you need to set bidirectional conversion of
VLAN IDs.

Related Tasks
A.7.3.7 Creating a VLAN Forwarding Table for an E-Line Service

B.6.1.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an Ethernet local area network (ELAN) service.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1594

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

l This parameter
specifies the ID of the
E-LAN service.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports simultaneous
creation of an E-LAN
service only.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the E-LAN
service.

BPDU

l This parameter
indicates the
transparent
transmission tag of the
BPDU packets.
l In the case of an ELAN service, this
parameter supports
only Not
Transparently
Transmitted and
cannot be set
manually.
l Not Transparently
Transmitted
indicates that the
BPDU packets are
used as the protocol
packets to compute the
spanning tree topology
of the network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1595

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tag Type

C-Awared

C-Awared

l C-Awared indicates
that the packets are
learnt according to CTag (the VLAN tag on
the client-side). To
create the 802.1q
bridge, set this
parameter to CAwared.

S-Awared
Tag-Transparent

l S-Awared indicates
that the packets are
learnt according to STag (the VLAN tag at
the carrier service
layer). To create the
802.1ad bridge, set this
parameter to SAwared.
l Tag-Transparent
indicates that the
packets are
transparently
transmitted. To create
the 802.1d bridge, set
this parameter to TagTransparent.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1596

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Self-Learning MAC
Address

Enabled

Enabled

l This parameter
specifies whether to
enable the MAC
address self-learning
function.

Disabled

l If the MAC selflearning function of an


Ethernet LAN is
enabled, the Ethernet
LAN learns an MAC
address according to
the original MAC
address in the packet
and automatically
refreshes the MAC
address forwarding
table.
l If the MAC selflearning function of an
Ethernet LAN is
disabled, a static MAC
address forwarding
table is recommended
to be configured.
MAC Address Learning
Mode

IVL

SVL

l This parameter
indicates the mode
used to learn an MAC
address.
l When the bridge uses
the SVL mode, all the
VLANs share one
MAC address table. If
the bridge uses the IVL
mode, each VLAN has
an MAC address table.

Deployment Status

This parameter indicates


whether E-LAN service is
deployed.

MTU(byte)

This parameter cannot be


set here.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1597

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for UNIs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the UNI port.

SVLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the S-VLAN
ID of the UNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Tag Type
is set to S-Awared.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

VLANs/CVLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the VLAN ID
of the UNI port.
l This parameter can be
set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l If this parameter is set
to null, all the services
of the UNI work as the
service source or
service sink.
l If this parameter is not
set to null, only the
services of the UNI
port whose VLAN IDs
are included in the set
value of this parameter
work as the service
source or service sink.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1598

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters of NNIs
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

l This parameter
indicates the NNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Tag Type
is set to S-Awared.

SVLANs

l This parameter
specifies the S-VLAN
ID of the NNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Tag Type
is set to S-Awared.

Parameters for the Split Horizon Group


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Split Horizon Group ID

l This parameter
indicates the ID of the
split horizon group.
l The default split
horizon group ID is 1
and cannot be set
manually.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1599

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Split Horizon Group


Member

l A split horizon group


member indicates the
logical port member in
the split horizon
group.
l The port members that
are added to the same
split horizon group
cannot communicate
with each other.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports only the
division of the split
horizon group
members according to
the Ethernet physical
port.
l If a UNI or NNI logical
port of the 802.1ad
bridge is added to a
split horizon group
member, the physical
port that is mounted
with the logical port is
automatically added to
the split horizon group
member.

Related Tasks
A.7.3.9 Configuring IEEE 802.1d Bridge-Based E-LAN Services
A.7.3.10 Configuring IEEE 802.1q Bridge-Based E-LAN Services
A.7.3.11 Configuring IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based E-LAN Services

B.6.1.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service


This topic describes the parameters that are related to E-LAN services.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1600

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

l This parameter
indicates the ID of the
E-LAN service.
l The supports
simultaneous creation
of an E-LAN service
only.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the E-LAN
service.

BPDU

l This parameter
indicates the
transparent
transmission tag of the
BPDU packets.
l In the case of an ELAN service, this
parameter supports
only Not
Transparently
Transmitted and
cannot be set
manually.
l Not Transparently
Transmitted
indicates that the
BPDU packets are
used as the protocol
packets to compute the
spanning tree topology
of the network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1601

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tag Type

C-Awared

C-Awared

l C-Awared indicates
that the packets are
learnt according to CTag (the VLAN tag on
the client-side). To
create the 802.1q
bridge, set this
parameter to CAwared.

S-Awared
Tag-Transparent

l S-Awared indicates
that the packets are
learnt according to STag (the VLAN tag at
the carrier service
layer). To create the
802.1ad bridge, set this
parameter to SAwared.
l Tag-Transparent
indicates that the
packets are
transparently
transmitted. To create
the 802.1d bridge, set
this parameter to TagTransparent.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1602

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Self-Learning MAC
Address

Enabled

Enabled

l This parameter
indicates whether to
enable the MAC
address self-learning
function.
l If the MAC selflearning function of an
Ethernet LAN is
enabled, the Ethernet
LAN learns an MAC
address according to
the original MAC
address in the packet
and automatically
refreshes the MAC
address forwarding
table.
l If the MAC selflearning function of an
Ethernet LAN is
disabled, a static MAC
address forwarding
table is recommended
to be configured.

MAC Address Learning


Mode

l This parameter
indicates the mode
used to learn an MAC
address.
l When the bridge uses
the SVL mode, all the
VLANs share one
MAC address table. If
the bridge uses the IVL
mode, each VLAN has
an MAC address table.

MTU(byte)

This parameter cannot be


queried here.

Service Tag Role

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Deployment Status

This parameter indicates


whether E-LAN service is
deployed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1603

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for UNIs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the UNI port.

SVLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the S-VLAN
ID of the UNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Tag Type
is set to S-Awared.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

VLANs/CVLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the VLAN ID
of the UNI port.
l This parameter can be
set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.
l If this parameter is set
to null, the E-LAN
service exclusively
uses the corresponding
UNI physical port.
That is, the entire port
is mounted to the
bridge.
l If this parameter is set
to a non-null value,
only the
corresponding UNI
port whose service
packets contain this
VLAN ID works as the
logical port and is
mounted to the bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1604

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for NNIs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

l This parameter
indicates the NNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Tag Type
is set to S-Awared.

SVLANs

l This parameter
specifies the S-VLAN
ID of the UNI port.
l This parameter is valid
only when Tag Type
is set to S-Awared.
l This parameter can be
set to null, a number,
or several numbers.
When setting this
parameter to several
numbers, use the
comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers,
or use the endash (-) to
represent a
consecutive number.
For example, the
numbers 1, and 3-6
indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and
6.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1605

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Static MAC Addresses


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

l This parameter is
invalid if MAC
Address Learning
Mode is SVL. That is,
the preset static MAC
address entries are
valid for all VLANs.
l If MAC Address
Learning Mode is set
to IVL, the preset
static MAC address
entries are valid for
only the VLANs
whose VLAN ID is
equal to the preset
VLAN ID.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

MAC Address

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the static MAC
address.
l A static MAC address
is an address that is set
manually. It is not
aged automatically
and needs to be deleted
manually.
l Generally, a static
MAC address is used
for the port that
receives but does not
forward Ethernet
service packets or the
port whose MAC
address need not be
aged automatically.

Egress Interface

l This parameter
specifies the Ethernet
port that corresponds
to the MAC address.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1606

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Self-Learning MAC Address


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

l This parameter is
invalid if MAC
Address Learning
Mode is SVL. That is,
the preset self-learning
MAC address entries
are valid for all
VLANs.
l If MAC Address
Learning Mode is set
to IVL, the preset selflearning MAC address
entries are valid for
only the VLANs
whose VLAN ID is
equal to the preset
VLAN ID.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

MAC Address

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the self-learning MAC
address. A selflearning MAC address
is also called a
dynamic MAC
address.
l A self-learning MAC
address is an entry
obtained by a bridge in
SVL or IVL learning
mode. A self-learning
MAC address can be
aged.

Egress Interface

l This parameter
specifies the Ethernet
port that corresponds
to the MAC address.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1607

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters Associated with MAC Address Learning


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Aging Ability

Enabled

Enabled

The OptiX RTN 980


supports enabling/
disabling of the aging
function and aging time
for the MAC address
table.
If one routing entry is not
updated in a certain
period, that is, if no new
packet from this MAC
address is received to
enable the re-learning of
this MAC address, this
routing entry is
automatically deleted.
This mechanism is called
aging, and this period is
called aging time. The
aging time of a MAC
address table is 5 minutes
by default.

Disabled
Aging Time(min)

1 to 640

Parameters for Disabled MAC Addresses


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

This parameter indicates


or specifies the VLAN ID
of the service. A disabled
MAC address is valid for
the VLAN whose VLAN
ID is equal to the preset
VLAN ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1608

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

MAC Address

l This parameter
specifies or indicates
the disabled MAC
address. A disabled
MAC address is also
called a blacklisted
MAC address.
l This parameter is used
for discarding an
entry, also called a
black hole entry,
whose data frame that
contains a specific
destination MAC
address. A disabled
MAC address needs to
be set manually and
cannot be aged.

Parameters for the Split Horizon Group


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Split Horizon Group ID

l This parameter
indicates the ID of the
split horizon group.
l The default split
horizon group ID is 1
and cannot be set
manually.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1609

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Split Horizon Group


Member

l A split horizon group


member indicates the
logical port member in
the split horizon
group.
l The port members that
are added to different
split horizon groups
cannot communicate
with each other.
l The supports only the
division of the split
horizon group
members according to
the Ethernet physical
port.
l If a UNI or NNI logical
port of the 802.1ad
bridge is added to a
split horizon group
member, the physical
port that is mounted
with the logical port is
automatically added to
the split horizon group
member.

Parameters for Unknown Frame Processing


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Frame Type

Unicast

This parameter indicates


the type of the received
unknown frame.

Broadcast

Selects the method of


processing the unknown
frame. If this parameter is
set to Discard, the
unknown frame is directly
discarded. If this
parameter is set to
Broadcast, the unknown
frame is broadcast at the
forwarding port.

Multicast
Handing Mode

Discard
Broadcast

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1610

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.7.4.1 Creating a Static MAC Address Entry
A.7.4.2 Creating a Blacklist Entry of MAC Addresses
A.7.4.3 Configuring the Aging Parameters of a MAC Address Table
A.7.4.4 Querying or Deleting a Dynamic MAC Address
A.7.5 Setting the Mode for Processing an Unknown Frame of the E-LAN Service

B.6.1.6 Parameter Description: QinQ Link_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a QinQ link.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > QinQ Link from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters for the General Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

QinQ Link ID

1 to 4294967295

This parameter specifies


the ID of the QinQ link.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports 1024 QinQ links,
whose IDs must be different
from each other.

Board

This parameter specifies


the board where the QinQ
link is located.

Port

This parameter specifies


the port where the QinQ
link is located.

S-Vlan ID

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the VLAN ID
(at the network
operator side) for the
QinQ link.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Related Tasks
A.7.3.1 Configuring the QinQ Link
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1611

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.6.1.7 Parameter Description: E-AGGR Services_Creation


This topic describes the parameters for creating E-AGGR services.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-AGGR Service from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter specifies


the ID of an E-AGGR
service.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of an E-AGGR
service.

MTU(bytes)

Setting this parameter is


not available.

Service Tag Role

Setting this parameter is


not available.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Location

Sink

This parameter specifies


whether a port functions
as a service source or sink.

UNI Parameters

Source

You can configure one or


more source ports but only
one sink port for an EAGGR service.
Otherwise, configuration
of the E-AGGR service
will fail.
Port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter displays


UNI ports.

1612

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLANs

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the VLAN ID
for a UNI port.
l Set this parameter to a
numeral or several
numerals. When you
set this parameter to
several numerals, use
","s to separate
discrete values and use
" - "s to indicate
consecutive numerals.
For example, 1, 3 - 6
indicates numerals 1,
3, 4, 5, and 6.
l It is recommended that
you do not set this
parameter to null.

Priority

Setting this parameter is


not available.

NNI (PW) Parameters


Table B-8 Basic attributes
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Location

Sink

This parameter specifies


whether a port functions
as a service source or sink.

Source

You can configure one or


more source ports but only
one sink port for an EAGGR service.
Otherwise, configuration
of the E-AGGR service
will fail.
PW ID

1 to 4294967295

This parameter specifies


the ID of a PW.

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

This parameter displays


the signaling type of a
PW.
You need to allocate the
same PW label for both
ends of a static PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1613

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Type

Ethernet

Ethernet

l This parameter
specifies whether PTAGs will be added to
Ethernet frames when
the Ethernet frames are
encapsulated on a PW.

Ethernet Tagged Mode

l If Request VLAN
does not need to be
added to Ethernet
frames that are
encapsulated on a PW,
set this parameter to
Ethernet. If Request
VLAN needs to be
added to Ethernet
frames that are
encapsulated on a PW,
set this parameter to
Ethernet Tagged
Mode.
Currently, this parameter
can be set only to
Ethernet because EAGGR services on the
OptiX RTN 980 do not
support PWs in Ethernet
tagged mode.
PW Direction

This parameter displays


the direction of a PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

This parameter displays


the encapsulation type of
a PW.

PW Incoming Label

16 to 1048575

This parameter specifies


the ingress label for a PW.

PW Outgoing Label

16 to 1048575

This parameter specifies


the egress label for a PW.

Tunnel Selection Mode

This parameter displays


whether an existing
MPLS tunnel or a new
MPLS tunnel is used.

Tunnel Type

This parameter displays


the type of a tunnel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1614

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel

This parameter requires


you to select an existing
static MPLS tunnel. If
there is no static MPLS
tunnel available, PW
creation will fail.

Peer LSR ID

This parameter specifies


the LSR ID for the NE at
the opposite end of a PW.
If an existing MPLS
tunnel is used, the peer
LSR ID is automatically
generated based on the
local LSR ID.

Table B-9 Advanced attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Not in use

Not in use

For ETH PWE3 services,


this parameter has a fixed
value of Not in use.

Control Channel Type

Alert Label
None

This parameter specifies


the control channel type,
which determines the PW
continuity check (CC)
mode.
l None: indicates that
virtual circuit
connectivity
verification (VCCV)
packets are not used.
l
l Alert Label: indicates
that VCCV packets in
Alert Label
encapsulation mode
are used.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1615

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCCV Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

l This parameter
specifies the VCCV
verification mode,
which is used for a PW
CC test.

None

l If the LSP ping


function is used to
implement VCCV,
VCCV Verification
Mode cannot be set to
None.
Request VLAN

Setting this parameter is


not available.

TPID

Setting this parameter is


not available.

Parameters for a VLAN Forwarding Table


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

This parameter specifies


the network attribute for a
source port.

Source Interface

This parameter specifies a


source port.

Source VLAN ID

1 to 4094

This parameter specifies


the source VLAN ID.

Sink Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

This parameter specifies


the network attribute for
the sink port.

Sink Interface

This parameter specifies


the sink port.

Sink VLAN ID

1 to 4094

This parameter specifies


the sink VLAN ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1616

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

NOTE

l Regardless of whether VLAN ID swapping is required by an E-AGGR service, a VLAN forwarding table
needs to be configured, specifying the source and sink VLAN IDs of each VLAN-based service.
l A VLAN forwarding table enables VLAN ID swapping for an E-AGGR service. After a VLAN forwarding
table is created, a service from Source Interface will carry the VLAN ID specified in Sink VLAN ID when
leaving Sink Interface.
l For an E-AGGR service, the VLAN forwarding table specifies bidirectional VLAN ID swapping
relationships. This means that swapping from Sink VLAN ID to Source VLAN ID and swapping from
Source VLAN ID to Sink VLAN ID will be implemented once a VLAN forwarding entry for changing
Source VLAN ID to Sink VLAN ID is configured.
l For service aggregation from UNI ports to an NNI port, Source VLAN ID must take any of the VLAN IDs
that have been configured for UNI ports.
l For service aggregation from NNI ports to a UNI port, Sink VLAN ID must take any of the VLAN IDs that
have been configured for UNI ports.

QoS (PW)
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

This parameter displays


the ID of a PW.

Direction

l This parameter
displays the direction
of a PW.
l Egress: indicates the
egress direction of a
PW.
l Ingress: indicates the
ingress direction of a
PW.

PW Type

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter displays


the type of a PW.

1617

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

This parameter displays or


specifies whether the
bandwidth limit function
is enabled for a PW to
prevent network
congestion.
l For transmission
channels, the
bandwidth limit
function controls the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs as required.
l For services, the
bandwidth limit
function controls the
bandwidth of each
ETH PWE3 service in
an MPLS tunnel,
because an ETH
PWE3 service
corresponds to a PW.

Policy

Setting this parameter is


not available.

CIR(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the committed
information rate (CIR) for
a PW.
The CIR is recommended
to be the same as the PIR.

CBS(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the committed
burst size (CBS) for a PW.

PIR(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the peak
information rate (PIR) for
a PW.
The PIR is recommended
to be the same as the CIR.

PBS(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the peak burst
size (PBS) for a PW.

EXP

Setting this parameter is


not available.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1618

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe: When an egress


node strips off the MPLS
tunnel labels in the
received service packets,
it does not renew the
packet scheduling
priorities.

Related Tasks
A.7.3.6 Creating E-AGGR Services

B.6.1.8 Parameter Description: E-AGGR Services


This topic describes E-AGGR service parameters.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service Management > E-AGGR Service from the Function
Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967294

This parameter specifies


the ID of an E-AGGR
service.

Service Name

This parameter specifies


the name of an E-AGGR
service.

MTU(byte)

Setting this parameter is


not available.

Service Tag Role

Setting this parameter is


not available. OptiX RTN
980.

Deployment Status

This parameter displays


whether an E-AGGR
service has been deployed.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1619

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

UNI Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID

This parameter displays


the ID of a UNI port.

Location

This parameter displays


whether a port functions
as a service source or sink.

Port

This parameter displays


UNI ports.

VLANs

This parameter displays


the VLAN ID of a UNI
port.

Priority

Setting this parameter is


not available.

NNI (PW) Parameters


Table B-10 Basic attributes
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID

This parameter displays


the ID of an NNI port.

Location

This parameter displays


whether a port functions
as a service source or sink.

PW ID

This parameter displays


the ID of a PW.

PW Status

This parameter displays


whether a PW is enabled.

PW Signaling Type

This parameter displays


the signaling type of a
PW.

PW Type

This parameter displays


the type of a PW.

PW Direction

This parameter displays


the direction of a PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

This parameter displays


the encapsulation type of
a PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1620

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Incoming Label

This parameter displays


the ingress label of a PW.

PW Outgoing Label

This parameter displays


the egress label of a PW.

Peer LSR ID

This parameter displays


the LSR ID for the NE at
the opposite end of a PW.

Tunnel Type

This parameter displays


the type of a tunnel.

Tunnel

This parameter displays


the tunnel carrying PWs.
Select an existing static
MPLS tunnel. If there is
no static MPLS tunnel
available, PW creation
will fail.

Control Word

This parameter displays


whether the control word
is used.

Control Channel Type

This parameter displays


the control channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

This parameter displays


the VCCV verification
mode.

Local Operation Status

This parameter displays


the PW running status at
the local end.

Local Operation Status

This parameter displays


the PW running status at
the opposite end.

Overall Operation
Status

This parameter displays


the overall PW running
status.

Request VLAN

This parameter displays


the request VLAN ID.

Automatic Tunnel
Selection Policy

This parameter displays


the automatic tunnel
selection policy.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1621

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TPID

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not allow TPIDs in
request VLANs to be
specified for a PW.

Parameters for a VLAN Forwarding Table


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

This parameter specifies


the network attribute for a
source port.

Source Interface

This parameter specifies a


source port.

Source VLAN ID

1 to 4094

This parameter specifies


the source VLAN ID.

Sink Interface Type

V-UNI

V-UNI

This parameter specifies


the network attribute for
the sink port.

Sink Interface

This parameter specifies


the sink port.

Sink VLAN ID

1 to 4094

This parameter specifies


the sink VLAN ID.

NOTE

l Regardless of whether VLAN ID swapping is required by an E-AGGR service, a VLAN forwarding table
needs to be configured, specifying the source and sink VLAN IDs of each VLAN-based service.
l A VLAN forwarding table enables VLAN ID swapping for an E-AGGR service. After a VLAN forwarding
table is created, a service from Source Interface will carry the VLAN ID specified in Sink VLAN ID when
leaving Sink Interface.
l For an E-AGGR service, the VLAN forwarding table specifies bidirectional VLAN ID swapping
relationships. This means that swapping from Sink VLAN ID to Source VLAN ID and swapping from
Source VLAN ID to Sink VLAN ID will be implemented once a VLAN forwarding entry for changing
Source VLAN ID to Sink VLAN ID is configured.
l For service aggregation from UNI ports to an NNI port, Source VLAN ID must take any of the VLAN IDs
that have been configured for UNI ports.
l For service aggregation from NNI ports to a UNI port, Sink VLAN ID must take any of the VLAN IDs that
have been configured for UNI ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1622

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

QoS (PW)
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

This parameter displays


the ID of a PW.

Direction

l This parameter
displays the direction
of a PW.
l Egress: indicates the
egress direction of a
PW.
l Ingress: indicates the
ingress direction of a
PW.

PW Type

This parameter displays


the type of a PW.

Bandwidth Limit

This parameter displays or


specifies whether the
bandwidth limit function
is enabled for a PW to
prevent network
congestion.
l For transmission
channels, the
bandwidth limit
function controls the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs as required.
l For services, the
bandwidth limit
function controls the
bandwidth of each
ETH PWE3 service in
an MPLS tunnel,
because an ETH
PWE3 service
corresponds to a PW.

Policy

Setting this parameter is


not available.

CIR(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the committed
information rate (CIR) for
a PW.
The CIR is recommended
to be the same as the PIR.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1623

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CBS(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the committed
burst size (CBS) for a PW.

PIR(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the peak
information rate (PIR) for
a PW.
The PIR is recommended
to be the same as the CIR.

PBS(Kbit/s)

This parameter displays or


specifies the peak burst
size (PBS) for a PW.

EXP

Setting this parameter is


not available.

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe: When an egress


node strips off the MPLS
tunnel labels in the
received service packets,
it does not renew the
packet scheduling
priorities.

B.6.2 Parameters for Ethernet Protocols


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Ethernet protocol.

B.6.2.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating ERPS management tasks.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protection > ERPS Management.

2.

Click New.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1624

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ERPS ID

1 to 8

l This parameter
specifies the ID of the
Ethernet ring
protection switching
(ERPS) instance.
l The IDs of ERPS
instances on an NE
must be different from
each other.

East Port

This parameter specifies


the east port of the ERPS
instance.

West Port

This parameter specifies


the west port of the ERPS
instance.

RPL Owner Ring Node


Flag

Yes

No

l This parameter
specifies whether the
node on the ring is the
ring protection link
(RPL) owner.

No

l Only one node on the


ring can be set as the
RPL owner for each
Ethernet ring.
l An RPL owner needs
to balance the traffic
on each link of an
Ethernet ring.
Therefore, it is not
recommended that you
select a convergence
node as an RPL owner.
Instead, select the NE
that is farthest away
from the convergence
node as an RPL owner.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1625

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RPL Port

l This parameter
specifies the RPL port.
l There is only one RPL
port and this RPL port
must be the east or
west port on the RPL
owner node.
l It is recommended that
you set the east port on
an RPL owner as an
RPL Port.

Control VLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the VLAN ID
of Control VLAN.
l Each node on the
Ethernet ring transmits
the R-APS packets on
the dedicated ring APS
(R-APS) channel to
ensure consistency
between the nodes
when the ERPS
switching is
performed. Control
VLAN is used for
isolating the dedicated
R-APS channel.
Therefore, the VLAN
ID in Control VLAN
cannot be duplicate
with the VLAN IDs
that are contained in
the service packets.
l The ID of a Control
VLAN must not be the
same as any VLAN ID
used by Ethernet
services. All ring
nodes should use the
same Control VLAN
ID.

Destination Node

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

01-19-A7-00-00-01

01-19-A7-00-00-01

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
destination node. The
default destination MAC
address in the R-APS
packets is always 01-19A7-00-00-01.
1626

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.7.1.1 Creating Ethernet Ring Protection Instances

B.6.2.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS)
management.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protection > ERPS Management from the Function Tree.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ERPS ID

1 to 8

This parameter indicates


the ID of the ERPS
instance.

East Port

This parameter indicates


the east port of the ERPS
instance.

West Port

This parameter indicates


the west port of the ERPS
instance.

RPL Owner Ring Node


Flag

Yes

This parameter indicates


whether a node on the ring
is the ring protection link
(RPL) owner.

RPL Port

This parameter indicates


the RPL port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

No

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1627

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control VLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the VLAN ID of
Control VLAN.
l Each node on the
Ethernet ring transmits
the R-APS packets on
the dedicated ring APS
(R-APS) channel to
ensure consistency
between the nodes
when the ERPS
switching is
performed. Control
VLAN is used for
isolating the dedicated
R-APS channel.
Therefore, the VLAN
ID in Control VLAN
cannot be duplicate
with the VLAN IDs
that are contained in
the service packets or
inband DCN packets.
l The Control VLAN
must be set to the same
value for all the NEs
on an ERPS ring.

Destination Node

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

01-19-A7-00-00-01

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
destination node. The
default destination MAC
address in the R-APS
packets is always 01-19A7-00-00-01.

1628

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Hold-Off Time(ms)

0 to 10000, in step of 100

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the hold-off time of the
ERPS hold-off timer.
l The hold-off timer is
used for negotiating
the protection
switching sequence
when the ERPS
coexists with other
protection schemes so
that the fault can be
rectified in the case of
other protection
switching (such as
LAG protection)
before the ERPS
occurs. When a node
on the ring detects one
or more new faults, it
starts up the hold-off
timer if the preset
hold-off time is set to a
value that is not 0.
During the hold-off
time, the fault is not
reported to trigger an
ERPS. When the holdoff timer times out, the
node checks the link
status regardless
whether the fault that
triggers the startup of
the timer exists. If the
fault exists, the node
reports it to trigger an
ERPS. This fault can
be the same as or
different from the fault
that triggers the initial
startup of the hold-off
timer.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1629

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Guard Time(ms)

10 to 2000, in step of 10

500

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the guard time of the
ERPS guard timer.
l The nodes on the ring
continuously forward
the R-APS packets to
the Ethernet ring. As a
result, the outdated RAPS packets may exist
on the ring network.
After a node on the
ring receives the
outdated R-APS
packets, an incorrect
ERPS may occur. The
ERPS guard timer is an
R-APS timer used for
preventing a node on
the ring from receiving
outdated R-APS
packets. When a faulty
node on the ring
detects that the
switching condition is
cleared, the node starts
up the guard timer and
starts to forward the RAPS (NR) packets.
During this period, the
R-APS packets
received by the node
are discarded. The
received R-APS
packets are forwarded
only after the time of
the guard timer
expires.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1630

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(mm:ss)

5 to 12, in step of 1

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the WTR time of the
WRT timer in the case
of ERPS protection.
l The WTR time refers
to the duration from
the time when the
working channel is
restored to the time
when the switching is
released. When the
working channel is
restored, the WTR
timer of the RPL
owner starts up. In
addition, a signal that
indicates the operation
of the WTR timer is
continuously output in
the timing process.
When the WTR timer
times out and no
switching request of a
higher priority is
received, the signal
indicating the
operation of the WTR
timer is not
transmitted. In
addition, the WTR
release signal is
continuously output.
l The WTR timer is used
to prevent frequent
switching caused by
the unstable working
channel.

Packet Transmit
Interval(s)

1 to 10

This parameter displays or


specifies the interval for
sending R-APS packets
periodically.

Entity Level

0 to 7

This parameter indicates


or specifies the level of the
maintenance entity.

Last Switching Request

This parameter indicates


the last switching request.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1631

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RB Status

This parameter indicates


the RB (RPL Blocked)
status of the packets
received by the working
node.
l noRB: The RPL is not
blocked.
l RB: The RPL is
blocked.

DNF Status

This parameter indicates


the DNF status of the
packets received by the
working node.
l noDNF: The R-APS
packets do not contain
the DNF flag. In this
case, the packets are
forwarded by the node
that detects the fault on
a non-RPL link, and
the node that receives
the packets is
requested to clear the
forwarding address
table.
l DNF: The R-APS
packets contain the
DNF flags. In this
case, the packets are
forwarded by the node
that detects the fault on
an RPL link, and the
node that receives the
packets is informed
not to clear the
forwarding address
table.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1632

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

State Machine Status

This parameter indicates


the status of the state
machine at the working
node.
l Idle: The Ethernet ring
is in normal state. For
example, no node on
the Ethernet ring
detects any faults or
receives the R_APS
(NR, RB) packets.
l Protection: The
Ethernet ring is in
protected state. For
example, a fault on the
node triggers the
ERPS, or a node on the
ring is in the WTR
period after the fault is
rectified.

Node Carried with


Current Packet

This parameter indicates


the MAC address carried
in the R-APS packets
received by the current
node. The MAC address
refers to the MAC address
of the source node that
initiates the switching
request.

East Port Status

Displays the status of the


east port.

West Port Status

Displays the status of the


west port.

Related Tasks
A.7.1.2 Setting the Parameters of Ethernet Ring Protocol
A.7.1.3 Querying the Status of the Ethernet Ring Protocol

B.6.2.3 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating MSTP port groups.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1633

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Group Parameters tab.

3.

Click Create.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protocol Type

MSTP

MSTP

This parameter specifies


the protocol type.

STP

l MSTP: stands for


Multiple Spanning
Tree Protocol. The
OptiX RTN 980
supports the CIST
MSTP only.
l STP: stands for
Spanning Tree
Protocol.
Enable Protocol

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter
specifies whether to
enable the protocol of
the port group or a
member port in the
port group.
l If the STP or MSTP is
enabled, the spanning
tree topology is
automatically reconfigured. As a
result, the services are
interrupted.

Parameters for Application Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter specifies


the board where the
member of port group is
located.

Available Port List

This parameter indicates


the available port list in
which a port can be added
to the port group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1634

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Selected Port List

This parameter indicates


the selected ports that can
be added to the port group.

Related Tasks
A.7.6.1 Creating the MSTP Port Group

B.6.2.4 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Configuration


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating MSTP port groups.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Group Parameters tab.

3.

On the main interface, select the port group to be configured.

4.

Click Config. The Config Port Group dialog box is displayed.

Parameters for the Added Port


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter specifies


the board where the
member of port group is
located.

Available Port List

This parameter indicates


the available port list in
which a port needs to be
added to the port group.

Selected Port List

This parameter indicates


the selected ports that
need to be added to the
port group.

Related Tasks
A.7.6.7 Modifying the Configuration Data of the MSTP Port Group

B.6.2.5 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_ Bridge Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to MSTP bridges.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1635

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Bridge Parameters tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Group ID

l This parameter
indicates the ID of the
port group.
l This parameter can be
set to only the port
group ID that is
automatically
allocated.

MST Domain Name

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Redaction Level

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Mapping List

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Group ID

l This parameter
indicates the ID of the
port group.

Bridge Parameters

l This parameter can be


set to only the port
Group ID that is
automatically
allocated.
MST Domain Max Hop
Count

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

20

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Specifies the maximum


hop count of the MSTP.

1636

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Network Diameter

2 to 7

l This parameter
specifies the MSTP
network diameter.
l Network Diameter is
related to the link
whose number of
switches is the most
and is indicated by the
number of switches
that are connected to
the link. When you set
Network Diameter
for the switches, the
MSTP automatically
sets Max Age(s),
Hello Time(s), and
Forward Delay(s) to
the more appropriate
values for the
switches.
l If the value of
Network Diameter is
greater, the network is
in a larger scale.

Hello Time(s)

1 to 10

l This parameter
specifies the interval
for transmitting the
CBPDU packets
through the bridge.
l The greater the value
of this parameter, the
less the network
resources that are
occupied by the
spanning tree. The
topology stability,
however, decreases.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1637

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Max Age(s)

6 to 40

20

l This parameter
specifies the
maximum age of the
CBPDU packet that is
recorded by the port.
l The greater the value,
the longer the
transmission distance
of the CBPDU, which
indicates that the
network diameter is
greater. When the
value of this parameter
is greater, it is less
possible that the bridge
detects the link fault in
a timely manner and
thus the network
adaptation ability is
reduced.

Forward Delay(s)

4 to 30

15

l This parameter
specifies the holdoff
time of a port in the
listening state and in
the learning state.
l The greater the value,
the longer the delay of
the network state
change. Hence, the
topology changes are
slower and the
recovery in the case of
faults is slower.

Port Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port in the port group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1638

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable Edge Attribute

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter
specifies the
management edge
attributes of the port.

Enabled

l This parameter
specifies whether to
set the port as an edge
port. The edge port
refers to the bridge
port that is connected
to the LAN. In normal
cases, this port does
not receive or transmit
BPDU messages.
l This parameter can be
set to Enabled only
when the port is
directly connected to
the data
communications
terminal equipment,
such as a computer. In
other cases, it is
recommended that you
use the default value.
Actual Edge Attribute

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the actual management
edge attributes of the port.

1639

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Point-to-Point Attribute

false

auto

l This parameter
specifies the point-topoint attribute of the
port.

true
auto

l false: forced nonpoint-to-point link


attribute
l true: forced point-topoint link attribute
l auto: automatically
detected point-topoint link attribute
l If this parameter is set
to auto, the bridge
determines Actual
Point-to-Point
Attribute of the port
according to the actual
working mode. If the
actual working mode
is full-duplex, the
actual point-to-point
attribute is true. If the
actual working mode
is half-duplex, Actual
Point-to-Point
Attribute is false.
l Only the designated
port whose Actual
Point-to-Point
Attribute is "True"
can transmit the rapid
state migration request
and response.
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.
Actual Point-to-Point
Attribute

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the actual point-to-point
attribute of the port.

1640

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Max Transmit Packet


Count

1 to 255

l This parameter
specifies the
maximum number of
packets to be
transmitted.
l The maximum number
of packets to be
transmitted by the port
refers to the maximum
number of MSTP
packets that the port
can transmit within 1s.
l This parameter needs
to be set according to
the planning
information.

Related Tasks
A.7.6.2 Setting the Bridge Parameters of the MSTP

B.6.2.6 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_CIST Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the MSTP CIST.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the CIST&MSTI Parameters tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Group

This parameter specifies


the port group.

MSTI ID

This parameter indicates


the MSTI ID. The value 0
indicates common and
internal spanning tree
(CIST). The OptiX RTN
980 supports only the
MSTP that uses CIST.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1641

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bridge Priority

0 to 61440, in step of 4096

32768

l The most significant


16 bits of the bridge ID
indicate the priority of
the bridge.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher. As a result, the
bridge is more possible
to be selected as the
root bridge.
l If the priorities of all
the bridges in the STP/
MSTP network use the
same value, the bridge
whose MAC address is
the smallest is selected
as the root bridge.

Port Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port in the port group.

Priority

0 to 240, in step of 16

128

l The most significant


eight bits of the port ID
indicate the port
priority.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher.

1 to 200000000

Path Cost

FE Port: 200000
GE Port: 20000

l This parameter
indicates the status of
the network that the
port is connected to.
l In the case of the
bridges on both ends of
the path, set this
parameter to the same
value.

Related Tasks
A.7.6.3 Setting the Parameters of the CIST

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1642

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.6.2.7 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Running Information About


the CIST
This topic describes the parameters that are related to the running information about the MSTP
CIST.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the CIST Running Information tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Group ID

This parameter indicates


the ID of the port group.

Protocol Running Mode

MSTP

l This parameter
indicates the running
mode of the protocol.

STP

l MSTP: stands for


Multiple Spanning
Tree Protocol. The
OptiX RTN 980
supports only the
CIST-based MSTP.
l STP: stands for
Spanning Tree
Protocol.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1643

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bridge Priority

0 to 61440, in step of 4096

32768

l This parameter
indicates the priority
of the bridge.
l The most significant
16 bits of the bridge ID
indicate the priority of
the bridge.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher. As a result, the
bridge is more possible
to be selected as the
root bridge.
l If the priorities of all
the bridges in the STP
network use the same
value, the bridge
whose MAC address is
the smallest is selected
as the root bridge.

Bridge MAC Address

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
bridge.

Root Bridge Priority

0 to 61440, in step of 4096

32768

This parameter indicates


the priority of the root
bridge.

Root Bridge MAC


Address

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
root bridge.

External Path Cost


ERPC

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Domain Root Bridge


Priority

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Domain Root Bridge


MAC Address

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Internal Path Cost IRPC

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1644

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Root Port Priority

0 to 240, in step of 16

128

l This parameter
indicates the priority
of the root port.
l The most significant
eight bits of the ID of
the root port indicate
the priority of the root
port.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher.

Root Port

This parameter indicates


the root port.

Hello Time(s)

l This parameter
indicates the interval
for transmitting
CBPDU packets
through the bridge.
l The greater the value
of this parameter, the
less the network
resources that are
occupied by the
spanning tree. The
topology stability,
however, decreases.

Max Age(s)

6 to 40

20

l This parameter
specifies the
maximum age of the
CBPDU packet that is
recorded by the port.
l The greater the value,
the longer the
transmission distance
of the CBPDU, which
indicates that the
network diameter is
greater. When the
value of this parameter
is greater, it is less
possible that the bridge
detects the link fault in
a timely manner and
thus the network
adaptation ability is
reduced.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1645

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Forward Delay(s)

4 to 30

15

l This parameter
specifies the holdoff
time of a port in the
listening state and in
the learning state.
l The greater the value,
the longer the delay of
the network state
change. Hence, the
topology changes are
slower and the
recovery in the case of
faults is slower.

MST Domain Max Hop


Count

This parameter indicates


the maximum hop count
of the MSTP.

Topology Change Count

This parameter indicates


the identifier of the
topology change.

Last Topology Change


Time(s)

This parameter indicates


the duration of the last
topology change.

Topology Change Count

This parameter indicates


the count of the topology
changes.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port in the port group.

Enable Protocol

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter indicates


whether the protocol of
the port group or a
member of the port group
is enabled.

Disabled

This parameter indicates


the role of a port.

Port Parameters

Disabled

Port Role

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1646

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Status

Discarding

Discarding

This parameter indicates


the state of a port.

Learning

l Discarding: receives
only BPDU packets

Forwarding

l Learning: only
receives or transmits
BPDU packets
l Forwarding: forwards
user traffic, and
transmits/receives
BPDU packets
Priority

0 to 240, in step of 16

128

l The most significant


eight bits of the port ID
indicate the port
priority.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher.

Path Cost

1 to 200000000

200000

l This parameter
indicates the status of
the network that the
port is connected to.
l In the case of the
bridges on both ends of
the path, set this
parameter to the same
value.

Bridge Priority

0 to 61440, in step of 4096

32768

l The most significant


16 bits of the bridge ID
indicate the priority of
the bridge.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher. As a result, the
bridge is more possible
to be selected as the
root bridge.
l If the priorities of all
the bridges in the STP
network use the same
value, the bridge
whose MAC address is
the smallest is selected
as the root bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1647

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bridge MAC Address

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
bridge.

Designated Port Priority

0 to 240, in step of 16

l The most significant


eight bits of the port ID
indicate the port
priority.
l When the value is
smaller, the priority is
higher.

Design Port

This parameter indicates


the designated port.

Edge Port Attribute

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter
specifies the
management edge
attributes of the port.

Enabled

l This parameter
specifies whether to
set the port as an edge
port. The edge port
refers to the bridge
port that is connected
to the LAN. In normal
cases, this port does
not receive or transmit
BPDU messages.
l This parameter can be
set to Enabled only
when the port is
directly connected to
the data
communications
terminal equipment,
such as a computer. In
other cases, it is
recommended that you
use the default value.
Actual Edge Port
Attribute

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the actual management
edge attributes of the port.

1648

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Point to Point

false

auto

l This parameter
specifies the point-topoint attribute of the
port.

true
auto

l false: forced nonpoint-to-point link


attribute
l true: forced point-topoint link attribute
l auto: automatically
detected point-topoint link attribute
l If this parameter is set
to auto, the bridge
determines Actual
Point to Point
Attribute of the port
according to the actual
working mode. If the
actual working mode
is full-duplex, the
actual point-to-point
attribute is true. If the
actual working mode
is half-duplex, Actual
Point to Point
Attribute is false.
l Only the designated
port whose Actual
Point-to-Point
Attribute is "True"
can transmit the rapid
state migration request
and response.
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.
Actual Point to Point

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the actual point-to-point
attribute of the port.

1649

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Max Count of
Transmitting Message

1 to 255

l This parameter
indicates the
maximum number of
packets to be
transmitted.
l The maximum number
of packets to be
transmitted by the port
refers to the maximum
number of MSTP
packets that the port
can transmit within 1s.

Protocol Running Mode

STP

MSTP

l This parameter
indicates the running
mode of the protocol.
l MSTP: stands for
Multiple Spanning
Tree Protocol. The
OptiX RTN 980
supports only the
CIST-based MSTP.
l STP: stands for
Spanning Tree
Protocol.

Hello Time(s)

1 to 10

l This parameter
indicates the interval
for transmitting the
CBPDU packets
through the bridge.
l The greater the value
of this parameter, the
less the network
resources that are
occupied by the
spanning tree. The
topology stability,
however, decreases.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1650

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Max Age(s)

6 to 40

20

l This parameter
specifies the
maximum age of the
CBPDU packet that is
recorded by the port.
l The greater the value,
the longer the
transmission distance
of the CBPDU, which
indicates that the
network diameter is
greater. When the
value of this parameter
is greater, it is less
possible that the bridge
detects the link fault in
a timely manner and
thus the network
adaptation ability is
reduced.

4 to 30

Forward Delay(s)

15

l This parameter
specifies the holding
time of a port in the
listening state and in
the learning state.
l The greater the value,
the longer the delay of
the network state
change. Hence, the
topology changes are
slower and the
recovery in the case of
faults is slower.

Remain Hop

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Related Tasks
A.7.6.4 Querying the CIST Running Information

B.6.2.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation Management_LAG


Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a link aggregation group (LAG).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1651

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAG No.

l This parameter
specifies the LAG
number to be set
manually.
l This parameter is valid
only when
Automatically
Assign is not selected.

Automatically Assign

Selected

Selected

Deselected

l This parameter
indicates whether
LAG No. is allocated
automatically.
l When Automatically
Assign is selected,
LAG No. cannot be
set.

LAG Name

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter specifies


the LAG name.

1652

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAG Type

Static

Static

l Static: You can create


a LAG. When you add
or delete a member
port to or from the
LAG, the Link
Aggregation Control
Protocol (LACP)
protocol is required. In
a LAG, a port can be in
selected, standby, or
unselected state. The
aggregation
information is
exchanged among
different equipment
through the LACP
protocol to ensure that
the aggregation
information is the
same among all the
nodes.

Manual

l Manual: You can


create a LAG. When
you add or delete a
member port, the
LACP protocol is not
required. The port can
be in the up or down
state. The system
determines whether to
aggregate a port
according to its
physical state (UP or
DOWN), working
mode, and rate.
Switch Protocol

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Switch Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Link Trace Protocol

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1653

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Revertive Mode

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive Mode

l Revertive Mode can


be set only when Load
Sharing is set to NonSharing.

Non-Revertive Mode

l When Revertive
Mode is set to
Revertive Mode, the
services are switched
back to the former
working channel after
this channel is restored
to normal.
l When Revertive
Mode is set to NonRevertive Mode, the
status of the LAG does
not change after the
former working
channel is restored to
normal. That is, the
services are still
transmitted on the
protection channel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1654

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Load Sharing

Sharing

Non-Sharing

l Set Load Sharing to


the same value as the
peer equipment. It is
recommended that you
set Load Sharing to
Non-Sharing at both
ends if the LAGs are
used for protection and
set Load Sharing to
Sharing at both ends if
the LAGs are used for
increasing
bandwidths.

Non-Sharing

l Sharing: Each member


link of a LAG
processes traffic at the
same time and shares
the traffic load. The
sharing mode can
increase a bandwidth
utilization for the link.
When the LAG
members change, or
certain links fail, the
system automatically
re-allocates the traffic.
l Non-Sharing: Only
one member link of a
LAG carries traffic,
and the other link is in
the standby state. In
this case, a hot backup
mechanism is
provided. When the
active link of a LAG is
faulty, the system
activates the standby
link, thus preventing
link failure.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1655

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Load Sharing Hash


Algorithm

Source MAC

Source MAC

l This parameter is valid


only when Load
Sharing of a LAG is
set to Sharing.

Destination MAC
Source and Destination
MAC
Source IP
Destination IP
Source and Destination IP
MPLS Label

l The load sharing


computation methods
include computation
based on MAC
addresses (based on
the source MAC
address, based on the
destination MAC
address, and based on
the source MAC
address + sink MAC
address), computation
based on IP addresses
(based on the source IP
address, based on the
destination IP address,
and based on the
source IP address and
sink IP address), and
computation based on
MPLS labels.
l After the configuration
data is deployed, Load
Sharing Hash
Algorithm takes
effect for the entire
NE.
l For PW-carried UNINNI E-Line services,
Load Sharing Hash
Algorithm cannot be
set to MPLS Label.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1656

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

System Priority

0 to 65535

32768

l System Priority
indicates the priority
of a LAG. The smaller
the value of System
Priority, the higher
the priority.
l When a local LAG
negotiates with an
opposite LAG through
LACP packets, both
LAGs can obtain the
system priorities of
each other. Then, the
LAG of the higher
system priority is
considered as the
comparison result of
both LAGs so that the
aggregation
information is
consistent at both
LAGs. If the priorities
of both LAGs are the
same, the system MAC
addresses are
compared. Then, the
comparison result
based on the LAG with
smaller system MAC
address is considered
as the result of both
LAGs and is used to
ensure that the
aggregation
information is
consistent at both
LAGs.

WTR Time(min)

1 to 30

10

l Specifies the WTR


time for the LAG.
l WTR Time(min)
takes effect only when
Revertive Mode is
Revertive Mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1657

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switch LAG upon Air


Interface SD

Disabled

Enabled

l This parameter
specifies whether to
enable the switching
triggered by bit errors.

Enabled

l If Switch LAG upon


Air Interface SD is set
to Enabled, the
MW_BER_SD alarm
will trigger the LAG
switching at the air
interface.

Port Settings Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Main Board

l This parameter
specifies the main
board in a LAG.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Main Port

l This parameter
specifies the main port
in a LAG.
l After a LAG is created,
you can add Ethernet
services to the main
port only. Services
cannot be added to a
slave port. When Load
Sharing is set to NonSharing, the link
connected to the main
port is used to transmit
the services, and the
link connected to the
slave port is used for
protection.

Board (Available Slave


Ports)

l This parameter
specifies the slave
board in a LAG.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1658

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port (Available Slave


Ports)

l This parameter
specifies the salve port
in a LAG.
l The slave ports in a
LAG are fixed. Unless
they are manually
modified, the system
does not automatically
add them to or delete
them from the LAG.

Selected Standby Ports

This parameter indicates


the selected slave ports.

Related Tasks
A.7.2.1 Creating a LAG

B.6.2.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Link Aggregation


This section describes the parameters for port priorities and system priorities.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Interface
Management > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Priority tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port whose priority can
be set.

Port Priority

0 to 65535

32768

l This parameter
indicates the priorities
of the ports in a LAG
as defined in the LACP
protocol. The smaller
the value, the higher
the priority.
l When ports are added
into a LAG, the port of
the highest priority is
preferred for service
transmission.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1659

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.7.2.2 Setting LAG Parameters

B.6.2.10 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Point LPT


This topic describes the parameters that are related to point-to-point LPT.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Point-to-Point LPT tab.

Parameters on the main interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Binding Status

This parameter displays


the binding status of pointto-point services.

Primary Function Point

This parameter displays


the port where the primary
point of point-to-point
LPT resides.

Secondary Function
Point Type

This parameter displays


the type of secondary
point for point-to-point
LPT.

Secondary Function
Point

This parameter displays


the port where the
secondary point of pointto-point LPT resides.

LPT Instance Status

This parameter displays


the status of point-to-point
LPT.

LPT Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter displays or


specifies the enabling
status of point-to-point
LPT.

Disabled

The LPT function can take


effect only when LPT
Enabled is set to
Enabled.
Recovery Times(s)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

1-600

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter displays or


specifies the recovery time
of point-to-point LPT.

1660

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Hold-Off Times(ms)

0-10000

1000

This parameter displays or


specifies the hold-off time
of point-to-point LPT.

Switching Mode

This parameter displays


the switching mode of
point-to-point LPT. Pointto-point LPT is available
only in strict mode.

Fault Detection Mode

PW OAM

LPT OAM

This parameter displays


the fault detection mode of
point-to-multipoint LPT.

LPT OAM

l LPT-enabled NEs
periodically transmit
LPT OAM packets in
specific formats to
check the status of an
L2 service network or
QinQ service network.
If the LPT OAM
packets are absent for
3.5 fault detection
periods or the number
and contents of
received LPT OAM
packets are incorrect,
the NEs consider that a
network-side fault
occurred and the LPT
switching is triggered.
l To detect a networkside fault on a PSN,
LPT OAM or PW
OAM packets can be
used. Note that the PW
OAM function must be
enabled on NEs before
usage of PW OAM
packets.
Fault Detection Period
(100ms)

10-100

10

This parameter displays or


specifies the fault
detection period of pointto-point LPT.

User-Side Port Status

This parameter displays


the status of a user-side
port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1661

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

L2 net ID-L2 Peer net ID

This parameter displays


the NET IDs of LPT
packet out ports at both
ends.

Related Tasks
A.7.10.1 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing an L2 Network
A.7.10.2 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing a PSN or QinQ Network

B.6.2.11 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creating Point-to-Point LPT


This topic describes the parameters that are related to creating point-to-point LPT.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Point-to-Point LPT tab.

3.

Click Bind in the lower right corner of the pane based on the type of service network.

4.

Choose PW+QinQ or L2 net from the shortcut menu based on the type of service network.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

L2 net ID

1-4294967295

This parameter specifies


the NET ID of LPT packet
out port at the local end.

L2 Peer net ID

1-4294967295

This parameter specifies


the NET ID of LPT packet
out port at the opposite
end.

Primary Function Point

This parameter specifies


the port where the primary
point of point-to-point
LPT resides.

VLAN ID

1-4094

This parameter specifies


the VLAN ID that is
carried by a point-to-point
LPT packet to traverse an
L2 network.

LPT package out port

This parameter specifies


the out port of a point-topoint LPT packet.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1662

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.7.10.1 Configuring Point-to-Point LPT Traversing an L2 Network

B.6.2.12 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Point-to-Multipoint LPT


This topic describes the parameters that are related to point-to-multipoint LPT.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Point-to-Multipoint LPT tab.

Parameters of Primary Point


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Primary Function Point


Type

This parameter displays


the type of primary point
for point-to-multipoint
LPT.

Primary Function Point

This parameter displays


the port where the primary
point of point-tomultipoint LPT resides.

LPT Instance Status

This parameter displays


the status of point-tomultipoint LPT.

LPT Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter displays


the enabling status of
point-to-multipoint LPT.

Disabled
Recovery Times(s)

1-600

This parameter displays or


specifies the recovery time
of point-to-multipoint
LPT.

Hold-Off Times(ms)

0-10000

1000

This parameter displays or


specifies the hold-off time
of point-to-multipoint
LPT.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1663

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switching Mode

Strict mode

Strict mode

This parameter displays


the switching mode of
point-to-multipoint LPT.
Point-to-point LPT is
available only in strict
mode.

Non-strict mode

l Strict mode
A primary point
triggers LPT switching
when all its secondary
points detect faults.
l Non-strict mode
A primary point
triggers LPT switching
when anyone of its
secondary points
detects a fault.
Fault Detection Mode

PW OAM

LPT OAM

LPT OAM

This parameter displays


the fault detection mode of
point-to-multipoint LPT.
l LPT-enabled NEs
periodically transmit
LPT OAM packets in
specific formats to
check the status of an
L2 service network or
QinQ service network.
If the LPT OAM
packets are absent for
3.5 fault detection
periods or the number
and contents of
received LPT OAM
packets are incorrect,
the NEs consider that a
network-side fault
occurred and the LPT
switching is triggered.
l To detect a networkside fault on a PSN,
LPT OAM or PW
OAM packets can be
used. Note that the PW
OAM function must be
enabled on NEs before
usage of PW OAM
packets.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1664

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Fault Detection Period


(100ms)

10-100

10

This parameter displays or


specifies the fault
detection period of pointto-multipoint LPT.

User-Side Port Status

This parameter displays


the status of a user-side
port.

L2 net ID-L2 Peer net ID

This parameter displays


the NET IDs of LPT
packet out ports at both
ends, when the service
network is an L2 network.

Parameters of Secondary Point


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Access Point Type

This parameter displays


the type of second point
for point-to-multipoint
LPT.

Access Point

This parameter displays


the port or PW ID for the
secondary point of pointto-multipoint LPT.

User-Side Port Status

This parameter displays


the status of a user-side
port.

L2 net ID-L2 Peer net ID

This parameter displays


the NET IDs of LPT
packet out ports at both
ends, when the service
network is an L2 network.

Related Tasks
A.7.10.3 Configuring Point-to-Multipoint LPT

B.6.2.13 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creating Point-to-Multipoint


LPT
This topic describes the parameters that are related to creating point-to-multipoint LPT.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1665

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT
Management > LPT from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Point-to-Multipoint LPT tab.

3.

Click New in the lower right corner of the pane based on the type of service network.

4.

Choose PW, QinQ, or L2 net from the shortcut menu based on the type of service network.

Parameters of primary point


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Point Type

UNI

This parameter specifies


the type of primary point
for point-to-multipoint
LPT. The value range of
this parameter pertains to
the type of service
network.

PW
QinQ
L2 net

If the primary point is on


the access side, select
UNI; if the primary point
is on the network side, set
the parameter as follows.
l If the service network
is a PSN, select PW.
l If the service network
is a QinQ network,
select QinQ.
l If the service network
is an L2 network,
select L2 net.
Board

This parameter specifies


the board where the
primary point of point-tomultipoint LPT resides.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to UNI.

Port

This parameter specifies


the port where the primary
point of point-tomultipoint LPT resides.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to UNI.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1666

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Point ID

This parameter specifies


the service ID for the
primary point of point-tomultipoint LPT.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to PW or QinQ.

L2 net ID

1-4294967295

This parameter specifies


the NET ID of a local NE.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type of
the primary point is set to
UNI, and when Point
Type of the secondary
point is set to L2 net.

L2 Peer net ID

1-4294967295

This parameter specifies


the NET ID of an opposite
NE.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to L2 net.

VLAN ID

1-4094

This parameter specifies


the VLAN ID that is
carried by an LPT packet
to traverse an L2 network.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to L2 net.

LPT package out port

This parameter specifies


the out port of an LPT
packet.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to L2 net.

Parameters of secondary point


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Point Type

UNI

This parameter displays or


specifies the type of
secondary point for pointto-multipoint LPT.

PW
QinQ
L2 net

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1667

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter specifies


the board where the
secondary point of pointto-multipoint LPT resides.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to PW, QinQ, or L2
net.

Available Points

This parameter displays


the available ports where
the secondary point of
point-to-multipoint LPT
can reside.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to PW, QinQ, or L2
net.

Selected Points

This parameter displays


the selected port where the
secondary point of pointto-multipoint LPT resides.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to PW, QinQ, or L2
net.

L2 net ID

1-4294967295

This parameter specifies


the NET ID of a local NE.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type is
set to UNI.

L2 Peer net ID

1-4294967295

This parameter specifies


the NET ID of an opposite
NE.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type of
the primary point is set to
UNI, and when Point
Type of the secondary
point is set to L2 net.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1668

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

1-4094

This parameter specifies


the VLAN ID that is
carried by an LPT packet
to traverse an L2 network.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type of
the primary point is set to
UNI, and when Point
Type of the secondary
point is set to L2 net.

LPT Package out port

This parameter specifies


the out port of an LPT
packet.
This parameter is valid
only when Point Type of
the primary point is set to
UNI, and when Point
Type of the secondary
point is set to L2 net.

Related Tasks
A.7.10.3 Configuring Point-to-Multipoint LPT

B.6.3 Parameters for the Ethernet OAM


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Ethernet operation, administration and
maintenance (OAM).

B.6.3.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance


Domain Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating maintenance domains.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Choose New > New Maintenance Domain.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1669

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Domain Name

default

l This parameter specifies the name of the


maintenance domain.
l The maintenance domain refers to the
network for the Ethernet OAM.
l This parameter can contain a maximum
of eight bytes.

Maintenance
Domain Level

l Maintenance Domain Level specifies


the level of the maintenance domain.
l The values 0 to 7 indicates maintenance
domain levels in an ascending order.

2
3

l MEPs transparently transmit OAM


protocol packets if the packets have a
higher level than the parameter value.

4
5
6

l MEPs discard OAM protocol packets if


the packets have a lower level than the
parameter value.

l MEPs respond to or terminate OAM


protocol packets based on the packet type
if the packets have the same level as the
parameter value.

Related Tasks
A.7.8.1 Creating an MD

B.6.3.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance


Association Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating maintenance associations.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Select the maintenance domain in which a maintenance association needs to be created.


Choose New > New Maintenance Association.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1670

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Domain Name

This parameter indicates the maintenance


domain of the created maintenance
association.

Maintenance
Association Name

l This parameter specifies the name of the


maintenance association, which is a
domain related to a service. Through
maintenance association division, the
connectivity check (CC) can be
performed on the network that transmits
a service instance.
l This parameter can contain a maximum
of eight bytes.

Relevant Service

This parameter specifies the service


instance that is related to the maintenance
association.

CC Test Transmit
Period

1s

1s

l This parameter specifies the interval for


transmitting packets in the CC.

10s

l The CC is performed to check the


availability of the service.

1m
10m

Related Tasks
A.7.8.2 Creating an MA

B.6.3.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MEP Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a maintenance association end
point (MEP).

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Select the maintenance association in which an MEP needs to be created. Choose New >
New MEP Point.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Domain Name

This parameter indicates the maintenance


domain of the created MEP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1671

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Association Name

This parameter indicates the maintenance


association of the created MEP.

Board

This parameter specifies the board where


the MEP is located.

Port

This parameter specifies the port where the


MEP is located.

VLAN

This parameter indicates the VLAN ID of


the current service.

MP ID

1 to 2048

l This parameter specifies the MEP ID.


l Each MEP needs to be configured with
an MP ID, which is unique in the
maintenance association. The MP ID is
required in the OAM operation.

Direction

Ingress

Ingress

Egress

l Direction specifies the direction of the


MEP.
l Ingress indicates the direction in which
the packets are transmitted to the port,
and Egress indicates the direction in
which the packets are transmitted from
the port.

CC Status

Active

Active

Inactive

l This parameter specifies whether to


enable the CC function of the MEP.
l In the case of the tests based on the MP
IDs, CC Status must be set to Active.

AIS Active Status

Active

Active

Inactive

l This parameter specifies the AIS active


status.
l If several MDs exist on a link, to locate
a fault accurately, set AIS Active
Status to Active and Client Layer
Level that functions to suppress the AIS
information.
l After a fault is detected by an MP, if this
MP activates the AIS, it sends the AIS
packet to a higher level MP, informing
the higher level MP of the fault
information; if this MP does not activate
the AIS, it does not report the fault.

Client Layer Level

1 to 7

l Normally, if an MP is set to level n,


Client Layer Level that functions to
suppress the AIS information should be
set to n+1.
l Client Layer Level is valid only if AIS
Active Status is Active.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1672

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.7.8.3 Creating MEPs

B.6.3.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Remote MEP


Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a remote MEP.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Choose OAM > Manage Remote MEP Point. The Manage Remote MEP Point dialog
box is displayed.

4.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Domain Name

This parameter indicates the maintenance


domain of the MEP.

Maintenance
Association Name

This parameter indicates the maintenance


association of the created MEP.

Remote
Maintenance Point
ID(e.g:1,3-6)

1 to 2048

l This parameter specifies the ID of the


remote MEP.
l If other MEPs will initiate OAM
operations to an MEP in the same MA,
set these MEPs as remote MEPs.

Related Tasks
A.7.8.4 Creating Remote MEPs in an MA

B.6.3.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MIP Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a maintenance association
intermediate point (MIP).

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the MIP Point tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1673

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

3.

B Parameters Description

Select the maintenance domain in which an MIP needs to be created, and then click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Domain Name

This parameter indicates the maintenance


domain of the MIP.

Board

This parameter specifies the board where


the MIP is located.

Port

This parameter specifies the port where the


MIP is located.

MP ID

1 to 2048

l This parameter specifies the MIP ID.


l Each MIP needs to be configured with an
MP ID, which is unique in the
maintenance domain. The MP ID is
required in the OAM operation.
NOTE
To create MEPs and MIPs in a service at a
port, ensure that only one MIP can be created
and the level of the MIP must be higher than
the level of the MEP.

Related Tasks
A.7.8.5 Creating MIPs

B.6.3.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LB Enabling


This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the LB.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Select the maintenance domain and maintenance association for the LB test.

4.

Choose OAM > Start LB.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination
Maintenance Point
ID

Selected

Deselected

This parameter needs to be selected if the


LB test is performed on the basis of
Destination Maintenance Point IDs.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Deselected

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1674

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination
Maintenance Point
MAC Address

Selected

Selected

This parameter needs to be selected if the


LB test is performed on the basis of MAC
addresses.

Maintenance
Domain Name

This parameter indicates the name of the


maintenance domain for the LB test.

Maintenance
Association Name

This parameter indicates the name of the


maintenance association for the LB test.

Source
Maintenance Point
ID

l This parameter specifies the source


maintenance point in the LB test.

Destination
Maintenance Point
ID

Deselected

l Only the MEP can be set to the source


maintenance point.
-

l This parameter specifies the destination


maintenance point in the LB test.
l Only the MEP ID can be set to the
Destination Maintenance Point ID.
l Destination Maintenance Point ID can
be set only when MP ID is selected.

Destination
Maintenance Point
MAC Address

00-00-00-00-00-00

l This parameter specifies the MAC


address of the port where the destination
maintenance point is located in the LB
test.
l Only the MAC address of the MEP can
be set to the MAC address of the
Destination Maintenance Point MAC
Address.
l Destination Maintenance Point MAC
Address can be set only when Sink
Maintenance Point MAC Address.

Transmitted
Packet Count

1 to 255

l This parameter specifies the number of


packets transmitted each time in the LB
test.
l When the value is greater, the required
duration is longer.

Transmitted
Packet Length

64 to 1400

64

l This parameter specifies the length of a


transmitted LBM packet.
l If the packet length is different, the test
result may be different. In normal cases,
it is recommended that you use the
default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1675

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Transmitted
Packet Priority

0 to 7

l This parameter specifies the priority of


transmitting packets.
l 0 indicates the lowest priority, and 7
indicates the highest priority. In normal
cases, this parameter is set to the highest
priority.

Detection Result

This parameter indicates the relevant


information and result of the LB test.

Related Tasks
A.7.8.7 Performing an LB Test

B.6.3.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LT Enabling


This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the LT.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3.

Select the maintenance domain and maintenance association for the LT test.

4.

Choose OAM > Start LT.

Test Node Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination
Maintenance Point
ID

Selected

Deselected

This parameter needs to be selected if the LT


test is performed on the basis of MP IDs.

Destination
Maintenance Point
MAC Address

Selected

Selected

This parameter needs to be selected if the LT


test is performed on the basis of MAC
addresses.

Maintenance
Domain Name

This parameter indicates the name of the


maintenance domain for the LT test.

Maintenance
Association Name

This parameter indicates the name of the


maintenance association for the LT test.

Source
Maintenance Point
ID

l This parameter specifies the source


maintenance point in the LT test.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Deselected

Deselected

l Only the MEP can be set to the source


maintenance point.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1676

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Destination
Maintenance Point
ID

l This parameter specifies the destination


maintenance point in the LT test.
l Only the MEP ID can be set to the
Destination Maintenance Point ID.
l Destination Maintenance Point ID can
be set only when MP ID is selected.

Destination
Maintenance Point
MAC Address

00-00-00-00-00-00

l This parameter specifies the MAC


address of the port where the destination
maintenance point is located in the LT
test.
l Only the MAC address of the MEP can
be set to the MAC address of the
Destination Maintenance Point MAC
Address.
l Destination Maintenance Point MAC
Address can be set only when Sink
Maintenance Point MAC Address.

Parameters for the Detection Result


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source
Maintenance Point
ID

This parameter indicates the source


maintenance point in the LT test.

Destination
Maintenance Point
ID/MAC

This parameter indicates the MAC address


of the port where the destination
maintenance point is located in the LT test.

Response
Maintenance Point
ID/MAC

This parameter indicates the MAC address


of the port where the responding
maintenance point is located in the LT test.

Hop Count

1 to 64

l This parameter indicates the number of


hops from the source maintenance point
to the responding maintenance point or
to the destination maintenance point in
the LT test.
l The number of hops indicates the
adjacent relation between the responding
maintenance point to the source
maintenance point. The number of hops
increases by one when a responding
point occurs on the link from the source
maintenance point to the destination
maintenance point.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1677

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Test Result

This parameter indicates the result of the LT


test.

Related Tasks
A.7.8.8 Performing an LT Test

B.6.3.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling Service Loopback


Detection
This topic describes the parameters for enabling E-LAN service loopback detection.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the desired NE and choose Configuration > Ethernet Service
Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters for Enabling Service Loopback Detection


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Vlans/CVLAN

1 to 4094

1 to 4094

Vlans/CVLAN displays
the VLAN ID of a
loopback service.
Loopback detection can be
performed for only one
service one time.

Packet Timeout Period


(s)

3 to 10

Loopback detection stops


if no loopback detection
packets are received until
Packet Timeout Period
(s) expires.

Packet Length

This parameter displays


the loopback detection
packet length.

VLAN Packet Sending


Interval(s)

This parameter displays


the intervals for
transmitting different
VLAN packets.

Disable Service When


Loopback is Detected

No

No

Disable Service When


Loopback is Detected
displays whether a
loopback service will be
deactivated.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Yes

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1678

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.6.3.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Parameter


This topic describes the OAM parameters that are related to Ethernet ports.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Parameter tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


port.

Enable OAM
Protocol

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the OAM protocol.

Disabled

l After the OAM protocol is enabled, the


current Ethernet port starts to use the
preset mode to create the OAM
connection with the opposite end.
OAM Working
Mode

Active

Active

Passive

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


working mode of the OAM.
l The port whose OAM working mode is
set to Active can initiate the OAM
connection.
l The port whose OAM working mode is
set to Passive can only wait for the
opposite end to send the OAM
connection request.
l The OAM working mode of the
equipment at only one end can be
Passive.

Link Event
Notification

Enabled
Disabled

Enabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the local link events can be
notified to the opposite end.
l If the alarms caused by link events can
be reported, that is, if the number of
performance events (for example, error
frame period, error frame, error frame
second, and error frame signal cycle) at
the local end exceeds the preset
threshold, these performance events are
notified to the port at the opposite end
through the link event notification
function.
l This parameter is set according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1679

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Remote Side
Loopback
Response

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether the port responds to the remote
loopback.

Enabled

l Remote loopback indicates that the local


OAM entity transmits packets to the
remote OAM entity for loopback. The
local OAM entity can locate the fault and
test the link performance through
loopback data analysis.
l If a port does not support remote
loopback response, this port does not
respond to the loopback request from the
remote port regardless of the OAM port
status.
Non-Loopback

Loopback Status

Initiate Loopback at
Local

This parameter indicates the loopback status


at the local end.
NOTE
Loopback Status is valid only after you choose
OAM > Enable Remote Loopback.

Respond Loopback
of Remote
OAM Discovery
Status

This parameter indicates the OAM


discovery status at the local end.

Port Transmit
Status

This parameter indicates the status of


transmitting packets at the local end.

Port Receive Status

This parameter indicates the status of


receiving packets at the local end.

Related Tasks
A.7.9.1 Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function
A.7.9.2 Enabling the Link Event Notification

B.6.3.10 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Error


Frame Monitoring
This topic describes the parameters that are used for monitoring the OAM error frames at the
Ethernet port.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1680

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates the corresponding


port.

Error Frame
Monitor Window
(ms)

1000 to 60000, in
step of 100

1000

This parameter specifies the duration of


monitoring error frames.

Error Frame
Monitor Threshold
(frames)

1 to 4294967295, in
step of 1

l This parameter specifies the threshold of


monitoring error frames.

Error Frame
Period Window
(frame)

1488 to 892800000,
in step of 1

892800000

This parameter specifies the window of


monitoring the error frame period.

Error Frame
Period Threshold
(frames)

1 to 892800000, in
step of 1

l This parameter specifies the threshold of


monitoring the error frame period.

Error Frame
Second Window(s)

10 to 900, in step of
1

60

This parameter specifies the time window of


monitoring the error frame second.

Error Frame
Second Threshold
(s)

10 to 900, in step of
1

l This parameter specifies the threshold of


monitoring error frame seconds.

l Within the specified value of Error


Frame Monitor Window(ms), if the
number of error frames on the link
exceeds the preset value of Error
Frame Monitor Threshold(frame), an
alarm is reported.

l Within the specified value of Error


Frame Period Window(frame), if the
number of error frames on the link
exceeds the preset value of Error
Frame Period Threshold(frame), an
alarm is reported.

l If any error frame occurs in one second,


this second is called an errored frame
second. Within the specified value of
Error Frame Second Window(s), if the
number of error frames on the link
exceeds the preset value of Error
Frame Second Threshold(s), an alarm
is reported.

Related Tasks
A.7.9.3 Modifying the OAM Error Frame Monitoring Threshold

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1681

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.6.4 QoS Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to QoS.

B.6.4.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing DiffServ domains.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the
Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mapping Relation ID

1 to 8

This parameter indicates


the ID of the mapping
relation between DiffServ
domains.

Mapping Relation Name

Default Map

This parameter indicates


the name of the mapping
relation between DiffServ
domains.

NOTE

If one default DiffServ domain exists on the OptiX RTN 980 equipment, Mapping Relation ID is set to 1, and
Mapping Relation Name is set to Default Map. If these parameters are not set, all the ports belong to this
domain.

Parameters for Ingress Mapping Relation


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
indicates the priority
of the C-VLAN of the
ingress packets.
l C-VLAN indicates the
client-side VLAN, and
the value 7 indicates
the highest priority.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1682

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
indicates the priority
of the S-VLAN of the
ingress packets.
l S-VLAN indicates the
server-side VLAN,
and the value 7
indicates the highest
priority.

IP DSCP

0 to 63

l This parameter
indicates the DSCP
priority of the IP
addresses of the
ingress packets.
l The differentiated
services code point
(DSCP) refers to bits
0-5 of the
differentiated services
(DS) field in the packet
and indicates the
service class and
discarding priority of
the packet.

MPLS EXP

0 to 7

l Displays the MPLS


EXP value of ingress
packets.
l When a packet in an
egress queue leaves an
NNI port, the NNI port
obtains the packet
priority value
according to the
mappings between
PHB service classes of
egress queues and
egress packet
priorities (MPLS EXP
values), and writes the
obtained priority value
into the EXP field of
the egress MPLS
packet.
NOTE
The MPLS EXP value can
be modified in the default
Diffserv domain (Default
Map) only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1683

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PHB

BE

l This parameter
indicates the per-hop
behavior (PHB)
service class of the
DiffServ domain.

AF1
AF2
AF3
AF4

l The PHB service class


refers to the
forwarding behavior
of the DiffServ node
on the behavior
aggregate (BA)
operation. The
forwarding behavior
can meet the specific
requirements.

EF
CS6
CS7

l The PHB service


classes are BE, AF1,
AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,
CS6, and CS7. The
priorities (C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN
priority, DSCP value,
and MPLS EXP value)
contained in the
packets of the DiffServ
domain and the eight
PHB service classes
meet the requirements
of the specified or
default mapping
relation.
NOTE
The AF1 is classified into
three sub service classes,
namely, AF11, AF12, and
AF13, only one of which is
valid. It is the same case
with the AF2, AF3, and
AF4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1684

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Egress Mapping Relation


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PHB

BE

l This parameter
indicates the PHB
service class of the
DiffServ domain.

AF1
AF2
AF3

l The PHB service class


refers to the
forwarding behavior
of the DiffServ node
on the behavior
aggregate (BA)
operation. The
forwarding behavior
can meet the specific
requirements.

AF4
EF
CS6
CS7

l The PHB service


classes are BE, AF1,
AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,
CS6, and CS7. The
priorities (C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN
priority, DSCP value
and MPLS value)
contained in the
packets of the DiffServ
domain and the eight
PHB service classes
meet the requirements
of the specified or
default mapping
relation.
NOTE
The AF1 is classified into
three sub service classes,
namely, AF11, AF12, and
AF13, only one of which is
valid. It is the same case
with the AF2, AF3, and
AF4.

CVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
indicates the priority
of the C-VLAN of the
egress packets.
l C-VLAN indicates the
client-side VLAN, and
the value 7 indicates
the highest priority.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1685

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
indicates the priority
of the S-VLAN of the
egress packets.
l S-VLAN indicates the
server-side VLAN,
and the value 7
indicates the highest
priority.

IP DSCP

0 to 63

l This parameter
indicates the DSCP
priority of the IP
addresses of the
ingress packets.
l The DSCP refers to
bits 0-5 of the DS field
in the packet and
indicates the service
class and discarding
priority of the packet.

MPLS EXP

0 to 7

l Displays the MPLS


EXP value of egress
packets.
l When a packet arrives
at an NNI port, the
NNI port obtains the
packet priority value
depending on its
trusted priority type
(MPLS EXP value)
and specifies the PHB
service class of the
packet according to the
mappings between
packet priorities and
PHB service classes.
NOTE
The MPLS EXP value can
be modified in the default
Diffserv domain (Default
Map) only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1686

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Application Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

This parameter indicates


the port that uses the
DiffServ domain.

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

The packets trusted by the


OptiX RTN 980 are the
C_VLAN, S_VLAN and
IP DSCP packets that
contain the C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN
priority, DSCP value or
MPLS value. By default,
the untrusted packets are
mapped to the BE service
class for best-effort
forwarding.

SVLAN
IP-DSCP
MPLS-EXP

NOTE
l The trusted packet
priorities of a UNI port
include DSCP value, CVLAN priority, and SVLAN priority. For the
E-Line services that are
transparently
transmitted end to end
(UNI-UNI), a UNI port
only trusts DSCP value.
l An NNI port carrying
MPLS/PWE3 services
trusts only packets with
MPLS EXP values.
l The trusted packet
priorities of a QinQ link
NNI port are configured
according to the
planning information.

Related Tasks
A.7.7.2 Modifying the Mapping Relationships for the DS Domain
A.7.7.10 Querying the DS Domain of a Port

B.6.4.2 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Management_Create


This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating DiffServ (DS) domains.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1687

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from
the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mapping Relation ID

2 to 8

This parameter specifies


the ID of the mapping
relationship of a DS
domain.

Mapping Relation Name

This parameter specifies


the name of the mapping
relationship of a DS
domain.

Parameters for Ingress Mapping Relation


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
specifies the C-VLAN
priority of the ingress
packets.
l C-VLAN indicates the
client-side VLAN, and
the value 7 indicates
the highest priority.

SVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
specifies the S-VLAN
priority of the ingress
packets.
l S-VLAN indicates the
server-side VLAN,
and the value 7
indicates the highest
priority.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1688

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IP DSCP

0 to 63

l This parameter
specifies the DSCP
priority of the IP
addresses of the
ingress packets.
l The differentiated
services code point
(DSCP) refers to bits
0-5 of the
differentiated services
(DS) field in the packet
and indicates the
service class and
discarding priority of
the packet.

MPLS EXP

l Displays the MPLS


EXP value of ingress
packets.
l When a packet in an
egress queue leaves an
NNI port, the NNI port
obtains the packet
priority value
according to the
mappings between
PHB service classes of
egress queues and
egress packet
priorities (MPLS EXP
values), and writes the
obtained priority value
into the EXP field of
the egress MPLS
packet.
NOTE
The MPLS EXP value can
be modified in the default
Diffserv domain (Default
Map) only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1689

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PHB

BE

l This parameter
indicates the PHB
service class of the DS
domain.

AF1
AF2
AF3

l The PHB service class


refers to the
forwarding behavior
of the DS node on the
behavior aggregate
(BA) operation. The
forwarding behavior
can meet the specific
requirements.

AF4
EF
CS6
CS7

l The PHB service


classes are BE, AF1,
AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,
CS6, and CS7. The
priorities (C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN
priority, DSCP value
and MPLS EXP value)
contained in the
packets of the DS
domain and the eight
PHB service classes
meet the requirements
of the specified or
default mapping
relationship.
NOTE
The AF1 is classified into
three sub service classes,
namely, AF11, AF12, and
AF13, only one of which is
valid. It is the same case
with the AF2, AF3, and
AF4.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1690

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Egress Mapping Relation


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PHB

BE

l This parameter
indicates the PHB
service class of the DS
domain.

AF1
AF2
AF3

l The PHB service class


refers to the
forwarding behavior
of the DS node on the
behavior aggregate
(BA) operation. The
forwarding behavior
can meet the specific
requirements.

AF4
EF
CS6
CS7

l The PHB service


classes are BE, AF1,
AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,
CS6, and CS7. The
priorities (C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN
priority, DSCP value
and MPLS EXP value)
contained in the
packets of the DS
domain and the eight
PHB service classes
meet the requirements
of the specified or
default mapping
relationship.
NOTE
The AF1 is classified into
three sub service classes,
namely, AF11, AF12, and
AF13, only one of which is
valid. It is the same case
with the AF2, AF3, and
AF4.

CVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
specifies the C-VLAN
priority of the egress
packets.
l C-VLAN indicates the
client-side VLAN
priority, and the value
7 indicates the highest
priority.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1691

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SVLAN

0 to 7

l This parameter
specifies the S-VLAN
priority of the egress
packets.
l S-VLAN indicates the
server-side VLAN
priority, and the value
7 indicates the highest
priority.

IP DSCP

0 to 63

l This parameter
specifies the DSCP
priority of the IP
addresses of the egress
packets.
l The differentiated
services code point
(DSCP) refers to bits
0-5 of the
differentiated services
(DS) field in the packet
and indicates the
service class and
discarding priority of
the packet.

MPLS EXP

l Displays the MPLS


EXP value of egress
packets.
l When a packet in an
egress queue leaves an
NNI port, the NNI port
obtains the packet
priority value
according to the
mappings between
PHB service classes of
egress queues and
egress packet
priorities (MPLS EXP
values), and writes the
obtained priority value
into the EXP field of
the egress MPLS
packet.
NOTE
The MPLS EXP value can
be modified in the default
Diffserv domain (Default
Map) only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1692

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Application Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

This parameter specifies


the board that uses the
mapping relationships
between DS domains.

Available Port

This parameter displays


the available port list from
which you can select the
port that uses the mapping
relationships between DS
domains.

Port

This parameter displays


the selected port list. The
ports in the list use the
mapping relationships
between DS domains.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1693

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Type

cvlan

cvlan

l This parameter
specifies the type of
the packet.

svlan
ip-dscp
mpls-exp

l The packets trusted by


the OptiX RTN 980
are the C_VLAN,
S_VLAN, IP DSCP
and MPLS packets that
contain the C_VLAN
priority, S_VLAN
priority, DSCP value
or MPLS EXP value.
By default, the
untrusted packets are
mapped to the BE
service class for besteffort forwarding.
NOTE
l The trusted packet
priorities of a UNI port
include DSCP value, CVLAN priority, and SVLAN priority. For the
E-Line services that are
transparently
transmitted end to end
(UNI-UNI), a UNI port
only trusts DSCP value.
l An NNI port carrying
MPLS/PWE3 services
trusts only packets with
MPLS EXP values.
l The trusted packet
priorities of a QinQ link
NNI port are configured
according to the
planning information.

Related Tasks
A.7.7.1 Creating a DS Domain

B.6.4.3 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Applied Port_Modification


This topic describes the parameters that are used for changing DiffServ (DS) domain applied
ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1694

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv Domain Management > Diffserv Domain Management from
the Function Tree.

2.

Select the DS domain to be changed in the main interface.

3.

Click the Apply Port tab.

4.

Click Modify.

Parameters for Configuring the Applied Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mapping Relation Name

This parameter indicates


the name of the mapping
relation of a DS domain.

Packet Type

CVLAN

CVLAN

The packets trusted by the


OptiX RTN 980 are the CVLAN, S-VLAN, IP
DSCP packets, and MPLS
packets that respectively
contain the C-VLAN
priority, S-VLAN
priority, IP DSCP value
and MPLS EXP value. By
default, the untrusted
packets are mapped to the
BE service class for besteffort forwarding.

SVLAN
IP-DSCP
MPLS-EXP

NOTE
l The trusted packet
priorities of a UNI port
include DSCP value, CVLAN priority, and SVLAN priority. For the
E-Line services that are
transparently
transmitted end to end
(UNI-UNI), a UNI port
only trusts DSCP value.
l An NNI port carrying
MPLS/PWE3 services
trusts only packets with
MPLS EXP values.
l The trusted packet
priorities of a QinQ link
NNI port are configured
according to the
planning information.

Board

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter specifies


the board where the port is
located.
1695

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Available Port

This parameter indicates


the available port.

Selected Port

This parameter indicates


the selected port.
The selected port is
applied to the DS domain.

NOTE

If one default DS domain exists on the OptiX RTN 980, Mapping Relation ID is set to 1, and Mapping Relation
Name is set to Default Map. If these parameters are not set, all the ports belong to this domain.

Related Tasks
A.7.7.3 Changing the Ports Applied to a DS Domain and Their Trusted Packet Types

B.6.4.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to port policies.

Navigation Path (Port Policy)


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the CoS Configuration tab.

Parameters (Port Policy)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy ID

This parameter indicates


the policy ID of the port.

Policy Name

This parameter indicates


or specifies the policy
name of the port.

WRR Scheduling Policy

This parameter indicates


the current WRR
scheduling policy.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1696

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS

CS7

l The BE, AF1, AF2,


AF3, AF4, EF, CS6,
and CS7 service
classes respectively
map eight queuing
entities. The OptiX
RTN 980 provides
different QoS policies
for the queues at
different service
classes.

CS6
EF
AF4
AF3
AF2
AF1
BE

l CS6-CS7: indicates
the highest service
grade, which is mainly
involved in signaling
transmission.
l EF: indicates fast
forwarding. This
service class is
applicable to the traffic
whose delay is small
and packet loss ratio is
low, for example,
voice and video
services.
l AF1-AF4: indicates
assured forwarding.
This service class is
applicable to the traffic
that requires rate
guarantee but does not
require delay or jitter
limit.
l BE: indicates that the
traffic is forwarded in
best-effort manner
without special
processing.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1697

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Grooming Police After


Reloading

SP

CS7, CS6, EF, BE: SP

WRR

AF4, AF3, AF2, AF1:


WRR

l The strict priority (SP)


scheduling algorithm
is designed for the key
services. One
important
characteristic of the
key services is that
higher priorities are
required to minimize
the response delay in
the case of congestion
events.
l The weighted round
robin (WRR)
scheduling algorithm
divides each port into
multiple output subqueues. The polling
scheduling is
performed among the
output sub-queues to
ensure that each subqueue has a certain
period of service time.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports the setting of
the SP+WRR
scheduling algorithm
of the CoS queue
according to the
requirement, and
provides one or more
queues that comply
with the SP algorithm.
Except for the default
value, however, the
value of the WRR
scheduling algorithm
and the value of the SP
scheduling algorithm
cannot be interleaved.
That is, except for the
default value,
Grooming Police
After Reloading can
be changed from SP to
WRR according to the
queue priorities in a
descending order
(CS7-BE).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1698

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Disabled

Enabled

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
whether traffic
shaping is enabled for
an egress queue
corresponding to a
PHB service class.
l CIR (kbit/s), PIR
(kbit/s), CBS (byte),
and PBS (byte) can be
set only when
Bandwidth Limit is
set to Enabled.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

CIR(kbit/s)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Traffic shaping for an


egress queue uses the
single token bucket two
color marker algorithm.
The value of the CIR must
be equal to the value of the
PIR. In actual traffic
shaping processing, only
the PIR is valid.

1699

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PIR(kbit/s)

l When the buffer queue


is empty, the packets
are processed as
follows: If the rate of a
packet is equal to or
lower than the PIR, it
is directly forwarded;
if the rate of a packet is
higher than the PIR, it
enters the buffer queue
and then is forwarded
at a rate equal to the
PIR.
l When the buffer queue
is not empty, the
packets whose rate
passes the restriction
of the PIR directly
enter the buffer queue
and then are forwarded
at a rate equal to the
PIR.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

CBS(byte)

l It is recommended that
you set the value of the
CBS equal to the value
of the PIR. In actual
traffic shaping
processing, only the
PBS is valid.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1700

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PBS(byte)

l When the buffer queue


is empty, certain burst
packets can be
forwarded if the rate of
the packets is equal to
or lower than the PIR
in a certain period. The
maximum traffic of the
burst packets is
determined by the
PBS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Navigation Path (WRR Scheduling Policy)


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > WRR Scheduling Policy from the Function Tree.

Parameters (WRR Scheduling Policy)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy ID

This parameter indicates


the policy ID of the WRR
scheduling policy.

Policy Name

This parameter indicates


the policy name of the
WRR scheduling policy.

Scheduling Weight

1 to 100

l The eight classes of


service (CoSs),
namely, BE, AF1,
AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,
CS6, and CS7
correspond to eight
queues.
l The Scheduling
Weight parameter
indicates the
percentage of the
bandwidth resources
gained by the WRR
queue.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1701

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.7.7.5 Modifying the Port Policy
A.7.7.7 Setting the Port That Uses the Port Policy
A.7.7.9 Querying the Port Policy

B.6.4.5 Parameter Description: Port Policy


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port policies.

Navigation Path (Creating a Port Policy)


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the CoS Configuration tab.

3.

Click New. The Create Port Policy dialog box is displayed.

Parameters (Creating a Port Policy)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy ID

This parameter specifies


the policy ID of the port.

Automatically Assign

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies


whether to automatically
allocate the policy ID of
the port policy. After this
parameter is selected, the
system automatically
allocates the policy ID,
and then the policy ID
cannot be set manually.

This parameter specifies


the policy name of the
port.

Deselected

Policy Name

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1702

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WRR Scheduling Policy

l This parameter
specifies the desired
WRR scheduling
policy.
l The WRR weight set
in the WRR
scheduling policy only
applies to WRR
queues.
l When the total WRR
weight value of all
WRR queues equals to
100%, the WRR
weight set for each
queue in the WRR
scheduling policy is
the actual WRR
weight. For example,
when AF4, AF3, AF2,
and AF1 are all WRR
queues and their
weight values are
25%, 25%, 25%, and
25% respectively,
each queue is actually
allocated with 25%
total bandwidth.
l When the total WRR
weight value of all
WRR queues is less
than 100%, the actual
WRR weight is
recalculated based on
the proportion
between the WRR
weights of different
queues set in the WRR
scheduling policy. For
example, when AF4,
AF3, AF2, and AF1
are all WRR queues
and their weight values
are 20%, 20%, 20%,
and 20% respectively,
the actual bandwidth
allocation weight of
each queue will be
recalculated based on
the proportion

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1703

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
between the set WRR
weight (1:1:1:1). That
is, each queue is
allocated with 25%
total bandwidth.

CoS

CS7

CS6
EF
AF4
AF3
AF2
AF1
BE

l The BE, AF1, AF2,


AF3, AF4, EF, CS6,
and CS7 service
classes respectively
map eight queuing
entities. The OptiX
RTN 980 provides
different QoS policies
for the queues at
different service class.
l CS6-CS7: indicates
the highest service
grade, which is mainly
involved in signaling
transmission.
l EF: indicates fast
forwarding. This
service class is
applicable to the traffic
whose delay is small
and packet loss ratio is
low, for example,
voice and video
services.
l AF1-AF4: indicates
assured forwarding.
This service class is
applicable to the traffic
that requires rate
guarantee but does not
require delay or jitter
limit.
l BE: indicates that the
traffic is forwarded in
best-effort manner
without special
processing.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1704

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Grooming Police After


Reloading

SP

CS7, CS6, EF, BE: SP

WRR

AF4, AF3, AF2, AF1:


WRR

l The strict priority (SP)


scheduling algorithm
is designed for the key
services. One
important
characteristic of the
key services is that
higher priorities are
required to minimize
the response delay in
the case of congestion
events.
l The weighted round
robin (WRR)
scheduling algorithm
divides each port into
multiple output subqueues. The polling
scheduling is
performed among the
output sub-queues to
ensure that each subqueue has a certain
period of service time.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports the setting of
the SP+WRR
scheduling algorithm
of the CoS queue
according to the
requirement, and
provides one or more
queues that comply
with the SP algorithm.
Except for the default
value, however, the
value of the WRR
scheduling algorithm
and the value of the SP
scheduling algorithm
cannot be interleaved.
That is, except for the
default value,
Grooming Police
After Reloading can
be changed from SP to
WRR according to the
queue priorities in a
descending order
(CS7-BE).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1705

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Disabled

Enabled

l Bandwidth Limit
indicates or specifies
whether traffic
shaping is enabled for
an egress queue
corresponding to a
PHB service class.
l CIR (kbit/s), PIR
(kbit/s), CBS (byte),
and PBS (byte) can be
set only when
Bandwidth Limit is
set to Enabled.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

CIR(kbit/s)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Traffic shaping for an


egress queue uses the
single token bucket two
color marker algorithm.
The value of the CIR must
be equal to the value of the
PIR. In actual traffic
shaping processing, only
the PIR is valid.

1706

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PIR(kbit/s)

l When the buffer queue


is empty, the packets
are processed as
follows: If the rate of a
packet is equal to or
lower than the PIR, it
is directly forwarded;
if the rate of a packet is
higher than the PIR, it
enters the buffer queue
and then is forwarded
at a rate equal to the
PIR.
l When the buffer queue
is not empty, the
packets whose rate
passes the restriction
of the PIR directly
enter the buffer queue
and then are forwarded
at a rate equal to the
PIR.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

CBS(byte)

l It is recommended that
you set the value of the
CBS equal to the value
of the PIR. In actual
traffic shaping
processing, only the
PBS is valid.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1707

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PBS(byte)

l When the buffer queue


is empty, certain burst
packets can be
forwarded if the rate of
the packets is equal to
or lower than the PIR
in a certain period. The
maximum traffic of the
burst packets is
determined by the
PBS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Navigation Path (Creating a WRR Scheduling Policy)


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > WRR Scheduling Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New. The Create WRR Policy dialog box is displayed.

Parameters (Creating a WRR Scheduling Policy)


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy ID

This parameter specifies


the policy ID of the WRR
scheduling policy.

Assign automatically

Selected

Deselected

This parameter specifies


whether to automatically
assign the policy ID of the
WRR scheduling policy.
If this parameter is set to
Selected, the policy ID of
the WRR scheduling
policy can only be
assigned automatically.
Manual assignment is not
available.

This parameter specifies


the policy name of the
WRR scheduling policy.

Deselected

Policy Name

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1708

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Scheduling Weight

1 to 100

l The eight classes of


service (CoSs),
namely, BE, AF1,
AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,
CS6, and CS7
correspond to eight
queues.
l The Scheduling
Weight parameter
indicates the
percentage of the
bandwidth resources
gained by the WRR
queue.
l This parameter must
be set to 0% for SP
queues.
l The scheduling weight
sum of WRR queues
must be 100%.

Related Tasks
A.7.7.4 Creating a Port Policy

B.6.4.6 Parameter Description: Port Policy_Traffic Classification Configuration


This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating traffic classification.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > Port Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Traffic Classification Configuration tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Traffic Classification ID

1 to 512

l This parameter
specifies the ID of the
traffic classification.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports a maximum
of 512 flow
classifications.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1709

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ACL Action

Permit

Permit

l The access control list


(ACL) determines
whether to forward or
discard the packets
that enter the port
according to the
specified matching
rules.

Deny

l When ACL Action is


set to Permit, the
ingress port accepts
and then performs QoS
processing for only the
packets that meet the
specified mapping
rules.
l When ACL Action is
set to Deny, the
ingress port discards
the packets that meet
the specified mapping
rules.

Ingress Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Logical Relation
Between Matched Rules

And

And

l This parameter
specifies the logical
relationship between
the traffic
classification
matching rules.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports the setting of
the logical AND
between multiple
matching rules.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1710

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Match Type

DSCP Value

l After you click Add or


Delete, complex
traffic classification
can be performed on
the traffic that enters
the ingress port
according to the preset
matching rules.

CVlan ID
CVlan priority
SVlan ID
SVlan priority

l In the case a specific


service, complex
traffic classification
can be divided into
basic traffic types
according to the DSCP
value, C-VLAN ID, CVLAN priority, SVLAN ID, or SVLAN priority.
Traffic type is based
on the associated
Ethernet packets.
Therefore, this
parameter is set
according to the packet
type and the planning
information.
Match Value

DSCP Value: 0 to 63

CVlan ID: 1 to 4094


CVlan priority: 0 to 7
SVlan ID: 1 to 4094
SVlan priority: 0 to 7

l If the matching value


of the packets is the
same as the preset
Match Value, the
packets match the
rules of complex
traffic classification.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Wildcard

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter has a fixed


value of 0.

1711

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS

l This parameter
specifies the PHB
service class queue
mapped by the traffic
classification packets.

CS7
CS6
EF
AF4

l If this parameter is set


to empty (-), the traffic
classification packets
map the PHB service
class queue according
the mapping relation
specified in the topic
about Diffserv domain
management.

AF3
AF2
AF1
BE

l This parameter is set


according to the
planning information.
Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Enabled

Enabled

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
whether the CAR
operation is performed
for the flow in the
ingress direction.
l CIR (kbit/s), PIR
(kbit/s), CBS (byte),
and PBS (byte) can be
set only when
Bandwidth Limit is
set to Enabled.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1712

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CIR(kbit/s)

l When the rate of the


packets is not more
than the CIR, the
packets are marked
blue and pass the CAR
policing. These
packets are first
forwarded in the case
of network congestion.
l When the rate of the
packets is more than
the CIR but not more
than the PIR, the
packets whose rate is
more than the CIR can
pass the restriction of
the CAR and are
marked yellow. The
processing method of
the packets marked
yellow can be set to
"Pass" or "Remark".
"Remark" indicates
that the packets are
mapped into another
specified queue of a
higher priority (this is
equal to changing the
priority of the packets)
and then forwarded to
the next port. If a
network congestion
event occurs again, the
packets marked
yellow can be
processed according to
the new priority.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1713

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PIR(kbit/s)

l When the rate of the


packets is more than
the PIR, the packets
that exceed the rate
restriction are marked
red and directly
discarded.
l When the rate of the
packets is more than
the CIR but not more
than the PIR, the
packets whose rate is
more than the CIR can
pass the restriction of
the CAR and are
marked yellow. The
processing method of
the packets marked
yellow can be set to
"Pass" or "Remark".
"Remark" indicates
that the packets are
mapped into another
specified queue of a
higher priority (this is
equal to changing the
priority of the packets)
and then forwarded to
the next port. If a
network congestion
event occurs again, the
packets marked
yellow can be
processed according to
the new priority.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1714

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CBS(byte)

l During a certain
period, if the rate of the
packets whose
processing method is
marked "Pass" is not
more than the CIR,
certain burst packets
are allowed and can be
first forwarded in the
case of network
congestion. The
maximum traffic of the
burst packets is
determined by the
CBS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

PBS(byte)

l During a certain
period, if the rate of the
packets whose
processing method is
marked "Pass" is more
than the CIR but not
more than the PIR,
certain burst packets
are allowed and
marked yellow. The
maximum traffic of the
burst packets is
determined by the
PBS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1715

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Coloration Mode

Color Blindness

Color Blindness

l This parameter
specifies the CAR
operation performed
by the equipment on
the packets. The
packets are dyed
according to the result
of the CAR operation.
The dying rule is
determined by the
comparison between
the rate of the packets
and the preset CAR
value.
l The OptiX RTN 980
supports Color
Blindness only.

Packet Color

Red

Packets can be dyed in


three colors: red, yellow,
and green. The packets in
red are first discarded.

l This parameter
specifies the method of
handling the packets.

Yellow
Green
Handling Mode

Discard
Pass
Remark

l Discard: The packets


are discarded.
l Pass: The packets are
forwarded.
l Remark: The packets
are remarked.
"Remark" indicates
that the packets are
mapped into another
specified queue of a
higher priority (this is
equal to changing the
priority of the packets)
and then forwarded to
the next port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1716

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Relabeled CoS

CS7

If the handling method is


set to "Remark", you can
reset the CoS of the
packets.

CS6
EF
AF4
AF3
AF2
AF1
BE

Egress Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Enable

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
whether the traffic
shaping is performed
in the egress function.

Enable

l CIR (kbit/s), PIR


(kbit/s), CBS (byte),
and PBS (byte) can be
set only when
Bandwidth Limit is
set to Enabled.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1717

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CIR(kbit/s)

l In the case that no


packets exist in the
egress queue: When
the rate of the packets
is not more than the
CIR, these packets
directly enter the
egress queue.
l In the case that certain
packets exist in the
egress queue: The
packets whose rate
passes the restriction
of the PIR directly
enter the egress queue,
which forwards the
packets to the next port
at the CIR.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1718

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PIR(kbit/s)

l In the case that no


packets exist in the
egress queue: If the
rate of the packets is
more than the CIR but
is not more than the
PIR, the packets
whose rate is more
than the CIR enter the
egress queue, which
forwards the packets to
the next port at the
CIR. If the rate of the
packets is more than
the PIR, the packets
are directly discarded.
l In the case that certain
packets exist in the
egress queue: The
packets whose rate
passes the restriction
of the PIR directly
enter the egress queue,
which forwards the
packets to the next port
at the CIR.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

CBS(byte)

l If the rate of the


packets is not more
than the CIR during a
certain period, the
burst packets are
directly transmitted.
The maximum traffic
of the burst packets is
determined by the
CBS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1719

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PBS(byte)

l If the rate of the


packets is more than
the CIR but is not more
than the PIR during a
certain period, the
burst packets enter the
egress queue. The
maximum traffic of the
burst packets is
determined by the
PBS.
l This parameter is set
according to the
planning information.

Related Tasks
A.7.7.6 Creating Traffic

B.6.4.7 Parameter Description: Port Shaping Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port shaping management tasks.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters for Port Shaping Management


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Slot No.

This parameter specifies


the slot ID.

Port

This parameter specifies


the port.

CIR (kbit/s)

CBS (byte)

PIR (kbit/s)

Traffic shaping for an


egress queue uses the
single token bucket two
color marker algorithm.
The value of the CIR must
be equal to the value of the
PIR. In actual traffic
shaping processing, only
the PIR is valid.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1720

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PBS (byte)

If the traffic shaping


function is enabled, OptiX
RTN 980 processes the
packets in the buffer
queue through the
following methods when
no packets are available in
the queue.
l When the buffer queue
is empty, the packets
are processed as
follows: If the rate of a
packet is equal to or
lower than the PIR, it
is directly forwarded;
if the rate of a packet is
higher than the PIR, it
enters the buffer queue
and then is forwarded
at a rate equal to the
PIR.
l When the buffer queue
is empty, certain burst
packets can be
forwarded if the rate of
the packets is equal to
or lower than the PIR
in a certain period. The
maximum traffic of the
burst packets is
determined by the
PBS.
l When the buffer queue
is not empty, the
packets whose rate
passes the restriction
of the PIR directly
enter the buffer queue
and then are forwarded
at a rate equal to the
PIR.

Related Tasks
A.7.7.8 Configuring Port Shaping
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1721

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.7 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet Features


on the EoS/EoPDH Plane
This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet services and Ethernet features on the EoS/
EoPDH plane, including service parameters, protocol parameters, OAM parameters, Ethernet
port parameters, and QoS parameters.

B.7.1 Parameters for Ethernet Services


This section describes the parameters for EoS/EoPDH-plane Ethernet services.

B.7.1.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service_Creation


This section describes the parameters for creating an Ethernet line service.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet Line Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Deselect Display QinQ Shared Service.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-11 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

Service Type

EPL

EPL

Specify the Ethernet service type to EPL.

EVPL(QinQ)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1722

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

l If this parameter is set to


Unidirectional, you only need to create
a service from the service source to the
service sink. That is, there is traffic only
in the direction from the service source
to the sink port.

Unidirectional

l If this parameter is set to Bidirectional,


you need to create a service from the
service source to the service sink and a
service from the service sink to the
service source. That is, there is traffic in
the direction from the service source to
the sink port and in the direction from the
service sink to the source port at the same
time.
l In normal cases, it is recommended that
you set this parameter to Bidirectional.
Source Port

l Specifies the port of the service source.


l When you create bidirectional Ethernet
services from a PORT to a VCTRUNK,
it is recommended that you set the PORT
to the source port.

Source VLAN(e.g.
1,3-6)

1-4095

l This parameter can be set to null, a


number, or several numbers. When
setting this parameter to several
numbers, use the comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers, or use the hyphen
(-) to represent consecutive numbers. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l The number of VLANs must be the same
as the value of Sink VLAN(e.g. 1,3-6).
l If this parameter is set to null, all the
services at the source port are used as the
service source.
l If this parameter is not set to null, only
the service that carries a specified VLAN
ID at the source port can be used as the
service source.

Sink Port

l Specifies the port of the service sink.


l This parameter cannot take the same
value as Source Port.
l When you create bidirectional Ethernet
services from a PORT to a VCTRUNK,
it is recommended that you set the
VCTRUNK to the sink port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1723

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink VLAN(e.g.
1,3-6)

1-4095

l This parameter can be set to null, a


number, or several numbers. When
setting this parameter to several
numbers, use the comma (,) to separate
the discrete numbers, or use the hyphen
(-) to represent consecutive numbers. For
example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate
1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l The number of VLANs must be the same
as the value of Source VLAN(e.g.
1,3-6).
l If this parameter is set to null, all the
services at the sink port are used as the
service sink.
l If this parameter is not set to null, only
the service that carries a specified VLAN
ID at the sink port can be used as the
service sink.

Table B-12 Parameters for port attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the ports involved in the Ethernet


service.

Port Type

Displays the network attribute of the


Ethernet port.

Port Enabled

Enabled

l When the source port or the sink port is


set to a PORT, set Port Enabled to
Enabled.

Disabled

l This parameter need not be set when the


source port or sink port is a VCTRUNK.
TAG

Tag Aware
Access
Hybrid

l If all the accessed services are frames


with VLAN tags (tagged frames), set this
parameter to Tag Aware.
l If all the accessed services are frames
without VLAN tags (untagged frames),
set this parameter to Access.
l If the accessed services contain tagged
frames and untagged frames, set this
parameter to Hybrid.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1724

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-13 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Configurable
Ports

EFP8:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK16

VCTRUNK1

Specifies the VCTRUNK to bind paths.

Displays the level of the bound VC path.

EMS6:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK8
Level

In the case of the EFP8 board, this parameter


always takes the value of VC12-Xv.
Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Uplink

l Set this parameter to Bidirectional


unless otherwise specified.

Downlink
Available
Resources

l Specifies the direction of the bound path.

l Displays the available VC4 paths.


l In the case of the EFP8 board, this
parameter always takes the value of
VC4-1.
l For EMS6 boards, when a VCTRUNK
needs to bind VC-12 paths, select VC-12
paths only in VC-4-4s.

Available
Timeslots

Specifies the available timeslots.

Bound Path

You need to plan and set this parameter


according to the following principles:
l The capacity of the VCTRUNK is
determined by the actual bandwidth
required by the services.
l The EFP8 board supports 16
VCTRUNKs. Each VCTRUNK can
bind a maximum of 16 VC-12 paths and
the total number of bound VC-12 paths
cannot exceed 63.
l For EMS6 boards, their VCTRUNKs 1-7
each support a maximum bandwidth of
100 Mbit/s. If a bandwidth higher than
100 Mbit/s is required, VCTRUNK8 is
recommended.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of the bound VC path.

Activation Status

Displays the activation status of the bound


VC path.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1725

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.8.3.1 Creating Ethernet Private Line Services

B.7.1.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service_Creating QinQ-Based


Ethernet Line Services
This section describes the parameters associated with QinQ-based Ethernet line services, which
need to be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service > Ethernet Line Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Select Display QinQ Shared Service.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-14 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

Service Type

EPL

EPL

Specifies the service type to EVPL(QinQ).

Bidirectional

l When this parameter is set to


Unidirectional, only the service from
the service source to the service sink is
created. That is, the service source is
forwarded only to the sink port.

EVPL(QinQ)
Direction

Bidirectional
Unidirectional

l When this parameter is set to


Bidirectional, both the service from the
service source to the service sink and the
service from the service sink to the
service source are created. That is, when
the service source is forwarded to the
sink port, the service sink is forwarded to
the source port.
l It is recommended that you set this
parameter to Bidirectional.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1726

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Operation Type

l Add S-VLAN

Strip S-VLAN

l When used for private line services,


QinQ can process VLAN tags in
different manners as required.

l Transparently
transmit CVLAN

l When Service Direction is set to


Unidirectional, you can set Operation
Type to Strip S-VLAN.

l Transparently
transmit SVLAN

l Set this parameter according to actual


situations.

l Transparently
transmit SVLAN and CVLAN
l Translate SVLAN
l Translate SVLAN and
transparently
transmit CVLAN
l Strip S-VLAN
Source Port

l Specifies the port where the service


source resides.
l When creating a bidirectional Ethernet
service from a PORT to a VCTRUNK, it
is recommended that you use the PORT
as the source port.

Source C-VLAN
(e.g. 1, 3-6)

1-4095

l You can set this parameter to null, a


number, or several numbers. When you
set this parameter to several numbers,
use "," to separate these discrete values
and use "-" to indicate continuous
numbers. For example, "1, 3-6" indicates
numbers 1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l The number of VLANs set in this
parameter should be the same as the
number of VLANs set in Sink C-VLAN
(e.g. 1, 3-6).
l When you set this parameter to null, all
the services of the source port work as
the service source.
l When you set this parameter to a nonnull value, only the services of the source
port whose VLAN IDs are included in
the value range of this parameter work as
the service source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1727

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source S-VLAN

1-4095

l This parameter must be set to a


numerical value.
l Only the service of the source port whose
S-VLAN ID is equal to the value of this
parameter work as the service source.

Sink Port

l Specifies the port where the service sink


resides.
l This parameter must be set to be a value
different from Source Port.
l When creating a bidirectional Ethernet
service from a PORT to a VCTRUNK, it
is recommended that you use the
VCTRUNK as the sink port.

Sink C-VLAN(e.g.
1, 3-6)

1-4095

l You can set this parameter to null, a


number, or several numbers. When you
set this parameter to several numbers,
use "," to separate these discrete values
and use "-" to indicate continuous
numbers. For example, "1, 3-6" indicates
numbers 1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.
l The number of VLANs set in this
parameter should be the same as the
number of VLANs set in Source CVLAN(e.g. 1, 3-6).
l When you set this parameter to null, all
the services of the sink port work as the
service sink.
l When you set this parameter to a nonnull value, only the services of the sink
port whose VLAN IDs are included in
the value range of this parameter work as
the service sink.

Sink S-VLAN

1-4095

l This parameter must be set to a


numerical value.
l Only the services of the sink port whose
S-VLAN IDs are equal to the value of
this parameter work as the service sink.

C-VLAN Priority

AUTO

AUTO

Displays the C-VLAN priority.

S-VLAN Priority

AUTO

AUTO

Specifies the S-VLAN priority. The bigger


the value, the higher the priority.

Priority 0 to Priority
7

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1728

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-15 Parameters of port attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the ports that are configured to


transmit the service.

Port Type

Displays the network attribute of the


Ethernet port.

Port Enabled

Enabled

l When the source port or the sink port is


set to a PORT, set Port Enabled to
Enabled.

Disabled

l This parameter need not be set when the


source port or sink port is a VCTRUNK.
TAG

This parameter is invalid for QinQ line


services.

Table B-16 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Configurable
Ports

EFP8:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK16

VCTRUNK1

Specifies the VCTRUNK to bind paths.

Displays the level of the bound VC path.

EMS6:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK8
Level

In the case of the EFP8 board, this parameter


always takes the value of VC12-Xv.
Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Uplink

l Set this parameter to Bidirectional


unless otherwise specified.

Downlink
Available
Resources

l Specifies the direction of the bound path.

l Displays the available VC4 paths.


l In the case of the EFP8 board, this
parameter always takes the value of
VC4-1.
l For EMS6 boards, when a VCTRUNK
needs to bind VC-12 paths, select VC-12
paths only in VC-4-4s.

Available
Timeslots

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Specifies the available timeslots.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1729

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bound Path

You need to plan and set this parameter


according to the following principles:
l The capacity of the VCTRUNK is
determined by the actual bandwidth
required by the services.
l The EFP8 board supports 16
VCTRUNKs. Each VCTRUNK can
bind a maximum of 16 VC-12 paths and
the total number of bound VC-12 paths
cannot exceed 63.
l For EMS6 boards, their VCTRUNKs 1-7
each support a maximum bandwidth of
100 Mbit/s. If a bandwidth higher than
100 Mbit/s is required, VCTRUNK8 is
recommended.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of the bound VC path.

Activation Status

Displays the activation status of the bound


VC path.

Related Tasks
A.8.3.5 Creating QinQ-Based EVPL Services

B.7.1.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Line Service


This section describes the parameters for Ethernet line services.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet Line Service from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-17 Parameters on the main interface (Display QinQ Shared Service is not selected)
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

Service Type

Displays the service type.

Service Direction

Displays the service direction.

Source Port

Displays the port of the service source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1730

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source VLAN

Displays the VLAN ID of the service source.

Sink Port

Displays the port of the service sink.

Sink VLAN

Displays the VLAN ID of the service sink.

Activation Status

Displays whether to activate the service.

Table B-18 Parameters on the main interface (Display QinQ Shared Service is selected)
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

Service Type

Displays the service type.

Service Direction

Displays the service direction.

Source Port

Displays the port of the service source.

Source C-VLAN

Displays the VLAN ID of the service source.

Source S-VLAN

l Displays the S-VLAN ID of the service


source.
l This parameter can be set only for the
QinQ-based EVPL service.

Sink Port

Displays the port of the service sink.

Sink C-VLAN

Displays the VLAN ID of the service sink.

Sink S-VLAN

l Displays the S-VLAN ID of the service


sink.
l This parameter can be set only for the
QinQ-based EVPL service.

C-VLAN Priority

l Displays the priority of the C-VLAN.


l This parameter can be set only for the
QinQ-based EVPL service.

S-VLAN Priority

l Displays the priority of the S-VLAN.


l This parameter can be set only for the
QinQ-based EVPL service.

Activation Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Displays whether to activate the service.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1731

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-19 Parameters for port attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

Port Type

Displays the network attribute of the


Ethernet port.

Port Enabled

When the source port or sink port is a PORT,


this parameter indicates whether the port is
enabled.

TAG

Displays the tag attribute of the Ethernet


port.

Table B-20 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK Port

Displays the VCTRUNK that binds VC


paths.

Level

Displays the level of the bound VC paths.

Service Direction

Displays the direction of the bound VC


paths.

Bound Path

Displays the serial numbers of the bound VC


paths.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of the bound VC paths.

Activation Status

Displays whether the bound VC paths are


activated.

B.7.1.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service_Creation of Ethernet LAN


Services Based on IEEE 802.1d/802.1q Bridge
This section describes the parameters for creating an Ethernet LAN service.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1732

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-21 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board that is configured with a


bridge.

VB name

Describes the bridge. It is recommended that


you set this parameter to a character string
that indicates the function of the bridge.

Bridge Type

802.1q

802.1q

l If this parameter is set to 802.1q, an


IEEE 802.1q bridge is created.

802.1d

l If this parameter is set to 802.1d, an


IEEE 802.1d bridge is created.

802.1ad
Bridge Switch
Mode

l IVL/Ingress
Filter Enable
(supported by the
IEEE 802.1q
bridge and IEEE
802.1ad bridge,
unsupported by
the IEEE 802.1d
bridge)
l SVL/Ingress
Filter Disable
(supported by the
IEEE 802.1d
bridge and IEEE
802.1ad bridge,
unsupported by
the IEEE 802.1q
bridge)

l IVL/Ingress
Filter Enable
(IEEE 802.1q
bridge and the
IEEE 802.1ad
bridge)
l SVL/Ingress
Filter Disable
(IEEE 802.1d
bridge)

l When the bridge uses the SVL mode, all


the VLANs share one MAC address
table. When the bridge uses the IVL
mode, each VLAN has an MAC address
table.
l When the filtering function is enabled at
the ingress port, the ingress port checks
the VLAN tags of all incoming packets.
If the VLAN ID contained in the VLAN
tag of a packet is not included in the
VLAN filtering table, the packet is
discarded. When the filtering function is
disabled at the ingress port, the ingress
port does not check any VLAN tag of the
incoming packets.

Bridge Learning
Mode

Displays the learning mode of the bridge.

Ingress Filter

Displays whether the filtering function is


enabled at the ingress port.

MAC Address Selflearning

Displays whether the MAC address selflearning of the bridge is enabled.

Table B-22 Parameters for mounting services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB Port

Displays the ID of the logical port on the


bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1733

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mount Port

Displays or specifies which physical port or


VCTRUNK on the Ethernet switch board is
mounted to the bridge.

Port Type

Displays the network attribute of the port


mounted to the bridge.

Port Enabled

Disabled

Displays or specifies whether the port


mounted to the bridge is enabled.

Displays or specifies the tag attribute of the


port mounted to the bridge.

Displays or specifies the default VLAN ID


of the port mounted to the bridge.

Enabled
TAG

Access
Tag Aware
Hybrid

Default VLAN ID

This parameter is valid only when you set


the tag attribute of the port to Access or
Hybrid.
Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Displays or specifies the working mode of


the port mounted to the bridge.

10M Half-Duplex
10M Full-Duplex
100M Half-Duplex
100M Full-Duplex
GE port: 1000M
Full-Duplex
Active

Displays whether to activate the service.

Service Direction

Displays the direction of the service.

C-VLAN

The IEEE 802.1d/802.1q bridge does not


support this parameter.

S-VLAN

The IEEE 802.1d/802.1q bridge does not


support this parameter.

S-VLAN Priority

The IEEE 802.1d/802.1q bridge does not


support this parameter.

C-VLAN Priority

The IEEE 802.1d/802.1q bridge does not


support this parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1734

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-23 Parameters for mounting configuration


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Available Mounted
Ports

Displays which physical port or VCTRUNK


on the Ethernet switch board can be mounted
to the bridge.

Selected Mounted
Ports

Displays which physical port or VCTRUNK


on the Ethernet switch board is mounted to
the bridge.

Table B-24 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Configurable
Ports

EFP8:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK16

VCTRUNK1

Specifies the VCTRUNK to bind paths.

Displays the level of the bound VC path.

EMS6:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK8
Level

In the case of the EFP8 board, this parameter


always takes the value of VC12-Xv.
Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Uplink

l Set this parameter to Bidirectional


unless otherwise specified.

Downlink
Available
Resources

l Specifies the direction of the bound path.

l Displays the available VC4 paths.


l In the case of the EFP8 board, this
parameter always takes the value of
VC4-1.
l For EMS6 boards, when a VCTRUNK
needs to bind VC-12 paths, select VC-12
paths only in VC-4-4s.

Available
Timeslots

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Specifies the available timeslots.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1735

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bound Path

You need to plan and set this parameter


according to the following principles:
l The capacity of the VCTRUNK is
determined by the actual bandwidth
required by the services.
l The EFP8 board supports 16
VCTRUNKs. Each VCTRUNK can
bind a maximum of 16 VC-12 paths and
the total number of bound VC-12 paths
cannot exceed 63.
l For EMS6 boards, their VCTRUNKs 1-7
each support a maximum bandwidth of
100 Mbit/s. If a bandwidth higher than
100 Mbit/s is required, VCTRUNK8 is
recommended.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of the bound VC path.

Activation Status

Displays the activation status of the bound


VC path.

Related Tasks
A.8.3.2 Creating Ethernet LAN Services

B.7.1.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service_Creating IEEE 802.1ad


Bridge-Based Ethernet LAN Service
This section describes the parameters associated with IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based Ethernet LAN
services, which need to be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and then choose Configuration >
Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-25 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board where the bridge is


configured.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1736

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB Name

This parameter is a string that describes the


bridge. It is recommended that you set this
parameter to a character string that contains
the information about the detailed
application of the bridge.

Bridge Type

802.1q

802.1q

When this parameter is set to 802.1ad,


create the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.

l IVL/Ingress
Filter Enable (the
802.1q bridge
and the 802.1ad
bridge)

l When the bridge uses the SVL mode, all


the VLANs share one MAC address
table. When the bridge uses the IVL
mode, all the VLANs correspond to their
respective MAC address tables.

l SVL/Ingress
Filter Disable
(the 802.1d
bridge)

l If the ingress filter is enabled, the VLAN


tag is checked at the ingress port. If the
VLAN ID does not equal the VLAN ID
of the port defined in the VLAN filtering
table, the packet is discarded. If the
ingress filter is disabled, the preceding
described check is not conducted.

802.1d
802.1ad
Bridge Switch
Mode

l IVL/Ingress
Filter Enable
(supported by the
802.1q bridge
and 802.1ad
bridge,
unsupported by
the 802.1d
bridge)
l SVL/Ingress
Filter Disable
(supported by the
802.1d bridge
and 802.1ad
bridge,
unsupported by
the 802.1q
bridge)

Bridge Learning
Mode

Displays the bridge learning mode.

Ingress Filter

Displays whether the ingress filter function


is enabled.

MAC Address Selflearning

Displays whether the MAC address selflearning function of the bridge is enabled.

Table B-26 Parameters of service mounting


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB Port

Displays the ID of the logical port of the


bridge.

Mount Port

Displays or specifies the external port or


VCTRUNK on the Ethernet switching
board that is connected to the bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1737

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Type

Displays the network attribute of the


external port/VCTRUNK connected to the
bridge.

Port Enabled

Disabled

Displays or specifies whether the external


port connected to the bridge is enabled.

Enabled
TAG

This parameter is invalid in the case of


Ethernet LAN services based on 802.1ad
bridge.

Default VLAN ID

Displays or specifies the default VLAN ID.


This parameter is valid only when TAG is
set to Access or Hybrid.

Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

Auto-Negotiation

Displays or specifies the working mode of


the external port.

10M Half-Duplex
10M Full-Duplex
100M Half-Duplex
100M Full-Duplex
GE port: 1000M
Full-Duplex
Activate

Displays whether the service is activated.

Service Direction

Displays the service direction.

C-VLAN

Displays or specifies the C-VLAN ID that


the data frames carry.
Is valid only when the bridge is an IEEE
802.1ad bridge and Operation Type is set
to Add S-VLAN Base for Port and CVLAN.
Specifies the mapping relationship between
the C-VLAN ID carried by the data frames
and the S-VLAN ID to be added.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1738

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

S-VLAN

Displays or specifies the S-VLAN ID that


the data frames carry.
l When Operation Type is set to Add SVLAN Base for Port, this parameter
specifies that the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge need to be
added with the S-VLAN ID.
l When Operation Type is set to Add SVLAN Base for Port and C-VLAN,
this parameter and C-VLAN specify the
mapping relationship between the SVLAN ID to be added and the C-VLAN
ID carried by the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.
l When Operation Type is set to Mount
Port, this parameter is invalid.
l When Operation Type is set to Mount
Port and Base for Port and S-VLAN,
this parameter specifies the S-VLAN ID
to be carried by the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.

S-VLAN Priority

Displays or specifies the S-VLAN priority.

C-VLAN Priority

Displays or specifies the C-VLAN priority.

Table B-27 Parameters of service mounting


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Operation Type

Add S-VLAN base


for port

Add S-VLAN base


for port

For the meaning of each operation type, see


Application of the QinQ Technology in
802.1ad Bridge Services.

Add S-VLAN base


for Port and CVLAN
Mount Port
Mount Port and base
for Port and SVLAN
VB Port

Specifies the ID of the logical port of the


bridge.

Mount Port

Selects the external port or VCTRUNK on


the Ethernet switching board that is
connected to the bridge.

Port Type

Displays the port type.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1739

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

C-VLAN

1-4095

Is valid only when Operation Type is set to


Add S-VLAN Base for Port and CVLAN.
Specifies the mapping relationship between
the C-VLAN ID carried by the data frames
and the S-VLAN ID to be added.

S-VLAN

1-4095

l When Operation Type is set to Add SVLAN Base for Port, this parameter
specifies that the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge need to be
added with the S-VLAN ID.
l When Operation Type is set to Add SVLAN Base for Port and C-VLAN,
this parameter and C-VLAN specify the
mapping relationship between the SVLAN ID to be added and the C-VLAN
ID carried by the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.
l When Operation Type is set to Mount
Port, this parameter is invalid.
l When Operation Type is set to Mount
Port and Base for Port and S-VLAN,
this parameter specifies the S-VLAN ID
to be carried by the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.

S-VLAN Priority

AUTO

AUTO

Specifies the S-VLAN priority.

Priority 0 to Priority
7
C-VLAN Priority

AUTO

AUTO

Specifies the C-VLAN priority.

Port Enabled

Displays or specifies whether the external


port connected to the bridge is enabled.

Table B-28 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Configurable
Ports

EFP8:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK16

VCTRUNK1

Specifies the VCTRUNK to bind paths.

EMS6:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK8

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1740

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

Displays the level of the bound VC path.


In the case of the EFP8 board, this parameter
always takes the value of VC12-Xv.

Service Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Uplink

l Set this parameter to Bidirectional


unless otherwise specified.

Downlink
Available
Resources

l Specifies the direction of the bound path.

l Displays the available VC4 paths.


l In the case of the EFP8 board, this
parameter always takes the value of
VC4-1.
l For EMS6 boards, when a VCTRUNK
needs to bind VC-12 paths, select VC-12
paths only in VC-4-4s.

Available
Timeslots

Specifies the available timeslots.

Bound Path

You need to plan and set this parameter


according to the following principles:
l The capacity of the VCTRUNK is
determined by the actual bandwidth
required by the services.
l The EFP8 board supports 16
VCTRUNKs. Each VCTRUNK can
bind a maximum of 16 VC-12 paths and
the total number of bound VC-12 paths
cannot exceed 63.
l For EMS6 boards, their VCTRUNKs 1-7
each support a maximum bandwidth of
100 Mbit/s. If a bandwidth higher than
100 Mbit/s is required, VCTRUNK8 is
recommended.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of the bound VC path.

Activation Status

Displays the activation status of the bound


VC path.

Related Tasks
A.8.3.6 Creating IEEE 802.1ad Bridge-Based EVPLAN Services

B.7.1.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet LAN Service


This section describes the parameters for creating an Ethernet LAN service.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1741

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-29 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board that is configured with a


bridge.

VB ID

Displays the ID of the bridge.

VB Name

This parameter is a character string that


describes the bridge. It is recommended that
you set this character string to a value that
indicates the specific purpose of the bridge.

Bridge Type

Displays the type of the bridge.

Bridge Switch
Mode

Displays the switching mode of the bridge.

Bridge Learning
Mode

Displays the learning mode of the bridge.

Ingress Filter

Displays whether the filtering function is


enabled at the ingress port.

MAC Address selfLearning

Displays whether the MAC address selflearning of the bridge is enabled.

Active

Displays whether to activate the service.

Table B-30 Parameters for mounting services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB Port

Displays the ID of the logical port of the


bridge.

Mount Port

Displays or specifies which physical port or


VCTRUNK on the Ethernet switch board is
mounted to the bridge.

Port Type

Displays the network attribute of the port


mounted to the bridge.

Port Enabled

Displays or specifies whether the port


mounted to the bridge is enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1742

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Hub/Spoke

Hub

Hub

Displays or specifies the Hub/Spoke


attribute of the port mounted to the bridge.

Spoke

l Hub ports can mutually access each


other.
l Hub ports and Spoke ports can mutually
access each other.
l Spoke ports cannot mutually access each
other.
TAG

Displays or specifies the TAG attribute of


the mounted port in the case of Ethernet
LAN services based on 802.1d bridge or
802.1q bridge.
This parameter is invalid in the case of
Ethernet LAN services based on 802.1ad
bridge.

Default VLAN ID

Displays or specifies the default VLAN ID


of the port mounted to the bridge.
This parameter is valid only when you set
the tag attribute of the port to Access or
Hybrid.

Working Mode

Displays or specifies the working mode of


the port mounted to the bridge.

Service Direction

Displays the direction of the service.

C-VLAN

Displays or specifies the C-VLAN ID


carried by the data frame.
This parameter is valid only when the bridge
is an IEEE 802.1ad bridge and Operation
Type is Add S-VLAN Base for Port and
C-VLAN.
This parameter specifies the mapping
relation between the C-VLAN tag carried by
the data frame and the S-VLAN tag to be
added.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1743

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

S-VLAN

Displays or specifies the S-VLAN ID


carried by the data frame.
l When Operation Type is set to Add SVLAN Base for Port, this parameter
specifies the S-VLAN to be added to the
data frames that enter the IEEE 802.1ad
bridge.
l When Operation Type is set to Add SVLAN Base for Port and C-VLAN,
this parameter and C-VLAN specify the
mapping relation between the S-VLAN
tag to be added and the C-VLAN tag
carried by the data frame that enters the
IEEE 802.1ad bridge.
l When Operation Type is set to Mount
Port, this parameter is invalid.
l When Operation Type is set to Mount
Port and Base for Port and S-VLAN,
this parameter specifies the S-VLAN tag
to be carried by the data frames that enter
the IEEE 802.1ad bridge.

S-VLAN Priority

Displays the priority of the S-VLAN.

C-VLAN Priority

Displays the priority of the C-VLAN.

Table B-31 Parameters for VLAN filtering table


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

Displays the VLAN ID that needs to be


filtered in forwarding.

VB Port

Displays the ID of the logical port of the


bridge.

Forwarding
Physical Port

Displays the actually specified forwarding


port.
l Selected forwarding ports can send
packets only among themselves.
l Selected forwarding ports can only
forward the packet that carries the
VLAN ID tag. These ports discard the
packet that carries other VLAN tags.
l The broadcast packets transmitted by
any of Selected forwarding ports can
be forwarded only among Selected
forwarding ports.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1744

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Activation Status

Displays whether the VLAN ID entry is


valid.

Table B-32 Parameters for VLAN unicast


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

l This parameter is invalid for the 802.1d


bridge and the 802.1ad bridge that adopt
the SVL learning mode. The entry
applies to all VLANs.
l In the case of the 802.1d bridge and the
802.1ad bridge that adopt the SVL
learning mode, the entry applies to only
the VLAN with the ID specified by this
parameter.
l Set this parameter according to the
planning information.

MAC Address

l Displays or specifies the static MAC


address.
l A static MAC address is an address that
is set manually. It does not age
automatically and needs to be deleted
manually.
l Generally, a static MAC address is used
for the port that receives but does not
forward Ethernet service packets or the
port whose MAC address need not age
automatically.

VB Port

Displays the ID of the logical port of the


bridge.

Physical Port

l Specifies the Ethernet port that


corresponds to the MAC address.
l Set this parameter according to the
planning information.

Aging Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Displays the aging status of the entries.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1745

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-33 Parameters for disabling MAC addresses


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID(e.g.
1,3-6)

Displays or specifies the VLAN ID of the


service. A disabled MAC address is valid for
the VLAN with the ID as specified by this
parameter.

MAC Address

l Displays or specifies the disabled MAC


address. A disabled MAC address is also
called a blacklisted MAC address.
l The data frame that contains a disabled
destination MAC address is discarded. A
disabled MAC address needs to be set
manually and does not age.

Table B-34 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK Port

Displays the VCTRUNK to bind VC paths.

Level

Displays the level of the bound VC paths.

Service Direction

Displays the direction of the bound VC


paths.

Bound Path

Displays the bound paths.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of bound paths.

Table B-35 Parameters for self-learned MAC addresses


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

MAC Address

l Displays or specifies the self-learned


MAC address. A self-learned MAC
address is also called a dynamic MAC
address.
l The entries of self-learned MAC
addresses are obtained when the bridge
uses the SVL or IVL learning mode. A
self-learned MAC address ages.

VB Port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Displays the ID of the logical port of the


bridge.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1746

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

l If the bridge uses the SVL learning


mode, this parameter is invalid. That is,
the preset self-learned MAC address
entries are valid for all VLANs.
l If the bridge uses the IVL learning mode,
the preset self-learned MAC address
entries are valid only for the VLAN with
the ID specified by this parameter.
l Set this parameter according to the
planning information.

Table B-36 Parameters for VLAN MAC address table capacity


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VLAN ID

Displays the VLAN ID specified for


querying the self-learned MAC addresses.

Actual MAC
Address Table
Capacity

Displays how many MAC addresses are


actually self-learned in the query condition
of a specific VLAN ID.

Table B-37 Parameters for VB port MAC address table capacity


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB Port

Displays the ID of the logical port of the


bridge. The ID is specified for querying the
self-learned MAC addresses.

Actual MAC
Address Table
Capacity

Displays how many MAC addresses are


actually self-learned in the query condition
of a specific VB port.

Related Tasks
A.8.4.1 Creating a Static MAC Address Entry
A.8.4.2 Creating a Blacklist Entry of a MAC Address
A.8.4.4 Querying or Deleting a Dynamic MAC Address
A.8.4.5 Querying the Actual Capacity of a MAC Address Table

B.7.1.7 Parameter Description: VLAN Filtering Table_Creation


This section describes the parameters for creating VLAN filtering tables.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1747

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Service > Ethernet LAN Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Select an IEEE 802.1q or 802.1ad bridge and click the VLAN Filtering tab.
NOTE

In the case of IEEE 802.1ad bridge-based Ethernet LAN services, the learning mode of the VB must
be IVL.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-38 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB

Displays the bridge whose VLAN filtering


table is to be created.

VLAN ID(e.g.
1,3-6)

1-4095

Specifies the VLAN IDs in the VLAN


filtering table.
l You can set this parameter to a number
or several numbers. When you set this
parameter to several numbers, use "," to
separate these discrete values and use "-"
to indicate continuous numbers. For
example, "1, 3-6" indicates numbers 1,
3, 4, 5, and 6.
l Set this parameter as required.

Available
forwarding ports

Displays the ports mounted to the bridge.

Selected
forwarding ports

Displays the selected forwarding ports.


l The selected forwarding ports can send
packets only among themselves.
l The selected forwarding ports can only
forward the packet that carries the
VLAN ID (e.g:1,3-6) tag. These ports
discard the packet that carries other
VLAN tags.
l The broadcast packet that carries the
VLAN ID(e.g.1,3-6) tag can be
forwarded only among the selected
forwarding ports.

Related Tasks
A.8.3.4 Creating the VLAN Filtering Table
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1748

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.7.1.8 Parameter Description: Aging Time of MAC Address Table Entries


This section describes the parameters associated with the aging time of MAC address table
entries, which need to be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Aging Time from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-39 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the Ethernet board.

MAC Address
Aging Time

l 1 to 120 Min

5 Min

l If one entry is not updated in a certain


period, that is, if no new packet from this
MAC address is received to enable the
re-learning of this MAC address, this
entry is deleted automatically. This
mechanism is called aging, and this
period is called the aging time.

l 1 to 120 Hour
l 1 to 12 Day

l If you set this parameter to a very large


value, the bridge stores excessive MAC
address table entries that are outdated,
which exhausts the resources of the
MAC address forwarding table.
l If you set this parameter to a very small
value, the bridge may delete the MAC
address table entry that is required,
which reduces the forwarding
efficiency.
l It is recommended that this parameter
takes the default value.
NOTE
The maximum MAC Address Aging Time
supported by EFP8 and EMS6 boards is 12 days.

Related Tasks
A.8.4.3 Setting the Aging Time of a MAC Address Table Entry

B.7.2 Parameters for Ethernet Protocols


This section describes the parameters for EoS/EoPDH-plane Ethernet protocols.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1749

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.7.2.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating ERPS management tasks.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Protection > ERPS Management.

2.

Click New.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ERPS ID

1 to 7

l This parameter
specifies the ID of the
Ethernet ring
protection switching
(ERPS) instance.
l The IDs of ERPS
instances on an NE
must be different from
each other.

East Port

This parameter specifies


the east port of the ERPS
instance.

West Port

This parameter specifies


the west port of the ERPS
instance.

RPL Owner Ring Node


Flag

Yes

No

l This parameter
specifies whether the
node on the ring is the
ring protection link
(RPL) owner.

No

l Only one node on the


ring can be set as the
RPL owner for each
Ethernet ring.
l An RPL owner needs
to balance the traffic
on each link of an
Ethernet ring.
Therefore, it is not
recommended that you
select a convergence
node as an RPL owner.
Instead, select the NE
that is farthest away
from the convergence
node as an RPL owner.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1750

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RPL Port

l This parameter
specifies the RPL port.
l There is only one RPL
port and this RPL port
must be the east or
west port on the RPL
owner node.
l It is recommended that
you set the east port on
an RPL owner as an
RPL Port.

Control VLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
specifies the VLAN ID
of Control VLAN.
l Each node on the
Ethernet ring transmits
the R-APS packets on
the dedicated ring APS
(R-APS) channel to
ensure consistency
between the nodes
when the ERPS
switching is
performed. Control
VLAN is used for
isolating the dedicated
R-APS channel.
Therefore, the VLAN
ID in Control VLAN
cannot be duplicate
with the VLAN IDs
that are contained in
the service packets.
l The ID of a Control
VLAN must not be the
same as any VLAN ID
used by Ethernet
services. All ring
nodes should use the
same Control VLAN
ID.

Destination Node

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

01-19-A7-00-00-01

01-19-A7-00-00-01

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
destination node. The
default destination MAC
address in the R-APS
packets is always 01-19A7-00-00-01.
1751

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.7.2.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management


This topic describes the parameters that are used for Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS)
management.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board. Choose Configuration > Ethernet Protection >
ERPS Management from the Function Tree.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ERPS ID

1 to 8

This parameter indicates


the ID of the ERPS
instance.

East Port

This parameter indicates


the east port of the ERPS
instance.

West Port

This parameter indicates


the west port of the ERPS
instance.

RPL Owner Ring Node


Flag

Yes

This parameter indicates


whether a node on the ring
is the ring protection link
(RPL) owner.

RPL Port

This parameter indicates


the RPL port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

No

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1752

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control VLAN

1 to 4094

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the VLAN ID of
Control VLAN.
l Each node on the
Ethernet ring transmits
the R-APS packets on
the dedicated ring APS
(R-APS) channel to
ensure consistency
between the nodes
when the ERPS
switching is
performed. Control
VLAN is used for
isolating the dedicated
R-APS channel.
Therefore, the VLAN
ID in Control VLAN
cannot be duplicate
with the VLAN IDs
that are contained in
the service packets or
inband DCN packets.
l The Control VLAN
must be set to the same
value for all the NEs
on an ERPS ring.

Destination Node

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

01-19-A7-00-00-01

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the MAC address of the
destination node. The
default destination MAC
address in the R-APS
packets is always 01-19A7-00-00-01.

1753

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Hold-Off Time(ms)

0 to 10000, in step of 100

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the hold-off time of the
ERPS hold-off timer.
l The hold-off timer is
used for negotiating
the protection
switching sequence
when the ERPS
coexists with other
protection schemes so
that the fault can be
rectified in the case of
other protection
switching (such as
LAG protection)
before the ERPS
occurs. When a node
on the ring detects one
or more new faults, it
starts up the hold-off
timer if the preset
hold-off time is set to a
value that is not 0.
During the hold-off
time, the fault is not
reported to trigger an
ERPS. When the holdoff timer times out, the
node checks the link
status regardless
whether the fault that
triggers the startup of
the timer exists. If the
fault exists, the node
reports it to trigger an
ERPS. This fault can
be the same as or
different from the fault
that triggers the initial
startup of the hold-off
timer.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1754

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Guard Time(ms)

10 to 2000, in step of 10

500

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the guard time of the
ERPS guard timer.
l The nodes on the ring
continuously forward
the R-APS packets to
the Ethernet ring. As a
result, the outdated RAPS packets may exist
on the ring network.
After a node on the
ring receives the
outdated R-APS
packets, an incorrect
ERPS may occur. The
ERPS guard timer is an
R-APS timer used for
preventing a node on
the ring from receiving
outdated R-APS
packets. When a faulty
node on the ring
detects that the
switching condition is
cleared, the node starts
up the guard timer and
starts to forward the RAPS (NR) packets.
During this period, the
R-APS packets
received by the node
are discarded. The
received R-APS
packets are forwarded
only after the time of
the guard timer
expires.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1755

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(mm:ss)

5 to 12, in step of 1

l This parameter
indicates or specifies
the WTR time of the
WRT timer in the case
of ERPS protection.
l The WTR time refers
to the duration from
the time when the
working channel is
restored to the time
when the switching is
released. When the
working channel is
restored, the WTR
timer of the RPL
owner starts up. In
addition, a signal that
indicates the operation
of the WTR timer is
continuously output in
the timing process.
When the WTR timer
times out and no
switching request of a
higher priority is
received, the signal
indicating the
operation of the WTR
timer is not
transmitted. In
addition, the WTR
release signal is
continuously output.
l The WTR timer is used
to prevent frequent
switching caused by
the unstable working
channel.

Packet Transmit
Interval(s)

1 to 10

This parameter displays or


specifies the interval for
sending R-APS packets
periodically.

Entity Level

0 to 7

This parameter indicates


or specifies the level of the
maintenance entity.

Last Switching Request

This parameter indicates


the last switching request.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1756

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RB Status

This parameter indicates


the RB (RPL Blocked)
status of the packets
received by the working
node.
l noRB: The RPL is not
blocked.
l RB: The RPL is
blocked.

DNF Status

This parameter indicates


the DNF status of the
packets received by the
working node.
l noDNF: The R-APS
packets do not contain
the DNF flag. In this
case, the packets are
forwarded by the node
that detects the fault on
a non-RPL link, and
the node that receives
the packets is
requested to clear the
forwarding address
table.
l DNF: The R-APS
packets contain the
DNF flags. In this
case, the packets are
forwarded by the node
that detects the fault on
an RPL link, and the
node that receives the
packets is informed
not to clear the
forwarding address
table.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1757

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

State Machine Status

This parameter indicates


the status of the state
machine at the working
node.
l Idle: The Ethernet ring
is in normal state. For
example, no node on
the Ethernet ring
detects any faults or
receives the R_APS
(NR, RB) packets.
l Protection: The
Ethernet ring is in
protected state. For
example, a fault on the
node triggers the
ERPS, or a node on the
ring is in the WTR
period after the fault is
rectified.

Node Carried with


Current Packet

This parameter indicates


the MAC address carried
in the R-APS packets
received by the current
node. The MAC address
refers to the MAC address
of the source node that
initiates the switching
request.

East Port Status

Displays the status of the


east port.

West Port Status

Displays the status of the


west port.

B.7.2.3 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Protocol Enabling


This section describes the parameters for the types of spanning tree protocols and for enabling
the spanning tree protocols.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the Protocol Enabled tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1758

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-40 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB

Displays the created bridge.

Protocol Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

l Indicates whether to enable the spanning


tree protocol.

Disabled

l Try to avoid Layer 2 service loopbacks


in the service networking. If no loop
occurs, you need not start the STP/
RSTP.
l If the loop is already formed in the
service networking, you must start the
STP or RSTP.
STP

Protocol Type

RSTP

RSTP

l This parameter is valid only when


Protocol Enabled is Enabled.
l The protocol type should be set
according to the requirement of the
interconnected Ethernet equipment. The
default value is recommended unless
otherwise specified.

Related Tasks
A.8.6.1 Configuring the Type and Enabled Status of the Spanning Tree Protocol

B.7.2.4 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Bridge Parameters


This section describes the parameters for the spanning tree protocol.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the Bridge Parameters tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-41 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB

Displays the created bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1759

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Priority

0-61440

32768

l The most significant 16 bits of the bridge


ID indicate the priority of the bridge.
l When the value is smaller, the priority is
higher. As a result, the bridge is more
likely to be selected as the root bridge.
l If the priorities of all the bridges on the
STP network take the same value, the
bridge whose MAC address is the
smallest is selected as the root bridge.

MAC Address

Displays the MAC address of a bridge.

Max Age(s)

6-40

20

l Indicates the maximum age of the


CBPDU packet that is recorded by the
port.
l The greater the value, the longer the
transmission distance of the CBPDU
packet, and the greater the network
diameter. When the value of this
parameter is greater, however, the link
fault detection of the bridge is slower and
thus the network adaptability is reduced.

1-10

Hello Time(s)

l Indicates the interval for transmitting


CBPDU packets through the bridge.
l The greater the value of this parameter,
the less the network resources that are
occupied by the spanning tree. As the
value of this parameter increases,
however, the topology stability
decreases.

4-30

Forward Delay(s)

15

l Indicates the holding time of a port in the


listening state and in the learning state.
l The greater the value, the longer the
delay of the network state change.
Therefore, the topology changes are
slower and recovery in the case of faults
is slower.

1-10

TxHoldCout(per
second)

Indicates how many times the port transmits


CBPDU packets in every second.

Related Tasks
A.8.6.2 Setting the Parameters of Spanning Tree Protocol

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1760

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.7.2.5 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Port Parameters


This section describes the parameters associated with the spanning tree protocol, which need to
be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Parameters tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-42 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the created bridge.

Priority

0-240

128

l The most significant eight bits of the port


ID indicate the port priority.
l The smaller the value of this parameter,
the higher the priority.

Port Path Cost

1-200000000

l Indicates the status of the network to


which the port is connected.
l In the case of the bridges on both ends of
the path, set this parameter to the same
value.

Status

Displays the state of a port.

Admin Edge
Attribute

Enabled

Disabled

l Is valid only when the RSTP is used.

Disabled

l Specifies whether to set the port to an


edge port. The edge port refers to the
bridge port that is connected only to the
LAN. The edge port receives the BPDU
and does not transmit the BPDU.
l Set this parameter to Enabled only when
the Ethernet port on the Ethernet board
is directly connected to the data
communication terminal equipment,
such as a computer. In other cases, it is
recommended that this parameter takes
the default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1761

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protocol Enabled

Enabled

Enabled

l Specifies whether the STP or RSTP is


enabled for the port.

Disabled

l When this parameter is set to Disabled,


the port does not process or transmit the
BPDU.
l It is recommended that this parameter
takes the default value.
Enabled

Auto Edge
Detection

Disabled

Disabled

l Is valid only when Admin Edge


Attribute is set to Enabled.
l When this parameter is set to Enabled,
if the bridge detects that this port is
connected to the port of another bridge,
the RSTP considers this port as a nonedge port.
l When Admin Edge Attribute is set to
Enabled, set this parameter to
Enabled. In other cases, it is
recommended that this parameter takes
the default value.

Related Tasks
A.8.6.2 Setting the Parameters of Spanning Tree Protocol

B.7.2.6 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Bridge Running Information


This section describes the parameters associated with the type and enabled status of the spanning
tree protocol, which need to be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Bridge Running Information tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-43 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB

Displays the created bridge.

Priority

Displays the priority of the bridge. The most


significant 16 bits of the bridge ID indicate
the priority of the bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1762

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

MAC Address

Displays the MAC address of the bridge.

Designed Root
Bridge Priority

Displays the priority of the specified bridge.

Designed Root
Bridge MAC
Address

Displays the MAC address of the specified


bridge.

Root Path Cost

Displays the root path cost. The root path


cost is the path cost of the root port and is
used for calculating the network topology.

Root Port

Displays the root port of the spanning tree


protocol.

Max Age(s)

Displays the maximum age of the CBPDU


packet that is recorded by the port.

Hello Time(s)

Displays the interval for transmitting the


CBPDU packets through the bridge.

Forward Delay(s)

Displays the holding time of a port in


listening state and in learning state.

HoldCout

Displays the number of times that each port


transmits CBPDU packets per second.

Related Tasks
A.8.6.3 Querying the Running Information About the Spanning Tree Protocol

B.7.2.7 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Port Running Information


This section describes the parameters associated with the type and enabled status of the spanning
tree protocol, which need to be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Port Running Information tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-44 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the logical port of the bridge.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1763

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port ID

Displays the port ID.

Port Status

Displays the port status.

Port Path Cost

Displays the port path cost.

Designated Port D

Displays the ID of the specified port.

Designated Root
Bridge Priority

Displays the priority of the specified root


bridge.

Designated Root
Bridge MAC
Address

Displays the MAC address of the specified


root bridge.

Designated Path
Cost

Displays the specified path cost.

Designated Bridge
Priority

Displays the priority of the specified bridge.

Designated Bridge
MAC Address

Displays the MAC address of the specified


bridge.

Topology
Detection

Displays the enabled status of topology


detection.

Edge Port Status

Displays the enabled status of the edge port.

Running Time(s)

Displays the duration when the topology


remains unchanged.

Related Tasks
A.8.6.3 Querying the Running Information About the Spanning Tree Protocol

B.7.2.8 Parameter Description: Spanning Tree_Point-to-Point Attribute


This section describes the parameters associated with the point-to-point attribute of the spanning
tree protocol, which need to be set on the NMS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and choose Configuration > Layer-2
Switching Management > Spanning Tree from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Point to Point Attribute tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1764

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-45 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the internal and external ports on


the Ethernet board.

Point-to-point
Attribute

Adaptive
connection

Adaptive connection

l This parameter is valid only when the


RSTP is used.

Link connection
Shared media

l If this parameter is set to Adaptive


connection, the bridge determines the
actual point-to-point attribute of the port
according to the actual working mode of
the port. If the port works in full-duplex
mode, the actual point-to-point attribute
of the port is True. If the port works in
half-duplex mode, the actual point-topoint attribute of the port is False.
l If you set this parameter to Link
connection, the actual point-to-point
attribute of the port is True.
l If you set this parameter to Shared
media, the actual point-to-point attribute
of the port is False.
l Only the port whose actual point to point
attribute is True can transmit the fast
transition request and response
messages.
l It is recommended that this parameter
takes the default value.

Related Tasks
A.8.6.2 Setting the Parameters of Spanning Tree Protocol

B.7.2.9 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Enabling


This section describes the parameters for enabling the IGMP snooping protocol.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.

2.

Click the Enable IGMP Snooping Protocol tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1765

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

VB

Displays the ID of the bridge.

Protocol Enable

Enabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether to enable the IGMP


snooping protocol.

Disabled

l If the IGMP multicast router exists on


the interconnected Ethernet network,
enable the IGMP snooping protocol
according to the requirements of the
router.
The Discarded Tag
of the Packet
Excluded in the
Multicast Group

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter specifies the method of


the port to process unknown multicast
packets. When the IEEE 802.1q or
802.1ad bridge receives the multicast
packets whose multicast addresses are
not included in the multicast table, these
packets are considered as unknown
packets.
l This parameter is valid only when
Protocol Enable is Enabled.
l If this parameter is set to Disabled,
unknown multicast packets are
broadcast in the VLAN.
l Set this parameter as required by the
IGMP multicast server.

1 to 4

Max.NonResponse Times

If the bridge transmits an IGMP group query


packet to the multicast member ports, the
router port starts the timer for the query of
the maximum response time. If the bridge
does not receive the IGMP report packet
within the maximum response time, the
bridge adds one to the no-response times of
the multicast member port. When the noresponse times of the port exceed the preset
threshold, the bridge deletes the multicast
member from the multicast group.

Related Tasks
A.8.7.1 Configuring the IGMP Snooping Protocol

B.7.2.10 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Creation of Static


Multicast Table Entries
This section describes the parameters for creating static multicast table entries.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1766

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.

2.

Click the Static Multicast Table tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VB ID

Displays the ID of the created bridge.

VLAN ID

Specifies the VLAN ID of the static


multicast table entry.

MAC Address

l Specifies the MAC address in the static


multicast table.
l Set this parameter as required.

Multicast Port

l Specifies the port as an entry in the static


multicast table.
l An entry in the static multicast table does
not age.

Related Tasks
A.8.7.2 Configuring Static Multicast Entries

B.7.2.11 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Protocol_Aging Time of Multicast


Table Entries
This section describes the parameters for the aging time of multicast table entries.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Layer-2 Switching Management > IGMP Snooping Protocol from the
Function Tree.

2.

Click the Multicast Aging Time tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1767

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Multicast Aging
Time(Min)

1-120

l Specifies the aging time for multicast


table entries. When a dynamic multicast
table entry is not updated in a certain
period (that is, no IGMP request from
this multicast address is received), this
entry is automatically deleted. This
mechanism is called aging, and this
period is called aging time.
l If this parameter is set to a very great
value, the bridge stores excessive
multicast table entries that are no longer
needed, which exhausts the resources of
the multicast table.
l If this parameter is set to a very small
value, the bridge may delete the
multicast table entry that is needed,
which reduces the forwarding
efficiency.
l The default value is recommended.

Related Tasks
A.8.7.3 Modifying the Aging Time of a Multicast Table Entry

B.7.2.12 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Creation of LAGs


This topic describes the parameters for creating a link aggregation group (LAG).

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Link Aggregation
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.

3.

Click New.

Attribute Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAG No

EFP8: 1-12

Specifies the LAG number.

Specifies the LAG name.

EMS6: 1-8
LAG Name

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1768

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LAG Type

Static

Static

l Static: A static LAG is created by the


user. To add or delete a member port, you
need to run the Link Aggregation
Control Protocol (LACP) protocol. In a
static LAG, a port can be in selected,
standby, or unselected state. By running
the LACP protocol, devices exchange
aggregation information so that they
share the same aggregation information.

Manual

l Manual: A manual LAG is created by the


user. When you add or delete a member
port, you need not run the LACP
protocol. In a manual LAG, a port can be
in the UP or DOWN state. The system
determines whether to aggregate a port
according to its physical state (UP or
DOWN), working mode, and rate.
Load Sharing

Sharing

Sharing

Non-Sharing

l Sharing: In a sharing LAG, all member


ports always share the traffic load. The
sharing mode can improve bandwidth
utilization on a link. When the member
ports are changed or some member ports
fail, the traffic load of each member port
is automatically re-allocated.
l Non-Sharing: In a non-sharing LAG,
only one member port carries the traffic
load and the other member ports are in
Standby state. Actually, a non-sharing
LAG works in hot-standby mode. When
the active port fails, the system selects a
standby port to substitute for the failed
port, thus preventing a link failure.

Sharing Mode

IP Sharing Mode

IP Sharing Mode

You can set this parameter only when Load


Sharing is Sharing.

Revertive

l You can set this parameter only when


Load Sharing is Non-Sharing.

MAC Sharing Mode


Revertive Mode

Revertive
Non-Revertive

l If this parameter is set to Revertive,


services are automatically switched back
to the working path after the working
path recovers.
l If this parameter is set to NonRevertive, services are still transmitted
in the protection path after the working
path recovers and the LAG remains the
same.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1769

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Port Setting Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Main Port

l Specifies the main port in a LAG.


l After a LAG is created, you can add
Ethernet services to the main port only.
That is, services cannot be added to a
slave port.
l When Load Sharing is set to NonSharing, the link connected to the main
port is the working path and the links
connected to the slave ports are
protection paths.

Available Standby
Ports

Selected Standby
Ports

l Specifies the salve port in a LAG.


l After a LAG is created, you need to
perform manual operations to add or
delete a slave port.

Displays the selected slave ports.

Related Tasks
A.8.2.1 Creating a LAG

B.7.2.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Link Aggregation


This section describes the parameters for port priorities and system priorities.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Link Aggregation
Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Link Aggregation Parameters tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

Port Priority

0-65535

32768

l This parameter is valid only when LAG


Type of a LAG is set to Static.
l This parameter indicates the priorities of
the ports in a LAG as defined in the
LACP protocol. The smaller the value,
the higher the priority.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1770

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for the system settings


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

System Priority

0-65535

32768

l This parameter is valid only when LAG


Type of a LAG is set to Static.
l This parameter indicates the priority of a
LAG. The smaller the value, the higher
the priority.
l When the local LAG and the opposite
LAG negotiate through LACP packets,
one can obtain the system priority of the
other. The LAG with the higher system
priority is considered as the comparison
result. Then, the aggregation
information is consistent at both ends. If
the local LAG and the opposite LAG
have the same system priority, the MAC
addresses are compared. The LAG with
a lower MAC address is considered as
the comparison result. Then, the
aggregation information is consistent at
both ends.

System MAC
Address

Displays the MAC address of the system.

Related Tasks
A.8.2.2 Setting Parameters for LAGs

B.7.2.14 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation of Point-to-Point


Service LPT
This section describes the parameters for creating point-to-point service LPT.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > LPT Management from the
Function Tree.

2.

Click Query.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

VCTRUNK Port

Displays the VCTRUNK used by the


Ethernet service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1771

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Direction

l Displays the direction of the Ethernet


service at the port.
l The service direction is set to positive
when the source port is a PORT and the
sink port is a VCTRUNK; the service
direction is set to reverse when the
source port is a VCTRUNK and the sink
port is a PORT.

Yes

LPT

No

Specifies whether to enable the LPT.

GFP(HUAWEI)

Ethernet

l Specifies the bearer mode of the LPT


packets.

GFP-CSF

l The default value is recommended.

No
Bearer Mode

GFP(HUAWEI)

PORT-Type Port
Hold-Off Time(ms)

0-10000

100

l When the link on which Ethernet


services are transmitted is configured
with other protection schemes, you need
to set the hold-off time of LPT. This
enables the NE to notify the equipment
at both ends of a transmission network of
the fault on the transmission link only
when the other protection schemes fail.
l This parameter is valid only in the
positive direction of LPT.

VCTRUNK Port
Hold-Off Time(ms)

0-10000

100

l When the link on which Ethernet


services are transmitted is configured
with other protection schemes, you need
to set the hold-off time of LPT. This
enables the NE to notify the equipment
at both ends of a transmission network of
the fault on the transmission link only
when the other protection schemes fail.
l This parameter is valid only in the
reverse direction of LPT.

Related Tasks
A.8.11.1 Configuring LPT for Point-to-Point Services

B.7.2.15 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation of Point-to-Multipoint


Service LPT
This section describes the parameters for creating point-to-multipoint service LPT.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1772

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > LPT Management from the
Function Tree.

2.

Click PtoMP LPT. Then, the LPT Management dialog box appears.

3.

Click New.

Parameters for Convergence Points


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Specifies the port of the convergence point.

Bearer Mode

GFP(HUAWEI)

GFP(HUAWEI)

Ethernet

l This parameter can be set only when the


selected port is a VCTRUNK.

GFP-CSF

l The default value is recommended.

Port Hold-Off
Time(ms)

0-10000

When the link on which Ethernet services


are transmitted is configured with other
protection schemes, you need to set the
hold-off time of LPT. This enables the NE
to notify the equipment at both ends of a
transmission network of the fault on the
transmission link only when the other
protection schemes fail.

Parameters for Access Points


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Specifies the port at the access node.

Bearer Mode

GFP(HUAWEI)

GFP(HUAWEI)

Ethernet

l This parameter can be set only when the


selected port is a VCTRUNK.

GFP-CSF

l The default value is recommended.

Related Tasks
A.8.11.2 Configuring LPT for Point-to-Multipoint Services

B.7.2.16 Parameter Description: Port Mirroring_Creation


This section describes the parameters for creating port mirroring tasks.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1773

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Interface Management > Port Mirroring from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the board name.

Mirror Listener
Port

l After the mirroring function of the port


is configured, you can monitor all the
mirrored ports by analyzing the packets
at the mirroring port only. As a result,
you can easily manage the ports.
l Mirror Listener Port indicates the port
that sends the packets copied from
Uplink Listened Port and Downlink
Listened Port.
l Mirror Listener Port cannot be set to a
port that carries any service.

Mirrored
Upstream Port

Mirrored
Downstream Port

l Mirrored Upstream Port and


Mirrored Downstream Port indicate
the ports that copy packets for Mirror
Listener Port.
l Mirrored Upstream Port can be a
PORT or a VCTRUNK. As a PORT, the
port copies the packets that it receives;
as a VCTRUNK, the port copies the
packets that it transmits. Mirror
Listener Port sends the packets copied
from Mirrored Upstream Port.
l Mirrored Downstream Port can be a
PORT or a VCTRUNK. As a PORT, the
port copies the packets that it transmits;
as a VCTRUNK, the port copies the
packets that it receives. Mirror Listener
Port sends the packets copied from
Mirrored Downstream Port.
NOTE
The transmit direction and receive direction
mentioned in this section are related to the local
NE.

B.7.3 Parameters for the Ethernet OAM


This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet OAM on the EoS/EoPDH plane.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1774

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.7.3.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MDs


This topic describes the parameters for creating maintenance domains (MDs).

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function
Tree.

2.

In the right pane, click OAM Configuration.

3.

Click New and choose Create MD from the drop-down list.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-46 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance Domain
Name

For example: MD1

Specifies the name of the


MD.

Maintenance Domain
Level

Consumer High(7)

Operator Low(0)

Specifies the level of the


MD. The greater the value,
the higher the level.

Consumer Middle(6)
Consumer Low(5)
Provider High(4)
Provider Low(3)
Operator High(2)
Operator Middle(1)
Operator Low(0)

Related Tasks
A.8.9.1 Creating MDs

B.7.3.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MAs


This section describes the parameters for creating maintenance associations (MAs).

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function
Tree.

2.

In the right pane, click OAM Configuration.

3.

Click New and choose Create MA from the drop-down list.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1775

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-47 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance Domain
Name

For example: MD1

Displays the MD in which


an MA is to be created.

Maintenance
Association Name

For example: MA1

This parameter specifies


the name of the MA,
which is a service-related
domain. By creating MAs,
the connectivity check
(CC) can be performed on
the network that transmits
a particular service
instance.

Related Tasks
A.8.9.2 Creating MAs

B.7.3.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Creation of MPs


This section describes the parameters for creating a maintenance point (MP).

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-48 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maintenance
Domain Name

NULL

Specifies the maintenance domain (MD) of


the MP.
NOTE
An MD is not required for a common MP. For
the creation of a common MP, select NULL.

Maintenance
Association Name

NULL

Specifies the maintenance association (MA)


of the MP.
NOTE
An MA is not required for a common MP. For
the creation of a common MP, select NULL.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1776

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Node

Specifies the port where you want to create


an MP.

VLAN ID

l Configures the ID of the VLAN to which


the service of the MP belongs. The
information is contained in the OAM
data packet. The MPs with the same
VLAN ID in an MD can communicate
with each other.
l This parameter can be null in the case of
PORT services, but need to be set in the
case of PORT+VLAN services.

MP ID

Standard MP:
00-00-0000 to FFFF-1FFF

00-00-0000

Uniquely identifies an MP. From the highest


to the lowest, the first byte indicates the
network number, the second byte indicates
the number of the node in the local network,
and the third and forth bytes indicate the ID
of the MP on the network node. The MP ID
must be unique in the entire network.

MEP

Specifies the MP type defined in IEEE


802.1ag. An MP can be a maintenance
association end point (MEP) or a
maintenance association intermediate point
(MIP).

SDH

l Specifies the MEP direction.

Common MP:
00-00-0000 to FFFF-FF00
Type

MEP
MIP

Direction

SDH
IP

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

l Set this parameter to SDH if the OAM


data initiated by the MEP travels through
the Ethernet switching unit on the local
NE. Otherwise, set this parameter to IP.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1777

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Advanced Attributes


Table B-49 Parameters for advanced attributes
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

Consumer High(7)

Provider High(4)

Specifies the level of a common MP. The


greater the value, the higher the level.

Consumer Middle
(6)

NOTE
This parameter is valid only for a common MP
(NULL).

Consumer Low(5)
Provider High(4)
Provider Low(3)
Operator High(2)
Operator Middle(1)
Operator Low(0)
CC Status

Active

Inactive

Specifies whether to enable the connectivity


check (CC) function at an MP.

5000

l Specifies the timeout duration of an LB


test.

Inactive
LB Timeout(ms)

3000 to 60000, in
step of 100

l This parameter can be set only for an


MEP.
LT Timeout(ms)

3000 to 60000, in
step of 100

5000

l Specifies the timeout duration of an LT


test.
l This parameter can be set only for an
MEP.

CCM Sending
Period(ms)

Standard MP:

Standard MP

1000

1000

10000

Common MP:

6000

5000

600000
Common MP:
1000 to 60000, in
step of 100

Specifies the interval for sending the CCM


packet at the MP where the CC test is
performed.
l If this parameter takes a very small
value, service bandwidth decreases
significantly.
l If this parameter takes a very large value,
the CC test will become less capable in
detecting service interruptions. The
default value is recommended.
l This parameter can be set only for an
MEP.

Related Tasks
A.8.9.3 Creating MPs

B.7.3.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling LB


This section describes the parameters for enabling the LB.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1778

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function
Tree.

2.

Select the node that requires an LB test, click OAM Operation, and select Start LB.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-50 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LB Source MP ID

Specifies the ID of the


source maintenance point
in the LB test.

LB Sink MP ID

Specifies the ID of the sink


maintenance point in the
LB test.

Test Result

Indicates the result of one


LB test.

Test based on the MAC


Address

Selected

Not selected

Select this parameter for


an LB test based on MAC
addresses.

Not selected

NOTE
This parameter is valid only
for a standard MP.

LB Sink MP MAC
Address

Specifies the MAC


address of the sink
maintenance point in the
LB test. This parameter is
valid only in the case of
Test based on the MAC
Address.

Related Tasks
A.8.9.5 Performing an LB Test

B.7.3.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM_Enabling LT


This topic describes the parameters for enabling the LT.

Navigation Path
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Service OAM from the Function
Tree.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1779

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

B Parameters Description

Select the node that requires an LT test, click OAM Operation, and select Start LT.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-51 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LT Source MP ID

Specifies the source MP in


the LT test.

LT Sink MP ID

Specifies the sink MP in


the LT test.

Responding MP ID

Displays the MP that


responds to the test.

Responding MP Type

Displays the type of the


MP that responds to the
test.

Hop Count

Displays the count of hops


between the source MP
and the responding MP.
That is, the number of
responding MPs from the
source MP to a certain
responding MP in an LT
test.

Test Result

Indicates the result of one


LT test.

Related Tasks
A.8.9.6 Performing an LT Test

B.7.3.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_OAM Parameter


This section describes the OAM parameters that are related to Ethernet ports.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Parameter tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1780

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-52 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PORT

Displays the name of the


external Ethernet port.

Enable OAM Protocol

Enabled

Disabled

Specifies whether the


point-to-point OAM
protocol is enabled.

Disabled

After the OAM protocol is


enabled, the current
Ethernet port starts to use
the preset mode to set up
an OAM connection with
the opposite end.
OAM Working Mode

Active

Active

Passive

The negotiation mode of


Ethernet port OAM
includes active and
passive modes.
If this parameter is set to
Active, the port can
initiate an OAM
connection. If this
parameter is set to
Passive, the port can only
respond to the OAM
connection requests from
the opposite end.

Remote Alarm Support


for Link Event

Enabled

Max OAM Packet


Length(byte)

Enabled

Specifies whether the


detected link event is
notified to the opposite
end (for example, error
frame periods, error
frames, and error frame
seconds).

Displays the maximum


length of the OAM
packets.

Disabled

This parameter takes the


same value as the
Maximum Frame
Length of the external
port.
Loopback Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Displays the loopback


status.

1781

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.8.10.1 Enabling the OAM Auto-Discovery Function

B.7.3.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_OAM Error Frame Monitoring


This section describes the parameters for monitoring the OAM error frames at the Ethernet port.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Ethernet Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-53 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PORT

For example:
PORT1

Displays the name of the external Ethernet


port.

Error Frame
Monitor Window
(ms)

1000 to 60000, in
step of 100

1000

In the specified Error Frame Monitor


Window (ms), if the number of error frames
exceeds the specified Error Frame
Monitor Threshold (Entries) due to the
link degradation, the link event alarm is
reported.

Error Frame
Monitor Threshold
(frames)

1 to 4294967295, in
step of 1

Specifies the threshold of monitoring error


frames.

Error Frame
Period Window
(frames)

1488 to 89280000,
in step of 1

GE port: 1488000

Within the specified value of Error Frame


Period Window (frames), if the number of
error frames on the link exceeds the preset
value of Error Frame Period Threshold
(frames), an alarm is reported.

Error Frame
Period Threshold
(frames)

1 to 89280000, in
step of 1

Specifies the threshold of monitoring the


error frame period.

Error Frame
Second Window(s)

10 to 900, in step of
1

60

If any error frame occurs in one second, this


second is called an error frame second.

FE port: 148800

Within the specified value of Error Frame


Second Window(s), if the number of error
frames on the link exceeds the preset value
of Error Frame Second Threshold (s), an
alarm is reported.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1782

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Error Frame
Second Threshold
(s)

1 to 900, in step of 1

Specifies the threshold of monitoring error


frame seconds.

Related Tasks
A.8.10.3 Modifying the OAM Error Frame Monitoring Threshold

B.7.3.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM_Remote OAM Parameter


This section describes the parameters for monitoring the OAM errored frames at the Ethernet
port.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board and choose Configuration > Ethernet
Maintenance > Ethernet Port OAM from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Remote OAM parameter tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-54 Parameters on the main interface
Field

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the


remote Ethernet port.

Remote OAM Working


Mode

Displays the working


mode of the remote
Ethernet port.

Remote Alarm Support


for Link Event

Displays whether the


remote Ethernet port can
notify link events to the
local port.

Remote Side Loopback


Response

Displays how the remote


Ethernet port responds to a
loopback.

Unidirectional
Operation

Displays whether the


remote Ethernet port
supports unidirectional
operations.

Max.OAM Packet
Length (byte)

Displays the maximum


OAM packet size
supported by the remote
Ethernet port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1783

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.8.10.2 Enabling the Link Event Notification

B.7.4 QoS Parameters


This section describes the parameters for the QoS on the EoS/EoPDH plane.

B.7.4.1 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of Flows


This parameter describes the parameters for creating flows.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Flow Configuration tab.

3.

Click New.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1784

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-55 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Flow Type

Port Flow

Port Flow

l Port flow: The packets from a certain


port are classified as a type of flow. The
Ethernet service associated with this
flow type is the line service or Layer 2
switching service that uses this port as
the service source.

Port+VLAN Flow
Port+SVLAN Flow
Port+CVLAN
+SVLAN Flow
Port+VLAN
+Priority Flow

l Port+VLAN flow: The packets that are


from a certain port and have a specified
VLAN ID are classified as a type of flow.
The associated Ethernet service of this
flow type is the EVPL service (based on
VLAN) or EVPLAN service (based on
the 802.1q bridge) that uses this PORT
+VLAN as the service source.
l Port+SVLAN flow: The packets that are
from a certain port and have a specified
SVLAN ID are classified as a type of
flow. The associated Ethernet service of
this flow type is the EVPL service (based
on QinQ) or EVPLAN service (based on
the 802.1ad bridge) that uses this PORT
+SVLAN as the service source.
l Port+CVLAN+SVLAN flow: The
packets that are received from or
transmitted to a certain port and have a
specified CVLAN+SVLAN are
classified as a type of flow. The
associated Ethernet service of this flow
type is the EVPL service (based on
QinQ) or EVPLAN service (based on the
802.1ad bridge) that uses this PORT
+CVLAN+SVLAN as the service
source.
l Port+VLAN+Priority flow: The packets
that are from a certain port and have a
specified VLAN ID and a specified
VLAN priority are classified as a type of
flow. The associated Ethernet service of
this flow type is the line service that uses
this Port+VLAN+Priority as the service
source.
NOTE
An EMS6 board does not support Port+VLAN
+Priority Flow.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1785

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

EFP8: PORT1 to
PORT9,
VCTRUNK1 to
VCTRUNK16

PORT1

l When the associated service is the line


service, set this parameter to the source
port or sink port of the associated
Ethernet service.

EMS6: PORT1 to
PORT7,
VCTRUNK1 to
VCTRUNK8
1 to 4095

VLAN ID

l When the associated service is the Layer


2 switching service, set this parameter to
a mounted port of the bridge.
1

l This parameter is valid only when Flow


Type is set to Port+VLAN Flow or Port
+VLAN+Priority Flow.
l Set this parameter to the source VLAN
of the associated Ethernet service.

C-VLAN

1 to 4095

l This parameter is valid only when Flow


Type is set to Port+CVLAN+SVLAN
Flow.
l Set this parameter to the source CVLAN of the associated Ethernet
service.

1 to 4095

S-VLAN

l This parameter is valid only when Flow


Type is set to Port+SVLAN Flow or
Port+SVLAN+CVLAN Flow.
l Set this parameter to the source S-VLAN
of the associated Ethernet service.

Priority

l This parameter is valid only when Flow


Type is PORT+VLAN+Priority Flow.
l This parameter indicates the VLAN
priority of the flow-associated Ethernet
services.
NOTE
An EMS6 board does not support Priority.

Related Tasks
A.8.8.1 Creating a Flow

B.7.4.2 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CAR


This section describes the parameters for creating CAR.

Navigation Path
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and then choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1786

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

2.

Click the CAR Configuration.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-56 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CAR ID

EFP8: 1 to 512

This parameter identifies a CAR operation,


and is used to bind a flow to an associated
CAR operation.

Disabled

Indicates whether to enable the CAR


operation performed on the flow bound to
the CAR.

l Indicates the CIR. When the rate of a


packet is not more than the CIR, this
packet passes the restriction of the CAR
and is forwarded first even in the case of
network congestion.

EMS6: 1 to 1024
Enabled/Disabled

Enabled
Disabled

Committed
information Rate
(kbit/s)

EFP8: 0 to 100032,
in steps of 64
EMS6 (FE ports): 0
to 102400, in steps
of 64

l The value of this parameter should not


be more than the PIR.

EMS6 (GE ports): 0


to 1024000, in steps
of 64
Committed Burst
Size (kbyte)

EFP8: 0 to 1024

Peak information
Rate (kbit/s)

EFP8: 0 to 100032,
in steps of 64

Indicates the CBS. When the rate of a packet


that passes the restriction of the CAR is not
more than the CIR in a certain period, some
packets can burst. These packets can be
forwarded first even in the case of network
congestion. The maximum traffic of the
burst packets is determined by the CBS.
Note that the CBS has an inherent size, and
this parameter indicates the increment value
only. The inherent size of the CBS is
determined by the CIR. The greater the CIR,
the greater the CBS.

l Indicates the PIR. When the rate of a


packet is more than the PIR, the packet
that exceeds the rate restriction is
directly discarded. When the rate of
packets is more than the CIR but is lower
than or equal to the PIR, these packets
whose rate exceeds the CIR can pass the
restriction of the CAR and are marked
yellow.

EMS6: 0 to 16384

EMS6 (FE ports): 0


to 102400, in steps
of 64
EMS6 (GE ports): 0
to 1024000, in steps
of 64

l The value of this parameter should not


be more than the port bandwidth.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1787

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maximum Burst
Size (kbyte)

EFP8: 0 to 1024

Indicates the MBS. When the rate of the


packet that passes the restriction of the CAR
is more than the CIR but is not more than
the PIR, some packets can burst and are
marked yellow. The maximum traffic of the
burst packets is determined by the MBS.
Note that the MBS has an inherent size, and
this parameter indicates the increment value
only. The inherent size of the MBS is
determined by the PIR. The greater the PIR,
the greater the MBS.

EMS6: 0 to 16384

Related Tasks
A.8.8.2 Creating the CAR

B.7.4.3 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CoS


This section describes the parameters for creating CoS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the CoS Configuration tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-57 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS ID

EFP8: 1-64

This parameter identifies a CoS operation,


and is used to bind a flow to an associated
CoS operation.

EMS6: 1-65535

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1788

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS Type

simple

simple

l If the CoS type of a flow is set to simple,


all the packets in this flow are directly
scheduled to a specified egress queue.

VLAN Priority
IPTOS

l If the CoS type of a flow is set to VLAN


priority, the packets in this flow are
scheduled to specified egress queues
according to the user priorities specified
in the VLAN tags of these packets.

DSCP

l If the CoS type of a flow is set to DSCP,


the packets in this flow are scheduled to
specified egress queues according to
differentiated services code point
(DSCP) in the IPv6 tags of these packets.
l If the CoS type of a flow is set to IP TOS,
the packets in this flow are scheduled to
specified egress queues according to the
TOS values carried in the IPv4 packets.
This CoS type is applicable to IPv4
packets.
CoS parameter

Displays the CoS parameters corresponding


to different CoS types.

CoS Priority

0-7

This parameter determines to which egress


queue a packet is schedule.
l Each Ethernet port on the EFP8/EMS6
board supports eight egress port queues.
Queues 1-8 respectively correspond to
the CoS priorities from 0 to 7.
l Queue 8, with the CoS priority of 7, is as
SP queue. Queues 1-7, with the CoS
priorities from 0 to 6, are WRR queues.
The weighted proportion of these WRR
queues is 1:2:4:8:16:32:64 (from
priority 0 to priority 6). On the EFP8
board, the weighted proportion of these
WRR queues cannot be changed. On the
EMS6 board, the weighted proportion of
these WRR queues can be changed.
l If the traffic shaping feature of some
queues is enabled, bandwidth is
allocated first to the queues whose traffic
shaping feature is enabled based on the
CIR. The remaining bandwidth is
allocated to the eight queues by using the
SP+WRR algorithm.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1789

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.8.8.3 Creating the CoS

B.7.4.4 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Creation of CAR/CoS


This section describes the parameters for creating CAR/CoS.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board, and then choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Flow Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Flow Configuration tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-58 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Flow Type

Displays the type of a flow.

VB ID

Displays the ID of the bridge.

Port

Displays the port where a flow is to be


created.

C-VLAN

l Displays the C-VLAN.


l This parameter is valid is Flow Type is
Port+VLAN Flow, Port+CVLAN
+SVLAN Flow, or Port+VLAN
+Priority Flow.

S-VLAN

l Displays the S-VLAN.


l This parameter is valid when Flow
Type is Port+SVLAN Flow or Port
+CVLAN+SVLAN Flow.

Priority

l Displays the priority of the flow.


l This parameter is valid when Flow
Type is Port+VLAN+Priority Flow.

Bound CAR

None

This parameter indicates the CAR ID


corresponding to a CAR operation.
Different CAR IDs should be bound to
different flows, even though the parameters
of the CAR operations are the same.

Bound CoS

None

Indicates the CoS ID that corresponds to a


CoS operation.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1790

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.8.8.4 Binding the CAR/CoS

B.7.4.5 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Shaping Management of Egress


Queues
This section describes the parameters for shaping management of egress queues.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the required Ethernet switching board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > QoS Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.
Click the Port Queue Information tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-59 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

Port Queue

Displays the queue name.

Status

Enabled

Disabled

Indicates whether to enable the traffic


shaping feature of an egress queue.

l When the rate of a packet is not more


than the CIR, this packet directly enters
the egress queue.

Disabled
CIR (kbit/s)

EFP8: 0 to 100032,
in steps of 64
EMS6 (FE ports): 0
to 102400, in steps
of 64

l The value of this parameter should not


be more than the PIR.

EMS6 (GE ports): 0


to 1024000, in steps
of 64
DCBS (kbyte)

Displays the excess burst size.

PIR (kbit/s)

EFP8: 0 to 100032,
in steps of 64

l When the rate of a packet is more than


the PIR, the packet that exceeds the rate
restriction is directly discarded. When
the rate of packets is more than the CIR
but not more than the PIR, the packets
that exceed the restriction of the CIR
enter the buffer of the CIR. When the
buffer overflows, the packets are marked
yellow and enter the egress queue, which
enables the packets to be discarded first
in the case of queue congestion.

EMS6 (FE ports): 0


to 102400, in steps
of 64
EMS6 (GE ports): 0
to 1024000, in steps
of 64

l The value of this parameter should not


be more than the port bandwidth.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1791

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

DMBS (kbyte)

Displays the maximum excess burst size.

Scheduling Mode

SP

Queue 1: WRR

WRR

Queue 2: WRR

By default, queue 8 (with the CoS priority


of 7) of the EMS6 board is the SP queue, and
queues 1-7 (with the respective CoS priority
of 0-6) are the WRR queues and their
weights are in the proportion of
1:2:8:16:32:64.

Queue 3: WRR
Queue 4: WRR
Queue 5: WRR
Queue 6: WRR
Queue 7: WRR
Queue 8: SP

The scheduling principles of the SP+WRR


are as follows:
l A port immediately transmits the packets
in the SP queue and can transmit the
packets in the WRR queue only when no
packets exist in the SP queue.
l If multiple SP queues exist on a port, the
port compares the SP queues according
to their priorities (queue 8 has the highest
priority and queue 1 has the lowest
priority).
l According to the fixed weight value, you
can allocate the time slice to each WRR
queue. Then, the port transmits the
packets in the corresponding WRR
queue in each time slice. If a WRR queue
in a time slice does not contain any
packets, the WRR queue removes this
time slice and then transmits the packets
in the corresponding WRR queue in the
next time slice.

Weight

An integer ranging
from 1 to 64

Queue 1: 1
Queue 2: 2
Queue 3: 4
Queue 4: 8

By default, queue 8 (with the CoS priority


of 7) of the EMS6 board is the SP queue, and
queues 1-7 (with the respective CoS priority
of 0-6) are the WRR queues and their
weights are 1:2:4:8:16:32:64.

Queue 5: 16
Queue 6: 32
Queue 7: 64
Queue 8: -

Related Tasks
A.8.8.5 Configuring Traffic Shaping for Egress Queues

B.7.4.6 Parameter Description: QoS Management_Port Shaping


This section describes the parameters associated with egress port shaping management.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1792

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
QoS Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.
Click the Port Shaping tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-60 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port name.

Status

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter specifies whether to enable


the traffic shaping at a port.

In the case of an EMS6 board, the PIR of a


port meets the following constraints:

Disabled
PIR (kbit/s)

EMS6 (FE ports): 0


to 102400, in steps
of 64

l The PIR of the port is equal to or more


than the PIR of any queue at this port.

EMS6 (GE ports): 0


to 1024000, in steps
of 64

l The PIR of the port is equal to or more


than the sum of the CIRs of all the queues
at this port.

B.7.5 Parameters for the Ports on Ethernet Boards


This section describes the parameters for the Ethernet ports on the EoS/EoPDH plane.

B.7.5.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_External Port


This section describes the parameters for Ethernet external ports.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board and then choose Configuration >
Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Select External Port.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-61 Parameters for the basic attributes
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the external port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1793

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Name

Displays or specifies the name of the


external port.

Enabled/Disabled

Enabled

Disabled

l If the port gains access to services, set


this parameter to Enabled. Otherwise,
set this parameter to Disabled.

Disabled

l If this parameter is set to Enabled for the


port that does not access services, an
ETH_LOS alarm may be generated.
This parameter is invalid for PORT9 on an
EFP8 board.
This parameter is invalid for PORT7 on an
EMS6 board.
Working Mode

Auto-Negotiation

EFP8:
l AutoNegotiation
l 10M HalfDuplex
l 10M FullDuplex
l 100M HalfDuplex
l 100M FullDuplex
EMS6:
l AutoNegotiation
l 10M HalfDuplex
l 10M FullDuplex

l Different types of Ethernet ports support


different working modes.
l If the opposite port works in autonegotiation mode, set this parameter to
Auto-Negotiation.
l If the opposite port works in full-duplex
mode, set this parameter to 10M FullDuplex or 100M Full-Duplex,
depending on the rate of the opposite
port.
l If the opposite port works in half-duplex
mode, set this parameter to 10M HalfDuplex or 100M Half-Duplex,
depending on the rate of the opposite
port, or set this parameter to AutoNegotiation.
l GE optical ports on an EMS6 board
support only Auto-Negotiation and
1000M Full-Duplex modes.

l 100M HalfDuplex

NOTE
This parameter is invalid for PORT9 on an EFP8
board.

l 100M FullDuplex

This parameter is invalid for PORT7 on an EMS6


board.

l 1000M FullDuplex

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1794

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maximum Frame
Length

EFP8: 1518 to 2000

1522

l Set this parameter to a value greater than


the maximum length of all the data
frames to be transmitted.

EMS6: 1518 to 9600

l The default value is recommended if the


jumbo frame is not considered and the
data frames contain only one layer of
VLAN tags or even no tags. The value of
1526 or greater is recommended if the
data frames contain two layers of tags,
such as QinQ.
Port Physical
Parameters

Displays the actual working status of a


PORT.
This parameter is invalid for PORT9 on an
EFP8 board.
This parameter is invalid for PORT7 on an
EMS6 board.

MAC Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

Loopback

l A MAC loopback is to loop back the


Ethernet frames transmitted to the
opposite port.
l Use the default value unless otherwise
specified.

PHY Loopback

Non-Loopback

Non-Loopback

Loopback

l A PHY loopback is to loop back the


Ethernet physical signals transmitted to
the opposite port.
l Use the default value unless otherwise
specified.
This parameter is invalid for PORT9 on an
EFP8 board.
This parameter is invalid for PORT7 on an
EMS6 board.

Table B-62 Parameters for flow control


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the external port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1795

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NonAutonegotiation
Flow Control
Mode

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter is valid only when


Working Mode is not set to AutoNegotiation.

Enable Symmetric
Flow Control Mode

l If this parameter is set to Enable


Symmetric Flow Control Mode, the
port can send PAUSE frames and
process the received PAUSE frames.

Send Only
Receive Only

l If this parameter is set to Send Only, the


port can send PAUSE frames in the case
of congestion but cannot process the
received PAUSE frames.
l If this parameter is set to Receive Only,
the port can process the received PAUSE
frames but cannot send PAUSE frames
in the case of congestion.
l Set this parameter to the same as the nonautonegotiation flow control mode of the
opposite port.
Autonegotiation
Flow Control
Mode

Disabled

Disabled

Enable
Dissymmetric Flow
Control
Enable Symmetric
Control
Enable Symmetric/
Dissymmetric Flow
Control

l This parameter is valid only when


Working Mode is Auto-Negotiation.
l If this parameter is set to Enable
Symmetric Control, the port can send
PAUSE frames and process the received
PAUSE frames.
l If this parameter is set to Enable
Dissymmetric Flow Control, the port
can send PAUSE frames in the case of
congestion but cannot process the
received PAUSE frames.
l If this parameter is set to Enable
Symmetric/Dissymmetric Flow
Control, the port can function as
follows:
Sends and processes PAUSE frames.
Sends but does not process PAUSE
frames.
Processes but does not send PAUSE
frames.
l Set this parameter according to the
autonegotiation flow control mode of the
opposite port.
This parameter is invalid for PORT9 on an
EFP8 board.
This parameter is invalid for PORT7 on an
EMS6 board.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1796

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-63 Parameters for the tag attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the external port.

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l With different tag attributes, the port


processes frames in different modes. For
details, see Table B-66.

Access
Hybrid

l Set this parameter to Tag Aware if the


port processes the frames with VLAN
tags (or tagged frames).
l Set this parameter to Access if the port
processes the frames without VLAN tags
(or untagged frames).
l Set this parameter to Hybrid if the port
processes the tagged frames and
untagged frames.

Default VLAN ID

1-4095

l This parameter is valid only when


TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l For the usage of this parameter, see
Table B-66.
l Set this parameter as required.

VLAN Priority

0-7

l This parameter is valid only when


TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l For the usage of this parameter, see
Table B-66.
l When the VLAN priority is required for
traffic classification or other purposes,
set this parameter as required. Use the
default value unless otherwise specified.

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

l Indicates whether to check the incoming


packets according to the tag attribute.
l Set this parameter as required.

Table B-64 Parameters for the network attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the external port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1797

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Attributes

UNI

UNI

l If this parameter is set to UNI, the port


processes data frames according to the
tag attribute.

C-Aware
S-Aware

l If this parameter is set to C-Aware or SAware, the port processes the data
frames by using the processing method
of QinQ services.
l Set this parameter to C-Aware or SAware when the port processes QinQ
services. Otherwise, this parameter takes
the default value.

Table B-65 Parameters for the advanced attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the external port.

Broadcast Packet
Suppression

Disabled

Disabled

This parameter specifies whether to restrict


the traffic of broadcast packets according to
the proportion of the broadcast packets to
the total packets. Set this parameter to
Enabled when a broadcast storm may occur
at the opposite port.

Broadcast Packet
Suppression
Threshold

10%-100%

30%

When the proportion of the received


broadcast packets to the total packets
crosses the threshold, the port discards the
received broadcast packets. Set this
parameter to a value greater than the
proportion when no broadcast storm occurs.
The value of 30% or greater is
recommended.

Traffic Threshold
(Mbit/s)

EFP8:

Specifies the traffic threshold of the port.


You can specify the traffic monitoring
period by setting Port Traffic Threshold
Time Window(Min).

Enabled

l 0 to 100 (PORT1
to PORT8)
l 0 to 1000
(PORT9)
EMS6:
l 0 to 1000
(PORT1 and
PORT2)
l 0 to 100 (PORT3
to PORT6)
l 0 to 1000
(PORT7)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1798

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port Traffic
Threshold Time
Window(Min)

0-30

Specifies the traffic monitoring period.


l If Port Traffic Threshold Time
Window(Min) is set to 0, an associated
alarm is reported at the moment when the
traffic received at the port crosses the
value of Traffic Threshold(Mbit/s).
l If the Port Traffic Threshold Time
Window(Min) is set to a value other
than 0, an associated alarm is reported
only when the traffic received at the port
always crosses the value of Traffic
Threshold(Mbit/s) in the monitoring
period.

Loop Detection

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

This parameter specifies whether to enable


loop detection, which is used to check
whether a loop exists on the port.

Table B-66 Methods used by ports to process data frames


Direction

Ingress port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

Receives the frame.

Discards the frame.

Receives the frame.

Untagged frame

Discards the frame.

The port receives the


frame after adding to
the frame the VLAN
tag that contains
Default VLAN ID
and VLAN
Priority.

The port receives the


frame after adding to
the frame the VLAN
tag that contains
Default VLAN ID
and VLAN
Priority.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1799

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Direction

Egress port

B Parameters Description

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

Transmits the frame.

The port strips the


VLAN tag from the
frame and then
transmits the frame.

l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
Default VLAN
ID, the port
strips the VLAN
tag from the
frame and then
transmits the
frame.
l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
not Default
VLAN ID, the
port directly
transmits the
frame.

Related Tasks
A.8.5.1 Configuring External Ethernet Ports

B.7.5.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port_Internal Port


This section describes the parameters for Ethernet internal ports.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board and then choose Configuration >
Ethernet Interface Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2.

Select Internal Port.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-67 Parameters for the tag attributes
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the internal port.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1800

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TAG

Tag Aware

Tag Aware

l With different tag attributes, the port


processes frames in different modes. For
details, see Table B-72.

Access
Hybrid

l Set this parameter to Tag Aware if the


port processes the frames with VLAN
tags (or tagged frames).
l Set this parameter to Access if the port
processes the frames without VLAN tags
(or untagged frames).
l Set this parameter to Hybrid if the port
processes the tagged frames and
untagged frames.

Default VLAN ID

1-4095

l This parameter is valid only when


TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l For the usage of this parameter, see
Table B-72.
l Set this parameter as required.

VLAN Priority

0-7

l This parameter is valid only when


TAG is set to Access or Hybrid.
l For the usage of this parameter, refer to
Table B-72.
l When the VLAN priority is required for
traffic classification or other purposes,
set this parameter as required. The
default value is recommended unless
otherwise specified.

Entry Detection

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

l Indicates whether to check the incoming


packets according to the tag attribute.
l Set this parameter as required.

Table B-68 Parameters for encapsulation or mapping


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the internal port.

Mapping Protocol

GFP

GFP

The default value is recommended.

HDLC

The EFP8 board supports GFP only.

LAPS
Scramble

Scrambling Mode
[X43+1]
Unscrambled

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Scrambling Mode
[X43+1]

l Indicates the scrambling polynomial


used by the mapping protocol.
l The default value is recommended.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1801

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Set Inverse Value


for CRC

l This parameter indicates whether the


value of the CRC field defined in the
LAPS or HDLC encapsulation frame
format will be reversed. This means that
this parameter takes effect only if
Mapping Protocol is set to LAPS or
HDLC.
l Set Set Inverse Value for CRC to the
same value for the VCTRUNKs at both
ends.

Check Field
Length

FCS32

FCS32

No

l When the Ethernet board uses the GFP


mapping protocol, set this parameter to
FCS32 or No.
l When you set this parameter to FCS32,
a 32-bit FCS is used.
l The default value is recommended.

FCS Calculated Bit


Sequence

Big endian

Big endian

Little endian

l When you set this parameter to Big


endian, the least significant byte of the
FCS is placed first and the most
significant byte is placed last.
l When you set this parameter to Little
endian, the most significant byte of the
FCS is placed first and the least
significant byte is placed last.
l The default value is recommended.

Table B-69 Parameters for the network attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the internal port.

Port Attributes

UNI

UNI

l If this parameter is set to UNI, the port


processes data frames according to the
tag attribute.

C-Aware
S-Aware

l If this parameter is set to C-Aware or SAware, the port processes the data
frames by using the processing method
of QinQ services.
l Set this parameter to C-Aware or SAware when the port processes QinQ
services. Otherwise, this parameter takes
the default value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1802

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-70 Parameters for the LCAS


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the name of the internal port.

Enabling LCAS

Disabled

Disabled

l Indicates whether to enable the LCAS


function.

Enabled

l The LCAS can dynamically adjust the


number of virtual containers for
mapping required services to meet the
bandwidth needs of the applications. As
a result, the bandwidth utilization is
improved.
LCAS Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Mode

Standard Mode

l Indicates the sequence in which the


LCAS sink sends the MST control
packet and Rs-Ack control packet.
l When you set this parameter to Huawei
Mode, the LCAS sink first sends the RsAck and then sends the MST.
l When you set this parameter to
Standard Mode, the LCAS sink first
sends the MST and then sends the RsAck.
l If the equipment at the opposite end is
the third-party equipment and does not
support the Huawei mode, set this
parameter to Standard Mode.
Otherwise, set this parameter to Huawei
Mode.

Hold Off Time(ms)

An integer ranging
from 0, 2000 to
10000, in the
increments of 100

2000

l When a member link is faulty, the LCAS


performs switching after a delay of time
to prevent the situation where an NE
simultaneously performs a protection
switching such as SNCP and performs an
LCAS switching. This parameter
specifies the duration of the delay.
l The default value is recommended.

WTR Time(s)

0-720

300

l When the time after a member link is


restored to normal reaches the specified
value of this parameter, the VCG uses
the restored member link.
l The default value is recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1803

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TSD

Disabled

Disabled

l Indicates whether the TSD is used as a


condition for determining whether a
member link is faulty. In the case of the
VC-12, the TSD refers to the BIP_SD.
In the case of the VC-3, the TSD refers
to the B3_SD_VC3.

Enabled

l The default value is recommended.


Min. MembersTransmit Direction

2-256

16

l Specifies the minimum number of


members in the transmit direction. After
the LCAS is enabled, the LCAS_PLCT
alarm is reported when the number of
effective members in the transmit
direction becomes lower than the
minimum number specified by this
parameter.
l The default value is recommended.

Mini. MembersReceive Direction

2-256

16

l Specifies the minimum number of


members in the receive direction. After
the LCAS is enabled, the LCAS_PLCT
alarm is reported when the number of
effective members in the receive
direction becomes lower than the
minimum number specified by this
parameter.
l The default value is recommended.

Table B-71 Parameters for bound paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Configurable
Ports

EFP8:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK16

VCTRUNK1

Specifies the VCTRUNK to bind paths.

Displays the level of the bound VC path.

EMS6:
VCTRUNK1VCTRUNK8
Level

In the case of the EFP8 board, this parameter


always takes the value of VC12-Xv.
Service Direction

Bidirectional
Uplink
Downlink

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Bidirectional

l Specifies the direction of the bound path.


l Set this parameter to Bidirectional
unless otherwise specified.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1804

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Available
Resources

l Displays the available VC4 paths.


l In the case of the EFP8 board, this
parameter always takes the value of
VC4-1.
l For EMS6 boards, when a VCTRUNK
needs to bind VC-12 paths, select VC-12
paths only in VC-4-4s.

Available
Timeslots

Specifies the available timeslots.

Bound Path

You need to plan and set this parameter


according to the following principles:
l The capacity of the VCTRUNK is
determined by the actual bandwidth
required by the services.
l The EFP8 board supports 16
VCTRUNKs. Each VCTRUNK can
bind a maximum of 16 VC-12 paths and
the total number of bound VC-12 paths
cannot exceed 63.
l For EMS6 boards, their VCTRUNKs 1-7
each support a maximum bandwidth of
100 Mbit/s. If a bandwidth higher than
100 Mbit/s is required, VCTRUNK8 is
recommended.

Number of Bound
Paths

Displays the number of the bound VC path.

Activation Status

Displays the activation status of the bound


VC path.

Table B-72 Methods used by ports to process data frames


Direction

Ingress port

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

Receives the frame.

Discards the frame.

Receives the frame.

Untagged frame

Discards the frame.

The port receives the


frame after adding to
the frame the VLAN
tag that contains
Default VLAN ID
and VLAN
Priority.

The port receives the


frame after adding to
the frame the VLAN
tag that contains
Default VLAN ID
and VLAN
Priority.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1805

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Direction

Egress port

B Parameters Description

Type of Data
Frame

Processing Method
Tag aware

Access

Hybrid

Tagged frame

Transmits the frame.

The port strips the


VLAN tag from the
frame and then
transmits the frame.

l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
Default VLAN
ID, the port
strips the VLAN
tag from the
frame and then
transmits the
frame.
l If the VLAN ID
in the frame is
not Default
VLAN ID, the
port directly
transmits the
frame.

Related Tasks
A.8.5.2 Configuring VCTRUNKs on an Ethernet Board

B.7.5.3 Parameter Description: Type Field of QinQ Frames


This section describes the parameters for setting the type field of QinQ frames.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the EFP8/EMS6 board from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Advance Attribute > QinQ Type Area Settings from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Table B-73 Parameters on the main interface
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Board

Displays the Ethernet board on which the


type field of QinQ frames needs to be set.
If the Ethernet board is the EFP8 board, this
parameter always takes the value of EFP8.
If the Ethernet board is the EMS6 board, this
parameter always takes the value of EMS6.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1806

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

QinQ Type Area


(Hexadecimal)

81 00

8100

Specifies the type field of QinQ frames. Set


this parameter according to the type field of
the accessed QinQ frames.

88 A8
91 00
0600 to FFFF

Related Tasks
A.8.5.3 Modifying the Type Field of QinQ Frames

B.8 RMON Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON performances.

B.8.1 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_Statistics Group


This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON statistics groups.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Statistics Group tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter specifies the object to be


monitored.

Sampling Period

5 to 150

This parameter specifies the duration of the


monitoring period.

Display
Accumulated
Value

Selected

Deselected

l This parameter specifies the method of


displaying the performance events.

Deselected

l If this parameter is not selected, the


displayed value is an increment
compared to the value that is collected in
last sampling period and stored in the
register.
l If this parameter is selected, the
displayed value is an absolute value that
is currently stored in the register.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1807

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Display Mode

Graphics

List

l This parameter specifies the method of


displaying the performance events.

List

l If this parameter is set to Graphics, the


number of performance events to be
monitored at each time cannot be more
than 10, and the unit should be the same.
Color

Legend

Description

l This parameter indicates the description


of different colors.
l This parameter is valid only when
Display Mode is set to Graphics.

Event

l This parameter indicates the queried


performance events.
l This parameter is valid only when
Display Mode is set to List.

Related Tasks
A.11.1 Browsing the Performance Data in the Statistics Group of a Port

B.8.2 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Group


This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON history groups.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the History Group tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

The parameter indicates the object to be


monitored.

Ended from/to

This parameter specifies the start time and


end time of the monitoring period.

History Table
Type

30-Second

30-Second

This parameter specifies the monitoring


period.

30-Minute
Custom Period 1
Custom Period 2

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1808

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Display Mode

Graphics

List

l This parameter specifies the method of


displaying the performance events.

List

l If this parameter is set to Graphics, the


number of performance events to be
monitored at each time cannot be more
than 10, and the unit should be the same.
Color

Legend

Description

l This parameter indicates the description


of different colors.
l This parameter is valid only when
Display Mode is set to Graphics.

Event

l This parameter indicates the queried


performance events.
l This parameter is valid only when
Display Mode is set to List.

Statistical Item

This parameter indicates the performance


items to be monitored.

Statistical Value

This parameter indicates the statistical value


of the monitored performance items.

Time Flag

This parameter indicates the time point of


each performance event.

B.8.3 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Control


Group
This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON history control groups.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON History
Control Group.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

30-Second

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the 30-Second
monitoring function.

Enabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the 30-Minute
monitoring function.

Disabled
30-Minute

Enabled
Disabled

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1809

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Custom Period 1

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable Custom Period 1.

Disabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable Custom Period 2.

300 to 43200
(Custom Period 1)

900(Custom Period
1)

300 to 86400
(Custom Period 2)

86400(Custom
Period 2)

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


monitoring period in Custom Period 1
and Custom Period 2.

History Register
Count

1 to 50

16

RMON Monitor
Start Time

Disabled
Custom Period 2

Enabled
Disabled

Period Length(s)

6(Custom Period 2)
-

l The value must be an integer multiple of


30.
This parameter indicates or specifies the
quantity of the history registers.
This parameter specifies the RMON start
time.

Related Tasks
A.11.3 Configuring a Historical Control Group

B.8.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting


This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON setting.

Navigation Path
l

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose
Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

Click the RMON Setting tab.

Object Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Object

This parameter indicates the object to be


collected.

30-Second

Enabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the 30-Second
monitoring function.

Disabled

NOTE
In the case of Object, 30-Second cannot be set.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1810

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

30-Minute

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the 30-Minute
monitoring function.

Disabled

l In RMON History Control Group of


the NE, if 30-Minute is set to Disabled,
Not Supported is displayed for this
parameter.
Custom Period 1

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the monitoring
function based on Custom Period 1.
l In RMON History Control Group of
the NE, if Custom Period 1 is set to
Disabled, Not Supported is displayed
for this parameter.

Custom Period 2

Enabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the monitoring
function based on Custom Period 2.
l In RMON History Control Group of
the NE, if Custom Period 2 is set to
Disabled, Not Supported is displayed
for this parameter.

Event Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Event

This parameter indicates the performance


event to be monitored.

30-Second

Enabled

Disabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the monitoring function
based on 30-Second.

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the 30-Minute
monitoring function.

Disabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the monitoring function
based on Custom Period 1Custom Period
1 Monitor.

Disabled

This parameter indicates or specifies


whether to enable the monitoring function
based on Custom Period 2Custom Period
2 Monitor.

Disabled
30-Minute

Enabled
Disabled

Custom Period 1

Enabled
Disabled

Custom Period 2

Enabled
Disabled

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1811

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Threshold Detect

Report All

Report All

l This parameter indicates or specifies the


threshold detection method.

Do Not Detect

l If the number of detected events reaches


the preset threshold, the events are
reported to the NMS. Otherwise, the
events are not reported to the NMS.

Report Only the


Upper Threshold
Report Only the
Lower Threshold

l If an event does not support this


parameter, Not Supported is displayed.

Upper Threshold

This parameter indicates or specifies the


upper threshold. If the number of
performance events exceeds the preset
upper threshold, the corresponding
performance events are reported.

Lower Threshold

This parameter indicates or specifies the


lower threshold. If the number of
performance events is less than the preset
lower threshold, the corresponding
performance events are reported.

Threshold Unit

This parameter indicates the unit of each


threshold of the performance events.

Related Tasks
A.11.2 Configuring an Alarm Group for a Port
A.11.4 Browsing the Performance Data in the Historical Group of a Port

B.9 Parameters for MPLS/PWE3 Services


This topic describes parameters that are related to MPLS/PWE3 services.
NOTE

For parameters for PW-carried E-Line services, see B.6 Parameters for Ethernet Services and Ethernet
Features on the Packet Plane.

B.9.1 MPLS Tunnel Parameters


This topic describes parameters that are related to MPLS tunnels.

B.9.1.1 Parameter Description: Basic Configurations of MPLS Tunnels


This topic describes parameters that are related to the basic configurations of MPLS tunnels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1812

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
MPLS Management > Basic Configuration from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

LSR ID

0.0.0.0

l Specifies or displays
the LSR ID of an NE.
On a PSN, each NE is
assigned a unique LSR
ID.
l This parameter must
be set in IPv4 address
format.

Start of Global Label


Space

0-1015808

l Specifies the start


value of a global label
space. The OptiX RTN
980 supports a step of
2048.
l The start value of a
global label space is
the smallest unicast
tunnel label. When
Start of Global Label
Space is 0, the smallest
unicast tunnel label is
16, with values 0 to 15
reserved.
l On an MPLS-enabled
network, global label
spaces of NEs are
recommended to
overlap each other if
possible.

Global Label Space Size

Displays the size of a


global label space.

Start of Multicast Label


Space

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.1 Setting Basic MPLS Attributes

B.9.1.2 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Static Tunnel


This topic describes parameters that are related to static tunnels.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1813

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the Static Tunnel tab.

3.

Click Query.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID

Displays the tunnel ID.

Name

Specifies or displays the


customized tunnel name.

Enable State

Enabled

Enabled

l Specifies or displays
whether a tunnel is
enabled.

Disabled

NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only the value
Enabled.

Node Type

l Displays the node type.


l For bidirectional
tunnels, this parameter
displays the node types
of forward tunnels.

Direction

Displays the direction of a


tunnel.

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

l Specifies or displays
the committed
information rate (CIR)
of a tunnel.

1024-1024000

l Generally, it is
recommended that you
set this parameter to No
Limit. If you need to
enable the CES CAC
function or limit the
PW bandwidth, set this
parameter to be the
same as the planned
tunnel bandwidth.
PIR(kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CBS(byte)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1814

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PBS(byte)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Bandwidth Remaining
(kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

In Port

Displays the ingress port


of a forward tunnel, which
is also the egress port of
the mapping reverse
tunnel.

Forward In Label

Displays the MPLS label


that a forward tunnel
carries when entering a
node.

Reverse Out Label

Specifies the MPLS label


that a reverse tunnel
carries when entering a
tunnel.

Out Port

Displays the egress port of


a forward tunnel, which is
also the ingress port of the
mapping reverse tunnel.

Forward Out Label

Displays the MPLS label


that a forward tunnel
carries when leaving a
node.

Reverse In Label

Displays the MPLS label


that a reverse tunnel
carries when leaving a
node.

Forward Next Hop


Address

Displays the IP address of


the next-hop port of a
forward tunnel.

Reverse Next Hop


Address

Displays the IP address of


the next-hop port of a
reverse tunnel.

Source Node

Displays the LSR ID of the


ingress node.

Sink Node

Displays the LSR ID of the


egress node.

Tunnel Type

Displays the tunnel type.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1815

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

0-7

l Specifies or displays
the value of the EXP
field in the packets
transmitted through
MPLS tunnels.

None

l For unidirectional
tunnels, this parameter
is available only if
Node Type is Ingress.
l For bidirectional
tunnels, this parameter
cannot be set if Node
Type is Transit.
l If this parameter is set
to a value from 0 to 7,
the EXP field takes its
fixed value.
l If this parameter takes
its default value None,
the EXP field varies
based on the DiffServ
mappings.
LSP Mode

Pipe

l Displays or specifies
the LSP mode.
l Pipe: When stripping
MPLS tunnel labels
from packets, an egress
node does not update
the scheduling priority
for the packets.
l For bidirectional
tunnels, this parameter
is available only if
Node Type is Egress.
l For bidirectional
tunnels, this parameter
cannot be set if Node
Type is Transit.
NOTE
On the OptiX RTN 980, this
parameter can be set to
Pipe only.

MTU(byte)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

1816

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group

Displays the MPLS APS


protection group to which
a tunnel belongs.

VLAN ID

l Specifies or displays
the VLAN ID that
Ethernet packets carry
when transmitted over
MPLS tunnels.
l If packets need to
traverse a Layer 2
network, set the VLAN
ID for the tunnel
carried by the NNI port
according to the
VLAN planning
requirements on the
Layer 2 network.
l Set this parameter to
the same value for both
ends of a tunnel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1817

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS

CS7

l This parameter
specifies the PHB
service class of an LLSP, if the type of an
MPLS tunnel is L-LSP.

CS6
EF
AF4
AF3

l CS6-CS7: indicates the


highest service grade,
which is mainly
involved in signaling
transmission.

AF2
AF1
BE

l EF: indicates fast


forwarding. This
service class is
applicable to the traffic
whose delay is small
and packet loss ratio is
low, for example,
voice and video
services.
l AF1-AF4: indicates
assured forwarding.
This service class is
applicable to the traffic
that requires rate
guarantee but does not
require delay or jitter
limit.
l BE: indicates that the
traffic is forwarded in
best-effort manner
without special
processing.
Deployment

Displays the deployment


status of the tunnel.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.4 Querying MPLS Tunnel Information

B.9.1.3 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Creation of


Unidirectional Tunnels
This topic describes parameters that are used for creating unidirectional tunnels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1818

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the Static Tunnel tab.

3.

Click New and choose Unidirectional Tunnel from the drop-down list.
The New Unicast Unidirectional Tunnel dialog box is displayed.

4.

Select New Reverse Tunnel.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel ID

1-65535

l Specifies the tunnel ID.


l The total number of tunnels and PWs
must be equal to or less than 1024. The
number of tunnels that carry PWs is not
included in the total.
NOTE
If you select New Reverse Tunnel, set forward
tunnel IDs and reverse tunnel IDs respectively.

Tunnel Name

Specifies the tunnel name.

Node Type

Ingress

Ingress

Specifies the node type of a forward tunnel.

Egress
Transit
Direction

Indicates the direction of a tunnel.

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

l Specifies the committed information rate


(CIR) of a tunnel.

1024-1024000

l Generally, it is recommended that you set


this parameter to No Limit. If you need
to enable the CES CAC function or limit
the tunnel bandwidth, set this parameter
to be the same as the planned tunnel
bandwidth.
CBS(kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

PIR(Byte)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

PBS(Byte)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

Specifies the MPLS port at the ingress


direction of a forward tunnel on a transit or
egress node.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1819

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

In Port

NOTE
l If the MPLS port is an FE/GE port, ensure
that:
l The Port Mode parameter of the MPLS
port is set to Layer 3 according to A.6.6.1
Setting the General Attributes of
Ethernet Ports.
l The Enable Tunnel, Specify IP
Address, andIP Address parameters of
the MPLS port are set to the values
specified in the network plan according to
A.6.6.4 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of
Ethernet Ports.
l If the MPLS port is an IF_ETH port, ensure
that:
l The Port Mode parameter of the MPLS
port is set to Layer 3 according to A.6.7.1
Setting the General Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports.
l The Enable Tunnel, Specify IP
Address, and IP Address parameters of
the MPLS port are set to the values
specified in the network plan according to
A.6.7.3 Setting Layer 3 Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports.

In Label

16-1048575

Specifies the MPLS label at the ingress


direction of a forward tunnel on a transit or
egress node.

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

Out Port

Specifies the MPLS port at the egress


direction of a forward tunnel on an ingress or
transit node.

Out Label

16-1048575

Specifies the MPLS label at the egress


direction of a forward tunnel on an ingress or
transit node.

Next Hop Address

l The Next Hop Address parameter needs


to be set only for the egress port on an
ingress or transit node.

NOTE
The method and prerequisites for setting
parameters of the MPLS port at the egress
direction of a forward tunnel are the same as those
on the ingress direction.

l Set the IP address of the MPLS ingress


port on the next hop LSR node to Next
Hop Address according to the network
plan.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1820

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source Node

l The Source Node parameter needs to be


set only on an egress or transit node.
l Set the LSR ID for the last hop MPLS
node to Source Node according to the
network plan.

Sink Node

l The Sink Node parameter needs to be set


only on an ingress or transit node.
l Set the LSR ID for the next hop MPLS
node to Sink Node according to the
network plan.

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

L-LSP

l Specifies the tunnel type.


l The value E-LSP indicates that the EXP
field is used to identify packet scheduling
priorities of PWs. An E-LSP tunnel can
contain PWs of eight packet scheduling
priorities.
l The value L-LSP indicates that the
MPLS label value is used to identify
packet scheduling priorities of PWs. An
L-LSP tunnel can contain PWs of the
same packet scheduling priority.

EXP

0-7

None

None

l Specifies the value of the EXP field in the


packets transmitted through MPLS
tunnels.
l This parameter is available only if Node
Type is Ingress.
l If this parameter is set to a value from 0
to 7, the EXP field takes its fixed value.
l If this parameter takes its default value
None, the EXP field is set based on the
DiffServ mappings.

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

l Pipe: When stripping MPLS tunnel


labels from packets, an egress node does
not update the scheduling priority for the
packets.
l This parameter is available only if Node
Type is Egress.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 supports only the value
Pipe.

MTU

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1821

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS

CS7

BE

l This parameter specifies the PHB service


class of an L-LSP, if the type of an MPLS
tunnel is L-LSP.

CS6
EF

l CS6-CS7: indicates the highest service


grade, which is mainly involved in
signaling transmission.

AF4
AF3
AF2

l EF: indicates fast forwarding. This


service class is applicable to the traffic
whose delay is small and packet loss ratio
is low, for example, voice and video
services.

AF1
BE

l AF1-AF4: indicates assured forwarding.


This service class is applicable to the
traffic that requires rate guarantee but
does not require delay or jitter limit.
l BE: indicates that the traffic is forwarded
in best-effort manner without special
processing.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.2 Creating a Unidirectional MPLS Tunnel

B.9.1.4 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_Creation of


Bidirectional Tunnels
This topic describes the parameters that are related to creating bidirectional tunnels.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the Static Tunnel tab.

3.

Click New and choose Bidirectional Tunnel from the drop-down list.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel ID

1 to 65535

l Specifies the tunnel ID.


l The total number of tunnels and PWs
must be equal to or less than 1024.
The number of tunnels that carry
PWs is not included in the total.

Tunnel Name
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Specifies the tunnel name.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1822

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Node Type

Ingress

Ingress

Specifies the node type of a forward


tunnel.

Egress
Transit
Direction

Indicates the direction of a tunnel.

CIR(kbit/s)

No Limit

No Limit

l Specifies the committed information


rate (CIR) of a tunnel.

1024-1024000

l Generally, it is recommended that


you set this parameter to No Limit.
If you need to enable the CES CAC
function or limit the PW bandwidth,
set this parameter to be the same as
the planned tunnel bandwidth.
CBS(kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support


this parameter.

PIR(Byte)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support


this parameter.

PBS(Byte)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support


this parameter.

In Board/Logic
Interface Type

Specifies the MPLS port at the ingress


direction of a forward tunnel on a transit
or egress node.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1823

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

In Port

NOTE
l If the MPLS port is an FE/GE port,
ensure that:
l The Port Mode parameter of the
MPLS port is set to Layer 3
according to A.6.6.1 Setting the
General Attributes of Ethernet
Ports.
l The Enable Tunnel, Specify IP
Address, and IP Address
parameters of the MPLS port are set
to the values specified in the
network plan according to A.6.6.4
Setting Layer 3 Attributes of
Ethernet Ports.
l If the MPLS port is an IF_ETH port,
ensure that:
l The Port Mode parameter of the
MPLS port is set to Layer 3
according to A.6.7.1 Setting the
General Attributes of IF_ETH
Ports.
l The Enable Tunnel, Specify IP
Address, and IP Address
parameters of the MPLS port are set
to the values specified in the
network plan according to A.6.7.3
Setting Layer 3 Attributes of
IF_ETH Ports.

Forward In Label

16 to 1048575

Specifies the MPLS label at the ingress


direction of a forward tunnel on a transit
or egress node.

Reverse Out Label

16 to 1048575

l Specifies the MPLS label at the


egress direction of a reverse tunnel
on a transit or egress node.
l Reverse Out Label and Forward
In Label can be set to either the same
value or different values.

Out Board/Logic
Interface Type

Out Port

Forward Out Label

16 to 1048575

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Specifies the MPLS port at the egress


direction of a forward tunnel on an
ingress or transit node.
NOTE
The method and prerequisites for setting
parameters of the MPLS port at the egress
direction of a forward tunnel are the same as
those on the ingress direction.

Specifies the MPLS label at the egress


direction of a forward tunnel on an
ingress or transit node.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1824

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Reverse In Label

16 to 1048575

l Specifies the MPLS label at the


ingress direction of a reverse tunnel
on an ingress or transit node.
l The Reverse In Label and Forward
Out Label parameters can be set to
either the same value or different
values.

Forward Next Hop


Address

l The Forward Next Hop Address


parameter needs to be set only for the
egress port on an ingress or transit
node.
l Set the IP address of the MPLS
ingress port on the next hop LSR
node to Forward Next Hop
Address according to the network
plan.

Reverse Next Hop


Address

l The Reverse Next Hop Address


parameter needs to be set only for the
ingress port on a transit or egress
node.
l Set the IP address of the MPLS
ingress port on the next hop LSR
node to Reverse Next Hop
Address according to the network
plan.

Source Node

l The Source Node parameter needs


to be set only on an egress or transit
node.
l Set the LSR ID for the last hop
MPLS node to Source Node
according to the network plan.

Sink Node

l The Sink Node parameter needs to


be set only on an ingress or transit
node.
l Set the LSR ID for the next hop
MPLS node to Sink Node according
to the network plan.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1825

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel Type

E-LSP

E-LSP

l Specifies the tunnel type.

L-LSP

l The value E-LSP indicates that the


EXP field is used to identify packet
scheduling priorities of PWs. An ELSP tunnel can contain PWs of eight
packet scheduling priorities.
l The value L-LSP indicates that the
MPLS label value is used to identify
packet scheduling priorities of PWs.
An L-LSP tunnel can contain PWs of
the same packet scheduling priority.

EXP

0 to 7

None

None

l Specifies the value of the EXP field


in the packets transmitted through
MPLS tunnels.
l This parameter cannot be set if Node
Type is Transit.
l If this parameter is set to a value
from 0 to 7, the EXP field takes its
fixed value.
l If this parameter takes its default
value None, the EXP field is set
based on the DiffServ mappings.

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

l Pipe: When stripping MPLS tunnel


labels from packets, an egress node
does not update the scheduling
priority for the packets.
l This parameter cannot be set if Node
Type is Transit.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 supports only the value
Pipe.

MTU

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support


this parameter.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1826

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS

CS7

BE

l This parameter specifies the PHB


service class of an L-LSP, if the type
of an MPLS tunnel is L-LSP.

CS6
EF

l CS6-CS7: indicates the highest


service grade, which is mainly
involved in signaling transmission.

AF4
AF3
AF2

l EF: indicates fast forwarding. This


service class is applicable to the
traffic whose delay is small and
packet loss ratio is low, for example,
voice and video services.

AF1
BE

l AF1-AF4: indicates assured


forwarding. This service class is
applicable to the traffic that requires
rate guarantee but does not require
delay or jitter limit.
l BE: indicates that the traffic is
forwarded in best-effort manner
without special processing.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.3 Creating a Bidirectional MPLS Tunnel

B.9.1.5 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_OAM Parameters


This topic describes parameters that are related to MPLS OAM.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Parameter tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel ID

Displays the tunnel ID.

Tunnel Name

Displays the tunnel name.

Node Type

l Displays the node type.


l For bidirectional
tunnels, this parameter
displays the node types
of forward tunnels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1827

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel Direction

Displays the direction of a


tunnel.

OAM Status

Enabled

Disabled

l Specifies or displays
whether the local node
can perform and
respond to OAM
operations.

Disabled

l If OAM Status is
Enabled, the local NE
can perform and
respond to OAM
operations.
l If OAM Status is
Disabled, the local NE
cannot perform and
respond to OAM
operations.
l If MPLS APS
protection needs to be
configured or a CC test
needs to be performed
for the tunnel, OAM
Status needs to be set
to Enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1828

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

l Specifies or displays
the MPLS OAM
detection mode.

Manual

l Manual: During a CC
test, MPLS OAM
packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l Auto-Sensing: During
a CC test, MPLS OAM
packets are sent at the
interval for receiving
MPLS OAM packets.
l For a unidirectional
tunnel, this parameter
can be set for its egress
node only.
l For a bidirectional
tunnel, if Detection
Mode is set to
Manual, you need to
set the MPLS OAM
detection packets to be
received and
transmitted.
l Generally, the value
Auto-Sensing is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1829

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l CV: The detection


packets are sent at a
fixed interval.

FFD

l FFD: The detection


packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l For the egress node of
a unidirectional tunnel,
if Detection Mode is
set to Manual, this
parameter specifies the
type of MPLS OAM
detection packets to be
received.
l For a bidirectional
tunnel, if Detection
Mode is set to AutoSensing, this
parameter specifies the
type of MPLS OAM
detection packets to be
transmitted.
l For a bidirectional
tunnel, if Detection
Mode is set to
Manual, this
parameter specifies the
types of MPLS OAM
detection packets to be
received and
transmitted.
l The value FFD is
assumed for MPLS
APS and the value
CV is assumed for
continuous
connectivity check on
MPLS tunnels.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1830

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Period


(ms)

3.3

50

l Displays or specifies
the OAM detection
period.

10
20

l This parameter is
available only when
Detection Packet
Type is FFD. It takes
its fixed value of 1000
ms when Detection
Packet Type is CV.

50
100
200
500

l Set this parameter to


3.3 for MPLS APS
usually. If the packet
transmission delay
time of an MPLS
tunnel exceeds 3.3 ms,
the transmission
interval of FFD
packets needs to be a
value greater than the
delay time.
Reverse Tunnel

l Specifies the mapping


reverse tunnel of a
forward tunnel.
l For a bidirectional
tunnel, this parameter
cannot be set.

CV/FFD Status

Displays whether CV/


FFD is enabled.

LSP Status

Displays whether an LSP


is available.

LSP Defect Type

Displays the LSP defect


type.

Disable LSP Duration


(ms)

Displays the duration


when an LSP is
unavailable.

LSP Defect Location

Displays the LSR ID of a


node where LSP defects
are detected.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1831

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SD Threshold

0-100

l Specifies or displays
the SD threshold.
When the OAM packet
loss ratio is higher than
the parameter value,
the corresponding
alarm is reported.
l For a unidirectional
tunnel, this parameter
can be set for its egress
node only.
l When this parameter is
set to 0, SD threshold
detection is not
supported.

0-100

SF Threshold

l Specifies or displays
the SF threshold.
When the OAM packet
loss ratio is higher than
the parameter value,
the corresponding
alarm is reported.
l For a unidirectional
tunnel, this parameter
can be set for its egress
node only.
l When this parameter is
set to 0, SF threshold
detection is not
supported.
l The SD threshold is not
higher than the SF
threshold.

Source Node

Displays the source node


of a tunnel.

Sink Node

Displays the sink node of


a tunnel.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.7 Setting MPLS OAM Parameters

B.9.1.6 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_FDI


This topic describes FDI parameters.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1832

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the FDI tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enable FDI

Selected

Selected

l Specifies or displays
whether Enable FDI is
selected.

Not selected

l If the FDI function is


enabled for a transit
node, the transit node
inserts an FDI packet
to all LSPs that travel
through the transit
node when a fault
occurs on the link
between the ingress
and transit nodes. On
reception of the FDI
packet, the egress node
reports an alarm. In
this case, if MPLS APS
is configured
correctly, protection
switching is triggered
before the egress node
detects an LSP defect
within a detection
period.
l Generally, the default
parameter value is
recommended.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.8 Enabling/Disabling FDI

B.9.1.7 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_LSP Ping


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the LSP Ping test.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1833

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Parameters tab.

3.

Select the required tunnel, click OAM Operation in the lower right corner, and choose
Ping Test from the drop-down list.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Count

1 to 4294967295

Specifies the number of


test request packets.

EXP Value

0 to 7

l Specifies the EXP


value of the MPLS
label in test request
packets. The value 7
indicates the highest
priority.
l The default value is
recommended.

TTL

1 to 255

255

l Specifies the time-tolive (TTL) value of the


MPLS label in test
request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Transmit Interval
(10ms)

1 to 1000

100

l Specifies the interval


for transmitting test
request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Packet Length

64 to 1400

64

l Specifies the length of


test request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Wait-to-Response
Timeout Time(10ms)

1 to 6000

300

l Specifies the wait-toresponse timeout


value.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1834

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Response Mode

IPv4 UDP Response

IPv4 UDP Response

l Specifies the response


mode of test request
packets.

No Response
Application Control
Channel

l The value No
Response indicates
that the test
performance event is
reported without
sending response
packets.
l The value Application
Control Channel
indicates that response
is performed through
the reverse channel.
l The value IPv4 UDP
Response indicates
that the IPv4 UDP
packets encapsulating
MPLS echo reply
messages are sent as
response packets.
l The value IPv4 UDP
Response is reserved
for scenarios where all
nodes on an LSP
communicate with
each other over a DCN
running IP protocols.
l Set this parameter
based on the situation
of the egress node. If
the egress node
supports reverse
channel response, set
this parameter to
Application Control
Channel. If the egress
node does not support
reverse channel
response but supports
DCN channel response
by means of IP
protocols, set this
parameter to IPv4
UDP Response.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1835

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
NOTE
For a unidirectional
tunnel, Response
Mode cannot be set to
Application Control
Channel.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.12 Performing an LSP Ping Test

B.9.1.8 Parameter Description: Unicast Tunnel Management_LSP Traceroute


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the LSP Traceroute test.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > Unicast Tunnel Management from the Function
Tree.

2.

Click the OAM Parameters tab.

3.

Select the required tunnel, click OAM Operation in the lower right corner, and choose
Traceroute Test from the drop-down list.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP Value

0 to 7

l Specifies the EXP


value of the MPLS
label in test request
packets. The value 7
indicates the highest
priority.
l The default value is
recommended.

TTL

1 to 255

255

l Specifies the time-tolive (TTL) value of the


MPLS label in test
request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Packet Length

84 to 1400

84

l Specifies the length of


test request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1836

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Wait-to-Response
Timeout Time(10ms)

1 to 6000

300

l Specifies the wait-toresponse timeout


value.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1837

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Response Mode

IPv4 UDP Response

IPv4 UDP Response

l Specifies the response


mode of test request
packets.

No Response
Application Control
Channel

l The value No
Response indicates
that the test
performance event is
reported without
sending response
packets.
l The value Application
Control Channel
indicates that response
is performed through
the reverse channel.
l The value IPv4 UDP
Response indicates
that the IPv4 UDP
packets encapsulating
MPLS echo reply
messages are sent as
response packets.
l The value IPv4 UDP
Response is reserved
for scenarios where all
nodes on an LSP
communicate with
each other over a DCN
running IP protocols.
l Set this parameter
based on the situation
of the egress node. If
the egress node
supports reverse
channel response, set
this parameter to
Application Control
Channel. If the egress
node does not support
reverse channel
response but supports
DCN channel response
by means of IP
protocols, set this
parameter to IPv4
UDP Response.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1838

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

B Parameters Description

Value Range

Default Value

Description
NOTE
For a unidirectional
tunnel, Response
Mode cannot be set to
Application Control
Channel.

Related Tasks
A.9.2.13 Performing an LSP Traceroute Test

B.9.1.9 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Management


This topic describes parameters that are related to PW management.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the PW Management tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW that carries a


service.

Enable State

Displays whether a PW is enabled.

PW Signaling
Type

Displays the PW signaling type.

PW Type

NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 uses only static PWs.

l Displays the PW type. Different PW types


perform different service processing
modes.
l When a PW transmits E-Line services, set
PW Type to Ethernet or Ethernet
Tagged Mode.
l If a PW transmits CES services, set PW
Type to CESoPSN or SATop.
l If a PW transmits ATM services, set PW
Type to ATM n-to-one VCC Cell
transport, ATM one-to-one VCC Cell
Mode, ATM n-to-one VPC Cell
transport, or ATM one-to-one VPC Cell
Mode.

Direction

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Displays the direction of a PW.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1839

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Ingress
Label/Source
Port

Displays the ingress label at the source port of


a PW.

PW
Encapsulation
Type

Displays the encapsulation type of the packets


on a PW.

PW Egress
Label/Sink
Port

Displays the egress label at the sink port of a


PW.

Opposite LSR
ID

Displays the LSR ID of the node at the other


end of a PW.

Local
Working
Status

Displays the working status of the PW at the


local end.

Remote
Working
Status

Displays the working status of the PW at the


remote end.

Compositive
Working
Status

Displays the working status of the entire PW.

Tunnel Type

Displays the type of the tunnel that carries a


PW.

NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 supports only MPLS
encapsulation.

NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 supports only MPLS tunnels.

Tunnel

Displays the ID of the tunnel that carries a PW.

Deployment
Status

Displays the deployment status of a PW.

Tunnel
Automatic
Selection
Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1840

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

QoS Parameters
Table B-74 CES services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the service.

Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW that carries the
service.

CIR(kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the service.

Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW that carries the
service.

Bandwidth Limit

Displays whether the


bandwidth is limited.

CIR(kbit/s)

Displays the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.

CBS(byte)

Displays the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(kbit/s)

Displays the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW

PBS(byte)

Displays the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

LSP Mode

Displays the LSP mode.

Table B-75 E-Line services

NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only Pipe.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1841

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the service.

Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW that carries the
service.

Bandwidth Limit

Displays whether the


bandwidth is limited.

CIR(kbit/s)

Displays the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.

CBS(byte)

Displays the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(kbit/s)

Displays the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW

PBS(byte)

Displays the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Table B-76 ATM services

Parameters for Advanced Attributes


Table B-77 CES services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

RTP Head

Displays whether the CES


service packets carry an
RTP header.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1842

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us)

Displays the jitter buffer


time for the received CES
packets.

Ingress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Egress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Enable CES Service


Alarm Transparent
Transmission

Displays whether CES


service alarms are
transparently transmitted.

Threshold of Entering R
bit Inserting Status

Displays the threshold of


the packet loss ratio of
CES services. The
corresponding alarm will
be reported if the actual
packet loss ratio crosses
this threshold.

Threshold of Exiting R
bit Inserting Status

Displays the threshold of


received CES service
packets. The
corresponding alarm will
be cleared after the actual
number of received CES
service packets crosses
this threshold.

Sequence Number Mode

Displays the sequence


number mode.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

Table B-78 E-Line services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1843

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Displays whether the


control word is used to
transfer packet
information. For ETH
PWE3 services, this
parameter is always not
used.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Request VLAN

When PW Type is
Ethernet Tag, this
parameter displays the
VLAN ID to be added to
packets that are sent from
the opposite end and do
not carry any VLAN IDs.

TPID

When PW Type is
Ethernet Tag, this
parameter displays the
TPID.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

Control Word

Displays whether the


control word is used to
transfer packet
information.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Max Concatenated Cell


Count

Displays the maximum


number of concatenated
cells.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Table B-79 ATM services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1844

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.9.4.1 Querying Information and Running Status of PWs

B.9.1.10 Parameter Description: PW Management_MS-PW Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to MS-PW creation.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the MS PW tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ID

Specifies the ID of MS-PW.

Name

Specifies the name of MS-PW.

MTU(bytes)

The OptiX RTN 980 does not support this


parameter.

Service Type

Ethernet Service

Ethernet Service

l Specifies the type of services carried by the


MS-PW.

CES Service

l Set this parameter according to the


planning information.

ATM Service
Connection
Type

Port Transparent

Port Transparent

PVP

l This parameter is available only when


Service Type is ATM Service.
l PVP: Only the VPIs of the source and sink
are exchanged.

PVC

l PVP: The VPIs and VCIs of the source and


sink are exchanged.
l Port Transparent: ATM transparent
transmission refers to the transparent
transmission of ATM cells that are
encapsulated into PWs as payloads.

Parameters for the Basic Attributes of PWs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1845

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

Specifies the signaling


type of the PW. Labels for
static PWs need to be
manually assigned.

PW Type

l Specifies the type of


the PW.
l Set this parameter to
Ethernet if Service
Type is ETH Service
and no VLAN IDs
need to be added. If it
is required to add
VLAN IDs, set this
parameter to Ethernet
Tag Mode and then set
Request VLAN in the
Advanced Attribute
tab.
l If Service Type is
CES Service, the
value CESoPSN
indicates structureaware emulation,
which allows timeslot
compression; the value
SAToP indicates
structure-agnostic
emulation, which does
not allow timeslot
compression.
l If Service Type is
ATM Service, set this
parameter according to
the value of
Connection Type.

PW Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

Displays the
encapsulation type of the
PW.

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Ingress


label.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Egress


label.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1846

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Specifies the method to


select tunnels.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only the value
Manually.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Specifies the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.

Tunnel

A created tunnel needs to


be selected. If no tunnel is
available, no PW can be
created.

Peer LSR ID

Specifies the LSR ID of


the PW at the remote end.
If an existing tunnel is
selected, the LSR ID will
be automatically assigned.

Egress Tunnel

For a bidirectional tunnel,


the system will configure
the reverse tunnel
automatically.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

QoS Parameters
CES Services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1847

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Ethernet services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit function
is enabled.
l This function limits the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ETH PWE3 service
corresponds to a PW.
Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ETH
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CIR(Kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS(byte)

Specifies the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(Kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS(byte)

Specifies the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

LSP Mode

Pipe

Pipe

Pipe: When stripping


MPLS tunnel labels from
packets, an egress node
does not update the
scheduling priority for the
packets.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1848

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

ATM services
Table B-80 ATM services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit is
enabled.
l This function can be
used to limit the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs, or the
bandwidth of one or
more ATM PWE3
services, in an MPLS
tunnel. (One ATM
PWE3 service
corresponds to one
PW.)
l An ATM PWE3
service corresponds to
a PW. Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ATM
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CIR (Kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
the PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS (kbyte)

Specifies the excess burst


size of the PW.

PIR (kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of
the PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS (kbyte)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Specifies the maximum


excess burst size of the
PW.

1849

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Parameters for the Advanced Attributes of PWs


CES Services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RTP Header

Disable

Disable

l Specifies the RTP


header.

Enable

l The RTP header


carries time stamps.
l The default value is
recommended.
Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us)

375 to 16000

8000

l Specifies the jitter


buffer time for the
received CES packets.
l A greater value of this
parameter means
fewer impacts of
transmission jitters on
CES services, greater
delays of CES
services, and more
resources occupied by
CES services.
l The default value is
recommended.
NOTE
Set Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us) to a
value greater than the value
of Packet Loading Time
(us) at the opposite end and
the local end.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1850

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Loading Time


(us)

125 to 5000

1000

l Specifies the length of


fragments in the TDM
data stream. Each
fragment is
encapsulated into one
PW packet.
l A greater value of this
parameter means
higher encapsulation
efficiency but greater
delays of CES
services.
l The default value is
recommended.

Ingress Clock mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Egress Clock mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Control Channel Type

None

CW

l Specifies the mode of


PW connectivity
check.

CW
Alert Label

l The value None


indicates that the
control word is not
supported. That is, the
PW connectivity
check is not supported.
l Alert Label indicates
VCCV packets in Alert
Label encapsulation
mode.
l The value CW
indicates that the
control word is
supported.

VCCV Verification
Mode

None

Ping

Ping

l Specifies the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is
used for PW
connectivity check.
l If the VCCV-Ping test
is required, do not set
this parameter to
None.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1851

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

64K Timeslot Number

1 to 31

l Specifies the number


of 64 kbit/s timeslots
that transmit service
traffic. If Frame
Mode of the opposite
end is 30, the source 64
kbit/s timeslots at the
local end must include
the 16th timeslot.
l On the two ends of a
radio link, the timeslot
lists can be different
but the numbers of
timeslots must be the
same.
l This parameter is
unavailable if PW
Type is SAToP.

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Huawei Mode

Specifies the sequence


number mode.

Standard Mode

Ethernet services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

No Use

No Use

For ETH PWE3 services,


the parameter value is
always No Use.

Control Channel Type

None

Alert Label

l Specifies the mode of


PW connectivity
check.

Alert Label

l None indicates that


VCCV is not used.
l Alert Label indicates
VCCV packets in
Alert Label
encapsulation mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1852

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCCV Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

l Specifies the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is
used for PW
connectivity check.

None

l If the VCCV-Ping test


is required, do not set
this parameter to
None.
Request VLAN

l Set this parameter


when PW Type is
Ethernet Tagged
Mode.
l If the received packets
do not carry any
VLAN IDs, the PW
will add VLAN IDs to
the packets as required
by the setting of this
parameter.

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support request VLAN
TPID of the PW level.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Must Use

Must Use

l Specifies whether to
use the control word.
In the MPLS packet
switching network, the
control word is used to
transmit packet
information.

TPID

ATM services

No Use

l Set Control Word to


Must Use if PW
Type is ATM 1:1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1853

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Channel Type

CW

CW

l Specifies the mode of


PW connectivity
check.

None
Alert Label

l The value None


indicates that the
control word is not
supported. That is, the
PW connectivity check
is not supported.
l The value CW
indicates that the
control word is
supported.
l The value Alert
Label indicates VCCV
packets in Alert
Label encapsulation
mode.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

None

l Specifies the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is
used for PW
connectivity check.
l If the VCCV-Ping test
is required, do not set
this parameter to
None.

Max. Concatenated Cell


Count

1 to 31

10

l Specifies the
maximum number of
concatenated cells.
l If the value 1 is
assumed, only one
ATM cell is
encapsulated in one
packet. If the value
from 2 to 31 is
assumed, a maximum
of 2 to 31 ATM cells
are encapsulated into
one packet.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1854

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Loading Time


(us)

100 to 50000

1000

l Specifies the packet


loading time. Once the
packet loading time
expires, the packet is
sent out even if the
concatenated cells are
less than the
maximum.
l If Max. Concatenated
Cell Count assumes
the value 1, this
parameter is
ineffective. That is, the
packet will be sent out
once the cell is loaded.

Related Tasks
A.9.4.2 Creating an MS-PW

B.9.1.11 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW OAM


This topic describes parameters that are related to PW OAM.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the PW OAM Parameter tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the service.

PW Type

Displays the type of the


PW that carries the
service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1855

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

OAM Status

Enabled

Disabled

l Specifies or displays
whether the local node
can perform and
respond to OAM
operations.

Disabled

l If OAM Status is
Enabled, the local NE
can perform and
respond to OAM
operations.
l If OAM Status is
Disabled, the local NE
cannot perform and
respond to OAM
operations.
l If PW APS protection
needs to be configured
or a CC test needs to be
performed for the
tunnel, OAM Status
needs to be set to
Enabled.
Associate AC State

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

l Specifies or displays
the detection mode for
PW OAM packets.

Manual

l Manual: During a CC
test, PW OAM packets
are sent at the interval
specified by the user.
l Auto-Sensing: During
a CC test, PW OAM
packets are sent at the
interval for receiving
PW OAM packets.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, you
need to set the type of
PW OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value AutoSensing is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1856

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l CV: The detection


packets are sent at a
fixed interval.

FFD

l FFD: The detection


packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Auto-Sensing,
this parameter
specifies the type of
PW OAM detection
packets to be
transmitted.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, this
parameter specifies the
type of PW OAM
detection packets to be
received and
transmitted.
l The value FFD is
assumed for PW APS
and the value CV is
assumed for
continuous
connectivity check on
PWs.
Detection Packet Period
(ms)

3.3

50

10
20

l Displays or specifies
the OAM detection
period.
l If Detection Packet
Type is FFD, this
parameter can be set; if
Detection Packet
Type is CV, the value
is always 1000.

50
100
200
500

l Set this parameter to


3.3 for PW APS
usually. If the packet
transmission delay
time of a PW exceeds
3.3 ms, the
transmission interval
of FFD packets needs
to be a value greater
than the delay time.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1857

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

SD Threshold (%)

0-100

l Specifies or displays
the SD threshold.
When the OAM packet
loss ratio is higher than
the parameter value,
the corresponding
alarm is reported.
l When this parameter is
set to 0, SD threshold
detection is not
supported.

SF Threshold (%)

0-100

l Specifies or displays
the SF threshold.
When the OAM packet
loss ratio is higher than
the parameter value,
the corresponding
alarm is reported.
l When this parameter is
set to 0, SF threshold
detection is not
supported.
l The SD threshold is not
higher than the SF
threshold.

LSR ID to Be Received

l Specifies or displays
the LSR ID to be
received.
l This parameter is
available only if OAM
Status is Disabled.

PW ID to be Received

l Specifies or displays
the PW ID to be
received.
l This parameter is
available only if OAM
Status is Disabled.

Local Working Status

Displays whether PWs at


the local end are available.

Local PW Defect Type

Displays the local PW


defect type.

Local Disable PW
Duration(ms)

Displays the duration


when the local PW is
unavailable.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1858

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Local PW Defect
Location

Displays the local PW


defect location.

Remote Working Status

Displays whether PWs at


the remote end are
available.

Remote PW Defect Type

Displays the remote PW


defect type.

Remote Disable PW
Duration(ms)

Displays the duration


when the remote PW is
unavailable.

Remote PW Defect
Location

Displays the remote PW


defect location.

Related Tasks
A.9.4.3 Setting PW OAM Parameters

B.9.1.12 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Ping


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the PW Ping test.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the PW OAM Parameter tab.

3.

Select the required PW and click OAM Operation > Ping Test.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Count

1 to 4294967295

Specifies the number of


test request packets.

EXP Value

0 to 7

l Specifies the EXP


value of the PW label
in test request packets.
The value 7 indicates
the highest priority.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1859

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

TTL

1 to 255

255

l Specifies the time-tolive (TTL) value of the


PW label in test request
packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Transmit Interval
(10ms)

1 to 1000

100

l Specifies the interval


for transmitting test
request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Packet Length

64 to 1400

64

l Specifies the length of


test request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Wait-to-Response
Timeout Time(10ms)

1 to 6000

300

l Specifies the wait-toresponse timeout


value.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1860

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Response Mode

IPv4 UDP Response

IPv4 UDP Response

l Specifies the response


mode of test request
packets.

No Response
Application Control
Channel Response

l The value No
Response indicates
that the test
performance event is
reported without
sending response
packets.
l The value Application
Control Channel
Response indicates
that response is
performed through the
reverse channel.
l The value IPv4 UDP
indicates that the IPv4
UDP packets
encapsulating MPLS
echo reply messages
are sent as response
packets.
l The value IPv4 UDP is
reserved for scenarios
where all nodes on an
LSP communicate
with each other over a
DCN running IP
protocols.
l Set this parameter
based on the situation
of the remote PE. If the
remote PE supports
reverse channel
response, set this
parameter to
Application Control
Channel Response. If
the remote PE does not
support reverse
channel response but
supports DCN channel
response by means of
IP protocols, set this
parameter to IPv4
UDP Response.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1861

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Peer PW ID

Specifies the PW ID of the


peer end.

Peer IP

Specifies the IP address of


the peer port.

Related Tasks
A.9.4.4 Performing a PW Ping Test

B.9.1.13 Parameter Description: PW Management_PW Traceroute


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the PW Traceroute test.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the PW OAM Parameter tab.

3.

Select the required PW, click OAM Operation in the lower right corner, and choose
Traceroute Test from the drop-down list.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP Value

0 to 7

l Specifies the EXP


value of the PW label
in test request packets.
The value 7 indicates
the highest priority.
l The default value is
recommended.

TTL

1 to 255

255

l Specifies the time-tolive (TTL) value of the


PW label in test request
packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Packet Length

84 to 1400

84

l Specifies the length of


test request packets.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1862

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Wait-to-Response
Timeout Time(10ms)

1 to 6000

300

l Specifies the wait-toresponse timeout


value.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1863

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Response Mode

IPv4 UDP Response

IPv4 UDP Response

l Specifies the response


mode of test request
packets.

No Response
Application Control
Channel Response

l The value No
Response indicates
that the test
performance event is
reported without
sending response
packets.
l The value Application
Control Channel
Response indicates
that response is
performed through the
reverse channel.
l The value IPv4 UDP
indicates that the IPv4
UDP packets
encapsulating MPLS
echo reply messages
are sent as response
packets.
l The value IPv4 UDP is
reserved for scenarios
where all nodes on an
LSP communicate
with each other over a
DCN running IP
protocols.
l Set this parameter
based on the situation
of the remote PE. If the
remote PE supports
reverse channel
response, set this
parameter to
Application Control
Channel Response. If
the remote PE does not
support reverse
channel response but
supports DCN channel
response by means of
IP protocols, set this
parameter to IPv4
UDP Response.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1864

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.9.4.5 Performing a PW Traceroute Test

B.9.1.14 Parameter Description: MPLS APS Protection Management


This topic describes parameters that are related to MPLS APS protection management.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > APS Protection Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Tunnel APS Management tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group ID

l Displays the protection


group ID.
l The system
automatically assigns
IDs to the protection
groups according to
their creation
sequence.

Protection Type

Displays the protection


group type.

Switching Mode

Dual-Ended

l Displays or specifies
the switching mode of
a protection group.

Single-Ended

l The value SingleEnded indicates that


services are switched
only in the direction
where faults occur.
l The value DualEnded indicates that
services in both
positive and reverse
directions are switched
to their protection
channels when faults
occur.
l It is recommended that
you set this parameter
to Dual-Ended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1865

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

BDI Status

Disabled

l Specifies or displays
whether the protection
switching is triggered
upon receiving BDI
packets.

Enabled

l This parameter is
available only when
Switching Mode is set
to Single-Ended.
l If BDI Status is set to
Enabled, the egress
node notifies the
ingress node of any
detected faults by
sending BDI packets;
upon receiving BDI
packets, the ingress
node triggers
protection switching.
Transmit and receive
Status of Protocol Packet

Displays the protocol


packet status.

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

l Specifies or displays
whether to switch
services to the original
working tunnel after
the fault is rectified.

Revertive

l The value Revertive


indicates to perform
the switching; the
value Non-Revertive
indicates not to
perform the switching.
l It is recommended that
you set this parameter
to Revertive.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1866

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(min)

1-12

l Specifies and displays


the WTR time of the
protection group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working
tunnel recovers,
services are switched
to the original working
tunnel.
l This parameter is
available only when
Revertive Mode is
Revertive.
l It is recommended that
you set this parameter
to 5.

Hold-Time(100ms)

0-100

l Specifies the hold-off


time of the protection
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but wait
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detect whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.
l It is recommended that
you set this parameter
to 0.

Protocol Status

Displays the protocol


status.

Switching Status

Displays the switching


status of the protection
group.

Deployment Status

Displays the deployment


status of the protection
group.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1867

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Unit

Displays whether a tunnel


is a working or protection
tunnel.

Active Tunnel

Displays the currently


used tunnel.

Tunnel Status

Displays the tunnel status.

Tunnel Type

Displays the tunnel type.

Tunnel Direction

Displays the direction of a


tunnel.

Ingress Tunnel

Displays the ingress


tunnel.

Egress Tunnel

Displays the egress tunnel.

Related Tasks
A.9.3.2 Querying MPLS APS Status

B.9.1.15 Parameter Description: Tunnel Protection Group_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to creating a tunnel protection group.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > APS
Protection Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Tunnel APS Management tab.

3.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

1:1

1:1

Specifies the protection


type of the tunnel
protection group.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only the value 1:1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1868

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switching Mode

Single-Ended

Dual-Ended

l Specifies the switching


mode to be adopted
when a tunnel fails.

Dual-Ended

l The value SingleEnded indicates that


services are switched
only in the direction
where faults occur.
l The value DualEnded indicates that
services are switched
to the protection
channel in both
directions when faults
occur.
l The value DualEnded is
recommended.
BDI Status

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies whether the


protection switching is
triggered upon
receiving BDI packets.
l This parameter is
available only when
Switching Mode is set
to Single-Ended.
l If BDI Status is set to
Enabled, the egress
node notifies the
ingress node of any
detected faults by
sending BDI packets;
upon receiving BDI
packets, the ingress
node triggers the
protection switching.

Working Tunnel Type

MPLS Tunnel

MPLS Tunnel

Specifies the type of the


working tunnel.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only the value
MPLS Tunnel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1869

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Working Ingress Tunnel


ID

l Specifies the working


tunnel of the protection
group in the ingress
direction.
l If this parameter is set
for a bidirectional
tunnel, a value is
automatically assigned
to the parameter
Working Egress
Tunnel ID.

Working Ingress Tunnel


Name

Displays the name of the


working tunnel in the
ingress direction.

Working Egress Tunnel


ID

l Specifies the working


tunnel of the protection
group in the egress
direction.
l For a bidirectional
tunnel, if the parameter
Working Ingress
Tunnel ID is set, a
value is automatically
assigned to the
parameter Working
Egress Tunnel ID.

Working Egress Tunnel


Name

Displays the name of the


working tunnel in the
egress direction.

Protection Tunnel Type

Displays the type of


protection tunnel, which is
the same as the type of
working tunnel.

Protection Ingress
Tunnel ID

l Specifies the working


tunnel of the protection
group in the ingress
direction.
l If this parameter is set
for a bidirectional
tunnel, a value is
automatically assigned
to the parameter
Protection Egress
Tunnel ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1870

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Ingress
Tunnel Name

Displays the name of the


protection tunnel in the
ingress direction.

Protection Egress
Tunnel ID

l Specifies the
protection tunnel of the
protection group in the
egress direction.
l For a bidirectional
tunnel, if the parameter
Protection Ingress
Tunnel ID is set, a
value is automatically
assigned to the
parameter Protection
Egress Tunnel ID.

Protection Egress
Tunnel Name

Displays the name of the


protection tunnel in the
egress direction.

Revertive Mode

Non-Revertive

Non-Revertive

l This parameter
specifies whether to
switch services back to
the original working
tunnel after it recovers.

Revertive

l The value Revertive


indicates to switch
services back to the
original working
tunnel after it recovers;
the value NonRevertive indicates
not to switch services
back to the original
working tunnel after it
recovers.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1871

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

WTR Time(min)

1 to 12

l Specifies the WTR


time of the protection
group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working
tunnel recovers,
services are switched
to the original working
tunnel.
l This parameter is
available only when
Revertive Mode is
Revertive.
l The default value is
recommended.

Hold-Time(100ms)

0 to 100

l Specifies the hold-off


time of the protection
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.
l The default value is
recommended.

Protocol Status

Disabled

Disabled

Enabled

l Specifies the protocol


status.
l During the creation of
a protection group, set
Protocol Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Protocol
Status to Enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1872

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.9.3.1 Creating an MPLS APS Protection Group

B.9.1.16 Parameter Description: PW APS Protection Group_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a PW APS protection group.

Navigation Path
The navigation path for CES services is as follows:
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Protection Group tab.

3.

Click the PW APS tab.

4.

Click New.

The navigation path for E-Line services is as follows:


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Protection Group tab.

3.

Click the PW APS tab.

4.

Click New.

The navigation path for ATM services is as follows:


1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Protection Group tab.

3.

Click the PW APS tab.

4.

Click New.

Parameters for the Basic Attributes of PWs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

Specifies the signaling


type of the PW. Labels for
static PWs need to be
manually assigned.

PW Type

Displays the PW type.

PW Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1873

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Encapsulation Type

Displays the
encapsulation type of the
PW.

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Ingress


label.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Egress


label.

Tunnel selection mode

Displays the method to


select tunnels.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.

Tunnel

A tunnel needs to be
selected. If no tunnel is
available, creation of a
PW will fail.

Peer LSR ID

Specifies the LSR ID of


the PW at the remote end.
If an existing tunnel is
selected, the LSR ID will
be automatically assigned.

Egress Tunnel

For a bidirectional tunnel,


the system will configure
the reverse tunnel
automatically.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

QoS Parameters
Table B-81 CES services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1874

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-82 E-Line services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit function
is enabled.

Enabled

l This function limits the


bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ETH PWE3 service
corresponds to a PW.
Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ETH
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.
Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS(byte)

Specifies the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS(byte)

Specifies the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

LSP Mode

Displays the LSP mode.


NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only Pipe.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1875

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-83 ATM services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit function
is enabled.

Enabled

l This function limits the


bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ATM PWE3
service corresponds to
a PW. Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ATM
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.
CIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS(byte)

Specifies the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS(byte)

Specifies the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1876

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Advanced Attributes


Table B-84 CES services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RTP Head

Displays whether the CES


service packets carry an
RTP header.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us)

Displays the jitter buffer


time for the received CES
packets.

Ingress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Egress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Control Channel Type

Displays the mode of PW


connectivity check.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is used
for PW connectivity
check.

Enable CES Service


Alarm Transparent
Transmission

Displays whether CES


service alarms are
transparently transmitted.

Threshold of Entering R
bit Inserting Status

Displays the threshold of


the packet loss ratio of
CES services. The
corresponding alarm will
be reported if the actual
packet loss ratio crosses
this threshold.

Threshold of Exiting R
bit Inserting Status

Displays the threshold of


received CES service
packets. The
corresponding alarm will
be cleared after the actual
number of received CES
service packets crosses
this threshold.

Sequence Number Mode

Displays the sequence


number mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1877

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-85 E-Line services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Displays whether the


control word is used to
transfer packet
information. For ETH
PWE3 services, this
parameter is always not
used.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Request VLAN

When PW Type is
Ethernet Tag, this
parameter displays the
VLAN ID to be added to
packets that are sent from
the opposite end and do
not carry any VLAN IDs.

TPID

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support VLAN TPID
of the PW level.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Displays whether the


control word is used to
transfer packet
information.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Max Concatenated Cell


Count

Displays the maximum


number of concatenated
cells.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Table B-86 ATM services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1878

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

Specifies the protection


type.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the protection


group ID.

Enabling Status

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies the enabling


status of the PW
protection group.

Enabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports 1:1 protection
mode.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Switching Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports dual-ended
switching.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1879

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Revertive Mode

Non-revertive

Revertive

l This parameter
specifies whether to
switch services back to
the original working
PW after it recovers.

Revertive

l The value Revertive


indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.
Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Specifies the WTR


time of the protection
group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1880

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Specifies the hold-off


time of the protection
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.
l The default value is
recommended.

Displays the detection


mode of the PW APS
protection group.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

OAM Status

Displays the enabling


status of PW OAM.

Detection mode

OAM Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1881

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

l Specifies the detection


mode of OAM packets.

Manual

l Manual: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval specified
by the user.
l Auto-Sensing: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval of
receiving PW OAM
packets.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, you
need to set the PW
OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value AutoSensing is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1882

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l CV: The detection


packets are sent at a
fixed interval.

FFD

l FFD: The detection


packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Auto-Sensing,
this parameter
specifies the PW OAM
detection packets to be
transmitted.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, this
parameter specifies the
PW OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value FFD is
assumed for PW APS
and the value CV is
assumed for
continuous
connectivity check on
PWs.
Detection Packet Period
(ms)

3.3

50

10

l Specifies the period of


detection packets.
l This parameter is
configurable when
Detection Packet
Type is FFD and
assumes the fixed
value of 1000 when
Detection Packet
Type is CV.

20
50
100
200
500

l Set this parameter to


3.3 for PW APS.
LSR ID to be Received

Specifies the LSR ID to be


received.

PW ID to be Received

Specifies the PW ID to be
received.

Related Tasks
A.9.5.1 Creating a PW APS Protection Group
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1883

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.9.1.17 Parameter Description: Slave Protection Pair of a PW APS Protection


Group_Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a slave protection pair of a PW
APS protection group.

Navigation Path
The navigation path for CES services is as follows:
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Protection Group tab.

3.

Click the Slave Protection Pair tab.

4.

Click New.

The navigation path for E-Line services is as follows:


1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet
Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Protection Group tab.

3.

Click the Slave Protection Pair tab.

4.

Click New.

The navigation path for ATM services is as follows:


1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Protection Group tab.

3.

Click the Slave Protection Pair tab.

4.

Click New.

Parameters for the Basic Attributes of PWs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

Specifies the signaling


type of the PW. Labels for
static PWs need to be
manually assigned.

PW Type

Displays the PW type.

PW Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

Displays the
encapsulation type of the
PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1884

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Ingress


label.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Egress


label.

Tunnel selection mode

Displays the method to


select tunnels.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.

Tunnel

A tunnel needs to be
selected. If no tunnel is
available, creation of a
PW will fail.

Peer LSR ID

Specifies the LSR ID of


the PW at the remote end.
If an existing tunnel is
selected, the LSR ID will
be automatically assigned.

Egress Tunnel

For a bidirectional tunnel,


the system will configure
the reverse tunnel
automatically.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

QoS Parameters
Table B-87 CES services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1885

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-88 E-Line services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit function
is enabled.

Enabled

l This function limits the


bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ETH PWE3 service
corresponds to a PW.
Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ETH
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.
Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS(byte)

Specifies the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS(byte)

Specifies the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

LSP Mode

Displays the LSP mode.


NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports only Pipe.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1886

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-89 ATM services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Disabled

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit function
is enabled.

Enabled

l This function limits the


bandwidth of one or
more PWs in an MPLS
tunnel.
l An ATM PWE3
service corresponds to
a PW. Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ATM
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.
CIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
a PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS(byte)

Specifies the committed


burst size (CBS) of a PW.

PIR(kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of a
PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS(byte)

Specifies the peak burst


size (PBS) of a PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1887

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Advanced Attributes


Table B-90 CES services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RTP Head

Displays whether the CES


service packets carry an
RTP header.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us)

Displays the jitter buffer


time for the received CES
packets.

Ingress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Egress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Control Channel Type

Displays the mode of PW


connectivity check.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is used
for PW connectivity
check.

Enable CES Service


Alarm Transparent
Transmission

Displays whether CES


service alarms are
transparently transmitted.

Threshold of Entering R
bit Inserting Status

Displays the threshold of


the packet loss ratio of
CES services. The
corresponding alarm will
be reported if the actual
packet loss ratio crosses
this threshold.

Threshold of Exiting R
bit Inserting Status

Displays the threshold of


received CES service
packets. The
corresponding alarm will
be cleared after the actual
number of received CES
service packets crosses
this threshold.

Sequence Number Mode

Displays the sequence


number mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1888

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Table B-91 E-Line services


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Displays whether the


control word is used to
transfer packet
information. For ETH
PWE3 services, this
parameter is always not
used.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Request VLAN

When PW Type is
Ethernet Tag, this
parameter displays the
VLAN ID to be added to
packets that are sent from
the opposite end and do
not carry any VLAN IDs.

TPID

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support VLAN TPID
of the PW level.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Displays whether the


control word is used to
transfer packet
information.

Control Channel Type

Displays the control


channel type.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV mode.

Max Concatenated Cell


Count

Displays the maximum


number of concatenated
cells.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Table B-92 ATM services

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1889

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the ID of the


slave protection pair. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection group
triggers the switching of
the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW in the slave
protection pair.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW in the slave
protection pair.

Related Tasks
A.9.5.2 Configuring Slave Protection Pairs of PW APS

B.9.2 CES Parameters


This topic describes parameters that are related to CES services.

B.9.2.1 Parameter Description: CES Service Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to CES service management.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

Displays the ID of the CES


service to be created.

Service name

Displays or specifies the


service name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1890

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Level

Displays the level of the


received TDM frames.

Source Board

Displays the source board


of the CES service.

Source High Channel

For the OptiX RTN 980,


this parameter cannot be
configured.

Source Low Channel

Displays the source lower


order path.

Source 64K Timeslot

Displays the source 64


kbit/s timeslot.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1891

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Priority List

CS7

l Specifies the priority


of a CES service. This
parameter is available
only when Mode is set
to UNI-NNI.

CS6
EF
AF4
AF3

l This parameter needs


to be configured if QoS
processing needs to be
performed for different
CES services.

AF2
AF1
BE

l CS6-CS7: indicate the


highest service classes,
which are mainly
involved in signaling
transmission.
l EF: indicates the
expedited forwarding
of service, which is
applicable to services
of low transmission
delay and low packet
loss rate, for example,
voice and video
services.
l AF1-AF4: indicate the
assured forwarding
classes of service,
which are applicable to
services that require an
assured rate but no
delay or jitter limit.
l BE: is applicable to
services that need not
be processed in a
special manner.
l The default value is
recommended.
PW ID

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the CES
service. This parameter is
meaningful when the CES
service type is UNI-NNI.

1892

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel

Displays the tunnel that


carries the PW. The tunnel
must have been
configured in advance.
This parameter is
meaningful when the CES
service type is UNI-NNI.

Sink Board

Displays the sink board of


the CES service. This
parameter is meaningful
when the CES service type
is UNI-UNI.

Sink High Channel

For the OptiX RTN 980,


this parameter cannot be
configured.

Sink Low Channel

Displays the sink lower


order path. This parameter
is meaningful when the
CES service type is UNIUNI.

Sink 64K Timeslot

Displays the sink 64 kbit/s


timeslot. This parameter is
meaningful when the CES
service type is UNI-UNI.

Deployment Status

Displays the deployment


status of the CES service.

Parameters for the Basic Attributes of PWs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the CES
service.

Working Status

Displays working status of


the PW.

PW Status

Displays the enabling


status of the PW.

PW Signaling Type

Displays the PW signaling


type.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports static PWs only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1893

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Type

Displays the PW type for


CES service
encapsulation.
CESoPSN: Indicates
structure-aware TDM
circuit emulation service
over packet switched
network. Timeslot
compression can be set.
SAToP: Indicates
structure-agnostic TDM
over packet. Timeslot
compression cannot be
set.

PW Encapsulation Type

Displays the tunnel type


for PW encapsulation.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports MPLS only.

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

Displays the Ingress label


of the PW that carries the
CES service.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

Displays the Egress label


of the PW that carries the
CES service.

Peer LSR ID

Displays the LSR ID of the


PW at the remote end.

Local Working Status

Displays the working


status of the PW at the
local end.

Remote Working Status

Displays the working


status of the PW at the
remote end.

Compositive Working
Status

Displays the compositive


working status of the PW.
The compositive working
status is up when both
ends are up, and is down
when one end is down.

Tunnel type

Displays the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports MPLS tunnels
only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1894

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Tunnel

Displays the ID of the


tunnel that carries the CES
service.

Deployment Status

Displays the deployment


status of the tunnel.

Tunnel Automatic
Selection Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW.

CIR(kbit/s)

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

QoS Parameters

Parameters of Advanced Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

RTP Header

Displays the RTP header.


The RTP header carries
time stamps.

Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us)

375 to 16000

l Displays or specifies
the jitter buffer time.
l The jitter buffer time
guarantees the realtime performance of
the CES service.
NOTE
Set Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us) to a
value greater than the value
of Packet Loading Time
(us) at the opposite end and
the local end.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1895

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Packet Loading Time


(us)

Displays the packet


loading time.

Ingress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Egress Clock Mode

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Control Channel Type

Displays the mode of PW


connectivity check.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Displays the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is used
for PW connectivity
check.

Enable CES Service


Alarm Transparent
Transmission

Enabled

Displays or specifies the


enabling status of the
transparent transmission
of CES service alarms. If
this function is enabled,
the fault on the AC side of
the CES service is notified
to the remote end. Upon
receiving the fault
notification from the
network side or the remote
end, the local NE inserts
the corresponding alarm to
the AC side.

Threshold of Entering R
Bit Inserting Status

1-65535

Displays or specifies the


threshold of packet loss
ratio of CES services. The
corresponding alarm will
be reported once the actual
packet loss ratio crosses
this threshold. This
parameter is available
only when the transparent
transmission of CES
service alarms is enabled.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Disabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1896

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Threshold of Exiting R
Bit Inserting Status

1-65535

Displays or specifies the


threshold of received CES
service packets. The
corresponding alarm will
be cleared after the actual
number of received CES
service packets crosses
this threshold. This
parameter is available
only when the transparent
transmission of CES
service alarms is enabled.

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Specifies the sequence


number mode. The
Sequence Number
Mode must be set to the
same value at both ends of
a radio link.

Standard Mode

Protection Group Parameters (PW APS)


NOTE

The following parameters are available only after the PW APS protection group is configured.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group ID

Displays the ID of the


protection group to be
created.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1897

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enabling Status

Enabled

l Displays or specifies
the enabling status of
the PW protection
group.

Disabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Switchover Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supporting dual-ended
switching.

Restoration Mode

Non-revertive

Revertive

l Specifies whether to
switch services to the
original working PW
after the fault is
rectified.
l The value Revertive
indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1898

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Displays or specifies
the WTR time of the
protection group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Displays or specifies
the hold-off time of the
protection group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.

Deployment Status

Display the deployment


status of the protection
group.

Switchover Status

Displays the switchover


status of the protection
group.

Protocol Status

Displays the enabling


status of the protocol.

Working Path Status

Displays the status of the


current working path.

Protection Path Status

Display the status of the


current protection path.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1899

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters (Slave Protection Pair)


NOTE

The following parameters are available only after the slave protection pair is configured.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group ID

Specifies the ID of the


slave protection pair. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection group
triggers the switching of
the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW in the slave
protection pair.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW in the slave
protection pair.

DNI PW ID

Displays the DNI PW ID.

PW Type

Displays the PW type.

Deployment Status

Displays the deployment


status of the slave
protection pair.

Related Tasks
A.9.6.2 Modifying CES Service Parameters
A.9.6.3 Querying CES Service Information

B.9.2.2 Parameter Description: CES Service Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to creating CES services.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > CES
Service Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID(e.g.1,3-6)

1 to 4294967295

Specifies the service ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1900

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service name

Specifies the service


name.

Level

E1

E1

The value E1 indicates


that the CES service is
used to transmit the TDM
services from E1 ports.

Mode

UNI-NNI

UNI-NNI

l Specifies the mode of


CES service.

UNI-UNI

l The value UNI-NNI


indicates that the CES
service is carried by a
PW. Therefore, the
information about the
PW needs to be
configured.
Source Board

Specifies the board where


the source (UNI) of the
CES service is located.

Source High Channel

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Source Low Channel


(e.g.1,3-6)

If Level is set to E1, this


parameter indicates the E1
port where the service
source is located. If
Mode is set to UNI-NNI,
this parameter can assume
only one value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1901

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source 64K Timeslot


(e.g.1,3-6)

1-31

1-31

l Specifies the 64 kbit/s


timeslot that transmits
data. This parameter
can assume multiple
values. If Frame
Mode of the opposite
end is 30, the source 64
kbit/s timeslots at the
local end must include
the 16th timeslot.
l On the two ends of a
radio link, the timeslot
lists can be different
but the numbers of
timeslots must the
same.
l This parameter does
not need to be set if
Mode is UNI-NNI and
PW Type is SAToP.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1902

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Priority List

CS7

EF

l Specifies the priority


of a CES service. This
parameter is available
only when Mode is set
to UNI-NNI.

CS6
EF
AF4
AF3

l This parameter needs


to be configured if QoS
processing needs to be
performed for different
CES services.

AF2
AF1
BE

l CS6-CS7: indicate the


highest service classes,
which are mainly
involved in signaling
transmission.
l EF: indicates the
expedited forwarding
of service, which is
applicable to services
of low transmission
delay and low packet
loss rate, for example,
voice and video
services.
l AF1-AF4: indicate the
assured forwarding
classes of service,
which are applicable to
services that require an
assured rate but no
delay or jitter limit.
l BE: is applicable to
services that need not
be processed in a
special manner.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1903

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Type

CESoPSN

CESoPSN

l Specifies the type of


the PW. This
parameter is available
only when Mode is
UNI-NNI.

SAToP

l CESoPSN: Indicates
structure-aware TDM
circuit emulation
service over packet
switched network.
Timeslot compression
can be set. SAToP:
Indicates structureagnostic TDM over
packet. Timeslot
compression cannot be
set.
Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

PW APS
Slave Protection Pair

l Specifies the
protection mode of the
PW. This parameter is
available only when
Mode is UNI-NNI.
l If this parameter is set
to PW APS, working
and protection PWs
need to be configured.
l When this parameter is
set to
Slave Protection Pair
, you need to bind the
slave PW APS
protection group with
the master PW APS
protection group. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection
group triggers the
switching of the slave
PW APS protection
group simultaneously.

Sink Board

l Specifies the board


where the sink of the
CES service is located.
l This parameter is
available only when
Mode is set to UNIUNI.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1904

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink High Channel

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Sink Low Channel(e.g.


1,3-6)

l If Level is set to E1,


this parameter
indicates the E1 port
where the service sink
is located.
l This parameter is
available only when
Mode is set to UNIUNI.

Sink 64K Timeslot(e.g.


1,3-6)

1-31

1-31

l Specifies the 64 kbit/s


timeslot that the
service sink occupies.
On the two ends of a
radio link, the timeslot
lists can be different
but the numbers of
timeslots must the
same.
l This parameter is
available only when
Mode is set to UNIUNI.

Parameters for the Basic Attributes of PWs


NOTE

If the parameter Protection Type of PWs is set to PW APS or Slave Protection Pair, all the parameters of
working and protection PWs need to be configured. This section considers the parameters of the working PW
as an example.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

PW Signaling Type

Static

Static

Specifies the signaling


type of the PW. Labels for
static PWs need to be
manually assigned.

PW Type

Displays the PW type.

PW Direction

Displays the direction of


the PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1905

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Encapsulation Type

Displays the
encapsulation type of the
PW.

PW Ingress Label/
Source Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Ingress


label.

PW Egress Label/Sink
Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Egress


label.

Tunnel selection mode

Displays the method to


select tunnels.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.

Tunnel

A tunnel needs to be
selected. If no tunnel is
available, creation of a
PW will fail.

Peer LSR ID

Specifies the LSR ID of


the PW at the remote end.
If an existing tunnel is
selected, the LSR ID will
be automatically assigned.

Egress Tunnel

For a bidirectional tunnel,


the system will configure
the reverse tunnel
automatically.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

QoS Parameters

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1906

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for the Advanced Attributes of PWs


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

RTP Header

Disable

Disable

l Specifies the RTP


header.

Enable Huawei RTP

l The RTP header


carries time stamps.
l The default value is
recommended.
Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time (us)

375 to 16000

8000

l Specifies the jitter


buffer time for the
received CES packets.
The step is 125.
l A greater value of this
parameter means
fewer impacts of
transmission jitters on
CES services, greater
delays of CES
services, and more
resources occupied by
CES services.
l The default value is
recommended.
NOTE
Set Jitter Compensation
Buffering Time(us) to a
value greater than the value
of Packet Loading Time
(us) at the opposite end and
the local end.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

125 to 5000

1000

l Specifies the length of


fragments in the TDM
data stream. The step is
125.
l A greater value of this
parameter means
higher encapsulation
efficiency but greater
delays of CES
services.
l The default value is
recommended.

Ingress Clock Mode

Null

Null

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Adaptive Clock Mode


Egress Clock Mode

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1907

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Channel Type

None

CW

l Specifies the mode of


PW connectivity
check.

CW
Alert Label

l The value None


indicates that the
control word is not
supported. That is, the
PW connectivity
check is not supported.
l Alert Label indicates
VCCV packets in Alert
Label encapsulation
mode.
l The value CW
indicates that the
control word is
supported.

VCCV Verification
Mode

None

Ping

Ping

l Specifies the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is
used for PW
connectivity check.
l If the VCCV-Ping test
is required, do not set
this parameter to
None.

Enable CES Service


Alarm Transparent
Transmission

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Disabled

Disabled

Enabled

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

If this function is enabled,


the fault on the AC side of
the CES service is notified
to the remote end. On
receiving the fault
notification from the
network side or the remote
end, the local NE inserts
the corresponding alarm
to the AC side.

1908

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Threshold of Entering R
Bit Inserting Status

1-65535

100

l The corresponding
alarm will be reported
if the number of
consecutive lost
packets crosses the
threshold specified by
this parameter.
l This function is
available only when
the transparent
transmission of CES
service alarms is
enabled.

Threshold of Exiting R
Bit Inserting Status

1-65535

l The corresponding
alarm will be cleared if
the number of
consecutive received
packets crosses the
threshold specified by
this parameter.
l This function is
available only when
the transparent
transmission of CES
service alarms is
enabled.

Sequence Number Mode

Huawei Mode

Standard Mode

Standard Mode

Specifies the sequence


number mode. The
Sequence Number
Mode must be set to the
same value at both ends of
a radio link.

Protection Group Parameters (PW APS)


NOTE

The parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of PWs is set to
PW APS.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

Specifies the protection


type.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the protection


group ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1909

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enabling Status

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies the enabling


status of the PW
protection group.

Enabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports 1:1 protection
mode.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Switching Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports dual-ended
switching.

Revertive Mode

Non-revertive

Revertive

Revertive

l This parameter
specifies whether to
switch services back to
the original working
PW after it recovers.
l The value Revertive
indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1910

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Specifies the WTR


time of the protection
group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.
l The default value is
recommended.

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Specifies the hold-off


time of the protection
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.
l The default value is
recommended.

Detection mode

Displays the detection


mode of the PW APS
protection group.

OAM Parameters
NOTE

l The OAM parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of
PWs is set to PW APS.
l To configure PW OAM parameters, choose Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management >
PW OAM Parameter from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1911

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

OAM Status

Displays the enabling


status of PW OAM.

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

l Specifies the detection


mode of OAM packets.

Manual

l Manual: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval specified
by the user.
l Auto-Sensing: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval of
receiving PW OAM
packets.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, you
need to set the PW
OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value AutoSensing is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1912

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l CV: The detection


packets are sent at a
fixed interval.

FFD

l FFD: The detection


packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Auto-Sensing,
this parameter
specifies the PW OAM
detection packets to be
transmitted.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, this
parameter specifies the
PW OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value FFD is
assumed for PW APS
and the value CV is
assumed for
continuous
connectivity check on
PWs.
Detection Packet Period
(ms)

3.3

50

10

l Specifies the period of


detection packets.
l This parameter is
configurable when
Detection Packet
Type is FFD and
assumes the fixed
value of 1000 when
Detection Packet
Type is CV.

20
50
100
200
500

l Set this parameter to


3.3 for PW APS.
LSR ID to be Received

Specifies the LSR ID to be


received.

PW ID to be Received

Specifies the PW ID to be
received.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1913

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters (Slave Protection Pair)


NOTE

The parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of PWs is set to
Slave Protection Pair.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the ID of the


slave protection pair. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection group
triggers the switching of
the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW in the slave
protection pair.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW in the slave
protection pair.

Related Tasks
A.9.6.1 Creating CES Services

B.9.3 ATM Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATM services.

B.9.3.1 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Group Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IMA group management.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IMA Group Management tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK

Displays the ATM


TRUNK.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1914

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IMA Protocol Enable


Status

Enabled

Disabled

l Specifies the IMA


protocol enable status.

Disabled

l Set IMA Protocol


Enable Status to
Enabled if the links
bound in the ATM
TRUNK require the
IMA protocol;
otherwise, set this
parameter to
Disabled.
l After IMA Protocol
Enable Status is set to
Enabled, the E1 links
or Fractional E1
timeslots bound in the
ATM TRUNK start
running the IMA
protocol.
Minimum Number of
Active Transmitting
Links

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

1 to 16

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

l The links of the IMA


group can carry
services only when the
number of activated
links in the transmit/
receive direction is not
smaller than the value
of Minimum Number
of Active
Transmitting Links/
Minimum Number of
Active Receiving
Links.
l The values of
Minimum Number of
Active Transmitting
Links and Minimum
Number of Active
Receiving Links must
be the same because
the OptiX RTN 980
supports Symmetrical
Mode and
Symmetrical
Operation only. The
parameters Minimum
Number of Active
Transmitting Links
and Minimum

1915

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Minimum Number of
Active Receiving Links

1 to 16

Number of Active
Receiving Links must
assume the same value
on the two ends of an
IMA link.
l The default value is
recommended.

IMA Protocol Version

1.0

1.1

l Specifies the IMA


protocol version.

1.1

l The parameter IMA


Protocol Version
must assume the same
value on the two ends
of an IMA link.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1916

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IMA Transmit Frame


Length

32

128

l Specifies the IMA


transmit frame length.

64

l Based on the IMA


frame format, the
receive end rebuilds
the ATM cell stream
with the cells arriving
from diverselydelayed links. Longer
IMA frames result in
higher transmission
efficiency and occupy
more resources. Once a
member link fails, the
impact on the entire
IMA group increases
as the length of IMA
frames increases.

128
256

l The IMA Transmit


Frame Length must
assume the same value
on the two ends of an
IMA link.
l The default value is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1917

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

IMA Symmetry Mode

Symmetrical Mode and


Symmetrical Operation

Symmetrical Mode and


Symmetrical Operation

l Specifies the
symmetrical mode of
the IMA group.
l If the symmetrical
mode and symmetrical
operation is adopted,
the bandwidth of the
IMA group is always
consistent in the
transmit direction and
in the receive
direction, even when
some member links
fail. In symmetrical
mode:
Bandwidth of the
IMA group = min
{bandwidth in the
transmit direction,
bandwidth in the
receive direction}
The unidirectional
failure in one
member link is
equivalent to the
bidirectional
failure in one
member link.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1918

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Maximum Delay
Between Links (ms)

1 to 120

25

l Specifies the
maximum differential
delay that is allowed
between the member
links.
l If the differential delay
between a member link
and the other member
links exceeds the
value, this link will be
deactivated and
deleted from the IMA
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value higher than
the normal value
range, the delay of
IMA services will be
prolonged and even
packet loss will occur;
if this parameter is set
to a value lower than
the normal value
range, a working link
will be deleted by
mistake.
l The Maximum Delay
Between Links (ms)
must assume the same
value on the two ends
of an IMA link.
l The default value is
recommended.

Clock Mode

CTC Mode

CTC Mode

ITC Mode

l Specifies the clock


mode of the IMA
group.
l Clock Mode is set to
the same value for the
interconnected ends of
IMA links.

Related Tasks
A.9.7.2 Configuring an IMA group

B.9.3.2 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_Bound Path Configuration


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the bound paths in the ATM TRUNK.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1919

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Binding tab.

3.

Click Configuration.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Available Boards

Selects the available


boards.

Configurable Ports

Selects the configurable


ATM trunks.

Level

E1

E1

Specifies the level of


bound paths.

Fractional E1

l If ATM/IMA services
need to be mapped into
the ATM TRUNK that
binds one or more E1
ports, select E1 in
Level.
l If ATM/IMA services
need to be mapped into
the ATM TRUNK that
binds one or more
serial ports, select
Fractional E1 in
Level.
Direction

Displays the direction of


bound paths. The fixed
value is bidirectional.

Optical Interface

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Available Resources

Displays the ports that


carry the available paths
for IMA services.
NOTE
For Fractional ATM/IMA
services, set Port Mode in
PDH Interface to Layer 1
and configure A.6.5 Setting
Serial Port Parameters.

Available Timeslots

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Selected Bound Paths

Displays the bound paths.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1920

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK

Displays the name of the


ATM TRUNK.

Level

Displays the level of


bound paths.

Direction

Displays the direction of


bound paths. The fixed
value is bidirectional.

Bound Paths

Displays the bound paths.

Number of Bound Paths

Displays the number of


bound paths.

Display in Combination

Selected

Selected

Specifies whether to
display bound paths in
combination.

Not selected

Related Tasks
A.9.7.1 Binding ATM TRUNKs

B.9.3.3 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Group Status


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IMA group status.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IMA Group States tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK

Displays the VCTRUNK.

Near-End Group Status

Displays the status of the


near-end group.

Far-End Group Status

Displays the status of the


far-end group.

Transmit Rate (cell/s)

Displays the cell


transmission rate.

Receive Rate (cell/s)

Displays the cell receiving


rate.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1921

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Number of Transmit
Links

Displays the number of


transmit links.

Number of Receive
Links

Displays the number of


receive links.

Number of Activated
Transmit Links

Displays the number of


activated transmit links.

Number of Activated
Receive Links

Displays the number of


activated receive links.

Related Tasks
A.9.7.4 Querying Running Status of an IMA Group

B.9.3.4 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_IMA Link Status


This topic describes the parameters that are related to IMA link status.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the IMA Link States tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK

Displays the VCTRUNK.

E1 Link

Displays E1 links.

Differential Delay Check


Status

Displays the status of the


deferential delay check.

Near-End Receiving
Status

Displays the near-end


receiving status.

Near-End Transmitting
Status

Displays the near-end


transmitting status.

Far-End Receiving
Status

Displays the far-end


receiving status.

Far-End Transmitting
Status

Displays the far-end


transmitting status.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1922

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.9.7.5 Querying Link Running Status of an IMA Group

B.9.3.5 Parameter Description: ATM IMA Management_ATM Interface


Management
This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATM interface management.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Interface Management > ATM IMA Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the ATM Interface Management tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port.

Name

Displays or specifies the


name of port.

Port Type

UNI

UNI

Specifies the type of ATM


port.

NNI

l UNI: the port


connecting user-side
devices. For example,
the UNI port applies to
the user-side interface
on the common ATM
network or to the userside interface of the PE
on the PSN network
that transmits ATM
PWE3 services.
l NNI: the port
connecting networkside devices. For
example, the NNI port
applies to the networkside interface on the
common ATM
network.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1923

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ATM Cell Payload


Scrambling

Disabled

Enabled

Specifies whether to
enable payload
scrambling of ATM cells.

Enabled

l The ITU-T G.804


stipulates that the
payload (48 bytes) of
ATM cells must be
scrambled before it is
mapped into E1
signals. Therefore, it is
recommended that you
set ATM Cell Payload
Scrambling to
Enabled.
l ATM Cell Payload
Scrambling must
assume the same value
on the two ends of an
ATM link. Otherwise,
packet loss will occur.
Min. VPI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Max. VPI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Min. VCI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Max. VCI

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

VCC-Supported VPI
Count

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Loopback

No Loopback

No Loopback

Specifies the loopback


status of the port.

Outloop
Inloop

Related Tasks
A.9.7.3 Setting ATM Port Parameters

B.9.3.6 Parameter Description: Configuration of ATM Service Class Mapping Table


This topic describes the parameters that are related to configuration of the ATM service class
mapping table.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1924

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv domain Management > ATM COS Mapping Configuration from
the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mapping Relation ID

Specifies the ID of the


mapping table.

Mapping Relation Name

Specifies the name of the


mapping relationship.

UBR

BE
AF11
AF12
AF13
AF21
AF22
AF23
AF31
AF32
AF33
AF41
AF42
AF43
EF
CS6
CS7

UBR: BE

Displays or specifies the


PHB service classes that
correspond to different
ATM service types.
l Eight PHB service
classes are available:
BE, AF1, AF2, AF3,
AF4, EF, CS6, and
CS7. The OptiX RTN
980 provides different
QoS policies for the
queues of different
service classes.
l CS6 to CS7: highest
service classes, mainly
applicable to signaling
transmission.
l EF: fast forwarding,
applicable to services
of low transmission
delays and low packet
loss rates.
l AF1 to AF4: assured
forwarding, applicable
to services that require
an assured
transmission rate
rather than delay or
jitter limits.

CBR
RT-VBR
NRT-VBR
UBR+

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CBR: EF
RT-VBR: AF31
NRT-VBR: AF21
UBR+: AF11
PORT-TRANS: BE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1925

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
NOTE
The AF1 class includes
three subclasses: AF11,
AF12, and AF13. Only
one of these subclasses
can take effect for one
queue. It is the same
case with AF2, AF3, and
AF4.

PORT-TRANS

l BE: best effort,


applicable to services
that do not require
special processing.

Related Tasks
A.9.9.2 Modifying an ATM-Diffserv Domain

B.9.3.7 Parameter Description: Configuration of ATM Service Class Mapping


Table_Creation
This topic describes the parameters that are related to creation of the ATM service class mapping
table.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1926

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Diffserv domain Management > ATM COS Mapping Configuration
from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Mapping Relation ID

2 to 8

Specifies the ID of the


mapping table.

Mapping Relation Name

Specifies the name of the


mapping relationship.

UBR

BE
AF11
AF12
AF13
AF21
AF22
AF23
AF31
AF32
AF33
AF41
AF42
AF43
EF
CS6
CS7

UBR: BE

Specifies the PHB service


classes that correspond to
different ATM service
types.
l Eight PHB service
classes are available:
BE, AF1, AF2, AF3,
AF4, EF, CS6, and
CS7. The OptiX RTN
980 provides different
QoS policies for the
queues of different
service classes.
l CS6 to CS7: highest
service classes, mainly
applicable to signaling
transmission.
l EF: fast forwarding,
applicable to services
of low transmission
delays and low packet
loss rates.
l AF1 to AF4: assured
forwarding, applicable
to services that require
an assured
transmission rate
rather than delay or
jitter limits.

CBR
RT-VBR
NRT-VBR
UBR+

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

CBR: EF
RT-VBR: AF31
NRT-VBR: AF21
UBR+: AF11
PORT-TRANS: BE

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1927

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
NOTE
The AF1 class includes
three subclasses: AF11,
AF12, and AF13. Only
one of these subclasses
can take effect for one
queue. It is the same
case with AF2, AF3, and
AF4.

PORT-TRANS

l BE: best effort,


applicable to services
that do not require
special processing.

Related Tasks
A.9.9.1 Creating an ATM-DiffServ Domain

B.9.3.8 Parameter Description: ATM Policy Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATM policy management.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > ATM Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the ATM Policy tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1928

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy ID

Displays the policy ID of


the ATM service.

Policy Name

Displays or specifies the


policy name of the ATM
service. The maximum
length of the value is 64
bytes.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1929

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Configuring ATM Traffic


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Type

UBR

UBR

Displays or specifies the


type of the ATM service.

CBR
RT-VBR
NRT-VBR
UBR+

l The UBR service is


characterized by nonreal-time applications
and many bursts. The
UBR service does not
specify traffic-related
service guarantees. To
be specific, the UBR
service only requires
that the network side
provides the service
with the best effort.
The network side does
not provide any
assured QoS for the
UBR service. In the
case of network
congestion, the UBR
cells are discarded
first.
l The CBR service
requires tightly
constrained delay
variation and requires
that data be transmitted
at a constant rate. In
addition, the CBR
service requests a
static amount of
bandwidth and the
highest priority. The
CBR service is
characterized by stable
traffic and few bursts.
l The rt-VBR service
requires tightly
constrained delay and
delay variation.
Compared with the
CBR service, the rtVBR service allows
sources to transmit
data at a rate that varies
with time.
Equivalently, the
sources can be

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1930

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
described as bursty. In
addition, the rt-VBR
service does not
require a static amount
of bandwidth.
l Compared with the rtVBR service, the nrtVBR service does not
require tightly
constrained delay or
delay variation, and is
intended for non-realtime applications.
l The UBR+ service is
supplementary to the
UBR service and is
intended for
applications that
require assured
minimum cell rate,
which is indicated by
the minimum cell rate
(MCR) parameter. The
other characteristics of
the UBR+ service are
the same as the
corresponding
characteristics of the
UBR service.

Traffic Type

Clp01Pcr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Clp01Scr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Clp0Pcr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Clp0Scr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Max. Cell Burst Size


(cell)

2 to 200000

Cell Delay Variation


Tolerance (0.1us)

7 to 13300000

Discard Traffic Frame

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

The Table B-93 lists the


ATM service type, traffic
type descriptor, and the
related traffic parameters.
ATM policies are
configured based on these
mapping relationships.

Displays or specifies the


frame discarding mark in
ATM policies. This
parameter is effective to
AAL5 traffic.

1931

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

UPC/NPC

Enabled

Disabled

Displays or specifies
UPC/NPC.

Disabled

l UPC is user-side
parameter control and
NPC is network-side
parameter control.
l After UPC/NPC is
enabled, the cells with
a frame discarding
mark will be discarded
in network congestion.

Table B-93 Mapping relationship between ATM service types, traffic types, and traffic parameters
ATM
Service
Type

ATM Traffic Type


Descriptor

Traffic
Parameter 1

Traffic
Parameter 2

Traffic
Parameter 3

Traffic
Parameter 4

UBR

NoTrafficDescriptor

NoClpTaggingNoScr

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr

NoClpNoScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

ClpTransparentNoScr

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

ClpNoTaggingNoScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Pcr

ClpTaggingNoScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Pcr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr

NoClpNoScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

NoClpScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Scr

MBS

ClpNoTaggingScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

ClpTaggingScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

ClpTransparentScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Scr

MBS

CDVT

NoClpScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Scr

MBS

CDVT

ClpNoTaggingScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

CDVT

ClpTaggingScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

CDVT

atmnotrafficdescriptormcr

Clp01Mcr

atmnoclpmcr

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Mcr

CBR

nrtVBR

rtVBR

UBR+

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1932

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

ATM
Service
Type

B Parameters Description

ATM Traffic Type


Descriptor

Traffic
Parameter 1

Traffic
Parameter 2

Traffic
Parameter 3

Traffic
Parameter 4

atmnoclpmcrcdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Mcr

CDVT

Parameters for the application object


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

Displays the ID
configured for the ATM
service.

Service Name

Displays the name


configured for the ATM
service.

Link ID

Displays the link ID.

Direction

Displays the direction of


the service.

Related Tasks
A.9.9.4 Modifying an ATM Policy

B.9.3.9 Parameter Description: ATM Policy Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to creation of ATM policies.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > QoS
Management > Policy Management > ATM Policy from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy ID

Specifies the policy ID of


the ATM service. The
policy ID can also be
automatically allocated.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1933

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy Name

Synchronous signal

Synchronous signal

Specifies the policy name


of the ATM service. The
maximum length of the
value is 64 bytes.

Signaling
Voice
Data

NOTE
You can select one of the
five ATM service policy
names from the drop-down
list or enter the policy name.

Video

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1934

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Type

UBR

UBR

Specifies the type of the


ATM service.

CBR
RT-VBR
NRT-VBR
UBR+

l The UBR service is


characterized by nonreal-time applications
and many bursts. The
UBR service does not
specify traffic-related
service guarantees. To
be specific, the UBR
service only requires
that the network side
provides the service
with the best effort.
The network side does
not provide any
assured QoS for the
UBR service. In the
case of network
congestion, the UBR
cells are discarded
first.
l The CBR service
requires tightly
constrained delay
variation and requires
that data be transmitted
at a constant rate. In
addition, the CBR
service requests a
static amount of
bandwidth and the
highest priority. The
CBR service is
characterized by stable
traffic and few bursts.
l The rt-VBR service
requires tightly
constrained delay and
delay variation.
Compared with the
CBR service, the rtVBR service allows
sources to transmit
data at a rate that varies
with time.
Equivalently, the
sources can be
described as bursty. In

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1935

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
addition, the rt-VBR
service does not
require a static amount
of bandwidth.
l Compared with the rtVBR service, the nrtVBR service does not
require tightly
constrained delay or
delay variation, and is
intended for non-realtime applications.
l The UBR+ service is
supplementary to the
UBR service and is
intended for
applications that
require assured
minimum cell rate,
which is indicated by
the minimum cell rate
(MCR) parameter. The
other characteristics of
the UBR+ service are
the same as the
corresponding
characteristics of the
UBR service.

Traffic Type

Clp01Pcr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Clp01Scr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Clp0Pcr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Clp0Scr(cell/s)

90 to 74539

Max. Cell Burst Size


(cell)

2 to 200000

Cell Delay Variation


Tolerance (0.1us)

7 to 13300000

Discard Traffic Frame

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

For the mapping


relationships between
ATM service types, ATM
traffic type descriptors,
and traffic parameters, see
Table B-94. ATM
policies are configured
based on these mapping
relationships.

Specifies the frame


discarding mark in ATM
policies. This parameter is
effective to AAL5 traffic.

1936

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

UPC/NPC

Enabled

Disabled

l UPC is user-side
parameter control and
NPC is network-side
parameter control.

Disabled

l After UPC/NPC is
enabled, the cells with
a frame discarding
mark will be discarded
in network congestion.

Table B-94 Mapping relationship between ATM service types, ATM traffic types, and traffic parameters
ATM
Service
Type

ATM Traffic Type


Descriptor

Traffic
Parameter 1

Traffic
Parameter 2

Traffic
Parameter 3

Traffic
Parameter 4

UBR

NoTrafficDescriptor

NoClpTaggingNoScr

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr

NoClpNoScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

ClpTransparentNoScr

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

ClpNoTaggingNoScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Pcr

ClpTaggingNoScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Pcr

NoClpNoScr

Clp01Pcr

NoClpNoScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

CDVT

NoClpScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Scr

MBS

ClpNoTaggingScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

ClpTaggingScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

ClpTransparentScr

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Scr

MBS

CDVT

NoClpScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Scr

MBS

CDVT

ClpNoTaggingScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

CDVT

ClpTaggingScrCdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp0Scr

MBS

CDVT

atmnotrafficdescriptormcr

Clp01Mcr

atmnoclpmcr

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Mcr

atmnoclpmcrcdvt

Clp01Pcr

Clp01Mcr

CDVT

CBR

nrtVBR

rtVBR

UBR+

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1937

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.9.9.3 Creating an ATM Policy

B.9.3.10 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management


This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATM service management.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

Displays the service ID.

Service Name

Displays or specifies the


service name.

Service Type

Displays the ATM service


type.

Deployment Status

Displays the deployment


status of the ATM service.

Connection Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Connection ID

Displays the connection


ID of the ATM service.

Connection Name

Displays or specifies the


connection name of the
ATM service.

Source Port

Displays the source port of


the ATM service.

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries ATM PWE3
services, if any.

Sink Port

Displays the sink board of


the ATM service.

Source VPI

Displays the VPI of the


source port of the ATM
service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1938

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source VCI

Displays the VCI of the


source port of the ATM
service.

Sink VPI

Displays the VPI of the


sink port of the ATM
service.

Sink VCI

Displays the VCI of the


sink port of the ATM
service.

Uplink Policy

Displays the QoS policy of


the uplink ATM
connection.

Down link Policy

Displays the QoS policy of


the downlink ATM
connection.

Parameters for Port Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port of the


ATM IMA service.

Port Type

Displays the port type of


the ATM IMA service.

Max. VPI

Displays the maximum


VPI.

Max. VCI

Displays the maximum


VCI.

VCC-Supported VPI
Count

Displays the count of VPIs


that are used for VC
exchange.

Parameters for Bound Paths


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

VCTRUNK

Displays the VCTRUNK.

Level

Displays the level of


bound paths.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1939

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Direction

Displays the direction of


bound paths. The fixed
value is bidirectional.

Bound Paths

Displays the bound paths.

Number of Bound Paths

Displays the number of


bound paths.

IMA Group Status

Displays the status of the


IMA group.

Parameters of PWs
Tab

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

General
Attributes

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

Work Status

Displays the working


status of a PW.

Displays whether a PW
is enabled.

Displays the PW
signaling type.

PW Signaling Type

NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 uses
static PWs only.

PW Type

l Displays the
configured PW type.
l This parameter
corresponds to the
connection type.
The encapsulation
type can be 1:1 or N:
1 if the connection
type is PVP or PVC.

PW Direction

Displays the direction


of the PW.

PW Encapsulation
Type

Displays the
encapsulation type of
the packets on the PW.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980 uses
MPLS only.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Displays the configured


PW Ingress label.
1940

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Tab

QoS

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Outgoing
Label / Sink Port

Displays the configured


PW Egress label.

Peer LSR ID

Displays the LSR ID of


the destination.

Tunnel Type

Displays the type of the


tunnel.

Ingress Tunnel No

Displays the tunnel ID


of the ingress tunnel.

Egress Tunnel No

Displays the tunnel ID


of the egress tunnel.

Local Operating
Status

Displays the local


running status of PW.

Remote Operating
Status

Displays the remote


running status of PW.

Overall Operating
Status

Displays the
comprehensive
working status of the
PW.

Tunnel for Auto


Selection

Displays the tunnel that


is automatically
selected.

PW ID

Displays the PW ID.

Direction

Displays the direction


of the PW.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1941

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Tab

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Displays or specifies
whether the bandwidth
limit is enabled.
l This function can be
used to limit the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs, or the
bandwidth of one or
more ATM PWE3
services, in an
MPLS tunnel. (One
ATM PWE3 service
corresponds to one
PW.)
l An ATM PWE3
service corresponds
to a PW. Therefore,
this function can
also limit the
bandwidth of ATM
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.

CIR (Kbit/s)

Displays or specifies
the committed
information rate.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS (kbyte)

Displays or specifies
the excess burst size of
the PW.

PIR (kbit/s)

Displays or specifies
the peak information
rate.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS (kbyte)

Displays or specifies
the maximum excess
burst size of the PW.

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980


does not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1942

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Tab

Advanced
Attributes

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980


does not support this
parameter.

Control Word

Must Use

Displays or specifies
whether to use the
control word. In the
MPLS packet switching
network, the control
word is used to transmit
packet information.

l Displays or
specifies the mode
of PW connectivity
check.

No Use

Control Channel
Type

CW
None
Alert Label

l The value None


indicates that the
control word is not
supported. That is,
the PW connectivity
check is not
supported.
l The value CW
indicates that the
control word is
supported.
l The value Alert
Label indicates
VCCV packets in
Alert Label
encapsulation
mode.
VCCV Verification
Mode

Ping

None

l Displays or
specifies the VCCV
verification mode.
The VCCV
verification is used
for PW connectivity
check.
l If the VCCV-ping
function is required,
do not set VCCV
Verification Mode
of PWs to None.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1943

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Tab

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Max. Concatenated
Cell Count

1 to 31

l Displays or
specifies the
maximum number
of concatenated
cells.
l If the value 1 is
assumed, only one
ATM cell is
encapsulated in one
packet. If the value
from 2 to 31 is
assumed, a
maximum of 2 to 31
ATM cells are
encapsulated into
one packet.

Packet Loading
Time (us)

100 to 50000

l Displays or
specifies the packet
loading time. Once
the packet loading
time expires, the
packet is sent out
even if the
concatenated cells
are less than the
maximum.
l If Max.
Concatenated Cell
Count assumes the
value 1, this
parameter is
ineffective. That is,
the packet will be
sent out once the cell
is loaded.

Parameters for CoS Mapping


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries the service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1944

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CoS Mapping

Specifies the policy for


mapping different ATM
service levels to CoS
priorities. By setting this
parameter, different
quality measures are
provided for different
ATM services.

Protection Group Parameters (PW APS)


NOTE

The following parameters are available only after the PW APS protection group is configured.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Group ID

Displays the ID of the


protection group to be
created.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Enabling Status

Enabled

l Displays or specifies
the enabling status of
the PW protection
group.

Disabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Switchover Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supporting dual-ended
switching.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1945

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Restoration Mode

Non-revertive

l Specifies whether to
switch services to the
original working PW
after the fault is
rectified.

Revertive

l The value Revertive


indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.
Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Displays or specifies
the WTR time of the
protection group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Displays or specifies
the hold-off time of the
protection group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1946

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Deployment Status

Display the deployment


status of the protection
group.

Switchover Status

Displays the switchover


status of the protection
group.

Protocol Status

Displays the enabling


status of the protocol.

Working Path Status

Displays the status of the


current working path.

Protection Path Status

Display the status of the


current protection path.

Related Tasks
A.9.8.2 Modifying ATM Service Parameters
A.9.8.3 Querying ATM Services

B.9.3.11 Parameter Description: ATM Service Management_Creation


This topic describes the parameters that are related to creation of ATM services.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
Service Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service ID

1 to 4294967295

Specifies the service ID.

Service Name

Specifies the service


name.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1947

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Service Type

UNIs-NNI

UNIs-NNI

l Specifies the type of


the ATM service.

UNI-UNI

l UNIs-NNI: This value


applies to ATM PWE3
services. The attributes
in Connection, PW,
and CoS Mapping
need to be configured.
l UNI-UNI: This value
applies to common
ATM services. Only
the attributes in
Connection need to be
configured.
Connection Type

PVC

PVC

PVP
Transparent

Specifies the connection


type of the ATM service.
For common ATM
services (UNI-UNI):
l PVP: Only the VPIs of
the source and sink are
exchanged.
l PVC: The VPIs and
VCIs of the source and
sink are exchanged.
For ATM PWE3 services
(UNIs-NNI):
l PVP: This value
applies to the N-to-1/1to-1 VPC
encapsulation mode.
l PVC: This value
applies to the N-to-1/1to-1 VCC
encapsulation mode.
For transparently
transmitted ATM
services, set Connection
Type to Transparent.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1948

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

No Protection

No Protection

l Specifies the
protection mode of the
PW. This parameter is
available only when
Service Type is UNIsNNI.

PW APS
Slave Protection Pair

l Set this parameter


according to the
network plan.

Connection Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Connection Name

Specifies the name of the


ATM connection.

Source Board

Specifies the source board


of the ATM service.

Source Port

Specifies the source port


of the ATM service.

Source VPI(eg.35,36-39)

UNI: 0 to 255

Specifies the VPI of the


source port of the ATM
service.

NNI: 0 to 4095
Source VCI(eg.35,36-39)

32 to 65535

Specifies the VCI of the


source port of the ATM
service.

PW ID

1 to 4294967295

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

Sink Board

Specifies the sink board of


the ATM service.

Sink Port

Specifies the sink board of


the ATM service.
NOTE
This parameter does not
need to be set if Service
Type is UNIs-NNI. This
parameter needs to be set if
Service Type is UNI-UNI
and the value must be
different from that of the
source board.

Sink VPI(eg.35,36-39)

UNI: 0 to 255

NNI: 0 to 4095

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Specifies the VPI of the


sink port of the ATM
service.
1949

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Sink VCI(eg.35,36-39)

32 to 65535

Specifies the VCI of the


sink port of the ATM
service.

Uplink Policy

Specifies the QoS policy


of the uplink ATM
connection.

Down link Policy

Specifies the QoS policy


of the downlink ATM
connection.

Parameters of PWs
NOTE

If the parameter Protection Type of PWs is set to PW APS, all the parameters of working and protection PWs
need to be configured. This section considers the parameters of the working PW as an example.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Specifies the ID of the PW


that carries services.

Working Status

Displays the working


status of the PW.
NOTE
This parameter is available
only after the PW
parameters are configured.

Enable Status

Displays the enabling


status of the PW.
NOTE
This parameter is available
only after the PW
parameters are configured.

PW Signaling Type

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Static

Static

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Labels for static PWs need


to be manually assigned.

1950

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW Type

The ATM connection type


is PVC:

The ATM connection type


is PVC:

l Specifies the type of


the PW.

l ATM n-to-one VCC


cell transport

ATM n-to-one VCC cell


transport

l ATM one-to-one VCC


Cell Mode

The ATM connection type


is PVP:

l In the case of ATM


1_to_1 encapsulation,
one PW carries one
VPC or VCC.

The ATM connection type


is PVP:

ATM n-to-one VPC cell


transport

l In the case of ATM


n_to_1 encapsulation,
one PW carries one or
more VPCs or VCCs.

l ATM n-to-one VPC


cell transport
l ATM one-to-one VPC
Cell Mode
PW Direction

Bidirectional

Bidirectional

Displays the direction of


the PW.

PW Encapsulation Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the
encapsulation type of the
packets on the PW.

PW Ingress Label /
Source Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Ingress


label.

PW Egress Label / Sink


Port

16 to 1048575

Specifies the PW Egress


label.

Tunnel Selection Mode

Manually

Manually

Displays the method to


select tunnels.

Tunnel Type

MPLS

MPLS

Displays the type of the


tunnel that carries the PW.

Tunnel

A tunnel needs to be
selected. If no tunnel is
available, creation of a
PW will fail.

Peer LSR ID

Specifies the LSR ID of


the PW at the remote end.
If an existing tunnel is
selected, the LSR ID will
be automatically assigned.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1951

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

QoS Parameters
Table B-95 ATM services
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Bandwidth Limit

Specifies whether the


bandwidth limit is
enabled.
l This function can be
used to limit the
bandwidth of one or
more PWs, or the
bandwidth of one or
more ATM PWE3
services, in an MPLS
tunnel. (One ATM
PWE3 service
corresponds to one
PW.)
l An ATM PWE3
service corresponds to
a PW. Therefore, this
function can also limit
the bandwidth of ATM
PWE3 services in an
MPLS tunnel.

Policy

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

CIR (Kbit/s)

Specifies the committed


information rate (CIR) of
the PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as PIR.

CBS (kbyte)

Specifies the excess burst


size of the PW.

PIR (kbit/s)

Specifies the peak


information rate (PIR) of
the PW.
It is recommended that
you set this parameter to
the same value as CIR.

PBS (kbyte)

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Specifies the maximum


excess burst size of the
PW.

1952

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

EXP

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this parameter.

Parameters of Advanced Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Control Word

Must Use

Must Use

l Specifies whether to
use the control word.
In the MPLS packet
switching network, the
control word is used to
transmit packet
information.

No Use

l Set Control Word to


Must Use if PW
Type is ATM 1:1.
Control Channel Type

CW

CW

None
Alert Label

l Specifies the mode of


PW connectivity
check.
l The value None
indicates that the
control word is not
supported. That is, the
PW connectivity check
is not supported.
l The value CW
indicates that the
control word is
supported.
l The value Alert
Label indicates VCCV
packets in Alert
Label encapsulation
mode.

VCCV Verification
Mode

Ping

Ping

None

l Specifies the VCCV


verification mode. The
VCCV verification is
used for PW
connectivity check.
l If the VCCV-Ping test
is required, do not set
this parameter to
None.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1953

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Max. Concatenated Cell


Count

1 to 31

10

l Specifies the
maximum number of
concatenated cells.
l If the value 1 is
assumed, only one
ATM cell is
encapsulated in one
packet. If the value
from 2 to 31 is
assumed, a maximum
of 2 to 31 ATM cells
are encapsulated into
one packet.

Packet Loading Time


(us)

100 to 50000

1000

l Specifies the packet


loading time. Once the
packet loading time
expires, the packet is
sent out even if the
concatenated cells are
less than the
maximum.
l If Max. Concatenated
Cell Count assumes
the value 1, this
parameter is
ineffective. That is, the
packet will be sent out
once the cell is loaded.

Protection Group Parameters (PW APS)


NOTE

The parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of PWs is set to
PW APS.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Type

Specifies the protection


type.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the protection


group ID.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1954

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Enabling Status

Disabled

Disabled

l Specifies the enabling


status of the PW
protection group.

Enabled

l During the creation of


a protection group, set
Enabling Status to
Disabled. After the
APS protection group
is configured at both
ends, set Enabling
Status to Enabled.
Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports 1:1 protection
mode.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW.

Switching Mode

Displays the switching


mode to be used when a
PW fails.
NOTE
The OptiX RTN 980
supports dual-ended
switching.

Revertive Mode

Non-revertive

Revertive

Revertive

l This parameter
specifies whether to
switch services back to
the original working
PW after it recovers.
l The value Revertive
indicates that services
are switched to the
original working PW
and the value Nonrevertive indicates
that services are not
switched to the
original working PW.
l The value Revertive is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1955

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Switchover Restoration
Time(min)

1 to 12

l Specifies the WTR


time of the protection
group.
l When the preset WTR
time expires after the
original working PW
recovers, services are
switched to the
original working PW.
l This parameter is
available only when
Restoration Mode is
Revertive.
l The default value is
recommended.

Switchover Delay Time


(100ms)

0 to 100

l Specifies the hold-off


time of the protection
group.
l If this parameter is set
to a value other than 0,
the protection group
does not trigger
switching once it
detects faults, but waits
until the hold-off time
expires, and then
detects whether any
faults persist. If any
faults persist, the
switching is triggered;
otherwise, no
switching is triggered.
l The default value is
recommended.

Detection mode

Displays the detection


mode of the PW APS
protection group.

OAM Parameters
NOTE

l The OAM parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of
PWs is set to PW APS.
l To configure PW OAM parameters, choose Configuration > MPLS Management > PW Management >
PW OAM Parameter from the Function Tree.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1956

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

OAM Status

Displays the enabling


status of PW OAM.

Detection Mode

Auto-Sensing

Auto-Sensing

l Specifies the detection


mode of OAM packets.

Manual

l Manual: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval specified
by the user.
l Auto-Sensing: The
connectivity check
(CC) packets are sent
at the interval of
receiving PW OAM
packets.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, you
need to set the PW
OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value AutoSensing is
recommended.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1957

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Detection Packet Type

CV

CV

l CV: The detection


packets are sent at a
fixed interval.

FFD

l FFD: The detection


packets are sent at the
interval specified by
the user.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Auto-Sensing,
this parameter
specifies the PW OAM
detection packets to be
transmitted.
l If Detection Mode is
set to Manual, this
parameter specifies the
PW OAM detection
packets to be received
and transmitted.
l The value FFD is
assumed for PW APS
and the value CV is
assumed for
continuous
connectivity check on
PWs.
Detection Packet Period
(ms)

3.3

50

10

l Specifies the period of


detection packets.
l This parameter is
configurable when
Detection Packet
Type is FFD and
assumes the fixed
value of 1000 when
Detection Packet
Type is CV.

20
50
100
200
500

l Set this parameter to


3.3 for PW APS.
LSR ID to be Received

Specifies the LSR ID to be


received.

PW ID to be Received

Specifies the PW ID to be
received.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1958

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Protection Group Parameters (Slave Protection Pair)


NOTE

The parameters of the PW APS protection group need to be configured if the Protection Type of PWs is set to
Slave Protection Pair.

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Mode

Displays the protection


mode.

Protection Group ID

Specifies the ID of the


slave protection pair. The
switching of the master
PW APS protection group
triggers the switching of
the slave PW APS
protection group
simultaneously.

Working PW ID

Displays the ID of the


working PW in the slave
protection pair.

Protection PW ID

Displays the ID of the


protection PW in the slave
protection pair.

Parameters for CoS Mapping


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

PW ID

Displays the ID of the PW


that carries service.

CoS Mapping

Specifies the policy for


mapping different ATM
service levels to CoS
priorities. By setting this
parameter, different
quality measures are
provided for different
ATM services.

Related Tasks
A.9.8.1 Creating ATM Services

B.9.3.12 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_Segment and End


Attributes
This topic describes the parameters that are related to segment end attributes of ATM OAM.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1959

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Segment End Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source

Displays the source node


of the ATM/IMA service.

Sink

Displays the sink node of


the ATM/IMA service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1960

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Connection Direction

Source

Displays the direction of


the ATM connection.

Sink

l Source: indicates the


forward direction.
For common ATM
services (UNIUNI), Source
indicates the
direction from the
source end to the
sink end of the
ATM connection.
For ATM PWE3
services (UNINNI), Source
indicates the
direction from the
UNI port side to the
MPLS interface
side.
l Sink: indicates the
backward direction.
For common ATM
services (UNIUNI), Sink
indicates the
direction from the
sink end to the
source end of the
ATM connection.
For ATM PWE3
services (UNINNI), Sink
indicates the
direction from the
MPLS interface
side to the UNI port
side.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1961

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Segment and End


Attribute

Non segment and


Endpoint

Non segment and


Endpoint

Specifies the segment and


end attributes of the source
and sink of the ATM
connection.

Segment point
Endpoint
Segment and Endpoint

l Non segment and


endpoint: intermediate
point, which refers to
the OAM node
between two segment
points or two end
points. Therefore,
intermediate points
can be further
classified into
intermediate points
between segment
points, and
intermediate points
between end points.
Upon detecting a
fault, an
intermediate point
reports the
corresponding
alarms and inserts
segment AIS cells
and end AIS cells to
the downstream.
Afterwards, the
intermediate point
periodically sends
these cells.
An intermediate
point does not catch
any AIS/RDI cells.
l Segment point: an end
point of a segment.
One ATM link consists
of multiple segments.
Upon detecting a
fault, a segment
point reports the
corresponding
alarms and inserts
end AIS cells to the
downstream.
Afterwards, the
segment point

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1962

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
periodically sends
these cells.
A segment point
catches segment
AIS/RDI cells
only.
l End point: an end point
of an ATM link. It is
usually an edge point
on the ATM network.
Upon detecting a
fault, an end point
reports the
corresponding
alarms but does not
insert any AIS
cells.
An end point
catches end AIS/
RDI cells only.
l Segment and endpoint:
a segment-end point,
or an edge point of a
segment and an end.
Upon detecting a
fault, a segmentend point reports
the corresponding
alarms but does not
insert any AIS
cells.
A segment-end
point catches the
AIS/RDI cells of a
segment and an
end.

Related Tasks
A.9.10.1 Setting Segment and End Attributes of AIS/RDI

B.9.3.13 Parameter Description: ATM OMA Management_CC Activation Status


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the CC activation status of ATM OAM.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1963

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the CC Activation Status tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source

Displays the source node


of the ATM/IMA service.

Sink

Displays the sink node of


the ATM/IMA service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1964

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Connection Direction

Source

Specifies the connection


direction.

Sink

l Source: indicates the


forward direction.
For common ATM
services (UNIUNI), Source
indicates the
direction from the
source end to the
sink end of the
ATM connection.
For ATM PWE3
services (UNINNI), Source
indicates the
direction from the
UNI port side to the
MPLS interface
side.
l Sink: indicates the
backward direction.
For common ATM
services (UNIUNI), Sink
indicates the
direction from the
sink end to the
source end of the
ATM connection.
For ATM PWE3
services (UNINNI), Sink
indicates the
direction from the
MPLS interface
side to the UNI port
side.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1965

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Segment and End


Attribute

Specifies the segment and


end attributes of nodes.
l Segment point: an end
point of a segment.
One ATM link consists
of multiple segments.
Segment CC cells are
terminated at segment
points.
l End point: an end point
of an ATM link. It is
usually an edge point
on an ATM network.
End-to-end CC cells
are terminated at end
points.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1966

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

CC Activate Flag

Deactivate

l Specifies the CC
activation flag.

Source activate
Sink activate
Source + sink activate

l Deactivate: This node


does not transmit or
receive CC cells.
l Source activate: This
point transmits but
does not receive CC
cells.
l Sink activate: This
point receives but does
not transmit CC cells.
If this point does not
receive any service
cells or CC cells within
a time interval of 3.5
(0.5) seconds, it will
report the LOC alarm
and transmit AIS cells
in the forward
direction.
l Source + sink activate:
This node transmits
and receives CC cells.
If this point does not
receive any service
cells or CC cells within
a time interval of 3.5
(0.5) seconds, it will
report the LOC alarm
and transmit AIS cells
in the forward
direction.
l Once the node receives
any CC cells or service
cells, the LOC alarm
will be cleared.

Related Tasks
A.9.10.2 Performing a Continuity Check Test

B.9.3.14 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_Remote End Loopback


Status
This topic describes the parameters that are related to the remote end loopback status of ATM
OAM.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1967

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Remote Loopback Test tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Source

Displays the source node


of the ATM/IMA service.

Sink

Displays the sink node of


the ATM/IMA service.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1968

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Connection Direction

Source

Displays the direction of


the ATM connection.

Sink

l Source: indicates the


forward direction.
For common ATM
services (UNIUNI), Source
indicates the
direction from the
source end to the
sink end of the
ATM connection.
For ATM PWE3
services (UNINNI), Source
indicates the
direction from the
UNI port side to the
MPLS interface
side.
l Sink: indicates the
backward direction.
For common ATM
services (UNIUNI), Sink
indicates the
direction from the
sink end to the
source end of the
ATM connection.
For ATM PWE3
services (UNINNI), Sink
indicates the
direction from the
MPLS interface
side to the UNI port
side.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1969

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Segment and End


Attribute

Specifies the segment and


end attribute.
l Segment LB cells are
looped back only at a
Segment point,
Segment and
Endpoint, or Non
segment and
Endpoint.
l End-to-end LB cells
are looped back only at
an Endpoint or
Segment and
Endpoint.

Loopback Point NE

l Specifies the NE
where the loopback
point is located.
l Before an end-to-end
LB test, you need to set
end points in the test
domain. After the test,
remove the end points.
l Before a segment-tosegment LB test, you
need to set segment
points in the test
domain. After the test,
remove the segment
points.

Test Result

Displays whether the


loopback command is
successfully issued.

Related Tasks
A.9.10.4 Performing an LB Test

B.9.3.15 Parameter Description: ATM OAM Management_LLID


This topic describes the parameters that are related to LLID configuration.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > ATM
OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the LLID tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1970

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Country Code
(Hexadecimal Code)

00 00

Displays or specifies the


country code of the ATM
service. The value is 2
bytes in length.

Network Code
(Hexadecimal Code)

00 01

Displays or specifies the


network code of the ATM
service. The value is 2
bytes in length.

NE Code (Hexadecimal
Code)

00 30 00 04 00 00 00 00 00
00 00

l Displays or specifies
the NE code of the
ATM service. The
value is 11 bytes in
length.
l The default NE code
can be used if it is
unique on the network.
l NE code and NE ID are
associated. Therefore,
each NE on the
network has a unique
NE code.

Related Tasks
A.9.10.3 Querying or Setting LLIDs

B.10 Clock Parameters


This topic describes the parameters that are related to clocks.

B.10.1 Physical Clock Parameters


This topic describes physical clock parameters.

B.10.1.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the priority table of a clock source.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Source Priority.

2.

Click the System Clock Source Priority List tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1971

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Source

l External clock source


1 indicates the external
clock source at the
CLK/TOD1 port on
the CSHN board in
physical slot 15.
External clock source
2 indicates the external
clock source at the
CLK/TOD1 port on
the CSHN board in
physical slot 20.
l The internal clock
source is always at the
lowest priority and
indicates that the NE
works in the free-run
mode.
l The clock sources and
the corresponding
clock source priority
levels are determined
according to the clock
synchronization
schemes.

External Clock Source


Mode

2 Mbit/s

2Mbit/s

2 MHz

l This parameter
indicates the type of
the external clock
source signal.
l This parameter is set
according to the
external clock signal.
In normal cases, the
external clock signal is
a 2 Mbit/s signal.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1972

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Synchronous Status Byte

SA4 to SA8

SA4

l This parameter is valid


only when External
Clock Source Mode is
set to 2Mbit/s.
l This parameter
indicates which bit of
the TS0 in odd frames
of the external clock
signal is used to
transmit the SSM.
l This parameter needs
to be set only when the
SSM or extended SSM
is enabled. In normal
cases, the external
clock sources use the
SA4 to transmit the
SSM.

Clock Source Priority


Sequence (Highest: 1)

Displays the priority


sequence of clock sources.
1 indicates the highest
clock source priority.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.1 Configuring the Clock Sources

B.10.1.2 Parameter Description: Priority Table for the PLL Clock Source of the
External Clock Port
This topic describes the parameters that are related to the priority table for the phase-locked loop
(PLL) clock source of the external clock port.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and then choose Configuration >
Clock > Physical Clock > Clock Source Priority from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Priority for PLL Clock Sources of 1st External Output tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1973

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for configuring the priority table for the PLL clock source of the external
clock port
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Source

Internal Clock Source

l When the PLL clock


source of the external
clock port extracts the
system clock (namely,
the local clock of the
NE), Clock Source
takes its default value
Internal Clock
Source. In this case,
no manual
configuration is
required.
l When the PLL clock
source of the external
clock port needs to
extract the clock from
an SDH line board,
clock from a radio link,
clock from a PDH
tributary board, or
synchronous Ethernet
clock, set Clock
Source to the
corresponding clock
source according to the
network planning
information.

Current Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Displays the valid status


of clock sources.

1974

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Lock Status

l The PLL clock source


of the external clock
port extracts only an
unlocked clock source.
l If a clock source is in
locked state, the PLL
clock source of the
external clock port
does not extract the
clock source until the
clock source is
changed from the
locked state to the
unlocked state.
l The internal clock
source should not be in
locked state.

Clock Source Priority


(Highest: 1)

Displays the priority level


of a clock source. 1 is the
highest priority.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.7 Configuring Clock Sources for External Clock Output

B.10.1.3 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Subnet


This topic describes the parameters that are related to a clock subnet.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.

2.

Click the Clock Subnet tab.

Parameters for Setting a Clock Subnet


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Affiliated Subnet

The OptiX RTN 980 does


not support this
parameter.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1975

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Protection Status

Start Extended SSM


Protocol

Stop SSM Protocol

l The SSM protocol is a


scheme used for
synchronous
management on an
SDH network and
indicates that the SSM
is passed by the lower
four bits of the S1 byte
and can be exchanged
between the nodes.
The SSM protocol
ensures that the
equipment
automatically selects
the clock source of the
highest quality and
highest priority, thus
preventing mutual
clock tracing.

Start Standard SSM


Protocol
Stop SSM Protocol

l After the standard


SSM protocol is
started, the NE first
performs the
protection switching
on the clock source
according to the clock
quality level
information provided
by the S1 byte. If the
quality level of the
clock source is the
same, the NE then
performs the
protection switching
according to the clock
priority table. That is,
the NE selects an
unlocked clock source
that is of the highest
quality and highest
priority from all the
current available clock
sources as the clock
source to be
synchronized and
traced by the local
station.
l If the SSM protocol is
stopped, it indicates

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1976

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
that the S1 byte is not
used. The NE selects
and switches a clock
source only according
to the sequence
specified in the
priority table. The
clock source of the
highest priority is used
as the clock source to
be traced.
l After the SSM
protocol is stopped,
each NE performs the
protection switching
on the clock according
to the preset priority
table of the clock
source only when the
clock source of a
higher priority is lost.

Clock Source

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

This parameter indicates


the clock source that is
configured for an NE. In
Clock Source Priority,
you can set whether to add
or delete a clock source.

1977

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Source ID

(None)

(None)

l This parameter is valid


only when the
extended SSM
protocol is started.

1 to 15

l Clock source IDs are


allocated for the
following clock
sources only:
External clock
source
Internal clock
source of the node
that accesses the
external clock
sources
Internal clock
source of the joint
node of a ring and a
chain or the joint
node of two rings
Line clock source
that enters the ring
when the intra-ring
line clock source is
configured at the
joint node of a ring
and a chain or the
joint node of two
rings

Related Tasks
A.10.1.2 Configuring Clock Subnets

B.10.1.4 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Quality


This topic describes the parameters that are related clock quality.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.

2.

Click the Received Quality tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1978

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Clock Source Quality


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Source

This parameter indicates


the name of the
configured clock source.
In Clock Source
Priority, you can set
whether to add or delete a
clock source.

Configured Quality

Unknown
Synchronization Quality

Automatic Extraction

This parameter specifies


the quality level that is
configured for the clock
source. This function is
required only in a special
scenario or in a test.
Generally, this parameter
need not be set.

This parameter indicates


the clock source quality
signal received by the NE.
The NE extracts the clock
source quality signal from
the S1 byte of each clock
source.

G.811 Clock Signal


G.812 Transit Clock
Signal
G.812 Local Clock Signal
G.813 SDH Equipment
Timing Source (SETS)
Signal
Do Not Use For
Synchronization
Automatic Extraction
Received Quality

Parameters for Manual Setting of 0 Quality Level


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Name

This parameter indicates


the name of the NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1979

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Quality Level 0

Do Not Use For


Synchronization

Do Not Use For


Synchronization

This parameter specifies


the clock quality whose
level is manually set to
zero.

G.811 Reference Clock


Between G.811 Reference
Clock and G.812 Transit
Clock
G.812 Transit Clock
Between G.812 Transit
Clock and G.812 Local
Clock
G.812 Local Clock
Between G.812 Local
Clock and synchronous
equipment timing source
(SETS)
SETS Clock
Between synchronous
equipment timing source
(SETS) and quality
unavailable

l Do Not Use For


Synchronization: the
notification
information in the
reverse direction of the
selected
synchronization clock
source to avoid direct
mutual locking of
adjacent NEs.
l G.811 Reference
Clock: the clock signal
specified in ITU-T G.
811.
l Between G.811
Reference Clock and
G.812 Transit Clock:
lower than the quality
level of the clock
signal specified in
ITU-T G.811 but
higher than the quality
level of the transit
exchange clock signal
specified in ITU-T G.
812.
l G.812 Transit Clock:
the transit exchange
clock signal specified
in ITU-T G.812.
l Between G.812
Transit Clock and G.
812 Local Clock:
lower than the quality
level of the transit
exchange clock signal
specified in ITU-T G.
812 but higher than the
quality level of the
local exchange clock
signal specified in
ITU-T G.812.
l G.812 Local Clock:
the local exchange

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1980

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
clock signal specified
in ITU-T G.812.
l Between G.812 Local
Clock and
synchronous
equipment timing
source (SETS): lower
than the quality level
of the local exchange
clock signal specified
in ITU-T G.812 but
higher than the quality
level of the clock
signal of the SETS.
l SETS Clock: the clock
signal of the SETS.
l Between synchronous
equipment timing
source (SETS) and
quality unavailable:
lower than the quality
level of the clock
signal of the SETS but
higher than the quality
level unavailable in the
synchronous timing
source.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.3 User-Defined Clock Quality

B.10.1.5 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_SSM Output Control


This topic describes the parameters that are related to SSM output control.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.

2.

Click the SSM Output tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1981

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Line Port

l This parameter
indicates the name of
the line clock port.
l Line Port: indicates
the SSM quality
information output
port of the current
available line clock
source and the external
clock source. This
output port can
transmit the quality
information of the
clock source by
outputting the S1 byte
to the downstream NE.

Output S1 Byte Info

Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

l Output S1 Byte Info


is valid only when the
SSM protocol or the
extended SSM
protocol is started.
l Output S1 Byte Info
indicates whether the
SSM is output at the
line port.
l When the line port is
connected to an NE in
the same clock subnet,
set Output S1 Byte
Info to Enabled.
Otherwise, set this
parameter to
Disabled.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.4 Configuring the SSM Output Status

B.10.1.6 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_Clock ID Enabling Status


This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the clock ID function.

Navigation Path
1.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1982

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

2.

B Parameters Description

Click the Clock ID Output tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Line Port

l This parameter
indicates the name of
the line clock port.
l Line Port: indicates
the SSM quality
information output
port of the current
available line clock
source and the external
clock source. This
output port can
transmit the quality
information of the
clock source by
outputting the S1 byte
to the downstream NE.

Enabled

Output Clock ID

Enabled

Disabled

l Output Clock ID is
valid only when the
extended SSM
protocol is started.
l Output Clock ID
indicates whether the
clock source ID is
output at the line port.
l If the line ports are
connected to the NEs
in the same clock
subnet and if the
extended SSM
protocol is started on
the opposite NE,
Output Clock ID is
set to Enabled.
Otherwise, this
parameter is set to
Disabled.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.5 Configuring the Clock ID Output Status

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1983

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.10.1.7 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Restoration


Parameters
This topic describes the parameters that are related to clock source restoration.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Clock Source Switching.

2.

Click the Clock Source Reversion tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Name

This parameter indicates


the name of the NE.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1984

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Higher Priority Clock


Source Reversion

Auto-Revertive

Auto-Revertive

l When the quality of a


higher-priority clock
source degrades, the
NE automatically
switches the clock
source to a lowerpriority clock source.
If this parameter is set
to Auto-Revertive,
the NE automatically
switches the clock
source to the higherpriority clock source
when this higherpriority clock source
restores. If this
parameter is set to
Non-Revertive, the
NE does not
automatically switch
the clock source to the
higher-priority clock
source when this
higher-priority clock
source restores.

Non-Revertive

l Correct setting of
Clock Source
Switching Condition
ensures the reliability
of the clock source
switching. To improve
the clock quality,
select AutoRevertive. Otherwise,
to prevent jitter of the
clock, generally, it is
recommended that you
set this parameter to
Non-Revertive.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1985

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Source WTR


Time(min.)

0 to 12

l This parameter
specifies the duration
from the time when the
clock source
restoration is detected
to the time when the
clock source switching
is triggered. This
parameter is used to
avoid frequent
switching of the clock
source due to
instability of the clock
source state within a
short time.
l This parameter is valid
only when Higher
Priority Clock
Source Reversion is
set to AutoRevertive.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.9 Modifying the Recovery Parameter of the Clock Source

B.10.1.8 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the switching status of a clock source.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Source Switching.

2.

Click the Clock Source Switching tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Source

This parameter indicates


the name of the clock
source.

Current Status

Valid

This parameter indicates


whether the clock source
is valid.

Invalid

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1986

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Lock Status

Lock

l This parameter
specifies the locking
status of the clock
source in the priority
table.

Unlock

l Lock: A clock source


in the priority table is
in the locked state. The
clock source in the
locked state cannot be
switched.
l Unlock: A clock
source in the priority
table is in the unlocked
state. The clock source
in the unlocked state
can be switched.
Switching Source

This parameter indicates


the clock source to be
traced by the NE after the
switching.

Switching Status

Normal

This parameter indicates


the switching status of the
current clock source.

Manual Switching
Forced Switching

B.10.1.9 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching


Conditions
This section describes the parameters that are related to the switching conditions of clock sources.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Clock > Clock Source Switching from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Clock Source Switching Conditions tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Name

Displays the name of the


NE.

Clock Source

Displays the clock source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1987

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

AIS Alarm

Yes

No

l The default value is


recommended.

No

l When this parameter is


set to Yes, it indicates
that clock source
switching occurs if the
clock source reports
the AIS alarm.
l When this parameter is
set to No, it indicates
that no clock source
switching occurs if the
clock source reports
the AIS alarm.
B1 BER ThresholdCrossing

The parameter is invalid.

RLOS,RLOF and OOF/


RLOC Alarms

Yes

Yes

This parameter indicates


that clock switching
occurs when the clock
source reports the RLOS,
RLOF, OOF, or LOC
alarm.

CV Threshold-Crossing

The parameter is invalid.

CV Threshold

The parameter is invalid.

B2-EXC Alarm

Yes

No

l The default value is


recommended.

No

l When this parameter is


set to Yes, it indicates
that clock source
switching occurs if the
clock source reports
the B2-EXC alarm.
l When this parameter is
set to No, it indicates
that no clock source
switching occurs if the
clock source reports
the B2-EXC alarm.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.8 Changing the Conditions for Clock Source Switching

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1988

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.10.1.10 Parameter Description: Output Phase-Locked Source of the External


Clock Source
This topic describes the parameters of the output phase-locked source of the external clock
source.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Phase-Locked Source Output by External Clock.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

2M Phase-Locked
Source Number

External Clock Source 1

This parameter indicates


the number of the external
clock source output of the
NE.

External Clock Output


Mode

2Mbit/s

2Mbit/s

l This parameter
specifies the mode of
the output clock.

External Clock Source 2

2MHz

l This parameter needs


to be set according to
the requirements of the
interconnected
equipment. Generally,
the output external
clock signal is a 2
Mbit/s signal.
External Clock Output
Timeslot

SA4 to SA8

ALL

ALL

l This parameter is valid


only when External
Clock Output Mode
is set to 2Mbit/s.
l This parameter
indicates which bit of
the TS0 in odd frames
of the output clock
signal is used to
transmit the SSM.
l If this parameter is set
to ALL, it indicates
that all the bits of the
TS0 are used to
transmit the SSM.
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1989

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

External Source Output


Threshold

Threshold Disabled

Threshold Disabled

l This parameter
specifies the lowest
quality of the output
clock. If the clock
quality is lower than
the value of this
parameter, it indicates
that the external clock
source does not output
any clock signal.

Not Inferior to G.813


SETS Signal
Not Inferior to G.812
Local Signal
Not Inferior to G.812
Transit Clock Signal
Not Inferior to G.811
Clock Signal

l If this parameter is set


to Threshold
Disabled, it indicates
that the external clock
source always outputs
the clock signal.
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.
2M Phase-Locked
Source Failure
Condition

No Failure Condition

No Failure Condition

AIS
LOF
AIS OR LOF

l This parameter
specifies the failure
condition of the 2
Mbit/s phase-locked
clock source.
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.

2M Phase-Locked
Source Failure Action

Shut Down Output

Shut Down Output

2M Output S1 Byte
Unavailable
Send AIS

l This parameter is valid


only when 2M PhaseLocked Source
Failure Condition is
not set to No Failure
Condition.
l This parameter
specifies the operation
of the 2 Mbit/s phaselocked loop (PLL)
when the 2 Mbit/s
phase-locked clock
source meets the
failure conditions.
l It is recommended that
you use the default
value.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1990

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Related Tasks
A.10.1.6 Modifying the Parameters of the Clock Output

B.10.1.11 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the clock synchronization status.

Navigation Path
Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock >
Physical Clock > Clock Synchronization Status.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

NE Name

This parameter indicates


the name of the NE.

NE Clock Mode

This parameter indicates


the working mode of the
NE clock.

S1 Byte Synchronization
Quality Info

This parameter indicates


the synchronization
quality information of the
S1 byte.

S1 Byte Clock
Synchronous Source

This parameter indicates


the clock synchronization
source of the S1 byte.

Synchronous Source

This parameter indicates


the synchronization
source.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1991

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Data Output Method in


Holdover Mode

Normal Data Output

Normal Data Output

l When all the reference


timing signals are lost,
the slave clock
changes to the
holdover mode. At this
time, the slave clock
works based on the
latest frequency
information stored
before the reference
timing signals are lost.
Then, the frequency of
the oscillator drifts
slowly to ensure that
the offset between the
frequency of the slave
clock and the reference
frequency is very
small. As a result, the
impact caused by the
drift is limited within
the specified
requirement.

Keep the Latest Data

l Normal Data Output:


The slave clock works
based on the latest
frequency information
stored before the
reference timing
signals are lost, and the
holdover duration
depends on the size of
the phase-locked clock
register on the
equipment. The
holdover duration can
be up to 24 hours.
l Keep the Latest Data:
The slave clock works
in holdover mode all
the time based on the
latest frequency
information stored
before the reference
timing signals are lost.

Related Tasks
A.10.1.10 Querying the Clock Synchronization Status
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1992

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

B.10.2 CES ACR Clock Parameters


This topic describes CES ACR clock parameters.

B.10.2.1 Parameter Description: ACR Clock Source


This topic describes parameters that are related to the ACR clock source.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Clock > ACR Clock from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

ACR Clock Source

Identifies the ACR clock


domain.

CES Service

This parameter displays or


specifies the CES service
that the master ACR clock
source uses.

Track Mode

This parameter displays


the trace mode of an ACR
clock source.

Lock Status

This parameter displays


whether an ACR clock
source is locked.

Current CES Service

This parameter displays


the CES service from
which the current ACR
clock source is obtained.

Related Tasks
A.10.2.1 Configuring the Primary Clock for an ACR Clock Domain

B.10.2.2 Parameter Description: Clock Domain


This topic describes parameters that are related to clock domains.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration >
Clock > Clock Domain from the Function Tree.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1993

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Domain

Displays the clock


domain.

Clock Domain Board

Displays the board where


the clock domain is
located.

Clock Port

Displays the Smart E1


ports that are bound to a
clock domain.

B.10.2.3 Parameter Description: Clock Domain_Creation


This topic describes the parameters for creating a clock domain.

Navigation Path
1.

In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree and choose
Configuration > Clock > Clock Domain from the Function Tree.

2.

Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Clock Domain

System Clock Domain

System Clock Domain

Specifies the clock


domain to be bound.

CES ACR1 Clock


Domain
CES ACR2 Clock
Domain
CES ACR3 Clock
Domain
CES ACR4 Clock
Domain
Clock Domain Board

Displays the board where


the clock domain is
located.

Board

Specifies the board where


the Smart E1 port is
located.

Available Port

Displays the Smart E1


ports that are not bound to
a clock domain.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1994

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Selected Port

Displays the Smart E1


ports that are bound to a
clock domain.

Related Tasks
A.10.2.2 Configuring Ports Using the Clock Domain

B.10.3 Parameter Description: Auxiliary Ports


This topic describes parameters that are used for configuring an external time port as an RS-485
monitoring port.

Navigation Path
In the NE Explorer, select the NE from the Object Tree and choose Configuration > Auxiliary
Interface from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Port

Displays the port that


functions as the auxiliary
port.

Interface Mode

1st external clock

1st external clock

Specifies the working


mode of the auxiliary port.

2nd external clock


1st external time
2nd external time
Orderwire
S1/F1

l For an external time


input/output port, set
Interface Mode to 1st
external time or 2nd
external time.

Commissioning serial port

B.11 Parameters for the Orderwire and Auxiliary Interfaces


This topic describes the parameters that are related to the orderwire and auxiliary interfaces.

B.11.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General


This topic describes the parameters that are used for general orderwire features.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1995

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the General tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Call Waiting Time


(s)

1 to 9

l This parameter indicates the waiting


time after the local station dials the
number. If the calling station does not
receive the response message from the
called station within the call waiting
time, it automatically removes the
communication connection.
l If less than 30 nodes exist in the
orderwire subnet, it is recommended that
you set this parameter to five seconds. If
more than 30 nodes exist in the orderwire
subnet, it is recommended that you set
this parameter to nine seconds.
l The call waiting time should be set to the
same for all the NEs.

Dialling Mode

Pulse
Dual-Tone
Frequency

Conference Call

Dual-Tone
Frequency

This parameter indicates the dialling mode


of the orderwire phone.

888

l This parameter indicates the telephone


number of the network-wide orderwire
conference call.
l When an OptiX RTN 980 dials the
telephone number 888, the orderwire
phones of all the NEs on the orderwire
subnet ring. When an OptiX RTN 980
receives the call, the orderwire phones
on the other NEs do not ring. In this case,
the orderwire point-to-multipoint group
call changes to a point-to-point call
between two NEs.
l The telephone number of the orderwire
conference call should be the same for
all the nodes on the same subnet.
l The telephone number of the orderwire
conference call must have the same
length as the telephone number of the
orderwire phone (phone 1) at the local
site.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1996

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Phone 1

100 to 99999999

101

l This parameter specifies the orderwire


phone number of the local station. An
addressing call refers to a point-to-point
call.
l The length of the orderwire phone
number of each NE should be the same.
It is recommended that you set the phone
number to a three-digit number.
l The orderwire phone number of each NE
should be unique. It is recommended that
the phone numbers are allocated from
101 for the NEs in a sequential order
according to the NE IDs.
l The orderwire phone number cannot be
set to the group call number 888 and
cannot start with 888.

Available
Orderwire Port

This parameter indicates the available port


for the orderwire phone.

Selected
Orderwire Port

This parameter indicates the selected port


for the orderwire phone.

Related Tasks
A.12.1 Configuring Orderwire

B.11.2 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Advanced


This topic describes the parameters that are used for advanced orderwire features.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Advanced tab.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1997

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for Bytes Occupied by Orderwire Phones


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Orderwire
Occupied Bytes

E1

E1

l This parameter specifies the overhead


byte that is used to transmit the orderwire
signals.

E2

l Regardless the parameter value, the


radio link always uses a customized
overhead byte to transmit the orderwire
signals. Hence, this parameter should be
set according to the occupied SDH
overhead bytes in the ordinary SDH.

Related Tasks
A.12.1 Configuring Orderwire

B.11.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port


This topic describes the parameters that are used for F1 data ports.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the F1 Data Port tab.

Parameters
Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Available Data
Path

l This parameter indicates the available F1


data channel.
l Two data channels should be selected for
the configuration.

Number

This parameter indicates the number of the


F1 data port.

Data Channel 1

l If an SDH optical or electrical line port


is selected, this parameter corresponds to
the F1 byte in the SDH frame at the line
port.
l If an IF port is selected, this parameter
corresponds to the customized F1 byte in
the microwave frame at the IF port.
l If F1 is selected, this parameter
corresponds to the F1/S1 interface on the
AUX board. The F1/S1 interface

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1998

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

Parameter

Value Range

B Parameters Description

Default Value

Description
complies with ITU-T G.703 and
operates at the rate of 64 kbit/s.

Data Channel 2

Related Tasks
A.12.2 Configuring the Synchronous Data Service

B.11.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port


This topic describes the parameters that are used for broadcast data ports.

Navigation Path
1.

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2.

Click the Broadcast Data Port tab.

Parameters for Broadcast Data Ports


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Overhead Byte

SERIAL1 to
SERIAL4

SERIAL1

l In the case of an SDH optical/electrical


line, the preset overhead byte is used to
transmit the asynchronous data services.
l In the case of a radio link, a customized
serial overhead byte in the microwave
frame is used to transmit the
asynchronous data services.

Broadcast Data
Source

No Data

l When this parameter is set to the


SERIAL1, the F1/S1 interface on the
corresponding AUX board is used.
l When this parameter is set to the SDH
optical/electrical line port, the value of
Overhead Byte of this port is used.
l When this parameter is set to the IF port,
the customized Serial byte in the
microwave frame of this port is used.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1999

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Available
Broadcast Data
Sink

This parameter indicates the available


broadcast data sink.

Selected Broadcast
Data Sink

l When this parameter is set to the


SERIAL1, the F1/S1 interface on the
corresponding AUX board is used.
l When this parameter is set to the SDH
optical/electrical line port, the value of
Overhead Byte of this port is used.
l When this parameter is set to the IF port,
the customized Serial byte in the
microwave frame of this port is used.

Related Tasks
A.12.3 Configuring the Asynchronous Data Service

B.11.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface


This topic describes the parameters that are used for environment monitoring interfaces.

Navigation Path
Select the AUX board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >
Environment Monitor Configuration > Environment Monitor Interface from the Function
Tree.

Parameters for the General Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Operation Object

This parameter indicates the operation


object.

Relay Control
Mode

Auto Control

Auto Control

l Auto Control: If an alarm is reported, the


alarming relay is started up
automatically. Otherwise, the alarming
relay is shut down.

Manual Control

l Manual Control: Relay Status in Major


Alarm(K0) and Relay Status in
Critical Alarm(K1) need to be set.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2000

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Relay Status in
Major Alarm(K0)

Disabled

Disabled

l This parameter indicates that the status


of the relay is set manually for major
alarms.

Enabled

l Enable: The relay is set to the "ON"


status for major alarms.
l Disabled: The relay is set to the "OFF"
status for major alarms.
l This parameter is valid only when Relay
Control Mode is set to Manual
Control.
Relay Status in
Critical Alarm(K1)

Disabled

Disabled

Enabled

l This parameter indicates that the status


of the relay is set manually for critical
alarms.
l Enable: The relay is set to the enabled
status for critical alarms.
l Disabled: The relay is set to the disabled
status for critical alarms.
l This parameter is valid only when Relay
Control Mode is set to Manual
Control.

Parameters for the Input Relay


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Operation Object

This parameter indicates the operation


object.

Path Name

This parameter indicates or specifies the


name of the channel.

Using Status

Unused

Unused

This parameter specifies whether the alarm


interface of the input relay is used.

Relay Turns Off/


High Level

l If this parameter is set to Relay Turns


Off/High Level, an alarm is generated
when the relay is turned off.

Used
Alarm Mode

Relay Turns Off/


High Level
Relay Turns On/
Low Level

l If this parameter is set to Relay Turns


On/Low Level, an alarm is generated
when the relay is turned on.
l This parameter is valid only when Using
Status is set to Used.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2001

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Alarm Severity

Critical Alarm

Critical Alarm

This parameter specifies the severity of the


alarm that is generated at the input relay.

Major Alarm
Minor Alarm
Warning Alarm

Parameters for the Output Relay


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Operation Object

This parameter indicates the operation


object.

Path Name

This parameter indicates or specifies the


name of the output channel.

Use or Not

Unused

Unused

This parameter specifies whether the alarm


interface of the output relay is used.

Used

Parameters for the Temperature Attributes


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Operation Object

This parameter indicates the operation


object.

Monitor Status

This parameter indicates whether the


temperature attribute is monitored.

Temperature
Upper Threshold
(DEG.C)

This parameter indicates the upper


temperature threshold of the board. When
the actual temperature is higher than the
preset value, an alarm is generated.

Temperature
Lower Threshold
(DEG.C)

This parameter indicates the lower


temperature threshold of the board. When
the actual temperature is lower than the
preset value, an alarm is generated.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2002

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

B Parameters Description

Parameters for the Alarm Relay


Parameter

Value Range

Default Value

Description

Alarm Severity

Critical Alarm

This parameter indicates the severity of the


alarm.

CSK-1

This parameter specifies the channel of the


output alarm relay.

Major Alarm
Minor Alarm
Warning Alarm
Alarm Output
Channel

CSK-1
CSK-2
CSK-3
CSK-4

Related Tasks
A.12.5 Configure External Alarms

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2003

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

Glossary

Terms are listed in an alphabetical order.


C.1 0-9
This section provides the terms starting with numbers.
C.2 A-E
This section provides the terms starting with letters A to E.
C.3 F-J
This section provides the terms starting with letters F to J.
C.4 K-O
This section provides the terms starting with letters K to O.
C.5 P-T
This section provides the terms starting with letters P to T.
C.6 U-Z
This section provides the terms starting with letters U to Z.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2004

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

C.1 0-9
This section provides the terms starting with numbers.
1U

The standard electronics industries association (EIA) rack unit (44 mm/1.75 in.)

C.2 A-E
This section provides the terms starting with letters A to E.

A
ABR

See available bit rate

ACAP

See adjacent channel alternate polarization

access control list

A list of entities, together with their access rights, which are authorized to have access
to a resource.

ACL

See access control list

adaptive modulation

A technology that is used to automatically adjust the modulation scheme according to


the channel quality. When the channel quality is favorable, the equipment adopts a highefficiency modulation scheme to improve the transmission efficiency and the spectrum
utilization of the system. When the channel quality is degraded, the equipment adopts
the low-efficiency modulation scheme to improve the anti-interference capability of the
link that carries high-priority services.

ADC

See analog to digital converter

add/drop multiplexer

Network elements that provide access to all or some subset of the constituent signals
contained within an STM-N signal. The constituent signals are added to (inserted), and/
or dropped from (extracted) the STM-N signal as it passed through the ADM.

Address Resolution
Protocol

Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is an Internet Protocol used to map IP addresses to


MAC addresses. It allows hosts and routers to determine the link layer addresses through
ARP requests and ARP responses. The address resolution is a process in which the host
converts the target IP address into a target MAC address before transmitting a frame.
The basic function of the ARP is to query the MAC address of the target equipment
through its IP address.

adjacent channel
alternate polarization

A channel configuration method, which uses two adjacent channels (a horizontal


polarization wave and a vertical polarization wave) to transmit two signals.

ADM

See add/drop multiplexer

administrative unit

The information structure which provides adaptation between the higher order path layer
and the multiplex section layer. It consists of an information payload (the higher order
VC) and an AU pointer which indicates the offset of the payload frame start relative to
the multiplex section frame start.

AF

See assured forwarding

aggregation

A collection of objects that makes a whole. An aggregation can be a concrete or


conceptual set of whole-part relationships among objects.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2005

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

AIS

C Glossary

See alarm indication signal

alarm automatic report When an alarm is generated on the device side, the alarm is reported to the Network
Management System (NMS). Then, an alarm panel prompts and the user can view the
details of the alarm.
alarm cascading

The shunt-wound output of the alarm signals of several subracks or cabinets.

Alarm Filtering

An NE reports the detected alarm to the element management system (EMS). Based on
the filter state of the alarm, the EMS determines whether to display or save the alarm
information. If the filter state of an alarm is set to Filter, the alarm is not displayed or
stored on the EMS. The alarm, however, is still monitored by the NE.

alarm indication signal A code sent downstream in a digital network as an indication that an upstream failure
has been detected and alarmed. It is associated with multiple transport layers.
alarm suppression

A function used not to monitor alarms for a specific object, which may be the
networkwide equipment, a specific NE, a specific board and even a specific function
module of a specific board.

AM

See adaptive modulation

analog to digital
converter

An electronic circuit that converts continuous signals to discrete digital numbers. The
reverse operation is performed by a digital-to-analog converter (DAC).

APS

See automatic protection switching

ARP

See Address Resolution Protocol

assured forwarding

One of the four per-hop behaviors (PHB) defined by the Diff-Serv workgroup of IETF.
It is suitable for certain key data services that require assured bandwidth and short delay.
For traffic within the bandwidth limit, AF assures quality in forwarding. For traffic that
exceeds the bandwidth limit, AF degrades the service class and continues to forward the
traffic instead of discarding the packets.

Asynchronous
Transfer Mode

A protocol for the transmission of a variety of digital signals using uniform 53 byte cells.
A transfer mode in which the information is organized into cells; it is asynchronous in
the sense that the recurrence of cells depends on the required or instantaneous bit rate.
Statistical and deterministic values may also be used to qualify the transfer mode.

ATM

See Asynchronous Transfer Mode

ATM PVC

ATM permanent virtual circuit

ATPC

See automatic transmit power control

attenuator

A device used to increase the attenuation of an Optical Fiber Link. Generally used to
ensure that the signal at the receive end is not too strong.

AU

See administrative unit

automatic protection
switching

Capability of a transmission system to detect a failure on a working facility and to switch


to a standby facility to recover the traffic.

automatic transmit
power control

A method of adjusting the transmit power based on fading of the transmit signal detected
at the receiver

available bit rate

A kind of service categories defined by the ATM forum. ABR only provides possible
forwarding service and applies to the connections that does not require the real-time
quality. It does not provide any guarantee in terms of cell loss or delay.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2006

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

B
backward defect
indication

When detecting a defect, the sink node of an LSP uses backward defect indication (BDI)
to inform the upstream end of the LSP of a downstream defect along the return path.

bandwidth

A range of transmission frequencies that a transmission line or channel can carry in a


network. In fact, it is the difference between the highest and lowest frequencies the
transmission line or channel. The greater the bandwidth, the faster the data transfer rate.

base station controller

A logical entity that connects the BTS with the MSC in a GSM network. It interworks
with the BTS through the Abis interface, the MSC through the A interface. It provides
the following functions: radio resource management, base station management, power
control, handover control, and traffic measurement. One BSC controls and manages one
or more BTSs in an actual network.

base transceiver station A Base Transceiver Station terminates the radio interface. It allows transmission of traffic
and signaling across the air interface. The BTS includes the baseband processing, radio
equipment, and the antenna.
basic input/output
system

A firmware stored in the computer mainboard. It contains basic input/output control


programs, power-on self test (POST) programs, bootstraps, and system setting
information. The BIOS provides hardware setting and control functions for the computer.

BDI

See backward defect indication

BE

See best effort

BER

See bit error rate

best effort

A traditional IP packet transport service. In this service, the diagrams are forwarded
following the sequence of the time they reach. All diagrams share the bandwidth of the
network and routers. The amount of resource that a diagram can use depends of the time
it reaches. BE service does not ensure any improvement in delay time, jitter, packet loss
ratio, and high reliability.

binding strap

The binding strap is 12.7 mm wide, with one hook side (made of transparent
polypropylene material) and one mat side (made of black nylon material).

BIOS

See basic input/output system

BIP

See bit interleaved parity

bit error

An incompatibility between a bit in a transmitted digital signal and the corresponding


bit in the received digital signal.

bit error rate

Ratio of received bits that contain errors. BER is an important index used to measure the
communications quality of a network.

bit interleaved parity

A method of error monitoring. With even parity an X-bit code is generated by the
transmitting equipment over a specified portion of the signal in such a manner that the
first bit of the code provides even parity over the first bit of all X-bit sequences in the
covered portion of the signal, the second bit provides even parity over the second bit of
all X-bit sequences within the specified portion, etc. Even parity is generated by setting
the BIP-X bits so that there is an even number of 1s in each monitored partition of the
signal. A monitored partition comprises all bits which are in the same bit position within
the X-bit sequences in the covered portion of the signal. The covered portion includes
the BIP-X.

BPDU

See bridge protocol data unit

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2007

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

bridge protocol data


unit

The data messages that are exchanged across the switches within an extended LAN that
uses a spanning tree protocol (STP) topology. BPDU packets contain information on
ports, addresses, priorities and costs and ensure that the data ends up where it was
intended to go. BPDU messages are exchanged across bridges to detect loops in a
network topology. The loops are then removed by shutting down selected bridges
interfaces and placing redundant switch ports in a backup, or blocked, state.

broadcast

A means of delivering information to all members in a network. The broadcast range is


determined by the broadcast address.

BSC

See base station controller

BTS

See base transceiver station

buffer

A storage area used for handling data in transit. Buffers are used in inter-networking to
compensate for differences in processing speed between network devices. Bursts of data
can be stored in buffers until they can be handled by slower processing devices. In a
program, buffers are created to hold some amount of data from each of the files that will
be read or written. In a streaming media application, the program uses buffers to store
an advance supply of audio or video data to compensate for momentary delays.

C
cable tie

The tape used to bind the cables.

cable tray

N/A

cable trough

N/A

CAR

See committed access rate

CBR

See constant bit rate

CBS

See committed burst size

CC

See connectivity check

CCC

See circuit cross connect

CCDP

See co-channel dual polarization

CCM

See continuity check message

CE

See customer edge

central processing unit The computational and control unit of a computer. The CPU is the device that interprets
and executes instructions. The CPU has the ability to fetch, decode, and execute
instructions and to transfer information to and from other resources over the computer's
main data-transfer path, the bus.
CES

See circuit emulation service

CF

See compact flash

CGMP

See Cisco Group Management Protocol

channel

A telecommunication path of a specific capacity and/or at a specific speed between two


or more locations in a network. The channel can be established through wire, radio
(microwave), fiber or a combination of the three. The amount of information transmitted
per second in a channel is the information transmission speed, expressed in bits per
second. For example, b/s (100 bit/s), kb/s (103 bit/s), Mb/s (106 bit/s), Gb/s (109 bit/s),
and Tb/s (1012 bit/s).

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2008

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

CIR

See committed information rate

circuit cross connect

An implementation of MPLS L2VPN through the static configuration of labels.

circuit emulation
service

A function with which the E1/T1 data can be transmitted through ATM networks. At the
transmission end, the interface module packs timeslot data into ATM cells. These ATM
cells are sent to the reception end through the ATM network. At the reception end, the
interface module re-assigns the data in these ATM cells to E1/T1 timeslots. The CES
technology guarantees that the data in E1/T1 timeslots can be recovered to the original
sequence at the reception end.

Cisco Group
Management Protocol

N/A

CIST

See common and internal spanning tree

CIST root

A switch of the highest priority is elected as the root in an MSTP network.

clock tracing

The method to keep the time on each node being synchronized with a clock source in a
network.

co-channel dual
polarization

A channel configuration method, which uses a horizontal polarization wave and a vertical
polarization wave to transmit two signals. The Co-Channel Dual Polarization is twice
the transmission capacity of the single polarization.

coarse wavelength
division multiplexing

A signal transmission technology that multiplexes widely-spaced optical channels into


the same fiber. CWDM widely spaces wavelengths at a spacing of several nm. CWDM
does not support optical amplifiers and is applied in a short-distance chain network.

colored packet

A packet whose priority is determined by defined colors.

committed access rate

A traffic control method that uses a set of rate limits to be applied to a router interface.
CAR is a configurable method by which incoming and outgoing packets can be classified
into QoS (Quality of Service) groups, and by which the input or output transmission rate
can be defined.

committed burst size

committed burst size. A parameter used to define the capacity of token bucket C, that is,
the maximum burst IP packet size when the information is transferred at the committed
information rate. This parameter must be larger than 0. It is recommended that this
parameter should be not less than the maximum length of the IP packet that might be
forwarded.

committed information The rate at which a frame relay network agrees to transfer information in normal
rate
conditions. Namely, it is the rate, measured in bit/s, at which the token is transferred to
the leaky bucket.
common and internal
spanning tree

The single spanning tree calculated by STP and RSTP together with the logical
continuation of that connectivity by using MST Bridges and regions, calculated by MSTP
to ensure that all LANs in the bridged local area network are simply and fully connected.

compact flash

Compact flash (CF) was originally developed as a type of data storage device used in
portable electronic devices. For storage, CompactFlash typically uses flash memory in
a standardized enclosure.

concatenation

A process that combines multiple virtual containers. The combined capacities can be
used a single capacity. The concatenation also keeps the integrity of bit sequence.

connectivity check

Ethernet CFM can detect the connectivity between MEPs. The detection is achieved by
each MEP transmitting a Continuity Check Message (CCM) periodically.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2009

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

constant bit rate

A kind of service categories defined by the ATM forum. CBR transfers cells based on
the constant bandwidth. It is applicable to service connections that depend on precise
clocking to ensure undistorted transmission.

continuity check
message

CCM is used to detect the link status.

corrugated pipe

Used to protect optical fibers.

CPU

See central processing unit

CRC

See cyclic redundancy check

cross polarization
interference
cancellation

A technology used in the case of the Co-Channel Dual Polarization (CCDP) to eliminate
the cross-connect interference between two polarization waves in the CCDP.

customer edge

A part of BGP/MPLS IP VPN model. It provides interfaces for direct connection to the
Service Provider (SP) network. A CE can be a router, switch, or host.

CWDM

See coarse wavelength division multiplexing

cyclic redundancy
check

A procedure used in checking for errors in data transmission. CRC error checking uses
a complex calculation to generate a number based on the data transmitted. The sending
device performs the calculation before transmission and includes it in the packet that it
sends to the receiving device. The receiving device repeats the same calculation after
transmission. If both devices obtain the same result, it is assumed that the transmission
was error free. The procedure is known as a redundancy check because each transmission
includes not only data but extra (redundant) error-checking values.

D
data communication
network

A communication network used in a TMN or between TMNs to support the Data


Communication Function (DCF).

data communications
channel

The data channel that uses the D1-D12 bytes in the overhead of an STM-N signal to
transmit information on operation, management, maintenance and provision (OAM&P)
between NEs. The DCC channels that are composed of bytes D1-D3 is referred to as the
192 kbit/s DCC-R channel. The other DCC channel that are composed of bytes D4-D12
is referred to as the 576 kbit/s DCC-M channel.

Datagram

A kind of PDU which is used in Connectionless Network Protocol, such as IP datagram,


UDP datagram.

DC

See direct current

DC-C

See DC-return common (with ground)

DC-C

DC-return common (with ground)

DC-C

See DC-return common (with ground)

DC-I

See DC-return isolate (with ground)

DC-return common
(with ground)

A power system, in which the BGND of the DC return conductor is short-circuited with
the PGND on the output side of the power supply cabinet and also on the line between
the output of the power supply cabinet and the electric equipment.

DC-return common
(with ground)

A power system, in which the BGND of the DC return conductor is short-circuited with
the PGND on the output side of the power supply cabinet and also on the line between
the output of the power supply cabinet and the electric equipment.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2010

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

DC-return isolate (with A power system, in which the BGND of the DC return conductor is short-circuited with
ground)
the PGND on the output side of the power supply cabinet and is isolated from the PGND
on the line between the output of the power supply cabinet and the electric equipment.
DCC

See data communications channel

DCN

See data communication network

DDF

See digital distribution frame

DDN

See digital data network

DE

See discard eligible

differentiated services

A service architecture that provides the end-to-end QoS function. It consists of a series
of functional units implemented at the network nodes, including a small group of perhop forwarding behaviors, packet classification functions, and traffic conditioning
functions such as metering, marking, shaping and policing.

differentiated services
code point

A marker in the header of each IP packet that prompts network routers to apply
differentiated grades of service to various packet streams. It is specified by the DiffServ
policy proposed by the IETF (Internet Engineering Task Force). This allows Internet and
other IP-based network service providers to offer different levels of service to customers.

DiffServ

See differentiated services

digital data network

A high-quality data transport tunnel that combines the digital channel (such as fiber
channel, digital microwave channel, or satellite channel) and the cross multiplex
technology.

digital distribution
frame

A type of equipment used between the transmission equipment and the exchange with
transmission rate of 2 to 155 Mbit/s to provide the functions such as cables connection,
cable patching, and test of loops that transmitting digital signals.

digital modulation

A digital modulation controls the changes in amplitude, phase, and frequency of the
carrier based on the changes in the baseband digital signal. In this manner, the
information can be transmitted by the carrier.

direct current

Electrical current whose direction of flow does not reverse. The current may stop or
change amplitude, but it always flows in the same direction.

discard eligible

A bit in the frame relay header. It indicates the priority of a packet. If a node supports
the FR QoS, the rate of the accessed FR packets is controlled. When the packet traffic
exceeds the specified traffic, the DE value of the redundant packets is set to 1. In the
case of network congestion, the packets with DE value as 1 are discarded at the node.

Distance Vector
Multicast Routing
Protocol

An Internet gateway protocol mainly based on the RIP. The protocol implements a typical
dense mode IP multicast solution. The DVMRP protocol uses IGMP to exchange routing
datagrams with its neighbors.

DS boundary node

A DS node that connects one DS domain to a node either in another DS domain or in a


domain that is not DS-capable.

DS domain

In the DifferServ mechanism, the DS domain is a domain consisting of a group of


network nodes that share the same service provisioning policy and same PHB. It provides
point-to-point QoS guarantees for services transmitted over this domain.

DS interior node

A DS node located at the center of a DS domain. It is a non-DS boundary node.

DS node

A DS-compliant node, which is subdivided into DS boundary node and ID interior node.

DSCP

See differentiated services code point

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2011

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

dual-polarized antenna An antenna intended to radiate or receive simultaneously two independent radio waves
orthogonally polarized.
DVMRP

See Distance Vector Multicast Routing Protocol

E
E-Aggr

See Ethernet aggregation

E-LAN

See Ethernet LAN

E-Line

See Ethernet line

E-Tree

See Ethernet-tree

EBS

See excess burst size

ECC

See embedded control channel

EF

See expedited forwarding

electromagnetic
compatibility

Electromagnetic compatibility is the condition which prevails when telecommunications


equipment is performing its individually designed function in a common electromagnetic
environment without causing or suffering unacceptable degradation due to unintentional
electromagnetic interference to or from other equipment in the same environment.

electromagnetic
interference

Any electromagnetic disturbance that interrupts, obstructs, or otherwise degrades or


limits the effective performance of electronics/electrical equipment.

electrostatic discharge

The sudden and momentary electric current that flows between two objects at different
electrical potentials caused by direct contact or induced by an electrostatic field.

embedded control
channel

A logical channel that uses a data communications channel (DCC) as its physical layer,
to enable transmission of operation, administration, and maintenance (OAM)
information between NEs.

EMC

See electromagnetic compatibility

EMI

See electromagnetic interference

Engineering label

A mark on a cable, a subrack, or a cabinet for identification.

EPL

See Ethernet private line

EPLAN

See Ethernet private LAN service

equalization

A method of avoiding selective fading of frequencies. Equalization can compensate for


the changes of amplitude frequency caused by frequency selective fading.

ERPS

See Ethernet ring protection switching

ESD

See electrostatic discharge

ESD jack

Electrostatic discharge jack. A hole in the cabinet or shelf, which connect the shelf or
cabinet to the insertion of ESD wrist strap.

Ethernet

A technology complemented in LAN. It adopts Carrier Sense Multiple Access/Collision


Detection. The speed of an Ethernet interface can be 10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s, 1000 Mbit/
s or 10000 Mbit/s. The Ethernet network features high reliability and easy maintaining.

Ethernet

A technology complemented in LAN. It adopts Carrier Sense Multiple Access/Collision


Detection. The speed of an Ethernet interface can be 10 Mbit/s, 100 Mbit/s, 1000 Mbit/
s or 10000 Mbit/s. The Ethernet network features high reliability and easy maintaining.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2012

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

Ethernet aggregation

A type of Ethernet service that is based on a multipoint-to-point EVC (Ethernet virtual


connection).

Ethernet LAN

A type of Ethernet service that is based on a multipoint-to-multipoint EVC (Ethernet


virtual connection).

Ethernet line

A type of Ethernet service that is based on a point-to-point EVC (Ethernet virtual


connection).

Ethernet private LAN


service

An Ethernet service type, which carries Ethernet characteristic information over a


dedicated bridge, point-to-multipoint connections, provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or
MPLS server layer networks.

Ethernet private line

A type of Ethernet service that is provided with dedicated bandwidth and point-to-point
connections on an SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server layer network.

Ethernet ring
protection switching

protection switching mechanisms for ETH layer Ethernet ring topologies.

Ethernet virtual
private LAN service

An Ethernet service type, which carries Ethernet characteristic information over a shared
bridge, point-to-multipoint connections, provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server
layer networks.

Ethernet virtual
private line

An Ethernet service type, which carries Ethernet characteristic information over shared
bandwidth, point-to-point connections, provided by SDH, PDH, ATM, or MPLS server
layer networks.

Ethernet-tree

An Ethernet service type that is based on a Point-to-multipoint Ethernet Virtual


Connection.

ETS

European Telecommunication Standards

ETSI

See European Telecommunications Standards Institute

European
Telecommunications
Standards Institute

A standards-setting body in Europe. Also the standards body responsible for GSM.

EVPL

See Ethernet virtual private line

EVPLAN

See Ethernet virtual private LAN service

excess burst size

A parameter related to traffic. In the single rate three color marker (srTCM) mode, the
traffic control is achieved by the token buckets C and E. Excess burst size is a parameter
used to define the capacity of token bucket E, that is, the maximum burst IP packet size
when the information is transferred at the committed information rate. This parameter
must be larger than 0. It is recommended that this parameter should be not less than the
maximum length of the IP packet that might be forwarded.

Exercise Switching

An operation to check if the protection switching protocol functions normally. The


protection switching is not really performed.

expansion

Connecting a storage system to more disk enclosures through connection cables,


expanding the capacity of the storage system.

expedited forwarding

The highest order QoS in the Diff-Serv network. EF PHB is suitable for services that
demand low packet loss ratio, short delay, and broad bandwidth. In all the cases, EF
traffic can guarantee a transmission rate equal to or faster than the set rate. The DSCP
value of EF PHB is "101110".

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2013

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

C.3 F-J
This section provides the terms starting with letters F to J.

F
failure

If the fault persists long enough to consider the ability of an item with a required function
to be terminated. The item may be considered as having failed; a fault has now been
detected.

fast Ethernet

Any network that supports transmission rate of 100Mbits/s. The Fast Ethernet is 10 times
faster than 10BaseT, and inherits frame format, MAC addressing scheme, MTU, and so
on. Fast Ethernet is extended from the IEEE802.3 standard, and it uses the following
three types of transmission media: 100BASE-T4 (4 pairs of phone twisted-pair cables),
100BASE-TX (2 pairs of data twisted-pair cables), and 100BASE-FX (2-core optical
fibers).

fast link pulse

The link pulse that is used to encode information during automatic negotiation.

FD

See frequency diversity

FDI

See forward defect indication

FE

See fast Ethernet

FEC

See forward error correction

FFD

fast failure detection

fiber patch cord

A kind of fiber used for connections between the subrack and the ODF, and for
connections between subracks or inside a subrack.

field programmable
gate array

A type of semi-customized circuit used in the Application Specific Integrated Circuit


(ASIC) field. It is developed on the basis of the programmable components, such as the
PAL, GAL, and EPLD. It not only remedies the defects of customized circuits, but also
overcomes the disadvantage of the original programmable components in terms of the
limited number of gate arrays.

FIFO

See First in First out

File Transfer Protocol

A member of the TCP/IP suite of protocols, used to copy files between two computers
on the Internet. Both computers must support their respective FTP roles: one must be an
FTP client and the other an FTP server.

First in First out

A stack management mechanism. The first saved data is first read and invoked.

Forced switch

For normal traffic signals, switches normal traffic signal to the protection section, unless
an equal or higher priority switch command is in effect or SF condition exists on the
protection section, by issuing a forced switch request for that traffic signal.

forward defect
indication

Forward defect indication (FDI) is generated and traced forward to the sink node of the
LSP by the node that first detects defects. It includes fields to indicate the nature of the
defect and its location. Its primary purpose is to suppress alarms being raised at affected
higher level client LSPs and (in turn) their client layers.

forward error
correction

A bit error correction technology that adds the correction information to the payload at
the transmit end. Based on the correction information, the bit errors generated during
transmission are corrected at the receive end.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2014

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

Forwarding plane

Also referred to as the data plane. The forwarding plane is connection-oriented, and can
be used in Layer 2 networks such as an ATM network.

FPGA

See field programmable gate array

fragment

Piece of a larger packet that has been broken down to smaller units.

Fragmentation

Process of breaking a packet into smaller units when transmitting over a network medium
that cannot support the original size of the packet.

frame

A frame, starting with a header, is a string of bytes with a specified length. Frame length
is represented by the sampling circle or the total number of bytes sampled during a circle.
A header comprises one or a number of bytes with pre-specified values. In other words,
a header is a code segment that reflects the distribution (diagram) of the elements prespecified by the sending and receiving parties.

frequency diversity

A diversity scheme that enables two or more microwave frequencies with a certain
frequency interval are used to transmit/receive the same signal and selection is then
performed between the two signals to ease the impact of fading.

FTP

See File Transfer Protocol

full-duplex

A full-duplex, or sometimes double-duplex system, allows communication in both


directions, and, unlike half-duplex, allows this to happen simultaneously. Land-line
telephone networks are full-duplex, since they allow both callers to speak and be heard
at the same time. A good analogy for a full-duplex system would be a two-lane road with
one lane for each direction.

G
gateway network
element

A network element that is used for communication between the NE application layer and
the NM application layer

GE

See gigabit Ethernet

generic framing
procedure

A framing and encapsulated method which can be applied to any data type. It has been
standardized by ITU-T SG15.

generic traffic shaping A traffic control measure that initiatively adjusts the output speed of the traffic. This is
to adapt the traffic to network resources that can be provided by the downstream router
to avoid packet discarding and congestion.
GFP

See generic framing procedure

gigabit Ethernet

GE adopts the IEEE 802.3z. GE is compatible with 10 Mbit/s and 100 Mbit/s Ethernet.
It runs at 1000 Mbit/s. Gigabit Ethernet uses a private medium, and it does not support
coaxial cables or other cables. It also supports the channels in the bandwidth mode. If
Gigabit Ethernet is, however, deployed to be the private bandwidth system with a bridge
(switch) or a router as the center, it gives full play to the performance and the bandwidth.
In the network structure, Gigabit Ethernet uses full duplex links that are private, causing
the length of the links to be sufficient for backbone applications in a building and campus.

Global Positioning
System

A global navigation satellite system. It provides reliable positioning, navigation, and


timing services to worldwide users.

GNE

See gateway network element

GPS

See Global Positioning System

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2015

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

graphical user interface A visual computer environment that represents programs, files, and options with
graphical images, such as icons, menus, and dialog boxes, on the screen.
GTS

See generic traffic shaping

GUI

See graphical user interface

guide rail

Components to guide, position, and support plug-in boards.

H
HA

See high availability

half-duplex

A transmitting mode in which a half-duplex system provides for communication in both


directions, but only one direction at a time (not simultaneously). Typically, once a party
begins receiving a signal, it must wait for the transmitter to stop transmitting, before
replying.

HDLC

See high level data link control

hierarchical quality of
service

A type of QoS that can control the traffic of users, and perform the scheduling according
to the priority of user services. HQoS has a perfect traffic statistics function, and the
administrator can monitor the usage of bandwidth of each service. Hence, the bandwidth
can be allocated reasonably through traffic analysis.

high availability

Typically, a scheme in which two modules operate in active/standby mode to achieve


high availability. When the active module fails, the standby module automatically takes
over the system functions of the active module.

high level data link


control

The HDLC protocol is a general purpose protocol which operates at the data link layer
of the OSI reference model. Each piece of data is encapsulated in an HDLC frame by
adding a trailer and a header.

High Speed Downlink


Packet Access

A modulating-demodulating algorithm put forward in 3GPP R5 to meet the requirement


for asymmetric uplink and downlink transmission of data services. It enables the
maximum downlink data service rate to reach 14.4 Mbit/s without changing the
WCDMA network topology.

higher order path

In an SDH network, the higher order path layers provide a server network from the lower
order path layers.

Hold priority

The priority of the tunnel with respect to holding resources, ranging from 0 (indicates
the highest priority) to 7. It is used to determine whether the resources occupied by the
tunnel can be preempted by other tunnels.

hop

A network connection between two distant nodes. For Internet operation a hop represents
a small step on the route from one main computer to another.

hot standby

A mechanism of ensuring device running security. The environment variables and


storage information of each running device are synchronized to the standby device. When
the faults occur on the running device, the standby device can take over the services in
the faulty device in automatic or manual way to ensure the normal running of the entire
system.

HP

See higher order path

HQoS

See hierarchical quality of service

HSB

See hot standby

HSDPA

See High Speed Downlink Packet Access

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2016

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

HSM

hitless switch mode

HTB

high tributary bus

hybrid radio

The hybrid transmission of Native E1 and Native Ethernet signals. Hybrid radio supports
the AM function.

I
ICMP

See Internet Control Message Protocol

IDU

See indoor unit

IEC

See International Electrotechnical Commission

IEEE

See Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers

IETF

See Internet Engineering Task Force

IF

See intermediate frequency

IGMP

See Internet Group Management Protocol

IGMP snooping

A multicast constraint mechanism running on a layer 2 device. This protocol manages


and controls the multicast group by listening to and analyze the Internet Group
Management Protocol (IGMP) packet between hosts and layer 3 devices. In this manner,
the spread of the multicast data on layer 2 network can be prevented efficiently.

IMA

See inverse multiplexing over ATM

indoor unit

The indoor unit of the split-structured radio equipment. It implements accessing,


multiplexing/demultiplexing, and IF processing for services.

Inloop

A method of looping the signals from the cross-connect unit back to the cross-connect
unit.

Institute of Electrical
and Electronics
Engineers

A society of engineering and electronics professionals based in the United States but
boasting membership from numerous other countries. The IEEE focuses on electrical,
electronics, computer engineering, and science-related matters.

intermediate frequency The transitional frequency between the frequencies of a modulated signal and an RF
signal.
Intermediate System

The basic unit in the IS-IS protocol used to transmit routing information and generate
routes.

Intermediate System to A protocol used by network devices (routers) to determine the best way to forward
Intermediate System
datagrams or packets through a packet-based network, a process called routing.
routing protocol
internal spanning tree

A segment of CIST in a certain MST region. An IST is a special MSTI whose ID is 0.

International
Electrotechnical
Commission

The International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) is an international and nongovernmental standards organization dealing with electrical and electronic standards.

International
Organization for
Standardization

An international association that works to establish global standards for communications


and information exchange. Primary among its accomplishments is the widely accepted
ISO/OSI reference model, which defines standards for the interaction of computers
connected by communications networks.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2017

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

International
Telecommunication
UnionTelecommunication
Standardization Sector

An international body that develops worldwide standards for telecommunications


technologies. These standards are grouped together in series which are prefixed with a
letter indicating the general subject and a number specifying the particular standard. For
example, X.25 comes from the "X" series which deals with data networks and open
system communications and number "25" deals with packet switched networks.

Internet Control
Message Protocol

A network-layer (ISO/OSI level 3) Internet protocol that provides error correction and
other information relevant to IP packet processing. For example, it can let the IP software
on one machine inform another machine about an unreachable destination. See also
communications protocol, IP, ISO/OSI reference model, packet (definition 1).

Internet Engineering
Task Force

A worldwide organization of individuals interested in networking and the Internet.


Managed by the Internet Engineering Steering Group (IESG), the IETF is charged with
studying technical problems facing the Internet and proposing solutions to the Internet
Architecture Board (IAB). The work of the IETF is carried out by various working groups
that concentrate on specific topics, such as routing and security. The IETF is the publisher
of the specifications that led to the TCP/IP protocol standard.

Internet Group
Management Protocol

The protocol for managing the membership of Internet Protocol multicast groups among
the TCP/IP protocols. It is used by IP hosts and adjacent multicast routers to establish
and maintain multicast group memberships.

Internet Protocol

The TCP/IP standard protocol that defines the IP packet as the unit of information sent
across an internet and provides the basis for connectionless, best-effort packet delivery
service. IP includes the ICMP control and error message protocol as an integral part. The
entire protocol suite is often referred to as TCP/IP because TCP and IP are the two
fundamental protocols. IP is standardized in RFC 791.

Internet protocol
version 6

A update version of IPv4. It is also called IP Next Generation (IPng). The specifications
and standardizations provided by it are consistent with the Internet Engineering Task
Force (IETF). IPv6 is also called. It is a new version of the Internet Protocol, designed
as the successor to IPv4. The difference between IPv6 and IPv4 is that an IPv4 address
has 32 bits while an IPv6 address has 128 bits.

Internet protocol
version 6

A update version of IPv4. It is also called IP Next Generation (IPng). The specifications
and standardizations provided by it are consistent with the Internet Engineering Task
Force (IETF). IPv6 is also called. It is a new version of the Internet Protocol, designed
as the successor to IPv4. The difference between IPv6 and IPv4 is that an IPv4 address
has 32 bits while an IPv6 address has 128 bits.

inverse multiplexing
over ATM

The ATM inverse multiplexing technique involves inverse multiplexing and demultiplexing of ATM cells in a cyclical fashion among links grouped to form a higher
bandwidth logical link whose rate is approximately the sum of the link rates. This is
referred to as an IMA group.

IP

See Internet Protocol

IPV6

See Internet protocol version 6

IPv6

See Internet protocol version 6

IS-IS

See Intermediate System to Intermediate System routing protocol

ISO

See International Organization for Standardization

IST

See internal spanning tree

ITU-T

See International Telecommunication Union-Telecommunication Standardization


Sector

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2018

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

J
Jitter

Short waveform variations caused by vibration, voltage fluctuations, and control system
instability.

C.4 K-O
This section provides the terms starting with letters K to O.

L
L2VPN

See Layer 2 virtual private network

label switched path

A sequence of hops (R0...Rn) in which a packet travels from R0 to Rn through label


switching mechanisms. A label-switched path can be chosen dynamically, based on
normal routing mechanisms, or through configuration.

label switching router

Basic element of MPLS network. All LSRs support the MPLS protocol. The LSR is
composed of two parts: control unit and forwarding unit. The former is responsible for
allocating the label, selecting the route, creating the label forwarding table, creating and
removing the label switch path; the latter forwards the labels according to groups
received in the label forwarding table.

LACP

See Link Aggregation Control Protocol

LAG

See link aggregation group

LAN

See local area network

LAN

See local area network

LAPS

link access protocol-SDH

Laser

A component that generates directional optical waves of narrow wavelengths. The laser
light has better coherence than ordinary light. The fiber system takes the semi-conductor
laser as the light source.

layer 2 switch

A data forwarding method. In LAN, a network bridge or 802.3 Ethernet switch transmits
and distributes packet data based on the MAC address. Since the MAC address is the
second layer of the OSI model, this data forwarding method is called layer 2 switch.

Layer 2 virtual private A virtual private network achieved by Layer 2 switching technologies in the packet
network
switched (IP/MPLS) network.
LB

See loopback

LCAS

See link capacity adjustment scheme

LCT

local craft terminal

line rate

The maximum packet forwarding capacity on a cable. The value of line rate equals the
maximum transmission rate capable on a given type of media.

line rate forwarding

The line rate equals the maximum transmission rate capable on a given type of media.

Link Aggregation
Control Protocol

A method of bundling a group of physical interfaces together as a logical interface to


increase bandwidth and reliability. For related protocols and standards, refer to IEEE
802.3ad.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2019

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

link aggregation group An aggregation that allows one or more links to be aggregated together to form a link
aggregation group so that a MAC client can treat the link aggregation group as if it were
a single link.
link capacity
adjustment scheme

LCAS in the virtual concatenation source and sink adaptation functions provides a
control mechanism to hitlessly increase or decrease the capacity of a link to meet the
bandwidth needs of the application. It also provides a means of removing member links
that have experienced failure. The LCAS assumes that in cases of capacity initiation,
increases or decreases, the construction or destruction of the end-to-end path is the
responsibility of the Network and Element Management Systems.

Link Protection

Protection provided by the bypass tunnel for the link on the working tunnel. The link is
a downstream link adjacent to the PLR. When the PLR fails to provide node protection,
the link protection should be provided.

LMSP

linear multiplex section protection

local area network

A network formed by the computers and workstations within the coverage of a few square
kilometers or within a single building. It features high speed and low error rate. Ethernet,
FDDI, and Token Ring are three technologies used to implement a LAN. Current LANs
are generally based on switched Ethernet or Wi-Fi technology and running at 1,000 Mbit/
s (that is, 1 Gbit/s).

local area network

A network formed by the computers and workstations within the coverage of a few square
kilometers or within a single building. It features high speed and low error rate. Ethernet,
FDDI, and Token Ring are three technologies used to implement a LAN. Current LANs
are generally based on switched Ethernet or Wi-Fi technology and running at 1,000 Mbit/
s (that is, 1 Gbit/s).

Locked switching

When the switching condition is satisfied, this function disables the service from being
switched from the working channel to the protection channel. When the service has been
switched, the function enables the service to be restored from the protection channel to
the working channel.

LOF

See Loss Of Frame

LOM

loss of multiframe

loopback

A troubleshooting technique that returns a transmitted signal to its source so that the
signal or message can be analyzed for errors.

LOP

See loss of pointer

LOS

See Loss Of Signal

Loss Of Frame

A condition at the receiver or a maintenance signal transmitted in the PHY overhead


indicating that the receiving equipment has lost frame delineation. This is used to monitor
the performance of the PHY layer.

loss of pointer

Loss of Pointer: A condition at the receiver or a maintenance signal transmitted in the


PHY overhead indicating that the receiving equipment has lost the pointer to the start of
cell in the payload. This is used to monitor the performance of the PHY layer.

Loss Of Signal

Loss of signal (LOS) indicates that there are no transitions occurring in the received
signal.

LP

lower order path

LPT

link-state pass through

LSP

See label switched path

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2020

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

LSR

C Glossary

See label switching router

M
MA

See maintenance association

MAC

See media access control

MAC

See media access control

MADM

multiple add/drop multiplexer

main topology

A interface that displays the connection relationships of NEs on the NMS (screen
display). The default client interface of the NMS, a basic component of the humanmachine interactive interface. The topology clearly shows the structure of the network,
the alarms of different NEs, subnets in the network, the communication status as well as
the basic network operation status. All topology management functions are accessed
here.

maintenance
association

That portion of a Service Instance, preferably all of it or as much as possible, the


connectivity of which is maintained by CFM. It is also a full mesh of Maintenance
Entities.

maintenance
association end point

A MEP is an actively managed CFM Entity, associated with a specific DSAP of a Service
Instance, which can generate and receive CFM frames and track any responses. It is an
end point of a single Maintenance Association, and terminates a separate Maintenance
Entity for each of the other MEPs in the same Maintenance Association.

maintenance domain

The network or the part of the network for which connectivity is managed by CFM. The
devices in an MD are managed by a single ISP.

maintenance point

Maintenance Point (MP) is one of either a MEP or a MIP.

management
information base

A type of database used for managing the devices in a communications network. It


comprises a collection of objects in a (virtual) database used to manage entities (such as
routers and switches) in a network.

manual switch

Switches normal traffic signal to the protection section, unless a failure condition exists
on other sections (including the protection section) or an equal or higher priority switch
command is in effect, by issuing a manual switch request for that normal traffic signal.

maximum transmission The largest packet of data that can be transmitted on a network. MTU size varies,
unit
depending on the network576 bytes on X.25 networks, for example, 1500 bytes on
Ethernet, and 17,914 bytes on 16 Mbps Token Ring. Responsibility for determining the
size of the MTU lies with the link layer of the network. When packets are transmitted
across networks, the path MTU, or PMTU, represents the smallest packet size (the one
that all networks can transmit without breaking up the packet) among the networks
involved.
MBS

maximum burst size

MCF

See message communication function

MD

See maintenance domain

MDI

See medium dependent interface

Mean Time Between


Failures

The average time between consecutive failures of a piece of equipment. It is a measure


of the reliability of the system.

Mean Time To Repair

The average time that a device will take to recover from a failure.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2021

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

media access control

A protocol at the media access control sublayer. The protocol is at the lower part of the
data link layer in the OSI model and is mainly responsible for controlling and connecting
the physical media at the physical layer. When transmitting data, the MAC protocol
checks whether to be able to transmit data. If the data can be transmitted, certain control
information is added to the data, and then the data and the control information are
transmitted in a specified format to the physical layer. When receiving data, the MAC
protocol checks whether the information is correct and whether the data is transmitted
correctly. If the information is correct and the data is transmitted correctly, the control
information is removed from the data and then the data is transmitted to the LLC layer.

media access control

A protocol at the media access control sublayer. The protocol is at the lower part of the
data link layer in the OSI model and is mainly responsible for controlling and connecting
the physical media at the physical layer. When transmitting data, the MAC protocol
checks whether to be able to transmit data. If the data can be transmitted, certain control
information is added to the data, and then the data and the control information are
transmitted in a specified format to the physical layer. When receiving data, the MAC
protocol checks whether the information is correct and whether the data is transmitted
correctly. If the information is correct and the data is transmitted correctly, the control
information is removed from the data and then the data is transmitted to the LLC layer.

medium dependent
interface

The electrical and mechanical interface between the equipment and the media
transmission.

MEP

See maintenance association end point

MEP

maintenance end point

message
communication
function

The MCF is composed of a protocol stack that allows exchange of management


information with their prs.

MIB

See management information base

MIP

maintenance intermediate point

mounting ear

A piece of angle plate with holes in it on a rack. It is used to fix network elements or
components.

MP

See maintenance point

MPID

maintenance point identification

MPLS

See Multiprotocol Label Switching

MPLS L2VPN

The MPLS L2VPN provides the Layer 2 VPN service based on an MPLS network. In
this case, on a uniform MPLS network, the carrier is able to provide Layer 2 VPNs of
different media types, such as ATM, FR, VLAN, Ethernet, and PPP.

MPLS OAM

The MPLS OAM provides continuity check for a single LSP, and provides a set of fault
detection tools and fault correct mechanisms for MPLS networks. The MPLS OAM and
relevant protection switching components implement the detection function for the CRLSP forwarding plane, and perform the protection switching in 50 ms after a fault occurs.
In this way, the impact of a fault can be lowered to the minimum.

MPLS TE

See multiprotocol label switching traffic engineering

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2022

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

MPLS TE tunnel

In the case of reroute deployment, or when traffic needs to be transported through


multiple trails, multiple LSP tunnels might be used. In traffic engineering, such a group
of LSP tunnels are referred to as TE tunnels. An LSP tunnel of this kind has two
identifiers. One is the Tunnel ID carried by the SENDER object, and is used to uniquely
define the TE tunnel. The other is the LSP ID carried by the SENDER_TEMPLATE or
FILTER_SPEC object.

MS

See multiplex section

MSP

See multiplex section protection

MSTP

See Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol

MTBF

See Mean Time Between Failures

MTTR

See Mean Time To Repair

MTU

See maximum transmission unit

Multicast

A process of transmitting packets of data from one source to many destinations. The
destination address of the multicast packet uses Class D address, that is, the IP address
ranges from 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255. Each multicast address represents a multicast
group rather than a host.

Multiple Spanning
Tree Protocol

Multiple spanning tree protocol. The MSTP can be used in a loop network. Using an
algorithm, the MSTP blocks redundant paths so that the loop network can be trimmed
as a tree network. In this case, the proliferation and endless cycling of packets is avoided
in the loop network. The protocol that introduces the mapping between VLANs and
multiple spanning trees. This solves the problem that data cannot be normally forwarded
in a VLAN because in STP/RSTP, only one spanning tree corresponds to all the VLANs.

multiplex section

The trail between and including two multiplex section trail termination functions.

multiplex section
protection

A function, which is performed to provide capability for switching a signal between and
including two multiplex section termination (MST) functions, from a "working" to a
"protection" channel.

Multiprotocol Label
Switching

A technology that uses short tags of fixed length to encapsulate packets in different link
layers, and provides connection-oriented switching for the network layer on the basis of
IP routing and control protocols. It improves the cost performance and expandability of
networks, and is beneficial to routing.

multiprotocol label
switching traffic
engineering

N/A

N
N+1 protection

A radio link protection system composed of N working channels and one protection
channel.

NE

See network element

NE Explorer

The main operation interface, of the NMS, which is used to manage the
telecommunication equipment. In the NE Explorer, the user can query, manage and
maintain the NE, boards, and ports on a per-NE basis.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2023

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

network element

C Glossary

A network element (NE) contains both the hardware and the software running on it. One
NE is at least equipped with one system control and communication(SCC) board which
manages and monitors the entire network element. The NE software runs on the SCC
board.

Network Management A system in charge of the operation, administration, and maintenance of a network.
System
network service access A network address defined by ISO, through which entities on the network layer can
point
access OSI network services.
network to network
interface

An internal interface within a network linking two or more elements.

next hop

The next router to which a packet is sent from any given router as it traverses a network
on its journey to its final destination.

NLP

normal link pulse

NMS

See Network Management System

NNI

See network to network interface

node

A node stands for a managed device in the network. For a device with a single frame,
one node stands for one device. For a device with multiple frames, one node stands for
one frame of the device. Therefore, a node does not always mean a device.

Node Protection

A parameter of the FRR protection. It indicates that the bypass tunnel should be able to
protect the downstream node that is involved in the working tunnel and adjacent to the
PLR. The node cannot be a merge point, and the bypass tunnel should also be able to
protect the downstream link that is involved in the working tunnel and adjacent to the
PLR.

non-gateway network
element

A network element whose communication with the NM application layer must be


transferred by the gateway network element application layer.

non-GNE

See non-gateway network element

NSAP

See network service access point

NSF

not stop forwarding

O
OAM

See operation, administration and maintenance

ODF

See optical distribution frame

ODU

See outdoor unit

OM

Operation and maintenance

One-to-One Backup

A local repair method in which a backup tunnel is separately created for each protected
tunnel at a PLR.

open shortest path first A link-state, hierarchical interior gateway protocol (IGP) for network routing. Dijkstra's
algorithm is used to calculate the shortest path tree. It uses cost as its routing metric. A
link state database is constructed of the network topology which is identical on all routers
in the area.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2024

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

Open Systems
Interconnection

A framework of ISO standards for communication between different systems made by


different vendors, in which the communications process is organized into seven different
categories that are placed in a layered sequence based on their relationship to the user.
Each layer uses the layer immediately below it and provides a service to the layer above.
Layers 7 through 4 deal with end-to-end communication between the message source
and destination, and layers 3 through 1 deal with network functions.

operation,
administration and
maintenance

A group of network support functions that monitor and sustain segment operation,
activities that are concerned with, but not limited to, failure detection, notification,
location, and repairs that are intended to eliminate faults and keep a segment in an
operational state and support activities required to provide the services of a subscriber
access network to users/subscribers.

optic fiber connector

A device installed at the end of a fiber, optical source or receive unit. It is used to couple
the optical wave to the fiber when connected to another device of the same type. A
connector can either connect two fiber ends or connect a fiber end and an optical source
(or a detector).+

optical distribution
frame

A frame which is used to transfer and spool fibers.

orderwire

A channel that provides voice communication between operation engineers or


maintenance engineers of different stations.

OSI

See Open Systems Interconnection

OSPF

See open shortest path first

outdoor unit

The outdoor unit of the split-structured radio equipment. It implements frequency


conversion and amplification for RF signals.

Outloop

A method of looping back the input signals received at a port to an output port without
changing the structure of the signals.

Output optical power

The ranger of optical energy level of output signals.

C.5 P-T
This section provides the terms starting with letters P to T.

P
packet switched
network

A telecommunication network which works in packet switching mode.

Packing case

A case which is used for packing the board or subrack.

Path

A performance resource object defined in the network management system. The left end
of a path is a device node whose port needs to be specified and the right end of a path is
a certain IP address which can be configured by the user. By defining a path in the
network management system, a user can test the performance of a network path between
a device port and an IP address. The tested performance may be the path delay, packet
loss ratio or other aspects.

PBS

See peak burst size

PCB

See printed circuit board

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2025

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

PCI bus

PCI (Peripheral Component Interconnect) bus. A high performance bus, 32-bit or 64-bit
for interconnecting chips, expansion boards, and processor/memory subsystems.

PDH

See plesiochronous digital hierarchy

PDU

See protocol data unit

PE

See provider edge

peak burst size

A parameter used to define the capacity of token bucket P, that is, the maximum burst
IP packet size when the information is transferred at the peak information rate. This
parameter must be larger than 0. It is recommended that this parameter should be not
less than the maximum length of the IP packet that might be forwarded.

peak information rate

A traffic parameter, expressed in bit/s, whose value should be not less than the committed
information rate.

penultimate hop
popping

Penultimate Hop Popping (PHP) is a function performed by certain routers in an MPLS


enabled network. It refers to the process whereby the outermost label of an MPLS tagged
packet is removed by a Label Switched Router (LSR) before the packet is passed to an
adjacent Label Edge Router (LER).

per-hop behavior

IETF Diff-Serv workgroup defines forwarding behaviors of network nodes as per-hop


behaviors (PHB), such as, traffic scheduling and policing. A device in the network should
select the proper PHB behaviors, based on the value of DSCP. At present, the IETF
defines four types of PHB. They are class selector (CS), expedited forwarding (EF),
assured forwarding (AF), and best-effort (BE).

PHB

See per-hop behavior

PHP

See penultimate hop popping

PIR

See peak information rate

PLA

physical link aggregation

plesiochronous digital
hierarchy

A multiplexing scheme of bit stuffing and byte interleaving. It multiplexes the minimum
rate 64 kit/s into the 2 Mbit/s, 34 Mbit/s, 140 Mbit/s, and 565 Mbit/s rates.

Point-to-Point Protocol A protocol on the data link layer, provides point-to-point transmission and encapsulates
data packets on the network layer. It is located in layer 2 of the IP protocol stack.
polarization

A kind of electromagnetic wave, the direction of whose electric field vector is fixed or
rotates regularly. Specifically, if the electric field vector of the electromagnetic wave is
perpendicular to the plane of horizon, this electromagnetic wave is called vertically
polarized wave; if the electric field vector of the electromagnetic wave is parallel to the
plane of horizon, this electromagnetic wave is called horizontal polarized wave; if the
tip of the electric field vector, at a fixed point in space, describes a circle, this
electromagnetic wave is called circularly polarized wave.

Power box

A direct current power distribution box at the upper part of a cabinet, which supplies
power for the subracks in the cabinet.

PPP

See Point-to-Point Protocol

PQ

See priority queue

PRBS

See pseudo random binary sequence

PRC

primary reference clock

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2026

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

printed circuit board

A board used to mechanically support and electrically connect electronic components


using conductive pathways, tracks, or traces, etched from copper sheets laminated onto
a non-conductive substrate.

priority queue

An abstract data type in computer programming that supports the following three
operations: (1) InsertWithPriority: add an element to the queue with an associated
priority (2) GetNext: remove the element from the queue that has the highest priority,
and return it (also known as "PopElement(Off)", or "GetMinimum") (3) PeekAtNext
(optional): look at the element with highest priority without removing it

protection ground
cable

A cable which connects the equipment and the protection ground bar. Usually, one half
of the cable is yellow; while the other half is green.

Protection path

A specific path that is part of a protection group and is labeled protection.

protocol data unit

It is a data packet at the network layer of the OSI model.

provider edge

A device that is located in the backbone network of the MPLS VPN structure. A PE is
responsible for VPN user management, establishment of LSPs between PEs, and
exchange of routing information between sites of the same VPN. During the process, a
PE performs the mapping and forwarding of packets between the private network and
the public channel. A PE can be a UPE, an SPE, or an NPE.

pseudo random binary A sequence that is random in a sense that the value of an element is independent of the
sequence
values of any of the other elements, similar to real random sequences.
pseudo wire

An emulated connection between two PEs for transmitting frames. The PW is established
and maintained by PEs through signaling protocols. The status information of a PW is
maintained by the two end PEs of a PW.

pseudo wire emulation A type of end-to-end Layer 2 transmitting technology. It emulates the essential attributes
edge-to-edge
of a telecommunication service such as ATM, FR or Ethernet in a Packet Switched
Network (PSN). PWE3 also emulates the essential attributes of low speed Time Division
Multiplexed (TDM) circuit and SONET/SDH. The simulation approximates to the real
situation.
PSN

See packet switched network

PTN

packet transport network

PW

See pseudo wire

PWE3

See pseudo wire emulation edge-to-edge

Q
QinQ

A layer 2 tunnel protocol based on IEEE 802.1Q encapsulation. It encapsulates the tag
of the user's private virtual local area network (VLAN) into the tag of the public VLAN.
The packet carries two layers of tags to travel through the backbone network of the
carrier. In this manner, the layer 2 virtual private network (VPN) is provided for the user.

QoS

See quality of service

QPSK

See quadrature phase shift keying

quadrature phase shift A modulation method of data transmission through the conversion or modulation and
keying
the phase determination of the reference signals (carrier). It is also called the fourth period
or 4-phase PSK or 4-PSK. QPSK uses four dots in the star diagram. The four dots are
evenly distributed on a circle. On these phases, each QPSK character can perform twobit coding and display the codes in Gray code on graph with the minimum BER.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2027

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

quality of service

C Glossary

A commonly-used performance indicator of a telecommunication system or channel.


Depending on the specific system and service, it may relate to jitter, delay, packet loss
ratio, bit error ratio, and signal-to-noise ratio. It functions to measure the quality of the
transmission system and the effectiveness of the services, as well as the capability of a
service provider to meet the demands of users.

R
radio frequency

A type of electric current in the wireless network using AC antennas to create an


electromagnetic field. It is the abbreviation of high-frequency AC electromagnetic wave.
The AC with the frequency lower than 1 kHz is called low-frequency current. The AC
with frequency higher than 10 kHz is called high-frequency current. RF can be classified
into such high-frequency current.

radio network
controller

A device in the RNS which is in charge of controlling the use and the integrity of the
radio resources.

random early detection A packet loss algorithm used in congestion avoidance. It discards the packet according
to the specified higher limit and lower limit of a queue so that global TCP synchronization
resulted in traditional Tail-Drop can be prevented.
Rapid Spanning Tree
Protocol

An evolution of the Spanning Tree Protocol, providing for faster spanning tree
convergence after a topology change. The RSTP protocol is backward compatible with
the STP protocol.

RDI

See remote defect indication

received signal level

The signal level at a receiver input terminal.

Received Signal
Strength Indicator

The received wide band power, including thermal noise and noise generated in the
receiver, within the bandwidth defined by the receiver pulse shaping filter, for TDD
within a specified timeslot. The reference point for the measurement shall be the antenna

Receiver Sensitivity

Receiver sensitivity is defined as the minimum acceptable value of average received


power at point R to achieve a 1 x 10-12 BER (The FEC is open).

RED

See random early detection

Reed-Solomon-Code

A forward error correction code located before interleaving that enables correction of
errors induced by burst noise. Widely used error correction scheme to fight transmission
errors at the receiver site.

REI

See remote error indication

remote defect
indication

A signal transmitted at the first opportunity in the outgoing direction when a terminal
detects specific defects in the incoming signal.

remote error indication A remote error indication (REI) is sent upstream to signal an error condition. There are
two types of REI alarms: Remote error indication line (REI-L) is sent to the upstream
LTE when errors are detected in the B2 byte. Remote error indication path (REI-P) is
sent to the upstream PTE when errors are detected in the B3 byte.
Request For Comments A document in which a standard, a protocol, or other information pertaining to the
operation of the Internet is published. The RFC is actually issued, under the control of
the IAB, after discussion and serves as the standard. RFCs can be obtained from sources
such as InterNIC.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2028

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

Resource Reservation
Protocol

The Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP) is designed for Integrated Service and is
used to reserve resources on every node along a path. RSVP operates on the transport
layer; however, RSVP does not transport application data. RSVP is a network control
protocol like Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP).

reverse pressure

A traffic control method. In telecommunication, when detecting that the transmit end
transmits a large volume of traffic, the receive end sends signals to ask the transmit end
to slow down the transmission rate.

RF

See radio frequency

RFC

See Request For Comments

RIP

See Routing Information Protocol

RMON

remote network monitoring

RMON

remote network monitoring

RNC

See radio network controller

Root alarm

An alarm directly caused by anomaly events or faults in the network. Some lower-level
alarms always accompany a root alarm.

route

A route is the path that network traffic takes from its source to its destination. In a TCP/
IP network, each IP packet is routed independently. Routes can change dynamically.

route table

A mapping table that stores the relationship between the original address, destination
address, short message (SM) protocol type and account. The SMSC delivers an SM to
the designated account according to the information set in the route table.

Routing Information
Protocol

A simple routing protocol that is part of the TCP/IP protocol suite. It determines a route
based on the smallest hop count between source and destination. RIP is a distance vector
protocol that routinely broadcasts routing information to its neighboring routers and is
known to waste bandwidth.

routing table

A table that stores and updates the locations (addresses) of network devices. Routers
regularly share routing table information to be up to date. A router relies on the
destination address and on the information in the table that gives the possible routes--in
hops or in number of jumps--between itself, intervening routers, and the destination.
Routing tables are updated frequently as new information is available.

RSL

See received signal level

RSSI

See Received Signal Strength Indicator

RSTP

See Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol

RSVP

See Resource Reservation Protocol

RTN

radio transmission node

S
SD

See space diversity

SDH

See synchronous digital hierarchy

SEMF

See synchronous equipment management function

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2029

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

service level agreement A service contract between a customer and a service provider that specifies the
forwarding service a customer should receive. A customer may be a user organization
(source domain) or another differentiated services domain (upstream domain). A SLA
may include traffic conditioning rules which constitute a traffic conditioning agreement
as a whole or partially.
Service Level
Agreement *

A management-documented agreement that defines the relationship between service


provider and its customer. It also provides specific, quantifiable information about
measuring and evaluating the delivery of services. The SLA details the specific operating
and support requirements for each service provided. It protects the service provider and
customer and allows the service provider to provide evidence that it has achieved the
documented target measure.

SES

See severely errored second

Setup Priority

The priority of the tunnel with respect to obtaining resources, ranging from 0 (indicates
the highest priority) to 7. It is used to determine whether the tunnel can preempt the
resources required by other backup tunnels.

severely errored second A one-second period which has a bit error ratio X 10-3 or at least one defect. Time
interval of one second during which a given digital signal is received with an error ratio
greater than 1 X 10 -3 (Rec. ITU R F. 592 needs correction).
SF

See signal fail

SFP

See small form-factor pluggable

side trough

The trough on the side of the cable rack, which is used to place nuts so as to fix the
cabinet.

signal cable

Common signal cables cover the E1 cable, network cable, and other non-subscriber
signal cable.

signal fail

A signal that indicates the associated data has failed in the sense that a near-end defect
condition (non-degrade defect) is active.

signal to noise ratio

The ratio of the amplitude of the desired signal to the amplitude of noise signals at a
given point in time. SNR is expressed as 10 times the logarithm of the power ratio and
is usually expressed in dB (Decibel).

Simple Network
Management Protocol

A network management protocol of TCP/IP. It enables remote users to view and modify
the management information of a network element. This protocol ensures the
transmission of management information between any two points. The polling
mechanism is adopted to provide basic function sets. According to SNMP, agents, which
can be hardware as well as software, can monitor the activities of various devices on the
network and report these activities to the network console workstation. Control
information about each device is maintained by a management information block.

simplex

Designating or pertaining to a method of operation in which information can be


transmitted in either direction, but not simultaneously, between two points.

SLA

See service level agreement

SLA*

See Service Level Agreement *

Slicing

To divide data into the information units proper for transmission.

small form-factor
pluggable

A specification for a new generation of optical modular transceivers.

SNC

See subnetwork connection

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2030

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

SNCP

See subnetwork connection protection

SNMP

See Simple Network Management Protocol

SNR

See signal to noise ratio

space diversity

A diversity scheme that enables two or more antennas separated by a specific distance
to transmit/receive the same signal and selection is then performed between the two
signals to ease the impact of fading. Currently, only receive SD is used.

Spanning Tree Protocol STP is a protocol that is used in the LAN to remove the loop. STP applies to the redundant
network to block some undesirable redundant paths through certain algorithms and prune
a loop network into a loop-free tree network.
SSM

See Synchronization Status Message

static virtual circuit

Static virtual circuit. A static implementation of MPLS L2VPN that transfers L2VPN
information by manual configuration of VC labels, instead of by a signaling protocol.

Statistical multiplexing A multiplexing technique whereby information from multiple logical channels can be
transmitted across a single physical channel. It dynamically allocates bandwidth only to
active input channels, to make better use of available bandwidth and allow more devices
to be connected than with other multiplexing techniques. Compare with TDM.
STM

See Synchronous Transport Module

STM-1

See synchronous transport mode-1

STM-N

See synchronous transport module of order N

STP

See Spanning Tree Protocol

sub-network

Sub-network is the logical entity in the transmission network and comprises a group of
network management objects. The network that consists of a group of interconnected or
correlated NEs, according to different functions. For example, protection subnet, clock
subnet and so on. A sub-network can contain NEs and other sub-networks. Generally, a
sub-network is used to contain the equipment located in adjacent regions and closely
related with one another, and it is indicated with a sub-network icon on a topological
view. The U2000 supports multilevels of sub-networks. A sub-network planning can
better the organization of a network view. On the one hand, the view space can be saved,
on the other hand, it helps the network management personnel focus on the equipment
under their management.

subnet mask

The technique used by the IP protocol to determine which network segment packets are
destined for. The subnet mask is a binary pattern that is stored in the client machine,
server or router and is matched with the IP address.

subnetwork connection A "transport entity" that transfers information across a subnetwork, it is formed by the
association of "ports" on the boundary of the subnetwork.
subnetwork connection A function, which allows a working subnetwork connection to be replaced by a protection
protection
subnetwork connection if the working subnetwork connection fails, or if its performance
falls below a required level.
SVC

See static virtual circuit

switch

To filter, forward frames based on label or the destination address of each frame. This
behavior operates at the data link layer of the OSI model.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2031

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

Synchronization Status A message that carries quality levels of timing signals on a synchronous timing link.
Message
Nodes on an SDH network and a synchronization network acquire upstream clock
information through this message. Then the nodes can perform proper operations on their
clocks, such as tracing, switching, or converting to holdoff, and forward the
synchronization information to downstream nodes.
synchronous digital
hierarchy

A transmission scheme that follows ITU-T G.707, G.708, and G.709. It defines the
transmission features of digital signals such as frame structure, multiplexing mode,
transmission rate level, and interface code. SDH is an important part of ISDN and BISDN. It interleaves the bytes of low-speed signals to multiplex the signals to high-speed
counterparts, and the line coding of scrambling is used only for signals. SDH is suitable
for the fiber communication system with high speed and a large capacity since it uses
synchronous multiplexing and flexible mapping structure.

synchronous
equipment
management function

The SEMF converts performance data and implementation specific hardware alarms into
object-oriented messages for transmission over DCCs and/or a Q interface.

synchronous transport Synchronous Transfer Mode at 155 Mbit/s.


mode-1
Synchronous
Transport Module

An STM is the information structure used to support section layer connections in the
SDH. It consists of information payload and Section Overhead (SOH) information fields
organized in a block frame structure which repeats every 125. The information is suitably
conditioned for serial transmission on the selected media at a rate which is synchronized
to the network. A basic STM is defined at 155 520 kbit/s. This is termed STM-1. Higher
capacity STMs are formed at rates equivalent to N times this basic rate. STM capacities
for N = 4, N = 16 and N = 64 are defined; higher values are under consideration.

synchronous transport A STM-N is the information structure used to support section layer connections in SDH.
See ITU-T Recommendation G. 707 for STM modules of order 1, 4, 16 and 64.
module of order N

T
tail drop

A type of QoS. When a queue within a network router reaches its maximum length,
packet drops can occur. When a packet drop occurs, connection-based protocols such as
TCP slow down their transmission rates in an attempt to let queued packets be serviced,
thereby letting the queue empty. This is also known as tail drop because packets are
dropped from the input end (tail) of the queue.

Tail drop

A congestion management mechanism, in which packets arrive later are discarded when
the queue is full. This policy of discarding packets may result in network-wide
synchronization due to the TCP slow startup mechanism.

TCI

tag control information

TCP

See Transmission Control Protocol

TDM

See time division multiplexing

TE

See traffic engineering

TEDB

See traffic engineering database

Telecommunication
A protocol model defined by ITU-T for managing open systems in a communications
Management Network network. An architecture for management, including planning, provisioning, installation,
maintenance, operation and administration of telecommunications equipment, networks
and services.
Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2032

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

TIM

trace identifier mismatch

time division
multiplexing

A multiplexing technology. TDM divides the sampling cycle of a channel into time slots
(TSn, n=0, 1, 2, 3, ...), and the sampling value codes of multiple signals engross time
slots in a certain order, forming multiple multiplexing digital signals to be transmitted
over one channel.

time to live

A technique used in best-effort delivery systems to prevent packets that loop endlessly.
The TTL is set by the sender to the maximum time the packet is allowed to be in the
network. Each router in the network decrements the TTL field when the packet arrives,
and discards any packet if the TTL counter reaches zero.

TMN

See Telecommunication Management Network

ToS priority

A ToS sub-field (the bits 0 to 2 in the ToS field) in the ToS field of the IP packet header.

TPS

See tributary protection switch

traffic engineering

A technology that is used to dynamically monitor the traffic of the network and the load
of the network elements, to adjust in real time the parameters such as traffic management
parameters, route parameters and resource restriction parameters, and to optimize the
utilization of network resources. The purpose is to prevent the congestion caused by
unbalanced loads.

traffic engineering
database

TEDB is the abbreviation of the traffic engineering database. MPLS TE needs to know
the features of the dynamic TE of every links by expanding the current IGP, which uses
the link state algorithm, such as OSPF and IS-IS. The expanded OSPF and IS-IS contain
some TE features, such as the link bandwidth and color. The maximum reserved
bandwidth of the link and the unreserved bandwidth of every link with priority are rather
important. Every router collects the information about TE of every links in its area and
generates TE DataBase. TEDB is the base of forming the dynamic TE path in the MPLS
TE network.

Traffic shaping

It is a way of controlling the network traffic from a computer to optimize or guarantee


the performance and minimize the delay. It actively adjusts the output speed of traffic
in the scenario that the traffic matches network resources provided by the lower layer
devices, avoiding packet loss and congestion.

Transmission Control
Protocol

The protocol within TCP/IP that governs the breakup of data messages into packets to
be sent via IP (Internet Protocol), and the reassembly and verification of the complete
messages from packets received by IP. A connection-oriented, reliable protocol (reliable
in the sense of ensuring error-free delivery), TCP corresponds to the transport layer in
the ISO/OSI reference model.

tributary protection
switch

Tributary protection switching, a function provided by the equipment, is intended to


protect N tributary processing boards through a standby tributary processing board.

trTCM

See two rate three color marker

TTL

See time to live

TU

tributary unit

Tunnel

A channel on the packet switching network that transmits service traffic between PEs.
In VPN, a tunnel is an information transmission channel between two entities. The tunnel
ensures secure and transparent transmission of VPN information. In most cases, a tunnel
is an MPLS tunnel.

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2033

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

two rate three color


marker

C Glossary

The trTCM meters an IP packet stream and marks its packets based on two rates, Peak
Information Rate (PIR) and Committed Information Rate (CIR), and their associated
burst sizes to be either green, yellow, or red. A packet is marked red if it exceeds the
PIR. Otherwise it is marked either yellow or green depending on whether it exceeds or
doesn't exceed the CIR.

C.6 U-Z
This section provides the terms starting with letters U to Z.

U
U-VLAN

A VLAN attribute indicating that the current VLAN is a user VLAN of an M-VLAN.
Multicast services are copied from the M-VLAN to the user VLAN.

UAS

unavailable second

UBR

See unspecified bit rate

UDP

See User Datagram Protocol

underfloor cabling

The cables connected cabinets and other devices are routed underfloor.

UNI

See user network interface

unicast

The process of sending data from a source to a single recipient.

unspecified bit rate

No commitment to transmission. No feedback to congestion. This type of service is ideal


for the transmission of IP datagrams. In case of congestion, UBR cells are discarded,
and no feedback or request for slowing down the data rate is delivered to the sender.

upload

An operation to report some or all configuration data of an NE to the NMS(Network


Management system). The configuration data then covers the configuration data stored
at the NMS side.

User Datagram
Protocol

A TCP/IP standard protocol that allows an application program on one device to send a
datagram to an application program on another. User Datagram Protocol (UDP) uses IP
to deliver datagrams. UDP provides application programs with the unreliable
connectionless packet delivery service. Therefore, UDP messages can be lost, duplicated,
delayed, or delivered out of order. UDP is used to try to transmit the data packet, that is,
the destination device does not actively confirm whether the correct data packet is
received.

user network interface The interface between user equipment and private or public network equipment (for
example, ATM switches).

V
V-UNI

See virtual user-network interface

variable bit rate

One of the traffic classes used by ATM (Asynchronous Transfer Mode). Unlike a
permanent CBR (Constant Bit Rate) channel, a VBR data stream varies in bandwidth
and is better suited to non real time transfers than to real-time streams such as voice calls.

VBR

See variable bit rate

VC

See virtual container

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2034

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

VCC

See virtual channel connection

VCG

See virtual concatenation group

VCI

See virtual channel identifier

VCTRUNK

A virtual concatenation group applied in data service mapping, also called the internal
port of a data service processing board

virtual channel
connection

The VC logical trail that carries data between two end points in an ATM network. A
logical grouping of multiple virtual channel connections into one virtual connection.

virtual channel
identifier

A 16-bit field in the header of an ATM cell. The VCI, together with the VPI, is used to
identify the next destination of a cell as it passes through a series of ATM switches on
its way to its destination.

virtual concatenation
group

A group of co-located member trail termination functions that are connected to the same
virtual concatenation link

virtual container

The information structure used to support path layer connections in the SDH. It consists
of information payload and path Overhead (POH) information fields organized in a block
frame structure which repeats every 125 or 500 s.

virtual local area


network

A logical grouping of two or more nodes which are not necessarily on the same physical
network segment but which share the same IP network number. This is often associated
with switched Ethernet.

virtual path identifier

The field in the Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) cell header that identifies to which
virtual path the cell belongs.

virtual private LAN


service

A type of point-to-multipoint L2VPN service provided over the public network. VPLS
enables geographically isolated user sites to communicate with each other through the
MAN/WAN as if they are on the same LAN.

virtual private network A system configuration, where the subscriber is able to build a private network via
connections to different network switches that may include private network capabilities.
virtual route forward

VRF performs the function of establishing multiple virtual routing devices on one actual
routing device. That is, the L3 interfaces of the device are distributed to different VRFs,
performing the function of establishing multiple virtual route forwarding instances on
the device.

virtual user-network
interface

A virtual user-network interface, works as an action point to perform service


classification and traffic control in HQoS.

VLAN

See virtual local area network

voice over IP

An IP telephony term for a set of facilities used to manage the delivery of voice
information over the Internet. VoIP involves sending voice information in a digital form
in discrete packets rather than by using the traditional circuit-committed protocols of the
public switched telephone network (PSTN).

VoIP

See voice over IP

VPI

See virtual path identifier

VPLS

See virtual private LAN service

VPN

See virtual private network

VRF

See virtual route forward

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2035

OptiX RTN 980 Radio Transmission System


Configuration Guide (U2000)

C Glossary

W
wait to restore

The number of minutes to wait before services are switched back to the working line.

WAN

See wide area network

Web LCT

The local maintenance terminal of a transport network, which is located on the NE


management layer of the transport network

weighted fair queuing

A fair queue scheduling algorithm based on bandwidth allocation weights. This


scheduling algorithm allocates the total bandwidth of an interface to queues, according
to their weights and schedules the queues cyclically. In this manner, packets of all priority
queues can be scheduled.

weighted random early A packet loss algorithm used for congestion avoidance. It can prevent the global TCP
detection
synchronization caused by traditional tail-drop. WRED is favorable for the high-priority
packet when calculating the packet loss ratio.
weighted round Robin N/A
WFQ

See weighted fair queuing

wide area network

A network composed of computers which are far away from each other which are
physically connected through specific protocols. WAN covers a broad area, such as a
province, a state or even a country.

winding pipe

A tool for fiber routing, which acts as the corrugated pipe.

WRED

See weighted random early detection

WRR

See weighted round Robin

WTR

See wait to restore

X
XPIC

Issue 01 (2011-10-30)

See cross polarization interference cancellation

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential


Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2036

You might also like